Factory Workshop Manual
Make
Ford
Model
Expedition 2wd
Engine and year
V8-5.4L (2009)
Please navigate through the PDF using the options
provided by OnlyManuals.com on the sidebar.
This manual was submitted by
Anonymous
Date
1st January 2018
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory
Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory
Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 8
Accessory Delay Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory
Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 9
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna
Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Antenna Control Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 13
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 14
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 15
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Communications Control Module: > 10-2-8 > Feb > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Defaults To 'Privacy Mode'
Communications Control Module: Customer Interest SYNC(R) System - Defaults To 'Privacy Mode'
TSB 10-2-8
02/15/10
SYNC SYSTEM DEFAULTS TO OR STAYS IN PRIVACY MODE, MULTIPLE VEHICLE LINES
FORD: 2008-2009 Taurus X 2008-2010 Focus, Fusion, Mustang, Taurus, Edge, Escape,
Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer, F-150, F-250, F-350, F-450 2009-2010 Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2010 MKZ 2009-2010 MKS 2008 Mark LT 2008-2010 MKX, Navigator 2010 MKT
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable 2008-2010 Milan, Mariner, Mountaineer
ISSUE Some customers of 2008-2010 SYNC-equipped vehicles may express concern with their
SYNC paired device defaulting, switching or staying on privacy mode. The customer may not be
able to accept the call through the SYNC system or must answer the call manually on their
personal device.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Set the Privacy mode to Off on the device and recheck Sync operation.
2. If necessary, test the device on another vehicle with the same version SYNC. If the concern is
still present, the device is the concern. Continue with
normal WSM Diagnostics.
NOTE
PRIVACY MODE MEANS THAT THE PHONE IS CONTROLLING THE AUDIO. SYNC ONLY
MAKES REQUESTS TO THE PHONE TO TRANSFER THIS RESPONSIBILITY OR AUDIO TO
SYNC. IF THE PHONE DOES NOT ACCEPT THIS REQUEST OR THERE IS A PROBLEM IN
THE COMMUNICATION TO MAKE THIS HAPPEN, YOU ARE BY DEFAULT IN PRIVACY MODE.
WARRANTY STATUS: Information Only
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Communications Control Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns
Communications Control Module: Customer Interest SYNC(R) System - Software Update For
Various Concerns
TSB 09-26-8
01/04/10
SYNC SOFTWARE UPDATE - VARIOUS ISSUES
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 9-22-14 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2008 and 2009 SYNC® equipped vehicles may exhibit one or more of the following
symptoms:
^ Universal Serial Bus (USB) port inoperative.
^ USB audio muting when using various non-Apple USB devices.
^ Phone book access difficulty on certain 2-digit phone book entries when using voice commands.
^ Excessive background noise and/or poor voice sound quality.
^ Phone book auto download inoperative on supported devices.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative intermittently.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Reprogram the accessory protocol inter[ace module (APIM) to the following consumer inter[ace
processor (CIP) software levels.
^ 9L3T-14D544-AE (vehicles not equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health Report)
^ 9L2T-14D544-BE (vehicles already equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health
Report)
Service Pack files may be obtained at www.syncmyride.com.
Reprogram the APIM
Contains software fix updates for the following:
^ Phone book auto download inoperative.
^ USB audio muting.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative.
^ Voice recognition on 2-digit entries.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Communications Control Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns >
Page 28
^ USB port inoperative with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B1342.
^ Poor call sound quality.
This software update also contains enhancements that will improve the reliability of both Bluetooth
and USB connections to SYNC(R) from various consumer devices, and microphone enhancements
to reduce background noise, and will default Vehicle Health Report (if equipped) to off. The
Bluetooth enhancements improve the stability of hands-free calls, call waiting, caller ID, multiple
call handling and other mobile phone features. The USB enhancements improve support for media
players and the playing of file formats and podcasts.
NOTE
REFERENCE OTHER TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETINS (TSB) FOR ADDITIONAL SYNC
SOFTWARE PROGRAMMING TIPS.
1. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
2. Connect the VCM to the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) tool or laptop running IDS software.
3. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
4. Launch IDS tool.
5. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
6. Close the IDS tool.
7. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN & DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO button.
8. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
9. Press read APIM button.
10. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
11. Program both processors in the APIM (Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and CIP).
NOTE
DO NOT USE A MALE-TO-MALE USB DATA TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
a. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software and
to the vehicle USB port.
b. Follow the on-screen instructions to program both processors on the Sync module (VIP and
CIP).
12. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
13. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 08-21-02
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092608A 2008-2009 Edge, Explorer, 0.4 Hr.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Communications Control Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns >
Page 29
Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac, Focus, Fusion, Milan, MKX, MKZ, Sable, Navigator, Taurus,
Taurus X, 2009 Expedition, Escape, Escape Hybrid, Mariner, Mariner Hybrid, F-150, F-Super Duty,
Flex, MKS: Reprogram The APIM (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Communications Control Module: > 09-14-3 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set
Communications Control Module: Customer Interest SYNC(R) System - Functions
Inoperative/DTC's Set
TSB 09-14-3
07/27/09
SYNC FUNCTIONS INOPERATIVE, DTC U3000-41, U0485, OR U0100, AND/OR BATTERY
DRAW WITH ACCESSORY PROTOCOL INTERFACE MODULE CONNECTED
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Taurus X, Taurus 2008-2010 Fusion 2010 Mustang 2008-2009 Edge,
Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009 Escape Hybrid, Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 Zephyr 2008-2010 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable 2008-2010 Milan 2008-2009 Mountaineer 2009 Mariner Hybrid,
Mariner
ISSUE Some 2008-2010 vehicles equipped with SYNC version 2 software level, SYNC 911 Assist
and Vehicle Health Report, may exhibit all or most of the following symptoms:
^ Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC) U3000-41, U0485, or U0100 in Accessory Protocol Interface
Module (APIM)
^ SYNC display menus/options blank
^ USB port inoperative
^ No SYNC Blue Tooth device connectivity
^ Voice/Phone/OK steering wheel controls inoperative
^ Lack of APIM communication
^ Parasitic battery draw with APIM connected
These symptoms may be triggered by a low battery state of charge, or a recent battery
disconnect/reconnect.
ACTION Follow the service procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
This software upgrade only applies to the following Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and Customer Interface Processor (CIP) software levels:
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AC / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BC
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AD / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BD
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AE / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BD
To determine the current APIM software level, reference the Professional Technician Society (PTS)
website, enter the VIN in OASIS, click the GO
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Communications Control Module: > 09-14-3 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set > Page 34
button and select the SYNC button.
1. Determine if communication can be established with the APIM using IDS.
a. If communication cannot be verified, proceed to Step 2.
b. If communication is present, proceed to Step 3.
2. Reference Workshop Manual, Section 418-00, Module Communication Network to determine if
communication can be established. If not, perform
an APIM power reset by disconnecting and reconnecting the vehicle battery.
a. If communication is now present, proceed to Step 3.
b. If communication still cannot be established, replace the APIM.
3. Reprogram the APIM to VIP software level 9L2T-14D205-AF by following the Service Procedure.
NOTE
SOFTWARE IS AVAILABLE ONLY THROUGH THE PTS WEBSITE, AND NOT AVAILABLE
THROUGH THE SYNCMYRIDE.COM WEBSITE.
NOTE
CONFIGURATION AND PROGRAMMING REQUIRES THE USE OF A SPECIAL PTS
APPLICATION. INSTALLER MUST HAVE ACCESS TO PTS AND HAVE A VALID PTS USER ID
AND PASSWORD.
a. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
b. Connect the VCM to the IDS tool or laptop running IDS software.
c. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
d. Launch IDS tool.
e. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
f. Close the IDS tool.
g. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN And DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO
button.
h. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
i. Press read APIM button.
j. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMU5B2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT USE A TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
k. Program the processor in the APIM.
l. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMU5B2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software, and to the vehicle USB port.
m. Follow the on-screen instructions to program the VIP module.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Communications Control Module: > 09-14-3 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set > Page 35
n. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
o. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT091403 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Communications Control Module: > 10-2-8 > Feb > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Defaults To 'Privacy Mode'
Communications Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins SYNC(R) System - Defaults To
'Privacy Mode'
TSB 10-2-8
02/15/10
SYNC SYSTEM DEFAULTS TO OR STAYS IN PRIVACY MODE, MULTIPLE VEHICLE LINES
FORD: 2008-2009 Taurus X 2008-2010 Focus, Fusion, Mustang, Taurus, Edge, Escape,
Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer, F-150, F-250, F-350, F-450 2009-2010 Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2010 MKZ 2009-2010 MKS 2008 Mark LT 2008-2010 MKX, Navigator 2010 MKT
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable 2008-2010 Milan, Mariner, Mountaineer
ISSUE Some customers of 2008-2010 SYNC-equipped vehicles may express concern with their
SYNC paired device defaulting, switching or staying on privacy mode. The customer may not be
able to accept the call through the SYNC system or must answer the call manually on their
personal device.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Set the Privacy mode to Off on the device and recheck Sync operation.
2. If necessary, test the device on another vehicle with the same version SYNC. If the concern is
still present, the device is the concern. Continue with
normal WSM Diagnostics.
NOTE
PRIVACY MODE MEANS THAT THE PHONE IS CONTROLLING THE AUDIO. SYNC ONLY
MAKES REQUESTS TO THE PHONE TO TRANSFER THIS RESPONSIBILITY OR AUDIO TO
SYNC. IF THE PHONE DOES NOT ACCEPT THIS REQUEST OR THERE IS A PROBLEM IN
THE COMMUNICATION TO MAKE THIS HAPPEN, YOU ARE BY DEFAULT IN PRIVACY MODE.
WARRANTY STATUS: Information Only
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Communications Control Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns
Communications Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins SYNC(R) System - Software
Update For Various Concerns
TSB 09-26-8
01/04/10
SYNC SOFTWARE UPDATE - VARIOUS ISSUES
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 9-22-14 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2008 and 2009 SYNC® equipped vehicles may exhibit one or more of the following
symptoms:
^ Universal Serial Bus (USB) port inoperative.
^ USB audio muting when using various non-Apple USB devices.
^ Phone book access difficulty on certain 2-digit phone book entries when using voice commands.
^ Excessive background noise and/or poor voice sound quality.
^ Phone book auto download inoperative on supported devices.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative intermittently.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Reprogram the accessory protocol inter[ace module (APIM) to the following consumer inter[ace
processor (CIP) software levels.
^ 9L3T-14D544-AE (vehicles not equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health Report)
^ 9L2T-14D544-BE (vehicles already equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health
Report)
Service Pack files may be obtained at www.syncmyride.com.
Reprogram the APIM
Contains software fix updates for the following:
^ Phone book auto download inoperative.
^ USB audio muting.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative.
^ Voice recognition on 2-digit entries.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Communications Control Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns >
Page 45
^ USB port inoperative with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B1342.
^ Poor call sound quality.
This software update also contains enhancements that will improve the reliability of both Bluetooth
and USB connections to SYNC(R) from various consumer devices, and microphone enhancements
to reduce background noise, and will default Vehicle Health Report (if equipped) to off. The
Bluetooth enhancements improve the stability of hands-free calls, call waiting, caller ID, multiple
call handling and other mobile phone features. The USB enhancements improve support for media
players and the playing of file formats and podcasts.
NOTE
REFERENCE OTHER TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETINS (TSB) FOR ADDITIONAL SYNC
SOFTWARE PROGRAMMING TIPS.
1. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
2. Connect the VCM to the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) tool or laptop running IDS software.
3. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
4. Launch IDS tool.
5. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
6. Close the IDS tool.
7. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN & DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO button.
8. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
9. Press read APIM button.
10. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
11. Program both processors in the APIM (Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and CIP).
NOTE
DO NOT USE A MALE-TO-MALE USB DATA TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
a. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software and
to the vehicle USB port.
b. Follow the on-screen instructions to program both processors on the Sync module (VIP and
CIP).
12. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
13. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 08-21-02
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092608A 2008-2009 Edge, Explorer, 0.4 Hr.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Communications Control Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns >
Page 46
Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac, Focus, Fusion, Milan, MKX, MKZ, Sable, Navigator, Taurus,
Taurus X, 2009 Expedition, Escape, Escape Hybrid, Mariner, Mariner Hybrid, F-150, F-Super Duty,
Flex, MKS: Reprogram The APIM (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Communications Control Module: > 09-14-3 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set
Communications Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins SYNC(R) System - Functions
Inoperative/DTC's Set
TSB 09-14-3
07/27/09
SYNC FUNCTIONS INOPERATIVE, DTC U3000-41, U0485, OR U0100, AND/OR BATTERY
DRAW WITH ACCESSORY PROTOCOL INTERFACE MODULE CONNECTED
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Taurus X, Taurus 2008-2010 Fusion 2010 Mustang 2008-2009 Edge,
Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009 Escape Hybrid, Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 Zephyr 2008-2010 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable 2008-2010 Milan 2008-2009 Mountaineer 2009 Mariner Hybrid,
Mariner
ISSUE Some 2008-2010 vehicles equipped with SYNC version 2 software level, SYNC 911 Assist
and Vehicle Health Report, may exhibit all or most of the following symptoms:
^ Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC) U3000-41, U0485, or U0100 in Accessory Protocol Interface
Module (APIM)
^ SYNC display menus/options blank
^ USB port inoperative
^ No SYNC Blue Tooth device connectivity
^ Voice/Phone/OK steering wheel controls inoperative
^ Lack of APIM communication
^ Parasitic battery draw with APIM connected
These symptoms may be triggered by a low battery state of charge, or a recent battery
disconnect/reconnect.
ACTION Follow the service procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
This software upgrade only applies to the following Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and Customer Interface Processor (CIP) software levels:
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AC / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BC
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AD / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BD
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AE / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BD
To determine the current APIM software level, reference the Professional Technician Society (PTS)
website, enter the VIN in OASIS, click the GO
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Communications Control Module: > 09-14-3 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set > Page 51
button and select the SYNC button.
1. Determine if communication can be established with the APIM using IDS.
a. If communication cannot be verified, proceed to Step 2.
b. If communication is present, proceed to Step 3.
2. Reference Workshop Manual, Section 418-00, Module Communication Network to determine if
communication can be established. If not, perform
an APIM power reset by disconnecting and reconnecting the vehicle battery.
a. If communication is now present, proceed to Step 3.
b. If communication still cannot be established, replace the APIM.
3. Reprogram the APIM to VIP software level 9L2T-14D205-AF by following the Service Procedure.
NOTE
SOFTWARE IS AVAILABLE ONLY THROUGH THE PTS WEBSITE, AND NOT AVAILABLE
THROUGH THE SYNCMYRIDE.COM WEBSITE.
NOTE
CONFIGURATION AND PROGRAMMING REQUIRES THE USE OF A SPECIAL PTS
APPLICATION. INSTALLER MUST HAVE ACCESS TO PTS AND HAVE A VALID PTS USER ID
AND PASSWORD.
a. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
b. Connect the VCM to the IDS tool or laptop running IDS software.
c. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
d. Launch IDS tool.
e. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
f. Close the IDS tool.
g. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN And DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO
button.
h. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
i. Press read APIM button.
j. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMU5B2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT USE A TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
k. Program the processor in the APIM.
l. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMU5B2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software, and to the vehicle USB port.
m. Follow the on-screen instructions to program the VIP module.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Communications Control Module: > 09-14-3 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set > Page 52
n. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
o. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT091403 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Communications Control Module: Locations Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) >
Page 55
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) >
Page 56
Communications Control Module: Locations Audio Control Module (ACM)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) >
Page 57
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) >
Page 58
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Communications Control Module: Diagrams Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) >
Page 61
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) >
Page 62
Communications Control Module: Diagrams Audio Control Module (ACM)
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) >
Page 63
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) >
Page 64
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) >
Page 65
Communications Control Module: Diagrams Audio Digital Signal Processing (DSP) Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) >
Page 66
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) >
Page 67
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Communications Control Module: Procedures
Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) Software Level Check
Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) Software Level Check
NOTE: This procedure applies to checking the Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
software level. To program the APIM, refer to Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Programming in Information Bus. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Information Bus/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Accessory Protocol
Interface Module (APIM) Programming
1. Turn the Audio Control Module (ACM) on.
2. Connect the scan tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC).
3. Connect one end of the Universal Serial Bus (USB) male-A to male-A cable to the scan tool.
4. Connect the other end of the USB male-A to male-A cable to the vehicle USB port.
5. From the technician service publication website, run On-Line Automotive Service Information
System (OASIS) using Quick Start or by manually
entering the Vehicle Identification Number (VIN).
6. From the OASIS tab, select the "Sync/APIM" bullet.
7. Select the "Read APIM" button to verify the current APIM software level.
- The display shows both the Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and Consumer Interface Processor
(CIP) software levels.
8. The scan tool displays the following information:
- Last Recorded State - Hardware VIN: vehicle identification number associated with the current APIM
- Installed date: date the APIM was installed
- Radio: currently identified ACM in the vehicle
- HW Part No.: APIM hardware part number
- Un-installed date: date (if any) the APIM was uninstalled
- S/N: APIM serial number
- Last Recorded State - Software Date/Time: date and time of last recorded software installation
- VIP: VIP software that was installed at that time
- CIP: CIP software that was installed at that time
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 70
- Description: a description of the content of the software revision
- History - Software Date/Time: date and time of any recorded software installation
- VIP: VIP software that was installed at that time
- CIP: CIP software that was installed at that time
- Description: a description of the content of the software revision
- Available Software for Programming Select: allows the software package to be selected
- Lineage: the original software release, if the software available is a revision
- VIP: VIP software level that is available with the selection
- CIP: CIP software level that is available with the selection
- Description: a description of the content of the software revision
9. Click a CIP software level to view the device compatibility list associated with the CIP software
level, if desired.
10. To exit the APIM software level check, disconnect the scan tool from the DLC and the USB
port, or exit the OASIS screen.
Audio Control Module (ACM) Self-Diagnostic Mode
Audio Control Module (ACM) Self-Diagnostic Mode
Audio Systems Without Navigation
1. Turn the Audio Control Module (ACM) on.
2. Operate the audio system in radio tuner (AM/FM) mode.
3. Press and hold preset buttons 3 and 6 for 3 seconds until the speaker walk test begins.
- The display indicates each speaker as it is tested.
4. NOTE: If the speaker walk test is the only test required, this procedure can be stopped after Step
3 by turning the ACM off.
Before the speaker walk test is complete, carry out any of the following actions:
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 71
5. To exit the self-diagnostic mode, turn the ACM off.
Satellite Digital Audio Receiver System (SDARS) Module Electronic Serial Number (ESN) Retrieval
- Vehicles Without Navigation
1. Operate the audio system in satellite radio mode.
2. Press and hold the AUX button and preset button 1, simultaneously.
- The Satellite Digital Audio Receiver System (SDARS) module Electronic Serial Number (ESN)
displays on the screen.
3. Record the SDARS module ESN.
4. Turn the audio system off.
Audio Systems With Navigation
1. Turn the Audio Control Module (ACM) on.
2. Operate the audio system in radio tuner (AM/FM) mode.
3. Press and hold preset buttons 3 and 6 for 3 seconds until the speaker walk test begins.
- The display indicates each speaker as it is tested.
4. NOTE: If the speaker walk test is the only test required, this procedure can be stopped after this
step, or by allowing the speaker walk test to
complete on its own.
Before the speaker walk test is complete, press the "End Test" selection.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 72
5. The following tests are available through the "BEZEL DIAGNOSTICS" menu:
6. To exit the self-diagnostic mode, press the "Exit Diagnostics" selection from the "BEZEL
DIAGNOSTICS" menu.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 73
Communications Control Module: Removal and Replacement
Audio Digital Signal Processing (DSP) Module
Audio Digital Signal Processing (DSP) Module
Audio Digital Signal Processing (DSP) Module Lower Attachment
Audio DSP Module Upper Attachment
Audio DSP Module Removal Routing
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 74
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: Module configuration is required when a new audio Digital Signal Processing (DSP)
module is being installed.
Upload the audio DSP module configuration information to the scan tool.
2. Remove the Audio Control Module (ACM). For additional information, refer to Audio Control
Module (ACM) See: Audio Control Module
(ACM).
3. Remove the necessary attachments and move the center console 5 cm (2.0 in) towards the rear
of the vehicle.
4. Disconnect the audio DSP module electrical connectors.
5. Remove the 2 lower audio DSP module nuts.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
6. NOTICE: The audio Digital Signal Processing (DSP) module is heavy. Be sure to support the
amplifier during removal, or damage to the
vehicle may occur.
Remove the 2 upper audio DSP module nuts.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
7. Remove the audio DSP module.
- Route the audio DSP module down and towards the passenger side of the vehicle.
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Download the configuration information to the audio DSP module.
Audio Control Module (ACM)
Audio Control Module (ACM)
NOTE: Expedition without navigation shown, all others similar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 75
Removal and Installation
NOTE: It is not necessary to remove the Audio Control Module (ACM) to retrieve the part number.
For additional information, refer to Audio Control Module (ACM) Self-Diagnostic Mode See:
Procedures/Audio Control Module (ACM) Self-Diagnostic Mode.
1. NOTE: Module configuration is required when a new ACM is being installed.
Upload the ACM configuration information to the scan tool.
2. Remove the instrument panel center finish panel.
3. Remove the 4 screws and the ACM.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors and the antenna cable connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Download the configuration information to the ACM.
Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 76
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: It is necessary to record the current Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
software and hardware level when a new APIM is being
installed to make sure that the new component is the same version as the component being
replaced.
Retrieve and record the current APIM software and hardware level. For additional information, refer
to Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) Software Level Check See: Procedures/Accessory
Protocol Interface Module (APIM) Software Level Check.
2. Remove the front floor console.
3. Remove the 4 APIM screws and position the APIM aside.
4. Disconnect the Universal Serial Bus (USB) cable and the electrical connectors, and remove the
APIM.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- If a new APIM is being installed, program the APIM to the correct software level.
Universal Serial Bus (USB) Cable And Port
Universal Serial Bus (USB) Cable and Port
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the floor console.
2. Remove the rear cupholder trim panel by pulling straight upward to disengage the clips.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Communications Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 77
ERROR: undefined
OFFENDING COMMAND: ‘~
STACK:
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-14-3 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set
Emergency Contact Module: Customer Interest SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's
Set
TSB 09-14-3
07/27/09
SYNC FUNCTIONS INOPERATIVE, DTC U3000-41, U0485, OR U0100, AND/OR BATTERY
DRAW WITH ACCESSORY PROTOCOL INTERFACE MODULE CONNECTED
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Taurus X, Taurus 2008-2010 Fusion 2010 Mustang 2008-2009 Edge,
Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009 Escape Hybrid, Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 Zephyr 2008-2010 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable 2008-2010 Milan 2008-2009 Mountaineer 2009 Mariner Hybrid,
Mariner
ISSUE Some 2008-2010 vehicles equipped with SYNC version 2 software level, SYNC 911 Assist
and Vehicle Health Report, may exhibit all or most of the following symptoms:
^ Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC) U3000-41, U0485, or U0100 in Accessory Protocol Interface
Module (APIM)
^ SYNC display menus/options blank
^ USB port inoperative
^ No SYNC Blue Tooth device connectivity
^ Voice/Phone/OK steering wheel controls inoperative
^ Lack of APIM communication
^ Parasitic battery draw with APIM connected
These symptoms may be triggered by a low battery state of charge, or a recent battery
disconnect/reconnect.
ACTION Follow the service procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
This software upgrade only applies to the following Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and Customer Interface Processor (CIP) software levels:
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AC / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BC
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AD / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BD
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AE / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BD
To determine the current APIM software level, reference the Professional Technician Society (PTS)
website, enter the VIN in OASIS, click the GO
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-14-3 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set > Page 86
button and select the SYNC button.
1. Determine if communication can be established with the APIM using IDS.
a. If communication cannot be verified, proceed to Step 2.
b. If communication is present, proceed to Step 3.
2. Reference Workshop Manual, Section 418-00, Module Communication Network to determine if
communication can be established. If not, perform
an APIM power reset by disconnecting and reconnecting the vehicle battery.
a. If communication is now present, proceed to Step 3.
b. If communication still cannot be established, replace the APIM.
3. Reprogram the APIM to VIP software level 9L2T-14D205-AF by following the Service Procedure.
NOTE
SOFTWARE IS AVAILABLE ONLY THROUGH THE PTS WEBSITE, AND NOT AVAILABLE
THROUGH THE SYNCMYRIDE.COM WEBSITE.
NOTE
CONFIGURATION AND PROGRAMMING REQUIRES THE USE OF A SPECIAL PTS
APPLICATION. INSTALLER MUST HAVE ACCESS TO PTS AND HAVE A VALID PTS USER ID
AND PASSWORD.
a. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
b. Connect the VCM to the IDS tool or laptop running IDS software.
c. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
d. Launch IDS tool.
e. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
f. Close the IDS tool.
g. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN And DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO
button.
h. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
i. Press read APIM button.
j. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMU5B2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT USE A TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
k. Program the processor in the APIM.
l. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMU5B2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software, and to the vehicle USB port.
m. Follow the on-screen instructions to program the VIP module.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-14-3 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set > Page 87
n. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
o. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT091403 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality
Emergency Contact Module: Customer Interest SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality
TSB 09-13-5
07/13/09
SYNC - CALL SOUND QUALITY/BACKGROUND NOISE ISSUES AND/OR VOICE
RECOGNITION DIFFICULTIES WHILE DRIVING
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape Hybrid, Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner Hybrid, Mariner
ISSUE Some customers of 2008-2009 SYNC equipped vehicles may express concern with their
call sound quality while using the SYNC microphone, complaints of excessive background noise
during a phone call, and/or issues with voice recognition accuracy while driving.
ACTION Follow the service procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The following service procedure involves updating the Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
software level and installing an external alternate SYNC microphone attached to the headliner.
NOTE
THIS PROCEDURE DOES NOT APPLY TO DEALER-INSTALLED SYNC SYSTEMS.
Do not perform Step 1 if vehicle is already equipped with SYNC 2.0 (911 and Vehicle Health
Report) or has been upgraded to consumer interface processor (CIP) level 9L3T-14D544-AE. To
determine the current APIM software level, Refer to the Professional Technician Society (PTS)
website, enter the VIN in OASIS, click the GO button, and select the SYNC button.
1. Reprogram the APIM to CIP software level 9L3T-14D544-AE. For additional information Refer to
other SYNC TSB's and WSM, Section 418-01.
Service Pack files may also be obtained at www.syncmyride.com.
When diagnosing a concern related to voice recognition (VR) difficulties, instruct the customer to
test VR functionality while the vehicle is parked. If customer concerns are still present, this
procedure will not yield an improvement, and the service procedure should not be performed.
Instead, Refer to the SYNC supplement guide and www.syncmyride.com for additional VR tips to
assist customer.
The VR experience can be improved with user training and making improvements to the phone
book entries (longer entries make the system more robust). Ensure the customer does not try to
speak too loud or slow and remove any objects hanging on the rear view mirror as this will reduce
system effectiveness.
When diagnosing a concern related to call sound quality, expect marginal improvements for calls
described as speaking in a tunnel, chamber, etc. Expect substantial improvements for complaints
where the call audio seems to drop out intermittently.
NOTE
THIS REPAIR WILL CHANGE THE APPEARANCE OF THE VEHICLE INTERIOR. REFER TO
THE PHOTOGRAPHS FOR THE APPLICABLE VEHICLE LOCATED IN THIS PROCEDURE. DO
NOT PERFORM THIS REPAIR WITHOUT CUSTOMER APPROVAL PRIOR TO PROCEEDING
WITH MICROPHONE INSTALLATION.
2. Install SYNC microphone service kit. Installing the kit includes mounting an external microphone
directly to the headliner and splicing in a jumper
harness to the vehicle's existing wiring harness. The existing SYNC microphone will no longer be
functional.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 92
a. Refer to the appropriate vehicle line and microphone illustration(s) below for microphone
installation and wire splicing locations. Refer to
Wiring Diagram (WD), Section 5-1 for recommended splicing methods.
b. Ensure the SYNC microphone wires are secure and do not interfere with vehicle operation or
functionality.
c. The microphone is directional. Make sure the microphone is always positioned so wire length is
minimized from view. When installing the
microphone adjacent to trim, place microphone as close to trim as possible to help minimize visible
wire.
2008-2009 Edge / MKX
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 1)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable up through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connectors 210 and 211 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for
links to location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C211. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C210.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2009 Escape / Mariner
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 93
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration (Figures 2 and 3). Firmly
press the microphone into place. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead
console trim (if equipped), or positioned directly above A-pillar on headliner if not equipped with an
overhead console. Proceed to Step 5 if not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner to
run microphone cable.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 214 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C214. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD182 (BK-GY) from C214.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD1 82 (BK-GY).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
9. Connect the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Navigator / 2009 Expedition
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 94
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figures 4 and 5)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim (if equipped), or
positioned directly above A-pillar on headliner if not
equipped with an overhead console.
^ Proceed to Step 5 if not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 298 located behind the dash panel on passenger side. Refer to online
WD, Section 124-1 for links to location and connector
views.
6. Identify circuits VMN07 (GY), RMN07 (VT), and DMN07 (shield - BK) from C298. Cut the three
circuits on the male side of the connector
(17C712 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP31 (BU-OG) and GD133 (BK) from C298 (2008 Navigator only). Identify
circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C298
(2009 Expedition/Navigator only).
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP31 (BU-OG) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK)
for 2008 Navigator only. Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness
wire to GD133 (BK) for 2009 Expedition/Navigator only.
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 95
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN07 (GY) and remaining black jumper harness wires to RMN07
(VT) and DMN07 (shield - BK).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Connect the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the headliner.
2008-2009 Explorer / Explorer Sport Trac / Mountaineer
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 6)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner run
microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 248 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify and cut circuits VMNO7 (GY), RMNO7 (VT), and DMNO7 (shield) from C248. Cut the
three circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP05 (YE) and GD143 (BK-VT) from C248.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP05 (YE) and any black jumper harness wire to GD143 (BK-VT).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN07 (GY) and remaining black jumper harness wires to RMN07
(VT) and DMN07 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2009 F-150
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 96
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 7)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim or front lamp.
2. Lower the overhead console or front lamp. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional
information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and temporarily tuck excess wire
into headliner to the rear of the console or lamp.
4. Install overhead console or front lamp; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console or
front lamp trim directly behind microphone as
shown.
5. Gain access to connectors 314 and 315 in roof panel near left hand side. Refer to online WD,
Section 124-1 for links to location and connector
views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C314. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14358 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) from C315 and GD133 (BK) from C314.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the headliner.
2009 F-Super Duty
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 97
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 8)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
c. This repair is not recommended for vehicles not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 264 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield - BK) from C264. Cut the
three circuits on the female side of the connector
(17K745 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C264.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield - BK).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Connect the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2009 Flex
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 98
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 9)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 925 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C925. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector (14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C925.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Focus
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 99
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration (Figure 10). Firmly press
the microphone into place. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to the dome lamp trim.
2. Lower the dome lamp assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable up through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger
side A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop
headliner to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install dome lamp assembly; ensure microphone cable enters the dome lamp trim directly behind
microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 934 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD for location and connector
views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C934. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CPL60 (BN-YE) and GD161 (BK-YE) from C934.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CPL60 (BN-YE) and any black jumper harness wire to GD161
(BK-YE).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Fusion / Milan / MKZ
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 100
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 11)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 913 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C913. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP02 (GN) and GD139 (BK-YE) from C913.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP02 (GN) and any black jumper harness wire to GD139 (BK-YE).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Taurus / Sable / Taurus X
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 12)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner to
run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 101
5. Gain access to connector 925 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMN02 (WH-BN), RMN02 (VT-BN), and DMN07 (shield) from C925. Cut the
three circuits on the female side of the connector
(17K745 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C925.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN02 (WH-BN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMN02 (VT-BN) and DMN07 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2009 MKS
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 13)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and out the front of the headliner
above the rear view mirror.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 911 at the rear view mirror. Refer to the online WD, Section 124-1 for
links to location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMNO2 (WH-BN), RMN02 (VT-BN), and DMN07 (shield) from C911. Pull back
the black harness sleeve and cut the three
circuits near C91 1 or if equipped with a headlamp control module-2 (HCM-2), remove the HCM-2
access cover and cut circuits under trim cover. Refer to WSM, Section 417-01 for additional
information.
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C911.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 102
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN02 (WH-BN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMN02 (VT-BN) and DMN07 (shield).
^ Only splice into the wires heading away from the connector. The wires heading into the connector
(mirror) are no longer used.
^ Ensure the wiring is neatly routed from the splice locations into the headliner, following the
existing wire harness routing from mirror to headliner.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 08-21-2
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT091305 Claim Diagnosis And Labor Actual
Performed As Actual Time. Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
17700 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-14-3 > Jul >
09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins SYNC(R) System - Functions
Inoperative/DTC's Set
TSB 09-14-3
07/27/09
SYNC FUNCTIONS INOPERATIVE, DTC U3000-41, U0485, OR U0100, AND/OR BATTERY
DRAW WITH ACCESSORY PROTOCOL INTERFACE MODULE CONNECTED
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Taurus X, Taurus 2008-2010 Fusion 2010 Mustang 2008-2009 Edge,
Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009 Escape Hybrid, Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 Zephyr 2008-2010 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable 2008-2010 Milan 2008-2009 Mountaineer 2009 Mariner Hybrid,
Mariner
ISSUE Some 2008-2010 vehicles equipped with SYNC version 2 software level, SYNC 911 Assist
and Vehicle Health Report, may exhibit all or most of the following symptoms:
^ Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC) U3000-41, U0485, or U0100 in Accessory Protocol Interface
Module (APIM)
^ SYNC display menus/options blank
^ USB port inoperative
^ No SYNC Blue Tooth device connectivity
^ Voice/Phone/OK steering wheel controls inoperative
^ Lack of APIM communication
^ Parasitic battery draw with APIM connected
These symptoms may be triggered by a low battery state of charge, or a recent battery
disconnect/reconnect.
ACTION Follow the service procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
This software upgrade only applies to the following Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and Customer Interface Processor (CIP) software levels:
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AC / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BC
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AD / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BD
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AE / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BD
To determine the current APIM software level, reference the Professional Technician Society (PTS)
website, enter the VIN in OASIS, click the GO
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-14-3 > Jul >
09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set > Page 108
button and select the SYNC button.
1. Determine if communication can be established with the APIM using IDS.
a. If communication cannot be verified, proceed to Step 2.
b. If communication is present, proceed to Step 3.
2. Reference Workshop Manual, Section 418-00, Module Communication Network to determine if
communication can be established. If not, perform
an APIM power reset by disconnecting and reconnecting the vehicle battery.
a. If communication is now present, proceed to Step 3.
b. If communication still cannot be established, replace the APIM.
3. Reprogram the APIM to VIP software level 9L2T-14D205-AF by following the Service Procedure.
NOTE
SOFTWARE IS AVAILABLE ONLY THROUGH THE PTS WEBSITE, AND NOT AVAILABLE
THROUGH THE SYNCMYRIDE.COM WEBSITE.
NOTE
CONFIGURATION AND PROGRAMMING REQUIRES THE USE OF A SPECIAL PTS
APPLICATION. INSTALLER MUST HAVE ACCESS TO PTS AND HAVE A VALID PTS USER ID
AND PASSWORD.
a. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
b. Connect the VCM to the IDS tool or laptop running IDS software.
c. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
d. Launch IDS tool.
e. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
f. Close the IDS tool.
g. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN And DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO
button.
h. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
i. Press read APIM button.
j. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMU5B2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT USE A TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
k. Program the processor in the APIM.
l. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMU5B2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software, and to the vehicle USB port.
m. Follow the on-screen instructions to program the VIP module.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-14-3 > Jul >
09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set > Page 109
n. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
o. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT091403 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-13-5 > Jul >
09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone
Sound Quality
TSB 09-13-5
07/13/09
SYNC - CALL SOUND QUALITY/BACKGROUND NOISE ISSUES AND/OR VOICE
RECOGNITION DIFFICULTIES WHILE DRIVING
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape Hybrid, Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner Hybrid, Mariner
ISSUE Some customers of 2008-2009 SYNC equipped vehicles may express concern with their
call sound quality while using the SYNC microphone, complaints of excessive background noise
during a phone call, and/or issues with voice recognition accuracy while driving.
ACTION Follow the service procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The following service procedure involves updating the Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
software level and installing an external alternate SYNC microphone attached to the headliner.
NOTE
THIS PROCEDURE DOES NOT APPLY TO DEALER-INSTALLED SYNC SYSTEMS.
Do not perform Step 1 if vehicle is already equipped with SYNC 2.0 (911 and Vehicle Health
Report) or has been upgraded to consumer interface processor (CIP) level 9L3T-14D544-AE. To
determine the current APIM software level, Refer to the Professional Technician Society (PTS)
website, enter the VIN in OASIS, click the GO button, and select the SYNC button.
1. Reprogram the APIM to CIP software level 9L3T-14D544-AE. For additional information Refer to
other SYNC TSB's and WSM, Section 418-01.
Service Pack files may also be obtained at www.syncmyride.com.
When diagnosing a concern related to voice recognition (VR) difficulties, instruct the customer to
test VR functionality while the vehicle is parked. If customer concerns are still present, this
procedure will not yield an improvement, and the service procedure should not be performed.
Instead, Refer to the SYNC supplement guide and www.syncmyride.com for additional VR tips to
assist customer.
The VR experience can be improved with user training and making improvements to the phone
book entries (longer entries make the system more robust). Ensure the customer does not try to
speak too loud or slow and remove any objects hanging on the rear view mirror as this will reduce
system effectiveness.
When diagnosing a concern related to call sound quality, expect marginal improvements for calls
described as speaking in a tunnel, chamber, etc. Expect substantial improvements for complaints
where the call audio seems to drop out intermittently.
NOTE
THIS REPAIR WILL CHANGE THE APPEARANCE OF THE VEHICLE INTERIOR. REFER TO
THE PHOTOGRAPHS FOR THE APPLICABLE VEHICLE LOCATED IN THIS PROCEDURE. DO
NOT PERFORM THIS REPAIR WITHOUT CUSTOMER APPROVAL PRIOR TO PROCEEDING
WITH MICROPHONE INSTALLATION.
2. Install SYNC microphone service kit. Installing the kit includes mounting an external microphone
directly to the headliner and splicing in a jumper
harness to the vehicle's existing wiring harness. The existing SYNC microphone will no longer be
functional.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-13-5 > Jul >
09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 114
a. Refer to the appropriate vehicle line and microphone illustration(s) below for microphone
installation and wire splicing locations. Refer to
Wiring Diagram (WD), Section 5-1 for recommended splicing methods.
b. Ensure the SYNC microphone wires are secure and do not interfere with vehicle operation or
functionality.
c. The microphone is directional. Make sure the microphone is always positioned so wire length is
minimized from view. When installing the
microphone adjacent to trim, place microphone as close to trim as possible to help minimize visible
wire.
2008-2009 Edge / MKX
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 1)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable up through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connectors 210 and 211 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for
links to location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C211. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C210.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2009 Escape / Mariner
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-13-5 > Jul >
09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 115
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration (Figures 2 and 3). Firmly
press the microphone into place. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead
console trim (if equipped), or positioned directly above A-pillar on headliner if not equipped with an
overhead console. Proceed to Step 5 if not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner to
run microphone cable.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 214 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C214. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD182 (BK-GY) from C214.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD1 82 (BK-GY).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
9. Connect the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Navigator / 2009 Expedition
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-13-5 > Jul >
09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 116
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figures 4 and 5)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim (if equipped), or
positioned directly above A-pillar on headliner if not
equipped with an overhead console.
^ Proceed to Step 5 if not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 298 located behind the dash panel on passenger side. Refer to online
WD, Section 124-1 for links to location and connector
views.
6. Identify circuits VMN07 (GY), RMN07 (VT), and DMN07 (shield - BK) from C298. Cut the three
circuits on the male side of the connector
(17C712 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP31 (BU-OG) and GD133 (BK) from C298 (2008 Navigator only). Identify
circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C298
(2009 Expedition/Navigator only).
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP31 (BU-OG) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK)
for 2008 Navigator only. Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness
wire to GD133 (BK) for 2009 Expedition/Navigator only.
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-13-5 > Jul >
09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 117
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN07 (GY) and remaining black jumper harness wires to RMN07
(VT) and DMN07 (shield - BK).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Connect the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the headliner.
2008-2009 Explorer / Explorer Sport Trac / Mountaineer
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 6)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner run
microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 248 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify and cut circuits VMNO7 (GY), RMNO7 (VT), and DMNO7 (shield) from C248. Cut the
three circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP05 (YE) and GD143 (BK-VT) from C248.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP05 (YE) and any black jumper harness wire to GD143 (BK-VT).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN07 (GY) and remaining black jumper harness wires to RMN07
(VT) and DMN07 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2009 F-150
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-13-5 > Jul >
09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 118
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 7)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim or front lamp.
2. Lower the overhead console or front lamp. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional
information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and temporarily tuck excess wire
into headliner to the rear of the console or lamp.
4. Install overhead console or front lamp; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console or
front lamp trim directly behind microphone as
shown.
5. Gain access to connectors 314 and 315 in roof panel near left hand side. Refer to online WD,
Section 124-1 for links to location and connector
views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C314. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14358 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) from C315 and GD133 (BK) from C314.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the headliner.
2009 F-Super Duty
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-13-5 > Jul >
09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 119
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 8)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
c. This repair is not recommended for vehicles not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 264 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield - BK) from C264. Cut the
three circuits on the female side of the connector
(17K745 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C264.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield - BK).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Connect the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2009 Flex
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-13-5 > Jul >
09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 120
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 9)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 925 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C925. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector (14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C925.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Focus
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-13-5 > Jul >
09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 121
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration (Figure 10). Firmly press
the microphone into place. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to the dome lamp trim.
2. Lower the dome lamp assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable up through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger
side A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop
headliner to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install dome lamp assembly; ensure microphone cable enters the dome lamp trim directly behind
microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 934 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD for location and connector
views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C934. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CPL60 (BN-YE) and GD161 (BK-YE) from C934.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CPL60 (BN-YE) and any black jumper harness wire to GD161
(BK-YE).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Fusion / Milan / MKZ
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-13-5 > Jul >
09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 122
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 11)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 913 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C913. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP02 (GN) and GD139 (BK-YE) from C913.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP02 (GN) and any black jumper harness wire to GD139 (BK-YE).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Taurus / Sable / Taurus X
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 12)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner to
run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-13-5 > Jul >
09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 123
5. Gain access to connector 925 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMN02 (WH-BN), RMN02 (VT-BN), and DMN07 (shield) from C925. Cut the
three circuits on the female side of the connector
(17K745 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C925.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN02 (WH-BN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMN02 (VT-BN) and DMN07 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2009 MKS
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 13)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and out the front of the headliner
above the rear view mirror.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 911 at the rear view mirror. Refer to the online WD, Section 124-1 for
links to location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMNO2 (WH-BN), RMN02 (VT-BN), and DMN07 (shield) from C911. Pull back
the black harness sleeve and cut the three
circuits near C91 1 or if equipped with a headlamp control module-2 (HCM-2), remove the HCM-2
access cover and cut circuits under trim cover. Refer to WSM, Section 417-01 for additional
information.
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C911.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-13-5 > Jul >
09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 124
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN02 (WH-BN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMN02 (VT-BN) and DMN07 (shield).
^ Only splice into the wires heading away from the connector. The wires heading into the connector
(mirror) are no longer used.
^ Ensure the wiring is neatly routed from the splice locations into the headliner, following the
existing wire harness routing from mirror to headliner.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 08-21-2
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT091305 Claim Diagnosis And Labor Actual
Performed As Actual Time. Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
17700 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-11-8 > Jun >
09 > SYNC(R) System - 911 Assist VHR Software Upgrade
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins SYNC(R) System - 911 Assist VHR
Software Upgrade
TSB 09-11-8
06/15/09
SYNC WITH 911 ASSIST AND VEHICLE HEALTH REPORT (VHR) DEALER UPGRADE
SOFTWARE
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape Hybrid, Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner Hybrid, Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 9-5-4 to update the Service Procedure and add a production fix date.
ISSUE Some customers with 2008 or 2009 vehicles equipped with SYNC may request the 911
assist and vehicle health report (VHR) service upgrade installation. This software upgrade is not a
warrantable repair. Software is available only through professional technician society (PTS)
website, and not available through the syncmyride.com website.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to upgrade the SYNC software.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
This software upgrade applies only to the following vehicle model years and build dates:
^ 2008-2009 Focus built before 1/20/2009
^ 2008-2009 Explorer, Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer built before 1/12/2009
^ 2008-2009 Edge, MKX, and 2009 Flex, Escape, Mariner built before 12/4/2008
^ 2008-2009 Taurus, Taurus X, Sable, and 2009 F-Super Duty, MKS, F-150 built before 12/1/2008
^ 2008-2009 Fusion, Milan, MKZ
Vehicles built on or after these dates are already equipped with the 911 Assist/Vehicle Health
Report features and do not require updating.
To determine if the vehicles are within these build ranges or have already been upgraded to SYNC
911 Assist/VHR, access the Professional Technician Society (PTS) website, run OASIS by
pressing the Read VIN and DTC's button, and click on the SYNC tab. If the description box
indicates 911 and Vehicle Health Report, vehicle has been upgraded.
The 911 assist with VHR upgrade automatically reprograms the accessory protocol interface
module (APIM), instrument cluster (IC), and restraints control module (RCM).
The VHR applies only to United States (US) vehicles, 911 assist is for US and Canadian vehicles
operated within the US and Canada.
Performing this upgrade may result in some untested devices losing certain functionality, such as
bluetooth connection and phonebook download. Before continuing with this upgrade, make sure
the customer's device is listed on the compatibility matrix. It is strongly recommended to pair the
device to another vehicle currently equipped with 911 Assist/Vehicle Health Report to ensure
proper functionality before continuing.
Configuration and programming requires the use of IDS and a special PTS application. Installer
must have access to PTS and have a valid PTS user ID and password. Ensure the IDS is at the
latest software version.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-11-8 > Jun >
09 > SYNC(R) System - 911 Assist VHR Software Upgrade > Page 129
For additional programming tips, dealer network setting requirements, and possible error states
related to 911 Assist and VHR upgrades, reference the latest information on the Professional
Technician Society (PTS) website.
1. When updating 2008-2009 Explorer, Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac, Expedition, or Navigator
vehicles, it is necessary to manually record and
reenter the Oil Life % Value as displayed on the message center. Record the current oil life before
updating 911 Assist/VHR, and reenter using the message center once programming is complete.
2. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
3. Connect the VCM to the IDS tool or laptop running IDS software.
4. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
5. Launch IDS tool but do not start a new session.
6. If required, update the VCM with the latest IDS release 59.9 and higher.
7. Close the IDS tool.
8. From the P15 website, run OASIS by pressing the read VIN and DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the go button.
9. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, select the Upgrade/Mods tab.
10. Once correct vehicle is chosen, select SYNC upgrade with 911 Assist/VHR.
11. Follow the on-screen instructions to program the APIM, IC, and RCM.
NOTE
TO COMPLETE THE UPGRADE PROCESS PERFORM THE FOLLOWING STEPS TO CONFIRM
THE VEHICLE HAS BEEN CORRECTLY CONFIGURED TO HAVE THESE FEATURES. FAILING
TO COMPLETE THE STEPS BELOW MAY RESULT IN 911 ASSIST/VHR NOT DISPLAYING ON
THE SYNC MENU.
12. Set ignition to off.
13. Open and close driver side door.
14. Set ignition to on.
15. Follow applicable instructions (see below) to ensure 911 Assist/VHR appear on Sync menu.
16. Close all Internet Explorer browser windows.
17. Clear all DTC's on all modules.
18. Reenter the Oil Life % Value for 2008-2009 Explorer, Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac,
Expedition, or Navigator vehicles.
Navigation Radio Instructions
911 Assist/VHR feature confirmation.
1. Press phone button on the Navigation LCD to enter phone menu.
2. Press cancel when pop-up menu appears on Navigation LCD display.
3. Press settings soft key on Navigation LCD display.
4. Press advanced soft key on Navigation LCD display.
5. Verify 911 Assist/VHR is in menu in Navigation LCD display.
Non Navigation Radio Instructions
911 Assist/VHR feature confirmation.
1. Press phone button on steering wheel.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-11-8 > Jun >
09 > SYNC(R) System - 911 Assist VHR Software Upgrade > Page 130
2. Press left arrow on steering wheel until return is displayed on radio screen, then press ok.
3. Press left arrow on steering wheel until return is displayed on radio screen, then press ok.
4. Press left arrow until 911 Assist/VHR is displayed.
Once 911 Assist/VHR installation is complete, the customer will need to reload their phone book if
that application is desired.
NOTE
IF SERVICE IS REQUIRED ON 2008 OR 2009 EARLY BUILT VEHICLES UPGRADED TO 911
ASSIST/VHR, REFERENCE THE APPLICABLE 2009 WORKSHOP MANUAL AND FOLLOW THE
V2 DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURES.
WARRANTY STATUS: Information Only - Not Warrantable
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact
Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
TSB 09-15-8
08/10/09
5.4L 3V 6R80 - HARSH 1-2 UPSHIFT - HARSH 2-1 DOWNSHIFT WHILE COASTING - HARSH
DOWNSHIFT TO 4TH GEAR - INTERMITTENT P0741
FORD: 2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with 5.4L 3V engine may exhibit
symptoms during warm-up: a harsh 1-2 upshift, harsh 2-1 downshift while coasting 15 MPH (24
Km/h). A harsh downshift into 4th gear at highway speeds 45-70 MPH (72-113 Km/h) may also be
experienced. Some vehicles may have a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0741 torque converter
performance code present or stored.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
MECHATRONIC REPAIR/REPLACEMENT IS NOT
AUTHORIZED FOR THIS ISSUE.
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the Powertrain Control Module/Transmission Control Module (PCM/TCM) calibration
using IDS release 61.15 and higher or 62.03 and
higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be
obtained at the website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the TCM Calibration shows AL3P-7J104-AB part number after reprogramming is
complete.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) OBD Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR TSB TO BE
FULLY AFFECTIVE
3. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact
Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 136
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM.
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175° F (79° C). If it is not at
175° F (79° C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175° F (79° C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091508A 2009 Expedition, Navigator 1.0 Hr.
6R80 Transmission: Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear The
TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact
Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 137
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact
Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 143
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM.
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175° F (79° C). If it is not at
175° F (79° C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175° F (79° C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091508A 2009 Expedition, Navigator 1.0 Hr.
6R80 Transmission: Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear The
TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency
Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact
Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 144
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Entertainment System Control Module: > 10-9-7 > May > 10 > Audio System - Unexpected CD Shuffle With Key Off
Entertainment System Control Module: Customer Interest Audio System - Unexpected CD Shuffle
With Key Off
TSB 10-9-7
05/24/10
UNEXPECTED COMPACT DISC SHUFFLE OR CYCLING DURING NORMAL RADIO
OPERATION OR WITH THE KEY OFF - NON-NAVIGATION RADIOS ONLY
FORD: 2008-2010 Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer
MERCURY: 2008-2010 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some 2008-2010 Expedition, Explorer, Explorer Sport Trac and Mountaineer vehicles
equipped with a non-navigation CD-6 Audio Control Module (ACM) may experience an unexpected
Compact Disc (CD) shuffle or cycling during start up, during normal ACM operation, or shutting off
the vehicle.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
This service procedure affects non-navigation radios only. If you attempt to run module
reprogramming on the 2008-2010 ACM and the service tool does not recognize the part numbers
of the ACM currently installed, this procedure does not apply.
Reprogram the ACM to the latest calibration using IDS release 66.05A and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010. Version A DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained
at the website.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100907A 2008-2010 Expedition, 0.3 Hr.
Explorer, Mountaineer, And Explorer Sport Trac: Reprogram The Audio Control Module (Do Not
Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Entertainment System Control Module: > 10-9-7 > May > 10 > Audio System - Unexpected CD Shuffle With
Key Off
Entertainment System Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Audio System - Unexpected
CD Shuffle With Key Off
TSB 10-9-7
05/24/10
UNEXPECTED COMPACT DISC SHUFFLE OR CYCLING DURING NORMAL RADIO
OPERATION OR WITH THE KEY OFF - NON-NAVIGATION RADIOS ONLY
FORD: 2008-2010 Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer
MERCURY: 2008-2010 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some 2008-2010 Expedition, Explorer, Explorer Sport Trac and Mountaineer vehicles
equipped with a non-navigation CD-6 Audio Control Module (ACM) may experience an unexpected
Compact Disc (CD) shuffle or cycling during start up, during normal ACM operation, or shutting off
the vehicle.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
This service procedure affects non-navigation radios only. If you attempt to run module
reprogramming on the 2008-2010 ACM and the service tool does not recognize the part numbers
of the ACM currently installed, this procedure does not apply.
Reprogram the ACM to the latest calibration using IDS release 66.05A and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010. Version A DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained
at the website.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100907A 2008-2010 Expedition, 0.3 Hr.
Explorer, Mountaineer, And Explorer Sport Trac: Reprogram The Audio Control Module (Do Not
Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Rear Entertainment Module (RETM)
Entertainment System Control Module: Locations Rear Entertainment Module (RETM)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Rear Entertainment Module (RETM) > Page
160
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Rear Entertainment Module (RETM) > Page
161
Entertainment System Control Module: Locations Audio Rear Control Unit (RCU) Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Rear Entertainment Module (RETM) > Page
162
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Rear Entertainment Module (RETM)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Rear Entertainment Module (RETM) > Page
165
Entertainment System Control Module: Diagrams Audio Rear Control Unit (RCU) Module
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Rear Entertainment Module (RETM) > Page
166
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Global
Positioning System Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Global
Positioning System Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns
Global Positioning System Module: Customer Interest SYNC(R) System - Software Update For
Various Concerns
TSB 09-26-8
01/04/10
SYNC SOFTWARE UPDATE - VARIOUS ISSUES
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 9-22-14 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2008 and 2009 SYNC® equipped vehicles may exhibit one or more of the following
symptoms:
^ Universal Serial Bus (USB) port inoperative.
^ USB audio muting when using various non-Apple USB devices.
^ Phone book access difficulty on certain 2-digit phone book entries when using voice commands.
^ Excessive background noise and/or poor voice sound quality.
^ Phone book auto download inoperative on supported devices.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative intermittently.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Reprogram the accessory protocol inter[ace module (APIM) to the following consumer inter[ace
processor (CIP) software levels.
^ 9L3T-14D544-AE (vehicles not equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health Report)
^ 9L2T-14D544-BE (vehicles already equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health
Report)
Service Pack files may be obtained at www.syncmyride.com.
Reprogram the APIM
Contains software fix updates for the following:
^ Phone book auto download inoperative.
^ USB audio muting.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative.
^ Voice recognition on 2-digit entries.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Global
Positioning System Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Global
Positioning System Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns > Page 175
^ USB port inoperative with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B1342.
^ Poor call sound quality.
This software update also contains enhancements that will improve the reliability of both Bluetooth
and USB connections to SYNC(R) from various consumer devices, and microphone enhancements
to reduce background noise, and will default Vehicle Health Report (if equipped) to off. The
Bluetooth enhancements improve the stability of hands-free calls, call waiting, caller ID, multiple
call handling and other mobile phone features. The USB enhancements improve support for media
players and the playing of file formats and podcasts.
NOTE
REFERENCE OTHER TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETINS (TSB) FOR ADDITIONAL SYNC
SOFTWARE PROGRAMMING TIPS.
1. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
2. Connect the VCM to the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) tool or laptop running IDS software.
3. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
4. Launch IDS tool.
5. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
6. Close the IDS tool.
7. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN & DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO button.
8. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
9. Press read APIM button.
10. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
11. Program both processors in the APIM (Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and CIP).
NOTE
DO NOT USE A MALE-TO-MALE USB DATA TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
a. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software and
to the vehicle USB port.
b. Follow the on-screen instructions to program both processors on the Sync module (VIP and
CIP).
12. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
13. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 08-21-02
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092608A 2008-2009 Edge, Explorer, 0.4 Hr.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Global
Positioning System Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Global
Positioning System Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns > Page 176
Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac, Focus, Fusion, Milan, MKX, MKZ, Sable, Navigator, Taurus,
Taurus X, 2009 Expedition, Escape, Escape Hybrid, Mariner, Mariner Hybrid, F-150, F-Super Duty,
Flex, MKS: Reprogram The APIM (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Global
Positioning System Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Global Positioning System Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns
Global Positioning System Module: All Technical Service Bulletins SYNC(R) System - Software
Update For Various Concerns
TSB 09-26-8
01/04/10
SYNC SOFTWARE UPDATE - VARIOUS ISSUES
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 9-22-14 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2008 and 2009 SYNC® equipped vehicles may exhibit one or more of the following
symptoms:
^ Universal Serial Bus (USB) port inoperative.
^ USB audio muting when using various non-Apple USB devices.
^ Phone book access difficulty on certain 2-digit phone book entries when using voice commands.
^ Excessive background noise and/or poor voice sound quality.
^ Phone book auto download inoperative on supported devices.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative intermittently.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Reprogram the accessory protocol inter[ace module (APIM) to the following consumer inter[ace
processor (CIP) software levels.
^ 9L3T-14D544-AE (vehicles not equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health Report)
^ 9L2T-14D544-BE (vehicles already equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health
Report)
Service Pack files may be obtained at www.syncmyride.com.
Reprogram the APIM
Contains software fix updates for the following:
^ Phone book auto download inoperative.
^ USB audio muting.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative.
^ Voice recognition on 2-digit entries.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Global
Positioning System Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Global Positioning System Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns >
Page 182
^ USB port inoperative with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B1342.
^ Poor call sound quality.
This software update also contains enhancements that will improve the reliability of both Bluetooth
and USB connections to SYNC(R) from various consumer devices, and microphone enhancements
to reduce background noise, and will default Vehicle Health Report (if equipped) to off. The
Bluetooth enhancements improve the stability of hands-free calls, call waiting, caller ID, multiple
call handling and other mobile phone features. The USB enhancements improve support for media
players and the playing of file formats and podcasts.
NOTE
REFERENCE OTHER TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETINS (TSB) FOR ADDITIONAL SYNC
SOFTWARE PROGRAMMING TIPS.
1. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
2. Connect the VCM to the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) tool or laptop running IDS software.
3. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
4. Launch IDS tool.
5. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
6. Close the IDS tool.
7. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN & DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO button.
8. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
9. Press read APIM button.
10. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
11. Program both processors in the APIM (Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and CIP).
NOTE
DO NOT USE A MALE-TO-MALE USB DATA TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
a. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software and
to the vehicle USB port.
b. Follow the on-screen instructions to program both processors on the Sync module (VIP and
CIP).
12. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
13. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 08-21-02
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092608A 2008-2009 Edge, Explorer, 0.4 Hr.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Global
Positioning System Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Global Positioning System Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns >
Page 183
Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac, Focus, Fusion, Milan, MKX, MKZ, Sable, Navigator, Taurus,
Taurus X, 2009 Expedition, Escape, Escape Hybrid, Mariner, Mariner Hybrid, F-150, F-Super Duty,
Flex, MKS: Reprogram The APIM (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R)
System - Software Update For Various Concerns
Navigation Module: Customer Interest SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns
TSB 09-26-8
01/04/10
SYNC SOFTWARE UPDATE - VARIOUS ISSUES
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 9-22-14 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2008 and 2009 SYNC® equipped vehicles may exhibit one or more of the following
symptoms:
^ Universal Serial Bus (USB) port inoperative.
^ USB audio muting when using various non-Apple USB devices.
^ Phone book access difficulty on certain 2-digit phone book entries when using voice commands.
^ Excessive background noise and/or poor voice sound quality.
^ Phone book auto download inoperative on supported devices.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative intermittently.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Reprogram the accessory protocol inter[ace module (APIM) to the following consumer inter[ace
processor (CIP) software levels.
^ 9L3T-14D544-AE (vehicles not equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health Report)
^ 9L2T-14D544-BE (vehicles already equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health
Report)
Service Pack files may be obtained at www.syncmyride.com.
Reprogram the APIM
Contains software fix updates for the following:
^ Phone book auto download inoperative.
^ USB audio muting.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative.
^ Voice recognition on 2-digit entries.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R)
System - Software Update For Various Concerns > Page 192
^ USB port inoperative with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B1342.
^ Poor call sound quality.
This software update also contains enhancements that will improve the reliability of both Bluetooth
and USB connections to SYNC(R) from various consumer devices, and microphone enhancements
to reduce background noise, and will default Vehicle Health Report (if equipped) to off. The
Bluetooth enhancements improve the stability of hands-free calls, call waiting, caller ID, multiple
call handling and other mobile phone features. The USB enhancements improve support for media
players and the playing of file formats and podcasts.
NOTE
REFERENCE OTHER TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETINS (TSB) FOR ADDITIONAL SYNC
SOFTWARE PROGRAMMING TIPS.
1. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
2. Connect the VCM to the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) tool or laptop running IDS software.
3. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
4. Launch IDS tool.
5. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
6. Close the IDS tool.
7. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN & DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO button.
8. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
9. Press read APIM button.
10. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
11. Program both processors in the APIM (Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and CIP).
NOTE
DO NOT USE A MALE-TO-MALE USB DATA TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
a. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software and
to the vehicle USB port.
b. Follow the on-screen instructions to program both processors on the Sync module (VIP and
CIP).
12. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
13. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 08-21-02
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092608A 2008-2009 Edge, Explorer, 0.4 Hr.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R)
System - Software Update For Various Concerns > Page 193
Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac, Focus, Fusion, Milan, MKX, MKZ, Sable, Navigator, Taurus,
Taurus X, 2009 Expedition, Escape, Escape Hybrid, Mariner, Mariner Hybrid, F-150, F-Super Duty,
Flex, MKS: Reprogram The APIM (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 >
SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns
Navigation Module: All Technical Service Bulletins SYNC(R) System - Software Update For
Various Concerns
TSB 09-26-8
01/04/10
SYNC SOFTWARE UPDATE - VARIOUS ISSUES
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 9-22-14 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2008 and 2009 SYNC® equipped vehicles may exhibit one or more of the following
symptoms:
^ Universal Serial Bus (USB) port inoperative.
^ USB audio muting when using various non-Apple USB devices.
^ Phone book access difficulty on certain 2-digit phone book entries when using voice commands.
^ Excessive background noise and/or poor voice sound quality.
^ Phone book auto download inoperative on supported devices.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative intermittently.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Reprogram the accessory protocol inter[ace module (APIM) to the following consumer inter[ace
processor (CIP) software levels.
^ 9L3T-14D544-AE (vehicles not equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health Report)
^ 9L2T-14D544-BE (vehicles already equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health
Report)
Service Pack files may be obtained at www.syncmyride.com.
Reprogram the APIM
Contains software fix updates for the following:
^ Phone book auto download inoperative.
^ USB audio muting.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative.
^ Voice recognition on 2-digit entries.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 >
SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns > Page 199
^ USB port inoperative with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B1342.
^ Poor call sound quality.
This software update also contains enhancements that will improve the reliability of both Bluetooth
and USB connections to SYNC(R) from various consumer devices, and microphone enhancements
to reduce background noise, and will default Vehicle Health Report (if equipped) to off. The
Bluetooth enhancements improve the stability of hands-free calls, call waiting, caller ID, multiple
call handling and other mobile phone features. The USB enhancements improve support for media
players and the playing of file formats and podcasts.
NOTE
REFERENCE OTHER TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETINS (TSB) FOR ADDITIONAL SYNC
SOFTWARE PROGRAMMING TIPS.
1. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
2. Connect the VCM to the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) tool or laptop running IDS software.
3. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
4. Launch IDS tool.
5. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
6. Close the IDS tool.
7. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN & DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO button.
8. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
9. Press read APIM button.
10. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
11. Program both processors in the APIM (Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and CIP).
NOTE
DO NOT USE A MALE-TO-MALE USB DATA TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
a. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software and
to the vehicle USB port.
b. Follow the on-screen instructions to program both processors on the Sync module (VIP and
CIP).
12. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
13. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 08-21-02
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092608A 2008-2009 Edge, Explorer, 0.4 Hr.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 >
SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns > Page 200
Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac, Focus, Fusion, Milan, MKX, MKZ, Sable, Navigator, Taurus,
Taurus X, 2009 Expedition, Escape, Escape Hybrid, Mariner, Mariner Hybrid, F-150, F-Super Duty,
Flex, MKS: Reprogram The APIM (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation Module: >
10-12-4 > Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh Downshifts
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh
Downshifts
TSB 10-12-4
07/05/10
5.4L 3V AND 6R80 TRANSMISSION - DELAYED/HARSH DOWNSHIFT ABOVE 40 MPH (64
KM/H)
FORD: 2009-2010 Expedition, F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built on or before 5/1/2010 and
2009-2010 F-150 vehicles built on or before 2/1/2010 and equipped with 5.4L 3V engine and 6R80
transmission may exhibit a delayed then harsh downshift during a commanded downshift at speeds
above 40 MPH (64 Km/h).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
ID vehicle.
2. Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 67.03 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the 1CM Calibration is:
(1) AL3P-7J104-AC for all vehicles except the F-150 4X4.
(2) AL3P-7J104-BC for F-150 4X4.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox
(2) Powertrain
(3) OBD Test Modes
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info
(5) 1CM Cal Part Number
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT 1CM KAM BE CLEARED FOR THIS PROCEDURE TO BE FULLY
EFFECTIVE
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox
(2) Choose Powertrain Then Choose TCM
(3) Choose Reset KAM
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation Module: >
10-12-4 > Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh Downshifts > Page 206
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset 1CM KAM
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM
KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop, allow at least six (6) seconds.
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101204A 2009-2010 Expedition, 1.0 Hr.
Navigator, F-150: Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM And Perform Road
Tests (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation Module: >
10-12-4 > Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh Downshifts > Page 207
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation Module: >
09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4
Shifts
TSB 09-15-8
08/10/09
5.4L 3V 6R80 - HARSH 1-2 UPSHIFT - HARSH 2-1 DOWNSHIFT WHILE COASTING - HARSH
DOWNSHIFT TO 4TH GEAR - INTERMITTENT P0741
FORD: 2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with 5.4L 3V engine may exhibit
symptoms during warm-up: a harsh 1-2 upshift, harsh 2-1 downshift while coasting 15 MPH (24
Km/h). A harsh downshift into 4th gear at highway speeds 45-70 MPH (72-113 Km/h) may also be
experienced. Some vehicles may have a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0741 torque converter
performance code present or stored.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
MECHATRONIC REPAIR/REPLACEMENT IS NOT
AUTHORIZED FOR THIS ISSUE.
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the Powertrain Control Module/Transmission Control Module (PCM/TCM) calibration
using IDS release 61.15 and higher or 62.03 and
higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be
obtained at the website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the TCM Calibration shows AL3P-7J104-AB part number after reprogramming is
complete.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) OBD Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR TSB TO BE
FULLY AFFECTIVE
3. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation Module: >
09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 212
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM.
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175° F (79° C). If it is not at
175° F (79° C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175° F (79° C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091508A 2009 Expedition, Navigator 1.0 Hr.
6R80 Transmission: Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear The
TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation Module: >
09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 213
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation Module: >
10-12-4 > Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh Downshifts > Page 219
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset 1CM KAM
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM
KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop, allow at least six (6) seconds.
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101204A 2009-2010 Expedition, 1.0 Hr.
Navigator, F-150: Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM And Perform Road
Tests (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation Module: >
10-12-4 > Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh Downshifts > Page 220
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation Module: >
09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 225
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM.
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175° F (79° C). If it is not at
175° F (79° C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175° F (79° C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091508A 2009 Expedition, Navigator 1.0 Hr.
6R80 Transmission: Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear The
TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Navigation Module: >
09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 226
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Parking Assist Control Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 230
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 231
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 232
Parking Assist Control Module: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 233
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 234
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 235
Parking Assist Control Module: Service and Repair
Parking Aid Module (PAM) - Expedition
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the Parking Aid Module (PAM) sub-harness from the body harness.
2. Remove the rear bumper cover.
3. Remove the 4 insulator-to-bumper cover nuts and the insulator from the bumper cover.
4. Disconnect the sub-harness from the PAM.
5. Remove the 2 PAM bracket bolts.
6. Remove the PAM bracket assembly.
7. Release the module tabs from the bracket and remove the module from the bracket.
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 240
Memory Positioning Module: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 241
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 242
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 243
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 244
Memory Positioning Module: Service and Repair
Driver Seat Module (DSM)
Removal and Installation
NOTICE: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these charges,
damage may result.
NOTE: Prior to the removal of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to a scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new Driver Seat Module
(DSM) after installation.
1. Upload the module configuration information from the DSM into the scan tool.
2. NOTE: The module is accessed with the seat fully in the UP position.
Position the DSM forward to remove it from the bracket.
3. Disconnect the battery.
4. Disconnect the electrical connectors and remove the DSM.
5. NOTE: Once the module is installed, it is necessary to download the module configuration
information from the scan tool into the new module.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 248
Power Seat Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 249
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Locations
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 253
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 254
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 255
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 256
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Latch Remote Control
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Service and Repair Liftgate Latch Remote Control
Liftgate Latch Remote Control
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The liftgate latch remote control is available with power liftgate only.
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel.
2. Position the watershield aside.
3. NOTICE: Be careful not to kink the liftgate latch actuating cable while disconnecting it from the
latch.
Disconnect the liftgate latch.
1. Release the liftgate latch actuator rod.
2. Disconnect the liftgate latch actuating cable.
4. Remove 3 bolts and position the liftgate latch remote control aside.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-in).
5. Disconnect the electrical connectors and remove the liftgate latch remote control.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Latch Remote Control > Page 259
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Service and Repair Liftgate/Trunk Module (LTM)
Liftgate/Trunk Module (LTM)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear quarter trim panel.
2. Remove the Liftgate/Trunk Module (LTM).
1. Disconnect the electrical connectors.
2. Remove the bolt.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Initialize the power liftgate. For additional information, refer to Power Liftgate Initialization See:
Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Trunk / Liftgate/Service and Repair/Procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board
Module > Component Information > Locations
Auxiliary Step / Running Board Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 263
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 264
Auxiliary Step / Running Board Module: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 265
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 266
Auxiliary Step / Running Board Module: Service and Repair
Power Running Board (PRB) Module
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the LH B-pillar trim panel.
2. Disconnect the Power Running Board (PRB) module electrical connectors.
3. Remove the 2 bolts and the PRB module assembly.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Rear Heated Seat Module
Seat Heater Control Module: Locations Rear Heated Seat Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Rear Heated Seat Module > Page 271
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Rear Heated Seat Module > Page 272
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Rear Heated Seat Module
Seat Heater Control Module: Diagrams Rear Heated Seat Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Rear Heated Seat Module > Page 275
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Rear Heated Seat Module > Page 276
Seat Heater Control Module: Diagrams Dual Climate Controlled Seat Module (DCSM)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Rear Heated Seat Module > Page 277
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Rear Heated Seat Module > Page 278
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat Heater Control Module: Service and Repair Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent
NOTE: Driver power seat backrest shown, passenger and manual similar.
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent
NOTE: Driver memory seat shown, driver and passenger power seat similar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 281
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 282
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 283
Seat Heater Control Module: Service and Repair Dual Climate Controlled Seat Module (DCSM)
Dual Climate Controlled Seat Module (DCSM)
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on safety belt buckle/retractor pretensioners or
adaptive load limiting retractors. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental
deployment of the safety belt pretensioners or adaptive load limiting retractors, which increases the
risk of serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on air bag, Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain
modules. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of these
modules, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
NOTE: For component identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Front See: Body
and Frame/Seats/Service and Repair/Front Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Front.
1. When installing a new Dual Climate Controlled Seat Module (DCSM), carry out the appropriate
steps in the Programmable Module Installation
(PMI) procedure. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Information
Bus/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning
2. NOTICE: Do not pull from the inboard side of the front seat cushion panel shield to avoid
damaging it.
Position the front passenger seat fully upward and remove the front seat cushion panel shield.
- Release the upper retaining clips working from the outboard side and then release the lower
retaining clips.
3. Release the 2 tabs and slide out the DCSM.
4. Remove the DCSM.
- Cut and remove the wiring harness tie strap.
- Release the 2 locking wedges.
- Disconnect the 3 electrical connectors.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
6. If a new DCSM has been installed, carry out the appropriate steps in the Programmable Module
Installation (PMI) procedure. See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Information Bus/Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 284
Seat Heater Control Module: Service and Repair Heated Seat Module - Second Row
Heated Seat Module - Second Row
NOTE: Bottom of floor console shown.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front floor console.
2. Disconnect the 2 heated seat module electrical connectors at the bottom of the front floor
console.
3. Remove the screw and un-hook the heated seat module.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
5. Carry out the auto-configuration sequence to program the heated seat module for use with a
dual momentary switch.
- Start the vehicle and push the low button on either heated seat switch.
- Operate the heated seats, monitor the indicators and verify the system is operating correctly in
high and low.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Module >
Component Information > Locations
Sunroof / Moonroof Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 288
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 289
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Electronic Brake Control Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 297
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 298
Electronic Brake Control Module: Diagrams
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 299
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 300
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module
Removal and Installation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 301
NOTE: On vehicles equipped with Roll Stability Control (RSC(R)), the ABS module and the
Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) are calibrated to one another. Do not swap ABS modules between
RSC(R)-equipped vehicles.
NOTE: On vehicles equipped with RSC(R), the ABS module is available separately from the HCU
and should be serviced separately. However, if the RSC(R)-equipped vehicle requires a new HCU,
then the ABS module and the HCU must be installed as an assembly. Make sure to use the most
recently released service parts.
NOTE: When installing a new ABS module/HCU assembly, it must be configured (either by
download/upload or uploading the as-built data method).
1. Release the Air Cleaner (ACL) cover retaining clips and disconnect the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor electrical connector.
2. Loosen the ACL outlet clamp and disconnect the ACL cover from the outlet pipe.
- To install, tighten to 4 Nm (35 lb-in).
3. Remove the 3 HCU bracket-to-frame bolts.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (177 lb-in).
4. Disconnect the ABS module electrical connector.
5. Remove the 4 ABS module bolts and the ABS module.
- To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
7. If installing a new ABS module on a vehicle equipped with RSC(R), configure the ABS module.
8. If installing a new ABS module on a vehicle equipped with RSC(R), calibrate the RSC(R) sensor.
Connect the scan tool and carry out the IVD
Initialization sequence.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Trailer Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Trailer Brake Control Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Trailer Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 305
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Trailer Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 306
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Blower Motor Relay
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Blower Motor Relay > Page 312
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Blower Motor Relay > Page 313
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Blower Motor Relay > Page 314
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Blower Motor Relay
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Blower Motor Relay
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Blower Motor Relay > Page 317
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Blower Motor Relay > Page 318
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Auxiliary Blower Motor Relay 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Blower Motor Relay > Page 319
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Blower Motor Relay > Page 320
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Auxiliary Blower Motor Relay 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Blower Motor Relay > Page 321
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Blower Motor Relay > Page 322
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Auxiliary Blower Motor Relay 3
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Blower Motor Relay > Page 323
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 327
Compressor Clutch Relay: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Air Conditioning (A/C) Clutch Relay (A/CCR)
Note: The PCM parameter identifiers (PIDs) wide open throttle air conditioning cutoff (WAC) and
wide open throttle air conditioning cutoff fault (WAC_F) are used to monitor the A/CCR output.
The A/CCR is wired normally open. There is no direct electrical connection between the A/C switch
or electronic automatic temperature control (EATC) module and the A/C clutch. The PCM receives
a signal indicating that A/C is requested. For some applications, this message is sent through the
communications network. When A/C is requested, the PCM checks other A/C related inputs that
are available, such as A/C pressure switch and A/C cycling switch. If these inputs indicate A/C
operation and the engine conditions are OK (coolant temperature, engine RPM, throttle position),
the PCM grounds the A/CCR output, closing the relay contacts and sending voltage to the A/CCR.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > HVAC Module, EMTC
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > HVAC Module, EMTC > Page 332
Control Module HVAC: Locations HVAC Module, DATC
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > HVAC Module, EMTC > Page 333
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > HVAC Module, DATC
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams HVAC Module, DATC
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > HVAC Module, DATC > Page 336
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > HVAC Module, DATC > Page 337
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams HVAC Module, EMTC
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > HVAC Module, DATC > Page 338
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > HVAC Module, DATC > Page 339
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Exterior Lighting Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Exterior Lighting Module: Service and Repair
Ballast
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Make sure that the headlamp switch and the ignition switch are in the OFF position.
1. Remove the headlamp assembly. For additional information, refer to Headlamp Assembly See:
Lighting and Horns/Headlamp/Service and Repair.
2. Remove the 4 bolts and the ballast.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 351
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left
Headlamp Relay: Testing and Inspection High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 354
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 355
Headlamp Relay: Testing and Inspection High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Right
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 356
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Right Turn
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Right Turn > Page 364
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Right Turn > Page 365
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Right Turn > Page 366
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp > Page 369
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp > Page 370
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp > Page 371
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair
Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Removal
NOTICE: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these charges,
damage to the module may result.
NOTE: Prior to the replacement of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to a scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new Smart Junction Box
(SJB) after installation. In the event that As-Built data entry is required (SJB will not communicate),
all Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) devices must be programmed to the new SJB. A minimum of 2
devices are necessary to complete the configuration and turn off the flashing interior lights.
1. NOTE: This step is only necessary if the SJB is being replaced.
NOTE: The Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) functionality is integral to the SJB. A new
SJB is delivered in a "manufacturing mode" with 7 pre-set DTCs. A successful configuration of the
SJB, then a successful TPMS sensor training, then a successful self-test including the clearing of
all DTCs is required in order to clear the 7 pre-set manufacturing mode DTCs. The 7 manufacturing
mode DTCs are: -
B106D (Tire Pressure Monitor System [TPMS] Initiators Not Configured) - This DTC is present
when the SJB is not configured, even on applications that are not equipped with initiators.
- B2477 (Module Configuration Failure)
- B2868 (Left Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2869 (Right Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2870 (Right Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2871 (Left Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- C2780 (ECU in Manufacturer Sub-State)
Upload the module configuration information from the SJB into the scan tool.
2. Disconnect the battery.
3. Remove the RH cowl panel side trim.
4. Remove the glove compartment.
5. Disconnect the 7 electrical connectors.
6. Remove the 2 bolts and the SJB.
Installation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 376
1. Position the SJB and install the 2 bolts.
- Tighten the bolts to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
2. Connect the 7 electrical connectors.
3. Install the RH cowl panel side trim.
4. Install the glove compartment.
5. NOTE: If the SJB is not being replaced, this is the last step that is necessary. Connect the
battery.
6. NOTE: When successful, this step provides the calibration necessary for the SJB operation and
clears the DTCs B106D and B2477. The clearing
of these DTCs indicates the calibration data has been successfully downloaded to the SJB.
NOTE: DTC B2276 may be set, indicating there are less than 2 transmitters programmed to the
SJB.
Download the SJB configuration information from the scan tool to the SJB.
7. NOTE: When successful, this step clears DTCs B2868, B2869, B2870 and B2871. The clearing
of these DTCs indicates the SJB has recognized
the tire pressure sensors during the training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensors.
8. NOTE: DTC C2780 will not clear if any of the pre-set DTCs are still present in the SJB.
Carry out the SJB self-test (must include an on-demand self-test) and then repeat the self-test to
confirm all DTCs have been cleared.
9. Rotate the instrument panel dimmer switch from the full dim position to the dome ON position.
This will make sure that all displays are visible
under all lighting conditions.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Relay - Macro ISO
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO > Page 382
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO > Page 383
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Relay - Micro ISO
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO > Page 384
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO > Page 385
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Relay - Mini ISO
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO > Page 386
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO > Page 387
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2
Relay Box: Locations Auxiliary Relay Box 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 392
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 393
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 394
Relay Box: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 395
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 396
Relay Box: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 397
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 398
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 399
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 400
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 401
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 404
Relay Box: Diagrams Smart Junction Box (SJB)
C2280A
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 405
C2280B Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 406
C2280B Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 407
C2280C
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 408
C2280D Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 409
C2280D Part 2
C2280E
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 410
C2280F
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 411
C2280G
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 414
Relay Box: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 415
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 416
Relay Box: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 417
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Electronic Throttle Control Module: Description and Operation
Torque-Based Electronic Throttle Control (ETC)
Overview
The torque-based ETC is a hardware and software strategy that delivers an engine output torque
(via throttle angle) based on driver demand (pedal position). It uses an electronic throttle body, the
powertrain control module (PCM), and an accelerator pedal assembly to control the throttle
opening and engine torque.
Torque-based ETC enables aggressive automatic transmission shift schedules (earlier upshifts and
later downshifts). This is possible by adjusting the throttle angle to achieve the same wheel torque
during shifts, and by calculating this desired torque, the system prevents engine lugging (low RPM
and low manifold vacuum) while still delivering the performance and torque requested by the driver.
It also enables many fuel economy/emission improvement technologies such as variable camshaft
timing (VCT), which delivers same torque during transitions.
Torque-based ETC also results in less intrusive vehicle and engine speed limiting, along with
smoother traction control.
Other benefits of torque-based ETC are:
- eliminate cruise control actuators
- eliminate idle air control (IAC) valve
- better airflow range
- packaging (no cable)
- more responsive powertrain at altitude and improved shift quality
The ETC system illuminates a powertrain malfunction indicator (wrench) on the instrument cluster
when a concern is present. Concerns are accompanied by diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) and
may also illuminate the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL).
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB)
The ETB has the following characteristics:
- The throttle actuator control (TAC) motor is a DC motor controlled by the PCM (requires 2 wires).
- There are two designs: parallel and in-line. The parallel design has the motor under the bore
parallel to the plate shaft. The motor housing is integrated into the main housing. The in-line design
has a separate motor housing.
- An internal spring is used in both designs to return the throttle plate to a default position. The
default position is typically a throttle angle of 7 to 8 degrees from the hard stop angle.
- The closed throttle plate hard stop is used to prevent the throttle from binding in the bore. This
hard stop setting is not adjustable and is set to result in less airflow than the minimum engine
airflow required at idle.
- The required idle airflow is provided by the plate angle in the throttle body assembly. This plate
angle controls idle, idle quality, and eliminates the need for an IAC valve.
- There is one reference voltage and one signal return circuit between the PCM and the ETB. The
reference voltage and the signal return circuits are shared with the reference voltage and signal
return circuits used by the accelerator pedal position (APP) sensor. There are also two throttle
position (TP) signal circuits for redundancy. The redundant TP signals are required for increased
monitoring reasons. The first TP signal (TP1) has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing
voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage).
The TP2 signal reaches a limit of approximately 4.5 volts at approximately 45 degrees of throttle
angle.
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor
Depending on the application either a 2-track or 3-track APP sensor is used. For additional
information on the APP sensor, refer to Engine Control Components See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Description and Operation/Engine Control
Components.
Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) System Strategy
The torque-based ETC strategy was developed to improve fuel economy and to accommodate
variable camshaft timing (VCT). This is possible by not coupling the throttle angle to the driver
pedal position. Uncoupling the throttle angle (produce engine torque) from the pedal position (driver
demand)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 423
allows the powertrain control strategy to optimize fuel control and transmission shift schedules
while delivering the requested wheel torque.
The ETC monitor system is distributed across two processors within the PCM: the main powertrain
control processor unit (CPU) and a separate monitoring processor. The primary monitoring function
is carried out by the independent plausibility check (IPC) software, which resides on the main
processor. It is responsible for determining the driver-demanded torque and comparing it to an
estimate of the actual torque delivered. If the generated torque exceeds driver demand by a
specified amount, appropriate corrective action is taken.
ETC System With A 3-Track APP Sensor Failure Mode And Effects Management:
a - ETC illuminates or displays a message on the message center immediately; MIL illuminates
after 2 driving cycles
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 424
ETC System With A 2-Track APP Sensor Failure Mode And Effects Management:
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation:
a - Monitor execution is continuous. Monitor false detection duration is less than 1 second to
register a concern.
APP and TP Sensor Inputs
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 425
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Check:
Correlation and range/performance - sensor disagreement between processors internal to the
PCM. Monitor execution is continuous. Monitor false detection duration is less than 1 second to
register a concern. Refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Charts and Descriptions for additional
DTC information.
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Check:
a - Correlation and range/performance - sensor disagreement between processors internal to the
PCM, TP inconsistent with requested throttle plate position. Monitor execution is continuous.
Monitor false detection duration is less than 1 second to register a concern. Refer to Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DTC) Charts and Descriptions for additional DTC information.
Electronic Throttle Actuator Control (TAC) Output
Electronic TAC Operation Check:
a - Note: For all DTCs, in addition to the MIL, the powertrain malfunction indicator (wrench) is on for
the concern that caused the FMEM action. Monitor execution is continuous. Monitor false detection
duration is less than 5 seconds to register a concern.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 10-12-4 > Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh Downshifts
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh Downshifts
TSB 10-12-4
07/05/10
5.4L 3V AND 6R80 TRANSMISSION - DELAYED/HARSH DOWNSHIFT ABOVE 40 MPH (64
KM/H)
FORD: 2009-2010 Expedition, F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built on or before 5/1/2010 and
2009-2010 F-150 vehicles built on or before 2/1/2010 and equipped with 5.4L 3V engine and 6R80
transmission may exhibit a delayed then harsh downshift during a commanded downshift at speeds
above 40 MPH (64 Km/h).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
ID vehicle.
2. Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 67.03 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the 1CM Calibration is:
(1) AL3P-7J104-AC for all vehicles except the F-150 4X4.
(2) AL3P-7J104-BC for F-150 4X4.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox
(2) Powertrain
(3) OBD Test Modes
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info
(5) 1CM Cal Part Number
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT 1CM KAM BE CLEARED FOR THIS PROCEDURE TO BE FULLY
EFFECTIVE
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox
(2) Choose Powertrain Then Choose TCM
(3) Choose Reset KAM
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 10-12-4 > Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh Downshifts >
Page 434
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset 1CM KAM
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM
KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop, allow at least six (6) seconds.
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101204A 2009-2010 Expedition, 1.0 Hr.
Navigator, F-150: Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM And Perform Road
Tests (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 10-12-4 > Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh Downshifts >
Page 435
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
TSB 09-15-8
08/10/09
5.4L 3V 6R80 - HARSH 1-2 UPSHIFT - HARSH 2-1 DOWNSHIFT WHILE COASTING - HARSH
DOWNSHIFT TO 4TH GEAR - INTERMITTENT P0741
FORD: 2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with 5.4L 3V engine may exhibit
symptoms during warm-up: a harsh 1-2 upshift, harsh 2-1 downshift while coasting 15 MPH (24
Km/h). A harsh downshift into 4th gear at highway speeds 45-70 MPH (72-113 Km/h) may also be
experienced. Some vehicles may have a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0741 torque converter
performance code present or stored.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
MECHATRONIC REPAIR/REPLACEMENT IS NOT
AUTHORIZED FOR THIS ISSUE.
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the Powertrain Control Module/Transmission Control Module (PCM/TCM) calibration
using IDS release 61.15 and higher or 62.03 and
higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be
obtained at the website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the TCM Calibration shows AL3P-7J104-AB part number after reprogramming is
complete.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) OBD Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR TSB TO BE
FULLY AFFECTIVE
3. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts >
Page 440
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM.
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175° F (79° C). If it is not at
175° F (79° C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175° F (79° C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091508A 2009 Expedition, Navigator 1.0 Hr.
6R80 Transmission: Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear The
TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts >
Page 441
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-12-4 > Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh
Downshifts
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh
Downshifts
TSB 10-12-4
07/05/10
5.4L 3V AND 6R80 TRANSMISSION - DELAYED/HARSH DOWNSHIFT ABOVE 40 MPH (64
KM/H)
FORD: 2009-2010 Expedition, F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built on or before 5/1/2010 and
2009-2010 F-150 vehicles built on or before 2/1/2010 and equipped with 5.4L 3V engine and 6R80
transmission may exhibit a delayed then harsh downshift during a commanded downshift at speeds
above 40 MPH (64 Km/h).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
ID vehicle.
2. Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 67.03 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the 1CM Calibration is:
(1) AL3P-7J104-AC for all vehicles except the F-150 4X4.
(2) AL3P-7J104-BC for F-150 4X4.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox
(2) Powertrain
(3) OBD Test Modes
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info
(5) 1CM Cal Part Number
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT 1CM KAM BE CLEARED FOR THIS PROCEDURE TO BE FULLY
EFFECTIVE
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox
(2) Choose Powertrain Then Choose TCM
(3) Choose Reset KAM
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-12-4 > Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh
Downshifts > Page 447
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset 1CM KAM
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM
KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop, allow at least six (6) seconds.
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101204A 2009-2010 Expedition, 1.0 Hr.
Navigator, F-150: Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM And Perform Road
Tests (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-12-4 > Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh
Downshifts > Page 448
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4
Shifts
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4
Shifts
TSB 09-15-8
08/10/09
5.4L 3V 6R80 - HARSH 1-2 UPSHIFT - HARSH 2-1 DOWNSHIFT WHILE COASTING - HARSH
DOWNSHIFT TO 4TH GEAR - INTERMITTENT P0741
FORD: 2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with 5.4L 3V engine may exhibit
symptoms during warm-up: a harsh 1-2 upshift, harsh 2-1 downshift while coasting 15 MPH (24
Km/h). A harsh downshift into 4th gear at highway speeds 45-70 MPH (72-113 Km/h) may also be
experienced. Some vehicles may have a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0741 torque converter
performance code present or stored.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
MECHATRONIC REPAIR/REPLACEMENT IS NOT
AUTHORIZED FOR THIS ISSUE.
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the Powertrain Control Module/Transmission Control Module (PCM/TCM) calibration
using IDS release 61.15 and higher or 62.03 and
higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be
obtained at the website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the TCM Calibration shows AL3P-7J104-AB part number after reprogramming is
complete.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) OBD Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR TSB TO BE
FULLY AFFECTIVE
3. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4
Shifts > Page 453
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM.
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175° F (79° C). If it is not at
175° F (79° C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175° F (79° C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091508A 2009 Expedition, Navigator 1.0 Hr.
6R80 Transmission: Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear The
TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4
Shifts > Page 454
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
455
Engine Control Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
456
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
457
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
458
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
459
Engine Control Module: Diagrams
C175B Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
460
C175B Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
461
C175B Part 3
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
462
C175E Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
463
C175E Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
464
C175E Part 3
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
465
C175T Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
466
C175T Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Engine Control Module: Procedures
Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EEPROM)
Description
The EEPROM is contained in an integrated circuit internal to the powertrain control module (PCM).
The EEPROM contains the vehicle strategy including calibration information specific to the vehicle,
and is capable of being programmed or flashed repeatedly.
As part of the calibration there is an area referred to as the vehicle identification (VID) block. The
VID block is programmed when installing a new PCM as described under Programming the VID
Block for a Replacement PCM. Failure to carry out this procedure may generate DTC P1635 or
P1639. The VID block in an existing PCM can also be tailored to accommodate various hardware
or parameter changes made to the vehicle since production. Failure to carry out this procedure
properly may generate DTC P1635, Tire/Axle Ratio out of Acceptable Range. An incorrect tire/axle
ratio is one of the main causes for DTC P1639. This is described under Making Changes to the VID
Block and also under Making Changes to the PCM Calibration. The VID block contains many items
used by the strategy for a variety of functions. Some of these items include the vehicle identification
number (VIN), octane adjust, fuel octane, fuel type, vehicle speed limit, tire size, axle ratio, the
presence of speed control, and 4-wheel drive electronic shift-on-the-fly (ESOF) versus manual
shift-on-the-fly (MSOF). Only items applicable to the vehicle hardware and supported by the VID
block is displayed on the scan tool.
When changing items in the VID block, the strategy places range limits on certain items such as
tire and axle ratio. The number of times the VID block may be reconfigured is limited. When this
limit is reached, the scan tool displays a message indicating the need to flash the PCM again to
reset the VID block.
On selected vehicles equipped with permanent DTC reporting capabilities, neutral profile correction
should be learned after a PCM replacement in order to activate the misfire monitor. This can be
accomplished using the Misfire Monitor Neutral Profile Learn function on the scan tool.
Programming can be carried out by a local Ford dealer or any non-Ford facility. Refer to the scan
tool manufacturer's instruction manual for details.
Neutral Profile Correction
In order for the misfire detection system to function properly, any mechanical inaccuracies in the
crankshaft position (CKP) sensor must be learned by the PCM. This information is stored in
non-volatile memory (NVM) in the PCM. It is not cleared when the keep alive memory (KAM) is
reset.
Neutral profile learning is accomplished using the scan tool any time a PCM is replaced. It should
also be relearned any time the CKP sensor is replaced or major engine repairs have been
completed.
To determine if the neutral profile learning has been completed, check the MP_LRN parameter
identification (PID) using the scan tool. The PID should read YES if the neutral profile learning has
been completed. If the PID reads NO, complete the neutral profile learning prior to diagnosing any
misfire DTCs.
Programming the VID Block for a Replacement PCM
The VID block on a replacement PCM is blank and requires programming. There are two
procedures available. The first is an automatic data transfer from the old PCM to the new PCM,
and the second is manual data entry into the new PCM.
Automatic data transfer is carried out if the old PCM is capable of communicating. This is done by
using a scan tool to retrieve data from the old PCM before removing it from the vehicle. The stored
data can be downloaded to the new PCM after it has been installed.
Carry out manual data entry if the old PCM is damaged or incapable of communicating. Remove
and install a new PCM. Using a compatible scan tool, select and carry out the module/parameter
programming, referring to the scan tool manufacturer's instruction manual. Make certain that all
parameters are included. Failure to properly program tire size in revolutions per mile, (rev/mile
equals 63,360 divided by the tire circumference in inches), axle ratio, 4x4/4x2, and/or MSOF/ESOF
may result in DTCs P1635 and P1639. You may be instructed to contact the As-Built Data Center
for the information needed to manually update the VID block with the scan tool. Contact the center
only if the old PCM cannot be used or the data is corrupt. For Ford and Lincoln Mercury
technicians, contact your National Hotline or the Professional Technician Society (PTS) website for
As-Built data listed under the Service Publications Index. Non-Ford technicians use the
Motorcraft(R) website at www.motorcraft.com. From the Motorcraft(R) homepage, use the search
function to find the Module Programming or As-Built Data.
For Ford and Lincoln Mercury technicians, check the Programmable Module Installation link on the
PTS website for quick Programmable Module data information by vehicle.
Making Changes to the VID Block
A programmed PCM may require changes to be made to certain VID information to accommodate
the vehicle hardware. Refer to Module Reprogramming on the scan tool.
Making Changes to the PCM Calibration
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 469
At certain times, the entire EEPROM needs to be completely reprogrammed. This is due to
changes made to the strategy or calibration after production, or the need to reset the VID block
because it has reached its limit. Refer to Module Reprogramming on the scan tool.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 470
Engine Control Module: Removal and Replacement
Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: Refer to Computers and Control Systems Information for correct Vehicle Communication
Module (VCM) hook-up procedure.
If servicing the PCM, connect the scan tool to the vehicle. Allow the scan tool to identify the vehicle
and obtain configuration data.
- All programmable module information will automatically be retrieved by the VCM.
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
3. Disconnect the 3 PCM electrical connectors.
4. Remove the 2 stud bolts and the PCM.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
5. NOTE: If the Instrument Cluster (IC) or the PCM is being replaced (or both), the parameters
must be reset in both modules or the vehicle will
experience a Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) no-start. This will occur even if the vehicle is not
equipped with PATS.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
6. Using the scan tool, perform the Misfire Monitor Neutral Profile Correction procedure, following
the on-screen instructions.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 474
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 475
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Control Unit > Component Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pump Control Unit: Service and Repair
Fuel Pump Control Module
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the fuel pump control module electrical connector.
2. Remove the 2 bolts and the fuel pump control module.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 483
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 484
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 488
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 489
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations
Air Bag Control Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 494
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 495
Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams
C310A
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 496
C310B Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 497
C310B Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 498
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair
Restraints Control Module (RCM)
NOTE: Seats removed for clarity.
Removal
WARNING: If a vehicle has been in a crash, inspect the restraints control module (RCM) and the
impact sensor (if equipped) mounting areas for deformation. If damaged, restore the mounting
areas to the original production configuration. A new RCM and sensors must be installed whether
or not the air bags have deployed. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury or death in a crash.
WARNING: Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the
restraints control module (RCM) while the RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON. Failure
to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of the Safety Canopy(R) and
cause serious personal injury or death.
NOTICE: When installing a new Restraints Control Module (RCM), it is necessary to carry out
Programmable Module Installation (PMI). When installing a new RCM, always make sure the
correct RCM is being installed. If an incorrect RCM is installed, erroneous Diagnostic Trouble
Codes (DTCs) will result. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Information Bus/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All vehicles
NOTE: Carrying out Programmable Module Installation (PMI) will not enable the 911 assist option
that is disabled. The RCM and Accessory Protocol
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 499
Interface Module (APIM) must be configured correctly to fully support 911 assist functionality.
1. When installing a new RCM, carry out the appropriate steps necessary for the PMI procedure.
2. Depower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering. See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Air Bag(s) Arming and
Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering
Vehicles with center console
3. Remove the center console.
Vehicles with bucket seats without center console
4. Position the carpet aside and remove the 3 RCM pushnut retainers and the RCM cover.
All vehicles
5. Disconnect the small RCM electrical connector.
1. Push down to release the retaining tab.
2. While releasing the retaining tab, pull out and disconnect the small RCM electrical connector.
6. Disconnect the large RCM electrical connector.
1. Pinch the thumb tab and pivot the connector position assurance lever away from the RCM,
disengaging the lever.
2. Pull out and disconnect the large RCM electrical connector.
7. Remove the 3 bolts and RCM.
Installation
All vehicles
1. WARNING: Always tighten the fasteners of the restraints control module (RCM) and impact
sensor (if equipped) to the specified torque.
Failure to do so may result in incorrect restraint system operation, which increases the risk of
personal injury or death in a crash.
Install the RCM and 3 bolts. Tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
2. Make sure the connector position assurance lever is in the full release position before attempting
to connect the connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 500
3. NOTICE: Putting the large Restraints Control Module (RCM) electrical connector into the RCM
on an angle can cause bad electrical
connections and damage components.
Position the large electrical connector into the RCM. NOTICE: Do not push on the connector so that the lever pivots and seats itself. Light pressure is
needed to get the connector into position on the Restraints Control Module (RCM) before using the
lever to fully seat the connector.
With the large RCM electrical connector uniformly aligned to the RCM, lightly push in until a subtle
audible click is heard and slight resistance is felt.
4. Connect the RCM electrical connector.
- Pivot the connector position assurance lever toward the RCM, drawing the connector in to the
RCM. Make sure the thumb tab is engaged to the retainer on the RCM and locked in place.
5. Connect the small RCM electrical connector.
Vehicles with bucket seats without center console
6. Install the 3 pushnut retainers and RCM cover.
Vehicles with center console
7. Install the center console.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 501
All vehicles
8. Repower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Air Bag(s) Arming and
Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering.
9. If a new RCM was installed, carry out the appropriate steps in the Programmable Module
Installation (PMI) procedure. See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Information Bus/Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning
10. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition switch from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the ignition switch back to ON
and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag
warning indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn OFF. If an air
bag SRS fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will:
- fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The air bag warning indicator might not light until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch
has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator and any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous memory DTCs from the RCM.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Starter Relay
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Starter Relay > Page 507
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Starter Relay
Starter Relay: Testing and Inspection Starter Relay
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Starter Relay > Page 510
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Starter Relay > Page 511
Starter Relay: Testing and Inspection Run/Start Relay
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Starter Relay > Page 512
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules Suspension > Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules Suspension > Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Suspension Control Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules Suspension > Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 521
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules Suspension > Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 522
Suspension Control Module: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules Suspension > Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 523
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules Suspension > Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 524
Suspension Control Module: Service and Repair
Vehicle Dynamics Module (VDM)
Removal and Installation
NOTICE: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these charges,
damage may result.
1. NOTE: The Vehicle Dynamics Module (VDM) is mounted to the lower left side of the dash above
the parking brake control.
Disconnect the 2 VDM electrical connectors.
2. Remove the VDM bracket nuts and the module.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
3. NOTE: The VDM is calibrated with information from the ride height sensors. A new or exchanged
VDM requires that the LH and RH ride height
sensors are calibrated and a Pneumatic Test is carried out. For additional information, refer to
Vehicle Dynamic Suspension See: Steering and Suspension/Suspension/Suspension Control (
Automatic - Electronic )/Testing and Inspection Calibration Initialize System - Clear C1990 and
C1991 DTCs.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module:
> 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
Control Module: Customer Interest Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
TSB 09-15-8
08/10/09
5.4L 3V 6R80 - HARSH 1-2 UPSHIFT - HARSH 2-1 DOWNSHIFT WHILE COASTING - HARSH
DOWNSHIFT TO 4TH GEAR - INTERMITTENT P0741
FORD: 2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with 5.4L 3V engine may exhibit
symptoms during warm-up: a harsh 1-2 upshift, harsh 2-1 downshift while coasting 15 MPH (24
Km/h). A harsh downshift into 4th gear at highway speeds 45-70 MPH (72-113 Km/h) may also be
experienced. Some vehicles may have a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0741 torque converter
performance code present or stored.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
MECHATRONIC REPAIR/REPLACEMENT IS NOT
AUTHORIZED FOR THIS ISSUE.
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the Powertrain Control Module/Transmission Control Module (PCM/TCM) calibration
using IDS release 61.15 and higher or 62.03 and
higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be
obtained at the website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the TCM Calibration shows AL3P-7J104-AB part number after reprogramming is
complete.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) OBD Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR TSB TO BE
FULLY AFFECTIVE
3. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module:
> 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 535
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM.
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175° F (79° C). If it is not at
175° F (79° C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175° F (79° C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091508A 2009 Expedition, Navigator 1.0 Hr.
6R80 Transmission: Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear The
TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module:
> 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 536
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
TSB 09-15-8
08/10/09
5.4L 3V 6R80 - HARSH 1-2 UPSHIFT - HARSH 2-1 DOWNSHIFT WHILE COASTING - HARSH
DOWNSHIFT TO 4TH GEAR - INTERMITTENT P0741
FORD: 2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with 5.4L 3V engine may exhibit
symptoms during warm-up: a harsh 1-2 upshift, harsh 2-1 downshift while coasting 15 MPH (24
Km/h). A harsh downshift into 4th gear at highway speeds 45-70 MPH (72-113 Km/h) may also be
experienced. Some vehicles may have a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0741 torque converter
performance code present or stored.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
MECHATRONIC REPAIR/REPLACEMENT IS NOT
AUTHORIZED FOR THIS ISSUE.
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the Powertrain Control Module/Transmission Control Module (PCM/TCM) calibration
using IDS release 61.15 and higher or 62.03 and
higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be
obtained at the website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the TCM Calibration shows AL3P-7J104-AB part number after reprogramming is
complete.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) OBD Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR TSB TO BE
FULLY AFFECTIVE
3. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 542
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM.
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175° F (79° C). If it is not at
175° F (79° C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175° F (79° C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091508A 2009 Expedition, Navigator 1.0 Hr.
6R80 Transmission: Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear The
TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 543
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 548
Heated Glass Element Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 549
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Quarter Window Open Relay
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Quarter Window Open Relay > Page 554
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay
Power Window Relay: Testing and Inspection Quarter Window Close Relay
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay > Page 557
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay > Page 558
Power Window Relay: Testing and Inspection Quarter Window Open Relay
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay > Page 559
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 564
Wiper Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 565
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 571
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 572
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left > Page 577
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left > Page 578
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left > Page 579
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left > Page 580
Parking Assist Distance Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left > Page 581
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left > Page 582
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left > Page 583
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left > Page 584
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left > Page 585
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left > Page 586
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left > Page 587
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor Front Outer Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor Front Outer Left > Page 590
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor Front Outer Left > Page 591
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor Front Outer Left > Page 592
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor Front Outer Left > Page 593
Parking Assist Distance Sensor: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor Front Outer Left > Page 594
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor Front Outer Left > Page 595
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor Front Outer Left > Page 596
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Aid Sensor - Front
Parking Assist Distance Sensor: Service and Repair Parking Aid Sensor - Front
Parking Aid Sensor - Front
Sedan
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front bumper cover.
2. Disconnect the parking aid sensor electrical connectors.
3. NOTE: Press the retaining tabs to release the sensor(s).
Remove the parking aid sensor(s).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- NOTICE: Paint the new sensor(s) with base coat and one coat of clear. Excessive paint film
buildup may result in incorrect sensor operation.
Using the scan tool, verify that the parking aid sensor PIDs read no object present, and that the
parking aid sensor attenuation PIDs read between 0.8-1.6 ms. If the parking aid sensor attenuation
PIDs do not read between 0.8-1.6 ms, the paint is too thick on the sensor(s) and it will be
necessary to repaint the sensor(s) as required.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Aid Sensor - Front > Page 599
Parking Assist Distance Sensor: Service and Repair Parking Aid Sensor - Rear
Parking Aid Sensor - Rear
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear bumper cover.
2. Disconnect the parking aid sensor electrical connectors.
3. NOTE: Press the retaining tabs to release the sensor(s).
Remove the parking aid sensor(s).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Using the scan tool, verify that the parking aid sensor PIDs read no object present, and that the
parking aid sensor attenuation PIDs read between 0.8-1.6 ms.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Locations
Pedal Positioning Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 603
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 604
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Adjustable Pedal Switch - Without Memory
Pedal Positioning Switch: Testing and Inspection Adjustable Pedal Switch - Without Memory
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Adjustable Pedal Switch - Without Memory > Page
607
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Adjustable Pedal Switch - Without Memory > Page
608
Pedal Positioning Switch: Testing and Inspection Adjustable Pedal Switch - With Memory
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Adjustable Pedal Switch - Without Memory > Page
609
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor >
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor >
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 615
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor >
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 616
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Pedal Positioning Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 620
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 621
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Adjustable Pedal Switch - Without Memory
Pedal Positioning Switch: Testing and Inspection Adjustable Pedal Switch - Without Memory
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Adjustable Pedal Switch - Without Memory > Page 624
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Adjustable Pedal Switch - Without Memory > Page 625
Pedal Positioning Switch: Testing and Inspection Adjustable Pedal Switch - With Memory
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Adjustable Pedal Switch - Without Memory > Page 626
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side
Power Door Lock Switch: Locations Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side > Page 631
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side > Page 632
Power Door Lock Switch: Locations Door Lock Switch, Driver Side
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side > Page 633
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Door Lock Switch, Driver Side
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Door Lock Switch, Driver Side > Page 636
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 637
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 638
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Power Mirror Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 642
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 643
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 644
Power Mirror Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 645
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 646
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 647
Power Mirror Switch: Service and Repair
Exterior Mirror Control Switch
NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the driver front door trim panel.
2. Remove the exterior mirror control switch.
1. Depress the locking tabs.
2. Remove the exterior mirror control switch.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front Height Position Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front Height Position Sensor > Page 652
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front Height Position Sensor > Page 653
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front Height Position Sensor > Page 654
Power Seat Motor Position Sensor: Locations Height Sensor, Left Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front Height Position Sensor > Page 655
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front Height Position Sensor > Page 656
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front Height Position Sensor > Page 657
Power Seat Motor Position Sensor: Locations Height Sensor, Right Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front Height Position Sensor > Page 658
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor > Page 661
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor > Page 662
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor > Page 663
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor > Page 664
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Third Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left
Power Seat Switch: Locations Third Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Third Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left > Page 669
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Third Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left > Page 670
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Third Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left > Page 671
Power Seat Switch: Locations Third Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Right
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Third Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left > Page 672
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Third Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left > Page 673
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Third Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left > Page 674
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Third Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left > Page 675
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Seat Control Switch, Left
Power Seat Switch: Diagrams Seat Control Switch, Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Seat Control Switch, Left > Page 678
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Seat Control Switch, Left > Page 679
Power Seat Switch: Diagrams Seat Control Switch, Right
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Seat Control Switch, Left > Page 680
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Seat Control Switch, Left > Page 681
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Seat Control Switch, Left > Page 682
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 685
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 686
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Right
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 687
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 688
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Seat Control Switch, 6-Way - Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 689
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 690
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Seat Control Switch, 6-Way - Right
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 691
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 692
ERROR: undefined
OFFENDING COMMAND: f‘~
STACK:
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 693
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 694
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 695
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 696
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 697
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 698
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 699
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 700
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 701
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 702
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 703
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 704
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent
NOTE: Driver power seat backrest shown, passenger and manual similar.
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent
NOTE: Driver memory seat shown, driver and passenger power seat similar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 707
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 708
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 709
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Memory Set Switch
Memory Set Switch
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on safety belt buckle/retractor pretensioners or
adaptive load limiting retractors. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental
deployment of the safety belt pretensioners or adaptive load limiting retractors, which increases the
risk of serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on air bag, Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain
modules. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of these
modules, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: For component identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Front See: Body
and Frame/Seats/Service and Repair/Front Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Front.
All seats
1. NOTICE: Do not pull from the inboard side of the front seat cushion panel shield to avoid
damaging it.
Remove the front seat cushion panel shield.
- Release the upper retaining clips working from the outboard side and then release the lower
retaining clips.
Driver seat side shield with insert
2. Release the retainers and remove the insert from the side shield.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
Driver seat side shield with cover
3. Remove the front side shield screw.
4. Remove the side shield cover.
All seats
5. Release the clips and remove the memory SET switch.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 710
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate
Hazard Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Pinch Strip, Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate
Hazard Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Pinch Strip, Left > Page 715
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Handle Release Switch
Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock Switch: Locations Handle Release Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Handle Release Switch > Page 720
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Handle Release Switch > Page 721
Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock Switch: Locations Liftgate Glass Release Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Handle Release Switch > Page 722
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Handle Release Switch
Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock Switch: Diagrams Handle Release Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Handle Release Switch > Page 725
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Handle Release Switch > Page 726
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 727
Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock Switch: Service and Repair
Liftgate Release Switch
Expedition
Navigator
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel.
- Position the water shield aside.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 728
Expedition
2. Remove the 2 nuts and the liftgate release handle.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
3. Remove the liftgate release switch.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
Navigator
4. Remove the liftgate parking lamps.
5. Remove the 6 nuts and the license plate housing.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
6. Remove the 2 nuts and the liftgate release switch housing.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
7. Remove the liftgate release switch.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
All vehicles
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Heated Seat Switch, Left Rear
Seat Heater Switch: Locations Heated Seat Switch, Left Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Heated Seat Switch, Left Rear > Page 733
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Heated Seat Switch, Left Rear > Page 734
Seat Heater Switch: Locations Heated Seat Switch, Right Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Heated Seat Switch, Left Rear > Page 735
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Seat Switch, Left Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Seat Switch, Left Rear > Page 738
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent
NOTE: Driver power seat backrest shown, passenger and manual similar.
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent
NOTE: Driver memory seat shown, driver and passenger power seat similar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 741
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 742
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 743
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Seat Control Switch - Front
Seat Control Switch - Front
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on safety belt buckle/retractor pretensioners or
adaptive load limiting retractors. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental
deployment of the safety belt pretensioners or adaptive load limiting retractors, which increases the
risk of serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on air bag, Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain
modules. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of these
modules, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: For component identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Front See: Body
and Frame/Seats/Service and Repair/Front Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Front.
NOTE: Driver seat shown, passenger similar.
All seats
1. NOTICE: Do not pull from the inboard side of the front seat cushion panel shield to avoid
damaging it.
Remove the front seat cushion panel shield.
- Release the upper retaining clips working from the outboard side and then release the lower
retaining clips.
Side shield with insert
2. Release the retainers and remove the insert from the side shield.
- Disconnect the electrical connector(s).
Side shield with cover
3. Remove the front side shield screw.
4. Remove the side shield cover.
- Disconnect the electrical connector(s).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 744
All seats
5. Pull and remove the seat control switch button(s).
- If equipped, remove the power recliner switch button.
6. Release the clips and remove the seat control switch.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 745
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Heated Seat Switch - Second Row
Heated Seat Switch - Second Row
Removal and Installation
1. Release the 4 retainer clips and remove the rear cup holder.
- Remove any remaining retainers from the floor console and reinstall to the cup holder before
installation.
2. Remove the front floor console rear panel.
- Remove the 2 screws.
- Release the 6 retainer clips and separate the rear panel.
- Disconnect all the electrical connectors and remove the rear panel.
- Remove any remaining retainers from the floor console and reinstall to the rear cover before
installation.
3. Release and remove the heated seat switch(es).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 746
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Seat Control Switch - Third Row
Seat Control Switch - Third Row
Removal and Installation
1. Release and remove the tray from the RH rear quarter trim panel.
2. NOTE: The LH and RH switch wiring harness electrical connectors are not interchangeable.
Remove the affected seat control switch.
- Release the 2 retaining tabs and detach the seat control switch from the RH rear quarter trim
panel.
- Pull the seat control switch through the opening and disconnect the electrical connector.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Memory Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Memory Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 750
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Switch
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Switch
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 754
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Rear Control Switch
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Locations Liftgate Rear Control Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Rear Control Switch > Page 759
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Rear Control Switch > Page 760
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Rear Control Switch > Page 761
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Locations Power Liftgate/Traction Control/Hazard Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Rear Control Switch > Page 762
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Rear Control Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Rear Control Switch > Page 765
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Position
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
Trunk / Liftgate Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Pinch Strip Switch
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Left side shown, right side similar.
1. Remove the brake light.
- Remove the screws.
2. Disconnect the pinch strip electrical connector.
3. Remove the pinch strip.
1. Remove the pin-type retainers.
2. Remove the grommet and route the harness out of the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Position
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 769
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS Sensor
Block > Component Information > Locations
ABS Sensor Block: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS Sensor
Block > Component Information > Locations > Page 774
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS Sensor
Block > Component Information > Locations > Page 775
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control >
Acceleration/Deceleration Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
Acceleration/Deceleration Sensor: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
Vehicles with floor shift
1. Remove the front floor console.
2. Remove the 4 bolts and the front floor console support bracket.
- To install: Tighten the upper bolts to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
- Tighten the lower bolts to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
Vehicles with column shift
3. Remove the stability control sensor cover.
All vehicles
4. Disconnect the stability control sensor cluster electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control >
Acceleration/Deceleration Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 779
5. Remove the 2 bolts and the stability control sensor cluster.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Connect the scan tool and carry out the IVD Initialization sequence.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Booster
Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Brake Booster Vacuum Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Booster
Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 783
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Booster
Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 784
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 788
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 789
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 793
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 794
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Service and Repair
Steering Angle Sensor: Service and Repair
Steering Wheel Rotation Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the steering wheel rotation sensor electrical connector.
2. Remove the 2 bolts and the steering wheel rotation sensor.
- To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
4. NOTE: If the sensor is not calibrated after installation, a DTC will be set in the ABS module.
Calibrate the sensor in the following sequence:
1. Start the engine.
2. Rotate the steering wheel from lock to lock a minimum of 2 times.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction Control
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Traction Control Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction Control
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 801
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction Control
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 802
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 807
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 808
Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Wheel Speed Sensor, Right Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 809
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 810
Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 811
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 812
Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Wheel Speed Sensor, Right Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 813
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 816
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 817
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 818
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the wheel and tire.
2. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector.
3. Remove the wheel speed sensor harness bolt and detach the retainers.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
4. NOTICE: Do not allow the caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can result.
Remove the 2 caliper anchor bolts and position the caliper, pads and anchor plate aside.
- Support the caliper with mechanic's wire.
- To install, tighten to 200 Nm (148 lb-ft).
5. Remove the brake disc.
6. Remove the front wheel speed sensor bolt and the sensor.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front > Page 821
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the parking brake shoes.
2. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor harness from the retaining clips.
3. Remove the rear wheel speed sensor bolt and the sensor.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Radiator Cooling Fan Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Fan Speed Sensor (FSS)
The FSS is a Hall-effect sensor that measures the cooling fan clutch speed by generating a
waveform with a frequency proportional to the fan speed. If the cooling fan clutch is moving at a
relatively low speed, the sensor produces a signal with a low frequency. As the cooling fan clutch
speed increases, the sensor generates a signal with a higher frequency. The PCM uses the
frequency signal generated by the FSS as a feedback for closed loop control of the cooling fan
clutch. For additional information on the cooling fan clutch, refer to the Cooling Fan Clutch.
Cooling Fan Clutch with Fan Speed Sensor (FSS)
Cooling Fan Clutch with FSS
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
The ECT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The ECT measures the temperature of the engine coolant. The PCM uses the ECT input for fuel
control and for cooling fan control. There are three types of ECT sensors, threaded, push-in, and
twist-lock. The ECT sensor is located in an engine coolant passage.
Typical Thread Type Sensor
Typical Thread Type ECT Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 833
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 834
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Cylinder Head Temperature (CHT) Sensor
The CHT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with the temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
The CHT sensor is installed in the cylinder head and measures the metal temperature. The CHT
sensor can provide complete engine temperature information and can be used to infer coolant
temperature. If the CHT sensor conveys an overheating condition to the PCM, the PCM initiates a
fail-safe cooling strategy based on information from the CHT sensor. A cooling system concern
such as low coolant or coolant loss could cause an overheating condition. As a result, damage to
major engine components could occur. Using both the CHT sensor and fail-safe cooling strategy,
the PCM prevents damage by allowing air cooling of the engine and limp home capability. For
additional information, refer to Powertrain Control Software See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Description and Operation/Powertrain Control
Software for Fail-Safe Cooling Strategy.
Typical CHT Sensor
Typical CHT Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 835
Engine Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
Cylinder Head Temperature (CHT) Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold.
2. Disconnect the Cylinder Head Temperature (CHT) sensor electrical connector.
3. Remove the CHT sensor and discard.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Coat the new CHT sensor threads with high temperature nickel anti-seize lubricant prior to
installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control)
> Component Information > Locations
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control)
> Component Information > Locations > Page 840
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control)
> Component Information > Locations > Page 841
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control)
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
Engine Control Components
Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to as the stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal
to the PCM indicating the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Typical BPP Switch
Typical BPP Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control)
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch > Page 844
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Brake Pedal Switch (BPS)/Brake
Deactivator Switch
Engine Control Components
Brake Pedal Switch (BPS)/Brake Deactivator Switch
The BPS, also called the brake deactivator switch, is for vehicle speed control deactivation. A
normally closed switch supplies battery positive voltage (B+) to the PCM when the brake pedal is
not applied. When the brake pedal is applied, the normally closed switch opens and power is
removed from the PCM.
On some applications the normally closed BPS, along with the normally open BPP switch, are used
for a brake rationality test within the PCM. The PCM misfire monitor profile learn function may be
disabled if a brake switch concern occurs. If one or both brake pedal inputs to the PCM is not
changing states when they were expected to, a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) is set by the PCM
strategy.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise Control
> Component Information > Description and Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
The CPP switch is an input to the PCM indicating the clutch pedal position. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the CPP circuit. When the CPP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The CPP input to the PCM is used to detect a reduction in engine
load. The PCM uses the load information for mass air flow and fuel calculations.
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair
Speed Control Switch
Expedition
Navigator
Removal and Installation
Expedition
NOTE: It is not necessary to remove the driver air bag module during this procedure.
NOTE: Be careful not to allow the speed control switch electrical connector to fall back into the
steering wheel.
1. Remove the speed control switch by pulling the switch toward the rear of the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 851
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
Navigator
2. Remove the driver air bag module. For additional information, refer to Air Bag Systems.
3. Remove the 2 screws and the steering wheel controls bezel.
4. Remove the speed control switch by pulling the switch toward the rear of the vehicle.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
All vehicles
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 856
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 857
Oil Pressure Sender: Service and Repair
Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) Switch
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Disconnect the Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) switch electrical connector.
3. Remove the EOP switch.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Temperature Sensor/Switch,
Engine > Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Temperature Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) Sensor
The EOT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The EOT sensor measures the temperature of the engine oil. The sensor is typically threaded into
the engine oil lubrication system. The PCM can use the EOT sensor input to determine the
following:
- On variable camshaft timing (VCT) applications the EOT input is used to adjust the VCT control
gains and logic for camshaft timing.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input in conjunction with other PCM inputs to determine oil
degradation.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input to initiate a soft engine shutdown. To prevent engine
damage from occurring as a result of high oil temperatures, the PCM has the ability to initiate a soft
engine shutdown. Whenever engine RPM exceeds a calibrated level for a certain period of time,
the PCM begins reducing power by disabling engine cylinders.
Typical Thread Type Sensor
Typical EOT Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch
HVAC > Component Information > Locations
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch
HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 865
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch
HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 866
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 870
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 871
Blower Motor Switch: Service and Repair
Blower Motor Speed Control
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH lower instrument panel insulator (if equipped).
2. Disconnect the blower motor speed control electrical connector.
3. Remove the 2 blower motor speed control screws.
4. Remove the blower motor speed control.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 875
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 876
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Ambient Air Temperature Sensor
Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair Ambient Air Temperature Sensor
Ambient Air Temperature Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the upper radiator sight shield.
2. Detach and disconnect the ambient temperature sensor electrical connector.
3. Remove the ambient air temperature sensor.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Ambient Air Temperature Sensor > Page 879
Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor
In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor - Expedition
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument cluster finish panel.
2. Remove the in-vehicle temperature sensor.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 883
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 884
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Air Conditioning
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning
Air Conditioning
Evaporator Temperature Sensor
The evaporator temperature sensor communicates the evaporator fin temperature to the HVAC
module.
The PCM maintains evaporator core temperature and prevents icing of the evaporator core, by
disengaging the A/C compressor clutch when the evaporator temperature sensor reading falls
below acceptable levels, and by engaging the A/C compressor clutch when the discharge air
temperature rises above acceptable levels.
The evaporator temperature sensor electrical connector is located outside of the heater core and
evaporator core housing behind the glove compartment, with the sensor pigtail leading into the
housing to the sensor probe which is inserted between the evaporator core fins.
The evaporator temperature sensor is not available as a separate component. To install a new
evaporator temperature sensor, a new heater core and evaporator core housing must be installed.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Air Conditioning > Page 887
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Engine Control Components
Engine Control Components
Air Conditioning Evaporator Temperature (ACET) Sensor
The ACET sensor measures the evaporator air discharge temperature. The ACET sensor is a
thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of a
thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance increases as the
temperature decreases. The PCM sources a low current 5 volts on the ACET circuit. With SIG RTN
also connected to the ACET sensor, the varying resistance changes the voltage drop across the
sensor terminals. As A/C evaporator air temperature changes, the varying resistance of the ACET
sensor changes the voltage the PCM detects.
The ACET sensor is used to more accurately control A/C clutch cycling and improve defrost/demist
performance.
Note: These values can vary 15% due to sensor and VREF variations. Voltage values were
calculated for VREF equals 5.0 volts.
A/C Evaporator Temperature (ACET) Sensor Voltage And Resistance Chart
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 888
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
Air Conditioning (A/C) Evaporator Discharge Air Temperature Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Detach the glove compartment dampener and lower the glove compartment.
2. Disconnect the evaporator discharge air temperature sensor electrical connector.
3. Carefully pry the evaporator discharge air temperature sensor probe out of the heater core and
evaporator core housing.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch,
HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch,
HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > Air Conditioning (A/C) Cycling Switch
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning (A/C) Cycling
Switch
Engine Control Components
Air Conditioning (A/C) Cycling Switch
The A/C cycling switch may be wired to either the ACCS or ACPSW PCM input. When the A/C
cycling switch opens, the PCM turns off the A/C clutch. For information on the specific function of
the A/C cycling switch, refer to the Climate Control System Air Conditioning System Overview.
Also, refer to the applicable Wiring Diagrams for vehicle specific wiring.
If the ACCS signal is not received by the PCM, the PCM circuit will not allow the A/C to operate.
For additional information, refer to wide open throttle air conditioning cutoff (WAC).
Some applications do not have a dedicated (separate) input to the PCM indicating that A/C is
requested. This information is received by the PCM through the communication link.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch,
HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > Air Conditioning (A/C) Cycling Switch > Page 894
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning (A/C) High
Pressure Switch
Engine Control Components
Air Conditioning (A/C) High Pressure Switch
The A/C high pressure switch is used for additional A/C system pressure control. The A/C high
pressure switch is either dual function for multiple speed, relay controlled for electric fan
applications, or single function for all others.
For refrigerant containment control, the normally closed high pressure contacts open at a
predetermined A/C pressure. This results in the A/C turning off, preventing the A/C pressure from
rising to a level that would open the A/C high pressure relief valve.
For fan control, the normally open medium pressure contacts close at a predetermined A/C
pressure. This grounds the ACPSW circuit input to the PCM. The PCM then turns on the high
speed fan to help reduce the pressure.
For additional information, refer to the Climate Control System, Air Conditioning System Overview
or the Wiring Diagrams.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch,
HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > Air Conditioning (A/C) Cycling Switch > Page 895
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning Pressure (ACP)
Transducer Sensor
Engine Control Components
Air Conditioning Pressure (ACP) Transducer Sensor
The ACP transducer sensor is located in the high pressure (discharge) side of the A/C system. The
ACP transducer sensor provides a voltage signal to the PCM that is proportional to the A/C
pressure. The PCM uses this information for A/C clutch control, fan control and idle speed control.
A/C Pressure Transducer Sensor Output Voltage Vs Pressure Chart
Typical ACP Transducer Sensor
Typical ACP Transducer Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations
Solar Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Page 899
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Page 900
Solar Sensor: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair
Instrument Panel Dimmer Switch
NOTE: Navigator shown, Expedition similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the Instrument Cluster (IC) finish panel.
2. Press the tabs and remove the instrument panel dimmer switch.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 909
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 910
Door Switch: Locations Door Ajar Switch, Left Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 911
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 912
Door Switch: Locations Door Ajar Switch, Right Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 913
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 916
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 917
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 918
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 919
Door Switch: Service and Repair
Door Ajar Switch
NOTE: LH front door latch shown, others similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door latch. For additional information, refer to Front Door Latch See: Body and
Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front
Door/Front Door Latch/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement or Rear Door Latch See:
Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Rear Door/Rear Door Latch/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement.
2. Release the locking tab and remove the door ajar switch.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 09-11-7 > Jun > 09 >
Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity
Fuel Gauge Sender: Customer Interest Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity
TSB 09-11-7
06/15/09
LONG WHEEL BASE (LWB), LOWER THAN EXPECTED FUEL FILL CAPACITY - BUILT
BEFORE 4/10/2009
FORD: 2007-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Expedition and Navigator long wheel base (LWB) vehicles built before
4/10/2009, may encounter the amount of fuel needed to fill the fuel tank may be lower than
expected. This may be encountered when the distance to empty (DIE) states 50 miles or lower to
empty, or the fuel gauge reads lower than 1/8 tank of fuel prior to refueling.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Ask the customer the following questions.
1. Does the customer refill the fuel tank with the engine off?
a. No - Retest the vehicle with engine off before proceeding, if concern does not occur, this
procedure does not apply.
b. Yes - Go to Step 2.
NOTE
SOME CREDIT CARDS HAVE PRESET LIMITS ON THE DOLLAR AMOUNT AVAILABLE FUEL
TRANSACTION. THE PUMP WILL SHUT OFF AT THIS LIMIT. THIS LIMIT MAY BE IN THE
RANGE OF $50 TO $75.
2. Does the customer refill the fuel tank until 1 to 3 gas pump automatic shutoffs?
a. Yes - Go to Step 3.
b. No - Retest the vehicle using the gasoline pump automatic shutoff function before proceeding, if
concern does not occur, this procedure does not
apply.
3. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) using the Workshop Manual, Section 310-01 with
certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near the
gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091107A 2007-2009 Expedition, 1.8 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace The Fuel Delivery Module (Do
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 09-11-7 > Jun > 09 >
Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity > Page 928
Not Use With 9002A, 9002A6)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 09-11-7 >
Jun > 09 > Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity
Fuel Gauge Sender: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill
Capacity
TSB 09-11-7
06/15/09
LONG WHEEL BASE (LWB), LOWER THAN EXPECTED FUEL FILL CAPACITY - BUILT
BEFORE 4/10/2009
FORD: 2007-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Expedition and Navigator long wheel base (LWB) vehicles built before
4/10/2009, may encounter the amount of fuel needed to fill the fuel tank may be lower than
expected. This may be encountered when the distance to empty (DIE) states 50 miles or lower to
empty, or the fuel gauge reads lower than 1/8 tank of fuel prior to refueling.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Ask the customer the following questions.
1. Does the customer refill the fuel tank with the engine off?
a. No - Retest the vehicle with engine off before proceeding, if concern does not occur, this
procedure does not apply.
b. Yes - Go to Step 2.
NOTE
SOME CREDIT CARDS HAVE PRESET LIMITS ON THE DOLLAR AMOUNT AVAILABLE FUEL
TRANSACTION. THE PUMP WILL SHUT OFF AT THIS LIMIT. THIS LIMIT MAY BE IN THE
RANGE OF $50 TO $75.
2. Does the customer refill the fuel tank until 1 to 3 gas pump automatic shutoffs?
a. Yes - Go to Step 3.
b. No - Retest the vehicle using the gasoline pump automatic shutoff function before proceeding, if
concern does not occur, this procedure does not
apply.
3. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) using the Workshop Manual, Section 310-01 with
certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near the
gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091107A 2007-2009 Expedition, 1.8 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace The Fuel Delivery Module (Do
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 09-11-7 >
Jun > 09 > Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity > Page 934
Not Use With 9002A, 9002A6)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module
Fuel Gauge Sender: Locations Fuel Pump Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 937
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 938
Fuel Gauge Sender: Locations Fuel Pump (FP) Control Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 939
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Page 940
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Engine Control Components
Fuel Pump (FP) Module
The FP module is a device that contains the fuel pump and sender assembly. The fuel pump is
located inside the FP module reservoir and supplies fuel through the FP module manifold to the
engine and FP module jet pump. The jet pump continuously refills the reservoir with fuel, and a
check valve located in the manifold outlet maintains system pressure when the fuel pump is not
energized. A flapper valve located in the bottom of the reservoir allows fuel to enter the reservoir
and prime the fuel pump during the initial fill.
Typical Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Typical Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Typical Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Typical Mechanical Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Typical Mechanical Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump (FP) Module > Page 943
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Fuel Pump (FP) Module and Reservoir
Engine Control Components
Fuel Pump (FP) Module and Reservoir
The FP module is mounted inside the fuel tank in a reservoir. The pump has a discharge check
valve that maintains the system pressure after the ignition has been turned off to minimize starting
concerns. The reservoir prevents fuel flow interruptions during extreme vehicle maneuvers with low
tank fill levels.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View
Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View
106L (28 Gal) Fuel Tank
127L (33.5 Gal) Fuel Tank
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 946
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 947
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module
Fuel Pump Module
106L (28 Gal) Fuel Tank
127L (33.5 Gal) Fuel Tank
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 948
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
All fuel tanks
1. Remove the fuel tank. For additional information, refer to Fuel Tank See: Powertrain
Management/Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel
Tank/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Fuel Tank.
127L (33.5 gal) fuel tank
2. Remove the 4 nuts and the Fuel Pump (FP) module cover.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
3. Disconnect the return fuel tube-to-FP module quick connect coupling.
All fuel tanks
4. Disconnect the Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-FP module quick
connect coupling and the supply fuel tube-to-FP
module quick connect coupling.
5. Using the Fuel Tank Sender Unit Wrench, remove the FP lock ring.
106L (28 gal) fuel tank
6. NOTICE: Carefully remove the Fuel Pump (FP) assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level
sensor.
NOTE: If the FP does not clear the FP mounting flange on the fuel tank, the use of a screwdriver
may be necessary.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 949
Remove the FP and FP O-ring seal. If necessary, insert a screwdriver into the empty FP rod hole and slightly pull the screwdriver
inboard until the base of the FP clears the FP mounting flange.
- Discard the FP O-ring seal.
127L (33.5 gal) fuel tank
7. NOTICE: Carefully remove the Fuel Pump (FP) assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level
sensor.
NOTE: Note the location of the FP alignment tabs.
Remove the FP module assembly. Remove and discard the O-ring seal.
All fuel tanks
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 953
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 954
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Ambient Light Sensor: Service and Repair
Light Sensor
NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Using a suitable tool (such as a pocket screwdriver), remove the light sensor from the instrument
panel.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
2. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Aug > 09 > Recall Brake Light Switch Adjustment
Technical Service Bulletin # 09C09 Date: 090817
Attachment I - Administrative Information
OASIS ACTIVATED?
Yes, OASIS will be activated on June 17, 2009.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Aug > 09 > Recall Brake Light Switch Adjustment > Page 967
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED?
Yes, FSA VIN list will be available through by June 17, 2009. Owner names and addresses will be
available by July 13, 2009.
NOTE:
Your FSA VIN list may contain owner names and addresses obtained from motor vehicle
registration records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than in
connection with this recall is a violation of law in several states, provinces, and countries.
Accordingly, you must limit the use of this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this recall
action.
STOCK VEHICLES
Correct all affected units in your new vehicle inventory before delivery.
SOLD VEHICLES
^ Owners of affected vehicles will be directed to dealers for repairs.
^ Immediately contact any of your affected owners whose vehicles are not on your VIN lists but are
identified in OASIS. Give the customer a copy of the Owner Notification Letter (when available) and
schedule a service date.
^ Correct other affected vehicles identified in OASIS which are brought to your dealership.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition, call the
Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted. Ford Motor Company
reserves the right to deny coverage for related damage in cases where the vehicle owner has not
had this recall performed on a timely basis.
ADDITIONAL LABOR TIME
^ If a condition exists that requires additional labor to complete the repair, call the Special Service
Support Center to request approval prior to performing any additional labor. Requests for approval
after completion of the repair will not be granted.
^ If you encounter aftermarket equipment or modifications to the vehicle which might prevent the
repair of the covered condition, call the Special Service Support Center.
OWNER REFUNDS
Refunds are not authorized for this program.
RENTAL VEHICLES
The use of rental vehicles is not authorized for this program.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
^ Related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line on which
the FSA is claimed. Related damage requires prior approval from the Special Service Support
Center.
^ "MT" labor should be submitted on a separate repair line with the related damage flag checked.
"MT" labor requires prior approval from the Special Service Support Center.
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Aug > 09 > Recall Brake Light Switch Adjustment > Page 968
LABOR ALLOWANCES
PARTS REQUIREMENTS / ORDERING INFORMATION
Parts are not required to complete this repair.
Attachment III - Technical Information
OVERVIEW
This program involves adjustment of the brake stoplamp switch by removing and reinstalling it.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
It is very important to not press, pull or touch the brake pedal assembly during the installation of the
brake stoplamp switch. Failure to follow these instructions may damage the brake stoplamp switch.
1. Disconnect the brake stoplamp switch electrical connector.
2. NOTE: The stoplamp switch will be difficult to remove if the switch plunger is not depressed. A
slight rearward force should be adequate to depress
the plunger.
With a light force (approximately 1-4 Pounds [4-16 Newtons]), pull rearward on the brake pedal,
rotate the brake stoplamp switch 45 degrees clockwise and remove the brake stoplamp switch.
3. Without movement to the brake pedal assembly, install the brake stoplamp switch and rotate 45
degrees counterclockwise.
4. Connect the brake stoplamp switch electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Aug > 09 > Recall Brake Light Switch Adjustment > Page 969
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Aug > 09 > Recall Brake Light Switch Adjustment > Page 970
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > NHTSA09V232000 > Jun > 09 >
Recall 09V232000: Brake Light Switch Adjustment
Brake Light Switch: Recalls Recall 09V232000: Brake Light Switch Adjustment
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Ford/Expedition 2009 Lincoln/Navigator 2009
MANUFACTURER: Ford Motor Company
MFR'S REPORT DATE: June 23, 2009
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 09V232000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Service Brakes, Hydraulic: Switches: Brake Light
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 1357
SUMMARY: Ford is recalling 1,357 M/Y 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles for failing to
comply with the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No. 108, "Lamps, Reflective Devices, and
Associated Equipment." The brake stop lamp switch may be improperly adjusted. This may result
in a delay in brake stoplamp illumination when the brake pedal is depressed. In situations of very
mild brake application, the brake stoplamps may not illuminate.
CONSEQUENCE: Delay or loss of brake stoplamp function may increase the risk of a crash.
REMEDY: Dealers will adjust the brake stoplamp switch free of charge. The recall is expected to
begin on or before July 6, 2009. Owners may contact Ford Motor Company Customer Relationship
Center at 1-866-436-7332 or www.ownerconnection.com.
NOTES: Ford recall No. 09C09. Owners may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake
Light Switch Non-Compliance
Technical Service Bulletin # 09C09 Date: 090617
Attachment I - Administrative Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake
Light Switch Non-Compliance > Page 979
OASIS ACTIVATED?
Yes, OASIS will be activated on June 17,2009.
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED?
Yes, FSA VIN list will be available through the website by June 17, 2009. Owner names and
addresses will be available by July 13, 2009.
NOTE:
Your FSA VIN list may contain owner names and addresses obtained from motor vehicle
registration records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than in
connection with this recall is a violation of law in several states, provinces, and countries.
Accordingly, you must limit the use of this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this recall
action.
STOCK VEHICLES
Correct all affected units in your new vehicle inventory before delivery.
SOLD VEHICLES
^ Owners of affected vehicles will be directed to dealers for repairs.
^ Immediately contact any of your affected owners whose vehicles are not on your VIN lists but are
identified in OASIS. Give the customer a copy of the Owner Notification Letter (when available) and
schedule a service date.
^ Correct other affected vehicles identified in OASIS which are brought to your dealership.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition, call the
Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted. Ford Motor Company
reserves the right to deny coverage for related damage in cases where the vehicle owner has not
had this recall performed on a timely basis.
ADDITIONAL LABOR TIME
^ If a condition exists that requires additional labor to complete the repair, call the Special Service
Support Center to request approval prior to performing any additional labor. Requests for approval
after completion of the repair will not be granted.
^ If you encounter aftermarket equipment or modifications to the vehicle which might prevent the
repair of the covered condition, call the Special Service Support Center.
OWNER REFUNDS
Refunds are not authorized for this program.
RENTAL VEHICLES
The use of rental vehicles is not authorized for this program.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
^ Related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line on which
the FSA is claimed. Related damage requires prior approval from the Special Service Support
Center.
^ "MT" labor should be submitted on a separate repair line with the related damage flag checked.
"MT" labor requires prior approval from the Special Service Support Center.
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake
Light Switch Non-Compliance > Page 980
LABOR ALLOWANCES
PARTS REQUIREMENTS / ORDERING INFORMATION
Parts are not required to complete this repair.
Attachment III - Technical Information
OVERVIEW
This program involves adjustment of the brake stoplamp switch by removing and reinstalling it.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
It is very important to not press, pull or touch the brake pedal assembly during the installation of the
brake stoplamp switch. Failure to follow these instructions may damage the brake stoplamp switch.
1. Disconnect the brake stoplamp switch electrical connector.
2. NOTE: The stoplamp switch will be difficult to remove if the switch plunger is not depressed. A
slight rearward force should be adequate to depress
the plunger.
With a light force (approximately 1-4 Pounds [4-16 Newtons]), pull rearward on the brake pedal,
rotate the brake stoplamp switch 45 degrees clockwise and remove the brake stoplamp switch.
3. Without movement to the brake pedal assembly, install the brake stoplamp switch and rotate 45
degrees counterclockwise.
4. Connect the brake stoplamp switch electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake
Light Switch Non-Compliance > Page 981
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake
Light Switch Non-Compliance > Page 982
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 >
Aug > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Adjustment
Technical Service Bulletin # 09C09 Date: 090817
Attachment I - Administrative Information
OASIS ACTIVATED?
Yes, OASIS will be activated on June 17, 2009.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 >
Aug > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Adjustment > Page 988
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED?
Yes, FSA VIN list will be available through by June 17, 2009. Owner names and addresses will be
available by July 13, 2009.
NOTE:
Your FSA VIN list may contain owner names and addresses obtained from motor vehicle
registration records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than in
connection with this recall is a violation of law in several states, provinces, and countries.
Accordingly, you must limit the use of this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this recall
action.
STOCK VEHICLES
Correct all affected units in your new vehicle inventory before delivery.
SOLD VEHICLES
^ Owners of affected vehicles will be directed to dealers for repairs.
^ Immediately contact any of your affected owners whose vehicles are not on your VIN lists but are
identified in OASIS. Give the customer a copy of the Owner Notification Letter (when available) and
schedule a service date.
^ Correct other affected vehicles identified in OASIS which are brought to your dealership.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition, call the
Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted. Ford Motor Company
reserves the right to deny coverage for related damage in cases where the vehicle owner has not
had this recall performed on a timely basis.
ADDITIONAL LABOR TIME
^ If a condition exists that requires additional labor to complete the repair, call the Special Service
Support Center to request approval prior to performing any additional labor. Requests for approval
after completion of the repair will not be granted.
^ If you encounter aftermarket equipment or modifications to the vehicle which might prevent the
repair of the covered condition, call the Special Service Support Center.
OWNER REFUNDS
Refunds are not authorized for this program.
RENTAL VEHICLES
The use of rental vehicles is not authorized for this program.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
^ Related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line on which
the FSA is claimed. Related damage requires prior approval from the Special Service Support
Center.
^ "MT" labor should be submitted on a separate repair line with the related damage flag checked.
"MT" labor requires prior approval from the Special Service Support Center.
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 >
Aug > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Adjustment > Page 989
LABOR ALLOWANCES
PARTS REQUIREMENTS / ORDERING INFORMATION
Parts are not required to complete this repair.
Attachment III - Technical Information
OVERVIEW
This program involves adjustment of the brake stoplamp switch by removing and reinstalling it.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
It is very important to not press, pull or touch the brake pedal assembly during the installation of the
brake stoplamp switch. Failure to follow these instructions may damage the brake stoplamp switch.
1. Disconnect the brake stoplamp switch electrical connector.
2. NOTE: The stoplamp switch will be difficult to remove if the switch plunger is not depressed. A
slight rearward force should be adequate to depress
the plunger.
With a light force (approximately 1-4 Pounds [4-16 Newtons]), pull rearward on the brake pedal,
rotate the brake stoplamp switch 45 degrees clockwise and remove the brake stoplamp switch.
3. Without movement to the brake pedal assembly, install the brake stoplamp switch and rotate 45
degrees counterclockwise.
4. Connect the brake stoplamp switch electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 >
Aug > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Adjustment > Page 990
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 >
Aug > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Adjustment > Page 991
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: >
NHTSA09V232000 > Jun > 09 > Recall 09V232000: Brake Light Switch Adjustment
Brake Light Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 09V232000: Brake Light Switch
Adjustment
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Ford/Expedition 2009 Lincoln/Navigator 2009
MANUFACTURER: Ford Motor Company
MFR'S REPORT DATE: June 23, 2009
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 09V232000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Service Brakes, Hydraulic: Switches: Brake Light
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 1357
SUMMARY: Ford is recalling 1,357 M/Y 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles for failing to
comply with the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No. 108, "Lamps, Reflective Devices, and
Associated Equipment." The brake stop lamp switch may be improperly adjusted. This may result
in a delay in brake stoplamp illumination when the brake pedal is depressed. In situations of very
mild brake application, the brake stoplamps may not illuminate.
CONSEQUENCE: Delay or loss of brake stoplamp function may increase the risk of a crash.
REMEDY: Dealers will adjust the brake stoplamp switch free of charge. The recall is expected to
begin on or before July 6, 2009. Owners may contact Ford Motor Company Customer Relationship
Center at 1-866-436-7332 or www.ownerconnection.com.
NOTES: Ford recall No. 09C09. Owners may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 >
Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Non-Compliance
Technical Service Bulletin # 09C09 Date: 090617
Attachment I - Administrative Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 >
Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Non-Compliance > Page 1000
OASIS ACTIVATED?
Yes, OASIS will be activated on June 17,2009.
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED?
Yes, FSA VIN list will be available through the website by June 17, 2009. Owner names and
addresses will be available by July 13, 2009.
NOTE:
Your FSA VIN list may contain owner names and addresses obtained from motor vehicle
registration records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than in
connection with this recall is a violation of law in several states, provinces, and countries.
Accordingly, you must limit the use of this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this recall
action.
STOCK VEHICLES
Correct all affected units in your new vehicle inventory before delivery.
SOLD VEHICLES
^ Owners of affected vehicles will be directed to dealers for repairs.
^ Immediately contact any of your affected owners whose vehicles are not on your VIN lists but are
identified in OASIS. Give the customer a copy of the Owner Notification Letter (when available) and
schedule a service date.
^ Correct other affected vehicles identified in OASIS which are brought to your dealership.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition, call the
Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted. Ford Motor Company
reserves the right to deny coverage for related damage in cases where the vehicle owner has not
had this recall performed on a timely basis.
ADDITIONAL LABOR TIME
^ If a condition exists that requires additional labor to complete the repair, call the Special Service
Support Center to request approval prior to performing any additional labor. Requests for approval
after completion of the repair will not be granted.
^ If you encounter aftermarket equipment or modifications to the vehicle which might prevent the
repair of the covered condition, call the Special Service Support Center.
OWNER REFUNDS
Refunds are not authorized for this program.
RENTAL VEHICLES
The use of rental vehicles is not authorized for this program.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
^ Related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line on which
the FSA is claimed. Related damage requires prior approval from the Special Service Support
Center.
^ "MT" labor should be submitted on a separate repair line with the related damage flag checked.
"MT" labor requires prior approval from the Special Service Support Center.
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 >
Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Non-Compliance > Page 1001
LABOR ALLOWANCES
PARTS REQUIREMENTS / ORDERING INFORMATION
Parts are not required to complete this repair.
Attachment III - Technical Information
OVERVIEW
This program involves adjustment of the brake stoplamp switch by removing and reinstalling it.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
It is very important to not press, pull or touch the brake pedal assembly during the installation of the
brake stoplamp switch. Failure to follow these instructions may damage the brake stoplamp switch.
1. Disconnect the brake stoplamp switch electrical connector.
2. NOTE: The stoplamp switch will be difficult to remove if the switch plunger is not depressed. A
slight rearward force should be adequate to depress
the plunger.
With a light force (approximately 1-4 Pounds [4-16 Newtons]), pull rearward on the brake pedal,
rotate the brake stoplamp switch 45 degrees clockwise and remove the brake stoplamp switch.
3. Without movement to the brake pedal assembly, install the brake stoplamp switch and rotate 45
degrees counterclockwise.
4. Connect the brake stoplamp switch electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 >
Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Non-Compliance > Page 1002
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 >
Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Non-Compliance > Page 1003
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1004
Brake Light Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1005
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1006
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1007
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to as the stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal
to the PCM indicating the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Typical BPP Switch
Typical BPP Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1008
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
Stoplamp Switch
Removal
1. Disconnect the stoplamp switch electrical connector.
2. NOTE: The stoplamp switch will be difficult to remove if the switch plunger is not depressed. A
slight rearward force should be adequate to
depress the plunger.
With a light force (approximately 1-4 N [1-3 lb]), pull rearward on the brake pedal, rotate the
stoplamp switch 45 degrees clockwise and remove the stoplamp switch.
Installation
NOTICE: It is very important to not press, pull or touch the brake pedal assembly during the
installation of the stoplamp switch. Failure to follow these instructions may damage the stoplamp
switch.
1. Without movement to the brake pedal assembly, install the stoplamp switch and rotate 45
degrees counterclockwise.
2. Connect the stoplamp switch electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 1013
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 1014
Door Switch: Locations Door Ajar Switch, Left Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 1015
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 1016
Door Switch: Locations Door Ajar Switch, Right Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 1017
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 1020
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 1021
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 1022
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1023
Door Switch: Service and Repair
Door Ajar Switch
NOTE: LH front door latch shown, others similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door latch. For additional information, refer to Front Door Latch See: Body and
Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front
Door/Front Door Latch/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement or Rear Door Latch See:
Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Rear Door/Rear Door Latch/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement.
2. Release the locking tab and remove the door ajar switch.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Hazard Warning Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1027
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1028
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1029
Hazard Warning Switch: Service and Repair
Hazard Flasher Lamp Switch
NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument panel center finish panel.
2. Release the tabs and remove the hazard flasher lamp switch.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1033
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Multifunction Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Multifunction Switch > Page 1036
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Illumination Dimmer Switch
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Testing and Inspection Illumination Dimmer Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Illumination Dimmer Switch > Page 1039
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Illumination Dimmer Switch > Page 1040
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Illumination Dimmer Switch > Page 1041
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1042
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
NOTE: Power tilt column shown, manual tilt similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the steering column shroud.
2. Disconnect the 2 multifunction switch electrical connectors.
3. Remove the 2 screws and the multifunction switch.
- To install, tighten to 1 Nm (9 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Headlamp Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1046
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1047
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1048
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1049
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1050
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair
Headlamp Switch
Expedition
Navigator
Removal and Installation
Expedition
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1051
1. Remove the screw and the LH lower instrument panel finish panel.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
Navigator
2. Remove the 3 screws and the steering column finish panel.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
All vehicles
3. NOTE: The headlamp switch is removed by releasing the tabs and pushing from behind.
Remove the headlamp switch.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Horn Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1055
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1056
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Turn Signal Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1060
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1061
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1062
Turn Signal Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1063
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1064
Turn Signal Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
NOTE: Power tilt column shown, manual tilt similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the steering column shroud.
2. Disconnect the 2 multifunction switch electrical connectors.
3. Remove the 2 screws and the multifunction switch.
- To install, tighten to 1 Nm (9 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1070
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1071
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1072
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
amount of torque requested by the operator. Depending on the application either a 2-track or
3-track APP sensor is used.
2-Track APP Sensor
There are two pedal position signals in the sensor. Both signals, APP1 and APP2, have a positive
slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage), but are offset and increase at different rates. The two
pedal position signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if one signal has a
concern. The PCM determines if a signal is incorrect by calculating where it should be, inferred
from the other signals. If a concern is present with one of the circuits the other input is used. There
are two reference voltage circuits, two signal return circuits, and two signal circuits (a total of six
circuits and pins) between the PCM and the APP sensor assembly. The reference voltage circuits
and the signal return circuits are shared with the reference voltage circuit and signal return circuit
used by the electronic throttle body (ETB) throttle position (TP) sensor. The pedal position signal is
converted to pedal travel degrees (rotary angle) by the PCM. The software then converts these
degrees to counts, which is the input to the torque based strategy. For additional information, refer
to Torque Based Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) See: Powertrain Management/Computers and
Control Systems/Electronic Throttle Control Module/Description and Operation.
2-Track APP Sensor
Typical 2-Track APP Sensor
3-Track APP Sensor
There are three pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APP1, has a negative slope
(increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APP2 and APP3, both have a positive
slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APP1 is used as the
indication of pedal position by the strategy. The three pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if one signal has a concern. The PCM determines if a signal is
incorrect by calculating where it should be, inferred from the other signals. If a concern is present
with one of the circuits the other inputs are used. The pedal position signal is converted to pedal
travel degrees (rotary angle) by the PCM. The software then converts these degrees to counts,
which is the input to the torque based strategy. There are two reference voltage circuits, two signal
return circuits, and three signal circuits (a total of seven circuits and pins) between the PCM and
the APP sensor assembly. The reference voltage circuits and the signal return circuits are shared
with the reference voltage circuit and signal return circuit used by the electronic throttle body (ETB)
throttle position sensor. For additional information, refer to Torque Based Electronic Throttle
Control (ETC) See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Electronic Throttle
Control Module/Description and Operation.
3-Track APP Sensor
Typical 3-Track APP Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1076
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1077
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Electronic Engine Controls
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Engine Controls
Electronic Engine Controls
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor:
- sends the PCM a signal indicating mass airflow rate of air entering the engine.
- incorporates the Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor.
For removal and installation, refer to Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor See: Service and Repair.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Electronic Engine Controls > Page 1080
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Engine Control Components
Engine Control Components
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. The current required to
maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow. The MAF sensor then
outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air mass. The PCM
calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired air/fuel ratio. This
input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC), shift and torque
converter clutch (TCC) scheduling.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly. Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology with an integrated IAT sensor.
The hot wire electronic sensing element must be replaced as an assembly. Replacing only the
element may change the air flow calibration.
Diagram of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot and Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Diagram of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot and Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals.
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Electronic Engine Controls > Page 1081
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Page 1082
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector.
2. Remove the 2 bolts and the MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft
Position Sensor 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft
Position Sensor 2 > Page 1087
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft
Position Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft
Position Sensor > Page 1090
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
1091
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston
number 1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing
the sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil on plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP
signal to select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with two CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). The second
sensor is used to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2.
There are two types of CMP sensors: the 2-pin variable reluctance type sensor and the 3-pin
Hall-effect type sensor.
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
Typical Hall-effect CMP Sensor
Typical Hall-effect CMP Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
1092
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
Removal and Installation
LH Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor
1. Remove the Air Cleaner (ACL) outlet pipe.
All CMP sensors
2. Disconnect the Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor electrical connector.
3. Remove the bolt and the CMP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Clutch Switch, ECM > Component Information > Description and Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
The CPP switch is an input to the PCM indicating the clutch pedal position. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the CPP circuit. When the CPP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The CPP input to the PCM is used to detect a reduction in engine
load. The PCM uses the load information for mass air flow and fuel calculations.
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
The ECT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The ECT measures the temperature of the engine coolant. The PCM uses the ECT input for fuel
control and for cooling fan control. There are three types of ECT sensors, threaded, push-in, and
twist-lock. The ECT sensor is located in an engine coolant passage.
Typical Thread Type Sensor
Typical Thread Type ECT Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1102
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1103
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid decelerations between teeth.
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1104
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the accessory drive belt from the A/C compressor pulley.
3. Disconnect the A/C compressor electrical connector.
4. Disconnect the Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor electrical connector.
5. Remove the 3 bolts and position the A/C compressor aside.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
6. Remove the bolt and the CKP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1105
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
8. Using the scan tool, perform the Misfire Monitor Neutral Profile Correction procedure, following
the on-screen instructions.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1109
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1110
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Cylinder Head Temperature (CHT) Sensor
The CHT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with the temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
The CHT sensor is installed in the cylinder head and measures the metal temperature. The CHT
sensor can provide complete engine temperature information and can be used to infer coolant
temperature. If the CHT sensor conveys an overheating condition to the PCM, the PCM initiates a
fail-safe cooling strategy based on information from the CHT sensor. A cooling system concern
such as low coolant or coolant loss could cause an overheating condition. As a result, damage to
major engine components could occur. Using both the CHT sensor and fail-safe cooling strategy,
the PCM prevents damage by allowing air cooling of the engine and limp home capability. For
additional information, refer to Powertrain Control Software See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Description and Operation/Powertrain Control
Software for Fail-Safe Cooling Strategy.
Typical CHT Sensor
Typical CHT Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1111
Engine Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
Cylinder Head Temperature (CHT) Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold.
2. Disconnect the Cylinder Head Temperature (CHT) sensor electrical connector.
3. Remove the CHT sensor and discard.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Coat the new CHT sensor threads with high temperature nickel anti-seize lubricant prior to
installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Fuel Level Input (FLI)
The FLI is a communications network message. Most vehicle applications use a potentiometer type
FLI sensor connected to a float in the FP module to determine fuel level.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View
Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View
106L (28 Gal) Fuel Tank
127L (33.5 Gal) Fuel Tank
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 1117
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 1118
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module
Fuel Pump Module
106L (28 Gal) Fuel Tank
127L (33.5 Gal) Fuel Tank
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 1119
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
All fuel tanks
1. Remove the fuel tank. For additional information, refer to Fuel Tank See: Powertrain
Management/Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel
Tank/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Fuel Tank.
127L (33.5 gal) fuel tank
2. Remove the 4 nuts and the Fuel Pump (FP) module cover.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
3. Disconnect the return fuel tube-to-FP module quick connect coupling.
All fuel tanks
4. Disconnect the Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-FP module quick
connect coupling and the supply fuel tube-to-FP
module quick connect coupling.
5. Using the Fuel Tank Sender Unit Wrench, remove the FP lock ring.
106L (28 gal) fuel tank
6. NOTICE: Carefully remove the Fuel Pump (FP) assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level
sensor.
NOTE: If the FP does not clear the FP mounting flange on the fuel tank, the use of a screwdriver
may be necessary.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 1120
Remove the FP and FP O-ring seal. If necessary, insert a screwdriver into the empty FP rod hole and slightly pull the screwdriver
inboard until the base of the FP clears the FP mounting flange.
- Discard the FP O-ring seal.
127L (33.5 gal) fuel tank
7. NOTICE: Carefully remove the Fuel Pump (FP) assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level
sensor.
NOTE: Note the location of the FP alignment tabs.
Remove the FP module assembly. Remove and discard the O-ring seal.
All fuel tanks
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1124
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1125
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1126
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
The FTP sensor or in-line FTP sensor is used to measure the fuel tank pressure.
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
In-line Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
In-line Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
106L (28 Gal) Fuel Tank
125L (33 Gal) Fuel Tank
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Page 1129
Removal and Installation
All fuel tanks
1. Remove the fuel tank.
106L (28 gal) fuel tank
2. Disconnect the fuel supply tube-to-heat shield pushpin retainer.
125L (33 gal) fuel tank
3. Remove the fuel tank heat shield retainer(s).
All fuel tanks
4. Remove the fuel tank heat shield.
5. Disconnect the Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-fuel vapor/grade
vent valves quick connect couplings.
6. Disconnect the FTP sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-fuel pump module quick connect
coupling.
7. Remove the FTP sensor and vapor tube assembly from the fuel tank.
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Carry out the Evaporative Emission System Leak Test. For additional information, refer to
Evaporative Emission System Leak Test See: Powertrain Management/Emission Control
Systems/Evaporative Emissions System/Testing and Inspection.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Page 1130
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Evaporative Emission (EVAP) System
Components - Exploded View
Evaporative Emission (EVAP) System Components - Exploded View
Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Canister Assembly
NOTE: 106L (28 gal) fuel tank vapor tubes shown, 125L (33 gal) similar.
EVAP Canister, Vent Solenoid and Dust Separator and Brackets
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Page 1131
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1135
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1136
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1137
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor
The IAT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The electrical
resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance increases
as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the sensor
terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The IAT sensor provides air temperature information to the PCM. The PCM uses the air
temperature information as a correction factor in the calculation of fuel, spark, and air flow.
The IAT sensor provides a quicker temperature change response time than the ECT or CHT
sensor.
Currently there are two types of IAT sensors used, a stand-alone/non-integrated type and a
integrated type. Both types function the same, however the integrated type is incorporated into the
mass air flow (MAF) sensor instead of being a stand alone sensor.
Supercharged vehicles use two IAT sensors. Both sensors are thermistor type devices and operate
as described above. One is located before the supercharger at the air cleaner for standard
OBD/cold weather input, while a second sensor (IAT2) is located after the supercharger in the
intake manifold. The IAT2 sensor located after the supercharger provides air temperature
information to the PCM to control spark and to help determine charge air cooler (CAC) efficiency.
Typical Stand-Alone/Non-Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensors
Typical Stand-Alone/Non-Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensors
Typical Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Incorporated Into a Drop-in or Flange-type
MAF Sensor
Typical Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Incorporated Into a Drop-in or Flange-type
MAF sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Knock Sensor 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Knock Sensor 1 >
Page 1142
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1 >
Page 1145
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1146
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Two Types of Knock Sensor (KS)
Two Types of Knock Sensor (KS)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1147
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
Knock Sensor (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold.
2. Disconnect the Knock Sensor (KS) electrical connectors.
3. Remove the 2 bolts and the 2 KS.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (177 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
The MAP sensor measures intake manifold absolute pressure. The PCM uses information from the
MAP sensor to measure how much exhaust gas is introduced into the intake manifold.
Typical Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
Typical Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) Sensor
The EOT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The EOT sensor measures the temperature of the engine oil. The sensor is typically threaded into
the engine oil lubrication system. The PCM can use the EOT sensor input to determine the
following:
- On variable camshaft timing (VCT) applications the EOT input is used to adjust the VCT control
gains and logic for camshaft timing.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input in conjunction with other PCM inputs to determine oil
degradation.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input to initiate a soft engine shutdown. To prevent engine
damage from occurring as a result of high oil temperatures, the PCM has the ability to initiate a soft
engine shutdown. Whenever engine RPM exceeds a calibrated level for a certain period of time,
the PCM begins reducing power by disabling engine cylinders.
Typical Thread Type Sensor
Typical EOT Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 1158
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #12
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 1159
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 1160
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 1161
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #22
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 1162
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 1165
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 1166
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 1167
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Engine Control Components
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
The HO2S detects the presence of oxygen in the exhaust and produces a variable voltage
according to the amount of oxygen detected. A high concentration of oxygen (lean air/fuel ratio) in
the exhaust produces a voltage signal less than 0.4 volt. A low concentration of oxygen (rich
air/fuel ratio) produces a voltage signal greater than 0.6 volt. The HO2S provides feedback to the
PCM indicating air/fuel ratio in order to achieve a near stoichiometric air/fuel ratio of 14.7:1 during
closed loop engine operation. The HO2S generates a voltage between 0.0 and 1.1 volts.
Embedded with the sensing element is the HO2S heater. The heating element heats the sensor to
a temperature of 800°C (1,472°F). At approximately 300°C (572°F) the engine can enter closed
loop operation. The VPWR circuit supplies voltage to the heater. The PCM turns the heater on by
providing the ground when the correct conditions occur. The heater allows the engine to enter
closed loop operation sooner. The use of this heater requires the HO2S heater control to be duty
cycled, to prevent damage to the heater.
Typical Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Typical Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 1170
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation Universal Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Engine Control Components
Universal Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
The universal HO2S, sometimes referred to as a wideband oxygen sensor, uses the typical HO2S
combined with a current controller in the PCM to infer an air/fuel ratio relative to the stoichiometric
air/fuel ratio. This is accomplished by balancing the amount of oxygen ions pumped in or out of a
measurement chamber within the sensor. The typical HO2S within the universal HO2S is used to
detect the oxygen content of the exhaust gas in the measurement chamber. The oxygen content
inside the measurement chamber is maintained at the stoichiometric air/fuel ratio by pumping
oxygen ions in and out of the measurement chamber. As the exhaust gasses get richer or leaner,
the amount of oxygen that must be pumped in or out to maintain a stoichiometric air/fuel ratio in the
measurement chamber varies in proportion to the air/fuel ratio. The amount of current required to
pump the oxygen ions in or out of the measurement chamber is used to measure the air/fuel ratio.
The measured air/fuel ratio is actually the output from the current controller in the PCM and not a
signal that comes directly from the sensor.
The universal HO2S also uses a self-contained reference chamber to make sure an oxygen
differential is always present. The oxygen for the reference chamber is supplied by pumping small
amounts of oxygen ions from the measurement chamber into the reference chamber. The universal
HO2S does not need access to outside air.
Part to part variance is compensated for by placing a resistor in the connector. This resistor is used
to trim the current measured by the current controller in the PCM.
Embedded with the sensing element is the universal HO2S heater. The heater allows the engine to
enter closed loop operation sooner. The heating element heats the sensor to a temperature of
780°C (1,436°F). The VPWR circuit supplies voltage to the heater. The PCM controls the heater on
and off by providing the ground to maintain the sensor at the correct temperature for maximum
accuracy.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) And Catalyst Monitor Sensor - Exploded View
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) And Catalyst Monitor Sensor Exploded View
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) and Catalyst Monitor Sensor - Exploded View
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) And Catalyst Monitor Sensor - Exploded View > Page 1173
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Disconnect the Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) electrical connector.
3. Using the Exhaust Gas Oxygen Sensor Socket, remove the HO2S.
- Apply penetrating lubricant to the HO2S to assist in removal.
Installation
1. Install the HO2S.
- Apply a light coat of high temperature nickel anti-seize lubricant to the HO2S threads prior to
installation.
- Calculate the correct torque wrench setting for the following torque.
- Using the Exhaust Gas Oxygen Sensor Socket, tighten to 46 Nm (34 lb-ft).
2. Connect the HO2S electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) And Catalyst Monitor Sensor - Exploded View > Page 1174
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Catalyst Monitor Sensor
Catalyst Monitor Sensor
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Disconnect the Catalyst Monitor Sensor (CMS) electrical connector.
3. Using the Exhaust Gas Oxygen Sensor Socket, remove the CMS.
- Apply penetrating lubricant to the CMS to assist in removal.
Installation
1. Install the CMS.
- Apply a light coat of high temperature nickel anti-seize lubricant to the CMS threads prior to
installation.
- Calculate the correct torque wrench setting for the following torque.
- Using the Exhaust Gas Oxygen Sensor Socket, tighten to 46 Nm (34 lb-ft).
2. Connect the CMS electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1178
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1179
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Switch
Engine Control Components
Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
The PSP switch monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP switch
is a normally closed switch that opens as the hydraulic pressure increases. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the PSP circuit. When the PSP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The PCM uses the input signal from the PSP switch to compensate
for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the idle RPM and preventing engine stall during
parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP switch signals the PCM to adjust the transmission EPC
pressure during increased engine load, for example during parking maneuvers.
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch > Page 1182
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Sensor
Engine Control Components
Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
The PSP sensor monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP
sensor voltage input to the PCM changes as the hydraulic pressure changes. The PCM uses the
input signal from the PSP sensor to compensate for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the
idle RPM and preventing engine stall during parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP sensor signals the
PCM to adjust the transmission EPC pressure during increased engine load, for example, during
parking maneuvers.
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer
that monitors the differential pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly.
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as
the downstream pressure hose (REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI
and REF hose connections are marked on the differential pressure feedback EGR sensor housing
for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger diameter hose). The differential pressure
feedback EGR sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the metering
orifice and supplies it to the PCM as EGR flow rate feedback.
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
The tube mounted differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is identical in operation as the larger
plastic differential pressure feedback EGR sensors and uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF
hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1189
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle
Position Sensor
Engine Control Components
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle Position Sensor
The ETB throttle position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant
ETB throttle position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB throttle position
sensor signal (TP1) has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second
signal (TP2) has a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). The 2 ETB throttle position
sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There is
1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor. The reference voltage circuit
and the signal return circuit is shared with the reference voltage circuits and signal return circuits
used by the APP sensor. For additional information, refer to Torque Based Electronic Throttle
Control (ETC) See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Electronic Throttle
Control Module/Description and Operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle Position Sensor > Page 1192
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
Engine Control Components
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases the corrosion resistance on the
terminals and increases the connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body.
As the TP sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, four operating conditions are determined by the
PCM from the TP. These are:
- closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration)
- part throttle (includes cruise or moderate acceleration)
- wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on crank)
- throttle angle rate
Typical TP Sensor
Typical TP Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 1193
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
Removal
1. Remove the Throttle Body (TB).
2. NOTICE: Do not put direct heat on the Throttle Position (TP) sensor or any other plastic parts
because heat damage may occur. Damage
may also occur if Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) temperature exceeds 120°C (248°F).
NOTE: Do not use power tools.
Remove the TP sensor.
1. Using a suitable heat gun, apply heat to the top of the ETB until the top TP sensor bolt ear
reaches approximately 55°C (130°F), this should
take no more than 3 minutes using an 1,100-watt heat gun. The heat gun should be about 25.4 mm
(1 in) away from the ETB.
2. Monitor the temperature of the top TP sensor bolt ear on the ETB with a suitable temperature
measuring device, such as a digital temperature
laser or infrared thermometer, while heating the ETB.
3. Using hand tools, quickly remove the bolt farthest from the heat source first and discard.
4. Using hand tools, remove the remaining bolt and discard.
5. Remove and discard the TP sensor.
Installation
1. NOTE: When installing the new TP sensor, make sure that the radial locator tab on the TP
sensor is aligned with the radial locator hole on the
ETB.
NOTE: Do not use power tools.
Install the new TP sensor. Using hand tools, install the 2 new bolts. Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
2. Install the TB.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Engine Control Components
Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
The OSS sensor provides the PCM with information about the rotational speed of an output shaft.
The PCM uses the information to control and diagnose powertrain behavior. In some applications,
the sensor is also used as the source of vehicle speed. The sensor may be physically located in
different places on the vehicle, depending upon the specific application. The design of each speed
sensor is unique and depends on which powertrain control feature uses the information that is
generated.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor > Page 1198
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
Engine Control Components
Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
The VSS is a variable reluctance or Hall-effect sensor that generates a waveform with a frequency
that is proportional to the speed of the vehicle. If the vehicle is moving at a relatively low speed, the
sensor produces a signal with a low frequency. As the vehicle velocity increases, the sensor
generates a signal with a higher frequency. The PCM uses the frequency signal generated by the
VSS (and other inputs) to control such parameters as fuel injection, ignition control,
transmission/transaxle shift scheduling, and torque converter clutch scheduling.
Typical Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
Typical Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer
that monitors the differential pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly.
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as
the downstream pressure hose (REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI
and REF hose connections are marked on the differential pressure feedback EGR sensor housing
for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger diameter hose). The differential pressure
feedback EGR sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the metering
orifice and supplies it to the PCM as EGR flow rate feedback.
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
The tube mounted differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is identical in operation as the larger
plastic differential pressure feedback EGR sensors and uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF
hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1207
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1208
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1209
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
amount of torque requested by the operator. Depending on the application either a 2-track or
3-track APP sensor is used.
2-Track APP Sensor
There are two pedal position signals in the sensor. Both signals, APP1 and APP2, have a positive
slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage), but are offset and increase at different rates. The two
pedal position signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if one signal has a
concern. The PCM determines if a signal is incorrect by calculating where it should be, inferred
from the other signals. If a concern is present with one of the circuits the other input is used. There
are two reference voltage circuits, two signal return circuits, and two signal circuits (a total of six
circuits and pins) between the PCM and the APP sensor assembly. The reference voltage circuits
and the signal return circuits are shared with the reference voltage circuit and signal return circuit
used by the electronic throttle body (ETB) throttle position (TP) sensor. The pedal position signal is
converted to pedal travel degrees (rotary angle) by the PCM. The software then converts these
degrees to counts, which is the input to the torque based strategy. For additional information, refer
to Torque Based Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) See: Powertrain Management/Computers and
Control Systems/Electronic Throttle Control Module/Description and Operation.
2-Track APP Sensor
Typical 2-Track APP Sensor
3-Track APP Sensor
There are three pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APP1, has a negative slope
(increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APP2 and APP3, both have a positive
slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APP1 is used as the
indication of pedal position by the strategy. The three pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if one signal has a concern. The PCM determines if a signal is
incorrect by calculating where it should be, inferred from the other signals. If a concern is present
with one of the circuits the other inputs are used. The pedal position signal is converted to pedal
travel degrees (rotary angle) by the PCM. The software then converts these degrees to counts,
which is the input to the torque based strategy. There are two reference voltage circuits, two signal
return circuits, and three signal circuits (a total of seven circuits and pins) between the PCM and
the APP sensor assembly. The reference voltage circuits and the signal return circuits are shared
with the reference voltage circuit and signal return circuit used by the electronic throttle body (ETB)
throttle position sensor. For additional information, refer to Torque Based Electronic Throttle
Control (ETC) See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Electronic Throttle
Control Module/Description and Operation.
3-Track APP Sensor
Typical 3-Track APP Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1213
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1214
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Electronic Engine Controls
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Engine Controls
Electronic Engine Controls
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor:
- sends the PCM a signal indicating mass airflow rate of air entering the engine.
- incorporates the Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor.
For removal and installation, refer to Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor See: Service and Repair.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Electronic Engine Controls > Page 1217
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Engine Control Components
Engine Control Components
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. The current required to
maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow. The MAF sensor then
outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air mass. The PCM
calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired air/fuel ratio. This
input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC), shift and torque
converter clutch (TCC) scheduling.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly. Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology with an integrated IAT sensor.
The hot wire electronic sensing element must be replaced as an assembly. Replacing only the
element may change the air flow calibration.
Diagram of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot and Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Diagram of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot and Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals.
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Electronic Engine Controls > Page 1218
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 1219
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector.
2. Remove the 2 bolts and the MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail.
The temperature sensing portion of the FRPT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance
changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor decreases as the temperature
increases, and the resistance increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance
changes the voltage drop across the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM
corresponding to temperature.
Both the pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the fuel pump. The
speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid state. The
dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which allows the
injector pulse width to decrease.
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Fuel Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail.
The temperature sensing portion of the FRPT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance
changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor decreases as the temperature
increases, and the resistance increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance
changes the voltage drop across the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM
corresponding to temperature.
Both the pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the fuel pump. The
speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid state. The
dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which allows the
injector pulse width to decrease.
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1229
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1230
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1231
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1232
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Inertia Fuel Shut-off (IFS) Switch
The IFS switch is used in conjunction with the electric fuel pump. The purpose of the IFS switch is
to shut off the fuel pump if a collision occurs. It consists of a steel cone held in place by a magnet.
When a sharp impact occurs, the cone breaks loose from the magnet, rolls up a conical ramp and
strikes a target plate which opens the electrical contacts of the switch and shuts off the electric fuel
pump. Once the switch is open, it must be manually reset before restarting the vehicle. Refer to the
Owner's Literature, Roadside Emergencies for the location of the IFS switch.
Typical Inertia Fuel Shut-off (IFS) Switch
Typical Inertia Fuel Shut-off (IFS) Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1233
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Service and Repair
Inertia Fuel Shutoff (IFS) Switch
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: The Inertia Fuel Shutoff (IFS) switch is located behind the LH quarter trim panel access
cover.
Remove the LH quarter trim panel access cover.
2. Remove the power liftgate motor electrical connector pushpins from the power liftgate motor
bracket.
3. NOTE: Slide the IFS switch out below the power liftgate motor bracket.
Remove the 2 bolts and the IFS switch. To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
4. Disconnect the IFS switch electrical connector.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1237
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle
Position Sensor
Engine Control Components
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle Position Sensor
The ETB throttle position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant
ETB throttle position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB throttle position
sensor signal (TP1) has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second
signal (TP2) has a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). The 2 ETB throttle position
sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There is
1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor. The reference voltage circuit
and the signal return circuit is shared with the reference voltage circuits and signal return circuits
used by the APP sensor. For additional information, refer to Torque Based Electronic Throttle
Control (ETC) See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Electronic Throttle
Control Module/Description and Operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle Position Sensor > Page 1240
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
Engine Control Components
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases the corrosion resistance on the
terminals and increases the connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body.
As the TP sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, four operating conditions are determined by the
PCM from the TP. These are:
- closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration)
- part throttle (includes cruise or moderate acceleration)
- wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on crank)
- throttle angle rate
Typical TP Sensor
Typical TP Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Page 1241
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
Removal
1. Remove the Throttle Body (TB).
2. NOTICE: Do not put direct heat on the Throttle Position (TP) sensor or any other plastic parts
because heat damage may occur. Damage
may also occur if Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) temperature exceeds 120°C (248°F).
NOTE: Do not use power tools.
Remove the TP sensor.
1. Using a suitable heat gun, apply heat to the top of the ETB until the top TP sensor bolt ear
reaches approximately 55°C (130°F), this should
take no more than 3 minutes using an 1,100-watt heat gun. The heat gun should be about 25.4 mm
(1 in) away from the ETB.
2. Monitor the temperature of the top TP sensor bolt ear on the ETB with a suitable temperature
measuring device, such as a digital temperature
laser or infrared thermometer, while heating the ETB.
3. Using hand tools, quickly remove the bolt farthest from the heat source first and discard.
4. Using hand tools, remove the remaining bolt and discard.
5. Remove and discard the TP sensor.
Installation
1. NOTE: When installing the new TP sensor, make sure that the radial locator tab on the TP
sensor is aligned with the radial locator hole on the
ETB.
NOTE: Do not use power tools.
Install the new TP sensor. Using hand tools, install the 2 new bolts. Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
2. Install the TB.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor
2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor
2 > Page 1247
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor
> Page 1250
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1251
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston
number 1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing
the sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil on plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP
signal to select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with two CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). The second
sensor is used to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2.
There are two types of CMP sensors: the 2-pin variable reluctance type sensor and the 3-pin
Hall-effect type sensor.
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
Typical Hall-effect CMP Sensor
Typical Hall-effect CMP Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1252
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
Removal and Installation
LH Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor
1. Remove the Air Cleaner (ACL) outlet pipe.
All CMP sensors
2. Disconnect the Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor electrical connector.
3. Remove the bolt and the CMP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1256
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1257
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid decelerations between teeth.
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1258
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the accessory drive belt from the A/C compressor pulley.
3. Disconnect the A/C compressor electrical connector.
4. Disconnect the Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor electrical connector.
5. Remove the 3 bolts and position the A/C compressor aside.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
6. Remove the bolt and the CKP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1259
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
8. Using the scan tool, perform the Misfire Monitor Neutral Profile Correction procedure, following
the on-screen instructions.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) transceiver.
2. NOTE: The ignition lock cylinder must be in the RUN position.
Using a suitable tool, press the release pin and remove the ignition lock cylinder.
3. If a new lock cylinder with keys is replaced, the new PATS keys must be programmed.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Verify the ignition lock cylinder operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional > Page 1265
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Ignition Lock Cylinder - Non Functional
Ignition Lock Cylinder - Non Functional
Removal
1. Remove the Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) transceiver.
2. Remove the ignition lock cylinder.
- Use a 1/8-inch diameter drill bit to drill out the lock cylinder retaining pin.
- Use a 3/8-inch diameter drill bit to drill down the middle of the ignition lock key slot until the
ignition lock cylinder breaks loose.
- Remove and discard the ignition lock cylinder and drill shavings from the steering column.
3. Remove the bearing retainer.
4. Remove the steering column lock housing bearing and steering column lock gear.
Installation
1. Thoroughly clean all drill shavings from the steering column and inspect it for damage.
2. Install a new ignition lock cylinder.
- Verify the ignition lock cylinder operation.
3. Program the new PATS keys.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Knock Sensor 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Knock Sensor 1 > Page 1270
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1 > Page 1273
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1274
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Two Types of Knock Sensor (KS)
Two Types of Knock Sensor (KS)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1275
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
Knock Sensor (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold.
2. Disconnect the Knock Sensor (KS) electrical connectors.
3. Remove the 2 bolts and the 2 KS.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (177 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor
Impact Sensor: Locations Front Impact Severity Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1281
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1282
Impact Sensor: Locations Driver Side Impact Sensor, C-Pillar
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1283
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1284
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1285
Impact Sensor: Locations Passenger Side Impact Sensor, C-Pillar
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1286
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1287
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1288
Impact Sensor: Locations Driver Front Door, Side Impact Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1289
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1290
Impact Sensor: Locations Passenger Front Door, Side Impact Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1291
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Front Impact Severity Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1294
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1295
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1296
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1297
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Front Impact Severity Sensor
Front Impact Severity Sensor
Removal and Installation
WARNING: If a vehicle has been in a crash, inspect the restraints control module (RCM) and the
impact sensor (if equipped) mounting areas for deformation. If damaged, restore the mounting
areas to the original production configuration. A new RCM and sensors must be installed whether
or not the air bags have deployed. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury or death in a crash.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
NOTE: The front impact severity sensor is located on the bottom of the lower radiator support.
1. Depower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Air Bag(s) Arming and
Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering
in the General Procedures portion.
2. Disconnect the front impact severity sensor electrical connector.
3. WARNING: Always tighten the fasteners of the restraints control module (RCM) and impact
sensor (if equipped) to the specified torque.
Failure to do so may result in incorrect restraint system operation, which increases the risk of
personal injury or death in a crash.
NOTE: Make sure the radiator support and front impact severity sensor mating surfaces are clean
and free of foreign material.
Remove the bolt and front impact severity sensor. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
5. Repower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Air Bag(s) Arming and
Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering
in the General Procedures portion.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1300
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Side Impact Sensor - C-Pillar
Side Impact Sensor - C-Pillar
NOTE: Expedition/Navigator shown, Expedition EL/Navigator L similar.
NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
WARNING: If a vehicle has been in a crash, inspect the restraints control module (RCM) and the
impact sensor (if equipped) mounting areas for deformation. If damaged, restore the mounting
areas to the original production configuration. A new RCM and sensors must be installed whether
or not the air bags have deployed. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury or death in a crash.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the
customer.
1. Depower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Air Bag(s) Arming and
Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering
in the General Procedures portion.
2. Remove the rear door scuff plate.
3. Detach the rear door weatherstrip.
4. Remove the bolt and second row safety belt retractor anchor.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
5. Position aside the quarter trim panel.
- Pull out on the quarter trim panel at the C-pillar and release the retaining clips to gain access to
the C-pillar side impact sensor.
6. Disconnect the side impact sensor electrical connector.
7. WARNING: Always tighten the fasteners of the restraints control module (RCM) and impact
sensor (if equipped) to the specified torque.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1301
Failure to do so may result in incorrect restraint system operation, which increases the risk of
personal injury or death in a crash.
NOTE: Make sure the C-pillar and side impact sensor mating surfaces are clean and free of foreign
material.
Remove the bolt and side impact sensor. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
8. NOTE: Before installation, make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted and the safety belts
and buckles are accessible to the occupants.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
9. Repower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Air Bag(s) Arming and
Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering
in the General Procedures portion.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1302
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Side Impact Sensor - Front Door
Side Impact Sensor - Front Door
NOTE: RH door shown, LH similar.
Removal and Installation
WARNING: If a vehicle has been in a crash, inspect the restraints control module (RCM) and the
impact sensor (if equipped) mounting areas for deformation. If damaged, restore the mounting
areas to the original production configuration. A new RCM and sensors must be installed whether
or not the air bags have deployed. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury or death in a crash.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Depower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Air Bag(s) Arming and
Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering
in the General Procedures portion.
2. Remove the front door trim panel.
3. Separate the weathershield from the door enough to access the side impact sensor.
4. Disconnect the side impact sensor electrical connector.
5. Remove the 2 bolts and side impact sensor.
6. NOTICE: To prevent stripping the insert nuts, tighten the side impact sensor bolts only enough to
retain the side impact sensor correctly.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1303
- Inspect the insert nut for damage. If the insert nut is damaged, install a new insert.
7. Repower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Air Bag(s) Arming and
Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering
in the General Procedures portion.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1307
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Seat Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Seat Position Sensor
NOTE: Power seat shown, manual similar.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Move the driver seat to the full forward and highest position.
2. Change to Ignition Off. Wait 1 minute.
3. Remove the seat position sensor and bracket bolt.
4. Unhook the seat position sensor and bracket from the seat track cross brace.
5. Disconnect the electrical connector and remove the seat position sensor and bracket.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
7. Repower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Air Bag(s) Arming and
Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering
in the General Procedures portion.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1314
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) transceiver.
2. NOTE: The ignition lock cylinder must be in the RUN position.
Using a suitable tool, press the release pin and remove the ignition lock cylinder.
3. If a new lock cylinder with keys is replaced, the new PATS keys must be programmed.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Verify the ignition lock cylinder operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional > Page
1321
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Ignition Lock Cylinder - Non Functional
Ignition Lock Cylinder - Non Functional
Removal
1. Remove the Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) transceiver.
2. Remove the ignition lock cylinder.
- Use a 1/8-inch diameter drill bit to drill out the lock cylinder retaining pin.
- Use a 3/8-inch diameter drill bit to drill down the middle of the ignition lock key slot until the
ignition lock cylinder breaks loose.
- Remove and discard the ignition lock cylinder and drill shavings from the steering column.
3. Remove the bearing retainer.
4. Remove the steering column lock housing bearing and steering column lock gear.
Installation
1. Thoroughly clean all drill shavings from the steering column and inspect it for damage.
2. Install a new ignition lock cylinder.
- Verify the ignition lock cylinder operation.
3. Program the new PATS keys.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1327
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1328
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Power
Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Switch
Engine Control Components
Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
The PSP switch monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP switch
is a normally closed switch that opens as the hydraulic pressure increases. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the PSP circuit. When the PSP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The PCM uses the input signal from the PSP switch to compensate
for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the idle RPM and preventing engine stall during
parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP switch signals the PCM to adjust the transmission EPC
pressure during increased engine load, for example during parking maneuvers.
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Power
Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch > Page 1331
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Sensor
Engine Control Components
Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
The PSP sensor monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP
sensor voltage input to the PCM changes as the hydraulic pressure changes. The PCM uses the
input signal from the PSP sensor to compensate for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the
idle RPM and preventing engine stall during parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP sensor signals the
PCM to adjust the transmission EPC pressure during increased engine load, for example, during
parking maneuvers.
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Steering Angle Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1335
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1336
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Telescoping Wheel Switch > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Telescoping Wheel Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1340
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Tilt Wheel Switch > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Tilt Wheel Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1344
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Ride Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Service and Repair
Ride Height Sensor: Service and Repair
Suspension Height Sensor
LH Side
RH Side
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Ride Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page
1349
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Disconnect the height sensor harness from the sensor bracket.
3. Disconnect the height sensor electrical connector.
4. Disconnect the height sensor arm from the ball stud on the lower control arm.
5. Remove and discard the 2 height sensor bolts.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
6. NOTE: The RH and LH height sensor assemblies cannot be used on opposite sides of the
vehicle.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
7. Calibrate the LH and RH height sensors. For additional information, refer to Ride Height
Adjustments See: Steering and
Suspension/Suspension/Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic )/Service and Repair/Ride
Height Adjustments.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Steering Angle Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1353
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1354
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Training
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training
NOTE: If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, the sensors will go into a "sleep
mode" to conserve battery power. It will be necessary to wake them up so they will transmit the
latest tire pressure information to the Smart Junction Box (SJB). For additional information, refer to
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Activation See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and
Warning Indicators/Tire Monitoring System/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning.
NOTE: The tire pressure sensor training procedure must be done on a single vehicle, in an area
without radio frequency noise and at least 1 m (3 ft) away from other vehicles equipped with a Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS). Radio frequency noise is generated by electrical motors and
appliance operation, cellular telephones, remote transmitters, power inverters and portable
entertainment equipment.
NOTE: If a sensor does not respond to the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool, attempt to
activate the same sensor with the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. If the sensor still does not
respond, move the vehicle to rotate the wheels at least one-fourth of a turn and attempt to activate
the same sensor again.
NOTE: The SJB has a 2-minute time limit between sensor responses. If the SJB does not
recognize any 1 of the 4 tire pressure sensors during this time limit, the horn will sound twice and
the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE NOT TRAINED REPEAT and the entire
procedure must be repeated.
NOTE: For vehicles with different front and rear tire pressures (such as the E-Series and certain
F-Series), the tire pressure sensors must be trained following a tire rotation. Failure to train the
sensors will cause the TPMS indicator to illuminate. For vehicles with the same tire pressure for
front and rear tires, tire rotation will not affect the system.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position, then press and release the brake pedal.
2. Cycle the ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN
position.
3. Press and release the brake pedal.
4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
5. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN
position.
- The horn will sound once and the TPMS indicator will flash if the training mode has been entered
successfully. If equipped, the message center will display TRAIN LF TIRE.
6. NOTE: It may take up to 6 seconds to activate a tire pressure sensor. During this time, the Tire
Pressure Monitor Activation Tool must remain in
place 180 degrees from the valve stem.
Place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the LF tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees) from
the valve stem. Press and release the test button on the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. The
horn will sound briefly to indicate that the tire pressure sensor has been recognized by the SJB.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training > Page 1360
7. Within 2 minutes of the horn sounding, place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the RF
tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees) from the
valve stem and press and release the test button to train the RF tire pressure sensor.
8. NOTE: Do not wait more than 2 minutes between training each sensor or the SJB will time out
and the entire procedure must be repeated.
Repeat Step 7 for the RR and LR tires.
The procedure is completed after the last tire has been trained. When the training procedure is
complete, the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE TRAINING COMPLETE.
For vehicles not equipped with a message center, successful completion of the training procedure
will be verified by turning the ignition switch to the OFF position without the horn sounding. If the
horn sounds twice when the switch is turned to the OFF position, the training procedure was not
successful.
9. Using the scan tool, locate the updated TPMS sensor identifiers trained to the SJB and
document them on the applicable warranty claim.
10. NOTE: This step is required to clear DTC C2780, cause the SJB to exit the manufacturing
mode and to make sure there are no other concerns
with a newly programmed SJB.
If the sensors are being trained due to the installation of a new SJB, clear any DTCs and carry out
the SJB On-Demand Self Test.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training > Page 1361
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Activation
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Activation
NOTE: The tire pressure sensors will go into a "sleep mode" after 30 minutes of inactivity to
conserve battery power. The sensors do not transmit information while in sleep mode. It will be
necessary to wake them up so they will transmit the latest tire pressure information.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
2. Position the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool against the LF tire sidewall, 180 degrees from
the tire valve stem.
3. NOTE: The Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool will provide feedback in the form of a flashing
green light and a beep sound for each
successful response from a tire pressure sensor.
Press the test button on the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool to activate the sensor, activate
the sensor at least 2 times.
4. Repeat Steps 2 and 3 for the remaining tires.
5. If the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) indicator remains illuminated after adjusting and
activating each sensor, refer to the Symptom
Chart in Diagnosis and Testing. See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators/Tire
Monitoring System/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Disassembly
WARNING: The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) sensor battery may release hazardous
chemicals if exposed to extreme mechanical damage. If these chemicals contact the skin or eyes,
flush immediately with water for a minimum of 15 minutes and get prompt medical attention. If any
part of the battery is swallowed, contact a physician immediately. When disposing of TPMS
sensors, follow the correct procedures for hazardous material disposal. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in serious personal injury.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application. When
installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color of the
sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor can be removed and installed without removing the strap or the cradle.
1. NOTICE: The sensor, cradle and strap may be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Dismount the tire only as instructed.
Remove the tire from the wheel. For additional information, refer to Wheel and Tire See:
Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Overhaul.
2. NOTICE: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to the
sensor locking clip may occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver or similar tool, remove the sensor locking clip.
3. NOTICE: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to the
sensor may occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver or similar tool, detach the sensor from the cradle.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1364
4. Remove the sensor.
Assembly
1. NOTICE: Damage to the sensor may occur if excessive force is applied during sensor
installation.
NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the cradle. The sensor will make a "click" noise
when correctly seated.
Position the sensor into the cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end of the
cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. NOTE: The locking clip can only be fully seated when installed in the correct orientation. If the
sensor locking clip cannot be fully inserted, then
the sensor may not be fully seated on the cradle or the locking clip may be inserted backward.
Insert a new locking clip into the sensor.
3. NOTICE: The sensor, cradle and strap may be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel. For additional information, refer to Wheel and Tire See:
Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Overhaul.
4. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s). For additional information, refer to Tire Pressure Monitoring
System (TPMS) Sensor Training See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators/Tire
Monitoring System/Testing and Inspection/Monitors, Trips, Drive Cycles and Readiness Codes.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1365
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and
Cradle
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and Cradle
Disassembly
WARNING: The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) sensor battery may release hazardous
chemicals if exposed to extreme mechanical damage. If these chemicals contact the skin or eyes,
flush immediately with water for a minimum of 15 minutes and get prompt medical attention. If any
part of the battery is swallowed, contact a physician immediately. When disposing of TPMS
sensors, follow the correct procedures for hazardous material disposal. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in serious personal injury.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application. When
installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color of the
sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor is available separately, the cradle and strap are available as a strap kit. There
are several different strap kits available based on wheel diameter, but all strap kits share the same
base part number.
1. Remove the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) sensor. For additional information, refer to
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Sensor See: Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor.
2. WARNING: Always wear eye protection when servicing a vehicle. Failure to follow this
instruction may result in serious personal injury.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1366
WARNING: Wear protective gloves when handling components or parts that have pointed or sharp
edges. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
Remove a factory-installed strap in the following sequence:
1. Locate the strap buckle and secure the strap to the wheel using duct tape or a similar item on
both sides of the buckle, approximately 25 mm
(0.98 in) from the buckle.
2. Using a large screwdriver and a twisting motion, unbuckle the strap.
3. Discard the strap.
3. To remove a dealer-installed strap, turn the worm gear screw until the strap is fully released from
the worm gear.
- Discard the strap.
4. NOTE: To aid assembly, mark the location of the cradle prior to disassembly.
Using a screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the cradle by inserting the screwdriver under the cradle
and prying up.
Assembly
1. NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the new cradle. The sensor will make a "click"
noise when fully seated.
Position the sensor into the new cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end
of the cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. NOTICE: Metal scrapers may damage the wheel. Use only plastic or non-metallic scrapers to
remove the cradle adhesive strip residue.
NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be installed in the drop well of the wheel, 180 degrees from the
valve stem.
Using wheel and tire cleaner, clean the area where the sensor and cradle are to be installed.
3. NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be positioned with the hinge side of the sensor on the RH
side when viewed from the curb side (beauty side)
of the wheel.
NOTE: The sensor has raised markings indicating how to position the sensor.
Remove the adhesive tape liner from the cradle and position the sensor and cradle into the wheel
drop well 180 degrees from the valve stem.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1367
4. Install the tapered end of the strap through the opening of the cradle on the hinge side of the
sensor. This will position the worm gear on the
locking clip side of the sensor.
5. NOTICE: Steel wheels have a "high spot" along their circumference. Make sure the strap and
sensor are mounted at the lowest spot
possible to avoid damaging the sensor during wheel and tire disassembly and assembly.
NOTE: Keep the strap parallel with the wheel flange while tightening the worm gear.
Position the worm gear 13-26 mm (0.5-1.0 in) away from the sensor and tighten the worm gear.
- Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
6. NOTICE: The sensor, cradle and strap may be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel. For additional information, refer to Wheel and Tire See:
Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Overhaul.
7. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s). For additional information, refer to Tire Pressure Monitoring
System (TPMS) Sensor Training See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators/Tire
Monitoring System/Testing and Inspection/Monitors, Trips, Drive Cycles and Readiness Codes.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Description and Operation
Brake Switch - TCC: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to as the stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal
to the PCM indicating the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Typical BPP Switch
Typical BPP Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 1376
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 1377
Transmission Mode Switch: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
The TCS signals the PCM with VPWR whenever the TCS is pressed. On vehicles with this feature,
the transmission control indicator lamp (TCIL) illuminates when the TCS is cycled to disengage
overdrive.
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS) (Column Shift)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS) (Floor Shift)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Control
(TC) Switch - Column Shift
Transmission Mode Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift
Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The Tow/Haul switch is not replaceable. If a new Tow/Haul switch is required, install a new
selector lever assembly.
1. For additional information, refer to Selector Lever - Column Shift See: Transmission and
Drivetrain/Automatic Transmission/Transaxle/Shifter
A/T/Service and Repair/Selector Lever - Column Shift.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Control
(TC) Switch - Column Shift > Page 1380
Transmission Mode Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Floor Shift
Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Floor Shift
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The Tow/Haul switch is not serviced. If a new switch is required, install a new selector lever
knob assembly.
1. For additional information, refer to Selector Lever Knob See: Transmission and
Drivetrain/Automatic Transmission/Transaxle/Shifter
A/T/Service and Repair/Selector Lever Knob.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Locations Master Window Adjust Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1386
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1387
Power Window Switch: Locations Power Window Switch, RH Side Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1388
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1389
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1390
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Master Window Adjust Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1393
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1394
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1395
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1396
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1397
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Power Window Switch, RH Side Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1398
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Master Window Adjust Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1401
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1402
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Window Switch, RH Side Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1403
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1404
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Window Adjust Switches - Left Rear and Right Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1405
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1406
Power Window Switch: Service and Repair
Window Control Switch
Removal and Installation
NOTE: LF shown, all others similar.
1. Remove the door trim panel.
2. NOTE: There are 2 tabs on the opposite side not shown in the illustration.
Unlock the 4 tabs and remove the window control switch from the door trim panel.
3. To install, reverse removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Rain Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-24-13 > Dec > 09 > Wipers/Washers - Rain
Sensor Detached From Windshield
Rain Sensor: Customer Interest Wipers/Washers - Rain Sensor Detached From Windshield
TSB 09-24-13
12/14/09
RAIN SENSOR MOUNTING RING DETACHED FROM WINDSHIELD
FORD: 2010 Taurus
2009-2010 Expedition, F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 MKS 2010 MKZ 2009-2010 Navigator 2010 MKT
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 F-150 Platinum, Expedition, Navigator, MKS and 2010 Taurus, MKT and
MKZ vehicles equipped with Rain Sensing Windshield Wipers may exhibit a detached rain sensor
mounting ring. The rain sensor mounting ring is attached to the inside of the windshield near the
rear view mirror. The windshield wipers will continue to function in manual mode, only the rain
sensor feature is affected.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
A service repair kit has been made available to resolve this issue. Order the Rain Sensor Repair Kit
and follow the instruction sheet contained with this kit to resolve a detached rain sensor mounting
ring.
NOTE
THE KIT REQUIRES CHEMICALS WHICH ARE NOT INCLUDED IN THE KIT. THESE
CHEMICALS HAVE A SHORT SHELF LIFE AND ARE REQUIRED TO BE OBTAINED DIRECTLY
FROM A SOURCE LISTED IN THE INSTRUCTION SHEET.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT092413 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
17D596 33
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Rain Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-24-13 > Dec > 09 >
Wipers/Washers - Rain Sensor Detached From Windshield
Rain Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Wipers/Washers - Rain Sensor Detached From
Windshield
TSB 09-24-13
12/14/09
RAIN SENSOR MOUNTING RING DETACHED FROM WINDSHIELD
FORD: 2010 Taurus
2009-2010 Expedition, F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 MKS 2010 MKZ 2009-2010 Navigator 2010 MKT
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 F-150 Platinum, Expedition, Navigator, MKS and 2010 Taurus, MKT and
MKZ vehicles equipped with Rain Sensing Windshield Wipers may exhibit a detached rain sensor
mounting ring. The rain sensor mounting ring is attached to the inside of the windshield near the
rear view mirror. The windshield wipers will continue to function in manual mode, only the rain
sensor feature is affected.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
A service repair kit has been made available to resolve this issue. Order the Rain Sensor Repair Kit
and follow the instruction sheet contained with this kit to resolve a detached rain sensor mounting
ring.
NOTE
THE KIT REQUIRES CHEMICALS WHICH ARE NOT INCLUDED IN THE KIT. THESE
CHEMICALS HAVE A SHORT SHELF LIFE AND ARE REQUIRED TO BE OBTAINED DIRECTLY
FROM A SOURCE LISTED IN THE INSTRUCTION SHEET.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT092413 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
17D596 33
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Rain Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Rain Sensor: > 10-18-1 > Sep > 10 >
A/T - Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735
Valve Body: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735
TSB 10-18-1
09/27/10
5.4L WITH 6R75/6R80 - DELAYED FORWARD/REVERSE ENGAGEMENT - DTCS P0741,
P0731, AND/OR P0735 - AFTER COLD START
FORD: 2007-2010 Expedition 2009-2010 F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2010 Expedition, 2009-2010 Navigator and F-150 vehicles equipped with a
5.4L engine and a 6R75/6R80 transmission may exhibit delayed forward/reverse engagement.
Diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) P0741, P0731, and/or P0735 for torque converter and/or gear
ratio concerns may be stored in the powertrain control module (PCM). This concern typically occurs
after cold start and in colder climates.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Remove the mechatronic assembly. Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Inspect the fluid pump adapter seal molded frame for evidence of cracks, which are most often
found in the corner(s) of the molded frame.
a. If evidence of cracks are present, proceed to Step 3.
b. If evidence of cracks are not present, do not continue with this article. Refer to WSM Section
307-01 for further diagnostics.
3. Partially disassemble the mechatronic assembly to access only the main oil pressure regulator
valve located in the lower half. Refer to WSM, Section
307-01.
4. Inspect the main oil pressure regulator valve for free movement in its bore.
a. If the valve moves easily in the bore, proceed to Step 5.
b. If the valve does not move or sticks, remove the valve and clean both the valve and bore,
reinstall the valve. Proceed to Step 5.
5. Reassemble the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
6. Install a new front pump adapter seal.
7. Reinstall the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101801A 2007-2010 Expedition, 2.7 Hrs.
2009-2010 F-150,
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Rain Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Rain Sensor: > 10-18-1 > Sep > 10 >
A/T - Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735 > Page 1426
Navigator: Follow Service Procedure To Repair Mechatronic Includes Time To Remove And Install
The Mechatronic And Reprogram (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7F401 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Rain Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Rain Sensor: > 10-18-1 > Sep > 10 >
A/T - Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735 > Page 1432
Navigator: Follow Service Procedure To Repair Mechatronic Includes Time To Remove And Install
The Mechatronic And Reprogram (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7F401 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Rain Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1433
Rain Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Rain Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1434
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Rain Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1435
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Rain Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1436
Rain Sensor: Service and Repair
Rain Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Pull outward on the rain sensor cover to remove.
2. Disconnect the rain sensor electrical connector.
3. NOTE: Prior to releasing the rain sensor retaining clips, it is necessary to apply light inward
pressure at the bend of the retaining clips.
Using a suitable screwdriver, release the 2 rain sensor retaining clips from the windshield mounted
bracket and remove the rain sensor.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid
Level Switch > Component Information > Locations
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid
Level Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1440
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid
Level Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1441
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations
Windshield Washer Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1445
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1446
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1447
Windshield Washer Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1448
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1449
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1450
Windshield Washer Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
NOTE: Power tilt column shown, manual tilt similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the steering column shroud.
2. Disconnect the 2 multifunction switch electrical connectors.
3. Remove the 2 screws and the multifunction switch.
- To install, tighten to 1 Nm (9 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Wiper Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1454
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1455
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1456
Wiper Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1457
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1458
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1459
Wiper Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
NOTE: Power tilt column shown, manual tilt similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the steering column shroud.
2. Disconnect the 2 multifunction switch electrical connectors.
3. Remove the 2 screws and the multifunction switch.
- To install, tighten to 1 Nm (9 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications
Alignment: Specifications Alignment Specifications
Alignment Specifications Vehicles With Rear Coil Spring Suspension
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications >
Page 1465
Alignment Specifications Vehicles With Rear Air Suspension
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications >
Page 1466
Alignment: Specifications Ball Joint Deflection, Ride Height, and Vehicle Lean
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications >
Page 1467
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications >
Page 1468
Alignment: Specifications Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation > Camber
Alignment: Description and Operation Camber
Wheel Alignment Angles
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie rods. The rear camber is adjusted by removing the upper arm
camber set shim or shim pins to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slot. The rear toe is
adjusted by the use of the rear toe link cam bolt and nut.
Camber
Negative and Positive Camber
Camber is the vertical tilt of the wheel when viewed from the front. Camber can be positive or
negative and has a direct affect on tire wear.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation > Camber > Page
1471
Alignment: Description and Operation Caster
Wheel Alignment Angles
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie rods. The rear camber is adjusted by removing the upper arm
camber set shim or shim pins to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slot. The rear toe is
adjusted by the use of the rear toe link cam bolt and nut.
Caster
Caster is the deviation from vertical of an imaginary line drawn through the ball joints when viewed
from the side. The caster specifications will give the vehicle the best directional stability
characteristics when loaded and driven. The caster setting does not affect tire wear.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation > Camber > Page
1472
Alignment: Description and Operation Drift/Pull
Wheel Alignment Angles
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie rods. The rear camber is adjusted by removing the upper arm
camber set shim or shim pins to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slot. The rear toe is
adjusted by the use of the rear toe link cam bolt and nut.
Drift/Pull
Pull is a tugging sensation, felt by the hands on the steering wheel, that must be overcome to keep
the vehicle going straight.
Drift describes what a vehicle with this condition does with hands off the steering wheel.
- A vehicle-related drift/pull, on a flat road, will cause a consistent deviation from the straight-ahead
path and require constant steering input in the opposite direction to counteract the effect.
- Drift/pull may be induced by conditions external to the vehicle (such as wind or road camber).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation > Camber > Page
1473
Alignment: Description and Operation Nibble
Wheel Alignment Angles
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie rods. The rear camber is adjusted by removing the upper arm
camber set shim or shim pins to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slot. The rear toe is
adjusted by the use of the rear toe link cam bolt and nut.
Nibble
Sometimes confused with shimmy, nibble is a condition resulting from tire interaction with various
road surfaces or tire imbalance. This condition is observed by the driver as small rotational
oscillations of the steering wheel.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation > Camber > Page
1474
Alignment: Description and Operation
Camber
Wheel Alignment Angles
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie rods. The rear camber is adjusted by removing the upper arm
camber set shim or shim pins to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slot. The rear toe is
adjusted by the use of the rear toe link cam bolt and nut.
Camber
Negative and Positive Camber
Camber is the vertical tilt of the wheel when viewed from the front. Camber can be positive or
negative and has a direct affect on tire wear.
Caster
Wheel Alignment Angles
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie rods. The rear camber is adjusted by removing the upper arm
camber set shim or shim pins to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slot. The rear toe is
adjusted by the use of the rear toe link cam bolt and nut.
Caster
Caster is the deviation from vertical of an imaginary line drawn through the ball joints when viewed
from the side. The caster specifications will give the vehicle the best directional stability
characteristics when loaded and driven. The caster setting does not affect tire wear.
Drift/Pull
Wheel Alignment Angles
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie rods. The rear camber is adjusted by removing the upper arm
camber set shim or shim pins to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slot. The rear toe is
adjusted by the use of the rear toe link cam bolt and nut.
Drift/Pull
Pull is a tugging sensation, felt by the hands on the steering wheel, that must be overcome to keep
the vehicle going straight.
Drift describes what a vehicle with this condition does with hands off the steering wheel.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation > Camber > Page
1475
- A vehicle-related drift/pull, on a flat road, will cause a consistent deviation from the straight-ahead
path and require constant steering input in the opposite direction to counteract the effect.
- Drift/pull may be induced by conditions external to the vehicle (such as wind or road camber).
Nibble
Wheel Alignment Angles
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie rods. The rear camber is adjusted by removing the upper arm
camber set shim or shim pins to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slot. The rear toe is
adjusted by the use of the rear toe link cam bolt and nut.
Nibble
Sometimes confused with shimmy, nibble is a condition resulting from tire interaction with various
road surfaces or tire imbalance. This condition is observed by the driver as small rotational
oscillations of the steering wheel.
Poor Groove Feel
Wheel Alignment Angles
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie rods. The rear camber is adjusted by removing the upper arm
camber set shim or shim pins to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slot. The rear toe is
adjusted by the use of the rear toe link cam bolt and nut.
Poor Groove Feel
Poor groove feel is characterized by little or no buildup of turning effort felt in the steering wheel as
the wheel is rocked slowly left and right within very small turns around center or straight-ahead
(under 20 degrees of steering wheel turn). Efforts may be said to be "flat on center."
- Under 20 degrees of turn, most of the turning effort that builds up comes from the mesh of gear
teeth in the steering gear. In this range, the steering wheel is not yet turned enough to feel the
effort from the self-aligning forces at the road wheel or tire patch.
- In the diagnosis of a steering or alignment concern, it is important to understand the difference
between wander and poor groove feel.
Poor Returnability/Sticky Steering
Wheel Alignment Angles
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie rods. The rear camber is adjusted by removing the upper arm
camber set shim or shim pins to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slot. The rear toe is
adjusted by the use of the rear toe link cam bolt and nut.
Poor Returnability/Sticky Steering
Poor returnability and sticky steering is used to describe the poor return of the steering wheel to
center after a turn or when the steering correction is completed.
Shimmy
Wheel Alignment Angles
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie rods. The rear camber is adjusted by removing the upper arm
camber set shim or shim pins to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slot. The rear toe is
adjusted by the use of the rear toe link cam bolt and nut.
Shimmy
Shimmy, as observed by the driver, is large, consistent, rotational oscillations of the steering wheel
resulting from large, side-to-side (lateral) tire/wheel movements.
Shimmy is usually experienced near 64 km/h (40 mph), and can begin or be amplified when the tire
contacts pot holes or irregularities in the road surface.
Toe
Wheel Alignment Angles
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation > Camber > Page
1476
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie rods. The rear camber is adjusted by removing the upper arm
camber set shim or shim pins to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slot. The rear toe is
adjusted by the use of the rear toe link cam bolt and nut.
Toe
Positive Toe (Toe In)
Negative Toe (Toe Out)
The vehicle toe setting:
- affects tire wear and directional stability.
- must be checked after adding aftermarket equipment, such as a snowplow.
Wander
Wheel Alignment Angles
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie rods. The rear camber is adjusted by removing the upper arm
camber set shim or shim pins to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slot. The rear toe is
adjusted by the use of the rear toe link cam bolt and nut.
Wander
Wander is the tendency of the vehicle to require frequent, random left and right steering wheel
corrections to maintain a straight path down a level road.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Ride Height
Measurement
Alignment: Service and Repair Ride Height Measurement
Ride Height Measurement
Front Ride Height Measurement
NOTE: Make sure that the vehicle is positioned on a flat, level surface and the tires are inflated to
the correct pressure. Vehicle should have a full tank of fuel.
1. Position a suitable surface gauge (such as Starrett 57D Surface Gauge), on a flat, level surface
and adjust the gauge's arm until the scriber point is
located in the center of the lower arm rearward bolt. Lock the surface gauge in this position.
2. With the surface gauge positioned on a flat, level surface, record the measurement of the
surface gauge position (measurement 2).
3. Position the surface gauge on the same flat, level surface as used in Step 1, adjust the gauge's
arm until the scriber point is located on the lower
surface of the wheel knuckle near the ball joint. Lock the surface gauge in this position.
4. With the surface gauge positioned on a flat, level surface, record the measurement of the
surface gauge position (measurement 3).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Ride Height
Measurement > Page 1479
5. Subtract measurement 3 from measurement 2 to obtain the front ride height.
- For additional information, refer to Specifications.
Rear Ride Height Measurement
NOTE: Make sure that the vehicle is positioned on a flat, level surface and the tires are inflated to
the correct pressure. Vehicle should have a full tank of fuel.
1. Measure the distance between the flat level surface and the center of the lower arm rearward
bolt (measurement 2).
2. Measure the distance between the flat level surface and the center of the shock absorber lower
bolt (rearward side) (measurement 3).
3. Subtract measurement 3 from measurement 2 to obtain the rear ride height.
- For additional information, refer to Specifications.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Ride Height
Measurement > Page 1480
Alignment: Service and Repair Camber And Caster Adjustment - Front
Camber and Caster Adjustment - Front
NOTICE: Do not remove the stabilizer bar brackets until the stabilizer links have been
disconnected or damage to the stabilizer bar links may occur.
NOTE: Air suspension vehicles must be at trim ride height prior to measuring or adjusting the
caster, camber or toe.
NOTE: To allow for adjustment of the lower arm in the frame slots, the lower arm bolts and nuts
must be removed and discarded. They are replaced with cam bolt kit 3C333. The vehicle should be
supported by the frame to ease movement of the lower arm in the slot.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturers instructions, measure the front caster and
camber.
- Refer to Alignment Specifications in the Specifications portion for optimal alignment settings.
- If the caster and camber values are not within specification, go to the next step.
2. Remove and discard the lower arm front and rear nuts and bolts.
3. NOTICE: Do not hold the stabilizer link boot with any tool, as damage to the boot will occur.
NOTE: Use the hex-holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while removing the nuts.
Remove and discard the stabilizer bar link lower nuts.
4. Remove the 4 stabilizer bar bracket nuts, 2 stabilizer bar brackets and position the stabilizer bar
aside.
5. Remove the stabilizer bar bracket bolts and plate assembly.
6. Install the front cam bolt kit and loosely install the nut.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Ride Height
Measurement > Page 1481
7. Install the rear cam bolt kit and loosely install the nut.
8. To adjust the caster and camber, refer to the following chart.
- Adjustments that require moving the front and the rear of the lower arm should be made equally.
9. With the weight of the vehicle resting on the wheel and tire assemblies, hold the front cam bolt
and tighten the nut to 350 Nm (258 lb-ft).
10. With the weight of the vehicle resting on the wheel and tire assemblies, hold the rear cam bolt
and tighten the nut to 350 Nm (258 lb-ft).
11. Install the 2 stabilizer bar bracket bolts and plate assembly.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Ride Height
Measurement > Page 1482
12. Position the stabilizer bar, install the 2 stabilizer bar brackets and the 4 stabilizer bar bracket
nuts.
- Tighten the nuts to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
13. NOTICE: Do not hold the stabilizer link boot with any tool, as damage to the boot will occur.
NOTE: Use the hex-holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while installing the nuts.
Install the 2 stabilizer bar link lower nuts.
- Tighten the nuts to 80 Nm (59 lb-ft).
14. Check and, if necessary, adjust the front toe. For additional information, refer to Toe
Adjustment - Front See: Toe Adjustment - Front.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Ride Height
Measurement > Page 1483
Alignment: Service and Repair Toe Adjustment - Front
Toe Adjustment - Front
NOTE: Air suspension vehicles must be at trim ride height prior to measuring or adjusting the
caster, camber or toe.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturer's instructions, measure the front toe.
- Refer to Alignment Specifications in the Specifications portion for optimal alignment settings.
- If the front toe values are not within specification, go to the next step.
2. Start the engine and center the steering wheel.
3. Turn the engine off and, using a suitable steering wheel holding device, lock the steering wheel
in the straight-ahead position.
4. Remove the steering gear bellows clamp(s).
5. Loosen the tie-rod end jam nut(s).
6. NOTE: Do not allow the steering gear bellows to twist while rotating the tie rod.
Rotate the tie rod(s) to achieve the desired toe setting.
7. NOTICE: Make sure to hold the tie-rod end stationary while tightening the jam nut or damage to
the boot may occur.
NOTE: Make sure that the toe settings are not disturbed while tightening the jam nuts.
Tighten the tie-rod end jam nut(s) to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
8. Install the steering gear bellows clamp(s).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Ride Height
Measurement > Page 1484
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Ride Height
Measurement > Page 1485
Alignment: Service and Repair Toe Adjustment - Rear
Toe Adjustment - Rear
NOTE: Air suspension vehicles must be at trim ride height prior to measuring or adjusting the rear
toe.
NOTE: Before carrying out a toe adjustment, check the tires for the correct pressure. Inspect the
tires for incorrect wear or damage. Inspect the suspension for wear or damage.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturer's instructions, measure the rear toe.
- Refer to Alignment Specifications in the Specifications portion for optimal alignment settings.
- If the rear toe values are not within specification, go to the next step.
2. Loosen the toe link cam bolt nut(s).
3. Rotate the toe link cam bolt(s) until the toe setting is within specification.
4. NOTE: Make sure the toe settings are not disturbed while tightening the cam nut(s).
Tighten the toe link cam bolt nut(s) to 275 Nm (203 lb-ft).
5. Recheck the rear toe setting, adjust as necessary.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Ride Height
Measurement > Page 1486
Alignment: Service and Repair Camber Adjustment - Rear
Camber Adjustment - Rear
NOTE: Air suspension vehicles must be at trim ride height prior to measuring or adjusting the rear
camber or toe.
NOTE: Before carrying out a camber adjustment, check the tires for the correct pressure. Inspect
the tires for incorrect wear or damage. Inspect the suspension for wear or damage.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturer's instructions, measure the rear camber.
- Refer to Alignment Specifications in the Specifications portion for optimal alignment settings.
- If the rear camber value is not within specification, go to the next step.
2. Remove the upper arm-to-frame bolt and the camber set shim.
- Discard the camber set shim.
- Install and snug the upper arm-to frame bolt.
3. Position the upper arm-to-frame bolt in the upper arm-to-frame slot until the camber setting is
within specification.
4. NOTE: Do not allow the upper arm to move and change the camber adjustment setting when
tightening the bolt.
Tighten the upper arm-to-frame bolt to 225 Nm (166 lb-ft).
5. Recheck the camber setting, adjust as necessary.
6. Check and, if necessary, adjust the rear toe. For additional information, refer to Toe Adjustment Rear See: Toe Adjustment - Rear.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System Information
> Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
Fuel Pressure
Engine running.....................................................................................................................................
..............................................379-414 kPa (55-60 psi) Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).........................
..................................................................................................................................379-414 kPa
(55-60 psi)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System Information
> Specifications > Page 1491
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection
Fuel System Pressure Test
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Before working on or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components,
relieve the fuel system pressure to prevent accidental spraying of fuel. Fuel in the fuel system
remains under high pressure, even when the engine is not running. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
WARNING: When handling fuel, always observe fuel handling precautions and be prepared in the
event of fuel spillage. Spilled fuel may be ignited by hot vehicle components or other ignition
sources. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
1. Remove the cap from the fuel pressure relief valve located on the fuel rail.
2. Install the Fuel Pressure Test Kit onto the fuel pressure relief valve.
3. Test the fuel system pressure to make sure it is within the specified range. For additional
information, refer to Specifications.
4. NOTE: Open the drain valve slowly to relieve the fuel system pressure. This may drain fuel from
the system. Place fuel in a suitable container.
Upon completion of the fuel system pressure test, open the drain valve on the Fuel Pressure Test
Kit and relieve the fuel system pressure.
5. NOTE: It may take more than one key cycle to pressurize the fuel system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System Information
> Specifications > Page 1492
Cycle the ignition key and wait 3 seconds to pressurize the fuel system. Check for leaks before
starting the engine.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System Information >
Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Typical Diagnostic Reference Value
Measured/PID Values 695 RPM ..........................................................................................................
..................................................................................................... Hot Idle
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Intake Air System Components - Exploded View
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Intake Air System Components - Exploded View
Intake Air System Components - Exploded View
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Intake Air System Components - Exploded View > Page 1501
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Air Cleaner Element
Air Cleaner Element
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the Air Cleaner (ACL) outlet pipe from the ACL cover.
- To install, tighten the clamps to 4 Nm (35 lb-in).
2. Disconnect the Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector.
3. Release the retaining clips and position the ACL cover aside.
4. Remove the ACL element.
5. NOTE: The ACL element must be fully seated into the ACL housing. Failure to do so will result in
unusual engine noise.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure Release
> System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
Fuel System Pressure Release
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Before working on or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components,
relieve the fuel system pressure to prevent accidental spraying of fuel. Fuel in the fuel system
remains under high pressure, even when the engine is not running. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: When handling fuel, always observe fuel handling precautions and be prepared in the
event of fuel spillage. Spilled fuel may be ignited by hot vehicle components or other ignition
sources. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
2. Remove the cap from the fuel pressure relief valve located on the fuel rail.
3. Install the Fuel Pressure Test Kit onto the fuel pressure relief valve.
4. NOTE: Open the manual valve slowly to relieve the system pressure. This may drain fuel from
the fuel system. Place fuel in a suitable container.
Open the manual valve on the Fuel Pressure Test Kit and relieve the fuel pressure.
5. NOTE: It may take more than one key cycle to pressurize the fuel system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure Release
> System Information > Service and Repair > Page 1506
Cycle the ignition key and wait 3 seconds to pressurize the fuel system. Check for leaks before
starting the engine.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order > Component
Information > Specifications > Firing Order
Firing Order: Specifications Firing Order
Firing order...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................1-3-7-2-6-5-4-8
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order > Component
Information > Specifications > Firing Order > Page 1511
Firing Order: Specifications Engine Cylinder Identification
Engine Cylinder Identification
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing > System
Information > Specifications
Ignition Timing: Specifications
Base ignition timing..............................................................................................................................
........................10° Before Top Dead Center (BTDC)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Specifications > Gap
Spark Plug: Specifications Gap
Spark plug gap.....................................................................................................................................
.................................1.05 ± 0.05 mm (0.039-0.043 in)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Specifications > Gap > Page 1519
Spark Plug: Specifications Torque Specifications
Spark plugs...........................................................................................................................................
........................................................12 Nm (106 lb-in)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1520
Spark Plug: Application and ID
Spark plug............................................................................................................................................
...................................................................HJFS-24FP
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1521
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection
Spark Plug Inspection
1. Inspect the spark plug for a bridged gap.
- Check for deposit build-up closing the gap between the electrodes. Deposits are caused by oil or
carbon fouling.
- Install a new spark plug.
2. Check for oil fouling.
- Check for wet, black deposits on the insulator shell bore electrodes, caused by excessive oil
entering the combustion chamber through worn rings and pistons, excessive valve-to-guide
clearance or worn or loose bearings.
- Correct the oil leak concern.
- Install a new spark plug.
3. Inspect for carbon fouling. Look for black, dry, fluffy carbon deposits on the insulator tips,
exposed shell surfaces and electrodes, caused by a
spark plug with an incorrect heat range, dirty air cleaner, too rich a fuel mixture or excessive idling.
Install new spark plugs.
4. Inspect for normal burning.
- Check for light tan or gray deposits on the firing tip.
5. Inspect for pre-ignition, identified by melted electrodes and a possibly damaged insulator.
Metallic deposits on the insulator indicate engine
damage. This may be caused by incorrect ignition timing, wrong type of fuel or the unauthorized
installation of a heli-coil insert in place of the spark plug threads. Install a new spark plug.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1522
6. Inspect for overheating, identified by white or light gray spots and a bluish-burnt appearance of
electrodes. This is caused by engine overheating,
wrong type of fuel, loose spark plugs, spark plugs with an incorrect heat range, low fuel pump
pressure or incorrect ignition timing. Install a new spark plug.
7. Inspect for fused deposits, identified by melted or spotty deposits resembling bubbles or blisters.
These are caused by sudden acceleration.
- Install new spark plugs.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Engine Ignition Components - Exploded View
Spark Plug: Service and Repair Engine Ignition Components - Exploded View
Engine Ignition Components - Exploded View
Engine Ignition - RH
Engine Ignition - LH
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Engine Ignition Components - Exploded View > Page 1525
Spark Plug: Service and Repair Spark Plugs
Spark Plugs
Removal
NOTICE: The spark plug procedure must be followed exactly or damage to the cylinder head and
spark plug will result.
1. Remove the ignition coil-on-plug. For additional information, refer to Ignition Coil-On-Plug See:
Powertrain Management/Ignition
System/Ignition Coil/Service and Repair/Ignition Coil-On-Plug.
2. NOTICE: Only use hand tools when removing or installing the spark plugs or damage can occur
to the cylinder head or spark plug.
NOTE: Use compressed air to remove any foreign material from the spark plug well before
removing the spark plugs.
Remove the spark plug.
3. Inspect the spark plug.
Installation
1. Adjust the spark plug gap as necessary. For the correct spark plug gap specification, refer to
Specifications.
2. NOTICE: Only use hand tools when removing or installing the spark plugs or damage can occur
to the cylinder head or spark plug.
Install the spark plug.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
3. Install the ignition coil. For additional information, refer to Ignition Coil-On-Plug See: Powertrain
Management/Ignition System/Ignition
Coil/Service and Repair/Ignition Coil-On-Plug.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check > System
Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Compression Test - Test Results
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75% of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit Chart.
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
If one or more cylinders reads low, squirt approximately one tablespoon of engine oil on top of the
pistons in the low-reading cylinders. Repeat the compression pressure check on these cylinders.
Compression Test - Interpreting Compression Readings
1. If compression improves considerably, piston rings are faulty.
2. If compression does not improve, valves are sticking or seating incorrectly.
3. If 2 adjacent cylinders indicate low compression pressures and squirting oil on each piston does
not increase compression, the head gasket may be
leaking between cylinders. Engine oil or coolant in cylinders could result from this condition.
Use the Compression Pressure Limit Chart when checking cylinder compression so that the lowest
reading is within 75% of the highest reading.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check > System
Information > Specifications > Page 1529
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
Engine
Component Tests
The following component tests are used to diagnose engine concerns.
Compression Test - Compression Gauge Check
1. Make sure the oil in the crankcase is of the correct viscosity and at the correct level and that the
battery is correctly charged. Operate the vehicle
until the engine is at normal operating temperature. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position,
then remove all the spark plugs.
2. Set the throttle plates in the wide-open position.
3. Install a compression gauge in the No. 1 cylinder.
4. Install an auxiliary starter switch in the starting circuit. With the ignition switch in the OFF
position, and using the auxiliary starter switch, crank
the engine a minimum of 5 compression strokes and record the highest reading. Note the
approximate number of compression strokes required to obtain the highest reading.
5. Repeat the test on each cylinder, cranking the engine approximately the same number of
compression strokes.
Compression Test - Test Results
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75% of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit Chart.
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check > System
Information > Specifications > Page 1530
If one or more cylinders reads low, squirt approximately one tablespoon of engine oil on top of the
pistons in the low-reading cylinders. Repeat the compression pressure check on these cylinders.
Compression Test - Interpreting Compression Readings
1. If compression improves considerably, piston rings are faulty.
2. If compression does not improve, valves are sticking or seating incorrectly.
3. If 2 adjacent cylinders indicate low compression pressures and squirting oil on each piston does
not increase compression, the head gasket may be
leaking between cylinders. Engine oil or coolant in cylinders could result from this condition.
Use the Compression Pressure Limit Chart when checking cylinder compression so that the lowest
reading is within 75% of the highest reading.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Diagrams
Drive Belt: Diagrams
Accessory Drive
Accessory Drive Belt Routing
Front End Accessory Drive (FEAD) Components
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Belt Noise/Flutter
Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection Drive Belt - Noise/Flutter
Accessory Drive
Component Tests
Drive Belt - Noise/Flutter
NOTICE: Under no circumstances should the accessory drive belt, tensioner or pulleys have any
fluids or belt dressing applied to them as damage to the belt material and tensioner damping
mechanism may occur.
Drive belt chirp occurs due to pulley misalignment or excessive pulley runout. It can be the result of
a damaged or incorrectly aligned grooved pulley.
To correct, determine the area where the noise comes from. Check each of the pulleys in that area
with a straightedge to the crankshaft pulley. Look for accessory pulleys out of position in the fore/aft
direction or at an angle to the straightedge.
Drive belt squeal may be an intermittent or constant noise that occurs when the drive belt slips on
an accessory pulley under certain conditions.
A short intermittent squeal may occur during engine start up and shut down or during very rapid
engine acceleration and decelerations, such as:
- Wide Open Throttle (WOT) 1-2 and 2-3 shifts or 2-3 and 3-4 back-out shifts on automatic
transmissions.
- WOT 1-2 and 2-3 shifts and any combination of rapid downshifting on manual transmissions.
These special short-term transient events are expected, and are due to the higher system inertias
required to meet the electrical and cooling demands on today's vehicle systems. Constant or
reoccurring drive belt squeal can occur:
- if the A/C discharge pressure goes above specifications: the A/C system is overcharged.
- the A/C condenser core airflow is blocked.
- the A/C anti-slugging strategy executes after a long hot heat soak.
- if the A/C off equalized pressure (the common discharged and suction pressure that occurs after
several minutes) exceeds specifications.
- if any of the accessories or idler pulley(s) are damaged or have a worn or damaged bearing. All
accessories should be rotatable by hand in the unloaded condition. If not, inspect the accessory.
- if there is evidence of fluid contamination on the accessory drive belt. When the drive belt has
been exposed to fluid contamination during vehicle operation, such as leaks from the power
steering system, A/C system or cooling system, clean all pulleys with soap and water, rinse with
clean water and install a new accessory drive belt. If the drive belt has been exposed to fluids in a
localized area during routine vehicle service, such as replacement of hoses or fluids, the drive belt
and pulleys should be washed with soap and water immediately (prior to starting the engine), and
rinsed with clean water.
- if the accessory drive belt is too long. A drive belt that is too long will allow the accessory drive
belt tensioner arm to go all the way to the arm travel stop under certain load conditions, which will
release tension to the drive belt. If the accessory drive belt tensioner indicator is outside the normal
installation wear range window, install a new accessory drive belt.
- NOTE: The accessory drive belt tensioner arm should rotate freely without binding.
Install a new accessory drive belt tensioner if the drive belt tensioner is worn or damaged.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Belt Noise/Flutter > Page 1536
Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection Drive Belt - Incorrect Installation
Accessory Drive
Component Tests
Drive Belt - Incorrect Installation
NOTICE: Incorrect accessory drive belt installation will cause excessive drive belt wear and may
cause the drive belt to come off the pulleys.
Non-standard accessory drive belts can track differently or incorrectly. If an accessory drive belt
tracks incorrectly, install a new accessory drive belt to avoid performance failure or loss of the drive
belt.
Incorrect Installation
Correct Installation
With the engine running, check accessory drive belt tracking on all pulleys. If the edge of the
accessory drive belt rides beyond the edge of the pulleys, noise and premature wear will occur.
Make sure the accessory drive belt rides correctly on the pulley. If an accessory drive belt tracking
condition exists, proceed with the following:
- Visually check the accessory drive belt tensioner for damage and wear, especially the mounting
pad surface and arm alignment. If the accessory drive belt tensioner is not installed correctly, the
mounting surface pad will be out of position. If the tensioner arm is worn, the arm will be out of
alignment. Either of these conditions will result in chirp and squeal noises.
- With the engine running, visually observe the grooves in the pulleys (not the pulley flanges or the
pulley forward faces) for excessive wobble. Install new components as necessary.
- Check all accessories, mounting brackets and the accessory drive belt tensioner for any
interference that would prevent the component from mounting correctly. Correct any interference
condition and recheck the accessory drive belt tracking.
- Tighten all accessories, mounting brackets and accessory drive belt tensioner retaining hardware
to specification. Recheck the accessory drive belt tracking.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front End Accessory
Drive (FEAD) - Exploded View
Drive Belt: Service and Repair Front End Accessory Drive (FEAD) - Exploded View
Front End Accessory Drive (FEAD) - Exploded View
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front End Accessory
Drive (FEAD) - Exploded View > Page 1539
Drive Belt: Service and Repair Accessory Drive Belt
Accessory Drive Belt
Removal and Installation
1. Rotate the accessory drive belt tensioner clockwise and remove the accessory drive belt.
2. NOTE: Make sure the drive belt is correctly installed on each pulley.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Refer to Accessory Drive See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Drive Belts, Mounts,
Brackets and Accessories/Description and Operation in Description and Operation for drive belt
routing.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Intake Air System Components - Exploded View
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Intake Air System Components - Exploded View
Intake Air System Components - Exploded View
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Intake Air System Components - Exploded View > Page 1546
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Air Cleaner Element
Air Cleaner Element
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the Air Cleaner (ACL) outlet pipe from the ACL cover.
- To install, tighten the clamps to 4 Nm (35 lb-in).
2. Disconnect the Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector.
3. Release the retaining clips and position the ACL cover aside.
4. Remove the ACL element.
5. NOTE: The ACL element must be fully seated into the ACL housing. Failure to do so will result in
unusual engine noise.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Cabin Air Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair
Cabin Air Filter: Service and Repair
NOTE: The air distribution system of this vehicle cannot be equipped with a cabin air filter.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Evaporative Canister Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Evaporative Emission (EVAP) System Components - Exploded View
Evaporative Canister Filter: Service and Repair Evaporative Emission (EVAP) System Components
- Exploded View
Evaporative Emission (EVAP) System Components - Exploded View
Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Canister Assembly
NOTE: 106L (28 gal) fuel tank vapor tubes shown, 125L (33 gal) similar.
EVAP Canister, Vent Solenoid and Dust Separator and Brackets
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Evaporative Canister Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Evaporative Emission (EVAP) System Components - Exploded View > Page 1554
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair
Fluid Filter - A/T: Service and Repair
6R80
Fluid Pan, Gasket and Filter
Removal
NOTICE: The use of any transmission fluid other than specified can result in the transmission
failing to operate in a normal manner or transmission failure.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the transmission fluid fill plug transmission fluid level indicator assembly located on the
passenger side front portion of the transmission
case. Removal of the transmission fluid fill plug will relieve any vacuum that might have built up in
the transmission. This will aid in allowing the transmission fluid pan to be easily removed when the
bolts are removed.
3. Remove the transmission fluid pan and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
4. Remove the transmission fluid pan gasket.
5. Remove and discard the transmission fluid filter.
6. Clean and inspect the transmission fluid pan and magnet.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page
1558
Installation
NOTE: If the transmission is being repaired for a contamination-related failure, install a new
transmission fluid filter and seal assembly. The transmission fluid filter may be reused if no
excessive contamination is indicated.
1. Inspect the transmission case for the transmission fluid filter seal. If the seal is in the case,
carefully remove the seal without scratching the case.
2. Make sure that the seal is on the transmission fluid filter and lubricate the seal with automatic
transmission fluid.
3. NOTE: The transmission fluid filter may be reused if no excessive contamination is indicated.
Install a new transmission fluid filter.
4. Position the magnet in the transmission fluid pan.
5. NOTE: The transmission fluid pan gasket can be reused if not damaged.
Install a new transmission fluid pan gasket if required.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page
1559
6. Install the transmission fluid pan and tighten the bolts in a crisscross pattern.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
7. Using the Adding Additional Transmission Fluid procedure, fill and check the transmission fluid.
For additional information, refer to Transmission
Fluid Drain and Refill See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Automatic Transmission/Transaxle/Service
and Repair/Procedures/Transmission Fluid Drain And Refill.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure Release > System Information > Service and
Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
Fuel System Pressure Release
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Before working on or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components,
relieve the fuel system pressure to prevent accidental spraying of fuel. Fuel in the fuel system
remains under high pressure, even when the engine is not running. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: When handling fuel, always observe fuel handling precautions and be prepared in the
event of fuel spillage. Spilled fuel may be ignited by hot vehicle components or other ignition
sources. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
2. Remove the cap from the fuel pressure relief valve located on the fuel rail.
3. Install the Fuel Pressure Test Kit onto the fuel pressure relief valve.
4. NOTE: Open the manual valve slowly to relieve the system pressure. This may drain fuel from
the fuel system. Place fuel in a suitable container.
Open the manual valve on the Fuel Pressure Test Kit and relieve the fuel pressure.
5. NOTE: It may take more than one key cycle to pressurize the fuel system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure Release > System Information > Service and
Repair > Page 1564
Cycle the ignition key and wait 3 seconds to pressurize the fuel system. Check for leaks before
starting the engine.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Coolant Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair
Coolant Line/Hose: Service and Repair
Coolant Crossover Manifold Assembly
Removal and Installation
1. The coolant crossover manifold assembly is serviced with the intake manifold.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line
Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line
Removal
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 1573
NOTE: The auxiliary evaporator inlet and outlet lines are not supplied together as an assembly for
Expedition or Navigator vehicles. The auxiliary evaporator inlet line and outlet line are each
installed from the factory as one-piece assemblies. The replacement parts are supplied as
separate kits containing multiple-piece lines for ease of installation.
NOTE: The auxiliary evaporator inlet and outlet lines for Expedition EL or Navigator L vehicles are
installed from the factory as a single one-piece assembly including both lines. The replacement
part is supplied as a multiple-piece kit for ease of installation.
NOTE: For Expedition or Navigator vehicles, the following procedure can be used to remove and
install one or both the auxiliary evaporator inlet and auxiliary evaporator outlet lines. If only one
auxiliary evaporator line is to be removed and installed, cut or disconnect only the desired line at
the specified points within the procedure. For Expedition EL or Navigator L vehicles, both lines
must be removed.
All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Recover the refrigerant.
3. NOTE: If only one auxiliary evaporator line is to be removed, disconnect only the desired line.
Remove the auxiliary evaporator outlet and inlet line front fitting nut(s) and disconnect the fitting(s).
- Discard the O-ring seals and gasket seals.
4. Remove the spare tire.
5. Remove the RH front wheel and tire.
6. Remove the RH fender splash shield.
7. Working through the RH fender well opening, remove the front auxiliary line bracket nut and the
front auxiliary line bracket.
8. Working through the RH fender well opening, remove the RH catalytic converter heat shield front
bolt.
Expedition or Navigator only
9. NOTE: Both A/C fittings must be disconnected even if only one line is to be removed.
Disconnect the auxiliary evaporator outlet and inlet line rear fittings.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
Expedition EL or Navigator L only
10. Remove the RH rear wheel and tire assembly.
11. Remove the auxiliary evaporator outlet and inlet line rear fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the gasket seals.
All vehicles
12. Remove the muffler.
13. Remove the 3 spare tire carrier splash shield bolts and the spare tire carrier splash shield.
14. Remove the 3 muffler heat shield bolts and the heat shield.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 1574
15. Remove the 2 exhaust hanger bolts and the exhaust hanger.
16. Remove the RH Catalyst Monitor Sensor (CMS).
17. Remove the 3 remaining RH catalytic converter heat shield bolts and the heat shield.
18. Remove the 3 remaining auxiliary line bracket nuts and the auxiliary line brackets.
19. NOTE: If installing only one auxiliary evaporator line, cut only the desired line.
Assemble and lay out the replacement line(s) in the same position as the existing line(s) and, using
a suitable tool, cut the auxiliary evaporator line(s) in the same position as the fittings on the new
line(s).
Expedition EL or Navigator L only
20. Remove the center section(s) of the auxiliary evaporator line(s) through the RH rear wheel well
opening between the body and the frame.
Expedition or Navigator only
21. Remove the center section(s) of the auxiliary evaporator line(s) by manipulating the line(s)
toward the front of the vehicle between the RH
catalytic converter and frame.
All vehicles
22. Remove the remaining auxiliary evaporator inlet and outlet line pieces.
Installation
Expedition or Navigator only
1. Install the rear portion of the auxiliary evaporator line(s) and connect the auxiliary evaporator
outlet and inlet line rear fittings.
- Install new O-ring seals.
Expedition EL or Navigator L only
2. Install the rear portion of the auxiliary evaporator outlet and inlet line.
3. Connect the auxiliary evaporator outlet and inlet line rear fitting and install the nut.
- Install new gasket seals.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 1575
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
All vehicles
4. Install the front portion of the auxiliary evaporator outlet and inlet line(s).
5. Connect the evaporator outlet and inlet line front fitting(s) and install the nut(s).
- Install new O-ring seals and gasket seals.
- Tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
Expedition EL or Navigator L only
6. NOTE: Loosely connect, but do not tighten, the fittings.
Install the center section(s) of the auxiliary evaporator line(s) by manipulating the line(s) toward the
front of the vehicle through RH rear wheel well opening between the body and the frame.
Expedition or Navigator only
7. NOTE: Loosely connect, but do not tighten, the fittings.
Install the center section(s) of the auxiliary evaporator line(s) by manipulating the line(s) toward the
rear of the vehicle through the opening between the RH catalytic converter and frame.
All vehicles
8. Starting from the rear of the vehicle, install the first 3 auxiliary line brackets and nuts.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
9. NOTE: Expedition/Navigator shown, Expedition EL or Navigator L similar.
Tighten the middle auxiliary evaporator line fittings.
10. Inspect the auxiliary evaporator lines for correct installation. Loosen, reposition and tighten as
needed.
11. Install the RH catalytic converter heat shield and the 3 rear catalytic converter heat shield bolts.
12. Install the exhaust hanger and the 2 exhaust hanger bolts.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 1576
13. Install the muffler heat shield and the 3 muffler heat shield bolts.
14. Install the RH CMS.
15. Install the muffler.
16. Working through the RH fender well opening, Install the RH catalytic converter heat shield front
bolt.
17. Install the front auxiliary line bracket and the front auxiliary line bracket nut.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
18. Install the spare tire carrier splash shield and the 3 spare tire carrier splash shield bolts.
19. Install the RH front fender splash shield.
20. Install the RH front wheel.
Expedition EL or Navigator L only
21. Install the RH rear wheel and tire assembly.
All vehicles
22. Install the spare tire.
23. Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
24. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 1577
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Compressor To Condenser Discharge Line
Compressor to Condenser Discharge Line
Removal and Installation
1. Recover the refrigerant.
2. Remove the compressor discharge fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal and gasket seal.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
3. Remove the condenser inlet jumper line fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal and gasket seal.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
4. Remove the compressor-to-condenser discharge line.
5. If removing the condenser inlet jumper line, remove the RH headlamp assembly.
6. If removing the condenser inlet jumper line, disconnect the A/C pressure transducer electrical
connector.
7. If removing the condenser inlet jumper line, remove the condenser inlet fitting bolt and
disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring and gasket seals.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 1578
8. Remove the condenser inlet jumper line.
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new gasket seals and O-ring seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 1579
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Thermostatic Expansion Valve Manifold and Tube Assembly
Thermostatic Expansion Valve Manifold and Tube Assembly
Removal and Installation
1. Recover the refrigerant.
2. Remove the RH headlamp assembly.
3. Remove the condenser outlet fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal and gasket seal.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
4. Disconnect the 3 PCM electrical connectors.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 1580
5. Disconnect the 2 wire harness electrical connectors at the RH inner fender splash shield.
6. Remove the Thermostatic Expansion Valve (TXV) manifold and tube assembly bracket bolt.
7. Remove the TXV manifold and tube suction fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal and gasket seal.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
8. Remove the auxiliary evaporator inlet line fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal and gasket seal.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
9. Remove the auxiliary evaporator outlet line fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal and gasket seal.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
10. Remove the TXV fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the gasket seals.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
11. Remove the TXV manifold and tube assembly.
12. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new gasket seals and O-ring seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
13. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 1581
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Auxiliary Heater Outlet and Inlet Line
Auxiliary Heater Outlet and Inlet Line
Removal
NOTE: The auxiliary heater inlet and outlet lines are not supplied together as an assembly. The
auxiliary heater inlet line and outlet line are each installed from the factory as one-piece
assemblies. The replacement parts are supplied as separate kits containing multiple-piece lines for
ease of installation.
NOTE: The following procedure can be used to remove and install one or both the auxiliary heater
inlet and auxiliary heater outlet lines. If only one auxiliary heater line is to be removed and installed,
cut or disconnect only the desired line at the specified points within the procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 1582
All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Drain the engine coolant.
3. Remove the spare tire.
4. Remove the RH front wheel and tire.
5. Remove the RH fender splash shield.
6. NOTE: If only one auxiliary heater line is to be removed, disconnect only the desired line.
Disconnect the auxiliary heater outlet and/or inlet line front quick disconnect fitting(s).
7. Working through the RH fender well opening, remove the front auxiliary line bracket nut and the
front auxiliary line bracket.
8. Working through the RH fender well opening, remove the RH catalytic converter heat shield front
bolt.
Expedition EL or Navigator L only
9. Remove the RH rear wheel and tire assembly.
All vehicles
10. NOTE: If only one auxiliary heater line is to be removed, disconnect only the desired line.
Disconnect the auxiliary heater outlet and inlet line rear quick disconnect fitting(s) from the heater
core at the floor pan connection.
11. Remove the muffler.
12. Remove the 3 spare tire carrier splash shield bolts and the spare tire carrier splash shield.
13. Remove the 3 muffler heat shield bolts and the muffler heat shield.
14. Remove the 2 exhaust hanger bolts and the exhaust hanger.
15. Remove the RH Catalyst Monitor Sensor (CMS).
16. Remove the 3 remaining RH catalytic converter heat shield bolts and the heat shield.
17. Remove the 3 remaining auxiliary line bracket nuts and the line brackets.
18. NOTE: If installing only one auxiliary heater line, cut only the desired line.
Assemble and lay out the replacement line(s) in the same position as the existing line(s) and, using
a suitable tool, cut the auxiliary heater line(s) in the same position as the fittings on the new line(s).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 1583
Expedition EL or Navigator L only
19. Remove the center section(s) of the auxiliary heater line(s) through the RH rear wheel well
opening between the body and the frame.
Expedition or Navigator only
20. Remove the center section(s) of the auxiliary heater line(s) by manipulating the line(s) toward
the front of the vehicle between the RH catalytic
converter and frame.
All vehicles
21. Remove the remaining auxiliary heater inlet and outlet line pieces.
Installation
All vehicles
1. Install the rear portion of the auxiliary heater outlet and inlet line(s) and connect the quick
disconnect fittings.
2. Install the front auxiliary heater line(s) and connect the quick disconnect fittings.
Expedition EL or Navigator L only
3. NOTE: Loosely connect, but do not tighten, the fittings.
Install the center section(s) of the auxiliary heater line(s) by manipulating the line(s) toward the
front of the vehicle through RH rear wheel well opening between the body and the frame.
Expedition or Navigator only
4. NOTE: Loosely connect, but do not tighten, the fittings.
Install the center section(s) of the auxiliary heater line(s) by manipulating the line(s) toward the rear
of the vehicle through the opening between the RH catalytic converter and frame.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 1584
All vehicles
5. Starting from the rear of the vehicle, install the first 3 auxiliary line brackets and nuts.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
6. Tighten the middle auxiliary heater line fittings.
7. Inspect the auxiliary heater lines for correct installation. Loosen, reposition and tighten as
needed.
8. Install the RH catalytic converter heat shield and the 3 catalytic converter heat shield rear bolts.
9. Install the RH CMS.
10. Install the exhaust hanger and the 2 exhaust hanger bolts.
11. Install the muffler heat shield and the 3 muffler heat shield bolts.
12. Install the muffler.
13. Install the spare tire carrier splash shield and the 3 spare tire carrier splash shield bolts.
14. Working through the RH fender well opening, Install the RH catalytic converter heat shield front
bolt.
15. Install the front auxiliary line bracket and the front auxiliary line bracket and nut.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
16. Install the RH front fender splash shield.
17. Install the RH front wheel and tire.
Expedition EL or Navigator L only
18. Install the RH rear wheel and tire.
All vehicles
19. Install the spare tire.
20. Fill the engine cooling system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear To Fluid Cooler Return Hose
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Steering Gear To Fluid Cooler Return Hose
Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose
Removal and Installation
NOTICE: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
foreign material or failure of the power steering components may result.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the upper air deflector.
1. Remove the 10 upper air deflector pin-type retainers.
2. Remove the air deflector.
3. Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe.
4. Release the clamp and disconnect the power steering gear-to-fluid cooler return hose from the
power steering fluid cooler.
5. Release the lower cooling fan shroud tab and rotate the shroud upward.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear To Fluid Cooler Return Hose > Page 1589
6. Remove the 2 bolts and the oil drip shield.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
7. Remove the power steering line clamp plate bolt, rotate the clamp plate and disconnect the
power steering gear-to-fluid cooler return hose.
- To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 lb-ft).
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
9. Fill the power steering system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear To Fluid Cooler Return Hose > Page 1590
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Power Steering Pump To Steering Gear Pressure
Line
Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure Line
Removal and Installation
NOTICE: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
foreign material or failure of the power steering components may result.
1. Remove the power steering pump pulley. For additional information, refer to Power Steering
Pump Pulley See: Steering and
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear To Fluid Cooler Return Hose > Page 1591
Suspension/Steering/Power Steering/Power Steering Pump/Service and Repair/Power Steering
Pump Pulley.
2. Remove the 2 bolts and the oil drip shield.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
3. Disconnect the power steering pressure line-to-power steering pump fitting.
- To install, tighten to 65 Nm (48 lb-ft).
4. Disconnect the Power Steering Pressure (PSP) switch electrical connector.
5. Remove the power steering pressure line bracket-to-crossmember bolt.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
6. Remove the power steering pressure line bracket-to-engine nut.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
7. Remove the power steering line clamp plate bolt, rotate the clamp plate and disconnect the
power steering pressure line.
- To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 lb-ft).
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
9. Fill the power steering system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Specifications
Brake Fluid: Specifications
BRAKE FLUID
Motorcraft High Performance DOT 3 Motor Vehicle Brake Fluid
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
.................................................................. PM-1-C Ford Specification
...................................................................................................................................................
WSS-M6C62-A or WSS-M6C65-A1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Coolant: Capacity Specifications
Engine Coolant
BASE RADIATOR
Without aux rear heat ..........................................................................................................................
........................................ 16.4 quarts (15.5 liters) With aux rear heat ................................................
....................................................................................................................... 19.0 quarts (18.0 liters)
HEAVY DUTY TRAILER TOW RADIATOR
Without aux rear heat ..........................................................................................................................
........................................ 16.9 quarts (16.0 liters) With aux rear heat ................................................
....................................................................................................................... 19.5 quarts (18.5 liters)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1600
Coolant: Fluid Type Specifications
ENGINE COOLANT
Motorcraft Premium Gold Engine Coolant (yellow-colored)
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
.................................................................. VC-7-B Ford Specification ................................................
................................................................................................................................ WSS-M97B51-A1
Add the coolant type originally equipped in your vehicle.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
Automatic Transmission Fluid (6R80)
.............................................................................................................................................. 11.0
quarts (10.5 liters)
NOTE: Indicates only approximate dry fill capacity. Some applications may vary based on cooler
size and if equipped with an in-tank cooler.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1605
Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID
Motorcraft MERCON LV ATF
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
............................................................... XT-10-QLV Ford Specification .............................................
..............................................................................................................................................
MERCON LV
Automatic transmissions that require MERCON LV should only use MERCON LV fluid. Refer to
scheduled maintenance information to determine the correct service interval. Use of any fluid other
than the recommended fluid may cause transmission damage.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid Drain And Refill
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair Transmission Fluid Drain And Refill
6R80
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill
Drain
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. NOTE: Some transmission fluid leakage may occur when removing the transmission fluid fill
plug.
Remove the transmission fluid fill plug fluid level indicator assembly located on the passenger side
front portion of the transmission case. Removal of the transmission fluid fill plug will relieve any
vacuum that might have built up in the transmission. This will aid in allowing the transmission fluid
pan to be easily removed when the bolts are removed.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid Drain And Refill > Page 1608
3. Remove the transmission fluid pan and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
4. NOTE: The transmission fluid pan gasket can be reused if not damaged.
Install a new transmission fluid pan gasket, if required.
5. Install the transmission fluid pan and tighten the bolts in a crisscross pattern.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
Transmission Fluid Refill
NOTICE: This procedure contains the air purge steps required to purge air from the transmission
fluid cooling system. This procedure is NOT intended for use with the Transmission Fluid Level
Check.
NOTICE: The vehicle should not be driven if the transmission fluid level is low as internal failure
could result.
NOTICE: The transmission fluid fill plug is located near the exhaust system. The exhaust will be
extremely hot during this procedure.
NOTICE: The use of any other transmission fluid than specified, can result in the transmission
failing to operate in a normal manner or transmission failure.
NOTE: If the transmission starts to slip, shifts slowly or shows signs of transmission fluid leaking,
the transmission fluid level should be checked.
NOTE: Here is an overview of the Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill procedure.
- Adding 3.3L (3.5 qt) of transmission fluid to the transmission is an initial fill enabling you to start
the engine.
- The cold level range shown in the procedure allows the vehicle to be driven.
- The vehicle should be driven to allow the transmission fluid temperature to reach 85°C-88°C
(185°F-190°F) in order to purge the air from the transmission fluid cooling system.
- Fill the transmission fluid to the fill range on the transmission fluid level indicator at the normal
operating range 80°C-85°C (175°F-185°F).
1. NOTE: The transmission will need 3.3L (3.5 qt) of transmission fluid added to the transmission
as an initial fill if:
- the transmission has been overhauled.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid Drain And Refill > Page 1609
- a new mechatronic assembly has been installed.
- the transmission fluid pan or transmission fluid filter have been removed.
Using the Transmission Fluid Fill Tube, add 3.3L (3.5 qt) of transmission fluid to the transmission
through the transmission fluid fill hole. For additional information, refer to Adding Additional
Transmission Fluid in this procedure.
2. Check the transmission fluid level cold.
- The vehicle is safe to drive if the transmission fluid is in the cold level range 32°C-43°C
(90°F-110°F).
- Using the scan tool and with the engine running, place the selector lever in each gear position
and hold approximately 5 seconds. Place the selector lever in PARK, with the engine at idle
(600-750 rpm).
3. Separate the transmission fluid level indicator from the transmission fluid fill plug.
4. Wipe the transmission fluid level indicator clean. Reinstall the transmission fluid level indicator
only back into the transmission fluid fill plug hole
to check the transmission fluid level. Repeat this until a consistent reading is established.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid Drain And Refill > Page 1610
ERROR: stackunderflow
OFFENDING COMMAND: ~
STACK:
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid Drain And Refill > Page 1611
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair Transmission Fluid Exchange
6R80
Transmission Fluid Exchange
NOTICE: Use transmission fluid specific for this transmission. Do not use any supplemental
transmission fluid additives or cleaning agents. The use of these products can cause internal
transmission components to fail, which will affect the operation of the transmission.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Use the Heavy-Duty Transmission and Power Steering Fluid X-Changer to change the fluid.
3. Connect the Heavy-Duty Transmission and Power Steering Fluid X-Changer to the transmission
fluid cooler tube after the transmission fluid
cooler on the return tube. This will help remove any foreign material trapped in the transmission
fluid coolers.
4. Perform the transmission fluid exchange using the Heavy-Duty Transmission and Power
Steering Fluid X-Changer. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions included with the machine.
5. Once the transmission fluid exchange is completed, disconnect the Heavy-Duty Transmission
and Power Steering Fluid X-Changer. Reconnect any
disconnected transmission fluid cooler tubes.
6. Using the scan tool with the engine running, check and make sure that the transmission is at
normal operating temperature 66-77°C (150-170°F).
Check and adjust the transmission fluid level and check for any leaks. If transmission fluid is
needed, add transmission fluid in increments of 0.24L (0.5 pt) until the correct level is achieved.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid Drain And Refill > Page 1612
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair Transmission Fluid Level Check
6R80
Transmission Fluid Level Check
NOTICE: The vehicle should not be driven if the transmission fluid level is low as internal failure
could result.
NOTICE: The transmission fluid fill plug is located near the exhaust system. The exhaust will be
extremely hot during this procedure.
NOTE: If the vehicle has been operated for an extended period at high highway speeds, in city
traffic, during hot weather or while pulling a trailer, the transmission fluid must cool down to obtain
an accurate reading.
NOTE: If the transmission starts to slip, shifts slowly or shows signs of transmission fluid leaking,
the transmission fluid level should be checked.
NOTE: Do not overfill the transmission. The transmission fluid level must be at the upper level of
the crosshatch mark.
NOTE: If the installation of a new transmission fluid cooler or transmission fluid cooler tubes has
been carried out, the vehicle must be driven to get the transmission fluid to a temperature of 88°C
(190°F) in order to purge the air from the transmission fluid cooling system.
1. With the engine running, place the transmission selector lever in each gear position and hold
approximately 5 seconds. Place the transmission
selector lever in PARK.
2. With the engine idling (600-750 rpm) in PARK, position it on a hoist.
3. Remove the transmission fluid fill plug transmission fluid level indicator assembly, located on the
passenger side front portion of the transmission
case.
4. Separate the transmission fluid level indicator from the transmission fluid fill plug.
5. Wipe the transmission fluid level indicator clean. Reinstall the transmission fluid level indicator
only back into the transmission fluid fill plug hole
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid Drain And Refill > Page 1613
to check the transmission fluid level.
6. Using the scan tool, verify that the Transmission Fluid Temperature (TFT) is between 80°C-85°C
(175°F-185°F). Do not overfill the transmission.
The transmission fluid level must be at the upper level of the crosshatch mark.
7. NOTE: If the transmission fluid is not at the correct level, follow the steps for Adding Additional
Transmission Fluid or Removing Transmission
Fluid. For additional information, refer to Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill See: Transmission
and Drivetrain/Automatic Transmission/Transaxle/Service and Repair/Procedures/Transmission
Fluid Drain And Refill.
Install the transmission fluid fill plug. Tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Differential > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Fluid - Differential: Capacity Specifications
Differential Oil Capacity
Conventional Differential .....................................................................................................................
..................................................... 4.5 Pints ( 2.13 L ) Limited Slip Differential ...................................
...................................................................................................................................... 4.25 Pints (
2.01 L )
NOTE: Add 4 oz. (118 ml) of Additive Friction Modifier XL-3 (or equivalent) for complete refill of
Ford Limited Slip axles
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Differential > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1618
Fluid - Differential: Fluid Type Specifications
Differential Fluid Type
Ford Part Name ..................................................................................................................................
Motorcraft SAE 75W-140 Synthetic Rear Axle Lube Ford Part Number .............................................
..........................................................................................................................................
XY-75W140-QL Ford Part Specification ..............................................................................................
................................................................................. WSL-M2C192-A
NOTE: Your vehicles rear axle is filled with a synthetic rear axle lubricant and is considered
lubricated for life. These lubricants are not to be checked or changed unless a leak is suspected,
service is required or the axle has been submerged in water. The axle lubricant should be changed
any time the axle has been submerged in water.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil
With Filter ............................................................................................................................................
............................................................. 6.6L (7.0 Qt)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1623
Engine Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Engine Oil
U.S.A. ...................................................................................................................................
Motorcraft SAE 5W-20 Premium Synthetic Blend Motor Oil Canada
..................................................................................................................................................
Motorcraft SAE 5W-20 Super Premium Motor Oil
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
........................................... XO-5W20-QSP (U.S.A) Ford P/N ............................................................
...................................................................................................................... CXO-5W20-LSP12
(Canada) Ford Specification
.........................................................................................................................................
WSS-M2C930-A with API Certification Mark
NOTE: Use of synthetic or synthetic blend motor oil is not mandatory. Engine oil need only meet
the requirements of Ford specification WSS-M2C930-A and the API Certification mark.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Specifications
Power Steering Fluid: Specifications
Power Steering Fluid Type
Ford Part Name ...................................................................................................................................
................................ Motorcraft MERCON V ATF Ford Part Number .................................................
............................................................................................................................................. XT-5-QM
Ford Specification ................................................................................................................................
......................................................... MERCON V
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Refrigerant: Capacity Specifications
Item..............................................................................................................................R-134a
Refrigerant YN-19 (US); CYN-16-P or CYN-16-R (Canada) Specification...........................................
......................................................................................................................................................WS
H-M17B19-A Fill Capacity....................................................................................................................
...................................................................0.94 kg (33 oz) (2.07 lb)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1631
Refrigerant: Fluid Type Specifications
Item..............................................................................................................................R-134a
Refrigerant YN-19 (US); CYN-16-P or CYN-16-R (Canada) Specification...........................................
......................................................................................................................................................WS
H-M17B19-A Fill Capacity....................................................................................................................
...................................................................0.94 kg (33 oz) (2.07 lb)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1632
Refrigerant: Testing and Inspection
Refrigerant Identification Testing
Refrigerant Identification
1. NOTE: A Refrigerant Blend Identifier with Printer must be used to identify gas samples taken
directly from the refrigeration system or storage
containers prior to recovering or charging the refrigerant system.
Follow the instructions included with the Refrigerant Blend Identifier with Printer to obtain the
sample for testing.
2. The Refrigerant Blend Identifier with Printer will display one of the following:
- If the purity level of R-134a is 98% or greater by weight, the green PASS LED will light. The
weight concentrations of R-134a, R-12, R-22, hydrocarbons and air will be displayed on the digital
display.
- If refrigerant R-134a does not meet the 98% purity level, the red FAIL LED will light and an alarm
will sound alerting the user of potential hazards. The weight concentrations of R-134a, R-12, R-22
and hydrocarbons will be displayed on the digital display.
- If hydrocarbon concentrations are 2% or greater by weight, the red FAIL LED will light,
"Hydrocarbon High" will be displayed on the digital display, and an alarm will sound alerting the
user of potential hazards. The weight concentrations of R-134a, R-12, R-22 and hydrocarbons will
also be displayed on the digital display.
3. The percentage of air contained in the sample will be displayed if the R-134a content is 98% or
greater. The Refrigerant Blend Identifier with
Printer eliminates the effect of air when determining the refrigerant sample content because air is
not considered a contaminant, although air can affect A/C system performance. When the
Refrigerant Blend Identifier with Printer has determined that a refrigerant source is pure (R-134a is
98% or greater by weight) and air concentration levels are 2% or greater by weight, the scan tool
will prompt the user if an air purge is desired.
4. If contaminated refrigerant is detected, repeat the refrigerant identification test to verify that the
refrigerant is indeed contaminated.
Contaminated Refrigerant Handling
NOTICE: If contaminated refrigerant is detected, DO NOT recover the refrigerant into R-134a
recovery/recycling equipment. Recovery of contaminated refrigerant will contaminate the recovered
refrigerant supply and may damage the recovery/recycling equipment.
NOTE: A new suction accumulator or receiver/drier must be installed as directed by the A/C system
flushing procedure.
1. Recover the contaminated refrigerant using suitable recovery-only equipment designed for
capturing and storing contaminated refrigerant only.
- If this equipment is not available, contact an A/C service facility in the area with the correct
equipment to carry out this service.
2. Determine and correct the cause of the customers initial concern.
3. Flush the A/C system.
4. Dispose of the contaminated refrigerant in accordance with all federal, state and local
regulations.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air
Conditioning (A/C) System Recovery, Evacuation and Charging
Refrigerant: Service and Repair Air Conditioning (A/C) System Recovery, Evacuation and Charging
Air Conditioning (A/C) System Recovery, Evacuation and Charging
Refrigerant System Recovery
NOTICE: An Air Conditioning (A/C) refrigerant analyzer must be used before the recovery of any
vehicle's A/C refrigerant. Failure to do so puts the shop's bulk refrigerant at risk of contamination. If
the vehicle's A/C refrigerant is contaminated, refer the customer to the service
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air
Conditioning (A/C) System Recovery, Evacuation and Charging > Page 1635
facility that carried out the last A/C service. If the customer wishes to pay the additional cost, use
the A/C recovery equipment that is designated for recovering contaminated A/C refrigerant. All
contaminated A/C refrigerant must be disposed of as hazardous waste. For all equipment, follow
the equipment manufacturer procedures and instructions.
NOTE: Ford Motor Company recommends the use of R-134a refrigerant management equipment
that meets the requirements of the SAE J2788 standard.
NOTE: Ford Motor Company recommends use of a R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine to
carry out recovery. If a R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine is not available, refrigerant
system recovery may be accomplished using a separate recovery station.
NOTE: Leaks in refrigerant system service equipment, hoses or gauges can cause a leak in
vacuum that may be misinterpreted as a problem with the vehicle's refrigerant system. It is
necessary to leak-test all refrigerant system service equipment, hoses and gauges on a weekly
basis to verify that no leaks are present.
1. Prior to recovering, the purity of the refrigerant must be verified. For additional information, refer
to Refrigerant Identification Testing See:
Heating and Air Conditioning/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics/Refrigerant Identification Testing.
2. Connect a R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine to the low- and high-pressure service
gauge port valves following the operating instructions
provided by the equipment manufacturer.
3. Recover the refrigerant from the system following the operating instructions provided by the
equipment manufacturer. Note the amount of oil
removed during the refrigerant recovery (if any). Add that same amount back into the system once
repairs are complete.
4. Once the R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine has recovered the refrigerant, switch OFF
the power supply.
5. Allow the system to set for about 2 minutes, and observe the system vacuum reading. If the
vacuum is not lost, disconnect the recovery equipment.
6. If the system does lose vacuum, repeat Steps 3 through 5 until the vacuum level remains stable
for 2 minutes.
7. Carry out the required repairs.
Refrigerant System Evacuation Using a R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine
NOTE: Ford Motor Company recommends use of a R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine to
carry out recovery, evacuation and charging of the refrigerant system. If a R-134a Refrigerant
Management Machine is not available, evacuation may be accomplished using a separate Vacuum
Pump and R-134a Manifold Gauge Set.
NOTE: Leaks in refrigerant system service equipment, hoses or gauges can cause a leak in
vacuum that may be misinterpreted as a problem with the vehicle's refrigerant system. It is
necessary to leak-test all refrigerant system service equipment, hoses and gauges on a weekly
basis to verify that no leaks are present.
1. Connect a R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine to the low- and high-pressure service
gauge port valves following the operating instructions
provided by the equipment manufacturer.
2. Evacuate the system until the low-pressure gauge reads at least 99.4 kPa (29.5 in-Hg) of
vacuum and as close to 101.1 kPa (30 in-Hg) as possible.
Continue to operate the Vacuum Pump for a minimum of 45 minutes.
3. Turn OFF the Vacuum Pump. Observe the low-pressure gauge for 5 minutes to make sure that
the system vacuum is held. If vacuum is not held for
5 minutes, leak test the system, repair the leak and evacuate the system again.
Refrigerant System Evacuation Using a R-134a Manifold Gauge Set and Vacuum Pump
NOTE: Ford Motor Company recommends use of a R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine to
carry out evacuation of the refrigerant system. If a R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine is not
available, refrigerant system evacuation may be accomplished using a separate Vacuum Pump
and R-134a Manifold Gauge Set.
NOTE: Leaks in refrigerant system service equipment, hoses or gauges can cause a leak in
vacuum that may be misinterpreted as a problem with the vehicle's refrigerant system. It is
necessary to leak-test all refrigerant system service equipment, hoses and gauges on a weekly
basis to verify that no leaks are present.
1. Connect the R-134a Manifold Gauge Set to the low-side and high-side service gauge port
valves.
2. Connect the center (yellow) hose from the R-134a Manifold Gauge Set to the suction port on the
Vacuum Pump.
3. Open all valves on the R-134a Manifold Gauge Set and both service gauge port valves.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air
Conditioning (A/C) System Recovery, Evacuation and Charging > Page 1636
4. Turn on the Vacuum Pump and evacuate the system until the low-pressure gauge reads at least
99.4 kPa (29.5 in-Hg) of vacuum and as close to
101.1 kPa (30 in-Hg) as possible. Continue to operate the Vacuum Pump for a minimum of 45
minutes.
5. Close the high-side and low-side valves on the R-134a Manifold Gauge Set (not the service
gauge port valves) and turn OFF the Vacuum Pump.
6. Observe the low-pressure gauge for 5 minutes to make sure that the system vacuum is held. If
vacuum is not held for 5 minutes, leak test the
system, repair the leak and evacuate the system again.
Refrigerant System Charging Using a R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine
NOTE: Ford Motor Company recommends use of a R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine to
carry out charging of the refrigerant system. If a R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine is not
available, refrigerant system charging may be accomplished using a separate Automatic
Refrigerant Charging Meter and R-134a Manifold Gauge Set.
NOTE: Leaks in refrigerant system service equipment, hoses or gauges can cause a leak that may
be misinterpreted as a problem with the vehicle's refrigerant system. It is necessary to leak-test all
refrigerant system service equipment, hoses and gauges on a weekly basis to verify that no leaks
are present.
1. Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil. For additional
information, refer to Refrigerant Oil Adding See:
Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Adding.
2. Connect a R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine to the low-side and high-side service
gauge port valves following the operating instructions
provided by the equipment manufacturer.
3. Set the refrigerant charge amount, and charge the refrigerant system following the instructions
provided by the equipment manufacturer.
Refrigerant System Charging Using a R-134a Manifold Gauge Set and Automatic Refrigerant
Charging Meter
NOTE: Ford Motor Company recommends use of a R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine to
carry out charging of the refrigerant system. If a R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine is not
available, refrigerant system charging may be accomplished using a separate Automatic
Refrigerant Charging Meter and R-134a Manifold Gauge Set.
NOTE: Leaks in refrigerant system service equipment, hoses or gauges can cause a leak that may
be misinterpreted as a problem with the vehicle's refrigerant system. It is necessary to leak-test all
refrigerant system service equipment, hoses and gauges on a weekly basis to verify that no leaks
are present.
1. Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil. For additional
information, refer to Refrigerant Oil Adding See:
Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Adding.
2. Assemble the R-134a Manifold Gauge Set, Automatic Refrigerant Charging Meter and R-134a
supply tank following the Automatic Refrigerant
Charging Meter operating instructions.
3. Charge the refrigerant system following the Automatic Refrigerant Charging Meter operating
instructions.
4. If the refrigerant flow stops before the refrigerant charge is complete, start the engine, select
MAX A/C operation and allow the refrigerant charge
to complete.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air
Conditioning (A/C) System Recovery, Evacuation and Charging > Page 1637
Refrigerant: Service and Repair Refrigerant System Filtering Following Air Conditioning (A/C)
Compressor Installation
Refrigerant System Filtering Following Air Conditioning (A/C) Compressor Installation
NOTICE: On vehicles being serviced for an internal compressor or desiccant failure, a new
Thermostatic Expansion Valve (TXV), auxiliary system TXV (if equipped) and any hoses containing
mufflers must be installed prior to filtering the Air Conditioning (A/C) system. Internal plumbing of
these devices makes it impossible to correctly remove any foreign material/debris. These
components are typically discarded after A/C system contamination. Hoses without mufflers can
normally be reused unless they are clogged with foreign material. The F8VZ-19E773-AB filter is
intended for use on one vehicle only.
1. Remove the condenser core.
2. Remove the plastic receiver/drier cap.
3. Remove the receiver/drier plug.
1. Push the receiver/drier plug upwards and remove the snap ring.
2. Install an M5 bolt in the center of the receiver/drier plug and remove the plug.
4. Using a suitable tool, grasp the receiver/drier cartridge grab handle and remove the
receiver/drier cartridge.
5. NOTE: Do not install a new receiver/drier cartridge at this time.
With the receiver/drier cartridge removed, reinstall the receiver/drier plug and snap ring into the
condenser core.
6. NOTE: Do not evacuate or charge the refrigerant system at this time.
NOTE: The RH headlamp assembly must remain removed for access to the condenser outlet
fitting.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air
Conditioning (A/C) System Recovery, Evacuation and Charging > Page 1638
Install the condenser core back into the vehicle and completely reassemble the vehicle except for
the condenser outlet fitting and RH headlamp assembly.
7. NOTICE: The flexible extension adapters included in the A/C Flush Adapter Kit (219-00074) are
designed for low-pressure flushing and
are not designed for use with a charged refrigerant system. Do not make the condenser fitting
connections using the flexible extension adapters or damage to the adapters and loss of refrigerant
will occur.
NOTE: Use flexible refrigerant hose of 17,238 kPa (2,500 psi) burst rating.
Using the correct adapters and service hoses, install the pancake filter between the condenser
outlet and the condenser outlet fitting.
8. Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil. For additional
information, refer to Refrigerant Oil Adding See:
Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Adding.
9. Evacuate and charge the refrigerant system. For additional information, refer to Air Conditioning
(A/C) System Recovery, Evacuation and
Charging See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Air Conditioning (A/C) System
Recovery, Evacuation and Charging.
10. Provide adequate airflow to the front of the vehicle (with a fan, if necessary). Start the engine
and allow it to idle briefly. Select A/C operation and
set the blower speed to HI. Verify that the A/C is operating correctly.
11. If the vehicle is equipped with auxiliary A/C, set the auxiliary system to full COOL at HI blower
speed. Verify that the auxiliary A/C is operating
correctly.
12. Gradually bring the engine up to 1,200 rpm by running it at lower rpms for short periods (first at
800 rpm, then at 1,000 rpm). Set the engine at
1,200 rpm and run it for one hour with the A/C system operating.
13. Stop the engine.
14. Recover the refrigerant. For additional information, refer to Air Conditioning (A/C) System
Recovery, Evacuation and Charging See: Heating and
Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Air Conditioning (A/C) System Recovery, Evacuation and
Charging.
15. Remove the pancake filter, hoses and adapter from the vehicle.
16. Remove the condenser core.
17. Remove and discard the receiver/drier plug snap ring and the receiver/drier plug.
18. Install a new receiver/drier cartridge.
19. NOTE: The vehicle should be fully assembled at the completion of this step.
Install the condenser core.
20. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system. For additional information refer to Air
Conditioning (A/C) System Recovery, Evacuation and
Charging See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Air Conditioning (A/C) System
Recovery, Evacuation and Charging.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Refrigerant Oil: Capacity Specifications
Item.........................................................................................................................................PAG
Refrigerant Compressor Oil (R-134a Systems) YN-12-D Specification...............................................
..................................................................................................................................................WSHM1C231-B Fill Capacity........................................................................................................................
......................................207 ml (7 fl oz) See: Service and Repair
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1643
Refrigerant Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Item.........................................................................................................................................PAG
Refrigerant Compressor Oil (R-134a Systems) YN-12-D Specification...............................................
..................................................................................................................................................WSHM1C231-B Fill Capacity........................................................................................................................
......................................207 ml (7 fl oz) See: Service and Repair
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1644
Refrigerant Oil: Service and Repair
Refrigerant Oil Adding
Refrigerant Oil Adding
NOTICE: During normal Air Conditioning (A/C) operation, oil is circulated through the system with
the refrigerant, and a small amount is retained in each component. If certain components of the
system are removed, some of the refrigerant oil will go with the component. To maintain the original
total oil charge, it is necessary to compensate for the oil lost by adding oil to the system with the
new part.
1. Refer to the chart below for refrigerant oil adding amounts and methods of installation.
a If an excessive amount of refrigerant oil is lost due to a hose rupture/separation or other damage,
the total system refrigerant oil capacity must be
added.
b The amount specified may be used for one or multiple O-ring leak repairs. Do not multiply the
refrigerant oil amount by the number of O-ring leaks
being repaired.
Refrigerant Oil Adding for New A/C Compressor Without Clutch Installation
NOTE: Service A/C compressors are shipped without refrigerant oil.
1. Rotate the old A/C compressor shaft 8 to 10 full rotations (clockwise) while collecting the
refrigerant oil in a clean measuring cup.
- Add the same amount plus the amount collected during refrigerant recovery.
Refrigerant Oil Adding for New A/C Compressor With Clutch Installation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1645
1. Rotate the old A/C compressor shaft 6 to 8 revolutions while collecting oil in a clean measuring
device.
- If the amount of oil drained from the old A/C compressor is less than 89 ml (3 oz), remove 118 ml
(4 oz) from the new A/C compressor.
- If the amount of oil drained from the old A/C compressor is 89 ml (3 oz), remove 89 ml (3 oz) from
the new A/C compressor.
- If the amount of oil drained from the old A/C compressor is 118 ml (4 oz), remove 59 ml (2 oz)
from the new A/C compressor.
- If the amount of oil drained from the old A/C compressor is 148 ml (5 oz), remove 29 ml (1 oz)
from the new A/C compressor.
- If the amount of oil drained from the old A/C compressor is greater than 148 ml (5 oz), remove 0
ml (0 oz) from the new A/C compressor.
Oil Injection Using a Dye/Lubricant Injector
NOTE: The dye/lubricant injector is included as part of the 219-00069 R-134a Loop/Add On
Injector Kit-Set.
NOTE: If fluorescent leak detection dye is also to be added during A/C charging, the dye may be
added to the dye/lubricant injector along with the refrigerant oil.
1. Evacuate the refrigerant system. For additional information, refer to Air Conditioning (A/C)
System Recovery, Evacuation and Charging See:
Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Air Conditioning (A/C) System Recovery,
Evacuation and Charging.
2. Assemble the dye/lubricant injector using the correct adapters to match the amount of refrigerant
compressor oil to be injected.
3. Verify that all the valves on the dye/lubricant injector are closed.
4. Fill the dye/lubricant injector with the correct amount of new refrigerant compressor oil.
5. Install the dye/lubricant injector between the low-side service gauge port valve and the
refrigerant service station or manifold gauge set.
6. Open all valves and charge the refrigerant system. For additional information, refer to Air
Conditioning (A/C) System Recovery, Evacuation and
Charging See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Air Conditioning (A/C) System
Recovery, Evacuation and Charging.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Component
Bleeding
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Component Bleeding
Master Cylinder
Component Bleeding
Master Cylinder
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
WARNING: Do not allow the brake master cylinder to run dry during the bleeding operation. Master
cylinder may be damaged if operated without fluid, resulting in degraded braking performance.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid on painted or plastic surfaces or damage to the surface may
occur. If brake fluid is spilled onto a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with
water.
NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder is installed, or the system is emptied or partially
emptied, it should be primed to prevent air from entering the system.
1. Disconnect the brake tubes from the master cylinder.
2. Install short brake tubes with the ends submerged in the brake master cylinder reservoir.
3. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid.
4. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal until clear fluid flows from both brake tubes, without air
bubbles.
5. Remove the short brake tubes and install the brake outlet tubes.
6. Bleed each brake tube at the brake master cylinder as follows:
1. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal at least 2 times and then hold firm pressure on the
brake pedal.
2. Loosen the rearmost brake tube fitting until a stream of brake fluid comes out. While the
assistant maintains pressure on the brake pedal,
tighten the brake tube fitting.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Component
Bleeding > Page 1650
3. Repeat this operation until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
4. Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary. Repeat the bleeding operation at the
front brake tube.
5. Tighten the brake tube fittings to specifications. For additional information, refer to
Specifications.
7. Bleed the brake system, refer to Brake System Bleeding See: Brake System Bleeding.
Brake Caliper
Component Bleeding
Brake Caliper
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
WARNING: Do not allow the brake master cylinder to run dry during the bleeding operation. Master
cylinder may be damaged if operated without fluid, resulting in degraded braking performance.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid on painted or plastic surfaces or damage to the surface may
occur. If brake fluid is spilled onto a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with
water.
1. NOTE: It is not necessary to do a complete brake system bleed if only the brake caliper was
disconnected or installed new.
Remove the bleeder screw cap and place a box-end wrench on the bleeder screw. Attach a rubber
drain hose to the bleeder screw and submerge the free end of the hose in a container partially filled
with clean, specified brake fluid.
2. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal at least 2 times and then hold firm pressure on the
brake pedal.
3. Loosen the bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. While the assistant maintains
pressure on the brake pedal, tighten the bleeder
screw. Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
- Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
4. Remove the rubber hose and tighten the bleeder screw to specifications. For additional
information, refer to Specifications.
- Install the bleeder screw cap.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Component
Bleeding > Page 1651
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Component
Bleeding > Page 1652
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Brake System Bleeding
Brake System Bleeding
Pressure
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
WARNING: Do not allow the brake master cylinder to run dry during the bleeding operation. Master
cylinder may be damaged if operated without fluid, resulting in degraded braking performance.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid on painted or plastic surfaces or damage to the surface may
occur. If brake fluid is spilled onto a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with
water.
NOTE: The Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) bleeding procedure must be carried out if the HCU or any
components upstream of the HCU are installed new.
NOTE: Pressure bleeding the brake system is preferred to manual bleeding.
1. Clean all dirt from and remove the brake master cylinder filler cap and fill the brake master
cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid.
2. NOTE: Master cylinder pressure bleeder adapter tools are available from various manufacturers
of pressure bleeding equipment. Follow the
instructions of the equipment manufacturer when installing the adapter.
Install the bleeder adapter to the brake master cylinder reservoir and attach the bleeder tank hose
to the fitting on the adapter.
3. NOTE: Make sure the bleeder tank contains enough clean, specified brake fluid to complete the
bleeding operation.
Remove the RH rear bleeder cap and place a box-end wrench on the bleeder screw. Attach a
rubber drain tube to the RH rear bleeder screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a
container partially filled with clean, specified brake fluid.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Component
Bleeding > Page 1653
4. Open the valve on the bleeder tank.
- Set pressure to 207-345 kPa (30-50 psi).
5. Loosen the RH rear bleeder screw. Leave open until clear, bubble-free brake fluid flows, then
tighten the RH rear bleeder screw and remove the
rubber hose. Tighten to specifications. For additional information, refer to Specifications.
- Install the bleeder screw cap.
6. Continue bleeding the system, going in order from the LH rear bleeder screw to the RH front
bleeder screw ending with the LH front bleeder
screw.
7. Release the bleeder tank pressure and close the bleeder tank valve. Remove the tank hose from
the adapter and remove the adapter from the brake
fluid reservoir.
Manual
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
WARNING: Do not allow the brake master cylinder to run dry during the bleeding operation. Master
cylinder may be damaged if operated without fluid, resulting in degraded braking performance.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid on painted or plastic surfaces or damage to the surface may
occur. If brake fluid is spilled onto a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with
water.
NOTE: The Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) bleeding procedure must be carried out if the HCU or any
components upstream of the HCU are installed new.
NOTE: Pressure bleeding the brake system is preferred to manual bleeding.
1. Clean all dirt from and remove the brake master cylinder filler cap and fill the brake master
cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid.
2. Remove the bleeder screw cap and place a box-end wrench on the RH rear bleeder screw.
Attach a rubber drain hose to the RH rear bleeder screw
and submerge the free end of the hose in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake
fluid.
3. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal at least 3 times and then hold firm pressure on the
brake pedal.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Component
Bleeding > Page 1654
4. Loosen the RH rear bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. While the assistant
maintains pressure on the brake pedal, tighten the
RH rear bleeder screw. Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
- Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
5. Remove the rubber hose and tighten the bleeder screw to specifications. For additional
information, refer to Specifications.
- Install the bleeder screw cap.
6. Repeat Steps 2 through 5 for the LH rear, RH front and LH front bleeder screws in this order.
Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU)
NOTE: The Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) bleeding procedure must be carried out if the HCU or any
components upstream of the HCU are installed new.
NOTE: Pressure bleeding the brake system is preferred to manual bleeding.
1. Follow the Pressure Bleeding or Manual Bleeding procedure steps to bleed the system.
2. Connect the scan tool and follow the ABS Service Bleed instructions.
3. Repeat the Pressure Bleeding or Manual Bleeding procedure steps to bleed the system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering
Depowering Procedure
WARNING: Always wear eye protection when servicing a vehicle. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on air bag, Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain
modules. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of these
modules, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the
restraints control module (RCM) while the RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON. Failure
to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of the Safety Canopy(R) and
cause serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: To reduce the risk of accidental deployment, do not use any memory saver devices.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF.
2. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
3. At the Smart Junction Box (SJB), located in the RH lower kick panel, remove the cover and the
RCM fuse 32 (10A) from the SJB. For additional
information, refer to the Wiring Diagrams.
4. Turn the ignition switch ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30
seconds. The air bag warning indicator will remain
lit continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
6. WARNING: Always deplete the backup power supply before repairing or installing any new front
or side air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) component and before servicing, removing, installing, adjusting or striking
components near the front or side impact sensors or the restraints control module (RCM). Nearby
components include doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood
latches.
Refer to the Description and Operation portion of Air Bag Systems for location of the RCM and
impact sensor(s).
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
1 minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury or death in the event of an
accidental deployment.
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
Repowering Procedure
1. Make sure that all SRS components are connected.
2. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1659
3. Install RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the SJB and close the cover.
4. WARNING: Make sure no one is in the vehicle and there is nothing blocking or placed in front of
any air bag module when the battery is
connected. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury in the event of
an accidental deployment.
Connect the battery ground cable.
5. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the back to ON and visually monitor
the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag warning indicator will
illuminate continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an SRS fault is present,
the air bag warning indicator will:
- fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The flashing might not occur until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition has been turned from
the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to complete the testing of the
SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault exists, a chime will sound in a
pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning indicator and any SRS fault
discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous DTCs from the RCM using a scan tool.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1660
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Deactivation and Reactivation
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deactivation and Reactivation
Deactivation
WARNING: Always carry or place a live air bag module with the air bag and deployment door/trim
cover/tear seam pointed away from the body. Do not set a live air bag module down with the
deployment door/trim cover/tear seam face down. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on air bag, Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain
modules. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of these
modules, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: To reduce the risk of accidental deployment, do not use any memory saver devices.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF.
2. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
3. At the Smart Junction Box (SJB), located in the RH lower kick panel, remove the cover and the
RCM fuse 32 (10A) from the SJB. For additional
information, refer to the Wiring Diagrams.
4. Turn the ignition switch ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30
seconds. The air bag warning indicator will remain
lit continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: Always deplete the backup power supply before repairing or installing any new front
or side air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) component and before servicing, removing, installing, adjusting or striking
components near the front or side impact sensors or the restraints control module (RCM). Nearby
components include doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood
latches.
Refer to the Description and Operation portion of Air Bag Systems for location of the RCM and
impact sensor(s).
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
1 minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury or death in the event of an
accidental deployment.
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
7. Make sure the road wheels are in the straight-ahead position.
8. Center the tilt steering column to allow for steering column upper and lower shroud removal.
9. NOTICE: Turn the steering wheel such that the top is at 90 degrees (at the 9 o'clock position) to
the left from the straight-ahead position
to access the driver air bag module wire clips and to prevent damage to the steering column
multi-function switch. Failure to follow this instruction may result in component damage.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1661
Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is 90 degrees to the left (at the 9 o'clock position)
as shown.
10. Remove the lower steering column opening cover.
- Remove the 3 screws.
- Pull out to release the top retainers.
- Remove the lower steering column opening cover. If equipped, disconnect the adjustable pedals switch connector.
11. If equipped, remove the screw and steering column manual tilt lever.
12. Remove the 3 steering column lower shroud screws.
13. Release the clips and remove the steering column upper shroud.
14. Remove the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, disconnect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
15. NOTICE: Make sure each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are disengaged from each of
the 3 steering wheel hooks before
removing the driver air bag module from the steering wheel. Failure to follow this instruction may
result in component damage and/or system failure.
NOTE: Steering wheel is removed for clarity. The rear of the steering wheel is shown.
NOTE: Use a mirror to view the rear of the steering wheel to locate where the 3 driver air bag
module wire clips attach to the steering wheel hooks.
Using a screwdriver or a suitable tool, release each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips from
the steering wheel hooks. Access the 3 driver air bag module wire clips through the back of the steering wheel cover and
push the wire clips toward the center of the steering wheel to release.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1662
16. NOTE: Once the driver air bag module is removed, note the position of the 2 driver air bag
module locator pins on the steering wheel for
installation.
Disconnect the driver air bag module and horn switch electrical connectors and remove the driver
air bag module.
17. Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is back in the straight-ahead position (the 12
o'clock position).
18. Open and lower the glove compartment door to allow access to the passenger air bag electrical
connector.
- If equipped, disconnect the glove compartment door dampener.
19. Disconnect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
20. NOTE: There are 2 similar connectors under the passenger seat. The passenger seat side air
bag module electrical connector is located toward the
seat outboard position.
Remove the passenger front seat cushion panel shield and disconnect the passenger seat side air
bag module electrical.
21. Release the RH second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1663
22. Remove the bolt and the RH second row safety belt retractor D-ring.
23. Remove the cover and the RH C-pillar trim panel nut.
24. Release the rear door weatherstrip and remove the RH C-pillar trim panel.
25. Disconnect the RH safety canopy module electrical connector.
26. Release the LH second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
27. Remove the bolt and the LH second row safety belt retractor D-ring.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1664
28. Remove the cover and the LH C-pillar trim panel nut.
29. Release the rear door weatherstrip and remove the driver C-pillar trim panel.
30. Disconnect the LH safety canopy module electrical connector.
31. NOTE: There are 2 similar connectors under the driver seat. The driver seat side air bag
module electrical connector is located toward the seat
outboard position.
Remove the driver front seat cushion panel shield and disconnect the driver seat side air bag
module electrical connector.
32. Install the RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the Smart Junction Box (SJB).
33. Connect the battery ground cable.
Reactivation
1. Remove the RCM fuse 32 (10A) from the SJB.
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
3. Connect the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector and install the driver front seat
cushion panel shield.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1665
4. Connect the LH safety canopy module electrical connector.
5. Install the LH C-pillar trim panel and attach the rear door weatherstrip.
6. Install the LH C-pillar trim panel nut and cover.
7. Install the LH second row safety belt retractor D-ring and bolt.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
8. Attach the LH second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
9. Connect the RH safety canopy module electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1666
10. Install the RH C-pillar trim panel and attach the rear door weatherstrip.
11. Install the passenger C-pillar trim panel nut and cover.
12. Install the RH second row safety belt retractor D-ring and bolt.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
13. Attach the RH second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding. Extract and retract the safety belt between the full extension and stowed positions.
- If excessive effort or binding is present, install a new safety belt buckle retractor and tongue
assembly as necessary. For additional information, refer to Seat Belt Systems.
14. Connect the passenger seat side air bag module electrical connector and install the passenger
front seat cushion panel shield.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1667
15. Connect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
16. Close the glove compartment door.
- If equipped, connect the glove compartment door dampener.
17. NOTICE: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag module. Match
the electrical connector key to the keyway in the driver air bag module. Do not force the electrical
connectors into the driver air bag module. Damage to the connector or component may occur.
Connect the horn switch and 2 driver air bag module electrical connectors.
18. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, lining up the locator pins.
19. NOTE: Make sure that all 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged and seated
correctly to the steering wheel.
NOTE: Audible clicks will be heard when the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged.
Firmly press the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, seating the 3 driver air bag module
wire clips to the steering wheel hooks.
- Check the driver air bag module trim cover to the steering wheel for an even gap clearance and
correct movement.
20. Install the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, connect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
21. Install the steering column upper shroud.
22. Install the 3 steering column lower shroud screws.
23. If equipped, install the steering column manual tilt lever and screw.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
24. If equipped, connect the adjustable pedals switch connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1668
25. Install the lower steering column opening cover and 3 screws.
26. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON.
27. Install the RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the SJB and install the cover.
28. WARNING: Make sure no one is in the vehicle and there is nothing blocking or placed in front
of any air bag module when the battery is
connected. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury in the event of
an accidental deployment.
Connect the battery ground cable.
29. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition switch from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the ignition switch back to ON
and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag
warning indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag
SRS fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will either:
- fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The air bag warning indicator may not illuminate until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition
switch has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator will need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Clear all continuous memory DTCs from the RCM using a scan tool.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 1674
Fuse: Locations Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Passenger Compartment Fuse Box
1 - 24
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 1675
25 - 48
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 1676
Fuse: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 1677
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 1678
Fuse: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 1679
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 1680
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 1683
Fuse: Application and ID Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Passenger Compartment Fuse Box
1 - 24
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 1684
25 - 48
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 1685
Fuse: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 1686
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 1687
Fuse: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 1688
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 1689
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Fuse Block: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 1694
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 1695
Fuse Block: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 1696
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 1697
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 1698
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 1699
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 1700
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuse Block: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagram in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be
seen completely in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference
is given to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in parentheses next to or under a component.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System, and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1703
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in set 4
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the
indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to
illustrate proper orientation.
Power Distribution
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1704
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
Component and Connector Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1705
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component Location
Charts.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Locations information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the
various items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written
description of the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1706
Symbols (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1707
Symbols (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1708
Symbols (Part 3)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1709
Symbols (Part 4)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1710
Symbols (Part 5)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1711
Fuse Block: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminal by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1712
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal.
Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1713
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1714
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1715
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seat wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1716
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1717
7. If visible, be sure to place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the
barrel. 9. Holding the wire in place, barrel squeeze tool handles appropriate ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1718
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1719
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1720
Fuse Block: Connector Views
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1721
C2280A
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1722
C2280B Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1723
C2280B Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1724
C2280C
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1725
C2280D Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1726
C2280D Part 2
C2280E
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1727
C2280F
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1728
C2280G
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 2
Relay Box: Locations Auxiliary Relay Box 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 1733
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 1734
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 1735
Relay Box: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 1736
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 1737
Relay Box: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 1738
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 1739
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 1740
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 1741
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 1742
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams >
Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 1745
Relay Box: Diagrams Smart Junction Box (SJB)
C2280A
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 1746
C2280B Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 1747
C2280B Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 1748
C2280C
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 1749
C2280D Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 1750
C2280D Part 2
C2280E
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 1751
C2280F
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 1752
C2280G
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 1755
Relay Box: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 1756
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 1757
Relay Box: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 1758
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator: Procedures
Message Center Configuration
Oil Life Reset Message Center Cluster
NOTE: The oil life calculation is set at a maximum of approximately 12,000 km (7,500 miles) or 180
days.
NOTE: The XX's in the message center displays below represent a numeric value. For example,
the message center may display OIL LIFE = 80%.
1. Press and release the SETUP button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX%
HOLD RESET = NEW. 2. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the
message center displays OIL LIFE SET TO 100%. 3. Press and release the SETUP button to exit
the procedure. Oil Life Reset Base Instrument Cluster (IC)
NOTE: All message center functions are carried out using the single stem reset button in the
Instrument Cluster (IC).
NOTE: The oil life calculation is set at a maximum of approximately 12,000 km (7,500 miles) or 180
days.
NOTE: The XX's in the message center displays below represent a numeric value. For example,
the message center may display OIL LIFE = 80%.
1. Press and release the reset button to scroll through the information displays until the message
center displays HOLD RESET FOR SETUP MENU. 2. Press and hold the reset button for
approximately 2 seconds until the message center displays HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK.
3. Press and release the reset button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX% HOLD
RESET = NEW. 4. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the
message center displays OIL LIFE SET TO 100%. 5. Press and release the reset button to exit the
procedure. Oil Life Start Value Message Center Cluster
NOTE: The oil life start value is used to increase or decrease the starting point of the oil life. The
value can be changed back to the maximum of approximately 12,000 km (7,500 miles) if the value
was previously changed or lowered by 10% increments down to 10%.
NOTE: The XX's in the message center displays below represent a numeric value. For example,
the message center may display OIL LIFE = 80%.
1. Press and release the SETUP button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX%
HOLD RESET = NEW. 2. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the
message center displays OIL LIFE SET TO 100%. 3. NOTE: The oil life start value can be lowered
from 100% to 10% in 10% increments then the value starts again at 100%. Press the RESET
button once for each 10% reduction below the default 100% until the message center displays OIL
LIFE SET TO XX%. 4. Press and release the SETUP button to exit the procedure. Oil Life Start
Value Base Instrument Cluster (IC)
NOTE: All message center functions are carried out using the single stem reset button in the
Instrument Cluster (IC).
NOTE: The oil life start value is used to increase or decrease the starting point of the oil life. The
value can be changed back to the maximum of approximately 12,000 km (7,500 miles) if the value
was previously changed or lowered by 10% increments down to 10%.
1. Press and release the reset button to scroll through the information displays until the message
center displays HOLD RESET FOR SETUP MENU. 2. Press and hold the reset button for
approximately 2 seconds until the message center displays HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK.
3. Press and release the reset button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX% HOLD
RESET = NEW. 4. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the
message center displays OIL LIFE SET TO 100%. 5. Press the RESET button to lower 10% from
the default 100% until the message center displays OIL LIFE SET TO XX%. 6. NOTE: The oil life
start value can be lowered from 100% to 10% in 10% increments then the value starts again at
100%. Repeat steps 2-5 for each desired 10% reduction. 7. Press and release the reset button to
exit the procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1764
Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator: Reset Procedure
Oil Life Reset - Message Center Cluster
Message Center Configuration
Oil Life Reset - Message Center Cluster
NOTE: The oil life calculation is set at a maximum of approximately 12,000 km (7,500 miles) or 180
days.
NOTE: The XX's in the message center displays below represent a numeric value. For example,
the message center may display OIL LIFE = 80%.
1. Press and release the SETUP button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX%
HOLD RESET = NEW.
2. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the message center displays
OIL LIFE SET TO 100%.
3. Press and release the SETUP button to exit the procedure.
Oil Life Reset - Base Instrument Cluster (IC)
Message Center Configuration
Oil Life Reset - Base Instrument Cluster (IC)
NOTE: All message center functions are carried out using the single stem reset button in the
Instrument Cluster (IC).
NOTE: The oil life calculation is set at a maximum of approximately 12,000 km (7,500 miles) or 180
days.
NOTE: The XX's in the message center displays below represent a numeric value. For example,
the message center may display OIL LIFE = 80%.
1. Press and release the reset button to scroll through the information displays until the message
center displays HOLD RESET FOR SETUP MENU.
2. Press and hold the reset button for approximately 2 seconds until the message center displays
HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK.
3. Press and release the reset button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX% HOLD
RESET = NEW.
4. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the message center displays
OIL LIFE SET TO 100%.
5. Press and release the reset button to exit the procedure.
Oil Life Start Value - Message Center Cluster
Message Center Configuration
Oil Life Start Value - Message Center Cluster
NOTE: The oil life start value is used to increase or decrease the starting point of the oil life. The
value can be changed back to the maximum of approximately 12,000 km (7,500 miles) if the value
was previously changed or lowered by 10% increments down to 10%.
NOTE: The XX's in the message center displays below represent a numeric value. For example,
the message center may display OIL LIFE = 80%.
1. Press and release the SETUP button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX%
HOLD RESET = NEW.
2. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the message center displays
OIL LIFE SET TO 100%.
3. NOTE: The oil life start value can be lowered from 100% to 10% in 10% increments then the
value starts again at 100%.
Press the RESET button once for each 10% reduction below the default 100% until the message
center displays OIL LIFE SET TO XX%.
4. Press and release the SETUP button to exit the procedure.
Oil Life Start Value - Base Instrument Cluster (IC)
Message Center Configuration
Oil Life Start Value - Base Instrument Cluster (IC)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1765
NOTE: All message center functions are carried out using the single stem reset button in the
Instrument Cluster (IC).
NOTE: The oil life start value is used to increase or decrease the starting point of the oil life. The
value can be changed back to the maximum of approximately 12,000 km (7,500 miles) if the value
was previously changed or lowered by 10% increments down to 10%.
1. Press and release the reset button to scroll through the information displays until the message
center displays HOLD RESET FOR SETUP MENU.
2. Press and hold the reset button for approximately 2 seconds until the message center displays
HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK.
3. Press and release the reset button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX% HOLD
RESET = NEW.
4. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the message center displays
OIL LIFE SET TO 100%.
5. Press the RESET button to lower 10% from the default 100% until the message center displays
OIL LIFE SET TO XX%.
6. NOTE: The oil life start value can be lowered from 100% to 10% in 10% increments then the
value starts again at 100%.
Repeat steps 2-5 for each desired 10% reduction.
7. Press and release the reset button to exit the procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL)
The MIL notifies the driver that the powertrain control module (PCM) has detected an on board
diagnostic (OBD) emission-related component or system concern. When this occurs, an OBD
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) sets.
- The MIL is located in the instrument cluster and is labeled CHECK ENGINE, SERVICE ENGINE
SOON or the international standards organization (ISO) standard engine symbol.
- The MIL is illuminated during the instrument cluster prove out for approximately four seconds.
- The MIL remains illuminated after instrument cluster prove out if:
- an emission-related concern and DTC exists.
- the PCM does not send a control message to the instrument cluster (applications with the MIL
controlled through the communication link).
- the PCM is operating in the hardware limited operation strategy (HLOS).
- The MIL remains off during the instrument cluster prove out if an indicator or instrument cluster
concern is present.
- To turn off the MIL after a repair, a reset command from the scan tool must be sent, or three
consecutive drive cycles must be completed without a concern.
- For all MIL concerns, go to Symptom Charts See: Powertrain Management/Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/No Diagnostic
Trouble Codes (DTCs) Present Symptom Chart Index.
- If the MIL flashes at a steady rate, a severe misfire condition may exist.
- If the MIL flashes erratically, the PCM can reset while cranking if the battery voltage is low.
- The MIL flashes after a period of time with the ignition in the RUN position (engine not running) if
DTC P1000 is set.
CHECK ENGINE, SERVICE ENGINE SOON, or ISO Standard Engine Symbol
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Oil Change Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Oil Change Reminder Lamp: Service and Repair
Oil Life
An oil change is required whenever indicated by the message center. USE ONLY
RECOMMENDED ENGINE OILS.
To reset the oil monitoring system to 100% after each oil change ( approximately 7,500 miles (
12,000 km ) or 12 months ) perform the following:
1. Press and release the SETUP control to display "OIL LIFE = XXX% HOLD RESET = NEW".
2. Press and hold the RESET stem for 2 seconds and release. Oil life is set to XX% and "OIL LIFE
SET TO XX%" is displayed.
Note: Oil Life Start Value of 100% equals 7,500 miles (12,070 km) or 6 months. For example,
setting Oil Life Start Value to 60% sets the Oil Life Start Value to 3,000 miles (4,828 km) and 120
days.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Vehicle Lifting: Description and Operation
Jacking and Lifting
Jacking Points - Front
WARNING: Shut off the electrical power to the air suspension system prior to hoisting or jacking an
air suspension equipped vehicle. Failure to do so may result in unexpected inflation or deflation of
the air springs, which may result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations. Failure to follow
this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Turn off (disable) the power running boards (if equipped) before jacking, lifting or
placing any object under the vehicle.
Never place your hand between the power running board and the vehicle. Extended power running
boards will retract when doors are closed.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: When jacking or lifting the vehicle, block all wheels remaining on the ground. Set the
parking brake if the rear wheels will remain on the ground. These actions help prevent unintended
vehicle movement. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Never get underneath a vehicle that is supported only by a jack. The jack could
unintentionally lower. Always support vehicle with floor stands. Failure to follow these instructions
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Only raise the vehicle when positioned on a hard, level surface. Attempting to raise the
vehicle on an uneven or soft surface may result in vehicle slipping or falling from the jack or
jackstand. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Identify the correct jacking points by locating the triangle stamped into the uni-body
sheet metal or vehicle frame. Raising a vehicle in any other location may result in vehicle shifting or
falling. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
NOTICE: The jack provided with the vehicle is intended to be used in an emergency for changing a
deflated tire. To avoid damage to the vehicle, never use the jack to hoist the vehicle for any other
purpose.
NOTICE: To prevent possible damage to the underbody, do not drive the vehicle onto the drive-on
lift without first checking for possible interference.
NOTICE: Damage to the suspension, exhaust or steering linkage components may occur if care is
not exercised when positioning the hoist adapters prior to lifting the vehicle.
The front jacking point is indicated by an arrow cutout in the frame, located behind the front tire and
wheel.
Jacking Points - Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 1776
NOTICE: Do not use the differential housing as a lift point. Leaks or damage to the rear axle cover
and adjoining differential housing surface may occur if a floor jack or any lifting device is allowed to
contact the cover at any point where the cover joins the housing.
The rear jacking point is indicated by an arrow cutout in the frame, located in front of the rear tire
and wheel.
Lifting Points - Front and Rear
Locate the front hoist adapters and rear hoist adapters as indicated.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Training
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training
NOTE: If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, the sensors will go into a "sleep
mode" to conserve battery power. It will be necessary to wake them up so they will transmit the
latest tire pressure information to the Smart Junction Box (SJB). For additional information, refer to
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Activation See: Tire Monitoring System/Testing
and Inspection/Programming and Relearning.
NOTE: The tire pressure sensor training procedure must be done on a single vehicle, in an area
without radio frequency noise and at least 1 m (3 ft) away from other vehicles equipped with a Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS). Radio frequency noise is generated by electrical motors and
appliance operation, cellular telephones, remote transmitters, power inverters and portable
entertainment equipment.
NOTE: If a sensor does not respond to the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool, attempt to
activate the same sensor with the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. If the sensor still does not
respond, move the vehicle to rotate the wheels at least one-fourth of a turn and attempt to activate
the same sensor again.
NOTE: The SJB has a 2-minute time limit between sensor responses. If the SJB does not
recognize any 1 of the 4 tire pressure sensors during this time limit, the horn will sound twice and
the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE NOT TRAINED REPEAT and the entire
procedure must be repeated.
NOTE: For vehicles with different front and rear tire pressures (such as the E-Series and certain
F-Series), the tire pressure sensors must be trained following a tire rotation. Failure to train the
sensors will cause the TPMS indicator to illuminate. For vehicles with the same tire pressure for
front and rear tires, tire rotation will not affect the system.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position, then press and release the brake pedal.
2. Cycle the ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN
position.
3. Press and release the brake pedal.
4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
5. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN
position.
- The horn will sound once and the TPMS indicator will flash if the training mode has been entered
successfully. If equipped, the message center will display TRAIN LF TIRE.
6. NOTE: It may take up to 6 seconds to activate a tire pressure sensor. During this time, the Tire
Pressure Monitor Activation Tool must remain in
place 180 degrees from the valve stem.
Place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the LF tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees) from
the valve stem. Press and release the test button on the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. The
horn will sound briefly to indicate that the tire pressure sensor has been recognized by the SJB.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training >
Page 1782
7. Within 2 minutes of the horn sounding, place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the RF
tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees) from the
valve stem and press and release the test button to train the RF tire pressure sensor.
8. NOTE: Do not wait more than 2 minutes between training each sensor or the SJB will time out
and the entire procedure must be repeated.
Repeat Step 7 for the RR and LR tires.
The procedure is completed after the last tire has been trained. When the training procedure is
complete, the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE TRAINING COMPLETE.
For vehicles not equipped with a message center, successful completion of the training procedure
will be verified by turning the ignition switch to the OFF position without the horn sounding. If the
horn sounds twice when the switch is turned to the OFF position, the training procedure was not
successful.
9. Using the scan tool, locate the updated TPMS sensor identifiers trained to the SJB and
document them on the applicable warranty claim.
10. NOTE: This step is required to clear DTC C2780, cause the SJB to exit the manufacturing
mode and to make sure there are no other concerns
with a newly programmed SJB.
If the sensors are being trained due to the installation of a new SJB, clear any DTCs and carry out
the SJB On-Demand Self Test.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training >
Page 1783
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Activation
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Activation
NOTE: The tire pressure sensors will go into a "sleep mode" after 30 minutes of inactivity to
conserve battery power. The sensors do not transmit information while in sleep mode. It will be
necessary to wake them up so they will transmit the latest tire pressure information.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
2. Position the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool against the LF tire sidewall, 180 degrees from
the tire valve stem.
3. NOTE: The Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool will provide feedback in the form of a flashing
green light and a beep sound for each
successful response from a tire pressure sensor.
Press the test button on the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool to activate the sensor, activate
the sensor at least 2 times.
4. Repeat Steps 2 and 3 for the remaining tires.
5. If the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) indicator remains illuminated after adjusting and
activating each sensor, refer to the Symptom
Chart in Diagnosis and Testing. See: Tire Monitoring System/Testing and Inspection/Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Disassembly
WARNING: The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) sensor battery may release hazardous
chemicals if exposed to extreme mechanical damage. If these chemicals contact the skin or eyes,
flush immediately with water for a minimum of 15 minutes and get prompt medical attention. If any
part of the battery is swallowed, contact a physician immediately. When disposing of TPMS
sensors, follow the correct procedures for hazardous material disposal. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in serious personal injury.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application. When
installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color of the
sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor can be removed and installed without removing the strap or the cradle.
1. NOTICE: The sensor, cradle and strap may be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Dismount the tire only as instructed.
Remove the tire from the wheel. For additional information, refer to Wheel and Tire See: Service
and Repair/Overhaul.
2. NOTICE: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to the
sensor locking clip may occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver or similar tool, remove the sensor locking clip.
3. NOTICE: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to the
sensor may occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver or similar tool, detach the sensor from the cradle.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1786
4. Remove the sensor.
Assembly
1. NOTICE: Damage to the sensor may occur if excessive force is applied during sensor
installation.
NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the cradle. The sensor will make a "click" noise
when correctly seated.
Position the sensor into the cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end of the
cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. NOTE: The locking clip can only be fully seated when installed in the correct orientation. If the
sensor locking clip cannot be fully inserted, then
the sensor may not be fully seated on the cradle or the locking clip may be inserted backward.
Insert a new locking clip into the sensor.
3. NOTICE: The sensor, cradle and strap may be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel. For additional information, refer to Wheel and Tire See: Service and
Repair/Overhaul.
4. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s). For additional information, refer to Tire Pressure Monitoring
System (TPMS) Sensor Training See: Tire Monitoring System/Testing and Inspection/Monitors,
Trips, Drive Cycles and Readiness Codes.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1787
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and
Cradle
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and Cradle
Disassembly
WARNING: The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) sensor battery may release hazardous
chemicals if exposed to extreme mechanical damage. If these chemicals contact the skin or eyes,
flush immediately with water for a minimum of 15 minutes and get prompt medical attention. If any
part of the battery is swallowed, contact a physician immediately. When disposing of TPMS
sensors, follow the correct procedures for hazardous material disposal. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in serious personal injury.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application. When
installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color of the
sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor is available separately, the cradle and strap are available as a strap kit. There
are several different strap kits available based on wheel diameter, but all strap kits share the same
base part number.
1. Remove the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) sensor. For additional information, refer to
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Sensor See: Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor.
2. WARNING: Always wear eye protection when servicing a vehicle. Failure to follow this
instruction may result in serious personal injury.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1788
WARNING: Wear protective gloves when handling components or parts that have pointed or sharp
edges. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
Remove a factory-installed strap in the following sequence:
1. Locate the strap buckle and secure the strap to the wheel using duct tape or a similar item on
both sides of the buckle, approximately 25 mm
(0.98 in) from the buckle.
2. Using a large screwdriver and a twisting motion, unbuckle the strap.
3. Discard the strap.
3. To remove a dealer-installed strap, turn the worm gear screw until the strap is fully released from
the worm gear.
- Discard the strap.
4. NOTE: To aid assembly, mark the location of the cradle prior to disassembly.
Using a screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the cradle by inserting the screwdriver under the cradle
and prying up.
Assembly
1. NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the new cradle. The sensor will make a "click"
noise when fully seated.
Position the sensor into the new cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end
of the cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. NOTICE: Metal scrapers may damage the wheel. Use only plastic or non-metallic scrapers to
remove the cradle adhesive strip residue.
NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be installed in the drop well of the wheel, 180 degrees from the
valve stem.
Using wheel and tire cleaner, clean the area where the sensor and cradle are to be installed.
3. NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be positioned with the hinge side of the sensor on the RH
side when viewed from the curb side (beauty side)
of the wheel.
NOTE: The sensor has raised markings indicating how to position the sensor.
Remove the adhesive tape liner from the cradle and position the sensor and cradle into the wheel
drop well 180 degrees from the valve stem.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1789
4. Install the tapered end of the strap through the opening of the cradle on the hinge side of the
sensor. This will position the worm gear on the
locking clip side of the sensor.
5. NOTICE: Steel wheels have a "high spot" along their circumference. Make sure the strap and
sensor are mounted at the lowest spot
possible to avoid damaging the sensor during wheel and tire disassembly and assembly.
NOTE: Keep the strap parallel with the wheel flange while tightening the worm gear.
Position the worm gear 13-26 mm (0.5-1.0 in) away from the sensor and tighten the worm gear.
- Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
6. NOTICE: The sensor, cradle and strap may be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel. For additional information, refer to Wheel and Tire See: Service and
Repair/Overhaul.
7. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s). For additional information, refer to Tire Pressure Monitoring
System (TPMS) Sensor Training See: Tire Monitoring System/Testing and Inspection/Monitors,
Trips, Drive Cycles and Readiness Codes.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Training
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training
NOTE: If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, the sensors will go into a "sleep
mode" to conserve battery power. It will be necessary to wake them up so they will transmit the
latest tire pressure information to the Smart Junction Box (SJB). For additional information, refer to
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Activation See: Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning.
NOTE: The tire pressure sensor training procedure must be done on a single vehicle, in an area
without radio frequency noise and at least 1 m (3 ft) away from other vehicles equipped with a Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS). Radio frequency noise is generated by electrical motors and
appliance operation, cellular telephones, remote transmitters, power inverters and portable
entertainment equipment.
NOTE: If a sensor does not respond to the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool, attempt to
activate the same sensor with the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. If the sensor still does not
respond, move the vehicle to rotate the wheels at least one-fourth of a turn and attempt to activate
the same sensor again.
NOTE: The SJB has a 2-minute time limit between sensor responses. If the SJB does not
recognize any 1 of the 4 tire pressure sensors during this time limit, the horn will sound twice and
the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE NOT TRAINED REPEAT and the entire
procedure must be repeated.
NOTE: For vehicles with different front and rear tire pressures (such as the E-Series and certain
F-Series), the tire pressure sensors must be trained following a tire rotation. Failure to train the
sensors will cause the TPMS indicator to illuminate. For vehicles with the same tire pressure for
front and rear tires, tire rotation will not affect the system.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position, then press and release the brake pedal.
2. Cycle the ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN
position.
3. Press and release the brake pedal.
4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
5. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN
position.
- The horn will sound once and the TPMS indicator will flash if the training mode has been entered
successfully. If equipped, the message center will display TRAIN LF TIRE.
6. NOTE: It may take up to 6 seconds to activate a tire pressure sensor. During this time, the Tire
Pressure Monitor Activation Tool must remain in
place 180 degrees from the valve stem.
Place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the LF tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees) from
the valve stem. Press and release the test button on the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. The
horn will sound briefly to indicate that the tire pressure sensor has been recognized by the SJB.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training > Page 1795
7. Within 2 minutes of the horn sounding, place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the RF
tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees) from the
valve stem and press and release the test button to train the RF tire pressure sensor.
8. NOTE: Do not wait more than 2 minutes between training each sensor or the SJB will time out
and the entire procedure must be repeated.
Repeat Step 7 for the RR and LR tires.
The procedure is completed after the last tire has been trained. When the training procedure is
complete, the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE TRAINING COMPLETE.
For vehicles not equipped with a message center, successful completion of the training procedure
will be verified by turning the ignition switch to the OFF position without the horn sounding. If the
horn sounds twice when the switch is turned to the OFF position, the training procedure was not
successful.
9. Using the scan tool, locate the updated TPMS sensor identifiers trained to the SJB and
document them on the applicable warranty claim.
10. NOTE: This step is required to clear DTC C2780, cause the SJB to exit the manufacturing
mode and to make sure there are no other concerns
with a newly programmed SJB.
If the sensors are being trained due to the installation of a new SJB, clear any DTCs and carry out
the SJB On-Demand Self Test.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training > Page 1796
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Activation
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Activation
NOTE: The tire pressure sensors will go into a "sleep mode" after 30 minutes of inactivity to
conserve battery power. The sensors do not transmit information while in sleep mode. It will be
necessary to wake them up so they will transmit the latest tire pressure information.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
2. Position the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool against the LF tire sidewall, 180 degrees from
the tire valve stem.
3. NOTE: The Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool will provide feedback in the form of a flashing
green light and a beep sound for each
successful response from a tire pressure sensor.
Press the test button on the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool to activate the sensor, activate
the sensor at least 2 times.
4. Repeat Steps 2 and 3 for the remaining tires.
5. If the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) indicator remains illuminated after adjusting and
activating each sensor, refer to the Symptom
Chart in Diagnosis and Testing. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic
Procedures
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Disassembly
WARNING: The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) sensor battery may release hazardous
chemicals if exposed to extreme mechanical damage. If these chemicals contact the skin or eyes,
flush immediately with water for a minimum of 15 minutes and get prompt medical attention. If any
part of the battery is swallowed, contact a physician immediately. When disposing of TPMS
sensors, follow the correct procedures for hazardous material disposal. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in serious personal injury.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application. When
installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color of the
sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor can be removed and installed without removing the strap or the cradle.
1. NOTICE: The sensor, cradle and strap may be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Dismount the tire only as instructed.
Remove the tire from the wheel. For additional information, refer to Wheel and Tire See: Service
and Repair/Overhaul.
2. NOTICE: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to the
sensor locking clip may occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver or similar tool, remove the sensor locking clip.
3. NOTICE: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to the
sensor may occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver or similar tool, detach the sensor from the cradle.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1799
4. Remove the sensor.
Assembly
1. NOTICE: Damage to the sensor may occur if excessive force is applied during sensor
installation.
NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the cradle. The sensor will make a "click" noise
when correctly seated.
Position the sensor into the cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end of the
cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. NOTE: The locking clip can only be fully seated when installed in the correct orientation. If the
sensor locking clip cannot be fully inserted, then
the sensor may not be fully seated on the cradle or the locking clip may be inserted backward.
Insert a new locking clip into the sensor.
3. NOTICE: The sensor, cradle and strap may be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel. For additional information, refer to Wheel and Tire See: Service and
Repair/Overhaul.
4. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s). For additional information, refer to Tire Pressure Monitoring
System (TPMS) Sensor Training See: Testing and Inspection/Monitors, Trips, Drive Cycles and
Readiness Codes.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1800
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and
Cradle
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and Cradle
Disassembly
WARNING: The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) sensor battery may release hazardous
chemicals if exposed to extreme mechanical damage. If these chemicals contact the skin or eyes,
flush immediately with water for a minimum of 15 minutes and get prompt medical attention. If any
part of the battery is swallowed, contact a physician immediately. When disposing of TPMS
sensors, follow the correct procedures for hazardous material disposal. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in serious personal injury.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application. When
installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color of the
sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor is available separately, the cradle and strap are available as a strap kit. There
are several different strap kits available based on wheel diameter, but all strap kits share the same
base part number.
1. Remove the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) sensor. For additional information, refer to
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Sensor See: Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor.
2. WARNING: Always wear eye protection when servicing a vehicle. Failure to follow this
instruction may result in serious personal injury.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1801
WARNING: Wear protective gloves when handling components or parts that have pointed or sharp
edges. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
Remove a factory-installed strap in the following sequence:
1. Locate the strap buckle and secure the strap to the wheel using duct tape or a similar item on
both sides of the buckle, approximately 25 mm
(0.98 in) from the buckle.
2. Using a large screwdriver and a twisting motion, unbuckle the strap.
3. Discard the strap.
3. To remove a dealer-installed strap, turn the worm gear screw until the strap is fully released from
the worm gear.
- Discard the strap.
4. NOTE: To aid assembly, mark the location of the cradle prior to disassembly.
Using a screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the cradle by inserting the screwdriver under the cradle
and prying up.
Assembly
1. NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the new cradle. The sensor will make a "click"
noise when fully seated.
Position the sensor into the new cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end
of the cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. NOTICE: Metal scrapers may damage the wheel. Use only plastic or non-metallic scrapers to
remove the cradle adhesive strip residue.
NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be installed in the drop well of the wheel, 180 degrees from the
valve stem.
Using wheel and tire cleaner, clean the area where the sensor and cradle are to be installed.
3. NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be positioned with the hinge side of the sensor on the RH
side when viewed from the curb side (beauty side)
of the wheel.
NOTE: The sensor has raised markings indicating how to position the sensor.
Remove the adhesive tape liner from the cradle and position the sensor and cradle into the wheel
drop well 180 degrees from the valve stem.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1802
4. Install the tapered end of the strap through the opening of the cradle on the hinge side of the
sensor. This will position the worm gear on the
locking clip side of the sensor.
5. NOTICE: Steel wheels have a "high spot" along their circumference. Make sure the strap and
sensor are mounted at the lowest spot
possible to avoid damaging the sensor during wheel and tire disassembly and assembly.
NOTE: Keep the strap parallel with the wheel flange while tightening the worm gear.
Position the worm gear 13-26 mm (0.5-1.0 in) away from the sensor and tighten the worm gear.
- Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
6. NOTICE: The sensor, cradle and strap may be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel. For additional information, refer to Wheel and Tire See: Service and
Repair/Overhaul.
7. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s). For additional information, refer to Tire Pressure Monitoring
System (TPMS) Sensor Training See: Testing and Inspection/Monitors, Trips, Drive Cycles and
Readiness Codes.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Suspension
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front Suspension
Wheel Bearing and Wheel Hub
Removal and Installation
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be
installed with the same part numbers or equivalent parts, if replacement is necessary. Do not use a
replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified
during reassembly to make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector.
2. Remove the wheel and tire.
3. Remove the wheel speed sensor harness bracket bolt and detach the harness from the
retainers.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Suspension > Page 1807
4. NOTICE: Do not allow the caliper and anchor plate assembly to hang from the brake hose or
damage to the hose may result.
Remove the 2 bolts and position the caliper and anchor plate aside.
- Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
- To install, tighten to 200 Nm (148 lb-ft).
5. Remove the brake disc.
6. Remove the 4 bolts and the wheel bearing and wheel hub.
- Discard the bolts.
- To install, tighten to 175 Nm (129 lb-ft).
7. If installing a new wheel bearing and wheel hub, remove the wheel speed sensor bolt and the
wheel speed sensor.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
8. NOTICE: If the original wheel bearing and wheel hub is being installed, a new O-ring seal must
be installed or damage to the wheel
bearing may occur.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Suspension > Page 1808
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear Suspension
Wheel Bearing and Wheel Hub
Removal
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts and
systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be installed with the
same part numbers or equivalent part, if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement
part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during
reassembly to make sure of correct retention of these parts.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Suspension > Page 1809
1. Remove the wheel and tire.
2. NOTE: Have an assistant press the brake pedal to keep the axle from rotating.
Remove and discard the halfshaft nut.
3. Using a suitable hub puller, separate the outboard CV joint from the wheel hub.
4. NOTICE: Do not allow the caliper and anchor plate assembly to hang from the brake hose or
damage to the hose may result.
Remove the bolts and position the caliper and anchor plate assembly aside.
- Support the caliper and anchor plate assembly using mechanic's wire.
5. Remove the brake disc.
6. Detach the wheel speed sensor harness from the retainers and disconnect the wheel speed
sensor electrical connector. Push the wheel speed sensor
harness grommet through the brake disc shield.
7. Remove the 4 bolts, the wheel bearing and wheel hub, and the wheel speed sensor as an
assembly.
- Route the sensor wiring through the access hole in the brake disc shield.
- Discard the bolts.
8. If necessary, remove the wheel speed sensor bolt and the wheel speed sensor from the wheel
bearing and wheel hub.
Installation
1. If necessary, install the wheel speed sensor and bolt.
- Tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
2. Position the wheel bearing and wheel hub, and the wheel speed sensor. Install the 4 new wheel
bearing and wheel hub bolts.
- Route the sensor wiring through the access hole in the brake disc shield.
- Tighten to 175 Nm (129 lb-ft).
3. Attach the wheel speed sensor harness to the retainers and connect the wheel speed sensor
electrical connector. Push the wheel speed sensor
harness grommet through the brake disc shield.
4. Install the brake disc.
5. Position the caliper and anchor plate assembly and install the bolts.
- Tighten to 190 Nm (140 lb-ft).
6. NOTE: Have an assistant press the brake pedal to keep the axle from rotating.
Install the new halfshaft nut.
- Tighten to 300 Nm (221 lb-ft).
7. Install the wheel and tire.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
Rear Suspension
Wheel Bearing and Wheel Hub
Install the new halfshaft nut, tighten to
.................................................................................................................................................... 300
Nm (221 lb-ft)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Wheel Hub Lock Solenoid > Component
Information > Locations
Wheel Hub Lock Solenoid: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Wheel Hub Lock Solenoid > Component
Information > Locations > Page 1817
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Wheel Hub Lock Solenoid > Component
Information > Locations > Page 1818
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub (Locking) > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Wheel Hub (Locking): Service and Repair
Integrated Wheel End (IWE)
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the front wheel and tire.
3. Remove the dust cap.
4. Remove and discard the axle nut.
5. Disconnect the vacuum tubes from the Integrated Wheel End (IWE).
6. Remove the 3 IWE-to-wheel knuckle retaining bolts.
7. Remove the tie-rod nut and separate the tie rod from the wheel knuckle.
- Discard the tie-rod nut.
8. Remove the wheel speed sensor harness bracket bolt and position the harness aside.
9. Remove the front brake flexible hose bracket bolt and position the brake hose aside.
10. Remove the upper ball joint nut and separate the upper ball joint from the wheel knuckle.
- Discard the upper ball joint nut.
11. NOTE: Allow the wheel knuckle to swing outward while keeping the halfshaft pushed inward.
Once clearance is available, remove the halfshaft outboard end from the wheel knuckle hub
bearing.
12. Remove the IWE from the halfshaft outboard end.
Installation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub (Locking) > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Page 1822
1. Compress the IWE and install a vacuum cap on the vacuum port.
2. NOTICE: Do not dislodge the Integrated Wheel End (IWE) seal spring when installing the IWE
on halfshaft outboard end or component
damage may occur.
Install the IWE onto the halfshaft outboard end.
3. NOTE: Allow the wheel knuckle to swing outward while keeping the halfshaft pushed inward.
Once clearance is available, install the halfshaft outboard end into the wheel knuckle hub bearing.
4. Connect the upper ball joint and install a new nut.
- Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
5. Connect the tie rod and install a new nut.
- Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
6. Position the front brake flexible hose bracket and install the bolt.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
7. Position the wheel speed sensor harness bracket and install the bolt.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
8. Install the 3 IWE-to-wheel knuckle retaining bolts.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
9. Remove the IWE vacuum cap and connect the vacuum tubes.
10. NOTICE: Verify the spline engagement by checking for spline lash before installing the axle nut
or component damage may occur.
Install the new axle nut.
- Tighten to 27 Nm (20 lb-ft).
11. Install the dust cap.
12. Install the front wheel and tire.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Specifications
Wheel Fastener: Specifications
Tighten the wheel nuts in a star/cross pattern. Tighten to....................................................................
...............................................................................................................................135 Nm (100 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Suspension - Rear Wheel Drive (RWD)
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair Front Suspension - Rear Wheel Drive (RWD)
Wheel Studs
Removal
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be
installed with the same part numbers or equivalent parts, if replacement is necessary. Do not use a
replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified
during reassembly to make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the wheel and tire.
2. NOTICE: Do not allow the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly to hang from the brake hose
or damage to the hose may result.
Remove the 2 bolts and position the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly aside.
- Support the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly using mechanic's wire.
3. Remove the brake disc.
4. Using the C-Frame and Screw Assembly, remove the wheel stud.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Suspension - Rear Wheel Drive (RWD) > Page 1828
Installation
1. NOTE: Make sure to use washers that have an ID that is larger than the OD of the wheel stud
serrations. Use enough washers (approximately 4) to
allow the wheel stud to fully seat against the hub flange.
Position the new wheel stud in the wheel hub, aligning the serrations in the wheel hub flange made
by the original wheel stud.
- Place 4 washers over the outside end of the wheel stud and thread a standard wheel nut onto the
wheel stud with the flat side against the washers.
- Tighten the wheel nut until the wheel stud head seats against the back side of the wheel hub
flange.
2. Remove the wheel nut and washers.
3. Install the brake disc.
4. Position the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly and install the bolts.
- Tighten the bolts to 200 Nm (148 lb-ft).
5. Install the wheel and tire.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Suspension - Rear Wheel Drive (RWD) > Page 1829
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair Rear Suspension
Wheel Studs
Removal
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be
installed with the same part numbers or equivalent part, if replacement is necessary. Do not use a
replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified
during reassembly to make sure correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the wheel bearing and wheel hub. For additional information, refer to Wheel Bearing
and Wheel Hub See: Wheel Bearing/Service and
Repair/Rear Suspension.
2. NOTICE: Never use a hammer to remove a wheel stud. Damage to the wheel hub may result.
Place the wheel hub in a soft-jawed vise and, using the C-Frame and Screw, remove the wheel
stud.
Installation
1. Position the new wheel stud in the wheel bearing and hub assembly, aligning the serrations in
the wheel hub flange made by the original wheel
stud.
2. NOTICE: Do not use power tools to install the wheel stud. The serrations on the flange can be
stripped.
NOTE: Do not use the wheel nut that came with the vehicle.
NOTE: Make sure to use washers that have an ID that is larger than the OD of the wheel stud
serrations. Use enough washers (approximately 4) to allow the wheel stud to fully seat against the
hub flange.
Install 4 washers and a wheel nut on the wheel stud and tighten the wheel nut until the stud seats
against the flange.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Suspension - Rear Wheel Drive (RWD) > Page 1830
3. Remove the wheel nut and washers.
- Discard the wheel nut.
4. Install the wheel bearing and wheel hub. For additional information, refer to Wheel Bearing and
Wheel Hub See: Wheel Bearing/Service and
Repair/Rear Suspension.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Description and Operation
Vehicle Lifting: Description and Operation
Jacking and Lifting
Jacking Points - Front
WARNING: Shut off the electrical power to the air suspension system prior to hoisting or jacking an
air suspension equipped vehicle. Failure to do so may result in unexpected inflation or deflation of
the air springs, which may result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations. Failure to follow
this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Turn off (disable) the power running boards (if equipped) before jacking, lifting or
placing any object under the vehicle.
Never place your hand between the power running board and the vehicle. Extended power running
boards will retract when doors are closed.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: When jacking or lifting the vehicle, block all wheels remaining on the ground. Set the
parking brake if the rear wheels will remain on the ground. These actions help prevent unintended
vehicle movement. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Never get underneath a vehicle that is supported only by a jack. The jack could
unintentionally lower. Always support vehicle with floor stands. Failure to follow these instructions
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Only raise the vehicle when positioned on a hard, level surface. Attempting to raise the
vehicle on an uneven or soft surface may result in vehicle slipping or falling from the jack or
jackstand. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Identify the correct jacking points by locating the triangle stamped into the uni-body
sheet metal or vehicle frame. Raising a vehicle in any other location may result in vehicle shifting or
falling. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
NOTICE: The jack provided with the vehicle is intended to be used in an emergency for changing a
deflated tire. To avoid damage to the vehicle, never use the jack to hoist the vehicle for any other
purpose.
NOTICE: To prevent possible damage to the underbody, do not drive the vehicle onto the drive-on
lift without first checking for possible interference.
NOTICE: Damage to the suspension, exhaust or steering linkage components may occur if care is
not exercised when positioning the hoist adapters prior to lifting the vehicle.
The front jacking point is indicated by an arrow cutout in the frame, located behind the front tire and
wheel.
Jacking Points - Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
1834
NOTICE: Do not use the differential housing as a lift point. Leaks or damage to the rear axle cover
and adjoining differential housing surface may occur if a floor jack or any lifting device is allowed to
contact the cover at any point where the cover joins the housing.
The rear jacking point is indicated by an arrow cutout in the frame, located in front of the rear tire
and wheel.
Lifting Points - Front and Rear
Locate the front hoist adapters and rear hoist adapters as indicated.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Variable Valve Timing
Actuator: > 10-18-4 > Sep > 10 > Engine - Low Frequency Hot Idle Knocking Noise
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Customer Interest Engine - Low Frequency Hot Idle Knocking
Noise
TSB 10-18-4
09/27/10
LOW FREQUENCY ENGINE KNOCKING NOISE AT HOT IDLE
FORD: 2009-2010 Expedition, F-150, F-250, F-350
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 09-23-7 to update the vehicle model lines, Service Procedure and
Service Labor Time Standards.
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 F-150 and F-Super Duty vehicles equipped with a 4.6L 3V or 5.4L 3V
engine, Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a low frequency knocking noise from the
engine at hot idle only. The noise is predominately heard from the right front wheel well area and/or
the right hand (RH) engine cam cover. This noise may be generated from the RH variable camshaft
timing (VCT) phaser assembly. This procedure was created to diagnose the RH VCT phaser
assembly.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) tests were developed specifically for the vehicles and
Power Control Module (PCM) strategies for these vehicles.
Per Workshop Manual (WSM), Powertrain Controls and Emissions Diagnostics (PC/ED) and
Scheduled Maintenance Guide, review customer service history for use of any aftermarket oil
filters.
1. Check for possible diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs).
a. No DTCs present, proceed to Step 2.
b. If DTCs are present, do not continue with this procedure and refer to the PC/ED manual for
diagnostics.
2. Engine must be at full operating temperature over 190 °F (88 °C) cylinder head temperature
(CHT).
3. Connect IDS diagnostics tool and verify software version is at the latest level (63 or later
required).
4. Begin a new vehicle session.
5. Open Tool Box selection.
6. Open Data Logger.
7. Select Powertrain Engine.
8. Select PCM Data Logger.
9. Clear the preselected items by clicking the eraser icon button.
10. Select variable cam timing desired angle number (VCLDSD).
11. Go to live display and press the tick mark.
12. Make sure the parameter identification (PID) is highlighted with the dark lines above and below
the data being displayed.
13. Press number symbol: (output state control mode) of the VCT_DSD number PID.
14. Press the Control Item Activate (finger on the button) icon to enable manual control of the PID.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Variable Valve Timing
Actuator: > 10-18-4 > Sep > 10 > Engine - Low Frequency Hot Idle Knocking Noise > Page 1846
15. Use the plus button to command to 4 degrees. (One click is equal to 1 degree) When
commanding the advance, both banks will normally adjust.
16. Listen carefully to the low frequency knock noise while commanding the VCT_DSD from 0 to 4
degrees. Some higher frequency clatter is normal
at or above the 5 degree advance. What is being pursued is for the level of the low frequency
knock noise to be noticeably reduced when advanced from 4 to 5 degrees.
a. If noise level is noticeably reduced as the VCT desired angle is commanded from 3 to 4 degrees,
the noise source is the RH VCT phaser
assembly. Proceed to Step 17.
b. If the low frequency knock noise is not noticeably reduced at 4 degrees, refer to WSM, Section
303-00 for engine noise diagnostics.
17. Due to normal engine dynamics, the VCT phaser knock noise is produced by the RH VCT
phaser assembly. Replace only the RH VCT phaser
assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 303-01.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT:Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101804A 2009-2010 Expedition, 2.3 Hrs
Navigator 5.4L 3V: Replace The RH VCT Phaser Assembly Includes Time To Diagnose (Do Not
Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101804A 2009-2010 F-150 4.6L 3V: 1.8 Hrs.
Replace The RH VCT Phaser Assembly Includes Time To Diagnose (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101804A 2009-2010 F-150, F-Super 2.1 Hrs.
Duty 5.4L 3V: Replace The RH VCT Phaser Assembly Includes Time To Diagnose (Do Not Use
With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
6A257 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Variable Valve
Timing Actuator: > 10-18-4 > Sep > 10 > Engine - Low Frequency Hot Idle Knocking Noise
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Low Frequency Hot Idle
Knocking Noise
TSB 10-18-4
09/27/10
LOW FREQUENCY ENGINE KNOCKING NOISE AT HOT IDLE
FORD: 2009-2010 Expedition, F-150, F-250, F-350
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 09-23-7 to update the vehicle model lines, Service Procedure and
Service Labor Time Standards.
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 F-150 and F-Super Duty vehicles equipped with a 4.6L 3V or 5.4L 3V
engine, Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a low frequency knocking noise from the
engine at hot idle only. The noise is predominately heard from the right front wheel well area and/or
the right hand (RH) engine cam cover. This noise may be generated from the RH variable camshaft
timing (VCT) phaser assembly. This procedure was created to diagnose the RH VCT phaser
assembly.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) tests were developed specifically for the vehicles and
Power Control Module (PCM) strategies for these vehicles.
Per Workshop Manual (WSM), Powertrain Controls and Emissions Diagnostics (PC/ED) and
Scheduled Maintenance Guide, review customer service history for use of any aftermarket oil
filters.
1. Check for possible diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs).
a. No DTCs present, proceed to Step 2.
b. If DTCs are present, do not continue with this procedure and refer to the PC/ED manual for
diagnostics.
2. Engine must be at full operating temperature over 190 °F (88 °C) cylinder head temperature
(CHT).
3. Connect IDS diagnostics tool and verify software version is at the latest level (63 or later
required).
4. Begin a new vehicle session.
5. Open Tool Box selection.
6. Open Data Logger.
7. Select Powertrain Engine.
8. Select PCM Data Logger.
9. Clear the preselected items by clicking the eraser icon button.
10. Select variable cam timing desired angle number (VCLDSD).
11. Go to live display and press the tick mark.
12. Make sure the parameter identification (PID) is highlighted with the dark lines above and below
the data being displayed.
13. Press number symbol: (output state control mode) of the VCT_DSD number PID.
14. Press the Control Item Activate (finger on the button) icon to enable manual control of the PID.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Variable Valve
Timing Actuator: > 10-18-4 > Sep > 10 > Engine - Low Frequency Hot Idle Knocking Noise > Page 1852
15. Use the plus button to command to 4 degrees. (One click is equal to 1 degree) When
commanding the advance, both banks will normally adjust.
16. Listen carefully to the low frequency knock noise while commanding the VCT_DSD from 0 to 4
degrees. Some higher frequency clatter is normal
at or above the 5 degree advance. What is being pursued is for the level of the low frequency
knock noise to be noticeably reduced when advanced from 4 to 5 degrees.
a. If noise level is noticeably reduced as the VCT desired angle is commanded from 3 to 4 degrees,
the noise source is the RH VCT phaser
assembly. Proceed to Step 17.
b. If the low frequency knock noise is not noticeably reduced at 4 degrees, refer to WSM, Section
303-00 for engine noise diagnostics.
17. Due to normal engine dynamics, the VCT phaser knock noise is produced by the RH VCT
phaser assembly. Replace only the RH VCT phaser
assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 303-01.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT:Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101804A 2009-2010 Expedition, 2.3 Hrs
Navigator 5.4L 3V: Replace The RH VCT Phaser Assembly Includes Time To Diagnose (Do Not
Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101804A 2009-2010 F-150 4.6L 3V: 1.8 Hrs.
Replace The RH VCT Phaser Assembly Includes Time To Diagnose (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101804A 2009-2010 F-150, F-Super 2.1 Hrs.
Duty 5.4L 3V: Replace The RH VCT Phaser Assembly Includes Time To Diagnose (Do Not Use
With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
6A257 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1853
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Description and Operation
Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) System
Overview
The VCT system enables rotation of the camshaft(s) relative to the crankshaft rotation as a function
of engine operating conditions. There are four types of VCT systems.
- Exhaust phase shifting (EPS) system - the exhaust cam is the active cam being retarded.
- Intake phase shifting (IPS) system - the intake cam is the active cam being advanced.
- Dual equal phase shifting (DEPS) system - both intake and exhaust cams are phase shifted and
equally advanced or retarded.
- Dual independent phase shifting (DIPS) system - where both the intake and exhaust cams are
shifted independently.
All systems have four operational modes: idle, part throttle, wide open throttle (WOT), and default
mode. At idle and low engine speeds with closed throttle, the powertrain control module (PCM)
determines the phase angle based on air flow, engine oil temperature and engine coolant
temperature. At part and wide open throttle the PCM determines the phase angle based on engine
RPM, load, and throttle position. VCT systems provide reduced emissions and enhanced engine
power, fuel economy and idle quality. IPS systems also have the added benefit of improved torque.
In addition, some VCT system applications can eliminate the need for an external exhaust gas
recirculation (EGR) system. The elimination of the EGR system is accomplished by controlling the
overlap time between the intake valve opening and exhaust valve closing. Currently, both the IPS
and DEPS systems are used.
The VCT system knocking and noise concerns are diagnosed in the Testing and Inspection
section. For additional information, refer to the Engine System - General Information. Verification of
incorrect VCT phasing on a warm engine operating below 1500 RPM can be isolated using a
stethoscope and by monitoring the VCTADV, VCTADVERR and VCTDC PIDs using a scan tool. If
the VCT phaser does not maintain correct valve timing, low oil pressure or oil flow restrictions are
primary possible causes. Verify correct oil pressure and flow, refer to the Engine System - General
Information.
Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) System
The VCT system consists of an electric hydraulic positioning control solenoid, a camshaft position
(CMP) sensor, and a trigger wheel. The CMP trigger wheel indicates the CMP signal for that bank.
A crankshaft position (CKP) sensor provides the PCM with crankshaft positioning information in 10
degree increments.
1. The PCM receives input signals from the intake air temperature (IAT), engine coolant
temperature (ECT), engine oil temperature (EOT), CMP,
throttle position (TP), mass air flow (MAF), and CKP sensors to determine the operating conditions
of the engine. At idle and low engine speeds with closed throttle, the PCM controls the camshaft
position based on ECT, EOT, IAT, and MAF. During part and wide open throttle, the camshaft
position is determined by engine RPM, load and throttle position. The VCT system does not
operate until the engine is at normal operating temperature.
2. The VCT system is enabled by the PCM when the correct conditions are met. 3. The CKP signal
is used as a reference for CMP positioning. 4. The VCT solenoid valve is an integral part of the
VCT system. The solenoid valve controls the flow of engine oil in the VCT actuator assembly.
As the PCM controls the duty cycle of the solenoid valve, oil pressure/flow advances or retards the
cam timing. Duty cycles near 0% or 100% represent rapid movement of the camshaft. Retaining a
fixed camshaft position is accomplished by dithering (oscillating) the solenoid valve duty cycle. The
PCM calculates and determines the desired camshaft position. It continually updates the VCT
solenoid duty cycle until the desired position is
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1854
achieved. A difference between the desired and actual camshaft position represents a position
error in the PCM VCT control loop. The PCM disables the VCT and places the camshaft in a
default position if a concern is detected. A related DTC is also set when the concern is detected.
5. When the VCT solenoid is energized, engine oil is allowed to flow to the VCT actuator assembly
which advances or retards the camshaft timing.
One half of the VCT actuator is coupled to the camshaft and the other half is connected to the
timing chain. Oil chambers between the two halves couple the camshaft to the timing chain. When
the flow of oil is shifted from one side of the chamber to the other, the differential change in oil
pressure forces the camshaft to rotate in either an advance or retard position depending on the oil
flow.
VCT System
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Solenoid 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Solenoid 1 > Page 1859
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Solenoid > Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Solenoid 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Solenoid > Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Solenoid 1 > Page 1862
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Solenoid > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1863
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid: Service and Repair
Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Oil Control Solenoid
NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the valve cover.
2. Remove the bolt and the Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) oil control solenoid.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Compression Check > System Information >
Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Compression Test - Test Results
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75% of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit Chart.
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
If one or more cylinders reads low, squirt approximately one tablespoon of engine oil on top of the
pistons in the low-reading cylinders. Repeat the compression pressure check on these cylinders.
Compression Test - Interpreting Compression Readings
1. If compression improves considerably, piston rings are faulty.
2. If compression does not improve, valves are sticking or seating incorrectly.
3. If 2 adjacent cylinders indicate low compression pressures and squirting oil on each piston does
not increase compression, the head gasket may be
leaking between cylinders. Engine oil or coolant in cylinders could result from this condition.
Use the Compression Pressure Limit Chart when checking cylinder compression so that the lowest
reading is within 75% of the highest reading.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Compression Check > System Information >
Specifications > Page 1867
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
Engine
Component Tests
The following component tests are used to diagnose engine concerns.
Compression Test - Compression Gauge Check
1. Make sure the oil in the crankcase is of the correct viscosity and at the correct level and that the
battery is correctly charged. Operate the vehicle
until the engine is at normal operating temperature. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position,
then remove all the spark plugs.
2. Set the throttle plates in the wide-open position.
3. Install a compression gauge in the No. 1 cylinder.
4. Install an auxiliary starter switch in the starting circuit. With the ignition switch in the OFF
position, and using the auxiliary starter switch, crank
the engine a minimum of 5 compression strokes and record the highest reading. Note the
approximate number of compression strokes required to obtain the highest reading.
5. Repeat the test on each cylinder, cranking the engine approximately the same number of
compression strokes.
Compression Test - Test Results
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75% of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit Chart.
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Compression Check > System Information >
Specifications > Page 1868
If one or more cylinders reads low, squirt approximately one tablespoon of engine oil on top of the
pistons in the low-reading cylinders. Repeat the compression pressure check on these cylinders.
Compression Test - Interpreting Compression Readings
1. If compression improves considerably, piston rings are faulty.
2. If compression does not improve, valves are sticking or seating incorrectly.
3. If 2 adjacent cylinders indicate low compression pressures and squirting oil on each piston does
not increase compression, the head gasket may be
leaking between cylinders. Engine oil or coolant in cylinders could result from this condition.
Use the Compression Pressure Limit Chart when checking cylinder compression so that the lowest
reading is within 75% of the highest reading.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications
Camshaft Bearing: Specifications
Tighten to..............................................................................................................................................
....................10 Nm (89 lb-in) in the sequence shown.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft
Gear/Sprocket > Component Information > Specifications
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Specifications
Using the Cam Phaser Locking Tool, tighten the LH and RH camshaft phaser and sprocket bolts in
2 stages. Stage 1: Tighten to................................................................................................................
.........................................................................40 Nm (30 lb-ft). Stage 2: Tighten an additional..........
..............................................................................................................................................................
.........90 degrees.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Camshaft: Procedures
Camshaft Journal To Bearing Clearance - OHC Engines
Camshaft Journal to Bearing Clearance - OHC Engines
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
1. NOTE: The camshaft journals must meet specifications before checking camshaft journal
clearance.
Measure each camshaft bearing in 2 directions.
- Subtract the camshaft journal diameter from the camshaft bearing diameter.
Camshaft End Play - OHC Engines
Camshaft End Play - OHC Engines
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
1. Using the Dial Indicator Gauge with Holding Fixture, measure the camshaft end play.
2. Position the camshaft to the rear of the cylinder head.
3. Zero the Dial Indicator Gauge.
4. Move the camshaft to the front of the cylinder head. Note and record the camshaft end play.
- If camshaft end play exceeds specifications, install a new camshaft and recheck end play.
- If camshaft end play exceeds specification after camshaft installation, install a new cylinder head.
Camshaft Surface Inspection
Camshaft Surface Inspection
1. Inspect camshaft lobes for pitting or damage in the contact area. Minor pitting is acceptable
outside the contact area.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1880
Camshaft Bearing Journal Diameter
Camshaft Bearing Journal Diameter
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
1. Measure each camshaft journal diameter in 2 directions.
Camshaft Lobe Lift
Camshaft Lobe Lift
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
1. Use the Dial Indicator Gauge with Holding Fixture to measure camshaft intake/exhaust lobe lift.
- Rotate the camshaft and subtract the lowest Dial Indicator Gauge reading from the highest Dial
Indicator Gauge reading to figure the camshaft lobe lift.
Camshaft Runout
Camshaft Runout
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1881
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
1. NOTE: Camshaft journals must be within specifications before checking runout.
Using the Dial Indicator Gauge with Holding Fixture, measure the camshaft runout.
- Rotate the camshaft and subtract the lowest Dial Indicator Gauge reading from the highest Dial
Indicator Gauge reading.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1882
Camshaft: Removal and Replacement
Valve Train Components - Exploded View
Valve Train Components - Exploded View
NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Camshaft - LH
Camshaft - LH
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1883
Removal
NOTICE: The camshaft procedure must be followed exactly or damage to the valves and pistons
will result.
1. Position the crankshaft damper spoke at the 12 o'clock position and the timing mark indentation
at the 1 o'clock position.
2. Remove the LH valve cover. For additional information, refer to Valve Cover - LH See: Cylinder
Head Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and
Repair/Valve Cover - LH.
3. NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
NOTICE: Only use hand tools to remove the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly or damage
may occur to the camshaft or camshaft phaser and sprocket.
Loosen and back off the LH camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt one full turn.
4. Disconnect the LH Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor electrical connector.
5. Remove the bolt and the LH CMP sensor.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1884
6. NOTE: If the camshaft lobes are not exactly positioned as shown, the crankshaft keyway will
require one full additional rotation to 12 o'clock.
The No. 5 cylinder camshaft lobe must be coming up on the exhaust stroke. Verify by noting the
position of the 2 intake camshaft lobes and the exhaust lobe on the No. 5 cylinder.
7. Remove only the 3 camshaft roller followers shown in the illustration.
8. NOTICE: The camshaft roller followers must be installed in their original locations. Record
camshaft roller follower locations. Failure to
follow these instructions may result in engine damage.
NOTE: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off of the valve or the valve may drop into the cylinder.
If a valve drops into the cylinder, the cylinder head must be removed. For additional information,
refer to Cylinder Head See: Cylinder Head Assembly/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Cylinder Head - Removal.
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
Using the Valve Spring Compressor, remove only the 3 designated camshaft roller followers from
the previous step.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1885
9. NOTICE: The crankshaft cannot be moved past the 6 o'clock position once set or engine
damage may occur.
Rotate the crankshaft clockwise, as viewed from the front, positioning the crankshaft damper spoke
at the 6 o'clock position and the timing mark indentation at the 7 o'clock position.
10. NOTICE: Engine is not freewheeling. Camshaft procedure must be followed exactly or damage
to valves and pistons will result.
NOTE: The Timing Chain Locking Tool must be installed square to the timing chain and the engine
block.
NOTE: Engine front cover removed for clarity.
Install the Timing Chain Locking Tool in the LH timing chain as shown.
11. NOTICE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Locking Tool at any time during assembly. If the
Timing Chain Locking Tool is removed or
out of placement, the engine front cover must be removed and the engine must be retimed. For
additional information, refer to Timing Drive Components See: Timing Components/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement.
NOTICE: The timing chain must be installed in its original position onto the camshaft phaser and
sprocket using the scribed marks, or damage to valves and pistons will result.
Scribe a location mark on the timing chain and the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1886
12. NOTICE: Remove the front thrust camshaft bearing cap straight upward from the bearing
towers or the bearing cap may be damaged
from side loading.
Remove the 2 bolts and the LH camshaft front bearing cap.
13. NOTICE: The camshaft bearing caps must be installed in their original locations. Record
camshaft bearing cap locations. Failure to
follow these instructions may result in engine damage.
Remove the remaining 8 bolts in the sequence shown and remove the 4 camshaft bearing caps.
14. Clean and inspect the LH camshaft bearing caps.
- The camshaft front thrust bearing cap contains an oil metering groove. Make sure the groove is
free of foreign material.
15. NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
NOTICE: Only use hand tools to remove the camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt or damage may
occur to the camshaft or camshaft phaser and sprocket.
NOTICE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Locking Tool at any time during assembly. If the Timing
Chain Locking Tool is removed or out of placement, the engine front cover must be removed and
the engine must be retimed. For additional information, refer to Timing Drive Components See:
Timing Components/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement.
Remove the bolt and the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly from the camshaft.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1887
- Discard the bolt and washer.
16. Remove the camshaft.
17. Remove and inspect the camshaft phaser and sprocket for damage.
Installation
1. NOTE: Do not allow the camshaft roller followers to move out of position when installing the
camshaft.
Lubricate the camshaft and camshaft journals with clean engine oil and install the camshaft.
2. NOTICE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Locking Tool at any time during assembly. If the
Timing Chain Locking Tool is removed or
out of placement, the engine front cover must be removed and the engine must be retimed. For
additional information, refer to Timing Drive Components See: Timing Components/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement.
NOTICE: The timing chain must be installed in its original position onto the camshaft phaser and
sprocket using the scribed marks, or damage to valves and pistons will result.
NOTE: If replacement of the camshaft phaser and sprocket is necessary, transfer the scribe mark
to the new camshaft phaser and sprocket.
Position the camshaft phaser and sprocket into the timing chain with the timing chain scribe marks
in alignment.
3. NOTICE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Locking Tool at any time during assembly. If the
Timing Chain Locking Tool is removed or
out of placement, the engine front cover must be removed and the engine must be retimed. For
additional information, refer to Timing Drive Components See: Timing Components/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement.
NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or used
as a lifting or leveraging device.
NOTICE: Only use hand tools to install the camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt or damage may
occur to the camshaft or camshaft phaser and sprocket.
Install the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly onto the camshaft and install a new camshaft
phaser and sprocket bolt finger-tight.
4. NOTE: Do not allow the camshaft roller followers to move out of position when installing the
camshaft.
Install the 5 camshaft bearing caps in their original locations.
- Lubricate the camshaft bearing caps with clean engine oil.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1888
- Position the 2 front camshaft bearing cap.
- Position the remaining 8 camshaft bearing caps.
- Install the 10 bolts loosely.
5. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
6. NOTE: Engine front cover removed for clarity.
Remove the Timing Chain Locking Tool.
7. Rotate the crankshaft a half turn counterclockwise and position the crankshaft damper spoke at
the 12 o'clock position and the timing mark
indentation at the 1 o'clock position.
8. Verify correct camshaft position by noting the position of the No. 5 cylinder intake and exhaust
camshaft lobes.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1889
9. NOTE: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off of the valve or the valve may drop into the
cylinder. If a valve drops into the cylinder, the
cylinder head must be removed. For additional information, refer to Cylinder Head See: Cylinder
Head Assembly/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Cylinder Head - Removal.
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
Using the Valve Spring Compressor, install the 3 originally removed camshaft roller followers.
10. Install the CMP sensor and the bolt.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
11. Connect the CMP electrical connector.
12. NOTICE: Only use hand tools to install the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly or damage
may occur to the camshaft or camshaft
phaser and sprocket.
NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or used
as a lifting or leveraging device.
Tighten the camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt in 2 stages:
- Stage 1: Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
- Stage 2: Tighten an additional 90 degrees.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1890
13. Install the LH valve cover. For additional information, refer to Valve Cover - LH See: Cylinder
Head Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and
Repair/Valve Cover - LH.
Camshaft - RH
Camshaft - RH
Removal
NOTICE: The camshaft procedure must be followed exactly or damage to the valves and pistons
will result.
1. Position the crankshaft damper spoke at the 12 o'clock position and the timing mark indentation
at the 1 o'clock position.
2. Remove the RH valve cover. For additional information, refer to Valve Cover - RH See: Cylinder
Head Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and
Repair/Valve Cover - RH.
3. NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
NOTICE: Only use hand tools to remove the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly or damage
may occur to the camshaft or camshaft phaser and sprocket.
Loosen and backoff the RH camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt one full turn.
4. Disconnect the RH Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1891
5. Remove the bolt and the RH CMP sensor.
6. NOTE: If the camshaft lobes are not exactly positioned as shown, the crankshaft will require one
full additional rotation to 12 o'clock.
The No. 1 cylinder camshaft exhaust lobe must be coming up on the exhaust stroke. Verify by
noting the position of the 2 intake camshaft lobes and the exhaust lobe on the No. 1 cylinder.
7. Remove only the 3 camshaft roller followers shown in the illustration.
8. NOTICE: The camshaft roller followers must be installed in their original locations. Record
camshaft roller follower locations. Failure to
follow these instructions may result in engine damage.
NOTE: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off of the valve or the valve may drop into the cylinder.
If a valve drops into the cylinder, the cylinder head must be removed. For additional information,
refer to Cylinder Head See: Cylinder Head Assembly/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Cylinder Head - Removal.
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
Using the Valve Spring Compressor, remove only the 3 designated camshaft roller followers from
the previous step.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1892
9. NOTICE: The crankshaft cannot be moved past the 6 o'clock position once set or engine
damage may occur.
Rotate the crankshaft clockwise, as viewed from the front, positioning the crankshaft damper spoke
at the 6 o'clock position and the timing mark indentation at the 7 o'clock position.
10. NOTICE: Engine is not freewheeling. Camshaft procedure must be followed exactly or damage
to valves and pistons will result.
NOTE: The Timing Chain Locking Tool must be installed square to the timing chain and the engine
block.
NOTE: Engine front cover removed for clarity.
Install the Timing Chain Locking Tool in the RH timing chain as shown.
11. NOTICE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Locking Tool at any time during assembly. If the
Timing Chain Locking Tool is removed or
out of placement, the engine front cover must be removed and the engine must be retimed. For
additional information, refer to Timing Drive Components See: Timing Components/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement.
NOTICE: The timing chain must be installed in its original position onto the camshaft phaser and
sprocket using the scribed marks, or damage to valves and pistons will result.
Scribe a location mark on the timing chain and the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly.
12. NOTICE: Remove the front thrust camshaft bearing cap straight upward from the bearing
towers or the bearing cap may be damaged
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1893
from side loading.
Remove the 2 bolts and the front camshaft bearing cap.
13. NOTICE: The camshaft bearing caps must be installed in their original locations. Record
camshaft bearing cap locations. Failure to
follow these instructions may result in engine damage.
Remove the remaining bolts in the sequence shown and remove the remaining camshaft bearing
caps.
14. Clean and inspect the RH camshaft bearing caps.
- The camshaft front thrust bearing cap contains an oil metering groove. Make sure the groove is
free of foreign material.
15. NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
NOTICE: Only use hand tools to remove the camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt or damage may
occur to the camshaft or camshaft phaser and sprocket.
NOTICE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Locking Tool at any time during assembly. If the Timing
Chain Locking Tool is removed or out of placement, the engine front cover must be removed and
the engine must be retimed. For additional information, refer to Timing Drive Components See:
Timing Components/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement.
Remove the bolt and the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly from the camshaft.
- Discard the bolt and washer.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1894
16. Remove the camshaft.
17. Remove and inspect the camshaft phaser and sprocket for damage.
Installation
1. NOTE: Do not allow the camshaft roller followers to move out of position when installing the
camshaft.
Lubricate the camshaft and camshaft journals with clean engine oil and install the camshaft.
2. NOTICE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Locking Tool at any time during assembly. If the
Timing Chain Locking Tool is removed or
out of placement, the engine front cover must be removed and the engine must be retimed. For
additional information, refer to Timing Drive Components See: Timing Components/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement.
NOTICE: The timing chain must be installed in its original position onto the camshaft phaser and
sprocket using the scribed marks, or damage to valves and pistons will result.
NOTE: If replacement of the camshaft phaser and sprocket is necessary, transfer the scribe mark
to the new camshaft phaser and sprocket.
Position the camshaft phaser and sprocket into the timing chain with the timing chain scribe marks
in alignment.
3. NOTICE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Locking Tool at any time during assembly. If the
Timing Chain Locking Tool is removed or
out of placement, the engine front cover must be removed and the engine must be retimed. For
additional information, refer to Timing Drive Components See: Timing Components/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement.
NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or used
as a lifting or leveraging device.
NOTICE: Only use hand tools to install the camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt or damage may
occur to the camshaft or camshaft phaser and sprocket.
Install the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly onto the camshaft and install a new camshaft
phaser and sprocket bolt finger-tight.
4. NOTE: Do not allow the camshaft roller followers to move out of position when installing the
camshaft.
Install the 5 camshaft bearing caps in their original locations.
- Lubricate the camshaft bearing caps with clean engine oil.
- Position the front camshaft bearing cap.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1895
- Position the remaining camshaft bearing caps.
- Install the 10 bolts loosely.
5. Tighten the 10 bolts in the sequence shown.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
6. NOTE: Engine front cover removed for clarity.
Remove the Timing Chain Locking Tool.
7. Rotate the crankshaft a half turn counterclockwise and position the crankshaft damper spoke at
the 12 o'clock position and the timing mark
indentation at the 1 o'clock position.
8. Verify correct camshaft position by noting the position of the No. 1 cylinder intake and exhaust
camshaft lobes.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1896
9. NOTE: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off of the valve or the valve may drop into the
cylinder. If a valve drops into the cylinder, the
cylinder head must be removed. For additional information, refer to Cylinder Head See: Cylinder
Head Assembly/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Cylinder Head - Removal.
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
Using the Valve Spring Compressor, install the 3 originally removed camshaft roller followers.
10. Install the CMP sensor and the bolt.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
11. Connect the CMP electrical connector.
12. NOTICE: Only use hand tools to install the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly or damage
may occur to the camshaft or camshaft
phaser and sprocket.
NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or used
as a lifting or leveraging device.
Tighten the new camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt in 2 stages:
- Stage 1: Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
- Stage 2: Tighten an additional 90 degrees.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1897
13. Install the RH valve cover. For additional information, refer to Valve Cover - RH See: Cylinder
Head Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and
Repair/Valve Cover - RH.
Camshaft Phaser And Sprocket - LH
Camshaft Phaser and Sprocket - LH
Removal
NOTICE: The camshaft procedure must be followed exactly or damage to the valves and pistons
will result.
1. Position the crankshaft damper spoke at the 12 o'clock position and the timing mark indentation
at the 1 o'clock position.
2. Remove the LH valve cover. For additional information, refer to Valve Cover - LH See: Cylinder
Head Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and
Repair/Valve Cover - LH.
3. NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
NOTICE: Only use hand tools to remove the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly or damage
may occur to the camshaft or camshaft phaser and sprocket.
Loosen and back off the LH camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt one full turn.
4. Disconnect the LH Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1898
5. Remove the bolt and the LH CMP sensor.
6. NOTE: If the camshaft lobes are not exactly positioned as shown, the crankshaft keyway will
require one full additional rotation to 12 o'clock.
The No. 5 cylinder camshaft lobe must be coming up on the exhaust stroke. Verify by noting the
position of the 2 intake camshaft lobes and the exhaust lobe on the No. 5 cylinder.
7. Remove only the 3 camshaft roller followers shown in the illustration.
8. NOTICE: The camshaft roller followers must be installed in their original locations. Record
camshaft roller follower locations. Failure to
follow these instructions may result in engine damage.
NOTE: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off of the valve or the valve may drop into the cylinder.
If a valve drops into the cylinder, the cylinder head must be removed. For additional information,
refer to Cylinder Head See: Cylinder Head Assembly/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Cylinder Head - Removal.
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
Using the Valve Spring Compressor, remove only the 3 designated camshaft roller followers from
the previous step.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1899
9. NOTICE: The crankshaft cannot be moved past the 6 o'clock position once set or engine
damage may occur.
Rotate the crankshaft clockwise, as viewed from the front, positioning the crankshaft damper spoke
at the 6 o'clock position and the timing mark indentation at the 7 o'clock position.
10. NOTICE: Engine is not freewheeling. Camshaft procedure must be followed exactly or damage
to valves and pistons will result.
NOTICE: The Timing Chain Locking Tool must be installed square to the timing chain and the
engine block or damage may result.
NOTE: Engine front cover removed for clarity.
Install the Timing Chain Locking Tool in the LH timing chain as shown.
11. NOTICE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Locking Tool at any time during assembly. If the
Timing Chain Locking Tool is removed or
out of placement, the engine front cover must be removed and the engine must be retimed. For
additional information, refer to Timing Drive Components See: Timing Components/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement.
NOTICE: The timing chain must be installed in its original position onto the camshaft phaser and
sprocket using the scribed marks, or damage to valves and pistons will result.
Scribe a location mark on the timing chain and the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1900
12. NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
NOTICE: Only use hand tools to remove the camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt or damage may
occur to the camshaft or camshaft phaser and sprocket.
NOTICE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Locking Tool at any time during assembly. If the Timing
Chain Locking Tool is removed or out of placement, the engine front cover must be removed and
the engine must be retimed. For additional information, refer to Timing Drive Components See:
Timing Components/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement.
Remove the bolt and the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly from the camshaft.
- Discard the bolt and washer.
13. Remove the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly from the timing chain and inspect for
damage.
Installation
1. NOTICE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Locking Tool at any time during assembly. If the
Timing Chain Locking Tool is removed or
out of placement, the engine front cover must be removed and the engine must be retimed. For
additional information, refer to Timing Drive Components See: Timing Components/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement.
NOTICE: The timing chain must be installed in its original position onto the camshaft phaser and
sprocket using the scribed marks, or damage to valves and pistons will result.
NOTE: If replacement of the camshaft phaser and sprocket is necessary, transfer the scribe mark
to the new camshaft phaser and sprocket.
Position the camshaft phaser and sprocket into the timing chain with the timing chain scribe marks
in alignment.
2. NOTICE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Locking Tool at any time during assembly. If the
Timing Chain Locking Tool is removed or
out of placement, the engine front cover must be removed and the engine must be retimed. For
additional information, refer to Timing Drive Components See: Timing Components/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement.
NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or used
as a lifting or leveraging device.
NOTICE: Only use hand tools to install the camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt or damage may
occur to the camshaft or camshaft phaser and sprocket.
Install the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly onto the camshaft and install a new camshaft
phaser and sprocket bolt finger-tight.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1901
3. NOTE: Engine front cover removed for clarity.
Remove the Timing Chain Locking Tool.
4. Rotate the crankshaft a half turn counterclockwise and position the crankshaft damper spoke at
the 12 o'clock position and the timing mark
indentation at the 1 o'clock position.
5. Verify correct camshaft position by noting the position of the No. 5 cylinder intake and exhaust
camshaft lobes.
6. NOTE: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off of the valve or the valve may drop into the
cylinder. If a valve drops into the cylinder, the
cylinder head must be removed. For additional information, refer to Cylinder Head See: Cylinder
Head Assembly/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Cylinder Head - Removal.
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
Using the Valve Spring Compressor, install the 3 originally removed camshaft roller followers.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1902
7. NOTE: Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Install the CMP sensor and the bolt.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
8. Connect the CMP electrical connector.
9. NOTICE: Only use hand tools to install the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly or damage
may occur to the camshaft or camshaft
phaser and sprocket.
NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or used
as a lifting or leveraging device.
Tighten the camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt in 2 stages:
- Stage 1: Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
- Stage 2: Tighten an additional 90 degrees.
10. Install the LH valve cover. For additional information, refer to Valve Cover - LH See: Cylinder
Head Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and
Repair/Valve Cover - LH.
Camshaft Phaser And Sprocket - RH
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1903
Camshaft Phaser and Sprocket - RH
Removal
NOTICE: This procedure must be followed exactly or damage to the valves and pistons will result.
1. Position the crankshaft damper spoke at the 12 o'clock position and the timing mark indentation
at the 1 o'clock position.
2. Remove the RH valve cover. For additional information, refer to Valve Cover - RH See: Cylinder
Head Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and
Repair/Valve Cover - RH.
3. NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
NOTICE: Only use hand tools to remove the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly or damage
may occur to the camshaft or camshaft phaser and sprocket.
Loosen and backoff the RH camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt one full turn.
4. Disconnect the RH Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor electrical connector.
5. Remove the bolt and the RH CMP sensor.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1904
6. NOTE: If the camshaft lobes are not exactly positioned as shown, the crankshaft will require one
full additional rotation to 12 o'clock.
The No. 1 cylinder camshaft exhaust lobe must be coming up on the exhaust stroke. Verify by
noting the position of the 2 intake camshaft lobes and the exhaust lobe on the No. 1 cylinder.
7. Remove only the 3 camshaft roller followers shown in the illustration.
8. NOTICE: The camshaft roller followers must be installed in their original locations. Record
camshaft roller follower locations. Failure to
follow these instructions may result in engine damage.
NOTE: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off of the valve or the valve may drop into the cylinder.
If a valve drops into the cylinder, the cylinder head must be removed. For additional information,
refer to Cylinder Head See: Cylinder Head Assembly/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Cylinder Head - Removal.
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
Using the Valve Spring Compressor, remove only the 3 designated camshaft roller followers from
the previous step.
9. NOTICE: The crankshaft cannot be moved past the 6 o'clock position once set or engine
damage may occur.
Rotate the crankshaft clockwise, as viewed from the front, positioning the crankshaft damper spoke
at the 6 o'clock position and the timing mark indentation at the 7 o'clock position.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1905
10. NOTICE: Engine is not freewheeling. Camshaft procedure must be followed exactly or damage
to valves and pistons will result.
NOTE: The Timing Chain Locking Tool must be installed square to the timing chain and the engine
block.
NOTE: Engine front cover removed for clarity.
Install the Timing Chain Locking Tool in the RH timing chain as shown.
11. NOTICE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Locking Tool at any time during assembly. If the
Timing Chain Locking Tool is removed or
out of placement, the engine front cover must be removed and the engine must be retimed. For
additional information, refer to Timing Drive Components See: Timing Components/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement.
NOTICE: The timing chain must be installed in its original position onto the camshaft phaser and
sprocket using the scribed marks, or damage to valves and pistons will result.
Scribe a location mark on the timing chain and the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly.
12. NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
NOTICE: Only use hand tools to remove the camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt or damage may
occur to the camshaft or camshaft phaser and sprocket.
NOTICE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Locking Tool at any time during assembly. If the Timing
Chain Locking Tool is removed or out of placement, the engine front cover must be removed and
the engine must be retimed. For additional information, refer to Timing Drive Components See:
Timing Components/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement.
Remove the bolt and remove the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly from camshaft.
- Discard the bolt and washer.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1906
13. Remove the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly from the timing chain and inspect for
damage.
Installation
1. NOTICE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Locking Tool at any time during assembly. If the
Timing Chain Locking Tool is removed or
out of placement, the engine front cover must be removed and the engine must be retimed. For
additional information, refer to Timing Drive Components See: Timing Components/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement.
NOTICE: The timing chain must be installed in its original position onto the camshaft phaser and
sprocket using the scribed marks, or damage to valves and pistons will result.
NOTE: If replacement of the camshaft phaser and sprocket is necessary, transfer the scribe mark
to the new camshaft phaser and sprocket.
Position the camshaft phaser and sprocket into the timing chain with the timing chain scribe marks
in alignment.
2. NOTICE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Locking Tool at any time during assembly. If the
Timing Chain Locking Tool is removed or
out of placement, the engine front cover must be removed and the engine must be retimed. For
additional information, refer to Timing Drive Components See: Timing Components/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement.
NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or used
as a lifting or leveraging device.
NOTICE: Only use hand tools to install the camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt or damage may
occur to the camshaft or camshaft phaser and sprocket.
Install the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly onto the camshaft and install a new camshaft
phaser and sprocket bolt finger-tight.
3. NOTE: Engine front cover removed for clarity.
Remove the Timing Chain Locking Tool.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1907
4. Rotate the crankshaft a half turn counterclockwise and position the crankshaft damper spoke at
the 12 o'clock position and the timing mark
indentation at the 1 o'clock position.
5. Verify correct camshaft position by noting the position of the No. 1 cylinder intake and exhaust
camshaft lobes.
6. NOTE: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off of the valve or the valve may drop into the
cylinder. If a valve drops into the cylinder, the
cylinder head must be removed. For additional information, refer to Cylinder Head See: Cylinder
Head Assembly/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Cylinder Head - Removal.
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
Using the Valve Spring Compressor, install the 3 originally removed camshaft roller followers.
7. NOTE: Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Install the CMP sensor and the bolt.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1908
8. Connect the CMP electrical connector.
9. NOTICE: Only use hand tools to install the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly or damage
may occur to the camshaft or camshaft
phaser and sprocket.
NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or used
as a lifting or leveraging device.
Tighten the new camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt in 2 stages:
- Stage 1: Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
- Stage 2: Tighten an additional 90 degrees.
10. Install the RH valve cover. For additional information, refer to Valve Cover - RH See: Cylinder
Head Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and
Repair/Valve Cover - RH.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Lifter / Lash Adjuster: Procedures
Hydraulic Lash Adjuster Inspection
1. Inspect the hydraulic lash adjuster and roller follower for damage. If any damage is found,
inspect the camshaft lobes and valves for damage.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1913
Lifter / Lash Adjuster: Removal and Replacement
Valve Train Components - Exploded View
Valve Train Components - Exploded View
NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Hydraulic Lash Adjuster
Hydraulic Lash Adjuster
Removal and Installation
RH cylinder head hydraulic lash adjusters
1. Remove the RH camshaft. For additional information, refer to Camshaft - RH See:
Camshaft/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Camshaft - RH.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1914
LH cylinder head hydraulic lash adjusters
2. Remove the LH camshaft. For additional information, refer to Camshaft - LH See:
Camshaft/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Camshaft - LH.
All hydraulic lash adjusters
3. Remove the camshaft roller follower from the hydraulic lash adjuster being serviced.
4. NOTICE: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Mark the components for installation into
their original locations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in engine damage.
Remove the hydraulic lash adjuster that is being serviced.
5. Inspect the hydraulic lash adjuster.
6. NOTE: Lubricate the hydraulic lash adjuster with clean engine oil prior to installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Rocker Arm Assembly: Procedures
Roller Follower Inspection
1. Inspect the roller follower for flat spots or scoring. If any damage is found, inspect the camshaft
lobes and hydraulic lash adjuster for damage.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1919
Rocker Arm Assembly: Removal and Replacement
Valve Train Components - Exploded View
Valve Train Components - Exploded View
NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Camshaft Roller Follower
Camshaft Roller Follower
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1920
Removal
LH cylinder head camshaft roller followers
1. Remove the LH valve cover. For additional information, refer to Valve Cover - LH See: Cylinder
Head Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and
Repair/Valve Cover - LH.
RH cylinder head camshaft roller followers
2. Remove the RH valve cover. For additional information, refer to Valve Cover - RH See: Cylinder
Head Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and
Repair/Valve Cover - RH.
All camshaft roller followers
3. Rotate the crankshaft until the piston for the valve being serviced is at the top of its stroke with
the intake valve and the exhaust valves closed.
4. NOTICE: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Mark the components for installation into
their original locations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in engine damage.
NOTE: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off of the valve or the valve may drop into the cylinder.
If a valve drops into the cylinder, the cylinder head must be removed. For additional information,
refer to Cylinder Head See: Cylinder Head Assembly/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Cylinder Head - Removal.
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
Using the Valve Spring Compressor, compress the valve spring and remove the camshaft roller
follower.
5. Repeat the previous 2 steps for each camshaft roller follower being serviced.
6. Inspect the camshaft roller follower.
Installation
All camshaft roller followers
1. NOTICE: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Failure to follow these instructions may
result in engine damage.
NOTE: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off of the valve or the valve may drop into the cylinder.
If a valve drops into the cylinder, the cylinder head must be removed. For additional information,
refer to Cylinder Head See: Cylinder Head Assembly/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Cylinder Head - Removal.
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
NOTE: Lubricate the camshaft roller followers with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Using the Valve Spring Compressor, compress the valve spring and install the camshaft roller
follower.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1921
2. Repeat the previous step for each camshaft roller follower being serviced.
LH cylinder head camshaft roller followers
3. Install the LH valve cover. For additional information, refer to Valve Cover - LH See: Cylinder
Head Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and
Repair/Valve Cover - LH.
RH cylinder head camshaft roller followers
4. Install the RH valve cover. For additional information, refer to Valve Cover - RH See: Cylinder
Head Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and
Repair/Valve Cover - RH.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Variable Valve Timing
Actuator: > 10-18-4 > Sep > 10 > Engine - Low Frequency Hot Idle Knocking Noise
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Customer Interest Engine - Low Frequency Hot Idle Knocking
Noise
TSB 10-18-4
09/27/10
LOW FREQUENCY ENGINE KNOCKING NOISE AT HOT IDLE
FORD: 2009-2010 Expedition, F-150, F-250, F-350
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 09-23-7 to update the vehicle model lines, Service Procedure and
Service Labor Time Standards.
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 F-150 and F-Super Duty vehicles equipped with a 4.6L 3V or 5.4L 3V
engine, Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a low frequency knocking noise from the
engine at hot idle only. The noise is predominately heard from the right front wheel well area and/or
the right hand (RH) engine cam cover. This noise may be generated from the RH variable camshaft
timing (VCT) phaser assembly. This procedure was created to diagnose the RH VCT phaser
assembly.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) tests were developed specifically for the vehicles and
Power Control Module (PCM) strategies for these vehicles.
Per Workshop Manual (WSM), Powertrain Controls and Emissions Diagnostics (PC/ED) and
Scheduled Maintenance Guide, review customer service history for use of any aftermarket oil
filters.
1. Check for possible diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs).
a. No DTCs present, proceed to Step 2.
b. If DTCs are present, do not continue with this procedure and refer to the PC/ED manual for
diagnostics.
2. Engine must be at full operating temperature over 190 °F (88 °C) cylinder head temperature
(CHT).
3. Connect IDS diagnostics tool and verify software version is at the latest level (63 or later
required).
4. Begin a new vehicle session.
5. Open Tool Box selection.
6. Open Data Logger.
7. Select Powertrain Engine.
8. Select PCM Data Logger.
9. Clear the preselected items by clicking the eraser icon button.
10. Select variable cam timing desired angle number (VCLDSD).
11. Go to live display and press the tick mark.
12. Make sure the parameter identification (PID) is highlighted with the dark lines above and below
the data being displayed.
13. Press number symbol: (output state control mode) of the VCT_DSD number PID.
14. Press the Control Item Activate (finger on the button) icon to enable manual control of the PID.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Variable Valve Timing
Actuator: > 10-18-4 > Sep > 10 > Engine - Low Frequency Hot Idle Knocking Noise > Page 1930
15. Use the plus button to command to 4 degrees. (One click is equal to 1 degree) When
commanding the advance, both banks will normally adjust.
16. Listen carefully to the low frequency knock noise while commanding the VCT_DSD from 0 to 4
degrees. Some higher frequency clatter is normal
at or above the 5 degree advance. What is being pursued is for the level of the low frequency
knock noise to be noticeably reduced when advanced from 4 to 5 degrees.
a. If noise level is noticeably reduced as the VCT desired angle is commanded from 3 to 4 degrees,
the noise source is the RH VCT phaser
assembly. Proceed to Step 17.
b. If the low frequency knock noise is not noticeably reduced at 4 degrees, refer to WSM, Section
303-00 for engine noise diagnostics.
17. Due to normal engine dynamics, the VCT phaser knock noise is produced by the RH VCT
phaser assembly. Replace only the RH VCT phaser
assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 303-01.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT:Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101804A 2009-2010 Expedition, 2.3 Hrs
Navigator 5.4L 3V: Replace The RH VCT Phaser Assembly Includes Time To Diagnose (Do Not
Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101804A 2009-2010 F-150 4.6L 3V: 1.8 Hrs.
Replace The RH VCT Phaser Assembly Includes Time To Diagnose (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101804A 2009-2010 F-150, F-Super 2.1 Hrs.
Duty 5.4L 3V: Replace The RH VCT Phaser Assembly Includes Time To Diagnose (Do Not Use
With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
6A257 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Variable Valve
Timing Actuator: > 10-18-4 > Sep > 10 > Engine - Low Frequency Hot Idle Knocking Noise
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Low Frequency Hot Idle
Knocking Noise
TSB 10-18-4
09/27/10
LOW FREQUENCY ENGINE KNOCKING NOISE AT HOT IDLE
FORD: 2009-2010 Expedition, F-150, F-250, F-350
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 09-23-7 to update the vehicle model lines, Service Procedure and
Service Labor Time Standards.
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 F-150 and F-Super Duty vehicles equipped with a 4.6L 3V or 5.4L 3V
engine, Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a low frequency knocking noise from the
engine at hot idle only. The noise is predominately heard from the right front wheel well area and/or
the right hand (RH) engine cam cover. This noise may be generated from the RH variable camshaft
timing (VCT) phaser assembly. This procedure was created to diagnose the RH VCT phaser
assembly.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) tests were developed specifically for the vehicles and
Power Control Module (PCM) strategies for these vehicles.
Per Workshop Manual (WSM), Powertrain Controls and Emissions Diagnostics (PC/ED) and
Scheduled Maintenance Guide, review customer service history for use of any aftermarket oil
filters.
1. Check for possible diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs).
a. No DTCs present, proceed to Step 2.
b. If DTCs are present, do not continue with this procedure and refer to the PC/ED manual for
diagnostics.
2. Engine must be at full operating temperature over 190 °F (88 °C) cylinder head temperature
(CHT).
3. Connect IDS diagnostics tool and verify software version is at the latest level (63 or later
required).
4. Begin a new vehicle session.
5. Open Tool Box selection.
6. Open Data Logger.
7. Select Powertrain Engine.
8. Select PCM Data Logger.
9. Clear the preselected items by clicking the eraser icon button.
10. Select variable cam timing desired angle number (VCLDSD).
11. Go to live display and press the tick mark.
12. Make sure the parameter identification (PID) is highlighted with the dark lines above and below
the data being displayed.
13. Press number symbol: (output state control mode) of the VCT_DSD number PID.
14. Press the Control Item Activate (finger on the button) icon to enable manual control of the PID.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Variable Valve
Timing Actuator: > 10-18-4 > Sep > 10 > Engine - Low Frequency Hot Idle Knocking Noise > Page 1936
15. Use the plus button to command to 4 degrees. (One click is equal to 1 degree) When
commanding the advance, both banks will normally adjust.
16. Listen carefully to the low frequency knock noise while commanding the VCT_DSD from 0 to 4
degrees. Some higher frequency clatter is normal
at or above the 5 degree advance. What is being pursued is for the level of the low frequency
knock noise to be noticeably reduced when advanced from 4 to 5 degrees.
a. If noise level is noticeably reduced as the VCT desired angle is commanded from 3 to 4 degrees,
the noise source is the RH VCT phaser
assembly. Proceed to Step 17.
b. If the low frequency knock noise is not noticeably reduced at 4 degrees, refer to WSM, Section
303-00 for engine noise diagnostics.
17. Due to normal engine dynamics, the VCT phaser knock noise is produced by the RH VCT
phaser assembly. Replace only the RH VCT phaser
assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 303-01.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT:Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101804A 2009-2010 Expedition, 2.3 Hrs
Navigator 5.4L 3V: Replace The RH VCT Phaser Assembly Includes Time To Diagnose (Do Not
Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101804A 2009-2010 F-150 4.6L 3V: 1.8 Hrs.
Replace The RH VCT Phaser Assembly Includes Time To Diagnose (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101804A 2009-2010 F-150, F-Super 2.1 Hrs.
Duty 5.4L 3V: Replace The RH VCT Phaser Assembly Includes Time To Diagnose (Do Not Use
With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
6A257 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1937
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Description and Operation
Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) System
Overview
The VCT system enables rotation of the camshaft(s) relative to the crankshaft rotation as a function
of engine operating conditions. There are four types of VCT systems.
- Exhaust phase shifting (EPS) system - the exhaust cam is the active cam being retarded.
- Intake phase shifting (IPS) system - the intake cam is the active cam being advanced.
- Dual equal phase shifting (DEPS) system - both intake and exhaust cams are phase shifted and
equally advanced or retarded.
- Dual independent phase shifting (DIPS) system - where both the intake and exhaust cams are
shifted independently.
All systems have four operational modes: idle, part throttle, wide open throttle (WOT), and default
mode. At idle and low engine speeds with closed throttle, the powertrain control module (PCM)
determines the phase angle based on air flow, engine oil temperature and engine coolant
temperature. At part and wide open throttle the PCM determines the phase angle based on engine
RPM, load, and throttle position. VCT systems provide reduced emissions and enhanced engine
power, fuel economy and idle quality. IPS systems also have the added benefit of improved torque.
In addition, some VCT system applications can eliminate the need for an external exhaust gas
recirculation (EGR) system. The elimination of the EGR system is accomplished by controlling the
overlap time between the intake valve opening and exhaust valve closing. Currently, both the IPS
and DEPS systems are used.
The VCT system knocking and noise concerns are diagnosed in the Testing and Inspection
section. For additional information, refer to the Engine System - General Information. Verification of
incorrect VCT phasing on a warm engine operating below 1500 RPM can be isolated using a
stethoscope and by monitoring the VCTADV, VCTADVERR and VCTDC PIDs using a scan tool. If
the VCT phaser does not maintain correct valve timing, low oil pressure or oil flow restrictions are
primary possible causes. Verify correct oil pressure and flow, refer to the Engine System - General
Information.
Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) System
The VCT system consists of an electric hydraulic positioning control solenoid, a camshaft position
(CMP) sensor, and a trigger wheel. The CMP trigger wheel indicates the CMP signal for that bank.
A crankshaft position (CKP) sensor provides the PCM with crankshaft positioning information in 10
degree increments.
1. The PCM receives input signals from the intake air temperature (IAT), engine coolant
temperature (ECT), engine oil temperature (EOT), CMP,
throttle position (TP), mass air flow (MAF), and CKP sensors to determine the operating conditions
of the engine. At idle and low engine speeds with closed throttle, the PCM controls the camshaft
position based on ECT, EOT, IAT, and MAF. During part and wide open throttle, the camshaft
position is determined by engine RPM, load and throttle position. The VCT system does not
operate until the engine is at normal operating temperature.
2. The VCT system is enabled by the PCM when the correct conditions are met. 3. The CKP signal
is used as a reference for CMP positioning. 4. The VCT solenoid valve is an integral part of the
VCT system. The solenoid valve controls the flow of engine oil in the VCT actuator assembly.
As the PCM controls the duty cycle of the solenoid valve, oil pressure/flow advances or retards the
cam timing. Duty cycles near 0% or 100% represent rapid movement of the camshaft. Retaining a
fixed camshaft position is accomplished by dithering (oscillating) the solenoid valve duty cycle. The
PCM calculates and determines the desired camshaft position. It continually updates the VCT
solenoid duty cycle until the desired position is
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1938
achieved. A difference between the desired and actual camshaft position represents a position
error in the PCM VCT control loop. The PCM disables the VCT and places the camshaft in a
default position if a concern is detected. A related DTC is also set when the concern is detected.
5. When the VCT solenoid is energized, engine oil is allowed to flow to the VCT actuator assembly
which advances or retards the camshaft timing.
One half of the VCT actuator is coupled to the camshaft and the other half is connected to the
timing chain. Oil chambers between the two halves couple the camshaft to the timing chain. When
the flow of oil is shifted from one side of the chamber to the other, the differential change in oil
pressure forces the camshaft to rotate in either an advance or retard position depending on the oil
flow.
VCT System
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Cover / Housing > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Variable Valve Timing Cover / Housing: Procedures
Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Housing Cleaning and Inspection
1. Remove the screw and the Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) oil control solenoid.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
2. Clean the mating surfaces and oil passages with metal surface prep. Follow the directions on the
packaging.
3. Inspect the VCT housing for pitting, cracks or damaged sealing surfaces. Install a new VCT
housing if damaged.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Cover / Housing > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1943
Variable Valve Timing Cover / Housing: Removal and Replacement
Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Housing
Removal
All Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) housings
1. Remove the timing drive components. For additional information, refer to Timing Drive
Components See: Timing Components/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement.
RH VCT housing
2. Remove the 2 bolts and the RH Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) housing.
LH VCT housing
3. Remove the 2 bolts and the LH VCT housing.
All VCT housings
4. Remove and discard the VCT housing gasket.
5. NOTICE: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These tools
cause scratches and gouges which make leak paths. Use a plastic scraping tool to remove all
traces of old sealant.
Clean and inspect the cylinder head sealing surfaces with metal surface prep. Follow the directions
on the packaging.
6. Clean and inspect the VCT housing.
Installation
All VCT housing
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Cover / Housing > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1944
1. Install a new gasket onto the VCT housing.
RH VCT housing
2. Position the RH VCT housing and install the 2 bolts.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
LH VCT housing
3. Position the LH VCT housing and install the 2 bolts.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
All VCT housings
4. Install the timing drive components. For additional information, refer to Timing Drive Components
See: Timing Components/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications
Connecting Rod Bearing: Specifications
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1949
a The time required for the plunger to leak down 1.6 mm (0.062 in) of travel with 222 N force and
leak-down fluid in the lash adjuster.
b The pin bore and crank bearing bore must be parallel and in the same vertical plane within the
specified total difference when measured at the ends of
a 203 mm bar, 105.5 mm on each side of rod centerline.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1950
Connecting Rod Bearing: Service and Repair
Bearing Inspection
1. Inspect bearings for the following defects:
1. Cratering - fatigue failure
2. Spot polishing - incorrect seating
3. Imbedded dirty engine oil
4. Scratching - dirty engine oil
5. Base exposed - poor lubrication
6. Both edges worn - journal damaged
7. One edge worn - journal tapered or bearing not seated
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Connecting Rod: Specifications
CONNECTING ROD
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1954
a The time required for the plunger to leak down 1.6 mm (0.062 in) of travel with 222 N force and
leak-down fluid in the lash adjuster.
b The pin bore and crank bearing bore must be parallel and in the same vertical plane within the
specified total difference when measured at the ends of
a 203 mm bar, 105.5 mm on each side of rod centerline.
ROD BEARING CAP
Tighten the 16 bolts in 2 stages, in the sequence shown. Stage 1: Tighten to....................................
.....................................................................................................................................................43
Nm (32 lb-ft). Stage 2: Tighten an additional........................................................................................
.......................................................................................105 degrees.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1955
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Connecting Rod Bearing Journal Taper and Out-of-Round
Connecting Rod: Service and Repair Connecting Rod Bearing Journal Taper and Out-of-Round
Connecting Rod Bearing Journal Taper and Out-of-Round
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
1. Measure the crankshaft connecting rod journal diameters in 2 directions perpendicular to one
another at each end of the connecting rod journal.
The difference in the measurements from one end to the other is the taper. Verify measurement is
within the wear limit.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Connecting Rod Bearing Journal Taper and Out-of-Round > Page 1958
Connecting Rod: Service and Repair Connecting Rod Bearing Journal-to-Bearing Clearance
Connecting Rod Bearing Journal-to-Bearing Clearance
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
NOTE: The crankshaft connecting rod journals must be within specifications to check the
connecting rod bearing journal clearance.
1. Remove the connecting rod bearing cap.
2. Position a piece of Plastigage across the bearing surface.
3. NOTE: Do not turn the crankshaft during this step.
Install and tighten to specifications, then remove the connecting rod bearing cap.
4. Measure the Plastigage to get the connecting rod bearing journal clearance. The Plastigage
should be smooth and flat. A changing width indicates
a tapered or damaged connecting rod or connecting rod bearing.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Connecting Rod Bearing Journal Taper and Out-of-Round > Page 1959
Connecting Rod: Service and Repair Connecting Rod Bend
Connecting Rod Bend
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
1. Using the Feeler Gauge Set, measure the connecting rod bend on a suitable alignment fixture.
Follow the instructions of the fixture manufacturer.
Verify the bend measurement is within specification.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Connecting Rod Bearing Journal Taper and Out-of-Round > Page 1960
Connecting Rod: Service and Repair Connecting Rod Bushing Diameter
Connecting Rod Bushing Diameter
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
1. Use a telescoping gauge to determine the ID of the connecting rod bushing, if equipped.
2. Measure the telescoping gauge with a micrometer. Verify the diameter is within specification.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Connecting Rod Bearing Journal Taper and Out-of-Round > Page 1961
Connecting Rod: Service and Repair
Connecting Rod Bearing Journal Taper and Out-of-Round
Connecting Rod Bearing Journal Taper and Out-of-Round
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
1. Measure the crankshaft connecting rod journal diameters in 2 directions perpendicular to one
another at each end of the connecting rod journal.
The difference in the measurements from one end to the other is the taper. Verify measurement is
within the wear limit.
Connecting Rod Bearing Journal-to-Bearing Clearance
Connecting Rod Bearing Journal-to-Bearing Clearance
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
NOTE: The crankshaft connecting rod journals must be within specifications to check the
connecting rod bearing journal clearance.
1. Remove the connecting rod bearing cap.
2. Position a piece of Plastigage across the bearing surface.
3. NOTE: Do not turn the crankshaft during this step.
Install and tighten to specifications, then remove the connecting rod bearing cap.
4. Measure the Plastigage to get the connecting rod bearing journal clearance. The Plastigage
should be smooth and flat. A changing width indicates
a tapered or damaged connecting rod or connecting rod bearing.
Connecting Rod Bend
Connecting Rod Bend
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Connecting Rod Bearing Journal Taper and Out-of-Round > Page 1962
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
1. Using the Feeler Gauge Set, measure the connecting rod bend on a suitable alignment fixture.
Follow the instructions of the fixture manufacturer.
Verify the bend measurement is within specification.
Connecting Rod Bushing Diameter
Connecting Rod Bushing Diameter
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
1. Use a telescoping gauge to determine the ID of the connecting rod bushing, if equipped.
2. Measure the telescoping gauge with a micrometer. Verify the diameter is within specification.
Connecting Rod Cleaning
Connecting Rod Cleaning
NOTICE: Do not use a caustic cleaning solution or damage to connecting rods can occur.
1. NOTE: The connecting rod large end is a matched set. The connecting rod cap must be installed
on the original connecting rod in the original
position. Do not reverse the cap. Parts are not interchangeable.
Mark and separate the parts and clean with solvent. Clean the oil passages.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Connecting Rod Bearing Journal Taper and Out-of-Round > Page 1963
Connecting Rod Large End Bore
Connecting Rod Large End Bore
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
1. Tighten the bolts to specification, then measure the bore in 2 directions. The difference is the
connecting rod bore out-of-round. Verify the
out-of-round is within specification.
Connecting Rod to Crankshaft Side Clearance
Connecting Rod to Crankshaft Side Clearance
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
1. Using the Feeler Gauge Set, measure the clearance between the connecting rod and the
crankshaft. Verify the measurement is within specification.
Connecting Rod Twist
Connecting Rod Twist
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Connecting Rod Bearing Journal Taper and Out-of-Round > Page 1964
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
1. Using the Feeler Gauge Set, measure the connecting rod twist on a suitable alignment fixture.
Follow the instructions of the fixture manufacturer.
Verify the measurement is within specification.
Connecting Rod-to-Piston Clearance
Connecting Rod-to-Piston Clearance
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
1. Using the Feeler Gauge Set, measure the clearance between the connecting rod and the piston.
Verify the measurement is within specification.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Specifications
a The time required for the plunger to leak down 1.6 mm (0.062 in) of travel with 222 N force and
leak-down fluid in the lash adjuster.
b The pin bore and crank bearing bore must be parallel and in the same vertical plane within the
specified total difference when measured at the ends of
a 203 mm bar, 105.5 mm on each side of rod centerline.
MAIN BEARING CAP
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1968
Install the 10 vertical main bearing cap fasteners and tighten in 2 stages, in the sequence shown.
Stage 1: Tighten to...............................................................................................................................
..........................................................40 Nm (30 lb-ft). Stage 2: Tighten an additional.........................
........................................................................................................................................................90
degrees.
Install the 10 side bolts and tighten them in 2 stages, in the sequence shown. Stage 1: Tighten to ...
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................... 30 Nm (22 lb-ft). Stage 2: Tighten .................................................................................
............................................................................................. an additional 90 degrees.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1969
ERROR: stackunderflow
OFFENDING COMMAND: ~
STACK:
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1970
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Service and Repair
Bearing Inspection
1. Inspect bearings for the following defects:
1. Cratering - fatigue failure
2. Spot polishing - incorrect seating
3. Imbedded dirty engine oil
4. Scratching - dirty engine oil
5. Base exposed - poor lubrication
6. Both edges worn - journal damaged
7. One edge worn - journal tapered or bearing not seated
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Crankshaft: Specifications
a The time required for the plunger to leak down 1.6 mm (0.062 in) of travel with 222 N force and
leak-down fluid in the lash adjuster.
b The pin bore and crank bearing bore must be parallel and in the same vertical plane within the
specified total difference when measured at the ends of
a 203 mm bar, 105.5 mm on each side of rod centerline.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Main Bearing Journal Taper And Out-Of-Round
Crankshaft: Service and Repair Crankshaft Main Bearing Journal Taper And Out-Of-Round
Crankshaft Main Bearing Journal Taper and Out-of-Round
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
1. Measure each of the crankshaft main bearing journal diameters in at least 2 directions at each
end of the main bearing journal.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Main Bearing Journal Taper And Out-Of-Round > Page 1976
Crankshaft: Service and Repair Crankshaft Main Bearing Journal-To-Bearing Clearance
Crankshaft Main Bearing Journal-to-Bearing Clearance
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
NOTE: Crankshaft main bearing journals must be within specifications before checking journal
clearance.
1. Remove the crankshaft main bearing caps and crankshaft main bearing.
2. Lay a piece of Plastigage across the face of each crankshaft main bearing surface.
3. NOTE: Do not turn the crankshaft while carrying out this procedure.
Install and remove the crankshaft main bearing cap.
4. Verify the crankshaft journal clearance.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Main Bearing Journal Taper And Out-Of-Round > Page 1977
Crankshaft: Service and Repair Crankshaft End Play
Crankshaft End Play
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
1. Install the Dial Indicator Gauge with Holding Fixture.
2. Position the crankshaft to the rear of the cylinder block.
3. Zero the Dial Indicator Gauge.
4. Move the crankshaft to the front of the cylinder block. Note and record the crankshaft end play.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Main Bearing Journal Taper And Out-Of-Round > Page 1978
Crankshaft: Service and Repair Crankshaft Main Bearing Journal Diameter
Crankshaft Main Bearing Journal Diameter
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
1. Measure each of the crankshaft main bearing journal diameters in at least 2 directions.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Engine Block Heater >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Engine Block Heater: Service and Repair
Block Heater
Removal and Installation
1. Drain the engine cooling system. For additional information, refer to Cooling System Draining,
Filling and Bleeding See: Cooling System/Service
and Repair/Cooling System Draining, Filling And Bleeding.
2. NOTE: Do not loosen the block heater retaining screw more than necessary for removal.
Loosen the block heater retaining screw and remove the block heater.
- To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
3. NOTICE: Route the block heater power cable away from hot or rotating components, or damage
to the cable can occur.
NOTE: Lubricate the block heater O-ring seal with clean engine coolant prior to installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications
Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Specifications
Tighten the new crankshaft pulley bolt in 4 stages. Stage 1: Tighten to..............................................
...........................................................................................................................................90 Nm (66
lb-ft). Stage 2: Loosen..........................................................................................................................
...........................................................................360 degrees. Stage 3: Tighten to..............................
...........................................................................................................................................................5
0 Nm (37 lb-ft). Stage 4: Tighten an additional.....................................................................................
............................................................................................90 degrees.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1985
Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Pulley
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the cooling fan.
3. Rotate the tensioner clockwise and remove the accessory drive belt from the crankshaft pulley.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1986
4. Remove the crankshaft pulley bolt and washer.
- Discard the crankshaft pulley bolt.
5. Using the 3-Jaw Puller, remove the crankshaft pulley.
Installation
1. NOTE: If not secured within 4 minutes, the sealant must be removed and the sealing area
cleaned with metal surface prep and silicone gasket
remover. Allow to dry until there is no sign of wetness, or 4 minutes, whichever is longer. Failure to
follow this procedure can cause future oil leakage.
Apply silicone gasket and sealant to the Woodruff key slot in the crankshaft pulley.
2. Lubricate the crankshaft pulley sealing area with clean engine oil prior to installation.
3. Using the Crankshaft Vibration Damper Installer, install the crankshaft pulley.
4. Using a new crankshaft pulley bolt, install the bolt and washer and tighten the bolt in 4 stages.
- Stage 1: Tighten to 90 Nm (66 lb-ft).
- Stage 2: Loosen 360 degrees.
- Stage 3: Tighten to 50 Nm (37 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1987
- Stage 4: Tighten an additional 90 degrees.
5. Rotate the tensioner clockwise and install the accessory drive belt onto the crankshaft pulley.
6. Install the cooling fan.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Piston: Specifications
a The time required for the plunger to leak down 1.6 mm (0.062 in) of travel with 222 N force and
leak-down fluid in the lash adjuster.
b The pin bore and crank bearing bore must be parallel and in the same vertical plane within the
specified total difference when measured at the ends of
a 203 mm bar, 105.5 mm on each side of rod centerline.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Piston: Procedures
Piston Inspection
Piston Inspection
NOTICE: Do not use a caustic cleaning solution or a wire brush to clean the pistons or damage can
occur.
1. Clean and inspect the (1) ring lands, (2) skirts, (3) pin bosses and the (4) tops of the pistons. If
wear marks, scores or glazing is found on the piston
skirt, check for a bent or twisted connecting rod.
2. Use the Piston Ring Groove Scraper to clean the piston ring grooves.
- Make sure the oil ring holes are clean.
Piston Pin Bore Diameter
Piston Pin Bore Diameter
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
1. NOTE: Piston and piston pins are a matched set and should not be interchanged.
Measure the piston pin bore diameter in 2 directions on each side. Verify the diameter is within
specification.
Piston Diameter
Piston Diameter
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1993
1. Measure the piston diameter 90 degrees from the piston pin and 42 mm (1.65 in) down from the
top of the piston at the point indicated.
Piston To Cylinder Bore Clearance
Piston To Cylinder Bore Clearance
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
1. Subtract the piston diameter from the cylinder bore diameter to find the piston-to-cylinder bore
clearance.
Piston Selection
Piston Selection
NOTE: The cylinder bore must be within the specifications for taper and out-of-round before fitting
a piston.
1. Select a piston size based on the cylinder bore.
2. NOTE: For precision fit, new pistons are divided into 3 categories within each size range based
on their relative position within the range. A paint
spot or specific size grade on a new piston indicates the position within the size range.
Choose the piston with the correct paint color or specific size grade.
- Refer to the appropriate system for the procedure.
Piston Ring End Gap
Piston Ring End Gap
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1994
NOTICE: Use care when fitting piston rings to avoid possible damage to the piston ring or the
cylinder bore.
NOTE: Piston rings should not be transferred from one piston to another.
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
NOTE: The cylinder bore must be within specification for taper and out-of-round.
1. Use a piston without rings to push a piston ring in a cylinder to the bottom of ring travel.
2. Use the Feeler Gauge Set to measure the top piston ring end gap and the second piston ring
end gap.
Piston Ring-To-Groove Clearance
Piston Ring-to-Groove Clearance
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
1. Inspect the piston for ring land damage or accelerated wear.
2. Using the Feeler Gauge Set, measure the piston ring-to-groove clearance.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1995
Piston Pin Diameter
Piston Pin Diameter
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
1. Measure the piston pin diameter in 2 directions at the points shown. Verify the diameter is within
specification.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1996
Piston: Overhaul
Piston
Disassembly
WARNING: Since the retainer ring has a tendency to spring out, cover the end of the pin bore with
a hand or shop rag when removing the ring. Wear eye protection. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in serious personal injury.
1. Remove the piston rings from the piston.
- Discard the piston rings.
2. Mark the piston and connecting rod on the same side for assembly reference.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1997
3. Remove the 2 piston pin retainers and the piston pin.
4. Separate the piston from the connecting rod.
5. Clean and inspect the piston and connecting rod.
Assembly
1. NOTE: The connecting rod must be installed into the piston with the marks made during
disassembly on the same side. If a new piston or
connecting rod is being installed, it can be installed in either direction.
Position the connecting rod in the piston.
2. Lubricate the piston pin and pin bore with clean engine oil.
3. Install the piston pin in the piston and connecting rod assembly.
4. Install the 2 piston pin retaining clips in the piston.
5. Lubricate the piston and the new piston rings with clean engine oil.
6. Install the piston rings onto the piston.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Ring, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Piston Ring: Specifications
a The time required for the plunger to leak down 1.6 mm (0.062 in) of travel with 222 N force and
leak-down fluid in the lash adjuster.
b The pin bore and crank bearing bore must be parallel and in the same vertical plane within the
specified total difference when measured at the ends of
a 203 mm bar, 105.5 mm on each side of rod centerline.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Fuel Pressure Release >
System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
Fuel System Pressure Release
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Before working on or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components,
relieve the fuel system pressure to prevent accidental spraying of fuel. Fuel in the fuel system
remains under high pressure, even when the engine is not running. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: When handling fuel, always observe fuel handling precautions and be prepared in the
event of fuel spillage. Spilled fuel may be ignited by hot vehicle components or other ignition
sources. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
2. Remove the cap from the fuel pressure relief valve located on the fuel rail.
3. Install the Fuel Pressure Test Kit onto the fuel pressure relief valve.
4. NOTE: Open the manual valve slowly to relieve the system pressure. This may drain fuel from
the fuel system. Place fuel in a suitable container.
Open the manual valve on the Fuel Pressure Test Kit and relieve the fuel pressure.
5. NOTE: It may take more than one key cycle to pressurize the fuel system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Fuel Pressure Release >
System Information > Service and Repair > Page 2005
Cycle the ignition key and wait 3 seconds to pressurize the fuel system. Check for leaks before
starting the engine.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Rocker Arm Assembly: Procedures
Roller Follower Inspection
1. Inspect the roller follower for flat spots or scoring. If any damage is found, inspect the camshaft
lobes and hydraulic lash adjuster for damage.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2010
Rocker Arm Assembly: Removal and Replacement
Valve Train Components - Exploded View
Valve Train Components - Exploded View
NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Camshaft Roller Follower
Camshaft Roller Follower
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2011
Removal
LH cylinder head camshaft roller followers
1. Remove the LH valve cover. For additional information, refer to Valve Cover - LH See: Valve
Cover/Service and Repair/Valve Cover - LH.
RH cylinder head camshaft roller followers
2. Remove the RH valve cover. For additional information, refer to Valve Cover - RH See: Valve
Cover/Service and Repair/Valve Cover - RH.
All camshaft roller followers
3. Rotate the crankshaft until the piston for the valve being serviced is at the top of its stroke with
the intake valve and the exhaust valves closed.
4. NOTICE: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Mark the components for installation into
their original locations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in engine damage.
NOTE: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off of the valve or the valve may drop into the cylinder.
If a valve drops into the cylinder, the cylinder head must be removed. For additional information,
refer to Cylinder Head See: Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Cylinder Head Removal.
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
Using the Valve Spring Compressor, compress the valve spring and remove the camshaft roller
follower.
5. Repeat the previous 2 steps for each camshaft roller follower being serviced.
6. Inspect the camshaft roller follower.
Installation
All camshaft roller followers
1. NOTICE: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Failure to follow these instructions may
result in engine damage.
NOTE: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off of the valve or the valve may drop into the cylinder.
If a valve drops into the cylinder, the cylinder head must be removed. For additional information,
refer to Cylinder Head See: Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Cylinder Head Removal.
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
NOTE: Lubricate the camshaft roller followers with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Using the Valve Spring Compressor, compress the valve spring and install the camshaft roller
follower.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2012
2. Repeat the previous step for each camshaft roller follower being serviced.
LH cylinder head camshaft roller followers
3. Install the LH valve cover. For additional information, refer to Valve Cover - LH See: Valve
Cover/Service and Repair/Valve Cover - LH.
RH cylinder head camshaft roller followers
4. Install the RH valve cover. For additional information, refer to Valve Cover - RH See: Valve
Cover/Service and Repair/Valve Cover - RH.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH
Valve Cover: Service and Repair Valve Cover - LH
Valve Cover - LH
PCV Tube, Engine Wiring Harness Retainers and Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Solenoid
Electrical Connector
Engine Wiring Harness Retainers, Intake Manifold Vacuum Tube, LH Valve Cover and Gasket
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 2017
Removal
1. Remove the Air Cleaner (ACL) outlet pipe.
2. Remove the bolt and position the oil level indicator and tube aside.
3. Disconnect the quick connect couplings and remove the PCV tube.
4. Disconnect the intake manifold vacuum tube hose from the brake booster.
5. Disconnect the intake manifold vacuum tube from the support bracket and the valve cover stud.
6. Disconnect the Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) solenoid electrical connector.
7. Disconnect the 3 wiring harness retainers from the front of the LH valve cover and the 2 wiring
harness retainers from the LH valve cover studs.
8. Remove the 4 LH ignition coils.
9. NOTICE: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These tools
cause scratches and gouges which make leak paths. Use a plastic scraping tool to remove all
traces of old sealant.
NOTICE: When removing the valve cover, make sure to avoid damaging the Variable Camshaft
Timing (VCT) solenoid.
NOTE: The fasteners are part of the valve cover and should not be removed.
Loosen the 10 fasteners and remove the LH valve cover and gasket. Clean the valve cover mating surface of the cylinder head with silicone gasket remover and metal
surface prep. Follow the directions on the packaging.
- Discard the valve cover gasket. Clean the valve cover gasket groove with soap and water or a
suitable solvent.
Installation
1. NOTE: If the valve cover is not secured within 4 minutes, the sealant must be removed and the
sealing area cleaned with silicone gasket remover
and metal surface prep. Follow the directions on the packaging. Allow to dry until there is no sign of
wetness, or 4 minutes, whichever is longer. Failure to follow this procedure can cause future oil
leakage.
Apply a bead of silicone gasket and sealant in 2 places where the engine front cover meets the
cylinder head.
2. NOTICE: When installing the valve cover, make sure to avoid damaging the Variable Camshaft
Timing (VCT) solenoid.
Position the LH valve cover and new gasket on the cylinder head and tighten the 10 fasteners in
the sequence shown.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 2018
3. Position the intake manifold vacuum tube assembly onto the support bracket and the valve cover
stud.
4. Connect the intake manifold vacuum tube hose to the brake booster.
5. Install the 4 LH ignition coils.
6. Connect the 3 wiring harness retainers to the front of the RH valve cover and the 2 wiring
harness retainers to the RH valve cover studs.
7. Connect the VCT solenoid electrical connector.
8. Position the PCV tube and connect the quick connect couplings.
9. Position back the oil level indicator and tube and install the bolt.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
10. Install the ACL outlet pipe.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 2019
Valve Cover: Service and Repair Valve Cover - RH
Valve Cover - RH
Engine Wiring Harness Retainers, Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Solenoid Electrical Connector,
Crankcase Ventilation Tube, RH Valve Cover and Gasket
Removal
Vehicles with auxiliary heat
1. Drain the cooling system.
2. Disconnect the 2 auxiliary heat coolant hoses and position the auxiliary heat coolant hoses
aside.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 2020
All vehicles
3. Disconnect the quick connect couplings and remove the crankcase vent tube.
4. Disconnect the PCM electrical connector and position aside.
5. Remove the nut and the ground cable and disconnect the wiring harness retainer.
6. Disconnect the PCM electrical connector.
7. Disconnect the 2 electrical connectors and the wiring harness retainer and position the wiring
harness aside.
8. Disconnect the RH radio ignition interference capacitor and engine cooling fan clutch electrical
connectors.
9. Remove the 4 RH ignition coils.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 2021
10. Disconnect the RH Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) solenoid electrical connector.
11. Disconnect the 2 engine wiring harness retainers from the RH valve cover studs and position
the wiring harness aside.
12. NOTICE: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These tools
cause scratches and gouges which make leak paths. Use a plastic scraping tool to remove all
traces of old sealant.
NOTICE: When removing the valve cover, make sure to avoid damaging the Variable Camshaft
Timing (VCT) solenoid.
NOTE: The fasteners are part of the valve cover and should not be removed.
Loosen the 9 fasteners and remove the RH valve cover and gasket. Clean the valve cover mating surface of the cylinder head with silicone gasket remover and metal
surface prep. Follow the directions on the packaging.
- Discard the valve cover gasket. Clean the valve cover gasket groove with soap and water or a
suitable solvent.
Installation
All vehicles
1. NOTE: If the valve cover is not secured within 4 minutes, the sealant must be removed and the
sealing area cleaned with silicone gasket remover
and metal surface prep. Follow the directions on the packaging. Allow to dry until there is no sign of
wetness, or 4 minutes, whichever is longer. Failure to follow this procedure can cause future oil
leakage.
Apply a bead of silicone gasket and sealant in 2 places where the engine front cover meets the
cylinder head.
2. NOTICE: When installing the valve cover, make sure to avoid damaging the Variable Camshaft
Timing (VCT) solenoid.
Position the RH valve cover and new gasket on the cylinder head and tighten the 9 fasteners in the
sequence shown.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
3. Install the 4 RH ignition coils.
4. Position back the engine wiring harness and connect the 2 electrical connectors and the wiring
harness retainer.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 2022
5. Connect the PCM electrical connector.
6. Connect the wiring harness retainer and ground cable and install the nut.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
7. Connect the PCM electrical connector.
8. Connect the RH radio ignition interference capacitor and engine cooling fan clutch electrical
connectors.
9. Connect the RH VCT solenoid electrical connector.
10. Connect the wiring harness retainers to the valve cover.
11. Position the crankcase vent tube and connect the quick connect couplings.
Vehicles with auxiliary heat
12. Connect the 2 auxiliary heat coolant hoses.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 2023
13. Fill and bleed the coolant system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Guide > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Valve Guide: Service and Repair
Valve Guide Inner Diameter
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
1. NOTE: Valve guides tend to wear in an hourglass pattern. The ball gauge can be inserted into
the combustion chamber side of the valve guide, if
necessary.
Use a ball gauge to determine the inside diameter of the valve guides in 2 directions at the top,
middle and bottom of the valve guide.
2. Measure the ball gauge with a micrometer.
3. If the valve guide is not within specifications, install a new cylinder head assembly.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Seat > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve And Seat Refacing Measurements
Valve Seat: Service and Repair Valve And Seat Refacing Measurements
Valve Seat Inspection
Valve and Seat Refacing Measurements
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
NOTE: After grinding valves or valve seats, check valve clearance.
1. Check the valve head and seat.
- Check valve angles.
- Check margin width.
- Be sure margin width is within specification.
2. Inspect for abnormalities on the valve face and seat. Install a new cylinder head assembly if
abnormalities are found.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Seat > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve And Seat Refacing Measurements > Page 2031
Valve Seat: Service and Repair Valve Seat Width
Valve Seat Width
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
1. Measure the valve seat width. If necessary, grind the valve seat to specification.
- Measure the intake valve seat width.
- Measure the exhaust valve seat width.
- Recheck the valve spring installed length after the seats have been ground, and shim the valve
springs as necessary to achieve the correct installed spring length.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Seat > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve And Seat Refacing Measurements > Page 2032
Valve Seat: Service and Repair Valve Seat Runout
Valve Seat Runout
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
1. Use a valve seat runout gauge to check valve seat runout.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Valve Spring: Procedures
Valve Spring Installed Length
Valve Spring Installed Length
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
1. Measure the installed length of each valve spring.
Valve Spring Free Length
Valve Spring Free Length
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
1. Measure the free length of each valve spring.
Valve Spring Squareness
Valve Spring Squareness
1. Measure the out-of-square on each valve spring.
- Turn the valve spring and observe the space between the top of the valve spring and the square.
Valve Spring Strength
Valve Spring Strength
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2037
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
1. Use the Valve/Clutch Spring Pressure Gauge to check the valve spring for correct strength at the
specified valve spring length.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2038
Valve Spring: Removal and Replacement
Valve Train Components - Exploded View
Valve Train Components - Exploded View
NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Valve Springs
Valve Springs
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2039
Removal
RH cylinder head valve springs
1. Remove the RH valve cover. For additional information, refer to Valve Cover - RH See: Valve
Cover/Service and Repair/Valve Cover - RH.
LH cylinder head valve springs
2. Remove the LH valve cover. For additional information, refer to Valve Cover - LH See: Valve
Cover/Service and Repair/Valve Cover - LH.
All valve springs
3. Remove the spark plug for the cylinder being serviced.
4. Rotate the crankshaft until the piston for the valve being serviced is at the top of its stroke with
the intake valve and the exhaust valves closed.
5. NOTICE: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Mark the components for installation into
their original locations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in engine damage.
NOTE: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off of the valve or the valve may drop into the cylinder.
If a valve drops into the cylinder, the cylinder head must be removed. For additional information,
refer to Cylinder Head See: Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Cylinder Head Removal.
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
Using the Valve Spring Compressor, compress the valve spring and remove the camshaft roller
follower.
6. Use compressed air in the cylinder being serviced to hold both valves in position.
- Apply a minimum of 965 kPa (140 psi) of compressed air into the cylinder.
7. NOTICE: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Mark the components for installation into
their original locations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in engine damage.
NOTE: If air pressure has forced the piston to the bottom of the cylinder, any loss of air pressure
will allow the valve to fall into the cylinder. If air pressure must be removed, support the valve prior
to removal. If a valve drops into the cylinder, remove the cylinder head. For additional information,
refer to Cylinder Head See: Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Cylinder Head Removal.
Using the Valve Spring Compressor, compress the valve spring and remove the valve spring
retainer keys.
8. Remove the valve spring retainer and the valve spring.
9. Inspect the valve spring.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2040
Installation
All valve springs
1. NOTICE: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Failure to follow these instructions may
result in engine damage.
Using the Valve Spring Compressor, install the valve spring, the valve spring retainer and the valve
spring retainer keys.
2. Relieve the air pressure from the cylinder.
3. NOTICE: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Failure to follow this instruction may
result in engine damage.
NOTE: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off of the valve or the valve may drop into the cylinder.
If a valve drops into the cylinder, the cylinder head must be removed. For additional information,
refer to Cylinder Head See: Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Cylinder Head Removal.
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
NOTE: Lubricate the camshaft roller followers with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Using the Valve Spring Compressor, compress the valve spring and install the camshaft roller
follower.
4. Install the spark plug.
LH cylinder head valve springs
5. Install the LH valve cover. For additional information, refer to Valve Cover - LH See: Valve
Cover/Service and Repair/Valve Cover - LH.
RH cylinder head valve springs
6. Install the RH valve cover. For additional information, refer to Valve Cover - RH See: Valve
Cover/Service and Repair/Valve Cover - RH.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Valve Stem Diameter
Valve: Service and Repair Valve Stem Diameter
Valve Stem Diameter
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
1. Measure the diameter of each intake and exhaust valve stem at the points shown. Verify the
diameter is within specification.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Valve Stem Diameter > Page 2045
Valve: Service and Repair Valve Inspection
Valve Inspection
1. Inspect the following valve areas:
1. The end of the stem for grooves or scoring.
2. The valve face and the edge for pits, grooves or scores.
3. The valve head for signs of burning, erosion, warpage and cracking.
4. The valve margin for wear.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Valve Stem Diameter > Page 2046
Valve: Service and Repair Valve Stem To Valve Guide Clearance
Valve Stem to Valve Guide Clearance
NOTE: Refer to the Engine system level for the specification.
NOTE: The valve stem diameter must be within specifications before checking valve stem-to-valve
guide clearance.
1. NOTE: If necessary, use a magnetic base.
Install a Valve Guide Clearance Gauge on the valve stem and install a Dial Indicator Gauge with
Holding Fixture. Lower the valve until the clearance gauge contacts the upper surface of the valve
guide.
2. Move the Valve Guide Clearance Gauge toward the Dial Indicator Gauge with Holding Fixture
and zero the Dial Indicator Gauge. Move the
Valve Guide Clearance Gauge away from the Dial Indicator Gauge with Holding Fixture and note
the reading. The reading will be DOUBLE the valve stem-to-valve guide clearance.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Diagrams
Drive Belt: Diagrams
Accessory Drive
Accessory Drive Belt Routing
Front End Accessory Drive (FEAD) Components
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Belt - Noise/Flutter
Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection Drive Belt - Noise/Flutter
Accessory Drive
Component Tests
Drive Belt - Noise/Flutter
NOTICE: Under no circumstances should the accessory drive belt, tensioner or pulleys have any
fluids or belt dressing applied to them as damage to the belt material and tensioner damping
mechanism may occur.
Drive belt chirp occurs due to pulley misalignment or excessive pulley runout. It can be the result of
a damaged or incorrectly aligned grooved pulley.
To correct, determine the area where the noise comes from. Check each of the pulleys in that area
with a straightedge to the crankshaft pulley. Look for accessory pulleys out of position in the fore/aft
direction or at an angle to the straightedge.
Drive belt squeal may be an intermittent or constant noise that occurs when the drive belt slips on
an accessory pulley under certain conditions.
A short intermittent squeal may occur during engine start up and shut down or during very rapid
engine acceleration and decelerations, such as:
- Wide Open Throttle (WOT) 1-2 and 2-3 shifts or 2-3 and 3-4 back-out shifts on automatic
transmissions.
- WOT 1-2 and 2-3 shifts and any combination of rapid downshifting on manual transmissions.
These special short-term transient events are expected, and are due to the higher system inertias
required to meet the electrical and cooling demands on today's vehicle systems. Constant or
reoccurring drive belt squeal can occur:
- if the A/C discharge pressure goes above specifications: the A/C system is overcharged.
- the A/C condenser core airflow is blocked.
- the A/C anti-slugging strategy executes after a long hot heat soak.
- if the A/C off equalized pressure (the common discharged and suction pressure that occurs after
several minutes) exceeds specifications.
- if any of the accessories or idler pulley(s) are damaged or have a worn or damaged bearing. All
accessories should be rotatable by hand in the unloaded condition. If not, inspect the accessory.
- if there is evidence of fluid contamination on the accessory drive belt. When the drive belt has
been exposed to fluid contamination during vehicle operation, such as leaks from the power
steering system, A/C system or cooling system, clean all pulleys with soap and water, rinse with
clean water and install a new accessory drive belt. If the drive belt has been exposed to fluids in a
localized area during routine vehicle service, such as replacement of hoses or fluids, the drive belt
and pulleys should be washed with soap and water immediately (prior to starting the engine), and
rinsed with clean water.
- if the accessory drive belt is too long. A drive belt that is too long will allow the accessory drive
belt tensioner arm to go all the way to the arm travel stop under certain load conditions, which will
release tension to the drive belt. If the accessory drive belt tensioner indicator is outside the normal
installation wear range window, install a new accessory drive belt.
- NOTE: The accessory drive belt tensioner arm should rotate freely without binding.
Install a new accessory drive belt tensioner if the drive belt tensioner is worn or damaged.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Belt - Noise/Flutter > Page 2053
Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection Drive Belt - Incorrect Installation
Accessory Drive
Component Tests
Drive Belt - Incorrect Installation
NOTICE: Incorrect accessory drive belt installation will cause excessive drive belt wear and may
cause the drive belt to come off the pulleys.
Non-standard accessory drive belts can track differently or incorrectly. If an accessory drive belt
tracks incorrectly, install a new accessory drive belt to avoid performance failure or loss of the drive
belt.
Incorrect Installation
Correct Installation
With the engine running, check accessory drive belt tracking on all pulleys. If the edge of the
accessory drive belt rides beyond the edge of the pulleys, noise and premature wear will occur.
Make sure the accessory drive belt rides correctly on the pulley. If an accessory drive belt tracking
condition exists, proceed with the following:
- Visually check the accessory drive belt tensioner for damage and wear, especially the mounting
pad surface and arm alignment. If the accessory drive belt tensioner is not installed correctly, the
mounting surface pad will be out of position. If the tensioner arm is worn, the arm will be out of
alignment. Either of these conditions will result in chirp and squeal noises.
- With the engine running, visually observe the grooves in the pulleys (not the pulley flanges or the
pulley forward faces) for excessive wobble. Install new components as necessary.
- Check all accessories, mounting brackets and the accessory drive belt tensioner for any
interference that would prevent the component from mounting correctly. Correct any interference
condition and recheck the accessory drive belt tracking.
- Tighten all accessories, mounting brackets and accessory drive belt tensioner retaining hardware
to specification. Recheck the accessory drive belt tracking.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front End Accessory Drive (FEAD) - Exploded View
Drive Belt: Service and Repair Front End Accessory Drive (FEAD) - Exploded View
Front End Accessory Drive (FEAD) - Exploded View
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front End Accessory Drive (FEAD) - Exploded View > Page 2056
Drive Belt: Service and Repair Accessory Drive Belt
Accessory Drive Belt
Removal and Installation
1. Rotate the accessory drive belt tensioner clockwise and remove the accessory drive belt.
2. NOTE: Make sure the drive belt is correctly installed on each pulley.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Refer to Accessory Drive See: Description and Operation in Description and Operation for drive
belt routing.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt Tensioner > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Belt Tensioner - Mechanical
Drive Belt Tensioner: Testing and Inspection Belt Tensioner - Mechanical
Accessory Drive
Component Tests
Belt Tensioner - Mechanical
The only mechanical check that needs to be made is a check for tensioner stick, grab or bind.
1. With the engine off, check routing of the accessory drive belt. Refer to the illustrations under
Accessory Drive See: Description and Operation in
the Description and Operation portion.
2. NOTE: The accessory drive belt tensioner spring is very strong and requires substantial force to
release.
Using a suitable, commercially available serpentine belt tensioner release tool, release the tension
on the belt and detach the accessory drive belt from the tensioner. Carry out the following tests:
- Using the release tool, move the tensioner from its relaxed position, through its full stroke and
back to the relaxed position to make sure there is no stick, grab or bind, and to make sure that
there is tension on the tensioner spring.
- Rotate the tensioner pulley by hand and check for a binding, contaminated or seized condition.
- Inspect the area surrounding the accessory drive belt tensioner for oil leaks or contamination and
repair any leaks.
3. If the accessory drive belt tensioner does not meet the criteria in the previous step, install a new
tensioner. If the accessory drive belt tensioner
meets the criteria in the previous step, proceed to testing the tensioner dynamically.
4. If the tensioner is saturated with oil and grease internally, install a new tensioner.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt Tensioner > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Belt Tensioner - Mechanical > Page 2061
Drive Belt Tensioner: Testing and Inspection Belt Tensioner - Dynamics
Accessory Drive
Component Tests
Belt Tensioner - Dynamics
The accessory drive belt tensioner can be checked dynamically as follows:
1. With the engine running, observe the accessory drive belt tensioner movement. The accessory
drive tensioner should move (respond) when the
A/C clutch cycles (if equipped), or when the engine is accelerated rapidly. If the accessory drive
belt tensioner movement is excessive without A/C clutch cycling or engine acceleration, check belt
rideout. Excessive belt rideout (uneven depth of grooves in the belt) can cause excessive
accessory drive belt tensioner movement. Check rideout condition by installing a new belt. If
excessive accessory drive belt tensioner movement still exists, install a new accessory drive belt
tensioner.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt Tensioner > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front End Accessory Drive (FEAD) - Exploded View
Drive Belt Tensioner: Service and Repair Front End Accessory Drive (FEAD) - Exploded View
Front End Accessory Drive (FEAD) - Exploded View
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt Tensioner > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front End Accessory Drive (FEAD) - Exploded View >
Page 2064
Drive Belt Tensioner: Service and Repair Accessory Drive Belt Tensioner
Accessory Drive Belt Tensioner
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the pushpin, press the position retaining tab and rotate the lower cooling fan shroud
upward until the position retainer tab locks into
position.
3. Rotate the accessory drive belt tensioner clockwise and remove the accessory drive belt from
the A/C compressor pulley.
4. Remove the 3 bolts and the accessory drive belt tensioner.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Engine Mount: Procedures
Powertrain/Drivetrain Mount Neutralizing
NOTE: Refer to the appropriate system and procedure for special instructions on loosening and
tightening mount fasteners.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Loosen, but do not remove, the powertrain/drivetrain mount fasteners.
3. Lower the vehicle.
4. NOTICE: Do not twist or strain the powertrain/drivetrain mounts or damage to the mounts may
occur.
Start the vehicle and move it in forward 0.6-1.2 m (2-4 ft). Then move the vehicle in reverse the
same distance.
5. Raise and support the vehicle.
6. Tighten the powertrain/drivetrain mount fasteners.
7. Lower the vehicle.
8. Test the system for normal operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2069
Engine Mount: Removal and Replacement
Engine Support Insulators
LH Engine Support Insulator
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2070
RH Engine Support Insulator
Removal
All engine support insulators
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
3. Remove the Throttle Body (TB).
4. Remove the cooling fan.
5. Remove the generator.
6. Remove the starter.
7. If servicing the engine support insulators on a Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) vehicle, remove the front
drive shaft.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2071
8. Install the Engine Support Bar, Support Hook and Engine Support Bracket.
9. Remove the 4 (2 RH and 2 LH) Y-pipe flange nuts.
10. NOTICE: Only use hand tools when removing the transmission mount-to-crossmember nuts or
damage to the transmission mount can
occur.
Loosen the 2 transmission mount-to-crossmember nuts.
RH engine support insulator
11. NOTICE: Only use hand tools when loosening the engine support insulator through bolts or
damage to the engine support
insulator-to-cylinder block bracket can occur.
Loosen the LH engine support insulator through bolt.
12. NOTICE: Only use hand tools when removing the engine support insulator through bolts or
damage to the engine support
insulator-to-cylinder block bracket can occur.
Remove the RH engine support insulator through bolt.
13. NOTICE: Only use hand tools when removing the engine support insulator nuts or damage to
the engine support insulator can occur.
NOTE: If during nut removal the stud bolt is extracted from the engine support insulator, separate
the nut from the stud bolt prior to stud bolt installation.
Remove the 2 RH engine support insulator nuts.
14. NOTICE: Only use hand tools when removing the engine support insulator stud bolts or
damage to the engine support insulator can
occur.
Remove the 2 RH engine support insulator stud bolts.
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) - RH engine support insulator
15. Position a suitable hydraulic jack under the front axle. Securely strap the jack to the axle.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2072
16. NOTE: Rotate the steering column so the pinch bolt for the steering column coupling allows
clearance for the isolator bolt.
Remove the upper front axle carrier mounting bushing bolt.
17. Remove the axle shaft housing carrier bushing bolt.
18. Remove the lower front axle carrier mounting bushing bolt.
19. NOTICE: Use care when lowering the front axle housing, or when vacuum lines to the axle
solenoid may become disconnected or
damaged.
Lower the axle to allow clearance to the RH lower front mount bracket bolt.
RH engine support insulator
20. Using the Engine Support Bar, Support Hook and Engine Support Bracket, raise the engine.
21. Remove the 3 bolts and the RH engine support insulator-to-cylinder block bracket.
22. Remove the RH engine support insulator.
LH engine support insulator
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2073
23. NOTICE: Only use hand tools when loosening the engine support insulator through bolts or
damage to the engine support
insulator-to-cylinder block bracket can occur.
Loosen the RH engine support insulator through bolt.
24. NOTICE: Only use hand tools when removing the engine support insulator through bolts or
damage to the engine support
insulator-to-cylinder block bracket can occur.
Remove the LH engine support insulator through bolt.
25. Using the Engine Support Bar, Support Hook and Engine Support Bracket, raise the engine.
26. NOTICE: Only use hand tools when removing the engine support insulator-to-frame bolts or
damage to the engine support
insulator-to-frame nut plate can occur.
Remove the 3 engine support insulator-to-frame bolts.
- Discard the 3 bolts.
27. Remove the 3 bolts and the LH engine support insulator-to-cylinder block bracket.
28. Remove the LH engine support insulator.
29. Inspect the engine support insulator-to-frame nut plate for thread damage. If the nut plate is
damaged, bend 2 tabs back and remove the nut plate.
Replace the nut plate with service part number 56190 and bend the 2 tabs back to the original
position.
Installation
RH engine support insulator
1. Clean the engine support insulator-to-cylinder block and engine support insulator-to-frame
mating surfaces of any dirt or foreign material prior to
installation.
2. NOTICE: Only use hand tools when installing the engine support insulator stud bolts or damage
to the engine support insulator can
occur.
Position the RH engine support insulator into the vehicle and install the 2 stud bolts.
- Tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2074
3. Position the RH engine support insulator-to-cylinder block bracket and install the 3 bolts.
- Tighten to 63 Nm (46 lb-ft).
4. NOTICE: Only use hand tools when installing the RH engine support insulator nuts or damage to
the engine support insulator can occur.
Install the 2 RH engine support insulator nuts.
- Tighten to 175 Nm (129 lb-ft).
LH engine support insulator
5. Clean the engine support insulator-to-cylinder block and engine support insulator-to-frame
mating surfaces of any dirt or foreign material prior to
installation.
6. Position the LH engine support insulator and hand start the 3 new engine support
insulator-to-frame bolts.
- Tighten to 175 Nm (129 lb-ft).
7. Position the LH engine support insulator-to-cylinder block bracket and install the 3 bolts.
- Tighten to 63 Nm (46 lb-ft).
All engine support insulators
8. Using the Engine Support Bar, Support Hook and Engine Support Bracket, lower the engine into
position.
9. NOTICE: Only use hand tools when installing the engine support insulator through bolt or
damage to the engine support
insulator-to-cylinder block bracket can occur.
Install the LH and RH engine support insulator bolts.
- Apply threadlock to the bolt threads prior to installation.
- Tighten to 350 Nm (258 lb-ft).
4WD vehicles - RH engine support insulator
10. NOTICE: Use care when positioning the front axle housing or the vacuum lines to the axle
solenoid may become disconnected or
damaged.
Raise the front axle carrier into position.
11. Install the lower front axle carrier mounting bushing bolt.
- Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2075
12. Install the axle shaft housing carrier bushing bolt.
- Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
13. Install the upper front axle carrier mounting bushing bolt.
- Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
All engine support insulators
14. NOTICE: Only use hand tools when installing the transmission mount-to-crossmember nuts or
damage to the transmission mount can
occur.
Install the transmission mount-to-crossmember nuts.
- Tighten to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
15. Position the Y-pipe and install the 4 nuts (2 RH and 2 LH).
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
16. Remove the Engine Support Bar, Support Hook and Engine Support Bracket.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2076
17. Install the starter.
18. If servicing the engine support insulator on a 4WD vehicle, install the front driveshaft.
19. Install the generator.
20. Install the cooling fan.
21. Install the TB.
22. Connect the battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Idler
Pulley > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front End Accessory Drive (FEAD) - Exploded View
Idler Pulley: Service and Repair Front End Accessory Drive (FEAD) - Exploded View
Front End Accessory Drive (FEAD) - Exploded View
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Idler
Pulley > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front End Accessory Drive (FEAD) - Exploded View > Page 2081
Idler Pulley: Service and Repair Accessory Drive Belt Idler Pulley
Accessory Drive Belt Idler Pulley
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe.
2. Rotate the accessory drive belt tensioner clockwise and position the accessory drive belt aside.
3. Remove the bolt and the accessory drive belt idler pulley.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
4. Repeat the previous step for each accessory drive belt idler pulley being serviced.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Pressure >
Component Information > Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure: Specifications
Minimum oil pressure at idle (engine at normal operating
temperature)........................................................................................................172 kPa (25 psi) Oil
pressure minimum at 2,000 rpm (engine at normal operating
temperature).................................................................................275-517 kPa (40-75 psi)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Pressure >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2086
Engine Oil Pressure: Testing and Inspection
Engine
Component Tests
The following component tests are used to diagnose engine concerns.
Oil Pressure Test
NOTICE: Inspect the engine for installation of an aftermarket oil filter. Review oil and filter
maintenance history to make sure that the vehicle has not gone beyond the standard Ford
recommended oil change intervals. Check the engine oil level and check the oil for contamination.
If the oil is contaminated, engine damage can occur, the source of the contamination must be
identified and repaired as necessary.
1. Disconnect and remove the Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) switch from the engine.
2. Connect the Oil Pressure Gauge to the oil pressure port.
3. Run the engine until normal operating temperature is reached.
4. With the engine at idle record the gauge reading.
5. Run the engine at 2,000 rpm and record the gauge reading.
6. The oil pressure should be within specifications; refer to the specifications in the appropriate
engine system.
7. If the pressure is not within specification, Go To Pinpoint Test B. See: Testing and
Inspection/Pinpoint Tests/Pinpoint Test B: Low Oil Pressure
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Dip Stick - Dip Stick
Tube > Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Lubrication Components - Exploded View
Engine Oil Dip Stick - Dip Stick Tube: Service and Repair Engine Lubrication Components Exploded View
Engine Lubrication Components - Exploded View
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Dip Stick - Dip Stick
Tube > Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Lubrication Components - Exploded View > Page 2091
Engine Oil Dip Stick - Dip Stick Tube: Service and Repair Oil Level Indicator And Tube
Oil Level Indicator and Tube
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the LH exhaust manifold. For additional information, refer to Exhaust Manifold - LH See:
Exhaust System/Exhaust Manifold/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Exhaust Manifold - LH.
2. Remove the oil level indicator and tube bolt.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
3. Remove the oil level indicator and tube from the cylinder block.
- Discard the O-ring seal.
4. NOTE: Lubricate the new oil level indicator tube O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to
installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install a new O-ring seal.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil
With Filter ............................................................................................................................................
............................................................. 6.6L (7.0 Qt)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 2096
Engine Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Engine Oil
U.S.A. ...................................................................................................................................
Motorcraft SAE 5W-20 Premium Synthetic Blend Motor Oil Canada
..................................................................................................................................................
Motorcraft SAE 5W-20 Super Premium Motor Oil
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
........................................... XO-5W20-QSP (U.S.A) Ford P/N ............................................................
...................................................................................................................... CXO-5W20-LSP12
(Canada) Ford Specification
.........................................................................................................................................
WSS-M2C930-A with API Certification Mark
NOTE: Use of synthetic or synthetic blend motor oil is not mandatory. Engine oil need only meet
the requirements of Ford specification WSS-M2C930-A and the API Certification mark.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter Adapter > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Oil Filter Adapter: Service and Repair
Oil Filter Adapter
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Drain the engine cooling system.
3. Drain the engine oil.
- Install the drain plug and tighten to 23 Nm (17 lb-ft).
4. Disconnect the engine oil pressure switch electrical connector.
5. Disconnect the lower radiator hose and position it aside.
6. Remove and discard the engine oil filter.
- To install, lubricate the oil filter gasket with clean engine oil and tighten until the seal makes
contact. Using an oil filter strap wrench, tighten the filter an additional 270 degrees.
7. Remove the 4 bolts and the oil filter adapter.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
8. NOTICE: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These may
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter Adapter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 2100
cause scratches and gouges resulting in leak paths. Use a plastic scraper to clean the sealing
surfaces.
Remove and discard the oil filter adapter gasket.
- Clean the sealing surfaces with silicone gasket remover and metal surface prep. Follow the
directions on the packaging.
- Inspect the mating surfaces.
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Fill the engine with clean engine oil.
10. Fill and bleed the engine cooling system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Specifications
Oil Pan: Specifications
Position a new gasket and the oil pan and install the 16 bolts. Tighten the bolts in the sequence
shown in 3 stages. Stage 1: Tighten to................................................................................................
..........................................................................................2 Nm (18 lb-in). Stage 2: Tighten to...........
..............................................................................................................................................................
.............20 Nm (177 lb-in). Stage 3: Tighten an additional...................................................................
..............................................................................................................60 degrees.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Engine Lubrication Components - Exploded View
Oil Pan: Service and Repair Engine Lubrication Components - Exploded View
Engine Lubrication Components - Exploded View
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Engine Lubrication Components - Exploded View > Page 2106
Oil Pan: Service and Repair Oil Pan
Oil Pan
Removal
All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the oil drain plug and drain the engine oil. Install the drain plug when finished.
- Tighten to 23 Nm (17 lb-ft).
3. Remove the 4 nuts, the 4 bolts and the crossmember.
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) vehicles
4. Position a suitable hydraulic jack under the front axle. Securely strap the jack to the axle.
5. NOTE: Rotate the steering column so the pinch bolt for the steering column coupling allows
clearance for the isolator bolt.
Remove the upper front axle carrier mounting bushing bolt.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Engine Lubrication Components - Exploded View > Page 2107
6. Remove the axle shaft housing carrier bushing bolt.
7. Remove the lower front axle carrier mounting bushing bolt.
8. NOTICE: Use care when lowering the front axle housing, or the vacuum lines to the axle
solenoid may become disconnected or damaged.
Lower the axle to allow clearance for the oil pan to be removed.
All vehicles
9. Remove the starter wiring harness rear support bracket bolt.
10. Remove the pushpin, press the position retaining tab and rotate the lower cooling fan shroud
upward until the position retainer tab locks into
position.
11. Remove the nut and position the starter wiring harness and the transmission fluid cooler tubes
aside.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Engine Lubrication Components - Exploded View > Page 2108
12. Detach the oil pressure switch wiring harness from the oil pan bolt.
13. Remove the 16 bolts, the oil pan and the gasket.
- Discard the gasket.
14. NOTICE: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These tools
cause scratches and gouges, which make leak paths. Use a plastic scraping tool to remove all
traces of old sealant.
Inspect the oil pan. Clean the gasket mating surfaces of the oil pan and engine block with silicone
gasket remover and metal surface prep. Follow the directions on the packaging.
Installation
All vehicles
1. NOTE: If not secured within 4 minutes, the sealant must be removed and the sealing area
cleaned with silicone gasket remover and metal surface
prep. Follow the directions on the packaging. Allow to dry until there is no sign of wetness, or 4
minutes, whichever is longer. Failure to follow this procedure can cause future oil leakage.
Apply silicone gasket and sealant at the crankshaft rear seal retainer plate-to-cylinder block sealing
surface.
2. NOTE: If not secured within 4 minutes, the sealant must be removed and the sealing area
cleaned with silicone gasket remover and metal surface
prep. Follow the directions on the packaging. Allow to dry until there is no sign of wetness, or 4
minutes, whichever is longer. Failure to follow this procedure can cause future oil leakage.
Apply silicone gasket and sealant at the engine front cover-to-cylinder block sealing surface.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Engine Lubrication Components - Exploded View > Page 2109
3. Position a new gasket and the oil pan and install the 16 bolts.
- Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown in 3 stages. Stage 1: Tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
- Stage 2: Tighten to 20 Nm (177 lb-in).
- Stage 3: Tighten an additional 60 degrees.
4. Attach the oil pressure switch wiring harness to the oil pan bolt.
5. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube support bracket, the starter wiring harness support
bracket and install the nut.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
6. Press the position retaining tab and rotate the lower cooling fan shroud downward until the
position retainer tab locks into position. Install the
pushpin.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Engine Lubrication Components - Exploded View > Page 2110
7. Position the starter wiring harness and install the starter wiring harness rear support bracket bolt.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
8. Install the transmission fluid cooling tubes rear support bracket bolt.
- Tighten to 48 Nm (35 lb-ft).
4WD vehicles
9. NOTICE: Use care when positioning the front axle housing, or the vacuum lines to the axle
solenoid may become disconnected or
damaged.
Raise the front axle carrier into position.
10. Install the lower front axle carrier mounting bushing bolt.
- Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
11. Install the axle shaft housing carrier bushing bolt.
- Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Engine Lubrication Components - Exploded View > Page 2111
12. Install the upper front axle carrier mounting bushing bolt.
- Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
All vehicles
13. Position the crossmember and install the 4 bolts and the 4 nuts.
- Tighten to 90 Nm (66 lb-ft).
14. Fill the engine with clean engine oil.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2115
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2116
Oil Pressure Sender: Service and Repair
Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) Switch
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Disconnect the Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) switch electrical connector.
3. Remove the EOP switch.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pick Up/Strainer > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Engine Lubrication Components - Exploded View
Oil Pick Up/Strainer: Service and Repair Engine Lubrication Components - Exploded View
Engine Lubrication Components - Exploded View
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pick Up/Strainer > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Engine Lubrication Components - Exploded View > Page 2121
Oil Pick Up/Strainer: Service and Repair Oil Pump Screen And Pickup Tube
Oil Pump Screen and Pickup Tube
Removal
1. Remove the oil pan. For additional information, refer to Oil Pan See: Oil Pan/Service and
Repair/Oil Pan.
2. Remove the 3 bolts and the oil pump screen and pickup tube.
Installation
1. NOTICE: Make sure the O-ring is in place and not damaged. A missing or damaged O-ring can
cause foam in the lubrication system, low
oil pressure and severe engine damage.
NOTE: Clean and inspect the mating surfaces and install a new O-ring. Lubricate the O-ring with
clean engine oil prior to installation.
Position the oil pump screen and pickup tube and install the 3 bolts.
- Tighten the 2 oil pump screen and pickup tube-to-oil pump bolts to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Tighten the oil pump screen and pickup tube-to-spacer bolt to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
2. Install the oil pan. For additional information, refer to Oil Pan See: Oil Pan/Service and Repair/Oil
Pan.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pump, Engine > Engine Oil
Pressure > Component Information > Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure: Specifications
Minimum oil pressure at idle (engine at normal operating
temperature)........................................................................................................172 kPa (25 psi) Oil
pressure minimum at 2,000 rpm (engine at normal operating
temperature).................................................................................275-517 kPa (40-75 psi)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pump, Engine > Engine Oil
Pressure > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2126
Engine Oil Pressure: Testing and Inspection
Engine
Component Tests
The following component tests are used to diagnose engine concerns.
Oil Pressure Test
NOTICE: Inspect the engine for installation of an aftermarket oil filter. Review oil and filter
maintenance history to make sure that the vehicle has not gone beyond the standard Ford
recommended oil change intervals. Check the engine oil level and check the oil for contamination.
If the oil is contaminated, engine damage can occur, the source of the contamination must be
identified and repaired as necessary.
1. Disconnect and remove the Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) switch from the engine.
2. Connect the Oil Pressure Gauge to the oil pressure port.
3. Run the engine until normal operating temperature is reached.
4. With the engine at idle record the gauge reading.
5. Run the engine at 2,000 rpm and record the gauge reading.
6. The oil pressure should be within specifications; refer to the specifications in the appropriate
engine system.
7. If the pressure is not within specification, Go To Pinpoint Test B. See: Testing and
Inspection/Pinpoint Tests/Pinpoint Test B: Low Oil Pressure
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Temperature Sensor/Switch,
Engine > Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Temperature Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) Sensor
The EOT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The EOT sensor measures the temperature of the engine oil. The sensor is typically threaded into
the engine oil lubrication system. The PCM can use the EOT sensor input to determine the
following:
- On variable camshaft timing (VCT) applications the EOT input is used to adjust the VCT control
gains and logic for camshaft timing.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input in conjunction with other PCM inputs to determine oil
degradation.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input to initiate a soft engine shutdown. To prevent engine
damage from occurring as a result of high oil temperatures, the PCM has the ability to initiate a soft
engine shutdown. Whenever engine RPM exceeds a calibrated level for a certain period of time,
the PCM begins reducing power by disabling engine cylinders.
Typical Thread Type Sensor
Typical EOT Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications > Intake Manifold
Intake Manifold: Specifications Intake Manifold
Install the 10 intake manifold bolts and tighten in 2 stages in the sequence shown. Stage 1: Tighten
to...........................................................................................................................................................
...............................2 Nm (18 lb-in). Stage 2: Tighten to......................................................................
..................................................................................................................10 Nm (89 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications > Intake Manifold > Page 2134
Intake Manifold: Specifications Throttle Body
Using a new O-ring seal, position the TB, the vibration damper and tighten the 4 bolts in 2 stages.
Stage 1: Tighten to...............................................................................................................................
...........................................................9 Nm (80 lb-in). Stage 2: Tighten an additional.........................
............................................................................................................................90 degrees
(one-fourth turn).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement
Intake Manifold: Removal and Replacement
Intake Manifold
Air Cleaner (ACL) Outlet Pipe-to-Throttle Body (TB) Adapter and Air Intake Resonator Assembly
Throttle Body (TB) and Ignition Coil Electrical Connectors
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 2137
Intake Manifold Vacuum Tube Assembly
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 2138
Intake Manifold, Coolant Crossover Manifold Assembly and Gaskets
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 2139
Removal
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Before working on or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components,
relieve the fuel system pressure to prevent accidental spraying of fuel. Fuel in the fuel system
remains under high pressure, even when the engine is not running. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
1. Drain the cooling system.
2. Remove the generator.
3. Disconnect the quick connect couplings and remove the crankcase vent tube.
4. Loosen the clamp and remove the bolt and the air intake resonator assembly.
5. Remove the 3 bolts and the Throttle Body (TB)-to-Air Cleaner (ACL) outlet pipe adapter.
6. Disconnect the quick connect couplings and remove the PCV tube.
7. Disconnect the fuel supply tube quick connect coupling.
8. Disconnect the Evaporative Emission (EVAP) electrical connector and the EVAP tube quick
connect coupling from the EVAP canister purge
valve.
9. Disconnect the upper radiator hose from the thermostat housing.
10. Disconnect the heater coolant hose from the coolant crossover manifold assembly.
11. Disconnect the 8 fuel injector electrical connectors.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 2140
12. Disconnect the Throttle Position (TP) sensor and Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) electrical
connectors.
13. Disconnect the heated PCV element electrical connector.
14. Disconnect the 4 LH ignition coil and the LH Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) solenoid
electrical connectors and detach the 2 engine wiring
harness retainers from the LH valve cover studs.
15. Disconnect the intake manifold vacuum tube from the brake booster vacuum hose.
16. NOTE: The intake manifold vacuum tube must be removed with the intake manifold as an
assembly.
Disconnect the intake manifold vacuum tube from the LH valve cover studbolt and the support
bracket at the rear of the LH cylinder head.
17. Remove the 10 intake manifold bolts.
18. NOTICE: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These tools
cause scratches and gouges which make leak paths. Use a plastic scraping tool to remove all
traces of old sealant.
Remove the 3 bolts, the coolant crossover manifold assembly and discard the gaskets.
- Clean and inspect the sealing surfaces with silicone gasket remover and metal surface prep.
Follow the directions on the packaging.
19. NOTE: The intake manifold vacuum tube must be positioned under the engine wiring harness
and removed with the intake manifold as an
assembly.
Position the intake forward to gain access to the wiring harness retainers.
20. Disconnect the 2 engine wiring harness retainers from the rear of the intake manifold.
21. Disconnect the Cylinder Head Temperature (CHT) sensor jumper harness electrical connector
retainer.
22. NOTICE: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These tools
cause scratches and gouges which make leak paths. Use a plastic scraping tool to remove all
traces of old sealant.
NOTE: The intake manifold vacuum tube must be positioned under the engine wiring harness and
removed with the intake manifold as an assembly.
Remove the intake manifold and discard the gaskets.
- Clean and inspect the sealing surfaces with silicone gasket remover and metal surface prep.
Follow the directions on the packaging.
Installation
1. NOTICE: If the engine is repaired or replaced because of upper engine failure, typically including
valve or piston damage, check the
intake manifold for metal debris. If metal debris is found, install a new intake manifold. Failure to
follow these instructions can result in engine damage.
NOTE: The intake manifold vacuum tube must be positioned under the engine wiring harness
during installation of the intake manifold.
Using new intake manifold gaskets, position the intake manifold.
2. Position the intake manifold forward and connect the CHT sensor jumper harness electrical
connector retainer.
3. Connect the 2 engine wiring harness retainers to the rear of the intake manifold and position
back the intake manifold assembly.
4. Using new gaskets, position the coolant crossover manifold assembly and install the 3 bolts.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
5. Install the 10 intake manifold bolts and tighten in 2 stages in the sequence shown.
- Stage 1: Tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
- Stage 2: Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 2141
6. Connect the intake manifold vacuum tube to the support bracket and the valve cover stud.
7. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the intake manifold vacuum tube.
8. Connect the 4 LH ignition coil and the LH VCT solenoid electrical connectors and attach the 2
engine wiring harness retainers to the LH valve
cover studs.
9. Connect the heated PCV element electrical connector.
10. Connect the TP sensor and ETC electrical connectors.
11. Connect the 8 fuel injector electrical connectors.
12. Connect the heater coolant hose to the coolant crossover manifold assembly.
13. Connect the upper radiator hose to the thermostat housing.
14. Connect the EVAP canister purge valve electrical connector and the EVAP tube quick connect
coupling to the EVAP canister purge valve.
15. Connect the fuel supply tube quick connect coupling.
16. Position the PCV tube and connect the quick connect couplings.
17. Position the TB-to-ACL outlet pipe adapter and install the 3 bolts.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
18. Position the air intake resonator assembly, install the bolt and the clamp.
- Tighten the bolt to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
19. Position the crankcase vent tube and connect the quick connect couplings.
20. Install the generator.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 2142
21. Fill and bleed the engine cooling system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 2143
Intake Manifold: Overhaul
Intake Manifold Assembly
Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Purge Valve, Fuel Rail and Fuel Injectors
Intake Manifold Vacuum Tube, Throttle Body (TB) and Intake Manifold
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 2144
Disassembly
1. Remove the bolt and disconnect the quick connect coupling and remove the Evaporative
Emission (EVAP) purge valve assembly.
2. Remove the 4 bolts and the fuel rail.
3. Remove the 8 fuel injector-to-fuel rail locking clips and separate the 8 fuel injectors from the fuel
rail.
- Discard the 2 O-ring seals from each fuel injector.
4. Remove the vacuum tube assembly from the intake manifold.
5. Remove the 2 bolts and the PCV heater element.
- Discard the O-ring seal.
6. Remove the 4 bolts, the vibration damper and the Throttle Body (TB).
Assembly
1. NOTICE: If the engine is repaired or replaced because of upper engine failure, typically including
valve or piston damage, check the
intake manifold for metal debris. If metal debris is found, install a new intake manifold. Failure to
follow these instructions can result in engine damage.
NOTE: Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 2145
Install the PCV heater element and the 2 bolts.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
2. Install the vacuum tube assembly onto the intake manifold.
3. Install the TB, vibration damper and tighten the 4 bolts in 2 stages.
- Stage 1: Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
- Stage 2: Tighten an additional 90 degrees.
4. NOTE: Lubricate the new O-ring seals with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Install 16 new O-ring seals on each of the fuel injectors.
5. Assemble the 8 fuel injectors onto the fuel rail and install the 8 locking clips.
6. Install the fuel rail and fuel injector as an assembly onto the intake manifold.
7. Install the 4 fuel rail bolts.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
8. Position the Evaporative Emission (EVAP) purge valve assembly and connect the quick connect
coupling and install the bolt.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Flexplate Or Flywheel And Crankshaft Rear Seal - Exploded View
Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal: Service and Repair Flexplate Or Flywheel And Crankshaft Rear
Seal - Exploded View
Flexplate or Flywheel and Crankshaft Rear Seal - Exploded View
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Flexplate Or Flywheel And Crankshaft Rear Seal - Exploded View >
Page 2151
Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal: Service and Repair Crankshaft Rear Seal
Crankshaft Rear Seal
Removal
1. Remove the transmission.
2. Remove the 8 bolts and the flexplate.
3. Using the Slide Hammer and the Crankshaft Rear Oil Slinger Remover, remove and discard the
crankshaft oil slinger.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Flexplate Or Flywheel And Crankshaft Rear Seal - Exploded View >
Page 2152
4. Using the Slide Hammer and the Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Remover, remove and discard the
crankshaft rear seal.
Installation
1. NOTE: Lubricate the crankshaft rear seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Using the Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Installers, install a new crankshaft rear seal.
2. NOTE: Lubricate the crankshaft oil slinger with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Using the Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Installers and the Crankshaft Rear Oil Slinger Installer, install a
new crankshaft oil slinger.
3. Install the flexplate and tighten the 8 bolts in the sequence shown.
- Tighten to 80 Nm (59 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Flexplate Or Flywheel And Crankshaft Rear Seal - Exploded View >
Page 2153
4. Install the transmission.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Flexplate Or Flywheel And Crankshaft Rear Seal - Exploded View >
Page 2154
Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal: Service and Repair Crankshaft Rear Seal With Retainer Plate
Crankshaft Rear Seal with Retainer Plate
Removal
1. Remove the transmission.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Flexplate Or Flywheel And Crankshaft Rear Seal - Exploded View >
Page 2155
2. Remove the oil pan. For additional information, refer to Oil Pan See: Engine Lubrication/Oil
Pan/Service and Repair/Oil Pan.
3. Remove the rear engine cover.
4. Using the Slide Hammer and the Crankshaft Rear Oil Slinger Remover, remove and discard the
crankshaft oil slinger.
5. Using the Slide Hammer and the Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Remover, remove and discard the
crankshaft rear seal.
6. Remove the 6 bolts and the crankshaft rear seal retainer plate.
Installation
1. NOTICE: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These tools
cause scratches and gouges which make leak paths. Use a plastic scraping tool to remove all
traces of old sealant.
NOTE: Clean the sealing surfaces with silicone gasket remover and metal surface prep. Follow the
directions on the packaging.
Clean and inspect the mating surface.
2. NOTE: If the rear crankshaft seal retaining plate is not secured within 4 minutes, the sealant
must be removed and the sealing area cleaned with
silicone gasket remover and metal surface prep. Follow the directions on the packaging. Allow to
dry until there is no sign of wetness, or 4 minutes, whichever is longer. Failure to follow this
procedure may cause future oil leaks.
NOTE: The silicone must be applied on the groove along the retainer plate.
Apply a 4.06 mm (0.16 in) bead of silicone gasket and sealant around the crankshaft rear seal
retainer plate sealing surface.
3. Install the crankshaft rear seal retainer plate and the 6 bolts in the sequence shown.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
4. NOTE: Lubricate the crankshaft rear seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Flexplate Or Flywheel And Crankshaft Rear Seal - Exploded View >
Page 2156
Using the Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Installers, install a new crankshaft rear seal.
5. NOTE: Lubricate the crankshaft oil slinger with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Using the Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Installers and the Crankshaft Rear Oil Slinger Installer, install a
new crankshaft oil slinger.
6. Install the rear engine cover.
7. Install the flexplate and tighten the 8 bolts in the sequence shown.
- Tighten to 80 Nm (59 lb-ft).
8. Install the oil pan. For additional information, refer to Oil Pan See: Engine Lubrication/Oil
Pan/Service and Repair/Oil Pan.
9. Install the transmission.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Front Crankshaft Seal: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Front Seal
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2160
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the cooling fan.
3. Rotate the tensioner clockwise and remove the accessory drive belt from the crankshaft pulley.
4. Remove the crankshaft pulley bolt and washer.
- Discard the crankshaft pulley bolt.
5. Using the 3-Jaw Puller, remove the crankshaft pulley.
6. Using the Crankshaft Front Oil Seal Remover, remove and discard the crankshaft seal.
Installation
1. Lubricate the engine front cover and the new crankshaft seal inner lip with clean engine oil.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2161
2. Using the Crankshaft Front Oil Seal Installer, the Crankshaft Vibration Damper Installer and the
Front Cover Oil Seal Installer, install the new
crankshaft front seal into the engine front cover.
3. NOTE: If not secured within 4 minutes, the sealant must be removed and the sealing area
cleaned with metal surface prep and silicone gasket
remover. Allow to dry until there is no sign of wetness, or 4 minutes, whichever is longer. Failure to
follow this procedure can cause future oil leakage.
Apply silicone gasket and sealant to the Woodruff key slot in the crankshaft pulley.
4. Using the Crankshaft Vibration Damper Installer, install the crankshaft pulley.
5. Using a new crankshaft pulley bolt, install the bolt and washer and tighten the bolt in 4 stages.
- Stage 1: Tighten to 90 Nm (66 lb-ft).
- Stage 2: Loosen 360 degrees.
- Stage 3: Tighten to 50 Nm (37 lb-ft).
- Stage 4: Tighten an additional 90 degrees.
6. Rotate the tensioner clockwise and install the accessory drive belt onto the crankshaft pulley.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2162
7. Install the cooling fan.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Valve Train Components - Exploded View
Valve Guide Seal: Service and Repair Valve Train Components - Exploded View
Valve Train Components - Exploded View
NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Valve Train Components - Exploded View > Page 2167
Valve Guide Seal: Service and Repair Valve Seals
Valve Seals
Removal
RH cylinder head valve seals
1. Remove the RH valve cover. For additional information, refer to Valve Cover - RH See: Cylinder
Head Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and
Repair/Valve Cover - RH.
LH cylinder head valve seals
2. Remove the LH valve cover. For additional information, refer to Valve Cover - LH See: Cylinder
Head Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and
Repair/Valve Cover - LH.
All valve seals
3. Remove the spark plug for the cylinder being serviced.
4. Rotate the crankshaft until the piston for the valve being serviced is at the top of its stroke with
the intake valve and the exhaust valves closed.
5. NOTICE: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Mark the components for installation into
their original locations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in engine damage.
NOTE: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off of the valve or the valve may drop into the cylinder.
If a valve drops into the cylinder, the cylinder head must be removed. For additional information,
refer to Cylinder Head See: Cylinder Head Assembly/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Cylinder Head - Removal.
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
Using the Valve Spring Compressor, compress the valve spring and remove the camshaft roller
follower.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Valve Train Components - Exploded View > Page 2168
6. Use compressed air in the cylinder being serviced to hold the valves in position.
- Apply a minimum of 965 kPa (140 psi) of compressed air into the cylinder.
7. NOTICE: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Mark the components for installation into
their original locations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in engine damage.
NOTE: If air pressure has forced the piston to the bottom of the cylinder, any loss of air pressure
will allow the valve to fall into the cylinder. If air pressure must be removed, support the valve prior
to removal. If a valve drops into the cylinder, remove the cylinder head. For additional information,
refer to Cylinder Head See: Cylinder Head Assembly/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Cylinder Head - Removal.
Using the Valve Spring Compressor, compress the valve spring and remove the valve spring
retainer keys.
8. Remove the valve spring retainer, the valve spring and the valve seal.
- Discard the valve seal.
9. Inspect the components.
Installation
All valve seals
1. NOTE: Lubricate the valve seal and valve stem with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Position a new valve seal onto the valve stem.
2. Using the Valve Stem Oil Seal Installer, install the new valve seal.
3. NOTICE: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Failure to follow this instruction may
result in engine damage.
Using the Valve Spring Compressor, install the valve spring, the valve spring retainer and the valve
spring retainer keys.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Valve Train Components - Exploded View > Page 2169
4. Relieve the air pressure from the cylinder.
5. NOTICE: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Failure to follow this instruction may
result in engine damage.
NOTE: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off of the valve or the valve may drop into the cylinder.
If a valve drops into the cylinder, the cylinder head must be removed. For additional information,
refer to Cylinder Head See: Cylinder Head Assembly/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Cylinder Head - Removal.
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
NOTE: Lubricate the camshaft roller followers with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Using the Valve Spring Compressor, compress the valve spring and install the camshaft roller
follower.
6. Install the spark plug.
LH cylinder head valve seals
7. Install the LH valve cover. For additional information, refer to Valve Cover - LH See: Cylinder
Head Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and
Repair/Valve Cover - LH.
RH cylinder head valve seals
8. Install the RH valve cover. For additional information, refer to Valve Cover - RH See: Cylinder
Head Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and
Repair/Valve Cover - RH.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender
> Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender
> Component Information > Locations > Page 2174
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender
> Component Information > Locations > Page 2175
Oil Pressure Sender: Service and Repair
Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) Switch
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Disconnect the Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) switch electrical connector.
3. Remove the EOP switch.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Temperature
Sensor/Switch, Engine > Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Temperature Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) Sensor
The EOT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The EOT sensor measures the temperature of the engine oil. The sensor is typically threaded into
the engine oil lubrication system. The PCM can use the EOT sensor input to determine the
following:
- On variable camshaft timing (VCT) applications the EOT input is used to adjust the VCT control
gains and logic for camshaft timing.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input in conjunction with other PCM inputs to determine oil
degradation.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input to initiate a soft engine shutdown. To prevent engine
damage from occurring as a result of high oil temperatures, the PCM has the ability to initiate a soft
engine shutdown. Whenever engine RPM exceeds a calibrated level for a certain period of time,
the PCM begins reducing power by disabling engine cylinders.
Typical Thread Type Sensor
Typical EOT Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Camshaft Gear/Sprocket >
Component Information > Specifications
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Specifications
Using the Cam Phaser Locking Tool, tighten the LH and RH camshaft phaser and sprocket bolts in
2 stages. Stage 1: Tighten to................................................................................................................
.........................................................................40 Nm (30 lb-ft). Stage 2: Tighten an additional..........
..............................................................................................................................................................
.........90 degrees.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain > Component
Information > Diagrams
Timing Chain: Diagrams
NOTICE: Timing chain procedures must be followed exactly or damage to valves and pistons may
result.
If the copper links are not visible, mark 2 links on one end and 1 link on the other end, and use as
timing marks.
Install the crankshaft sprocket, making sure the flange faces forward.
Position the lower end of the LH (inner) timing chain on the crankshaft sprocket, aligning the timing
mark on the outer flange of the crankshaft sprocket with the single copper (marked) link on the
chain.
NOTE: Make sure the upper half of the timing chain is below the tensioner arm dowel.
Position the timing chain on the camshaft phaser and sprocket with the timing mark positioned
between the 2 copper (marked) chain links.
Position the lower end of the RH (outer) timing chain on the crankshaft sprocket, aligning the timing
mark on the sprocket with the single copper (marked) chain link.
NOTE: The lower half of the timing chain must be positioned above the tensioner arm dowel.
NOTE: The camshaft phaser and sprocket will be stamped with one of the illustrated timing marks
for the RH camshaft.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 2186
Position the RH timing chain on the camshaft phaser and sprocket. Make sure the timing mark is
positioned between the 2 copper (marked) chain links.
As a post-check, verify correct alignment of all timing marks.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications
Timing Chain Tensioner: Specifications
Position the LH and RH timing chain guides and install the 4 bolts. Tighten to...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.....10 Nm (89 lb-in).
Position the LH timing chain tensioner arm on the dowel pin and install the LH timing chain
tensioner and 2 bolts. Tighten to..........................................................................................................
.............................................................................................25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
Position the RH timing chain tensioner arm on the dowel pin and install the RH timing chain
tensioner and the 2 bolts. Tighten to....................................................................................................
...................................................................................................25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2190
Timing Chain Tensioner: Service and Repair
Timing Drive Components
Removal
1. Remove the engine front cover. For additional information, refer to Engine Front Cover See:
Timing Cover/Service and Repair.
2. Remove the crankshaft sensor ring from the crankshaft.
3. Position the crankshaft keyway at the 12 o'clock position.
4. NOTE: If the camshaft lobes are not exactly positioned as shown, the crankshaft will require one
full additional rotation to 12 o'clock.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2191
The No. 1 cylinder camshaft exhaust lobe must be coming up on the exhaust stroke. Verify by
noting the position of the 2 intake camshaft lobes and the exhaust lobe on the No. 1 cylinder.
5. NOTICE: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Mark the components for installation into
their original locations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in engine damage.
Remove only the 3 camshaft roller followers shown in the illustration from the RH cylinder head.
6. NOTE: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off of the valve or the valve may drop into the
cylinder. If a valve drops into the cylinder, the
cylinder head must be removed. For additional information, refer to Cylinder Head See: Cylinder
Head Assembly/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Cylinder Head - Removal.
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
Using the Valve Spring Compressor, remove the 3 designated camshaft roller followers in the
previous step from the RH cylinder head.
7. NOTICE: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Mark the components for installation into
their original locations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in engine damage.
Remove only the 3 camshaft roller followers shown in the illustration from the LH cylinder head.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2192
8. NOTE: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off of the valve or the valve may drop into the
cylinder. If a valve drops into the cylinder, the
cylinder head must be removed. For additional information, refer to Cylinder Head See: Cylinder
Head Assembly/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Cylinder Head - Removal.
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
Using the Valve Spring Compressor, remove the 3 designated camshaft roller followers in the
previous step from the LH cylinder head.
9. NOTICE: The crankshaft cannot be moved past the 6 o'clock position once set or engine
damage may occur.
Rotate the crankshaft clockwise and position the crankshaft keyway at the 6 o'clock position.
10. NOTICE: If one or both tensioner mounting bolts are loosened or removed, the
tensioner-sealing bead must be inspected for seal
integrity. If cracks, tears, separation from the tensioner body or permanent compression of the seal
bead is observed, install a new tensioner or engine damage may occur.
Remove the 2 bolts, the LH timing chain tensioner and tensioner arm.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2193
11. NOTICE: If one or both tensioner mounting bolts are loosened or removed, the
tensioner-sealing bead must be inspected for seal
integrity. If cracks, tears, separation from the tensioner body or permanent compression of the seal
bead is observed, install a new tensioner or engine damage may occur.
Remove the 2 bolts, the RH timing chain tensioner and tensioner arm.
12. Remove the RH and LH timing chains and the crankshaft sprocket.
- Remove the RH timing chain from the camshaft sprocket.
- Remove the RH timing chain from the crankshaft sprocket.
- Remove the LH timing chain from the camshaft sprocket.
- Remove the LH timing chain and crankshaft sprocket.
13. NOTE: RH shown, LH similar.
Remove the LH and RH timing chain guides.
- Remove the 4 bolts.
- Remove both timing chain guides.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2194
14. NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
NOTICE: Only use hand tools to remove the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly or damage
may occur to the camshaft or camshaft phaser and sprocket.
Using the Cam Phaser Locking Tool, remove the bolt and the RH camshaft phaser and sprocket
assembly.
- Discard the camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt.
15. NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
NOTICE: Only use hand tools to remove the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly or damage
may occur to the camshaft or camshaft phaser and sprocket.
Using the Cam Phaser Locking Tool, remove the bolt and the LH camshaft phaser and sprocket
assembly.
- Discard the camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt.
16. NOTICE: Remove the front thrust camshaft bearing cap straight upward from the bearing
towers or the bearing cap may be damaged
from side loading.
Remove the 2 bolts and the RH camshaft front bearing cap.
17. NOTICE: The camshaft bearing caps must be installed in their original locations. Record
camshaft bearing cap locations. Failure to
follow these instructions may result in engine damage.
Remove the remaining bolts in the sequence shown and remove the remaining RH camshaft
bearing caps.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2195
18. Clean and inspect the RH camshaft bearing caps.
- The camshaft front thrust bearing cap contains an oil metering groove. Make sure the groove is
free of foreign material.
19. Remove the RH camshaft.
20. NOTICE: Remove the front thrust camshaft bearing cap straight upward from the bearing
towers or the bearing cap may be damaged
from side loading.
Remove the 2 bolts and the RH camshaft front bearing cap.
21. NOTICE: The camshaft bearing caps must be installed in their original locations. Record
camshaft bearing cap locations. Failure to
follow these instructions may result in engine damage.
Remove the remaining bolts in the sequence shown and remove the remaining LH camshaft
bearing caps.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2196
22. Clean and inspect the LH camshaft bearing caps.
- The camshaft front thrust bearing cap contains an oil metering groove. Make sure the groove is
free of foreign material.
23. Remove the LH camshaft.
24. NOTICE: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Mark the components for installation into
the original locations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in engine damage.
Remove all of the remaining camshaft roller followers from the cylinder heads.
Installation
1. Install the LH and RH camshafts.
- Lubricate the camshaft and camshaft journals with clean engine oil prior to installation.
2. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Install the LH and RH camshaft bearing caps in their original locations.
- Lubricate the camshaft bearing caps with clean engine oil.
- Position the 2 front camshaft bearing caps.
- Position the 8 remaining camshaft bearing caps.
- Install the 20 bolts loosely.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in) in the sequence shown.
3. NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Position the camshaft phaser and sprockets and install 2 new camshaft phaser and sprocket bolts
finger-tight.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2197
4. NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
NOTICE: Only use hand tools to remove the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly or damage
may occur to the camshaft or camshaft phaser and sprocket.
NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Using the Cam Phaser Locking Tool, tighten the LH and RH camshaft phaser and sprocket bolts in
2 stages. Stage 1: Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
- Stage 2: Tighten an additional 90 degrees.
5. Position the crankshaft with the Crankshaft Holding Tool, then remove the tool.
6. NOTICE: Timing chain procedures must be followed exactly or damage to valves and pistons will
result.
NOTICE: Prior to installation, inspect the tensioner-sealing bead for seal integrity. If cracks, tears,
separation from the tensioner body or permanent compression of the seal bead is observed, install
a new tensioner or engine damage may occur.
Compress the tensioner plunger, using a vise.
7. Install a retaining clip on the tensioner to hold the plunger in during installation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2198
8. Remove the tensioner from the vise.
9. If the copper links are not visible, mark 2 links on one end and 1 link on the other end, and use
as timing marks.
10. Install the crankshaft sprocket, making sure the flange faces forward.
11. Install the 4 bolts and the LH and RH timing chain guides.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
12. Position the lower end of the LH (inner) timing chain on the crankshaft sprocket, aligning the
timing mark on the outer flange of the crankshaft
sprocket with the single copper (marked) link on the chain.
13. NOTE: Make sure the upper half of the timing chain is below the tensioner arm dowel.
Position the timing chain on the camshaft phaser and sprocket with the timing mark positioned
between the 2 copper (marked) chain links.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2199
14. NOTE: The LH timing chain tensioner arm has a bump near the dowel hole for identification.
Position the LH timing chain tensioner arm on the dowel pin and install the LH timing chain
tensioner and the 2 bolts.
- Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
15. Remove the retaining clip from the LH timing chain tensioner.
16. Position the lower end of the RH (outer) timing chain on the crankshaft sprocket, aligning the
timing mark on the sprocket with the single copper
(marked) chain link.
17. NOTE: The lower half of the timing chain must be positioned above the tensioner arm dowel.
NOTE: The camshaft phaser and sprocket will be stamped with one of the illustrated timing marks
for the RH camshaft.
Position the RH timing chain on the camshaft phaser and sprocket. Make sure the timing mark is
positioned between the 2 copper (marked) chain links.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2200
18. Position the RH timing chain tensioner arm on the dowel pin and install the RH timing chain
tensioner and the 2 bolts.
- Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
19. Remove the retaining clip from the RH timing chain tensioner.
20. As a post-check, verify correct alignment of all timing marks.
21. Install the crankshaft sensor ring on the crankshaft.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2201
22. NOTICE: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed into their original
locations. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in engine damage.
NOTE: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off of the valve or the valve may drop into the cylinder.
If a valve drops into the cylinder, the cylinder head must be removed. For additional information,
refer to Cylinder Head See: Cylinder Head Assembly/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Cylinder Head - Removal.
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
Using the Valve Spring Compressor, install all of the camshaft roller followers. Lubricate the camshaft roller followers with clean engine oil prior to installation.
23. Install the engine front cover. For additional information, refer to Engine Front Cover See:
Timing Cover/Service and Repair.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications
Timing Cover: Specifications
Tighten the 15 engine front cover fasteners in the sequence shown in 2 stages. Stage 1: Tighten
fasteners 1 through 15
to.....................................................................................................................................................25
Nm (18 lb-ft). Stage 2: Tighten fasteners 6 and 7 to............................................................................
.................................................................................48 Nm (35 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2205
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2206
Timing Cover: Service and Repair
Engine Front Cover
Front End Accessory Drive (FEAD), LH and RH Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensors
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2207
Radio Ignition Interference Capacitors, Coolant Pump Pulley, Crankshaft Pulley and Front Oil Pan
Bolts
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2208
Engine Front Cover, Gaskets and Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2209
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the RH valve cover. For additional information, refer to Valve Cover - RH See: Cylinder
Head Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and
Repair/Valve Cover - RH.
3. Remove the LH valve cover. For additional information, refer to Valve Cover - LH See: Cylinder
Head Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and
Repair/Valve Cover - LH.
4. Remove the engine cooling fan.
5. Loosen the 4 coolant pump pulley bolts.
6. Rotate the tensioner clockwise and remove the accessory drive belt.
7. Remove the 4 bolts and the coolant pump pulley.
8. Drain the engine oil.
9. Remove the pushpin and press the position retaining tab and rotate the lower cooling fan shroud
upward until the position retainer tab locks into
position.
10. Remove the bolt and position the starter wiring harness and starter wiring harness rear support
bracket aside.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2210
11. Remove the nut and position aside the transmission cooler tube support bracket and the starter
wiring harness support bracket.
12. Disconnect the Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor electrical connector.
13. Remove the nut and position aside the power steering pressure hose support bracket.
14. Remove the crankshaft pulley bolt and washer.
- Discard the crankshaft pulley bolt.
15. Remove and discard the crankshaft pulley bolt. Using the 3-Jaw Puller, remove the crankshaft
pulley.
16. Using the Crankshaft Front Oil Seal Remover, remove and discard the crankshaft front seal.
17. Remove the 3 bolts and the 3 accessory drive idler pulleys.
18. Remove the 3 bolts and the accessory drive belt tensioner.
19. If equipped, remove the 4 bolts and the skid plate.
20. Remove the 4 front oil pan bolts.
21. Disconnect the wiring harness retainer from the power steering pump studbolt.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2211
22. Remove the stud bolt, the 2 bolts, and position aside the power steering pump.
23. Disconnect the RH Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor electrical connector.
24. Remove the bolt and the RH CMP sensor.
25. Remove the nut and position the RH radio ignition interference capacitor aside.
26. Disconnect the LH CMP sensor electrical connector.
27. Remove the bolt and the LH CMP sensor.
28. Remove the nut and position the LH radio ignition interference capacitor aside.
29. Remove the 10 bolts and the 5 studs.
30. Remove the engine front cover from the front cover-to-cylinder block dowel.
- Remove the engine front cover gaskets.
31. Remove the bolt and the CKP sensor.
- Discard the O-ring seal.
32. NOTICE: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These tools
cause scratches and gouges which make leak paths. Use a plastic scraping tool to remove all
traces of old sealant.
Clean the mating surfaces with silicone gasket remover and metal surface prep. Follow the
directions on the packaging.
- Inspect the mating surfaces.
Installation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2212
1. NOTE: Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Install the CKP sensor and the bolt.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
2. NOTICE: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These tools
cause scratches and gouges which make leak paths. Use a plastic scraping tool to remove all
traces of old sealant.
NOTE: If the engine front cover is not secured within 4 minutes, the sealant must be removed and
the sealing area cleaned. To clean the sealing area, use silicone gasket remover and metal surface
prep. Allow to dry until there is no sign of wetness, or 4 minutes, whichever is longer. Follow the
directions on the packaging. Failure to follow this procedure can cause future oil leakage.
NOTE: Make sure that the engine front cover gasket is in place on the engine front cover before
installation.
Apply a bead of silicone gasket and sealant along the cylinder head-to-cylinder block surface and
the oil pan-to-cylinder block surface, at the locations shown.
3. Install a new engine front cover gasket on the engine front cover. Position the engine front cover
onto the dowels. Install the fasteners finger-tight.
4. Tighten the 15 engine front cover fasteners in the sequence shown in 2 stages.
- Stage 1: Tighten fasteners 1 through 15 to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
- Stage 2: Tighten fasteners 6 and 7 to 48 Nm (35 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2213
5. Loosely install the 4 bolts, then tighten in 2 stages, in the sequence shown.
- Stage 1: Tighten to 20 Nm (177 lb-in).
- Stage 2: Tighten an additional 60 degrees.
6. Connect the CKP sensor electrical connector.
7. Position the starter wiring harness support bracket and the transmission cooler tube support
bracket and tighten the nut.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2214
8. Position the starter wiring harness and starter wiring harness rear support bracket and install the
bolt.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
9. Lubricate the engine front cover and the crankshaft seal inner lip with clean engine oil.
10. Using the Crankshaft Vibration Damper Installer, Front Cover Oil Seal Installer and the
Crankshaft Front Oil Seal Installer, install a new
crankshaft front seal into the engine front cover.
11. NOTE: If not secured within 4 minutes, the sealant must be removed and the sealing area
cleaned with metal surface prep and silicone gasket
remover. Follow the directions on the packaging. Allow to dry until there is no sign of wetness, or 4
minutes, whichever is longer. Failure to follow this procedure can cause future oil leakage.
Apply silicone gasket and sealant to the Woodruff key slot on the crankshaft pulley.
12. Use the Crankshaft Vibration Damper Installer to install the crankshaft pulley.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2215
13. Tighten the new crankshaft pulley bolt in 4 stages.
- Stage 1: Tighten to 90 Nm (66 lb-ft).
- Stage 2: Loosen 360 degrees.
- Stage 3: Tighten to 50 Nm (37 lb-ft).
- Stage 4: Tighten an additional 90 degrees.
14. Install the accessory drive belt tensioner and the 3 bolts.
- Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
15. Install the 3 accessory drive idler pulleys and the 3 bolts.
- Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
16. Position the coolant pump pulley and install the 4 bolts finger-tight.
17. Rotate the lower cooling fan shroud downward until the position retainer tab locks into position
and install the pushpin.
18. If equipped, install the skid plate and the 4 bolts.
- Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
19. Position the power steering pump and install the stud bolt and the 2 bolts.
- Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
20. Attach the engine wiring harness to the power steering pump stud bolt.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2216
21. Position the power steering pressure hose support bracket and install the nut.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
22. NOTE: Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Install the RH CMP sensor and the bolt.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
23. Connect the RH CMP sensor electrical connector.
24. Install the LH radio ignition interference capacitor and the nut.
- Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
25. NOTE: Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Install the LH CMP sensor and the bolt.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
26. Connect the LH CMP sensor electrical connector.
27. Install the RH radio ignition interference capacitor and the nut.
- Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
28. Rotate the tensioner clockwise and install the accessory drive belt.
29. Tighten the 4 coolant pump pulley bolts.
- Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
30. Install the engine cooling fan.
31. Install the LH valve cover. For additional information, refer to Valve Cover - LH See: Cylinder
Head Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and
Repair/Valve Cover - LH.
32. Install the RH valve cover. For additional information, refer to Valve Cover - RH See: Cylinder
Head Assembly/Valve Cover/Service and
Repair/Valve Cover - RH.
33. Fill the crankcase with clean engine oil.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2217
34. Using the scan tool, perform the Misfire Monitor Neutral Profile Correction procedure, following
the on-screen instructions.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Variable
Valve Timing Actuator: > 10-18-4 > Sep > 10 > Engine - Low Frequency Hot Idle Knocking Noise
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Customer Interest Engine - Low Frequency Hot Idle Knocking
Noise
TSB 10-18-4
09/27/10
LOW FREQUENCY ENGINE KNOCKING NOISE AT HOT IDLE
FORD: 2009-2010 Expedition, F-150, F-250, F-350
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 09-23-7 to update the vehicle model lines, Service Procedure and
Service Labor Time Standards.
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 F-150 and F-Super Duty vehicles equipped with a 4.6L 3V or 5.4L 3V
engine, Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a low frequency knocking noise from the
engine at hot idle only. The noise is predominately heard from the right front wheel well area and/or
the right hand (RH) engine cam cover. This noise may be generated from the RH variable camshaft
timing (VCT) phaser assembly. This procedure was created to diagnose the RH VCT phaser
assembly.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) tests were developed specifically for the vehicles and
Power Control Module (PCM) strategies for these vehicles.
Per Workshop Manual (WSM), Powertrain Controls and Emissions Diagnostics (PC/ED) and
Scheduled Maintenance Guide, review customer service history for use of any aftermarket oil
filters.
1. Check for possible diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs).
a. No DTCs present, proceed to Step 2.
b. If DTCs are present, do not continue with this procedure and refer to the PC/ED manual for
diagnostics.
2. Engine must be at full operating temperature over 190 °F (88 °C) cylinder head temperature
(CHT).
3. Connect IDS diagnostics tool and verify software version is at the latest level (63 or later
required).
4. Begin a new vehicle session.
5. Open Tool Box selection.
6. Open Data Logger.
7. Select Powertrain Engine.
8. Select PCM Data Logger.
9. Clear the preselected items by clicking the eraser icon button.
10. Select variable cam timing desired angle number (VCLDSD).
11. Go to live display and press the tick mark.
12. Make sure the parameter identification (PID) is highlighted with the dark lines above and below
the data being displayed.
13. Press number symbol: (output state control mode) of the VCT_DSD number PID.
14. Press the Control Item Activate (finger on the button) icon to enable manual control of the PID.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Variable
Valve Timing Actuator: > 10-18-4 > Sep > 10 > Engine - Low Frequency Hot Idle Knocking Noise > Page 2227
15. Use the plus button to command to 4 degrees. (One click is equal to 1 degree) When
commanding the advance, both banks will normally adjust.
16. Listen carefully to the low frequency knock noise while commanding the VCT_DSD from 0 to 4
degrees. Some higher frequency clatter is normal
at or above the 5 degree advance. What is being pursued is for the level of the low frequency
knock noise to be noticeably reduced when advanced from 4 to 5 degrees.
a. If noise level is noticeably reduced as the VCT desired angle is commanded from 3 to 4 degrees,
the noise source is the RH VCT phaser
assembly. Proceed to Step 17.
b. If the low frequency knock noise is not noticeably reduced at 4 degrees, refer to WSM, Section
303-00 for engine noise diagnostics.
17. Due to normal engine dynamics, the VCT phaser knock noise is produced by the RH VCT
phaser assembly. Replace only the RH VCT phaser
assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 303-01.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT:Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101804A 2009-2010 Expedition, 2.3 Hrs
Navigator 5.4L 3V: Replace The RH VCT Phaser Assembly Includes Time To Diagnose (Do Not
Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101804A 2009-2010 F-150 4.6L 3V: 1.8 Hrs.
Replace The RH VCT Phaser Assembly Includes Time To Diagnose (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101804A 2009-2010 F-150, F-Super 2.1 Hrs.
Duty 5.4L 3V: Replace The RH VCT Phaser Assembly Includes Time To Diagnose (Do Not Use
With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
6A257 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: > 10-18-4 > Sep > 10 > Engine - Low Frequency Hot Idle Knocking Noise
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Low Frequency Hot Idle
Knocking Noise
TSB 10-18-4
09/27/10
LOW FREQUENCY ENGINE KNOCKING NOISE AT HOT IDLE
FORD: 2009-2010 Expedition, F-150, F-250, F-350
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 09-23-7 to update the vehicle model lines, Service Procedure and
Service Labor Time Standards.
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 F-150 and F-Super Duty vehicles equipped with a 4.6L 3V or 5.4L 3V
engine, Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a low frequency knocking noise from the
engine at hot idle only. The noise is predominately heard from the right front wheel well area and/or
the right hand (RH) engine cam cover. This noise may be generated from the RH variable camshaft
timing (VCT) phaser assembly. This procedure was created to diagnose the RH VCT phaser
assembly.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) tests were developed specifically for the vehicles and
Power Control Module (PCM) strategies for these vehicles.
Per Workshop Manual (WSM), Powertrain Controls and Emissions Diagnostics (PC/ED) and
Scheduled Maintenance Guide, review customer service history for use of any aftermarket oil
filters.
1. Check for possible diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs).
a. No DTCs present, proceed to Step 2.
b. If DTCs are present, do not continue with this procedure and refer to the PC/ED manual for
diagnostics.
2. Engine must be at full operating temperature over 190 °F (88 °C) cylinder head temperature
(CHT).
3. Connect IDS diagnostics tool and verify software version is at the latest level (63 or later
required).
4. Begin a new vehicle session.
5. Open Tool Box selection.
6. Open Data Logger.
7. Select Powertrain Engine.
8. Select PCM Data Logger.
9. Clear the preselected items by clicking the eraser icon button.
10. Select variable cam timing desired angle number (VCLDSD).
11. Go to live display and press the tick mark.
12. Make sure the parameter identification (PID) is highlighted with the dark lines above and below
the data being displayed.
13. Press number symbol: (output state control mode) of the VCT_DSD number PID.
14. Press the Control Item Activate (finger on the button) icon to enable manual control of the PID.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: > 10-18-4 > Sep > 10 > Engine - Low Frequency Hot Idle Knocking Noise > Page 2233
15. Use the plus button to command to 4 degrees. (One click is equal to 1 degree) When
commanding the advance, both banks will normally adjust.
16. Listen carefully to the low frequency knock noise while commanding the VCT_DSD from 0 to 4
degrees. Some higher frequency clatter is normal
at or above the 5 degree advance. What is being pursued is for the level of the low frequency
knock noise to be noticeably reduced when advanced from 4 to 5 degrees.
a. If noise level is noticeably reduced as the VCT desired angle is commanded from 3 to 4 degrees,
the noise source is the RH VCT phaser
assembly. Proceed to Step 17.
b. If the low frequency knock noise is not noticeably reduced at 4 degrees, refer to WSM, Section
303-00 for engine noise diagnostics.
17. Due to normal engine dynamics, the VCT phaser knock noise is produced by the RH VCT
phaser assembly. Replace only the RH VCT phaser
assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 303-01.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT:Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101804A 2009-2010 Expedition, 2.3 Hrs
Navigator 5.4L 3V: Replace The RH VCT Phaser Assembly Includes Time To Diagnose (Do Not
Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101804A 2009-2010 F-150 4.6L 3V: 1.8 Hrs.
Replace The RH VCT Phaser Assembly Includes Time To Diagnose (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101804A 2009-2010 F-150, F-Super 2.1 Hrs.
Duty 5.4L 3V: Replace The RH VCT Phaser Assembly Includes Time To Diagnose (Do Not Use
With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
6A257 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2234
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Description and Operation
Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) System
Overview
The VCT system enables rotation of the camshaft(s) relative to the crankshaft rotation as a function
of engine operating conditions. There are four types of VCT systems.
- Exhaust phase shifting (EPS) system - the exhaust cam is the active cam being retarded.
- Intake phase shifting (IPS) system - the intake cam is the active cam being advanced.
- Dual equal phase shifting (DEPS) system - both intake and exhaust cams are phase shifted and
equally advanced or retarded.
- Dual independent phase shifting (DIPS) system - where both the intake and exhaust cams are
shifted independently.
All systems have four operational modes: idle, part throttle, wide open throttle (WOT), and default
mode. At idle and low engine speeds with closed throttle, the powertrain control module (PCM)
determines the phase angle based on air flow, engine oil temperature and engine coolant
temperature. At part and wide open throttle the PCM determines the phase angle based on engine
RPM, load, and throttle position. VCT systems provide reduced emissions and enhanced engine
power, fuel economy and idle quality. IPS systems also have the added benefit of improved torque.
In addition, some VCT system applications can eliminate the need for an external exhaust gas
recirculation (EGR) system. The elimination of the EGR system is accomplished by controlling the
overlap time between the intake valve opening and exhaust valve closing. Currently, both the IPS
and DEPS systems are used.
The VCT system knocking and noise concerns are diagnosed in the Testing and Inspection
section. For additional information, refer to the Engine System - General Information. Verification of
incorrect VCT phasing on a warm engine operating below 1500 RPM can be isolated using a
stethoscope and by monitoring the VCTADV, VCTADVERR and VCTDC PIDs using a scan tool. If
the VCT phaser does not maintain correct valve timing, low oil pressure or oil flow restrictions are
primary possible causes. Verify correct oil pressure and flow, refer to the Engine System - General
Information.
Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) System
The VCT system consists of an electric hydraulic positioning control solenoid, a camshaft position
(CMP) sensor, and a trigger wheel. The CMP trigger wheel indicates the CMP signal for that bank.
A crankshaft position (CKP) sensor provides the PCM with crankshaft positioning information in 10
degree increments.
1. The PCM receives input signals from the intake air temperature (IAT), engine coolant
temperature (ECT), engine oil temperature (EOT), CMP,
throttle position (TP), mass air flow (MAF), and CKP sensors to determine the operating conditions
of the engine. At idle and low engine speeds with closed throttle, the PCM controls the camshaft
position based on ECT, EOT, IAT, and MAF. During part and wide open throttle, the camshaft
position is determined by engine RPM, load and throttle position. The VCT system does not
operate until the engine is at normal operating temperature.
2. The VCT system is enabled by the PCM when the correct conditions are met. 3. The CKP signal
is used as a reference for CMP positioning. 4. The VCT solenoid valve is an integral part of the
VCT system. The solenoid valve controls the flow of engine oil in the VCT actuator assembly.
As the PCM controls the duty cycle of the solenoid valve, oil pressure/flow advances or retards the
cam timing. Duty cycles near 0% or 100% represent rapid movement of the camshaft. Retaining a
fixed camshaft position is accomplished by dithering (oscillating) the solenoid valve duty cycle. The
PCM calculates and determines the desired camshaft position. It continually updates the VCT
solenoid duty cycle until the desired position is
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2235
achieved. A difference between the desired and actual camshaft position represents a position
error in the PCM VCT control loop. The PCM disables the VCT and places the camshaft in a
default position if a concern is detected. A related DTC is also set when the concern is detected.
5. When the VCT solenoid is energized, engine oil is allowed to flow to the VCT actuator assembly
which advances or retards the camshaft timing.
One half of the VCT actuator is coupled to the camshaft and the other half is connected to the
timing chain. Oil chambers between the two halves couple the camshaft to the timing chain. When
the flow of oil is shifted from one side of the chamber to the other, the differential change in oil
pressure forces the camshaft to rotate in either an advance or retard position depending on the oil
flow.
VCT System
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Cover / Housing > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Variable Valve Timing Cover / Housing: Procedures
Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Housing Cleaning and Inspection
1. Remove the screw and the Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) oil control solenoid.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
2. Clean the mating surfaces and oil passages with metal surface prep. Follow the directions on the
packaging.
3. Inspect the VCT housing for pitting, cracks or damaged sealing surfaces. Install a new VCT
housing if damaged.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Cover / Housing > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2240
Variable Valve Timing Cover / Housing: Removal and Replacement
Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Housing
Removal
All Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) housings
1. Remove the timing drive components. For additional information, refer to Timing Drive
Components See: Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement.
RH VCT housing
2. Remove the 2 bolts and the RH Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) housing.
LH VCT housing
3. Remove the 2 bolts and the LH VCT housing.
All VCT housings
4. Remove and discard the VCT housing gasket.
5. NOTICE: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These tools
cause scratches and gouges which make leak paths. Use a plastic scraping tool to remove all
traces of old sealant.
Clean and inspect the cylinder head sealing surfaces with metal surface prep. Follow the directions
on the packaging.
6. Clean and inspect the VCT housing.
Installation
All VCT housing
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Cover / Housing > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2241
1. Install a new gasket onto the VCT housing.
RH VCT housing
2. Position the RH VCT housing and install the 2 bolts.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
LH VCT housing
3. Position the LH VCT housing and install the 2 bolts.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
All VCT housings
4. Install the timing drive components. For additional information, refer to Timing Drive Components
See: Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Solenoid 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Solenoid 1 >
Page 2246
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid > Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Solenoid 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid > Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Solenoid 1 >
Page 2249
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2250
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid: Service and Repair
Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Oil Control Solenoid
NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the valve cover.
2. Remove the bolt and the Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) oil control solenoid.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
Fuel Pressure
Engine running.....................................................................................................................................
..............................................379-414 kPa (55-60 psi) Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).........................
..................................................................................................................................379-414 kPa
(55-60 psi)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > Specifications > Page 2255
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection
Fuel System Pressure Test
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Before working on or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components,
relieve the fuel system pressure to prevent accidental spraying of fuel. Fuel in the fuel system
remains under high pressure, even when the engine is not running. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
WARNING: When handling fuel, always observe fuel handling precautions and be prepared in the
event of fuel spillage. Spilled fuel may be ignited by hot vehicle components or other ignition
sources. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
1. Remove the cap from the fuel pressure relief valve located on the fuel rail.
2. Install the Fuel Pressure Test Kit onto the fuel pressure relief valve.
3. Test the fuel system pressure to make sure it is within the specified range. For additional
information, refer to Specifications.
4. NOTE: Open the drain valve slowly to relieve the fuel system pressure. This may drain fuel from
the system. Place fuel in a suitable container.
Upon completion of the fuel system pressure test, open the drain valve on the Fuel Pressure Test
Kit and relieve the fuel system pressure.
5. NOTE: It may take more than one key cycle to pressurize the fuel system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > Specifications > Page 2256
Cycle the ignition key and wait 3 seconds to pressurize the fuel system. Check for leaks before
starting the engine.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle
Speed > System Information > Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Typical Diagnostic Reference Value
Measured/PID Values 695 RPM ..........................................................................................................
..................................................................................................... Hot Idle
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Intake Air System Components Exploded View
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Intake Air System Components - Exploded View
Intake Air System Components - Exploded View
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Intake Air System Components Exploded View > Page 2265
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Air Cleaner Element
Air Cleaner Element
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the Air Cleaner (ACL) outlet pipe from the ACL cover.
- To install, tighten the clamps to 4 Nm (35 lb-in).
2. Disconnect the Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector.
3. Release the retaining clips and position the ACL cover aside.
4. Remove the ACL element.
5. NOTE: The ACL element must be fully seated into the ACL housing. Failure to do so will result in
unusual engine noise.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter
> Fuel Pressure Release > System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
Fuel System Pressure Release
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Before working on or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components,
relieve the fuel system pressure to prevent accidental spraying of fuel. Fuel in the fuel system
remains under high pressure, even when the engine is not running. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: When handling fuel, always observe fuel handling precautions and be prepared in the
event of fuel spillage. Spilled fuel may be ignited by hot vehicle components or other ignition
sources. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
2. Remove the cap from the fuel pressure relief valve located on the fuel rail.
3. Install the Fuel Pressure Test Kit onto the fuel pressure relief valve.
4. NOTE: Open the manual valve slowly to relieve the system pressure. This may drain fuel from
the fuel system. Place fuel in a suitable container.
Open the manual valve on the Fuel Pressure Test Kit and relieve the fuel pressure.
5. NOTE: It may take more than one key cycle to pressurize the fuel system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter
> Fuel Pressure Release > System Information > Service and Repair > Page 2270
Cycle the ignition key and wait 3 seconds to pressurize the fuel system. Check for leaks before
starting the engine.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing
Order > Component Information > Specifications > Firing Order
Firing Order: Specifications Firing Order
Firing order...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................1-3-7-2-6-5-4-8
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing
Order > Component Information > Specifications > Firing Order > Page 2275
Firing Order: Specifications Engine Cylinder Identification
Engine Cylinder Identification
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Timing > System Information > Specifications
Ignition Timing: Specifications
Base ignition timing..............................................................................................................................
........................10° Before Top Dead Center (BTDC)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Specifications > Gap
Spark Plug: Specifications Gap
Spark plug gap.....................................................................................................................................
.................................1.05 ± 0.05 mm (0.039-0.043 in)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Specifications > Gap > Page 2283
Spark Plug: Specifications Torque Specifications
Spark plugs...........................................................................................................................................
........................................................12 Nm (106 lb-in)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2284
Spark Plug: Application and ID
Spark plug............................................................................................................................................
...................................................................HJFS-24FP
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2285
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection
Spark Plug Inspection
1. Inspect the spark plug for a bridged gap.
- Check for deposit build-up closing the gap between the electrodes. Deposits are caused by oil or
carbon fouling.
- Install a new spark plug.
2. Check for oil fouling.
- Check for wet, black deposits on the insulator shell bore electrodes, caused by excessive oil
entering the combustion chamber through worn rings and pistons, excessive valve-to-guide
clearance or worn or loose bearings.
- Correct the oil leak concern.
- Install a new spark plug.
3. Inspect for carbon fouling. Look for black, dry, fluffy carbon deposits on the insulator tips,
exposed shell surfaces and electrodes, caused by a
spark plug with an incorrect heat range, dirty air cleaner, too rich a fuel mixture or excessive idling.
Install new spark plugs.
4. Inspect for normal burning.
- Check for light tan or gray deposits on the firing tip.
5. Inspect for pre-ignition, identified by melted electrodes and a possibly damaged insulator.
Metallic deposits on the insulator indicate engine
damage. This may be caused by incorrect ignition timing, wrong type of fuel or the unauthorized
installation of a heli-coil insert in place of the spark plug threads. Install a new spark plug.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2286
6. Inspect for overheating, identified by white or light gray spots and a bluish-burnt appearance of
electrodes. This is caused by engine overheating,
wrong type of fuel, loose spark plugs, spark plugs with an incorrect heat range, low fuel pump
pressure or incorrect ignition timing. Install a new spark plug.
7. Inspect for fused deposits, identified by melted or spotty deposits resembling bubbles or blisters.
These are caused by sudden acceleration.
- Install new spark plugs.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Ignition Components - Exploded View
Spark Plug: Service and Repair Engine Ignition Components - Exploded View
Engine Ignition Components - Exploded View
Engine Ignition - RH
Engine Ignition - LH
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Ignition Components - Exploded View > Page 2289
Spark Plug: Service and Repair Spark Plugs
Spark Plugs
Removal
NOTICE: The spark plug procedure must be followed exactly or damage to the cylinder head and
spark plug will result.
1. Remove the ignition coil-on-plug. For additional information, refer to Ignition Coil-On-Plug See:
Powertrain Management/Ignition
System/Ignition Coil/Service and Repair/Ignition Coil-On-Plug.
2. NOTICE: Only use hand tools when removing or installing the spark plugs or damage can occur
to the cylinder head or spark plug.
NOTE: Use compressed air to remove any foreign material from the spark plug well before
removing the spark plugs.
Remove the spark plug.
3. Inspect the spark plug.
Installation
1. Adjust the spark plug gap as necessary. For the correct spark plug gap specification, refer to
Specifications.
2. NOTICE: Only use hand tools when removing or installing the spark plugs or damage can occur
to the cylinder head or spark plug.
Install the spark plug.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
3. Install the ignition coil. For additional information, refer to Ignition Coil-On-Plug See: Powertrain
Management/Ignition System/Ignition
Coil/Service and Repair/Ignition Coil-On-Plug.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Compression Check > System Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Compression Test - Test Results
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75% of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit Chart.
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
If one or more cylinders reads low, squirt approximately one tablespoon of engine oil on top of the
pistons in the low-reading cylinders. Repeat the compression pressure check on these cylinders.
Compression Test - Interpreting Compression Readings
1. If compression improves considerably, piston rings are faulty.
2. If compression does not improve, valves are sticking or seating incorrectly.
3. If 2 adjacent cylinders indicate low compression pressures and squirting oil on each piston does
not increase compression, the head gasket may be
leaking between cylinders. Engine oil or coolant in cylinders could result from this condition.
Use the Compression Pressure Limit Chart when checking cylinder compression so that the lowest
reading is within 75% of the highest reading.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Compression Check > System Information > Specifications > Page 2293
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
Engine
Component Tests
The following component tests are used to diagnose engine concerns.
Compression Test - Compression Gauge Check
1. Make sure the oil in the crankcase is of the correct viscosity and at the correct level and that the
battery is correctly charged. Operate the vehicle
until the engine is at normal operating temperature. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position,
then remove all the spark plugs.
2. Set the throttle plates in the wide-open position.
3. Install a compression gauge in the No. 1 cylinder.
4. Install an auxiliary starter switch in the starting circuit. With the ignition switch in the OFF
position, and using the auxiliary starter switch, crank
the engine a minimum of 5 compression strokes and record the highest reading. Note the
approximate number of compression strokes required to obtain the highest reading.
5. Repeat the test on each cylinder, cranking the engine approximately the same number of
compression strokes.
Compression Test - Test Results
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75% of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit Chart.
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Compression Check > System Information > Specifications > Page 2294
If one or more cylinders reads low, squirt approximately one tablespoon of engine oil on top of the
pistons in the low-reading cylinders. Repeat the compression pressure check on these cylinders.
Compression Test - Interpreting Compression Readings
1. If compression improves considerably, piston rings are faulty.
2. If compression does not improve, valves are sticking or seating incorrectly.
3. If 2 adjacent cylinders indicate low compression pressures and squirting oil on each piston does
not increase compression, the head gasket may be
leaking between cylinders. Engine oil or coolant in cylinders could result from this condition.
Use the Compression Pressure Limit Chart when checking cylinder compression so that the lowest
reading is within 75% of the highest reading.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Specifications
Water Pump: Specifications
Tighten the 4 coolant pump bolts. Tighten to.......................................................................................
................................................................................................................25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 2298
Water Pump: Service and Repair
Coolant Pump
Removal
1. Drain the engine cooling system. For additional information, refer to Cooling System Draining,
Filling and Bleeding See: Cooling System/Service
and Repair/Cooling System Draining, Filling And Bleeding.
2. Remove the cooling fan. For additional information, refer to Cooling Fan See: Cooling
System/Radiator Cooling Fan/Fan Blade/Service and
Repair.
3. Loosen the 4 coolant pump pulley bolts.
4. Remove the accessory drive belt.
5. Remove the 4 bolts and the coolant pump pulley.
6. Remove the 4 bolts and the coolant pump. Discard the O-ring seal.
7. Inspect the sealing surfaces and clean with metal surface prep. Follow the directions on the
packaging.
Installation
1. NOTICE: Align the bolt holes with the bosses prior to insertion of the coolant pump and insert the
pump straight into the coolant pump
cavity. Do not rotate the coolant pump once installed in the coolant pump cavity or damage to the
O-ring seal can occur, causing the coolant pump to leak.
NOTE: Install a new O-ring seal and lubricate with clean engine coolant.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 2299
Install the coolant pump and 4 bolts.
- Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
2. Install the coolant pump pulley and 4 bolts.
3. Install the accessory drive belt.
4. Tighten the 4 bolts for the coolant pump pulley.
- Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
5. Install the cooling fan. For additional information, refer to Cooling Fan See: Cooling
System/Radiator Cooling Fan/Fan Blade/Service and Repair.
6. Fill the engine cooling system. For addition information, refer to Cooling System Draining, Filling
and Bleeding See: Cooling System/Service and
Repair/Cooling System Draining, Filling And Bleeding.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Coolant: Capacity Specifications
Engine Coolant
BASE RADIATOR
Without aux rear heat ..........................................................................................................................
........................................ 16.4 quarts (15.5 liters) With aux rear heat ................................................
....................................................................................................................... 19.0 quarts (18.0 liters)
HEAVY DUTY TRAILER TOW RADIATOR
Without aux rear heat ..........................................................................................................................
........................................ 16.9 quarts (16.0 liters) With aux rear heat ................................................
....................................................................................................................... 19.5 quarts (18.5 liters)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 2305
Coolant: Fluid Type Specifications
ENGINE COOLANT
Motorcraft Premium Gold Engine Coolant (yellow-colored)
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
.................................................................. VC-7-B Ford Specification ................................................
................................................................................................................................ WSS-M97B51-A1
Add the coolant type originally equipped in your vehicle.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Line/Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Coolant Line/Hose: Service and Repair
Coolant Crossover Manifold Assembly
Removal and Installation
1. The coolant crossover manifold assembly is serviced with the intake manifold.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Reservoir > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Coolant Reservoir: Service and Repair
Coolant Expansion Tank
Removal and Installation
1. NOTICE: Allow the engine to cool before removing the coolant expansion tank. The radiator
draws coolant from the coolant expansion
tank as the engine cools. If the coolant expansion tank is removed before the engine cools, the
radiator will draw air into the system, resulting in possible engine damage.
Using a suitable suction device, siphon the coolant from the coolant expansion tank.
2. Remove the Air Cleaner (ACL) element.
3. Remove the hood sensor and nut.
4. Disconnect the coolant overflow hose from the radiator.
5. Remove the 2 bolts and the coolant expansion tank/lower ACL housing assembly.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Fill the coolant expansion tank with a 50/50 mixture of coolant and clean, drinkable water.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagram in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be
seen completely in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference
is given to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in parentheses next to or under a component.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System, and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2317
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in set 4
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the
indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to
illustrate proper orientation.
Power Distribution
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2318
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
Component and Connector Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2319
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component Location
Charts.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Locations information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the
various items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written
description of the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2320
Symbols (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2321
Symbols (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2322
Symbols (Part 3)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2323
Symbols (Part 4)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2324
Symbols (Part 5)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2325
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminal by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2326
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal.
Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2327
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2328
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2329
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seat wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2330
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2331
7. If visible, be sure to place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the
barrel. 9. Holding the wire in place, barrel squeeze tool handles appropriate ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2332
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2333
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2334
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Fan Control
The PCM monitors certain parameters (such as engine coolant temperature, vehicle speed, A/C
on/off status, A/C pressure) to determine engine cooling fan needs.
For variable speed electric fan(s):
The PCM controls the fan speed and operation using a duty cycle output on the fan control variable
(FCV) circuit. The fan controller (located at or integral to the engine cooling fan assembly) receives
the FCV command and operates the cooling fan at the speed requested (by varying the power
applied to the fan motor).
FCV Duty Cycle Output From PCM (Negative Duty Cycle)
For relay controlled fans:
The PCM controls the fan operation through the fan control (FC), (single speed fan applications),
low fan control (LFC), medium fan control (MFC), and high fan control (HFC) outputs. Some
applications will have the xFC circuit wired to 2 separate relays.
For 3-speed fans, although the PCM output circuits are called low, medium, and high fan control
cooling fan speed is controlled by a combination of these outputs. Refer to the following table.
2.0L Focus (with A/C): PCM FC Output State For Cooling Fan Speeds
2.5L Escape: PCM FC Output State For Cooling Fan Speeds
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Radiator Cooling Fan Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Fan Speed Sensor (FSS)
The FSS is a Hall-effect sensor that measures the cooling fan clutch speed by generating a
waveform with a frequency proportional to the fan speed. If the cooling fan clutch is moving at a
relatively low speed, the sensor produces a signal with a low frequency. As the cooling fan clutch
speed increases, the sensor generates a signal with a higher frequency. The PCM uses the
frequency signal generated by the FSS as a feedback for closed loop control of the cooling fan
clutch. For additional information on the cooling fan clutch, refer to the Cooling Fan Clutch.
Cooling Fan Clutch with Fan Speed Sensor (FSS)
Cooling Fan Clutch with FSS
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Blade >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Fan Blade: Service and Repair
Cooling Fan
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Disconnect the cooling fan electronic clutch electrical connector.
3. Remove the nut and the cooling fan electronic clutch harness support bracket from the stud bolt.
- To install, tighten to 13 Nm (115 lb-in).
4. Remove the 2 cooling fan shroud pushpins.
- Discard the pushpins.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Blade >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2341
5. Release the cooling fan shroud position tab and rotate the shroud upwards until the lower tab
locks into position.
6. NOTICE: Do not sideload the cooling fan clutch coil or the cooling fan clutch may be damaged.
Using the Fan Clutch Nut Wrench and Fan Pulley Holding Wrench, remove the cooling fan and
clutch assembly.
- To install, tighten to 48 Nm (35 lb-ft).
- If servicing the cooling fan or cooling fan clutch, refer to Cooling Fan and Cooling Fan Clutch See:
Service and Repair.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install 2 new cooling fan shroud pushpins.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2345
Fan Clutch: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Cooling Fan Clutch
The cooling fan clutch is an electrically actuated viscous clutch that consists of three main
elements:
- a working chamber
- a reservoir chamber
- a cooling fan clutch actuator valve and a fan speed sensor (FSS)
The cooling fan clutch actuator valve controls the fluid flow from the reservoir into the working
chamber. Once viscous fluid is in the working chamber, shearing of the fluid results in fan rotation.
The cooling fan clutch actuator valve is activated with a pulse width modulated (PWM) output
signal from the PCM. By opening and closing the fluid port valve, the PCM can control the cooling
fan clutch speed. The cooling fan clutch speed is measured by a Hall-effect sensor and is
monitored by the PCM during closed loop operation.
The PCM optimizes fan speed based on engine coolant temperature (ECT), engine oil temperature
(EOT), transmission fluid temperature (TFT), intake air temperature (IAT), or air conditioning
requirements. When an increased demand for fan speed is requested for vehicle cooling, the PCM
monitors the fan speed through the Hall-effect sensor. If a fan speed increase is required, the PCM
outputs the PWM signal to the fluid port, providing the required fan speed increase.
Cooling Fan Clutch with Fan Speed Sensor (FSS)
Cooling Fan Clutch with Fan Speed Sensor (FSS)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2346
Fan Clutch: Tools and Equipment
Fan Clutch Holding Tool AST tool# 8005
Allows the technician to hold the water pump pulleuy in place while loosening the radiator fan.
2009 Suggested user price: $41.20
Assenmacher Specialty Tools 1 800 525 2943
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch
> Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Description and Operation
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
The ECT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The ECT measures the temperature of the engine coolant. The PCM uses the ECT input for fuel
control and for cooling fan control. There are three types of ECT sensors, threaded, push-in, and
twist-lock. The ECT sensor is located in an engine coolant passage.
Typical Thread Type Sensor
Typical Thread Type ECT Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch
> Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch
> Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2354
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch
> Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2355
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Cylinder Head Temperature (CHT) Sensor
The CHT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with the temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
The CHT sensor is installed in the cylinder head and measures the metal temperature. The CHT
sensor can provide complete engine temperature information and can be used to infer coolant
temperature. If the CHT sensor conveys an overheating condition to the PCM, the PCM initiates a
fail-safe cooling strategy based on information from the CHT sensor. A cooling system concern
such as low coolant or coolant loss could cause an overheating condition. As a result, damage to
major engine components could occur. Using both the CHT sensor and fail-safe cooling strategy,
the PCM prevents damage by allowing air cooling of the engine and limp home capability. For
additional information, refer to Powertrain Control Software See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Description and Operation/Powertrain Control
Software for Fail-Safe Cooling Strategy.
Typical CHT Sensor
Typical CHT Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch
> Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2356
Engine Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
Cylinder Head Temperature (CHT) Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold.
2. Disconnect the Cylinder Head Temperature (CHT) sensor electrical connector.
3. Remove the CHT sensor and discard.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Coat the new CHT sensor threads with high temperature nickel anti-seize lubricant prior to
installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Fan Shroud > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Fan Shroud: Service and Repair
Cooling Fan Shroud
Cooling Module, Power Steering Fluid Reservoir, Hoses and Power Distribution Box (PDB)
Cooling Fan Shroud
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Fan Shroud > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 2360
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
3. Drain the engine cooling system. For additional information, refer to Cooling System Draining,
Filling and Bleeding See: Service and
Repair/Cooling System Draining, Filling And Bleeding.
4. Remove the upper air deflector.
1. Remove the 12 upper air deflector pushpin-type retainers.
2. Remove the air deflector.
5. Remove the Air Cleaner (ACL) outlet pipe.
6. Remove the nut and disconnect the electrical cables.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
7. Disconnect the wiring harness retainer.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Fan Shroud > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 2361
8. Disconnect the upper radiator hose from the radiator.
9. Disconnect the upper radiator hose position retainer from the cooling fan shroud.
10. Disconnect the electrical connector and the wiring harness position retainer.
11. If equipped, disconnect the wiring harness position retainer from the vacuum reservoir.
12. If equipped, disconnect the vacuum connectors and the electrical connector on the LH side of
the cooling fan shroud and remove the vacuum
canister.
13. Disconnect the wiring harness retainer from the RH side of the radiator.
14. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Remove the 2 cooling fan shroud bolts and the wiring harness retainers.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Fan Shroud > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 2362
15. Remove the 4 bolts and position the Power Distribution Box (PDB) and support bracket aside.
- NOTICE: Hand start the 4 Power Distribution Box (PDB) support bracket bolts or damage to the
radiator support can result.
To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
16. Disconnect the Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor electrical harness position retainer.
17. Disconnect the power steering fluid hose position retainer from the radiator support.
18. Remove the bolt and position the power steering reservoir aside.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
19. Disconnect the coolant overflow hose from the radiator.
20. Remove the 2 lower cooling fan shroud pushpin retainers.
- Discard the retainers.
21. Release the lower cooling fan shroud position tab and rotate the lower cooling fan shroud
upwards until the lower tab locks into position.
22. Remove the clip and disconnect the lower radiator hose quick connect coupling from the
radiator.
23. Remove the cooling fan shroud.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Fan Shroud > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 2363
24. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install 2 new lower cooling fans shroud pushpin retainers.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Heater Core
Heater Core: Testing and Inspection Heater Core
Climate Control System
Component Tests
Heater Core
1. NOTE: If a heater core leak is suspected, the heater core must be tested by following the
Plugged Heater Core component test before the heater
core pressure test. Carry out a system inspection by checking the heater system thoroughly as
follows:
Inspect for evidence of coolant leakage at the heater hose to heater core attachments. A coolant
leak in the heater hose could follow the heater core tube to the heater core and appear as a leak in
the heater core.
2. NOTE: Spring-type clamps are installed as original equipment. Installation and overtightening of
non-specified clamps can cause leakage at the
heater hose connection and damage the heater core.
Check the integrity of the heater hose clamps.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Heater Core > Page 2368
Heater Core: Testing and Inspection Heater Core - Plugged
Climate Control System
Component Tests
Heater Core - Plugged
1. Check to see that the engine coolant is at the correct level.
2. Start the engine and turn on the heater.
3. When the engine coolant reaches operating temperature, using a suitable temperature
measuring device, check the heater core inlet and outlet
hoses to see if they are hot.
4. If the outlet only is not hot:
- the heater core may have an air pocket.
- the heater core may be plugged.
5. If the inlet only is not hot:
- the thermostat may not be working correctly.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Heater Core > Page 2369
Heater Core: Testing and Inspection Heater Core - Pressure Test
Climate Control System
Component Tests
Heater Core - Pressure Test
WARNING: Before disconnecting any heater water hoses, shut OFF the engine and wait until
engine is fully cool. Failure to comply with this warning may result in serious injury or burns from
hot liquid escaping from the engine cooling system.
Use the Pressure Test Kit to carry out the pressure test.
1. NOTE: Due to space limitations, a bench test may be necessary for pressure testing.
Drain the coolant from the cooling system.
2. Disconnect the heater hoses from the heater core.
3. Install a short piece of heater hose, approximately 101 mm (4 in) long on each heater core tube.
4. Fill the heater core and heater hoses with water and install the plug BT-7422-B and the adapter
BT-7422-A from the Pressure Test Kit. Secure the
heater hoses, plug and adapter with hose clamps.
5. Attach the pump and gauge assembly from the Pressure Test Kit to the adapter.
6. Close the bleed valve at the base of the gauge. Pump 138 kPa (20 psi) of air pressure into the
heater core.
7. Observe the pressure gauge for a minimum of 3 minutes.
8. If the pressure drops, check the heater hose connections to the core tubes for leaks. If the
heater hoses do not leak, remove the heater core from the
vehicle and carry out the bench test. See: Heater Core - Bench Test
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Heater Core > Page 2370
Heater Core: Testing and Inspection Heater Core - Bench Test
Climate Control System
Component Tests
Heater Core - Bench Test
1. Remove the heater core from the vehicle.
2. Drain all of the coolant from the heater core.
3. Connect the 101 mm (4 in) test heater hoses with plug and adapter to the core tubes. Then
connect the Pressure Test Kit to the adapter.
4. Apply 138 kPa (20 psi) of air pressure to the heater core. Submerge the heater core in water.
5. If a leak is observed, install a new heater core.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Core
Heater Core: Service and Repair Heater Core
Heater Core
Removal and Installation
NOTE: If a heater core leak is suspected, the heater core must be leak tested before it is removed
from the vehicle.
1. Remove the heater core and evaporator core housing. For additional information, refer to Heater
Core And Evaporator Core Housing See:
Heating and Air Conditioning/Housing Assembly HVAC/Service and Repair/Heater Core And
Evaporator Core Housing.
2. Remove the 8 plenum chamber screws.
3. Release the plenum chamber clip and position the plenum chamber aside.
4. Remove 2 heater core fitting clips and the dash panel seal.
5. Remove the heater core tube bracket screw and the heater core tube bracket.
6. Remove the heater core bracket screw and the heater core bracket.
7. Remove the heater core.
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Core > Page 2373
Heater Core: Service and Repair Auxiliary Heater Core
Auxiliary Heater Core - Expedition, Navigator
Removal and Installation
NOTE: If a heater core leak is suspected, the heater core must be pressure leak tested before it is
removed from the vehicle.
1. Remove the auxiliary heater core and evaporator core housing. For additional information, refer
to Auxiliary Heater Core and Evaporator Core
Housing - Expedition, Navigator See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Housing Assembly
HVAC/Service and Repair/Auxiliary Heater Core and Evaporator Core Housing.
2. Release the clip and open the floorpan bracket.
3. Remove the heater core tube bracket screw and the heater core tube bracket.
4. Remove the 12 evaporator/heater core access cover screws.
5. Remove the evaporator/heater core access cover.
6. Remove the heater core.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Core > Page 2374
Heater Core: Service and Repair Auxiliary Heater Core - Expedition EL, Navigator L
Auxiliary Heater Core - Expedition EL, Navigator L
Removal and Installation
NOTE: If a heater core leak is suspected, the heater core must be pressure leak tested before it is
removed from the vehicle.
NOTE: It is not necessary to install the new heater core tubes contained in the heater core service
kit unless there is evidence of damage to the heater core tubes. New O-ring seals must be installed
any time the heater core tubes are detached from the heater core.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Drain the engine coolant.
3. Remove the RH quarter trim panel.
4. Position a suitable drain pan and disconnect the 2 auxiliary heater outlet and inlet line quick
disconnect fittings at the floorpan connections to
allow any residual coolant to drain from the auxiliary heater core.
5. Remove the heater core door screw.
6. Remove the 2 auxiliary heater core tube fitting clips.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Core > Page 2375
7. Disconnect the 2 auxiliary heater core tubes.
1. Position the auxiliary heater core partially out of the housing.
2. Disconnect the auxiliary heater core inlet tube.
3. Disconnect the auxiliary heater core outlet tube.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
8. Remove the auxiliary heater core.
9. NOTE: Use only the O-ring seals contained in the auxiliary heater core service kit.
NOTE: Verify that the heater core tube fittings are completely seated in the heater core before
installing the heater core tube fitting clips.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
10. Fill the engine cooling system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cooling Module
Radiator: Service and Repair Cooling Module
Cooling Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cooling Module > Page 2380
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Drain the engine cooling system. For additional information, refer to Cooling System Draining,
Filling and Bleeding See: Service and
Repair/Cooling System Draining, Filling And Bleeding.
3. Recover the A/C system refrigerant.
4. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
5. Remove the RH and LH headlamp assemblies.
6. Remove the front bumper cover.
7. Release the 2 clamps and disconnect the 2 power steering fluid cooler hoses from the
condenser core.
8. Remove the cooling fan shroud. For additional information, refer to Cooling Fan Shroud See:
Fan Shroud/Service and Repair.
9. Remove the 2 hood latch assembly bolts.
10. Disconnect the 2 cable position retainers and position the hood latch assembly aside.
11. Remove the pushpin and move the air deflector aside.
12. Remove the 2 transmission cooler tube secondary latches.
13. Using the Transmission Cooler Line Disconnect Tool, disconnect the transmission fluid cooler
tubes from the transmission fluid cooler hoses.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cooling Module > Page 2381
14. Remove the condenser inlet fitting bolt, the condenser outlet fitting nut and disconnect the 2
fittings.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
15. Disconnect the horn assembly electrical connector.
16. Disconnect the ambient temperature sensor electrical connector.
17. Remove the 6 cooling module bolts and remove the cooling module from the vehicle.
Installation
1. Position the cooling module in the vehicle.
2. Install the 6 cooling module bolts.
- Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cooling Module > Page 2382
3. Connect the ambient temperature sensor electrical connector.
4. Connect the horn assembly electrical connector.
5. Using new O-ring seals, connect the A/C condenser outlet and inlet fittings and install the nut
and bolt.
- Tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
6. Connect the transmission fluid cooler tubes and install the 2 secondary latches.
7. Position the air deflector and install the pushpin.
8. Position the hood latch assembly and install the 2 hood latch assembly bolts.
- Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cooling Module > Page 2383
9. Connect the 2 hood latch cable position retainers.
10. Install the cooling fan shroud. For additional information, refer to Cooling Fan Shroud See: Fan
Shroud/Service and Repair.
11. Connect the 2 power steering fluid cooler hoses to the condenser core.
12. Install the front bumper cover.
13. Install the RH and LH headlamp assemblies.
14. Connect the battery ground cable.
15. Fill and bleed the engine cooling system. For additional information, refer to Cooling System
Draining, Filling and Bleeding See: Service and
Repair/Cooling System Draining, Filling And Bleeding.
16. Fill and bleed the power steering system.
17. Fill the transmission with fluid and verify correct operation.
18. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cooling Module > Page 2384
Radiator: Service and Repair Radiator
Radiator
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the RH and LH headlamp assemblies.
3. Remove the cooling fan shroud. For additional information, refer to Cooling Fan Shroud See:
Fan Shroud/Service and Repair.
4. Remove the 2 radiator bolts.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
5. Remove the 2 bolts and position the coolant expansion tank aside.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
6. Disconnect the electrical connector and remove the bolt and the horn assembly.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cooling Module > Page 2385
7. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Remove the 6 LH and RH air deflector-to-condenser core pin-type retainers.
8. Disconnect the 2 transmission fluid cooler-to-radiator hoses.
9. NOTE: The cooling module must be positioned rearward to raise and detach the 4 condenser
mounts from the radiator.
Depress the retaining tabs on the 2 lower condenser mounting brackets and raise the condenser
assembly until the 4 condenser mounting brackets detach from the radiator.
10. Remove the radiator.
11. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Fill the transmission fluid level.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Radiator Cooling Fan Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Radiator Cooling Fan Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Fan Speed Sensor (FSS)
The FSS is a Hall-effect sensor that measures the cooling fan clutch speed by generating a
waveform with a frequency proportional to the fan speed. If the cooling fan clutch is moving at a
relatively low speed, the sensor produces a signal with a low frequency. As the cooling fan clutch
speed increases, the sensor generates a signal with a higher frequency. The PCM uses the
frequency signal generated by the FSS as a feedback for closed loop control of the cooling fan
clutch. For additional information on the cooling fan clutch, refer to the Cooling Fan Clutch.
Cooling Fan Clutch with Fan Speed Sensor (FSS)
Cooling Fan Clutch with FSS
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
The ECT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The ECT measures the temperature of the engine coolant. The PCM uses the ECT input for fuel
control and for cooling fan control. There are three types of ECT sensors, threaded, push-in, and
twist-lock. The ECT sensor is located in an engine coolant passage.
Typical Thread Type Sensor
Typical Thread Type ECT Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2397
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2398
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Cylinder Head Temperature (CHT) Sensor
The CHT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with the temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
The CHT sensor is installed in the cylinder head and measures the metal temperature. The CHT
sensor can provide complete engine temperature information and can be used to infer coolant
temperature. If the CHT sensor conveys an overheating condition to the PCM, the PCM initiates a
fail-safe cooling strategy based on information from the CHT sensor. A cooling system concern
such as low coolant or coolant loss could cause an overheating condition. As a result, damage to
major engine components could occur. Using both the CHT sensor and fail-safe cooling strategy,
the PCM prevents damage by allowing air cooling of the engine and limp home capability. For
additional information, refer to Powertrain Control Software See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Description and Operation/Powertrain Control
Software for Fail-Safe Cooling Strategy.
Typical CHT Sensor
Typical CHT Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2399
Engine Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
Cylinder Head Temperature (CHT) Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold.
2. Disconnect the Cylinder Head Temperature (CHT) sensor electrical connector.
3. Remove the CHT sensor and discard.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Coat the new CHT sensor threads with high temperature nickel anti-seize lubricant prior to
installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Specifications
Thermostat: Specifications
Thermostat Opening Temperature
Starts to open.......................................................................................................................................
.............................................86.7-90.6°C (188-195°F) Fully open.......................................................
...................................................................................................................................................100°C
(212°F)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2403
Thermostat: Service and Repair
Thermostat and Thermostat Housing
Removal and Installation
1. Drain the engine cooling system. For additional information, refer to Cooling System Draining,
Filling and Bleeding See: Service and
Repair/Cooling System Draining, Filling And Bleeding.
2. If servicing the thermostat housing, disconnect the upper radiator hose from the thermostat
housing.
3. Remove the 2 bolts, the thermostat housing and the thermostat. Discard the O-ring seal.
- Inspect the mating surfaces. Clean the sealing surfaces with metal surface prep and silicone
gasket remover. Follow the directions on the packaging.
- If necessary, install a new thermostat with the spring facing down.
- Install a new O-ring seal.
- NOTE: Make sure the thermostat housing is seated evenly by hand tightening the 2 thermostat
housing bolts prior to final tightening.
To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat Housing, Engine Cooling >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Thermostat Housing: Service and Repair
Thermostat and Thermostat Housing
Removal and Installation
1. Drain the engine cooling system. For additional information, refer to Cooling System Draining,
Filling and Bleeding See: Service and
Repair/Cooling System Draining, Filling And Bleeding.
2. If servicing the thermostat housing, disconnect the upper radiator hose from the thermostat
housing.
3. Remove the 2 bolts, the thermostat housing and the thermostat. Discard the O-ring seal.
- Inspect the mating surfaces. Clean the sealing surfaces with metal surface prep and silicone
gasket remover. Follow the directions on the packaging.
- If necessary, install a new thermostat with the spring facing down.
- Install a new O-ring seal.
- NOTE: Make sure the thermostat housing is seated evenly by hand tightening the 2 thermostat
housing bolts prior to final tightening.
To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications
Water Pump: Specifications
Tighten the 4 coolant pump bolts. Tighten to.......................................................................................
................................................................................................................25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2410
Water Pump: Service and Repair
Coolant Pump
Removal
1. Drain the engine cooling system. For additional information, refer to Cooling System Draining,
Filling and Bleeding See: Service and
Repair/Cooling System Draining, Filling And Bleeding.
2. Remove the cooling fan. For additional information, refer to Cooling Fan See: Radiator Cooling
Fan/Fan Blade/Service and Repair.
3. Loosen the 4 coolant pump pulley bolts.
4. Remove the accessory drive belt.
5. Remove the 4 bolts and the coolant pump pulley.
6. Remove the 4 bolts and the coolant pump. Discard the O-ring seal.
7. Inspect the sealing surfaces and clean with metal surface prep. Follow the directions on the
packaging.
Installation
1. NOTICE: Align the bolt holes with the bosses prior to insertion of the coolant pump and insert the
pump straight into the coolant pump
cavity. Do not rotate the coolant pump once installed in the coolant pump cavity or damage to the
O-ring seal can occur, causing the coolant pump to leak.
NOTE: Install a new O-ring seal and lubricate with clean engine coolant.
Install the coolant pump and 4 bolts.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2411
- Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
2. Install the coolant pump pulley and 4 bolts.
3. Install the accessory drive belt.
4. Tighten the 4 bolts for the coolant pump pulley.
- Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
5. Install the cooling fan. For additional information, refer to Cooling Fan See: Radiator Cooling
Fan/Fan Blade/Service and Repair.
6. Fill the engine cooling system. For addition information, refer to Cooling System Draining, Filling
and Bleeding See: Service and Repair/Cooling
System Draining, Filling And Bleeding.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component Information
> Description and Operation
Catalytic Converter: Description and Operation
Catalyst and Exhaust Systems
Overview
The catalytic converter and exhaust systems work together to control the release of harmful engine
exhaust emissions into the atmosphere. The engine exhaust gas consists mainly of nitrogen (N),
carbon dioxide (CO2) and water (H2O). However, it also contains carbon monoxide (CO), oxides of
nitrogen (NOx), hydrogen (H), and various unburned hydrocarbons (HCs). The major air pollutants
of CO, NOx, and HCs, and their emission into the atmosphere must be controlled.
The exhaust system generally consists of an exhaust manifold, front exhaust pipe, front heated
oxygen sensor (HO2S), rear exhaust pipe, catalyst HO2S, a muffler, and an exhaust tailpipe. The
catalytic converter is typically installed between the front and rear exhaust pipes. On some vehicle
applications, more than one catalyst is used between the front and rear exhaust pipes. Catalytic
converter efficiency is monitored by the on board diagnostic (OBD) system strategy in the
powertrain control module (PCM). For information on the OBD catalyst monitor, refer to the
description for the Catalyst Efficiency Monitor See: Powertrain Management/Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Monitors, Trips, Drive Cycles and Readiness
Codes/Catalyst Efficiency Monitor.
For most vehicles, only two HO2Ss are used in an exhaust stream. The front sensors
(HO2S11/HO2S21) before the catalyst are used for primary fuel control while the ones after the
catalyst (HO2S12/HO2S22) are used to monitor catalyst efficiency. However, some partial zero
emission vehicles (PZEVs) use three HO2Ss. The stream 1 sensor (HO2S11) located before the
catalyst is used for primary fuel control, the stream 2 sensor (HO2S12) is used to monitor the
light-off catalyst, and the stream 3 sensor (HO2S13) located after the catalyst is used for long term
fuel trim control to optimize catalyst efficiency (fore aft oxygen sensor control).
V-Engines
V-Engines
In-Line Engines
In-Line Engines
Catalytic Converter
A catalyst is a material that remains unchanged when it initiates and increases the speed of a
chemical reaction. A catalyst also enables a chemical reaction to occur at a lower temperature. The
concentration of exhaust gas products released to the atmosphere must be controlled. The
catalytic converter assists in this task. It contains a catalyst in the form of a specially treated
ceramic honeycomb structure saturated with catalytically active precious metals. As the exhaust
gases come in contact with the catalyst, they are changed into mostly harmless products. The
catalyst initiates and speeds up heat producing chemical reactions of the exhaust gas components
so they are used up as much as possible.
Light Off Catalyst
As the catalyst heats up, converter efficiency rises rapidly. The point at which conversion efficiency
exceeds 50% is called catalyst light off. For most catalysts this point occurs at 246°C to 302°C
(475°F to 575°F). A fast light catalyst is a three way catalytic converter (TWC) that is located as
close to the exhaust manifold as possible. Because the light off catalyst is located close to the
exhaust manifold it lights off faster and reduces emissions more quickly than the catalyst located
under the body. Once the catalyst lights off, the catalyst quickly reaches the maximum conversion
efficiency for that
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Page 2416
catalyst.
Three Way Catalytic Converter (TWC) Conversion Efficiency
A TWC requires a stoichiometric fuel ratio, 14.7 pounds of air to 1 pound of fuel (14.7:1), for high
conversion efficiency. In order to achieve these high efficiencies, the air/fuel ratio must be tightly
controlled with a narrow window of stoichiometry. Deviations outside of this window greatly
decrease the conversion efficiency. For example a rich mixture decreases the HC and CO
conversion efficiency while a lean mixture decreases the NOx conversion efficiency.
TWC Conversion Efficiency Chart
TWC Conversion Efficiency Chart
Exhaust System
The purpose of the exhaust system is to convey engine emissions from the exhaust manifold to the
atmosphere. Engine exhaust emissions are directed from the engine exhaust manifold to the
catalytic converter through the front exhaust pipe. A HO2S is mounted on the front exhaust pipe
before the catalyst. The catalytic converter reduces the concentration of CO, unburned HCs, and
NOx in the exhaust emissions to an acceptable level. The reduced exhaust emissions are directed
from the catalytic converter past another HO2S mounted in the rear exhaust pipe and then on into
the muffler. Finally, the exhaust emissions are directed to the atmosphere through an exhaust
tailpipe.
On some PZEV, there is a total of three HO2Ss in the exhaust stream. One near the exhaust
manifold (stream 1), one in the middle of the light-off catalyst (stream 2), and the third (stream 3) is
mounted after the light-off catalyst.
Typical Bank 1 Catalyst 2 H2OS Configuration
Typical Bank 1 Catalyst 2 HO2S Configuration
Typical Bank 1 Catalyst 3 H2OS Configuration
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Page 2417
Typical Bank 1 Catalyst 3 HO2S Configuration
Underbody Catalyst
The underbody catalyst is located after the light off catalyst. The underbody catalyst may be in line
with the light off catalyst, or the underbody catalyst may be common to two light off catalysts,
forming a Y pipe configuration. For an exact configuration of the catalyst and exhaust system for a
specific vehicle, refer to the Exhaust System for the exhaust system exploded view.
Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter
The TWC contains either platinum (Pt) and rhodium (Rh) or palladium (Pd) and rhodium (Rh). The
TWC catalyzes the oxidation reactions of unburned HCs and CO and the reduction reaction of
NOx. The 3-way conversion can be best accomplished by always operating the engine air fuel/ratio
at or close to stoichiometry.
Exhaust Manifold Runners
The exhaust manifold runners collect exhaust gases from engine cylinders. The number of exhaust
manifolds and exhaust manifold runners depends on the engine configuration and number of
cylinders.
Exhaust Pipes
Exhaust pipes are usually treated during manufacturing with an anti-corrosive coating agent to
increase the life of the product. The pipes serve as guides for the flow of exhaust gases from the
engine exhaust manifold through the catalytic converter and the muffler.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
The HO2Ss provide the PCM with information related to the oxygen content of the exhaust gas. For
additional information on the HO2S, refer to Engine Control Components See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Description and Operation/Engine Control
Components.
Muffler
Mufflers are usually treated during manufacturing with an anti-corrosive coating agent to increase
the life of the product. The muffler reduces the level of noise produced by the engine, and also
reduces the noise produced by exhaust gases as they travel from the catalytic converter to the
atmosphere.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Page 2418
Catalytic Converter: Service and Repair
Exhaust System - Exploded View
Expedition and Navigator
NOTE: Rear Wheel Drive (RWD) shown, Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) similar.
Expedition EL and Navigator L
NOTE: Rear Wheel Drive (RWD) shown, Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) similar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Page 2419
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications
Exhaust Manifold: Specifications
Install 16 new exhaust manifold studs. Tighten to................................................................................
....................................................................................................................12 Nm (106 lb-in).
Position a new gasket, the LH exhaust manifold and tighten the 8 nuts in the sequence shown.
Tighten to..............................................................................................................................................
.........................................................25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
Exhaust Manifold - LH
Position a new gasket, the RH exhaust manifold and tighten the 8 nuts in the sequence shown.
Tighten to..............................................................................................................................................
.........................................................25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
Exhaust Manifold - RH
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures
Exhaust Manifold: Procedures
Exhaust Manifold Cleaning and Inspection
1. Clean the exhaust manifold using a suitable solvent. Use a plastic scraping tool to clean the
gasket sealing surfaces.
2. NOTE: New exhaust manifold gaskets, studs, nuts and/or bolts must be installed when an
exhaust manifold is serviced.
NOTE: Use a Straightedge that is calibrated by the manufacturer to be flat within 0.005 mm
(0.0002 in) per running foot of length, such as Snap-On(R) GA438A or equivalent. For example, if
the Straightedge is 61 cm (24 in) long, the machined edge must be flat within 0.010 mm (0.0004 in)
from end to end.
Using the Straightedge and a Feeler Gauge Set, check the exhaust manifold sealing surface for
warpage. If the warpage is greater than 0.76 mm (0.0299 in), install a new exhaust manifold.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2425
Exhaust Manifold: Removal and Replacement
Exhaust Manifold - LH
Exhaust Manifold - LH
Removal
All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the Air Cleaner (ACL) outlet pipe.
3. Remove the degas bottle.
4. NOTICE: Do not allow the steering column shaft to rotate while the intermediate shaft is
disconnected or damage to the clockspring can
result. If there is evidence that the shaft has rotated, the clockspring must be removed and
recentered. For additional information, refer to Air Bag Systems.
Remove the bolt and disconnect the steering shaft and position aside.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2426
5. Remove the 4 (2 LH and 2 RH) exhaust manifold-to-catalytic converter nuts.
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) vehicles
6. Remove the front driveshaft.
All vehicles
7. Remove the 8 exhaust manifold nuts, the 8 studs and the exhaust manifold.
- Discard the exhaust manifold nuts and studs.
8. NOTICE: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These may
cause scratches and gouges resulting in leak paths. Use a plastic scraper to clean the sealing
surfaces.
NOTE: Clean the sealing surfaces with metal surface prep. Follow the directions on the packaging.
Remove and discard the 2 exhaust manifold gaskets. Clean the sealing surfaces with metal surface
prep.
9. Inspect the exhaust manifold.
Installation
All vehicles
1. Using 2 new exhaust manifold gaskets and 8 new studs, position the 2 gaskets and exhaust
manifold and install the 8 studs.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
2. Using new exhaust manifold nuts, install the 8 nuts.
- Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft) in the sequence shown.
Exhaust Manifold - LH
4WD vehicles
3. Install the front driveshaft.
All vehicles
4. NOTICE: Do not allow the steering column shaft to rotate while the intermediate shaft is
disconnected or damage to the clockspring can
result. If there is evidence that the shaft has rotated, the clockspring must be removed and
recentered. For additional information, refer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2427
to Air Bag Systems.
Connect the steering shaft and install the bolt. To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
5. Install the 4 exhaust manifold-to-catalytic converter nuts.
6. Install the degas bottle.
7. Install the ACL outlet tube.
Exhaust Manifold - RH
Exhaust Manifold - RH
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2428
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the RH inner fenderwell.
3. Remove the RH engine support insulator. For additional information, refer to Engine Support
Insulators See: Engine/Drive Belts, Mounts,
Brackets and Accessories/Engine Mount/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement.
4. Remove the 2 bolts and the exhaust manifold heat shield.
5. Remove the 8 exhaust manifold nuts, the 8 studs and the exhaust manifold.
- Discard the exhaust manifold nuts and studs.
6. NOTICE: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These may
cause scratches and gouges resulting in leak paths. Use a plastic scraper to clean the sealing
surfaces.
NOTE: Clean the sealing surfaces with metal surface prep. Follow the directions on the packaging.
Remove and discard the 2 exhaust manifold gaskets. Clean the sealing surfaces with metal surface
prep.
7. Inspect the exhaust manifold.
Installation
1. Using 2 new exhaust manifold gaskets and 8 new studs, position the 2 gaskets and exhaust
manifold and install the 8 studs.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
2. Using 8 new exhaust manifold nuts, install the 8 nuts.
- Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft) in the sequence shown.
Exhaust Manifold - RH
3. Position the exhaust manifold heat shield and install the 2 bolts.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
4. Install the RH engine support insulator. For additional information, refer to Engine Support
Insulators See: Engine/Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets
and Accessories/Engine Mount/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement.
5. Install the RH inner fenderwell.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Exhaust System - Exploded View
Exhaust Pipe: Service and Repair Exhaust System - Exploded View
Exhaust System - Exploded View
Expedition and Navigator
NOTE: Rear Wheel Drive (RWD) shown, Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) similar.
Expedition EL and Navigator L
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Exhaust System - Exploded View > Page 2433
NOTE: Rear Wheel Drive (RWD) shown, Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) similar.
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Exhaust System - Exploded View > Page 2434
Exhaust Pipe: Service and Repair Exhaust Y-Pipe - Dual Catalytic Converter
Exhaust Y-Pipe - Dual Catalytic Converter
Removal
NOTICE: Do not use oil or grease-based lubricants on isolators as they deteriorate the rubber.
NOTE: The exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter is a 2-piece assembly. The RH and LH
converters can be serviced separately as needed.
All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Disconnect the Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) and Catalyst Monitor Sensor (CMS) electrical
connectors.
3. Remove the transmission support crossmember.
4. Loosen the exhaust and transmission mounting bracket cap bolt.
Rear Wheel Drive (RWD) vehicles
5. Remove the 3 bolts and then slide off the exhaust and transmission mounting bracket from the
exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter.
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) vehicles
6. NOTE: On Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) vehicles, the exhaust and transmission mounting bracket
will not slide off the exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic
converter until the exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter is removed from the vehicle.
NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
Remove the 4 bolts from the exhaust and transmission mounting bracket.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Exhaust System - Exploded View > Page 2435
All vehicles
7. Remove the 2 exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter-to-muffler assembly bolts.
8. NOTE: LH catalytic converter-to-exhaust manifold nuts shown, RH similar.
Remove the 4 exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter-to-exhaust manifold nuts.
- Discard the nuts.
9. Remove the exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter from the vehicle.
4WD vehicles
10. If necessary, remove the exhaust and transmission mounting bracket from the exhaust Y-pipe
dual catalytic converter.
All vehicles
11. If necessary, loosen the RH catalytic converter-to-LH catalytic converter Torca(R) clamp.
12. If necessary, separate the RH catalytic converter from the LH catalytic converter.
Installation
All vehicles
NOTICE: Do not tighten the fasteners until all components are assembled and aligned, making
sure to tighten all fasteners beginning at the front of the vehicle. For additional information, refer to
Exhaust System Alignment See: Service and Repair.
NOTE: Clean the mating surfaces of the exhaust manifold outlet flare and the exhaust Y-pipe dual
catalytic converter inlet flares. Also clean the mating surfaces of the exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic
converter-to-muffler assembly.
1. If separated, install RH catalytic converter to the LH catalytic converter.
4WD vehicles
2. If removed, install the exhaust and transmission mounting bracket to the exhaust Y-pipe dual
catalytic converter.
All vehicles
3. Position the exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter into the vehicle.
4. Install the 2 new RH catalytic converter-to-exhaust manifold nuts and tighten in the following
sequence:
1. Tighten the RH lower catalytic converter-to-exhaust manifold nut.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
2. Tighten the RH upper catalytic converter-to-exhaust manifold nut.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Exhaust System - Exploded View > Page 2436
5. Install the 2 new LH catalytic converter-to-exhaust manifold nuts and tighten in the following
sequence:
1. Snug the LH inner catalytic converter-to-exhaust manifold nut.
2. Tighten the LH outer catalytic converter-to-exhaust manifold nut.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3. Tighten the LH inner catalytic converter-to-exhaust manifold nut.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
6. If loosened, tighten the RH catalytic converter-to-LH catalytic converter Torca(R) clamp.
- Tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
7. Install the 2 exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter-to-muffler assembly bolts and tighten in the
following sequence:
1. Snug the outer exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter-to-muffler assembly bolt.
2. Tighten the inner exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter-to-muffler assembly bolt.
- Tighten to 63 Nm (46 lb-ft).
3. Tighten the outer exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter-to-muffler assembly bolt.
- Tighten to 63 Nm (46 lb-ft).
4WD vehicles
8. NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
Install the 4 exhaust and transmission mounting bracket-to-transmission bolts.
- Tighten to 90 Nm (66 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Exhaust System - Exploded View > Page 2437
RWD vehicles
9. Slide on the exhaust and transmission mounting bracket to the exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic
converter and install the 3 exhaust and transmission
mounting bracket-to-transmission bolts. Tighten to 90 Nm (66 lb-ft).
All vehicles
10. Tighten the exhaust and transmission mounting bracket cap bolt.
- Tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
11. Install the transmission support crossmember.
12. Connect the HO2S and CMS electrical connectors.
13. Check to see if the exhaust system isolators are at zero load. If the exhaust system isolators
are not at zero load, then carry out the exhaust system
alignment procedure. For additional information, refer the Exhaust System Alignment See: Service
and Repair.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Exhaust System - Exploded View
Muffler: Service and Repair Exhaust System - Exploded View
Exhaust System - Exploded View
Expedition and Navigator
NOTE: Rear Wheel Drive (RWD) shown, Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) similar.
Expedition EL and Navigator L
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Exhaust System - Exploded View > Page 2442
NOTE: Rear Wheel Drive (RWD) shown, Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) similar.
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Exhaust System - Exploded View > Page 2443
Muffler: Service and Repair Muffler And Tailpipe
Muffler and Tailpipe
Removal
NOTICE: Do not use oil or grease-based lubricants on the isolators. These lubricants may cause
deterioration of the isolator. This can lead to separation of the isolator from the exhaust hanger
bracket during vehicle operation.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. NOTE: LH side shown, RH side similar.
If equipped, remove the 6 bolts and transfer case skid plate.
3. Loosen the tail pipe or resonator-to-muffler assembly Torca(R) clamp.
4. Remove the 2 isolator and bracket assembly bolts and remove:
- the tail pipe for Expedition models.
- the resonator for Navigator models.
5. Using a suitable jackstand, support the muffler.
6. Remove the 2 exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter-to-muffler assembly bolts.
7. NOTICE: Make sure not to make contact with the axle boots while routing the muffler assembly
outlet over the rear axle or damage to
the boots may result.
Detach the isolators from the muffler assembly and remove from the vehicle.
Installation
NOTICE: Do not use oil or grease-based lubricants on the isolators. These lubricants may cause
deterioration of the isolator. This can lead to separation of the isolators from the exhaust hanger
bracket during vehicle operation.
1. NOTE: Clean the mating surfaces of the exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter-to-muffler
assembly.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Exhaust System - Exploded View > Page 2444
NOTE: Check the exhaust hanger isolators for wear or damage, install new isolators, if necessary.
Install the muffler assembly into the vehicle and attach the isolators.
2. Install the 2 exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter-to-muffler assembly bolts and tighten in the
following sequence:
1. Snug the outer exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter-to-muffler assembly bolt.
2. Tighten the inner exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter-to-muffler assembly bolt.
- Tighten to 63 Nm (46 lb-ft).
3. Tighten the outer exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter-to-muffler assembly bolt.
- Tighten to 63 Nm (46 lb-ft).
3. Install the tail pipe for Expedition models or the resonator for Navigator models and install the
isolator and 2 bracket assembly bolts.
- Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
4. Tighten the tail pipe or resonator-to-muffler assembly Torca(R) clamp.
- Tighten to 48 Nm (35 lb-ft).
5. Check to see if the exhaust system isolators are at zero load. If the exhaust system isolators are
not at zero load, then carry out the exhaust system
alignment procedure. For additional information, refer the Exhaust System Alignment See: Service
and Repair.
6. NOTE: LH side shown, RH side similar.
If equipped, install the transfer case skid plate and 6 bolts.
- Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Electronic Throttle Control Module: Description and Operation
Torque-Based Electronic Throttle Control (ETC)
Overview
The torque-based ETC is a hardware and software strategy that delivers an engine output torque
(via throttle angle) based on driver demand (pedal position). It uses an electronic throttle body, the
powertrain control module (PCM), and an accelerator pedal assembly to control the throttle
opening and engine torque.
Torque-based ETC enables aggressive automatic transmission shift schedules (earlier upshifts and
later downshifts). This is possible by adjusting the throttle angle to achieve the same wheel torque
during shifts, and by calculating this desired torque, the system prevents engine lugging (low RPM
and low manifold vacuum) while still delivering the performance and torque requested by the driver.
It also enables many fuel economy/emission improvement technologies such as variable camshaft
timing (VCT), which delivers same torque during transitions.
Torque-based ETC also results in less intrusive vehicle and engine speed limiting, along with
smoother traction control.
Other benefits of torque-based ETC are:
- eliminate cruise control actuators
- eliminate idle air control (IAC) valve
- better airflow range
- packaging (no cable)
- more responsive powertrain at altitude and improved shift quality
The ETC system illuminates a powertrain malfunction indicator (wrench) on the instrument cluster
when a concern is present. Concerns are accompanied by diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) and
may also illuminate the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL).
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB)
The ETB has the following characteristics:
- The throttle actuator control (TAC) motor is a DC motor controlled by the PCM (requires 2 wires).
- There are two designs: parallel and in-line. The parallel design has the motor under the bore
parallel to the plate shaft. The motor housing is integrated into the main housing. The in-line design
has a separate motor housing.
- An internal spring is used in both designs to return the throttle plate to a default position. The
default position is typically a throttle angle of 7 to 8 degrees from the hard stop angle.
- The closed throttle plate hard stop is used to prevent the throttle from binding in the bore. This
hard stop setting is not adjustable and is set to result in less airflow than the minimum engine
airflow required at idle.
- The required idle airflow is provided by the plate angle in the throttle body assembly. This plate
angle controls idle, idle quality, and eliminates the need for an IAC valve.
- There is one reference voltage and one signal return circuit between the PCM and the ETB. The
reference voltage and the signal return circuits are shared with the reference voltage and signal
return circuits used by the accelerator pedal position (APP) sensor. There are also two throttle
position (TP) signal circuits for redundancy. The redundant TP signals are required for increased
monitoring reasons. The first TP signal (TP1) has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing
voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage).
The TP2 signal reaches a limit of approximately 4.5 volts at approximately 45 degrees of throttle
angle.
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor
Depending on the application either a 2-track or 3-track APP sensor is used. For additional
information on the APP sensor, refer to Engine Control Components See: Computers and Control
Systems/Description and Operation/Engine Control Components.
Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) System Strategy
The torque-based ETC strategy was developed to improve fuel economy and to accommodate
variable camshaft timing (VCT). This is possible by not coupling the throttle angle to the driver
pedal position. Uncoupling the throttle angle (produce engine torque) from the pedal position (driver
demand)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 2451
allows the powertrain control strategy to optimize fuel control and transmission shift schedules
while delivering the requested wheel torque.
The ETC monitor system is distributed across two processors within the PCM: the main powertrain
control processor unit (CPU) and a separate monitoring processor. The primary monitoring function
is carried out by the independent plausibility check (IPC) software, which resides on the main
processor. It is responsible for determining the driver-demanded torque and comparing it to an
estimate of the actual torque delivered. If the generated torque exceeds driver demand by a
specified amount, appropriate corrective action is taken.
ETC System With A 3-Track APP Sensor Failure Mode And Effects Management:
a - ETC illuminates or displays a message on the message center immediately; MIL illuminates
after 2 driving cycles
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 2452
ETC System With A 2-Track APP Sensor Failure Mode And Effects Management:
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation:
a - Monitor execution is continuous. Monitor false detection duration is less than 1 second to
register a concern.
APP and TP Sensor Inputs
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 2453
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Check:
Correlation and range/performance - sensor disagreement between processors internal to the
PCM. Monitor execution is continuous. Monitor false detection duration is less than 1 second to
register a concern. Refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Charts and Descriptions for additional
DTC information.
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Check:
a - Correlation and range/performance - sensor disagreement between processors internal to the
PCM, TP inconsistent with requested throttle plate position. Monitor execution is continuous.
Monitor false detection duration is less than 1 second to register a concern. Refer to Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DTC) Charts and Descriptions for additional DTC information.
Electronic Throttle Actuator Control (TAC) Output
Electronic TAC Operation Check:
a - Note: For all DTCs, in addition to the MIL, the powertrain malfunction indicator (wrench) is on for
the concern that caused the FMEM action. Monitor execution is continuous. Monitor false detection
duration is less than 5 seconds to register a concern.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 10-12-4 > Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh
Downshifts
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh Downshifts
TSB 10-12-4
07/05/10
5.4L 3V AND 6R80 TRANSMISSION - DELAYED/HARSH DOWNSHIFT ABOVE 40 MPH (64
KM/H)
FORD: 2009-2010 Expedition, F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built on or before 5/1/2010 and
2009-2010 F-150 vehicles built on or before 2/1/2010 and equipped with 5.4L 3V engine and 6R80
transmission may exhibit a delayed then harsh downshift during a commanded downshift at speeds
above 40 MPH (64 Km/h).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
ID vehicle.
2. Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 67.03 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the 1CM Calibration is:
(1) AL3P-7J104-AC for all vehicles except the F-150 4X4.
(2) AL3P-7J104-BC for F-150 4X4.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox
(2) Powertrain
(3) OBD Test Modes
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info
(5) 1CM Cal Part Number
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT 1CM KAM BE CLEARED FOR THIS PROCEDURE TO BE FULLY
EFFECTIVE
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox
(2) Choose Powertrain Then Choose TCM
(3) Choose Reset KAM
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 10-12-4 > Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh
Downshifts > Page 2462
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset 1CM KAM
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM
KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop, allow at least six (6) seconds.
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101204A 2009-2010 Expedition, 1.0 Hr.
Navigator, F-150: Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM And Perform Road
Tests (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 10-12-4 > Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh
Downshifts > Page 2463
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4
Shifts
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
TSB 09-15-8
08/10/09
5.4L 3V 6R80 - HARSH 1-2 UPSHIFT - HARSH 2-1 DOWNSHIFT WHILE COASTING - HARSH
DOWNSHIFT TO 4TH GEAR - INTERMITTENT P0741
FORD: 2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with 5.4L 3V engine may exhibit
symptoms during warm-up: a harsh 1-2 upshift, harsh 2-1 downshift while coasting 15 MPH (24
Km/h). A harsh downshift into 4th gear at highway speeds 45-70 MPH (72-113 Km/h) may also be
experienced. Some vehicles may have a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0741 torque converter
performance code present or stored.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
MECHATRONIC REPAIR/REPLACEMENT IS NOT
AUTHORIZED FOR THIS ISSUE.
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the Powertrain Control Module/Transmission Control Module (PCM/TCM) calibration
using IDS release 61.15 and higher or 62.03 and
higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be
obtained at the website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the TCM Calibration shows AL3P-7J104-AB part number after reprogramming is
complete.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) OBD Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR TSB TO BE
FULLY AFFECTIVE
3. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4
Shifts > Page 2468
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM.
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175° F (79° C). If it is not at
175° F (79° C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175° F (79° C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091508A 2009 Expedition, Navigator 1.0 Hr.
6R80 Transmission: Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear The
TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4
Shifts > Page 2469
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-12-4 > Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls Delayed/Harsh Downshifts
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh
Downshifts
TSB 10-12-4
07/05/10
5.4L 3V AND 6R80 TRANSMISSION - DELAYED/HARSH DOWNSHIFT ABOVE 40 MPH (64
KM/H)
FORD: 2009-2010 Expedition, F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built on or before 5/1/2010 and
2009-2010 F-150 vehicles built on or before 2/1/2010 and equipped with 5.4L 3V engine and 6R80
transmission may exhibit a delayed then harsh downshift during a commanded downshift at speeds
above 40 MPH (64 Km/h).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
ID vehicle.
2. Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 67.03 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the 1CM Calibration is:
(1) AL3P-7J104-AC for all vehicles except the F-150 4X4.
(2) AL3P-7J104-BC for F-150 4X4.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox
(2) Powertrain
(3) OBD Test Modes
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info
(5) 1CM Cal Part Number
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT 1CM KAM BE CLEARED FOR THIS PROCEDURE TO BE FULLY
EFFECTIVE
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox
(2) Choose Powertrain Then Choose TCM
(3) Choose Reset KAM
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-12-4 > Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls Delayed/Harsh Downshifts > Page 2475
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset 1CM KAM
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM
KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop, allow at least six (6) seconds.
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101204A 2009-2010 Expedition, 1.0 Hr.
Navigator, F-150: Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM And Perform Road
Tests (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-12-4 > Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls Delayed/Harsh Downshifts > Page 2476
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh
1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4
Shifts
TSB 09-15-8
08/10/09
5.4L 3V 6R80 - HARSH 1-2 UPSHIFT - HARSH 2-1 DOWNSHIFT WHILE COASTING - HARSH
DOWNSHIFT TO 4TH GEAR - INTERMITTENT P0741
FORD: 2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with 5.4L 3V engine may exhibit
symptoms during warm-up: a harsh 1-2 upshift, harsh 2-1 downshift while coasting 15 MPH (24
Km/h). A harsh downshift into 4th gear at highway speeds 45-70 MPH (72-113 Km/h) may also be
experienced. Some vehicles may have a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0741 torque converter
performance code present or stored.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
MECHATRONIC REPAIR/REPLACEMENT IS NOT
AUTHORIZED FOR THIS ISSUE.
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the Powertrain Control Module/Transmission Control Module (PCM/TCM) calibration
using IDS release 61.15 and higher or 62.03 and
higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be
obtained at the website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the TCM Calibration shows AL3P-7J104-AB part number after reprogramming is
complete.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) OBD Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR TSB TO BE
FULLY AFFECTIVE
3. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh
1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 2481
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM.
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175° F (79° C). If it is not at
175° F (79° C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175° F (79° C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091508A 2009 Expedition, Navigator 1.0 Hr.
6R80 Transmission: Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear The
TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh
1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 2482
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 2483
Engine Control Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 2484
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 2485
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 2486
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 2487
Engine Control Module: Diagrams
C175B Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 2488
C175B Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 2489
C175B Part 3
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 2490
C175E Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 2491
C175E Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 2492
C175E Part 3
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 2493
C175T Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 2494
C175T Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures
Engine Control Module: Procedures
Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EEPROM)
Description
The EEPROM is contained in an integrated circuit internal to the powertrain control module (PCM).
The EEPROM contains the vehicle strategy including calibration information specific to the vehicle,
and is capable of being programmed or flashed repeatedly.
As part of the calibration there is an area referred to as the vehicle identification (VID) block. The
VID block is programmed when installing a new PCM as described under Programming the VID
Block for a Replacement PCM. Failure to carry out this procedure may generate DTC P1635 or
P1639. The VID block in an existing PCM can also be tailored to accommodate various hardware
or parameter changes made to the vehicle since production. Failure to carry out this procedure
properly may generate DTC P1635, Tire/Axle Ratio out of Acceptable Range. An incorrect tire/axle
ratio is one of the main causes for DTC P1639. This is described under Making Changes to the VID
Block and also under Making Changes to the PCM Calibration. The VID block contains many items
used by the strategy for a variety of functions. Some of these items include the vehicle identification
number (VIN), octane adjust, fuel octane, fuel type, vehicle speed limit, tire size, axle ratio, the
presence of speed control, and 4-wheel drive electronic shift-on-the-fly (ESOF) versus manual
shift-on-the-fly (MSOF). Only items applicable to the vehicle hardware and supported by the VID
block is displayed on the scan tool.
When changing items in the VID block, the strategy places range limits on certain items such as
tire and axle ratio. The number of times the VID block may be reconfigured is limited. When this
limit is reached, the scan tool displays a message indicating the need to flash the PCM again to
reset the VID block.
On selected vehicles equipped with permanent DTC reporting capabilities, neutral profile correction
should be learned after a PCM replacement in order to activate the misfire monitor. This can be
accomplished using the Misfire Monitor Neutral Profile Learn function on the scan tool.
Programming can be carried out by a local Ford dealer or any non-Ford facility. Refer to the scan
tool manufacturer's instruction manual for details.
Neutral Profile Correction
In order for the misfire detection system to function properly, any mechanical inaccuracies in the
crankshaft position (CKP) sensor must be learned by the PCM. This information is stored in
non-volatile memory (NVM) in the PCM. It is not cleared when the keep alive memory (KAM) is
reset.
Neutral profile learning is accomplished using the scan tool any time a PCM is replaced. It should
also be relearned any time the CKP sensor is replaced or major engine repairs have been
completed.
To determine if the neutral profile learning has been completed, check the MP_LRN parameter
identification (PID) using the scan tool. The PID should read YES if the neutral profile learning has
been completed. If the PID reads NO, complete the neutral profile learning prior to diagnosing any
misfire DTCs.
Programming the VID Block for a Replacement PCM
The VID block on a replacement PCM is blank and requires programming. There are two
procedures available. The first is an automatic data transfer from the old PCM to the new PCM,
and the second is manual data entry into the new PCM.
Automatic data transfer is carried out if the old PCM is capable of communicating. This is done by
using a scan tool to retrieve data from the old PCM before removing it from the vehicle. The stored
data can be downloaded to the new PCM after it has been installed.
Carry out manual data entry if the old PCM is damaged or incapable of communicating. Remove
and install a new PCM. Using a compatible scan tool, select and carry out the module/parameter
programming, referring to the scan tool manufacturer's instruction manual. Make certain that all
parameters are included. Failure to properly program tire size in revolutions per mile, (rev/mile
equals 63,360 divided by the tire circumference in inches), axle ratio, 4x4/4x2, and/or MSOF/ESOF
may result in DTCs P1635 and P1639. You may be instructed to contact the As-Built Data Center
for the information needed to manually update the VID block with the scan tool. Contact the center
only if the old PCM cannot be used or the data is corrupt. For Ford and Lincoln Mercury
technicians, contact your National Hotline or the Professional Technician Society (PTS) website for
As-Built data listed under the Service Publications Index. Non-Ford technicians use the
Motorcraft(R) website at www.motorcraft.com. From the Motorcraft(R) homepage, use the search
function to find the Module Programming or As-Built Data.
For Ford and Lincoln Mercury technicians, check the Programmable Module Installation link on the
PTS website for quick Programmable Module data information by vehicle.
Making Changes to the VID Block
A programmed PCM may require changes to be made to certain VID information to accommodate
the vehicle hardware. Refer to Module Reprogramming on the scan tool.
Making Changes to the PCM Calibration
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 2497
At certain times, the entire EEPROM needs to be completely reprogrammed. This is due to
changes made to the strategy or calibration after production, or the need to reset the VID block
because it has reached its limit. Refer to Module Reprogramming on the scan tool.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 2498
Engine Control Module: Removal and Replacement
Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: Refer to Computers and Control Systems Information for correct Vehicle Communication
Module (VCM) hook-up procedure.
If servicing the PCM, connect the scan tool to the vehicle. Allow the scan tool to identify the vehicle
and obtain configuration data.
- All programmable module information will automatically be retrieved by the VCM.
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
3. Disconnect the 3 PCM electrical connectors.
4. Remove the 2 stud bolts and the PCM.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
5. NOTE: If the Instrument Cluster (IC) or the PCM is being replaced (or both), the parameters
must be reset in both modules or the vehicle will
experience a Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) no-start. This will occur even if the vehicle is not
equipped with PATS.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
6. Using the scan tool, perform the Misfire Monitor Neutral Profile Correction procedure, following
the on-screen instructions.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2502
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2503
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Control Unit > Component Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pump Control Unit: Service and Repair
Fuel Pump Control Module
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the fuel pump control module electrical connector.
2. Remove the 2 bolts and the fuel pump control module.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 2511
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 2512
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2516
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2517
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2523
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2524
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2525
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
amount of torque requested by the operator. Depending on the application either a 2-track or
3-track APP sensor is used.
2-Track APP Sensor
There are two pedal position signals in the sensor. Both signals, APP1 and APP2, have a positive
slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage), but are offset and increase at different rates. The two
pedal position signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if one signal has a
concern. The PCM determines if a signal is incorrect by calculating where it should be, inferred
from the other signals. If a concern is present with one of the circuits the other input is used. There
are two reference voltage circuits, two signal return circuits, and two signal circuits (a total of six
circuits and pins) between the PCM and the APP sensor assembly. The reference voltage circuits
and the signal return circuits are shared with the reference voltage circuit and signal return circuit
used by the electronic throttle body (ETB) throttle position (TP) sensor. The pedal position signal is
converted to pedal travel degrees (rotary angle) by the PCM. The software then converts these
degrees to counts, which is the input to the torque based strategy. For additional information, refer
to Torque Based Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) See: Computers and Control Systems/Electronic
Throttle Control Module/Description and Operation.
2-Track APP Sensor
Typical 2-Track APP Sensor
3-Track APP Sensor
There are three pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APP1, has a negative slope
(increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APP2 and APP3, both have a positive
slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APP1 is used as the
indication of pedal position by the strategy. The three pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if one signal has a concern. The PCM determines if a signal is
incorrect by calculating where it should be, inferred from the other signals. If a concern is present
with one of the circuits the other inputs are used. The pedal position signal is converted to pedal
travel degrees (rotary angle) by the PCM. The software then converts these degrees to counts,
which is the input to the torque based strategy. There are two reference voltage circuits, two signal
return circuits, and three signal circuits (a total of seven circuits and pins) between the PCM and
the APP sensor assembly. The reference voltage circuits and the signal return circuits are shared
with the reference voltage circuit and signal return circuit used by the electronic throttle body (ETB)
throttle position sensor. For additional information, refer to Torque Based Electronic Throttle
Control (ETC) See: Computers and Control Systems/Electronic Throttle Control Module/Description
and Operation.
3-Track APP Sensor
Typical 3-Track APP Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2529
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2530
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Electronic Engine Controls
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Engine Controls
Electronic Engine Controls
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor:
- sends the PCM a signal indicating mass airflow rate of air entering the engine.
- incorporates the Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor.
For removal and installation, refer to Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor See: Service and Repair.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Electronic Engine Controls > Page 2533
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Engine Control Components
Engine Control Components
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. The current required to
maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow. The MAF sensor then
outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air mass. The PCM
calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired air/fuel ratio. This
input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC), shift and torque
converter clutch (TCC) scheduling.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly. Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology with an integrated IAT sensor.
The hot wire electronic sensing element must be replaced as an assembly. Replacing only the
element may change the air flow calibration.
Diagram of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot and Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Diagram of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot and Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals.
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Electronic Engine Controls > Page 2534
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Page 2535
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector.
2. Remove the 2 bolts and the MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft
Position Sensor 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft
Position Sensor 2 > Page 2540
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft
Position Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft
Position Sensor > Page 2543
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
2544
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston
number 1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing
the sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil on plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP
signal to select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with two CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). The second
sensor is used to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2.
There are two types of CMP sensors: the 2-pin variable reluctance type sensor and the 3-pin
Hall-effect type sensor.
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
Typical Hall-effect CMP Sensor
Typical Hall-effect CMP Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
2545
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
Removal and Installation
LH Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor
1. Remove the Air Cleaner (ACL) outlet pipe.
All CMP sensors
2. Disconnect the Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor electrical connector.
3. Remove the bolt and the CMP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Clutch Switch, ECM > Component Information > Description and Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
The CPP switch is an input to the PCM indicating the clutch pedal position. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the CPP circuit. When the CPP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The CPP input to the PCM is used to detect a reduction in engine
load. The PCM uses the load information for mass air flow and fuel calculations.
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
The ECT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The ECT measures the temperature of the engine coolant. The PCM uses the ECT input for fuel
control and for cooling fan control. There are three types of ECT sensors, threaded, push-in, and
twist-lock. The ECT sensor is located in an engine coolant passage.
Typical Thread Type Sensor
Typical Thread Type ECT Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2555
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2556
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid decelerations between teeth.
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2557
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the accessory drive belt from the A/C compressor pulley.
3. Disconnect the A/C compressor electrical connector.
4. Disconnect the Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor electrical connector.
5. Remove the 3 bolts and position the A/C compressor aside.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
6. Remove the bolt and the CKP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2558
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
8. Using the scan tool, perform the Misfire Monitor Neutral Profile Correction procedure, following
the on-screen instructions.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2562
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2563
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Cylinder Head Temperature (CHT) Sensor
The CHT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with the temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
The CHT sensor is installed in the cylinder head and measures the metal temperature. The CHT
sensor can provide complete engine temperature information and can be used to infer coolant
temperature. If the CHT sensor conveys an overheating condition to the PCM, the PCM initiates a
fail-safe cooling strategy based on information from the CHT sensor. A cooling system concern
such as low coolant or coolant loss could cause an overheating condition. As a result, damage to
major engine components could occur. Using both the CHT sensor and fail-safe cooling strategy,
the PCM prevents damage by allowing air cooling of the engine and limp home capability. For
additional information, refer to Powertrain Control Software See: Computers and Control
Systems/Description and Operation/Powertrain Control Software for Fail-Safe Cooling Strategy.
Typical CHT Sensor
Typical CHT Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2564
Engine Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
Cylinder Head Temperature (CHT) Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold.
2. Disconnect the Cylinder Head Temperature (CHT) sensor electrical connector.
3. Remove the CHT sensor and discard.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Coat the new CHT sensor threads with high temperature nickel anti-seize lubricant prior to
installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Fuel Level Input (FLI)
The FLI is a communications network message. Most vehicle applications use a potentiometer type
FLI sensor connected to a float in the FP module to determine fuel level.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View
Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View
106L (28 Gal) Fuel Tank
127L (33.5 Gal) Fuel Tank
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 2570
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 2571
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module
Fuel Pump Module
106L (28 Gal) Fuel Tank
127L (33.5 Gal) Fuel Tank
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 2572
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
All fuel tanks
1. Remove the fuel tank. For additional information, refer to Fuel Tank See: Fuel Delivery and Air
Induction/Fuel Tank/Service and Repair/Removal
and Replacement/Fuel Tank.
127L (33.5 gal) fuel tank
2. Remove the 4 nuts and the Fuel Pump (FP) module cover.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
3. Disconnect the return fuel tube-to-FP module quick connect coupling.
All fuel tanks
4. Disconnect the Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-FP module quick
connect coupling and the supply fuel tube-to-FP
module quick connect coupling.
5. Using the Fuel Tank Sender Unit Wrench, remove the FP lock ring.
106L (28 gal) fuel tank
6. NOTICE: Carefully remove the Fuel Pump (FP) assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level
sensor.
NOTE: If the FP does not clear the FP mounting flange on the fuel tank, the use of a screwdriver
may be necessary.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 2573
Remove the FP and FP O-ring seal. If necessary, insert a screwdriver into the empty FP rod hole and slightly pull the screwdriver
inboard until the base of the FP clears the FP mounting flange.
- Discard the FP O-ring seal.
127L (33.5 gal) fuel tank
7. NOTICE: Carefully remove the Fuel Pump (FP) assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level
sensor.
NOTE: Note the location of the FP alignment tabs.
Remove the FP module assembly. Remove and discard the O-ring seal.
All fuel tanks
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2577
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2578
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2579
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
The FTP sensor or in-line FTP sensor is used to measure the fuel tank pressure.
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
In-line Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
In-line Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
106L (28 Gal) Fuel Tank
125L (33 Gal) Fuel Tank
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Page 2582
Removal and Installation
All fuel tanks
1. Remove the fuel tank.
106L (28 gal) fuel tank
2. Disconnect the fuel supply tube-to-heat shield pushpin retainer.
125L (33 gal) fuel tank
3. Remove the fuel tank heat shield retainer(s).
All fuel tanks
4. Remove the fuel tank heat shield.
5. Disconnect the Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-fuel vapor/grade
vent valves quick connect couplings.
6. Disconnect the FTP sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-fuel pump module quick connect
coupling.
7. Remove the FTP sensor and vapor tube assembly from the fuel tank.
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Carry out the Evaporative Emission System Leak Test. For additional information, refer to
Evaporative Emission System Leak Test See: Emission Control Systems/Evaporative Emissions
System/Testing and Inspection.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Page 2583
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Evaporative Emission (EVAP) System
Components - Exploded View
Evaporative Emission (EVAP) System Components - Exploded View
Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Canister Assembly
NOTE: 106L (28 gal) fuel tank vapor tubes shown, 125L (33 gal) similar.
EVAP Canister, Vent Solenoid and Dust Separator and Brackets
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Page 2584
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2588
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2589
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2590
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor
The IAT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The electrical
resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance increases
as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the sensor
terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The IAT sensor provides air temperature information to the PCM. The PCM uses the air
temperature information as a correction factor in the calculation of fuel, spark, and air flow.
The IAT sensor provides a quicker temperature change response time than the ECT or CHT
sensor.
Currently there are two types of IAT sensors used, a stand-alone/non-integrated type and a
integrated type. Both types function the same, however the integrated type is incorporated into the
mass air flow (MAF) sensor instead of being a stand alone sensor.
Supercharged vehicles use two IAT sensors. Both sensors are thermistor type devices and operate
as described above. One is located before the supercharger at the air cleaner for standard
OBD/cold weather input, while a second sensor (IAT2) is located after the supercharger in the
intake manifold. The IAT2 sensor located after the supercharger provides air temperature
information to the PCM to control spark and to help determine charge air cooler (CAC) efficiency.
Typical Stand-Alone/Non-Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensors
Typical Stand-Alone/Non-Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensors
Typical Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Incorporated Into a Drop-in or Flange-type
MAF Sensor
Typical Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Incorporated Into a Drop-in or Flange-type
MAF sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Knock Sensor 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Knock Sensor 1 >
Page 2595
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1 >
Page 2598
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2599
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Two Types of Knock Sensor (KS)
Two Types of Knock Sensor (KS)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2600
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
Knock Sensor (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold.
2. Disconnect the Knock Sensor (KS) electrical connectors.
3. Remove the 2 bolts and the 2 KS.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (177 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
The MAP sensor measures intake manifold absolute pressure. The PCM uses information from the
MAP sensor to measure how much exhaust gas is introduced into the intake manifold.
Typical Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
Typical Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) Sensor
The EOT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The EOT sensor measures the temperature of the engine oil. The sensor is typically threaded into
the engine oil lubrication system. The PCM can use the EOT sensor input to determine the
following:
- On variable camshaft timing (VCT) applications the EOT input is used to adjust the VCT control
gains and logic for camshaft timing.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input in conjunction with other PCM inputs to determine oil
degradation.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input to initiate a soft engine shutdown. To prevent engine
damage from occurring as a result of high oil temperatures, the PCM has the ability to initiate a soft
engine shutdown. Whenever engine RPM exceeds a calibrated level for a certain period of time,
the PCM begins reducing power by disabling engine cylinders.
Typical Thread Type Sensor
Typical EOT Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 2611
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #12
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 2612
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 2613
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 2614
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #22
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 2615
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 2618
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 2619
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 2620
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Engine Control Components
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
The HO2S detects the presence of oxygen in the exhaust and produces a variable voltage
according to the amount of oxygen detected. A high concentration of oxygen (lean air/fuel ratio) in
the exhaust produces a voltage signal less than 0.4 volt. A low concentration of oxygen (rich
air/fuel ratio) produces a voltage signal greater than 0.6 volt. The HO2S provides feedback to the
PCM indicating air/fuel ratio in order to achieve a near stoichiometric air/fuel ratio of 14.7:1 during
closed loop engine operation. The HO2S generates a voltage between 0.0 and 1.1 volts.
Embedded with the sensing element is the HO2S heater. The heating element heats the sensor to
a temperature of 800°C (1,472°F). At approximately 300°C (572°F) the engine can enter closed
loop operation. The VPWR circuit supplies voltage to the heater. The PCM turns the heater on by
providing the ground when the correct conditions occur. The heater allows the engine to enter
closed loop operation sooner. The use of this heater requires the HO2S heater control to be duty
cycled, to prevent damage to the heater.
Typical Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Typical Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 2623
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation Universal Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Engine Control Components
Universal Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
The universal HO2S, sometimes referred to as a wideband oxygen sensor, uses the typical HO2S
combined with a current controller in the PCM to infer an air/fuel ratio relative to the stoichiometric
air/fuel ratio. This is accomplished by balancing the amount of oxygen ions pumped in or out of a
measurement chamber within the sensor. The typical HO2S within the universal HO2S is used to
detect the oxygen content of the exhaust gas in the measurement chamber. The oxygen content
inside the measurement chamber is maintained at the stoichiometric air/fuel ratio by pumping
oxygen ions in and out of the measurement chamber. As the exhaust gasses get richer or leaner,
the amount of oxygen that must be pumped in or out to maintain a stoichiometric air/fuel ratio in the
measurement chamber varies in proportion to the air/fuel ratio. The amount of current required to
pump the oxygen ions in or out of the measurement chamber is used to measure the air/fuel ratio.
The measured air/fuel ratio is actually the output from the current controller in the PCM and not a
signal that comes directly from the sensor.
The universal HO2S also uses a self-contained reference chamber to make sure an oxygen
differential is always present. The oxygen for the reference chamber is supplied by pumping small
amounts of oxygen ions from the measurement chamber into the reference chamber. The universal
HO2S does not need access to outside air.
Part to part variance is compensated for by placing a resistor in the connector. This resistor is used
to trim the current measured by the current controller in the PCM.
Embedded with the sensing element is the universal HO2S heater. The heater allows the engine to
enter closed loop operation sooner. The heating element heats the sensor to a temperature of
780°C (1,436°F). The VPWR circuit supplies voltage to the heater. The PCM controls the heater on
and off by providing the ground to maintain the sensor at the correct temperature for maximum
accuracy.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) And Catalyst Monitor Sensor - Exploded View
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) And Catalyst Monitor Sensor Exploded View
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) and Catalyst Monitor Sensor - Exploded View
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) And Catalyst Monitor Sensor - Exploded View > Page 2626
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Disconnect the Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) electrical connector.
3. Using the Exhaust Gas Oxygen Sensor Socket, remove the HO2S.
- Apply penetrating lubricant to the HO2S to assist in removal.
Installation
1. Install the HO2S.
- Apply a light coat of high temperature nickel anti-seize lubricant to the HO2S threads prior to
installation.
- Calculate the correct torque wrench setting for the following torque.
- Using the Exhaust Gas Oxygen Sensor Socket, tighten to 46 Nm (34 lb-ft).
2. Connect the HO2S electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) And Catalyst Monitor Sensor - Exploded View > Page 2627
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Catalyst Monitor Sensor
Catalyst Monitor Sensor
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Disconnect the Catalyst Monitor Sensor (CMS) electrical connector.
3. Using the Exhaust Gas Oxygen Sensor Socket, remove the CMS.
- Apply penetrating lubricant to the CMS to assist in removal.
Installation
1. Install the CMS.
- Apply a light coat of high temperature nickel anti-seize lubricant to the CMS threads prior to
installation.
- Calculate the correct torque wrench setting for the following torque.
- Using the Exhaust Gas Oxygen Sensor Socket, tighten to 46 Nm (34 lb-ft).
2. Connect the CMS electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2631
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2632
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Switch
Engine Control Components
Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
The PSP switch monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP switch
is a normally closed switch that opens as the hydraulic pressure increases. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the PSP circuit. When the PSP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The PCM uses the input signal from the PSP switch to compensate
for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the idle RPM and preventing engine stall during
parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP switch signals the PCM to adjust the transmission EPC
pressure during increased engine load, for example during parking maneuvers.
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch > Page 2635
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Sensor
Engine Control Components
Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
The PSP sensor monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP
sensor voltage input to the PCM changes as the hydraulic pressure changes. The PCM uses the
input signal from the PSP sensor to compensate for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the
idle RPM and preventing engine stall during parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP sensor signals the
PCM to adjust the transmission EPC pressure during increased engine load, for example, during
parking maneuvers.
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer
that monitors the differential pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly.
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as
the downstream pressure hose (REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI
and REF hose connections are marked on the differential pressure feedback EGR sensor housing
for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger diameter hose). The differential pressure
feedback EGR sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the metering
orifice and supplies it to the PCM as EGR flow rate feedback.
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
The tube mounted differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is identical in operation as the larger
plastic differential pressure feedback EGR sensors and uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF
hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2642
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle
Position Sensor
Engine Control Components
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle Position Sensor
The ETB throttle position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant
ETB throttle position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB throttle position
sensor signal (TP1) has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second
signal (TP2) has a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). The 2 ETB throttle position
sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There is
1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor. The reference voltage circuit
and the signal return circuit is shared with the reference voltage circuits and signal return circuits
used by the APP sensor. For additional information, refer to Torque Based Electronic Throttle
Control (ETC) See: Computers and Control Systems/Electronic Throttle Control Module/Description
and Operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle Position Sensor > Page 2645
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
Engine Control Components
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases the corrosion resistance on the
terminals and increases the connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body.
As the TP sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, four operating conditions are determined by the
PCM from the TP. These are:
- closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration)
- part throttle (includes cruise or moderate acceleration)
- wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on crank)
- throttle angle rate
Typical TP Sensor
Typical TP Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 2646
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
Removal
1. Remove the Throttle Body (TB).
2. NOTICE: Do not put direct heat on the Throttle Position (TP) sensor or any other plastic parts
because heat damage may occur. Damage
may also occur if Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) temperature exceeds 120°C (248°F).
NOTE: Do not use power tools.
Remove the TP sensor.
1. Using a suitable heat gun, apply heat to the top of the ETB until the top TP sensor bolt ear
reaches approximately 55°C (130°F), this should
take no more than 3 minutes using an 1,100-watt heat gun. The heat gun should be about 25.4 mm
(1 in) away from the ETB.
2. Monitor the temperature of the top TP sensor bolt ear on the ETB with a suitable temperature
measuring device, such as a digital temperature
laser or infrared thermometer, while heating the ETB.
3. Using hand tools, quickly remove the bolt farthest from the heat source first and discard.
4. Using hand tools, remove the remaining bolt and discard.
5. Remove and discard the TP sensor.
Installation
1. NOTE: When installing the new TP sensor, make sure that the radial locator tab on the TP
sensor is aligned with the radial locator hole on the
ETB.
NOTE: Do not use power tools.
Install the new TP sensor. Using hand tools, install the 2 new bolts. Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
2. Install the TB.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Engine Control Components
Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
The OSS sensor provides the PCM with information about the rotational speed of an output shaft.
The PCM uses the information to control and diagnose powertrain behavior. In some applications,
the sensor is also used as the source of vehicle speed. The sensor may be physically located in
different places on the vehicle, depending upon the specific application. The design of each speed
sensor is unique and depends on which powertrain control feature uses the information that is
generated.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor > Page 2651
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
Engine Control Components
Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
The VSS is a variable reluctance or Hall-effect sensor that generates a waveform with a frequency
that is proportional to the speed of the vehicle. If the vehicle is moving at a relatively low speed, the
sensor produces a signal with a low frequency. As the vehicle velocity increases, the sensor
generates a signal with a higher frequency. The PCM uses the frequency signal generated by the
VSS (and other inputs) to control such parameters as fuel injection, ignition control,
transmission/transaxle shift scheduling, and torque converter clutch scheduling.
Typical Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
Typical Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer
that monitors the differential pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly.
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as
the downstream pressure hose (REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI
and REF hose connections are marked on the differential pressure feedback EGR sensor housing
for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger diameter hose). The differential pressure
feedback EGR sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the metering
orifice and supplies it to the PCM as EGR flow rate feedback.
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
The tube mounted differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is identical in operation as the larger
plastic differential pressure feedback EGR sensors and uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF
hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2660
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2661
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2662
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
amount of torque requested by the operator. Depending on the application either a 2-track or
3-track APP sensor is used.
2-Track APP Sensor
There are two pedal position signals in the sensor. Both signals, APP1 and APP2, have a positive
slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage), but are offset and increase at different rates. The two
pedal position signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if one signal has a
concern. The PCM determines if a signal is incorrect by calculating where it should be, inferred
from the other signals. If a concern is present with one of the circuits the other input is used. There
are two reference voltage circuits, two signal return circuits, and two signal circuits (a total of six
circuits and pins) between the PCM and the APP sensor assembly. The reference voltage circuits
and the signal return circuits are shared with the reference voltage circuit and signal return circuit
used by the electronic throttle body (ETB) throttle position (TP) sensor. The pedal position signal is
converted to pedal travel degrees (rotary angle) by the PCM. The software then converts these
degrees to counts, which is the input to the torque based strategy. For additional information, refer
to Torque Based Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) See: Computers and Control Systems/Electronic
Throttle Control Module/Description and Operation.
2-Track APP Sensor
Typical 2-Track APP Sensor
3-Track APP Sensor
There are three pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APP1, has a negative slope
(increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APP2 and APP3, both have a positive
slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APP1 is used as the
indication of pedal position by the strategy. The three pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if one signal has a concern. The PCM determines if a signal is
incorrect by calculating where it should be, inferred from the other signals. If a concern is present
with one of the circuits the other inputs are used. The pedal position signal is converted to pedal
travel degrees (rotary angle) by the PCM. The software then converts these degrees to counts,
which is the input to the torque based strategy. There are two reference voltage circuits, two signal
return circuits, and three signal circuits (a total of seven circuits and pins) between the PCM and
the APP sensor assembly. The reference voltage circuits and the signal return circuits are shared
with the reference voltage circuit and signal return circuit used by the electronic throttle body (ETB)
throttle position sensor. For additional information, refer to Torque Based Electronic Throttle
Control (ETC) See: Computers and Control Systems/Electronic Throttle Control Module/Description
and Operation.
3-Track APP Sensor
Typical 3-Track APP Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2666
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2667
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Electronic Engine Controls
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Engine Controls
Electronic Engine Controls
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor:
- sends the PCM a signal indicating mass airflow rate of air entering the engine.
- incorporates the Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor.
For removal and installation, refer to Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor See: Service and Repair.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Electronic Engine Controls > Page 2670
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Engine Control Components
Engine Control Components
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. The current required to
maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow. The MAF sensor then
outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air mass. The PCM
calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired air/fuel ratio. This
input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC), shift and torque
converter clutch (TCC) scheduling.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly. Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology with an integrated IAT sensor.
The hot wire electronic sensing element must be replaced as an assembly. Replacing only the
element may change the air flow calibration.
Diagram of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot and Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Diagram of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot and Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals.
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Electronic Engine Controls > Page 2671
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 2672
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector.
2. Remove the 2 bolts and the MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail.
The temperature sensing portion of the FRPT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance
changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor decreases as the temperature
increases, and the resistance increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance
changes the voltage drop across the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM
corresponding to temperature.
Both the pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the fuel pump. The
speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid state. The
dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which allows the
injector pulse width to decrease.
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Fuel Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail.
The temperature sensing portion of the FRPT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance
changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor decreases as the temperature
increases, and the resistance increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance
changes the voltage drop across the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM
corresponding to temperature.
Both the pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the fuel pump. The
speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid state. The
dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which allows the
injector pulse width to decrease.
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2682
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2683
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2684
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2685
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Inertia Fuel Shut-off (IFS) Switch
The IFS switch is used in conjunction with the electric fuel pump. The purpose of the IFS switch is
to shut off the fuel pump if a collision occurs. It consists of a steel cone held in place by a magnet.
When a sharp impact occurs, the cone breaks loose from the magnet, rolls up a conical ramp and
strikes a target plate which opens the electrical contacts of the switch and shuts off the electric fuel
pump. Once the switch is open, it must be manually reset before restarting the vehicle. Refer to the
Owner's Literature, Roadside Emergencies for the location of the IFS switch.
Typical Inertia Fuel Shut-off (IFS) Switch
Typical Inertia Fuel Shut-off (IFS) Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2686
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Service and Repair
Inertia Fuel Shutoff (IFS) Switch
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: The Inertia Fuel Shutoff (IFS) switch is located behind the LH quarter trim panel access
cover.
Remove the LH quarter trim panel access cover.
2. Remove the power liftgate motor electrical connector pushpins from the power liftgate motor
bracket.
3. NOTE: Slide the IFS switch out below the power liftgate motor bracket.
Remove the 2 bolts and the IFS switch. To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
4. Disconnect the IFS switch electrical connector.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2690
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle
Position Sensor
Engine Control Components
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle Position Sensor
The ETB throttle position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant
ETB throttle position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB throttle position
sensor signal (TP1) has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second
signal (TP2) has a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). The 2 ETB throttle position
sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There is
1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor. The reference voltage circuit
and the signal return circuit is shared with the reference voltage circuits and signal return circuits
used by the APP sensor. For additional information, refer to Torque Based Electronic Throttle
Control (ETC) See: Computers and Control Systems/Electronic Throttle Control Module/Description
and Operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle Position Sensor > Page 2693
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
Engine Control Components
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases the corrosion resistance on the
terminals and increases the connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body.
As the TP sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, four operating conditions are determined by the
PCM from the TP. These are:
- closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration)
- part throttle (includes cruise or moderate acceleration)
- wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on crank)
- throttle angle rate
Typical TP Sensor
Typical TP Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Page 2694
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
Removal
1. Remove the Throttle Body (TB).
2. NOTICE: Do not put direct heat on the Throttle Position (TP) sensor or any other plastic parts
because heat damage may occur. Damage
may also occur if Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) temperature exceeds 120°C (248°F).
NOTE: Do not use power tools.
Remove the TP sensor.
1. Using a suitable heat gun, apply heat to the top of the ETB until the top TP sensor bolt ear
reaches approximately 55°C (130°F), this should
take no more than 3 minutes using an 1,100-watt heat gun. The heat gun should be about 25.4 mm
(1 in) away from the ETB.
2. Monitor the temperature of the top TP sensor bolt ear on the ETB with a suitable temperature
measuring device, such as a digital temperature
laser or infrared thermometer, while heating the ETB.
3. Using hand tools, quickly remove the bolt farthest from the heat source first and discard.
4. Using hand tools, remove the remaining bolt and discard.
5. Remove and discard the TP sensor.
Installation
1. NOTE: When installing the new TP sensor, make sure that the radial locator tab on the TP
sensor is aligned with the radial locator hole on the
ETB.
NOTE: Do not use power tools.
Install the new TP sensor. Using hand tools, install the 2 new bolts. Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
2. Install the TB.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor
2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor
2 > Page 2700
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor
> Page 2703
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2704
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston
number 1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing
the sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil on plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP
signal to select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with two CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). The second
sensor is used to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2.
There are two types of CMP sensors: the 2-pin variable reluctance type sensor and the 3-pin
Hall-effect type sensor.
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
Typical Hall-effect CMP Sensor
Typical Hall-effect CMP Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2705
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
Removal and Installation
LH Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor
1. Remove the Air Cleaner (ACL) outlet pipe.
All CMP sensors
2. Disconnect the Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor electrical connector.
3. Remove the bolt and the CMP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2709
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2710
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid decelerations between teeth.
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2711
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the accessory drive belt from the A/C compressor pulley.
3. Disconnect the A/C compressor electrical connector.
4. Disconnect the Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor electrical connector.
5. Remove the 3 bolts and position the A/C compressor aside.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
6. Remove the bolt and the CKP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2712
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
8. Using the scan tool, perform the Misfire Monitor Neutral Profile Correction procedure, following
the on-screen instructions.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) transceiver.
2. NOTE: The ignition lock cylinder must be in the RUN position.
Using a suitable tool, press the release pin and remove the ignition lock cylinder.
3. If a new lock cylinder with keys is replaced, the new PATS keys must be programmed.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Verify the ignition lock cylinder operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional > Page 2718
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Ignition Lock Cylinder - Non Functional
Ignition Lock Cylinder - Non Functional
Removal
1. Remove the Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) transceiver.
2. Remove the ignition lock cylinder.
- Use a 1/8-inch diameter drill bit to drill out the lock cylinder retaining pin.
- Use a 3/8-inch diameter drill bit to drill down the middle of the ignition lock key slot until the
ignition lock cylinder breaks loose.
- Remove and discard the ignition lock cylinder and drill shavings from the steering column.
3. Remove the bearing retainer.
4. Remove the steering column lock housing bearing and steering column lock gear.
Installation
1. Thoroughly clean all drill shavings from the steering column and inspect it for damage.
2. Install a new ignition lock cylinder.
- Verify the ignition lock cylinder operation.
3. Program the new PATS keys.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Knock Sensor 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Knock Sensor 1 > Page 2723
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1 > Page 2726
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2727
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Two Types of Knock Sensor (KS)
Two Types of Knock Sensor (KS)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2728
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
Knock Sensor (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold.
2. Disconnect the Knock Sensor (KS) electrical connectors.
3. Remove the 2 bolts and the 2 KS.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (177 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
Fuel Pressure
Engine running.....................................................................................................................................
..............................................379-414 kPa (55-60 psi) Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).........................
..................................................................................................................................379-414 kPa
(55-60 psi)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Specifications > Page 2733
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection
Fuel System Pressure Test
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Before working on or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components,
relieve the fuel system pressure to prevent accidental spraying of fuel. Fuel in the fuel system
remains under high pressure, even when the engine is not running. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
WARNING: When handling fuel, always observe fuel handling precautions and be prepared in the
event of fuel spillage. Spilled fuel may be ignited by hot vehicle components or other ignition
sources. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
1. Remove the cap from the fuel pressure relief valve located on the fuel rail.
2. Install the Fuel Pressure Test Kit onto the fuel pressure relief valve.
3. Test the fuel system pressure to make sure it is within the specified range. For additional
information, refer to Specifications.
4. NOTE: Open the drain valve slowly to relieve the fuel system pressure. This may drain fuel from
the system. Place fuel in a suitable container.
Upon completion of the fuel system pressure test, open the drain valve on the Fuel Pressure Test
Kit and relieve the fuel system pressure.
5. NOTE: It may take more than one key cycle to pressurize the fuel system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Specifications > Page 2734
Cycle the ignition key and wait 3 seconds to pressurize the fuel system. Check for leaks before
starting the engine.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System
Information > Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Typical Diagnostic Reference Value
Measured/PID Values 695 RPM ..........................................................................................................
..................................................................................................... Hot Idle
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing >
Air Filter Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Intake Air System Components - Exploded View
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Intake Air System Components - Exploded View
Intake Air System Components - Exploded View
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing >
Air Filter Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Intake Air System Components - Exploded View > Page
2743
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Air Cleaner Element
Air Cleaner Element
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the Air Cleaner (ACL) outlet pipe from the ACL cover.
- To install, tighten the clamps to 4 Nm (35 lb-in).
2. Disconnect the Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector.
3. Release the retaining clips and position the ACL cover aside.
4. Remove the ACL element.
5. NOTE: The ACL element must be fully seated into the ACL housing. Failure to do so will result in
unusual engine noise.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel
Pressure Release > System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
Fuel System Pressure Release
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Before working on or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components,
relieve the fuel system pressure to prevent accidental spraying of fuel. Fuel in the fuel system
remains under high pressure, even when the engine is not running. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: When handling fuel, always observe fuel handling precautions and be prepared in the
event of fuel spillage. Spilled fuel may be ignited by hot vehicle components or other ignition
sources. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
2. Remove the cap from the fuel pressure relief valve located on the fuel rail.
3. Install the Fuel Pressure Test Kit onto the fuel pressure relief valve.
4. NOTE: Open the manual valve slowly to relieve the system pressure. This may drain fuel from
the fuel system. Place fuel in a suitable container.
Open the manual valve on the Fuel Pressure Test Kit and relieve the fuel pressure.
5. NOTE: It may take more than one key cycle to pressurize the fuel system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel
Pressure Release > System Information > Service and Repair > Page 2748
Cycle the ignition key and wait 3 seconds to pressurize the fuel system. Check for leaks before
starting the engine.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order >
Component Information > Specifications > Firing Order
Firing Order: Specifications Firing Order
Firing order...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................1-3-7-2-6-5-4-8
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order >
Component Information > Specifications > Firing Order > Page 2753
Firing Order: Specifications Engine Cylinder Identification
Engine Cylinder Identification
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing > System
Information > Specifications
Ignition Timing: Specifications
Base ignition timing..............................................................................................................................
........................10° Before Top Dead Center (BTDC)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Specifications > Gap
Spark Plug: Specifications Gap
Spark plug gap.....................................................................................................................................
.................................1.05 ± 0.05 mm (0.039-0.043 in)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Specifications > Gap > Page 2761
Spark Plug: Specifications Torque Specifications
Spark plugs...........................................................................................................................................
........................................................12 Nm (106 lb-in)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2762
Spark Plug: Application and ID
Spark plug............................................................................................................................................
...................................................................HJFS-24FP
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2763
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection
Spark Plug Inspection
1. Inspect the spark plug for a bridged gap.
- Check for deposit build-up closing the gap between the electrodes. Deposits are caused by oil or
carbon fouling.
- Install a new spark plug.
2. Check for oil fouling.
- Check for wet, black deposits on the insulator shell bore electrodes, caused by excessive oil
entering the combustion chamber through worn rings and pistons, excessive valve-to-guide
clearance or worn or loose bearings.
- Correct the oil leak concern.
- Install a new spark plug.
3. Inspect for carbon fouling. Look for black, dry, fluffy carbon deposits on the insulator tips,
exposed shell surfaces and electrodes, caused by a
spark plug with an incorrect heat range, dirty air cleaner, too rich a fuel mixture or excessive idling.
Install new spark plugs.
4. Inspect for normal burning.
- Check for light tan or gray deposits on the firing tip.
5. Inspect for pre-ignition, identified by melted electrodes and a possibly damaged insulator.
Metallic deposits on the insulator indicate engine
damage. This may be caused by incorrect ignition timing, wrong type of fuel or the unauthorized
installation of a heli-coil insert in place of the spark plug threads. Install a new spark plug.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2764
6. Inspect for overheating, identified by white or light gray spots and a bluish-burnt appearance of
electrodes. This is caused by engine overheating,
wrong type of fuel, loose spark plugs, spark plugs with an incorrect heat range, low fuel pump
pressure or incorrect ignition timing. Install a new spark plug.
7. Inspect for fused deposits, identified by melted or spotty deposits resembling bubbles or blisters.
These are caused by sudden acceleration.
- Install new spark plugs.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Ignition Components - Exploded View
Spark Plug: Service and Repair Engine Ignition Components - Exploded View
Engine Ignition Components - Exploded View
Engine Ignition - RH
Engine Ignition - LH
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Ignition Components - Exploded View > Page 2767
Spark Plug: Service and Repair Spark Plugs
Spark Plugs
Removal
NOTICE: The spark plug procedure must be followed exactly or damage to the cylinder head and
spark plug will result.
1. Remove the ignition coil-on-plug. For additional information, refer to Ignition Coil-On-Plug See:
Ignition System/Ignition Coil/Service and
Repair/Ignition Coil-On-Plug.
2. NOTICE: Only use hand tools when removing or installing the spark plugs or damage can occur
to the cylinder head or spark plug.
NOTE: Use compressed air to remove any foreign material from the spark plug well before
removing the spark plugs.
Remove the spark plug.
3. Inspect the spark plug.
Installation
1. Adjust the spark plug gap as necessary. For the correct spark plug gap specification, refer to
Specifications.
2. NOTICE: Only use hand tools when removing or installing the spark plugs or damage can occur
to the cylinder head or spark plug.
Install the spark plug.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
3. Install the ignition coil. For additional information, refer to Ignition Coil-On-Plug See: Ignition
System/Ignition Coil/Service and Repair/Ignition
Coil-On-Plug.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check >
System Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Compression Test - Test Results
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75% of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit Chart.
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
If one or more cylinders reads low, squirt approximately one tablespoon of engine oil on top of the
pistons in the low-reading cylinders. Repeat the compression pressure check on these cylinders.
Compression Test - Interpreting Compression Readings
1. If compression improves considerably, piston rings are faulty.
2. If compression does not improve, valves are sticking or seating incorrectly.
3. If 2 adjacent cylinders indicate low compression pressures and squirting oil on each piston does
not increase compression, the head gasket may be
leaking between cylinders. Engine oil or coolant in cylinders could result from this condition.
Use the Compression Pressure Limit Chart when checking cylinder compression so that the lowest
reading is within 75% of the highest reading.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check >
System Information > Specifications > Page 2771
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
Engine
Component Tests
The following component tests are used to diagnose engine concerns.
Compression Test - Compression Gauge Check
1. Make sure the oil in the crankcase is of the correct viscosity and at the correct level and that the
battery is correctly charged. Operate the vehicle
until the engine is at normal operating temperature. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position,
then remove all the spark plugs.
2. Set the throttle plates in the wide-open position.
3. Install a compression gauge in the No. 1 cylinder.
4. Install an auxiliary starter switch in the starting circuit. With the ignition switch in the OFF
position, and using the auxiliary starter switch, crank
the engine a minimum of 5 compression strokes and record the highest reading. Note the
approximate number of compression strokes required to obtain the highest reading.
5. Repeat the test on each cylinder, cranking the engine approximately the same number of
compression strokes.
Compression Test - Test Results
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75% of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit Chart.
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check >
System Information > Specifications > Page 2772
If one or more cylinders reads low, squirt approximately one tablespoon of engine oil on top of the
pistons in the low-reading cylinders. Repeat the compression pressure check on these cylinders.
Compression Test - Interpreting Compression Readings
1. If compression improves considerably, piston rings are faulty.
2. If compression does not improve, valves are sticking or seating incorrectly.
3. If 2 adjacent cylinders indicate low compression pressures and squirting oil on each piston does
not increase compression, the head gasket may be
leaking between cylinders. Engine oil or coolant in cylinders could result from this condition.
Use the Compression Pressure Limit Chart when checking cylinder compression so that the lowest
reading is within 75% of the highest reading.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
> Component Information > Locations
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Page 2777
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Page 2778
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Page 2779
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
amount of torque requested by the operator. Depending on the application either a 2-track or
3-track APP sensor is used.
2-Track APP Sensor
There are two pedal position signals in the sensor. Both signals, APP1 and APP2, have a positive
slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage), but are offset and increase at different rates. The two
pedal position signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if one signal has a
concern. The PCM determines if a signal is incorrect by calculating where it should be, inferred
from the other signals. If a concern is present with one of the circuits the other input is used. There
are two reference voltage circuits, two signal return circuits, and two signal circuits (a total of six
circuits and pins) between the PCM and the APP sensor assembly. The reference voltage circuits
and the signal return circuits are shared with the reference voltage circuit and signal return circuit
used by the electronic throttle body (ETB) throttle position (TP) sensor. The pedal position signal is
converted to pedal travel degrees (rotary angle) by the PCM. The software then converts these
degrees to counts, which is the input to the torque based strategy. For additional information, refer
to Torque Based Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) See: Electronic Throttle Control
Module/Description and Operation.
2-Track APP Sensor
Typical 2-Track APP Sensor
3-Track APP Sensor
There are three pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APP1, has a negative slope
(increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APP2 and APP3, both have a positive
slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APP1 is used as the
indication of pedal position by the strategy. The three pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if one signal has a concern. The PCM determines if a signal is
incorrect by calculating where it should be, inferred from the other signals. If a concern is present
with one of the circuits the other inputs are used. The pedal position signal is converted to pedal
travel degrees (rotary angle) by the PCM. The software then converts these degrees to counts,
which is the input to the torque based strategy. There are two reference voltage circuits, two signal
return circuits, and three signal circuits (a total of seven circuits and pins) between the PCM and
the APP sensor assembly. The reference voltage circuits and the signal return circuits are shared
with the reference voltage circuit and signal return circuit used by the electronic throttle body (ETB)
throttle position sensor. For additional information, refer to Torque Based Electronic Throttle
Control (ETC) See: Electronic Throttle Control Module/Description and Operation.
3-Track APP Sensor
Typical 3-Track APP Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2783
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2784
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic Engine Controls
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Engine Controls
Electronic Engine Controls
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor:
- sends the PCM a signal indicating mass airflow rate of air entering the engine.
- incorporates the Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor.
For removal and installation, refer to Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor See: Service and Repair.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic Engine Controls > Page 2787
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Engine Control Components
Engine Control Components
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. The current required to
maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow. The MAF sensor then
outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air mass. The PCM
calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired air/fuel ratio. This
input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC), shift and torque
converter clutch (TCC) scheduling.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly. Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology with an integrated IAT sensor.
The hot wire electronic sensing element must be replaced as an assembly. Replacing only the
element may change the air flow calibration.
Diagram of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot and Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Diagram of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot and Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals.
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic Engine Controls > Page 2788
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 2789
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector.
2. Remove the 2 bolts and the MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2793
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2794
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2795
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor
The IAT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The electrical
resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance increases
as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the sensor
terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The IAT sensor provides air temperature information to the PCM. The PCM uses the air
temperature information as a correction factor in the calculation of fuel, spark, and air flow.
The IAT sensor provides a quicker temperature change response time than the ECT or CHT
sensor.
Currently there are two types of IAT sensors used, a stand-alone/non-integrated type and a
integrated type. Both types function the same, however the integrated type is incorporated into the
mass air flow (MAF) sensor instead of being a stand alone sensor.
Supercharged vehicles use two IAT sensors. Both sensors are thermistor type devices and operate
as described above. One is located before the supercharger at the air cleaner for standard
OBD/cold weather input, while a second sensor (IAT2) is located after the supercharger in the
intake manifold. The IAT2 sensor located after the supercharger provides air temperature
information to the PCM to control spark and to help determine charge air cooler (CAC) efficiency.
Typical Stand-Alone/Non-Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensors
Typical Stand-Alone/Non-Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensors
Typical Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Incorporated Into a Drop-in or Flange-type
MAF Sensor
Typical Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Incorporated Into a Drop-in or Flange-type
MAF sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Brake Signal > Component
Information > Locations
Brake Signal: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Brake Signal > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2799
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Brake Signal > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2800
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Brake Signal > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
Brake Signal: Description and Operation Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
Engine Control Components
Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to as the stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal
to the PCM indicating the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Typical BPP Switch
Typical BPP Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Brake Signal > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch > Page 2803
Brake Signal: Description and Operation Brake Pedal Switch (BPS)/Brake Deactivator Switch
Engine Control Components
Brake Pedal Switch (BPS)/Brake Deactivator Switch
The BPS, also called the brake deactivator switch, is for vehicle speed control deactivation. A
normally closed switch supplies battery positive voltage (B+) to the PCM when the brake pedal is
not applied. When the brake pedal is applied, the normally closed switch opens and power is
removed from the PCM.
On some applications the normally closed BPS, along with the normally open BPP switch, are used
for a brake rationality test within the PCM. The PCM misfire monitor profile learn function may be
disabled if a brake switch concern occurs. If one or both brake pedal inputs to the PCM is not
changing states when they were expected to, a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) is set by the PCM
strategy.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor 2 > Page 2808
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor > Page 2811
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2812
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston
number 1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing
the sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil on plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP
signal to select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with two CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). The second
sensor is used to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2.
There are two types of CMP sensors: the 2-pin variable reluctance type sensor and the 3-pin
Hall-effect type sensor.
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
Typical Hall-effect CMP Sensor
Typical Hall-effect CMP Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2813
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
Removal and Installation
LH Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor
1. Remove the Air Cleaner (ACL) outlet pipe.
All CMP sensors
2. Disconnect the Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor electrical connector.
3. Remove the bolt and the CMP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Clutch Switch, ECM > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
The CPP switch is an input to the PCM indicating the clutch pedal position. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the CPP circuit. When the CPP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The CPP input to the PCM is used to detect a reduction in engine
load. The PCM uses the load information for mass air flow and fuel calculations.
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Description and Operation
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
The ECT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The ECT measures the temperature of the engine coolant. The PCM uses the ECT input for fuel
control and for cooling fan control. There are three types of ECT sensors, threaded, push-in, and
twist-lock. The ECT sensor is located in an engine coolant passage.
Typical Thread Type Sensor
Typical Thread Type ECT Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2823
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2824
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid decelerations between teeth.
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2825
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the accessory drive belt from the A/C compressor pulley.
3. Disconnect the A/C compressor electrical connector.
4. Disconnect the Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor electrical connector.
5. Remove the 3 bolts and position the A/C compressor aside.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
6. Remove the bolt and the CKP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2826
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
8. Using the scan tool, perform the Misfire Monitor Neutral Profile Correction procedure, following
the on-screen instructions.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Locations
Data Link Connector: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2830
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2831
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Actuator >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Actuator >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2835
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Actuator >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2836
Electronic Throttle Actuator: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Electronic Throttle Actuator Control (TAC)
The electronic TAC is a DC motor controlled by the PCM (requires 2 wires). There are 2 designs
for the TAC, parallel and in-line. The parallel design has the motor under the bore parallel to the
plate shaft. The motor housing is integrated into the main housing. The in-line design has a
separate motor housing. An internal spring is used in both designs to return the throttle plate to a
default position. The default position is typically a throttle angle of 7 to 8 degrees from the hard stop
angle. The closed throttle plate hard stop is used to prevent the throttle from binding in the bore.
This hard stop setting is not adjustable and is set to result in less airflow than the minimum engine
airflow required at idle. For additional information, refer to Torque Based Electronic Throttle Control
(ETC) See: Electronic Throttle Control Module/Description and Operation.
Typical In-line TAC Design
Typical In-line TAC Design
Typical Parallel TAC Design
Typical Parallel TAC Design
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module
> Component Information > Description and Operation
Electronic Throttle Control Module: Description and Operation
Torque-Based Electronic Throttle Control (ETC)
Overview
The torque-based ETC is a hardware and software strategy that delivers an engine output torque
(via throttle angle) based on driver demand (pedal position). It uses an electronic throttle body, the
powertrain control module (PCM), and an accelerator pedal assembly to control the throttle
opening and engine torque.
Torque-based ETC enables aggressive automatic transmission shift schedules (earlier upshifts and
later downshifts). This is possible by adjusting the throttle angle to achieve the same wheel torque
during shifts, and by calculating this desired torque, the system prevents engine lugging (low RPM
and low manifold vacuum) while still delivering the performance and torque requested by the driver.
It also enables many fuel economy/emission improvement technologies such as variable camshaft
timing (VCT), which delivers same torque during transitions.
Torque-based ETC also results in less intrusive vehicle and engine speed limiting, along with
smoother traction control.
Other benefits of torque-based ETC are:
- eliminate cruise control actuators
- eliminate idle air control (IAC) valve
- better airflow range
- packaging (no cable)
- more responsive powertrain at altitude and improved shift quality
The ETC system illuminates a powertrain malfunction indicator (wrench) on the instrument cluster
when a concern is present. Concerns are accompanied by diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) and
may also illuminate the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL).
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB)
The ETB has the following characteristics:
- The throttle actuator control (TAC) motor is a DC motor controlled by the PCM (requires 2 wires).
- There are two designs: parallel and in-line. The parallel design has the motor under the bore
parallel to the plate shaft. The motor housing is integrated into the main housing. The in-line design
has a separate motor housing.
- An internal spring is used in both designs to return the throttle plate to a default position. The
default position is typically a throttle angle of 7 to 8 degrees from the hard stop angle.
- The closed throttle plate hard stop is used to prevent the throttle from binding in the bore. This
hard stop setting is not adjustable and is set to result in less airflow than the minimum engine
airflow required at idle.
- The required idle airflow is provided by the plate angle in the throttle body assembly. This plate
angle controls idle, idle quality, and eliminates the need for an IAC valve.
- There is one reference voltage and one signal return circuit between the PCM and the ETB. The
reference voltage and the signal return circuits are shared with the reference voltage and signal
return circuits used by the accelerator pedal position (APP) sensor. There are also two throttle
position (TP) signal circuits for redundancy. The redundant TP signals are required for increased
monitoring reasons. The first TP signal (TP1) has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing
voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage).
The TP2 signal reaches a limit of approximately 4.5 volts at approximately 45 degrees of throttle
angle.
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor
Depending on the application either a 2-track or 3-track APP sensor is used. For additional
information on the APP sensor, refer to Engine Control Components See: Description and
Operation/Engine Control Components.
Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) System Strategy
The torque-based ETC strategy was developed to improve fuel economy and to accommodate
variable camshaft timing (VCT). This is possible by not coupling the throttle angle to the driver
pedal position. Uncoupling the throttle angle (produce engine torque) from the pedal position (driver
demand)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 2840
allows the powertrain control strategy to optimize fuel control and transmission shift schedules
while delivering the requested wheel torque.
The ETC monitor system is distributed across two processors within the PCM: the main powertrain
control processor unit (CPU) and a separate monitoring processor. The primary monitoring function
is carried out by the independent plausibility check (IPC) software, which resides on the main
processor. It is responsible for determining the driver-demanded torque and comparing it to an
estimate of the actual torque delivered. If the generated torque exceeds driver demand by a
specified amount, appropriate corrective action is taken.
ETC System With A 3-Track APP Sensor Failure Mode And Effects Management:
a - ETC illuminates or displays a message on the message center immediately; MIL illuminates
after 2 driving cycles
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 2841
ETC System With A 2-Track APP Sensor Failure Mode And Effects Management:
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation:
a - Monitor execution is continuous. Monitor false detection duration is less than 1 second to
register a concern.
APP and TP Sensor Inputs
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 2842
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Check:
Correlation and range/performance - sensor disagreement between processors internal to the
PCM. Monitor execution is continuous. Monitor false detection duration is less than 1 second to
register a concern. Refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Charts and Descriptions for additional
DTC information.
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Check:
a - Correlation and range/performance - sensor disagreement between processors internal to the
PCM, TP inconsistent with requested throttle plate position. Monitor execution is continuous.
Monitor false detection duration is less than 1 second to register a concern. Refer to Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DTC) Charts and Descriptions for additional DTC information.
Electronic Throttle Actuator Control (TAC) Output
Electronic TAC Operation Check:
a - Note: For all DTCs, in addition to the MIL, the powertrain malfunction indicator (wrench) is on for
the concern that caused the FMEM action. Monitor execution is continuous. Monitor false detection
duration is less than 5 seconds to register a concern.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 10-12-4 > Jul > 10
> Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh Downshifts
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh Downshifts
TSB 10-12-4
07/05/10
5.4L 3V AND 6R80 TRANSMISSION - DELAYED/HARSH DOWNSHIFT ABOVE 40 MPH (64
KM/H)
FORD: 2009-2010 Expedition, F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built on or before 5/1/2010 and
2009-2010 F-150 vehicles built on or before 2/1/2010 and equipped with 5.4L 3V engine and 6R80
transmission may exhibit a delayed then harsh downshift during a commanded downshift at speeds
above 40 MPH (64 Km/h).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
ID vehicle.
2. Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 67.03 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the 1CM Calibration is:
(1) AL3P-7J104-AC for all vehicles except the F-150 4X4.
(2) AL3P-7J104-BC for F-150 4X4.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox
(2) Powertrain
(3) OBD Test Modes
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info
(5) 1CM Cal Part Number
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT 1CM KAM BE CLEARED FOR THIS PROCEDURE TO BE FULLY
EFFECTIVE
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox
(2) Choose Powertrain Then Choose TCM
(3) Choose Reset KAM
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 10-12-4 > Jul > 10
> Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh Downshifts > Page 2851
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset 1CM KAM
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM
KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop, allow at least six (6) seconds.
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101204A 2009-2010 Expedition, 1.0 Hr.
Navigator, F-150: Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM And Perform Road
Tests (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 10-12-4 > Jul > 10
> Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh Downshifts > Page 2852
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09
> Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
TSB 09-15-8
08/10/09
5.4L 3V 6R80 - HARSH 1-2 UPSHIFT - HARSH 2-1 DOWNSHIFT WHILE COASTING - HARSH
DOWNSHIFT TO 4TH GEAR - INTERMITTENT P0741
FORD: 2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with 5.4L 3V engine may exhibit
symptoms during warm-up: a harsh 1-2 upshift, harsh 2-1 downshift while coasting 15 MPH (24
Km/h). A harsh downshift into 4th gear at highway speeds 45-70 MPH (72-113 Km/h) may also be
experienced. Some vehicles may have a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0741 torque converter
performance code present or stored.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
MECHATRONIC REPAIR/REPLACEMENT IS NOT
AUTHORIZED FOR THIS ISSUE.
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the Powertrain Control Module/Transmission Control Module (PCM/TCM) calibration
using IDS release 61.15 and higher or 62.03 and
higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be
obtained at the website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the TCM Calibration shows AL3P-7J104-AB part number after reprogramming is
complete.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) OBD Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR TSB TO BE
FULLY AFFECTIVE
3. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09
> Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 2857
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM.
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175° F (79° C). If it is not at
175° F (79° C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175° F (79° C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091508A 2009 Expedition, Navigator 1.0 Hr.
6R80 Transmission: Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear The
TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09
> Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 2858
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-12-4
> Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh Downshifts
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh
Downshifts
TSB 10-12-4
07/05/10
5.4L 3V AND 6R80 TRANSMISSION - DELAYED/HARSH DOWNSHIFT ABOVE 40 MPH (64
KM/H)
FORD: 2009-2010 Expedition, F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built on or before 5/1/2010 and
2009-2010 F-150 vehicles built on or before 2/1/2010 and equipped with 5.4L 3V engine and 6R80
transmission may exhibit a delayed then harsh downshift during a commanded downshift at speeds
above 40 MPH (64 Km/h).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
ID vehicle.
2. Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 67.03 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the 1CM Calibration is:
(1) AL3P-7J104-AC for all vehicles except the F-150 4X4.
(2) AL3P-7J104-BC for F-150 4X4.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox
(2) Powertrain
(3) OBD Test Modes
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info
(5) 1CM Cal Part Number
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT 1CM KAM BE CLEARED FOR THIS PROCEDURE TO BE FULLY
EFFECTIVE
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox
(2) Choose Powertrain Then Choose TCM
(3) Choose Reset KAM
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-12-4
> Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh Downshifts > Page 2864
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset 1CM KAM
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM
KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop, allow at least six (6) seconds.
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101204A 2009-2010 Expedition, 1.0 Hr.
Navigator, F-150: Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM And Perform Road
Tests (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-12-4
> Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh Downshifts > Page 2865
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 09-15-8
> Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4
Shifts
TSB 09-15-8
08/10/09
5.4L 3V 6R80 - HARSH 1-2 UPSHIFT - HARSH 2-1 DOWNSHIFT WHILE COASTING - HARSH
DOWNSHIFT TO 4TH GEAR - INTERMITTENT P0741
FORD: 2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with 5.4L 3V engine may exhibit
symptoms during warm-up: a harsh 1-2 upshift, harsh 2-1 downshift while coasting 15 MPH (24
Km/h). A harsh downshift into 4th gear at highway speeds 45-70 MPH (72-113 Km/h) may also be
experienced. Some vehicles may have a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0741 torque converter
performance code present or stored.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
MECHATRONIC REPAIR/REPLACEMENT IS NOT
AUTHORIZED FOR THIS ISSUE.
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the Powertrain Control Module/Transmission Control Module (PCM/TCM) calibration
using IDS release 61.15 and higher or 62.03 and
higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be
obtained at the website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the TCM Calibration shows AL3P-7J104-AB part number after reprogramming is
complete.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) OBD Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR TSB TO BE
FULLY AFFECTIVE
3. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 09-15-8
> Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 2870
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM.
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175° F (79° C). If it is not at
175° F (79° C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175° F (79° C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091508A 2009 Expedition, Navigator 1.0 Hr.
6R80 Transmission: Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear The
TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 09-15-8
> Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 2871
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2872
Engine Control Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2873
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2874
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2875
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2876
Engine Control Module: Diagrams
C175B Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2877
C175B Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2878
C175B Part 3
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2879
C175E Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2880
C175E Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2881
C175E Part 3
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2882
C175T Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2883
C175T Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Engine Control Module: Procedures
Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EEPROM)
Description
The EEPROM is contained in an integrated circuit internal to the powertrain control module (PCM).
The EEPROM contains the vehicle strategy including calibration information specific to the vehicle,
and is capable of being programmed or flashed repeatedly.
As part of the calibration there is an area referred to as the vehicle identification (VID) block. The
VID block is programmed when installing a new PCM as described under Programming the VID
Block for a Replacement PCM. Failure to carry out this procedure may generate DTC P1635 or
P1639. The VID block in an existing PCM can also be tailored to accommodate various hardware
or parameter changes made to the vehicle since production. Failure to carry out this procedure
properly may generate DTC P1635, Tire/Axle Ratio out of Acceptable Range. An incorrect tire/axle
ratio is one of the main causes for DTC P1639. This is described under Making Changes to the VID
Block and also under Making Changes to the PCM Calibration. The VID block contains many items
used by the strategy for a variety of functions. Some of these items include the vehicle identification
number (VIN), octane adjust, fuel octane, fuel type, vehicle speed limit, tire size, axle ratio, the
presence of speed control, and 4-wheel drive electronic shift-on-the-fly (ESOF) versus manual
shift-on-the-fly (MSOF). Only items applicable to the vehicle hardware and supported by the VID
block is displayed on the scan tool.
When changing items in the VID block, the strategy places range limits on certain items such as
tire and axle ratio. The number of times the VID block may be reconfigured is limited. When this
limit is reached, the scan tool displays a message indicating the need to flash the PCM again to
reset the VID block.
On selected vehicles equipped with permanent DTC reporting capabilities, neutral profile correction
should be learned after a PCM replacement in order to activate the misfire monitor. This can be
accomplished using the Misfire Monitor Neutral Profile Learn function on the scan tool.
Programming can be carried out by a local Ford dealer or any non-Ford facility. Refer to the scan
tool manufacturer's instruction manual for details.
Neutral Profile Correction
In order for the misfire detection system to function properly, any mechanical inaccuracies in the
crankshaft position (CKP) sensor must be learned by the PCM. This information is stored in
non-volatile memory (NVM) in the PCM. It is not cleared when the keep alive memory (KAM) is
reset.
Neutral profile learning is accomplished using the scan tool any time a PCM is replaced. It should
also be relearned any time the CKP sensor is replaced or major engine repairs have been
completed.
To determine if the neutral profile learning has been completed, check the MP_LRN parameter
identification (PID) using the scan tool. The PID should read YES if the neutral profile learning has
been completed. If the PID reads NO, complete the neutral profile learning prior to diagnosing any
misfire DTCs.
Programming the VID Block for a Replacement PCM
The VID block on a replacement PCM is blank and requires programming. There are two
procedures available. The first is an automatic data transfer from the old PCM to the new PCM,
and the second is manual data entry into the new PCM.
Automatic data transfer is carried out if the old PCM is capable of communicating. This is done by
using a scan tool to retrieve data from the old PCM before removing it from the vehicle. The stored
data can be downloaded to the new PCM after it has been installed.
Carry out manual data entry if the old PCM is damaged or incapable of communicating. Remove
and install a new PCM. Using a compatible scan tool, select and carry out the module/parameter
programming, referring to the scan tool manufacturer's instruction manual. Make certain that all
parameters are included. Failure to properly program tire size in revolutions per mile, (rev/mile
equals 63,360 divided by the tire circumference in inches), axle ratio, 4x4/4x2, and/or MSOF/ESOF
may result in DTCs P1635 and P1639. You may be instructed to contact the As-Built Data Center
for the information needed to manually update the VID block with the scan tool. Contact the center
only if the old PCM cannot be used or the data is corrupt. For Ford and Lincoln Mercury
technicians, contact your National Hotline or the Professional Technician Society (PTS) website for
As-Built data listed under the Service Publications Index. Non-Ford technicians use the
Motorcraft(R) website at www.motorcraft.com. From the Motorcraft(R) homepage, use the search
function to find the Module Programming or As-Built Data.
For Ford and Lincoln Mercury technicians, check the Programmable Module Installation link on the
PTS website for quick Programmable Module data information by vehicle.
Making Changes to the VID Block
A programmed PCM may require changes to be made to certain VID information to accommodate
the vehicle hardware. Refer to Module Reprogramming on the scan tool.
Making Changes to the PCM Calibration
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2886
At certain times, the entire EEPROM needs to be completely reprogrammed. This is due to
changes made to the strategy or calibration after production, or the need to reset the VID block
because it has reached its limit. Refer to Module Reprogramming on the scan tool.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2887
Engine Control Module: Removal and Replacement
Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: Refer to Computers and Control Systems Information for correct Vehicle Communication
Module (VCM) hook-up procedure.
If servicing the PCM, connect the scan tool to the vehicle. Allow the scan tool to identify the vehicle
and obtain configuration data.
- All programmable module information will automatically be retrieved by the VCM.
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
3. Disconnect the 3 PCM electrical connectors.
4. Remove the 2 stud bolts and the PCM.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
5. NOTE: If the Instrument Cluster (IC) or the PCM is being replaced (or both), the parameters
must be reset in both modules or the vehicle will
experience a Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) no-start. This will occur even if the vehicle is not
equipped with PATS.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
6. Using the scan tool, perform the Misfire Monitor Neutral Profile Correction procedure, following
the on-screen instructions.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2891
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2892
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Cylinder Head Temperature (CHT) Sensor
The CHT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with the temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
The CHT sensor is installed in the cylinder head and measures the metal temperature. The CHT
sensor can provide complete engine temperature information and can be used to infer coolant
temperature. If the CHT sensor conveys an overheating condition to the PCM, the PCM initiates a
fail-safe cooling strategy based on information from the CHT sensor. A cooling system concern
such as low coolant or coolant loss could cause an overheating condition. As a result, damage to
major engine components could occur. Using both the CHT sensor and fail-safe cooling strategy,
the PCM prevents damage by allowing air cooling of the engine and limp home capability. For
additional information, refer to Powertrain Control Software See: Description and
Operation/Powertrain Control Software for Fail-Safe Cooling Strategy.
Typical CHT Sensor
Typical CHT Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2893
Engine Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
Cylinder Head Temperature (CHT) Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold.
2. Disconnect the Cylinder Head Temperature (CHT) sensor electrical connector.
3. Remove the CHT sensor and discard.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Coat the new CHT sensor threads with high temperature nickel anti-seize lubricant prior to
installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Fuel Level Input (FLI)
The FLI is a communications network message. Most vehicle applications use a potentiometer type
FLI sensor connected to a float in the FP module to determine fuel level.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View
Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View
106L (28 Gal) Fuel Tank
127L (33.5 Gal) Fuel Tank
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 2899
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 2900
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module
Fuel Pump Module
106L (28 Gal) Fuel Tank
127L (33.5 Gal) Fuel Tank
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 2901
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
All fuel tanks
1. Remove the fuel tank. For additional information, refer to Fuel Tank See: Fuel Delivery and Air
Induction/Fuel Tank/Service and Repair/Removal
and Replacement/Fuel Tank.
127L (33.5 gal) fuel tank
2. Remove the 4 nuts and the Fuel Pump (FP) module cover.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
3. Disconnect the return fuel tube-to-FP module quick connect coupling.
All fuel tanks
4. Disconnect the Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-FP module quick
connect coupling and the supply fuel tube-to-FP
module quick connect coupling.
5. Using the Fuel Tank Sender Unit Wrench, remove the FP lock ring.
106L (28 gal) fuel tank
6. NOTICE: Carefully remove the Fuel Pump (FP) assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level
sensor.
NOTE: If the FP does not clear the FP mounting flange on the fuel tank, the use of a screwdriver
may be necessary.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 2902
Remove the FP and FP O-ring seal. If necessary, insert a screwdriver into the empty FP rod hole and slightly pull the screwdriver
inboard until the base of the FP clears the FP mounting flange.
- Discard the FP O-ring seal.
127L (33.5 gal) fuel tank
7. NOTICE: Carefully remove the Fuel Pump (FP) assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level
sensor.
NOTE: Note the location of the FP alignment tabs.
Remove the FP module assembly. Remove and discard the O-ring seal.
All fuel tanks
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2906
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2907
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2908
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
The FTP sensor or in-line FTP sensor is used to measure the fuel tank pressure.
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
In-line Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
In-line Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
106L (28 Gal) Fuel Tank
125L (33 Gal) Fuel Tank
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Page 2911
Removal and Installation
All fuel tanks
1. Remove the fuel tank.
106L (28 gal) fuel tank
2. Disconnect the fuel supply tube-to-heat shield pushpin retainer.
125L (33 gal) fuel tank
3. Remove the fuel tank heat shield retainer(s).
All fuel tanks
4. Remove the fuel tank heat shield.
5. Disconnect the Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-fuel vapor/grade
vent valves quick connect couplings.
6. Disconnect the FTP sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-fuel pump module quick connect
coupling.
7. Remove the FTP sensor and vapor tube assembly from the fuel tank.
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Carry out the Evaporative Emission System Leak Test. For additional information, refer to
Evaporative Emission System Leak Test See: Emission Control Systems/Evaporative Emissions
System/Testing and Inspection.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Page 2912
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Evaporative Emission (EVAP) System
Components - Exploded View
Evaporative Emission (EVAP) System Components - Exploded View
Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Canister Assembly
NOTE: 106L (28 gal) fuel tank vapor tubes shown, 125L (33 gal) similar.
EVAP Canister, Vent Solenoid and Dust Separator and Brackets
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Page 2913
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Description and Operation
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Idle Air Control (IAC) Valve
Note: The IAC valve assembly is not adjustable and cannot be cleaned, also some IAC valves are
normally open and others are normally closed. Some IAC valves require engine vacuum to
operate.
The IAC valve assembly controls the engine idle speed and provides a dashpot function. The IAC
valve assembly meters intake air around the throttle plate through a bypass within the IAC valve
assembly and throttle body. The PCM determines the desired idle speed or bypass air and signals
the IAC valve assembly through a specified duty cycle. The IAC valve responds by positioning the
IAC valve to control the amount of bypassed air. The PCM monitors engine RPM and increases or
decreases the IAC duty cycle in order to achieve the desired RPM.
The PCM uses the IAC valve assembly to control:
- no touch start
- cold engine fast idle for rapid warm-up
- idle (corrects for engine load)
- stumble or stalling on deceleration (provides a dashpot function)
- over-temperature idle boost
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Information Bus: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagram in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be
seen completely in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference
is given to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in parentheses next to or under a component.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System, and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2921
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in set 4
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the
indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to
illustrate proper orientation.
Power Distribution
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2922
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
Component and Connector Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2923
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component Location
Charts.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Locations information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the
various items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written
description of the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2924
Symbols (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2925
Symbols (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2926
Symbols (Part 3)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2927
Symbols (Part 4)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2928
Symbols (Part 5)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2929
Information Bus: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminal by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2930
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal.
Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2931
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2932
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2933
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seat wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2934
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2935
7. If visible, be sure to place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the
barrel. 9. Holding the wire in place, barrel squeeze tool handles appropriate ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2936
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2937
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2938
Information Bus: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
14-1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2939
14-2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2940
14-3
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2941
14-4
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2942
14-5
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (i.e. 13-2, 24-6, 10-2, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Location Views. See: Locations/Component Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 2943
Information Bus: Description and Operation
Communications Network
NOTE: The Smart Junction Box (SJB) is also known as the Generic Electronic Module (GEM).
Multiplexing is a method of sending 2 or more signals simultaneously over a single circuit.
Multiplexing is used to allow 2 or more electronic modules (nodes) to communicate simultaneously
over a twisted-wire pair [data (+) and data (-)] network. The information or messages that can be
communicated on these wires consists of commands, status or data. The advantage of using
multiplexing is to reduce the weight of the vehicle by reducing the number of redundant
components and electrical wiring.
The vehicle has 2 module communication networks which are connected to the Data Link
Connector (DLC), located under the instrument panel:
- High Speed Controller Area Network (HS-CAN)
- Medium Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN)
The HS-CAN and MS-CAN are defined by various ISO documents:
- ISO 11898 specifies the electrical, mechanical, and procedural interface for Controller Area
Network (CAN) serial communication technology.
- ISO 15765 specifies network-layer protocol and timing parameters for CAN-based systems.
- ISO 14229 specifies a common set of unified diagnostics and changes the way PIDs, DTCs and
active commands are processed and displayed on the scan tool.
Network Topology
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 2944
Medium Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN) Operation
The MS-CAN communicates using bussed messages. The MS-CAN has an unshielded twisted pair
cable, data bus (+) and data bus (-) circuits. In addition to scan tool communication, this network
allows sharing of information between all modules on the network.
The MS-CAN is a medium speed communication network used for the following modules:
- ACM
- APIM
- Audio DSP module (Navigator only)
- Audio RCU (if equipped)
- DCSM (if equipped)
- DSM (if equipped)
- HVAC module
- IC
- LTM (if equipped)
- PAM (if equipped)
- PRB (if equipped)
- SDARS module (if equipped)
- SJB
- RETM (if equipped)
High Speed Controller Area Network (HS-CAN) Operation
The HS-CAN communicates using bussed messages. The HS-CAN uses an unshielded twisted
pair cable, data bus (+) and data bus (-) circuits. In addition to scan tool communication, this
network allows sharing of information between all modules on the network.
The HS-CAN is a high speed communication network used for the following modules:
- 4X4 control module (if equipped)
- ABS module
- APIM
- IC
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 2945
- PCM
- RCM
- TCM
- VDM (if equipped)
Network Termination
The CAN uses a network termination circuit to improve communication reliability. The network
termination of the CAN bus takes place inside the termination modules by termination resistors.
Termination modules are located at either end of the bus network. As network messages are
broadcast in the form of voltage signals, the network voltage signals are stabilized by the
termination resistors. Each termination module has a 120 ohm resistor across the positive and
negative bus connection in the termination module. With 2 termination modules on each network,
and the 120 ohm resistors located in a parallel circuit configuration, the total network impedance, or
total resistance is 60 ohms.
Network termination improves bus message reliability by:
- stabilizing bus voltage.
- eliminating electrical interference.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Information Bus: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Special Tools Used With Diagnostics
Communications Network
Principles Of Operation
Communications Network
Principles of Operation
NOTE: The Smart Junction Box (SJB) is also known as the Generic Electronic Module (GEM).
Vehicle communication utilizes both the medium and high speed Controller Area Network (CAN)
communications. CAN is a method for transferring data among distributed electronic modules via a
serial data bus.
The vehicle is equipped with 2 module communication networks:
- Medium Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN)
- High Speed Controller Area Network (HS-CAN)
Medium Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN)
The MS-CAN is a medium speed communication network that uses an unshielded twisted pair
cable of data (+) and data (-) circuits. The data (+) and the data (-) circuits are each regulated to
approximately 2.5 volts during neutral or rested network traffic. As bus messages are sent on the
data (+) circuit, voltage is increased by approximately 1.0 volt. Inversely, the data (-) circuit is
reduced by approximately 1.0 volt when a bus message is sent. Multiple bus messages can be
sent over the network CAN circuits allowing multiple modules to communicate with each other. The
MS-CAN will not communicate while certain faults are present, but will operate with diminished
performance with other faults present. The MS-CAN may remain operational when 1 of the 2
termination resistors are not present.
The MS-CAN operates at a data transfer speed of 125 Kbps for bus messages and is designed for
general information transfer. The network will remain operational, but at a degraded level when
certain circuit faults are present. The MS-CAN may remain operational with only one termination
resistor present.
In the event that one of the 2 network circuits (MS-CAN + or MS-CAN -) becomes open to a
module on the network, unreliable network communication to all modules on the network may
result. The module to which the network circuit is open may repeatedly send network messages
indicating there has been partial data received. This type of message is referred to as a
Negative-Acknowledge (NACK) message. Repeated NACK messages may "load" the network with
too much activity causing intermittent no communication to other network modules and/or the scan
tool.
The following modules are on the MS-CAN:
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2948
- Audio Control Module (ACM)
- Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
- Audio Digital Signal Processing (DSP) module (if equipped)
- Audio Rear Control Unit (RCU) (if equipped)
- Driver Seat Module (DSM) (if equipped)
- Dual Climate Controlled Seat Module (DCSM) (if equipped)
- HVAC module - Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) (if equipped)
- HVAC module - Electronic Manual Temperature Control (EMTC) (if equipped)
- Instrument Cluster (IC)
- Liftgate/Trunk Module (LTM) (if equipped)
- Parking Aid Module (PAM) (if equipped)
- Power Running Board (PRB) module (if equipped)
- Rear Entertainment Module (RETM) (if equipped)
- Satellite Digital Audio Receiver System (SDARS) module (if equipped)
- Smart Junction Box (SJB)
The following fault chart describes the specific MS-CAN failures and their resulting symptom:
Medium Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN) Communication Fault Chart
High Speed Controller Area Network (HS-CAN)
The HS-CAN is a high speed communication network that uses an unshielded twisted pair cable of
data (+) and data (-) circuits. The data (+) and the data (-) circuits are each regulated to
approximately 2.5 volts during neutral or rested network traffic. As bus messages are sent on the
data (+) circuit, voltage is increased by approximately 1.0 volt. Inversely, the data (-) circuit is
reduced by approximately 1.0 volt when a bus message is sent. Multiple bus messages can be
sent over the network CAN circuits allowing multiple modules to communicate with each other. The
HS-CAN will not communicate while certain faults are present, but will operate with diminished
performance with other faults present. The HS-CAN bus may remain operational when 1 of the 2
termination resistors are not present.
The HS-CAN operates at a data transfer speed of 500 Kbps and is designed for real time
information transfer and control. The network will remain operational, but at a degraded level when
certain circuit faults are present. The HS-CAN may remain operational with only one termination
resistor present.
In the event that one of the 2 network circuits (HS-CAN + or HS-CAN -) becomes open to a module
on the network, unreliable network communication to all modules on the network may result. The
module to which the network circuit is open may repeatedly send network messages indicating
there has been partial data received. This type of message is referred to as a
Negative-Acknowledge (NACK) message. Repeated NACK messages may "load" the network with
too much activity causing intermittent no communication to other network modules and/or the scan
tool.
The following modules are on the HS-CAN:
- 4X4 control module (if equipped)
- ABS module
- Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
- IC
- PCM
- Restraints Control Module (RCM)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
- Vehicle Dynamics Module (VDM) (if equipped)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2949
The following fault chart describes the specific HS-CAN failures and their resulting symptom:
High Speed Controller Area Network (HS-CAN) Communication Fault Chart
The following chart describes the specific CAN messages broadcast by each module, and the
module(s) that receive the message:
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2950
Controller Area Network (CAN) Module Communication Message Chart (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2951
Controller Area Network (CAN) Module Communication Message Chart (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2952
Controller Area Network (CAN) Module Communication Message Chart (Part 3)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2953
Controller Area Network (CAN) Module Communication Message Chart (Part 4)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2954
Controller Area Network (CAN) Module Communication Message Chart (Part 5)
Inspection And Verification
Communications Network
Inspection and Verification
1. Verify the customer concern.
2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of electrical damage.
- If an obvious cause for an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible)
before proceeding to the next step.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2955
Visual Inspection Chart
3. Connect the scan tool to the DLC.
- NOTE: Make sure to use the latest scan tool software release.
NOTE: The Vehicle Communication Module (VCM) LED prove-out confirms power and ground
from the DLC are provided to the VCM.
If the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) does not communicate with the VCM: Check the VCM connection to the vehicle.
- Check the scan tool connection to the VCM.
- Go To Pinpoint Test Y, to diagnose No Power To The Scan Tool. See: Pinpoint Tests/Pinpoint
Test Y: No Power To The Scan Tool
4. Establish a scan tool session.
- NOTE: The scan tool will first attempt to communicate with the PCM, after establishing
communication with the PCM, the scan tool will then attempt to communicate with all other
modules on the vehicle.
If an IDS session cannot be established with the vehicle, (IDS may state "No communication can
be established with the PCM"): Choose "NO" when the scan tool prompts whether or not to retry communication.
- Enter either a PCM part number, tear tag or calibration number to identify the vehicle and start a
session (the PCM part number and 4-character tear tag are printed on the PCM label).
- Go To Pinpoint Test A, to diagnose The PCM Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool. See:
Pinpoint Tests/Pinpoint Test A: The PCM Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2956
5. Carry out the network test.
- If the network test passes, retrieve and record the continuous memory DTCs and proceed to Step
6.
- If the network test fails, GO to Symptom Chart to diagnose the failed communication network.
See: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
- If a module fails to communicate during the network test, GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures
6. Retrieve and review the DTCs.
- If the DTCs retrieved are related to the concern, go to DTC Charts. Follow the non-network DTC
diagnostics (B-codes, C-codes, P-codes) prior to the network DTC diagnostics (U-codes). For all
other DTCs, refer to the Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Chart in Body Control Systems. See:
Diagnostic Trouble Code Descriptions/Communications Network See: Body and Frame/Body
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Descriptions/Diagnostic Trouble
Code (DTC) Chart
- If no DTCs related to the concern are retrieved, GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
Special Tools Used With Diagnostics
Module Configuration
Principles Of Operation
Module Configuration
Principles of Operation
Configurable modules accommodate a variety of vehicle options, eliminating the need for many
unique modules for one vehicle line. These modules must be configured when replaced as part of a
repair procedure. Configurable modules should not be exchanged between vehicles since the
settings are unique to each vehicle. Failure to configure a new module may result in improper
operation and/or DTCs setting.
The following are the 3 different methods of configuration:
- Programmable Module Installation (PMI)
- Module reprogramming ("flashing")
- Programmable parameters
Some modules do not support all 3 methods.
Definition of Terms
The following are definitions of configuration terms:
Programmable Module Installation (PMI)
PMI is a scan tool process which configures settings in a new module. Data used for the PMI
process is automatically downloaded from the original module and stored when a scan tool session
is started. If this data cannot be retrieved from the module being replaced, the scan tool may
prompt for As-Built data entry or display a list of parameter values that need to be manually
selected. Some modules are reprogrammed during PMI when a strategy/calibration update is
available. To carry out PMI, refer to Programmable Module Installation (PMI) See: Service and
Repair.
NOTE: It is important that the scan tool identifies the vehicle and obtains configuration data prior to
removing any modules. The new module must be able to communicate with the scan tool in order
to carry out PMI. See: Programming and Relearning
Module Reprogramming
Module reprogramming (also referred to as "flashing") is a scan tool process which updates the
strategy/calibration in a module. Reprogramming a module with the same level of software will not
improve module operation or repair a hardware failure. Module reprogramming is automatically
carried
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2957
out during PMI when a later strategy/calibration is available.
NOTE: Module reprogramming should be limited to circumstances where a published TSB
procedure recommends doing so.
NOTE: A module cannot communicate with other modules on the communication network while
being reprogrammed. Clear any network communication DTCs which may have been set in other
modules during the reprogramming process.
Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) Programming
APIM programming is a process that updates the APIM Consumer Interface Processor (CIP) and
Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) software. The VIP programming updates the calibration files in
the portion of the APIM that interfaces with the Controller Area Network (CAN). The CIP
programming updates calibration files in the portion of the APIM that interfaces with mobile phones
and other customer devices.
APIM programming uses the VCM to read and program the VIP software through the Data Link
Connector (DLC). A web-based On-Line Automotive Service Information System (OASIS)
application is used to read and program the CIP software via a Universal Serial Bus (USB) cable
between the scan tool and vehicle USB port. Both the VCM and OASIS application must be
running on the scan tool during APIM programming. To carry out APIM programming, refer to
Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) Programming See: Programming and
Relearning/Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) Programming.
Programmable Parameters
Programmable parameters are customer preference items that may be modified by the dealer via
scan tool or in some cases modified by the customer following a procedure listed in the vehicle
Owner's Literature. While many configuration options may exist for a module, only a few of these
options are programmable parameters.
Adaptive Learning and Calibration
Some modules require a separate learning procedure be carried out if replaced as part of a repair
procedure. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal
and installation procedures.
Vehicle Identification Block
The PCM contains a memory area called a vehicle identification block. The PCM vehicle
identification block commonly stores powertrain configuration items such as Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN), tire size, axle ratio, and whether or not the vehicle is equipped with speed control.
Module Address
A unique module address is assigned to each module on the network for identification.
As-Built Data
As-Built data is a VIN-specific module configuration record. During vehicle build, the configuration
from all modules is downloaded and stored in the As-Built database. As-Built data will not reflect
customer preference items that have been changed from the default state. These items will need to
be changed using programmable parameters after the module is configured.
NOTE: It is not necessary to obtain As-Built data unless directed to do so by the scan tool. This
data may be accessed from the technician service publication website.
The following chart lists As-Built data addresses and describes specific module configuration
information:
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2958
Module Configuration And Parameter Chart (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2959
Module Configuration And Parameter Chart (Part 2)
Inspection And Verification
Module Configuration
Inspection and Verification
This provides step-by-step module configuration procedures. Carry out the Programmable Module
Installation (PMI) procedure when another diagnostic/repair information directs to carry out
configuration or when DTCs from the below list are present: See: Programming and Relearning
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2960
Information Bus: Diagnostic Trouble Code Descriptions
Communications Network
Communications Network
DTC Charts
NOTE: Network DTCs (U-codes) are often a result of intermittent concerns such as faulty wiring or
low battery voltage occurrences. Additionally, vehicle service procedures such as module
reprogramming will often set network DTCs. Replacing a module to resolve a network DTC is
unlikely to resolve the concern. To prevent repeat network DTC concerns, inspect all network
wiring, especially connectors. Test the vehicle battery, refer to Battery.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2961
U0001-U0121
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2962
U0121-U0155
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2963
U0155-U0184
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2964
U0184:00-U0238
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2965
U0238:00-U2011
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2966
U2013-U3000:88
Module Configuration
Module Configuration
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2967
B2477-B2900 / P0602-P1639 / U201A:51-U0300
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2968
U2050-U2101:00
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2969
Information Bus: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Communications Network
Symptom Chart
Symptom Chart (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2970
Symptom Chart (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2971
Symptom Chart (Part 3)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2972
Information Bus: Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test A: The PCM Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Communications Network
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test A: The PCM Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 14, Module Communications Network for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 25, Electronic Engine Controls - 5.4L for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The PCM communicates with the scan tool through the High Speed Controller Area Network
(HS-CAN). Circuits VDB04 (WH/BU) (HS-CAN +) and VDB05 (WH) (HS-CAN -) provide the
network connection to the PCM.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- PCM
PINPOINT TEST A: THE PCM DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- A1 VERIFY IF OTHER HS-CAN MODULES PASS THE
NETWORK TEST
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Network Test.
- In the left hand pane of the IDS network test display screen, verify whether any HS-CAN modules
passed the network test.
- Is the text "pass" or a DTC listed next to any of the following modules (if equipped): ABS module,
Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM), Instrument Cluster (IC), 4x4 control module,
Restraints Control Module (RCM), PCM, Transmission Control Module (TCM) or Vehicle Dynamics
Module (VDM)?
Yes
If "pass" or a DTC was listed next to the PCM, a network fault is not currently present. Go To
Pinpoint Test U to diagnose an intermittent HS-CAN fault condition. See: Pinpoint Test U:
Intermittent No Medium Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN) Communication, One Or More
Modules Are Not Respo
If "pass" or a DTC was listed next to one or more modules other than the PCM, GO to A2.
No
No modules are currently communicating on the HS-CAN. Go To Pinpoint Test T to diagnose no
HS-CAN communication. See: Pinpoint Test T: The Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
------------------------------------------------- A2 VERIFY COMPUTERS AND CONTROL SYSTEMS
INFORMATION PINPOINT TEST QA HAS BEEN CARRIED OUT
- Verify that pinpoint test QA has been carried out.
- Has pinpoint test QA been carried out?
Yes
GO to A3.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2973
No
REFER to Computers and Control Systems Information, Pinpoint Tests, pinpoint test QA to
diagnose no communication with the PCM.
------------------------------------------------- A3 CHECK THE HS-CAN TERMINATION RESISTANCE
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
- Measure the resistance between the Data Link Connector (DLC) C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU),
harness side and the DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side.
- Is the resistance between 54 and 66 ohms?
Yes
GO to A5.
No
GO to A4.
------------------------------------------------- A4 CHECK THE HS-CAN CIRCUITS BETWEEN THE PCM
AND THE DLC FOR AN OPEN
- Disconnect: PCM C175b.
- Measure the resistance between the PCM C175b-59, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and
the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side.
- Measure the resistance between the PCM C175b-43, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side and the
DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side.
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to A5.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT
the network test with the scan tool.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2974
------------------------------------------------- A5 CHECK THE HS-CAN (+) AND HS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side and ground.
- Are the resistances greater than 1,000 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable.GO to A6.
No
CONNECT the negative battery cable. Go To Pinpoint Test W. See: Pinpoint Test W: Intermittent
No High Speed Controller Area Network (HS-CAN) Communication, One Or More Modules Are Not
Respond
------------------------------------------------- A6 CHECK THE HS-CAN (+) AND HS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 6 volts?
Yes
REPAIR the circuit. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
GO to A7.
------------------------------------------------- A7 CHECK FOR CORRECT PCM OPERATION
- Disconnect all the PCM connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the PCM connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new PCM. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2975
network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test B: The ABS Module Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Communications Network
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test B: The ABS Module Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 14, Module Communications Network for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 42, Vehicle Dynamic Systems for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The ABS module communicates with the scan tool through the High Speed Controller Area
Network (HS-CAN). Circuits VDB04 (WH/BU) (HS-CAN +) and VDB05 (WH) (HS-CAN -) provide
the network connection to the ABS module. Voltage for the ABS module is provided by circuit
CBB52 (GN/WH) and ground is provided by circuit GD120 (BK/GN).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- ABS module
PINPOINT TEST B: THE ABS MODULE DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- B1 CHECK THE ABS MODULE VOLTAGE SUPPLY
CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: ABS Module C135.
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the ABS module C135-1, circuit SBB69 (GY/RD), C135-8, circuit
CBB52 (GN/WH), and C135-32, circuit SBB68 (GN/RD), harness side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to B2.
No
VERIFY the Battery Junction Box (BJB) fuses 52 (10A), 68 (60A) and 69 (60A) are OK. If OK,
REPAIR the circuit. If not OK, REFER to the Wiring Diagrams to identify the possible causes of the
circuit short. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
-------------------------------------------------
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2976
B2 CHECK THE ABS MODULE GROUND CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
- Measure the resistance between the ABS module C135-16, circuit GD120 (BK/GN), harness side
and ground.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to B3.
No
REPAIR the circuit. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network
test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- B3 CHECK THE HS-CAN CIRCUITS BETWEEN THE ABS
MODULE AND THE DLC FOR AN OPEN
- Measure the resistance between the ABS module C135-12, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side
and the Data Link Connector (DLC) C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side.
- Measure the resistance between the ABS module C135-13, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side
and the DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side.
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to B4.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT
the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- B4 CHECK FOR CORRECT ABS MODULE OPERATION
- Disconnect the ABS module connector.
- Check for:
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2977
- corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect the ABS module connector and make sure it seats correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new ABS module. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test C: The Instrument Cluster (IC) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Communications Network
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test C: The Instrument Cluster (IC) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 14, Module Communications Network for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 60, Instrument Cluster for schematic and connector information. See:
Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The Instrument Cluster (IC) communicates with the scan tool through the High Speed Controller
Area Network (HS-CAN). Circuits VDB04 (WH/BU) (HS-CAN +) and VDB05 (WH) (HS-CAN -)
provide the HS-CAN connection to the IC and circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07
(VT/OG) (MS-CAN -) provide the Medium Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN) connection to
the IC. Voltage for the IC is provided by circuits CBP29 (WH/VT) and SBP26 (YE/RD). Circuit
GD133 (BK) provides ground.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- IC
PINPOINT TEST C: THE IC DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- C1 CHECK THE HS-CAN TERMINATION RESISTANCE
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
- Disconnect the scan tool cable from the Data Link Connector (DLC).
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and the
DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2978
- Is the resistance between 54 and 66 ohms?
Yes
GO to C2.
No
GO to C4.
------------------------------------------------- C2 CHECK THE IC GROUND CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN
- Measure the resistance between the IC C220-6, circuit GD133 (BK), harness side and ground.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to C3.
No
REPAIR the circuit. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network
test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- C3 CHECK THE IC VOLTAGE SUPPLY CIRCUITS FOR AN
OPEN
- Disconnect: IC C220.
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the IC C220-1, circuit SBP26 (YE/RD) harness side and ground;
and between the IC C220-14, circuit CBP29 (WH/VT) harness side and ground.
- Are the voltages greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to C5.
No
VERIFY the SJB fuse 26 (10A) or fuse 29 (5A) is OK. If OK, REPAIR the circuit in question. If not
OK, REFER to the Wiring Diagrams to identify the possible causes of the circuit short. CLEAR the
DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- C4 CHECK THE HS-CAN CIRCUITS BETWEEN THE IC
AND THE DLC FOR AN OPEN
- Measure the resistance between the IC C220-7, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and the
Data Link Connector (DLC) C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2979
- Measure the resistance between the IC C220-8, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side and the DLC
C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side.
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to C5.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- C5 CHECK THE MS-CAN CIRCUITS BETWEEN THE IC
AND THE DLC FOR AN OPEN
- Measure the resistance between the IC C220-4, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and the
DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side.
- Measure the resistance between the IC C220-5, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side and the
DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to C6.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2980
------------------------------------------------- C6 CHECK FOR CORRECT IC OPERATION
- Disconnect the IC connector.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect the IC connector and make sure it seats correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new IC. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test D: The Restraints Control Module (RCM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Communications Network
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test D: The Restraints Control Module (RCM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 14, Module Communications Network for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 46, Supplemental Restraint System for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The Restraints Control Module (RCM) communicates with the scan tool through the High Speed
Controller Area Network (HS-CAN). Circuits VDB04 (WH/BU) (HS-CAN +) and VDB05 (WH)
(HS-CAN -) provide the network connection to the RCM. Voltage for the RCM is provided by circuit
CBP32 (GN/VT), and the RCM is case grounded.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Case ground open
- RCM
PINPOINT TEST D: THE RCM DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on air bag, safety canopy or side air curtain
modules. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of these
modules, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on safety belt buckle/retractor pretensioners or
adaptive load limiting retractors. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental
deployment of the safety belt pretensioners or adaptive load limiting retractors, which increases the
risk of serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
NOTE: Most faults are due to connector and/or wiring concerns. Carry out a thorough inspection
and verification before proceeding with the Pinpoint Test. See: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic
Overview/Communications Network/Inspection And Verification
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2981
------------------------------------------------- D1 CHECK THE RCM CONNECTION
- Ignition OFF.
- Depower the SRS. Refer to Air Bag Systems.
- Disconnect: RCM C310a.
- Disconnect: RCM C310b.
- Are RCM C310a-24, RCM C310b-17 and C310b-18 OK?
Yes
GO to D2.
No
REPAIR the RCM connector pins as necessary. REPOWER the SRS. REFER to Air Bag Systems.
CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- D2 CHECK THE RCM VOLTAGE SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR
AN OPEN
- Repower the SRS. Refer to Air Bag Systems.
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the RCM C310a-24, circuit CBP32 (GN/VT), harness side and
ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to D3.
No
VERIFY the Smart Junction Box (SJB) fuse 32 (10A) is OK. If OK, REPAIR the circuit. If not OK,
REFER to the Wiring Diagrams to identify the possible causes of the circuit short. REACTIVATE
the SRS. REFER to Air Bag Systems. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan
tool.
------------------------------------------------- D3 CHECK THE RCM CASE GROUND
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
- Measure the resistance between the RCM case and a good chassis ground.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to D4.
No
REPAIR the RCM case ground as necessary. CONNECT the negative battery cable.
REACTIVATE the SRS. REFER to Air Bag Systems. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test
with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- D4 CHECK THE HS-CAN CIRCUITS BETWEEN THE RCM
AND THE DLC FOR AN OPEN
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2982
- Measure the resistance between the RCM C310b-18, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and
the Data Link Connector (DLC) C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side.
- Measure the resistance between the RCM C310b-17, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side and the
DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side.
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to D5.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT the negative battery cable. REACTIVATE the SRS.
REFER to Air Bag Systems. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- D5 CHECK FOR CORRECT RCM OPERATION
- Disconnect all the RCM connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the RCM connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new RCM. REACTIVATE the SRS. REFER to Air Bag Systems. CLEAR the DTCs.
REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. REACTIVATE the SRS. REFER to Air Bag Systems. CLEAR the DTCs.
REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test E: The 4X4 Control Module Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Communications Network
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test E: The 4X4 Control Module Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2983
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 14, Module Communications Network for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 34, Four Wheel Drive Systems for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The 4X4 control module communicates with the scan tool through the High Speed Controller Area
Network (HS-CAN). Circuits VDB04 (WH/BU) (HS-CAN +) and VDB05 (WH) (HS-CAN -) provide
the network connection to the 4X4 control module. Voltage is supplied by circuits CBP35 (YE/GY),
SBB20 (GN/RD) and SBB27 (BU/RD). Ground is supplied by circuits GD123 (BK/GY) and GD133
(BK).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- 4X4 control module
PINPOINT TEST E: THE 4X4 CONTROL MODULE DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- E1 CHECK THE 4X4 CONTROL MODULE VOLTAGE
SUPPLY CIRCUITS FOR AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: 4X4 Control Module C281a.
- Disconnect: 4X4 Control Module C281b.
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the 4X4 control module, harness side and ground as follows:
- Are the voltages greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to E2.
No
VERIFY the Battery Junction Box (BJB) fuse 27 (20A) or fuse 20 (20A) is OK and the SJB fuse 35
(10A) is OK. If OK, REPAIR the circuit in question. If not OK, REFER to the Wiring Diagrams to
identify the possible causes of the circuit short. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with
the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- E2 CHECK THE 4X4 CONTROL MODULE GROUND
CIRCUITS FOR AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
- Measure the resistance between the 4X4 control module, harness side and ground as follows:
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2984
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to E3.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT
the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- E3 CHECK THE HS-CAN CIRCUITS BETWEEN THE 4X4
CONTROL MODULE AND THE DLC FOR AN OPEN
- Measure the resistance between the 4X4 control module C281a-10, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU),
harness side and the Data Link Connector (DLC) C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side.
- Measure the resistance between the 4X4 control module C281a-9, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness
side and the DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side.
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to E4.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT
the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- E4 CHECK FOR CORRECT 4X4 CONTROL MODULE
OPERATION
- Disconnect all the 4X4 control module connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the 4X4 control module connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2985
INSTALL a new 4X4 control module. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan
tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test F: The Vehicle Dynamics Module (VDM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Communications Network
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test F: The Vehicle Dynamics Module (VDM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 14, Module Communications Network for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 41, Vehicle Dynamic Suspension for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The Vehicle Dynamics Module (VDM) communicates with the scan tool through the High Speed
Controller Area Network (HS-CAN). Circuits VDB04 (WH/BU) (HS-CAN +) and VDB05 (WH)
(HS-CAN -) provide the network connection to the VDM. The VDM shares the HS-CAN with the
PCM, the Transmission Control Module (TCM), the ABS module, the Restraints Control Module
(RCM), the 4X4 control module (if equipped) and the Instrument Cluster (IC). Voltage for the VDM
is provided by circuits CBB53 (GN/BN) and SBB48 (VT/RD). Circuit GD120 (BK/GN) provides
ground.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- VDM
PINPOINT TEST F: THE VDM DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- F1 CHECK THE VDM VOLTAGE SUPPLY CIRCUITS FOR
AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: VDM C2131a.
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the VDM, harness side and ground as follows:
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2986
- Are the voltages greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to F2.
No
VERIFY the Battery Junction Box (BJB) fuse 48 (30A) or fuse 53 (10A) is OK. If OK, REPAIR the
circuit in question. If not OK, REFER to the Wiring Diagrams to identify the possible causes of the
circuit short. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- F2 CHECK THE VDM GROUND CIRCUITS FOR AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
- Measure the resistance between the VDM, harness side and ground as follows:
Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to F3.
No
REPAIR the circuit. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network
test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- F3 CHECK THE CAN CIRCUITS BETWEEN THE DLC AND
THE VDM FOR AN OPEN
- Measure the resistance between the Data Link Connector (DLC) C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU),
harness side and the VDM C2131a-10, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH) harness side and the
VDM C2131a-9, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2987
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to F4.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT
the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- F4 CHECK FOR CORRECT VDM OPERATION
- Disconnect all the VDM connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the VDM connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new VDM. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test G: The Transmission Control Module (TCM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Communications Network
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test G: The Transmission Control Module (TCM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 14, Module Communications Network for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 29, Transmission Controls for schematic and connector information.
See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The Transmission Control Module (TCM) communicates with the scan tool through the High Speed
Controller Area Network (HS-CAN). Circuits VDB04 (WH/BU) (HS-CAN +) and VDB05 (WH)
(HS-CAN -) provide the network connection to the TCM. The TCM shares the HS-CAN with the
PCM, the ABS module, the Restraints Control Module (RCM), the 4X4 control module (if
equipped), the Vehicle Dynamics Module (VDM) (if equipped) and the Instrument Cluster (IC).
Voltage for the TCM is provided by circuits CBB54 (VT/OG) and SBB31 (WH/RD). Circuit GD113
(BK/YE) provides ground.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2988
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- TCM
PINPOINT TEST G: THE TCM DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- G1 CHECK THE TCM VOLTAGE SUPPLY CIRCUITS FOR
AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: TCM C1548.
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the TCM, harness side and ground as follows:
- Are the voltages greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to G2.
No
VERIFY the Battery Junction Box (BJB) fuse 26 (15A) or fuse 54 (5A) is OK. If OK, REPAIR the
circuit in question. If not OK, REFER to the Wiring Diagrams to identify the possible causes of the
circuit short. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- G2 CHECK THE TCM GROUND CIRCUITS FOR AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
- Measure the resistance between the TCM, harness side and ground as follows:
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2989
Yes
GO to G3.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT
the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- G3 CHECK THE HS-CAN CIRCUITS BETWEEN THE TCM
AND THE DLC FOR AN OPEN
- Measure the resistance between the TCM C1548-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and
the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side.
- Measure the resistance between the TCM C1548-2, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side and the
DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side.
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to G4.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT
the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- G4 CHECK FOR CORRECT TCM OPERATION
- Disconnect the TCM connector.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect the TCM connector and make sure it seats correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new TCM. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
-------------------------------------------------
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2990
Pinpoint Test H: The Smart Junction Box (SJB) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Communications Network
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test H: The Smart Junction Box (SJB) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 10, Grounds for schematic and connector information. See:
Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 13, Power Distribution/SJB for schematic and connector information.
See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 14, Module Communications Network for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The Smart Junction Box (SJB) communicates with the scan tool through the Medium Speed
Controller Area Network (MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG)
(MS-CAN -) provide the network connection to the SJB. Voltage for the SJB is provided by SJB
fuse 5 (10A). Circuit GD138 (BK/WH) provides ground.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- SJB
PINPOINT TEST H: THE SJB DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- H1 CHECK THE SJB FUSE FOR VOLTAGE
- Ignition OFF.
- NOTE: Measurements are taken with the fuses installed.
- Measure the voltage between the SJB fuse 5 (10A) and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to H2.
No
VERIFY the SJB fuse 5 (10A) is OK. If OK, GO to H4. If not OK, REFER to the Wiring Diagrams to
identify the possible causes of the circuit short.
-------------------------------------------------
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2991
H2 CHECK THE SJB GROUND CIRCUITS FOR AN OPEN
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
- Disconnect: SJB C2280d.
- Measure the resistance between the SJB, harness side and ground as follows:
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to H3.
No
REPAIR the circuit. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network
test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- H3 CHECK THE MS-CAN CIRCUITS BETWEEN THE SJB
AND THE DLC FOR AN OPEN
- Disconnect: SJB C2280b.
- Measure the resistance between the SJB C2280b-37, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and
the Data Link Connector (DLC) C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side.
- Measure the resistance between the SJB C2280b-38, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side and
the DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to H4.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT
the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- H4 CHECK FOR CORRECT SJB OPERATION
- Disconnect all the SJB connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2992
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the SJB connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new SJB. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test I: The HVAC Module Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Communications Network
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test I: The HVAC Module Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 14, Module Communications Network for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 54, Manual Climate Control System for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The HVAC module communicates with the scan tool through the Medium Speed Controller Area
Network (MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG) (MS-CAN -)
provide the network connection to the HVAC module. Voltage for the HVAC module is provided by
circuits CBP37 (WH) and SBP15 (WH/RD). Circuit GD133 (BK) provides ground.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- HVAC module
PINPOINT TEST I: THE HVAC MODULE DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- I1 CHECK THE HVAC MODULE VOLTAGE SUPPLY
CIRCUITS FOR AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: HVAC Module C2357a (EMTC) or C228a (EATC).
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the HVAC module C228a-12 or C2357a-12, circuit CBP37 (WH),
and the HVAC moduleC228a-13 or C2357a-13, circuit SBP15 (WH/RD) and ground.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2993
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to I2.
No
VERIFY the SJB fuse 15 (10A) or 37 (10A) is OK. If OK, REPAIR the circuit in question. If not OK,
REFER to the Wiring Diagrams to identify the possible causes of the circuit short. CLEAR the
DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- I2 CHECK THE HVAC MODULE GROUND CIRCUIT FOR
AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
- Measure the resistance between the HVAC module C228a-23 or C2357a-23, circuit GD133 (BK)
and ground.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to I3.
No
REPAIR the circuit. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network
test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- I3 CHECK THE MS-CAN CIRCUITS BETWEEN THE HVAC
MODULE AND THE DLC FOR AN OPEN
- Measure the resistance between the HVAC module C228a-25 or C2357a-25, circuit VDB06
(GY/OG), harness side and the Data Link Connector (DLC) C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG),
harness side.
- Measure the resistance between the HVAC module C228a-26 or C2357a-26, circuit VDB07
(VT/OG), harness side and the DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2994
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to I4.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT
the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- I4 CHECK FOR CORRECT HVAC MODULE OPERATION
- Disconnect all the HVAC module connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the HVAC module connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new HVAC module. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test J: The Liftgate/Trunk Module (LTM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Communications Network
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test J: The Liftgate/Trunk Module (LTM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 14, Module Communications Network for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 109, Power Liftgate/Retractable Running Boards for schematic and
connector information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The Liftgate/Trunk Module (LTM) communicates with the scan tool through the Medium Speed
Controller Area Network (MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG)
(MS-CAN -) provide the network connection to the LTM. Voltage for the LTM is provided by circuits
SBP14 (BN/RD) and SBB36 (GN/RD). Circuit GD149 (BK/GY) provides ground.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuses
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- LTM
PINPOINT TEST J: THE LTM DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- J1 CHECK THE LTM VOLTAGE SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR AN
OPEN
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2995
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: LTM C4174a.
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the LTM C4174a-4, circuit SBB36 (GN/RD), harness side and
ground and between the LTM C4174a-9, circuit SBP14 (BN/RD), harness side and ground.
- Are the voltages greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to J2.
No
VERIFY the SJB fuse 14 (10A) and Battery Junction Box (BJB) fuse 36 (30A) are OK. If OK,
REPAIR the circuit in question. If not OK, REFER to the Wiring Diagrams to identify the possible
causes of the circuit short. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- J2 CHECK THE LTM GROUND CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
- Measure the resistance between the LTM C4174a-1, circuit GD149 (BK/GY), harness side and
ground.
Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to J3.
No
REPAIR the circuit. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network
test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- J3 CHECK THE MS-CAN CIRCUITS BETWEEN THE LTM
AND THE DLC FOR AN OPEN
- Disconnect: LTM C4174b.
- Measure the resistance between the LTM C4174b-11, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and
the Data Link Connector (DLC) C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2996
- Measure the resistance between the LTM C4174b-10, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side and
the DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to J4.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT
the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- J4 CHECK FOR CORRECT LTM OPERATION
- Disconnect all the LTM connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the LTM connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new LTM. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test K: The Audio Control Module (ACM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Communications Network
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test K: The Audio Control Module (ACM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 14, Module Communications Network for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 130, Audio System/Navigation for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2997
Normal Operation
The Audio Control Module (ACM) communicates with the scan tool through the Medium Speed
Controller Area Network (MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG)
(MS-CAN -) provide the network connection to the ACM. Voltage for the ACM is provided by circuit
SBP39 (WH/RD). Circuit GD114 (BK/BU) provides ground.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- ACM
PINPOINT TEST K: THE ACM DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- K1 CHECK THE ACM VOLTAGE SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR
AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: ACM C240a.
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the ACM C240a-1, circuit SBP39 (WH/RD), harness side and
ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to K2.
No
VERIFY the SJB fuse 39 (20A) is OK. If OK, REPAIR the circuit in question. If not OK, REFER to
the Wiring Diagrams to identify the possible causes of the circuit short. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT
the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- K2 CHECK THE ACM GROUND CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
- Measure the resistance between the ACM C240a-13, circuit GD114 (BK/BU), harness side and
ground.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to K3.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2998
No
REPAIR the circuit. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network
test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- K3 CHECK THE MS-CAN CIRCUITS BETWEEN THE ACM
AND THE DLC FOR AN OPEN
- Disconnect: ACM C240c.
- Measure the resistance between the ACM C240c-15, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and
the Data Link Connector (DLC) C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side.
- Measure the resistance between the base ACM C240c-16, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side
and the DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to K4.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT
the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- K4 CHECK FOR CORRECT ACM OPERATION
- Disconnect all the ACM connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the ACM connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new ACM. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test L: The Audio Digital Signal Processing (DSP) Module Does Not Respond To The
Scan Tool
Communications Network
Pinpoint Tests
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2999
Pinpoint Test L: The Audio Digital Signal Processing (DSP) Module Does Not Respond To The
Scan Tool
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 14, Module Communications Network for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 130, Audio System/Navigation for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The audio Digital Signal Processing (DSP) module communicates with the scan tool through the
Medium Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and
VDB07 (VT/OG) (MS-CAN -) provide the network connection to the audio DSP module. Voltage for
the audio DSP module is provided by circuits SBP38 (BN/RD) and SBP40 (VT/RD). Three circuits
GD114 (BK/BU) provide ground.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuses
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Audio DSP module
PINPOINT TEST L: THE AUDIO DSP MODULE DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- L1 CHECK THE AUDIO DSP MODULE VOLTAGE SUPPLY
CIRCUITS FOR AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Audio DSP Module C2364a.
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the audio DSP module, harness side and ground as follows:
- Are the voltages greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to L2.
No
VERIFY the SJB fuse 38 (20A) or fuse 40 (20A) is OK. If OK, REPAIR the circuit in question. If not
OK, REFER to the Wiring Diagrams to identify the possible causes of the circuit short. CLEAR the
DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- L2 CHECK THE AUDIO DSP MODULE GROUND CIRCUITS
FOR AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
- Measure the resistance between the audio DSP module, harness side and ground as follows:
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3000
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to L3.
No
REPAIR the circuit. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network
test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- L3 CHECK THE MS-CAN CIRCUITS BETWEEN THE DLC
AND THE AUDIO DSP MODULE FOR AN OPEN
- Disconnect: Audio DSP Module C2364c.
- Measure the resistance between the audio DSP module C2364c-11, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG),
harness side and the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side.
- Measure the resistance between the audio DSP module C2364c-1, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG),
harness side and the DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to L4.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT
the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- L4 CHECK FOR CORRECT AUDIO DSP MODULE
OPERATION
- Disconnect all the audio DSP module connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the audio DSP module connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3001
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new audio DSP module. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan
tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test M: The Satellite Digital Audio Receiver System (SDARS) Module Does Not Respond
To The Scan Tool
Communications Network
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test M: The Satellite Digital Audio Receiver System (SDARS) Module Does Not Respond
To The Scan Tool
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 14, Module Communications Network for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 130, Audio System/Navigation for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The Satellite Digital Audio Receiver System (SDARS) module communicates with the scan tool
through the Medium Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG)
(MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG) (MS-CAN -) provide the network connection to the SDARS
module. Voltage for the SDARS module is provided by circuit SBP03 (BU/RD). Circuit GD114
(BK/BU) provides ground.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- SDARS module
PINPOINT TEST M: THE SDARS MODULE DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- M1 CHECK THE SDARS MODULE VOLTAGE SUPPLY
CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: SDARS Module C3290.
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the SDARS module C3290-9, circuit SBP03 (BU/RD), harness side
and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3002
Yes
GO to M2.
No
VERIFY the SJB fuse 3 (15A) is OK. If OK, REPAIR the circuit. If not OK, REFER to the Wiring
Diagrams to identify the possible causes of the circuit short. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the
network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- M2 CHECK THE SDARS MODULE GROUND CIRCUIT FOR
AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
- Measure the resistance between the SDARS module C3290-3, circuit GD114 (BK/BU), harness
side and ground.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to M3.
No
REPAIR the circuit. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network
test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- M3 CHECK THE MS-CAN CIRCUITS BETWEEN THE
SDARS MODULE AND THE DLC FOR AN OPEN
- Measure the resistance between the SDARS module C3290-1, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness
side and the Data Link Connector (DLC) C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side.
- Measure the resistance between the SDARS module C3290-7, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness
side and the DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to M4.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3003
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT
the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- M4 CHECK FOR CORRECT SDARS MODULE OPERATION
- Disconnect the SDARS module connector.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect the SDARS module connector and make sure it seats correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new SDARS module. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test N: The Audio Rear Control Unit (RCU) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Communications Network
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test N: The Audio Rear Control Unit (RCU) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 14, Module Communications Network for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 130, Audio System/Navigation for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The audio Rear Control Unit (RCU) communicates with the scan tool through the Medium Speed
Controller Area Network (MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG)
(MS-CAN -) provide the network connection to the audio RCU. Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN
+) and VDB07 (VT/OG) (MS-CAN -) provide the network connection to the audio RCU. Voltage for
the audio RCU is provided by circuit SBP03 (BU/RD). Circuit GD114 (BK/BU) provides ground.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Audio RCU
PINPOINT TEST N: THE AUDIO RCU DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- N1 CHECK THE AUDIO RCU VOLTAGE SUPPLY CIRCUIT
FOR AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3004
- Disconnect: Audio RCU C3077.
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the audio RCU C3077-16, circuit SBP03 (BU/RD), harness side
and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to N2.
No
VERIFY the Smart Junction Box (SJB) fuse 3 (15A) is OK. If OK, REPAIR the circuit. If not OK,
REFER to the Wiring Diagrams to identify the possible causes of the circuit short. CLEAR the
DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- N2 CHECK THE AUDIO RCU GROUND CIRCUIT FOR AN
OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
- Measure the resistance between the audio RCU C3077-1, circuit GD114 (BK/BU), harness side
and ground.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to N3.
No
REPAIR the circuit. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network
test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- N3 CHECK THE MS-CAN CIRCUITS BETWEEN THE
AUDIO RCU AND THE DLC FOR AN OPEN
- Measure the resistance between the audio RCU C3077-8, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side
and the Data Link Connector (DLC) C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side.
- Measure the resistance between the audio RCU C3077-7, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side
and the DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3005
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to N4.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT
the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- N4 CHECK FOR CORRECT AUDIO RCU OPERATION
- Disconnect the audio RCU connector.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect the audio RCU connector and make sure it seats correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new audio RCU. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test O: The Rear Entertainment Module (RETM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Communications Network
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test O: The Rear Entertainment Module (RETM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 14, Module Communications Network for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 132, Video System for schematic and connector information. See:
Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The Rear Entertainment Module (RETM) communicates with the scan tool through the Medium
Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07
(VT/OG) (MS-CAN -) provide the network connection to the RETM. Voltage for the RETM is
provided by circuit SBP03 (BU/RD). Circuit GD114 (BK/BU) provides ground.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- RETM
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3006
PINPOINT TEST O: THE RETM DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- O1 CHECK THE RETM VOLTAGE SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR
AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: RETM C949.
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the RETM C949-16, circuit SBP03 (BU/RD), harness side and
ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to O2.
No
VERIFY the SJB fuse 3 (15A) is OK. If OK, REPAIR the circuit. If not OK, REFER to the Wiring
Diagrams to identify the possible causes of the circuit short. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the
network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- O2 CHECK THE RETM GROUND CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
- Measure the resistance between the RETM C949-1, circuit GD114 (BK/BU), harness side and
ground.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to O3.
No
REPAIR the circuit. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network
test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- O3 CHECK THE MS-CAN CIRCUITS BETWEEN THE RETM
AND THE DLC FOR AN OPEN
- Measure the resistance between the RETM C949-8, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and
the Data Link Connector (DLC) C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3007
- Measure the resistance between the RETM C949-7, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side and the
DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to O4.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT
the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- O4 CHECK FOR CORRECT RETM OPERATION
- Disconnect the RETM connector.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect the RETM connector and make sure it seats correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new RETM. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test P: The Driver Seat Module (DSM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Communications Network
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test P: The Driver Seat Module (DSM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 14, Module Communications Network for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 123, Memory Seats for schematic and connector information. See:
Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3008
Normal Operation
The Driver Seat Module (DSM) communicates with the scan tool through the Medium Speed
Controller Area Network (MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG)
(MS-CAN -) provide the network connection to the DSM. Voltage for the DSM is provided by circuit
SBB45 (GY/RD). Circuit GD133 (BK) provides ground.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- DSM
PINPOINT TEST P: THE DSM DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- P1 CHECK THE DSM VOLTAGE SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR
AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: DSM C341b.
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the DSM C341b-1, circuit SBP02 (YE/RD), harness side and
ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to P2.
No
VERIFY the SJB fuse 2 (15A) is OK. If OK, REPAIR the circuit. If not OK, REFER to the Wiring
Diagrams to identify the possible causes of the circuit short. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the
network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- P2 CHECK THE DSM GROUND CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
- Measure the resistance between the DSM C341b-24, circuit GD133 (BK), harness side and
ground.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3009
GO to P3.
No
REPAIR the circuit. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network
test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- P3 CHECK THE MS-CAN CIRCUITS BETWEEN THE DSM
AND THE DLC FOR AN OPEN
- Disconnect: DSM C341d.
- Measure the resistance between the DSM C341d-10, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and
the Data Link Connector (DLC) C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side.
- Measure the resistance between the DSM C341d-9, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side and the
DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to P4.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT
the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- P4 CHECK FOR CORRECT DSM OPERATION
- Disconnect all the DSM connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the DSM connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new DSM. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
-------------------------------------------------
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3010
Pinpoint Test Q: The Dual Climate Controlled Seat Module (DCSM) Does Not Respond To The
Scan Tool
Communications Network
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test Q: The Dual Climate Controlled Seat Module (DCSM) Does Not Respond To The
Scan Tool
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 14, Module Communications Network for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 119, Climate Controlled Seats for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The Dual Climate Controlled Seat Module (DCSM) communicates with the scan tool through the
Medium Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and
VDB07 (VT/OG) (MS-CAN -) provide the network connection to the DCSM. Voltage for the DCSM
is provided by circuit SBB08 (VT/RD). Circuit GD138 (BK/WH) provides ground.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- DCSM
PINPOINT TEST Q: THE DCSM DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- Q1 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT
- Inspect the vehicle for seat side air bags.
- Is the vehicle equipped with seat side air bags?
Yes
GO to Q2.
No
GO to Q3.
------------------------------------------------- Q2 CHECK THE DCSM VOLTAGE SUPPLY CIRCUITS FOR
AN OPEN - WITH SIDE AIR BAGS
NOTE: If a seat equipped with a Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) component is being
serviced, the SRS must be depowered. Refer to Air Bag Systems.
NOTE: The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the Restraints Control Module (RCM) fuse is
removed and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate an SRS
fault.
NOTE: The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the
customer.
- Ignition OFF.
- For vehicles with seat side air bags, carry out the following: Depower the SRS. Refer to Air Bag Systems.
- Disconnect the driver seat side air bag module C3226.
- Disconnect the passenger seat side air bag module C3227.
- Connect the negative battery cable.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3011
- Disconnect: DCSM C3265a.
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the DCSM, harness side and ground as follows:
- Are the voltages greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to Q4.
No
VERIFY the Battery Junction Box (BJB) fuse 67 (40A) is OK. If OK, REPAIR the circuit in question.
If not OK, REFER to the Wiring Diagrams to identify the possible causes of the circuit short.
CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- Q3 CHECK THE DCSM VOLTAGE SUPPLY CIRCUITS FOR
AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: DCSM C3265a.
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the DCSM, harness side and ground as follows:
- Are the voltages greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to Q4.
No
VERIFY the Battery Junction Box (BJB) fuse 67 (40A) is OK. If OK, REPAIR the circuit in question.
If not OK, REFER to the Wiring Diagrams to identify the possible causes of the circuit short.
CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- Q4 CHECK THE DCSM GROUND CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3012
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
- Measure the resistance between the DCSM C3265a-M, circuit GD138 (BK/WH), harness side and
ground.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to Q5.
No
REPAIR the circuit. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network
test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- Q5 CHECK THE MS-CAN CIRCUITS BETWEEN THE
DCSM AND THE DLC FOR AN OPEN
- Disconnect: DCSM C3265c.
- Measure the resistance between the DCSM C3265c-1, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and
the Data Link Connector (DLC) C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side.
- Measure the resistance between the DCSM C3265c-2, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side and
the DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to Q6.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT
the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- Q6 CHECK FOR CORRECT DCSM OPERATION
- Disconnect all the DCSM connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3013
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the DCSM connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new DCSM. REPOWER the SRS. REFER to Air Bag Systems. CLEAR the DTCs.
REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. REPOWER the SRS. REFER to Air Bag Systems. CLEAR the DTCs.
REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test R: The Power Running Board (PRB) Module Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Communications Network
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test R: The Power Running Board (PRB) Module Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 14, Module Communications Network for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 109, Power Liftgate/Retractable Running Boards for schematic and
connector information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The Power Running Board (PRB) module communicates with the scan tool through the Medium
Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07
(VT/OG) (MS-CAN -) provide the network connection to the PRB module. Voltage for the PRB
module is provided by circuit SBB11 (BU/RD). Circuit GD143 (BK/VT) provides ground.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- PRB module
PINPOINT TEST R: THE PRB MODULE DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- R1 CHECK THE PRB MODULE VOLTAGE SUPPLY
CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: PRB Module C3313b.
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the PRB module C3313b-1, circuit SBB11 (BU/RD), harness side
and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3014
Yes
GO to R2.
No
VERIFY the Battery Junction Box (BJB) fuse 11 (40A) is OK. If OK, REPAIR the circuit. If not OK,
REFER to the Wiring Diagrams to identify the possible causes of the circuit short. CLEAR the
DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- R2 CHECK THE PRB MODULE GROUND CIRCUIT FOR
AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
- Measure the resistance between the PRB module C3313b-4, circuit GD143 (BK/VT), harness
side and ground.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to R3.
No
REPAIR the circuit. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network
test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- R3 CHECK THE MS-CAN CIRCUITS BETWEEN THE PRB
MODULE AND THE DLC FOR AN OPEN
- Measure the resistance between the PRB module C3313b-8, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness
side and the Data Link Connector (DLC) C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side.
- Measure the resistance between the PRB module C3313b-7, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness
side and the DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3015
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to R4.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT
the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- R4 CHECK FOR CORRECT PRB MODULE OPERATION
- Disconnect all the PRB module connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the PRB module connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new PRB module. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test S: The Parking Aid Module (PAM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Communications Network
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test S: The Parking Aid Module (PAM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 14, Module Communications Network for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 131, Parking Aid for schematic and connector information. See:
Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The Parking Aid Module (PAM) communicates with the scan tool through the Medium Speed
Controller Area Network (MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG)
(MS-CAN -) provide the network connection to the PAM. Voltage for the PAM is provided by circuit
CBP35 (YE/GY). Circuit GD133 (BK) provides ground.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- PAM
PINPOINT TEST S: THE PAM DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- S1 CHECK THE PAM VOLTAGE SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR
AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: PAM C4226 (Expedition) or PAM C4014a (Navigator).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3016
- Ignition ON.
- For Expedition , measure the voltage between the PAM C4226-18, circuit CBP35 (YE/GY),
harness side and ground.
- For Navigator, measure the voltage between the PAM C4014a-1, circuit CBP35 (YE/GY), harness
side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to S2.
No
VERIFY the SJB fuse 35 (10A) is OK. If OK, REPAIR the circuit. If not OK, REFER to the Wiring
Diagrams to identify the possible causes of the circuit short. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the
network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- S2 CHECK THE PAM GROUND CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
- For Expedition, measure the resistance between the PAM C4226-6, circuit GD133 (BK), harness
side and ground.
- For Navigator, measure the resistance between the PAM C4014a-4, circuit GD133 (BK), harness
side and ground.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to S3.
No
REPAIR the circuit. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network
test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- S3 CHECK THE MS-CAN CIRCUITS BETWEEN THE PAM
AND THE DLC FOR AN OPEN
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3017
- For Expedition, measure the resistance between the PAM C4226-4, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG),
harness side and the Data Link Connector (DLC) C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side.
- For Expedition, measure the resistance between the PAM C4226-5, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG),
harness side and the DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
- For Navigator, measure the resistance between the PAM C4014a-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG),
harness side and the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side.
- For Navigator, measure the resistance between the PAM C4014a-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG),
harness side and the DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to S4.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT
the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- S4 CHECK FOR CORRECT PAM OPERATION
- Disconnect the PAM connector(s).
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect the PAM connector(s) and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3018
INSTALL a new PAM. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test T: The Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) Does Not Respond To The Scan
Tool
Communications Network
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test T: The Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) Does Not Respond To The Scan
Tool
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 14, Module Communications Network for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) communicates with the scan tool through the
High Speed Controller Area Network (HS-CAN). Circuits VDB04 (WH/BU) (HS-CAN +) and VDB05
(WH) (HS-CAN -) provide the HS-CAN connection to the APIM. Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN
+) and VDB07 (VT/OG) (MS-CAN -) provide the Medium Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN)
connection to the APIM. Voltage for the APIM is provided by circuit SBP03 (BU/RD). Circuit GD114
(BK/BU) provides ground.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- APIM
PINPOINT TEST T: THE APIM DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- T1 CHECK THE APIM VOLTAGE SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR
AN OPEN
- Disconnect: APIM C3342.
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the APIM C3342-1, circuit SBP03 (BU/RD), harness side and
ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to T2.
No
VERIFY the Smart Junction Box (SJB) fuse 3 (15A) is OK. If OK, REPAIR the circuit in question. If
not OK, REFER to the Wiring Diagrams to
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3019
identify the possible causes of the circuit short. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with
the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- T2 CHECK THE APIM GROUND CIRCUITS FOR AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
- Measure the resistance between the APIM C3342-37, circuit GD114 (BK/BU), harness side and
ground; and between the APIM C3342-38, circuit GD114 (BK/BU), harness side and ground.
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to T3.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT
the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- T3 CHECK THE HS-CAN CIRCUITS BETWEEN THE APIM
AND THE DLC FOR AN OPEN
- Measure the resistance between the APIM C3342-53, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and
the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side.
- Measure the resistance between the APIM C3342-54, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side and the
DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side.
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to T4.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT
the network test with the scan tool.
-------------------------------------------------
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3020
T4 CHECK THE MS-CAN CIRCUITS BETWEEN THE APIM AND THE DLC FOR AN OPEN
- Measure the resistance between the APIM C3342-16, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and
the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side.
- Measure the resistance between the APIM C3342-17, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side and
the DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to T5.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT
the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- T5 CHECK FOR CORRECT APIM OPERATION
- Disconnect the APIM connector.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect the APIM connector and make sure it seats correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new APIM. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test U: Intermittent No Medium Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN)
Communication, One Or More Modules Are Not Respo
Communications Network
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test U: Intermittent No Medium Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN)
Communication, One Or More Modules Are Not
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3021
Responding During Network Test
Normal Operation
The Medium Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN) uses an unshielded twisted pair cable.
Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) and VDB07 (VT/OG) provide the network connection to all modules on
the network.
In the event that one of the 2 network circuits (MS-CAN + or MS-CAN -) becomes open to a
module on the network, unreliable network communication to all modules on the network may
result.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
PINPOINT TEST U: INTERMITTENT NO MS-CAN COMMUNICATION, ONE OR MORE
MODULES ARE NOT RESPONDING DURING NETWORK TEST
NOTE: Most faults are due to connector and/or wiring concerns. Carry out a thorough inspection
and verification before proceeding with the Pinpoint Test. See: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic
Overview/Communications Network/Inspection And Verification
NOTE: Various network DTCs will set while disabling modules in this test procedure which will
need to be cleared after the diagnostic procedure is completed.
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- U1 CHECK THE DLC PINS FOR DAMAGE
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect the scan tool cable from the Data Link Connector (DLC).
- Inspect DLC pins 3 and 11 for damage.
- Are DLC pins 3 and 11 OK?
Yes
GO to U2.
No
REPAIR the DLC as necessary. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- U2 CHECK THE MS-CAN TERMINATION RESISTANCE
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and the
DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
- Is the resistance between 54 and 66 ohms?
Yes
GO to U3.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3022
No
CONNECT the negative battery cable. Go To Pinpoint Test V. See: Pinpoint Test V: No Medium
Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN) Communication, All Modules Are Not Responding
------------------------------------------------- U3 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side and ground.
- Are the resistances greater than 1,000 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to U4.
No
CONNECT the negative battery cable. Go To Pinpoint Test V. See: Pinpoint Test V: No Medium
Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN) Communication, All Modules Are Not Responding
------------------------------------------------- U4 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and ground;
and between the DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side and ground.
Is the voltage greater than 6 volts?
Yes
REPAIR the circuit. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
GO to U5.
------------------------------------------------- U5 CHECK FOR RESTORED NETWORK
COMMUNICATION WITH THE HVAC MODULE DISABLED
- Disconnect: SJB Fuses 15 (10A) and 37 (10A).
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Network Test.
- Repeat the network test.
- Do all other modules pass the network test?
Yes
INSTALL the removed fuses. Go To Pinpoint Test I. See: Pinpoint Test I: The HVAC Module Does
Not Respond To The Scan Tool
No
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3023
INSTALL the removed fuses. GO to U6.
------------------------------------------------- U6 CHECK FOR RESTORED NETWORK
COMMUNICATION WITH THE ACM DISABLED
- Disconnect: SJB Fuse 39 (20A).
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Network Test.
- Repeat the network test.
- Do all other modules pass the network test?
Yes
INSTALL the removed fuse. Go To Pinpoint Test K. See: Pinpoint Test K: The Audio Control
Module (ACM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
No
INSTALL the removed fuse. GO to U7.
------------------------------------------------- U7 CHECK FOR RESTORED NETWORK
COMMUNICATION WITH THE SJB DISABLED
- Disconnect: SJB Fuse 5 (10A).
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Network Test.
- Repeat the network test.
- Do all other modules pass the network test?
Yes
INSTALL the removed fuse. Go To Pinpoint Test H. See: Pinpoint Test H: The Smart Junction Box
(SJB) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
No
INSTALL the removed fuse. GO to U8.
------------------------------------------------- U8 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - DSM
- Inspect the vehicle for a DSM.
- Is the vehicle equipped with a DSM?
Yes
GO to U9.
No
GO to U10.
------------------------------------------------- U9 CHECK FOR RESTORED NETWORK
COMMUNICATION WITH THE DSM DISABLED
- Disconnect: SJB Fuse 2 (15A).
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Network Test.
- Repeat the network test.
- Do all other modules pass the network test?
Yes
INSTALL the removed fuses. Go To Pinpoint Test P. See: Pinpoint Test P: The Driver Seat Module
(DSM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
No
INSTALL the removed fuses. GO to U10.
------------------------------------------------- U10 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - LTM
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3024
- Inspect the vehicle for a Liftgate/Trunk Module (LTM).
- Is the vehicle equipped with a LTM?
Yes
GO to U11.
No
GO to U12.
------------------------------------------------- U11 CHECK FOR RESTORED NETWORK
COMMUNICATION WITH THE LTM DISABLED
- Disconnect: BJB Fuse 36 (30A) and SJB Fuse 14 (10A).
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Network Test.
- Repeat the network test.
Do all other modules pass the network test?
Yes
INSTALL the removed fuses. Go To Pinpoint Test J. See: Pinpoint Test J: The Liftgate/Trunk
Module (LTM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
No
INSTALL the removed fuses. GO to U12.
------------------------------------------------- U12 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - AUDIO RCU, RETM
AND SDARS MODULE
- Inspect the vehicle for an audio Rear Control Unit (RCU) , a Rear Entertainment Module (RETM)
and/or Satellite Digital Audio Receiver System (SDARS) module.
- Is the vehicle equipped with any of the following: an audio RCU, an RETM, and/or a SDARS
module?
Yes
GO to U13.
No
GO to U16.
------------------------------------------------- U13 CHECK FOR RESTORED NETWORK
COMMUNICATION WITH THE AUDIO RCU, RETM AND SDARS MODULE DISABLED
- Disconnect: SJB Fuse 3 (15A).
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Network Test.
- Repeat the network test.
- Do all other modules pass the network test?
Yes
INSTALL the removed fuse. GO to U14.
No
INSTALL the removed fuse. GO to U16.
------------------------------------------------- U14 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - SDARS MODULE
- Inspect the vehicle for a SDARS module.
- Is the vehicle equipped with a SDARS module?
Yes
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3025
GO to U15.
No
For RETM equipped vehicles, Go To Pinpoint Test O. See: Pinpoint Test O: The Rear
Entertainment Module (RETM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
For audio RCU equipped vehicles, Go To Pinpoint Test N. See: Pinpoint Test N: The Audio Rear
Control Unit (RCU) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
------------------------------------------------- U15 CHECK FOR RESTORED NETWORK
COMMUNICATION
- Disconnect: SDARS Module C3290.
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Network Test.
- Repeat the network test.
- Do all other modules pass the network test?
Yes
Go To Pinpoint Test M. See: Pinpoint Test M: The Satellite Digital Audio Receiver System
(SDARS) Module Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
No
For RETM equipped vehicles, Go To Pinpoint Test O. See: Pinpoint Test O: The Rear
Entertainment Module (RETM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
For audio RCU equipped vehicles, Go To Pinpoint Test N. See: Pinpoint Test N: The Audio Rear
Control Unit (RCU) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
------------------------------------------------- U16 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - AUDIO DSP
MODULE
- Inspect the vehicle for an audio Digital Signal Processing (DSP) module.
- Is the vehicle equipped with an audio DSP module?
Yes
GO to U17.
No
GO to U18.
------------------------------------------------- U17 CHECK FOR RESTORED NETWORK
COMMUNICATION WITH THE AUDIO DSP MODULE DISABLED
- Disconnect: SJB Fuse 38 (20A) and 40 (20A).
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Network Test.
- Repeat the network test.
- Do all other modules pass the network test?
Yes
INSTALL the removed fuses. Go To Pinpoint Test L. See: Pinpoint Test L: The Audio Digital Signal
Processing (DSP) Module Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
No
INSTALL the removed fuses. GO to U18.
------------------------------------------------- U18 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - DCSM
- Inspect the vehicle for a Dual Climate Controlled Seat Module (DCSM).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3026
- Is the vehicle equipped with a DCSM?
Yes
GO to U19.
No
GO to U20.
------------------------------------------------- U19 CHECK FOR RESTORED NETWORK
COMMUNICATION WITH THE DCSM DISABLED
- Disconnect: BJB Fuse 67 (40A).
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Network Test.
- Repeat the network test.
- Do all other modules pass the network test?
Yes
INSTALL the removed fuse. Go To Pinpoint Test Q. See: Pinpoint Test Q: The Dual Climate
Controlled Seat Module (DCSM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
No
INSTALL the removed fuse. GO to U20.
------------------------------------------------- U20 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - PRB MODULE
- Inspect the vehicle for a Power Running Board (PRB) module.
- Is the vehicle equipped with a PRB module?
Yes
GO to U21.
No
GO to U22.
------------------------------------------------- U21 CHECK FOR RESTORED NETWORK
COMMUNICATION WITH THE PRB MODULE DISABLED
- Disconnect: BJB Fuse 11 (40A).
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Network Test.
- Repeat the network test.
- Do all other modules pass the network test?
Yes
INSTALL the removed fuse. Go To Pinpoint Test R. See: Pinpoint Test R: The Power Running
Board (PRB) Module Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
No
INSTALL the removed fuse. GO to U22.
------------------------------------------------- U22 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - PAM
- Inspect the vehicle for a Parking Aid Module (PAM).
- Is the vehicle equipped with a PAM?
Yes
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3027
GO to U23.
No
GO to U24.
------------------------------------------------- U23 CHECK FOR RESTORED NETWORK
COMMUNICATION WITH THE PAM DISABLED
- Disconnect: SJB Fuse 35 (10A).
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Network Test.
- Repeat the network test.
- Do all other modules pass the network test?
Yes
INSTALL the removed fuse. Go To Pinpoint Test S. See: Pinpoint Test S: The Parking Aid Module
(PAM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
No
INSTALL the removed fuse. GO to U24.
------------------------------------------------- U24 CHECK FOR RESTORED NETWORK
COMMUNICATION WITH THE APIM DISABLED
- Disconnect: APIM C3342.
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Network Test.
- Repeat the network test.
- Do all other modules pass the network test?
Yes
CONNECT the APIM. Go To Pinpoint Test T. See: Pinpoint Test T: The Accessory Protocol
Interface Module (APIM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
No
CONNECT the APIM. GO to U25.
------------------------------------------------- U25 CHECK FOR RESTORED NETWORK
COMMUNICATION WITH THE IC DISABLED
- Disconnect: SJB Fuse 26 (10A) and 29 (5A).
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Network Test.
- Repeat the network test.
- Do all other modules pass the network test?
Yes
INSTALL the removed fuses. Go To Pinpoint Test C. See: Pinpoint Test C: The Instrument Cluster
(IC) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
No
INSTALL the removed fuses. An intermittent fault is not present. Go To Pinpoint Test V. See:
Pinpoint Test V: No Medium Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN) Communication, All
Modules Are Not Responding
------------------------------------------------V1-V24
Communications Network
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test V: No Medium Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN) Communication, All
Modules Are Not Responding
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3028
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 14, Module Communications Network for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The Medium Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN) uses an unshielded twisted pair cable,
circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) and VDB07 (VT/OG) provide the network connection to all modules on the
network.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Audio Control Module (ACM)
- Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
- Audio Digital Signal Processing (DSP) module (if equipped)
- Audio Rear Control Unit (RCU) (if equipped)
- Dual Climate Controlled Seat Module (DCSM) (if equipped)
- Driver Seat Module (DSM) (if equipped)
- HVAC module (if equipped)
- Instrument Cluster (IC)
- Liftgate/Trunk Module (LTM) (if equipped)
- Parking Aid Module (PAM) (if equipped)
- Power Running Board (PRB) module (if equipped)
- Rear Entertainment Module (RETM) (if equipped)
- Satellite Digital Audio Receiver System (SDARS) module (if equipped)
- Smart Junction Box (SJB)
- Data Link Connector (DLC)
PINPOINT TEST V: NO MS-CAN COMMUNICATION, ALL MODULES ARE NOT RESPONDING
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- V1 CHECK THE DLC PINS FOR DAMAGE
NOTE: Most faults are due to connector and/or wiring concerns. Carry out a thorough inspection
and verification before proceeding with the Pinpoint Test. See: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic
Overview/Communications Network/Inspection And Verification
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect the scan tool cable from the Data Link Connector (DLC).
- Inspect DLC pins 3 and 11 for damage.
- Are DLC pins 3 and 11 OK?
Yes
GO to V2.
No
REPAIR the DLC as necessary. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- V2 CHECK THE MS-CAN TERMINATION RESISTANCE
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and the
DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3029
side.
- Is the resistance between 54 and 66 ohms?
Yes
GO to V5.
No
GO to V3.
------------------------------------------------- V3 CHECK THE MS-CAN TERMINATION RESISTOR
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and the
DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
- Is the resistance between 108 and 132 ohms?
Yes
GO to V7.
No
GO to V4.
------------------------------------------------- V4 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TOGETHER
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and the
DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to V8.
No
GO to V7.
------------------------------------------------- V5 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-11, circuit
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3030
VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side and ground.
- Are the resistances greater than 1,000 ohms?
Yes
GO to V6.
No
GO to V33.
------------------------------------------------- V6 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE
- Connect the negative battery cable.
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and ground;
and between the DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 6 volts?
Yes
REPAIR the circuit. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
VERIFY all module fuses are OK. If OK, REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- V7 CHECK THE MS-CAN CIRCUITS BETWEEN THE SJB
AND THE DLC FOR AN OPEN
- Disconnect: SJB C2280b.
- Measure the resistance between the SJB C2280b-37, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and
the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side.
- Measure the resistance between the SJB C2280b-38, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side and
the DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3031
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
VERIFY all module fuses are OK. If OK, CONNECT the SJB. CONNECT the negative battery
cable. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT the SJB. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR
the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- V8 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TOGETHER WITH THE SJB DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: SJB C2280b.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and the
DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to V9.
No
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to V58.
------------------------------------------------- V9 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TOGETHER WITH THE IC DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: IC C220.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and the
DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to V10.
No
CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to V59.
-------------------------------------------------
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3032
V10 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS FOR A SHORT TOGETHER WITH
THE ACM DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: ACM C240a.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and the
DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to V11.
No
CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to V60.
------------------------------------------------- V11 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - AUDIO DSP
MODULE
- Inspect the vehicle for an audio Digital Signal Processing (DSP) module.
Is the vehicle equipped with an audio DSP module?
Yes
GO to V12.
No
GO to V13.
------------------------------------------------- V12 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TOGETHER WITH THE AUDIO DSP MODULE DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: Audio DSP Module C2364c.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and the
DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to V13.
No
CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to V61.
------------------------------------------------- V13 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - HVAC MODULE
- Inspect the vehicle for an HVAC module.
- Is the vehicle equipped with an HVAC module?
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3033
Yes
GO to V14.
No
GO to V15.
------------------------------------------------- V14 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TOGETHER WITH THE HVAC MODULE DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: HVAC Module C228a (EATC) or C2357a (EMTC).
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and the
DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to V17.
No
CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to V62.
------------------------------------------------- V15 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - APIM
- Inspect the vehicle for an APIM.
- Is the vehicle equipped with an APIM?
Yes
GO to V16.
No
GO to V17.
------------------------------------------------- V16 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TOGETHER WITH THE APIM DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: APIM C3342.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and the
DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to V17.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3034
No
CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to V63.
------------------------------------------------- V17 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - AUDIO RCU
- Inspect the vehicle for an audio Rear Control Unit (RCU).
- Is the vehicle equipped with an audio RCU?
Yes
GO to V18.
No
GO to V19.
------------------------------------------------- V18 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TOGETHER WITH THE AUDIO RCU DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: Audio RCU C3077.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and the
DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to V19.
No
CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to V64.
------------------------------------------------- V19 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - RETM
- Inspect the vehicle for a Rear Entertainment Module (RETM).
- Is the vehicle equipped with an RETM?
Yes
GO to V20.
No
GO to V21.
------------------------------------------------- V20 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TOGETHER WITH THE RETM DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: RETM C949.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and the
DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3035
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to V21.
No
CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to V65.
------------------------------------------------- V21 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - DSM
- Inspect the vehicle for a Driver Seat Module (DSM).
- Is the vehicle equipped with a DSM?
Yes
GO to V22.
No
GO to V23.
------------------------------------------------- V22 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TOGETHER WITH THE DSM DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: Driver Seat Module C341d.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and the
DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to V23.
No
CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to V66.
------------------------------------------------- V23 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - DCSM
- Inspect the vehicle for a Dual Climate Controlled Seat Module (DCSM).
- Is the vehicle equipped with a DCSM?
Yes
GO to V24.
No
GO to V25.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3036
------------------------------------------------- V24 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TOGETHER WITH THE DCSM DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: DCSM C3265c.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and the
DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to V25.
No
CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to V67.
------------------------------------------------V25-V48
Communications Network
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test V: No Medium Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN) Communication, All
Modules Are Not Responding
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 14, Module Communications Network for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The Medium Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN) uses an unshielded twisted pair cable,
circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) and VDB07 (VT/OG) provide the network connection to all modules on the
network.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Audio Control Module (ACM)
- Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
- Audio Digital Signal Processing (DSP) module (if equipped)
- Audio Rear Control Unit (RCU) (if equipped)
- Dual Climate Controlled Seat Module (DCSM) (if equipped)
- Driver Seat Module (DSM) (if equipped)
- HVAC module (if equipped)
- Instrument Cluster (IC)
- Liftgate/Trunk Module (LTM) (if equipped)
- Parking Aid Module (PAM) (if equipped)
- Power Running Board (PRB) module (if equipped)
- Rear Entertainment Module (RETM) (if equipped)
- Satellite Digital Audio Receiver System (SDARS) module (if equipped)
- Smart Junction Box (SJB)
- Data Link Connector (DLC)
PINPOINT TEST V: NO MS-CAN COMMUNICATION, ALL MODULES ARE NOT RESPONDING
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3037
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- V25 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - SDARS MODULE
- Inspect the vehicle for a Satellite Digital Audio Receiver System (SDARS) module.
- Is the vehicle equipped with a SDARS module?
Yes
GO to V26.
No
GO to V27.
------------------------------------------------- V26 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TOGETHER WITH THE SDARS MODULE DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: SDARS Module C3290.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and the
DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to V27.
No
CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to V68.
------------------------------------------------- V27 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - PRB MODULE
- Inspect the vehicle for a Power Running Board (PRB) module.
- Is the vehicle equipped with a PRB module?
Yes
GO to V28.
No
GO to V29.
------------------------------------------------- V28 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TOGETHER WITH THE PRB MODULE DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: PRB Module C3313b.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and the
DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3038
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to V29.
No
CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to V69.
------------------------------------------------- V29 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - PAM
- Inspect the vehicle for a Parking Aid Module (PAM).
- Is the vehicle equipped with a PAM?
Yes
GO to V30.
No
GO to V31.
------------------------------------------------- V30 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TOGETHER WITH THE PAM DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: PAM C4226 (Expedition) or C4014a (Navigator).
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and the
DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to V31.
No
CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to V70.
------------------------------------------------- V31 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - LTM
- Inspect the vehicle for a Liftgate/Trunk Module (LTM).
- Is the vehicle equipped with an LTM?
Yes
GO to V32.
No
REPAIR the circuits. CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the
DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3039
------------------------------------------------- V32 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TOGETHER WITH THE LTM DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: LTM C4174b.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and the
DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
REPAIR the circuits. CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the
DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to V71.
------------------------------------------------- V33 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO GROUND WITH THE SJB DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: SJB C2280b.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side and ground.
- Are the resistances greater than 1,000 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to V58.
No
GO to V34.
------------------------------------------------- V34 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO GROUND WITH THE IC DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: IC C220.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side and ground.
- Are the resistances greater than 1,000 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to V59.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3040
No
GO to V35.
------------------------------------------------- V35 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO GROUND WITH THE ACM DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: ACM C240b.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side and ground.
- Are the resistances greater than 1,000 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to V60.
No
GO to V36.
------------------------------------------------- V36 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - AUDIO DSP
MODULE
- Inspect the vehicle for an audio DSP module.
- Is the vehicle equipped with an audio DSP module?
Yes
GO to V37.
No
GO to V38.
------------------------------------------------- V37 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO GROUND WITH THE AUDIO DSP MODULE DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: Audio DSP Module C2364c.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side and ground.
- Are the resistances greater than 1,000 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to V61.
No
GO to V38.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3041
------------------------------------------------- V38 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - HVAC MODULE
- Inspect the vehicle for an HVAC module.
Is the vehicle equipped with an HVAC module?
Yes
GO to V39.
No
GO to V40.
------------------------------------------------- V39 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO GROUND WITH THE HVAC MODULE DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: HVAC Module C228a (EATC) or C2357a (EMTC).
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side and ground.
- Are the resistances greater than 1,000 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to V62.
No
GO to V42.
------------------------------------------------- V40 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - APIM
- Inspect the vehicle for an Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM).
- Is the vehicle equipped with an APIM?
Yes
GO to V41.
No
GO to V42.
------------------------------------------------- V41 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO GROUND WITH THE APIM DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: APIM C3342.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side and ground.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3042
- Are the resistances greater than 1,000 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to V63.
No
GO to V42.
------------------------------------------------- V42 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - AUDIO RCU
- Inspect the vehicle for an audio Rear Control Unit (RCU).
- Is the vehicle equipped with an audio RCU?
Yes
GO to V43.
No
GO to V44.
------------------------------------------------- V43 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO GROUND WITH THE AUDIO RCU DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: Audio RCU C3077.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side and ground.
- Are the resistances greater than 1,000 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to V64.
No
GO to V44.
------------------------------------------------- V44 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - RETM
- Inspect the vehicle for a Rear Entertainment Module (RETM).
- Is the vehicle equipped with an RETM?
Yes
GO to V45.
No
GO to V46.
------------------------------------------------- V45 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO GROUND WITH THE RETM DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: RETM C949.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-11, circuit
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3043
VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side and ground.
- Are the resistances greater than 1,000 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to V65.
No
GO to V46.
------------------------------------------------- V46 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - DSM
- Inspect the vehicle for a Driver Seat Module (DSM).
Is the vehicle equipped with a DSM?
Yes
GO to V47.
No
GO to V48.
------------------------------------------------- V47 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO GROUND WITH THE DSM DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: DSM C341d.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side and ground.
- Are the resistances greater than 1,000 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to V66.
No
GO to V48.
------------------------------------------------- V48 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - DCSM
- Inspect the vehicle for a Dual Climate Controlled Seat Module (DCSM).
- Is the vehicle equipped with a DCSM?
Yes
GO to V49.
No
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3044
GO to V50.
------------------------------------------------V49-V71
Communications Network
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test V: No Medium Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN) Communication, All
Modules Are Not Responding
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 14, Module Communications Network for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The Medium Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN) uses an unshielded twisted pair cable,
circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) and VDB07 (VT/OG) provide the network connection to all modules on the
network.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Audio Control Module (ACM)
- Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
- Audio Digital Signal Processing (DSP) module (if equipped)
- Audio Rear Control Unit (RCU) (if equipped)
- Dual Climate Controlled Seat Module (DCSM) (if equipped)
- Driver Seat Module (DSM) (if equipped)
- HVAC module (if equipped)
- Instrument Cluster (IC)
- Liftgate/Trunk Module (LTM) (if equipped)
- Parking Aid Module (PAM) (if equipped)
- Power Running Board (PRB) module (if equipped)
- Rear Entertainment Module (RETM) (if equipped)
- Satellite Digital Audio Receiver System (SDARS) module (if equipped)
- Smart Junction Box (SJB)
- Data Link Connector (DLC)
PINPOINT TEST V: NO MS-CAN COMMUNICATION, ALL MODULES ARE NOT RESPONDING
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- V49 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO GROUND WITH THE DCSM DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: DCSM C3265c.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side and ground.
- Are the resistances greater than 1,000 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to V67.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3045
No
GO to V50.
------------------------------------------------- V50 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - SDARS MODULE
- Inspect the vehicle for a Satellite Digital Audio Receiver System (SDARS) module.
- Is the vehicle equipped with a SDARS module?
Yes
GO to V51.
No
GO to V52.
------------------------------------------------- V51 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO GROUND WITH THE SDARS MODULE DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: SDARS Module C3290.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side and ground.
- Are the resistances greater than 1,000 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to V68.
No
GO to V52.
------------------------------------------------- V52 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - PRB MODULE
- Inspect the vehicle for a PRB module.
- Is the vehicle equipped with a PRB module?
Yes
GO to V53.
No
GO to V54.
------------------------------------------------- V53 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO GROUND WITH THE PRB MODULE DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: PRB Module C3313b.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side and ground.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3046
- Are the resistances greater than 1,000 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to V69.
No
GO to V54.
------------------------------------------------- V54 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - PAM
- Inspect the vehicle for a PAM.
- Is the vehicle equipped with a PAM?
Yes
GO to V55.
No
GO to V56.
------------------------------------------------- V55 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO GROUND WITH THE PAM DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: PAM C4226 (Expedition) or C4014a (Navigator).
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side and ground.
- Are the resistances greater than 1,000 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to V70.
No
GO to V56.
------------------------------------------------- V56 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - LTM
- Inspect the vehicle for an LTM.
- Is the vehicle equipped with an LTM?
Yes
GO to V57.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable.
CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3047
scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- V57 CHECK THE MS-CAN (+) AND MS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO GROUND WITH THE LTM DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: LTM C4174b.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-3, circuit VDB06 (GY/OG), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-11, circuit VDB07 (VT/OG), harness side and ground.
- Are the resistances greater than 1,000 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to V71.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable.
CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- V58 CHECK FOR CORRECT SJB OPERATION
- Disconnect all the SJB connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the SJB connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new SJB. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- V59 CHECK FOR CORRECT IC OPERATION
- Disconnect the IC connector.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect the IC connector and make sure it seats correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new IC. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3048
network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- V60 CHECK FOR CORRECT ACM OPERATION
- Disconnect all the ACM connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the ACM connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new ACM. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- V61 CHECK FOR CORRECT AUDIO DSP MODULE
OPERATION
- Disconnect all the audio DSP module connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the audio DSP module connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new audio DSP module. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan
tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- V62 CHECK FOR CORRECT HVAC MODULE OPERATION
- Disconnect all the HVAC module connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the HVAC module connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new HVAC module. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
-------------------------------------------------
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3049
V63 CHECK FOR CORRECT APIM OPERATION
- Disconnect the APIM connector.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect the APIM connector and make sure it seats correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new APIM. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- V64 CHECK FOR CORRECT AUDIO RCU OPERATION
- Disconnect the audio RCU connector.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect the audio RCU connector and make sure it seats correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new audio RCU. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool. TEST
the system for normal operation.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- V65 CHECK FOR CORRECT RETM OPERATION
- Disconnect the RETM connector.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect the RETM connector and make sure it seats correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new RETM. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool. TEST the
system for normal operation.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- V66 CHECK FOR CORRECT DSM OPERATION
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3050
- Disconnect all the DSM connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the DSM connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new DSM. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- V67 CHECK FOR CORRECT DCSM OPERATION
- Disconnect all the DCSM connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the DCSM connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new DCSM. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- V68 CHECK FOR CORRECT SDARS MODULE
OPERATION
- Disconnect the SDARS module connector.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect the SDARS module connector and make sure it seats correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new SDARS module. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- V69 CHECK FOR CORRECT PRB MODULE OPERATION
- Disconnect all the PRB module connectors.
- Check for:
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3051
- corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the PRB module connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new PRB module. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- V70 CHECK FOR CORRECT PAM OPERATION
- Disconnect all the PAM connector(s).
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the PAM connector(s) and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new PAM. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- V71 CHECK FOR CORRECT LTM OPERATION
- Disconnect all the LTM connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the LTM connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new LTM. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test W: Intermittent No High Speed Controller Area Network (HS-CAN) Communication,
One Or More Modules Are Not Respond
Communications Network
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3052
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test W: Intermittent No High Speed Controller Area Network (HS-CAN) Communication,
One Or More Modules Are Not Responding During Network Test
Normal Operation
The High Speed Controller Area Network (HS-CAN) uses an unshielded twisted pair cable, circuits
VDB04 (WH/BU) and VDB05 (WH). The PCM, the Transmission Control Module (TCM), the ABS
module, the Restraints Control Module (RCM), the 4X4 control module (if equipped), the Vehicle
Dynamics Module (VDM) (if equipped) and the Instrument Cluster (IC) all communicate with the
scan tool using the HS-CAN.
In the event that one of the 2 network circuits (HS-CAN + or HS-CAN -) becomes open to a module
on the network, unreliable network communication to all modules on the network may result.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Data Link Connector (DLC)
PINPOINT TEST W: INTERMITTENT NO HS-CAN COMMUNICATION, ONE OR MORE
MODULES ARE NOT RESPONDING DURING NETWORK TEST
NOTE: Most faults are due to connector and/or wiring concerns. Carry out a thorough inspection
and verification before proceeding with the Pinpoint Test. See: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic
Overview/Communications Network/Inspection And Verification
NOTE: Various network DTCs will set while disabling modules in this test procedure which will
need to be cleared after the diagnostic procedure is completed.
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- W1 CHECK THE DLC PINS FOR DAMAGE
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect the scan tool cable from the Data Link Connector (DLC).
- Inspect DLC pins 6 and 14 for damage.
- Are DLC pins 6 and 14 OK?
Yes
GO to W2.
No
REPAIR the DLC as necessary. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- W2 CHECK THE HS-CAN TERMINATION RESISTANCE
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and the
DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3053
- Is the resistance between 54 and 66 ohms?
Yes
GO to W3.
No
CONNECT the negative battery cable. Go To Pinpoint Test X. See: Pinpoint Test X: No High
Speed Controller Area Network (HS-CAN) Communication, All Modules Are Not Responding
------------------------------------------------- W3 CHECK THE HS-CAN (+) AND HS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side and ground.
- Are the resistances greater than 1,000 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to W4.
No
CONNECT the negative battery cable. Go To Pinpoint Test X. See: Pinpoint Test X: No High
Speed Controller Area Network (HS-CAN) Communication, All Modules Are Not Responding
------------------------------------------------- W4 CHECK THE HS-CAN (+) AND HS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 6 volts?
Yes
REPAIR the circuit. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
GO to W5.
------------------------------------------------- W5 CHECK FOR RESTORED COMMUNICATION WITH
THE PCM DISABLED
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3054
- Disconnect: Battery Junction Box (BJB) Fuses 35 (40A) and 75 (15A).
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Network Test.
- Repeat the network test.
- Do all other modules pass the network test?
Yes
INSTALL the removed fuses. Go To Pinpoint Test A. See: Pinpoint Test A: The PCM Does Not
Respond To The Scan Tool
No
INSTALL the removed fuses. GO to W6.
------------------------------------------------- W6 CHECK FOR RESTORED NETWORK
COMMUNICATION WITH THE ABS MODULE DISABLED
- Disconnect: BJB Fuses 52 (10A), 68 (60A) and 69 (60A).
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Network Test.
- Repeat the network test.
- Do all other modules pass the network test?
Yes
INSTALL the removed fuses. Go To Pinpoint Test B. See: Pinpoint Test B: The ABS Module Does
Not Respond To The Scan Tool
No
INSTALL the removed fuses. GO to W7.
------------------------------------------------- W7 CHECK FOR RESTORED NETWORK
COMMUNICATION WITH THE TCM DISABLED
- Disconnect: BJB Fuse 26 (15A) and 54 (5A).
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Network Test.
- Repeat the network test.
- Do all other modules pass the network test?
Yes
INSTALL the removed fuses. Go To Pinpoint Test G. See: Pinpoint Test G: The Transmission
Control Module (TCM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
No
INSTALL the removed fuses. GO to W8.
------------------------------------------------- W8 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - 4X4 CONTROL
MODULE
- Inspect the vehicle for a 4X4 control module.
- Is the vehicle equipped with a 4X4 control module?
Yes
GO to W9.
No
GO to W10.
------------------------------------------------- W9 CHECK FOR RESTORED NETWORK
COMMUNICATION WITH THE 4X4 CONTROL MODULE DISABLED
- Disconnect: BJB Fuse 20 (20A) and 27 (20A).
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Network Test.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3055
- Repeat the network test.
- Do all other modules pass the network test?
Yes
INSTALL the removed fuses. Go To Pinpoint Test E. See: Pinpoint Test E: The 4X4 Control
Module Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
No
INSTALL the removed fuses. GO to W10.
------------------------------------------------- W10 CHECK FOR RESTORED NETWORK
COMMUNICATION WITH THE IC DISABLED
- Disconnect: Smart Junction Box (SJB) Fuse 26 (10A) and 29 (5A).
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Network Test.
- Repeat the network test.
- Do all other modules pass the network test?
Yes
INSTALL the removed fuses. Go To Pinpoint Test C. See: Pinpoint Test C: The Instrument Cluster
(IC) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
No
INSTALL the removed fuses. GO to W11.
------------------------------------------------- W11 VERIFY VEHICLE EQUIPMENT - VDM
- Inspect the vehicle for a VDM.
- Is the vehicle equipped with a VDM?
Yes
GO to W12.
No
GO to W13.
------------------------------------------------- W12 CHECK FOR RESTORED NETWORK
COMMUNICATION WITH THE VDM DISABLED
- Disconnect: BJB Fuse 53 (10A) and 48 (30A).
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Network Test.
- Repeat the network test.
- Do all other modules pass the network test?
Yes
INSTALL the removed fuses. Go To Pinpoint Test F. See: Pinpoint Test F: The Vehicle Dynamics
Module (VDM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
No
INSTALL the removed fuses. GO to W13.
------------------------------------------------- W13 CHECK FOR RESTORED NETWORK
COMMUNICATION WITH THE RCM DISABLED
- Disconnect: SJB Fuse 32 (10A).
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Network Test.
- Repeat the network test.
- Do all other modules pass the network test?
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3056
Yes
INSTALL the removed fuse. Go To Pinpoint Test D. See: Pinpoint Test D: The Restraints Control
Module (RCM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
No
If the vehicle is equipped with an Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM), INSTALL the
removed fuses. GO to W14.
If the vehicle is not equipped with an APIM, INSTALL the removed fuse. An intermittent fault is not
present. Go To Pinpoint Test X. See: Pinpoint Test X: No High Speed Controller Area Network
(HS-CAN) Communication, All Modules Are Not Responding
------------------------------------------------- W14 CHECK FOR RESTORED NETWORK
COMMUNICATION WITH THE APIM DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: APIM C3342.
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Network Test.
- Repeat the network test.
- Do all other modules pass the network test?
Yes
INSTALL the removed fuses. Go To Pinpoint Test T. See: Pinpoint Test T: The Accessory Protocol
Interface Module (APIM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
No
INSTALL the removed fuse. An intermittent fault is not present. Go To Pinpoint Test X. See:
Pinpoint Test X: No High Speed Controller Area Network (HS-CAN) Communication, All Modules
Are Not Responding
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test X: No High Speed Controller Area Network (HS-CAN) Communication, All Modules
Are Not Responding
Communications Network
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test X: No High Speed Controller Area Network (HS-CAN) Communication, All Modules
Are Not Responding
Normal Operation
The High Speed Controller Area Network (HS-CAN) uses an unshielded twisted pair cable. Circuits
VDB04 (WH/BU) and VDB05 (WH) provide the network connection to all modules on the HS-CAN.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Data Link Connector (DLC)
- 4X4 control module (if equipped)
- ABS module
- Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
- Instrument Cluster (IC)
- PCM
- Restraints Control Module (RCM)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
- Vehicle Dynamics Module (VDM) (if equipped)
PINPOINT TEST X: NO HS-CAN COMMUNICATION, ALL MODULES ARE NOT RESPONDING
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Most faults are due to connector and/or wiring concerns. Carry out a thorough inspection
and verification before proceeding with the pinpoint
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3057
test. See: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview/Communications Network/Inspection And
Verification
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- X1 CHECK THE DLC PINS FOR DAMAGE
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect the scan tool cable from the Data Link Connector (DLC).
- Inspect DLC pins 6 and 14 for damage.
- Are DLC pins 6 and 14 OK?
Yes
GO to X2.
No
REPAIR the DLC as necessary. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- X2 CHECK THE HS-CAN TERMINATION RESISTANCE
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and the
DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side.
- Is the resistance between 54 and 66 ohms?
Yes
GO to X3.
No
GO to X5.
------------------------------------------------- X3 CHECK THE HS-CAN (+) AND HS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side and ground.
- Are the resistances greater than 1,000 ohms?
Yes
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3058
GO to X4.
No
GO to X19.
------------------------------------------------- X4 CHECK THE HS-CAN (+) AND HS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE
- Connect: Negative Battery Cable.
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 6 volts?
Yes
REPAIR the circuit. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
The CAN has tested within specifications. VERIFY the scan tool operation on a substitute vehicle,
and REPEAT the network test on the suspect vehicle.
------------------------------------------------- X5 CHECK THE HS-CAN TERMINATION RESISTOR
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and the
DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side.
- Is the resistance between 108 and 132 ohms?
Yes
GO to X6.
No
GO to X9.
------------------------------------------------- X6 CHECK THE HS-CAN TERMINATION RESISTOR WITH
THE PCM DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: PCM C175b.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and the
DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3059
- Is the resistance between 108 and 132 ohms?
Yes
GO to X7.
No
GO to X8.
------------------------------------------------- X7 CHECK THE HS-CAN CIRCUITS BETWEEN THE PCM
AND THE DLC FOR AN OPEN
- Measure the resistance between the PCM C175b-59, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and
the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side.
- Measure the resistance between the PCM C175b-43, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side and the
DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side.
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to X27.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT
the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- X8 CHECK THE HS-CAN CIRCUITS BETWEEN THE IC
AND THE DLC FOR AN OPEN
- Measure the resistance between the IC C220-7, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and the
Data Link Connector (DLC) C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side.
- Measure the resistance between the IC C220-8, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side and the DLC
C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3060
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to X33.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT
the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- X9 CHECK THE HS-CAN (+) AND HS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TOGETHER
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and the
DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to X11.
No
GO to X10.
------------------------------------------------- X10 CHECK THE HS-CAN CIRCUITS BETWEEN THE PCM
AND THE DLC FOR AN OPEN
- Disconnect: PCM C175b.
- Measure the resistance between the PCM C175b-59, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and
the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side.
- Measure the resistance between the PCM C175b-43, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side and the
DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3061
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
The Controller Area Network (CAN) has tested within specifications. CONNECT the negative
battery cable. VERIFY the scan tool operation on a substitute vehicle, and REPEAT the network
test on the suspect vehicle.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT
the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- X11 CHECK THE HS-CAN (+) AND HS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TOGETHER WITH THE PCM DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: PCM C175b.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and the
DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
If the vehicle is equipped with a Vehicle Dynamics Module (VDM), GO to X12.
If the vehicle is not equipped with a VDM, GO to X13.
No
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to X27.
------------------------------------------------- X12 CHECK THE HS-CAN (+) AND HS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TOGETHER WITH THE VDM DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: VDM C2131a.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and the
DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to X13.
No
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3062
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to X28.
------------------------------------------------- X13 CHECK THE HS-CAN (+) AND HS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TOGETHER WITH THE ABS MODULE DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: ABS Module C135.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and the
DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
If the vehicle is equipped with a 4X4 control module, GO to X14.
If the vehicle is not equipped with a 4X4 control module, GO to X15.
No
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to X29.
------------------------------------------------- X14 CHECK THE HS-CAN (+) AND HS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TOGETHER WITH THE 4X4 CONTROL MODULE DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: 4X4 Control Module C281a.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and the
DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to X15.
No
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to X30.
------------------------------------------------- X15 CHECK THE HS-CAN (+) AND HS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TOGETHER WITH THE RCM DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: RCM C310b.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and the
DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side.
Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3063
Yes
If the vehicle is equipped with an Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM), GO to X16.
If the vehicle is not equipped with an APIM, GO to X17.
No
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to X31.
------------------------------------------------- X16 CHECK THE HS-CAN (+) AND HS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TOGETHER WITH THE APIM DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: APIM C3342.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and the
DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to X17.
No
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to X32.
------------------------------------------------- X17 CHECK THE HS-CAN (+) AND HS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TOGETHER WITH THE IC DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: IC C220.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and the
DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
If the vehicle is equipped with a Transmission Control Module (TCM), GO to X18.
If the vehicle is not equipped with a TCM, REPAIR the circuit. CONNECT all modules. CONNECT
the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to X33.
------------------------------------------------- X18 CHECK THE HS-CAN (+) AND HS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TOGETHER WITH THE TCM DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: TCM C1548.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and the
DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3064
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
REPAIR the circuit. CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the
DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
No
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to X34.
------------------------------------------------- X19 CHECK THE HS-CAN (+) AND HS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO GROUND WITH THE PCM DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: PCM C175b.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side and ground.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to X27.
No
If the vehicle is equipped with a Vehicle Dynamics Module (VDM), GO to X20.
If the vehicle is not equipped with a VDM, GO to X21.
------------------------------------------------- X20 CHECK THE HS-CAN (+) AND HS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO GROUND WITH THE VDM DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: VDM C2131a.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side and ground.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to X28.
No
GO to X21.
-------------------------------------------------
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3065
X21 CHECK THE HS-CAN (+) AND HS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS FOR A SHORT TO GROUND WITH
THE ABS MODULE DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: ABS Module C135.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side and ground.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to X29.
No
If the vehicle is equipped with a 4X4 control module, GO to X22.
If the vehicle is not equipped with a 4X4 control module, GO to X23.
------------------------------------------------- X22 CHECK THE HS-CAN (+) AND HS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO GROUND WITH THE 4X4 CONTROL MODULE DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: 4X4 Control Module C281a.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side and ground.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to X30.
No
GO to X23.
------------------------------------------------- X23 CHECK THE HS-CAN (+) AND HS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO GROUND WITH THE RCM DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: RCM C310b.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side and ground.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to X31.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3066
No
If the vehicle is equipped with an Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM), GO to X24.
If the vehicle is not equipped with an APIM, GO to X25.
------------------------------------------------- X24 CHECK THE HS-CAN (+) AND HS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO GROUND WITH THE APIM DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: APIM C3342.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side and ground.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to X32.
No
GO to X25.
------------------------------------------------- X25 CHECK THE HS-CAN (+) AND HS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO GROUND WITH THE IC DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: IC C220.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side and ground.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to X33.
No
If the vehicle is equipped with a Transmission Control Module (TCM), GO to X26.
If the vehicle is not equipped with a TCM, REPAIR the circuit. CONNECT all modules. CONNECT
the negative battery cable. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- X26 CHECK THE HS-CAN (+) AND HS-CAN (-) CIRCUITS
FOR A SHORT TO GROUND WITH THE TCM DISCONNECTED
- Disconnect: TCM C1548.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-6, circuit VDB04 (WH/BU), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-14, circuit VDB05 (WH), harness side and ground.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3067
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to X34.
No
REPAIR the circuit. CONNECT all modules. CONNECT the negative battery cable. CLEAR the
DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- X27 CHECK FOR CORRECT PCM OPERATION
- Disconnect all the PCM connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the PCM connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new PCM. CONNECT all modules. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with
the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CONNECT all modules. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the
scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- X28 CHECK FOR CORRECT VDM OPERATION
- Disconnect all the VDM connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the VDM connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new VDM. CONNECT all modules. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with
the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CONNECT all modules. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the
scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- X29 CHECK FOR CORRECT ABS MODULE OPERATION
- Disconnect the ABS module connector.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3068
- Connect the ABS module connector and make sure it seats correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new ABS module. CONNECT all modules. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network
test with the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CONNECT all modules. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the
scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- X30 CHECK FOR CORRECT 4X4 CONTROL MODULE
OPERATION
- Disconnect all 4X4 control module connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all 4X4 control module connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new 4X4 control module. CONNECT all modules. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the
network test with the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CONNECT all modules. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the
scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- X31 CHECK FOR CORRECT RCM OPERATION
- Disconnect all the RCM connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the RCM connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new RCM. CONNECT all modules. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with
the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CONNECT all modules. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the
scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- X32 CHECK FOR CORRECT APIM OPERATION
- Disconnect the APIM connector.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect the APIM connector and make sure it seats correctly.
- Verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3069
Yes
INSTALL a new APIM. CONNECT all modules. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with
the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. CONNECT all modules. The concern may have been
caused by a loose or corroded connector. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- X33 CHECK FOR CORRECT IC OPERATION
- Disconnect the IC connector.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect the IC connector and make sure it seats correctly.
- Verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new IC. CONNECT all modules. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the
scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CONNECT all modules. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the
scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- X34 CHECK FOR CORRECT TCM OPERATION
- Disconnect the TCM connector.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect the TCM connector and make sure it seats correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new TCM. CONNECT all modules. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with
the scan tool.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CONNECT all modules. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the
scan tool.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test Y: No Power To The Scan Tool
Communications Network
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test Y: No Power To The Scan Tool
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 14, Module Communications Network for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3070
The scan tool is connected to the Data Link Connector (DLC) to communicate with the High Speed
Controller Area Network (HS-CAN) and the Medium Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN)
communications network. Voltage for the scan tool is provided by circuit SBP20 (GN/RD). Ground
is provided by circuits GD113 (BK/YE) and GD138 (BK/WH).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Data Link Connector (DLC)
- Scan tool
PINPOINT TEST Y: NO POWER TO THE SCAN TOOL
NOTE: Most faults are due to connector and/or wiring concerns. Carry out a thorough inspection
and verification before proceeding with the Pinpoint Test. See: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic
Overview/Communications Network/Inspection And Verification
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- Y1 CHECK THE DLC PINS FOR DAMAGE
- Disconnect the scan tool cable from the DLC.
- Inspect DLC pins 4, 5 and 16 for damage.
- Are DLC pins 4, 5 and 16 OK?
Yes
GO to Y2.
No
REPAIR the DLC as necessary. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- Y2 CHECK THE DLC VOLTAGE SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR AN
OPEN
- Measure the voltage between the DLC C251-16, circuit SBP20 (GN/RD), harness side and
ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to Y3.
No
VERIFY the Smart Junction Box (SJB) fuse 20 (15A) is OK. If OK, REPAIR the circuit. If not OK,
REFER to the Wiring Diagrams to identify the possible causes of the circuit short. REPEAT the
network test with the scan tool.
------------------------------------------------- Y3 CHECK THE DLC GROUND CIRCUITS FOR AN OPEN
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3071
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
- Measure the resistance between the DLC C251-4, circuit GD138 (BK/WH), harness side and
ground; and between the DLC C251-5, circuit GD113 (BK/YE), harness side and ground.
- Are the resistances less than 5 ohms?
Yes
REPAIR the scan tool. CONNECT the negative battery cable. REPEAT the network test with the
scan tool.
No
REPAIR the circuit in question. CONNECT the negative battery cable. REPEAT the network test
with the scan tool.
-------------------------------------------------
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3072
Information Bus: Programming and Relearning
Programmable Module Installation (PMI)
PROGRAMMABLE MODULE INSTALLATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) Using The Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) When The
Original Module Is Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure be
carried out. For instructions, refer to the specific module removal and installation procedures.
1. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle as normal. 2. From the Toolbox icon, select Module
Programming and press the check mark. 3. Select Programmable Module Installation. 4. Select the
module that is being replaced. 5. Follow the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the OFF
position, and press the check mark. 6. Install the new module and press the check mark. 7. Follow
the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the ON position, and press the check mark. 8.
The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration Complete. 9.
Test module for correct operation.
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) Using The Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) When The
Original Module Is Not Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure be
carried out. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal
and installation procedures.
1. Install the new module. 2. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle as normal. 3. From the
Toolbox icon, select Module Programming and press the check mark. 4. Select Programmable
Module Installation. 5. Select the module that was replaced. 6. Follow the on-screen instructions,
turn the ignition key to the OFF position, and press the check mark. 7. Follow the on-screen
instructions, turn the ignition key to the ON position, and press the check mark. 8. If the data is not
available, the IDS displays a screen stating to contact the As-Built Data Center. Retrieve the data
from the technician service
publication website at this time and press the check mark.
9. Enter the module data and press the check mark.
10. The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration
Complete. 11. Test module for correct operation.
Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) Programming
Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) Programming
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3073
Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) Programming Using the Integrated Diagnostic System
(IDS)
NOTE: If a new Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) is being installed, install the new
APIM before carrying out the following procedure.
1. Turn the Audio Control Module (ACM) on.
2. Connect the scan tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC).
3. Connect one end of the Universal Serial Bus (USB) male-A to male-A cable to the scan tool.
4. Connect the other end of the USB male-A to male-A cable to the vehicle USB port.
5. From the technician service publication website, run On-Line Automotive Service Information
System (OASIS) using Quick Start or by manually
entering the Vehicle Identification Number (VIN).
6. From the OASIS tab, select the "Sync/APIM" bullet.
7. Select the "Read APIM" button to verify the current APIM Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and
Consumer Interface Processor (CIP) software
levels.
8. NOTE: Do not disconnect the Vehicle Communication Module (VCM) or USB cables during
APIM programming.
Select the desired software level from the list of available software for programming then select the
"Program APIM" button to begin the APIM programming process. Enter the APIM As-Built data if
prompted.
- When the VIP is programmed, the CIP will be programmed automatically.
9. The Sync/APIM application downloads the software into the APIM and displays "Programming
has been completed successfully".
10. Test the audio system for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 3074
Information Bus: Service and Repair
PROGRAMMABLE MODULE INSTALLATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) Using The Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) When The
Original Module Is Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure be
carried out. For instructions, refer to the specific module removal and installation procedures.
1. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle as normal. 2. From the Toolbox icon, select Module
Programming and press the check mark. 3. Select Programmable Module Installation. 4. Select the
module that is being replaced. 5. Follow the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the OFF
position, and press the check mark. 6. Install the new module and press the check mark. 7. Follow
the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the ON position, and press the check mark. 8.
The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration Complete. 9.
Test module for correct operation.
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) Using The Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) When The
Original Module Is Not Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure be
carried out. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal
and installation procedures.
1. Install the new module. 2. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle as normal. 3. From the
Toolbox icon, select Module Programming and press the check mark. 4. Select Programmable
Module Installation. 5. Select the module that was replaced. 6. Follow the on-screen instructions,
turn the ignition key to the OFF position, and press the check mark. 7. Follow the on-screen
instructions, turn the ignition key to the ON position, and press the check mark. 8. If the data is not
available, the IDS displays a screen stating to contact the As-Built Data Center. Retrieve the data
from the technician service
publication website at this time and press the check mark.
9. Enter the module data and press the check mark.
10. The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration
Complete. 11. Test module for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Knock Sensor 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Knock Sensor 1 > Page 3079
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1 > Page 3082
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3083
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Two Types of Knock Sensor (KS)
Two Types of Knock Sensor (KS)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3084
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
Knock Sensor (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold.
2. Disconnect the Knock Sensor (KS) electrical connectors.
3. Remove the 2 bolts and the 2 KS.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (177 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 3088
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 3089
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL)
The MIL notifies the driver that the powertrain control module (PCM) has detected an on board
diagnostic (OBD) emission-related component or system concern. When this occurs, an OBD
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) sets.
- The MIL is located in the instrument cluster and is labeled CHECK ENGINE, SERVICE ENGINE
SOON or the international standards organization (ISO) standard engine symbol.
- The MIL is illuminated during the instrument cluster prove out for approximately four seconds.
- The MIL remains illuminated after instrument cluster prove out if:
- an emission-related concern and DTC exists.
- the PCM does not send a control message to the instrument cluster (applications with the MIL
controlled through the communication link).
- the PCM is operating in the hardware limited operation strategy (HLOS).
- The MIL remains off during the instrument cluster prove out if an indicator or instrument cluster
concern is present.
- To turn off the MIL after a repair, a reset command from the scan tool must be sent, or three
consecutive drive cycles must be completed without a concern.
- For all MIL concerns, go to Symptom Charts See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures/No Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) Present Symptom Chart Index.
- If the MIL flashes at a steady rate, a severe misfire condition may exist.
- If the MIL flashes erratically, the PCM can reset while cranking if the battery voltage is low.
- The MIL flashes after a period of time with the ignition in the RUN position (engine not running) if
DTC P1000 is set.
CHECK ENGINE, SERVICE ENGINE SOON, or ISO Standard Engine Symbol
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
The MAP sensor measures intake manifold absolute pressure. The PCM uses information from the
MAP sensor to measure how much exhaust gas is introduced into the intake manifold.
Typical Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
Typical Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM
> Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) Sensor
The EOT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The EOT sensor measures the temperature of the engine oil. The sensor is typically threaded into
the engine oil lubrication system. The PCM can use the EOT sensor input to determine the
following:
- On variable camshaft timing (VCT) applications the EOT input is used to adjust the VCT control
gains and logic for camshaft timing.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input in conjunction with other PCM inputs to determine oil
degradation.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input to initiate a soft engine shutdown. To prevent engine
damage from occurring as a result of high oil temperatures, the PCM has the ability to initiate a soft
engine shutdown. Whenever engine RPM exceeds a calibrated level for a certain period of time,
the PCM begins reducing power by disabling engine cylinders.
Typical Thread Type Sensor
Typical EOT Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #11
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 3103
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #12
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 3104
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 3105
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 3106
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #22
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 3107
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #22
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 3110
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 3111
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 3112
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Engine Control Components
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
The HO2S detects the presence of oxygen in the exhaust and produces a variable voltage
according to the amount of oxygen detected. A high concentration of oxygen (lean air/fuel ratio) in
the exhaust produces a voltage signal less than 0.4 volt. A low concentration of oxygen (rich
air/fuel ratio) produces a voltage signal greater than 0.6 volt. The HO2S provides feedback to the
PCM indicating air/fuel ratio in order to achieve a near stoichiometric air/fuel ratio of 14.7:1 during
closed loop engine operation. The HO2S generates a voltage between 0.0 and 1.1 volts.
Embedded with the sensing element is the HO2S heater. The heating element heats the sensor to
a temperature of 800°C (1,472°F). At approximately 300°C (572°F) the engine can enter closed
loop operation. The VPWR circuit supplies voltage to the heater. The PCM turns the heater on by
providing the ground when the correct conditions occur. The heater allows the engine to enter
closed loop operation sooner. The use of this heater requires the HO2S heater control to be duty
cycled, to prevent damage to the heater.
Typical Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Typical Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 3115
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation Universal Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Engine Control Components
Universal Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
The universal HO2S, sometimes referred to as a wideband oxygen sensor, uses the typical HO2S
combined with a current controller in the PCM to infer an air/fuel ratio relative to the stoichiometric
air/fuel ratio. This is accomplished by balancing the amount of oxygen ions pumped in or out of a
measurement chamber within the sensor. The typical HO2S within the universal HO2S is used to
detect the oxygen content of the exhaust gas in the measurement chamber. The oxygen content
inside the measurement chamber is maintained at the stoichiometric air/fuel ratio by pumping
oxygen ions in and out of the measurement chamber. As the exhaust gasses get richer or leaner,
the amount of oxygen that must be pumped in or out to maintain a stoichiometric air/fuel ratio in the
measurement chamber varies in proportion to the air/fuel ratio. The amount of current required to
pump the oxygen ions in or out of the measurement chamber is used to measure the air/fuel ratio.
The measured air/fuel ratio is actually the output from the current controller in the PCM and not a
signal that comes directly from the sensor.
The universal HO2S also uses a self-contained reference chamber to make sure an oxygen
differential is always present. The oxygen for the reference chamber is supplied by pumping small
amounts of oxygen ions from the measurement chamber into the reference chamber. The universal
HO2S does not need access to outside air.
Part to part variance is compensated for by placing a resistor in the connector. This resistor is used
to trim the current measured by the current controller in the PCM.
Embedded with the sensing element is the universal HO2S heater. The heater allows the engine to
enter closed loop operation sooner. The heating element heats the sensor to a temperature of
780°C (1,436°F). The VPWR circuit supplies voltage to the heater. The PCM controls the heater on
and off by providing the ground to maintain the sensor at the correct temperature for maximum
accuracy.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) And Catalyst Monitor Sensor - Exploded View
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) And Catalyst Monitor Sensor Exploded View
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) and Catalyst Monitor Sensor - Exploded View
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) And Catalyst Monitor Sensor - Exploded View > Page
3118
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Disconnect the Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) electrical connector.
3. Using the Exhaust Gas Oxygen Sensor Socket, remove the HO2S.
- Apply penetrating lubricant to the HO2S to assist in removal.
Installation
1. Install the HO2S.
- Apply a light coat of high temperature nickel anti-seize lubricant to the HO2S threads prior to
installation.
- Calculate the correct torque wrench setting for the following torque.
- Using the Exhaust Gas Oxygen Sensor Socket, tighten to 46 Nm (34 lb-ft).
2. Connect the HO2S electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) And Catalyst Monitor Sensor - Exploded View > Page
3119
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Catalyst Monitor Sensor
Catalyst Monitor Sensor
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Disconnect the Catalyst Monitor Sensor (CMS) electrical connector.
3. Using the Exhaust Gas Oxygen Sensor Socket, remove the CMS.
- Apply penetrating lubricant to the CMS to assist in removal.
Installation
1. Install the CMS.
- Apply a light coat of high temperature nickel anti-seize lubricant to the CMS threads prior to
installation.
- Calculate the correct torque wrench setting for the following torque.
- Using the Exhaust Gas Oxygen Sensor Socket, tighten to 46 Nm (34 lb-ft).
2. Connect the CMS electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3123
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3124
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Switch
Engine Control Components
Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
The PSP switch monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP switch
is a normally closed switch that opens as the hydraulic pressure increases. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the PSP circuit. When the PSP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The PCM uses the input signal from the PSP switch to compensate
for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the idle RPM and preventing engine stall during
parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP switch signals the PCM to adjust the transmission EPC
pressure during increased engine load, for example during parking maneuvers.
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch > Page 3127
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Sensor
Engine Control Components
Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
The PSP sensor monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP
sensor voltage input to the PCM changes as the hydraulic pressure changes. The PCM uses the
input signal from the PSP sensor to compensate for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the
idle RPM and preventing engine stall during parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP sensor signals the
PCM to adjust the transmission EPC pressure during increased engine load, for example, during
parking maneuvers.
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust
Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description and Operation
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer
that monitors the differential pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly.
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as
the downstream pressure hose (REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI
and REF hose connections are marked on the differential pressure feedback EGR sensor housing
for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger diameter hose). The differential pressure
feedback EGR sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the metering
orifice and supplies it to the PCM as EGR flow rate feedback.
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
The tube mounted differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is identical in operation as the larger
plastic differential pressure feedback EGR sensors and uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF
hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
Electronic Throttle Control Module: Description and Operation
Torque-Based Electronic Throttle Control (ETC)
Overview
The torque-based ETC is a hardware and software strategy that delivers an engine output torque
(via throttle angle) based on driver demand (pedal position). It uses an electronic throttle body, the
powertrain control module (PCM), and an accelerator pedal assembly to control the throttle
opening and engine torque.
Torque-based ETC enables aggressive automatic transmission shift schedules (earlier upshifts and
later downshifts). This is possible by adjusting the throttle angle to achieve the same wheel torque
during shifts, and by calculating this desired torque, the system prevents engine lugging (low RPM
and low manifold vacuum) while still delivering the performance and torque requested by the driver.
It also enables many fuel economy/emission improvement technologies such as variable camshaft
timing (VCT), which delivers same torque during transitions.
Torque-based ETC also results in less intrusive vehicle and engine speed limiting, along with
smoother traction control.
Other benefits of torque-based ETC are:
- eliminate cruise control actuators
- eliminate idle air control (IAC) valve
- better airflow range
- packaging (no cable)
- more responsive powertrain at altitude and improved shift quality
The ETC system illuminates a powertrain malfunction indicator (wrench) on the instrument cluster
when a concern is present. Concerns are accompanied by diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) and
may also illuminate the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL).
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB)
The ETB has the following characteristics:
- The throttle actuator control (TAC) motor is a DC motor controlled by the PCM (requires 2 wires).
- There are two designs: parallel and in-line. The parallel design has the motor under the bore
parallel to the plate shaft. The motor housing is integrated into the main housing. The in-line design
has a separate motor housing.
- An internal spring is used in both designs to return the throttle plate to a default position. The
default position is typically a throttle angle of 7 to 8 degrees from the hard stop angle.
- The closed throttle plate hard stop is used to prevent the throttle from binding in the bore. This
hard stop setting is not adjustable and is set to result in less airflow than the minimum engine
airflow required at idle.
- The required idle airflow is provided by the plate angle in the throttle body assembly. This plate
angle controls idle, idle quality, and eliminates the need for an IAC valve.
- There is one reference voltage and one signal return circuit between the PCM and the ETB. The
reference voltage and the signal return circuits are shared with the reference voltage and signal
return circuits used by the accelerator pedal position (APP) sensor. There are also two throttle
position (TP) signal circuits for redundancy. The redundant TP signals are required for increased
monitoring reasons. The first TP signal (TP1) has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing
voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage).
The TP2 signal reaches a limit of approximately 4.5 volts at approximately 45 degrees of throttle
angle.
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor
Depending on the application either a 2-track or 3-track APP sensor is used. For additional
information on the APP sensor, refer to Engine Control Components See: Description and
Operation/Engine Control Components.
Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) System Strategy
The torque-based ETC strategy was developed to improve fuel economy and to accommodate
variable camshaft timing (VCT). This is possible by not coupling the throttle angle to the driver
pedal position. Uncoupling the throttle angle (produce engine torque) from the pedal position (driver
demand)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
3135
allows the powertrain control strategy to optimize fuel control and transmission shift schedules
while delivering the requested wheel torque.
The ETC monitor system is distributed across two processors within the PCM: the main powertrain
control processor unit (CPU) and a separate monitoring processor. The primary monitoring function
is carried out by the independent plausibility check (IPC) software, which resides on the main
processor. It is responsible for determining the driver-demanded torque and comparing it to an
estimate of the actual torque delivered. If the generated torque exceeds driver demand by a
specified amount, appropriate corrective action is taken.
ETC System With A 3-Track APP Sensor Failure Mode And Effects Management:
a - ETC illuminates or displays a message on the message center immediately; MIL illuminates
after 2 driving cycles
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
3136
ETC System With A 2-Track APP Sensor Failure Mode And Effects Management:
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation:
a - Monitor execution is continuous. Monitor false detection duration is less than 1 second to
register a concern.
APP and TP Sensor Inputs
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
3137
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Check:
Correlation and range/performance - sensor disagreement between processors internal to the
PCM. Monitor execution is continuous. Monitor false detection duration is less than 1 second to
register a concern. Refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Charts and Descriptions for additional
DTC information.
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Check:
a - Correlation and range/performance - sensor disagreement between processors internal to the
PCM, TP inconsistent with requested throttle plate position. Monitor execution is continuous.
Monitor false detection duration is less than 1 second to register a concern. Refer to Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DTC) Charts and Descriptions for additional DTC information.
Electronic Throttle Actuator Control (TAC) Output
Electronic TAC Operation Check:
a - Note: For all DTCs, in addition to the MIL, the powertrain malfunction indicator (wrench) is on for
the concern that caused the FMEM action. Monitor execution is continuous. Monitor false detection
duration is less than 5 seconds to register a concern.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest
for Engine Control Module: > 10-12-4 > Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh Downshifts
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh Downshifts
TSB 10-12-4
07/05/10
5.4L 3V AND 6R80 TRANSMISSION - DELAYED/HARSH DOWNSHIFT ABOVE 40 MPH (64
KM/H)
FORD: 2009-2010 Expedition, F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built on or before 5/1/2010 and
2009-2010 F-150 vehicles built on or before 2/1/2010 and equipped with 5.4L 3V engine and 6R80
transmission may exhibit a delayed then harsh downshift during a commanded downshift at speeds
above 40 MPH (64 Km/h).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
ID vehicle.
2. Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 67.03 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the 1CM Calibration is:
(1) AL3P-7J104-AC for all vehicles except the F-150 4X4.
(2) AL3P-7J104-BC for F-150 4X4.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox
(2) Powertrain
(3) OBD Test Modes
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info
(5) 1CM Cal Part Number
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT 1CM KAM BE CLEARED FOR THIS PROCEDURE TO BE FULLY
EFFECTIVE
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox
(2) Choose Powertrain Then Choose TCM
(3) Choose Reset KAM
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest
for Engine Control Module: > 10-12-4 > Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh Downshifts > Page 3146
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset 1CM KAM
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM
KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop, allow at least six (6) seconds.
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101204A 2009-2010 Expedition, 1.0 Hr.
Navigator, F-150: Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM And Perform Road
Tests (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest
for Engine Control Module: > 10-12-4 > Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh Downshifts > Page 3147
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest
for Engine Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
TSB 09-15-8
08/10/09
5.4L 3V 6R80 - HARSH 1-2 UPSHIFT - HARSH 2-1 DOWNSHIFT WHILE COASTING - HARSH
DOWNSHIFT TO 4TH GEAR - INTERMITTENT P0741
FORD: 2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with 5.4L 3V engine may exhibit
symptoms during warm-up: a harsh 1-2 upshift, harsh 2-1 downshift while coasting 15 MPH (24
Km/h). A harsh downshift into 4th gear at highway speeds 45-70 MPH (72-113 Km/h) may also be
experienced. Some vehicles may have a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0741 torque converter
performance code present or stored.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
MECHATRONIC REPAIR/REPLACEMENT IS NOT
AUTHORIZED FOR THIS ISSUE.
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the Powertrain Control Module/Transmission Control Module (PCM/TCM) calibration
using IDS release 61.15 and higher or 62.03 and
higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be
obtained at the website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the TCM Calibration shows AL3P-7J104-AB part number after reprogramming is
complete.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) OBD Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR TSB TO BE
FULLY AFFECTIVE
3. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest
for Engine Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 3152
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM.
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175° F (79° C). If it is not at
175° F (79° C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175° F (79° C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091508A 2009 Expedition, Navigator 1.0 Hr.
6R80 Transmission: Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear The
TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest
for Engine Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 3153
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-12-4 > Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh Downshifts
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh
Downshifts
TSB 10-12-4
07/05/10
5.4L 3V AND 6R80 TRANSMISSION - DELAYED/HARSH DOWNSHIFT ABOVE 40 MPH (64
KM/H)
FORD: 2009-2010 Expedition, F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built on or before 5/1/2010 and
2009-2010 F-150 vehicles built on or before 2/1/2010 and equipped with 5.4L 3V engine and 6R80
transmission may exhibit a delayed then harsh downshift during a commanded downshift at speeds
above 40 MPH (64 Km/h).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
ID vehicle.
2. Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 67.03 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the 1CM Calibration is:
(1) AL3P-7J104-AC for all vehicles except the F-150 4X4.
(2) AL3P-7J104-BC for F-150 4X4.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox
(2) Powertrain
(3) OBD Test Modes
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info
(5) 1CM Cal Part Number
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT 1CM KAM BE CLEARED FOR THIS PROCEDURE TO BE FULLY
EFFECTIVE
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox
(2) Choose Powertrain Then Choose TCM
(3) Choose Reset KAM
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-12-4 > Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh Downshifts >
Page 3159
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset 1CM KAM
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM
KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop, allow at least six (6) seconds.
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101204A 2009-2010 Expedition, 1.0 Hr.
Navigator, F-150: Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM And Perform Road
Tests (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-12-4 > Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh Downshifts >
Page 3160
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4
Shifts
TSB 09-15-8
08/10/09
5.4L 3V 6R80 - HARSH 1-2 UPSHIFT - HARSH 2-1 DOWNSHIFT WHILE COASTING - HARSH
DOWNSHIFT TO 4TH GEAR - INTERMITTENT P0741
FORD: 2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with 5.4L 3V engine may exhibit
symptoms during warm-up: a harsh 1-2 upshift, harsh 2-1 downshift while coasting 15 MPH (24
Km/h). A harsh downshift into 4th gear at highway speeds 45-70 MPH (72-113 Km/h) may also be
experienced. Some vehicles may have a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0741 torque converter
performance code present or stored.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
MECHATRONIC REPAIR/REPLACEMENT IS NOT
AUTHORIZED FOR THIS ISSUE.
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the Powertrain Control Module/Transmission Control Module (PCM/TCM) calibration
using IDS release 61.15 and higher or 62.03 and
higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be
obtained at the website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the TCM Calibration shows AL3P-7J104-AB part number after reprogramming is
complete.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) OBD Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR TSB TO BE
FULLY AFFECTIVE
3. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page
3165
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM.
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175° F (79° C). If it is not at
175° F (79° C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175° F (79° C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091508A 2009 Expedition, Navigator 1.0 Hr.
6R80 Transmission: Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear The
TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page
3166
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3167
Engine Control Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3168
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3169
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3170
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3171
Engine Control Module: Diagrams
C175B Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3172
C175B Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3173
C175B Part 3
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3174
C175E Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3175
C175E Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3176
C175E Part 3
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3177
C175T Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3178
C175T Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Engine Control Module: Procedures
Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EEPROM)
Description
The EEPROM is contained in an integrated circuit internal to the powertrain control module (PCM).
The EEPROM contains the vehicle strategy including calibration information specific to the vehicle,
and is capable of being programmed or flashed repeatedly.
As part of the calibration there is an area referred to as the vehicle identification (VID) block. The
VID block is programmed when installing a new PCM as described under Programming the VID
Block for a Replacement PCM. Failure to carry out this procedure may generate DTC P1635 or
P1639. The VID block in an existing PCM can also be tailored to accommodate various hardware
or parameter changes made to the vehicle since production. Failure to carry out this procedure
properly may generate DTC P1635, Tire/Axle Ratio out of Acceptable Range. An incorrect tire/axle
ratio is one of the main causes for DTC P1639. This is described under Making Changes to the VID
Block and also under Making Changes to the PCM Calibration. The VID block contains many items
used by the strategy for a variety of functions. Some of these items include the vehicle identification
number (VIN), octane adjust, fuel octane, fuel type, vehicle speed limit, tire size, axle ratio, the
presence of speed control, and 4-wheel drive electronic shift-on-the-fly (ESOF) versus manual
shift-on-the-fly (MSOF). Only items applicable to the vehicle hardware and supported by the VID
block is displayed on the scan tool.
When changing items in the VID block, the strategy places range limits on certain items such as
tire and axle ratio. The number of times the VID block may be reconfigured is limited. When this
limit is reached, the scan tool displays a message indicating the need to flash the PCM again to
reset the VID block.
On selected vehicles equipped with permanent DTC reporting capabilities, neutral profile correction
should be learned after a PCM replacement in order to activate the misfire monitor. This can be
accomplished using the Misfire Monitor Neutral Profile Learn function on the scan tool.
Programming can be carried out by a local Ford dealer or any non-Ford facility. Refer to the scan
tool manufacturer's instruction manual for details.
Neutral Profile Correction
In order for the misfire detection system to function properly, any mechanical inaccuracies in the
crankshaft position (CKP) sensor must be learned by the PCM. This information is stored in
non-volatile memory (NVM) in the PCM. It is not cleared when the keep alive memory (KAM) is
reset.
Neutral profile learning is accomplished using the scan tool any time a PCM is replaced. It should
also be relearned any time the CKP sensor is replaced or major engine repairs have been
completed.
To determine if the neutral profile learning has been completed, check the MP_LRN parameter
identification (PID) using the scan tool. The PID should read YES if the neutral profile learning has
been completed. If the PID reads NO, complete the neutral profile learning prior to diagnosing any
misfire DTCs.
Programming the VID Block for a Replacement PCM
The VID block on a replacement PCM is blank and requires programming. There are two
procedures available. The first is an automatic data transfer from the old PCM to the new PCM,
and the second is manual data entry into the new PCM.
Automatic data transfer is carried out if the old PCM is capable of communicating. This is done by
using a scan tool to retrieve data from the old PCM before removing it from the vehicle. The stored
data can be downloaded to the new PCM after it has been installed.
Carry out manual data entry if the old PCM is damaged or incapable of communicating. Remove
and install a new PCM. Using a compatible scan tool, select and carry out the module/parameter
programming, referring to the scan tool manufacturer's instruction manual. Make certain that all
parameters are included. Failure to properly program tire size in revolutions per mile, (rev/mile
equals 63,360 divided by the tire circumference in inches), axle ratio, 4x4/4x2, and/or MSOF/ESOF
may result in DTCs P1635 and P1639. You may be instructed to contact the As-Built Data Center
for the information needed to manually update the VID block with the scan tool. Contact the center
only if the old PCM cannot be used or the data is corrupt. For Ford and Lincoln Mercury
technicians, contact your National Hotline or the Professional Technician Society (PTS) website for
As-Built data listed under the Service Publications Index. Non-Ford technicians use the
Motorcraft(R) website at www.motorcraft.com. From the Motorcraft(R) homepage, use the search
function to find the Module Programming or As-Built Data.
For Ford and Lincoln Mercury technicians, check the Programmable Module Installation link on the
PTS website for quick Programmable Module data information by vehicle.
Making Changes to the VID Block
A programmed PCM may require changes to be made to certain VID information to accommodate
the vehicle hardware. Refer to Module Reprogramming on the scan tool.
Making Changes to the PCM Calibration
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 3181
At certain times, the entire EEPROM needs to be completely reprogrammed. This is due to
changes made to the strategy or calibration after production, or the need to reset the VID block
because it has reached its limit. Refer to Module Reprogramming on the scan tool.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 3182
Engine Control Module: Removal and Replacement
Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: Refer to Computers and Control Systems Information for correct Vehicle Communication
Module (VCM) hook-up procedure.
If servicing the PCM, connect the scan tool to the vehicle. Allow the scan tool to identify the vehicle
and obtain configuration data.
- All programmable module information will automatically be retrieved by the VCM.
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
3. Disconnect the 3 PCM electrical connectors.
4. Remove the 2 stud bolts and the PCM.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
5. NOTE: If the Instrument Cluster (IC) or the PCM is being replaced (or both), the parameters
must be reset in both modules or the vehicle will
experience a Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) no-start. This will occur even if the vehicle is not
equipped with PATS.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
6. Using the scan tool, perform the Misfire Monitor Neutral Profile Correction procedure, following
the on-screen instructions.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 3186
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 3187
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3192
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3193
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3194
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
amount of torque requested by the operator. Depending on the application either a 2-track or
3-track APP sensor is used.
2-Track APP Sensor
There are two pedal position signals in the sensor. Both signals, APP1 and APP2, have a positive
slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage), but are offset and increase at different rates. The two
pedal position signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if one signal has a
concern. The PCM determines if a signal is incorrect by calculating where it should be, inferred
from the other signals. If a concern is present with one of the circuits the other input is used. There
are two reference voltage circuits, two signal return circuits, and two signal circuits (a total of six
circuits and pins) between the PCM and the APP sensor assembly. The reference voltage circuits
and the signal return circuits are shared with the reference voltage circuit and signal return circuit
used by the electronic throttle body (ETB) throttle position (TP) sensor. The pedal position signal is
converted to pedal travel degrees (rotary angle) by the PCM. The software then converts these
degrees to counts, which is the input to the torque based strategy. For additional information, refer
to Torque Based Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) See: Electronic Throttle Control
Module/Description and Operation.
2-Track APP Sensor
Typical 2-Track APP Sensor
3-Track APP Sensor
There are three pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APP1, has a negative slope
(increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APP2 and APP3, both have a positive
slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APP1 is used as the
indication of pedal position by the strategy. The three pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if one signal has a concern. The PCM determines if a signal is
incorrect by calculating where it should be, inferred from the other signals. If a concern is present
with one of the circuits the other inputs are used. The pedal position signal is converted to pedal
travel degrees (rotary angle) by the PCM. The software then converts these degrees to counts,
which is the input to the torque based strategy. There are two reference voltage circuits, two signal
return circuits, and three signal circuits (a total of seven circuits and pins) between the PCM and
the APP sensor assembly. The reference voltage circuits and the signal return circuits are shared
with the reference voltage circuit and signal return circuit used by the electronic throttle body (ETB)
throttle position sensor. For additional information, refer to Torque Based Electronic Throttle
Control (ETC) See: Electronic Throttle Control Module/Description and Operation.
3-Track APP Sensor
Typical 3-Track APP Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3198
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3199
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Electronic Engine Controls
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Engine Controls
Electronic Engine Controls
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor:
- sends the PCM a signal indicating mass airflow rate of air entering the engine.
- incorporates the Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor.
For removal and installation, refer to Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor See: Service and Repair.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Electronic Engine Controls > Page 3202
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Engine Control Components
Engine Control Components
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. The current required to
maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow. The MAF sensor then
outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air mass. The PCM
calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired air/fuel ratio. This
input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC), shift and torque
converter clutch (TCC) scheduling.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly. Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology with an integrated IAT sensor.
The hot wire electronic sensing element must be replaced as an assembly. Replacing only the
element may change the air flow calibration.
Diagram of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot and Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Diagram of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot and Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals.
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Electronic Engine Controls > Page 3203
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
3204
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector.
2. Remove the 2 bolts and the MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position
Sensor 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position
Sensor 2 > Page 3209
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position
Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position
Sensor > Page 3212
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3213
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston
number 1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing
the sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil on plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP
signal to select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with two CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). The second
sensor is used to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2.
There are two types of CMP sensors: the 2-pin variable reluctance type sensor and the 3-pin
Hall-effect type sensor.
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
Typical Hall-effect CMP Sensor
Typical Hall-effect CMP Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3214
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
Removal and Installation
LH Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor
1. Remove the Air Cleaner (ACL) outlet pipe.
All CMP sensors
2. Disconnect the Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor electrical connector.
3. Remove the bolt and the CMP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Clutch Switch, ECM > Component Information > Description and Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
The CPP switch is an input to the PCM indicating the clutch pedal position. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the CPP circuit. When the CPP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The CPP input to the PCM is used to detect a reduction in engine
load. The PCM uses the load information for mass air flow and fuel calculations.
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor
The ECT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The ECT measures the temperature of the engine coolant. The PCM uses the ECT input for fuel
control and for cooling fan control. There are three types of ECT sensors, threaded, push-in, and
twist-lock. The ECT sensor is located in an engine coolant passage.
Typical Thread Type Sensor
Typical Thread Type ECT Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3224
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3225
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid decelerations between teeth.
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3226
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the accessory drive belt from the A/C compressor pulley.
3. Disconnect the A/C compressor electrical connector.
4. Disconnect the Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor electrical connector.
5. Remove the 3 bolts and position the A/C compressor aside.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
6. Remove the bolt and the CKP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3227
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
8. Using the scan tool, perform the Misfire Monitor Neutral Profile Correction procedure, following
the on-screen instructions.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3231
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3232
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Cylinder Head Temperature (CHT) Sensor
The CHT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with the temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as temperature increases, and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
The CHT sensor is installed in the cylinder head and measures the metal temperature. The CHT
sensor can provide complete engine temperature information and can be used to infer coolant
temperature. If the CHT sensor conveys an overheating condition to the PCM, the PCM initiates a
fail-safe cooling strategy based on information from the CHT sensor. A cooling system concern
such as low coolant or coolant loss could cause an overheating condition. As a result, damage to
major engine components could occur. Using both the CHT sensor and fail-safe cooling strategy,
the PCM prevents damage by allowing air cooling of the engine and limp home capability. For
additional information, refer to Powertrain Control Software See: Description and
Operation/Powertrain Control Software for Fail-Safe Cooling Strategy.
Typical CHT Sensor
Typical CHT Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3233
Engine Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
Cylinder Head Temperature (CHT) Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold.
2. Disconnect the Cylinder Head Temperature (CHT) sensor electrical connector.
3. Remove the CHT sensor and discard.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Coat the new CHT sensor threads with high temperature nickel anti-seize lubricant prior to
installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Fuel Level Input (FLI)
The FLI is a communications network message. Most vehicle applications use a potentiometer type
FLI sensor connected to a float in the FP module to determine fuel level.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank And
Filler Pipe - Exploded View
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View
Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View
106L (28 Gal) Fuel Tank
127L (33.5 Gal) Fuel Tank
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank And
Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 3239
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank And
Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 3240
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module
Fuel Pump Module
106L (28 Gal) Fuel Tank
127L (33.5 Gal) Fuel Tank
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank And
Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 3241
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
All fuel tanks
1. Remove the fuel tank. For additional information, refer to Fuel Tank See: Fuel Delivery and Air
Induction/Fuel Tank/Service and Repair/Removal
and Replacement/Fuel Tank.
127L (33.5 gal) fuel tank
2. Remove the 4 nuts and the Fuel Pump (FP) module cover.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
3. Disconnect the return fuel tube-to-FP module quick connect coupling.
All fuel tanks
4. Disconnect the Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-FP module quick
connect coupling and the supply fuel tube-to-FP
module quick connect coupling.
5. Using the Fuel Tank Sender Unit Wrench, remove the FP lock ring.
106L (28 gal) fuel tank
6. NOTICE: Carefully remove the Fuel Pump (FP) assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level
sensor.
NOTE: If the FP does not clear the FP mounting flange on the fuel tank, the use of a screwdriver
may be necessary.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank And
Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 3242
Remove the FP and FP O-ring seal. If necessary, insert a screwdriver into the empty FP rod hole and slightly pull the screwdriver
inboard until the base of the FP clears the FP mounting flange.
- Discard the FP O-ring seal.
127L (33.5 gal) fuel tank
7. NOTICE: Carefully remove the Fuel Pump (FP) assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level
sensor.
NOTE: Note the location of the FP alignment tabs.
Remove the FP module assembly. Remove and discard the O-ring seal.
All fuel tanks
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3246
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3247
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3248
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
The FTP sensor or in-line FTP sensor is used to measure the fuel tank pressure.
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
In-line Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
In-line Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank
Pressure Sensor
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
106L (28 Gal) Fuel Tank
125L (33 Gal) Fuel Tank
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank
Pressure Sensor > Page 3251
Removal and Installation
All fuel tanks
1. Remove the fuel tank.
106L (28 gal) fuel tank
2. Disconnect the fuel supply tube-to-heat shield pushpin retainer.
125L (33 gal) fuel tank
3. Remove the fuel tank heat shield retainer(s).
All fuel tanks
4. Remove the fuel tank heat shield.
5. Disconnect the Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-fuel vapor/grade
vent valves quick connect couplings.
6. Disconnect the FTP sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-fuel pump module quick connect
coupling.
7. Remove the FTP sensor and vapor tube assembly from the fuel tank.
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Carry out the Evaporative Emission System Leak Test. For additional information, refer to
Evaporative Emission System Leak Test See: Emission Control Systems/Evaporative Emissions
System/Testing and Inspection.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank
Pressure Sensor > Page 3252
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Evaporative Emission (EVAP) System
Components - Exploded View
Evaporative Emission (EVAP) System Components - Exploded View
Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Canister Assembly
NOTE: 106L (28 gal) fuel tank vapor tubes shown, 125L (33 gal) similar.
EVAP Canister, Vent Solenoid and Dust Separator and Brackets
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank
Pressure Sensor > Page 3253
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3257
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3258
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3259
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor
The IAT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The electrical
resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance increases
as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the sensor
terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The IAT sensor provides air temperature information to the PCM. The PCM uses the air
temperature information as a correction factor in the calculation of fuel, spark, and air flow.
The IAT sensor provides a quicker temperature change response time than the ECT or CHT
sensor.
Currently there are two types of IAT sensors used, a stand-alone/non-integrated type and a
integrated type. Both types function the same, however the integrated type is incorporated into the
mass air flow (MAF) sensor instead of being a stand alone sensor.
Supercharged vehicles use two IAT sensors. Both sensors are thermistor type devices and operate
as described above. One is located before the supercharger at the air cleaner for standard
OBD/cold weather input, while a second sensor (IAT2) is located after the supercharger in the
intake manifold. The IAT2 sensor located after the supercharger provides air temperature
information to the PCM to control spark and to help determine charge air cooler (CAC) efficiency.
Typical Stand-Alone/Non-Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensors
Typical Stand-Alone/Non-Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensors
Typical Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Incorporated Into a Drop-in or Flange-type
MAF Sensor
Typical Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Incorporated Into a Drop-in or Flange-type
MAF sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Knock Sensor 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Knock Sensor 1 > Page 3264
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1 > Page 3267
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3268
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Two Types of Knock Sensor (KS)
Two Types of Knock Sensor (KS)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3269
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
Knock Sensor (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold.
2. Disconnect the Knock Sensor (KS) electrical connectors.
3. Remove the 2 bolts and the 2 KS.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (177 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
The MAP sensor measures intake manifold absolute pressure. The PCM uses information from the
MAP sensor to measure how much exhaust gas is introduced into the intake manifold.
Typical Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
Typical Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM > Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) Sensor
The EOT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The EOT sensor measures the temperature of the engine oil. The sensor is typically threaded into
the engine oil lubrication system. The PCM can use the EOT sensor input to determine the
following:
- On variable camshaft timing (VCT) applications the EOT input is used to adjust the VCT control
gains and logic for camshaft timing.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input in conjunction with other PCM inputs to determine oil
degradation.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input to initiate a soft engine shutdown. To prevent engine
damage from occurring as a result of high oil temperatures, the PCM has the ability to initiate a soft
engine shutdown. Whenever engine RPM exceeds a calibrated level for a certain period of time,
the PCM begins reducing power by disabling engine cylinders.
Typical Thread Type Sensor
Typical EOT Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#11
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#11 > Page 3280
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #12
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#11 > Page 3281
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#11 > Page 3282
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#11 > Page 3283
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #22
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#11 > Page 3284
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#22
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#22 > Page 3287
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#22 > Page 3288
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#22 > Page 3289
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Engine Control Components
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
The HO2S detects the presence of oxygen in the exhaust and produces a variable voltage
according to the amount of oxygen detected. A high concentration of oxygen (lean air/fuel ratio) in
the exhaust produces a voltage signal less than 0.4 volt. A low concentration of oxygen (rich
air/fuel ratio) produces a voltage signal greater than 0.6 volt. The HO2S provides feedback to the
PCM indicating air/fuel ratio in order to achieve a near stoichiometric air/fuel ratio of 14.7:1 during
closed loop engine operation. The HO2S generates a voltage between 0.0 and 1.1 volts.
Embedded with the sensing element is the HO2S heater. The heating element heats the sensor to
a temperature of 800°C (1,472°F). At approximately 300°C (572°F) the engine can enter closed
loop operation. The VPWR circuit supplies voltage to the heater. The PCM turns the heater on by
providing the ground when the correct conditions occur. The heater allows the engine to enter
closed loop operation sooner. The use of this heater requires the HO2S heater control to be duty
cycled, to prevent damage to the heater.
Typical Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Typical Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 3292
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation Universal Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Engine Control Components
Universal Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
The universal HO2S, sometimes referred to as a wideband oxygen sensor, uses the typical HO2S
combined with a current controller in the PCM to infer an air/fuel ratio relative to the stoichiometric
air/fuel ratio. This is accomplished by balancing the amount of oxygen ions pumped in or out of a
measurement chamber within the sensor. The typical HO2S within the universal HO2S is used to
detect the oxygen content of the exhaust gas in the measurement chamber. The oxygen content
inside the measurement chamber is maintained at the stoichiometric air/fuel ratio by pumping
oxygen ions in and out of the measurement chamber. As the exhaust gasses get richer or leaner,
the amount of oxygen that must be pumped in or out to maintain a stoichiometric air/fuel ratio in the
measurement chamber varies in proportion to the air/fuel ratio. The amount of current required to
pump the oxygen ions in or out of the measurement chamber is used to measure the air/fuel ratio.
The measured air/fuel ratio is actually the output from the current controller in the PCM and not a
signal that comes directly from the sensor.
The universal HO2S also uses a self-contained reference chamber to make sure an oxygen
differential is always present. The oxygen for the reference chamber is supplied by pumping small
amounts of oxygen ions from the measurement chamber into the reference chamber. The universal
HO2S does not need access to outside air.
Part to part variance is compensated for by placing a resistor in the connector. This resistor is used
to trim the current measured by the current controller in the PCM.
Embedded with the sensing element is the universal HO2S heater. The heater allows the engine to
enter closed loop operation sooner. The heating element heats the sensor to a temperature of
780°C (1,436°F). The VPWR circuit supplies voltage to the heater. The PCM controls the heater on
and off by providing the ground to maintain the sensor at the correct temperature for maximum
accuracy.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) And Catalyst Monitor Sensor - Exploded View
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) And Catalyst Monitor Sensor Exploded View
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) and Catalyst Monitor Sensor - Exploded View
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) And Catalyst Monitor Sensor - Exploded View > Page 3295
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Disconnect the Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) electrical connector.
3. Using the Exhaust Gas Oxygen Sensor Socket, remove the HO2S.
- Apply penetrating lubricant to the HO2S to assist in removal.
Installation
1. Install the HO2S.
- Apply a light coat of high temperature nickel anti-seize lubricant to the HO2S threads prior to
installation.
- Calculate the correct torque wrench setting for the following torque.
- Using the Exhaust Gas Oxygen Sensor Socket, tighten to 46 Nm (34 lb-ft).
2. Connect the HO2S electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) And Catalyst Monitor Sensor - Exploded View > Page 3296
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Catalyst Monitor Sensor
Catalyst Monitor Sensor
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Disconnect the Catalyst Monitor Sensor (CMS) electrical connector.
3. Using the Exhaust Gas Oxygen Sensor Socket, remove the CMS.
- Apply penetrating lubricant to the CMS to assist in removal.
Installation
1. Install the CMS.
- Apply a light coat of high temperature nickel anti-seize lubricant to the CMS threads prior to
installation.
- Calculate the correct torque wrench setting for the following torque.
- Using the Exhaust Gas Oxygen Sensor Socket, tighten to 46 Nm (34 lb-ft).
2. Connect the CMS electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3300
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3301
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Switch
Engine Control Components
Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
The PSP switch monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP switch
is a normally closed switch that opens as the hydraulic pressure increases. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the PSP circuit. When the PSP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The PCM uses the input signal from the PSP switch to compensate
for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the idle RPM and preventing engine stall during
parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP switch signals the PCM to adjust the transmission EPC
pressure during increased engine load, for example during parking maneuvers.
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch > Page 3304
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Sensor
Engine Control Components
Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
The PSP sensor monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP
sensor voltage input to the PCM changes as the hydraulic pressure changes. The PCM uses the
input signal from the PSP sensor to compensate for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the
idle RPM and preventing engine stall during parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP sensor signals the
PCM to adjust the transmission EPC pressure during increased engine load, for example, during
parking maneuvers.
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer
that monitors the differential pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly.
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as
the downstream pressure hose (REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI
and REF hose connections are marked on the differential pressure feedback EGR sensor housing
for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger diameter hose). The differential pressure
feedback EGR sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the metering
orifice and supplies it to the PCM as EGR flow rate feedback.
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
The tube mounted differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is identical in operation as the larger
plastic differential pressure feedback EGR sensors and uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF
hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3311
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle
Position Sensor
Engine Control Components
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle Position Sensor
The ETB throttle position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant
ETB throttle position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB throttle position
sensor signal (TP1) has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second
signal (TP2) has a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). The 2 ETB throttle position
sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There is
1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor. The reference voltage circuit
and the signal return circuit is shared with the reference voltage circuits and signal return circuits
used by the APP sensor. For additional information, refer to Torque Based Electronic Throttle
Control (ETC) See: Electronic Throttle Control Module/Description and Operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle Position Sensor > Page 3314
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
Engine Control Components
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases the corrosion resistance on the
terminals and increases the connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body.
As the TP sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, four operating conditions are determined by the
PCM from the TP. These are:
- closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration)
- part throttle (includes cruise or moderate acceleration)
- wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on crank)
- throttle angle rate
Typical TP Sensor
Typical TP Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
3315
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
Removal
1. Remove the Throttle Body (TB).
2. NOTICE: Do not put direct heat on the Throttle Position (TP) sensor or any other plastic parts
because heat damage may occur. Damage
may also occur if Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) temperature exceeds 120°C (248°F).
NOTE: Do not use power tools.
Remove the TP sensor.
1. Using a suitable heat gun, apply heat to the top of the ETB until the top TP sensor bolt ear
reaches approximately 55°C (130°F), this should
take no more than 3 minutes using an 1,100-watt heat gun. The heat gun should be about 25.4 mm
(1 in) away from the ETB.
2. Monitor the temperature of the top TP sensor bolt ear on the ETB with a suitable temperature
measuring device, such as a digital temperature
laser or infrared thermometer, while heating the ETB.
3. Using hand tools, quickly remove the bolt farthest from the heat source first and discard.
4. Using hand tools, remove the remaining bolt and discard.
5. Remove and discard the TP sensor.
Installation
1. NOTE: When installing the new TP sensor, make sure that the radial locator tab on the TP
sensor is aligned with the radial locator hole on the
ETB.
NOTE: Do not use power tools.
Install the new TP sensor. Using hand tools, install the 2 new bolts. Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
2. Install the TB.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output
Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Engine Control Components
Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
The OSS sensor provides the PCM with information about the rotational speed of an output shaft.
The PCM uses the information to control and diagnose powertrain behavior. In some applications,
the sensor is also used as the source of vehicle speed. The sensor may be physically located in
different places on the vehicle, depending upon the specific application. The design of each speed
sensor is unique and depends on which powertrain control feature uses the information that is
generated.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output
Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor > Page 3320
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
Engine Control Components
Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
The VSS is a variable reluctance or Hall-effect sensor that generates a waveform with a frequency
that is proportional to the speed of the vehicle. If the vehicle is moving at a relatively low speed, the
sensor produces a signal with a low frequency. As the vehicle velocity increases, the sensor
generates a signal with a higher frequency. The PCM uses the frequency signal generated by the
VSS (and other inputs) to control such parameters as fuel injection, ignition control,
transmission/transaxle shift scheduling, and torque converter clutch scheduling.
Typical Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
Typical Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3324
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle
Position Sensor
Engine Control Components
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle Position Sensor
The ETB throttle position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant
ETB throttle position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB throttle position
sensor signal (TP1) has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second
signal (TP2) has a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). The 2 ETB throttle position
sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There is
1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor. The reference voltage circuit
and the signal return circuit is shared with the reference voltage circuits and signal return circuits
used by the APP sensor. For additional information, refer to Torque Based Electronic Throttle
Control (ETC) See: Electronic Throttle Control Module/Description and Operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle Position Sensor > Page 3327
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
Engine Control Components
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases the corrosion resistance on the
terminals and increases the connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body.
As the TP sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, four operating conditions are determined by the
PCM from the TP. These are:
- closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration)
- part throttle (includes cruise or moderate acceleration)
- wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on crank)
- throttle angle rate
Typical TP Sensor
Typical TP Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3328
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
Removal
1. Remove the Throttle Body (TB).
2. NOTICE: Do not put direct heat on the Throttle Position (TP) sensor or any other plastic parts
because heat damage may occur. Damage
may also occur if Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) temperature exceeds 120°C (248°F).
NOTE: Do not use power tools.
Remove the TP sensor.
1. Using a suitable heat gun, apply heat to the top of the ETB until the top TP sensor bolt ear
reaches approximately 55°C (130°F), this should
take no more than 3 minutes using an 1,100-watt heat gun. The heat gun should be about 25.4 mm
(1 in) away from the ETB.
2. Monitor the temperature of the top TP sensor bolt ear on the ETB with a suitable temperature
measuring device, such as a digital temperature
laser or infrared thermometer, while heating the ETB.
3. Using hand tools, quickly remove the bolt farthest from the heat source first and discard.
4. Using hand tools, remove the remaining bolt and discard.
5. Remove and discard the TP sensor.
Installation
1. NOTE: When installing the new TP sensor, make sure that the radial locator tab on the TP
sensor is aligned with the radial locator hole on the
ETB.
NOTE: Do not use power tools.
Install the new TP sensor. Using hand tools, install the 2 new bolts. Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
2. Install the TB.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Variable Valve Timing Actuator: > 10-18-4 >
Sep > 10 > Engine - Low Frequency Hot Idle Knocking Noise
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Customer Interest Engine - Low Frequency Hot Idle Knocking
Noise
TSB 10-18-4
09/27/10
LOW FREQUENCY ENGINE KNOCKING NOISE AT HOT IDLE
FORD: 2009-2010 Expedition, F-150, F-250, F-350
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 09-23-7 to update the vehicle model lines, Service Procedure and
Service Labor Time Standards.
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 F-150 and F-Super Duty vehicles equipped with a 4.6L 3V or 5.4L 3V
engine, Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a low frequency knocking noise from the
engine at hot idle only. The noise is predominately heard from the right front wheel well area and/or
the right hand (RH) engine cam cover. This noise may be generated from the RH variable camshaft
timing (VCT) phaser assembly. This procedure was created to diagnose the RH VCT phaser
assembly.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) tests were developed specifically for the vehicles and
Power Control Module (PCM) strategies for these vehicles.
Per Workshop Manual (WSM), Powertrain Controls and Emissions Diagnostics (PC/ED) and
Scheduled Maintenance Guide, review customer service history for use of any aftermarket oil
filters.
1. Check for possible diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs).
a. No DTCs present, proceed to Step 2.
b. If DTCs are present, do not continue with this procedure and refer to the PC/ED manual for
diagnostics.
2. Engine must be at full operating temperature over 190 °F (88 °C) cylinder head temperature
(CHT).
3. Connect IDS diagnostics tool and verify software version is at the latest level (63 or later
required).
4. Begin a new vehicle session.
5. Open Tool Box selection.
6. Open Data Logger.
7. Select Powertrain Engine.
8. Select PCM Data Logger.
9. Clear the preselected items by clicking the eraser icon button.
10. Select variable cam timing desired angle number (VCLDSD).
11. Go to live display and press the tick mark.
12. Make sure the parameter identification (PID) is highlighted with the dark lines above and below
the data being displayed.
13. Press number symbol: (output state control mode) of the VCT_DSD number PID.
14. Press the Control Item Activate (finger on the button) icon to enable manual control of the PID.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Variable Valve Timing Actuator: > 10-18-4 >
Sep > 10 > Engine - Low Frequency Hot Idle Knocking Noise > Page 3337
15. Use the plus button to command to 4 degrees. (One click is equal to 1 degree) When
commanding the advance, both banks will normally adjust.
16. Listen carefully to the low frequency knock noise while commanding the VCT_DSD from 0 to 4
degrees. Some higher frequency clatter is normal
at or above the 5 degree advance. What is being pursued is for the level of the low frequency
knock noise to be noticeably reduced when advanced from 4 to 5 degrees.
a. If noise level is noticeably reduced as the VCT desired angle is commanded from 3 to 4 degrees,
the noise source is the RH VCT phaser
assembly. Proceed to Step 17.
b. If the low frequency knock noise is not noticeably reduced at 4 degrees, refer to WSM, Section
303-00 for engine noise diagnostics.
17. Due to normal engine dynamics, the VCT phaser knock noise is produced by the RH VCT
phaser assembly. Replace only the RH VCT phaser
assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 303-01.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT:Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101804A 2009-2010 Expedition, 2.3 Hrs
Navigator 5.4L 3V: Replace The RH VCT Phaser Assembly Includes Time To Diagnose (Do Not
Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101804A 2009-2010 F-150 4.6L 3V: 1.8 Hrs.
Replace The RH VCT Phaser Assembly Includes Time To Diagnose (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101804A 2009-2010 F-150, F-Super 2.1 Hrs.
Duty 5.4L 3V: Replace The RH VCT Phaser Assembly Includes Time To Diagnose (Do Not Use
With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
6A257 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Variable Valve Timing Actuator: >
10-18-4 > Sep > 10 > Engine - Low Frequency Hot Idle Knocking Noise
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Low Frequency Hot Idle
Knocking Noise
TSB 10-18-4
09/27/10
LOW FREQUENCY ENGINE KNOCKING NOISE AT HOT IDLE
FORD: 2009-2010 Expedition, F-150, F-250, F-350
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 09-23-7 to update the vehicle model lines, Service Procedure and
Service Labor Time Standards.
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 F-150 and F-Super Duty vehicles equipped with a 4.6L 3V or 5.4L 3V
engine, Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a low frequency knocking noise from the
engine at hot idle only. The noise is predominately heard from the right front wheel well area and/or
the right hand (RH) engine cam cover. This noise may be generated from the RH variable camshaft
timing (VCT) phaser assembly. This procedure was created to diagnose the RH VCT phaser
assembly.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) tests were developed specifically for the vehicles and
Power Control Module (PCM) strategies for these vehicles.
Per Workshop Manual (WSM), Powertrain Controls and Emissions Diagnostics (PC/ED) and
Scheduled Maintenance Guide, review customer service history for use of any aftermarket oil
filters.
1. Check for possible diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs).
a. No DTCs present, proceed to Step 2.
b. If DTCs are present, do not continue with this procedure and refer to the PC/ED manual for
diagnostics.
2. Engine must be at full operating temperature over 190 °F (88 °C) cylinder head temperature
(CHT).
3. Connect IDS diagnostics tool and verify software version is at the latest level (63 or later
required).
4. Begin a new vehicle session.
5. Open Tool Box selection.
6. Open Data Logger.
7. Select Powertrain Engine.
8. Select PCM Data Logger.
9. Clear the preselected items by clicking the eraser icon button.
10. Select variable cam timing desired angle number (VCLDSD).
11. Go to live display and press the tick mark.
12. Make sure the parameter identification (PID) is highlighted with the dark lines above and below
the data being displayed.
13. Press number symbol: (output state control mode) of the VCT_DSD number PID.
14. Press the Control Item Activate (finger on the button) icon to enable manual control of the PID.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Variable Valve Timing Actuator: >
10-18-4 > Sep > 10 > Engine - Low Frequency Hot Idle Knocking Noise > Page 3343
15. Use the plus button to command to 4 degrees. (One click is equal to 1 degree) When
commanding the advance, both banks will normally adjust.
16. Listen carefully to the low frequency knock noise while commanding the VCT_DSD from 0 to 4
degrees. Some higher frequency clatter is normal
at or above the 5 degree advance. What is being pursued is for the level of the low frequency
knock noise to be noticeably reduced when advanced from 4 to 5 degrees.
a. If noise level is noticeably reduced as the VCT desired angle is commanded from 3 to 4 degrees,
the noise source is the RH VCT phaser
assembly. Proceed to Step 17.
b. If the low frequency knock noise is not noticeably reduced at 4 degrees, refer to WSM, Section
303-00 for engine noise diagnostics.
17. Due to normal engine dynamics, the VCT phaser knock noise is produced by the RH VCT
phaser assembly. Replace only the RH VCT phaser
assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 303-01.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT:Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101804A 2009-2010 Expedition, 2.3 Hrs
Navigator 5.4L 3V: Replace The RH VCT Phaser Assembly Includes Time To Diagnose (Do Not
Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
101804A 2009-2010 F-150 4.6L 3V: 1.8 Hrs.
Replace The RH VCT Phaser Assembly Includes Time To Diagnose (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
101804A 2009-2010 F-150, F-Super 2.1 Hrs.
Duty 5.4L 3V: Replace The RH VCT Phaser Assembly Includes Time To Diagnose (Do Not Use
With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
6A257 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3344
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Description and Operation
Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) System
Overview
The VCT system enables rotation of the camshaft(s) relative to the crankshaft rotation as a function
of engine operating conditions. There are four types of VCT systems.
- Exhaust phase shifting (EPS) system - the exhaust cam is the active cam being retarded.
- Intake phase shifting (IPS) system - the intake cam is the active cam being advanced.
- Dual equal phase shifting (DEPS) system - both intake and exhaust cams are phase shifted and
equally advanced or retarded.
- Dual independent phase shifting (DIPS) system - where both the intake and exhaust cams are
shifted independently.
All systems have four operational modes: idle, part throttle, wide open throttle (WOT), and default
mode. At idle and low engine speeds with closed throttle, the powertrain control module (PCM)
determines the phase angle based on air flow, engine oil temperature and engine coolant
temperature. At part and wide open throttle the PCM determines the phase angle based on engine
RPM, load, and throttle position. VCT systems provide reduced emissions and enhanced engine
power, fuel economy and idle quality. IPS systems also have the added benefit of improved torque.
In addition, some VCT system applications can eliminate the need for an external exhaust gas
recirculation (EGR) system. The elimination of the EGR system is accomplished by controlling the
overlap time between the intake valve opening and exhaust valve closing. Currently, both the IPS
and DEPS systems are used.
The VCT system knocking and noise concerns are diagnosed in the Testing and Inspection
section. For additional information, refer to the Engine System - General Information. Verification of
incorrect VCT phasing on a warm engine operating below 1500 RPM can be isolated using a
stethoscope and by monitoring the VCTADV, VCTADVERR and VCTDC PIDs using a scan tool. If
the VCT phaser does not maintain correct valve timing, low oil pressure or oil flow restrictions are
primary possible causes. Verify correct oil pressure and flow, refer to the Engine System - General
Information.
Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) System
The VCT system consists of an electric hydraulic positioning control solenoid, a camshaft position
(CMP) sensor, and a trigger wheel. The CMP trigger wheel indicates the CMP signal for that bank.
A crankshaft position (CKP) sensor provides the PCM with crankshaft positioning information in 10
degree increments.
1. The PCM receives input signals from the intake air temperature (IAT), engine coolant
temperature (ECT), engine oil temperature (EOT), CMP,
throttle position (TP), mass air flow (MAF), and CKP sensors to determine the operating conditions
of the engine. At idle and low engine speeds with closed throttle, the PCM controls the camshaft
position based on ECT, EOT, IAT, and MAF. During part and wide open throttle, the camshaft
position is determined by engine RPM, load and throttle position. The VCT system does not
operate until the engine is at normal operating temperature.
2. The VCT system is enabled by the PCM when the correct conditions are met. 3. The CKP signal
is used as a reference for CMP positioning. 4. The VCT solenoid valve is an integral part of the
VCT system. The solenoid valve controls the flow of engine oil in the VCT actuator assembly.
As the PCM controls the duty cycle of the solenoid valve, oil pressure/flow advances or retards the
cam timing. Duty cycles near 0% or 100% represent rapid movement of the camshaft. Retaining a
fixed camshaft position is accomplished by dithering (oscillating) the solenoid valve duty cycle. The
PCM calculates and determines the desired camshaft position. It continually updates the VCT
solenoid duty cycle until the desired position is
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3345
achieved. A difference between the desired and actual camshaft position represents a position
error in the PCM VCT control loop. The PCM disables the VCT and places the camshaft in a
default position if a concern is detected. A related DTC is also set when the concern is detected.
5. When the VCT solenoid is energized, engine oil is allowed to flow to the VCT actuator assembly
which advances or retards the camshaft timing.
One half of the VCT actuator is coupled to the camshaft and the other half is connected to the
timing chain. Oil chambers between the two halves couple the camshaft to the timing chain. When
the flow of oil is shifted from one side of the chamber to the other, the differential change in oil
pressure forces the camshaft to rotate in either an advance or retard position depending on the oil
flow.
VCT System
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Solenoid >
Component Information > Locations > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Solenoid 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Solenoid >
Component Information > Locations > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Solenoid 1 > Page 3350
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Solenoid >
Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Solenoid 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Solenoid >
Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Solenoid 1 > Page 3353
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Solenoid >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3354
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid: Service and Repair
Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Oil Control Solenoid
NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the valve cover.
2. Remove the bolt and the Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) oil control solenoid.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Engine Control Components
Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
The OSS sensor provides the PCM with information about the rotational speed of an output shaft.
The PCM uses the information to control and diagnose powertrain behavior. In some applications,
the sensor is also used as the source of vehicle speed. The sensor may be physically located in
different places on the vehicle, depending upon the specific application. The design of each speed
sensor is unique and depends on which powertrain control feature uses the information that is
generated.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor > Page 3359
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
Engine Control Components
Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
The VSS is a variable reluctance or Hall-effect sensor that generates a waveform with a frequency
that is proportional to the speed of the vehicle. If the vehicle is moving at a relatively low speed, the
sensor produces a signal with a low frequency. As the vehicle velocity increases, the sensor
generates a signal with a higher frequency. The PCM uses the frequency signal generated by the
VSS (and other inputs) to control such parameters as fuel injection, ignition control,
transmission/transaxle shift scheduling, and torque converter clutch scheduling.
Typical Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
Typical Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Diverter Solenoid >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Air Diverter Solenoid: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Secondary Air Injection (AIR) Bypass Solenoid
The secondary AIR bypass solenoid is used by the PCM to control vacuum to the secondary air
injection diverter (AIR diverter) valve. The secondary AIR bypass solenoid is a normally closed
solenoid. The secondary AIR bypass solenoid also has a filtered vent feature to permit vacuum
release.
Secondary AIR Bypass Solenoid
Secondary AIR Bypass Solenoid
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Diverter Valve >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Air Diverter Valve: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Secondary AIR Diverter Valve
The secondary AIR diverter valve is used with the secondary AIR pump to provide on/off control of
air to the exhaust manifold and catalytic converter. When the secondary AIR pump is on and
vacuum is supplied to the AIR diverter valve, air passes the integral check valve disk. When the
secondary AIR pump is off, and vacuum is removed from the AIR diverter valve, the integral check
valve disk is held on the seat and stops air from being drawn into the exhaust system and prevents
the back flow of the exhaust into the secondary AIR system.
Secondary AIR Diverter Valve
Secondary AIR Diverter Valve
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Injection Pump >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Air Injection Pump: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Secondary AIR Pump
The secondary AIR pump provides pressurized air to the secondary AIR system. The secondary
AIR pump functions independently of RPM and is controlled by the PCM. The secondary AIR pump
is only used for short periods of time. Delivery of air is dependent on the amount of system
backpressure and system voltage. The secondary AIR pump draws dry filtered air from the intake
air system downstream of the mass air flow/intake air temperature sensor. For additional
information on the secondary AIR injection system, refer to Secondary Air Injection (AIR) System
See: Description and Operation.
Secondary Air Pump
Secondary Air Pump
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Catalytic Converter: Description and Operation
Catalyst and Exhaust Systems
Overview
The catalytic converter and exhaust systems work together to control the release of harmful engine
exhaust emissions into the atmosphere. The engine exhaust gas consists mainly of nitrogen (N),
carbon dioxide (CO2) and water (H2O). However, it also contains carbon monoxide (CO), oxides of
nitrogen (NOx), hydrogen (H), and various unburned hydrocarbons (HCs). The major air pollutants
of CO, NOx, and HCs, and their emission into the atmosphere must be controlled.
The exhaust system generally consists of an exhaust manifold, front exhaust pipe, front heated
oxygen sensor (HO2S), rear exhaust pipe, catalyst HO2S, a muffler, and an exhaust tailpipe. The
catalytic converter is typically installed between the front and rear exhaust pipes. On some vehicle
applications, more than one catalyst is used between the front and rear exhaust pipes. Catalytic
converter efficiency is monitored by the on board diagnostic (OBD) system strategy in the
powertrain control module (PCM). For information on the OBD catalyst monitor, refer to the
description for the Catalyst Efficiency Monitor See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Monitors, Trips, Drive Cycles and Readiness Codes/Catalyst Efficiency Monitor.
For most vehicles, only two HO2Ss are used in an exhaust stream. The front sensors
(HO2S11/HO2S21) before the catalyst are used for primary fuel control while the ones after the
catalyst (HO2S12/HO2S22) are used to monitor catalyst efficiency. However, some partial zero
emission vehicles (PZEVs) use three HO2Ss. The stream 1 sensor (HO2S11) located before the
catalyst is used for primary fuel control, the stream 2 sensor (HO2S12) is used to monitor the
light-off catalyst, and the stream 3 sensor (HO2S13) located after the catalyst is used for long term
fuel trim control to optimize catalyst efficiency (fore aft oxygen sensor control).
V-Engines
V-Engines
In-Line Engines
In-Line Engines
Catalytic Converter
A catalyst is a material that remains unchanged when it initiates and increases the speed of a
chemical reaction. A catalyst also enables a chemical reaction to occur at a lower temperature. The
concentration of exhaust gas products released to the atmosphere must be controlled. The
catalytic converter assists in this task. It contains a catalyst in the form of a specially treated
ceramic honeycomb structure saturated with catalytically active precious metals. As the exhaust
gases come in contact with the catalyst, they are changed into mostly harmless products. The
catalyst initiates and speeds up heat producing chemical reactions of the exhaust gas components
so they are used up as much as possible.
Light Off Catalyst
As the catalyst heats up, converter efficiency rises rapidly. The point at which conversion efficiency
exceeds 50% is called catalyst light off. For most catalysts this point occurs at 246°C to 302°C
(475°F to 575°F). A fast light catalyst is a three way catalytic converter (TWC) that is located as
close to the exhaust manifold as possible. Because the light off catalyst is located close to the
exhaust manifold it lights off faster and reduces emissions more quickly than the catalyst located
under the body. Once the catalyst lights off, the catalyst quickly reaches the maximum conversion
efficiency for that
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3374
catalyst.
Three Way Catalytic Converter (TWC) Conversion Efficiency
A TWC requires a stoichiometric fuel ratio, 14.7 pounds of air to 1 pound of fuel (14.7:1), for high
conversion efficiency. In order to achieve these high efficiencies, the air/fuel ratio must be tightly
controlled with a narrow window of stoichiometry. Deviations outside of this window greatly
decrease the conversion efficiency. For example a rich mixture decreases the HC and CO
conversion efficiency while a lean mixture decreases the NOx conversion efficiency.
TWC Conversion Efficiency Chart
TWC Conversion Efficiency Chart
Exhaust System
The purpose of the exhaust system is to convey engine emissions from the exhaust manifold to the
atmosphere. Engine exhaust emissions are directed from the engine exhaust manifold to the
catalytic converter through the front exhaust pipe. A HO2S is mounted on the front exhaust pipe
before the catalyst. The catalytic converter reduces the concentration of CO, unburned HCs, and
NOx in the exhaust emissions to an acceptable level. The reduced exhaust emissions are directed
from the catalytic converter past another HO2S mounted in the rear exhaust pipe and then on into
the muffler. Finally, the exhaust emissions are directed to the atmosphere through an exhaust
tailpipe.
On some PZEV, there is a total of three HO2Ss in the exhaust stream. One near the exhaust
manifold (stream 1), one in the middle of the light-off catalyst (stream 2), and the third (stream 3) is
mounted after the light-off catalyst.
Typical Bank 1 Catalyst 2 H2OS Configuration
Typical Bank 1 Catalyst 2 HO2S Configuration
Typical Bank 1 Catalyst 3 H2OS Configuration
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3375
Typical Bank 1 Catalyst 3 HO2S Configuration
Underbody Catalyst
The underbody catalyst is located after the light off catalyst. The underbody catalyst may be in line
with the light off catalyst, or the underbody catalyst may be common to two light off catalysts,
forming a Y pipe configuration. For an exact configuration of the catalyst and exhaust system for a
specific vehicle, refer to the Exhaust System for the exhaust system exploded view.
Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter
The TWC contains either platinum (Pt) and rhodium (Rh) or palladium (Pd) and rhodium (Rh). The
TWC catalyzes the oxidation reactions of unburned HCs and CO and the reduction reaction of
NOx. The 3-way conversion can be best accomplished by always operating the engine air fuel/ratio
at or close to stoichiometry.
Exhaust Manifold Runners
The exhaust manifold runners collect exhaust gases from engine cylinders. The number of exhaust
manifolds and exhaust manifold runners depends on the engine configuration and number of
cylinders.
Exhaust Pipes
Exhaust pipes are usually treated during manufacturing with an anti-corrosive coating agent to
increase the life of the product. The pipes serve as guides for the flow of exhaust gases from the
engine exhaust manifold through the catalytic converter and the muffler.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
The HO2Ss provide the PCM with information related to the oxygen content of the exhaust gas. For
additional information on the HO2S, refer to Engine Control Components See: Computers and
Control Systems/Description and Operation/Engine Control Components.
Muffler
Mufflers are usually treated during manufacturing with an anti-corrosive coating agent to increase
the life of the product. The muffler reduces the level of noise produced by the engine, and also
reduces the noise produced by exhaust gases as they travel from the catalytic converter to the
atmosphere.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3376
Catalytic Converter: Service and Repair
Exhaust System - Exploded View
Expedition and Navigator
NOTE: Rear Wheel Drive (RWD) shown, Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) similar.
Expedition EL and Navigator L
NOTE: Rear Wheel Drive (RWD) shown, Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) similar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3377
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Canister
Purge Control Valve: > 11-1-5 > Jan > 11 > Emissions - Rough Running/Hard Start/DTC's Set
Canister Purge Control Valve: Customer Interest Emissions - Rough Running/Hard Start/DTC's Set
TSB 11-1-5
01/25/11
RUNS ROUGH, HARD START AFTER REFUELING, AUDIBLE CLICKING NOISE UNDER
HOOD, AND/OR DTCS P0316, P144A, P1450, PO17X, P044X, P045X, BUILT ON OR BEFORE
11/1/2010
FORD: 2010-2011 Fusion 2009-2010 F-150 2009-2011 E-Series, Escape, Expedition 2011 F-250,
F-350
LINCOLN: 2011 MKZ 2009-2011 Navigator
MERCURY: 2010-2011 Milan 2009-2011 Mariner
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 F-150, 2009-2011 Expedition, Navigator, E-Series, Escape Hybrid,
Mariner Hybrid, 2010-2011 Fusion Hybrid, Milan Hybrid, 2011 MKZ Hybrid and F-Super Duty
250/350 equipped with a 6.2L engine and built on or before 11/1/2010, may exhibit a running rough
concern, hard start after refueling, audible clicking noise under the hood and/or diagnostic trouble
codes (DTCs) P0316, P144A, P1450, PO17X, P044X, P045X.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Replace the Evaporative Emission Canister Purge Valve. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section
303-13.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Canister
Purge Control Valve: > 11-1-5 > Jan > 11 > Emissions - Rough Running/Hard Start/DTC's Set > Page 3387
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
110105A 2009-2011 Expedition, 0.6 Hr.
Navigator, And Econoline 2009-2010 F-150: Check DTCs, And Replace The Evaporative Emission
Canister Purge Valve (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
110105A 2009-2011 Escape Hybrid, 0.7 Hr.
Mariner Hybrid, 2010-2011 Fusion Hybrid, Milan Hybrid, 2011 MKZ Hybrid, And 2011 F-Super Duty
6.2L: Check DTCs, And Replace The Evaporative Emission Canister Purge Valve (Do Not Use
With Any Other Labor Operations)
110105A 2009-2011 Econoline: 0.9 Hr.
Check DTCs, And Replace The Evaporative Emission Canister Purge Valve (Do Not Use With Any
Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9C915 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Canister Purge Control Valve: > 11-1-5 > Jan > 11 > Emissions - Rough Running/Hard Start/DTC's Set
Canister Purge Control Valve: All Technical Service Bulletins Emissions - Rough Running/Hard
Start/DTC's Set
TSB 11-1-5
01/25/11
RUNS ROUGH, HARD START AFTER REFUELING, AUDIBLE CLICKING NOISE UNDER
HOOD, AND/OR DTCS P0316, P144A, P1450, PO17X, P044X, P045X, BUILT ON OR BEFORE
11/1/2010
FORD: 2010-2011 Fusion 2009-2010 F-150 2009-2011 E-Series, Escape, Expedition 2011 F-250,
F-350
LINCOLN: 2011 MKZ 2009-2011 Navigator
MERCURY: 2010-2011 Milan 2009-2011 Mariner
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 F-150, 2009-2011 Expedition, Navigator, E-Series, Escape Hybrid,
Mariner Hybrid, 2010-2011 Fusion Hybrid, Milan Hybrid, 2011 MKZ Hybrid and F-Super Duty
250/350 equipped with a 6.2L engine and built on or before 11/1/2010, may exhibit a running rough
concern, hard start after refueling, audible clicking noise under the hood and/or diagnostic trouble
codes (DTCs) P0316, P144A, P1450, PO17X, P044X, P045X.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Replace the Evaporative Emission Canister Purge Valve. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section
303-13.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Canister Purge Control Valve: > 11-1-5 > Jan > 11 > Emissions - Rough Running/Hard Start/DTC's Set > Page 3393
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
110105A 2009-2011 Expedition, 0.6 Hr.
Navigator, And Econoline 2009-2010 F-150: Check DTCs, And Replace The Evaporative Emission
Canister Purge Valve (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
110105A 2009-2011 Escape Hybrid, 0.7 Hr.
Mariner Hybrid, 2010-2011 Fusion Hybrid, Milan Hybrid, 2011 MKZ Hybrid, And 2011 F-Super Duty
6.2L: Check DTCs, And Replace The Evaporative Emission Canister Purge Valve (Do Not Use
With Any Other Labor Operations)
110105A 2009-2011 Econoline: 0.9 Hr.
Check DTCs, And Replace The Evaporative Emission Canister Purge Valve (Do Not Use With Any
Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9C915 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3394
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3395
Canister Purge Control Valve: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Canister Purge Valve
The EVAP canister purge valve is part of the enhanced EVAP system that is controlled by the
PCM. This valve controls the flow of vapors (purging) from the EVAP canister to the intake manifold
during various engine operating modes. The EVAP canister purge valve is a normally closed valve.
The EVAP canister purge valve controls the flow of vapors by way of a solenoid, eliminating the
need for an electronic vacuum regulator and vacuum diaphragm. For E-Series, Escape/Mariner,
Expedition, F-Series, and Navigator, the PCM outputs a duty cycle between 0% and 100% to
control the EVAP canister purge valve. For all others, the PCM outputs a variable current between
0 mA and 1,000 mA to control the EVAP canister purge valve.
Typical EVAP Canister Purge Valve
Typical EVAP Canister Purge Valve (Part 1)
Typical EVAP Canister Purge Valve (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Evaporative Emission (EVAP) System
Components - Exploded View
Canister Purge Control Valve: Service and Repair Evaporative Emission (EVAP) System
Components - Exploded View
Evaporative Emission (EVAP) System Components - Exploded View
Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Canister Assembly
NOTE: 106L (28 gal) fuel tank vapor tubes shown, 125L (33 gal) similar.
EVAP Canister, Vent Solenoid and Dust Separator and Brackets
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Evaporative Emission (EVAP) System
Components - Exploded View > Page 3398
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Evaporative Emission (EVAP) System
Components - Exploded View > Page 3399
Canister Purge Control Valve: Service and Repair Evaporative Emission Canister Purge Valve
Evaporative Emission Canister Purge Valve
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Always disconnect the battery ground cable at the battery when working on an
evaporative emission (EVAP) system or fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are
always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
2. Disconnect the Evaporative Emission (EVAP) canister purge valve and hose electrical
connector.
3. Disconnect EVAP canister purge valve hose-to-intake manifold quick connect coupling.
4. Disconnect the EVAP canister-to-EVAP canister purge valve and hose assembly vapor tube
quick connect coupling.
5. Slide the EVAP canister purge valve and hose assembly off the bracket.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Carry out the Evaporative Emission System Leak Test. For additional information, refer to
Evaporative Emission System Leak Test See: Testing and Inspection.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Canister Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Evaporative Emission (EVAP) System
Components - Exploded View
Evaporative Canister Filter: Service and Repair Evaporative Emission (EVAP) System Components
- Exploded View
Evaporative Emission (EVAP) System Components - Exploded View
Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Canister Assembly
NOTE: 106L (28 gal) fuel tank vapor tubes shown, 125L (33 gal) similar.
EVAP Canister, Vent Solenoid and Dust Separator and Brackets
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Canister Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Evaporative Emission (EVAP) System
Components - Exploded View > Page 3404
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Service and Repair > Evaporative Emission (EVAP)
System Components - Exploded View
Evaporative Emission Control Canister: Service and Repair Evaporative Emission (EVAP) System
Components - Exploded View
Evaporative Emission (EVAP) System Components - Exploded View
Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Canister Assembly
NOTE: 106L (28 gal) fuel tank vapor tubes shown, 125L (33 gal) similar.
EVAP Canister, Vent Solenoid and Dust Separator and Brackets
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Service and Repair > Evaporative Emission (EVAP)
System Components - Exploded View > Page 3409
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Service and Repair > Evaporative Emission (EVAP)
System Components - Exploded View > Page 3410
Evaporative Emission Control Canister: Service and Repair Evaporative Emission Canister
Evaporative Emission Canister
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Always disconnect the battery ground cable at the battery when working on an
evaporative emission (EVAP) system or fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are
always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
NOTE: The Evaporative Emission (EVAP) canister vent solenoid and dust separator are an
assembly.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
3. Disconnect the EVAP canister vent solenoid electrical jumper from the wiring harness.
4. Disconnect the Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-EVAP canister
quick connect coupling.
5. Disconnect the EVAP canister purge valve vapor tube-to-EVAP canister quick connect coupling.
6. Disconnect the fresh air tube-to-canister vent solenoid and dust separator assembly quick
connect coupling.
7. Remove the EVAP canister assembly bracket-to-frame rail bolt in the rear.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (177 lb-in).
8. Remove the EVAP canister assembly bracket-to-frame rail bolt in the front.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (177 lb-in).
9. Remove the EVAP canister assembly bracket and exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter heat
shield-to-transmission crossmember bolt and
remove the EVAP canister assembly from the vehicle. To install, tighten to 20 Nm (177 lb-in).
10. Disconnect the EVAP canister vent solenoid electrical connector.
11. Remove the 5 EVAP canister-to-EVAP canister assembly bracket bolts.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
12. Remove the EVAP canister assembly from the EVAP canister assembly brackets.
13. Remove the canister vent solenoid and dust separator assembly from the EVAP canister.
14. NOTE: Inspect the EVAP canister heat shield and if damaged, install a new EVAP canister heat
shield.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. -
Carry out the Evaporative Emission System Leak Test. For additional information, refer to
Evaporative Emission System Leak Test See: Testing and Inspection.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Solenoid, Evaporative System > Component Information > Description and Operation
Leak Detection Solenoid: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Canister Vent (CV) Solenoid
During the evaporative emissions (EVAP) leak check monitor, the CV solenoid seals the EVAP
canister from the atmospheric pressure. This allows the EVAP canister purge valve to obtain the
target vacuum in the fuel tank during the EVAP leak check monitor.
Typical Canister Vent (CV) Solenoid
Typical Canister Vent (CV) Solenoid
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Valve, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations
Leak Detection Valve: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Valve, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 3417
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Valve, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 3418
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Valve, Evaporative System > Component Information > Service and Repair > Evaporative Emission (EVAP)
System Components - Exploded View
Leak Detection Valve: Service and Repair Evaporative Emission (EVAP) System Components Exploded View
Evaporative Emission (EVAP) System Components - Exploded View
Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Canister Assembly
NOTE: 106L (28 gal) fuel tank vapor tubes shown, 125L (33 gal) similar.
EVAP Canister, Vent Solenoid and Dust Separator and Brackets
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Valve, Evaporative System > Component Information > Service and Repair > Evaporative Emission (EVAP)
System Components - Exploded View > Page 3421
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Valve, Evaporative System > Component Information > Service and Repair > Evaporative Emission (EVAP)
System Components - Exploded View > Page 3422
Leak Detection Valve: Service and Repair Evaporative Emission Canister Vent Solenoid
Evaporative Emission Canister Vent Solenoid
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Always disconnect the battery ground cable at the battery when working on an
evaporative emission (EVAP) system or fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are
always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
NOTE: The Evaporative Emission (EVAP) canister vent solenoid and dust separator are an
assembly.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
3. Disconnect the EVAP canister vent solenoid electrical jumper from the wiring harness.
4. Disconnect the Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-EVAP canister
quick connect coupling.
5. Disconnect the EVAP canister purge valve vapor tube-to-EVAP canister quick connect coupling.
6. Disconnect the fresh air tube-to-canister vent solenoid and dust separator assembly quick
connect coupling.
7. Remove the EVAP canister assembly bracket-to-frame rail bolt in the rear.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (177 lb-in).
8. Remove the EVAP canister assembly bracket-to-frame rail bolt in the front.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (177 lb-in).
9. Remove the EVAP canister assembly bracket and exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter heat
shield-to-transmission crossmember bolt and
remove the EVAP canister assembly from the vehicle. To install, tighten to 20 Nm (177 lb-in).
10. Disconnect the EVAP canister vent solenoid electrical connector.
11. Remove the 2 EVAP canister-to-EVAP canister assembly bracket bolts in the front of the
canister.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
12. Remove the canister vent solenoid and dust separator assembly from the EVAP canister.
13. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Carry out the Evaporative Emission System Leak Test. For additional information, refer to
Evaporative Emission System Leak Test See: Testing and Inspection.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Electronic Vacuum Regulator Solenoid > Component Information > Description and Operation
EGR Electronic Vacuum Regulator Solenoid: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Vacuum Regulator Solenoid
The EGR vacuum regulator solenoid is an electromagnetic device used to regulate the vacuum
supply to the EGR valve. The solenoid contains a coil which magnetically controls the position of a
disc to regulate the vacuum. As the duty cycle to the coil increases, the vacuum signal passed
through the solenoid to the EGR valve also increases. Vacuum not directed to the EGR valve is
vented through the solenoid vent to atmosphere. Note that at 0% duty cycle (no electrical signal
applied), the EGR vacuum regulator solenoid allows some vacuum to pass, but not enough to open
the EGR valve.
EGR Vacuum Regulator Solenoid
EGR Vacuum Regulator Solenoid
EGR Vacuum Regulator Solenoid Duty Cycle Graph
EGR Vacuum Regulator Solenoid Data
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR Tube
> Component Information > Description and Operation
EGR Tube: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Orifice Tube Assembly
The orifice tube assembly is a section of tubing connecting the exhaust system to the intake
manifold. The assembly provides the flow path for the EGR to the intake manifold and also
contains the metering orifice and two pressure pick-up tubes. The internal metering orifice creates
a measurable pressure drop across it as the EGR valve opens and closes. This pressure
differential across the orifice is picked up by the differential pressure feedback EGR sensor which
provides feedback to the PCM.
EGR Orifice Tube Assembly
EGR Orifice Tube Assembly
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR Valve
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EEGR) Valve
EGR Valve: Description and Operation Electric Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EEGR) Valve
Engine Control Components
Electric Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EEGR) Valve
Depending on the application, the EEGR valve is a water cooled or an air cooled motor/valve
assembly. The motor is commanded to move in 52 discrete steps as it acts directly on the EEGR
valve. The position of the valve determines the rate of EGR. The built-in spring works to close the
valve (against the motor opening force).
EEGR Motor/Valve Assembly
EEGR Motor/Valve Assembly
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR Valve
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EEGR) Valve > Page 3434
EGR Valve: Description and Operation Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) System Module (ESM)
Engine Control Components
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) System Module (ESM)
The ESM is an integrated differential pressure feedback EGR system that functions in the same
manner as a conventional differential pressure feedback EGR system. The various system
components have been integrated into a single component called the ESM. The flange of the valve
portion of the ESM bolts directly to the intake manifold with a metal gasket that forms the metering
orifice. This arrangement increases system reliability, response time, and system precision. By
relocating the EGR orifice from the exhaust to the intake side of the EGR valve, the downstream
pressure signal measures manifold absolute pressure (MAP). This MAP signal is used for EGR
correction and inferred barometric pressure (BARO) at ignition on. The system provides the PCM
with a differential pressure feedback EGR signal, identical to a traditional differential pressure
feedback EGR system.
ESM
ESM (Part 1)
ESM (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR Valve
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EEGR) Valve > Page 3435
EGR Valve: Description and Operation Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Valve
Engine Control Components
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Valve
The EGR valve in the differential pressure feedback EGR system is a conventional,
vacuum-actuated valve. The valve increases or decreases the flow of EGR. As vacuum applied to
the EGR valve diaphragm overcomes the spring force, the valve begins to open. As the vacuum
signal weakens, at 5.4 kPa (1.6 in-Hg) or less, the spring force closes the valve. The EGR valve is
fully open at about 15 kPa (4.5 in-Hg).
Since EGR flow requirement varies greatly, providing repair specifications on flow rate is
impractical. The on board diagnostic (OBD) system monitors the EGR valve function and triggers a
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) if the test criteria is not met. The EGR valve flow rate is not
measured directly as part of the diagnostic procedures.
Typical EGR Valve
Typical EGR Valve (Part 1)
Typical EGR Valve (Part 2)
EGR Flow Rate Graph
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > Pressure
Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description and Operation
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer
that monitors the differential pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly.
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as
the downstream pressure hose (REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI
and REF hose connections are marked on the differential pressure feedback EGR sensor housing
for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger diameter hose). The differential pressure
feedback EGR sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the metering
orifice and supplies it to the PCM as EGR flow rate feedback.
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
The tube mounted differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is identical in operation as the larger
plastic differential pressure feedback EGR sensors and uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF
hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation > PCV
Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair
PCV Heater: Service and Repair
Positive Crankcase Ventilation (PCV) Heater Element
Air Intake Resonator and PCV Tube
Heated PCV Heater Element
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation > PCV
Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3443
Removal
1. Release the clamp and remove the bolt and the air intake resonator assembly.
2. Disconnect the quick connect couplings and remove the PCV tube.
3. Disconnect the PCV heater element electrical connector.
4. Remove the 2 bolts and the PCV heater element.
- Discard the O-ring seal.
Installation
1. NOTE: Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Using a new O-ring seal, install the PCV heater element and the 2 bolts.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
2. Connect the PCV heater element electrical connector.
3. Position the PCV tube and connect the quick connect couplings.
4. Position the air intake resonator assembly, install the bolt and the clamp.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve > Component Information > Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description and Operation
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer
that monitors the differential pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly.
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as
the downstream pressure hose (REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI
and REF hose connections are marked on the differential pressure feedback EGR sensor housing
for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger diameter hose). The differential pressure
feedback EGR sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the metering
orifice and supplies it to the PCM as EGR flow rate feedback.
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
The tube mounted differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is identical in operation as the larger
plastic differential pressure feedback EGR sensors and uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF
hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System Information
> Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
Fuel Pressure
Engine running.....................................................................................................................................
..............................................379-414 kPa (55-60 psi) Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).........................
..................................................................................................................................379-414 kPa
(55-60 psi)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System Information
> Specifications > Page 3455
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection
Fuel System Pressure Test
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Before working on or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components,
relieve the fuel system pressure to prevent accidental spraying of fuel. Fuel in the fuel system
remains under high pressure, even when the engine is not running. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
WARNING: When handling fuel, always observe fuel handling precautions and be prepared in the
event of fuel spillage. Spilled fuel may be ignited by hot vehicle components or other ignition
sources. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
1. Remove the cap from the fuel pressure relief valve located on the fuel rail.
2. Install the Fuel Pressure Test Kit onto the fuel pressure relief valve.
3. Test the fuel system pressure to make sure it is within the specified range. For additional
information, refer to Specifications.
4. NOTE: Open the drain valve slowly to relieve the fuel system pressure. This may drain fuel from
the system. Place fuel in a suitable container.
Upon completion of the fuel system pressure test, open the drain valve on the Fuel Pressure Test
Kit and relieve the fuel system pressure.
5. NOTE: It may take more than one key cycle to pressurize the fuel system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System Information
> Specifications > Page 3456
Cycle the ignition key and wait 3 seconds to pressurize the fuel system. Check for leaks before
starting the engine.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Release > System
Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
Fuel System Pressure Release
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Before working on or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components,
relieve the fuel system pressure to prevent accidental spraying of fuel. Fuel in the fuel system
remains under high pressure, even when the engine is not running. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: When handling fuel, always observe fuel handling precautions and be prepared in the
event of fuel spillage. Spilled fuel may be ignited by hot vehicle components or other ignition
sources. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
2. Remove the cap from the fuel pressure relief valve located on the fuel rail.
3. Install the Fuel Pressure Test Kit onto the fuel pressure relief valve.
4. NOTE: Open the manual valve slowly to relieve the system pressure. This may drain fuel from
the fuel system. Place fuel in a suitable container.
Open the manual valve on the Fuel Pressure Test Kit and relieve the fuel pressure.
5. NOTE: It may take more than one key cycle to pressurize the fuel system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Release > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3460
Cycle the ignition key and wait 3 seconds to pressurize the fuel system. Check for leaks before
starting the engine.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed > System Information >
Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Typical Diagnostic Reference Value
Measured/PID Values 695 RPM ..........................................................................................................
..................................................................................................... Hot Idle
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Adjustable Pedals - Without Memory Feature
Accelerator Pedal: Description and Operation Adjustable Pedals - Without Memory Feature
Adjustable Pedals
Adjustable brake and accelerator pedals are available as an optional feature on this vehicle. The
brake pedal position can be changed in phase with the accelerator pedal to increase driver comfort.
Two different adjustable pedal systems are available; one that is connected to the memory feature
option and one that is not connected to the memory feature option.
Without Memory Feature
Adjustable brake pedals without memory feature consist of the following components:
- Adjustable brake pedal and bracket
- Adjustable accelerator pedal and bracket, refer to Throttle Cable/Linkage.
- Adjustable pedal switch
- Adjustable pedal motor
- Adjustable pedal cables
The pedals are adjusted through the use of a rocker switch mounted on the instrument panel.
When the switch is pressed, voltage is sent to the motor which spins a cable that is attached to the
adjustable brake pedal. As the cable spins, the pedals move either forward (away from the driver)
or rearward (toward the driver) depending on how the switch is pressed.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Adjustable Pedals - Without Memory Feature > Page 3468
Accelerator Pedal: Description and Operation Adjustable Pedals - With Memory Feature
Adjustable Pedals
Adjustable brake and accelerator pedals are available as an optional feature on this vehicle. The
brake pedal position can be changed in phase with the accelerator pedal to increase driver comfort.
Two different adjustable pedal systems are available; one that is connected to the memory feature
option and one that is not connected to the memory feature option.
With Memory Feature
Adjustable brake and accelerator pedals are available as an optional feature on this vehicle. The
brake pedal position can be changed in phase with the accelerator pedal to increase driver comfort.
Two different adjustable pedal systems are available; one that is connected to the memory feature
option and one that is not connected to the memory feature option.
Adjustable brake pedals with memory feature consist of the following components:
- Driver Seat Module (DSM), refer to Seats
- Memory SET switch, refer to Seats
- Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter, refer to Locks
- Adjustable brake pedal and bracket
- Adjustable accelerator pedal and bracket, refer to Throttle Cable/Linkage
- Adjustable pedal switch
- Adjustable pedal motor
- Adjustable pedal cables
The pedals are adjusted through the use of a rocker switch mounted on the instrument panel, the
memory SET switch mounted on the seat trim panel or the door trim panel or the RKE transmitter.
When the switch is pressed or the transmitter is activated, a voltage signal is sent to the DSM. The
DSM then sends voltage to the adjustable pedal motor which spins a cable that is attached to the
adjustable brake pedal. As the cable spins, the pedals move either forward (away from the driver)
or rearward (toward the driver) depending on how the switch is pressed and/or current pedal
position.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Accelerator Pedal - Fixed
Accelerator Pedal: Service and Repair Accelerator Pedal - Fixed
Accelerator Pedal - Fixed
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor electrical connector.
2. Remove the 3 bolts and the accelerator pedal assembly.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Accelerator Pedal - Fixed > Page 3471
Accelerator Pedal: Service and Repair Accelerator Pedal - Adjustable
Accelerator Pedal - Adjustable
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The brake pedal and the accelerator pedal must be in the same position when installing a
new cable or a new pedal. The pedals must be in the all the way forward or the all the way
rearward position.
1. Disconnect the Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor electrical connector.
2. Remove the 3 bolts and the accelerator pedal assembly.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3475
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3476
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3477
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
amount of torque requested by the operator. Depending on the application either a 2-track or
3-track APP sensor is used.
2-Track APP Sensor
There are two pedal position signals in the sensor. Both signals, APP1 and APP2, have a positive
slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage), but are offset and increase at different rates. The two
pedal position signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if one signal has a
concern. The PCM determines if a signal is incorrect by calculating where it should be, inferred
from the other signals. If a concern is present with one of the circuits the other input is used. There
are two reference voltage circuits, two signal return circuits, and two signal circuits (a total of six
circuits and pins) between the PCM and the APP sensor assembly. The reference voltage circuits
and the signal return circuits are shared with the reference voltage circuit and signal return circuit
used by the electronic throttle body (ETB) throttle position (TP) sensor. The pedal position signal is
converted to pedal travel degrees (rotary angle) by the PCM. The software then converts these
degrees to counts, which is the input to the torque based strategy. For additional information, refer
to Torque Based Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) See: Computers and Control Systems/Electronic
Throttle Control Module/Description and Operation.
2-Track APP Sensor
Typical 2-Track APP Sensor
3-Track APP Sensor
There are three pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APP1, has a negative slope
(increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APP2 and APP3, both have a positive
slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APP1 is used as the
indication of pedal position by the strategy. The three pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if one signal has a concern. The PCM determines if a signal is
incorrect by calculating where it should be, inferred from the other signals. If a concern is present
with one of the circuits the other inputs are used. The pedal position signal is converted to pedal
travel degrees (rotary angle) by the PCM. The software then converts these degrees to counts,
which is the input to the torque based strategy. There are two reference voltage circuits, two signal
return circuits, and three signal circuits (a total of seven circuits and pins) between the PCM and
the APP sensor assembly. The reference voltage circuits and the signal return circuits are shared
with the reference voltage circuit and signal return circuit used by the electronic throttle body (ETB)
throttle position sensor. For additional information, refer to Torque Based Electronic Throttle
Control (ETC) See: Computers and Control Systems/Electronic Throttle Control Module/Description
and Operation.
3-Track APP Sensor
Typical 3-Track APP Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Intake Air System Components - Exploded View
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Intake Air System Components - Exploded View
Intake Air System Components - Exploded View
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Intake Air System Components - Exploded View > Page 3483
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Air Cleaner Element
Air Cleaner Element
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the Air Cleaner (ACL) outlet pipe from the ACL cover.
- To install, tighten the clamps to 4 Nm (35 lb-in).
2. Disconnect the Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector.
3. Release the retaining clips and position the ACL cover aside.
4. Remove the ACL element.
5. NOTE: The ACL element must be fully seated into the ACL housing. Failure to do so will result in
unusual engine noise.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3487
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3488
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic Engine Controls
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Engine Controls
Electronic Engine Controls
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor:
- sends the PCM a signal indicating mass airflow rate of air entering the engine.
- incorporates the Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor.
For removal and installation, refer to Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor See: Service and Repair.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic Engine Controls > Page 3491
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Engine Control Components
Engine Control Components
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. The current required to
maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow. The MAF sensor then
outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air mass. The PCM
calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired air/fuel ratio. This
input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC), shift and torque
converter clutch (TCC) scheduling.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly. Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology with an integrated IAT sensor.
The hot wire electronic sensing element must be replaced as an assembly. Replacing only the
element may change the air flow calibration.
Diagram of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot and Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Diagram of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot and Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals.
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic Engine Controls > Page 3492
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3493
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector.
2. Remove the 2 bolts and the MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filler Cap Warning Indicator >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Filler Cap Warning Indicator: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Check Fuel Cap Indicator
The check fuel cap indicator is a communications network message sent by the PCM. The PCM
sends the message to illuminate the lamp when the strategy determines there is a concern in the
EVAP system due to the fuel filler cap or capless fuel tank filler pipe not being sealed correctly.
This is detected by the inability to pull vacuum in the fuel tank after a fueling event.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure Release
> System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
Fuel System Pressure Release
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Before working on or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components,
relieve the fuel system pressure to prevent accidental spraying of fuel. Fuel in the fuel system
remains under high pressure, even when the engine is not running. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: When handling fuel, always observe fuel handling precautions and be prepared in the
event of fuel spillage. Spilled fuel may be ignited by hot vehicle components or other ignition
sources. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
2. Remove the cap from the fuel pressure relief valve located on the fuel rail.
3. Install the Fuel Pressure Test Kit onto the fuel pressure relief valve.
4. NOTE: Open the manual valve slowly to relieve the system pressure. This may drain fuel from
the fuel system. Place fuel in a suitable container.
Open the manual valve on the Fuel Pressure Test Kit and relieve the fuel pressure.
5. NOTE: It may take more than one key cycle to pressurize the fuel system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure Release
> System Information > Service and Repair > Page 3501
Cycle the ignition key and wait 3 seconds to pressurize the fuel system. Check for leaks before
starting the engine.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Fuel Injector: Electrical Specifications
Fuel Injector Resistance ......................................................................................................................
............................................................. 11 - 18 Ohms
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 3506
Fuel Injector: Pressure, Vacuum and Temperature Specifications
Fuel Injector Flow and Leakage ...................................................................................... Refer to
Pinpoint Test HC12 at Computers and Control Systems.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 3509
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 3510
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 3511
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 3512
Fuel Injector: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 3513
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 3514
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 3515
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 3516
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 3517
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 3518
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 3519
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3520
Fuel Injector: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Fuel Injectors
Note: Do not apply battery positive voltage (B+) directly to the fuel injector electrical connector
terminals. The solenoids may be damaged internally in a matter of seconds.
The fuel injector is a solenoid-operated valve that meters fuel flow to the engine. The fuel injector is
opened and closed a constant number of times per crankshaft revolution. The amount of fuel is
controlled by the length of time the fuel injector is held open.
The fuel injector is normally closed, and is operated by a 12-volt source from either the electronic
engine control (EEC) power relay or fuel pump relay. The ground signal is controlled by the PCM.
The injector is the deposit resistant injector (DRI) type and does not have to be cleaned. Install a
new fuel injector if the flow is checked and found to be out of specification.
Typical Fuel Injector
Typical Fuel Injector (Part 1)
Typical Fuel Injector (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Rail And Fuel Injector - Exploded View
Fuel Injector: Service and Repair Fuel Rail And Fuel Injector - Exploded View
Fuel Rail and Fuel Injector - Exploded View
Air Cleaner (ACL) Outlet Pipe-To-Throttle Body (TB) Adapter, Air Intake Resonator and PCV Tube
Fuel Rail and Fuel Injectors
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Rail And Fuel Injector - Exploded View > Page 3523
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Vapor Tube Fittings
Fuel Line Coupler: Service and Repair Vapor Tube Fittings
Vapor Tube Fittings
Disconnect
WARNING: Always disconnect the battery ground cable at the battery when working on an
evaporative emission (EVAP) system or fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are
always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
NOTICE: When reusing liquid or vapor tube connectors, make sure to use compressed air to
remove any foreign material from the connector retaining clip area before separating from the tube
or damage to the tube or connector retaining clip can occur. Apply clean engine oil to the end of the
tube before inserting the tube into the connector.
NOTICE: Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances.
It is essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components or
component damage can occur. Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
2. NOTICE: Do not use any tools. The use of tools may cause a deformity in the clip components
which may cause fuel leaks.
Disconnect the vapor tube fitting.
- Push the connector toward the tube or fitting to release pressure.
- Press the quick connect fitting button and pull the fuel tube to disconnect.
Connect
1. Inspect and clean both quick connect coupling ends.
2. NOTE: Make sure the fuel tube clicks into place when installing the tube. To make sure that the
fuel tube is fully seated, pull on the tube.
NOTE: Apply clean engine oil to the end of the tube or fitting before connecting.
Connect the vapor tube fitting.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Vapor Tube Fittings > Page 3528
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Vapor Tube Fittings > Page 3529
Fuel Line Coupler: Service and Repair Quick Connect Coupling
Quick Connect Coupling
Disconnect - Type I
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
NOTICE: When reusing liquid or vapor tube connectors, make sure to use compressed air to
remove any foreign material from the connector retaining clip area before separating from the tube
or damage to the tube or connector retaining clip can occur. Apply clean engine oil to the end of the
tube before inserting the tube into the connector.
NOTICE: Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances.
It is essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components or
component damage can occur. Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
1. NOTICE: Do not use any tools. The use of tools may cause a deformity in the clip components
which may cause fuel leaks.
Disconnect the quick connect coupling.
- Push the connector toward the tube to release pressure.
- Push the release tab clockwise.
- Disconnect the quick connect coupling.
Connect - Type I
1. Inspect and clean both quick connect coupling ends.
2. NOTICE: Do not use any tools. The use of tools may cause a deformity in the clip components
which may cause fuel leaks.
NOTE: Make sure the fuel tube clicks into place when installing the tube. To make sure that the
fuel tube is fully seated, pull on the tube.
NOTE: Apply clean engine oil to the end of the tube and the quick connect coupling O-ring seals.
Connect the quick connect coupling.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Vapor Tube Fittings > Page 3530
Disconnect - Type II
WARNING: Always disconnect the battery ground cable at the battery when working on an
evaporative emission (EVAP) system or fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are
always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
WARNING: When handling fuel, always observe fuel handling precautions and be prepared in the
event of fuel spillage. Spilled fuel may be ignited by hot vehicle components or other ignition
sources. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Before working on or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components,
relieve the fuel system pressure to prevent accidental spraying of fuel. Fuel in the fuel system
remains under high pressure, even when the engine is not running. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
NOTICE: When reusing liquid or vapor tube connectors, make sure to use compressed air to
remove any foreign material from the connector retaining clip area before separating from the tube
or damage to the tube or connector retaining clip can occur. Apply clean engine oil to the end of the
tube before inserting the tube into the connector.
NOTICE: Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances.
It is essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components or
component damage can occur. Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
1. If servicing a liquid fuel tube quick connect coupling, release the fuel system pressure. For
additional information, refer to Fuel System Pressure
Release See: Fuel Filter/Fuel Pressure Release/Service and Repair.
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
3. NOTICE: Do not use any tools. The use of tools may cause a deformity in the clip components
which may cause fuel leaks.
NOTE: When reusing liquid or vapor tube quick connect couplings, make sure to use compressed
air to remove any foreign material from the tube. Apply clean engine oil to the end of the tube
before connecting the quick connect coupling.
Spread the legs of the retainer clip and pull it to the outward position in the quick connect coupling.
4. Depress the retainer clip and disconnect the quick connect coupling from the tube.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Vapor Tube Fittings > Page 3531
Connect - Type II
1. Install the quick connect coupling onto the tube until fully seated.
2. NOTICE: Do not use any tools. The use of tools may cause a deformity in the clip components
which may cause fuel leaks.
NOTE: Make sure the retainer clip is fully seated and locked onto the tube by pulling on the quick
connect coupling.
Press the retainer clip into the quick connect coupling body until flush and the legs are locked in
place.
3. Connect the battery ground cable.
Disconnect - Type III
WARNING: Always disconnect the battery ground cable at the battery when working on an
evaporative emission (EVAP) system or fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are
always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
WARNING: Before working on or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components,
relieve the fuel system pressure to prevent accidental spraying of fuel. Fuel in the fuel system
remains under high pressure, even when the engine is not running. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: When handling fuel, always observe fuel handling precautions and be prepared in the
event of fuel spillage. Spilled fuel may be ignited by hot vehicle components or other ignition
sources. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
NOTICE: When reusing liquid or vapor tube connectors, make sure to use compressed air to
remove any foreign material from the connector retaining clip area before separating from the tube
or damage to the tube or connector retaining clip can occur. Apply clean engine oil to the end of the
tube before inserting the tube into the connector.
NOTICE: Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances.
It is essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components or
component damage can occur. Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
1. If servicing a liquid fuel tube, release the fuel system pressure. For additional information, refer
to Fuel System Pressure Release See: Fuel
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Vapor Tube Fittings > Page 3532
Filter/Fuel Pressure Release/Service and Repair.
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
3. NOTICE: Do not use any tools. The use of tools may cause a deformity in the clip components
which may cause fuel leaks.
Disconnect the fuel tube quick connect coupling.
- Press the fuel tube quick connect coupling button and pull the fuel tube to disconnect.
Connect - Type III
1. Inspect and clean both quick connect coupling ends.
2. NOTE: Make sure the fuel tube clicks into place when installing the tube. To make sure that the
fuel tube is fully seated, pull on the tube.
NOTE: Apply clean engine oil to the end of the tube and the quick connect coupling O-ring seals.
Install the quick connect coupling onto the tube until it is fully seated.
3. Connect the battery ground cable.
Disconnect - Type IV
WARNING: Always disconnect the battery ground cable at the battery when working on an
evaporative emission (EVAP) system or fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are
always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
WARNING: Before working on or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components,
relieve the fuel system pressure to prevent accidental spraying of fuel. Fuel in the fuel system
remains under high pressure, even when the engine is not running. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: When handling fuel, always observe fuel handling precautions and be prepared in the
event of fuel spillage. Spilled fuel may be ignited by hot vehicle components or other ignition
sources. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
NOTICE: When reusing liquid or vapor tube connectors, make sure to use compressed air to
remove any foreign material from the connector retaining clip area before separating from the tube
or damage to the tube or connector retaining clip can occur. Apply clean engine oil to the end of the
tube before inserting the tube into the connector.
NOTICE: Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances.
It is essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components or
component damage can occur. Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Vapor Tube Fittings > Page 3533
1. If servicing a liquid fuel tube, release the fuel system pressure. For additional information, refer
to Fuel System Pressure Release See: Fuel
Filter/Fuel Pressure Release/Service and Repair.
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
3. NOTICE: Do not use any tools. The use of tools may cause a deformity in the clip components
which may cause fuel leaks.
Disconnect the fuel tube quick connect coupling.
- Press the 2 fuel tube quick connect coupling buttons and pull the fuel tube to disconnect.
Connect - Type IV
1. Inspect and clean both quick connect coupling ends.
2. NOTE: Make sure the fuel tube clicks into place when installing the tube. To make sure that the
fuel tube is fully seated, pull on the tube.
NOTE: Apply clean engine oil to the end of the tube and the quick connect coupling O-ring seals.
Install the quick connect coupling onto the tube until it is fully seated.
3. Connect the battery ground cable.
Disconnect - Type V
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
WARNING: Before working on or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components,
relieve the fuel system pressure to prevent accidental spraying of fuel. Fuel in the fuel system
remains under high pressure, even when the engine is not running. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: When handling fuel, always observe fuel handling precautions and be prepared in the
event of fuel spillage. Spilled fuel may be ignited by hot vehicle components or other ignition
sources. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Always disconnect the battery ground cable at the battery when working on an
evaporative emission (EVAP) system or fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are
always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
NOTICE: When reusing liquid or vapor tube connectors, make sure to use compressed air to
remove any foreign material from the connector retaining clip area before separating from the tube
or damage to the tube or connector retaining clip can occur. Apply clean engine oil to the end of the
tube before inserting the tube into the connector.
NOTICE: Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances.
It is essential that absolute cleanliness is
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Vapor Tube Fittings > Page 3534
observed when working with these components or component damage can occur. Always install
blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
1. If servicing a liquid fuel tube, release the fuel system pressure. For additional information, refer
to Fuel System Pressure Release See: Fuel
Filter/Fuel Pressure Release/Service and Repair.
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
3. NOTICE: Do not use any tools. The use of tools may cause a deformity in the clip components
which may cause fuel leaks.
Depress the legs of the retainer clip and position the clip to the outward position.
4. Disconnect the quick connect coupling from the fuel tube.
Connect - Type V
1. Inspect and clean both quick connect coupling ends.
2. NOTE: Apply clean engine oil to the end of the tube and the quick connect coupling O-ring seals.
Install the quick connect coupling onto the fuel tube until fully seated.
3. NOTICE: Do not use any tools. The use of tools may cause a deformity in the clip components
which may cause fuel leaks.
NOTE: Make sure the retainer clip is fully seated and locked onto the fuel tube by pulling on the
quick connect coupling.
Press the retainer clip into the quick connect coupling body until flush and the legs are locked in
place.
4. Connect the battery ground cable.
Disconnect - Type VI
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Vapor Tube Fittings > Page 3535
Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
WARNING: Before working on or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components,
relieve the fuel system pressure to prevent accidental spraying of fuel. Fuel in the fuel system
remains under high pressure, even when the engine is not running. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: When handling fuel, always observe fuel handling precautions and be prepared in the
event of fuel spillage. Spilled fuel may be ignited by hot vehicle components or other ignition
sources. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
NOTICE: When reusing liquid or vapor tube connectors, make sure to use compressed air to
remove any foreign material from the connector retaining clip area before separating from the tube
or damage to the tube or connector retaining clip can occur. Apply clean engine oil to the end of the
tube before inserting the tube into the connector.
NOTICE: Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances.
It is essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components or
component damage can occur. Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
1. If servicing a liquid fuel tube, release the fuel system pressure. For additional information, refer
to Fuel System Pressure Release See: Fuel
Filter/Fuel Pressure Release/Service and Repair.
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
3. NOTICE: Do not use any tools. The use of tools may cause a deformity in the clip components
which may cause fuel leaks.
Unclip the locking tab.
4. Depress the tabs and press the clip downward.
5. Separate the quick connect coupling.
Connect - Type VI
1. Inspect and clean both quick connect coupling ends.
2. NOTE: Make sure the fuel tube clicks into place when installing the tube. To make sure that the
fuel tube is fully seated, pull on the tube.
NOTE: Apply clean engine oil to the end of the tube and the quick connect coupling O-ring seals.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Vapor Tube Fittings > Page 3536
Connect the tube into the quick connect coupling.
3. NOTICE: Do not use any tools. The use of tools may cause a deformity in the clip components
which may cause fuel leaks.
Push the clip up into the quick connect coupling. Pull on the tube to make sure it is seated
correctly.
4. Clip the locking tab into place.
5. Connect the battery ground cable.
Disconnect - Type VII
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
WARNING: Before working on or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components,
relieve the fuel system pressure to prevent accidental spraying of fuel. Fuel in the fuel system
remains under high pressure, even when the engine is not running. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: When handling fuel, always observe fuel handling precautions and be prepared in the
event of fuel spillage. Spilled fuel may be ignited by hot vehicle components or other ignition
sources. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
NOTICE: When reusing liquid or vapor tube connectors, make sure to use compressed air to
remove any foreign material from the connector retaining clip area before separating from the tube
or damage to the tube or connector retaining clip can occur. Apply clean engine oil to the end of the
tube before inserting the tube into the connector.
NOTICE: Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances.
It is essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components or
component damage can occur. Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
1. If servicing a liquid fuel tube, release the fuel system pressure. For additional information, refer
to Fuel System Pressure Release See: Fuel
Filter/Fuel Pressure Release/Service and Repair.
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
3. NOTICE: Do not use any tools. The use of tools may cause a deformity in the clip components
which may cause fuel leaks.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Vapor Tube Fittings > Page 3537
Squeeze the quick connect coupling retainer locking tabs to release the locking mechanism.
4. Push the locking mechanism outward to release the tube.
5. Remove the quick connect coupling from the tube.
Connect - Type VII
1. Inspect and clean both quick connect coupling ends.
2. NOTE: Make sure the fuel tube clicks into place when installing the tube. To make sure that the
fuel tube is fully seated, pull on the tube.
NOTE: Apply clean engine oil to the end of the tube and the quick connect coupling O-ring seals.
Install the quick connect coupling onto the tube.
3. NOTICE: Do not use any tools. The use of tools may cause a deformity in the clip components
which may cause fuel leaks.
Depress the quick connect coupling locking mechanism into the lock position.
4. Visually inspect and verify that the locking mechanism is flush with the quick connect coupling
housing and that the locking tabs are securely
fastened.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Vapor Tube Fittings > Page 3538
5. Pull on the quick connect coupling and the tube to make sure it is securely fastened.
6. Connect the battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail.
The temperature sensing portion of the FRPT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance
changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor decreases as the temperature
increases, and the resistance increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance
changes the voltage drop across the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM
corresponding to temperature.
Both the pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the fuel pump. The
speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid state. The
dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which allows the
injector pulse width to decrease.
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
Fuel Pressure
Engine running.....................................................................................................................................
..............................................379-414 kPa (55-60 psi) Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).........................
..................................................................................................................................379-414 kPa
(55-60 psi)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > Specifications > Page 3546
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection
Fuel System Pressure Test
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Before working on or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components,
relieve the fuel system pressure to prevent accidental spraying of fuel. Fuel in the fuel system
remains under high pressure, even when the engine is not running. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
WARNING: When handling fuel, always observe fuel handling precautions and be prepared in the
event of fuel spillage. Spilled fuel may be ignited by hot vehicle components or other ignition
sources. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
1. Remove the cap from the fuel pressure relief valve located on the fuel rail.
2. Install the Fuel Pressure Test Kit onto the fuel pressure relief valve.
3. Test the fuel system pressure to make sure it is within the specified range. For additional
information, refer to Specifications.
4. NOTE: Open the drain valve slowly to relieve the fuel system pressure. This may drain fuel from
the system. Place fuel in a suitable container.
Upon completion of the fuel system pressure test, open the drain valve on the Fuel Pressure Test
Kit and relieve the fuel system pressure.
5. NOTE: It may take more than one key cycle to pressurize the fuel system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > Specifications > Page 3547
Cycle the ignition key and wait 3 seconds to pressurize the fuel system. Check for leaks before
starting the engine.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Control
Unit > Component Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pump Control Unit: Service and Repair
Fuel Pump Control Module
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the fuel pump control module electrical connector.
2. Remove the 2 bolts and the fuel pump control module.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3554
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3555
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Fuel Rail
Fuel Rail: Service and Repair Fuel Rail
Fuel Rail
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Before working on or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components,
relieve the fuel system pressure to prevent accidental spraying of fuel. Fuel in the fuel system
remains under high pressure, even when the engine is not running. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
NOTICE: Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances.
It is therefore essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components.
Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
NOTICE: When reusing liquid or vapor tube connectors, make sure to use compressed air to
remove any foreign material from the connector retaining clip area before separating from the tube.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
2. Release the fuel system pressure.
3. Remove the Air Cleaner (ACL) outlet pipe.
4. Disconnect the crankcase ventilation tube quick connect coupling from the ACL outlet
pipe-to-Throttle Body (TB) adapter.
5. Release the clamp and remove the bolt and the air intake resonator assembly.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
6. Remove the 3 ACL outlet pipe-to-TB adapter bolts.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
7. Remove the ACL outlet pipe-to-TB adapter.
8. Disconnect the Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) electrical connector.
9. Disconnect the Throttle Position (TP) sensor electrical connector.
10. Disconnect the Evaporative Emission (EVAP) tube quick connect coupling from the intake
manifold.
11. Disconnect the heated PCV intake fitting electrical connector.
12. Disconnect the fuel tube quick connect coupling.
13. Disconnect the 8 fuel injector electrical connectors.
14. Remove the 4 fuel rail bolts and the fuel rail and injectors as an assembly.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Fuel Rail > Page 3560
15. NOTICE: Use O-ring seals that are made of special fuel-resistant material. Use of ordinary
O-rings can cause the fuel system to leak.
NOTE: Lubricate the new O-ring seals with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Remove the fuel injector-to-fuel rail locks and separate the 8 fuel injectors from the fuel rail.
- Discard the upper and lower fuel injector O-ring seals.
16. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Fuel Rail > Page 3561
Fuel Rail: Service and Repair Fuel Rail And Fuel Injector - Exploded View
Fuel Rail and Fuel Injector - Exploded View
Air Cleaner (ACL) Outlet Pipe-To-Throttle Body (TB) Adapter, Air Intake Resonator and PCV Tube
Fuel Rail and Fuel Injectors
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Fuel Rail > Page 3562
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View
Fuel Supply Line: Service and Repair Fuel Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View
Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View
106L (28 Gal) Fuel Tank
127L (33.5 Gal) Fuel Tank
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 3567
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 3568
Fuel Supply Line: Service and Repair Fuel Lines And Fuel Filter - Exploded View
Fuel Lines and Fuel Filter - Exploded View
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 3569
Fuel Supply Line: Service and Repair Fuel Lines
Fuel Lines
Removal
All vehicles
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Before working on or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components,
relieve the fuel system pressure to prevent accidental spraying of fuel. Fuel in the fuel system
remains under high pressure, even when the engine is not running. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
WARNING: When handling fuel, always observe fuel handling precautions and be prepared in the
event of fuel spillage. Spilled fuel may be ignited by hot vehicle components or other ignition
sources. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Release the fuel system pressure.
3. Disconnect the fuel supply tube-to-fuel rail quick connect coupling.
4. Disconnect the Evaporative Emission (EVAP) canister vapor tube-to-EVAP purge valve quick
connect coupling.
5. NOTE: LH side shown, RH side similar.
If equipped, remove the 6 bolts and the transfer case skid plate.
6. If equipped, remove the front driveshaft.
106L (28 gal) fuel tank
7. Disconnect the front fuel supply tube-to-fuel tank fuel supply tube quick connect coupling.
127L (33.5 gal) fuel tank
8. Disconnect the front fuel supply tube-to-fuel filter outlet tube quick connect coupling.
All vehicles
9. Disconnect the EVAP canister vapor tube-to-EVAP canister quick connect coupling and fresh air
tube-to-EVAP canister quick connect coupling.
10. If equipped, remove the selector lever heat shield.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 3570
11. Move the locking tab up and disconnect the selector lever cable from the manual lever ball
stud.
12. Remove the 2 selector lever bracket bolts and remove the bracket.
13. Remove the front fuel supply tube, fuel vapor tube and fresh air tube pushpin from the bracket
at the transmission bellhousing.
14. Disconnect the LH Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) sensor electrical connector and remove the
HO2S electrical connector wiring pushpin from the
fuel supply tube, fuel vapor tube and fresh air tube bracket at the rear of the transmission housing.
15. NOTE: Front pushpin retainer shown, other similar.
Disconnect the 3 transmission wiring harness pushpin retainers from the bracket at the
transmission bellhousing, the transmission housing and the bracket at the rear of the transmission.
16. Remove the fuel supply tube, fuel vapor tube, and fresh air tube from the bracket at the rear of
the transmission housing.
17. Remove the fuel supply tube, fuel vapor tube, and fresh air tube from the vehicle.
Installation
All vehicles
1. Install the fresh air tube into the vehicle and connect the pushpin retainer to the bracket at the
bellhousing and install the line into the bracket at the
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 3571
rear of the transmission.
2. Install the front fuel supply tube into the vehicle and clip it into the bracket at the bellhousing and
install it into the bracket at the rear of the
transmission.
3. Install the fuel vapor tube into the vehicle and clip it into the bracket at the bellhousing and install
it into the bracket at the rear of the transmission.
4. NOTE: Front pushpin retainer shown, other similar.
Connect the 3 transmission wiring harness pushpin retainers to the bracket at the transmission
bellhousing, the transmission housing and the bracket at the rear of the transmission.
5. Install the HO2S electrical connector wiring pushpin to the fuel supply tube, fuel vapor tube, and
fresh air tube bracket at the rear of the
transmission housing and connect the LH HO2S sensor electrical connector.
6. Install the selector lever bracket and 2 bolts.
- Tighten to 48 Nm (35 lb-ft).
7. NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable, make sure that the selector lever cable locking
tabs are locked in place and the cable end is
snapped onto the ball stud. Press the selector lever cable into the bracket and listen for the cable
to click into place. Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is locked in the bracket.
Also, make sure that the selector lever cable end is correctly installed onto the ball stud. Pull back
on the selector lever cable to make sure that the cable end is correctly installed.
With the manual lever in NEUTRAL, connect the selector lever cable onto the manual lever ball
stud and move the locking tab downward into the locked position.
- Listen for the audible click.
- Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure it is correctly installed.
8. If equipped, install the selector lever heat shield.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 3572
9. Connect the EVAP canister vapor tube-to-EVAP canister quick connect coupling and fresh air
tube-to-EVAP canister quick connect coupling.
106L (28 gal) fuel tank
10. Connect the front fuel supply tube-to-fuel tank fuel supply tube quick connect coupling.
127L (33.5 gal) fuel tank
11. Connect the front fuel supply tube-to-fuel filter outlet tube quick connect coupling.
All vehicles
12. If equipped, install the front driveshaft.
13. NOTE: LH side shown, RH side similar.
If equipped, install the transfer case skid plate and 6 bolts.
- Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
14. Connect the fuel supply tube-to-fuel rail quick connect coupling.
15. Connect the EVAP canister fuel vapor tube-to-EVAP purge valve quick connect coupling.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View
Fuel Filler Hose: Service and Repair Fuel Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View
Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View
106L (28 Gal) Fuel Tank
127L (33.5 Gal) Fuel Tank
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 3578
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank And Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 3579
Fuel Filler Hose: Service and Repair Fuel Tank Filler Pipe
Fuel Tank Filler Pipe
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: When handling fuel, always observe fuel handling precautions and be prepared in the
event of fuel spillage. Spilled fuel may be ignited by hot vehicle components or other ignition
sources. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
NOTE: The upper fuel tank filler pipe assembly is serviceable separately from the lower fuel tank
filler pipe assembly.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
3. Remove the fuel filler door cup bezel.
4. Remove the 3 fuel tank filler pipe-to-body screws.
- To install, tighten to 1 Nm (9 lb-in).
5. Disconnect the fuel tank filler pipe vent tube-to-fuel tank pressure sensor and vapor tube
assembly quick connect coupling.
6. Loosen the hose clamp and disconnect the fuel tank filler pipe hose-to-fuel tank.
- To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
7. Remove the 2 fuel tank filler pipe support brackets-to-frame bolts.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
8. Remove the fuel tank filler pipe assembly.
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-11-7 > Jun > 09 > Fuel System - Lower
Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity
Fuel Gauge Sender: Customer Interest Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity
TSB 09-11-7
06/15/09
LONG WHEEL BASE (LWB), LOWER THAN EXPECTED FUEL FILL CAPACITY - BUILT
BEFORE 4/10/2009
FORD: 2007-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Expedition and Navigator long wheel base (LWB) vehicles built before
4/10/2009, may encounter the amount of fuel needed to fill the fuel tank may be lower than
expected. This may be encountered when the distance to empty (DIE) states 50 miles or lower to
empty, or the fuel gauge reads lower than 1/8 tank of fuel prior to refueling.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Ask the customer the following questions.
1. Does the customer refill the fuel tank with the engine off?
a. No - Retest the vehicle with engine off before proceeding, if concern does not occur, this
procedure does not apply.
b. Yes - Go to Step 2.
NOTE
SOME CREDIT CARDS HAVE PRESET LIMITS ON THE DOLLAR AMOUNT AVAILABLE FUEL
TRANSACTION. THE PUMP WILL SHUT OFF AT THIS LIMIT. THIS LIMIT MAY BE IN THE
RANGE OF $50 TO $75.
2. Does the customer refill the fuel tank until 1 to 3 gas pump automatic shutoffs?
a. Yes - Go to Step 3.
b. No - Retest the vehicle using the gasoline pump automatic shutoff function before proceeding, if
concern does not occur, this procedure does not
apply.
3. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) using the Workshop Manual, Section 310-01 with
certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near the
gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091107A 2007-2009 Expedition, 1.8 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace The Fuel Delivery Module (Do
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-11-7 > Jun > 09 > Fuel System - Lower
Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity > Page 3588
Not Use With 9002A, 9002A6)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-11-7 > Jun > 09 > Fuel System
- Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity
Fuel Gauge Sender: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill
Capacity
TSB 09-11-7
06/15/09
LONG WHEEL BASE (LWB), LOWER THAN EXPECTED FUEL FILL CAPACITY - BUILT
BEFORE 4/10/2009
FORD: 2007-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Expedition and Navigator long wheel base (LWB) vehicles built before
4/10/2009, may encounter the amount of fuel needed to fill the fuel tank may be lower than
expected. This may be encountered when the distance to empty (DIE) states 50 miles or lower to
empty, or the fuel gauge reads lower than 1/8 tank of fuel prior to refueling.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Ask the customer the following questions.
1. Does the customer refill the fuel tank with the engine off?
a. No - Retest the vehicle with engine off before proceeding, if concern does not occur, this
procedure does not apply.
b. Yes - Go to Step 2.
NOTE
SOME CREDIT CARDS HAVE PRESET LIMITS ON THE DOLLAR AMOUNT AVAILABLE FUEL
TRANSACTION. THE PUMP WILL SHUT OFF AT THIS LIMIT. THIS LIMIT MAY BE IN THE
RANGE OF $50 TO $75.
2. Does the customer refill the fuel tank until 1 to 3 gas pump automatic shutoffs?
a. Yes - Go to Step 3.
b. No - Retest the vehicle using the gasoline pump automatic shutoff function before proceeding, if
concern does not occur, this procedure does not
apply.
3. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) using the Workshop Manual, Section 310-01 with
certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near the
gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091107A 2007-2009 Expedition, 1.8 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace The Fuel Delivery Module (Do
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-11-7 > Jun > 09 > Fuel System
- Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity > Page 3594
Not Use With 9002A, 9002A6)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-24-7 > Dec
> 08 > Suspension - Rear Load Leveling Leak Down
Level Control Solenoid Valve: All Technical Service Bulletins Suspension - Rear Load Leveling
Leak Down
TSB 08-24-7
12/08/08
REAR LOAD LEVELING LEAKS DOWN IN EXTREME COLD WEATHER
FORD: 2007-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Expedition and Navigators vehicles equipped with rear load leveling
suspension, may exhibit air suspension leak down on one or both rear corners after extended
periods of time in temperatures of -22 degrees Fahrenheit (-30 degrees Celsius) or below. The leak
down is the result of premature wear of solenoid seat at low temperatures.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Determine that concern occurs at -22 degrees Fahrenheit (-30 degrees Celsius) or below, after
sitting long periods of time, usually over night. If concern does not occur under these conditions, do
not continue with this procedure.
The concern may not be duplicated if the vehicle has been sitting inside for over 15 minutes.
Replace the air spring solenoid valve per Workshop Manual, Section 204-05: Vehicle Dynamic
Suspension.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082407A 2007-2009 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator: Replace ONE Rear Air Spring Solenoid. (Do Not Use With 5300A9 5300A, 12650D)
082407B 2007-2009 Expedition, 0.6 Hr.
Navigator: Replace BOTH Rear Air Spring Solenoids. (Do Not Use With 5300A9 5300A, 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3B486 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module
Fuel Gauge Sender: Locations Fuel Pump Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 3607
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 3608
Fuel Gauge Sender: Locations Fuel Pump (FP) Control Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 3609
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3610
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Engine Control Components
Fuel Pump (FP) Module
The FP module is a device that contains the fuel pump and sender assembly. The fuel pump is
located inside the FP module reservoir and supplies fuel through the FP module manifold to the
engine and FP module jet pump. The jet pump continuously refills the reservoir with fuel, and a
check valve located in the manifold outlet maintains system pressure when the fuel pump is not
energized. A flapper valve located in the bottom of the reservoir allows fuel to enter the reservoir
and prime the fuel pump during the initial fill.
Typical Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Typical Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Typical Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Typical Mechanical Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Typical Mechanical Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump (FP) Module > Page 3613
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Fuel Pump (FP) Module and Reservoir
Engine Control Components
Fuel Pump (FP) Module and Reservoir
The FP module is mounted inside the fuel tank in a reservoir. The pump has a discharge check
valve that maintains the system pressure after the ignition has been turned off to minimize starting
concerns. The reservoir prevents fuel flow interruptions during extreme vehicle maneuvers with low
tank fill levels.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View
Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View
106L (28 Gal) Fuel Tank
127L (33.5 Gal) Fuel Tank
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 3616
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 3617
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module
Fuel Pump Module
106L (28 Gal) Fuel Tank
127L (33.5 Gal) Fuel Tank
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 3618
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
All fuel tanks
1. Remove the fuel tank. For additional information, refer to Fuel Tank See: Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Fuel Tank.
127L (33.5 gal) fuel tank
2. Remove the 4 nuts and the Fuel Pump (FP) module cover.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
3. Disconnect the return fuel tube-to-FP module quick connect coupling.
All fuel tanks
4. Disconnect the Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-FP module quick
connect coupling and the supply fuel tube-to-FP
module quick connect coupling.
5. Using the Fuel Tank Sender Unit Wrench, remove the FP lock ring.
106L (28 gal) fuel tank
6. NOTICE: Carefully remove the Fuel Pump (FP) assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level
sensor.
NOTE: If the FP does not clear the FP mounting flange on the fuel tank, the use of a screwdriver
may be necessary.
Remove the FP and FP O-ring seal.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 3619
- If necessary, insert a screwdriver into the empty FP rod hole and slightly pull the screwdriver
inboard until the base of the FP clears the FP mounting flange.
- Discard the FP O-ring seal.
127L (33.5 gal) fuel tank
7. NOTICE: Carefully remove the Fuel Pump (FP) assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level
sensor.
NOTE: Note the location of the FP alignment tabs.
Remove the FP module assembly. Remove and discard the O-ring seal.
All fuel tanks
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module
Fuel Tank Unit: Locations Fuel Pump Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 3624
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 3625
Fuel Tank Unit: Locations Fuel Pump (FP) Control Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 3626
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Tank Unit
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Tank Unit > Page 3629
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Fuel Tank Unit: Description and Operation Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Engine Control Components
Fuel Pump (FP) Module
The FP module is a device that contains the fuel pump and sender assembly. The fuel pump is
located inside the FP module reservoir and supplies fuel through the FP module manifold to the
engine and FP module jet pump. The jet pump continuously refills the reservoir with fuel, and a
check valve located in the manifold outlet maintains system pressure when the fuel pump is not
energized. A flapper valve located in the bottom of the reservoir allows fuel to enter the reservoir
and prime the fuel pump during the initial fill.
Typical Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Typical Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Typical Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Typical Mechanical Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Typical Mechanical Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump (FP) Module > Page 3632
Fuel Tank Unit: Description and Operation Fuel Pump (FP) Module and Reservoir
Engine Control Components
Fuel Pump (FP) Module and Reservoir
The FP module is mounted inside the fuel tank in a reservoir. The pump has a discharge check
valve that maintains the system pressure after the ignition has been turned off to minimize starting
concerns. The reservoir prevents fuel flow interruptions during extreme vehicle maneuvers with low
tank fill levels.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail.
The temperature sensing portion of the FRPT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance
changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor decreases as the temperature
increases, and the resistance increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance
changes the voltage drop across the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM
corresponding to temperature.
Both the pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the fuel pump. The
speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid state. The
dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which allows the
injector pulse width to decrease.
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Description and Operation
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Idle Air Control (IAC) Valve
Note: The IAC valve assembly is not adjustable and cannot be cleaned, also some IAC valves are
normally open and others are normally closed. Some IAC valves require engine vacuum to
operate.
The IAC valve assembly controls the engine idle speed and provides a dashpot function. The IAC
valve assembly meters intake air around the throttle plate through a bypass within the IAC valve
assembly and throttle body. The PCM determines the desired idle speed or bypass air and signals
the IAC valve assembly through a specified duty cycle. The IAC valve responds by positioning the
IAC valve to control the amount of bypassed air. The PCM monitors engine RPM and increases or
decreases the IAC duty cycle in order to achieve the desired RPM.
The PCM uses the IAC valve assembly to control:
- no touch start
- cold engine fast idle for rapid warm-up
- idle (corrects for engine load)
- stumble or stalling on deceleration (provides a dashpot function)
- over-temperature idle boost
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3642
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3643
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3644
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3645
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Inertia Fuel Shut-off (IFS) Switch
The IFS switch is used in conjunction with the electric fuel pump. The purpose of the IFS switch is
to shut off the fuel pump if a collision occurs. It consists of a steel cone held in place by a magnet.
When a sharp impact occurs, the cone breaks loose from the magnet, rolls up a conical ramp and
strikes a target plate which opens the electrical contacts of the switch and shuts off the electric fuel
pump. Once the switch is open, it must be manually reset before restarting the vehicle. Refer to the
Owner's Literature, Roadside Emergencies for the location of the IFS switch.
Typical Inertia Fuel Shut-off (IFS) Switch
Typical Inertia Fuel Shut-off (IFS) Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3646
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Service and Repair
Inertia Fuel Shutoff (IFS) Switch
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: The Inertia Fuel Shutoff (IFS) switch is located behind the LH quarter trim panel access
cover.
Remove the LH quarter trim panel access cover.
2. Remove the power liftgate motor electrical connector pushpins from the power liftgate motor
bracket.
3. NOTE: Slide the IFS switch out below the power liftgate motor bracket.
Remove the 2 bolts and the IFS switch. To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
4. Disconnect the IFS switch electrical connector.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Duct > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Intake Air System Components - Exploded View
Intake Air Duct: Service and Repair Intake Air System Components - Exploded View
Intake Air System Components - Exploded View
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Duct > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Intake Air System Components - Exploded View > Page 3651
Intake Air Duct: Service and Repair Air Cleaner Outlet Pipe
Air Cleaner Outlet Pipe
Removal
Navigator
1. Remove the 2 bolts and the engine appearance cover.
All vehicles
2. Loosen the 2 Air Cleaner (ACL) outlet pipe clamps.
3. Remove the ACL outlet pipe.
Installation
Navigator
1. NOTE: The ACL outlet pipe should be securely sealed, with the ends flush with the flanges on
both the ACL and the Throttle Body (TB) to
prevent unusual engine noise.
Position the ACL outlet pipe with the alignment indicator positioned as shown and tighten the 2
clamps.
- Tighten to 4 Nm (35 lb-in).
Expedition
2. NOTE: The ACL outlet pipe should be securely sealed, with the ends flush with the flanges on
both the ACL and the TB to prevent unusual
engine noise.
Position the ACL outlet pipe and tighten the 2 clamps. Tighten to 4 Nm (35 lb-in).
Navigator
3. Position the engine appearance cover and install the 2 bolts.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 3655
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 3656
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Control Unit > Component Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pump Control Unit: Service and Repair
Fuel Pump Control Module
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the fuel pump control module electrical connector.
2. Remove the 2 bolts and the fuel pump control module.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 3664
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 3665
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 3669
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 3670
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3675
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3676
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3677
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
amount of torque requested by the operator. Depending on the application either a 2-track or
3-track APP sensor is used.
2-Track APP Sensor
There are two pedal position signals in the sensor. Both signals, APP1 and APP2, have a positive
slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage), but are offset and increase at different rates. The two
pedal position signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if one signal has a
concern. The PCM determines if a signal is incorrect by calculating where it should be, inferred
from the other signals. If a concern is present with one of the circuits the other input is used. There
are two reference voltage circuits, two signal return circuits, and two signal circuits (a total of six
circuits and pins) between the PCM and the APP sensor assembly. The reference voltage circuits
and the signal return circuits are shared with the reference voltage circuit and signal return circuit
used by the electronic throttle body (ETB) throttle position (TP) sensor. The pedal position signal is
converted to pedal travel degrees (rotary angle) by the PCM. The software then converts these
degrees to counts, which is the input to the torque based strategy. For additional information, refer
to Torque Based Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) See: Computers and Control Systems/Electronic
Throttle Control Module/Description and Operation.
2-Track APP Sensor
Typical 2-Track APP Sensor
3-Track APP Sensor
There are three pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APP1, has a negative slope
(increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APP2 and APP3, both have a positive
slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APP1 is used as the
indication of pedal position by the strategy. The three pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if one signal has a concern. The PCM determines if a signal is
incorrect by calculating where it should be, inferred from the other signals. If a concern is present
with one of the circuits the other inputs are used. The pedal position signal is converted to pedal
travel degrees (rotary angle) by the PCM. The software then converts these degrees to counts,
which is the input to the torque based strategy. There are two reference voltage circuits, two signal
return circuits, and three signal circuits (a total of seven circuits and pins) between the PCM and
the APP sensor assembly. The reference voltage circuits and the signal return circuits are shared
with the reference voltage circuit and signal return circuit used by the electronic throttle body (ETB)
throttle position sensor. For additional information, refer to Torque Based Electronic Throttle
Control (ETC) See: Computers and Control Systems/Electronic Throttle Control Module/Description
and Operation.
3-Track APP Sensor
Typical 3-Track APP Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3681
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3682
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic
Engine Controls
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Engine Controls
Electronic Engine Controls
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor:
- sends the PCM a signal indicating mass airflow rate of air entering the engine.
- incorporates the Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor.
For removal and installation, refer to Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor See: Service and Repair.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic
Engine Controls > Page 3685
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation Engine Control Components
Engine Control Components
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. The current required to
maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow. The MAF sensor then
outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air mass. The PCM
calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired air/fuel ratio. This
input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC), shift and torque
converter clutch (TCC) scheduling.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly. Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology with an integrated IAT sensor.
The hot wire electronic sensing element must be replaced as an assembly. Replacing only the
element may change the air flow calibration.
Diagram of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot and Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Diagram of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot and Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals.
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic
Engine Controls > Page 3686
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3687
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector.
2. Remove the 2 bolts and the MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail.
The temperature sensing portion of the FRPT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance
changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor decreases as the temperature
increases, and the resistance increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance
changes the voltage drop across the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM
corresponding to temperature.
Both the pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the fuel pump. The
speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid state. The
dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which allows the
injector pulse width to decrease.
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail.
The temperature sensing portion of the FRPT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance
changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor decreases as the temperature
increases, and the resistance increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance
changes the voltage drop across the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM
corresponding to temperature.
Both the pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the fuel pump. The
speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid state. The
dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which allows the
injector pulse width to decrease.
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3697
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3698
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3699
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3700
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Inertia Fuel Shut-off (IFS) Switch
The IFS switch is used in conjunction with the electric fuel pump. The purpose of the IFS switch is
to shut off the fuel pump if a collision occurs. It consists of a steel cone held in place by a magnet.
When a sharp impact occurs, the cone breaks loose from the magnet, rolls up a conical ramp and
strikes a target plate which opens the electrical contacts of the switch and shuts off the electric fuel
pump. Once the switch is open, it must be manually reset before restarting the vehicle. Refer to the
Owner's Literature, Roadside Emergencies for the location of the IFS switch.
Typical Inertia Fuel Shut-off (IFS) Switch
Typical Inertia Fuel Shut-off (IFS) Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3701
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Service and Repair
Inertia Fuel Shutoff (IFS) Switch
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: The Inertia Fuel Shutoff (IFS) switch is located behind the LH quarter trim panel access
cover.
Remove the LH quarter trim panel access cover.
2. Remove the power liftgate motor electrical connector pushpins from the power liftgate motor
bracket.
3. NOTE: Slide the IFS switch out below the power liftgate motor bracket.
Remove the 2 bolts and the IFS switch. To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
4. Disconnect the IFS switch electrical connector.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3705
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic
Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle
Position Sensor
Engine Control Components
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle Position Sensor
The ETB throttle position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant
ETB throttle position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB throttle position
sensor signal (TP1) has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second
signal (TP2) has a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). The 2 ETB throttle position
sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There is
1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor. The reference voltage circuit
and the signal return circuit is shared with the reference voltage circuits and signal return circuits
used by the APP sensor. For additional information, refer to Torque Based Electronic Throttle
Control (ETC) See: Computers and Control Systems/Electronic Throttle Control Module/Description
and Operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic
Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle Position Sensor > Page 3708
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
Engine Control Components
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases the corrosion resistance on the
terminals and increases the connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body.
As the TP sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, four operating conditions are determined by the
PCM from the TP. These are:
- closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration)
- part throttle (includes cruise or moderate acceleration)
- wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on crank)
- throttle angle rate
Typical TP Sensor
Typical TP Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3709
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
Removal
1. Remove the Throttle Body (TB).
2. NOTICE: Do not put direct heat on the Throttle Position (TP) sensor or any other plastic parts
because heat damage may occur. Damage
may also occur if Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) temperature exceeds 120°C (248°F).
NOTE: Do not use power tools.
Remove the TP sensor.
1. Using a suitable heat gun, apply heat to the top of the ETB until the top TP sensor bolt ear
reaches approximately 55°C (130°F), this should
take no more than 3 minutes using an 1,100-watt heat gun. The heat gun should be about 25.4 mm
(1 in) away from the ETB.
2. Monitor the temperature of the top TP sensor bolt ear on the ETB with a suitable temperature
measuring device, such as a digital temperature
laser or infrared thermometer, while heating the ETB.
3. Using hand tools, quickly remove the bolt farthest from the heat source first and discard.
4. Using hand tools, remove the remaining bolt and discard.
5. Remove and discard the TP sensor.
Installation
1. NOTE: When installing the new TP sensor, make sure that the radial locator tab on the TP
sensor is aligned with the radial locator hole on the
ETB.
NOTE: Do not use power tools.
Install the new TP sensor. Using hand tools, install the 2 new bolts. Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
2. Install the TB.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Throttle Body: Service and Repair
Throttle Body
Air Cleaner (ACL) Outlet Pipe-To-Throttle Body (TB) Adapter and Air Intake Resonator
Throttle Body (TB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3713
Removal
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
2. Remove the Air Cleaner (ACL) outlet pipe.
3. Disconnect the crankcase ventilation tube quick connect coupling from the ACL outlet
pipe-to-Throttle Body (TB) adapter.
4. Release the clamp and remove the bolt and the air intake resonator assembly.
5. Remove the 3 ACL outlet pipe-to-TB adapter bolts.
6. Remove the ACL outlet pipe-to-TB adapter.
7. Disconnect the Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) electrical connector.
8. Disconnect the Throttle Position (TP) sensor electrical connector.
9. Remove the 4 bolts, the vibration damper and the TB assembly.
- Discard the TB O-ring seal.
Installation
1. Using a new O-ring seal, position the TB, the vibration damper and tighten the 4 bolts in 2
stages.
- Stage 1: Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
- Stage 2: Tighten an additional 90 degrees (one-fourth turn).
2. Connect the TP sensor electrical connector.
3. Connect the ETC electrical connector.
4. Position the ACL outlet pipe-to-TB adapter.
5. Install the 3 ACL outlet pipe-to-TB adapter bolts.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
6. Position the air intake resonator assembly, install the bolt and the clamp.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
7. Connect the crankcase ventilation tube quick connect coupling to the ACL outlet pipe-to-TB
adapter.
8. Install the ACL outlet pipe.
9. Connect the battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3717
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle
Position Sensor
Engine Control Components
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle Position Sensor
The ETB throttle position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant
ETB throttle position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB throttle position
sensor signal (TP1) has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second
signal (TP2) has a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). The 2 ETB throttle position
sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There is
1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor. The reference voltage circuit
and the signal return circuit is shared with the reference voltage circuits and signal return circuits
used by the APP sensor. For additional information, refer to Torque Based Electronic Throttle
Control (ETC) See: Computers and Control Systems/Electronic Throttle Control Module/Description
and Operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Throttle Position Sensor > Page 3720
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
Engine Control Components
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases the corrosion resistance on the
terminals and increases the connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body.
As the TP sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, four operating conditions are determined by the
PCM from the TP. These are:
- closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration)
- part throttle (includes cruise or moderate acceleration)
- wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on crank)
- throttle angle rate
Typical TP Sensor
Typical TP Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3721
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
Removal
1. Remove the Throttle Body (TB).
2. NOTICE: Do not put direct heat on the Throttle Position (TP) sensor or any other plastic parts
because heat damage may occur. Damage
may also occur if Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) temperature exceeds 120°C (248°F).
NOTE: Do not use power tools.
Remove the TP sensor.
1. Using a suitable heat gun, apply heat to the top of the ETB until the top TP sensor bolt ear
reaches approximately 55°C (130°F), this should
take no more than 3 minutes using an 1,100-watt heat gun. The heat gun should be about 25.4 mm
(1 in) away from the ETB.
2. Monitor the temperature of the top TP sensor bolt ear on the ETB with a suitable temperature
measuring device, such as a digital temperature
laser or infrared thermometer, while heating the ETB.
3. Using hand tools, quickly remove the bolt farthest from the heat source first and discard.
4. Using hand tools, remove the remaining bolt and discard.
5. Remove and discard the TP sensor.
Installation
1. NOTE: When installing the new TP sensor, make sure that the radial locator tab on the TP
sensor is aligned with the radial locator hole on the
ETB.
NOTE: Do not use power tools.
Install the new TP sensor. Using hand tools, install the 2 new bolts. Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
2. Install the TB.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction System >
Variable Induction Control Actuator > Component Information > Description and Operation
Variable Induction Control Actuator: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Intake Manifold Tuning Valve (IMTV)
WARNING Substantial opening and closing torque is applied by this system. To prevent injury, be
careful to keep fingers away from lever mechanisms when actuated. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
The IMTV is a motorized actuated unit mounted directly to the intake manifold. The IMTV actuator
controls a shutter device attached to the actuator shaft. There is no monitor input to the PCM with
this system to indicate shutter position.
The motorized IMTV unit is not energized below a calibrated RPM. The shutter is in the closed
position to prevent airflow blend from occurring in the intake manifold. The motorized unit is
energized above a calibrated RPM. The motorized unit is commanded on by the PCM initially at a
100 percent duty cycle to move the shutter to the open position, and then falling to approximately
50 percent to continue to hold the shutter open.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Firing Order > Component Information >
Specifications > Firing Order
Firing Order: Specifications Firing Order
Firing order...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................1-3-7-2-6-5-4-8
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Firing Order > Component Information >
Specifications > Firing Order > Page 3731
Firing Order: Specifications Engine Cylinder Identification
Engine Cylinder Identification
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Timing > System Information >
Specifications
Ignition Timing: Specifications
Base ignition timing..............................................................................................................................
........................10° Before Top Dead Center (BTDC)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor 2 > Page 3739
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor > Page 3742
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3743
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston
number 1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing
the sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil on plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP
signal to select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with two CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). The second
sensor is used to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2.
There are two types of CMP sensors: the 2-pin variable reluctance type sensor and the 3-pin
Hall-effect type sensor.
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
Typical Hall-effect CMP Sensor
Typical Hall-effect CMP Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3744
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
Removal and Installation
LH Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor
1. Remove the Air Cleaner (ACL) outlet pipe.
All CMP sensors
2. Disconnect the Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor electrical connector.
3. Remove the bolt and the CMP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3748
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3749
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid decelerations between teeth.
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3750
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the accessory drive belt from the A/C compressor pulley.
3. Disconnect the A/C compressor electrical connector.
4. Disconnect the Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor electrical connector.
5. Remove the 3 bolts and position the A/C compressor aside.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
6. Remove the bolt and the CKP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3751
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
8. Using the scan tool, perform the Misfire Monitor Neutral Profile Correction procedure, following
the on-screen instructions.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil On Plug (COP) 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil On Plug (COP) 1 > Page 3756
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil On Plug (COP) 1 > Page 3757
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil On Plug (COP) 1 > Page 3758
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil On Plug (COP) 1 > Page 3759
Ignition Coil: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil On Plug (COP) 1 > Page 3760
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil On Plug (COP) 1 > Page 3761
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil On Plug (COP) 1 > Page 3762
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil On Plug (COP) 1 > Page 3763
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil On Plug (COP) 1 > Page 3764
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Coil on Plug (COP)
Ignition Coil: Description and Operation Coil on Plug (COP)
Engine Control Components
Coil On Plug (COP)
The COP ignition operates similar to a standard coil pack ignition except each plug has one coil per
plug. The COP has 3 different modes of operation: engine crank, engine running, and CMP failure
mode effects management (FMEM). For additional information, refer to Ignition Systems See:
Description and Operation/Ignition Systems.
Typical Coil On Plug (COP)
Typical Coil On Plug (COP)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Coil on Plug (COP) > Page 3767
Ignition Coil: Description and Operation Coil Pack
Engine Control Components
Coil Pack
The PCM provides a grounding switch for the coil primary circuit. When the switch is closed,
voltage is applied to the coil primary circuit. This creates a magnetic field around the primary coil.
The PCM opens the switch, causing the magnetic field to collapse, inducing the high voltage in the
secondary coil windings and firing the spark plug. The spark plugs are paired so that as one spark
plug fires on the compression stroke, the other spark plug fires on the exhaust stroke. The next
time the coil is fired the order is reversed. The next pair of spark plugs fire according to the engine
firing order.
Coil packs come in 4-tower, 6-tower horizontal and 6-tower series 5 models. Two adjacent coil
towers share a common coil and are called a matched pair. For 6-tower coil pack (6 cylinder)
applications, the matched pairs are 1 and 5, 2 and 6, and 3 and 4. For 4-tower coil pack (4 cylinder)
applications, the matched pairs are 1 and 4 and 2 and 3.
When the coil is fired by the PCM, spark is delivered through the matched pair towers to their
respective spark plugs. The spark plugs are fired simultaneously and are paired so that as one fires
on the compression stroke, the other spark plug fires on the exhaust stroke. The next time the coil
is fired, the situation is reversed. The next pair of spark plugs fire according to the engine firing
order.
Typical Four-Tower Coil Pack
Typical Four-Tower Coil Pack
Typical Six-Tower Coil Pack
Typical Six-Tower Coil Pack
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Engine Ignition Components - Exploded View
Ignition Coil: Service and Repair Engine Ignition Components - Exploded View
Engine Ignition Components - Exploded View
Engine Ignition - RH
Engine Ignition - LH
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Engine Ignition Components - Exploded View > Page 3770
Ignition Coil: Service and Repair Ignition Coil-On-Plug
Ignition Coil-On-Plug
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the ignition coil-on-plug electrical connector.
2. Remove the bolt and the ignition coil-on-plug.
- Remove the ignition coil-on-plug, using a twisting motion while pulling up on the ignition
coil-on-plug.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
3. NOTE: Verify that the ignition coil-on-plug spring is correctly located inside the ignition
coil-on-plug boot and that there is no damage to the tip
of the boot.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Apply a light coat of dielectric compound to the inside of the ignition coil boots.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Knock Sensor 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Knock Sensor 1 > Page 3775
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1 > Page 3778
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 3779
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Two Types of Knock Sensor (KS)
Two Types of Knock Sensor (KS)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 3780
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
Knock Sensor (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold.
2. Disconnect the Knock Sensor (KS) electrical connectors.
3. Remove the 2 bolts and the 2 KS.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (177 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Camshaft Position Sensor 2 > Page 3786
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor > Page 3789
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3790
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston
number 1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing
the sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil on plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP
signal to select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with two CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). The second
sensor is used to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2.
There are two types of CMP sensors: the 2-pin variable reluctance type sensor and the 3-pin
Hall-effect type sensor.
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
Typical Hall-effect CMP Sensor
Typical Hall-effect CMP Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3791
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Camshaft Position (CMP) Sensor
Removal and Installation
LH Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor
1. Remove the Air Cleaner (ACL) outlet pipe.
All CMP sensors
2. Disconnect the Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor electrical connector.
3. Remove the bolt and the CMP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3795
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3796
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid decelerations between teeth.
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3797
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the accessory drive belt from the A/C compressor pulley.
3. Disconnect the A/C compressor electrical connector.
4. Disconnect the Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor electrical connector.
5. Remove the 3 bolts and position the A/C compressor aside.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
6. Remove the bolt and the CKP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3798
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
8. Using the scan tool, perform the Misfire Monitor Neutral Profile Correction procedure, following
the on-screen instructions.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Ignition
Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) transceiver.
2. NOTE: The ignition lock cylinder must be in the RUN position.
Using a suitable tool, press the release pin and remove the ignition lock cylinder.
3. If a new lock cylinder with keys is replaced, the new PATS keys must be programmed.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Verify the ignition lock cylinder operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Ignition
Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
> Page 3804
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Ignition Lock Cylinder - Non Functional
Ignition Lock Cylinder - Non Functional
Removal
1. Remove the Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) transceiver.
2. Remove the ignition lock cylinder.
- Use a 1/8-inch diameter drill bit to drill out the lock cylinder retaining pin.
- Use a 3/8-inch diameter drill bit to drill down the middle of the ignition lock key slot until the
ignition lock cylinder breaks loose.
- Remove and discard the ignition lock cylinder and drill shavings from the steering column.
3. Remove the bearing retainer.
4. Remove the steering column lock housing bearing and steering column lock gear.
Installation
1. Thoroughly clean all drill shavings from the steering column and inspect it for damage.
2. Install a new ignition lock cylinder.
- Verify the ignition lock cylinder operation.
3. Program the new PATS keys.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Knock Sensor 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Knock Sensor 1 > Page 3809
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1 > Page 3812
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3813
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Two Types of Knock Sensor (KS)
Two Types of Knock Sensor (KS)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3814
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
Knock Sensor (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold.
2. Disconnect the Knock Sensor (KS) electrical connectors.
3. Remove the 2 bolts and the 2 KS.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (177 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information >
Specifications > Gap
Spark Plug: Specifications Gap
Spark plug gap.....................................................................................................................................
.................................1.05 ± 0.05 mm (0.039-0.043 in)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information >
Specifications > Gap > Page 3819
Spark Plug: Specifications Torque Specifications
Spark plugs...........................................................................................................................................
........................................................12 Nm (106 lb-in)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3820
Spark Plug: Application and ID
Spark plug............................................................................................................................................
...................................................................HJFS-24FP
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3821
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection
Spark Plug Inspection
1. Inspect the spark plug for a bridged gap.
- Check for deposit build-up closing the gap between the electrodes. Deposits are caused by oil or
carbon fouling.
- Install a new spark plug.
2. Check for oil fouling.
- Check for wet, black deposits on the insulator shell bore electrodes, caused by excessive oil
entering the combustion chamber through worn rings and pistons, excessive valve-to-guide
clearance or worn or loose bearings.
- Correct the oil leak concern.
- Install a new spark plug.
3. Inspect for carbon fouling. Look for black, dry, fluffy carbon deposits on the insulator tips,
exposed shell surfaces and electrodes, caused by a
spark plug with an incorrect heat range, dirty air cleaner, too rich a fuel mixture or excessive idling.
Install new spark plugs.
4. Inspect for normal burning.
- Check for light tan or gray deposits on the firing tip.
5. Inspect for pre-ignition, identified by melted electrodes and a possibly damaged insulator.
Metallic deposits on the insulator indicate engine
damage. This may be caused by incorrect ignition timing, wrong type of fuel or the unauthorized
installation of a heli-coil insert in place of the spark plug threads. Install a new spark plug.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3822
6. Inspect for overheating, identified by white or light gray spots and a bluish-burnt appearance of
electrodes. This is caused by engine overheating,
wrong type of fuel, loose spark plugs, spark plugs with an incorrect heat range, low fuel pump
pressure or incorrect ignition timing. Install a new spark plug.
7. Inspect for fused deposits, identified by melted or spotty deposits resembling bubbles or blisters.
These are caused by sudden acceleration.
- Install new spark plugs.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Engine Ignition Components - Exploded View
Spark Plug: Service and Repair Engine Ignition Components - Exploded View
Engine Ignition Components - Exploded View
Engine Ignition - RH
Engine Ignition - LH
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Engine Ignition Components - Exploded View > Page 3825
Spark Plug: Service and Repair Spark Plugs
Spark Plugs
Removal
NOTICE: The spark plug procedure must be followed exactly or damage to the cylinder head and
spark plug will result.
1. Remove the ignition coil-on-plug. For additional information, refer to Ignition Coil-On-Plug See:
Ignition Coil/Service and Repair/Ignition
Coil-On-Plug.
2. NOTICE: Only use hand tools when removing or installing the spark plugs or damage can occur
to the cylinder head or spark plug.
NOTE: Use compressed air to remove any foreign material from the spark plug well before
removing the spark plugs.
Remove the spark plug.
3. Inspect the spark plug.
Installation
1. Adjust the spark plug gap as necessary. For the correct spark plug gap specification, refer to
Specifications.
2. NOTICE: Only use hand tools when removing or installing the spark plugs or damage can occur
to the cylinder head or spark plug.
Install the spark plug.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
3. Install the ignition coil. For additional information, refer to Ignition Coil-On-Plug See: Ignition
Coil/Service and Repair/Ignition Coil-On-Plug.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information >
Locations
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information >
Locations > Page 3832
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information >
Locations > Page 3833
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Removal and Installation
1. Apply the park brake.
2. Remove the lower and upper steering column shrouds.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the accessory position and apply the brake or actuate the Brake Shift
Interlock Actuator (BSIA) override.
4. Put the selector lever into the NEUTRAL position.
5. Disconnect the BSIA electrical connector.
6. Remove the BSIA screw.
7. Gently pry the clip up and remove the BSIA.
8. NOTE: When installing the BSIA, verify that the BSIA override has been activated and the slider
is fully rearward. Before rotating the selector
lever from NEUTRAL into PARK, align the selector lever tab into the BSIA.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift > Page 3836
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Service and Repair
Shift Indicator: Service and Repair
Selector Lever Indicator Bulb
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the selector lever assembly.
2. Release the 4 tabs on the selector lever bezel and lift the selector lever bezel up to the selector
lever knob.
3. Remove the bulb retainers from the bezel and replace the bulb(s) as necessary.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Transmission Control Indicator Lamp (TCIL)
The TCIL is an output signal from the PCM that controls the lamp on/off function depending on the
engagement or disengagement of overdrive.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
Control Module: Customer Interest Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
TSB 09-15-8
08/10/09
5.4L 3V 6R80 - HARSH 1-2 UPSHIFT - HARSH 2-1 DOWNSHIFT WHILE COASTING - HARSH
DOWNSHIFT TO 4TH GEAR - INTERMITTENT P0741
FORD: 2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with 5.4L 3V engine may exhibit
symptoms during warm-up: a harsh 1-2 upshift, harsh 2-1 downshift while coasting 15 MPH (24
Km/h). A harsh downshift into 4th gear at highway speeds 45-70 MPH (72-113 Km/h) may also be
experienced. Some vehicles may have a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0741 torque converter
performance code present or stored.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
MECHATRONIC REPAIR/REPLACEMENT IS NOT
AUTHORIZED FOR THIS ISSUE.
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the Powertrain Control Module/Transmission Control Module (PCM/TCM) calibration
using IDS release 61.15 and higher or 62.03 and
higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be
obtained at the website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the TCM Calibration shows AL3P-7J104-AB part number after reprogramming is
complete.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) OBD Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR TSB TO BE
FULLY AFFECTIVE
3. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 3855
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM.
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175° F (79° C). If it is not at
175° F (79° C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175° F (79° C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091508A 2009 Expedition, Navigator 1.0 Hr.
6R80 Transmission: Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear The
TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 3856
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
TSB 09-15-8
08/10/09
5.4L 3V 6R80 - HARSH 1-2 UPSHIFT - HARSH 2-1 DOWNSHIFT WHILE COASTING - HARSH
DOWNSHIFT TO 4TH GEAR - INTERMITTENT P0741
FORD: 2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with 5.4L 3V engine may exhibit
symptoms during warm-up: a harsh 1-2 upshift, harsh 2-1 downshift while coasting 15 MPH (24
Km/h). A harsh downshift into 4th gear at highway speeds 45-70 MPH (72-113 Km/h) may also be
experienced. Some vehicles may have a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0741 torque converter
performance code present or stored.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
MECHATRONIC REPAIR/REPLACEMENT IS NOT
AUTHORIZED FOR THIS ISSUE.
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the Powertrain Control Module/Transmission Control Module (PCM/TCM) calibration
using IDS release 61.15 and higher or 62.03 and
higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be
obtained at the website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the TCM Calibration shows AL3P-7J104-AB part number after reprogramming is
complete.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) OBD Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR TSB TO BE
FULLY AFFECTIVE
3. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts >
Page 3862
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM.
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175° F (79° C). If it is not at
175° F (79° C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175° F (79° C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091508A 2009 Expedition, Navigator 1.0 Hr.
6R80 Transmission: Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear The
TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts >
Page 3863
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Brake Switch - TCC: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to as the stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal
to the PCM indicating the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Typical BPP Switch
Typical BPP Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 3872
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 3873
Transmission Mode Switch: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
The TCS signals the PCM with VPWR whenever the TCS is pressed. On vehicles with this feature,
the transmission control indicator lamp (TCIL) illuminates when the TCS is cycled to disengage
overdrive.
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS) (Column Shift)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS) (Floor Shift)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift
Transmission Mode Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift
Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The Tow/Haul switch is not replaceable. If a new Tow/Haul switch is required, install a new
selector lever assembly.
1. For additional information, refer to Selector Lever - Column Shift See: Transmission and
Drivetrain/Automatic Transmission/Transaxle/Shifter
A/T/Service and Repair/Selector Lever - Column Shift.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift > Page 3876
Transmission Mode Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Floor Shift
Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Floor Shift
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The Tow/Haul switch is not serviced. If a new switch is required, install a new selector lever
knob assembly.
1. For additional information, refer to Selector Lever Knob See: Transmission and
Drivetrain/Automatic Transmission/Transaxle/Shifter
A/T/Service and Repair/Selector Lever Knob.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 10-12-4 > Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh
Downshifts
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest Engine, A/T Controls Delayed/Harsh Downshifts
TSB 10-12-4
07/05/10
5.4L 3V AND 6R80 TRANSMISSION - DELAYED/HARSH DOWNSHIFT ABOVE 40 MPH (64
KM/H)
FORD: 2009-2010 Expedition, F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built on or before 5/1/2010 and
2009-2010 F-150 vehicles built on or before 2/1/2010 and equipped with 5.4L 3V engine and 6R80
transmission may exhibit a delayed then harsh downshift during a commanded downshift at speeds
above 40 MPH (64 Km/h).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
ID vehicle.
2. Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 67.03 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the 1CM Calibration is:
(1) AL3P-7J104-AC for all vehicles except the F-150 4X4.
(2) AL3P-7J104-BC for F-150 4X4.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox
(2) Powertrain
(3) OBD Test Modes
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info
(5) 1CM Cal Part Number
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT 1CM KAM BE CLEARED FOR THIS PROCEDURE TO BE FULLY
EFFECTIVE
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox
(2) Choose Powertrain Then Choose TCM
(3) Choose Reset KAM
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 10-12-4 > Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh
Downshifts > Page 3885
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset 1CM KAM
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM
KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop, allow at least six (6) seconds.
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101204A 2009-2010 Expedition, 1.0 Hr.
Navigator, F-150: Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM And Perform Road
Tests (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 10-12-4 > Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh
Downshifts > Page 3886
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh
1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh
1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
TSB 09-15-8
08/10/09
5.4L 3V 6R80 - HARSH 1-2 UPSHIFT - HARSH 2-1 DOWNSHIFT WHILE COASTING - HARSH
DOWNSHIFT TO 4TH GEAR - INTERMITTENT P0741
FORD: 2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with 5.4L 3V engine may exhibit
symptoms during warm-up: a harsh 1-2 upshift, harsh 2-1 downshift while coasting 15 MPH (24
Km/h). A harsh downshift into 4th gear at highway speeds 45-70 MPH (72-113 Km/h) may also be
experienced. Some vehicles may have a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0741 torque converter
performance code present or stored.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
MECHATRONIC REPAIR/REPLACEMENT IS NOT
AUTHORIZED FOR THIS ISSUE.
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the Powertrain Control Module/Transmission Control Module (PCM/TCM) calibration
using IDS release 61.15 and higher or 62.03 and
higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be
obtained at the website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the TCM Calibration shows AL3P-7J104-AB part number after reprogramming is
complete.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) OBD Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR TSB TO BE
FULLY AFFECTIVE
3. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh
1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 3891
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM.
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175° F (79° C). If it is not at
175° F (79° C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175° F (79° C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091508A 2009 Expedition, Navigator 1.0 Hr.
6R80 Transmission: Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear The
TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh
1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 3892
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
10-12-4 > Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh Downshifts
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T Controls Delayed/Harsh Downshifts
TSB 10-12-4
07/05/10
5.4L 3V AND 6R80 TRANSMISSION - DELAYED/HARSH DOWNSHIFT ABOVE 40 MPH (64
KM/H)
FORD: 2009-2010 Expedition, F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built on or before 5/1/2010 and
2009-2010 F-150 vehicles built on or before 2/1/2010 and equipped with 5.4L 3V engine and 6R80
transmission may exhibit a delayed then harsh downshift during a commanded downshift at speeds
above 40 MPH (64 Km/h).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
ID vehicle.
2. Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 67.03 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the 1CM Calibration is:
(1) AL3P-7J104-AC for all vehicles except the F-150 4X4.
(2) AL3P-7J104-BC for F-150 4X4.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox
(2) Powertrain
(3) OBD Test Modes
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info
(5) 1CM Cal Part Number
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT 1CM KAM BE CLEARED FOR THIS PROCEDURE TO BE FULLY
EFFECTIVE
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox
(2) Choose Powertrain Then Choose TCM
(3) Choose Reset KAM
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
10-12-4 > Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh Downshifts > Page 3898
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset 1CM KAM
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM
KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop, allow at least six (6) seconds.
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101204A 2009-2010 Expedition, 1.0 Hr.
Navigator, F-150: Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM And Perform Road
Tests (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
10-12-4 > Jul > 10 > Engine, A/T Controls - Delayed/Harsh Downshifts > Page 3899
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T Controls Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
TSB 09-15-8
08/10/09
5.4L 3V 6R80 - HARSH 1-2 UPSHIFT - HARSH 2-1 DOWNSHIFT WHILE COASTING - HARSH
DOWNSHIFT TO 4TH GEAR - INTERMITTENT P0741
FORD: 2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with 5.4L 3V engine may exhibit
symptoms during warm-up: a harsh 1-2 upshift, harsh 2-1 downshift while coasting 15 MPH (24
Km/h). A harsh downshift into 4th gear at highway speeds 45-70 MPH (72-113 Km/h) may also be
experienced. Some vehicles may have a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0741 torque converter
performance code present or stored.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
MECHATRONIC REPAIR/REPLACEMENT IS NOT
AUTHORIZED FOR THIS ISSUE.
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the Powertrain Control Module/Transmission Control Module (PCM/TCM) calibration
using IDS release 61.15 and higher or 62.03 and
higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be
obtained at the website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the TCM Calibration shows AL3P-7J104-AB part number after reprogramming is
complete.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) OBD Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR TSB TO BE
FULLY AFFECTIVE
3. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 3904
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM.
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175° F (79° C). If it is not at
175° F (79° C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175° F (79° C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091508A 2009 Expedition, Navigator 1.0 Hr.
6R80 Transmission: Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear The
TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 3905
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
08-21-2 > Oct > 08 > Computers/Controls - Sync Software Programming
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Computers/Controls Sync Software Programming
TSB 08-21-2
10/27/08
SYNC SOFTWARE PROGRAMMING SERVICE TIPS
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus 2009 Mustang 2008-2009 Edge, Explorer
Sport Trac, Explorer 2009 Escape Hybrid, Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator 2009 Mark LT
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner Hybrid, Mariner
ISSUE The Sync Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) may require updates to add system
enhancements, improve system reliability or address consumer issues. The installation or
availability of these updates may be made available in two different methods:
^ Downloadable consumer Service Pack updates available through www.SYNCmyride.com
website.
^ APIM Programming Using the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS).
The tool and installation requirements vary between these two methods. This information is being
provided to supplement current publications, clarify the requirements needed to reprogram or
update the APIM module and provide some additional diagnostic/operational system information.
ACTION Refer to the Service Tips for details.
SERVICE TIPS
Downloadable Consumer Service Pack Updates (Available At www.SyncMyRide.com)
These Service Pack Updates are for the Consumer Interface Processor (CIP) side of the APIM
module only and are customized for each vehicle based on the last reported APIM software level
state. The software download process will bundle the appropriate service packs that are required to
achieve the desired state. This is why consumers are asked to report back to the website once they
have completed the install.
NOTE
IT IS NOT RECOMMENDED TO REUSE A DOWNLOADED SERVICE PACK ACROSS
MULTIPLE VEHICLES. EACH DOWNLOAD IS PACKAGED ACCORDINGLY TO THE CURRENT
STATE OF THE VEHICLE THAT THE DOWNLOAD IS INTENDED FOR.
NOTE
CONSUMERS DO NOT HAVE THE ABILITY TO REMOVE SERVICE PACK UPDATES ONCE
THEY ARE INSTALLED.
Steps For Consumer's To Update Sync With The Latest Enhancements
1. Prepare universal serial bus (USB) storage drive by:
a. Log into their Sync account and select applications and updates to download.
b. Locates a portable USB storage drive that they can take to their vehicle.
NOTE
FOR OWNERS OF MULTIPLE SYNC-EQUIPPED VEHICLES, IT IS STRONGLY
RECOMMENDED TO USE A SEPARATE USB DRIVE FOR EACH SYNC-EQUIPPED VEHICLE.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
08-21-2 > Oct > 08 > Computers/Controls - Sync Software Programming > Page 3910
Dedicating a USB drive to each vehicle's Sync system helps keep each vehicle's download and
installation history current and accurate. In addition, as new Sync features and functionalities
become available, consumers may decide to install different features on different vehicles.
Dedicated USB drives will help maintain the unique applications for each vehicle.
2. Download files by:
a. Plug the USB drive into the computer's USB port.
b. Select the USB port being used on the computer.
c. Confirm choice of USB storage drive. Then click Next.
d. After clicking Next, the files will automatically begin downloading.
NOTE
DO NOT REMOVE THE USB DRIVE UNTIL THE DOWNLOAD IS COMPLETE. THE SCREEN
WILL CONFIRM THAT THE DOWNLOAD IS COMPLETE.
e. Safely remove the USB storage drive from the computer's USB port by clicking on the Windows
personal computer (PC) Safely Remove Hardware icon at the bottom right of the screen, next to
the clock.
3. Install files by:
a. Insert USB storage drive into the vehicle's Sync USB port.
b. Turn on both, the vehicle and radio.
NOTE
IT IS RECOMMENDED TO HAVE THE VEHICLE RUNNING (WITH PROPER EXHAUST
VENTILATION) AND NOT IN THE ACCESSORY MODE. THIS IS TO ENSURE THE VEHICLE'S
BATTERY SUPPLY VOLTAGE REMAINS STABLE DURING THE PROGRAMMING PROCESS.
c. Select User Device.
d. Select Settings.
e. Select Install. Display will change to Begin Installation?
f. Select Yes. Installing file - will display on the screen.
NOTE
DO NOT REMOVE THE USB DRIVE WHILE THE INSTALLATION IS IN PROGRESS.
g. Upon completion of downloading of files, Installation Complete will display on the Sync screen.
h. The Sync voice will say, Installation complete. Sync may also say, The system will now reboot.
Please wait a few moments before using the system. Installation Complete will remain on the Sync
display until you exit the installation mode.
i. Select the Menu radio button to exit installation mode.
j. Remove the USB storage drive.
k. Consumer takes their USB storage drive back to their computer to report the successful install.
(This feature allows for tracking and determining if the consumers vehicle has a newer version
available for downloading or not.)
NOTE
ADDITIONAL INFORMATION AND DETAILS ARE AVAILABLE ON THE SYNCMYRIDE.COM
WEBSITE. REGISTERED SYNC OWNERS WILL SEE VEHICLE SPECIFIC DETAILS AND
DIRECTIONS BASED ON THEIR VEHICLE'S OPTION CONTENT.
APIM Programming Using IDS
This method programs both, the Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) (through the data link connector)
and CIP (through the USB port), portions of the APIM module.
NOTE
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
08-21-2 > Oct > 08 > Computers/Controls - Sync Software Programming > Page 3911
SOFTWARE PACKAGES OBTAINED THROUGH THE PROFESSIONAL TECHNICIAN SOCIETY
(PTS) WEBSITE CONTAINS BOTH, VIP AND CIP FILES, THESE DO NOT NEED TO BE
INSTALLED IN SEQUENCE LIKE THE CONSUMER DOWNLOAD SERVICE PACK UPDATES,
BUT THE ENTIRE PACKAGE MUST BE INSTALLED DURING REPROGRAMMING FOR
PROPER OPERATION. THESE SOFTWARE PACKAGES ARE MUCH LARGER IN SIZE AND
CONTAIN ALL THE PREVIOUS LEVELS OF ENHANCEMENTS AND UPDATES AS WELL AS
ANY ADDITIONAL ENHANCEMENTS AND UPDATES FOR BOTH THE VIP AND CIP
PROCESSORS LOCATED IN THE APIM MODULE.
NOTE
YOU WILL NOT HAVE THE ABILITY TO RESTORE THE PREVIOUS LEVEL OF SYNC
OPERATING SOFTWARE ONCE THE APIM MODULE HAS BEEN SUCCESSFULLY UPDATED
TO THE NEXT HIGHER LEVEL.
NOTE
If a new APIM is being installed, install the new APIM before carrying out the following procedure.
For additional information, refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 415-00.
It is recommended to install a battery charger to the vehicles battery and set at the low charge
setting and insure the PC being used for reprogramming is fully charged or plugged into a power
source prior to starting the reprogramming process.
1. Turn the ignition key to the On position.
2. Turn the audio control module (ACM) on.
3. Connect the scan tool to the data link connector (DLC).
4. Connect one end of the USB male-A to male-A cable Rotunda part number
CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10 (1-800-Rotunda option 6) or equivalent to the scan tool. Compatible cables.
(Figures 1) Non-compatible cables. (Figure 2)
5. Connect the other end of the USB male-A to male-A cable to the vehicle USB port.
6. From the technician service publication website, run OASIS using Quick Start or by manually
entering the vehicle identification number (VIN).
7. From the OASIS tab, select the Sync/APIM bullet.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
08-21-2 > Oct > 08 > Computers/Controls - Sync Software Programming > Page 3912
8. Select the Read APIM button to verify the current APIM VIP and CIP software levels.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VEHICLE COMMUNICATION MODULE (VCM) OR USB CABLES
DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
9. Select the desired software level from the list of available software for programming then select
the Program APIM button to begin the APIM programming process. Enter the APIM As-Built data if
prompted.
a. When only the CIP is being programmed, select cancel when prompted whether or not to
program the VIP.
b. When the VIP is programmed, the CIP will be programmed automatically.
10. The Sync/APIM application downloads the software into the APIM and displays Programming
has been completed successfully.
11. Test the audio system for correct operation. PC requirements for successful reprogramming an
APIM module.
Ford And LIM Logon Issues - Including Proper Browser Settings
The following list will have you check various computer settings to insure your PC is set to the
proper configuration for reprogramming an APIM module.
NOTE
CHANGES TO PC SETTINGS MAY REQUIRE
ADMINISTRATOR ACCESS.
1. Do not use a customized browser like AOL, it will not work. Please use Internet Explorer (IE)
version 5.5 5P2, 6.0, or higher.
2. Log into website.
3. Navigate to PTS (Professional Technician Society) under the Technical Tools on the Parts and
Service tab.
4. Check IE settings by completing the following:
a. Preliminary Checks.
NOTE
THESE INSTRUCTIONS APPLY TO WINDOWS XP MACHINES WITH 5P2 AND IE 6.0 AND
ABOVE.
(1) Open IE, select Tools at the top of the screen and select Security.
(2) Click on the Internet Zone, and find Navigate Sub-frames across different domains and enable
this function.
(3) Then click OK, system may ask you if you want to accept these function please select Yes.
(4) Check the Windows Firewall to make sure it is turned off by:
(a) Selecting the Start button.
(b) Select Control Panel.
(c) Select Windows Firewall (if you do not see the icon, make sure you are using Classic View) and
set to off.
(5) Check Windows Pop-up Blocker to make sure it is turned off.
(a) Open IE.
(b) Select Tools at the top of the screen.
(c) Select Pop-up Blocker and turn it off.
(6) Remove any add-on toolbars such as Google or Yahoo toolbars, as these have additional built
in pop-up blockers.
(7) Verify that any third party anti-virus, anti-spyware, firewall, or internet security software is
temporarily disabled.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
08-21-2 > Oct > 08 > Computers/Controls - Sync Software Programming > Page 3913
b. Browser Settings - Open IE and select Internet Options under the Tools heading.
(1) Select the General tab
(2) Select Delete Files and check the Delete all offline content and select OK
(3) Select Delete Cookies and click OK
(4) Select Clear History and select Yes.
(5) Click on the Security tab.
(6) Click on the Trusted Sites icon.
(7) Click on Sites.
(8) In the box below add this website to the zone type in - website.
(9) Ensure that required server verification (https:) for all sites in this zone is not checked.
(10) Click the Add button.
(11) Click the Close button.
(12) Re-select the Security tab and select Custom Level.
(13) Under Reset Custom Settings, pull down and Reset to: Low, select Reset, select Yes and then
OK.
NOTE
IF RUNNING OASIS ON IE 7.0, RESET TO: MEDIUM-LOW. ALSO, UNDER SETTINGS, SCROLL
TO NAVIGATE SUB-FRAMES ACROSS DIFFERENT DOMAINS, SET TO ENABLED AND CLICK
OK.
(14) Select the Privacy tab, and move the slider to Low.
(15) Click on the Advanced, check the box Override automatic cookie handling and check the box
to Always allow session cookies' and
click OK.
(16) Select the Advanced tab and scroll down to HTP 1.1 settings; make sure both options under
this section are checked.
(17) Scroll down to Security section and make sure the following are checked:
(a) Empty Temporary Internet folder when browser is closed.
(b) Use SSL 2.0.
(c) Use SSL 3.0.
(d) Use TLS 1.0.
(e) Select Apply and then click on OK.
5. Close all browsers and reboot the computer to have the browser settings take affect properly.
The browser settings have now been setup correctly as per Ford Browser settings
recommendations.
Additional PC Security Settings (May Or May Not Be Required - Depends On Operating System)
Changes to PC Security Settings may require Administrator access.
1. Check for Information Bar near top of IE page stating - This website wants to run the following
add-ons.
2. Click on Information Bar and select Run ActiveX Controls or Temporarily Allow Pop-ups
depending on your operating system.
3. Click on Retry button to refresh information. (May not be required on some operating systems)
PC and Server Troubleshooting (Optional)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
08-21-2 > Oct > 08 > Computers/Controls - Sync Software Programming > Page 3914
^ If you wish to test another browser for web-based training only, download the free version of
Opera at www.Opera.com.
^ For web-based training sound problems, make sure your firewall allows downloading sound file
types such as MP3.
^ If you have installed special search and add-on programs such as Gator or Bonzi please remove
them.
^ If you have a router, make sure that port 443 is open for Secure Socket Layer (SSL), and ports
80 and 8080 are open for HTTP.
^ Internet access uses a caching or proxy server. Make sure the caching/proxy servers are set to
automatically detect settings. Contact your local network administrator and/or your Internet service
provider and have them turn off the caching on any and all caching proxy servers for the following:
^ Uniform Resource Locator (URL): www.proservicetech.com or ford website
Additional Sync Related Service Tips
1. Performing a Master Reset of the APIM module or removing and restoring the Keep Alive Power
circuit fuse (refer to the appropriate wiring manual) for 3-minutes, prior to reprogramming will
restore the factory APIM defaults. This can reduce the possibilities of corrupt files, that may have
been transferred into the APIM modules memory, from interfering with the reprogramming of the
CIP portion of the APIM module.
2. Non-factory installed items that can cause background noise, wind noise or obstruct the voice
path to the Sync system's microphone, will reduce the reliability or accuracy of the consumer's
voice commands or speech being recognized properly. Some examples may include but are not
limited to:
^ Objects hanging from the rear view mirror that may make noise or obstruct the system
microphone located on the mirror.
^ Bug shields.
^ Roof mounted accessories.
^ Damaged window moldings.
^ Non-factory installed overhead consoles or sun-visor storage compartments that obstruct the
voice path to the systems microphone. (It is recommended when diagnosing voice recognition or
phone call sound quality issues to eliminate these types of items before replacing any system
components)
3. Remote Starts may prevent the Automatic Discovery Process, of previously paired phones, from
connecting with the consumer's phone as it may be outside of the device's Bluetooth reception
range. Once the vehicle is started remotely, the Sync system automatically begins to search for
previously paired phones; eventually this process will time out if the customers phone does not
enter the vehicle prior to the expiration of this internal timer, resulting in the vehicle Sync not
automatically recognize the phone and pair with it. If this occurs, once the customer enters the
vehicle, the consumer will be required to manually connect the phone through the Sync menus if
they would like to use the hands free phone features.
NOTE
THE CONSUMER WILL NOT BE REQUIRED TO PAIR THE PHONE AGAIN.
4. When Reprogramming APIM modules, it is strongly recommended to use a hard wired internet
connection if possible, due to the APIM program file sizes. If a wired internet connection is not
available, it is recommended to access the PTS website and download the latest Sync software
files from the Tech Central tab prior to reprogramming. This will reduce the overall reprogramming
time when you are connected to the vehicle. If error messages appear during the reprogramming
process that indicate errors with the VIP or CIP file/image, comparing the saved file/image by
checking the file size, between your PC/IDS with the available file/image size indicated in the PTS
description can help determine if the file may be corrupt or damaged. If this has occurred or is
suspected, re-download the file/image and select Yes when asked Do you want to replace it?
5. Always diagnose and repair any DTC's for the Audio system or any module communication
related faults prior to APIM reprogramming.
WARRANTY STATUS: Information Only - Not Warrantable
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
08-21-2 > Oct > 08 > Computers/Controls - Sync Software Programming
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Computers/Controls Sync Software Programming
TSB 08-21-2
10/27/08
SYNC SOFTWARE PROGRAMMING SERVICE TIPS
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus 2009 Mustang 2008-2009 Edge, Explorer
Sport Trac, Explorer 2009 Escape Hybrid, Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator 2009 Mark LT
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner Hybrid, Mariner
ISSUE The Sync Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) may require updates to add system
enhancements, improve system reliability or address consumer issues. The installation or
availability of these updates may be made available in two different methods:
^ Downloadable consumer Service Pack updates available through www.SYNCmyride.com
website.
^ APIM Programming Using the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS).
The tool and installation requirements vary between these two methods. This information is being
provided to supplement current publications, clarify the requirements needed to reprogram or
update the APIM module and provide some additional diagnostic/operational system information.
ACTION Refer to the Service Tips for details.
SERVICE TIPS
Downloadable Consumer Service Pack Updates (Available At www.SyncMyRide.com)
These Service Pack Updates are for the Consumer Interface Processor (CIP) side of the APIM
module only and are customized for each vehicle based on the last reported APIM software level
state. The software download process will bundle the appropriate service packs that are required to
achieve the desired state. This is why consumers are asked to report back to the website once they
have completed the install.
NOTE
IT IS NOT RECOMMENDED TO REUSE A DOWNLOADED SERVICE PACK ACROSS
MULTIPLE VEHICLES. EACH DOWNLOAD IS PACKAGED ACCORDINGLY TO THE CURRENT
STATE OF THE VEHICLE THAT THE DOWNLOAD IS INTENDED FOR.
NOTE
CONSUMERS DO NOT HAVE THE ABILITY TO REMOVE SERVICE PACK UPDATES ONCE
THEY ARE INSTALLED.
Steps For Consumer's To Update Sync With The Latest Enhancements
1. Prepare universal serial bus (USB) storage drive by:
a. Log into their Sync account and select applications and updates to download.
b. Locates a portable USB storage drive that they can take to their vehicle.
NOTE
FOR OWNERS OF MULTIPLE SYNC-EQUIPPED VEHICLES, IT IS STRONGLY
RECOMMENDED TO USE A SEPARATE USB DRIVE FOR EACH SYNC-EQUIPPED VEHICLE.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
08-21-2 > Oct > 08 > Computers/Controls - Sync Software Programming > Page 3920
Dedicating a USB drive to each vehicle's Sync system helps keep each vehicle's download and
installation history current and accurate. In addition, as new Sync features and functionalities
become available, consumers may decide to install different features on different vehicles.
Dedicated USB drives will help maintain the unique applications for each vehicle.
2. Download files by:
a. Plug the USB drive into the computer's USB port.
b. Select the USB port being used on the computer.
c. Confirm choice of USB storage drive. Then click Next.
d. After clicking Next, the files will automatically begin downloading.
NOTE
DO NOT REMOVE THE USB DRIVE UNTIL THE DOWNLOAD IS COMPLETE. THE SCREEN
WILL CONFIRM THAT THE DOWNLOAD IS COMPLETE.
e. Safely remove the USB storage drive from the computer's USB port by clicking on the Windows
personal computer (PC) Safely Remove Hardware icon at the bottom right of the screen, next to
the clock.
3. Install files by:
a. Insert USB storage drive into the vehicle's Sync USB port.
b. Turn on both, the vehicle and radio.
NOTE
IT IS RECOMMENDED TO HAVE THE VEHICLE RUNNING (WITH PROPER EXHAUST
VENTILATION) AND NOT IN THE ACCESSORY MODE. THIS IS TO ENSURE THE VEHICLE'S
BATTERY SUPPLY VOLTAGE REMAINS STABLE DURING THE PROGRAMMING PROCESS.
c. Select User Device.
d. Select Settings.
e. Select Install. Display will change to Begin Installation?
f. Select Yes. Installing file - will display on the screen.
NOTE
DO NOT REMOVE THE USB DRIVE WHILE THE INSTALLATION IS IN PROGRESS.
g. Upon completion of downloading of files, Installation Complete will display on the Sync screen.
h. The Sync voice will say, Installation complete. Sync may also say, The system will now reboot.
Please wait a few moments before using the system. Installation Complete will remain on the Sync
display until you exit the installation mode.
i. Select the Menu radio button to exit installation mode.
j. Remove the USB storage drive.
k. Consumer takes their USB storage drive back to their computer to report the successful install.
(This feature allows for tracking and determining if the consumers vehicle has a newer version
available for downloading or not.)
NOTE
ADDITIONAL INFORMATION AND DETAILS ARE AVAILABLE ON THE SYNCMYRIDE.COM
WEBSITE. REGISTERED SYNC OWNERS WILL SEE VEHICLE SPECIFIC DETAILS AND
DIRECTIONS BASED ON THEIR VEHICLE'S OPTION CONTENT.
APIM Programming Using IDS
This method programs both, the Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) (through the data link connector)
and CIP (through the USB port), portions of the APIM module.
NOTE
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
08-21-2 > Oct > 08 > Computers/Controls - Sync Software Programming > Page 3921
SOFTWARE PACKAGES OBTAINED THROUGH THE PROFESSIONAL TECHNICIAN SOCIETY
(PTS) WEBSITE CONTAINS BOTH, VIP AND CIP FILES, THESE DO NOT NEED TO BE
INSTALLED IN SEQUENCE LIKE THE CONSUMER DOWNLOAD SERVICE PACK UPDATES,
BUT THE ENTIRE PACKAGE MUST BE INSTALLED DURING REPROGRAMMING FOR
PROPER OPERATION. THESE SOFTWARE PACKAGES ARE MUCH LARGER IN SIZE AND
CONTAIN ALL THE PREVIOUS LEVELS OF ENHANCEMENTS AND UPDATES AS WELL AS
ANY ADDITIONAL ENHANCEMENTS AND UPDATES FOR BOTH THE VIP AND CIP
PROCESSORS LOCATED IN THE APIM MODULE.
NOTE
YOU WILL NOT HAVE THE ABILITY TO RESTORE THE PREVIOUS LEVEL OF SYNC
OPERATING SOFTWARE ONCE THE APIM MODULE HAS BEEN SUCCESSFULLY UPDATED
TO THE NEXT HIGHER LEVEL.
NOTE
If a new APIM is being installed, install the new APIM before carrying out the following procedure.
For additional information, refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 415-00.
It is recommended to install a battery charger to the vehicles battery and set at the low charge
setting and insure the PC being used for reprogramming is fully charged or plugged into a power
source prior to starting the reprogramming process.
1. Turn the ignition key to the On position.
2. Turn the audio control module (ACM) on.
3. Connect the scan tool to the data link connector (DLC).
4. Connect one end of the USB male-A to male-A cable Rotunda part number
CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10 (1-800-Rotunda option 6) or equivalent to the scan tool. Compatible cables.
(Figures 1) Non-compatible cables. (Figure 2)
5. Connect the other end of the USB male-A to male-A cable to the vehicle USB port.
6. From the technician service publication website, run OASIS using Quick Start or by manually
entering the vehicle identification number (VIN).
7. From the OASIS tab, select the Sync/APIM bullet.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
08-21-2 > Oct > 08 > Computers/Controls - Sync Software Programming > Page 3922
8. Select the Read APIM button to verify the current APIM VIP and CIP software levels.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VEHICLE COMMUNICATION MODULE (VCM) OR USB CABLES
DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
9. Select the desired software level from the list of available software for programming then select
the Program APIM button to begin the APIM programming process. Enter the APIM As-Built data if
prompted.
a. When only the CIP is being programmed, select cancel when prompted whether or not to
program the VIP.
b. When the VIP is programmed, the CIP will be programmed automatically.
10. The Sync/APIM application downloads the software into the APIM and displays Programming
has been completed successfully.
11. Test the audio system for correct operation. PC requirements for successful reprogramming an
APIM module.
Ford And LIM Logon Issues - Including Proper Browser Settings
The following list will have you check various computer settings to insure your PC is set to the
proper configuration for reprogramming an APIM module.
NOTE
CHANGES TO PC SETTINGS MAY REQUIRE
ADMINISTRATOR ACCESS.
1. Do not use a customized browser like AOL, it will not work. Please use Internet Explorer (IE)
version 5.5 5P2, 6.0, or higher.
2. Log into website.
3. Navigate to PTS (Professional Technician Society) under the Technical Tools on the Parts and
Service tab.
4. Check IE settings by completing the following:
a. Preliminary Checks.
NOTE
THESE INSTRUCTIONS APPLY TO WINDOWS XP MACHINES WITH 5P2 AND IE 6.0 AND
ABOVE.
(1) Open IE, select Tools at the top of the screen and select Security.
(2) Click on the Internet Zone, and find Navigate Sub-frames across different domains and enable
this function.
(3) Then click OK, system may ask you if you want to accept these function please select Yes.
(4) Check the Windows Firewall to make sure it is turned off by:
(a) Selecting the Start button.
(b) Select Control Panel.
(c) Select Windows Firewall (if you do not see the icon, make sure you are using Classic View) and
set to off.
(5) Check Windows Pop-up Blocker to make sure it is turned off.
(a) Open IE.
(b) Select Tools at the top of the screen.
(c) Select Pop-up Blocker and turn it off.
(6) Remove any add-on toolbars such as Google or Yahoo toolbars, as these have additional built
in pop-up blockers.
(7) Verify that any third party anti-virus, anti-spyware, firewall, or internet security software is
temporarily disabled.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
08-21-2 > Oct > 08 > Computers/Controls - Sync Software Programming > Page 3923
b. Browser Settings - Open IE and select Internet Options under the Tools heading.
(1) Select the General tab
(2) Select Delete Files and check the Delete all offline content and select OK
(3) Select Delete Cookies and click OK
(4) Select Clear History and select Yes.
(5) Click on the Security tab.
(6) Click on the Trusted Sites icon.
(7) Click on Sites.
(8) In the box below add this website to the zone type in - website.
(9) Ensure that required server verification (https:) for all sites in this zone is not checked.
(10) Click the Add button.
(11) Click the Close button.
(12) Re-select the Security tab and select Custom Level.
(13) Under Reset Custom Settings, pull down and Reset to: Low, select Reset, select Yes and then
OK.
NOTE
IF RUNNING OASIS ON IE 7.0, RESET TO: MEDIUM-LOW. ALSO, UNDER SETTINGS, SCROLL
TO NAVIGATE SUB-FRAMES ACROSS DIFFERENT DOMAINS, SET TO ENABLED AND CLICK
OK.
(14) Select the Privacy tab, and move the slider to Low.
(15) Click on the Advanced, check the box Override automatic cookie handling and check the box
to Always allow session cookies' and
click OK.
(16) Select the Advanced tab and scroll down to HTP 1.1 settings; make sure both options under
this section are checked.
(17) Scroll down to Security section and make sure the following are checked:
(a) Empty Temporary Internet folder when browser is closed.
(b) Use SSL 2.0.
(c) Use SSL 3.0.
(d) Use TLS 1.0.
(e) Select Apply and then click on OK.
5. Close all browsers and reboot the computer to have the browser settings take affect properly.
The browser settings have now been setup correctly as per Ford Browser settings
recommendations.
Additional PC Security Settings (May Or May Not Be Required - Depends On Operating System)
Changes to PC Security Settings may require Administrator access.
1. Check for Information Bar near top of IE page stating - This website wants to run the following
add-ons.
2. Click on Information Bar and select Run ActiveX Controls or Temporarily Allow Pop-ups
depending on your operating system.
3. Click on Retry button to refresh information. (May not be required on some operating systems)
PC and Server Troubleshooting (Optional)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
08-21-2 > Oct > 08 > Computers/Controls - Sync Software Programming > Page 3924
^ If you wish to test another browser for web-based training only, download the free version of
Opera at www.Opera.com.
^ For web-based training sound problems, make sure your firewall allows downloading sound file
types such as MP3.
^ If you have installed special search and add-on programs such as Gator or Bonzi please remove
them.
^ If you have a router, make sure that port 443 is open for Secure Socket Layer (SSL), and ports
80 and 8080 are open for HTTP.
^ Internet access uses a caching or proxy server. Make sure the caching/proxy servers are set to
automatically detect settings. Contact your local network administrator and/or your Internet service
provider and have them turn off the caching on any and all caching proxy servers for the following:
^ Uniform Resource Locator (URL): www.proservicetech.com or ford website
Additional Sync Related Service Tips
1. Performing a Master Reset of the APIM module or removing and restoring the Keep Alive Power
circuit fuse (refer to the appropriate wiring manual) for 3-minutes, prior to reprogramming will
restore the factory APIM defaults. This can reduce the possibilities of corrupt files, that may have
been transferred into the APIM modules memory, from interfering with the reprogramming of the
CIP portion of the APIM module.
2. Non-factory installed items that can cause background noise, wind noise or obstruct the voice
path to the Sync system's microphone, will reduce the reliability or accuracy of the consumer's
voice commands or speech being recognized properly. Some examples may include but are not
limited to:
^ Objects hanging from the rear view mirror that may make noise or obstruct the system
microphone located on the mirror.
^ Bug shields.
^ Roof mounted accessories.
^ Damaged window moldings.
^ Non-factory installed overhead consoles or sun-visor storage compartments that obstruct the
voice path to the systems microphone. (It is recommended when diagnosing voice recognition or
phone call sound quality issues to eliminate these types of items before replacing any system
components)
3. Remote Starts may prevent the Automatic Discovery Process, of previously paired phones, from
connecting with the consumer's phone as it may be outside of the device's Bluetooth reception
range. Once the vehicle is started remotely, the Sync system automatically begins to search for
previously paired phones; eventually this process will time out if the customers phone does not
enter the vehicle prior to the expiration of this internal timer, resulting in the vehicle Sync not
automatically recognize the phone and pair with it. If this occurs, once the customer enters the
vehicle, the consumer will be required to manually connect the phone through the Sync menus if
they would like to use the hands free phone features.
NOTE
THE CONSUMER WILL NOT BE REQUIRED TO PAIR THE PHONE AGAIN.
4. When Reprogramming APIM modules, it is strongly recommended to use a hard wired internet
connection if possible, due to the APIM program file sizes. If a wired internet connection is not
available, it is recommended to access the PTS website and download the latest Sync software
files from the Tech Central tab prior to reprogramming. This will reduce the overall reprogramming
time when you are connected to the vehicle. If error messages appear during the reprogramming
process that indicate errors with the VIP or CIP file/image, comparing the saved file/image by
checking the file size, between your PC/IDS with the available file/image size indicated in the PTS
description can help determine if the file may be corrupt or damaged. If this has occurred or is
suspected, re-download the file/image and select Yes when asked Do you want to replace it?
5. Always diagnose and repair any DTC's for the Audio system or any module communication
related faults prior to APIM reprogramming.
WARRANTY STATUS: Information Only - Not Warrantable
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 3931
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 3932
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Shift
Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Removal and Installation
1. Apply the park brake.
2. Remove the lower and upper steering column shrouds.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the accessory position and apply the brake or actuate the Brake Shift
Interlock Actuator (BSIA) override.
4. Put the selector lever into the NEUTRAL position.
5. Disconnect the BSIA electrical connector.
6. Remove the BSIA screw.
7. Gently pry the clip up and remove the BSIA.
8. NOTE: When installing the BSIA, verify that the BSIA override has been activated and the slider
is fully rearward. Before rotating the selector
lever from NEUTRAL into PARK, align the selector lever tab into the BSIA.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Shift
Interlock Actuator - Column Shift > Page 3935
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 3941
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 3942
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Removal and Installation
1. Apply the park brake.
2. Remove the lower and upper steering column shrouds.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the accessory position and apply the brake or actuate the Brake Shift
Interlock Actuator (BSIA) override.
4. Put the selector lever into the NEUTRAL position.
5. Disconnect the BSIA electrical connector.
6. Remove the BSIA screw.
7. Gently pry the clip up and remove the BSIA.
8. NOTE: When installing the BSIA, verify that the BSIA override has been activated and the slider
is fully rearward. Before rotating the selector
lever from NEUTRAL into PARK, align the selector lever tab into the BSIA.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
> Page 3945
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Brake Switch - TCC: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to as the stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal
to the PCM indicating the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Typical BPP Switch
Typical BPP Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 >
Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
Control Module: Customer Interest Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
TSB 09-15-8
08/10/09
5.4L 3V 6R80 - HARSH 1-2 UPSHIFT - HARSH 2-1 DOWNSHIFT WHILE COASTING - HARSH
DOWNSHIFT TO 4TH GEAR - INTERMITTENT P0741
FORD: 2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with 5.4L 3V engine may exhibit
symptoms during warm-up: a harsh 1-2 upshift, harsh 2-1 downshift while coasting 15 MPH (24
Km/h). A harsh downshift into 4th gear at highway speeds 45-70 MPH (72-113 Km/h) may also be
experienced. Some vehicles may have a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0741 torque converter
performance code present or stored.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
MECHATRONIC REPAIR/REPLACEMENT IS NOT
AUTHORIZED FOR THIS ISSUE.
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the Powertrain Control Module/Transmission Control Module (PCM/TCM) calibration
using IDS release 61.15 and higher or 62.03 and
higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be
obtained at the website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the TCM Calibration shows AL3P-7J104-AB part number after reprogramming is
complete.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) OBD Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR TSB TO BE
FULLY AFFECTIVE
3. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 >
Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 3957
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM.
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175° F (79° C). If it is not at
175° F (79° C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175° F (79° C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091508A 2009 Expedition, Navigator 1.0 Hr.
6R80 Transmission: Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear The
TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 >
Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 3958
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug
> 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
TSB 09-15-8
08/10/09
5.4L 3V 6R80 - HARSH 1-2 UPSHIFT - HARSH 2-1 DOWNSHIFT WHILE COASTING - HARSH
DOWNSHIFT TO 4TH GEAR - INTERMITTENT P0741
FORD: 2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with 5.4L 3V engine may exhibit
symptoms during warm-up: a harsh 1-2 upshift, harsh 2-1 downshift while coasting 15 MPH (24
Km/h). A harsh downshift into 4th gear at highway speeds 45-70 MPH (72-113 Km/h) may also be
experienced. Some vehicles may have a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0741 torque converter
performance code present or stored.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
MECHATRONIC REPAIR/REPLACEMENT IS NOT
AUTHORIZED FOR THIS ISSUE.
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the Powertrain Control Module/Transmission Control Module (PCM/TCM) calibration
using IDS release 61.15 and higher or 62.03 and
higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be
obtained at the website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the TCM Calibration shows AL3P-7J104-AB part number after reprogramming is
complete.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) OBD Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR TSB TO BE
FULLY AFFECTIVE
3. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug
> 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 3964
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM.
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175° F (79° C). If it is not at
175° F (79° C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175° F (79° C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091508A 2009 Expedition, Navigator 1.0 Hr.
6R80 Transmission: Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear The
TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug
> 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 3965
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
Automatic Transmission Fluid (6R80)
.............................................................................................................................................. 11.0
quarts (10.5 liters)
NOTE: Indicates only approximate dry fill capacity. Some applications may vary based on cooler
size and if equipped with an in-tank cooler.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 3970
Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID
Motorcraft MERCON LV ATF
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
............................................................... XT-10-QLV Ford Specification .............................................
..............................................................................................................................................
MERCON LV
Automatic transmissions that require MERCON LV should only use MERCON LV fluid. Refer to
scheduled maintenance information to determine the correct service interval. Use of any fluid other
than the recommended fluid may cause transmission damage.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Drain And Refill
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair Transmission Fluid Drain And Refill
6R80
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill
Drain
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. NOTE: Some transmission fluid leakage may occur when removing the transmission fluid fill
plug.
Remove the transmission fluid fill plug fluid level indicator assembly located on the passenger side
front portion of the transmission case. Removal of the transmission fluid fill plug will relieve any
vacuum that might have built up in the transmission. This will aid in allowing the transmission fluid
pan to be easily removed when the bolts are removed.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Drain And Refill > Page 3973
3. Remove the transmission fluid pan and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
4. NOTE: The transmission fluid pan gasket can be reused if not damaged.
Install a new transmission fluid pan gasket, if required.
5. Install the transmission fluid pan and tighten the bolts in a crisscross pattern.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
Transmission Fluid Refill
NOTICE: This procedure contains the air purge steps required to purge air from the transmission
fluid cooling system. This procedure is NOT intended for use with the Transmission Fluid Level
Check.
NOTICE: The vehicle should not be driven if the transmission fluid level is low as internal failure
could result.
NOTICE: The transmission fluid fill plug is located near the exhaust system. The exhaust will be
extremely hot during this procedure.
NOTICE: The use of any other transmission fluid than specified, can result in the transmission
failing to operate in a normal manner or transmission failure.
NOTE: If the transmission starts to slip, shifts slowly or shows signs of transmission fluid leaking,
the transmission fluid level should be checked.
NOTE: Here is an overview of the Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill procedure.
- Adding 3.3L (3.5 qt) of transmission fluid to the transmission is an initial fill enabling you to start
the engine.
- The cold level range shown in the procedure allows the vehicle to be driven.
- The vehicle should be driven to allow the transmission fluid temperature to reach 85°C-88°C
(185°F-190°F) in order to purge the air from the transmission fluid cooling system.
- Fill the transmission fluid to the fill range on the transmission fluid level indicator at the normal
operating range 80°C-85°C (175°F-185°F).
1. NOTE: The transmission will need 3.3L (3.5 qt) of transmission fluid added to the transmission
as an initial fill if:
- the transmission has been overhauled.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Drain And Refill > Page 3974
- a new mechatronic assembly has been installed.
- the transmission fluid pan or transmission fluid filter have been removed.
Using the Transmission Fluid Fill Tube, add 3.3L (3.5 qt) of transmission fluid to the transmission
through the transmission fluid fill hole. For additional information, refer to Adding Additional
Transmission Fluid in this procedure.
2. Check the transmission fluid level cold.
- The vehicle is safe to drive if the transmission fluid is in the cold level range 32°C-43°C
(90°F-110°F).
- Using the scan tool and with the engine running, place the selector lever in each gear position
and hold approximately 5 seconds. Place the selector lever in PARK, with the engine at idle
(600-750 rpm).
3. Separate the transmission fluid level indicator from the transmission fluid fill plug.
4. Wipe the transmission fluid level indicator clean. Reinstall the transmission fluid level indicator
only back into the transmission fluid fill plug hole
to check the transmission fluid level. Repeat this until a consistent reading is established.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Drain And Refill > Page 3975
ERROR: stackunderflow
OFFENDING COMMAND: ~
STACK:
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Drain And Refill > Page 3976
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair Transmission Fluid Exchange
6R80
Transmission Fluid Exchange
NOTICE: Use transmission fluid specific for this transmission. Do not use any supplemental
transmission fluid additives or cleaning agents. The use of these products can cause internal
transmission components to fail, which will affect the operation of the transmission.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Use the Heavy-Duty Transmission and Power Steering Fluid X-Changer to change the fluid.
3. Connect the Heavy-Duty Transmission and Power Steering Fluid X-Changer to the transmission
fluid cooler tube after the transmission fluid
cooler on the return tube. This will help remove any foreign material trapped in the transmission
fluid coolers.
4. Perform the transmission fluid exchange using the Heavy-Duty Transmission and Power
Steering Fluid X-Changer. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions included with the machine.
5. Once the transmission fluid exchange is completed, disconnect the Heavy-Duty Transmission
and Power Steering Fluid X-Changer. Reconnect any
disconnected transmission fluid cooler tubes.
6. Using the scan tool with the engine running, check and make sure that the transmission is at
normal operating temperature 66-77°C (150-170°F).
Check and adjust the transmission fluid level and check for any leaks. If transmission fluid is
needed, add transmission fluid in increments of 0.24L (0.5 pt) until the correct level is achieved.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Drain And Refill > Page 3977
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair Transmission Fluid Level Check
6R80
Transmission Fluid Level Check
NOTICE: The vehicle should not be driven if the transmission fluid level is low as internal failure
could result.
NOTICE: The transmission fluid fill plug is located near the exhaust system. The exhaust will be
extremely hot during this procedure.
NOTE: If the vehicle has been operated for an extended period at high highway speeds, in city
traffic, during hot weather or while pulling a trailer, the transmission fluid must cool down to obtain
an accurate reading.
NOTE: If the transmission starts to slip, shifts slowly or shows signs of transmission fluid leaking,
the transmission fluid level should be checked.
NOTE: Do not overfill the transmission. The transmission fluid level must be at the upper level of
the crosshatch mark.
NOTE: If the installation of a new transmission fluid cooler or transmission fluid cooler tubes has
been carried out, the vehicle must be driven to get the transmission fluid to a temperature of 88°C
(190°F) in order to purge the air from the transmission fluid cooling system.
1. With the engine running, place the transmission selector lever in each gear position and hold
approximately 5 seconds. Place the transmission
selector lever in PARK.
2. With the engine idling (600-750 rpm) in PARK, position it on a hoist.
3. Remove the transmission fluid fill plug transmission fluid level indicator assembly, located on the
passenger side front portion of the transmission
case.
4. Separate the transmission fluid level indicator from the transmission fluid fill plug.
5. Wipe the transmission fluid level indicator clean. Reinstall the transmission fluid level indicator
only back into the transmission fluid fill plug hole
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Drain And Refill > Page 3978
to check the transmission fluid level.
6. Using the scan tool, verify that the Transmission Fluid Temperature (TFT) is between 80°C-85°C
(175°F-185°F). Do not overfill the transmission.
The transmission fluid level must be at the upper level of the crosshatch mark.
7. NOTE: If the transmission fluid is not at the correct level, follow the steps for Adding Additional
Transmission Fluid or Removing Transmission
Fluid. For additional information, refer to Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill See: Service and
Repair/Procedures/Transmission Fluid Drain And Refill.
Install the transmission fluid fill plug. Tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Fluid Filter - A/T: Service and Repair
6R80
Fluid Pan, Gasket and Filter
Removal
NOTICE: The use of any transmission fluid other than specified can result in the transmission
failing to operate in a normal manner or transmission failure.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the transmission fluid fill plug transmission fluid level indicator assembly located on the
passenger side front portion of the transmission
case. Removal of the transmission fluid fill plug will relieve any vacuum that might have built up in
the transmission. This will aid in allowing the transmission fluid pan to be easily removed when the
bolts are removed.
3. Remove the transmission fluid pan and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
4. Remove the transmission fluid pan gasket.
5. Remove and discard the transmission fluid filter.
6. Clean and inspect the transmission fluid pan and magnet.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3982
Installation
NOTE: If the transmission is being repaired for a contamination-related failure, install a new
transmission fluid filter and seal assembly. The transmission fluid filter may be reused if no
excessive contamination is indicated.
1. Inspect the transmission case for the transmission fluid filter seal. If the seal is in the case,
carefully remove the seal without scratching the case.
2. Make sure that the seal is on the transmission fluid filter and lubricate the seal with automatic
transmission fluid.
3. NOTE: The transmission fluid filter may be reused if no excessive contamination is indicated.
Install a new transmission fluid filter.
4. Position the magnet in the transmission fluid pan.
5. NOTE: The transmission fluid pan gasket can be reused if not damaged.
Install a new transmission fluid pan gasket if required.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3983
6. Install the transmission fluid pan and tighten the bolts in a crisscross pattern.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
7. Using the Adding Additional Transmission Fluid procedure, fill and check the transmission fluid.
For additional information, refer to Transmission
Fluid Drain and Refill See: Service and Repair/Procedures/Transmission Fluid Drain And Refill.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Fluid Pan: Specifications
Install the transmission fluid pan and tighten the bolts in a crisscross pattern. Tighten to...................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...................12 Nm (106 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3987
Fluid Pan: Service and Repair
6R80
Fluid Pan, Gasket and Filter
Removal
NOTICE: The use of any transmission fluid other than specified can result in the transmission
failing to operate in a normal manner or transmission failure.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the transmission fluid fill plug transmission fluid level indicator assembly located on the
passenger side front portion of the transmission
case. Removal of the transmission fluid fill plug will relieve any vacuum that might have built up in
the transmission. This will aid in allowing the transmission fluid pan to be easily removed when the
bolts are removed.
3. Remove the transmission fluid pan and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
4. Remove the transmission fluid pan gasket.
5. Remove and discard the transmission fluid filter.
6. Clean and inspect the transmission fluid pan and magnet.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3988
Installation
NOTE: If the transmission is being repaired for a contamination-related failure, install a new
transmission fluid filter and seal assembly. The transmission fluid filter may be reused if no
excessive contamination is indicated.
1. Inspect the transmission case for the transmission fluid filter seal. If the seal is in the case,
carefully remove the seal without scratching the case.
2. Make sure that the seal is on the transmission fluid filter and lubricate the seal with automatic
transmission fluid.
3. NOTE: The transmission fluid filter may be reused if no excessive contamination is indicated.
Install a new transmission fluid filter.
4. Position the magnet in the transmission fluid pan.
5. NOTE: The transmission fluid pan gasket can be reused if not damaged.
Install a new transmission fluid pan gasket if required.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3989
6. Install the transmission fluid pan and tighten the bolts in a crisscross pattern.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
7. Using the Adding Additional Transmission Fluid procedure, fill and check the transmission fluid.
For additional information, refer to Transmission
Fluid Drain and Refill See: Service and Repair/Procedures/Transmission Fluid Drain And Refill.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 10-18-1 > Sep > 10 > A/T - Delayed
Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735
Fluid Pump: Customer Interest A/T - Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735
TSB 10-18-1
09/27/10
5.4L WITH 6R75/6R80 - DELAYED FORWARD/REVERSE ENGAGEMENT - DTCS P0741,
P0731, AND/OR P0735 - AFTER COLD START
FORD: 2007-2010 Expedition 2009-2010 F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2010 Expedition, 2009-2010 Navigator and F-150 vehicles equipped with a
5.4L engine and a 6R75/6R80 transmission may exhibit delayed forward/reverse engagement.
Diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) P0741, P0731, and/or P0735 for torque converter and/or gear
ratio concerns may be stored in the powertrain control module (PCM). This concern typically occurs
after cold start and in colder climates.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Remove the mechatronic assembly. Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Inspect the fluid pump adapter seal molded frame for evidence of cracks, which are most often
found in the corner(s) of the molded frame.
a. If evidence of cracks are present, proceed to Step 3.
b. If evidence of cracks are not present, do not continue with this article. Refer to WSM Section
307-01 for further diagnostics.
3. Partially disassemble the mechatronic assembly to access only the main oil pressure regulator
valve located in the lower half. Refer to WSM, Section
307-01.
4. Inspect the main oil pressure regulator valve for free movement in its bore.
a. If the valve moves easily in the bore, proceed to Step 5.
b. If the valve does not move or sticks, remove the valve and clean both the valve and bore,
reinstall the valve. Proceed to Step 5.
5. Reassemble the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
6. Install a new front pump adapter seal.
7. Reinstall the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101801A 2007-2010 Expedition, 2.7 Hrs.
2009-2010 F-150,
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 10-18-1 > Sep > 10 > A/T - Delayed
Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735 > Page 3998
Navigator: Follow Service Procedure To Repair Mechatronic Includes Time To Remove And Install
The Mechatronic And Reprogram (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7F401 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 10-18-1 > Sep > 10 > A/T Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735
Fluid Pump: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735
TSB 10-18-1
09/27/10
5.4L WITH 6R75/6R80 - DELAYED FORWARD/REVERSE ENGAGEMENT - DTCS P0741,
P0731, AND/OR P0735 - AFTER COLD START
FORD: 2007-2010 Expedition 2009-2010 F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2010 Expedition, 2009-2010 Navigator and F-150 vehicles equipped with a
5.4L engine and a 6R75/6R80 transmission may exhibit delayed forward/reverse engagement.
Diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) P0741, P0731, and/or P0735 for torque converter and/or gear
ratio concerns may be stored in the powertrain control module (PCM). This concern typically occurs
after cold start and in colder climates.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Remove the mechatronic assembly. Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Inspect the fluid pump adapter seal molded frame for evidence of cracks, which are most often
found in the corner(s) of the molded frame.
a. If evidence of cracks are present, proceed to Step 3.
b. If evidence of cracks are not present, do not continue with this article. Refer to WSM Section
307-01 for further diagnostics.
3. Partially disassemble the mechatronic assembly to access only the main oil pressure regulator
valve located in the lower half. Refer to WSM, Section
307-01.
4. Inspect the main oil pressure regulator valve for free movement in its bore.
a. If the valve moves easily in the bore, proceed to Step 5.
b. If the valve does not move or sticks, remove the valve and clean both the valve and bore,
reinstall the valve. Proceed to Step 5.
5. Reassemble the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
6. Install a new front pump adapter seal.
7. Reinstall the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101801A 2007-2010 Expedition, 2.7 Hrs.
2009-2010 F-150,
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 10-18-1 > Sep > 10 > A/T Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735 > Page 4004
Navigator: Follow Service Procedure To Repair Mechatronic Includes Time To Remove And Install
The Mechatronic And Reprogram (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7F401 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fluid Pump: > 09-11-7 > Jun > 09 >
Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity
Fuel Gauge Sender: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill
Capacity
TSB 09-11-7
06/15/09
LONG WHEEL BASE (LWB), LOWER THAN EXPECTED FUEL FILL CAPACITY - BUILT
BEFORE 4/10/2009
FORD: 2007-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Expedition and Navigator long wheel base (LWB) vehicles built before
4/10/2009, may encounter the amount of fuel needed to fill the fuel tank may be lower than
expected. This may be encountered when the distance to empty (DIE) states 50 miles or lower to
empty, or the fuel gauge reads lower than 1/8 tank of fuel prior to refueling.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Ask the customer the following questions.
1. Does the customer refill the fuel tank with the engine off?
a. No - Retest the vehicle with engine off before proceeding, if concern does not occur, this
procedure does not apply.
b. Yes - Go to Step 2.
NOTE
SOME CREDIT CARDS HAVE PRESET LIMITS ON THE DOLLAR AMOUNT AVAILABLE FUEL
TRANSACTION. THE PUMP WILL SHUT OFF AT THIS LIMIT. THIS LIMIT MAY BE IN THE
RANGE OF $50 TO $75.
2. Does the customer refill the fuel tank until 1 to 3 gas pump automatic shutoffs?
a. Yes - Go to Step 3.
b. No - Retest the vehicle using the gasoline pump automatic shutoff function before proceeding, if
concern does not occur, this procedure does not
apply.
3. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) using the Workshop Manual, Section 310-01 with
certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near the
gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091107A 2007-2009 Expedition, 1.8 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace The Fuel Delivery Module (Do
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fluid Pump: > 09-11-7 > Jun > 09 >
Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity > Page 4010
Not Use With 9002A, 9002A6)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fluid Pump: > 09-11-7 > Jun > 09 >
Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity > Page 4016
Not Use With 9002A, 9002A6)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators - A/T
> Shift Indicator > Component Information > Service and Repair
Shift Indicator: Service and Repair
Selector Lever Indicator Bulb
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the selector lever assembly.
2. Release the 4 tabs on the selector lever bezel and lift the selector lever bezel up to the selector
lever knob.
3. Remove the bulb retainers from the bezel and replace the bulb(s) as necessary.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators - A/T
> Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Transmission Control Indicator Lamp (TCIL)
The TCIL is an output signal from the PCM that controls the lamp on/off function depending on the
engagement or disengagement of overdrive.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T >
Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: >
09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
Control Module: Customer Interest Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
TSB 09-15-8
08/10/09
5.4L 3V 6R80 - HARSH 1-2 UPSHIFT - HARSH 2-1 DOWNSHIFT WHILE COASTING - HARSH
DOWNSHIFT TO 4TH GEAR - INTERMITTENT P0741
FORD: 2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with 5.4L 3V engine may exhibit
symptoms during warm-up: a harsh 1-2 upshift, harsh 2-1 downshift while coasting 15 MPH (24
Km/h). A harsh downshift into 4th gear at highway speeds 45-70 MPH (72-113 Km/h) may also be
experienced. Some vehicles may have a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0741 torque converter
performance code present or stored.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
MECHATRONIC REPAIR/REPLACEMENT IS NOT
AUTHORIZED FOR THIS ISSUE.
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the Powertrain Control Module/Transmission Control Module (PCM/TCM) calibration
using IDS release 61.15 and higher or 62.03 and
higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be
obtained at the website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the TCM Calibration shows AL3P-7J104-AB part number after reprogramming is
complete.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) OBD Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR TSB TO BE
FULLY AFFECTIVE
3. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T >
Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: >
09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 4033
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM.
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175° F (79° C). If it is not at
175° F (79° C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175° F (79° C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091508A 2009 Expedition, Navigator 1.0 Hr.
6R80 Transmission: Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear The
TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T >
Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: >
09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 4034
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T >
Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control
Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
TSB 09-15-8
08/10/09
5.4L 3V 6R80 - HARSH 1-2 UPSHIFT - HARSH 2-1 DOWNSHIFT WHILE COASTING - HARSH
DOWNSHIFT TO 4TH GEAR - INTERMITTENT P0741
FORD: 2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with 5.4L 3V engine may exhibit
symptoms during warm-up: a harsh 1-2 upshift, harsh 2-1 downshift while coasting 15 MPH (24
Km/h). A harsh downshift into 4th gear at highway speeds 45-70 MPH (72-113 Km/h) may also be
experienced. Some vehicles may have a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0741 torque converter
performance code present or stored.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
MECHATRONIC REPAIR/REPLACEMENT IS NOT
AUTHORIZED FOR THIS ISSUE.
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the Powertrain Control Module/Transmission Control Module (PCM/TCM) calibration
using IDS release 61.15 and higher or 62.03 and
higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be
obtained at the website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the TCM Calibration shows AL3P-7J104-AB part number after reprogramming is
complete.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) OBD Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR TSB TO BE
FULLY AFFECTIVE
3. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T >
Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control
Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 4040
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM.
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175° F (79° C). If it is not at
175° F (79° C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175° F (79° C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091508A 2009 Expedition, Navigator 1.0 Hr.
6R80 Transmission: Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear The
TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T >
Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control
Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 4041
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seals and Gaskets: > 10-18-1 > Sep > 10 > A/T Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735
Seals and Gaskets: Customer Interest A/T - Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735
TSB 10-18-1
09/27/10
5.4L WITH 6R75/6R80 - DELAYED FORWARD/REVERSE ENGAGEMENT - DTCS P0741,
P0731, AND/OR P0735 - AFTER COLD START
FORD: 2007-2010 Expedition 2009-2010 F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2010 Expedition, 2009-2010 Navigator and F-150 vehicles equipped with a
5.4L engine and a 6R75/6R80 transmission may exhibit delayed forward/reverse engagement.
Diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) P0741, P0731, and/or P0735 for torque converter and/or gear
ratio concerns may be stored in the powertrain control module (PCM). This concern typically occurs
after cold start and in colder climates.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Remove the mechatronic assembly. Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Inspect the fluid pump adapter seal molded frame for evidence of cracks, which are most often
found in the corner(s) of the molded frame.
a. If evidence of cracks are present, proceed to Step 3.
b. If evidence of cracks are not present, do not continue with this article. Refer to WSM Section
307-01 for further diagnostics.
3. Partially disassemble the mechatronic assembly to access only the main oil pressure regulator
valve located in the lower half. Refer to WSM, Section
307-01.
4. Inspect the main oil pressure regulator valve for free movement in its bore.
a. If the valve moves easily in the bore, proceed to Step 5.
b. If the valve does not move or sticks, remove the valve and clean both the valve and bore,
reinstall the valve. Proceed to Step 5.
5. Reassemble the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
6. Install a new front pump adapter seal.
7. Reinstall the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101801A 2007-2010 Expedition, 2.7 Hrs.
2009-2010 F-150,
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seals and Gaskets: > 10-18-1 > Sep > 10 > A/T Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735 > Page 4050
Navigator: Follow Service Procedure To Repair Mechatronic Includes Time To Remove And Install
The Mechatronic And Reprogram (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7F401 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > By Symptom for Seals and Gaskets: > 10-18-1 > Sep > 10 > A/T Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735
Seals and Gaskets: By Symptom A/T - Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735
TSB 10-18-1
09/27/10
5.4L WITH 6R75/6R80 - DELAYED FORWARD/REVERSE ENGAGEMENT - DTCS P0741,
P0731, AND/OR P0735 - AFTER COLD START
FORD: 2007-2010 Expedition 2009-2010 F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2010 Expedition, 2009-2010 Navigator and F-150 vehicles equipped with a
5.4L engine and a 6R75/6R80 transmission may exhibit delayed forward/reverse engagement.
Diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) P0741, P0731, and/or P0735 for torque converter and/or gear
ratio concerns may be stored in the powertrain control module (PCM). This concern typically occurs
after cold start and in colder climates.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Remove the mechatronic assembly. Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Inspect the fluid pump adapter seal molded frame for evidence of cracks, which are most often
found in the corner(s) of the molded frame.
a. If evidence of cracks are present, proceed to Step 3.
b. If evidence of cracks are not present, do not continue with this article. Refer to WSM Section
307-01 for further diagnostics.
3. Partially disassemble the mechatronic assembly to access only the main oil pressure regulator
valve located in the lower half. Refer to WSM, Section
307-01.
4. Inspect the main oil pressure regulator valve for free movement in its bore.
a. If the valve moves easily in the bore, proceed to Step 5.
b. If the valve does not move or sticks, remove the valve and clean both the valve and bore,
reinstall the valve. Proceed to Step 5.
5. Reassemble the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
6. Install a new front pump adapter seal.
7. Reinstall the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101801A 2007-2010 Expedition, 2.7 Hrs.
2009-2010 F-150,
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > By Symptom for Seals and Gaskets: > 10-18-1 > Sep > 10 > A/T Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735 > Page 4056
Navigator: Follow Service Procedure To Repair Mechatronic Includes Time To Remove And Install
The Mechatronic And Reprogram (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7F401 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 10-18-1 > Sep
> 10 > A/T - Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735
Seals and Gaskets: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Delayed Engagement/DTC's
P0741/P0731/P0735
TSB 10-18-1
09/27/10
5.4L WITH 6R75/6R80 - DELAYED FORWARD/REVERSE ENGAGEMENT - DTCS P0741,
P0731, AND/OR P0735 - AFTER COLD START
FORD: 2007-2010 Expedition 2009-2010 F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2010 Expedition, 2009-2010 Navigator and F-150 vehicles equipped with a
5.4L engine and a 6R75/6R80 transmission may exhibit delayed forward/reverse engagement.
Diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) P0741, P0731, and/or P0735 for torque converter and/or gear
ratio concerns may be stored in the powertrain control module (PCM). This concern typically occurs
after cold start and in colder climates.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Remove the mechatronic assembly. Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Inspect the fluid pump adapter seal molded frame for evidence of cracks, which are most often
found in the corner(s) of the molded frame.
a. If evidence of cracks are present, proceed to Step 3.
b. If evidence of cracks are not present, do not continue with this article. Refer to WSM Section
307-01 for further diagnostics.
3. Partially disassemble the mechatronic assembly to access only the main oil pressure regulator
valve located in the lower half. Refer to WSM, Section
307-01.
4. Inspect the main oil pressure regulator valve for free movement in its bore.
a. If the valve moves easily in the bore, proceed to Step 5.
b. If the valve does not move or sticks, remove the valve and clean both the valve and bore,
reinstall the valve. Proceed to Step 5.
5. Reassemble the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
6. Install a new front pump adapter seal.
7. Reinstall the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101801A 2007-2010 Expedition, 2.7 Hrs.
2009-2010 F-150,
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 10-18-1 > Sep
> 10 > A/T - Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735 > Page 4062
Navigator: Follow Service Procedure To Repair Mechatronic Includes Time To Remove And Install
The Mechatronic And Reprogram (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7F401 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Output Shaft Seal
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Output Shaft Seal
6R80
Output Shaft Seal
NOTE: Rear Wheel Drive (RWD) shown, Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) similar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Output Shaft Seal > Page 4065
Removal
All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
Rear Wheel Drive (RWD) vehicles
2. Remove the rear driveshaft.
3. NOTE: The output shaft flange nut has been staked to prevent it from coming loose. Prior to
removing the nut, remove the stake to prevent
damage to the output shaft.
Remove and discard the output shaft flange nut.
4. Remove the extension housing flange seal and the output shaft flange.
5. Using the Input Shaft Oil Seal Remover and Slide Hammer, remove the output shaft seal.
6. Remove the slip plane washer.
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) vehicles
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Output Shaft Seal > Page 4066
7. Remove the transfer case.
8. Using the Input Shaft Oil Seal Remover and Slide Hammer, remove the output shaft seal.
Installation
RWD vehicles
1. Install the slip plane washer.
2. Position a new output shaft seal.
3. Using the 6R80 Rear Seal 4X2 Installer, install the output shaft seal.
4. Install the output shaft flange.
5. Install the extension housing flange seal and a new output shaft flange nut.
- Tighten to 80 Nm (59 lb-ft).
- After installing the new output shaft flange nut, it must be staked at the slots to prevent it from
coming loose.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Output Shaft Seal > Page 4067
6. Install the rear driveshaft.
4WD vehicles
7. Position the output shaft seal.
8. Using the 6R80 Rear Seal 4X4 Installer, install a new output shaft seal.
9. Install the transfer case.
All vehicles
10. Fill and check the transmission fluid. For additional information, refer to Transmission Fluid
Level Check See: Service and
Repair/Procedures/Transmission Fluid Level Check.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Output Shaft Seal > Page 4068
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Manual Control Lever Shaft And Seal
6R80
Manual Control Lever Shaft and Seal
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. If equipped, remove the heat shield.
3. NOTICE: To prevent selector lever cable damage, do not apply force to the selector lever cable
between the manual control lever and the
selector lever cable bracket.
Move the locking tab up and disconnect the transmission selector lever cable end from the manual
control lever ball stud.
4. Remove the transmission fluid fill plug transmission fluid level indicator assembly located on the
passenger side front portion of the transmission
case. Removal of the transmission fluid fill plug will relieve any vacuum that might have built up in
the transmission. This will aid in allowing the transmission fluid pan to be easily removed when the
bolts are removed.
5. Remove the transmission fluid pan and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Output Shaft Seal > Page 4069
6. Remove and discard the transmission fluid filter.
7. Remove the transmission fluid pan gasket.
8. NOTICE: Do not pull on the wire harness to disconnect the connector or damage to the
connector will occur.
Disconnect the main transmission electrical harness by twisting the outer shell and pulling back on
the connector.
9. Pull the release tab and pull down on the bulkhead connector retainer.
10. NOTICE: Do not touch the electrical connector pins or the exposed solenoid tabs on the
transmission vehicle harness connector.
Electrostatic discharge may occur and may cause damage to the mechatronic unit.
With the release tab down, pull the outer shell of the transmission vehicle harness connector out of
the mechatronic assembly.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Output Shaft Seal > Page 4070
11. NOTICE: Do not touch the electrical connector pins or the exposed solenoid tabs on the
mechatronic unit. Electrostatic discharge may
occur and may cause damage to the mechatronic unit.
Pull the transmission vehicle harness electrical connector out of the transmission.
12. NOTICE: During removal of the mechatronic assembly, the thermal bypass valve will fall out of
the transmission case. Damage to the
valve will occur if the valve falls out.
Remove the 11 bolts from the mechatronic assembly and remove the mechatronic assembly and
the bypass valve.
13. Remove the park rod actuating plate.
14. Remove the manual control lever.
1. Remove the roll pin.
2. Slide the manual control lever shaft out of the case.
3. Hold the spacer to keep it from falling out of the case.
4. Remove the manual valve inner lever and the park rod as an assembly.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Output Shaft Seal > Page 4071
15. Remove and discard the manual control lever seal.
Installation
1. Position a new manual control lever seal in place.
2. Using the Shift Shaft Fluid Seal Installer, install a new manual control lever shaft seal.
3. Install the manual lever in the case.
1. Slide the manual lever in the case.
2. Position the spacer in place while sliding the manual lever into the spacer.
3. Position the manual valve inner lever while sliding the manual lever and lining up the roll pin
hole.
4. Install the roll pin.
4. Position the park rod in place. Push down on the park pawl and position the park rod in place.
5. While holding the park rod down, install the park rod actuating plate.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Output Shaft Seal > Page 4072
6. NOTE: Before installing the mechatronic assembly into the transmission case, verify presence
and correct orientation of the thermal bypass valve,
pump adapter seal and center support seals. Also note that one or more of the center support seals
may have remained in the mechatronic assembly during removal and should be installed into the
transmission case at this time.
Verify the 4 rubber feed tubes for the center support are in place.
1. Black feed tubes
2. Green feed tube
3. Blue feed tube
7. Verify the rubber adapter is in place.
8. Coat the thermal bypass valve with petroleum jelly to hold it in place and install the thermal
bypass valve in the transmission case.
9. NOTICE: Do not touch the electrical connector pins or the exposed solenoid tabs on the
transmission vehicle harness connector.
Electrostatic discharge may occur and may cause damage to the mechatronic unit.
Position the mechatronic assembly in place and loosely install the 11 bolts.
1. Align the manual valve and control lever linkage.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Output Shaft Seal > Page 4073
10. Tighten the mechatronic bolts in the sequence shown.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
11. NOTICE: Do not touch the electrical connector pins. Electrostatic discharge may occur and will
cause damage to the mechatronic unit.
With the release tab down and unlocked, push the outer shell of the transmission vehicle harness
connector into the transmission. Make sure that the transmission vehicle harness connector is fully
seated into the mechatronic assembly.
12. Press up on the tab and lock the outer shell of the transmission vehicle harness connector in
place.
13. Install a new transmission fluid filter.
14. NOTE: The transmission fluid pan gasket can be reused if not damaged.
Install a new transmission fluid pan gasket, if necessary.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Output Shaft Seal > Page 4074
15. Install the transmission fluid pan and tighten the transmission fluid pan bolts in a crisscross
pattern.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
16. Connect the main transmission electrical harness by pushing it in and twisting the outer shell to
lock it in place.
17. NOTICE: To prevent selector lever cable damage, do not apply force to the selector lever cable
between the manual control lever and the
selector lever cable bracket.
NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable end, make sure that the selector lever cable end is
correctly installed onto the manual control lever ball stud. Pull back on the selector lever cable end
to make sure that the selector lever cable end is correctly installed onto the manual control lever
ball stud.
Install the selector lever cable end onto the manual control lever ball stud.
18. Lock the selector lever cable lock tab.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Output Shaft Seal > Page 4075
ERROR: stackunderflow
OFFENDING COMMAND: ~
STACK:
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Description and Operation
Brake Switch - TCC: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to as the stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal
to the PCM indicating the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Typical BPP Switch
Typical BPP Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4083
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4084
Transmission Mode Switch: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
The TCS signals the PCM with VPWR whenever the TCS is pressed. On vehicles with this feature,
the transmission control indicator lamp (TCIL) illuminates when the TCS is cycled to disengage
overdrive.
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS) (Column Shift)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS) (Floor Shift)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 4089
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 4090
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Removal and Installation
1. Apply the park brake.
2. Remove the lower and upper steering column shrouds.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the accessory position and apply the brake or actuate the Brake Shift
Interlock Actuator (BSIA) override.
4. Put the selector lever into the NEUTRAL position.
5. Disconnect the BSIA electrical connector.
6. Remove the BSIA screw.
7. Gently pry the clip up and remove the BSIA.
8. NOTE: When installing the BSIA, verify that the BSIA override has been activated and the slider
is fully rearward. Before rotating the selector
lever from NEUTRAL into PARK, align the selector lever tab into the BSIA.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift > Page
4093
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism
Shifter A/T: Service and Repair Selector Lever Mechanism
Selector Lever Mechanism
Selector Lever Mechanism
Removal
1. Remove the instrument panel lower finish panel.
2. Remove the steering column lower shroud.
1. Remove the screws and the lower shroud.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 4099
3. Remove the steering column upper shroud.
4. Remove the Instrument Cluster (IC) shroud trim.
5. Remove the RH IC trim screw.
6. Remove the LH IC trim screw and pull the IC trim from the instrument panel.
7. If equipped, disconnect the in-vehicle temperature sensor connector.
8. Disconnect the dimmer switch electrical connector and remove the IC trim.
9. Remove the upper IC screws.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 4100
10. Remove the RH lower IC screw.
11. Remove the LH lower IC screw and position the IC aside.
12. NOTICE: To prevent cable damage, do not apply force to the selector lever cable assembly
between the steering column selector lever
arm and the steering column bracket.
Disconnect the selector lever cable.
13. Remove the locking pin and the park lock cable.
1. Remove and discard the locking pin.
2. Disconnect the park lock cable.
14. Disconnect the Tow/Haul switch electrical connector and the harness from the retaining clips.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 4101
15. Remove the selector lever bolt.
16. Remove the selector lever.
17. Remove the selector lever mechanism lower bolt.
18. Disconnect the Brake Shift Interlock Actuator (BSIA) electrical connector and remove the
selector lever mechanism upper bolts and the selector
lever mechanism from the vehicle.
19. Remove the BSIA from the selector lever mechanism.
1. Pull the BSIA override button.
2. Remove the BSIA screw.
3. Gently pry the clip up and remove the BSIA.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 4102
Installation
1. Install the BSIA onto the selector lever mechanism.
1. Pull the BSIA override button.
2. Align the selector lever tab into the BSIA.
3. Position and secure the BSIA with the clip.
4. Install the screw.
2. Install the selector lever mechanism into the vehicle, install the upper bolts and connect the BSIA
electrical connector.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
3. Install the selector lever mechanism lower bolt.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
4. Install the selector lever.
- Tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
5. Connect the Tow/Haul switch electrical connector and the harness into the retaining clips.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 4103
6. Install the locking pin and the park lock cable.
1. Connect the park lock cable.
2. Install a new locking pin.
7. NOTICE: To prevent cable damage, do not apply force to the selector lever cable assembly
between the steering column selector lever
arm and the steering column bracket.
Connect the selector lever cable.
8. Position the IC and install the LH lower IC screw.
9. Install the RH lower IC screw.
10. Install the upper IC screws.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 4104
11. Position the IC trim and connect the dimmer switch electrical connector.
12. If equipped, connect the in-vehicle temperature sensor connector.
13. Install the LH IC trim screw.
14. Install the RH IC trim screw.
15. Install the IC shroud trim.
16. Install the steering column upper shroud.
17. Install the steering column lower shroud.
1. Install the lower shroud and the screws.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 4105
18. Install the instrument panel lower finish panel.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 4106
Shifter A/T: Service and Repair Selector Lever Knob
Selector Lever Knob
Expedition
Navigator
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 4107
Removal
1. NOTE: Expedition selector lever shown, Navigator similar.
Remove the PRNDL trim, console tray and cup holder insert.
2. Remove the screw and the console upper trim.
3. Remove and discard the RH selector lever knob cover.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 4108
1. Start at the bottom front only.
2. Move towards the top front and remove the cover.
4. Remove and discard the LH selector lever knob cover.
1. Start at the bottom front only.
2. Move towards the top front and remove the cover.
5. Remove and discard the RH selector lever knob screw.
6. NOTE: Verify the LH and RH knob body towers are present and not damaged.
Remove and discard the LH selector lever knob screw.
7. Disconnect the Tow/Haul switch electrical connector and remove the selector lever knob.
Installation
1. Connect the Tow/Haul switch electrical connector and install the selector lever knob.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 4109
2. Install a new LH selector lever knob screw.
- Tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
3. Install a new RH selector lever knob screw.
- Tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
4. NOTE: Wood-trimmed vehicles have a rubber damper not found on other trim levels.
Install a new LH selector lever knob cover.
5. NOTE: Wood-trimmed vehicles have a rubber damper not found on other trim levels.
Install a new RH selector lever knob cover.
6. Install the console upper trim and the screw.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 4110
7. Install the PRNDL trim, console tray and cup holder insert.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 4111
Shifter A/T: Service and Repair Selector Lever Bezel
Selector Lever Bezel
Expedition
Navigator
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 4112
Removal
Funkmaster Flex vehicles
1. NOTE: The serial numbered name plate is securely fastened to the console with double-sided
adhesive tape. Excessive lifting or prying will bend
or damage the serial numbered name plate.
Using an appropriate tool, slightly lift the lower RH corner of the serial numbered name plate
upward to gain access to the double-sided adhesive tape, located on the bottom of the name plate.
2. NOTE: The serial numbered name plate is securely fastened to the console with double-sided
adhesive tape. Excessive lifting or prying will bend
or damage the serial numbered name plate.
Starting at the RH corner of the serial numbered name plate, position a piano wire, or an equivalent
tool, between the name plate and the floor console finish panel and cut the double-sided adhesive
tape on the bottom of name plate.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 4113
3. NOTE: The serial numbered name plate is securely fastened to the console with double-sided
adhesive tape. Excessive lifting or prying will bend
or damage the serial numbered name plate.
Starting at the RH corner of the serial numbered name plate, position a piano wire, or an equivalent
tool, between the name plate and the floor console finish panel and cut the double-sided adhesive
tape on the bottom of name plate.
4. Remove the serial numbered name plate.
All vehicles
5. NOTE: Expedition selector lever shown, Navigator similar.
Remove the PRNDL trim, console tray and cup holder insert.
6. Remove the screw and the console upper trim.
7. Remove and discard the RH selector lever knob cover.
1. Start at the bottom front only.
2. Move towards the top front and remove the cover.
8. Remove and discard the LH selector lever knob cover.
1. Start at the bottom front only.
2. Move towards the top front and remove the cover.
9. Remove and discard the RH selector lever knob screw.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 4114
10. NOTE: Verify the LH and RH knob body towers are present and not damaged.
Remove and discard the LH selector lever knob screw.
11. Disconnect the Tow/Haul switch electrical connector and remove the selector lever knob.
12. Lift the tabs on the selector lever bezel and lift the bezel for access to the electrical harness.
Expedition
13. Disconnect the electrical harness from the bezel.
Installation
Expedition
1. Connect the electrical harness onto the bezel.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 4115
All vehicles
2. Align the brake shift interlock override tab into its guide.
3. Install the selector lever bezel onto the selector lever housing.
4. Connect the Tow/Haul switch electrical connector and install the selector lever knob.
5. Install a new LH selector lever knob screw.
- Tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
6. Install a new RH selector lever knob screw.
- Tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
7. NOTE: Wood-trimmed vehicles have a rubber damper not found on other trim levels.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 4116
Install a new LH selector lever knob cover.
8. NOTE: Wood-trimmed vehicles have a rubber damper not found on other trim levels.
Install a new RH selector lever knob cover.
9. Install the console upper trim and the screw.
10. Install the PRNDL trim, console tray and cup holder insert.
Funkmaster Flex vehicles
11. Using alcohol, remove the double-sided adhesive tape from the serial numbered name plate
and floor console finish panel surfaces.
12. Use a suitable double-sided adhesive tape and apply 6 new tape strips to the bottom of the
serial numbered name plate, as indicated.
13. Position the serial numbered name plate onto the floor console finish panel and apply
downward pressure, to securely fasten the name plate to the
floor console finish panel.
14. Verify brake shift interlock function.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 4117
Shifter A/T: Service and Repair Selector Lever - Column Shift
Selector Lever - Column Shift
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the lower steering column shroud.
1. Remove the screws and the lower steering column shroud.
2. Remove the upper steering column shroud.
3. Disconnect the electrical connector and the harness from the retaining clips.
4. Remove the selector lever bolt.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 4118
5. Remove the selector lever.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 4119
Shifter A/T: Service and Repair Selector Lever - Floor Shift
Selector Lever - Floor Shift
Expedition
Navigator
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 4120
Removal
Funkmaster Flex vehicles
1. NOTE: The serial numbered name plate is securely fastened to the console with double-sided
adhesive tape. Excessive lifting or prying will bend
or damage the serial numbered name plate.
Using an appropriate tool, slightly lift the lower RH corner of the serial numbered name plate
upward to gain access to the double-sided adhesive tape, located on the bottom of the name plate.
2. NOTE: The serial numbered name plate is securely fastened to the console with double-sided
adhesive tape. Excessive lifting or prying will bend
or damage the serial numbered name plate.
Starting at the RH corner of the serial numbered name plate, position a piano wire, or an equivalent
tool, between the name plate and the floor console finish panel and cut the double-sided adhesive
tape on the bottom of name plate.
3. NOTE: The serial numbered name plate is securely fastened to the console with double-sided
adhesive tape. Excessive lifting or prying will bend
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 4121
or damage the serial numbered name plate.
Starting at the RH corner of the serial numbered name plate, position a piano wire, or an equivalent
tool, between the name plate and the floor console finish panel and cut the double-sided adhesive
tape on the bottom of name plate.
4. Remove the serial numbered name plate.
Expedition
5. Remove the PRNDL trim, console tray and cup holder insert.
6. Remove the screw and the console upper trim.
7. NOTE: The selector lever bezel has been removed for clarity. Do not remove the selector lever
bezel.
Disconnect the selector lever cable from the selector lever.
1. Disconnect the selector lever cable from the selector lever arm ball stud.
2. Disconnect the selector lever cable from the selector lever housing.
8. Disconnect the selector lever electrical connector.
9. NOTE: The selector lever bezel has been removed for clarity. Do not remove the selector lever
bezel.
Remove the bolts and lift the selector lever out of the console.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 4122
Navigator
10. Remove the selector lever trim plate.
11. NOTE: Using a suitable tool, lift and remove the floor console upper panel from the rear.
Remove the floor console upper panel.
12. NOTE: The selector lever bezel has been removed for clarity. Do not remove the selector lever
bezel.
Disconnect the selector lever cable from the selector lever arm ball stud.
13. Remove the center console LH kick panel.
14. Disconnect the selector lever cable from the selector lever housing.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 4123
15. Disconnect the selector lever electrical connector.
16. NOTE: The selector lever bezel has been removed for clarity. Do not remove the selector lever
bezel.
Remove the bolts and lift the selector lever out of the console.
Installation
Expedition
1. NOTE: The selector lever bezel has been removed for clarity. Do not remove the selector lever
bezel.
Install the selector lever into the console.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
2. Connect the selector lever electrical connector.
3. NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable, make sure that the selector lever cable locking
tabs are locked in place. Press the selector lever
cable into the bracket and listen for the selector lever cable to click into place. Pull back on the
selector lever cable to make sure that it is locked into the bracket.
NOTE: The selector lever bezel has been removed for clarity. Do not remove the selector lever
bezel.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 4124
Connect the selector lever cable onto the selector lever.
1. Connect the selector lever cable onto the selector lever housing.
- Listen for the audible click.
- Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is correctly installed.
2. Connect the selector lever cable onto the selector lever arm ball stud.
- Listen for the audible click.
- Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is correctly installed.
4. Install the console upper trim and the screw.
5. Install the PRNDL trim, console tray and cup holder insert.
Navigator
6. NOTE: The selector lever bezel has been removed for clarity. Do not remove the selector lever
bezel.
Install the selector lever into the console.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
7. Connect the selector lever electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 4125
8. NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable, make sure that the selector lever cable locking
tabs are locked in place. Press the selector lever
cable into the bracket and listen for the selector lever cable to click into place. Pull back on the
selector lever cable to make sure that it is locked into the bracket.
Connect the selector lever cable onto the selector lever housing.
9. Install the center console LH kick panel.
10. NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable, make sure that the selector lever cable locking
tabs are locked in place. Press the selector lever
cable into the bracket and listen for the selector lever cable to click into place. Pull back on the
selector lever cable to make sure that it is locked into the bracket.
NOTE: The selector lever bezel has been removed for clarity. Do not remove the selector lever
bezel.
Connect the selector lever cable onto the selector lever arm ball stud.
- Listen for the audible click.
- Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is correctly installed.
11. Install the floor console upper panel.
12. NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable end, make sure that the selector lever cable
end is correctly installed onto the selector lever ball
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 4126
stud. Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that the selector cable end is correctly
installed onto the selector lever ball stud.
Install the selector lever trim plate.
Funkmaster Flex vehicles
13. Using alcohol, remove the double-sided adhesive tape from the serial numbered name plate
and floor console finish panel surfaces.
14. Use a suitable double-sided adhesive tape and apply 6 new tape strips to the bottom of the
serial numbered name plate, as indicated.
15. Position the serial numbered name plate onto the floor console finish panel and apply
downward pressure, to securely fasten the name plate to the
floor console finish panel.
All vehicles
16. Adjust the selector lever cable. For additional information, refer to Selector Lever Cable
Adjustment See: Adjustments.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable And Bracket - Column Shift
Shift Cable: Service and Repair Selector Lever Cable And Bracket - Column Shift
Selector Lever Cable and Bracket - Column Shift
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the instrument panel lower finish panel.
3. Remove the hood release cable lever.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable And Bracket - Column Shift > Page 4132
4. Remove the instrument panel lower reinforcement panel.
5. Remove the steering column lower shroud.
1. Remove the screws and the lower shroud.
6. NOTICE: To prevent selector lever cable damage, do not apply force to the selector lever cable
assembly between the steering column
selector lever arm and the steering column bracket.
Disconnect the selector lever cable from the steering column.
1. Disconnect the selector lever cable from the selector lever arm ball stud.
2. Carefully lift the locking tab and disconnect the selector lever cable from the steering column
bracket.
3. Disconnect the selector lever cable retainer.
7. Push the rubber grommet and selector lever cable down through the dash panel.
8. If equipped, remove the heat shield.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable And Bracket - Column Shift > Page 4133
9. NOTICE: To prevent selector lever cable damage, do not apply force to the selector lever cable
between the manual control lever and the
selector lever cable bracket.
Move the locking tab up and disconnect the selector lever cable from the manual control lever ball
stud.
10. Remove the selector lever cable clip to release the selector lever cable from the selector lever
cable bracket.
11. Remove the bolts and the selector lever cable bracket from the transmission.
Installation
1. Install the selector lever cable bracket and bolts onto the transmission.
- Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
2. NOTICE: To prevent selector lever cable damage, do not apply force to the selector lever cable
between the manual control lever and the
selector lever cable bracket.
NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable, make sure that the selector lever cable locking
tabs are locked in place. Press the selector lever cable into the selector lever cable bracket and
listen for the selector lever cable to click into place. Pull back on the selector lever cable to make
sure that the selector lever is locked into the selector lever cable bracket.
Install the selector lever cable into the selector lever cable bracket.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable And Bracket - Column Shift > Page 4134
3. NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable end, make sure that the selector lever cable end
is correctly installed onto the manual control lever
ball stud. Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that the selector cable end is correctly
installed onto the manual control lever ball stud.
NOTE: Apply pressure to the selector lever cable end while connecting it to the manual control
lever to make sure the selector lever has not moved out of the DRIVE position.
Connect the selector lever cable to the manual control lever ball stud.
- Listen for the audible click.
- Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that the selector lever cable is correctly
installed.
4. Lock the selector lever cable lock tab.
5. NOTE: Install a new heat shield if it is loose on the cable.
If equipped, install the heat shield.
6. Push the selector lever cable and rubber grommet up through the dash panel.
7. NOTICE: To prevent cable damage, do not apply force to the selector lever cable assembly
between the steering column selector lever
arm and the steering column bracket.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable And Bracket - Column Shift > Page 4135
Connect the selector lever cable onto the steering column.
1. Connect the selector lever cable retainer.
2. Connect the selector lever cable onto the steering column bracket.
- Listen for the audible click.
- Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is correctly installed.
3. Connect the selector lever cable onto the selector lever arm ball stud.
- Listen for the audible click.
- Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is correctly installed.
8. Install the steering column lower shroud.
1. Install the screws and the lower shroud.
9. Install the instrument panel lower reinforcement panel.
- Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
10. Install the hood release cable lever.
- Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
11. Install the instrument panel lower finish panel.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable And Bracket - Column Shift > Page 4136
12. Adjust the selector lever cable. For additional information, refer to Selector Lever Cable
Adjustment See: Adjustments.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable And Bracket - Column Shift > Page 4137
Shift Cable: Service and Repair Selector Lever Cable And Bracket - Floor Shift
Selector Lever Cable and Bracket - Floor Shift
Removal
All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
Funkmaster Flex vehicles
2. NOTE: The serial numbered name plate is securely fastened to the console with double-sided
adhesive tape. Excessive lifting or prying will bend
or damage the serial numbered name plate.
Using an appropriate tool, slightly lift the lower RH corner of the serial numbered name plate
upward to gain access to the double-sided adhesive tape, located on the bottom of the name plate.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable And Bracket - Column Shift > Page 4138
3. NOTE: The serial numbered name plate is securely fastened to the console with double-sided
adhesive tape. Excessive lifting or prying will bend
or damage the serial numbered name plate.
Starting at the RH corner of the serial numbered name plate, position a piano wire, or an equivalent
tool, between the name plate and the floor console finish panel and cut the double-sided adhesive
tape on the bottom of name plate.
4. Remove the serial numbered name plate.
Expedition
5. Remove the PRNDL trim, console tray and cup holder insert.
6. Remove the screw and the console upper trim.
7. NOTE: The selector lever bezel has been removed for clarity. Do not remove the selector lever
bezel.
Disconnect the selector lever cable from the selector lever.
1. Disconnect the selector lever cable from the selector lever arm ball stud.
2. Disconnect the selector lever cable from the selector lever housing.
Navigator
8. Remove the selector lever trim plate.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable And Bracket - Column Shift > Page 4139
9. NOTE: Using a suitable tool, lift and remove the floor console upper panel from the rear.
Remove the floor console upper panel.
10. NOTE: The selector lever bezel has been removed for clarity. Do not remove the selector lever
bezel.
Disconnect the selector lever cable from the selector lever arm ball stud.
11. Remove the center console LH kick panel.
12. Disconnect the selector lever cable from the selector lever housing.
All vehicles
13. Remove the selector lever cable and rubber grommet.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable And Bracket - Column Shift > Page 4140
14. If equipped, remove the heat shield.
15. NOTICE: To prevent selector lever cable damage, do not apply force to the selector lever cable
between the manual control lever and the
selector lever cable bracket.
Move the locking tab up and disconnect the selector lever cable from the manual control lever ball
stud.
16. Remove the selector lever cable clip to release the selector lever cable from the selector lever
cable bracket.
17. Remove the bolts and the selector lever cable bracket from the transmission.
Installation
All vehicles
1. Install the selector lever cable bracket and bolts onto the transmission.
- Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable And Bracket - Column Shift > Page 4141
2. NOTICE: To prevent selector lever cable damage, do not apply force to the selector lever cable
between the manual control lever and the
selector lever cable bracket.
NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable, make sure that the selector lever cable locking
tabs are locked in place. Press the selector lever cable into the selector lever cable bracket and
listen for the selector lever cable to click into place. Pull back on the selector lever cable to make
sure that the selector lever is locked into the selector lever cable bracket.
Install the selector lever cable into the selector lever cable bracket.
3. NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable end, make sure that the selector lever cable end
is correctly installed onto the manual control lever
ball stud. Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that the selector cable end is correctly
installed onto the manual control lever ball stud.
Connect the selector lever cable onto the manual control lever ball stud.
- Listen for the audible click.
- Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is correctly installed.
4. Lock the selector lever cable lock tab.
5. NOTE: Install a new heat shield if it is loose on the cable.
If equipped, install the heat shield.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable And Bracket - Column Shift > Page 4142
6. Install the selector lever cable and rubber grommet.
Expedition
7. NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable, make sure that the selector lever cable locking
tabs are locked in place. Press the selector lever
cable into the bracket and listen for the selector lever cable to click into place. Pull back on the
selector lever cable to make sure that it is locked into the bracket.
NOTE: The selector lever bezel has been removed for clarity. Do not remove the selector lever
bezel.
Connect the selector lever cable onto the selector lever.
1. Connect the selector lever cable onto the selector lever housing.
- Listen for the audible click.
- Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is correctly installed.
2. Connect the selector lever cable onto the selector lever arm ball stud.
- Listen for the audible click.
- Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is correctly installed.
8. Install the console upper trim and the screw.
9. Install the PRNDL trim, console tray and cup holder insert.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable And Bracket - Column Shift > Page 4143
Navigator
10. NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable, make sure that the selector lever cable locking
tabs are locked in place. Press the selector lever
cable into the bracket and listen for the selector lever cable to click into place. Pull back on the
selector lever cable to make sure that it is locked into the bracket.
Connect the selector lever cable onto the selector lever housing.
11. Install the center console LH kick panel.
12. NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable end, make sure that the selector lever cable
end is correctly installed onto the selector lever ball
stud. Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that the selector cable end is correctly
installed onto the selector lever ball stud.
NOTE: The selector lever bezel has been removed for clarity. Do not remove the selector lever
bezel.
Connect the selector lever cable onto the selector lever arm ball stud.
- Listen for the audible click.
- Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is correctly installed.
13. Install the floor console upper panel.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable And Bracket - Column Shift > Page 4144
14. Install the selector lever trim plate.
Funkmaster Flex vehicles
15. Using alcohol, remove the double-sided adhesive tape from the serial numbered name plate
and floor console finish panel surfaces.
16. Use a suitable double-sided adhesive tape and apply 6 new tape strips to the bottom of the
serial numbered name plate, as indicated.
17. Position the serial numbered name plate onto the floor console finish panel and apply
downward pressure, to securely fasten the name plate to the
floor console finish panel.
All vehicles
18. Adjust the selector lever cable. For additional information, refer to Selector Lever Cable
Adjustment See: Adjustments.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Torque Converter: Description and Operation
6R80
Torque Converter
The torque converter is a 4-element unit containing a 3-plate clutch. The clutch can be controlled
and engaged in any gear 2 to 6. Calibration parameters may be set to allow lockup in a higher gear
only. The clutch is applied by removing fluid pressure from one side of the plate. The torque
converter transmits and multiplies torque. The torque converter includes the following 4 elements:
- Impeller assembly
- Turbine assembly
- Reactor assembly
- Torque Converter Clutch (TCC)
Rotation of the torque converter housing and impeller set the transmission fluid in motion by driving
the impeller blades and pump.
The turbine is driven by the transmission fluid from the impeller and transmits power to the input
shaft.
The reactor redirects transmission fluid flow returned from the turbine to the impeller so that it
rotates in the same direction as the impeller. This action assists in torque multiplication.
The reactor has a One-Way Clutch (OWC) to hold it stationary during torque multiplication and
allows it to rotate at higher vehicle speeds.
Torque Converter Operation
Torque Converter Clutch (TCC)
The TCC has a cover assembly with a 3-plate clutch and a turbine and damper assembly that
connects to the transmission input shaft.
The TCC connects the cover to the turbine when the TCC is applied.
During TCC release, transmission fluid flows through the torque converter in one direction to
release the 3-plate clutch.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4148
During TCC apply, transmission fluid flows through the torque converter in the opposite direction to
apply the 3-plate clutch.
The TCC operates in 3 stages:
- Full release
- Controlled modulation
- Full apply
The Transmission Control Module (TCM) controls TCC operation using the TCC solenoid. TCC
solenoid operation provides the modulation of hydraulic pressure to change the position of the
bypass clutch control regulator valve. The valve changes the pressure and direction of
transmission fluid flow in the torque converter. The TCC may be applied in forward gears, 2 to 6.
Torque Converter Exploded View
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Torque Converter Diagnosis
Torque Converter: Testing and Inspection Torque Converter Diagnosis
6R80
Torque Converter Diagnosis
Prior to torque converter installation, all diagnostic procedures must be followed. This is to prevent
the unnecessary installation of good torque converters. Only after a complete diagnostic evaluation
can the decision be made to install a new torque converter.
Begin with the normal diagnostic procedures as follows:
1. Preliminary inspection.
2. Know and understand the customer concern.
3. Verify the condition - carry out the Torque Converter Operation Test.
4. Perform diagnostic procedures.
- Perform On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) test. Refer to Diagnostics See: Transmission Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview/Diagnostics. Repair all non-transmission related DTCs first.
- Repair all transmission-related DTCs.
- Rerun OBD test to verify repair.
- Perform Stall Speed Test. Refer to Special Testing Procedures. See: Transmission Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/Special Testing
Procedures
- Perform Diagnostic Routines. Refer to Diagnosis By Symptom See: Transmission Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/Diagnostic Routines
See: Transmission Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic
Procedures/Diagnosis By Symptom Use the Diagnosis by Symptom to locate the appropriate routine that best describes the
symptom(s). The routine will list all possible components that may cause or contribute to the
symptom. Check each component listed; diagnose and repair as required before changing the
torque converter.
Torque Converter Operation Test
The Torque Converter Operation Test verifies that the Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) control
system and the torque converter are operating correctly.
1. Perform a Self Test with the scan tool. Refer to Computers and Control Systems Information.
Check for DTCs.
2. Connect a scan tool to the vehicle.
3. Bring the engine to normal operating temperature by driving the vehicle at highway speeds in the
(D) position.
4. After normal operating temperature is reached, maintain a constant speed of about 56 km/h (35
mph) in 5th gear for 10 seconds.
5. Release the accelerator pedal and monitor the scan tool Throttle Position (TP) voltage to
approximately 1.25 volts or 25% throttle.
6. Monitor the TCC and RPM TCM PID. The TCC should release and engine rpms should increase
before the 5-4 shift occurs.
NOTE: The following is a list of common vehicle concerns that have been misdiagnosed as TCC
shudder. For diagnosis of the following items, refer to the appropriate systems of the
diagnostic/repair information and Computers and Control Systems Information.
- Spark plugs - check for cracks, high resistance or broken insulators
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Torque Converter Diagnosis > Page 4151
- Spark plug wires
- Fuel injector - filter may be plugged
- Fuel contamination - engine driveability concerns
- EGR valve - valve may let in too much exhaust gas and cause engine to run lean
- Vacuum leak - engine will not get correct air/fuel mixture
- Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) and Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor - incorrect air/fuel mixture
- Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) - too rich/lean air/fuel mixture
- Fuel pressure - may be too low
- Engine mounts - loose/damaged mounts can cause vibration concerns
- Axle joints - check for vibration
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Torque Converter Diagnosis > Page 4152
Torque Converter: Testing and Inspection Torque Converter Contamination Inspection
6R80
Torque Converter Contamination Inspection
1. A new or remanufactured torque converter must be installed if one or more of the following
statements is true:
- A torque converter malfunction has been determined based on complete diagnostic procedures.
- The torque converter stud or studs, impeller hub or bushing are damaged.
- The torque converter exhibits external discoloration (due to overheating).
- There is evidence of transmission assembly or fluid contamination due to the following
transmission or converter failure modes. Major metallic failure
- Multiple clutch plates or band failures
- Sufficient component wear which results in metallic contamination
- Water or antifreeze contamination
2. If none of the above conditions are present, continue with the following fluid inspection.
3. Pour a small amount of transmission fluid from the torque converter onto an absorbent white
tissue or through a paper filter.
4. Examine the fluid for contaminants, color and smell. The fluid must be free of contaminants, red
in color and not have a burnt smell.
5. NOTICE: Do not use water-based cleaners or mineral spirits to clean or flush the torque
converter or transmission damage will occur.
If the fluid passed inspection:
- drain the remaining fluid from the torque converter.
- using only the recommended transmission fluid, add 1.9L (2 qt) of clean fluid into the converter
and agitate by hand.
- thoroughly drain the fluid.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Material
Transmission Cooler: Specifications Material
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Material > Page 4157
Transmission Cooler: Specifications Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Transmission Cooling - 6R80 HD With Towing Package
Transmission Cooler: Description and Operation Transmission Cooling - 6R80 HD With Towing
Package
Transmission Cooling
The transmission fluid cooling system consists of:
- transmission fluid cooler inlet and outlet tubes.
- an in-tank transmission fluid cooler inlet tube.
- a non-repairable in-tank transmission fluid cooler.
- an auxiliary transmission fluid cooler inlet tube (HD).
- an auxiliary transmission fluid cooler (HD).
- an auxiliary transmission fluid cooler return tube (HD).
The transmission fluid flows from the transmission to the in-tank transmission fluid cooler, to the
auxiliary transmission fluid cooler and returns to the transmission.
For Transmission Fluid Cooler Flow Backflushing and Cleaning, refer to Transmission Control
Systems. See: Transmission Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
6R80 HD with Towing Package
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Transmission Cooling - 6R80 HD With Towing Package > Page 4160
Transmission Cooler: Description and Operation Transmission Cooling - 6R80 Base Package
Transmission Cooling
The transmission fluid cooling system consists of:
- transmission fluid cooler inlet and outlet tubes.
- an in-tank transmission fluid cooler inlet tube.
- a non-repairable in-tank transmission fluid cooler.
- an auxiliary transmission fluid cooler inlet tube (HD).
- an auxiliary transmission fluid cooler (HD).
- an auxiliary transmission fluid cooler return tube (HD).
The transmission fluid flows from the transmission to the in-tank transmission fluid cooler, to the
auxiliary transmission fluid cooler and returns to the transmission.
For Transmission Fluid Cooler Flow Backflushing and Cleaning, refer to Transmission Control
Systems. See: Transmission Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
6R80 Base Package
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Transmission Cooler: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Transmission Cooling
Inspection and Verification
NOTICE: When internal wear or damage occurs in the transmission, metal particles and clutch
plate material can travel into the torque converter, the transmission fluid cooler tubes, the in-tank
transmission fluid cooler and the auxiliary transmission fluid cooler, if equipped. These
contaminants are a major cause of recurring transmission concerns. To prevent future concerns,
remove these contaminants from the cooling system before placing the transmission back into use.
Refer to Transmission Control Systems for Transmission Fluid Cooler Backflushing and Cleaning.
See: Transmission Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
1. Visually inspect for obvious signs of mechanical damage, incorrect component installation and
system leaks. Repair as necessary.
- Install a new or remanufactured radiator when transmission fluid is found leaking from the in-tank
transmission fluid cooler. Refer to Cooling System.
- Install a new O-ring when transmission fluid is found leaking between the radiator transmission
fluid cooler and the transmission fluid cooler fitting (not the cooler tube into the fitting). Refer to the
Component Test. See: Component Tests and General Diagnostics/Transmission Fluid Cooler
Leaks At Radiator
- Install a new auxiliary transmission fluid cooler if there is leakage from the transmission fluid
cooler. Refer to Auxiliary Transmission Fluid Cooler See: Service and Repair/Auxiliary
Transmission Fluid Cooler.
2. If the fault is not visually evident, GO to Symptom Chart - Transmission Cooling or GO to
Symptom Chart - NVH. See: Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures/Symptom Chart - Transmission Cooling See: Symptom Related Diagnostic
Procedures/Symptom Chart - NVH
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 4163
Transmission Cooler: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Symptom Chart - Transmission Cooling
Transmission Cooling
Symptom Chart - Transmission Cooling
Symptom Chart - Transmission Cooling
Symptom Chart - NVH
Transmission Cooling
Symptom Chart - NVH
Symptom Chart - NVH
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 4164
Transmission Cooler: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Transmission Fluid Cooler
Transmission Fluid Cooler
NOTICE: Whenever a transmission has been disassembled to install new parts, the transmission
fluid cooler and transmission fluid cooler tubes must be cleaned and backflushed. Use a torque
converter/oil cooler cleaner.
NOTE: Cleaning and backflushing the transmission fluid cooling system, along with following all the
normal cleaning and inspection procedures during disassembly and reassembly, will keep
contaminants from entering the transmission, causing a repeat repair.
When internal wear or damage has occurred in the transmission, metal particles, clutch plate
material or band material may have been carried into the torque converter and transmission fluid
cooler. These contaminants are a major cause of recurring transmission troubles and must be
removed from the system before the transmission is put back into use.
Transmission Fluid Cooler Backflushing And Cleaning
Transmission Fluid Cooler Backflushing and Cleaning
NOTICE: Use only transmission fluid specified for this transmission. Do not use any supplemental
transmission fluid additives or cleaning agents. The use of these products could cause internal
transmission components to fail; this will affect the operation of the transmission.
NOTE: Transmission fluid cooler backflushing and cleaning will be performed using the Turbo-Tank
Heated Cooler Line Flusher or equivalent. Follow the manufacturer's instructions included with the
machine. Test the equipment to make sure that a vigorous fluid flow is present before proceeding.
NOTE: If the vehicle is equipped with an in-line transmission fluid filter, remove and discard the
in-line filter.
1. Check and top off fluid level of the Turbo-Tank Heated Cooler Line Flusher or equivalent tank
with transmission fluid.
2. Allow the fluid in the Turbo-Tank Heated Cooler Line Flusher or equivalent 15-30 minutes to heat
up to 60°C (140°F) before using.
3. Install the line adapters into the transmission cooler lines.
4. Attach the Turbo-Tank Heated Cooler Line Flusher or equivalent red line to the transmission fluid
cooler pressure line quick disconnect fitting.
5. Attach the Turbo-Tank Heated Cooler Line Flusher or equivalent blue line to the transmission
fluid cooler return line quick disconnect fitting.
6. Follow the equipment instructions to purge the cooler lines and cooler prior to starting the
flushing procedure.
7. Allow the cooling system to backflush for 10-15 minutes, then flush the cooler in a normal flow
direction for an additional 10-15 minutes.
Transmission Fluid Cooler Leaks At Radiator
Transmission Cooling
Component Test
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 4165
Transmission Fluid Cooler Leaks at Radiator
Transmission fluid may leak between the radiator transmission fluid cooler and the transmission
fluid cooler fitting (not the cooler tube into the fitting), which may result in a residue of transmission
fluid on the radiator tank around the fluid cooler fitting. The in-tank transmission fluid cooler is not
serviceable. If installation of a new transmission fluid cooler is required, refer to Cooling System.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Auxiliary Transmission Fluid Cooler
Transmission Cooler: Service and Repair Auxiliary Transmission Fluid Cooler
Auxiliary Transmission Fluid Cooler
Removal
1. Remove the upper radiator cover.
1. Remove the fasteners.
2. Remove and discard the auxiliary transmission fluid cooler inlet hose clamp.
3. Disconnect the auxiliary transmission fluid cooler inlet hose from the cooler.
4. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
5. Position the flexible air deflector aside, then remove and discard the auxiliary transmission fluid
cooler outlet hose clamp.
6. Disconnect the auxiliary transmission fluid cooler outlet hose from the cooler.
7. Remove the auxiliary transmission fluid cooler.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Auxiliary Transmission Fluid Cooler > Page 4168
Installation
1. Install the auxiliary transmission fluid cooler.
2. Connect the auxiliary transmission fluid cooler outlet hose to the cooler.
3. Install a new auxiliary transmission fluid cooler outlet hose clamp, then position the flexible air
deflector back into place.
4. Connect the auxiliary transmission fluid cooler inlet hose to the cooler.
5. Install a new auxiliary transmission fluid cooler inlet hose clamp.
6. Install the upper radiator cover.
1. Install the fasteners.
7. Fill the transmission with fluid and verify correct operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Auxiliary Transmission Fluid Cooler > Page 4169
Transmission Cooler: Service and Repair Transmission Fluid Cooler Hoses
Transmission Fluid Cooler Hoses
Removal
1. Remove the upper radiator cover.
1. Remove the fasteners.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Auxiliary Transmission Fluid Cooler > Page 4170
2. Remove and discard the auxiliary transmission fluid cooler inlet hose clamps.
3. Disconnect the auxiliary transmission fluid cooler inlet hose from the coolers.
4. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
5. Position the flexible air deflector aside, then remove and discard the transmission fluid cooler
tube secondary latches.
6. Using the Transmission Cooler Line Disconnect Tool, disconnect the transmission fluid cooler
hoses from the transmission fluid cooler tubes.
7. Remove and discard the transmission fluid cooler hose clamps.
8. Disconnect the transmission fluid cooler hoses from the coolers.
Installation
1. Connect the transmission fluid cooler hoses to the coolers.
2. Install new transmission fluid cooler hose clamps.
3. Connect the transmission fluid cooler hoses to the transmission fluid cooler tubes.
4. Install new transmission fluid cooler tube secondary latches, then position the flexible air
deflector back into place.
5. Connect the auxiliary transmission fluid cooler inlet hose to the coolers.
6. Install new auxiliary transmission fluid cooler inlet hose clamps.
7. Install the upper radiator cover.
1. Install the fasteners.
8. Fill the transmission with fluid and verify correct operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Auxiliary Transmission Fluid Cooler > Page 4171
Transmission Cooler: Service and Repair Transmission Fluid Cooler Tubes
Transmission Fluid Cooler Tubes
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the pushpin and position the air deflector aside.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Auxiliary Transmission Fluid Cooler > Page 4172
3. Remove the transmission cooler tube secondary latches.
4. Using the Transmission Cooler Line Disconnect Tool, disconnect the transmission fluid cooler
tubes from the transmission fluid cooler hoses.
5. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bracket nut from the front of the engine.
6. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bracket bolt from the RH side of the transmission.
7. NOTE: The transmission fluid cooler tube O-rings may remain in the transmission case.
Carefully remove them from the case if retained.
Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bracket bolt and disconnect the transmission fluid cooler
tubes from the transmission.
8. Remove and discard the 4 sway bar bracket nuts and lower the front sway bar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Auxiliary Transmission Fluid Cooler > Page 4173
9. NOTICE: Only use hand tools when removing the engine mount nuts or damage to the engine
mount may occur.
For Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) vehicles, remove the RH engine mount nuts and lift the engine
approximately 25 mm (1 in) to gain clearance for the transmission cooler tubes.
10. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tubes from the vehicle.
Installation
1. Position the transmission fluid cooler tubes in the vehicle.
2. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube bracket to the side of the transmission and install the
transmission fluid cooler tube bracket bolt.
- Tighten to 48 Nm (35 lb-ft).
3. Position the transmission fluid cooler tube bracket to the front of the engine and install the nut.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
4. Connect the transmission fluid cooler tubes to the transmission fluid cooler hoses.
5. Install the transmission cooler tube secondary latches.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Auxiliary Transmission Fluid Cooler > Page 4174
6. Reposition the air deflector and install the pushpin.
7. Position the sway bar in place and install 4 new sway bar bracket nuts.
- Tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
8. NOTICE: Only use hand tools when installing the engine mount nuts or damage to the engine
mount may occur.
For 4WD vehicles, lower the engine and install the RH engine mount nuts.
- Tighten to 175 Nm (129 lb-ft).
9. NOTE: Inspect the case to make sure that the old transmission fluid cooler tube O-rings are not
stuck in the case.
NOTE: Install new transmission fluid cooler tube O-rings on the ends of the cooler lines prior to
installing.
Install new O-rings on the transmission fluid cooler tubes.
10. Position the transmission fluid cooler tubes into the transmission, then install the transmission
fluid cooler tube bracket bolt.
- Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Auxiliary Transmission Fluid Cooler > Page 4175
11. Fill the transmission with fluid and verify correct operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode
Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Transmission Control Indicator Lamp (TCIL)
The TCIL is an output signal from the PCM that controls the lamp on/off function depending on the
engagement or disengagement of overdrive.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4182
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4183
Transmission Mode Switch: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
The TCS signals the PCM with VPWR whenever the TCS is pressed. On vehicles with this feature,
the transmission control indicator lamp (TCIL) illuminates when the TCS is cycled to disengage
overdrive.
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS) (Column Shift)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS) (Floor Shift)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Valve Body: > 10-18-1 > Sep > 10 > A/T Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735
Valve Body: Customer Interest A/T - Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735
TSB 10-18-1
09/27/10
5.4L WITH 6R75/6R80 - DELAYED FORWARD/REVERSE ENGAGEMENT - DTCS P0741,
P0731, AND/OR P0735 - AFTER COLD START
FORD: 2007-2010 Expedition 2009-2010 F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2010 Expedition, 2009-2010 Navigator and F-150 vehicles equipped with a
5.4L engine and a 6R75/6R80 transmission may exhibit delayed forward/reverse engagement.
Diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) P0741, P0731, and/or P0735 for torque converter and/or gear
ratio concerns may be stored in the powertrain control module (PCM). This concern typically occurs
after cold start and in colder climates.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Remove the mechatronic assembly. Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Inspect the fluid pump adapter seal molded frame for evidence of cracks, which are most often
found in the corner(s) of the molded frame.
a. If evidence of cracks are present, proceed to Step 3.
b. If evidence of cracks are not present, do not continue with this article. Refer to WSM Section
307-01 for further diagnostics.
3. Partially disassemble the mechatronic assembly to access only the main oil pressure regulator
valve located in the lower half. Refer to WSM, Section
307-01.
4. Inspect the main oil pressure regulator valve for free movement in its bore.
a. If the valve moves easily in the bore, proceed to Step 5.
b. If the valve does not move or sticks, remove the valve and clean both the valve and bore,
reinstall the valve. Proceed to Step 5.
5. Reassemble the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
6. Install a new front pump adapter seal.
7. Reinstall the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101801A 2007-2010 Expedition, 2.7 Hrs.
2009-2010 F-150,
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Valve Body: > 10-18-1 > Sep > 10 > A/T Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735 > Page 4192
Navigator: Follow Service Procedure To Repair Mechatronic Includes Time To Remove And Install
The Mechatronic And Reprogram (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7F401 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 10-18-1 > Sep > 10
> A/T - Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735
Valve Body: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735
TSB 10-18-1
09/27/10
5.4L WITH 6R75/6R80 - DELAYED FORWARD/REVERSE ENGAGEMENT - DTCS P0741,
P0731, AND/OR P0735 - AFTER COLD START
FORD: 2007-2010 Expedition 2009-2010 F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2010 Expedition, 2009-2010 Navigator and F-150 vehicles equipped with a
5.4L engine and a 6R75/6R80 transmission may exhibit delayed forward/reverse engagement.
Diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) P0741, P0731, and/or P0735 for torque converter and/or gear
ratio concerns may be stored in the powertrain control module (PCM). This concern typically occurs
after cold start and in colder climates.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Remove the mechatronic assembly. Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Inspect the fluid pump adapter seal molded frame for evidence of cracks, which are most often
found in the corner(s) of the molded frame.
a. If evidence of cracks are present, proceed to Step 3.
b. If evidence of cracks are not present, do not continue with this article. Refer to WSM Section
307-01 for further diagnostics.
3. Partially disassemble the mechatronic assembly to access only the main oil pressure regulator
valve located in the lower half. Refer to WSM, Section
307-01.
4. Inspect the main oil pressure regulator valve for free movement in its bore.
a. If the valve moves easily in the bore, proceed to Step 5.
b. If the valve does not move or sticks, remove the valve and clean both the valve and bore,
reinstall the valve. Proceed to Step 5.
5. Reassemble the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
6. Install a new front pump adapter seal.
7. Reinstall the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101801A 2007-2010 Expedition, 2.7 Hrs.
2009-2010 F-150,
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 10-18-1 > Sep > 10
> A/T - Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735 > Page 4198
Navigator: Follow Service Procedure To Repair Mechatronic Includes Time To Remove And Install
The Mechatronic And Reprogram (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7F401 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4199
Valve Body: Locations
Check Ball Location
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4200
Valve Body: Diagrams
Mechatronic Assembly
Mechatronic Upper Half
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4201
Mechatronic Lower Half
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4202
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4203
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4204
Check Ball Location
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4205
Valve Body: Service and Repair
6R80
Mechatronic Assembly
Removal
Mechatronic assembly
NOTICE: The only solenoid that is serviceable in the mechatronic assembly is Shift Solenoid E
(SSE). If the mechatronic assembly is being removed due to a faulty SSE, follow the specific steps
in this procedure to install a new SSE. If the mechatronic assembly is being removed due to a
faulty solenoid other than SSE, a new mechatronic assembly must be installed.
NOTE: If a new or existing mechatronic assembly is installed, the Transmission Control Module
(TCM) will need to be flashed with the latest calibration level.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. NOTICE: Do not pull on the wire harness to disconnect the connector or damage to the
connector will occur.
Disconnect the main transmission electrical harness by twisting the outer shell and pulling back on
the connector.
3. Remove the transmission fluid fill plug transmission fluid level indicator assembly located on the
passenger side front portion of the transmission
case. Removal of the transmission fluid fill plug will relieve any vacuum that might have built up in
the transmission. This will aid in allowing the transmission fluid pan to be easily removed when the
bolts are removed.
4. Remove the transmission fluid pan and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
5. Remove the transmission fluid pan gasket.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4206
6. Remove and discard the transmission fluid filter.
7. Pull the release tab and pull down on the bulkhead connector retainer.
8. NOTICE: Do not touch the electrical connector pins or the exposed solenoid tabs on the
transmission vehicle harness connector.
Electrostatic discharge may occur and may cause damage to the mechatronic unit.
With the release tab down, pull the outer shell of the transmission vehicle harness connector out of
the mechatronic assembly.
9. NOTICE: Do not touch the electrical connector pins or the exposed solenoid tabs on the
transmission vehicle harness connector.
Electrostatic discharge may occur and may cause damage to the mechatronic unit.
Pull the transmission vehicle harness connector out of the transmission.
10. NOTICE: During removal of the mechatronic assembly, the thermal bypass valve will fall out of
the transmission case. Damage to the
valve will occur if the valve falls out.
Remove the 11 bolts from the mechatronic assembly and remove the mechatronic assembly and
the bypass valve.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4207
Shift Solenoid E (SSE)
11. Remove the 6 long bolts from the TCM unit.
12. Carefully separate the TCM from the mechatronic assembly.
1. TCM
2. Mechatronic assembly
13. Remove the 8 solenoid bracket bolts and the solenoid bracket.
14. Remove Shift Solenoid E (SSE).
Installation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4208
SSE
1. Install SSE.
2. Position the solenoid bracket in place and install the 8 bolts.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
3. Position the TCM on the mechatronic assembly.
1. TCM
2. Mechatronic assembly
4. Install the 6 long bolts into the TCM unit. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
Mechatronic assembly
5. NOTE: Before installing the mechatronic assembly into the transmission case, verify presence
and correct orientation of the thermal bypass valve,
pump adapter seal and center support seals. Also note that one or more of the center support seals
may have remained in the mechatronic assembly during removal and should be installed into the
transmission case at this time.
Verify the 4 rubber feed tubes for the center support are in place.
1. Black feed tubes
2. Green feed tube
3. Blue feed tube
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4209
6. Verify the rubber adapter is in place.
7. Coat the thermal bypass valve with petroleum jelly to hold it in place and install the thermal
bypass valve in the transmission case.
8. NOTICE: Do not touch the electrical connector pins or the exposed solenoid tabs on the
transmission vehicle harness connector.
Electrostatic discharge may occur and may cause damage to the mechatronic unit.
Position the mechatronic assembly in place and loosely install the 11 bolts.
1. Align the manual valve and control lever linkage.
9. Tighten the mechatronic bolts in the sequence shown.
- Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
10. NOTICE: Do not touch the electrical connector pins or the exposed solenoid tabs on the
transmission vehicle harness connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4210
Electrostatic discharge may occur and may cause damage to the mechatronic unit.
With the release tab down and unlocked, push the outer shell of the transmission vehicle harness
connector into the transmission. Make sure that the transmission vehicle harness connector is fully
seated into the mechatronic assembly.
11. Press up on the tab and lock the outer shell of the transmission vehicle harness electrical
connector in place. Make sure that the locking tab is
securely locked.
12. Install a new transmission fluid filter.
13. NOTE: The transmission fluid pan gasket can be reused if not damaged.
Install a new transmission fluid pan gasket, if required.
14. Install the transmission fluid pan and tighten the transmission fluid pan bolts in a crisscross
pattern.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
15. Connect the main transmission electrical harness by pushing it in and twisting the outer shell to
lock it in place.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4211
16. Make sure the transmission fluid is at the correct level, follow the steps for Adding Additional
Transmission Fluid or Removing Transmission
Fluid. For additional information, refer to Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill See: Service and
Repair/Procedures/Transmission Fluid Drain And Refill.
17. If a new or existing mechatronic assembly is installed, the TCM will need to be flashed with the
latest calibration.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Wiring Harness, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wiring Harness: > 11-3-25 > Mar > 11 > A/T Fluid Leaks From Bulkhead Connector
Wiring Harness: Customer Interest A/T - Fluid Leaks From Bulkhead Connector
TSB 11-3-25
03/31/11
6R80 TRANSMISSION BULKHEAD CONNECTOR SLEEVE LEAKING TRANSMISSION FLUID
FORD: 2009-2010 Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer, F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
MERCURY: 2009-2010 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 F-150, Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer, Mountaineer and
Navigator vehicles equipped with a 6R80 transmission may show signs of transmission fluid
leakage around the transmission bulkhead connector sleeve.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Verify the leak is present at the transmission bulkhead connector sleeve. With the vehicle in
neutral, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section
100-02.
1. Disconnect the transmission vehicle harness connector by twisting the outer shell and pulling
back on the connector.
2. Remove the transmission fluid pan and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
3. Pull the release tab and pull down on the transmission bulkhead electrical connector retainer.
4. With the release tab down, pull the connector sleeve out of the case/mechatronic assembly.
5. Lube new connector sleeve 0-rings with clean transmission fluid, then install connector sleeve
into case/mechantronic assembly.
6. Press up on the tab and lock the outer shell of the transmission bulkhead electrical connector
sleeve in place. Make sure that the locking tab is
securely locked.
7. Install the transmission fluid pan/gasket and refill transmission fluid refer to WSM, Section
307-01 for refill procedure.
NOTE
DO NOT TOUCH THE ELECTRICAL CONNECTOR PINS OR THE EXPOSED SOLENOID TABS
ON THE TRANSMISSION BULKHEAD ELECTRICAL CONNECTOR. ELECTROSTATIC
DISCHARGE MAY OCCUR AND MAY CAUSE DAMAGE TO THE TRANSMISSION CONTROL
MODULE (TCM).
NOTE
BULKHEAD CONNECTOR SLEEVES MAY COME WITH RED OR BLACK 0-RING SEALS. USE
ONLY BULKHEAD CONNECTOR SLEEVE THAT HAS BLACK 0-RING SEAL FOR THIS
PROCEDURE.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Wiring Harness, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wiring Harness: > 11-3-25 > Mar > 11 > A/T Fluid Leaks From Bulkhead Connector > Page 4220
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
110325A 2009-2010 Explorer, 1.7 Hrs.
Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac, And F-150: Replace Connector Sleeve Includes Time To
Remove And Install Transmission Fluid Pan (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
110325A 2009-2010 Expedition And 1.8 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Connector Sleeve Includes Time To Remove And Install Transmission Fluid
Pan (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7G276 D8
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Wiring Harness, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 11-3-25 > Mar
> 11 > A/T - Fluid Leaks From Bulkhead Connector
Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Fluid Leaks From Bulkhead Connector
TSB 11-3-25
03/31/11
6R80 TRANSMISSION BULKHEAD CONNECTOR SLEEVE LEAKING TRANSMISSION FLUID
FORD: 2009-2010 Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer, F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
MERCURY: 2009-2010 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 F-150, Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer, Mountaineer and
Navigator vehicles equipped with a 6R80 transmission may show signs of transmission fluid
leakage around the transmission bulkhead connector sleeve.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Verify the leak is present at the transmission bulkhead connector sleeve. With the vehicle in
neutral, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section
100-02.
1. Disconnect the transmission vehicle harness connector by twisting the outer shell and pulling
back on the connector.
2. Remove the transmission fluid pan and allow the transmission fluid to drain.
3. Pull the release tab and pull down on the transmission bulkhead electrical connector retainer.
4. With the release tab down, pull the connector sleeve out of the case/mechatronic assembly.
5. Lube new connector sleeve 0-rings with clean transmission fluid, then install connector sleeve
into case/mechantronic assembly.
6. Press up on the tab and lock the outer shell of the transmission bulkhead electrical connector
sleeve in place. Make sure that the locking tab is
securely locked.
7. Install the transmission fluid pan/gasket and refill transmission fluid refer to WSM, Section
307-01 for refill procedure.
NOTE
DO NOT TOUCH THE ELECTRICAL CONNECTOR PINS OR THE EXPOSED SOLENOID TABS
ON THE TRANSMISSION BULKHEAD ELECTRICAL CONNECTOR. ELECTROSTATIC
DISCHARGE MAY OCCUR AND MAY CAUSE DAMAGE TO THE TRANSMISSION CONTROL
MODULE (TCM).
NOTE
BULKHEAD CONNECTOR SLEEVES MAY COME WITH RED OR BLACK 0-RING SEALS. USE
ONLY BULKHEAD CONNECTOR SLEEVE THAT HAS BLACK 0-RING SEAL FOR THIS
PROCEDURE.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Wiring Harness, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 11-3-25 > Mar
> 11 > A/T - Fluid Leaks From Bulkhead Connector > Page 4226
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
110325A 2009-2010 Explorer, 1.7 Hrs.
Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac, And F-150: Replace Connector Sleeve Includes Time To
Remove And Install Transmission Fluid Pan (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
110325A 2009-2010 Expedition And 1.8 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Connector Sleeve Includes Time To Remove And Install Transmission Fluid
Pan (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7G276 D8
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Fluid - Differential > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Fluid - Differential: Capacity Specifications
Differential Oil Capacity
Conventional Differential .....................................................................................................................
..................................................... 4.5 Pints ( 2.13 L ) Limited Slip Differential ...................................
...................................................................................................................................... 4.25 Pints (
2.01 L )
NOTE: Add 4 oz. (118 ml) of Additive Friction Modifier XL-3 (or equivalent) for complete refill of
Ford Limited Slip axles
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Fluid - Differential > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 4232
Fluid - Differential: Fluid Type Specifications
Differential Fluid Type
Ford Part Name ..................................................................................................................................
Motorcraft SAE 75W-140 Synthetic Rear Axle Lube Ford Part Number .............................................
..........................................................................................................................................
XY-75W140-QL Ford Part Specification ..............................................................................................
................................................................................. WSL-M2C192-A
NOTE: Your vehicles rear axle is filled with a synthetic rear axle lubricant and is considered
lubricated for life. These lubricants are not to be checked or changed unless a leak is suspected,
service is required or the axle has been submerged in water. The axle lubricant should be changed
any time the axle has been submerged in water.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Output Shaft, Differential > Differential
Output Shaft Bearing > Component Information > Service and Repair
Differential Output Shaft Bearing: Service and Repair
Stub Shaft Pilot Bearing and Seal
NOTE: The stub shaft seals must be replaced whenever the halfshafts are removed.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Output Shaft, Differential > Differential
Output Shaft Bearing > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4237
1. Remove the halfshaft assembly.
2. NOTE: If removing the stub shaft pilot bearing oil seal only, engage the tangs of the Bearing
Remover on the stub shaft pilot bearing oil seal only.
Using the Slide Hammer and Bearing Remover, remove and discard the stub shaft pilot bearing
and the stub shaft pilot bearing oil seal.
3. Inspect the seal journal for rust, nicks and scratches. Polish the seal journal surface with fine
crocus cloth, if necessary.
4. Lubricate the new stub shaft pilot bearing with axle lubricant.
5. NOTE: Installation of the stub shaft pilot bearing or stub shaft oil seal without the correct tools
can result in early bearing or seal failure. If the
stub shaft pilot bearing becomes cocked in the bore during installation, remove it and install a new
one.
Place the stub shaft pilot bearing onto the Halfshaft Pilot Bearing Installer and Adapter.
6. Install the stub shaft pilot bearing into the rear axle housing bore.
7. NOTE: Do not disassemble the new oil seal.
NOTE: Use a tool like the Lisle LIS17850 to avoid interference with the suspension components.
Install the new seal onto a suitable installer.
8. NOTICE: Strike only the handle. Directly striking the installer tool will damage the seal.
Carefully align the stub shaft pilot bearing seal with the housing bore and install the stub shaft pilot
bearing seal flush in the differential housing.
9. NOTE: If a feeler gauge of the specification shown in the illustration can be inserted between the
stub shaft oil seal and the differential housing,
the stub shaft seal is not seated correctly. Remove the stub shaft oil seal and install a new stub
shaft oil seal.
Make sure the stub shaft oil seal is correctly seated in the differential housing.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Output Shaft, Differential > Differential
Output Shaft Bearing > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4238
10. NOTE: Inspect the stub shaft seal journal for rust, nicks or scratches prior to installing the
halfshaft. Polish the seal journal with fine crocus cloth,
if required.
Install the halfshaft.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Flange, Differential > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Pinion Flange: Service and Repair
Drive Pinion Flange and Drive Pinion Seal
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Flange, Differential > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 4242
Removal
NOTICE: This operation disturbs the pinion bearing preload. Carefully reset the pinion bearing
preload during installation or damage to the component may occur.
NOTE: Remove the rear wheel and tire assemblies, brake calipers and brake discs to prevent
brake drag during the drive pinion bearing preload adjustment.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the rear wheel and tire.
3. NOTICE: Do not allow the brake caliper to hang from the brake hose. Provide a suitable support
or damage to the component may
occur.
Remove the rear brake discs.
4. Remove the rear driveshaft assembly.
5. Install a Nm (lb-in) torque wrench on the nut and record the torque necessary to maintain
rotation of the drive pinion gear through several
revolutions.
6. NOTICE: Install a new pinion nut with the same color as the original if not replacing the
collapsible spacer. If a new collapsible spacer is
installed, install the nut in the kit or damage to the component may occur.
Using the Drive Pinion Flange Holding Fixture to hold the pinion flange, remove the pinion nut.
- Discard the nut.
7. Index-mark the drive pinion flange and the drive pinion gear stem to maintain initial balance
during installation.
8. Using the 2-Jaw Puller, remove the drive pinion flange.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Flange, Differential > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 4243
9. Force up on the metal flange of the drive pinion seal. Install gripping pliers and strike with a
hammer until the pinion seal is removed.
Installation
1. Lubricate the lips of the new drive pinion seal with grease.
2. NOTE: If the drive pinion seal becomes misaligned during installation, remove it and install a
new seal.
Using the Drive Pinion Oil Seal Installer, install the drive pinion seal.
3. Lubricate the drive pinion flange splines with rear axle lubricant.
4. NOTE: Disregard the index marks if installing a new drive pinion flange.
Position the drive pinion flange.
5. Using the Drive Pinion Flange Installer, install the drive pinion flange.
6. NOTICE: The color on the rear face of the drive pinion nut is critical to this repair. Use the same
color new drive pinion nut for
installation as the original. If a new collapsible spacer must be installed for pinion bearing preload
reduction, install the nut supplied with the new spacer or damage to the component may occur.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Flange, Differential > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 4244
Select the correct drive pinion nut for installation.
7. Position the new drive pinion nut.
8. NOTICE: Do not under any circumstance loosen the nut to reduce preload. If it is necessary to
reduce preload, install a new drive pinion
collapsible spacer. If a new collapsible spacer must be installed for pinion bearing preload
reduction, install the nut supplied with the new spacer or damage to the component may occur.
NOTE: Remove the Drive Pinion Flange Holding Fixture while taking preload readings with the Nm
(inch-pound) torque wrench.
Using the Drive Pinion Flange Holding Fixture to hold the pinion flange, tighten the nut.
- Rotate the pinion occasionally to make sure the pinion bearings seat correctly. Take frequent
pinion bearing torque preload readings by rotating the drive pinion gear with a Nm (lb-in) torque
wrench.
- If the preload recorded prior to disassembly is lower than the specification for used bearings,
tighten the nut to specification. If the preload recorded prior to disassembly is higher than the
specification for used bearings, tighten the nut to the original reading as recorded.
- Refer to the torque specification for used pinion bearings in the Specifications portion.
9. NOTICE: The driveshaft flange yoke fits tightly on the pinion flange pilot. To make sure that the
yoke seats squarely on the flange,
tighten the bolts evenly in a cross pattern as shown or damage to the component may occur.
NOTE: Align the index marks.
Install the rear driveshaft.
10. Install the rear brake discs.
11. Install the rear wheel and tire.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Stub Shaft Pilot Bearing And Seal
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Stub Shaft Pilot Bearing And Seal
Stub Shaft Pilot Bearing and Seal
NOTE: The stub shaft seals must be replaced whenever the halfshafts are removed.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Stub Shaft Pilot Bearing And Seal > Page 4249
1. Remove the halfshaft assembly.
2. NOTE: If removing the stub shaft pilot bearing oil seal only, engage the tangs of the Bearing
Remover on the stub shaft pilot bearing oil seal only.
Using the Slide Hammer and Bearing Remover, remove and discard the stub shaft pilot bearing
and the stub shaft pilot bearing oil seal.
3. Inspect the seal journal for rust, nicks and scratches. Polish the seal journal surface with fine
crocus cloth, if necessary.
4. Lubricate the new stub shaft pilot bearing with axle lubricant.
5. NOTE: Installation of the stub shaft pilot bearing or stub shaft oil seal without the correct tools
can result in early bearing or seal failure. If the
stub shaft pilot bearing becomes cocked in the bore during installation, remove it and install a new
one.
Place the stub shaft pilot bearing onto the Halfshaft Pilot Bearing Installer and Adapter.
6. Install the stub shaft pilot bearing into the rear axle housing bore.
7. NOTE: Do not disassemble the new oil seal.
NOTE: Use a tool like the Lisle LIS17850 to avoid interference with the suspension components.
Install the new seal onto a suitable installer.
8. NOTICE: Strike only the handle. Directly striking the installer tool will damage the seal.
Carefully align the stub shaft pilot bearing seal with the housing bore and install the stub shaft pilot
bearing seal flush in the differential housing.
9. NOTE: If a feeler gauge of the specification shown in the illustration can be inserted between the
stub shaft oil seal and the differential housing,
the stub shaft seal is not seated correctly. Remove the stub shaft oil seal and install a new stub
shaft oil seal.
Make sure the stub shaft oil seal is correctly seated in the differential housing.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Stub Shaft Pilot Bearing And Seal > Page 4250
10. NOTE: Inspect the stub shaft seal journal for rust, nicks or scratches prior to installing the
halfshaft. Polish the seal journal with fine crocus cloth,
if required.
Install the halfshaft.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Stub Shaft Pilot Bearing And Seal > Page 4251
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Drive Pinion Flange And Drive Pinion Seal
Drive Pinion Flange and Drive Pinion Seal
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Stub Shaft Pilot Bearing And Seal > Page 4252
Removal
NOTICE: This operation disturbs the pinion bearing preload. Carefully reset the pinion bearing
preload during installation or damage to the component may occur.
NOTE: Remove the rear wheel and tire assemblies, brake calipers and brake discs to prevent
brake drag during the drive pinion bearing preload adjustment.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the rear wheel and tire.
3. NOTICE: Do not allow the brake caliper to hang from the brake hose. Provide a suitable support
or damage to the component may
occur.
Remove the rear brake discs.
4. Remove the rear driveshaft assembly.
5. Install a Nm (lb-in) torque wrench on the nut and record the torque necessary to maintain
rotation of the drive pinion gear through several
revolutions.
6. NOTICE: Install a new pinion nut with the same color as the original if not replacing the
collapsible spacer. If a new collapsible spacer is
installed, install the nut in the kit or damage to the component may occur.
Using the Drive Pinion Flange Holding Fixture to hold the pinion flange, remove the pinion nut.
- Discard the nut.
7. Index-mark the drive pinion flange and the drive pinion gear stem to maintain initial balance
during installation.
8. Using the 2-Jaw Puller, remove the drive pinion flange.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Stub Shaft Pilot Bearing And Seal > Page 4253
9. Force up on the metal flange of the drive pinion seal. Install gripping pliers and strike with a
hammer until the pinion seal is removed.
Installation
1. Lubricate the lips of the new drive pinion seal with grease.
2. NOTE: If the drive pinion seal becomes misaligned during installation, remove it and install a
new seal.
Using the Drive Pinion Oil Seal Installer, install the drive pinion seal.
3. Lubricate the drive pinion flange splines with rear axle lubricant.
4. NOTE: Disregard the index marks if installing a new drive pinion flange.
Position the drive pinion flange.
5. Using the Drive Pinion Flange Installer, install the drive pinion flange.
6. NOTICE: The color on the rear face of the drive pinion nut is critical to this repair. Use the same
color new drive pinion nut for
installation as the original. If a new collapsible spacer must be installed for pinion bearing preload
reduction, install the nut supplied with the new spacer or damage to the component may occur.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Stub Shaft Pilot Bearing And Seal > Page 4254
Select the correct drive pinion nut for installation.
7. Position the new drive pinion nut.
8. NOTICE: Do not under any circumstance loosen the nut to reduce preload. If it is necessary to
reduce preload, install a new drive pinion
collapsible spacer. If a new collapsible spacer must be installed for pinion bearing preload
reduction, install the nut supplied with the new spacer or damage to the component may occur.
NOTE: Remove the Drive Pinion Flange Holding Fixture while taking preload readings with the Nm
(inch-pound) torque wrench.
Using the Drive Pinion Flange Holding Fixture to hold the pinion flange, tighten the nut.
- Rotate the pinion occasionally to make sure the pinion bearings seat correctly. Take frequent
pinion bearing torque preload readings by rotating the drive pinion gear with a Nm (lb-in) torque
wrench.
- If the preload recorded prior to disassembly is lower than the specification for used bearings,
tighten the nut to specification. If the preload recorded prior to disassembly is higher than the
specification for used bearings, tighten the nut to the original reading as recorded.
- Refer to the torque specification for used pinion bearings in the Specifications portion.
9. NOTICE: The driveshaft flange yoke fits tightly on the pinion flange pilot. To make sure that the
yoke seats squarely on the flange,
tighten the bolts evenly in a cross pattern as shown or damage to the component may occur.
NOTE: Align the index marks.
Install the rear driveshaft.
10. Install the rear brake discs.
11. Install the rear wheel and tire.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Specifications > General Specifications
Axle Shaft Assembly: Specifications General Specifications
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Specifications > General Specifications > Page 4260
Axle Shaft Assembly: Specifications Material
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Specifications > General Specifications > Page 4261
Axle Shaft Assembly: Specifications Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4262
Axle Shaft Assembly: Description and Operation
Rear Drive Halfshafts
NOTE: The outboard CV joint shaft assembly should not be disassembled.
NOTE: Due to the sub-assembly process, if the outboard CV boot needs replacement, the inboard
CV boot must also be replaced. However, the inboard CV boot can be replaced by itself.
The rear drive halfshafts consist of the following:
- Inner CV joints
- Outer CV joints
- Interconnecting shafts
- Convoluted CV joint boots
- CV joint boot clamps
- Special CV high-temperature grease
- CV joint housings
- Ball and cage housings
- A circlip stopper that holds the cross-groove inboard race assembly (inboard CV joint) together
- A circlip that retains the splined inboard CV joint to the differential side gear
- The RH and LH halfshafts are different lengths, with the LH halfshaft being the longer of the 2.
The rear drive halfshafts link the rear axle to the rear wheel hubs. The CV joints allow the halfshafts
to rotate smoothly through the required changes in angles between the stationary axle and the
varying angles of the front wheels including jounce and rebound plus changes while turning. The
CV joints are caged ball type. New halfshaft components are available as kits containing grease,
boots and clamps.
Halfshaft Handling
Handle all halfshaft components carefully during removal and installation and during various
component disassembly and assembly procedures.
- Never pick up or hold the halfshaft only by the inboard or outboard CV joint.
- Do not overangle the CV joints.
- Damage will occur to an assembled inboard CV joint if it is overplunged outward from the joint
housing.
- Never use a hammer to remove or install the halfshafts from the hub.
- Never use the halfshaft assembly as a lever to position other components. Always support the
free end of the halfshaft.
- Do not allow the boots to contact sharp edges or hot exhaust components.
- Handle the halfshaft only by the interconnecting shaft to avoid pull-apart and potential damage to
the CV joints.
- Excessive pulling force on the interconnecting shaft between joints of the halfshaft will result in
internal joint damage. Axial loads used in assisting removal must be applied through the inboard
joint housing only.
- Do not drop assembled halfshafts. The impact will cut the boots from the inside without evidence
of external damage.
- Do not remove the outer CV joint by pulling on the interconnecting shaft.
- Inspect all machined surfaces and splines for damage.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4263
Axle Shaft Assembly: Testing and Inspection
Driveline System
Inspection and Verification
1. Verify the customer concern.
2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of mechanical damage.
Visual Inspection Chart
3. If an obvious cause for an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible)
before proceeding to the next step.
4. If the cause is not visually evident, verify the symptom and GO to Symptom Chart - Driveline or
GO to Symptom Chart - NVH. See: Differential
Assembly/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/Symptom Chart Driveline See: Differential Assembly/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic
Procedures/Symptom Chart - NVH
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement
Axle Shaft Assembly: Removal and Replacement
Halfshaft
Removal and Installation
NOTE: This procedure applies to both rear halfshaft assemblies.
NOTE: Always install a new differential stub shaft seal whenever a rear halfshaft is removed.
1. NOTICE: Do not loosen the rear axle wheel hub retainer until after the wheel and tire assembly
is removed from the vehicle. Wheel
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 4266
bearing damage will occur if the wheel bearing is unloaded with the weight of the vehicle applied.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the wheel and tire.
3. NOTE: Have an assistant press the brake pedal to keep the axle from rotating.
Remove and discard the rear axle wheel hub retainer and the washer.
- To install, tighten to 350 Nm (258 lb-ft).
4. Separate the halfshaft from the knuckle.
5. Remove the brake disc rotor.
6. Remove the upper trailing arm bolt.
- To install, tighten to 250 Nm (184 lb-ft).
7. Remove the upper trailing arm-to-wheel knuckle nut.
- To install, tighten to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
8. Using the Ball Joint Separator, separate the upper arm from the wheel knuckle.
9. Remove and discard the stabilizer bar link nut.
- To install, tighten the new nut to 63 Nm (46 lb-ft).
10. Remove the toe link-to-wheel knuckle bolt.
- To install, tighten 225 Nm (166 lb-ft).
11. Disconnect the anti-lock brake sensor at the connector and open the wire retaining clips.
12. Compress the spring, depress the retaining tabs and detach the parking brake cable from the
wheel knuckle.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 4267
13. Remove the 2 lower trailing arm-to-wheel knuckle bolts.
- To install, tighten to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
14. Rotate the top of the knuckle assembly outboard and remove the halfshaft from the knuckle.
15. Using the Halfshaft Remover and Adapter (Handle), disengage the inboard CV joint housing
from the differential side gear.
16. Remove the halfshaft assembly from the vehicle.
17. Remove and discard the halfshaft retainer circlip.
18. NOTE: Install a new differential stub shaft seal.
NOTE: Always install the halfshaft with a new retainer circlip and a new rear axle wheel hub
retainer.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 4268
Axle Shaft Assembly: Overhaul
Halfshaft Joint
Disassembly
1. Remove the halfshaft from the vehicle. For additional information, refer to Halfshaft See:
Removal and Replacement in the Removal and
Installation portion.
2. NOTE: Do not damage the boot.
Remove the 2 boot clamps.
3. Separate the boot from the inboard CV joint housing.
4. Remove the retaining ring.
5. Remove the inboard CV joint housing.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 4269
6. Index-mark the inner race and ball cage.
7. Remove the 8 balls.
8. Remove the snap ring.
9. Remove the inner race and the ball cage.
10. Remove the inboard boot.
11. Remove the 2 boot clamps.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 4270
12. Remove the outboard boot.
13. NOTE: If the grease is contaminated, clean and inspect the joint for wear. Install a new
outboard CV joint and interconnecting shaft assembly if
worn/damaged.
Check the grease for contamination.
Assembly
1. Position the outboard boot on the shaft.
2. Pack the outboard CV joint with 175 g (6.17 oz) of grease.
1. Use CV joint grease or equivalent provided in the boot kit.
2. Spread any remaining grease from the kit evenly inside the boot.
3. Install the outboard boot.
1. Clean the boot mounting surface.
2. Seat the boot in the joint boot groove.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 4271
4. Position the 2 boot clamps.
5. NOTE: Tighten the through-bolt until the tool is in the closed position.
Using the Constant Velocity Joint Boot Clamp Installer, install the 2 boot clamps.
6. Position the boot clamp on the shaft.
7. Position the inboard boot on the shaft.
8. Position the ball cage on the shaft with the tapered end facing the boot.
9. NOTE: Align the index marks.
Position the inner race on the shaft with the counterbored end facing the boot.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 4272
10. Install the snap ring.
11. Lubricate and position the 8 balls.
- Use CV joint grease or equivalent provided in the boot kit.
12. Fill the inboard CV joint housing with 225 g (7.94 oz) of grease.
- Use CV joint grease or equivalent provided in the boot kit.
13. Position the boot clamp on the inboard CV joint housing.
14. Position the inboard CV joint housing on the ball and race assembly.
15. Install the retaining ring.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 4273
16. Remove any excess grease from the mating surface. Seat the boot in the joint boot groove.
17. Set the halfshaft assembled length to specification. For additional information, refer to
Specifications.
18. NOTE: Do not damage the boot.
Insert a dull screwdriver blade under the boot to release the pressure.
19. NOTE: Tighten the through-bolt until the tool is in the closed position.
Using the Constant Velocity Joint Boot Clamp Installer, install the 2 boot clamps.
20. NOTICE: Verify the spline engagement by checking for spline lash before installing the
halfshaft nut or damage to the component may
occur.
Install the halfshaft in the vehicle. For additional information, refer to Halfshaft See: Removal and
Replacement in the Removal and Installation portion.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Suspension
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front Suspension
Wheel Bearing and Wheel Hub
Removal and Installation
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be
installed with the same part numbers or equivalent parts, if replacement is necessary. Do not use a
replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified
during reassembly to make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector.
2. Remove the wheel and tire.
3. Remove the wheel speed sensor harness bracket bolt and detach the harness from the
retainers.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 4278
4. NOTICE: Do not allow the caliper and anchor plate assembly to hang from the brake hose or
damage to the hose may result.
Remove the 2 bolts and position the caliper and anchor plate aside.
- Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
- To install, tighten to 200 Nm (148 lb-ft).
5. Remove the brake disc.
6. Remove the 4 bolts and the wheel bearing and wheel hub.
- Discard the bolts.
- To install, tighten to 175 Nm (129 lb-ft).
7. If installing a new wheel bearing and wheel hub, remove the wheel speed sensor bolt and the
wheel speed sensor.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
8. NOTICE: If the original wheel bearing and wheel hub is being installed, a new O-ring seal must
be installed or damage to the wheel
bearing may occur.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 4279
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear Suspension
Wheel Bearing and Wheel Hub
Removal
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts and
systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be installed with the
same part numbers or equivalent part, if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement
part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during
reassembly to make sure of correct retention of these parts.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 4280
1. Remove the wheel and tire.
2. NOTE: Have an assistant press the brake pedal to keep the axle from rotating.
Remove and discard the halfshaft nut.
3. Using a suitable hub puller, separate the outboard CV joint from the wheel hub.
4. NOTICE: Do not allow the caliper and anchor plate assembly to hang from the brake hose or
damage to the hose may result.
Remove the bolts and position the caliper and anchor plate assembly aside.
- Support the caliper and anchor plate assembly using mechanic's wire.
5. Remove the brake disc.
6. Detach the wheel speed sensor harness from the retainers and disconnect the wheel speed
sensor electrical connector. Push the wheel speed sensor
harness grommet through the brake disc shield.
7. Remove the 4 bolts, the wheel bearing and wheel hub, and the wheel speed sensor as an
assembly.
- Route the sensor wiring through the access hole in the brake disc shield.
- Discard the bolts.
8. If necessary, remove the wheel speed sensor bolt and the wheel speed sensor from the wheel
bearing and wheel hub.
Installation
1. If necessary, install the wheel speed sensor and bolt.
- Tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
2. Position the wheel bearing and wheel hub, and the wheel speed sensor. Install the 4 new wheel
bearing and wheel hub bolts.
- Route the sensor wiring through the access hole in the brake disc shield.
- Tighten to 175 Nm (129 lb-ft).
3. Attach the wheel speed sensor harness to the retainers and connect the wheel speed sensor
electrical connector. Push the wheel speed sensor
harness grommet through the brake disc shield.
4. Install the brake disc.
5. Position the caliper and anchor plate assembly and install the bolts.
- Tighten to 190 Nm (140 lb-ft).
6. NOTE: Have an assistant press the brake pedal to keep the axle from rotating.
Install the new halfshaft nut.
- Tighten to 300 Nm (221 lb-ft).
7. Install the wheel and tire.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut >
Component Information > Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
Rear Suspension
Wheel Bearing and Wheel Hub
Install the new halfshaft nut, tighten to
.................................................................................................................................................... 300
Nm (221 lb-ft)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub > Wheel Hub Lock
Solenoid > Component Information > Locations
Wheel Hub Lock Solenoid: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub > Wheel Hub Lock
Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 4288
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub > Wheel Hub Lock
Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 4289
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub (Locking) >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Wheel Hub (Locking): Service and Repair
Integrated Wheel End (IWE)
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the front wheel and tire.
3. Remove the dust cap.
4. Remove and discard the axle nut.
5. Disconnect the vacuum tubes from the Integrated Wheel End (IWE).
6. Remove the 3 IWE-to-wheel knuckle retaining bolts.
7. Remove the tie-rod nut and separate the tie rod from the wheel knuckle.
- Discard the tie-rod nut.
8. Remove the wheel speed sensor harness bracket bolt and position the harness aside.
9. Remove the front brake flexible hose bracket bolt and position the brake hose aside.
10. Remove the upper ball joint nut and separate the upper ball joint from the wheel knuckle.
- Discard the upper ball joint nut.
11. NOTE: Allow the wheel knuckle to swing outward while keeping the halfshaft pushed inward.
Once clearance is available, remove the halfshaft outboard end from the wheel knuckle hub
bearing.
12. Remove the IWE from the halfshaft outboard end.
Installation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub (Locking) >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4293
1. Compress the IWE and install a vacuum cap on the vacuum port.
2. NOTICE: Do not dislodge the Integrated Wheel End (IWE) seal spring when installing the IWE
on halfshaft outboard end or component
damage may occur.
Install the IWE onto the halfshaft outboard end.
3. NOTE: Allow the wheel knuckle to swing outward while keeping the halfshaft pushed inward.
Once clearance is available, install the halfshaft outboard end into the wheel knuckle hub bearing.
4. Connect the upper ball joint and install a new nut.
- Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
5. Connect the tie rod and install a new nut.
- Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
6. Position the front brake flexible hose bracket and install the bolt.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
7. Position the wheel speed sensor harness bracket and install the bolt.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
8. Install the 3 IWE-to-wheel knuckle retaining bolts.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
9. Remove the IWE vacuum cap and connect the vacuum tubes.
10. NOTICE: Verify the spline engagement by checking for spline lash before installing the axle nut
or component damage may occur.
Install the new axle nut.
- Tighten to 27 Nm (20 lb-ft).
11. Install the dust cap.
12. Install the front wheel and tire.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Description and Operation
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Description and Operation
Driveshaft
NOTE: All driveshafts are balanced. If undercoating the vehicle, protect the driveshaft and U-joints
to prevent overspray of any undercoating material.
Vehicles have the following types of driveshafts:
- Front driveshaft with CV joints at the front and rear. The front driveshafts are not serviced
- One-piece rear driveshafts with a front and a rear U-joint flange
- Two-piece rear driveshafts with a front U-joint, center bearing with a slip joint and a flanged
U-joint at the rear
Driveshafts are used to transfer movement from the transmission or transfer case to the front or
rear axle. The driveshaft is composed of the U-joints, CV joints, connecting shafts and the
attaching yokes. Some vehicles are equipped with a center support bearing. The center support
bearing is prelubricated and sealed for the life of the bearing.
Driveshafts differ in length, diameter and type of yoke to accommodate various wheelbase and
powertrain combinations.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Procedures
Driveline Angle Measurement
Driveline Angle Measurement
NOTE: This procedure does not apply to CV joints, flex couplers or double cardan joints that are
used in some driveshafts. This check is for single-cross and roller-style joints found in the
driveshafts.
NOTE: Prior to checking driveline angularity, inspect the U-joints for correct operation.
NOTE: An incorrect driveline angle can cause a vibration or shudder.
NOTE: Driveline angularity is the angular relationship between the engine crankshaft, the
driveshaft and the rear axle pinion. Factors determining driveline angularity include ride height, rear
spring and engine mounts.
All vehicles
1. Carry out the following preliminary setup steps:
- Inspect the U-joints for correct operation.
- Park the vehicle on a level surface such as a drive-on hoist, or back onto a front end alignment
rack.
- Verify the curb position ride height is within specifications with the vehicle unloaded and all of the
tires are inflated to their normal operating pressures.
- Calibrate the Anglemaster II Driveline Inclinometer/Protractor by placing it on a clean, flat level
section of the frame rail and press the ALT-ZERO button.
Vehicles with flat-flanged, split-pin or slip-flanged U-joints
2. NOTE: If equipped, remove the snap ring to allow access to the base of the U-joint cup. Make
sure the Anglemaster II Driveline
Inclinometer/Protractor is seated against the U-joint cup.
NOTE: Rotate the driveshaft until the flange U-joint cup is parallel with the floor. This will simplify
taking measurements.
To check the U-joint operating angle, install the Anglemaster II Driveline Inclinometer/Protractor.
Check and record the flange angle as angle A.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4300
3. Using the Anglemaster II Driveline Inclinometer/Protractor, measure the slope of the connecting
component. Record the measurement of the
component angle as angle B.
Multiple piece driveshafts
4. NOTE: Repeat this step for each center support bearing on the driveshaft.
NOTE: It is not necessary to remove the U-joint snap ring, if equipped, for these measurements.
Using the Anglemaster II Driveline Inclinometer/Protractor, measure the slope of the components in
front and behind the center support bearing U-joint in the area indicated. Record the front
component as angle A and the rear component as angle B.
All vehicles
5. NOTE: When 2 connected components slope in the same direction, subtract the smallest
number from the larger number to find the U-joint
operating angle. When 2 connected components slope in the opposite direction, add the
measurements to find the U-joint operating angle.
Calculate the difference in the slope of the components to determine the U-joint operating angle.
- The U-joint operating angle is the angle formed by 2 yokes connected by a cross and bearing kit.
Ideally, the operating angles on each connection of the driveshaft must: be equal or within one degree of each other.
- have a 3 degree maximum operating angle.
- have at least one-half of one degree continuous operating angle.
6. If the angle is not within specifications, repair or adjust to obtain the correct angle. Inspect the
engine mounts, transmission mounts, center support
bearing mounting, rear suspension, rear axle, rear axle mounting or the frame for wear or damage.
Driveshaft Runout And Balancing
Driveshaft Runout and Balancing
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4301
Driveshaft Inspection
NOTE: Driveline vibration exhibits a higher frequency and lower amplitude than high-speed shake.
Driveline vibration is directly related to the speed of the vehicle and is noticed at various speeds.
Driveline vibration can be perceived as a tremor in the floorpan or heard as a rumble, hum or
boom.
NOTE: Refer to Specifications for all runout specifications.
1. NOTE: Do not make any adjustments before carrying out a road test. Do not change the tire
pressure or the vehicle load.
Carry out a visual inspection of the vehicle. Operate the vehicle and verify the condition by
reproducing it during the road test.
- The concern should be directly related to vehicle road speed, not affected by acceleration or
deceleration or could not be reduced by coasting in NEUTRAL.
2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
- The driveshaft should be kept at an angle equal to or close to the curb-weighted position. Use a
twin-post hoist or a frame hoist with jackstands.
3. Inspect the driveshaft for damage, undercoating or incorrectly seated U-joints. Rotate the
driveshaft slowly by hand and feel for binding or end
play in the U-joint trunnions. Remove the driveshaft. Inspect the slip yoke splines for any galling,
dirt, rust or incorrect lubrication. Clean the driveshaft or install new U-joints as necessary. Install a
new driveshaft if damaged. After any corrections or new components are installed, recheck for the
vibration at the road test speed. If the vibration is gone, test drive the vehicle.
- If the vibration persists or the driveshaft passes visual inspection, measure the driveshaft runout.
Driveshaft Runout
1. Install the Dial Indicator Gauge with Holding Fixture. Rotate the driveshaft by turning the axle
and measure the runout at the front, the center and
the rear of the driveshaft. If the runout exceeds 1 mm (0.040 in) at the front or center, install a new driveshaft.
- If the front and center is within 1 mm (0.040 in), but the rear runout is not, index-mark the rear
runout high point and proceed to Step 2.
- If the runout is within 1 mm (0.040 in) at all points, recheck for vibration at road test speed. If the
vibration persists, balance the driveshaft. For additional information, refer to Driveshaft Balancing in
this procedure.
2. NOTE: Circular pinion flanges can be turned in 90 degree or one-fourth increments. Half-round
pinion flanges are limited to 2 positions.
Index-mark the driveshaft to the pinion flange. Disconnect the driveshaft and rotate it 180 degrees.
Reconnect the driveshaft. Recheck the runout at the rear of the driveshaft.
- If the runout is still over specification, mark the high point and proceed to Step 3.
- If the runout is within specification, check for the vibration at the road test speed. If the vibration is
still present, balance the driveshaft. For additional information, refer to Driveshaft Balancing in this
procedure.
3. Excessive driveshaft runout can originate in the driveshaft itself or from the pinion flange. To find
the source, compare the 2 high points
previously determined.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4302
- If the index marks are close together, within 25 mm (1 in), the driveshaft is eccentric. Install a new
driveshaft.
- If the marks are on opposite sides of the driveshaft, 180 degrees apart, the slip yoke or pinion
flange is responsible. Check the pinion flange runout. If the pinion flange runout exceeds
specifications, a bent pinion is indicated.
- If the pinion flange and pinion runouts are within specifications, road test and check for the
vibration at the road test speed. If the vibration persists, balance the driveshaft. For additional
information, refer to Driveshaft Balancing in this procedure.
Driveshaft Balancing - Using the Mastertech(R) Series MTS 4000 Driveline Balance and NVH
Analyzer (Vetronix)
All vehicles
1. Install the Mastertech(R) Series MTS 4000 Driveline Balance and NVH Analyzer (Vetronix) to
the vehicle.
2. Working under the vehicle, install an accelerometer. The accelerometer can be attached and
mounted near either the transmission or differential
end of the driveshaft.
3. Clean an area of the driveshaft and install the reflective tape, then install the photo-tachometer
sensor. The sensor should be placed at
approximately a 20-degree angle from perpendicular to the surface of the reflective tape. Make
sure the sensor does not get moved during the balance procedure.
1. Reflective tape.
2. Photo-tachometer sensor.
4. Using the Mastertech(R) Series MTS 4000 Driveline Balance and NVH Analyzer (Vetronix), run
a driveshaft balance test with the driveshaft
unmodified.
Vehicles with tapped pinion flanges
5. Label the tapped holes in the pinion flange numerically, starting at the top hole as 1. Mark the
remaining holes 2, 3 and 4. Label in the direction of
rotation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4303
6. Using the Mastertech(R) Series MTS 4000 Driveline Balance and NVH Analyzer (Vetronix), run
a second test with the 12 mm (0.47 in) test
weight set screw in the No. 1 hole, previously marked on the pinion flange.
7. Remove the test weight, then install the weight combination directed by the Mastertech(R)
Series MTS 4000 Driveline Balance and NVH
Analyzer (Vetronix).
Vehicles without tapped pinion flanges
8. Using the Mastertech(R) Series MTS 4000 Driveline Balance and NVH Analyzer (Vetronix), run
a second test with a test weight. Using a metal
band, secure the test weight to the end of the driveshaft. The weight should be placed at the end of
the driveshaft tube, as close to the tube-to-yoke weld seam as possible. Mark the location of the
test weight on the driveshaft, as shown in the figure below.
1. Test weight.
2. Tube-to-yoke weld seam.
3. Driveshaft pinion flange.
- Select the test weight based on driveshaft size. Larger driveshafts use 10 g (0.353 oz). Smaller
driveshafts use 5 g (0.176 oz).
9. Remove the test weight, then install the recommended weight at the position directed by the
Mastertech(R) Series MTS 4000 Driveline Balance
and NVH Analyzer (Vetronix). Using a metal band and epoxy, secure the test weight to the
driveshaft, as shown in the figure below.
1. Test weight.
2. Measure in this direction.
3. Driveshaft diameter.
4. Directional rotation.
5. Balance weight relative to test weight centerline.
- The results are displayed with respect to the location to where the test weight was placed.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4304
All vehicles
10. Using the Mastertech(R) Series MTS 4000 Driveline Balance and NVH Analyzer (Vetronix), run
a third test to verify the repair.
Driveshaft Balancing - Hose Clamp Method
1. Install 1 or 2 hose clamps on the driveshaft, near the rear. Position of the hose clamp head(s)
can be determined through trial and error.
2. Mark the rear of the driveshaft into 4 approximately equal sectors and number the marks 1
through 4. Install a hose clamp on the driveshaft with its
head at position No. 1, as shown in the figure below. Check for vibration at road speed. Recheck
with the clamp at each of the other positions to find the position that shows minimum vibration. If 2
adjacent positions show equal improvement, position the clamp head between them.
3. If the vibration persists, add a second clamp at the same position and recheck for vibration.
4. If no improvement is noted, rotate the clamps in opposite directions, equal distances from the
best position determined in Step 2. Separate the
clamp heads about 13 mm (1/2 in) and recheck for vibration at the road speed.
5. Repeat the process with increasing separation until the best combination is found or the vibration
is reduced to an acceptable level.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4305
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Removal and Replacement
Driveshaft - Front
Driveshaft - Front
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position the vehicle on a hoist.
2. Index-mark the front flange to the pinion flange.
3. Index-mark the rear flange to the transfer case flange.
4. Remove and discard the 6 rear flange-to-transfer case flange bolts and 3 washers.
- To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4306
5. Remove and discard the 6 front flange-to-pinion flange bolts and 2 washers.
- To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
6. Remove and discard the 4 stabilizer bracket nuts and allow the stabilizer bar to swing downward.
- To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
7. Remove the front driveshaft from the vehicle.
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Driveshaft - Rear
Driveshaft - Rear
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) Vehicles
Rear Wheel Drive (RWD) Vehicles
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4307
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) vehicles
2. Index-mark the driveshaft flange to the pinion flange.
3. Index-mark the driveshaft slip yoke to the transfer case housing.
4. Remove and discard the 4 driveshaft flange bolts.
5. NOTICE: The driveshaft flange fits tightly on the pinion flange pilot. Never hammer on the
driveshaft or any of its components to
disconnect the driveshaft from the pinion flange. Pry only in the area shown, with a suitable tool, to
disconnect the driveshaft flange from the pinion flange or damage to the component may occur.
Using a suitable tool, disconnect the driveshaft flange from the pinion flange.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4308
6. NOTE: Align the original index-marks at the transfer case. Do not rotate the driveshaft when
removing the slip yoke from the transfer case output
shaft.
Remove the driveshaft.
- Mark the transfer case output shaft to the transfer case housing after removing the driveshaft.
Rear Wheel Drive (RWD) vehicles
7. Index-mark the driveshaft flanges for correct alignment during installation.
8. Remove and discard the 4 driveshaft front flange bolts.
9. Remove and discard the 4 driveshaft rear flange bolts.
10. NOTICE: The driveshaft flange fits tightly on the pinion flange pilot. Never hammer on the
driveshaft or any of its components to
disconnect the driveshaft from the pinion flange. Pry only in the area shown, with a suitable tool, to
disconnect the driveshaft flange from the pinion flange or damage to the component may occur.
Using a suitable tool, disconnect the driveshaft flange from the pinion flange.
11. Remove the 2 driveshaft center bearing bolts, then remove the driveshaft.
- Discard the driveshaft center bearing bolts.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4309
Installation
4WD vehicles
1. Align all the index marks and install the driveshaft slip yoke into the transfer case housing.
2. NOTICE: The driveshaft flange fits tightly on the pinion flange pilot. To make sure that the
driveshaft flange seat squarely on the pinion
flange pilot, tighten the driveshaft flange bolts evenly in a cross pattern or damage to the
component may occur.
Align the index marks and install the driveshaft flange and the 4 driveshaft flange bolts.
- Tighten to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
RWD vehicles
3. NOTE: If new driveshaft center bearing bolts are not available, coat the threads of the original
driveshaft center bearing bolts with threadlock
sealer.
Position the driveshaft center bearing and hand-tighten the 2 new driveshaft center bearing bolts
until the driveshaft is mounted to the flanges.
- Tighten to 48 Nm (35 lb-ft).
4. Install the 4 new driveshaft front flange bolts.
- Tighten the bolts to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
5. NOTICE: The driveshaft flange fits tightly on the pinion flange pilot. To make sure that the
driveshaft flange seats squarely on the pinion
flange pilot, tighten the driveshaft flange bolts evenly in a cross pattern or damage to the
component may occur.
Install the 4 new driveshaft rear flange bolts.
- Tighten to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4310
Driveshaft Slip Yoke Boot
Driveshaft Slip Yoke Boot
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the driveshaft. For additional information, refer to Driveshaft - Rear See: Driveshaft Rear.
2. Index-mark the driveshaft to the center bearing for correct alignment during installation.
3. Remove clamps and disconnect the slip yoke boot.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4311
4. Separate the driveshaft.
5. Remove the slip yoke boot.
6. NOTE: Lubricate the slip yoke splines with premium long-life grease.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Align the index marks for correct alignment.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4312
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Overhaul
Driveshaft - Exploded View
Front, Expedition and Navigator
Rear - Navigator Four-Wheel Drive (4WD), Expedition 4WD and Rear Wheel Drive (RWD)
Rear, Navigator Rear Wheel Drive (RWD)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4313
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Description and Operation
Universal Joint: Description and Operation
Universal Joints
U-joints are composed of the following:
- Spiders
- Trunnions
- Grease seals
- Needle rollers
- Bearing cups
- Thrust washers
- Snap rings
The U-joint is a method of connecting the driveshaft to the drive axle. A U-joint allows the angles of
the output shafts, driveshafts and pinions to rotate smoothly while constantly accelerating and
decelerating. The U-joint is lubricated for the life of the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4317
Universal Joint: Service and Repair
Driveshaft Universal Joint - Single Cardan
Disassembly
1. Remove the driveshaft. For additional information, refer to Driveshaft - Front See: Drive/Propeller
Shaft/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Driveshaft - Front or Driveshaft - Rear See: Drive/Propeller Shaft/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Driveshaft - Rear.
2. NOTICE: Do not clamp the driveshaft in the jaws of a vise or a similar holding fixture or damage
to the component may occur.
Carefully place the driveshaft on a suitable workbench.
3. NOTE: Index-mark the driveshaft components relative to the driveshaft tube. Make sure all
components are reassembled in the same relationship
to maintain correct balance.
Index the driveshaft and driveshaft components.
4. Position the C-Frame and Screw Installer/Remover in a vise.
5. Remove the snap rings from the U-joint.
6. NOTE: If necessary, use a pair of pliers to remove a bearing cup if it cannot be pressed out all
the way.
Remove the driveshaft flange yoke.
1. Position the driveshaft flange in the C-Frame and Screw Installer/Remover.
2. Press out the bearing cup.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4318
3. Rotate the driveshaft flange yoke.
4. Press on the spider to remove the remaining bearing cup.
5. Remove the driveshaft flange yoke.
7. Repeat the previous step to remove the remaining bearing cups and spider from the driveshaft.
8. Clean the yoke area at the end of the driveshaft and flange yoke.
Assembly
NOTE: U-joint service kits are to be installed as complete assemblies only. Do not use components
from other U-joints.
1. Clamp the C-Frame and Screw Installer/Remover in a vise.
2. Install a new bearing cup.
1. Start a new bearing cup into the driveshaft yoke.
2. Position a new spider in the driveshaft yoke.
3. Install the driveshaft into the C-Frame and Screw Installer/Remover.
4. Press the bearing cup below the yoke surface.
3. Remove the driveshaft from the C-Frame and Screw Installer/Remover and install the snap ring.
4. Repeat the previous steps to install the remaining bearing cups.
5. NOTE: Do not strike the bearings. If binding, strike the yoke with a brass or plastic hammer.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4319
Check the U-joint for freedom of movement.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flex Plate > Component Information > Specifications
Flex Plate: Specifications
Install the flexplate and the 8 bolts in the sequence shown. Tighten to...............................................
........................................................................................................................................................80
Nm (59 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flex Plate > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures
Flex Plate: Procedures
Flexplate Inspection
1. Inspect the flexplate for:
1. any cracks.
2. worn ring gear teeth.
3. chipped or cracked ring gear teeth.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flex Plate > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 4325
Flex Plate: Removal and Replacement
Flexplate
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the transmission.
2. Remove the 8 bolts and the flexplate.
- To install, tighten to 80 Nm (59 lb-ft) in the sequence shown.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and
Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Service and Repair
Shift Indicator: Service and Repair
Selector Lever Indicator Bulb
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the selector lever assembly.
2. Release the 4 tabs on the selector lever bezel and lift the selector lever bezel up to the selector
lever knob.
3. Remove the bulb retainers from the bezel and replace the bulb(s) as necessary.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and
Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Transmission Control Indicator Lamp (TCIL)
The TCIL is an output signal from the PCM that controls the lamp on/off function depending on the
engagement or disengagement of overdrive.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Power Take-Off > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Power Take-Off: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Power Take-Off (PTO) Switch and Circuits
The PTO circuit is used by the PCM to disable some of the on board diagnostics (OBD) monitors
during PTO operation. The PTO switch is normally open. When the PTO unit is activated, the PTO
switch is closed and battery voltage is supplied to the PTO input circuit. This indicates to the PCM
that an additional load is being applied to the engine. The PTO indicator lamp illuminates when the
PTO system is functioning correctly and flashes when the PTO system is damaged.
When the PTO unit is activated, the PCM disables some OBD monitors which may not function
reliably during PTO operation. Without the PTO circuit information to the PCM, false DTCs may be
set during PTO operation. Prior to an Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) test, operate the vehicle with
the PTO disengaged long enough to successfully complete the OBD Monitors.
PTO Circuits Description
The three PTO input circuits are PTO mode, PTO engage, and PTO RPM.
The PTO engage circuit is used when the operator is requesting the PCM to check the needed
inputs required to initiate the PTO engagement.
The PTO RPM circuit is used when the operator is requesting additional engine RPM for PTO
operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
Control Module: Customer Interest Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
TSB 09-15-8
08/10/09
5.4L 3V 6R80 - HARSH 1-2 UPSHIFT - HARSH 2-1 DOWNSHIFT WHILE COASTING - HARSH
DOWNSHIFT TO 4TH GEAR - INTERMITTENT P0741
FORD: 2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with 5.4L 3V engine may exhibit
symptoms during warm-up: a harsh 1-2 upshift, harsh 2-1 downshift while coasting 15 MPH (24
Km/h). A harsh downshift into 4th gear at highway speeds 45-70 MPH (72-113 Km/h) may also be
experienced. Some vehicles may have a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0741 torque converter
performance code present or stored.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
MECHATRONIC REPAIR/REPLACEMENT IS NOT
AUTHORIZED FOR THIS ISSUE.
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the Powertrain Control Module/Transmission Control Module (PCM/TCM) calibration
using IDS release 61.15 and higher or 62.03 and
higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be
obtained at the website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the TCM Calibration shows AL3P-7J104-AB part number after reprogramming is
complete.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) OBD Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR TSB TO BE
FULLY AFFECTIVE
3. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 4347
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM.
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175° F (79° C). If it is not at
175° F (79° C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175° F (79° C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091508A 2009 Expedition, Navigator 1.0 Hr.
6R80 Transmission: Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear The
TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 4348
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
TSB 09-15-8
08/10/09
5.4L 3V 6R80 - HARSH 1-2 UPSHIFT - HARSH 2-1 DOWNSHIFT WHILE COASTING - HARSH
DOWNSHIFT TO 4TH GEAR - INTERMITTENT P0741
FORD: 2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with 5.4L 3V engine may exhibit
symptoms during warm-up: a harsh 1-2 upshift, harsh 2-1 downshift while coasting 15 MPH (24
Km/h). A harsh downshift into 4th gear at highway speeds 45-70 MPH (72-113 Km/h) may also be
experienced. Some vehicles may have a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0741 torque converter
performance code present or stored.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
MECHATRONIC REPAIR/REPLACEMENT IS NOT
AUTHORIZED FOR THIS ISSUE.
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the Powertrain Control Module/Transmission Control Module (PCM/TCM) calibration
using IDS release 61.15 and higher or 62.03 and
higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be
obtained at the website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the TCM Calibration shows AL3P-7J104-AB part number after reprogramming is
complete.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) OBD Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR TSB TO BE
FULLY AFFECTIVE
3. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 4354
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM.
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175° F (79° C). If it is not at
175° F (79° C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175° F (79° C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091508A 2009 Expedition, Navigator 1.0 Hr.
6R80 Transmission: Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear The
TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 4355
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Description and Operation
Brake Switch - TCC: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to as the stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal
to the PCM indicating the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Typical BPP Switch
Typical BPP Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4364
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4365
Transmission Mode Switch: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
The TCS signals the PCM with VPWR whenever the TCS is pressed. On vehicles with this feature,
the transmission control indicator lamp (TCIL) illuminates when the TCS is cycled to disengage
overdrive.
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS) (Column Shift)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS) (Floor Shift)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission
Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift
Transmission Mode Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift
Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The Tow/Haul switch is not replaceable. If a new Tow/Haul switch is required, install a new
selector lever assembly.
1. For additional information, refer to Selector Lever - Column Shift See: Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle/Shifter A/T/Service and
Repair/Selector Lever - Column Shift.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information >
Locations
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4374
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4375
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Removal and Installation
1. Apply the park brake.
2. Remove the lower and upper steering column shrouds.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the accessory position and apply the brake or actuate the Brake Shift
Interlock Actuator (BSIA) override.
4. Put the selector lever into the NEUTRAL position.
5. Disconnect the BSIA electrical connector.
6. Remove the BSIA screw.
7. Gently pry the clip up and remove the BSIA.
8. NOTE: When installing the BSIA, verify that the BSIA override has been activated and the slider
is fully rearward. Before rotating the selector
lever from NEUTRAL into PARK, align the selector lever tab into the BSIA.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift > Page 4378
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Service and Repair
Shift Indicator: Service and Repair
Selector Lever Indicator Bulb
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the selector lever assembly.
2. Release the 4 tabs on the selector lever bezel and lift the selector lever bezel up to the selector
lever knob.
3. Remove the bulb retainers from the bezel and replace the bulb(s) as necessary.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Transmission Control Indicator Lamp (TCIL)
The TCIL is an output signal from the PCM that controls the lamp on/off function depending on the
engagement or disengagement of overdrive.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4
Shifts
Control Module: Customer Interest Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
TSB 09-15-8
08/10/09
5.4L 3V 6R80 - HARSH 1-2 UPSHIFT - HARSH 2-1 DOWNSHIFT WHILE COASTING - HARSH
DOWNSHIFT TO 4TH GEAR - INTERMITTENT P0741
FORD: 2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with 5.4L 3V engine may exhibit
symptoms during warm-up: a harsh 1-2 upshift, harsh 2-1 downshift while coasting 15 MPH (24
Km/h). A harsh downshift into 4th gear at highway speeds 45-70 MPH (72-113 Km/h) may also be
experienced. Some vehicles may have a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0741 torque converter
performance code present or stored.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
MECHATRONIC REPAIR/REPLACEMENT IS NOT
AUTHORIZED FOR THIS ISSUE.
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the Powertrain Control Module/Transmission Control Module (PCM/TCM) calibration
using IDS release 61.15 and higher or 62.03 and
higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be
obtained at the website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the TCM Calibration shows AL3P-7J104-AB part number after reprogramming is
complete.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) OBD Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR TSB TO BE
FULLY AFFECTIVE
3. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4
Shifts > Page 4397
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM.
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175° F (79° C). If it is not at
175° F (79° C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175° F (79° C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091508A 2009 Expedition, Navigator 1.0 Hr.
6R80 Transmission: Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear The
TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4
Shifts > Page 4398
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh
1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh 1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts
TSB 09-15-8
08/10/09
5.4L 3V 6R80 - HARSH 1-2 UPSHIFT - HARSH 2-1 DOWNSHIFT WHILE COASTING - HARSH
DOWNSHIFT TO 4TH GEAR - INTERMITTENT P0741
FORD: 2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with 5.4L 3V engine may exhibit
symptoms during warm-up: a harsh 1-2 upshift, harsh 2-1 downshift while coasting 15 MPH (24
Km/h). A harsh downshift into 4th gear at highway speeds 45-70 MPH (72-113 Km/h) may also be
experienced. Some vehicles may have a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) P0741 torque converter
performance code present or stored.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
MECHATRONIC REPAIR/REPLACEMENT IS NOT
AUTHORIZED FOR THIS ISSUE.
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the Powertrain Control Module/Transmission Control Module (PCM/TCM) calibration
using IDS release 61.15 and higher or 62.03 and
higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2009.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be
obtained at the website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
a. Verify that the TCM Calibration shows AL3P-7J104-AB part number after reprogramming is
complete.
b. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) OBD Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Info.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR TSB TO BE
FULLY AFFECTIVE
3. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh
1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 4404
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM.
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175° F (79° C). If it is not at
175° F (79° C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5
Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175° F (79° C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091508A 2009 Expedition, Navigator 1.0 Hr.
6R80 Transmission: Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear The
TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do Not Use With 12650D, 12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 09-15-8 > Aug > 09 > Engine, A/T Controls - Harsh
1-2/2-1/5-4 Shifts > Page 4405
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Brake Switch - TCC: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to as the stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal
to the PCM indicating the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Typical BPP Switch
Typical BPP Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4414
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4415
Transmission Mode Switch: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
The TCS signals the PCM with VPWR whenever the TCS is pressed. On vehicles with this feature,
the transmission control indicator lamp (TCIL) illuminates when the TCS is cycled to disengage
overdrive.
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS) (Column Shift)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS) (Floor Shift)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift
Transmission Mode Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift
Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The Tow/Haul switch is not replaceable. If a new Tow/Haul switch is required, install a new
selector lever assembly.
1. For additional information, refer to Selector Lever - Column Shift See: Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle/Shifter A/T/Service and
Repair/Selector Lever - Column Shift.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Sensor Block >
Component Information > Locations
ABS Sensor Block: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Sensor Block >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4423
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Sensor Block >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4424
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems >
Acceleration/Deceleration Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
Acceleration/Deceleration Sensor: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
Vehicles with floor shift
1. Remove the front floor console.
2. Remove the 4 bolts and the front floor console support bracket.
- To install: Tighten the upper bolts to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
- Tighten the lower bolts to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
Vehicles with column shift
3. Remove the stability control sensor cover.
All vehicles
4. Disconnect the stability control sensor cluster electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems >
Acceleration/Deceleration Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4428
5. Remove the 2 bolts and the stability control sensor cluster.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Connect the scan tool and carry out the IVD Initialization sequence.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Electronic Brake Control Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4432
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4433
Electronic Brake Control Module: Diagrams
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4434
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4435
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module
Removal and Installation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4436
NOTE: On vehicles equipped with Roll Stability Control (RSC(R)), the ABS module and the
Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) are calibrated to one another. Do not swap ABS modules between
RSC(R)-equipped vehicles.
NOTE: On vehicles equipped with RSC(R), the ABS module is available separately from the HCU
and should be serviced separately. However, if the RSC(R)-equipped vehicle requires a new HCU,
then the ABS module and the HCU must be installed as an assembly. Make sure to use the most
recently released service parts.
NOTE: When installing a new ABS module/HCU assembly, it must be configured (either by
download/upload or uploading the as-built data method).
1. Release the Air Cleaner (ACL) cover retaining clips and disconnect the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor electrical connector.
2. Loosen the ACL outlet clamp and disconnect the ACL cover from the outlet pipe.
- To install, tighten to 4 Nm (35 lb-in).
3. Remove the 3 HCU bracket-to-frame bolts.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (177 lb-in).
4. Disconnect the ABS module electrical connector.
5. Remove the 4 ABS module bolts and the ABS module.
- To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
7. If installing a new ABS module on a vehicle equipped with RSC(R), configure the ABS module.
8. If installing a new ABS module on a vehicle equipped with RSC(R), calibrate the RSC(R) sensor.
Connect the scan tool and carry out the IVD
Initialization sequence.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Service and Repair
Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU)
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid on painted or plastic surfaces or damage to the surface may
occur. If brake fluid is spilled onto a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with
water.
NOTE: On vehicles equipped with Roll Stability Control (RSC(R)), the ABS module and the
Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) are calibrated to one another. Do not swap ABS modules between
RSC(R)-equipped vehicles.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4440
NOTE: On vehicles equipped with RSC(R), the ABS module is available separately from the HCU
and should be serviced separately. However, if the RSC(R)-equipped vehicle requires a new HCU,
then the ABS module and the HCU must be installed as an assembly. Make sure to use the most
recently released service parts.
NOTE: When installing a new ABS module/HCU assembly, it must be configured (either by
download/upload or uploading the as-built data method).
1. Disconnect the ABS module electrical connector.
2. NOTICE: Only authorized inlet hydraulic brake tubes should be used. These tubes are of specific
design and only authorized parts
should be used when installing new inlet brake tubes. Use of other than authorized inlet brake
tubes may result in damage to the components.
NOTE: Plug each open port to prevent brake fluid from spilling.
Disconnect the 6 brake tube fittings.
- To install: Tighten the master cylinder brake tube fittings to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
- Tighten the remaining brake tube fittings to 20 Nm (177 lb-in).
3. Remove the 3 HCU-to-bracket bolts and the HCU.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Bleed the brake system.
5. If installing a new ABS module/HCU assembly on a vehicle equipped with RSC(R), configure the
ABS module.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Service and Repair
Steering Angle Sensor: Service and Repair
Steering Wheel Rotation Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the steering wheel rotation sensor electrical connector.
2. Remove the 2 bolts and the steering wheel rotation sensor.
- To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
4. NOTE: If the sensor is not calibrated after installation, a DTC will be set in the ABS module.
Calibrate the sensor in the following sequence:
1. Start the engine.
2. Rotate the steering wheel from lock to lock a minimum of 2 times.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Traction Control
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Traction Control Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Traction Control
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4447
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Traction Control
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4448
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 4453
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 4454
Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Wheel Speed Sensor, Right Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 4455
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 4456
Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 4457
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 4458
Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Wheel Speed Sensor, Right Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 4459
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 4462
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 4463
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 4464
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the wheel and tire.
2. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector.
3. Remove the wheel speed sensor harness bolt and detach the retainers.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
4. NOTICE: Do not allow the caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can result.
Remove the 2 caliper anchor bolts and position the caliper, pads and anchor plate aside.
- Support the caliper with mechanic's wire.
- To install, tighten to 200 Nm (148 lb-ft).
5. Remove the brake disc.
6. Remove the front wheel speed sensor bolt and the sensor.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front > Page 4467
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the parking brake shoes.
2. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor harness from the retaining clips.
3. Remove the rear wheel speed sensor bolt and the sensor.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Component Bleeding
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Component Bleeding
Master Cylinder
Component Bleeding
Master Cylinder
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
WARNING: Do not allow the brake master cylinder to run dry during the bleeding operation. Master
cylinder may be damaged if operated without fluid, resulting in degraded braking performance.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid on painted or plastic surfaces or damage to the surface may
occur. If brake fluid is spilled onto a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with
water.
NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder is installed, or the system is emptied or partially
emptied, it should be primed to prevent air from entering the system.
1. Disconnect the brake tubes from the master cylinder.
2. Install short brake tubes with the ends submerged in the brake master cylinder reservoir.
3. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid.
4. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal until clear fluid flows from both brake tubes, without air
bubbles.
5. Remove the short brake tubes and install the brake outlet tubes.
6. Bleed each brake tube at the brake master cylinder as follows:
1. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal at least 2 times and then hold firm pressure on the
brake pedal.
2. Loosen the rearmost brake tube fitting until a stream of brake fluid comes out. While the
assistant maintains pressure on the brake pedal,
tighten the brake tube fitting.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Component Bleeding > Page 4472
3. Repeat this operation until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
4. Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary. Repeat the bleeding operation at the
front brake tube.
5. Tighten the brake tube fittings to specifications. For additional information, refer to
Specifications.
7. Bleed the brake system, refer to Brake System Bleeding See: Brake System Bleeding.
Brake Caliper
Component Bleeding
Brake Caliper
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
WARNING: Do not allow the brake master cylinder to run dry during the bleeding operation. Master
cylinder may be damaged if operated without fluid, resulting in degraded braking performance.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid on painted or plastic surfaces or damage to the surface may
occur. If brake fluid is spilled onto a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with
water.
1. NOTE: It is not necessary to do a complete brake system bleed if only the brake caliper was
disconnected or installed new.
Remove the bleeder screw cap and place a box-end wrench on the bleeder screw. Attach a rubber
drain hose to the bleeder screw and submerge the free end of the hose in a container partially filled
with clean, specified brake fluid.
2. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal at least 2 times and then hold firm pressure on the
brake pedal.
3. Loosen the bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. While the assistant maintains
pressure on the brake pedal, tighten the bleeder
screw. Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
- Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
4. Remove the rubber hose and tighten the bleeder screw to specifications. For additional
information, refer to Specifications.
- Install the bleeder screw cap.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Component Bleeding > Page 4473
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Component Bleeding > Page 4474
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Brake System Bleeding
Brake System Bleeding
Pressure
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
WARNING: Do not allow the brake master cylinder to run dry during the bleeding operation. Master
cylinder may be damaged if operated without fluid, resulting in degraded braking performance.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid on painted or plastic surfaces or damage to the surface may
occur. If brake fluid is spilled onto a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with
water.
NOTE: The Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) bleeding procedure must be carried out if the HCU or any
components upstream of the HCU are installed new.
NOTE: Pressure bleeding the brake system is preferred to manual bleeding.
1. Clean all dirt from and remove the brake master cylinder filler cap and fill the brake master
cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid.
2. NOTE: Master cylinder pressure bleeder adapter tools are available from various manufacturers
of pressure bleeding equipment. Follow the
instructions of the equipment manufacturer when installing the adapter.
Install the bleeder adapter to the brake master cylinder reservoir and attach the bleeder tank hose
to the fitting on the adapter.
3. NOTE: Make sure the bleeder tank contains enough clean, specified brake fluid to complete the
bleeding operation.
Remove the RH rear bleeder cap and place a box-end wrench on the bleeder screw. Attach a
rubber drain tube to the RH rear bleeder screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a
container partially filled with clean, specified brake fluid.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Component Bleeding > Page 4475
4. Open the valve on the bleeder tank.
- Set pressure to 207-345 kPa (30-50 psi).
5. Loosen the RH rear bleeder screw. Leave open until clear, bubble-free brake fluid flows, then
tighten the RH rear bleeder screw and remove the
rubber hose. Tighten to specifications. For additional information, refer to Specifications.
- Install the bleeder screw cap.
6. Continue bleeding the system, going in order from the LH rear bleeder screw to the RH front
bleeder screw ending with the LH front bleeder
screw.
7. Release the bleeder tank pressure and close the bleeder tank valve. Remove the tank hose from
the adapter and remove the adapter from the brake
fluid reservoir.
Manual
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
WARNING: Do not allow the brake master cylinder to run dry during the bleeding operation. Master
cylinder may be damaged if operated without fluid, resulting in degraded braking performance.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid on painted or plastic surfaces or damage to the surface may
occur. If brake fluid is spilled onto a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with
water.
NOTE: The Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) bleeding procedure must be carried out if the HCU or any
components upstream of the HCU are installed new.
NOTE: Pressure bleeding the brake system is preferred to manual bleeding.
1. Clean all dirt from and remove the brake master cylinder filler cap and fill the brake master
cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid.
2. Remove the bleeder screw cap and place a box-end wrench on the RH rear bleeder screw.
Attach a rubber drain hose to the RH rear bleeder screw
and submerge the free end of the hose in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake
fluid.
3. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal at least 3 times and then hold firm pressure on the
brake pedal.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Component Bleeding > Page 4476
4. Loosen the RH rear bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. While the assistant
maintains pressure on the brake pedal, tighten the
RH rear bleeder screw. Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
- Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
5. Remove the rubber hose and tighten the bleeder screw to specifications. For additional
information, refer to Specifications.
- Install the bleeder screw cap.
6. Repeat Steps 2 through 5 for the LH rear, RH front and LH front bleeder screws in this order.
Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU)
NOTE: The Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) bleeding procedure must be carried out if the HCU or any
components upstream of the HCU are installed new.
NOTE: Pressure bleeding the brake system is preferred to manual bleeding.
1. Follow the Pressure Bleeding or Manual Bleeding procedure steps to bleed the system.
2. Connect the scan tool and follow the ABS Service Bleed instructions.
3. Repeat the Pressure Bleeding or Manual Bleeding procedure steps to bleed the system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Adjustable Pedals - Without Memory Feature
Brake Pedal Assy: Description and Operation Adjustable Pedals - Without Memory Feature
Adjustable Pedals
Adjustable brake and accelerator pedals are available as an optional feature on this vehicle. The
brake pedal position can be changed in phase with the accelerator pedal to increase driver comfort.
Two different adjustable pedal systems are available; one that is connected to the memory feature
option and one that is not connected to the memory feature option.
Without Memory Feature
Adjustable brake pedals without memory feature consist of the following components:
- Adjustable brake pedal and bracket
- Adjustable accelerator pedal and bracket, refer to Throttle Cable/Linkage
- Adjustable pedal switch
- Adjustable pedal motor
- Adjustable pedal cables
The pedals are adjusted through the use of a rocker switch mounted on the instrument panel.
When the switch is pressed, voltage is sent to the motor which spins a cable that is attached to the
adjustable brake pedal. As the cable spins, the pedals move either forward (away from the driver)
or rearward (toward the driver) depending on how the switch is pressed.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Adjustable Pedals - Without Memory Feature > Page 4481
Brake Pedal Assy: Description and Operation Adjustable Pedals - With Memory Feature
Adjustable Pedals
Adjustable brake and accelerator pedals are available as an optional feature on this vehicle. The
brake pedal position can be changed in phase with the accelerator pedal to increase driver comfort.
Two different adjustable pedal systems are available; one that is connected to the memory feature
option and one that is not connected to the memory feature option.
With Memory Feature
Adjustable brake and accelerator pedals are available as an optional feature on this vehicle. The
brake pedal position can be changed in phase with the accelerator pedal to increase driver comfort.
Two different adjustable pedal systems are available; one that is connected to the memory feature
option and one that is not connected to the memory feature option.
Adjustable brake pedals with memory feature consist of the following components:
- Driver Seat Module (DSM), refer to Seats
- Memory SET switch, refer to Seats
- Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter, refer to Locks
- Adjustable brake pedal and bracket
- Adjustable accelerator pedal and bracket, refer to Throttle Cable/Linkage
- Adjustable pedal switch
- Adjustable pedal motor
- Adjustable pedal cables
The pedals are adjusted through the use of a rocker switch mounted on the instrument panel, the
memory SET switch mounted on the seat trim panel or the door trim panel or the RKE transmitter.
When the switch is pressed or the transmitter is activated, a voltage signal is sent to the DSM. The
DSM then sends voltage to the adjustable pedal motor which spins a cable that is attached to the
adjustable brake pedal. As the cable spins, the pedals move either forward (away from the driver)
or rearward (toward the driver) depending on how the switch is pressed and/or current pedal
position.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 4482
Brake Pedal Assy: Service and Repair
Brake Pedal and Bracket
NOTE: Adjustable brake pedal and bracket shown, fixed brake pedal and bracket similar.
Removal and Installation
Adjustable pedal vehicles
1. NOTICE: The brake pedal and the accelerator pedal must be in the same position when
installing a new cable or a new pedal. The pedals
must be all the way forward or all the way rearward or damage to components may occur.
Disconnect the accelerator pedal-to-brake pedal cable from the adjustable brake pedal gear set.
All vehicles
2. NOTICE: Do not service the brake pedal or brake booster without first removing the stoplamp
switch. This switch must be removed with
the brake pedal in the at-rest position. The switch plunger must be compressed for the switch to
rotate in the bracket. Attempting to remove the switch when the plunger is extended (during pedal
apply) will result in damage to the switch.
Remove the stoplamp switch.
3. NOTE: An 11 mm, 12-point socket or wrench can be used to compress the 2 tabs on the brake
pedal arm pin.
Remove the brake pedal arm pin and disconnect the brake booster push rod from the brake pedal
arm.
4. Remove the bulkhead sound insulator.
5. Remove the 4 brake pedal bracket nuts.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 4483
- To install, tighten to 27 Nm (20 lb-ft).
6. Remove the 2 brake pedal bracket bolts and remove the brake pedal and bracket.
- To install, tighten to 27 Nm (20 lb-ft).
7. NOTICE: Do not press, pull or otherwise move the brake pedal while installing the stoplamp
switch. This switch must be installed with
the booster push rod attached to the brake pedal and with the brake pedal in the at-rest position.
Installing this switch with the brake pedal in any other position will result in incorrect adjustment
and may damage the switch.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Brake Calipers
Brake Caliper: Testing and Inspection Brake Calipers
Brake System Inspection
Brake Calipers
1. Inspect the brake calipers for leaks, damage to seals and piston corrosion or binding.
- If the brake caliper is leaking or otherwise damaged, install a new brake caliper.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Brake Calipers > Page 4489
Brake Caliper: Testing and Inspection Brake Caliper Guide Pins
Brake System Inspection
Brake Caliper Guide Pins
1. The guide pins should slide with a reasonable amount of hand force. If the brake pads show
taper wear or the guide pins are difficult to move,
carry out the following steps. Disassemble the brake caliper guide pins and inspect the guide pins and guide pin bores for wear,
damage and corrosion. If bore is worn or damaged, replace the damaged component.
- Use a wire brush, rolled-up sandpaper or emery cloth to remove all corrosion and foreign material
from the caliper guide pin bores. Clean any remaining foreign material from the bores with brake
parts cleaner and compressed air.
- Assemble the caliper seals, boots and guide pins. Use an ample amount of the specified grease
to lubricate the bores and guide pins.
- Inspect the brake pads. For additional information, refer to Brake Pads inspection. See: Testing
and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/Brake System Inspection/Brake Pads
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures
Brake Caliper: Procedures
Component Bleeding
Brake Caliper
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
WARNING: Do not allow the brake master cylinder to run dry during the bleeding operation. Master
cylinder may be damaged if operated without fluid, resulting in degraded braking performance.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid on painted or plastic surfaces or damage to the surface may
occur. If brake fluid is spilled onto a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with
water.
1. NOTE: It is not necessary to do a complete brake system bleed if only the brake caliper was
disconnected or installed new.
Remove the bleeder screw cap and place a box-end wrench on the bleeder screw. Attach a rubber
drain hose to the bleeder screw and submerge the free end of the hose in a container partially filled
with clean, specified brake fluid.
2. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal at least 2 times and then hold firm pressure on the
brake pedal.
3. Loosen the bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. While the assistant maintains
pressure on the brake pedal, tighten the bleeder
screw. Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
- Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
4. Remove the rubber hose and tighten the bleeder screw to specifications. For additional
information, refer to Specifications.
- Install the bleeder screw cap.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4492
Brake Caliper: Removal and Replacement
Brake Caliper
Brake Caliper
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid on painted or plastic surfaces or damage to surface may occur. If
brake fluid is spilled onto a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with water.
1. Remove the brake pads. For additional information, refer to Brake Pads See: Brake Pad/Service
and Repair/Front Disc Brake/Brake Pads.
2. Remove the brake caliper flow bolt and the 2 copper washers.
- Discard the copper washers.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3. Inspect the brake caliper for leaks.
- If leaks are found, a new brake caliper must be installed.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new copper washers.
5. Bleed the brake caliper.
Disc Brake System - Exploded View
Disc Brake System - Exploded View
Disc Brake System (view 1 of 2)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4493
Disc Brake System (view 2 of 2)
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4494
Removal
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid on painted or plastic surfaces or damage to surface may occur. If
brake fluid is spilled onto a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with water.
1. If necessary, using a suitable suction device, remove the brake fluid from the master cylinder
reservoir until it is half filled.
2. Remove the wheel and tire.
3. NOTICE: If the anchor housing spring is to be removed, do not force the spring off the brake
caliper or damage to the spring may occur.
NOTICE: Do not use any tools to remove the spring, use hand force only. Do not use excessive
force or damage to the spring may occur.
Release the lower portion of the anchor housing spring.
- Apply force to the center of the spring and pull outward at the bottom of the spring to remove it
from the lower brake caliper cavity.
4. Rotate the spring upward and remove it from the brake caliper.
5. Rotate the outer brake pad upper and lower retaining springs to disengage them from the brake
caliper anchor plate.
6. NOTICE: Do not allow the caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose may
occur.
Remove the 2 guide pin bushing caps, remove and discard the 2 brake caliper guide pin bolts and
position the caliper aside.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4495
- Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
- Remove and discard the 2 brake caliper guide pin bushings.
7. Remove the 2 brake caliper anchor plate bolts and the anchor plate.
Installation
1. Position the brake caliper anchor plate and install the 2 anchor plate bolts.
- Tighten to 200 Nm (148 lb-ft).
2. NOTICE: Do not apply lubricant to guide pin threads or incorrect tightening of the guide pins may
result.
Install new brake hardware as follows:
- Apply the specified lubricant to the inside of the guide pin bushings.
- Install the guide pin bushings into the caliper bores.
- Install the guide pins into the bushings.
3. NOTE: Make sure that the inner brake pad retaining springs are correctly seated onto the brake
caliper anchor plate.
Position the brake caliper assembly onto the anchor plate.
4. Install the 2 brake caliper guide pin bolts and the 2 bushing caps.
- Tighten the bolts to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
5. Rotate the outer brake pad upper and lower retaining springs until they are correctly seated on
the anchor plate.
6. Install the anchor housing spring using the following procedure:
1. Insert the tab of the spring into the brake caliper cavity.
2. Twist the tab into the cavity.
7. NOTE: LH anchor housing spring shown, RH similar.
Rotate the anchor housing spring and position the upper portion onto the anchor plate.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4496
8. NOTE: LH anchor housing spring shown, RH similar.
Position the other anchor housing spring portion onto the anchor plate.
9. Push down and inward until the upper and lower ends of the anchor housing spring are latched
and seated in the brake caliper cavities.
10. NOTICE: The latch MUST be positioned as shown or damage to component may occur.
Verify that the brake pad anti-rattle spring is correctly latched by pulling on the spring.
11. Fill the master cylinder with clean, specified brake fluid.
12. Install the wheel and tire.
13. Apply the brake several times to verify correct brake operation.
Brake Caliper
Brake Caliper
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid onto painted or plastic surfaces or damage to surface may occur.
If brake fluid is spilled onto a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with water.
1. Remove the wheel and tire.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4497
2. Remove the brake hose flow bolt and disconnect the hose.
- Remove and discard the copper washers.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3. Remove the 2 brake caliper guide pin caps and bolts.
- Inspect the guide pin threads for damage, install a new guide pin(s) as necessary.
- To install, tighten to 38 Nm (28 lb-ft).
- Clean and dry guide pin threads as necessary.
4. Remove the brake caliper and remove the brake pads from the caliper.
5. Inspect the disc brake caliper dust boot for leaks and/or damage.
- If leaks or damage are found, install a new brake caliper.
6. NOTICE: Do not apply lubricant to guide pin threads or incorrect tightening of the guide pins may
result.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new guide pin bushings.
- Apply supplied white lubricant to the inside of the guide pin bushings.
7. Bleed the brake caliper.
Disc Brake System - Exploded View
Disc Brake System - Exploded View
Rear Brake Disc Components
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4498
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid onto painted or plastic surfaces or damage to surface may occur.
If brake fluid is spilled onto a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with water.
1. Check the brake fluid level in the brake master cylinder reservoir.
- If required, remove the fluid until the brake master cylinder reservoir is half full.
2. Remove the wheel and tire.
3. NOTICE: Do not allow the caliper and brake pad assembly to hang from the brake hose or
damage to the hose may occur.
Remove the 2 brake caliper guide pin caps and bolts and position the caliper and brake pad
assembly aside.
- Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
- Inspect the guide pin threads for damage and inspect the guide pin bushings for wear/damage.
Install a new guide pin(s) and bushing(s) as necessary.
- To install, tighten to 38 Nm (28 lb-ft).
4. Remove the 2 brake caliper anchor plate bolts and the brake caliper anchor plate.
- Inspect the caliper anchor plate bolt threads for damage and foreign material. Install cleaned and
dried anchor plate bolts or install new as necessary.
- To install, tighten to 190 Nm (140 lb-ft).
5. Clean, dry and inspect the brake caliper anchor plate. Apply equal amounts of the supplied
yellow lubricant to the 4 brake pad contact points on
the anchor plate as indicated.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4499
6. Fill the master cylinder with clean, specified brake fluid.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Apply the brake several times to verify correct brake operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Specifications
Brake Pad: Specifications
Brake pad minimum thickness..............................................................................................................
........................................................2.0 mm (0.079 in)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4503
Brake Pad: Testing and Inspection
Brake System Inspection
Brake Pads
NOTE: It is not required to install new brake pads when the brake discs are machined.
1. Inspect the brake pad friction material for contamination.
- If the friction material shows evidence of contamination, install new brake pads.
2. Inspect and measure the thickness of the brake pad friction material. For additional information,
refer to Specifications.
- Minor surface cracks do not require pad replacement, however, if there are missing chunks or
cracks in the lining through to the backing plate, install new brake pads.
- If the thickness of the friction material is less than the specified thickness, install new brake pads.
- If the friction material shows taper wear that is not within specifications, install new brake pads
and verify the caliper guide pins are functioning correctly. For additional information, refer to Brake
Caliper Guide Pins inspection. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics/Brake System Inspection/Brake Caliper Guide Pins
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake
Brake Pad: Service and Repair Front Disc Brake
Disc Brake System - Exploded View
Disc Brake System - Exploded View
Disc Brake System (view 1 of 2)
Disc Brake System (view 2 of 2)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake > Page 4506
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Brake Pads
Brake Pads
Removal
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
WARNING: Always install new brake shoes or pads at both ends of an axle to reduce the
possibility of brakes pulling vehicle to one side. Failure to follow this instruction may result in
uneven braking and serious personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid onto painted or plastic surfaces or damage to surface may occur.
If brake fluid is spilled on a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with water.
1. If necessary, using a suitable suction device, remove the brake fluid from the master cylinder
reservoir until it is half filled.
2. Remove the wheel and tire.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake > Page 4507
3. NOTICE: If the anchor housing spring is to be removed, do not force the spring off the brake
caliper or damage to the spring may occur.
NOTICE: Do not use any tools to remove the spring, use hand force only. Do not use excessive
force or damage to the spring may occur.
Release the lower portion of the anchor housing spring.
- Apply force to the center of the spring and pull outward at the bottom of the spring to remove it
from the lower brake caliper cavity.
4. Rotate the spring upward and remove it from the brake caliper.
5. Rotate the outer brake pad upper and lower retaining springs to disengage them from the brake
caliper anchor plate.
6. NOTICE: Do not allow the caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose may
occur.
Remove the 2 guide pin bushing caps, remove and discard the 2 brake caliper guide pin bolts and
position the caliper aside.
- Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
- Remove and discard the 2 brake caliper guide pin bushings.
7. Remove the 2 brake pads from the caliper.
8. Inspect the brake pads for wear and contamination, install new pads as necessary.
9. NOTICE: Protect the piston and boots when pushing the caliper piston into the caliper piston
bores, or damage to the piston or boots
may occur.
If installing new brake pads, using a C-clamp and a worn brake pad, compress the brake caliper
pistons into the caliper.
10. Inspect the brake disc and machine or install new as necessary.
Installation
1. Clean the brake pad contact areas of the brake caliper.
2. NOTICE: Do not apply lubricant to guide pin threads or incorrect tightening of the guide pins may
result.
Install new brake hardware as follows:
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake > Page 4508
- Apply the specified lubricant to the inside of the guide pin bushings.
- Install the guide pin bushings into the caliper bores.
- Install the guide pin into the bushings.
3. Install the inboard brake pad onto the caliper.
4. Rotate the outer brake pad upper and lower retaining springs 90 degrees.
5. Remove the protective paper from the outboard brake pad and install it onto the brake caliper.
6. NOTE: Make sure that the inner brake pad retaining springs are correctly seated onto the brake
caliper anchor plate.
Position the brake caliper assembly onto the anchor plate.
7. Install the 2 brake caliper guide pin bolts and the 2 bushing caps.
- Tighten the bolts to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
8. Rotate the outer brake pad upper and lower retaining springs until they are correctly seated in
the machined slot on the anchor plate.
9. Install the anchor housing spring using the following procedure:
1. Insert the tab of the spring into the brake caliper cavity.
2. Twist the tab into the cavity.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake > Page 4509
10. NOTE: LH anchor housing spring shown, RH similar.
Rotate the anchor housing spring and position the upper portion onto the anchor plate.
11. NOTE: LH anchor housing spring shown, RH similar.
Position the other anchor housing spring portion onto the anchor plate.
12. Push down and inward until the upper and lower ends of the anchor housing spring are latched
and seated in the brake caliper cavities.
13. NOTICE: The latch MUST be positioned as shown or damage to component may occur.
Verify that the brake pad anti-rattle spring is correctly latched by pulling on the spring.
14. Fill the master cylinder with clean, specified brake fluid.
15. Install the wheel and tire.
16. Apply the brake several times to verify correct brake operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake > Page 4510
Brake Pad: Service and Repair Rear Disc Brake
Disc Brake System - Exploded View
Disc Brake System - Exploded View
Rear Brake Disc Components
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Brake Pads
Brake Pads
Removal
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake > Page 4511
WARNING: Always install new brake shoes or pads at both ends of an axle to reduce the
possibility of brakes pulling vehicle to one side. Failure to follow this instruction may result in
uneven braking and serious personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid onto painted or plastic surfaces or damage to surface may occur.
If brake fluid is spilled onto a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with water.
1. Check the brake fluid level in the brake master cylinder reservoir.
- If required, remove the fluid until the brake master cylinder reservoir is half full.
2. Remove the wheel and tire.
3. NOTICE: Do not allow the brake caliper to hang by the flexible brake hose or damage to the
hose may occur.
Remove the 2 brake caliper guide pin caps and bolts and position the caliper and brake pad
assembly aside.
- Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
- Remove and discard the guide pin bushings.
- Inspect the guide pin threads for damage, install new guide pin(s) as necessary.
4. Remove the brake pads from the caliper.
5. Inspect the brake pads for wear or contamination and install new pads as necessary.
6. Using a C-clamp and a worn brake pad, press the piston into the caliper.
7. Inspect the brake disc and resurface or install a new brake disc as necessary.
Installation
1. Clean, dry and inspect the brake caliper anchor plate. Apply equal amounts of the supplied
yellow lubricant to the 4 brake pad contact points on
the anchor plate as shown.
2. NOTICE: Do not apply lubricant to guide pin threads or incorrect tightening of the guide pins may
result.
Install new brake hardware as follows:
- Apply equal amounts of the supplied white lubricant to the inside of the guide pin bushings.
- Install the guide pin bushings into the caliper bores.
- Install the guide pins into the bushings.
3. Install the brake pads to the caliper.
4. Position the caliper onto the anchor plate and install the 2 brake caliper guide pin bolts.
- To install, tighten to 38 Nm (28 lb-ft).
- Clean and dry guide pin threads as necessary.
5. Fill the master cylinder with clean, specified brake fluid.
6. Install the wheel and tire.
7. Apply the brake several times to verify correct brake operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Specifications > Front Brake Rotor/Disc
Brake Rotor/Disc: Specifications Front Brake Rotor/Disc
Front Brake disc minimum thickness....................................................................................................
......................................................32.0 mm (1.259 in)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Specifications > Front Brake Rotor/Disc > Page 4516
Brake Rotor/Disc: Specifications Rear Brake Rotor/Disc
Rear Brake disc minimum thickness....................................................................................................
.......................................................20.0 mm (0.787 in)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 4517
Brake Rotor/Disc: Testing and Inspection
Brake System Inspection
Brake Discs
NOTICE: Using an impact tool without a torque socket will lead to unevenly tightened wheel nuts.
This causes brake disc on-vehicle lateral runout and brake roughness.
1. Inspect the brake discs and measure the brake disc thickness in a minimum of 4 places around
the circumference of the brake disc. Record the
measurements, refer to Specifications. If the brake disc is cracked or otherwise damaged, install a new brake disc.
- If any measurement is below the minimum thickness specification, install a new brake disc.
- If the diagnosis has revealed vibration in the steering wheel, seat or pedal while braking that
varies with vehicle speed, machine the brake disc. Heavily scored brake discs, similar to that
caused by pads worn down to the backing plate, should also be machined. In order to machine,
discs must be above the minimum thickness specification. For additional information, refer to
Specifications and Brake Disc Machining See: Service and Repair/Procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures
Brake Rotor/Disc: Procedures
Brake Disc Machining
NOTE: Do not use a bench lathe to machine the brake discs. Use an on-vehicle brake lathe only.
Read the entire operating manual and/or view the video shipped with the lathe before installing,
operating or repairing the lathe.
NOTE: An on-vehicle brake lathe with an automatic runout adjustment feature is preferred.
However, if the lathe is not self adjusting, the lathe oscillation must be adjusted using a dial
indicator. The total indicated runout target is 0.000 mm (0.000 in). The maximum indicated runout
should be no more than 0.050 mm (0.002 in). If the runout adjustment (automatic or manual) is
carried out correctly prior to machining, then the final brake disc runout will be within specification
and a runout measurement is not necessary after machining.
NOTE: Lateral runout and disc thickness variation measurements are not required because correct
adjustment of the on-vehicle brake lathe will make sure that these dimensions are within
specification.
1. Remove the wheel and tire.
2. NOTICE: Do not allow the caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose may
occur.
Remove the bolts and position the brake caliper or brake caliper and anchor plate assembly aside,
as required.
- Support the brake caliper using mechanic's wire.
3. Install the hub adapter using:
- four wheel nuts on a 4-stud wheel hub.
- five wheel nuts on a 5-stud wheel hub.
- six wheel nuts on a 6-stud wheel hub.
- four wheel nuts on a 7- or 8-stud wheel hub.
- five wheel nuts on a 10-stud wheel hub.
4. Install the cutting lathe.
5. If the lathe is not self adjusting, adjust the lathe oscillation using a dial indicator. The total
indicated runout target is 0.000 mm (0.000 in). The
maximum indicated runout should be no more than 0.050 mm (0.002 in).
6. Center the cutting head, adjust the cutting bits and install the chip deflector/silencer.
7. NOTE: The depth of the cut should be between 0.10 and 0.40 mm (0.004 and 0.015 in). Lighter
cuts will cause the bit to heat up and wear faster.
Heavier cuts will cause poor brake disc surface finish.
Machine the brake disc.
8. Remove the lathe and the silencer.
9. Remove the wheel nuts and hub adapter.
10. Remove the metal shavings.
11. NOTE: It is not required to install new brake pads if friction material is within specifications. For
additional information, refer to Specifications.
Position the brake caliper or brake caliper and anchor plate assembly.
- Install the bolts.
- For fastener torque specifications, refer to Disc Brake System.
12. Install the wheel and tire.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4520
Brake Rotor/Disc: Removal and Replacement
Disc Brake System - Exploded View
Disc Brake System - Exploded View
Disc Brake System (view 1 of 2)
Disc Brake System (view 2 of 2)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4521
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Brake Disc
Brake Disc
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the brake caliper anchor plate. For additional information, refer to Brake Caliper Anchor
Plate See: Brake Caliper/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Front Disc Brake/Brake Caliper Anchor Plate.
2. Remove the brake disc.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Brake Disc Shield
Brake Disc Shield
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the brake disc. For additional information, refer to Brake Disc See: Front Disc
Brake/Brake Disc.
2. Remove the brake disc shield screws.
- To install, tighten to 17 Nm (150 lb-in).
3. Remove the brake disc shield.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Disc Brake System - Exploded View
Disc Brake System - Exploded View
Rear Brake Disc Components
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4522
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Brake Disc
Brake Disc
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the wheel and tire.
2. NOTICE: Do not allow the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly to hang by the flexible brake
hose or damage to the hose may occur.
Remove the brake caliper anchor plate bolts and position the anchor plate and caliper assembly
aside.
- Support the caliper and anchor plate assembly with mechanic's wire.
- Inspect the brake caliper anchor plate bolt threads for damage and foreign material. Install
cleaned and dried anchor plate bolts or install new as necessary.
- To install, tighten to 190 Nm (140 lb-ft).
3. NOTE: If the brake disc binds on the parking brake shoe, remove the adjustment hole access
plug and contract the parking brake shoe.
Remove the brake disc.
4. Inspect the brake disc and resurface or install a new brake disc as necessary.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information >
Specifications
Brake Shoe: Specifications
Minimum Thickness..............................................................................................................................
......................................................0.45 mm (0.02 in)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Component Bleeding
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Component Bleeding
Master Cylinder
Component Bleeding
Master Cylinder
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
WARNING: Do not allow the brake master cylinder to run dry during the bleeding operation. Master
cylinder may be damaged if operated without fluid, resulting in degraded braking performance.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid on painted or plastic surfaces or damage to the surface may
occur. If brake fluid is spilled onto a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with
water.
NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder is installed, or the system is emptied or partially
emptied, it should be primed to prevent air from entering the system.
1. Disconnect the brake tubes from the master cylinder.
2. Install short brake tubes with the ends submerged in the brake master cylinder reservoir.
3. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid.
4. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal until clear fluid flows from both brake tubes, without air
bubbles.
5. Remove the short brake tubes and install the brake outlet tubes.
6. Bleed each brake tube at the brake master cylinder as follows:
1. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal at least 2 times and then hold firm pressure on the
brake pedal.
2. Loosen the rearmost brake tube fitting until a stream of brake fluid comes out. While the
assistant maintains pressure on the brake pedal,
tighten the brake tube fitting.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Component Bleeding > Page 4532
3. Repeat this operation until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
4. Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary. Repeat the bleeding operation at the
front brake tube.
5. Tighten the brake tube fittings to specifications. For additional information, refer to
Specifications.
7. Bleed the brake system, refer to Brake System Bleeding See: Brake System Bleeding.
Brake Caliper
Component Bleeding
Brake Caliper
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
WARNING: Do not allow the brake master cylinder to run dry during the bleeding operation. Master
cylinder may be damaged if operated without fluid, resulting in degraded braking performance.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid on painted or plastic surfaces or damage to the surface may
occur. If brake fluid is spilled onto a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with
water.
1. NOTE: It is not necessary to do a complete brake system bleed if only the brake caliper was
disconnected or installed new.
Remove the bleeder screw cap and place a box-end wrench on the bleeder screw. Attach a rubber
drain hose to the bleeder screw and submerge the free end of the hose in a container partially filled
with clean, specified brake fluid.
2. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal at least 2 times and then hold firm pressure on the
brake pedal.
3. Loosen the bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. While the assistant maintains
pressure on the brake pedal, tighten the bleeder
screw. Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
- Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
4. Remove the rubber hose and tighten the bleeder screw to specifications. For additional
information, refer to Specifications.
- Install the bleeder screw cap.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Component Bleeding > Page 4533
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Component Bleeding > Page 4534
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Brake System Bleeding
Brake System Bleeding
Pressure
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
WARNING: Do not allow the brake master cylinder to run dry during the bleeding operation. Master
cylinder may be damaged if operated without fluid, resulting in degraded braking performance.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid on painted or plastic surfaces or damage to the surface may
occur. If brake fluid is spilled onto a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with
water.
NOTE: The Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) bleeding procedure must be carried out if the HCU or any
components upstream of the HCU are installed new.
NOTE: Pressure bleeding the brake system is preferred to manual bleeding.
1. Clean all dirt from and remove the brake master cylinder filler cap and fill the brake master
cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid.
2. NOTE: Master cylinder pressure bleeder adapter tools are available from various manufacturers
of pressure bleeding equipment. Follow the
instructions of the equipment manufacturer when installing the adapter.
Install the bleeder adapter to the brake master cylinder reservoir and attach the bleeder tank hose
to the fitting on the adapter.
3. NOTE: Make sure the bleeder tank contains enough clean, specified brake fluid to complete the
bleeding operation.
Remove the RH rear bleeder cap and place a box-end wrench on the bleeder screw. Attach a
rubber drain tube to the RH rear bleeder screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a
container partially filled with clean, specified brake fluid.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Component Bleeding > Page 4535
4. Open the valve on the bleeder tank.
- Set pressure to 207-345 kPa (30-50 psi).
5. Loosen the RH rear bleeder screw. Leave open until clear, bubble-free brake fluid flows, then
tighten the RH rear bleeder screw and remove the
rubber hose. Tighten to specifications. For additional information, refer to Specifications.
- Install the bleeder screw cap.
6. Continue bleeding the system, going in order from the LH rear bleeder screw to the RH front
bleeder screw ending with the LH front bleeder
screw.
7. Release the bleeder tank pressure and close the bleeder tank valve. Remove the tank hose from
the adapter and remove the adapter from the brake
fluid reservoir.
Manual
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
WARNING: Do not allow the brake master cylinder to run dry during the bleeding operation. Master
cylinder may be damaged if operated without fluid, resulting in degraded braking performance.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid on painted or plastic surfaces or damage to the surface may
occur. If brake fluid is spilled onto a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with
water.
NOTE: The Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) bleeding procedure must be carried out if the HCU or any
components upstream of the HCU are installed new.
NOTE: Pressure bleeding the brake system is preferred to manual bleeding.
1. Clean all dirt from and remove the brake master cylinder filler cap and fill the brake master
cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid.
2. Remove the bleeder screw cap and place a box-end wrench on the RH rear bleeder screw.
Attach a rubber drain hose to the RH rear bleeder screw
and submerge the free end of the hose in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake
fluid.
3. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal at least 3 times and then hold firm pressure on the
brake pedal.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Component Bleeding > Page 4536
4. Loosen the RH rear bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. While the assistant
maintains pressure on the brake pedal, tighten the
RH rear bleeder screw. Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
- Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
5. Remove the rubber hose and tighten the bleeder screw to specifications. For additional
information, refer to Specifications.
- Install the bleeder screw cap.
6. Repeat Steps 2 through 5 for the LH rear, RH front and LH front bleeder screws in this order.
Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU)
NOTE: The Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) bleeding procedure must be carried out if the HCU or any
components upstream of the HCU are installed new.
NOTE: Pressure bleeding the brake system is preferred to manual bleeding.
1. Follow the Pressure Bleeding or Manual Bleeding procedure steps to bleed the system.
2. Connect the scan tool and follow the ABS Service Bleed instructions.
3. Repeat the Pressure Bleeding or Manual Bleeding procedure steps to bleed the system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Brake Calipers
Brake Caliper: Testing and Inspection Brake Calipers
Brake System Inspection
Brake Calipers
1. Inspect the brake calipers for leaks, damage to seals and piston corrosion or binding.
- If the brake caliper is leaking or otherwise damaged, install a new brake caliper.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Brake Calipers > Page 4541
Brake Caliper: Testing and Inspection Brake Caliper Guide Pins
Brake System Inspection
Brake Caliper Guide Pins
1. The guide pins should slide with a reasonable amount of hand force. If the brake pads show
taper wear or the guide pins are difficult to move,
carry out the following steps. Disassemble the brake caliper guide pins and inspect the guide pins and guide pin bores for wear,
damage and corrosion. If bore is worn or damaged, replace the damaged component.
- Use a wire brush, rolled-up sandpaper or emery cloth to remove all corrosion and foreign material
from the caliper guide pin bores. Clean any remaining foreign material from the bores with brake
parts cleaner and compressed air.
- Assemble the caliper seals, boots and guide pins. Use an ample amount of the specified grease
to lubricate the bores and guide pins.
- Inspect the brake pads. For additional information, refer to Brake Pads inspection. See: Testing
and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/Brake System Inspection/Brake Pads
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Brake Caliper: Procedures
Component Bleeding
Brake Caliper
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
WARNING: Do not allow the brake master cylinder to run dry during the bleeding operation. Master
cylinder may be damaged if operated without fluid, resulting in degraded braking performance.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid on painted or plastic surfaces or damage to the surface may
occur. If brake fluid is spilled onto a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with
water.
1. NOTE: It is not necessary to do a complete brake system bleed if only the brake caliper was
disconnected or installed new.
Remove the bleeder screw cap and place a box-end wrench on the bleeder screw. Attach a rubber
drain hose to the bleeder screw and submerge the free end of the hose in a container partially filled
with clean, specified brake fluid.
2. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal at least 2 times and then hold firm pressure on the
brake pedal.
3. Loosen the bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. While the assistant maintains
pressure on the brake pedal, tighten the bleeder
screw. Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
- Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
4. Remove the rubber hose and tighten the bleeder screw to specifications. For additional
information, refer to Specifications.
- Install the bleeder screw cap.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4544
Brake Caliper: Removal and Replacement
Brake Caliper
Brake Caliper
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid on painted or plastic surfaces or damage to surface may occur. If
brake fluid is spilled onto a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with water.
1. Remove the brake pads. For additional information, refer to Brake Pads See: Disc Brake
System/Brake Pad/Service and Repair/Front Disc
Brake/Brake Pads.
2. Remove the brake caliper flow bolt and the 2 copper washers.
- Discard the copper washers.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3. Inspect the brake caliper for leaks.
- If leaks are found, a new brake caliper must be installed.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new copper washers.
5. Bleed the brake caliper.
Disc Brake System - Exploded View
Disc Brake System - Exploded View
Disc Brake System (view 1 of 2)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4545
Disc Brake System (view 2 of 2)
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4546
Removal
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid on painted or plastic surfaces or damage to surface may occur. If
brake fluid is spilled onto a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with water.
1. If necessary, using a suitable suction device, remove the brake fluid from the master cylinder
reservoir until it is half filled.
2. Remove the wheel and tire.
3. NOTICE: If the anchor housing spring is to be removed, do not force the spring off the brake
caliper or damage to the spring may occur.
NOTICE: Do not use any tools to remove the spring, use hand force only. Do not use excessive
force or damage to the spring may occur.
Release the lower portion of the anchor housing spring.
- Apply force to the center of the spring and pull outward at the bottom of the spring to remove it
from the lower brake caliper cavity.
4. Rotate the spring upward and remove it from the brake caliper.
5. Rotate the outer brake pad upper and lower retaining springs to disengage them from the brake
caliper anchor plate.
6. NOTICE: Do not allow the caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose may
occur.
Remove the 2 guide pin bushing caps, remove and discard the 2 brake caliper guide pin bolts and
position the caliper aside.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4547
- Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
- Remove and discard the 2 brake caliper guide pin bushings.
7. Remove the 2 brake caliper anchor plate bolts and the anchor plate.
Installation
1. Position the brake caliper anchor plate and install the 2 anchor plate bolts.
- Tighten to 200 Nm (148 lb-ft).
2. NOTICE: Do not apply lubricant to guide pin threads or incorrect tightening of the guide pins may
result.
Install new brake hardware as follows:
- Apply the specified lubricant to the inside of the guide pin bushings.
- Install the guide pin bushings into the caliper bores.
- Install the guide pins into the bushings.
3. NOTE: Make sure that the inner brake pad retaining springs are correctly seated onto the brake
caliper anchor plate.
Position the brake caliper assembly onto the anchor plate.
4. Install the 2 brake caliper guide pin bolts and the 2 bushing caps.
- Tighten the bolts to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
5. Rotate the outer brake pad upper and lower retaining springs until they are correctly seated on
the anchor plate.
6. Install the anchor housing spring using the following procedure:
1. Insert the tab of the spring into the brake caliper cavity.
2. Twist the tab into the cavity.
7. NOTE: LH anchor housing spring shown, RH similar.
Rotate the anchor housing spring and position the upper portion onto the anchor plate.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4548
8. NOTE: LH anchor housing spring shown, RH similar.
Position the other anchor housing spring portion onto the anchor plate.
9. Push down and inward until the upper and lower ends of the anchor housing spring are latched
and seated in the brake caliper cavities.
10. NOTICE: The latch MUST be positioned as shown or damage to component may occur.
Verify that the brake pad anti-rattle spring is correctly latched by pulling on the spring.
11. Fill the master cylinder with clean, specified brake fluid.
12. Install the wheel and tire.
13. Apply the brake several times to verify correct brake operation.
Brake Caliper
Brake Caliper
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid onto painted or plastic surfaces or damage to surface may occur.
If brake fluid is spilled onto a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with water.
1. Remove the wheel and tire.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4549
2. Remove the brake hose flow bolt and disconnect the hose.
- Remove and discard the copper washers.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3. Remove the 2 brake caliper guide pin caps and bolts.
- Inspect the guide pin threads for damage, install a new guide pin(s) as necessary.
- To install, tighten to 38 Nm (28 lb-ft).
- Clean and dry guide pin threads as necessary.
4. Remove the brake caliper and remove the brake pads from the caliper.
5. Inspect the disc brake caliper dust boot for leaks and/or damage.
- If leaks or damage are found, install a new brake caliper.
6. NOTICE: Do not apply lubricant to guide pin threads or incorrect tightening of the guide pins may
result.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new guide pin bushings.
- Apply supplied white lubricant to the inside of the guide pin bushings.
7. Bleed the brake caliper.
Disc Brake System - Exploded View
Disc Brake System - Exploded View
Rear Brake Disc Components
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4550
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid onto painted or plastic surfaces or damage to surface may occur.
If brake fluid is spilled onto a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with water.
1. Check the brake fluid level in the brake master cylinder reservoir.
- If required, remove the fluid until the brake master cylinder reservoir is half full.
2. Remove the wheel and tire.
3. NOTICE: Do not allow the caliper and brake pad assembly to hang from the brake hose or
damage to the hose may occur.
Remove the 2 brake caliper guide pin caps and bolts and position the caliper and brake pad
assembly aside.
- Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
- Inspect the guide pin threads for damage and inspect the guide pin bushings for wear/damage.
Install a new guide pin(s) and bushing(s) as necessary.
- To install, tighten to 38 Nm (28 lb-ft).
4. Remove the 2 brake caliper anchor plate bolts and the brake caliper anchor plate.
- Inspect the caliper anchor plate bolt threads for damage and foreign material. Install cleaned and
dried anchor plate bolts or install new as necessary.
- To install, tighten to 190 Nm (140 lb-ft).
5. Clean, dry and inspect the brake caliper anchor plate. Apply equal amounts of the supplied
yellow lubricant to the 4 brake pad contact points on
the anchor plate as indicated.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4551
6. Fill the master cylinder with clean, specified brake fluid.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Apply the brake several times to verify correct brake operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid > Component Information
> Specifications
Brake Fluid: Specifications
BRAKE FLUID
Motorcraft High Performance DOT 3 Motor Vehicle Brake Fluid
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
.................................................................. PM-1-C Ford Specification
...................................................................................................................................................
WSS-M6C62-A or WSS-M6C65-A1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4558
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4559
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection
Brake Hose/Line: Testing and Inspection
Brake System Inspection
Brake Flexible Hoses and Tubes
NOTICE: Never use copper tubing. It is subject to fatigue, cracking and corrosion, which may result
in brake tube failure.
NOTE: Double-wall steel tubing is used throughout the brake hydraulic system. All brake tube
fittings must be correctly double flared to provide strong, leakproof connections. When bending
tubing to fit the underbody or rear axle contours, be careful not to kink or crack the tube.
1. Inspect brake tubes for corrosion, cracks, leaks or any other signs of damage.
- If a section of the brake tube is damaged, the entire section must be installed with a new tube of
the same type, size, shape and length.
- When installing the hydraulic brake tubing, hoses or connectors, tighten all connections to
specifications. After installation, bleed the brake system. For additional information, refer to Brake
System Bleeding See: Brake Bleeding/Service and Repair/Brake System Bleeding.
2. Inspect the brake flexible hoses for cracks, leaks and swelling during brake application or any
other signs of damage.
- Install a new brake flexible hose if the hose shows signs of softening, cracking or other damage.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake
Brake Hose/Line: Service and Repair Front Disc Brake
Disc Brake System - Exploded View
Disc Brake System - Exploded View
Disc Brake System (view 1 of 2)
Disc Brake System (view 2 of 2)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake > Page 4565
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Brake Flexible Hose
Brake Flexible Hose
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid on painted or plastic surfaces or damage to surface may occur. If
brake fluid is spilled onto a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with water.
1. Remove the wheel and tire.
2. Detach the brake flexible hose retainer from the wheel speed sensor harness.
3. Disconnect the brake tube fitting from the brake flexible hose.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
4. Remove the brake flexible hose retaining clip.
5. Remove the brake caliper flow bolt and discard the 2 copper washers.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
- Use new copper washers.
6. Remove brake flexible hose bracket bolt and brake flexible hose.
- To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake > Page 4566
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Bleed the brake caliper.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake > Page 4567
Brake Hose/Line: Service and Repair Rear Disc Brake
Disc Brake System - Exploded View
Disc Brake System - Exploded View
Rear Brake Disc Components
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Brake Flexible Hose
Brake Flexible Hose
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake > Page 4568
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid onto painted or plastic surfaces or damage to surface may occur.
If brake fluid is spilled onto a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with water.
1. Remove the wheel and tire.
2. Remove the brake caliper flow bolt and discard the 2 copper washers.
- Install new copper washers.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3. Disconnect the brake tube fitting from the brake flexible hose.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
4. Remove the brake flexible hose bracket bolt.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Bleed the brake caliper.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock
Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Service and Repair
Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU)
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid on painted or plastic surfaces or damage to the surface may
occur. If brake fluid is spilled onto a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with
water.
NOTE: On vehicles equipped with Roll Stability Control (RSC(R)), the ABS module and the
Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) are calibrated to one another. Do not swap ABS modules between
RSC(R)-equipped vehicles.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock
Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4572
NOTE: On vehicles equipped with RSC(R), the ABS module is available separately from the HCU
and should be serviced separately. However, if the RSC(R)-equipped vehicle requires a new HCU,
then the ABS module and the HCU must be installed as an assembly. Make sure to use the most
recently released service parts.
NOTE: When installing a new ABS module/HCU assembly, it must be configured (either by
download/upload or uploading the as-built data method).
1. Disconnect the ABS module electrical connector.
2. NOTICE: Only authorized inlet hydraulic brake tubes should be used. These tubes are of specific
design and only authorized parts
should be used when installing new inlet brake tubes. Use of other than authorized inlet brake
tubes may result in damage to the components.
NOTE: Plug each open port to prevent brake fluid from spilling.
Disconnect the 6 brake tube fittings.
- To install: Tighten the master cylinder brake tube fittings to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
- Tighten the remaining brake tube fittings to 20 Nm (177 lb-in).
3. Remove the 3 HCU-to-bracket bolts and the HCU.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Bleed the brake system.
5. If installing a new ABS module/HCU assembly on a vehicle equipped with RSC(R), configure the
ABS module.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Brake Master Cylinder - Bypass Condition
Brake Master Cylinder: Testing and Inspection Brake Master Cylinder - Bypass Condition
Component Tests
Brake Master Cylinder - Bypass Condition
1. Inspect the master cylinder. For additional information, refer to Brake System Inspection See:
Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and
General Diagnostics/Brake System Inspection.
2. Disconnect the brake tubes from the master cylinder.
3. Plug the outlet ports of the master cylinder.
4. NOTE: Make sure that the outlet port plugs do not show signs of leakage.
Lightly apply the brakes and hold for 10 seconds. Release the brakes and then reapply with heavy
force. If brake pedal height cannot be maintained, the brake master cylinder has an internal leak
and a new brake master cylinder must be installed.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Brake Master Cylinder - Bypass Condition > Page 4577
Brake Master Cylinder: Testing and Inspection Brake Master Cylinder - Compensator Port
Component Tests
Brake Master Cylinder - Compensator Port
1. Inspect the master cylinder. For additional information, refer to Brake System Inspection See:
Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and
General Diagnostics/Brake System Inspection.
2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. Refer to Maintenance/Service and Repair.
3. Apply and release the brakes.
4. With the brakes released, attempt to rotate each wheel and check for any brake drag.
- If an excessive amount of brake drag exists at multiple wheels, continue to Step 4.
- If an excessive amount of brake drag exists at only one wheel, it indicates a possible seized brake
caliper, brake wheel cylinder or parking brake component. Repair or install new components as
necessary.
5. Check the brake stoplamp switch and the brake pedal free play to verify that the brake pedal is
not partially applied.
6. Loosen the brake master cylinder nuts and position the brake master cylinder away from the
brake booster.
7. With the brakes released, attempt to rotate each wheel and check for any brake drag.
- If the brake drag is no longer present, install a new brake booster.
- If the brake drag is still present, install a new master cylinder.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Brake Master Cylinder - Bypass Condition > Page 4578
Brake Master Cylinder: Testing and Inspection Brake System Inspection
Brake Pads
Brake System Inspection
Brake Pads
NOTE: It is not required to install new brake pads when the brake discs are machined.
1. Inspect the brake pad friction material for contamination.
- If the friction material shows evidence of contamination, install new brake pads.
2. Inspect and measure the thickness of the brake pad friction material. For additional information,
refer to Specifications.
- Minor surface cracks do not require pad replacement, however, if there are missing chunks or
cracks in the lining through to the backing plate, install new brake pads.
- If the thickness of the friction material is less than the specified thickness, install new brake pads.
- If the friction material shows taper wear that is not within specifications, install new brake pads
and verify the caliper guide pins are functioning correctly. For additional information, refer to Brake
Caliper Guide Pins inspection. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics/Brake System Inspection/Brake Caliper Guide Pins
Brake Discs
Brake System Inspection
Brake Discs
NOTICE: Using an impact tool without a torque socket will lead to unevenly tightened wheel nuts.
This causes brake disc on-vehicle lateral runout and brake roughness.
1. Inspect the brake discs and measure the brake disc thickness in a minimum of 4 places around
the circumference of the brake disc. Record the
measurements, refer to Specifications. If the brake disc is cracked or otherwise damaged, install a new brake disc.
- If any measurement is below the minimum thickness specification, install a new brake disc.
- If the diagnosis has revealed vibration in the steering wheel, seat or pedal while braking that
varies with vehicle speed, machine the brake disc. Heavily scored brake discs, similar to that
caused by pads worn down to the backing plate, should also be machined. In order to machine,
discs must be above the minimum thickness specification. For additional information, refer to
Specifications and Brake Disc Machining See: Disc Brake System/Brake Rotor/Disc/Service and
Repair/Procedures.
Brake Calipers
Brake System Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Brake Master Cylinder - Bypass Condition > Page 4579
Brake Calipers
1. Inspect the brake calipers for leaks, damage to seals and piston corrosion or binding.
- If the brake caliper is leaking or otherwise damaged, install a new brake caliper.
Brake Caliper Guide Pins
Brake System Inspection
Brake Caliper Guide Pins
1. The guide pins should slide with a reasonable amount of hand force. If the brake pads show
taper wear or the guide pins are difficult to move,
carry out the following steps. Disassemble the brake caliper guide pins and inspect the guide pins and guide pin bores for wear,
damage and corrosion. If bore is worn or damaged, replace the damaged component.
- Use a wire brush, rolled-up sandpaper or emery cloth to remove all corrosion and foreign material
from the caliper guide pin bores. Clean any remaining foreign material from the bores with brake
parts cleaner and compressed air.
- Assemble the caliper seals, boots and guide pins. Use an ample amount of the specified grease
to lubricate the bores and guide pins.
- Inspect the brake pads. For additional information, refer to Brake Pads inspection. See: Testing
and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/Brake System Inspection/Brake Pads
Brake Flexible Hoses and Tubes
Brake System Inspection
Brake Flexible Hoses and Tubes
NOTICE: Never use copper tubing. It is subject to fatigue, cracking and corrosion, which may result
in brake tube failure.
NOTE: Double-wall steel tubing is used throughout the brake hydraulic system. All brake tube
fittings must be correctly double flared to provide strong, leakproof connections. When bending
tubing to fit the underbody or rear axle contours, be careful not to kink or crack the tube.
1. Inspect brake tubes for corrosion, cracks, leaks or any other signs of damage.
- If a section of the brake tube is damaged, the entire section must be installed with a new tube of
the same type, size, shape and length.
- When installing the hydraulic brake tubing, hoses or connectors, tighten all connections to
specifications. After installation, bleed the brake system. For additional information, refer to Brake
System Bleeding See: Brake Bleeding/Service and Repair/Brake System Bleeding.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Brake Master Cylinder - Bypass Condition > Page 4580
2. Inspect the brake flexible hoses for cracks, leaks and swelling during brake application or any
other signs of damage.
- Install a new brake flexible hose if the hose shows signs of softening, cracking or other damage.
Brake Master Cylinder
Brake System Inspection
Brake Master Cylinder
NOTE: During normal operation of the brake master cylinder, the fluid level in the brake master
cylinder reservoir will fall during brake application and rise during release. The returning brake fluid
creates a slight turbulance in the master cylinder reservoir. This is a normal condition and indicates
that the compensator ports are not clogged. Clogged compensator ports may cause the brakes to
hang up or not fully release. The net fluid level (such as after brake application and release) will
remain unchanged. Fluid level will decrease with pad wear.
NOTE: A trace of brake fluid will exist on the booster shell below the master cylinder mounting
flange. This results from the normal lubricating action of the master cylinder bore and seal.
1. Inspect the brake master cylinder for fluid leaks.
- Install a new master cylinder or brake fluid reservoir if signs of excessive leaking are present.
- To check for correct brake master cylinder operation, refer to Component Tests See: Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics.
Brake Booster
Brake System Inspection
Brake Booster
1. Inspect the brake booster for excessive corrosion or damage. Inspect the vacuum hoses for
leaks and kinks.
- Install a new brake booster if signs of excessive corrosion or damage is found.
- Repair or replace vacuum hoses as necessary.
- To check for correct brake booster operation, refer to Component Tests See: Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Brake Master Cylinder - Bypass Condition > Page 4581
Brake Master Cylinder: Testing and Inspection Brake Booster
Component Tests
Brake Booster
1. Inspect the brake booster. For additional information, refer to Brake System Inspection See:
Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics/Brake System Inspection.
2. Disconnect the check valve from the brake booster and connect a suitable vacuum/pressure
tester to the booster side of the check valve.
3. Apply the parking brake, start the engine and place the transmission in NEUTRAL.
- Allow the engine to reach normal operating temperature.
4. NOTE: Subtract approximately 4.0193 kPa (1 in-Hg) from the specified reading for every 304.8
m (1,000 ft) of elevation above sea level.
Verify that vacuum is available at the check valve with engine running at normal idle speed.
- The vacuum gauge should read between 51-74 kPa (15-22 in-Hg).
- If specified vacuum is available, stop the engine, connect the check valve and continue with Step
5.
- If specified vacuum is not available, continue with Step 4.
5. Disconnect the check valve from the vacuum hose and verify that the specified vacuum is
available at the hose with the engine at idle speed and
the transmission in NEUTRAL. If specified vacuum is available, stop the engine, install a new check valve and continue with Step
5.
- If specified vacuum is not available, stop the engine, connect the vacuum hose to the check valve
and refer to Engine to diagnose the no/low vacuum condition. See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Engine/Testing and Inspection
6. Apply the brake pedal several times to exhaust all vacuum from the system.
7. Apply the brake pedal and hold it in the applied position. Start the engine and verify that the
brake pedal moves downward after the engine starts.
- If the brake pedal moves, the brake booster is operating correctly.
- If the brake pedal does not move, install a new brake booster.
8. Operate the engine a minimum of 20 seconds at idle. Stop the engine and let the vehicle stand
for 10 minutes, then apply the brake pedal. The
brake pedal feel should be the same as that noted with the engine operating. If the brake pedal feels hard (no power assist), install a new brake booster check valve and retest.
- If condition still exists, install a new brake booster.
- If the brake pedal feels the same as noted with the engine operating, the check valve is
functioning properly.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Brake Master Cylinder: Procedures
Component Bleeding
Master Cylinder
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
WARNING: Do not allow the brake master cylinder to run dry during the bleeding operation. Master
cylinder may be damaged if operated without fluid, resulting in degraded braking performance.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid on painted or plastic surfaces or damage to the surface may
occur. If brake fluid is spilled onto a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with
water.
NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder is installed, or the system is emptied or partially
emptied, it should be primed to prevent air from entering the system.
1. Disconnect the brake tubes from the master cylinder.
2. Install short brake tubes with the ends submerged in the brake master cylinder reservoir.
3. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid.
4. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal until clear fluid flows from both brake tubes, without air
bubbles.
5. Remove the short brake tubes and install the brake outlet tubes.
6. Bleed each brake tube at the brake master cylinder as follows:
1. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal at least 2 times and then hold firm pressure on the
brake pedal.
2. Loosen the rearmost brake tube fitting until a stream of brake fluid comes out. While the
assistant maintains pressure on the brake pedal,
tighten the brake tube fitting.
3. Repeat this operation until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
4. Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary. Repeat the bleeding operation at the
front brake tube.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4584
5. Tighten the brake tube fittings to specifications. For additional information, refer to
Specifications.
7. Bleed the brake system, refer to Brake System Bleeding See: Brake Bleeding/Service and
Repair/Brake System Bleeding.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4585
Brake Master Cylinder: Removal and Replacement
Brake Master Cylinder
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not use any fluid other than clean brake fluid meeting manufacturer's specification.
Additionally, do not use brake fluid that has been previously drained. Following these instructions
will help prevent system contamination, brake component damage and the risk of serious personal
injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
NOTICE: Do not spill brake fluid on painted or plastic surfaces or damage to the surface may
occur. If brake fluid is spilled onto a painted or plastic surface, immediately wash the surface with
water.
1. Disconnect the brake fluid level switch.
2. Remove the air cleaner element.
3. Remove the 2 bolts and position the coolant expansion tank assembly aside.
- To install, tighten bolts to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4586
4. Loosen the brake tube fittings and disconnect the brake tubes.
- Plug the master cylinder ports.
- To install, tighten the fittings to 20 Nm (177 lb-in).
5. NOTICE: When the master cylinder is removed, the piston will be exposed. Do not damage the
piston or piston surface or a fluid leak
may occur.
Remove the 2 brake master cylinder nuts and the brake master cylinder.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Bleed the brake system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Parking Brake Cable: Procedures
Parking Brake Cable Tension Release
1. Remove the LH cowl side trim panel.
2. With the help of an assistant, release the parking brake cable tension by pulling down on the
intermediate cable at the cable-to-cable union until
the parking brake control sector rotates to its stop and a 4 mm (0.15 in) x 150 mm (5.9 in) retainer
pin can be inserted.
3. To reload the tension on the parking brake cable, follow the release procedure in reverse.
- Make sure the cable tension is reloaded slowly.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4592
Parking Brake Cable: Removal and Replacement
Parking Brake Cable - Rear, LH
Parking Brake Cable - Rear, LH
Removal and Installation
1. Relieve the tension on the parking brake cable system. For additional information, refer to
Parking Brake Cable Tension Release See: Procedures.
2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
3. Separate the LH rear cable from the equalizer.
4. Compress the 2 tabs and remove the conduit from the bracket.
5. NOTE: Be sure to correctly install the park brake cable retainer spring and route cables between
suspension links.
Disconnect the parking brake cable retainer spring from the cable.
6. Disconnect the LH rear cable from the retaining clip.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4593
7. Disconnect the ABS wheel speed sensor wire from the retaining clip.
8. Release the parking brake cable from the LH bracket assembly.
9. Release the cable from the parking brake actuating lever and remove the cable.
10. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Parking Brake Cable - Rear, RH
Parking Brake Cable - Rear, RH
Removal and Installation
1. Relieve the tension on the parking brake cable system. For additional information, refer to
Parking Brake Cable Tension Release See: Procedures.
2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
3. Disconnect the RH rear cable from the cable union.
4. Compress the 2 tabs and release the conduit from the equalizer.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4594
5. Disconnect the RH rear cable from the retaining clip.
6. Remove the bolt and the wire form bracket from the LH side of the vehicle.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
7. Remove the rear parking brake cable-to-crossmember bolt.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
8. Remove the bolt and the wire form bracket from the RH side of the vehicle.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
9. Release the parking brake cable from the RH bracket assembly.
10. Release the cable from the parking brake actuating lever and remove the cable.
11. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Parking Brake Cable - Front
Parking Brake Cable - Front
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the parking brake control. For additional information, refer to Parking Brake Control
See: Parking Brake Control/Service and Repair.
2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
3. Remove the front park brake cable P-clip-to-frame bolt.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
4. Remove the front parking brake cable and conduit.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 4595
- Pry the rubber seal from the front floor pan.
- Compress the retainer and release the conduit from the bracket.
- Remove the front cable and conduit from the cable union.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Control > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Parking Brake Control: Service and Repair
Parking Brake Control
Removal and Installation
1. Relieve tension on the parking brake cable system. For additional information, refer to Parking
Brake Cable Tension Release See: Parking Brake
Cable/Service and Repair/Procedures.
2. Remove the front door scuff plate.
3. Remove the instrument panel steering column opening trim panel and if equipped, the
instrument panel lower cover.
4. Remove the parking brake release handle bolt.
- To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
5. Remove the retainer and the cowl trim panel.
6. Compress the 2 tabs and disconnect the parking brake release cable from the parking brake
control assembly.
7. Disconnect the parking brake release cable from the release lever and remove the parking brake
release handle.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Control > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 4599
8. Disconnect the parking brake switch electrical connector.
9. Remove the 3 parking brake control assembly bolts.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (177 lb-in).
10. Position the parking brake control assembly onto the floor.
11. Disconnect the parking brake cable from the take-up spool.
12. Compress the 2 tabs, disconnect the parking brake cable from the control assembly and
remove the control assembly.
13. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Shoe > Component
Information > Adjustments
Parking Brake Shoe: Adjustments
Parking Brake Shoe Adjustment
1. NOTE: Make sure the parking brake is fully released.
Using the release handle, release the parking brake control.
2. Remove the rear brake disc.
3. Using the Brake Adjusting Gauge, measure the inside diameter of the drum portion of the rear
brake disc and set the locking screw.
- Record the measurement.
4. Place the Brake Adjusting Gauge over the widest diameter of the parking brake shoes.
5. Adjust the parking brake shoe clearance to 0.45 mm (0.02 in) less than the inside diameter of
the drum portion of the rear brake disc.
- Rotate the parking brake shoe adjuster to achieve the correct parking brake shoe-to-brake disc
clearance.
6. Install the rear brake disc.
7. Test the parking brake for normal operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Shoe > Component
Information > Adjustments > Page 4603
Parking Brake Shoe: Service and Repair
Parking Brake Shoes
Removal
1. Relieve the tension on the parking brake cable system. For additional information, refer to
Parking Brake Cable Tension Release See: Parking
Brake Cable/Service and Repair/Procedures.
2. Remove the brake disc.
3. Remove the front parking brake shoe retaining clip and pin.
4. Remove the parking brake shoe adjuster.
- Using a suitable tool, spread the bottom of the parking brake shoes apart.
- Remove the parking brake shoe adjuster.
5. Remove the parking brake shoe adjuster spring.
6. Slide the front parking brake shoe up and out of the guide flange.
7. Remove the front parking brake shoe.
- Rotate the front parking brake shoe outward.
- Remove the parking brake shoe return spring.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Shoe > Component
Information > Adjustments > Page 4604
8. Remove the rear parking brake shoe.
- Remove the retaining clip and pin.
- Remove the rear parking brake shoe.
9. Inspect the components for excessive wear or damage and install new parts as required.
Installation
1. NOTICE: Apply the grease only where indicated, do not apply the grease to the parking brake
shoes. The grease will contaminate the
brake shoe linings and damage to the linings will result.
Apply a light coat of the specified grease to the 6 parking brake shoe contact points on the disc
brake shield.
2. Install the rear parking brake shoe.
- Hold the rear parking brake shoe in position.
- Install the retaining pin and clip.
3. Install the front parking brake shoe.
- Install the parking brake shoe return spring to the rear parking brake shoe and to the front parking
brake shoe.
- Rotate the front parking brake shoe into the guide flange.
4. Slide the front parking brake shoe down into position on the flange.
5. Install the front parking brake shoe retaining pin and clip.
6. Install the parking brake shoe adjuster spring.
7. Install the parking brake shoe adjuster.
- Using a suitable tool, spread the bottom of the parking brake shoes apart.
- Install the parking brake shoe adjuster.
8. Adjust the parking brake shoes. For additional information, refer to Parking Brake Shoe
Adjustment See: Adjustments.
9. NOTE: This step will require the aid of an assistant.
Enable the parking brake cable system.
- Pull down on the front parking brake cable at the coupler.
- Remove the retaining pin from the parking brake lever.
10. Check the parking brake for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4608
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4609
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Brake Booster Vacuum Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Brake Booster Vacuum Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Brake Booster Vacuum Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4614
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Brake Booster Vacuum Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4615
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Specifications
Vacuum Brake Booster: Specifications
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4619
Vacuum Brake Booster: Description and Operation
Brake Booster
The power brake actuation system consists of the following components:
- Brake booster
- Brake booster check valve
- Brake booster vacuum supply hose
The brake booster uses engine vacuum from the intake manifold to create a partial vacuum inside
the vacuum booster on both sides of the diaphragm. When the brake pedal is pressed, the booster
rod opens a valve, allowing air to enter the booster on one side of the diaphragm while sealing off
the opposite side. This increases pressure on that side of the diaphragm so that it helps push the
rod, which in turn pushes the piston in the master cylinder. As the brake pedal is released, the
valve seals off the outside air supply while opening the vacuum valve. This restores vacuum to
both sides of the diaphragm, allowing everything to return to its original position.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Brake Booster
Vacuum Brake Booster: Testing and Inspection Brake Booster
Component Tests
Brake Booster
1. Inspect the brake booster. For additional information, refer to Brake System Inspection See:
Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics/Brake System Inspection.
2. Disconnect the check valve from the brake booster and connect a suitable vacuum/pressure
tester to the booster side of the check valve.
3. Apply the parking brake, start the engine and place the transmission in NEUTRAL.
- Allow the engine to reach normal operating temperature.
4. NOTE: Subtract approximately 4.0193 kPa (1 in-Hg) from the specified reading for every 304.8
m (1,000 ft) of elevation above sea level.
Verify that vacuum is available at the check valve with engine running at normal idle speed.
- The vacuum gauge should read between 51-74 kPa (15-22 in-Hg).
- If specified vacuum is available, stop the engine, connect the check valve and continue with Step
5.
- If specified vacuum is not available, continue with Step 4.
5. Disconnect the check valve from the vacuum hose and verify that the specified vacuum is
available at the hose with the engine at idle speed and
the transmission in NEUTRAL. If specified vacuum is available, stop the engine, install a new check valve and continue with Step
5.
- If specified vacuum is not available, stop the engine, connect the vacuum hose to the check valve
and refer to Engine to diagnose the no/low vacuum condition. See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Engine/Testing and Inspection
6. Apply the brake pedal several times to exhaust all vacuum from the system.
7. Apply the brake pedal and hold it in the applied position. Start the engine and verify that the
brake pedal moves downward after the engine starts.
- If the brake pedal moves, the brake booster is operating correctly.
- If the brake pedal does not move, install a new brake booster.
8. Operate the engine a minimum of 20 seconds at idle. Stop the engine and let the vehicle stand
for 10 minutes, then apply the brake pedal. The
brake pedal feel should be the same as that noted with the engine operating. If the brake pedal feels hard (no power assist), install a new brake booster check valve and retest.
- If condition still exists, install a new brake booster.
- If the brake pedal feels the same as noted with the engine operating, the check valve is
functioning properly.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Brake Booster > Page 4622
Vacuum Brake Booster: Testing and Inspection Brake System Inspection - Brake Booster
Brake System Inspection
Brake Booster
1. Inspect the brake booster for excessive corrosion or damage. Inspect the vacuum hoses for
leaks and kinks.
- Install a new brake booster if signs of excessive corrosion or damage is found.
- Repair or replace vacuum hoses as necessary.
- To check for correct brake booster operation, refer to Component Tests See: Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 4623
Vacuum Brake Booster: Service and Repair
Brake Booster
NOTE: Non-roll stability control equipped shown, roll stability control equipped similar.
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the air cleaner element.
2. Remove the 2 bolts and position the degas bottle/lower air cleaner housing assembly aside.
- To install, tighten bolts to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
3. Relieve the vacuum in the brake booster by pressing and releasing the brake pedal a minimum
of 5 times with the engine not running.
4. Disconnect the brake fluid level switch.
5. NOTE: Support the master cylinder with mechanic's wire.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 4624
Remove the 2 brake master cylinder nuts and position the master cylinder aside.
- To install, tighten the nuts to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
Vehicles equipped with Roll Stability Control (RSC(R))
6. Disconnect the brake pedal travel solenoid electrical connector.
All vehicles
7. Disconnect the brake pedal travel sensor electrical connector.
8. Disconnect the manifold vacuum outlet assembly from the brake booster.
9. NOTICE: Do not service the brake pedal or brake booster without first removing the stoplamp
switch. This switch must be removed with
the brake pedal in the at-rest position. The switch plunger must be compressed for the switch to
rotate in the bracket. Attempting to remove the switch when the plunger is extended (during pedal
apply) will result in damage to the switch.
Remove the stoplamp switch.
10. Remove the brake pedal arm pin and disconnect the booster push rod from the brake pedal
arm.
11. Remove the 4 brake booster-to-pedal bracket nuts and remove the brake booster.
- To access the retaining nuts, fold back the sound insulation.
- To install, tighten to 27 Nm (20 lb-ft).
12. NOTICE: Do not press, pull or otherwise move the brake pedal while installing the stoplamp
switch. This switch must be installed with
the booster push rod attached to the brake pedal and with the brake pedal in the at-rest position.
Installing this switch with the brake pedal in any other position will result in incorrect adjustment
and may damage the switch.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- For vehicles equipped with Roll Stability Control (RSC(R)), calibrate the ABS module. Follow the
directions on the scan tool for the calibration procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Trailer Brakes > Trailer Brake Control Module > Component
Information > Locations
Trailer Brake Control Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Trailer Brakes > Trailer Brake Control Module > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4629
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Trailer Brakes > Trailer Brake Control Module > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4630
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Electronic Brake Control Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4635
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4636
Electronic Brake Control Module: Diagrams
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4637
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4638
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module
Removal and Installation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4639
NOTE: On vehicles equipped with Roll Stability Control (RSC(R)), the ABS module and the
Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) are calibrated to one another. Do not swap ABS modules between
RSC(R)-equipped vehicles.
NOTE: On vehicles equipped with RSC(R), the ABS module is available separately from the HCU
and should be serviced separately. However, if the RSC(R)-equipped vehicle requires a new HCU,
then the ABS module and the HCU must be installed as an assembly. Make sure to use the most
recently released service parts.
NOTE: When installing a new ABS module/HCU assembly, it must be configured (either by
download/upload or uploading the as-built data method).
1. Release the Air Cleaner (ACL) cover retaining clips and disconnect the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor electrical connector.
2. Loosen the ACL outlet clamp and disconnect the ACL cover from the outlet pipe.
- To install, tighten to 4 Nm (35 lb-in).
3. Remove the 3 HCU bracket-to-frame bolts.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (177 lb-in).
4. Disconnect the ABS module electrical connector.
5. Remove the 4 ABS module bolts and the ABS module.
- To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
7. If installing a new ABS module on a vehicle equipped with RSC(R), configure the ABS module.
8. If installing a new ABS module on a vehicle equipped with RSC(R), calibrate the RSC(R) sensor.
Connect the scan tool and carry out the IVD
Initialization sequence.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Trailer Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Trailer Brake Control Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Trailer Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4643
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Trailer Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4644
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS
Sensor Block > Component Information > Locations
ABS Sensor Block: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS
Sensor Block > Component Information > Locations > Page 4649
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS
Sensor Block > Component Information > Locations > Page 4650
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control >
Acceleration/Deceleration Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
Acceleration/Deceleration Sensor: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
Vehicles with floor shift
1. Remove the front floor console.
2. Remove the 4 bolts and the front floor console support bracket.
- To install: Tighten the upper bolts to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
- Tighten the lower bolts to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
Vehicles with column shift
3. Remove the stability control sensor cover.
All vehicles
4. Disconnect the stability control sensor cluster electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control >
Acceleration/Deceleration Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4654
5. Remove the 2 bolts and the stability control sensor cluster.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Connect the scan tool and carry out the IVD Initialization sequence.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Booster Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Brake Booster Vacuum Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Booster Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4658
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Booster Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4659
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4663
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4664
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4668
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4669
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering
Angle Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Service and Repair
Steering Angle Sensor: Service and Repair
Steering Wheel Rotation Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the steering wheel rotation sensor electrical connector.
2. Remove the 2 bolts and the steering wheel rotation sensor.
- To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
4. NOTE: If the sensor is not calibrated after installation, a DTC will be set in the ABS module.
Calibrate the sensor in the following sequence:
1. Start the engine.
2. Rotate the steering wheel from lock to lock a minimum of 2 times.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction
Control Switch > Component Information > Locations
Traction Control Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction
Control Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4676
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction
Control Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4677
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 4682
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 4683
Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Wheel Speed Sensor, Right Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 4684
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 4685
Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 4686
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 4687
Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Wheel Speed Sensor, Right Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 4688
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 4691
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 4692
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Wheel Speed Sensor, Left Front > Page 4693
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the wheel and tire.
2. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector.
3. Remove the wheel speed sensor harness bolt and detach the retainers.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
4. NOTICE: Do not allow the caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can result.
Remove the 2 caliper anchor bolts and position the caliper, pads and anchor plate aside.
- Support the caliper with mechanic's wire.
- To install, tighten to 200 Nm (148 lb-ft).
5. Remove the brake disc.
6. Remove the front wheel speed sensor bolt and the sensor.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front > Page 4696
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the parking brake shoes.
2. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor harness from the retaining clips.
3. Remove the rear wheel speed sensor bolt and the sensor.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) transceiver.
2. NOTE: The ignition lock cylinder must be in the RUN position.
Using a suitable tool, press the release pin and remove the ignition lock cylinder.
3. If a new lock cylinder with keys is replaced, the new PATS keys must be programmed.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Verify the ignition lock cylinder operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional > Page
4704
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Ignition Lock Cylinder - Non Functional
Ignition Lock Cylinder - Non Functional
Removal
1. Remove the Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) transceiver.
2. Remove the ignition lock cylinder.
- Use a 1/8-inch diameter drill bit to drill out the lock cylinder retaining pin.
- Use a 3/8-inch diameter drill bit to drill down the middle of the ignition lock key slot until the
ignition lock cylinder breaks loose.
- Remove and discard the ignition lock cylinder and drill shavings from the steering column.
3. Remove the bearing retainer.
4. Remove the steering column lock housing bearing and steering column lock gear.
Installation
1. Thoroughly clean all drill shavings from the steering column and inspect it for damage.
2. Install a new ignition lock cylinder.
- Verify the ignition lock cylinder operation.
3. Program the new PATS keys.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Starter Relay
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Starter Relay > Page 4710
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Starter Relay
Starter Relay: Testing and Inspection Starter Relay
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Starter Relay > Page 4713
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Starter Relay > Page 4714
Starter Relay: Testing and Inspection Run/Start Relay
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Starter Relay > Page 4715
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Service and Repair
Battery Cable: Service and Repair
Battery Cables
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Page 4720
2. Disconnect the battery. For additional information, refer to Battery Disconnect See: Service and
Repair/Battery Disconnect.
3. Remove the nut and position the battery ground cable terminal aside at the starter.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
4. Remove the nut and position the starter solenoid positive cable terminal aside.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
5. Remove the nut and position the starter solenoid wire terminal aside.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
6. Remove the 2 nuts and position the 2 battery cable harness brackets from the A/C compressor
mounting bolts.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
7. Remove the bolt and position the battery ground cable-to-frame terminal aside.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
8. Remove the nut and position the generator harness terminal and the Battery Junction Box (BJB)
cable terminal aside.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
9. Remove the bolt and position the battery ground cable-to-cowl panel terminal aside.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
10. Disconnect the battery cable harness in-line electrical connector, release the harness locator
and remove the battery cable harness assembly.
11. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Alternator: Electrical Specifications
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 4726
Alternator: Mechanical Specifications
General Specifications
Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4727
Alternator: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4728
Alternator: Description and Operation
Charging System
The charging system is a negative ground system consisting of:
- a generator.
- an internal voltage regulator.
- a charging system warning indicator.
- a battery.
- circuitry and cables.
- a PCM.
The generator is driven by the accessory drive belt. When the engine is started, the generator
begins to generate AC which is internally converted to DC. The DC is controlled by the voltage
regulator (located on the rear of the generator) and supplied to the battery. The PCM controls the
voltage regulation set point, working with the generator internal voltage regulator over 2 control and
communication circuits.
The generator and voltage regulator:
- supply current to the electrical system.
- charge the battery.
- adjust the generator field current to increase or decrease the generator output.
- have a PCM-controlled warning lamp.
- output is controlled by the PCM.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4729
Alternator: Service and Repair
Generator
Removal and Installation
NOTICE: Do not allow any metal object to come in contact with the generator housing and internal
diode cooling fins. A short circuit may result and burn out the diodes.
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. For Navigator, release the 2 retainers and remove the engine cover.
3. Remove the Air Cleaner (ACL) intake pipe.
4. Rotate the Front End Accessory Drive (FEAD) belt tensioner counterclockwise and position the
accessory drive belt aside.
5. Remove the harness locator from the generator bracket.
6. Remove the 4 bolts and the generator bracket.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
7. Remove the 2 bolts and position the generator aside.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4730
- Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
8. Disconnect the generator electrical connector.
9. Position the generator B+ protective cover aside, remove and discard the nut, then position the
generator B+ terminal aside.
- Install a new B+ terminal nut and tighten to 17 Nm (150 lb-in).
10. Remove the generator.
11. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) transceiver.
2. NOTE: The ignition lock cylinder must be in the RUN position.
Using a suitable tool, press the release pin and remove the ignition lock cylinder.
3. If a new lock cylinder with keys is replaced, the new PATS keys must be programmed.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Verify the ignition lock cylinder operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional > Page 4737
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Ignition Lock Cylinder - Non Functional
Ignition Lock Cylinder - Non Functional
Removal
1. Remove the Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) transceiver.
2. Remove the ignition lock cylinder.
- Use a 1/8-inch diameter drill bit to drill out the lock cylinder retaining pin.
- Use a 3/8-inch diameter drill bit to drill down the middle of the ignition lock key slot until the
ignition lock cylinder breaks loose.
- Remove and discard the ignition lock cylinder and drill shavings from the steering column.
3. Remove the bearing retainer.
4. Remove the steering column lock housing bearing and steering column lock gear.
Installation
1. Thoroughly clean all drill shavings from the steering column and inspect it for damage.
2. Install a new ignition lock cylinder.
- Verify the ignition lock cylinder operation.
3. Program the new PATS keys.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Key > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment
Key: Testing and Inspection Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using
Diagnostic Equipment
Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment
NOTE: This procedure is used when a customer needs keys programmed into the system and
does not have 2 programmed ignition keys available. This procedure is also useful when a
programmed ignition key(s) is lost or the ignition lock cylinder is replaced, and it is desired to erase
key code(s) from the Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) memory.
NOTE: This procedure erases all programmed ignition keys from the vehicle memory and the
vehicle does not start until 2 keys are programmed to the vehicle. This procedure also erases the
Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) identification codes (TICs) from the Smart Junction Box
(SJB), preventing the erased IKT from operating the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) functions on the
vehicle.
NOTE: Two PATS encoded (contains a transponder) IKT keys (or standard PATS keys) with the
correct mechanical cut must be available to carry out this procedure. One or both of them may be
the customer's original keys. One or both of them may be an IKT or a standard PATS key.
NOTE: If additional keys are to be programmed, refer to Key Programming Using Two
Programmed Keys See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing
and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys. If
the remaining keys are with the customer and are not available with the vehicle, instruct the
customer to refer to the Owner's Literature for instructions on programming the remaining keys. In
this case, the IC PID SPAREKEY must be enabled.
NOTE: This procedure is not necessary if only the PATS transceiver was replaced. Replacement of
the transceiver does not erase the PATS key codes in the IC.
1. Turn the key from the OFF position to the ON position.
2. From the scan tool, enter TOOLBOX. Select BODY-SECURITY-PATS Functions and follow the
on-screen instructions to ENTER SECURITY
ACCESS. For additional information, refer to Anti-Theft Security Access See: Accessories and
Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and
General Diagnostics.
3. From the scan tool menu select: IGNITION KEY CODE ERASE. Follow all Integrated Diagnostic
System (IDS) screen instructions until the key
erase procedure completes. The scan tool will also instruct to program 2 keys to complete the
process.
4. Turn the key to the OFF position and disconnect the scan tool (the key does not need to be
removed at this time).
5. NOTE: The RKE data transfer takes place between the key and the IC first. After both keys are
programmed into the IC, the RKE data transfers
from the IC to the SJB. Until the final data transfer takes place into the SJB, the RKE functions do
not operate.
NOTE: IKT keys require a 6-second programming time frame for the RKE data transfer to take
place, while standard PATS keys only require a minimum of 3 seconds.
Turn the first PATS key to the ON position for a minimum of 6 seconds (this additional 3 second
time frame allows for the RKE data transfer to take place).
6. Turn the first PATS key to the OFF position and remove the key from the ignition lock cylinder.
7. Insert the second PATS key into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the key to the ON position for
a minimum of 6 seconds (this additional 3
second time frame allows for the RKE data transfer to take place).
8. The vehicle should now start with both ignition keys and the RKE transmitter portion of an IKT
should function.
9. If it is desired to program additional key(s) (only up to 8 keys total can be programmed into the
IC), refer to Key Programming Using Two
Programmed Keys See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing
and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys for
each additional key that needs to be programmed.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Key > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment > Page 4742
Key: Testing and Inspection Key Programming Switch State Control
Key Programming Switch State Control
NOTE: The spare key programming switch is a programmable switch which provides the capability
to enable/disable the normal customer spare key programming procedure detailed in the Owner's
Literature. It must read ENABLE if more than 2 keys need to be programmed into the Instrument
Cluster (IC). For additional information, refer to Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys
See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys. This
programmable switch is provided as a convenience for rental company fleets or other fleet
purchasers who may not want the spare key programming procedure available to the vehicle
driver.
NOTE: The spare key programming switch state can be viewed with the IC PID SPAREKEY.
NOTE: If the Instrument Cluster (IC) SPAREKEY PID reads ENABLE, up to 8 keys total can be
programmed into the IC. For additional information, refer to Key Programming Using Two
Programmed Keys See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing
and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys. If
the SPAREKEY PID reads DISABLED, the key programming using two programmed keys
procedure cannot function. The switch is set to ENABLE when the vehicle is built. The switch does
not affect the Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment procedure or the Spare Key
Programming - Unlimited Key Mode procedure or the Spare Key Programming - Using Diagnostic
Equipment procedure.
1. Insert a programmed Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) key into the ignition lock cylinder and
turn the key from the OFF position to the ON
position.
2. From the scan tool, follow the on-screen instructions to ENTER SECURITY ACCESS. For
additional information, refer to Anti-Theft Security
Access See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics .
3. From the scan tool menu select: "Customer Spare Key Programming Enable" (or "Customer
Spare Key Programming Disable").
- "Customer Spare Key Programming Enable" - spare key programming procedure is accessible.
- "Customer Spare Key Programming Disable" - spare key programming procedure is not
accessible.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Key > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment > Page 4743
Key: Testing and Inspection Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys
Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys
NOTE: This procedure works only if 2 or more programmed ignition keys are available. If 2
programmed keys are not available, refer to Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key
Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and
Alarm Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Integrated Keyhead
Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment.
NOTE: The Instrument Cluster (IC) PID SPAREKEY must be enabled for this procedure to operate.
If this PID is not enabled, refer to Key Programming Switch State Control See: Accessories and
Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and
Relearning/Key Programming Switch State Control, then select SPAREKEY programming switch:
ENABLED. The PID SPAREKEY is set to ENABLE when the vehicle is built.
NOTE: If the programming procedure is successful, the new key(s) starts the vehicle and the
anti-theft indicator proves-out for approximately 3 seconds. If the programming procedure is not
successful and the new key(s) does not start the engine, leave the key in the ON position for at
least 3 seconds, then turn the key off. Repeat the key programming procedure from Step 1. If the
failure repeats, refer to Anti-Theft See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm
Systems/Testing and Inspection in the Diagnosis and Testing portion to review the DTCs and carry
out the appropriate pinpoint tests.
NOTE: A maximum of 8 Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) keys can be programmed into the
Instrument Cluster (IC) during this programming procedure, but only if the PID SPAREKEY is
ENABLED.
NOTE: If the vehicle is in unlimited key mode, this spare key programming procedure still functions.
Any 2 keys that can start the vehicle can be used to program an additional unlimited key.
NOTE: If additional keys are to be programmed, and the remaining keys are with the customer, or
are not available, instruct the customer to refer to the Owner's Literature for instructions on
programming the remaining keys. In this case, the PID SPAREKEY must be enabled.
NOTE: If the steps are not carried out as outlined, the programming procedure ends.
NOTE: Ignition keys must have a correct mechanical key cut for the vehicle and must be
PATS-encoded keys (contain a transponder).
NOTE: This procedure is not necessary if only the PATS transceiver was replaced. Replacement of
the transceiver does not erase the PATS key codes in the IC.
NOTE: When in the unlimited key mode (after the first 2 keys have been programmed to the
vehicle), the N_KEYCODE PID will always read 2, no matter how many keys are programmed to
the vehicle.
1. Insert the first programmed key into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the key from the OFF
position to the ON position (maintain the key in the
ON position for a minimum of 3 seconds and less than 10 seconds).
2. Turn the key to the OFF position and remove the key from the ignition lock cylinder.
3. Within 5 seconds of turning the key to the OFF position, insert the second programmed key into
the ignition lock cylinder and turn the key from
the OFF position to the ON position (maintain the key in the ON position for a minimum of 3
seconds and less than 10 seconds).
4. Turn the key to the OFF position and remove the key from the ignition lock cylinder.
5. Within 10 seconds of turning the key to the OFF position, insert the unprogrammed key (the new
key) into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the
key from the OFF position to the ON position, maintaining the key in the ON position for a minimum
of 6 seconds (the additional 3 second time frame allows for the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) data
transfer to take place, if programming an Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) key).
6. Start the vehicle with the new key(s).
7. If it is desired to program additional key(s) (only up to 8 keys total can be programmed into the
IC), repeat Steps 1-5 for each additional key that
needs to be programmed.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Key > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment > Page 4744
Key: Testing and Inspection Spare Key Programming - Unlimited Key Mode
Spare Key Programming - Unlimited Key Mode
Enabling Unlimited Key Mode
NOTE: Unlimited key mode is intended for use by those customers who need more than 8 keys for
their vehicle.
NOTE: Before programming, the new key(s) must have the correct mechanical cut for the ignition
lock cylinder(s).
NOTE: The unlimited key mode is set up by creating a special, unique unlimited transponder
security key code and programming this key code into all of the vehicle keys so they contain the
same key code.
NOTE: When in the unlimited key mode (after the first 2 keys have been programmed to the
vehicle), the N_KEYCODE PID will always read 2, no matter how many keys are programmed to
the vehicle.
1. The customer must choose an 8-digit number (except for 00000000 or 00000001) to be
programmed to all of their vehicles keys (or, to all of the
keys they want programmed to one vehicle). All customer vehicles keys (or all keys for one vehicle)
need to use the same number. Valid digits are 0-9 and the letters A-F.
2. NOTE: If the PID UNL_KEY_ID is not available, unlimited key mode is turned on, and must be
turned off before viewing the stored code. At
this time, unlimited keys may be programmed to the vehicle(s). To view/change the stored code,
follow the procedure for disabling the unlimited key mode below.
Monitor the PID UNL_KEY_ID and compare its value against the code chosen in Step 1. It should
not be the same key code.
3. From the scan tool, follow the on-screen instructions to ENTER SECURITY ACCESS. For
additional information, refer to Anti-Theft Security
Access See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics .
4. Once in security access, select: "program unlimited key code" and follow the on-screen
instructions. Enter the 8-digit code chosen by the customer
in Step 1 of this procedure and follow the on-screen instructions.
5. Select: "unlimited key mode ON" and follow the on-screen instructions.
6. Select: "Ignition Key Code Erase" and follow the on-screen instructions.
7. Disconnect the scan tool and turn the ignition key to the OFF position.
8. Insert the first Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) key into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the
key to the ON position for 3 seconds (6 seconds
if it is an Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) key).
9. Turn the first PATS key to the OFF position and remove the key from the ignition lock cylinder.
10. Insert the second PATS key into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the key to the ON position
for 3 seconds (6 seconds if it is an IKT key).
11. The vehicle should now start with both PATS keys.
12. If it is desired to program additional key(s), refer to Key Programming Using Two Programmed
Keys See: Accessories and Optional
Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key
Programming Using Two Programmed Keys for each additional key that needs to be programmed.
Disabling Unlimited Key Mode
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Key > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment > Page 4745
NOTE: By disabling the unlimited key mode, the previous access code no longer operates the
vehicle.
1. From the scan tool, follow the on-screen instructions to ENTER SECURITY ACCESS. For
additional information, refer to Anti-Theft Security
Access See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics .
2. Select: "unlimited key mode OFF" and follow the on-screen instructions.
3. Select: "Ignition Key Code Erase" and follow the on-screen instructions.
4. Disconnect the scan tool and turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
5. Insert the first PATS key into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the key to the ON position for 3
seconds (6 seconds if it is an IKT key).
6. Turn the first PATS key to the OFF position and remove the key from the ignition lock cylinder.
7. Insert the second PATS key into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the key to the ON position for
3 seconds (6 seconds if it is an IKT key).
8. NOTE: With the unlimited key mode turned off, a maximum of 8 keys can be programmed into
the Instrument Cluster (IC) using the Key
Programming Using Two Programmed Keys See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft
and Alarm Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key Programming Using
Two Programmed Keys procedure. The IC PID SPAREKEY must be enabled.
If it is desired to program additional key(s), refer to Key Programming Using Two Programmed
Keys See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys for each
additional key (up to 8 keys, total) that needs to be programmed. The IC PID SPAREKEY must be
enabled.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Key > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment > Page 4746
Key: Testing and Inspection
Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment
Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment
NOTE: This procedure is used when a customer needs keys programmed into the system and
does not have 2 programmed ignition keys available. This procedure is also useful when a
programmed ignition key(s) is lost or the ignition lock cylinder is replaced, and it is desired to erase
key code(s) from the Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) memory.
NOTE: This procedure erases all programmed ignition keys from the vehicle memory and the
vehicle does not start until 2 keys are programmed to the vehicle. This procedure also erases the
Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) identification codes (TICs) from the Smart Junction Box
(SJB), preventing the erased IKT from operating the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) functions on the
vehicle.
NOTE: Two PATS encoded (contains a transponder) IKT keys (or standard PATS keys) with the
correct mechanical cut must be available to carry out this procedure. One or both of them may be
the customer's original keys. One or both of them may be an IKT or a standard PATS key.
NOTE: If additional keys are to be programmed, refer to Key Programming Using Two
Programmed Keys See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing
and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys. If
the remaining keys are with the customer and are not available with the vehicle, instruct the
customer to refer to the Owner's Literature for instructions on programming the remaining keys. In
this case, the IC PID SPAREKEY must be enabled.
NOTE: This procedure is not necessary if only the PATS transceiver was replaced. Replacement of
the transceiver does not erase the PATS key codes in the IC.
1. Turn the key from the OFF position to the ON position.
2. From the scan tool, enter TOOLBOX. Select BODY-SECURITY-PATS Functions and follow the
on-screen instructions to ENTER SECURITY
ACCESS. For additional information, refer to Anti-Theft Security Access See: Accessories and
Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and
General Diagnostics.
3. From the scan tool menu select: IGNITION KEY CODE ERASE. Follow all Integrated Diagnostic
System (IDS) screen instructions until the key
erase procedure completes. The scan tool will also instruct to program 2 keys to complete the
process.
4. Turn the key to the OFF position and disconnect the scan tool (the key does not need to be
removed at this time).
5. NOTE: The RKE data transfer takes place between the key and the IC first. After both keys are
programmed into the IC, the RKE data transfers
from the IC to the SJB. Until the final data transfer takes place into the SJB, the RKE functions do
not operate.
NOTE: IKT keys require a 6-second programming time frame for the RKE data transfer to take
place, while standard PATS keys only require a minimum of 3 seconds.
Turn the first PATS key to the ON position for a minimum of 6 seconds (this additional 3 second
time frame allows for the RKE data transfer to take place).
6. Turn the first PATS key to the OFF position and remove the key from the ignition lock cylinder.
7. Insert the second PATS key into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the key to the ON position for
a minimum of 6 seconds (this additional 3
second time frame allows for the RKE data transfer to take place).
8. The vehicle should now start with both ignition keys and the RKE transmitter portion of an IKT
should function.
9. If it is desired to program additional key(s) (only up to 8 keys total can be programmed into the
IC), refer to Key Programming Using Two
Programmed Keys See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing
and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys for
each additional key that needs to be programmed.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Key > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment > Page 4747
Key Programming Switch State Control
Key Programming Switch State Control
NOTE: The spare key programming switch is a programmable switch which provides the capability
to enable/disable the normal customer spare key programming procedure detailed in the Owner's
Literature. It must read ENABLE if more than 2 keys need to be programmed into the Instrument
Cluster (IC). For additional information, refer to Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys
See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys. This
programmable switch is provided as a convenience for rental company fleets or other fleet
purchasers who may not want the spare key programming procedure available to the vehicle
driver.
NOTE: The spare key programming switch state can be viewed with the IC PID SPAREKEY.
NOTE: If the Instrument Cluster (IC) SPAREKEY PID reads ENABLE, up to 8 keys total can be
programmed into the IC. For additional information, refer to Key Programming Using Two
Programmed Keys See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing
and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys. If
the SPAREKEY PID reads DISABLED, the key programming using two programmed keys
procedure cannot function. The switch is set to ENABLE when the vehicle is built. The switch does
not affect the Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment procedure or the Spare Key
Programming - Unlimited Key Mode procedure or the Spare Key Programming - Using Diagnostic
Equipment procedure.
1. Insert a programmed Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) key into the ignition lock cylinder and
turn the key from the OFF position to the ON
position.
2. From the scan tool, follow the on-screen instructions to ENTER SECURITY ACCESS. For
additional information, refer to Anti-Theft Security
Access See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics .
3. From the scan tool menu select: "Customer Spare Key Programming Enable" (or "Customer
Spare Key Programming Disable").
- "Customer Spare Key Programming Enable" - spare key programming procedure is accessible.
- "Customer Spare Key Programming Disable" - spare key programming procedure is not
accessible.
Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys
Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys
NOTE: This procedure works only if 2 or more programmed ignition keys are available. If 2
programmed keys are not available, refer to Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key
Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and
Alarm Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Integrated Keyhead
Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment.
NOTE: The Instrument Cluster (IC) PID SPAREKEY must be enabled for this procedure to operate.
If this PID is not enabled, refer to Key Programming Switch State Control See: Accessories and
Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and
Relearning/Key Programming Switch State Control, then select SPAREKEY programming switch:
ENABLED. The PID SPAREKEY is set to ENABLE when the vehicle is built.
NOTE: If the programming procedure is successful, the new key(s) starts the vehicle and the
anti-theft indicator proves-out for approximately 3 seconds. If the programming procedure is not
successful and the new key(s) does not start the engine, leave the key in the ON position for at
least 3 seconds, then turn the key off. Repeat the key programming procedure from Step 1. If the
failure repeats, refer to Anti-Theft See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm
Systems/Testing and Inspection in the Diagnosis and Testing portion to review the DTCs and carry
out the appropriate pinpoint tests.
NOTE: A maximum of 8 Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) keys can be programmed into the
Instrument Cluster (IC) during this programming procedure, but only if the PID SPAREKEY is
ENABLED.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Key > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment > Page 4748
NOTE: If the vehicle is in unlimited key mode, this spare key programming procedure still functions.
Any 2 keys that can start the vehicle can be used to program an additional unlimited key.
NOTE: If additional keys are to be programmed, and the remaining keys are with the customer, or
are not available, instruct the customer to refer to the Owner's Literature for instructions on
programming the remaining keys. In this case, the PID SPAREKEY must be enabled.
NOTE: If the steps are not carried out as outlined, the programming procedure ends.
NOTE: Ignition keys must have a correct mechanical key cut for the vehicle and must be
PATS-encoded keys (contain a transponder).
NOTE: This procedure is not necessary if only the PATS transceiver was replaced. Replacement of
the transceiver does not erase the PATS key codes in the IC.
NOTE: When in the unlimited key mode (after the first 2 keys have been programmed to the
vehicle), the N_KEYCODE PID will always read 2, no matter how many keys are programmed to
the vehicle.
1. Insert the first programmed key into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the key from the OFF
position to the ON position (maintain the key in the
ON position for a minimum of 3 seconds and less than 10 seconds).
2. Turn the key to the OFF position and remove the key from the ignition lock cylinder.
3. Within 5 seconds of turning the key to the OFF position, insert the second programmed key into
the ignition lock cylinder and turn the key from
the OFF position to the ON position (maintain the key in the ON position for a minimum of 3
seconds and less than 10 seconds).
4. Turn the key to the OFF position and remove the key from the ignition lock cylinder.
5. Within 10 seconds of turning the key to the OFF position, insert the unprogrammed key (the new
key) into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the
key from the OFF position to the ON position, maintaining the key in the ON position for a minimum
of 6 seconds (the additional 3 second time frame allows for the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) data
transfer to take place, if programming an Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) key).
6. Start the vehicle with the new key(s).
7. If it is desired to program additional key(s) (only up to 8 keys total can be programmed into the
IC), repeat Steps 1-5 for each additional key that
needs to be programmed.
Spare Key Programming - Unlimited Key Mode
Spare Key Programming - Unlimited Key Mode
Enabling Unlimited Key Mode
NOTE: Unlimited key mode is intended for use by those customers who need more than 8 keys for
their vehicle.
NOTE: Before programming, the new key(s) must have the correct mechanical cut for the ignition
lock cylinder(s).
NOTE: The unlimited key mode is set up by creating a special, unique unlimited transponder
security key code and programming this key code into all of the vehicle keys so they contain the
same key code.
NOTE: When in the unlimited key mode (after the first 2 keys have been programmed to the
vehicle), the N_KEYCODE PID will always read 2, no matter how many keys are programmed to
the vehicle.
1. The customer must choose an 8-digit number (except for 00000000 or 00000001) to be
programmed to all of their vehicles keys (or, to all of the
keys they want programmed to one vehicle). All customer vehicles keys (or all keys for one vehicle)
need to use the same number. Valid digits are 0-9 and the letters A-F.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Key > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment > Page 4749
2. NOTE: If the PID UNL_KEY_ID is not available, unlimited key mode is turned on, and must be
turned off before viewing the stored code. At
this time, unlimited keys may be programmed to the vehicle(s). To view/change the stored code,
follow the procedure for disabling the unlimited key mode below.
Monitor the PID UNL_KEY_ID and compare its value against the code chosen in Step 1. It should
not be the same key code.
3. From the scan tool, follow the on-screen instructions to ENTER SECURITY ACCESS. For
additional information, refer to Anti-Theft Security
Access See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics .
4. Once in security access, select: "program unlimited key code" and follow the on-screen
instructions. Enter the 8-digit code chosen by the customer
in Step 1 of this procedure and follow the on-screen instructions.
5. Select: "unlimited key mode ON" and follow the on-screen instructions.
6. Select: "Ignition Key Code Erase" and follow the on-screen instructions.
7. Disconnect the scan tool and turn the ignition key to the OFF position.
8. Insert the first Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) key into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the
key to the ON position for 3 seconds (6 seconds
if it is an Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) key).
9. Turn the first PATS key to the OFF position and remove the key from the ignition lock cylinder.
10. Insert the second PATS key into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the key to the ON position
for 3 seconds (6 seconds if it is an IKT key).
11. The vehicle should now start with both PATS keys.
12. If it is desired to program additional key(s), refer to Key Programming Using Two Programmed
Keys See: Accessories and Optional
Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key
Programming Using Two Programmed Keys for each additional key that needs to be programmed.
Disabling Unlimited Key Mode
NOTE: By disabling the unlimited key mode, the previous access code no longer operates the
vehicle.
1. From the scan tool, follow the on-screen instructions to ENTER SECURITY ACCESS. For
additional information, refer to Anti-Theft Security
Access See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics .
2. Select: "unlimited key mode OFF" and follow the on-screen instructions.
3. Select: "Ignition Key Code Erase" and follow the on-screen instructions.
4. Disconnect the scan tool and turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
5. Insert the first PATS key into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the key to the ON position for 3
seconds (6 seconds if it is an IKT key).
6. Turn the first PATS key to the OFF position and remove the key from the ignition lock cylinder.
7. Insert the second PATS key into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the key to the ON position for
3 seconds (6 seconds if it is an IKT key).
8. NOTE: With the unlimited key mode turned off, a maximum of 8 keys can be programmed into
the Instrument Cluster (IC) using the Key
Programming Using Two Programmed Keys See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft
and Alarm Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key Programming Using
Two Programmed Keys procedure. The IC PID SPAREKEY must be enabled.
If it is desired to program additional key(s), refer to Key Programming Using Two Programmed
Keys See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys for each
additional key (up to 8 keys, total) that needs to be programmed. The IC PID SPAREKEY must be
enabled.
Spare Key Programming - Using Diagnostic Equipment
Spare Key Programming - Using Diagnostic Equipment
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Key > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment > Page 4750
NOTE: This procedure is used when a customer needs to have an additional key programmed into
the vehicle without erasing stored key codes, but does not have 2 programmed keys available. This
procedure is also useful when attempting to determine if an ignition key is damaged, as a new key
can be installed without erasing keys or without having 2 programmed keys available.
NOTE: Before programming, the new key must have the correct mechanical cut for the ignition lock
cylinder.
NOTE: If 8 keys are already programmed, this procedure does not allow any more Passive
Anti-Theft System (PATS) keys to be programmed. The number of keys that are programmed into
the PATS can be determined by viewing the Instrument Cluster (IC) PID N_KEYCODE.
NOTE: When in the unlimited key mode (after the first 2 keys have been programmed to the
vehicle), the N_KEYCODE PID will always read 2, no matter how many keys are programmed to
the vehicle.
1. Turn the unprogrammed PATS key from the OFF position to the ON position.
2. From the scan tool, follow the on-screen instructions to ENTER SECURITY ACCESS. For
additional information, refer to Anti-Theft Security
Access See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics .
3. NOTE: Make sure the selection made is "PROGRAM". If the "ERASE" selection is made, all of
the keys are erased from the system.
From the scan tool menu select: "Program additional ignition key".
4. Turn the key to the OFF position and disconnect the scan tool.
5. Start the vehicle with the new PATS key. The vehicle starts with the new PATS key and also with
the original PATS keys.
Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) Parameter Reset
Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) Parameter Reset
NOTE: When using the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS), the Instrument Cluster (IC) and the
PCM parameters are reset at the same time.
1. Turn the key from the OFF position to the ON position.
2. From the scan tool, follow the on-screen instructions to ENTER SECURITY ACCESS. For
additional information, refer to Anti-Theft Security
Access See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics .
3. From the scan tool, select: Parameter Reset and follow the on-screen instructions.
4. NOTE: If the IC was replaced, follow Steps 4-9. If the IC and the PCM were replaced, follow
Steps 4-9. If only the PCM was replaced, go to Step
9.
From the scan tool, select: Ignition Key Code Erase and follow the on-screen instructions.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Key > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment > Page 4751
5. Turn the key to the OFF position and disconnect the scan tool.
6. Turn the key to the ON position for a minimum of 3 seconds.
7. Turn the key to the OFF position and remove the key.
8. Insert the second key into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the key to the ON position for a
minimum of 3 seconds.
9. Both keys will now start the vehicle.
10. If more keys are required to be programmed, refer to Key Programming Using Two
Programmed Keys See: Accessories and Optional
Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key
Programming Using Two Programmed Keys.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > General Specifications
Starter Motor: Specifications General Specifications
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > General Specifications > Page 4756
Starter Motor: Specifications Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4757
Starter Motor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4758
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4759
Starter Motor: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4760
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4761
Starter Motor: Service and Repair
Starter Motor
Removal
WARNING: Always disconnect the battery ground cable at the battery before disconnecting the
starter motor battery terminal lead. If a tool is shorted at the starter motor battery terminal, the tool
can quickly heat enough to cause a skin burn. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious
personal injury.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
3. Remove the starter terminal cover and remove the nut and the solenoid S-terminal electrical
connection.
4. Remove the nut and the solenoid B-terminal electrical connection.
5. Remove the nut and the starter battery ground cable from the stud.
6. Remove the 2 bolts, the stud bolt and the starter motor.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4762
Installation
1. Position the starter and install the 2 bolts and the stud bolt in 3 stages.
- Stage 1: Install the 2 starter bolts and the stud bolt finger-tight.
- Stage 2: Tighten the upper bolt to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
- Stage 3: Tighten the lower bolt and stud bolt to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
2. Position the starter battery ground cable onto the stud and install the nut.
- Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
3. Connect the solenoid B-terminal electrical connection and install the nut.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
4. Connect the solenoid S-terminal electrical connection and install the nut and the starter terminal
cover.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
5. Connect the battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Starter Relay
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Starter Relay > Page 4767
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Starter Relay
Starter Relay: Testing and Inspection Starter Relay
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Starter Relay > Page 4770
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Starter Relay > Page 4771
Starter Relay: Testing and Inspection Run/Start Relay
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Starter Relay > Page 4772
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Power Point, Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Power Point, Rear > Page 4778
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Power Point, Rear > Page 4779
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Power Point, Rear > Page 4780
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Instrument Panel and Console
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Service and Repair Instrument Panel and Console
Power Point
Removal
NOTE: Power point cover may differ depending on location.
1. Open the power point cover.
2. Install the Power Point Socket Remover in one of the power point socket slots.
3. Position the Power Point Socket Remover so that it engages in the adjacent slot.
4. Using the Power Point Socket Remover, pull the power point socket out of the retainer.
5. Disconnect the electrical connector.
Installation
1. Connect the electrical connector.
2. Slide the power point socket into the retainer.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Instrument Panel and Console > Page 4783
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Service and Repair Interior Trim and Ornamentation
Power Point
Removal
NOTE: Power point cover may differ depending on location.
1. Open the power point cover.
2. Install the Power Point Socket Remover in one of the power point socket slots.
3. Position the Power Point Socket Remover so that it engages in the adjacent slot.
4. Using the Power Point Socket Remover, pull the power point socket out of the retainer.
5. Disconnect the electrical connector.
Installation
1. Connect the electrical connector.
2. Slide the power point socket into the retainer.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Electronic Noise Suppressor >
Component Information > Locations > Ignition Transformer Capacitor 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Electronic Noise Suppressor >
Component Information > Locations > Ignition Transformer Capacitor 1 > Page 4788
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Electronic Noise Suppressor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Ignition Transformer Capacitor 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Electronic Noise Suppressor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Ignition Transformer Capacitor 1 > Page 4791
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4796
Fuse: Locations Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Passenger Compartment Fuse Box
1 - 24
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4797
25 - 48
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4798
Fuse: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4799
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4800
Fuse: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4801
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4802
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4805
Fuse: Application and ID Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Passenger Compartment Fuse Box
1 - 24
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4806
25 - 48
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4807
Fuse: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4808
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4809
Fuse: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4810
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4811
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Fuse Block: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 4816
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 4817
Fuse Block: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 4818
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 4819
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 4820
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 4821
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 4822
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuse Block: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagram in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be
seen completely in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference
is given to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in parentheses next to or under a component.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System, and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4825
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in set 4
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the
indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to
illustrate proper orientation.
Power Distribution
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4826
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
Component and Connector Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4827
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component Location
Charts.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Locations information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the
various items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written
description of the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4828
Symbols (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4829
Symbols (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4830
Symbols (Part 3)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4831
Symbols (Part 4)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4832
Symbols (Part 5)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4833
Fuse Block: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminal by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4834
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal.
Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4835
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4836
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4837
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seat wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4838
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4839
7. If visible, be sure to place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the
barrel. 9. Holding the wire in place, barrel squeeze tool handles appropriate ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4840
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4841
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4842
Fuse Block: Connector Views
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4843
C2280A
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4844
C2280B Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4845
C2280B Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4846
C2280C
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4847
C2280D Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4848
C2280D Part 2
C2280E
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4849
C2280F
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4850
C2280G
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410
Multiple Junction Connector: Diagrams C110-C410
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4855
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4856
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4857
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4858
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4859
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4860
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4861
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4862
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4863
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4864
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4865
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4866
Part 1
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4867
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4868
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4869
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4870
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4871
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4872
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4873
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4874
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4875
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4876
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4877
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4878
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4879
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4880
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4881
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4882
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4883
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4884
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4885
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4886
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4887
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4888
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4889
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4890
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4891
Multiple Junction Connector: Diagrams C411-C4002
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4892
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4893
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4894
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4895
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4896
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4897
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4898
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4899
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4900
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4901
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4902
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4903
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4904
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4905
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4906
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4907
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4908
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4909
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4910
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4911
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4912
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4913
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4914
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4915
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4916
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 4917
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair
Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Removal
NOTICE: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these charges,
damage to the module may result.
NOTE: Prior to the replacement of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to a scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new Smart Junction Box
(SJB) after installation. In the event that As-Built data entry is required (SJB will not communicate),
all Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) devices must be programmed to the new SJB. A minimum of 2
devices are necessary to complete the configuration and turn off the flashing interior lights.
1. NOTE: This step is only necessary if the SJB is being replaced.
NOTE: The Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) functionality is integral to the SJB. A new
SJB is delivered in a "manufacturing mode" with 7 pre-set DTCs. A successful configuration of the
SJB, then a successful TPMS sensor training, then a successful self-test including the clearing of
all DTCs is required in order to clear the 7 pre-set manufacturing mode DTCs. The 7 manufacturing
mode DTCs are: -
B106D (Tire Pressure Monitor System [TPMS] Initiators Not Configured) - This DTC is present
when the SJB is not configured, even on applications that are not equipped with initiators.
- B2477 (Module Configuration Failure)
- B2868 (Left Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2869 (Right Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2870 (Right Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2871 (Left Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- C2780 (ECU in Manufacturer Sub-State)
Upload the module configuration information from the SJB into the scan tool.
2. Disconnect the battery.
3. Remove the RH cowl panel side trim.
4. Remove the glove compartment.
5. Disconnect the 7 electrical connectors.
6. Remove the 2 bolts and the SJB.
Installation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4921
1. Position the SJB and install the 2 bolts.
- Tighten the bolts to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
2. Connect the 7 electrical connectors.
3. Install the RH cowl panel side trim.
4. Install the glove compartment.
5. NOTE: If the SJB is not being replaced, this is the last step that is necessary. Connect the
battery.
6. NOTE: When successful, this step provides the calibration necessary for the SJB operation and
clears the DTCs B106D and B2477. The clearing
of these DTCs indicates the calibration data has been successfully downloaded to the SJB.
NOTE: DTC B2276 may be set, indicating there are less than 2 transmitters programmed to the
SJB.
Download the SJB configuration information from the scan tool to the SJB.
7. NOTE: When successful, this step clears DTCs B2868, B2869, B2870 and B2871. The clearing
of these DTCs indicates the SJB has recognized
the tire pressure sensors during the training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensors.
8. NOTE: DTC C2780 will not clear if any of the pre-set DTCs are still present in the SJB.
Carry out the SJB self-test (must include an on-demand self-test) and then repeat the self-test to
confirm all DTCs have been cleared.
9. Rotate the instrument panel dimmer switch from the full dim position to the dome ON position.
This will make sure that all displays are visible
under all lighting conditions.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Relay - Macro ISO
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO > Page 4927
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO > Page 4928
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Relay - Micro ISO
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO > Page 4929
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO > Page 4930
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Relay - Mini ISO
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO > Page 4931
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO > Page 4932
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair
Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Removal
NOTICE: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these charges,
damage to the module may result.
NOTE: Prior to the replacement of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to a scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new Smart Junction Box
(SJB) after installation. In the event that As-Built data entry is required (SJB will not communicate),
all Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) devices must be programmed to the new SJB. A minimum of 2
devices are necessary to complete the configuration and turn off the flashing interior lights.
1. NOTE: This step is only necessary if the SJB is being replaced.
NOTE: The Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) functionality is integral to the SJB. A new
SJB is delivered in a "manufacturing mode" with 7 pre-set DTCs. A successful configuration of the
SJB, then a successful TPMS sensor training, then a successful self-test including the clearing of
all DTCs is required in order to clear the 7 pre-set manufacturing mode DTCs. The 7 manufacturing
mode DTCs are: -
B106D (Tire Pressure Monitor System [TPMS] Initiators Not Configured) - This DTC is present
when the SJB is not configured, even on applications that are not equipped with initiators.
- B2477 (Module Configuration Failure)
- B2868 (Left Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2869 (Right Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2870 (Right Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2871 (Left Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- C2780 (ECU in Manufacturer Sub-State)
Upload the module configuration information from the SJB into the scan tool.
2. Disconnect the battery.
3. Remove the RH cowl panel side trim.
4. Remove the glove compartment.
5. Disconnect the 7 electrical connectors.
6. Remove the 2 bolts and the SJB.
Installation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4937
1. Position the SJB and install the 2 bolts.
- Tighten the bolts to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
2. Connect the 7 electrical connectors.
3. Install the RH cowl panel side trim.
4. Install the glove compartment.
5. NOTE: If the SJB is not being replaced, this is the last step that is necessary. Connect the
battery.
6. NOTE: When successful, this step provides the calibration necessary for the SJB operation and
clears the DTCs B106D and B2477. The clearing
of these DTCs indicates the calibration data has been successfully downloaded to the SJB.
NOTE: DTC B2276 may be set, indicating there are less than 2 transmitters programmed to the
SJB.
Download the SJB configuration information from the scan tool to the SJB.
7. NOTE: When successful, this step clears DTCs B2868, B2869, B2870 and B2871. The clearing
of these DTCs indicates the SJB has recognized
the tire pressure sensors during the training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensors.
8. NOTE: DTC C2780 will not clear if any of the pre-set DTCs are still present in the SJB.
Carry out the SJB self-test (must include an on-demand self-test) and then repeat the self-test to
confirm all DTCs have been cleared.
9. Rotate the instrument panel dimmer switch from the full dim position to the dome ON position.
This will make sure that all displays are visible
under all lighting conditions.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Relay - Macro ISO
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO >
Page 4943
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO >
Page 4944
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Relay - Micro ISO
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO >
Page 4945
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO >
Page 4946
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Relay - Mini ISO
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO >
Page 4947
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO >
Page 4948
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2
Relay Box: Locations Auxiliary Relay Box 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4953
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4954
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4955
Relay Box: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4956
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4957
Relay Box: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4958
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4959
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4960
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4961
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4962
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 4965
Relay Box: Diagrams Smart Junction Box (SJB)
C2280A
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 4966
C2280B Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 4967
C2280B Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 4968
C2280C
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 4969
C2280D Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 4970
C2280D Part 2
C2280E
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 4971
C2280F
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 4972
C2280G
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4975
Relay Box: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4976
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4977
Relay Box: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4978
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2
Relay Box: Locations Auxiliary Relay Box 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4983
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4984
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4985
Relay Box: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4986
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4987
Relay Box: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4988
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4989
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4990
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4991
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 4992
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 4995
Relay Box: Diagrams Smart Junction Box (SJB)
C2280A
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 4996
C2280B Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 4997
C2280B Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 4998
C2280C
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 4999
C2280D Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 5000
C2280D Part 2
C2280E
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 5001
C2280F
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 5002
C2280G
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 5005
Relay Box: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 5006
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 5007
Relay Box: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 5008
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams >
Power Point, Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams >
Power Point, Rear > Page 5014
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams >
Power Point, Rear > Page 5015
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams >
Power Point, Rear > Page 5016
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Instrument Panel and Console
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Service and Repair Instrument Panel and Console
Power Point
Removal
NOTE: Power point cover may differ depending on location.
1. Open the power point cover.
2. Install the Power Point Socket Remover in one of the power point socket slots.
3. Position the Power Point Socket Remover so that it engages in the adjacent slot.
4. Using the Power Point Socket Remover, pull the power point socket out of the retainer.
5. Disconnect the electrical connector.
Installation
1. Connect the electrical connector.
2. Slide the power point socket into the retainer.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Instrument Panel and Console > Page 5019
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Service and Repair Interior Trim and Ornamentation
Power Point
Removal
NOTE: Power point cover may differ depending on location.
1. Open the power point cover.
2. Install the Power Point Socket Remover in one of the power point socket slots.
3. Position the Power Point Socket Remover so that it engages in the adjacent slot.
4. Using the Power Point Socket Remover, pull the power point socket out of the retainer.
5. Disconnect the electrical connector.
Installation
1. Connect the electrical connector.
2. Slide the power point socket into the retainer.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Electronic Noise Suppressor > Component Information >
Locations > Ignition Transformer Capacitor 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Electronic Noise Suppressor > Component Information >
Locations > Ignition Transformer Capacitor 1 > Page 5024
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Electronic Noise Suppressor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Ignition Transformer Capacitor 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Electronic Noise Suppressor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Ignition Transformer Capacitor 1 > Page 5027
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay
Box 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay
Box 2 > Page 5032
Fuse: Locations Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Passenger Compartment Fuse Box
1 - 24
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay
Box 2 > Page 5033
25 - 48
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay
Box 2 > Page 5034
Fuse: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay
Box 2 > Page 5035
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay
Box 2 > Page 5036
Fuse: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay
Box 2 > Page 5037
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay
Box 2 > Page 5038
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary
Relay Box 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary
Relay Box 2 > Page 5041
Fuse: Application and ID Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Passenger Compartment Fuse Box
1 - 24
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary
Relay Box 2 > Page 5042
25 - 48
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary
Relay Box 2 > Page 5043
Fuse: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary
Relay Box 2 > Page 5044
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary
Relay Box 2 > Page 5045
Fuse: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary
Relay Box 2 > Page 5046
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary
Relay Box 2 > Page 5047
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Battery
Junction Box (BJB)
Fuse Block: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) > Page 5052
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) > Page 5053
Fuse Block: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) > Page 5054
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) > Page 5055
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) > Page 5056
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) > Page 5057
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) > Page 5058
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Fuse Block: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagram in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be
seen completely in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference
is given to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in parentheses next to or under a component.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System, and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5061
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in set 4
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the
indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to
illustrate proper orientation.
Power Distribution
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5062
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
Component and Connector Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5063
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component Location
Charts.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Locations information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the
various items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written
description of the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5064
Symbols (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5065
Symbols (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5066
Symbols (Part 3)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5067
Symbols (Part 4)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5068
Symbols (Part 5)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5069
Fuse Block: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminal by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5070
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal.
Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5071
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5072
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5073
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seat wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5074
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5075
7. If visible, be sure to place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the
barrel. 9. Holding the wire in place, barrel squeeze tool handles appropriate ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5076
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5077
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5078
Fuse Block: Connector Views
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5079
C2280A
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5080
C2280B Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5081
C2280B Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5082
C2280C
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5083
C2280D Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5084
C2280D Part 2
C2280E
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5085
C2280F
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5086
C2280G
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410
Multiple Junction Connector: Diagrams C110-C410
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5091
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5092
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5093
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5094
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5095
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5096
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5097
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5098
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5099
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5100
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5101
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5102
Part 1
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5103
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5104
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5105
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5106
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5107
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5108
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5109
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5110
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5111
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5112
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5113
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5114
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5115
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5116
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5117
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5118
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5119
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5120
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5121
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5122
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5123
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5124
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5125
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5126
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5127
Multiple Junction Connector: Diagrams C411-C4002
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5128
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5129
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5130
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5131
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5132
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5133
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5134
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5135
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5136
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5137
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5138
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5139
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5140
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5141
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5142
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5143
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5144
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5145
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5146
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5147
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5148
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5149
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5150
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5151
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5152
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C110-C410 > Page 5153
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair
Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Removal
NOTICE: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these charges,
damage to the module may result.
NOTE: Prior to the replacement of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to a scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new Smart Junction Box
(SJB) after installation. In the event that As-Built data entry is required (SJB will not communicate),
all Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) devices must be programmed to the new SJB. A minimum of 2
devices are necessary to complete the configuration and turn off the flashing interior lights.
1. NOTE: This step is only necessary if the SJB is being replaced.
NOTE: The Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) functionality is integral to the SJB. A new
SJB is delivered in a "manufacturing mode" with 7 pre-set DTCs. A successful configuration of the
SJB, then a successful TPMS sensor training, then a successful self-test including the clearing of
all DTCs is required in order to clear the 7 pre-set manufacturing mode DTCs. The 7 manufacturing
mode DTCs are: -
B106D (Tire Pressure Monitor System [TPMS] Initiators Not Configured) - This DTC is present
when the SJB is not configured, even on applications that are not equipped with initiators.
- B2477 (Module Configuration Failure)
- B2868 (Left Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2869 (Right Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2870 (Right Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2871 (Left Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- C2780 (ECU in Manufacturer Sub-State)
Upload the module configuration information from the SJB into the scan tool.
2. Disconnect the battery.
3. Remove the RH cowl panel side trim.
4. Remove the glove compartment.
5. Disconnect the 7 electrical connectors.
6. Remove the 2 bolts and the SJB.
Installation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Page 5157
1. Position the SJB and install the 2 bolts.
- Tighten the bolts to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
2. Connect the 7 electrical connectors.
3. Install the RH cowl panel side trim.
4. Install the glove compartment.
5. NOTE: If the SJB is not being replaced, this is the last step that is necessary. Connect the
battery.
6. NOTE: When successful, this step provides the calibration necessary for the SJB operation and
clears the DTCs B106D and B2477. The clearing
of these DTCs indicates the calibration data has been successfully downloaded to the SJB.
NOTE: DTC B2276 may be set, indicating there are less than 2 transmitters programmed to the
SJB.
Download the SJB configuration information from the scan tool to the SJB.
7. NOTE: When successful, this step clears DTCs B2868, B2869, B2870 and B2871. The clearing
of these DTCs indicates the SJB has recognized
the tire pressure sensors during the training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensors.
8. NOTE: DTC C2780 will not clear if any of the pre-set DTCs are still present in the SJB.
Carry out the SJB self-test (must include an on-demand self-test) and then repeat the self-test to
confirm all DTCs have been cleared.
9. Rotate the instrument panel dimmer switch from the full dim position to the dome ON position.
This will make sure that all displays are visible
under all lighting conditions.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Relay - Macro ISO
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO > Page 5163
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO > Page 5164
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Relay - Micro ISO
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO > Page 5165
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO > Page 5166
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Relay - Mini ISO
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO > Page 5167
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO > Page 5168
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair
Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Removal
NOTICE: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these charges,
damage to the module may result.
NOTE: Prior to the replacement of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to a scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new Smart Junction Box
(SJB) after installation. In the event that As-Built data entry is required (SJB will not communicate),
all Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) devices must be programmed to the new SJB. A minimum of 2
devices are necessary to complete the configuration and turn off the flashing interior lights.
1. NOTE: This step is only necessary if the SJB is being replaced.
NOTE: The Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) functionality is integral to the SJB. A new
SJB is delivered in a "manufacturing mode" with 7 pre-set DTCs. A successful configuration of the
SJB, then a successful TPMS sensor training, then a successful self-test including the clearing of
all DTCs is required in order to clear the 7 pre-set manufacturing mode DTCs. The 7 manufacturing
mode DTCs are: -
B106D (Tire Pressure Monitor System [TPMS] Initiators Not Configured) - This DTC is present
when the SJB is not configured, even on applications that are not equipped with initiators.
- B2477 (Module Configuration Failure)
- B2868 (Left Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2869 (Right Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2870 (Right Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2871 (Left Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- C2780 (ECU in Manufacturer Sub-State)
Upload the module configuration information from the SJB into the scan tool.
2. Disconnect the battery.
3. Remove the RH cowl panel side trim.
4. Remove the glove compartment.
5. Disconnect the 7 electrical connectors.
6. Remove the 2 bolts and the SJB.
Installation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5173
1. Position the SJB and install the 2 bolts.
- Tighten the bolts to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
2. Connect the 7 electrical connectors.
3. Install the RH cowl panel side trim.
4. Install the glove compartment.
5. NOTE: If the SJB is not being replaced, this is the last step that is necessary. Connect the
battery.
6. NOTE: When successful, this step provides the calibration necessary for the SJB operation and
clears the DTCs B106D and B2477. The clearing
of these DTCs indicates the calibration data has been successfully downloaded to the SJB.
NOTE: DTC B2276 may be set, indicating there are less than 2 transmitters programmed to the
SJB.
Download the SJB configuration information from the scan tool to the SJB.
7. NOTE: When successful, this step clears DTCs B2868, B2869, B2870 and B2871. The clearing
of these DTCs indicates the SJB has recognized
the tire pressure sensors during the training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensors.
8. NOTE: DTC C2780 will not clear if any of the pre-set DTCs are still present in the SJB.
Carry out the SJB self-test (must include an on-demand self-test) and then repeat the self-test to
confirm all DTCs have been cleared.
9. Rotate the instrument panel dimmer switch from the full dim position to the dome ON position.
This will make sure that all displays are visible
under all lighting conditions.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Relay - Macro ISO
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO > Page 5179
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO > Page 5180
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Relay - Micro ISO
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO > Page 5181
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO > Page 5182
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Relay - Mini ISO
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO > Page 5183
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Relay - Macro ISO > Page 5184
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2
Relay Box: Locations Auxiliary Relay Box 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 5189
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 5190
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 5191
Relay Box: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 5192
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 5193
Relay Box: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 5194
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 5195
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 5196
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 5197
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 5198
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 5201
Relay Box: Diagrams Smart Junction Box (SJB)
C2280A
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 5202
C2280B Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 5203
C2280B Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 5204
C2280C
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 5205
C2280D Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 5206
C2280D Part 2
C2280E
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 5207
C2280F
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 5208
C2280G
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 5211
Relay Box: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 5212
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 5213
Relay Box: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 5214
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 2
Relay Box: Locations Auxiliary Relay Box 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 2 > Page 5219
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 2 > Page 5220
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 2 > Page 5221
Relay Box: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 2 > Page 5222
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 2 > Page 5223
Relay Box: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 2 > Page 5224
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 2 > Page 5225
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 2 > Page 5226
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 2 > Page 5227
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 2 > Page 5228
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery
Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) > Page 5231
Relay Box: Diagrams Smart Junction Box (SJB)
C2280A
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) > Page 5232
C2280B Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) > Page 5233
C2280B Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) > Page 5234
C2280C
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) > Page 5235
C2280D Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) > Page 5236
C2280D Part 2
C2280E
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) > Page 5237
C2280F
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) > Page 5238
C2280G
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Auxiliary Relay Box 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 5241
Relay Box: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 5242
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 5243
Relay Box: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Auxiliary Relay Box 2 > Page 5244
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications
Alignment: Specifications Alignment Specifications
Alignment Specifications Vehicles With Rear Coil Spring Suspension
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications > Page 5250
Alignment Specifications Vehicles With Rear Air Suspension
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications > Page 5251
Alignment: Specifications Ball Joint Deflection, Ride Height, and Vehicle Lean
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications > Page 5252
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications > Page 5253
Alignment: Specifications Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation >
Camber
Alignment: Description and Operation Camber
Wheel Alignment Angles
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie rods. The rear camber is adjusted by removing the upper arm
camber set shim or shim pins to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slot. The rear toe is
adjusted by the use of the rear toe link cam bolt and nut.
Camber
Negative and Positive Camber
Camber is the vertical tilt of the wheel when viewed from the front. Camber can be positive or
negative and has a direct affect on tire wear.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation >
Camber > Page 5256
Alignment: Description and Operation Caster
Wheel Alignment Angles
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie rods. The rear camber is adjusted by removing the upper arm
camber set shim or shim pins to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slot. The rear toe is
adjusted by the use of the rear toe link cam bolt and nut.
Caster
Caster is the deviation from vertical of an imaginary line drawn through the ball joints when viewed
from the side. The caster specifications will give the vehicle the best directional stability
characteristics when loaded and driven. The caster setting does not affect tire wear.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation >
Camber > Page 5257
Alignment: Description and Operation Drift/Pull
Wheel Alignment Angles
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie rods. The rear camber is adjusted by removing the upper arm
camber set shim or shim pins to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slot. The rear toe is
adjusted by the use of the rear toe link cam bolt and nut.
Drift/Pull
Pull is a tugging sensation, felt by the hands on the steering wheel, that must be overcome to keep
the vehicle going straight.
Drift describes what a vehicle with this condition does with hands off the steering wheel.
- A vehicle-related drift/pull, on a flat road, will cause a consistent deviation from the straight-ahead
path and require constant steering input in the opposite direction to counteract the effect.
- Drift/pull may be induced by conditions external to the vehicle (such as wind or road camber).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation >
Camber > Page 5258
Alignment: Description and Operation Nibble
Wheel Alignment Angles
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie rods. The rear camber is adjusted by removing the upper arm
camber set shim or shim pins to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slot. The rear toe is
adjusted by the use of the rear toe link cam bolt and nut.
Nibble
Sometimes confused with shimmy, nibble is a condition resulting from tire interaction with various
road surfaces or tire imbalance. This condition is observed by the driver as small rotational
oscillations of the steering wheel.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation >
Camber > Page 5259
Alignment: Description and Operation
Camber
Wheel Alignment Angles
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie rods. The rear camber is adjusted by removing the upper arm
camber set shim or shim pins to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slot. The rear toe is
adjusted by the use of the rear toe link cam bolt and nut.
Camber
Negative and Positive Camber
Camber is the vertical tilt of the wheel when viewed from the front. Camber can be positive or
negative and has a direct affect on tire wear.
Caster
Wheel Alignment Angles
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie rods. The rear camber is adjusted by removing the upper arm
camber set shim or shim pins to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slot. The rear toe is
adjusted by the use of the rear toe link cam bolt and nut.
Caster
Caster is the deviation from vertical of an imaginary line drawn through the ball joints when viewed
from the side. The caster specifications will give the vehicle the best directional stability
characteristics when loaded and driven. The caster setting does not affect tire wear.
Drift/Pull
Wheel Alignment Angles
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie rods. The rear camber is adjusted by removing the upper arm
camber set shim or shim pins to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slot. The rear toe is
adjusted by the use of the rear toe link cam bolt and nut.
Drift/Pull
Pull is a tugging sensation, felt by the hands on the steering wheel, that must be overcome to keep
the vehicle going straight.
Drift describes what a vehicle with this condition does with hands off the steering wheel.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation >
Camber > Page 5260
- A vehicle-related drift/pull, on a flat road, will cause a consistent deviation from the straight-ahead
path and require constant steering input in the opposite direction to counteract the effect.
- Drift/pull may be induced by conditions external to the vehicle (such as wind or road camber).
Nibble
Wheel Alignment Angles
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie rods. The rear camber is adjusted by removing the upper arm
camber set shim or shim pins to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slot. The rear toe is
adjusted by the use of the rear toe link cam bolt and nut.
Nibble
Sometimes confused with shimmy, nibble is a condition resulting from tire interaction with various
road surfaces or tire imbalance. This condition is observed by the driver as small rotational
oscillations of the steering wheel.
Poor Groove Feel
Wheel Alignment Angles
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie rods. The rear camber is adjusted by removing the upper arm
camber set shim or shim pins to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slot. The rear toe is
adjusted by the use of the rear toe link cam bolt and nut.
Poor Groove Feel
Poor groove feel is characterized by little or no buildup of turning effort felt in the steering wheel as
the wheel is rocked slowly left and right within very small turns around center or straight-ahead
(under 20 degrees of steering wheel turn). Efforts may be said to be "flat on center."
- Under 20 degrees of turn, most of the turning effort that builds up comes from the mesh of gear
teeth in the steering gear. In this range, the steering wheel is not yet turned enough to feel the
effort from the self-aligning forces at the road wheel or tire patch.
- In the diagnosis of a steering or alignment concern, it is important to understand the difference
between wander and poor groove feel.
Poor Returnability/Sticky Steering
Wheel Alignment Angles
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie rods. The rear camber is adjusted by removing the upper arm
camber set shim or shim pins to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slot. The rear toe is
adjusted by the use of the rear toe link cam bolt and nut.
Poor Returnability/Sticky Steering
Poor returnability and sticky steering is used to describe the poor return of the steering wheel to
center after a turn or when the steering correction is completed.
Shimmy
Wheel Alignment Angles
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie rods. The rear camber is adjusted by removing the upper arm
camber set shim or shim pins to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slot. The rear toe is
adjusted by the use of the rear toe link cam bolt and nut.
Shimmy
Shimmy, as observed by the driver, is large, consistent, rotational oscillations of the steering wheel
resulting from large, side-to-side (lateral) tire/wheel movements.
Shimmy is usually experienced near 64 km/h (40 mph), and can begin or be amplified when the tire
contacts pot holes or irregularities in the road surface.
Toe
Wheel Alignment Angles
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation >
Camber > Page 5261
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie rods. The rear camber is adjusted by removing the upper arm
camber set shim or shim pins to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slot. The rear toe is
adjusted by the use of the rear toe link cam bolt and nut.
Toe
Positive Toe (Toe In)
Negative Toe (Toe Out)
The vehicle toe setting:
- affects tire wear and directional stability.
- must be checked after adding aftermarket equipment, such as a snowplow.
Wander
Wheel Alignment Angles
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie rods. The rear camber is adjusted by removing the upper arm
camber set shim or shim pins to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slot. The rear toe is
adjusted by the use of the rear toe link cam bolt and nut.
Wander
Wander is the tendency of the vehicle to require frequent, random left and right steering wheel
corrections to maintain a straight path down a level road.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Ride Height
Measurement
Alignment: Service and Repair Ride Height Measurement
Ride Height Measurement
Front Ride Height Measurement
NOTE: Make sure that the vehicle is positioned on a flat, level surface and the tires are inflated to
the correct pressure. Vehicle should have a full tank of fuel.
1. Position a suitable surface gauge (such as Starrett 57D Surface Gauge), on a flat, level surface
and adjust the gauge's arm until the scriber point is
located in the center of the lower arm rearward bolt. Lock the surface gauge in this position.
2. With the surface gauge positioned on a flat, level surface, record the measurement of the
surface gauge position (measurement 2).
3. Position the surface gauge on the same flat, level surface as used in Step 1, adjust the gauge's
arm until the scriber point is located on the lower
surface of the wheel knuckle near the ball joint. Lock the surface gauge in this position.
4. With the surface gauge positioned on a flat, level surface, record the measurement of the
surface gauge position (measurement 3).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Ride Height
Measurement > Page 5264
5. Subtract measurement 3 from measurement 2 to obtain the front ride height.
- For additional information, refer to Specifications.
Rear Ride Height Measurement
NOTE: Make sure that the vehicle is positioned on a flat, level surface and the tires are inflated to
the correct pressure. Vehicle should have a full tank of fuel.
1. Measure the distance between the flat level surface and the center of the lower arm rearward
bolt (measurement 2).
2. Measure the distance between the flat level surface and the center of the shock absorber lower
bolt (rearward side) (measurement 3).
3. Subtract measurement 3 from measurement 2 to obtain the rear ride height.
- For additional information, refer to Specifications.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Ride Height
Measurement > Page 5265
Alignment: Service and Repair Camber And Caster Adjustment - Front
Camber and Caster Adjustment - Front
NOTICE: Do not remove the stabilizer bar brackets until the stabilizer links have been
disconnected or damage to the stabilizer bar links may occur.
NOTE: Air suspension vehicles must be at trim ride height prior to measuring or adjusting the
caster, camber or toe.
NOTE: To allow for adjustment of the lower arm in the frame slots, the lower arm bolts and nuts
must be removed and discarded. They are replaced with cam bolt kit 3C333. The vehicle should be
supported by the frame to ease movement of the lower arm in the slot.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturers instructions, measure the front caster and
camber.
- Refer to Alignment Specifications in the Specifications portion for optimal alignment settings.
- If the caster and camber values are not within specification, go to the next step.
2. Remove and discard the lower arm front and rear nuts and bolts.
3. NOTICE: Do not hold the stabilizer link boot with any tool, as damage to the boot will occur.
NOTE: Use the hex-holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while removing the nuts.
Remove and discard the stabilizer bar link lower nuts.
4. Remove the 4 stabilizer bar bracket nuts, 2 stabilizer bar brackets and position the stabilizer bar
aside.
5. Remove the stabilizer bar bracket bolts and plate assembly.
6. Install the front cam bolt kit and loosely install the nut.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Ride Height
Measurement > Page 5266
7. Install the rear cam bolt kit and loosely install the nut.
8. To adjust the caster and camber, refer to the following chart.
- Adjustments that require moving the front and the rear of the lower arm should be made equally.
9. With the weight of the vehicle resting on the wheel and tire assemblies, hold the front cam bolt
and tighten the nut to 350 Nm (258 lb-ft).
10. With the weight of the vehicle resting on the wheel and tire assemblies, hold the rear cam bolt
and tighten the nut to 350 Nm (258 lb-ft).
11. Install the 2 stabilizer bar bracket bolts and plate assembly.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Ride Height
Measurement > Page 5267
12. Position the stabilizer bar, install the 2 stabilizer bar brackets and the 4 stabilizer bar bracket
nuts.
- Tighten the nuts to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
13. NOTICE: Do not hold the stabilizer link boot with any tool, as damage to the boot will occur.
NOTE: Use the hex-holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while installing the nuts.
Install the 2 stabilizer bar link lower nuts.
- Tighten the nuts to 80 Nm (59 lb-ft).
14. Check and, if necessary, adjust the front toe. For additional information, refer to Toe
Adjustment - Front See: Toe Adjustment - Front.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Ride Height
Measurement > Page 5268
Alignment: Service and Repair Toe Adjustment - Front
Toe Adjustment - Front
NOTE: Air suspension vehicles must be at trim ride height prior to measuring or adjusting the
caster, camber or toe.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturer's instructions, measure the front toe.
- Refer to Alignment Specifications in the Specifications portion for optimal alignment settings.
- If the front toe values are not within specification, go to the next step.
2. Start the engine and center the steering wheel.
3. Turn the engine off and, using a suitable steering wheel holding device, lock the steering wheel
in the straight-ahead position.
4. Remove the steering gear bellows clamp(s).
5. Loosen the tie-rod end jam nut(s).
6. NOTE: Do not allow the steering gear bellows to twist while rotating the tie rod.
Rotate the tie rod(s) to achieve the desired toe setting.
7. NOTICE: Make sure to hold the tie-rod end stationary while tightening the jam nut or damage to
the boot may occur.
NOTE: Make sure that the toe settings are not disturbed while tightening the jam nuts.
Tighten the tie-rod end jam nut(s) to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
8. Install the steering gear bellows clamp(s).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Ride Height
Measurement > Page 5269
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Ride Height
Measurement > Page 5270
Alignment: Service and Repair Toe Adjustment - Rear
Toe Adjustment - Rear
NOTE: Air suspension vehicles must be at trim ride height prior to measuring or adjusting the rear
toe.
NOTE: Before carrying out a toe adjustment, check the tires for the correct pressure. Inspect the
tires for incorrect wear or damage. Inspect the suspension for wear or damage.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturer's instructions, measure the rear toe.
- Refer to Alignment Specifications in the Specifications portion for optimal alignment settings.
- If the rear toe values are not within specification, go to the next step.
2. Loosen the toe link cam bolt nut(s).
3. Rotate the toe link cam bolt(s) until the toe setting is within specification.
4. NOTE: Make sure the toe settings are not disturbed while tightening the cam nut(s).
Tighten the toe link cam bolt nut(s) to 275 Nm (203 lb-ft).
5. Recheck the rear toe setting, adjust as necessary.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Ride Height
Measurement > Page 5271
Alignment: Service and Repair Camber Adjustment - Rear
Camber Adjustment - Rear
NOTE: Air suspension vehicles must be at trim ride height prior to measuring or adjusting the rear
camber or toe.
NOTE: Before carrying out a camber adjustment, check the tires for the correct pressure. Inspect
the tires for incorrect wear or damage. Inspect the suspension for wear or damage.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturer's instructions, measure the rear camber.
- Refer to Alignment Specifications in the Specifications portion for optimal alignment settings.
- If the rear camber value is not within specification, go to the next step.
2. Remove the upper arm-to-frame bolt and the camber set shim.
- Discard the camber set shim.
- Install and snug the upper arm-to frame bolt.
3. Position the upper arm-to-frame bolt in the upper arm-to-frame slot until the camber setting is
within specification.
4. NOTE: Do not allow the upper arm to move and change the camber adjustment setting when
tightening the bolt.
Tighten the upper arm-to-frame bolt to 225 Nm (166 lb-ft).
5. Recheck the camber setting, adjust as necessary.
6. Check and, if necessary, adjust the rear toe. For additional information, refer to Toe Adjustment Rear See: Toe Adjustment - Rear.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Suspension > Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Suspension > Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Suspension Control Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Suspension > Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 5280
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Suspension > Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 5281
Suspension Control Module: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Suspension > Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 5282
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Suspension > Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 5283
Suspension Control Module: Service and Repair
Vehicle Dynamics Module (VDM)
Removal and Installation
NOTICE: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these charges,
damage may result.
1. NOTE: The Vehicle Dynamics Module (VDM) is mounted to the lower left side of the dash above
the parking brake control.
Disconnect the 2 VDM electrical connectors.
2. Remove the VDM bracket nuts and the module.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
3. NOTE: The VDM is calibrated with information from the ride height sensors. A new or exchanged
VDM requires that the LH and RH ride height
sensors are calibrated and a Pneumatic Test is carried out. For additional information, refer to
Vehicle Dynamic Suspension See: Suspension/Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic
)/Testing and Inspection Calibration Initialize System - Clear C1990 and C1991 DTCs.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 5289
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 5290
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Power
Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Switch
Engine Control Components
Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
The PSP switch monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP switch
is a normally closed switch that opens as the hydraulic pressure increases. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the PSP circuit. When the PSP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The PCM uses the input signal from the PSP switch to compensate
for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the idle RPM and preventing engine stall during
parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP switch signals the PCM to adjust the transmission EPC
pressure during increased engine load, for example during parking maneuvers.
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Power
Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch > Page 5293
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Sensor
Engine Control Components
Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
The PSP sensor monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP
sensor voltage input to the PCM changes as the hydraulic pressure changes. The PCM uses the
input signal from the PSP sensor to compensate for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the
idle RPM and preventing engine stall during parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP sensor signals the
PCM to adjust the transmission EPC pressure during increased engine load, for example, during
parking maneuvers.
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Steering Angle Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5297
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5298
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Telescoping Wheel Switch > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Telescoping Wheel Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 5302
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Tilt Wheel Switch > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Tilt Wheel Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 5306
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Ride Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Service and Repair
Ride Height Sensor: Service and Repair
Suspension Height Sensor
LH Side
RH Side
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Ride Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page
5311
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Disconnect the height sensor harness from the sensor bracket.
3. Disconnect the height sensor electrical connector.
4. Disconnect the height sensor arm from the ball stud on the lower control arm.
5. Remove and discard the 2 height sensor bolts.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
6. NOTE: The RH and LH height sensor assemblies cannot be used on opposite sides of the
vehicle.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
7. Calibrate the LH and RH height sensors. For additional information, refer to Ride Height
Adjustments See: Suspension/Suspension Control (
Automatic - Electronic )/Service and Repair/Ride Height Adjustments.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Steering Angle Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5315
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5316
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Training
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training
NOTE: If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, the sensors will go into a "sleep
mode" to conserve battery power. It will be necessary to wake them up so they will transmit the
latest tire pressure information to the Smart Junction Box (SJB). For additional information, refer to
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Activation See: Wheels and Tires/Tire Monitoring
System/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning.
NOTE: The tire pressure sensor training procedure must be done on a single vehicle, in an area
without radio frequency noise and at least 1 m (3 ft) away from other vehicles equipped with a Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS). Radio frequency noise is generated by electrical motors and
appliance operation, cellular telephones, remote transmitters, power inverters and portable
entertainment equipment.
NOTE: If a sensor does not respond to the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool, attempt to
activate the same sensor with the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. If the sensor still does not
respond, move the vehicle to rotate the wheels at least one-fourth of a turn and attempt to activate
the same sensor again.
NOTE: The SJB has a 2-minute time limit between sensor responses. If the SJB does not
recognize any 1 of the 4 tire pressure sensors during this time limit, the horn will sound twice and
the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE NOT TRAINED REPEAT and the entire
procedure must be repeated.
NOTE: For vehicles with different front and rear tire pressures (such as the E-Series and certain
F-Series), the tire pressure sensors must be trained following a tire rotation. Failure to train the
sensors will cause the TPMS indicator to illuminate. For vehicles with the same tire pressure for
front and rear tires, tire rotation will not affect the system.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position, then press and release the brake pedal.
2. Cycle the ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN
position.
3. Press and release the brake pedal.
4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
5. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN
position.
- The horn will sound once and the TPMS indicator will flash if the training mode has been entered
successfully. If equipped, the message center will display TRAIN LF TIRE.
6. NOTE: It may take up to 6 seconds to activate a tire pressure sensor. During this time, the Tire
Pressure Monitor Activation Tool must remain in
place 180 degrees from the valve stem.
Place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the LF tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees) from
the valve stem. Press and release the test button on the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. The
horn will sound briefly to indicate that the tire pressure sensor has been recognized by the SJB.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training > Page 5322
7. Within 2 minutes of the horn sounding, place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the RF
tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees) from the
valve stem and press and release the test button to train the RF tire pressure sensor.
8. NOTE: Do not wait more than 2 minutes between training each sensor or the SJB will time out
and the entire procedure must be repeated.
Repeat Step 7 for the RR and LR tires.
The procedure is completed after the last tire has been trained. When the training procedure is
complete, the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE TRAINING COMPLETE.
For vehicles not equipped with a message center, successful completion of the training procedure
will be verified by turning the ignition switch to the OFF position without the horn sounding. If the
horn sounds twice when the switch is turned to the OFF position, the training procedure was not
successful.
9. Using the scan tool, locate the updated TPMS sensor identifiers trained to the SJB and
document them on the applicable warranty claim.
10. NOTE: This step is required to clear DTC C2780, cause the SJB to exit the manufacturing
mode and to make sure there are no other concerns
with a newly programmed SJB.
If the sensors are being trained due to the installation of a new SJB, clear any DTCs and carry out
the SJB On-Demand Self Test.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training > Page 5323
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Activation
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Activation
NOTE: The tire pressure sensors will go into a "sleep mode" after 30 minutes of inactivity to
conserve battery power. The sensors do not transmit information while in sleep mode. It will be
necessary to wake them up so they will transmit the latest tire pressure information.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
2. Position the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool against the LF tire sidewall, 180 degrees from
the tire valve stem.
3. NOTE: The Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool will provide feedback in the form of a flashing
green light and a beep sound for each
successful response from a tire pressure sensor.
Press the test button on the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool to activate the sensor, activate
the sensor at least 2 times.
4. Repeat Steps 2 and 3 for the remaining tires.
5. If the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) indicator remains illuminated after adjusting and
activating each sensor, refer to the Symptom
Chart in Diagnosis and Testing. See: Wheels and Tires/Tire Monitoring System/Testing and
Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Disassembly
WARNING: The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) sensor battery may release hazardous
chemicals if exposed to extreme mechanical damage. If these chemicals contact the skin or eyes,
flush immediately with water for a minimum of 15 minutes and get prompt medical attention. If any
part of the battery is swallowed, contact a physician immediately. When disposing of TPMS
sensors, follow the correct procedures for hazardous material disposal. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in serious personal injury.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application. When
installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color of the
sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor can be removed and installed without removing the strap or the cradle.
1. NOTICE: The sensor, cradle and strap may be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Dismount the tire only as instructed.
Remove the tire from the wheel. For additional information, refer to Wheel and Tire See: Wheels
and Tires/Service and Repair/Overhaul.
2. NOTICE: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to the
sensor locking clip may occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver or similar tool, remove the sensor locking clip.
3. NOTICE: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to the
sensor may occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver or similar tool, detach the sensor from the cradle.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 5326
4. Remove the sensor.
Assembly
1. NOTICE: Damage to the sensor may occur if excessive force is applied during sensor
installation.
NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the cradle. The sensor will make a "click" noise
when correctly seated.
Position the sensor into the cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end of the
cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. NOTE: The locking clip can only be fully seated when installed in the correct orientation. If the
sensor locking clip cannot be fully inserted, then
the sensor may not be fully seated on the cradle or the locking clip may be inserted backward.
Insert a new locking clip into the sensor.
3. NOTICE: The sensor, cradle and strap may be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel. For additional information, refer to Wheel and Tire See: Wheels and
Tires/Service and Repair/Overhaul.
4. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s). For additional information, refer to Tire Pressure Monitoring
System (TPMS) Sensor Training See: Wheels and Tires/Tire Monitoring System/Testing and
Inspection/Monitors, Trips, Drive Cycles and Readiness Codes.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 5327
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and
Cradle
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and Cradle
Disassembly
WARNING: The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) sensor battery may release hazardous
chemicals if exposed to extreme mechanical damage. If these chemicals contact the skin or eyes,
flush immediately with water for a minimum of 15 minutes and get prompt medical attention. If any
part of the battery is swallowed, contact a physician immediately. When disposing of TPMS
sensors, follow the correct procedures for hazardous material disposal. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in serious personal injury.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application. When
installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color of the
sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor is available separately, the cradle and strap are available as a strap kit. There
are several different strap kits available based on wheel diameter, but all strap kits share the same
base part number.
1. Remove the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) sensor. For additional information, refer to
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Sensor See: Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor.
2. WARNING: Always wear eye protection when servicing a vehicle. Failure to follow this
instruction may result in serious personal injury.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 5328
WARNING: Wear protective gloves when handling components or parts that have pointed or sharp
edges. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
Remove a factory-installed strap in the following sequence:
1. Locate the strap buckle and secure the strap to the wheel using duct tape or a similar item on
both sides of the buckle, approximately 25 mm
(0.98 in) from the buckle.
2. Using a large screwdriver and a twisting motion, unbuckle the strap.
3. Discard the strap.
3. To remove a dealer-installed strap, turn the worm gear screw until the strap is fully released from
the worm gear.
- Discard the strap.
4. NOTE: To aid assembly, mark the location of the cradle prior to disassembly.
Using a screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the cradle by inserting the screwdriver under the cradle
and prying up.
Assembly
1. NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the new cradle. The sensor will make a "click"
noise when fully seated.
Position the sensor into the new cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end
of the cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. NOTICE: Metal scrapers may damage the wheel. Use only plastic or non-metallic scrapers to
remove the cradle adhesive strip residue.
NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be installed in the drop well of the wheel, 180 degrees from the
valve stem.
Using wheel and tire cleaner, clean the area where the sensor and cradle are to be installed.
3. NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be positioned with the hinge side of the sensor on the RH
side when viewed from the curb side (beauty side)
of the wheel.
NOTE: The sensor has raised markings indicating how to position the sensor.
Remove the adhesive tape liner from the cradle and position the sensor and cradle into the wheel
drop well 180 degrees from the valve stem.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 5329
4. Install the tapered end of the strap through the opening of the cradle on the hinge side of the
sensor. This will position the worm gear on the
locking clip side of the sensor.
5. NOTICE: Steel wheels have a "high spot" along their circumference. Make sure the strap and
sensor are mounted at the lowest spot
possible to avoid damaging the sensor during wheel and tire disassembly and assembly.
NOTE: Keep the strap parallel with the wheel flange while tightening the worm gear.
Position the worm gear 13-26 mm (0.5-1.0 in) away from the sensor and tighten the worm gear.
- Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
6. NOTICE: The sensor, cradle and strap may be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel. For additional information, refer to Wheel and Tire See: Wheels and
Tires/Service and Repair/Overhaul.
7. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s). For additional information, refer to Tire Pressure Monitoring
System (TPMS) Sensor Training See: Wheels and Tires/Tire Monitoring System/Testing and
Inspection/Monitors, Trips, Drive Cycles and Readiness Codes.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Front Steering Knuckle: Service and Repair
Wheel Knuckle
Removal
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be
installed with the same part numbers or equivalent parts, if replacement is necessary. Do not use a
replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified
during reassembly to make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the wheel bearing and wheel hub. For additional information, refer to Wheel Bearing
and Wheel Hub See: Suspension/Wheel
Bearing/Service and Repair/Front Suspension.
2. Remove and discard the tie-rod end nut.
3. Using the Ball Joint Separator, separate the tie-rod end from the wheel knuckle.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 5334
4. Remove the wheel speed sensor harness bracket bolt and position the harness aside.
5. NOTE: Use the hex-holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while removing the nut.
Remove and discard the stabilizer bar link lower nut.
6. Remove and discard the shock absorber lower nut and bolt.
7. Remove and discard the upper ball joint nut.
8. NOTE: Be sure not to damage the ball joint boot when installing the Ball Joint Separator.
Using the Ball Joint Separator, separate the upper ball joint from the wheel knuckle.
9. Remove and discard the lower ball joint nut.
10. NOTICE: Make sure to use the Ball Joint Separator when separating the lower ball joint from
the knuckle to prevent damage to the ball
joint boot.
Using the Ball Joint Separator, separate the lower ball joint from the wheel knuckle.
11. If necessary, remove the 3 brake disc shield bolts and remove the brake disc shield.
Installation
NOTICE: Do not tighten the lower shock nut until the installation procedure is complete and the
weight of the vehicle is resting on the wheel and tire assemblies or incorrect clamp load and
bushing damage may occur.
1. If necessary, install the brake disc shield and the 3 brake disc shield bolts.
- Tighten to 17 Nm (150 lb-in).
2. Position the lower ball joint into the wheel knuckle and install the new lower ball joint nut.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 5335
- Tighten to 150 Nm (111 lb-ft).
3. Position the upper ball joint into the wheel knuckle and install the new upper ball joint nut.
- Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
4. NOTE: Do not tighten the nut at this time.
Loosely install the new shock absorber lower nut and bolt.
5. NOTE: Use the hex-holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while installing the nut.
Position the stabilizer bar link and install the new stabilizer bar link lower nut.
- Tighten to 80 Nm (59 lb-ft).
6. Position the wheel speed sensor harness bracket and install the wheel speed sensor harness
bracket bolt.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
7. Position the tie-rod end and install the new tie-rod end nut.
- Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
8. Install the wheel bearing and wheel hub. For additional information, refer to Wheel Bearing and
Wheel Hub See: Suspension/Wheel
Bearing/Service and Repair/Front Suspension.
9. With the weight of the vehicle on the wheel and tire, tighten the shock absorber lower nut to 550
Nm (406 lb-ft).
10. Check and, if necessary, align the front end.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair
Power Steering Bleeding: Service and Repair
Power Steering System Purging
NOTICE: If the air is not purged from the power steering system correctly, premature power
steering pump failure may result. The condition may occur on pre-delivery vehicles with evidence of
aerated fluid or on vehicles that have had steering component repairs.
1. NOTE: A whine heard from the power steering pump can be caused by air in the system. The
power steering purge procedure must be carried out
prior to any component repair for which power steering noise complaints are accompanied by
evidence of aerated fluid.
Remove the power steering reservoir cap. Check the fluid.
2. Raise the front wheels off the floor.
3. Tightly insert the Power Steering Evacuation Cap into the reservoir and connect the Vacuum
Pump Kit.
4. Start the engine.
5. Using the Vacuum Pump Kit, apply vacuum and maintain the maximum vacuum of 68-85 kPa
(20-25 in-Hg).
- If the Vacuum Pump Kit does not maintain vacuum, check the power steering system for leaks
before proceeding. For additional information, refer to Power Steering Fluid Leak Test. See:
Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/Power Steering Fluid Leak Test
6. If equipped with Hydro-Boost(R), apply the brake pedal 4 times.
7. NOTICE: Do not hold the steering wheel against the stops for an extended amount of time.
Damage to the power steering pump may
occur.
Cycle the steering wheel fully from stop-to-stop 10 times.
8. Stop the engine.
9. Release the vacuum and remove the Vacuum Pump Kit and the Power Steering Evacuation
Cap.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 5340
10. NOTE: Do not overfill the reservoir.
Fill the reservoir.
- Use approved transmission fluid.
11. Start the engine.
12. Install the Power Steering Evacuation Cap and the Vacuum Pump Kit. Apply and maintain the
maximum vacuum of 68-85 kPa (20-25 in-Hg).
13. NOTICE: Do not hold the steering wheel against the stops for an extended amount of time.
Damage to the power steering pump may
occur.
Cycle the steering wheel fully from stop-to-stop 10 times.
14. Stop the engine, release the vacuum and remove the Vacuum Pump Kit and the Power
Steering Evacuation Cap.
15. NOTE: Do not overfill the reservoir.
Fill the reservoir as needed and install the reservoir cap.
16. Visually inspect the power steering system for leaks.
17. NOTE: Do not overfill the reservoir.
Fill the reservoir as needed and visually inspect the power steering system for leaks.
18. Install the reservoir cap.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Specifications
Power Steering Fluid: Specifications
Power Steering Fluid Type
Ford Part Name ...................................................................................................................................
................................ Motorcraft MERCON V ATF Ford Part Number .................................................
............................................................................................................................................. XT-5-QM
Ford Specification ................................................................................................................................
......................................................... MERCON V
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Cooler >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Power Steering Fluid Cooler: Description and Operation
Air Conditioning
A/C Condenser/Power Steering Combo Cooler
The A/C condenser/power steering combo cooler is an aluminum fin-and-tube design heat
exchanger located in front of the vehicle radiator. It cools compressed refrigerant gas by allowing
air to pass over fins and tubes to extract heat and by condensing gas to liquid refrigerant as it is
cooled.
The receiver/drier is incorporated onto the LH side of the condenser core. The receiver/drier
cartridge is a separate component and can be removed and installed separately from the
condenser core.
The top portion of the condenser/power steering combo cooler is partitioned from the refrigerant
system and is used for power steering fluid cooling.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Reservoir >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Steering Fluid Reservoir: Service and Repair
Power Steering Fluid Reservoir
Removal and Installation
NOTICE: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
foreign material or failure of the power steering components may result.
1. Remove the upper air deflector.
1. Remove the 10 upper air deflector pin-type retainers.
2. Remove the air deflector.
2. Remove the air cleaner element.
3. Using a suitable suction device, remove the power steering fluid from the fluid reservoir.
4. Release the clamp and disconnect the power steering fluid cooler-to-power steering fluid
reservoir hose.
5. Release the clamp and disconnect the power steering fluid reservoir-to-pump supply hose.
6. Remove the power steering fluid reservoir bolt and reservoir.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Reservoir >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5350
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
8. Fill the power steering system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Gear To Fluid Cooler Return Hose
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Steering Gear To Fluid Cooler Return Hose
Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose
Removal and Installation
NOTICE: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
foreign material or failure of the power steering components may result.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the upper air deflector.
1. Remove the 10 upper air deflector pin-type retainers.
2. Remove the air deflector.
3. Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe.
4. Release the clamp and disconnect the power steering gear-to-fluid cooler return hose from the
power steering fluid cooler.
5. Release the lower cooling fan shroud tab and rotate the shroud upward.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Gear To Fluid Cooler Return Hose > Page 5355
6. Remove the 2 bolts and the oil drip shield.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
7. Remove the power steering line clamp plate bolt, rotate the clamp plate and disconnect the
power steering gear-to-fluid cooler return hose.
- To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 lb-ft).
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
9. Fill the power steering system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Gear To Fluid Cooler Return Hose > Page 5356
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Power Steering Pump To Steering Gear Pressure
Line
Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure Line
Removal and Installation
NOTICE: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
foreign material or failure of the power steering components may result.
1. Remove the power steering pump pulley. For additional information, refer to Power Steering
Pump Pulley See: Power Steering Pump/Service and
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Gear To Fluid Cooler Return Hose > Page 5357
Repair/Power Steering Pump Pulley.
2. Remove the 2 bolts and the oil drip shield.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
3. Disconnect the power steering pressure line-to-power steering pump fitting.
- To install, tighten to 65 Nm (48 lb-ft).
4. Disconnect the Power Steering Pressure (PSP) switch electrical connector.
5. Remove the power steering pressure line bracket-to-crossmember bolt.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
6. Remove the power steering pressure line bracket-to-engine nut.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
7. Remove the power steering line clamp plate bolt, rotate the clamp plate and disconnect the
power steering pressure line.
- To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 lb-ft).
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
9. Fill the power steering system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump
Power Steering Pump: Service and Repair Power Steering Pump
Power Steering Pump
Removal and Installation
NOTICE: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
foreign material or failure of the power steering components may result.
NOTE: A new Teflon(R) seal must be installed any time the line is disconnected from the power
steering pump.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump > Page 5362
1. Remove the power steering pump pulley. For additional information, refer to Power Steering
Pump Pulley See: Power Steering Pump Pulley.
2. Using a suitable suction device, remove the power steering fluid from the fluid reservoir.
3. Release the clamp and disconnect the power steering fluid reservoir-to-pump supply hose.
4. Remove the power steering pressure line bracket-to-engine nut.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
5. Disconnect the power steering pressure line-to-power steering pump fitting.
- Discard the Teflon(R) seal.
- To install, tighten to 65 Nm (48 lb-ft).
6. Remove the 3 bolts and the power steering pump.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Using the Teflon(R) Seal Installer Set, install a new Teflon(R) seal on the pressure line-to-pump
fitting.
8. Fill the power steering system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump > Page 5363
Power Steering Pump: Service and Repair Power Steering Pump Pulley
Power Steering Pump Pulley
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the upper air deflector.
1. Remove the 10 upper air deflector pin-type retainers.
2. Remove the air deflector.
3. Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe.
4. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Remove the 2 upper cooling fan shroud bolts and the wiring harness retainers.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump > Page 5364
5. Release the lower cooling fan shroud tab and rotate the shroud upwards.
6. Rotate the accessory drive belt tensioner clockwise and remove the accessory drive belt from
the power steering pump pulley.
7. Position the cooling fan shroud assembly upward to gain clearance to install the Power Steering
Pump Pulley Remover.
8. Using the Power Steering Pump Pulley Remover, remove the power steering pump pulley.
Installation
1. NOTE: If the pulley has been removed and installed twice, install a new power steering pump
pulley.
NOTE: Inspect the pulley for paint marks in the web area near the hub. If there are 2 paint marks,
install a new pulley. If there is 1 paint mark or none at all, use a paint pencil to mark the web area
of the pulley near the hub.
Using the Power Steering Pump Pulley Installer, install the power steering pump pulley.
2. Rotate the accessory drive belt tensioner clockwise and install the accessory drive belt to the
power steering pump pulley.
3. Lower the cooling fan shroud assembly.
- Release the lower cooling fan shroud tab, rotate the shroud downward.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump > Page 5365
4. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Install the 2 upper cooling fan shroud bolts and the wiring harness retainers.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
5. Install the air cleaner outlet pipe.
6. Install the upper air deflector and the 10 pin-type retainers.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 5370
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 5371
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Switch
Engine Control Components
Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
The PSP switch monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP switch
is a normally closed switch that opens as the hydraulic pressure increases. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the PSP circuit. When the PSP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The PCM uses the input signal from the PSP switch to compensate
for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the idle RPM and preventing engine stall during
parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP switch signals the PCM to adjust the transmission EPC
pressure during increased engine load, for example during parking maneuvers.
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch > Page
5374
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Sensor
Engine Control Components
Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
The PSP sensor monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP
sensor voltage input to the PCM changes as the hydraulic pressure changes. The PCM uses the
input signal from the PSP sensor to compensate for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the
idle RPM and preventing engine stall during parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP sensor signals the
PCM to adjust the transmission EPC pressure during increased engine load, for example, during
parking maneuvers.
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Steering Angle Sensor
> Component Information > Locations
Steering Angle Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Steering Angle Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Page 5378
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Steering Angle Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Page 5379
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Telescoping Wheel
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Telescoping Wheel
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 5383
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Tilt Wheel Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Tilt Wheel Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 5387
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information >
Locations
Steering Angle Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5391
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5392
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering
Depowering Procedure
WARNING: Always wear eye protection when servicing a vehicle. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on air bag, Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain
modules. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of these
modules, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the
restraints control module (RCM) while the RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON. Failure
to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of the Safety Canopy(R) and
cause serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: To reduce the risk of accidental deployment, do not use any memory saver devices.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF.
2. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
3. At the Smart Junction Box (SJB), located in the RH lower kick panel, remove the cover and the
RCM fuse 32 (10A) from the SJB. For additional
information, refer to the Wiring Diagrams.
4. Turn the ignition switch ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30
seconds. The air bag warning indicator will remain
lit continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
6. WARNING: Always deplete the backup power supply before repairing or installing any new front
or side air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) component and before servicing, removing, installing, adjusting or striking
components near the front or side impact sensors or the restraints control module (RCM). Nearby
components include doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood
latches.
Refer to the Description and Operation portion of Air Bag Systems for location of the RCM and
impact sensor(s).
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
1 minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury or death in the event of an
accidental deployment.
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
Repowering Procedure
1. Make sure that all SRS components are connected.
2. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
5398
3. Install RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the SJB and close the cover.
4. WARNING: Make sure no one is in the vehicle and there is nothing blocking or placed in front of
any air bag module when the battery is
connected. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury in the event of
an accidental deployment.
Connect the battery ground cable.
5. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the back to ON and visually monitor
the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag warning indicator will
illuminate continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an SRS fault is present,
the air bag warning indicator will:
- fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The flashing might not occur until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition has been turned from
the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to complete the testing of the
SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault exists, a chime will sound in a
pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning indicator and any SRS fault
discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous DTCs from the RCM using a scan tool.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
5399
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Deactivation and Reactivation
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deactivation and Reactivation
Deactivation
WARNING: Always carry or place a live air bag module with the air bag and deployment door/trim
cover/tear seam pointed away from the body. Do not set a live air bag module down with the
deployment door/trim cover/tear seam face down. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on air bag, Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain
modules. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of these
modules, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: To reduce the risk of accidental deployment, do not use any memory saver devices.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF.
2. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
3. At the Smart Junction Box (SJB), located in the RH lower kick panel, remove the cover and the
RCM fuse 32 (10A) from the SJB. For additional
information, refer to the Wiring Diagrams.
4. Turn the ignition switch ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30
seconds. The air bag warning indicator will remain
lit continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: Always deplete the backup power supply before repairing or installing any new front
or side air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) component and before servicing, removing, installing, adjusting or striking
components near the front or side impact sensors or the restraints control module (RCM). Nearby
components include doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood
latches.
Refer to the Description and Operation portion of Air Bag Systems for location of the RCM and
impact sensor(s).
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
1 minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury or death in the event of an
accidental deployment.
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
7. Make sure the road wheels are in the straight-ahead position.
8. Center the tilt steering column to allow for steering column upper and lower shroud removal.
9. NOTICE: Turn the steering wheel such that the top is at 90 degrees (at the 9 o'clock position) to
the left from the straight-ahead position
to access the driver air bag module wire clips and to prevent damage to the steering column
multi-function switch. Failure to follow this instruction may result in component damage.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
5400
Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is 90 degrees to the left (at the 9 o'clock position)
as shown.
10. Remove the lower steering column opening cover.
- Remove the 3 screws.
- Pull out to release the top retainers.
- Remove the lower steering column opening cover. If equipped, disconnect the adjustable pedals switch connector.
11. If equipped, remove the screw and steering column manual tilt lever.
12. Remove the 3 steering column lower shroud screws.
13. Release the clips and remove the steering column upper shroud.
14. Remove the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, disconnect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
15. NOTICE: Make sure each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are disengaged from each of
the 3 steering wheel hooks before
removing the driver air bag module from the steering wheel. Failure to follow this instruction may
result in component damage and/or system failure.
NOTE: Steering wheel is removed for clarity. The rear of the steering wheel is shown.
NOTE: Use a mirror to view the rear of the steering wheel to locate where the 3 driver air bag
module wire clips attach to the steering wheel hooks.
Using a screwdriver or a suitable tool, release each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips from
the steering wheel hooks. Access the 3 driver air bag module wire clips through the back of the steering wheel cover and
push the wire clips toward the center of the steering wheel to release.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
5401
16. NOTE: Once the driver air bag module is removed, note the position of the 2 driver air bag
module locator pins on the steering wheel for
installation.
Disconnect the driver air bag module and horn switch electrical connectors and remove the driver
air bag module.
17. Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is back in the straight-ahead position (the 12
o'clock position).
18. Open and lower the glove compartment door to allow access to the passenger air bag electrical
connector.
- If equipped, disconnect the glove compartment door dampener.
19. Disconnect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
20. NOTE: There are 2 similar connectors under the passenger seat. The passenger seat side air
bag module electrical connector is located toward the
seat outboard position.
Remove the passenger front seat cushion panel shield and disconnect the passenger seat side air
bag module electrical.
21. Release the RH second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
5402
22. Remove the bolt and the RH second row safety belt retractor D-ring.
23. Remove the cover and the RH C-pillar trim panel nut.
24. Release the rear door weatherstrip and remove the RH C-pillar trim panel.
25. Disconnect the RH safety canopy module electrical connector.
26. Release the LH second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
27. Remove the bolt and the LH second row safety belt retractor D-ring.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
5403
28. Remove the cover and the LH C-pillar trim panel nut.
29. Release the rear door weatherstrip and remove the driver C-pillar trim panel.
30. Disconnect the LH safety canopy module electrical connector.
31. NOTE: There are 2 similar connectors under the driver seat. The driver seat side air bag
module electrical connector is located toward the seat
outboard position.
Remove the driver front seat cushion panel shield and disconnect the driver seat side air bag
module electrical connector.
32. Install the RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the Smart Junction Box (SJB).
33. Connect the battery ground cable.
Reactivation
1. Remove the RCM fuse 32 (10A) from the SJB.
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
3. Connect the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector and install the driver front seat
cushion panel shield.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
5404
4. Connect the LH safety canopy module electrical connector.
5. Install the LH C-pillar trim panel and attach the rear door weatherstrip.
6. Install the LH C-pillar trim panel nut and cover.
7. Install the LH second row safety belt retractor D-ring and bolt.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
8. Attach the LH second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
9. Connect the RH safety canopy module electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
5405
10. Install the RH C-pillar trim panel and attach the rear door weatherstrip.
11. Install the passenger C-pillar trim panel nut and cover.
12. Install the RH second row safety belt retractor D-ring and bolt.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
13. Attach the RH second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding. Extract and retract the safety belt between the full extension and stowed positions.
- If excessive effort or binding is present, install a new safety belt buckle retractor and tongue
assembly as necessary. For additional information, refer to Seat Belt Systems.
14. Connect the passenger seat side air bag module electrical connector and install the passenger
front seat cushion panel shield.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
5406
15. Connect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
16. Close the glove compartment door.
- If equipped, connect the glove compartment door dampener.
17. NOTICE: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag module. Match
the electrical connector key to the keyway in the driver air bag module. Do not force the electrical
connectors into the driver air bag module. Damage to the connector or component may occur.
Connect the horn switch and 2 driver air bag module electrical connectors.
18. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, lining up the locator pins.
19. NOTE: Make sure that all 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged and seated
correctly to the steering wheel.
NOTE: Audible clicks will be heard when the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged.
Firmly press the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, seating the 3 driver air bag module
wire clips to the steering wheel hooks.
- Check the driver air bag module trim cover to the steering wheel for an even gap clearance and
correct movement.
20. Install the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, connect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
21. Install the steering column upper shroud.
22. Install the 3 steering column lower shroud screws.
23. If equipped, install the steering column manual tilt lever and screw.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
24. If equipped, connect the adjustable pedals switch connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
5407
25. Install the lower steering column opening cover and 3 screws.
26. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON.
27. Install the RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the SJB and install the cover.
28. WARNING: Make sure no one is in the vehicle and there is nothing blocking or placed in front
of any air bag module when the battery is
connected. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury in the event of
an accidental deployment.
Connect the battery ground cable.
29. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition switch from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the ignition switch back to ON
and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag
warning indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag
SRS fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will either:
- fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The air bag warning indicator may not illuminate until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition
switch has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator will need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Clear all continuous memory DTCs from the RCM using a scan tool.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Telescoping Wheel Motor >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Telescoping Wheel Motor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 5411
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Telescoping Wheel Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Telescoping Wheel Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 5415
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Tilt Wheel Motor > Component
Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Tilt Wheel Motor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5419
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Tilt Wheel Motor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5420
Tilt Wheel Motor: Service and Repair
Steering Column Motor
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the steering column. For additional information, refer to Steering Column See: Service
and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Steering
Column.
2. Remove the screw and the ignition switch.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
3. Remove the roll pin from the steering column motor.
4. Remove the bolt and the motor.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Tilt Wheel Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Tilt Wheel Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5424
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear
Steering Gear: Service and Repair Steering Gear
Steering Gear
Removal
NOTICE: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
foreign material or failure of the power steering components may result.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear > Page 5429
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. NOTICE: Do not allow the steering column shaft to rotate while disconnected from the gear or
damage to the clockspring may occur. If
there is evidence that the steering column shaft has rotated, the clockspring must be recentered.
For additional information, refer to Air Bag Systems.
Hold the steering wheel in the straight ahead position using a suitable holding device.
3. Remove and discard the outer tie-rod end nuts.
4. NOTICE: Use care when installing the Ball Joint Tool Separator or damage to the tie-rod end
boot may occur.
Using the Ball Joint Tool Separator, disconnect the tie-rod ends from the wheel knuckles.
5. Release the lower cooling fan shroud tab and rotate the shroud upward.
6. Remove the 2 bolts and the oil drip shield.
7. NOTICE: Do not allow the steering column shaft to rotate while it is disconnected from the
steering gear or damage to the clockspring
may result. If there is evidence that the steering column shaft has rotated, the clockspring must be
removed and recentered. For additional information, refer to Air Bag Systems.
Remove the steering column shaft-to-steering gear bolt and disconnect the steering column shaft
from the steering gear.
8. NOTICE: New O-ring seals must be installed any time the lines are disconnected from the
steering gear or a fluid leak may occur.
Remove the power steering line clamp plate bolt, rotate the clamp plate and disconnect the power
steering lines.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
9. Remove the 2 steering gear-to-crossmember bolts and remove the steering gear.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear > Page 5430
- Discard the bolts.
Installation
1. NOTICE: Make sure the LH steering gear bushing is seated correctly or failure of the steering
gear may occur. The RH side bushing does
not have locking tabs.
Position the steering gear and install the 2 steering gear-to-crossmember bolts.
- Tighten the new bolts to 440 Nm (325 lb-ft).
2. Connect the steering column shaft and install the bolt.
- Tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
3. NOTE: New O-ring seals must be installed any time the line is disconnected from the power
steering gear.
Connect the steering lines, rotate the clamp plate and install the clamp plate bolt.
- Tighten to 23 Nm (17 lb-ft).
4. Install the oil drip shield and the 2 bolts.
- Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
5. Release the lower cooling fan shroud tab and rotate the shroud downward.
6. NOTICE: Make sure that the tie-rod end boots are seated correctly on the tie-rod ends or tie-rod
end failure may occur.
Connect the tie-rod ends to the wheel knuckles and install the nuts.
- Tighten the new nuts to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear > Page 5431
7. Fill the power steering system.
8. Check and, if necessary, adjust the front toe.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear > Page 5432
Steering Gear: Service and Repair Steering Gear Turn Tubes
Steering Gear Turn Tubes
Removal and Installation
NOTICE: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
foreign material or failure of the power steering components may result.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. If equipped, remove the 4 skid plate bolts and the skid plate.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear > Page 5433
3. Release the lower cooling fan shroud position tab and rotate the shroud upwards until the lower
tab locks into position.
4. NOTICE: New O-ring seals must be installed any time the lines are disconnected from the
steering gear or a leak may occur.
Remove the steering gear turn tubes clamp plate bolt.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
5. NOTICE: Inspect the banjo bolt damper seals for wear or damage and install new seals as
necessary.
Remove the 2 banjo bolt dampers and the steering gear turn tubes.
- To install, tighten to 33 Nm (24 lb-ft).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
7. Fill the power steering system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Steering Shaft: Service and Repair
Steering Column Shaft
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position the vehicle on a hoist.
2. NOTE: Use a steering wheel holding device (such as Hunter(R) 28-75-1 or equivalent).
Using a suitable holding device, hold the steering wheel in the straight-ahead position.
3. NOTICE: Do not allow the steering column shaft to rotate while the intermediate shaft is
disconnected or damage to the clockspring may
result. If there is evidence that the shaft has rotated, the clockspring must be recentered. For
additional information, refer to Air Bag Systems.
Remove the bolt and disconnect the upper steering column shaft from the steering column. Discard the bolt.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 5437
- To install, tighten the new bolt to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
4. Remove the bolt and disconnect the upper steering column shaft from the lower steering column
shaft.
- Discard the bolt.
- To install, tighten the new bolt to 48 Nm (35 lb-ft).
5. Remove the 2 bolts, the dash seal and the upper steering column shaft.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
6. Remove the bolt and disconnect the lower steering column shaft from the steering gear.
- Discard the bolt.
- To install, tighten the new bolt to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
7. WARNING: Do not reuse steering column shaft bolts. This may result in fastener failure and
steering column shaft detachment or loss of
steering control. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious injury to vehicle occupant(s).
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Locations >
Steering Wheel Switch, Left
Steering Wheel: Locations Steering Wheel Switch, Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Locations >
Steering Wheel Switch, Left > Page 5442
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Locations >
Steering Wheel Switch, Left > Page 5443
Steering Wheel: Locations Steering Wheel Switch, Right
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Locations >
Steering Wheel Switch, Left > Page 5444
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Diagrams >
Steering Wheel Switch, Left
Steering Wheel: Diagrams Steering Wheel Switch, Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Diagrams >
Steering Wheel Switch, Left > Page 5447
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Diagrams >
Steering Wheel Switch, Left > Page 5448
Steering Wheel: Diagrams Steering Wheel Switch, Right
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Diagrams >
Steering Wheel Switch, Left > Page 5449
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5450
Steering Wheel: Service and Repair
Steering Wheel
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the driver air bag module. For additional information, refer to Air Bag Systems.
2. Turn the steering wheel to the straight-ahead position.
3. Remove and discard the steering wheel bolt.
- To install, tighten the new bolt to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
4. Disconnect the steering wheel switches electrical connector from the clockspring.
5. Remove the steering wheel while routing the wires from the clockspring through the steering
wheel.
6. Tape the clockspring center rotor to the outer housing to keep it from rotating.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Component Information > Service and Repair
Tie Rod: Service and Repair
Inner Tie Rod
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Page 5454
Removal
NOTICE: The steering gear bellows boots and clamps are designed to provide an airtight seal and
protect the internal components of the steering gear. If the seal is not airtight, the vacuum
generated during turning will draw water and contamination into the gear, causing damage. Zip ties
do not produce an airtight seal and must not be used.
NOTICE: If present, the orientation of the vent tube must be noted so the boots and vent tubes may
be installed in the correct location. Incorrect venting may lead to internal component damage.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Loosen the tie-rod end jam nut.
3. Remove and discard the outer tie-rod end nut.
4. NOTICE: Use care when installing the Ball Joint Tool Separator or damage to the tie-rod end
boot may occur.
Using the Ball Joint Tool Separator, disconnect the tie-rod end from the wheel knuckle.
5. NOTE: Count the number of turns required to remove the tie-rod end for reference during
installation.
Remove the outer tie-rod end.
6. Remove the tie-rod end jam nut.
7. NOTE: New bellows boot clamps must be installed.
Remove and discard the inner and outer bellows boot clamp.
8. Remove the steering gear bellows boot.
9. NOTE: Place the steering gear at the center position. Use an appropriate-sized crowfoot wrench
on the flat of the rack gear to resist rotation and to
prevent damage during removal and installation of the inner tie rod.
NOTE: If repairing the RH side, it will be necessary to pull back the LH inner tie-rod boot to hold the
steering gear.
NOTE: An assistant may be needed for removal of the RH inner tie rod.
While holding the steering gear rack, use an appropriate-sized crowfoot wrench to remove the
inner tie rod.
10. NOTICE: Thoroughly remove any abrasive material from steering gear components. This
material is extremely harmful to the steering
gear.
Thoroughly clean and inspect all the parts to be reused. Install new parts as necessary.
Installation
1. NOTICE: Place the steering gear at the center position. Use an appropriate-sized crowfoot
wrench on the flat of the rack gear to resist
rotation and to prevent damage during the installation of the inner tie rod.
NOTE: An assistant may be needed for installation of the RH inner tie rod.
Using an appropriate-sized crowfoot wrench, install the inner tie rod.
- Tighten to 120 Nm (89 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Page 5455
2. NOTE: Apply steering gear grease to the steering gear bellows boot groove in the inner tie rod.
NOTE: Make sure the steering gear bellows boot is positioned correctly over the steering gear
housing bead and the groove in the inner tie rod.
Install the steering gear bellows boot.
3. Using the Boot Clamp Pliers, install a new inner bellows boot clamp.
4. NOTE: Make sure the end of the steering gear bellows is positioned between the 2 grooves on
the inner tie rod or an internal leak can result.
Install a new outer bellows boot clamp.
5. Thread the tie-rod end jam nut onto the inner tie rod.
6. NOTE: Install the tie-rod end the same number of turns as recorded during the removal.
Install the tie-rod end to the inner tie rod.
7. NOTICE: Make sure that the tie-rod end boots are seated correctly on the tie-rod ends or failure
may occur.
Connect the tie-rod end to the wheel knuckle and install a new tie-rod end nut.
- Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
8. Tighten the tie-rod end jam nut.
- Tighten to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
9. Check and, if necessary, adjust the front toe.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Specifications
Ball Joint: Specifications
Ball Joint Deflection Lower...................................................................................................................
..................................................................................0-0.8 mm (0-0.032 in) Upper..............................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.........0-0.2 mm (0-0.008 in)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Suspension
Ball Joint: Service and Repair Front Suspension
Ball Joint - Lower
Removal
1. Remove the wheel knuckle. For additional information, refer to Wheel Knuckle See: Front
Steering Knuckle/Service and Repair.
2. Remove and discard the lower ball joint snap ring.
3. Using the C-Frame and Screw Installer/Remover and the Ball Joint Remover, remove the lower
ball joint.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Suspension > Page 5462
Installation
1. NOTICE: Do not damage the lower ball joint boot when installing the C-Frame and Screw
Installer/Remover and the Ball Joint
Installer/Remover or premature failure of the ball joint may occur.
NOTE: Make sure the ball joint snap ring is fully seated.
Using the C-Frame and Screw Installer/Remover and the Ball Joint Installer/Remover, install the
lower ball joint.
- Install the ball joint snap ring.
2. Install the wheel knuckle. For additional information, refer to Wheel Knuckle See: Front Steering
Knuckle/Service and Repair.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Suspension > Page 5463
Ball Joint: Service and Repair Rear Suspension
Ball Joint - Lower
Removal
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be
installed with the same part numbers or equivalent part, if replacement is necessary. Do not use a
replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified
during reassembly to make sure correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the wheel knuckle. For additional information, refer to Wheel Knuckle See: Rear
Knuckle/Service and Repair/Wheel Knuckle.
2. Remove and discard the ball joint snap ring.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Suspension > Page 5464
3. Using the C-Frame and Screw Installer/Remover and the Ball Joint Installer/Remover, remove
the ball joint.
Installation
1. NOTICE: Do not damage the ball joint boot when installing the special tool.
NOTE: Clean and inspect the ball joint bore for bore damage before installing a new ball joint.
Using the C-Frame and Screw Installer/Remover and the Ball Joint Installer/Remover, install the
ball joint.
2. NOTE: Always use a new ball joint snap ring.
Install a new snap ring.
3. Install the wheel knuckle. For additional information, refer to Wheel Knuckle See: Rear
Knuckle/Service and Repair/Wheel Knuckle.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Rear Suspension
Control Arm: Service and Repair Rear Suspension
Lower Arm
Lower Arm
Removal
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be
installed with the same part numbers or equivalent part, if replacement is necessary. Do not use a
replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified
during reassembly to make sure correct retention of these parts.
NOTE: Orientation of the suspension fasteners is important. Make sure the fasteners are installed
in the same direction as they were in when removed.
1. Remove the wheel and tire.
2. If equipped, disconnect the air suspension height sensor connecting link from the lower arm.
3. Remove and discard the shock absorber lower bolt and flagnut.
4. Remove and discard the lower arm-to-frame bolt and flagnut.
5. Remove and discard the lower ball joint nut.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Rear Suspension > Page 5469
6. NOTICE: Do not damage the ball joint boot while installing the Ball Joint Separator.
Using the Ball Joint Separator, separate the lower ball joint from the wheel knuckle.
7. Swing the lower arm to the rear of the vehicle and remove the lower arm.
Installation
1. Position the lower arm ball joint onto the wheel knuckle and install the new lower ball joint nut.
- Tighten to 150 Nm (111 lb-ft).
2. NOTE: Do not tighten the lower arm-to-frame bolt at this time.
Install the new lower arm-to-frame bolt and flagnut.
- Snug the bolt to 50 Nm (37 lb-ft).
3. NOTE: Do not tighten the shock absorber lower nut at this time.
Position the lower arm and install a new shock absorber lower bolt and nut.
4. Install the wheel and tire.
5. Lower the vehicle so that the weight of the vehicle is on the wheel and tire assemblies.
6. Tighten the lower arm-to-frame bolt to 225 Nm (166 lb-ft).
7. Tighten the shock absorber lower bolt to 550 Nm (406 lb-ft).
8. If equipped, connect the air suspension height sensor connecting link to the lower arm.
9. Check and, if necessary, align the rear end.
Upper Arm
Upper Arm
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Rear Suspension > Page 5470
Removal
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be
installed with the same part numbers or equivalent part, if replacement is necessary. Do not use a
replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified
during reassembly to make sure correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the wheel and tire.
2. Remove and discard the upper arm-to-wheel knuckle nut.
3. Using the Ball Joint Separator, separate the upper arm from the wheel knuckle.
4. Remove and discard the upper arm-to-frame bolt, washer, camber set shim and flagnut.
5. Remove the upper arm.
Installation
1. NOTE: Do not tighten the nut at this time.
Install the upper arm and loosely install the new upper arm-to-frame bolt, washer, camber set shim
and flagnut.
2. NOTE: Do not tighten the nut at this time.
Loosely install the new upper arm-to-wheel knuckle nut.
3. Install the wheel and tire.
4. With the weight of the vehicle on the wheel and tires, tighten the upper arm-to-frame bolt to 225
Nm (166 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Rear Suspension > Page 5471
5. With the weight of the vehicle on the wheel and tires, tighten the upper arm-to-wheel knuckle nut
to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
6. Check and, if necessary, adjust the rear alignment.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Rear Suspension > Page 5472
Control Arm: Service and Repair Front Suspension - Rear Wheel Drive (RWD)
Lower Arm
Lower Arm
Removal
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be
installed with the same part numbers or equivalent parts, if replacement is necessary. Do not use a
replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified
during reassembly to make sure of correct retention of these parts.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Rear Suspension > Page 5473
1. Measure the distance from the center of the hub to the lip of the fender with the vehicle in a
level, static ground position (curb height).
2. Remove the wheel and tire.
3. NOTE: Use the hex-holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while removing the nut.
Remove and discard the stabilizer bar link lower nut.
4. Remove and discard the lower ball joint nut.
5. NOTICE: Make sure to use the Ball Joint Separator when separating the lower ball joint from the
knuckle to prevent damage to the ball
joint boot.
Using the Ball Joint Separator, separate the ball joint from the knuckle.
6. Remove and discard the lower arm rearward nut and bolt.
7. Remove and discard the lower arm forward nut and bolt.
8. Remove the shock absorber lower nut, bolt and the lower arm.
- Discard the shock absorber lower nut and bolt.
Installation
1. Position the lower arm and loosely install the new shock absorber lower bolt and nut.
2. Loosely install the new lower arm forward nut and bolt.
3. Loosely install the new lower arm rearward nut and bolt.
4. Position the lower ball joint into the wheel knuckle and install the new lower ball joint nut.
- Tighten to 150 Nm (111 lb-ft).
5. Install the new stabilizer bar link lower nut.
- Tighten to 80 Nm (59 lb-ft).
6. Use a suitable jack to raise the suspension until the distance between the center of the hub and
the lip of the fender is equal to the measurement
taken in Step 1 (curb height).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Rear Suspension > Page 5474
7. NOTE: Use a crowfoot wrench to tighten the lower arm rearward nut.
Tighten the lower arm rearward nut to 350 Nm (258 lb-ft).
8. Tighten the lower arm forward nut to 350 Nm (258 lb-ft).
9. Tighten the shock absorber lower nut to 550 Nm (406 lb-ft).
10. Install the wheel and tire.
11. Check and, if necessary, align the front end.
Upper Arm
Upper Arm
Removal
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be
installed with the same part numbers or equivalent parts, if replacement is necessary. Do not use a
replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified
during reassembly to make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. Measure the distance from the center of the hub to the lip of the fender with the vehicle in a
level, static ground position (curb height).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Rear Suspension > Page 5475
2. Remove the shock absorber and spring assembly. For additional information, refer to Shock
Absorber and Spring Assembly See: Suspension Strut
/ Shock Absorber/Service and Repair/Front Suspension - Rear Wheel Drive (RWD).
3. Remove and discard the upper ball joint nut.
4. Using the Ball Joint Separator, separate the upper ball joint from the wheel knuckle.
5. Remove the upper arm-to-frame nuts and bolts and the upper arm.
- Discard the bolts.
Installation
1. NOTE: Do not tighten the nuts at this time.
Position the upper arm and loosely install the new upper arm-to-frame bolts and nuts.
2. Position the ball joint into the wheel knuckle and install the new upper ball joint nut.
- Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
3. Use a suitable jack to raise the suspension until the distance between the center of the hub and
the lip of the fender is equal to the measurement
taken in Step 1 (curb height).
4. Tighten the upper arm-to-frame nuts to 150 Nm (111 lb-ft).
5. Install the shock absorber and spring assembly. For additional information, refer to Shock
Absorber and Spring Assembly See: Suspension Strut /
Shock Absorber/Service and Repair/Front Suspension - Rear Wheel Drive (RWD).
6. Check and, if necessary, align the front end.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Cross-Member: Service and Repair
Transmission Support Crossmember
Removal and Installation
Transmission Support Crossmember - Exploded View
NOTE: Transmission not shown for clarity.
Transmission Support Crossmember - Exploded View
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. If equipped, remove the skid plate
fasteners and skid plate. 3. Remove the LH and RH exhaust heat shield-to-crossmember
fasteners.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Page 5479
4. Remove the 2 transmission mount nuts.
- To install, tighten to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
5. Support the transmission.
6. NOTE:
- Mark the transmission crossmember next to the edge of the frame bracket to make sure the
crossmember is installed in the same position it was removed from.
- The crossmember nuts are installed on the crossmember bolts facing the front of the vehicle.
Remove the 4 transmission crossmember bolts (2 each side) and the transmission crossmember. To install, tighten to 90 Nm (66 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Page 5480
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Front Steering Knuckle: Service and Repair
Wheel Knuckle
Removal
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be
installed with the same part numbers or equivalent parts, if replacement is necessary. Do not use a
replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified
during reassembly to make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the wheel bearing and wheel hub. For additional information, refer to Wheel Bearing
and Wheel Hub See: Wheel Bearing/Service and
Repair/Front Suspension.
2. Remove and discard the tie-rod end nut.
3. Using the Ball Joint Separator, separate the tie-rod end from the wheel knuckle.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 5484
4. Remove the wheel speed sensor harness bracket bolt and position the harness aside.
5. NOTE: Use the hex-holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while removing the nut.
Remove and discard the stabilizer bar link lower nut.
6. Remove and discard the shock absorber lower nut and bolt.
7. Remove and discard the upper ball joint nut.
8. NOTE: Be sure not to damage the ball joint boot when installing the Ball Joint Separator.
Using the Ball Joint Separator, separate the upper ball joint from the wheel knuckle.
9. Remove and discard the lower ball joint nut.
10. NOTICE: Make sure to use the Ball Joint Separator when separating the lower ball joint from
the knuckle to prevent damage to the ball
joint boot.
Using the Ball Joint Separator, separate the lower ball joint from the wheel knuckle.
11. If necessary, remove the 3 brake disc shield bolts and remove the brake disc shield.
Installation
NOTICE: Do not tighten the lower shock nut until the installation procedure is complete and the
weight of the vehicle is resting on the wheel and tire assemblies or incorrect clamp load and
bushing damage may occur.
1. If necessary, install the brake disc shield and the 3 brake disc shield bolts.
- Tighten to 17 Nm (150 lb-in).
2. Position the lower ball joint into the wheel knuckle and install the new lower ball joint nut.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 5485
- Tighten to 150 Nm (111 lb-ft).
3. Position the upper ball joint into the wheel knuckle and install the new upper ball joint nut.
- Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
4. NOTE: Do not tighten the nut at this time.
Loosely install the new shock absorber lower nut and bolt.
5. NOTE: Use the hex-holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while installing the nut.
Position the stabilizer bar link and install the new stabilizer bar link lower nut.
- Tighten to 80 Nm (59 lb-ft).
6. Position the wheel speed sensor harness bracket and install the wheel speed sensor harness
bracket bolt.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
7. Position the tie-rod end and install the new tie-rod end nut.
- Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
8. Install the wheel bearing and wheel hub. For additional information, refer to Wheel Bearing and
Wheel Hub See: Wheel Bearing/Service and
Repair/Front Suspension.
9. With the weight of the vehicle on the wheel and tire, tighten the shock absorber lower nut to 550
Nm (406 lb-ft).
10. Check and, if necessary, align the front end.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Wheel Knuckle Bushing
Rear Knuckle: Service and Repair Wheel Knuckle Bushing
Wheel Knuckle Bushing
Removal
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be
installed with the same part numbers or equivalent part, if replacement is necessary. Do not use a
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Wheel Knuckle Bushing > Page 5490
replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified
during reassembly to make sure correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the wheel and tire.
2. Remove and discard the upper trailing arm-to-wheel knuckle bolt.
- Position the upper trailing arm upward to access the wheel knuckle bushing.
3. Using the Bearings and Washers Forcing Screw, the Bushing Remover and the Bushing
Remover/Installer, remove the wheel knuckle bushing.
Installation
1. Clean and inspect the wheel knuckle bushing bore for damage or excessive wear.
2. Position the new wheel knuckle bushing with the larger void facing towards the upper trailing
arm.
3. Install the Bearings and Washers Forcing Screw, the Bushing Remover and the Bushing
Remover/Installer.
4. NOTE: Do not use the forward forcing screw nut to install the bushing. The forward forcing screw
nut is only used to correctly position and align
the bushing for installation.
Hand tighten the forward forcing screw nut to align the bushing with the rearward side of the wheel
knuckle bore.
5. NOTICE: Use the rearward forcing screw nut to install the bushing or damage to the bushing
and/or the wheel knuckle bushing bore
may result.
Tighten the rearward forcing screw nut and install the bushing until it is centered in the wheel
knuckle.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Wheel Knuckle Bushing > Page 5491
6. NOTE: After installing the wheel knuckle bushing, make sure to measure the bushing position in
the wheel knuckle bore. The measurement from
the bushings outer metal surface to the machined face surface of knuckle bore should be 2.54 mm
(0.16 in) +/- 0.25 mm (0.01 in).
If necessary, use the Bearings and Washers Forcing Screw, the Bushing Remover and the
Bushing Remover/Installer to adjust the bushing position in the wheel knuckle bushing bore.
7. NOTE: Do not tighten the trailing arm-to-wheel knuckle bolt at this time.
Connect the upper trailing arm-to-the wheel knuckle and loosely install the bolt.
8. Install the wheel and tire.
9. Lower the vehicle so that the weight of the vehicle is resting on the wheel and tires.
10. Tighten the new upper trailing arm-to-the wheel knuckle bolt to 250 Nm (184 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Wheel Knuckle Bushing > Page 5492
Rear Knuckle: Service and Repair Wheel Knuckle
Wheel Knuckle
Removal
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be
installed with the same part numbers or equivalent part, if replacement is necessary. Do not use a
replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified
during reassembly to make sure correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the wheel bearing and wheel hub assembly. For additional information, refer to Wheel
Bearing and Wheel Hub See: Wheel
Bearing/Service and Repair/Rear Suspension.
2. Remove the parking brake shoes.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Wheel Knuckle Bushing > Page 5493
3. Remove the brake disc shield.
4. Compress the spring and depress the retaining tabs and detach the parking brake cable from the
wheel knuckle and parking brake lever.
5. Remove and discard the upper arm-to-wheel knuckle nut.
6. Using the Ball Joint Separator, separate the upper arm from the wheel knuckle.
7. Remove and discard the lower ball joint nut.
8. Using the Ball Joint Separator, separate the lower ball joint from the wheel knuckle.
9. Remove and discard the 2 bolts and disconnect the lower trailing arm from the wheel knuckle.
10. Remove and discard the bolt and disconnect the toe link from the wheel knuckle.
11. NOTE: Use the hex-holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while removing the nut.
Using the hex-holding feature, remove and discard the stabilizer bar link nut and disconnect the link
from the wheel knuckle.
12. Remove the upper trailing arm-to-wheel knuckle bolt and the wheel knuckle.
- Discard the bolt.
Installation
1. NOTE: Do not tighten the upper trailing arm-to wheel knuckle bolt at this time.
Position the wheel knuckle and loosely install the new upper trailing arm-to-wheel knuckle bolt.
2. Connect the stabilizer bar link to the wheel knuckle and install the new nut.
- Tighten to 63 Nm (46 lb-ft).
3. NOTE: Do not tighten the toe link-to-wheel knuckle bolt at this time.
Connect the toe link-to-the wheel knuckle and loosely install the new bolt.
4. Connect the lower trailing arm to the wheel knuckle and install the 2 new bolts.
- Tighten to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
5. Position the lower ball joint onto the wheel knuckle and install the new lower ball joint nut.
- Tighten to 150 Nm (111 lb-ft).
6. Position the upper arm and install the new upper arm-to-wheel knuckle nut.
- Tighten the nut to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
7. Compress the spring, insert the retaining tabs and attach the parking brake cable to the wheel
knuckle and parking brake cable lever.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Wheel Knuckle Bushing > Page 5494
8. Install the brake disc shield.
9. Install the parking brake shoes.
10. Install the wheel bearing and wheel hub assembly. For additional information, refer to Wheel
Bearing and Wheel Hub See: Wheel
Bearing/Service and Repair/Rear Suspension.
11. Lower the vehicle so that the weight of the vehicle is resting on the wheel and tires.
12. Tighten the toe link-to-the wheel knuckle bolt to 225 Nm (166 lb-ft).
13. Tighten the upper trailing arm-to-wheel knuckle bolt to 250 Nm (184 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle Alignment Link > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Rear Knuckle Alignment Link: Service and Repair
Toe Link
Removal
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be
installed with the same part numbers or equivalent part, if replacement is necessary. Do not use a
replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified
during reassembly to make sure correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the wheel and tire.
2. Index-mark the cam bolt and cam washer positions.
3. Remove and discard the toe link-to-wheel knuckle bolt and washer.
4. Remove and discard the toe link-to-frame cam bolt, cam washer and nut.
5. Remove the toe link.
Installation
1. Using the index marks made in removal Step 2, transfer the marks onto the new cam bolt and
cam washer.
2. NOTE: Do not tighten the nut at this time.
Align the index marks and loosely install the new toe link-to-wheel knuckle bolt and washer.
3. NOTE: Do not tighten the bolt at this time.
Loosely install the new toe link-to-frame cam bolt, cam washer and nut.
4. Install the wheel and tire.
5. Lower the vehicle so that the weight of the vehicle is resting on the wheel and tires.
6. Tighten the toe link-to-wheel knuckle bolt to 225 Nm (166 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle Alignment Link > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 5498
7. Align the index marks and tighten the toe link-to-frame cam nut to 275 Nm (203 lb-ft).
8. Check and, if necessary, adjust the rear toe.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Relays and Modules - Suspension >
Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Relays and Modules - Suspension > Suspension
Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Suspension Control Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Relays and Modules - Suspension > Suspension
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 5506
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Relays and Modules - Suspension > Suspension
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 5507
Suspension Control Module: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Relays and Modules - Suspension > Suspension
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 5508
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Relays and Modules - Suspension > Suspension
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 5509
Suspension Control Module: Service and Repair
Vehicle Dynamics Module (VDM)
Removal and Installation
NOTICE: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these charges,
damage may result.
1. NOTE: The Vehicle Dynamics Module (VDM) is mounted to the lower left side of the dash above
the parking brake control.
Disconnect the 2 VDM electrical connectors.
2. Remove the VDM bracket nuts and the module.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
3. NOTE: The VDM is calibrated with information from the ride height sensors. A new or exchanged
VDM requires that the LH and RH ride height
sensors are calibrated and a Pneumatic Test is carried out. For additional information, refer to
Vehicle Dynamic Suspension See: Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic )/Testing and
Inspection Calibration Initialize System - Clear C1990 and C1991 DTCs.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Suspension > Ride Height
Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Service and Repair
Ride Height Sensor: Service and Repair
Suspension Height Sensor
LH Side
RH Side
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Suspension > Ride Height
Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5514
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Disconnect the height sensor harness from the sensor bracket.
3. Disconnect the height sensor electrical connector.
4. Disconnect the height sensor arm from the ball stud on the lower control arm.
5. Remove and discard the 2 height sensor bolts.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
6. NOTE: The RH and LH height sensor assemblies cannot be used on opposite sides of the
vehicle.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
7. Calibrate the LH and RH height sensors. For additional information, refer to Ride Height
Adjustments See: Suspension Control ( Automatic Electronic )/Service and Repair/Ride Height Adjustments.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Suspension > Steering Angle
Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Steering Angle Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Suspension > Steering Angle
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5518
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Suspension > Steering Angle
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5519
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Link >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Suspension - Rear Wheel Drive (RWD)
Stabilizer Link: Service and Repair Front Suspension - Rear Wheel Drive (RWD)
Stabilizer Bar and Link
NOTE: LH side shown, RH side similar.
Removal and Installation
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be
installed with the same part numbers or equivalent parts, if replacement is necessary. Do not use a
replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified
during reassembly to make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. NOTE: The hex-holding feature can be used to prevent turning of the stud while removing the
nut.
Remove and discard the 2 stabilizer bar link upper nuts.
- To install, tighten the new nuts to 80 Nm (59 lb-ft).
3. NOTICE: Do not hold the stabilizer link boot with any tool as damage to the boot will occur.
NOTE: Use the hex-holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while removing the nut.
Remove and discard the 2 stabilizer bar link lower nuts and remove the 2 stabilizer bar links.
- To install, tighten the new nuts to 80 Nm (59 lb-ft).
4. Remove the 4 stabilizer bar bracket nuts, brackets and the stabilizer bar.
- Discard the nuts.
- To install, tighten the new nuts to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Link >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Suspension - Rear Wheel Drive (RWD) > Page 5525
5. Remove and discard the stabilizer bracket bolt plates.
6. NOTE: Make sure the stabilizer bar bushing upset is installed into the bracket groove.
Inspect and, if necessary, install new stabilizer bar bushings.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Link >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Suspension - Rear Wheel Drive (RWD) > Page 5526
Stabilizer Link: Service and Repair Rear Suspension
Stabilizer Bar and Link
NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
Removal and Installation
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be
installed with the same part numbers or equivalent part, if replacement is necessary. Do not use a
replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified
during reassembly to make sure correct retention of these parts.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. NOTE: Use the hex-holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while removing the nut.
NOTE: The stabilizer bar links are designed with low friction ball joints that have a low breakaway
torque.
Remove the 4 stabilizer bar link nuts and the links.
- Discard the nuts.
- Remove the stone shields.
- To install, tighten the new nuts to 63 Nm (46 lb-ft).
3. Remove the 4 stabilizer bar bracket nuts, the 2 stabilizer bar brackets and the stabilizer bar.
- Discard the nuts.
- To install, tighten the new nuts to 48 Nm (35 lb-ft).
4. NOTE: Inspect and, if necessary, install new stabilizer bar bushings.
NOTE: The rear stabilizer bar must be installed with the center hump facing downward.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Link >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Suspension - Rear Wheel Drive (RWD) > Page 5527
NOTE: The rear stabilizer bar bushings must be installed outboard of the upset rings on the
stabilizer bar.
NOTE: The stabilizer bar link stone shields must be installed on the stabilizer bar attachment point.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Air
Dryer, Suspension Control > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Dryer: Service and Repair
Air Suspension Compressor Drier
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the air compressor. For additional information, refer to Air Suspension Compressor
See: Compressor/Pump/Service and Repair.
2. Remove the compressor drier screw.
- To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
3. NOTE: Make sure that the drier O-ring does not remain inside of the compressor assembly.
Rotate the compressor drier 90 degrees counterclockwise to unlock, then remove the air
compressor drier.
4. NOTE: Inspect the compressor drier O-ring for damage and install a new O-ring as necessary.
NOTE: When installing the air lines, make sure the white air line is fully inserted into the fitting for
correct installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Air
Spring > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Spring: > 08-24-7 > Dec > 08 >
Suspension - Rear Load Leveling Leak Down
Air Spring: Customer Interest Suspension - Rear Load Leveling Leak Down
TSB 08-24-7
12/08/08
REAR LOAD LEVELING LEAKS DOWN IN EXTREME COLD WEATHER
FORD: 2007-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Expedition and Navigators vehicles equipped with rear load leveling
suspension, may exhibit air suspension leak down on one or both rear corners after extended
periods of time in temperatures of -22 degrees Fahrenheit (-30 degrees Celsius) or below. The leak
down is the result of premature wear of solenoid seat at low temperatures.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Determine that concern occurs at -22 degrees Fahrenheit (-30 degrees Celsius) or below, after
sitting long periods of time, usually over night. If concern does not occur under these conditions, do
not continue with this procedure.
The concern may not be duplicated if the vehicle has been sitting inside for over 15 minutes.
Replace the air spring solenoid valve per Workshop Manual, Section 204-05: Vehicle Dynamic
Suspension.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082407A 2007-2009 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator: Replace ONE Rear Air Spring Solenoid. (Do Not Use With 5300A9 5300A, 12650D)
082407B 2007-2009 Expedition, 0.6 Hr.
Navigator: Replace BOTH Rear Air Spring Solenoids. (Do Not Use With 5300A9 5300A, 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3B486 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Air
Spring > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Spring: > 08-24-7 >
Dec > 08 > Suspension - Rear Load Leveling Leak Down
Air Spring: All Technical Service Bulletins Suspension - Rear Load Leveling Leak Down
TSB 08-24-7
12/08/08
REAR LOAD LEVELING LEAKS DOWN IN EXTREME COLD WEATHER
FORD: 2007-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Expedition and Navigators vehicles equipped with rear load leveling
suspension, may exhibit air suspension leak down on one or both rear corners after extended
periods of time in temperatures of -22 degrees Fahrenheit (-30 degrees Celsius) or below. The leak
down is the result of premature wear of solenoid seat at low temperatures.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Determine that concern occurs at -22 degrees Fahrenheit (-30 degrees Celsius) or below, after
sitting long periods of time, usually over night. If concern does not occur under these conditions, do
not continue with this procedure.
The concern may not be duplicated if the vehicle has been sitting inside for over 15 minutes.
Replace the air spring solenoid valve per Workshop Manual, Section 204-05: Vehicle Dynamic
Suspension.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082407A 2007-2009 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator: Replace ONE Rear Air Spring Solenoid. (Do Not Use With 5300A9 5300A, 12650D)
082407B 2007-2009 Expedition, 0.6 Hr.
Navigator: Replace BOTH Rear Air Spring Solenoids. (Do Not Use With 5300A9 5300A, 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3B486 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Compressor/Pump, Suspension Control > Component Information > Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Compressor/Pump, Suspension Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5548
Compressor/Pump: Service and Repair
Air Suspension Compressor
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Vent all air pressure from the air suspension system prior to disconnecting or removing
any air suspension components. It is dangerous to remove air suspension components while under
pressure. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
1. Remove the inner fender splash shield.
2. Disconnect the air line from the compressor drier.
- Compress the quick connect lock ring inward, then pull the line outward from the air drier.
3. Disconnect the air compressor air intake hose.
4. Disconnect the air compressor electrical connector.
5. Remove the 3 air compressor bracket bolts and remove the air compressor and bracket
assembly.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
6. NOTE: When installing the air lines, make sure the white inner air line is fully inserted into the
fitting for correct installation.
NOTE: Make sure that there are no objects trapped under or on the bracket. Make sure that the air
compressor is not in contact with any surrounding components that could cause vibration noises.
NOTE: Make sure that the air compressor moves freely in the rubber isolators. Make sure that the
bracket has no deformations that could cause the 3 rubber isolators to load against each other.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Level
Control Solenoid Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Level Control
Solenoid Valve: > 08-24-7 > Dec > 08 > Suspension - Rear Load Leveling Leak Down
Level Control Solenoid Valve: Customer Interest Suspension - Rear Load Leveling Leak Down
TSB 08-24-7
12/08/08
REAR LOAD LEVELING LEAKS DOWN IN EXTREME COLD WEATHER
FORD: 2007-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Expedition and Navigators vehicles equipped with rear load leveling
suspension, may exhibit air suspension leak down on one or both rear corners after extended
periods of time in temperatures of -22 degrees Fahrenheit (-30 degrees Celsius) or below. The leak
down is the result of premature wear of solenoid seat at low temperatures.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Determine that concern occurs at -22 degrees Fahrenheit (-30 degrees Celsius) or below, after
sitting long periods of time, usually over night. If concern does not occur under these conditions, do
not continue with this procedure.
The concern may not be duplicated if the vehicle has been sitting inside for over 15 minutes.
Replace the air spring solenoid valve per Workshop Manual, Section 204-05: Vehicle Dynamic
Suspension.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082407A 2007-2009 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator: Replace ONE Rear Air Spring Solenoid. (Do Not Use With 5300A9 5300A, 12650D)
082407B 2007-2009 Expedition, 0.6 Hr.
Navigator: Replace BOTH Rear Air Spring Solenoids. (Do Not Use With 5300A9 5300A, 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3B486 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Level
Control Solenoid Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Level
Control Solenoid Valve: > 08-24-7 > Dec > 08 > Suspension - Rear Load Leveling Leak Down
Level Control Solenoid Valve: All Technical Service Bulletins Suspension - Rear Load Leveling
Leak Down
TSB 08-24-7
12/08/08
REAR LOAD LEVELING LEAKS DOWN IN EXTREME COLD WEATHER
FORD: 2007-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Expedition and Navigators vehicles equipped with rear load leveling
suspension, may exhibit air suspension leak down on one or both rear corners after extended
periods of time in temperatures of -22 degrees Fahrenheit (-30 degrees Celsius) or below. The leak
down is the result of premature wear of solenoid seat at low temperatures.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Determine that concern occurs at -22 degrees Fahrenheit (-30 degrees Celsius) or below, after
sitting long periods of time, usually over night. If concern does not occur under these conditions, do
not continue with this procedure.
The concern may not be duplicated if the vehicle has been sitting inside for over 15 minutes.
Replace the air spring solenoid valve per Workshop Manual, Section 204-05: Vehicle Dynamic
Suspension.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082407A 2007-2009 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator: Replace ONE Rear Air Spring Solenoid. (Do Not Use With 5300A9 5300A, 12650D)
082407B 2007-2009 Expedition, 0.6 Hr.
Navigator: Replace BOTH Rear Air Spring Solenoids. (Do Not Use With 5300A9 5300A, 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3B486 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Level
Control Solenoid Valve > Component Information > Locations > Air Spring Solenoid Valve, Left Rear
Level Control Solenoid Valve: Locations Air Spring Solenoid Valve, Left Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Level
Control Solenoid Valve > Component Information > Locations > Air Spring Solenoid Valve, Left Rear > Page 5567
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Level
Control Solenoid Valve > Component Information > Locations > Air Spring Solenoid Valve, Left Rear > Page 5568
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Level
Control Solenoid Valve > Component Information > Locations > Air Spring Solenoid Valve, Left Rear > Page 5569
Level Control Solenoid Valve: Locations Air Spring Solenoid Valve, Right Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Level
Control Solenoid Valve > Component Information > Locations > Air Spring Solenoid Valve, Left Rear > Page 5570
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Level
Control Solenoid Valve > Component Information > Diagrams > Air Spring Solenoid Valve, Left Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Level
Control Solenoid Valve > Component Information > Diagrams > Air Spring Solenoid Valve, Left Rear > Page 5573
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Level
Control Solenoid Valve > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5574
Level Control Solenoid Valve: Service and Repair
Air Spring Solenoid Valve
Removal and Installation
1. If the air spring solenoid valve is functional, use the scan tool to vent the appropriate air
spring(s).
2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
3. Disconnect the air spring solenoid valve electrical connector.
4. Disconnect the air line at the air valve.
- Compress the orange quick connect lock ring, then pull downward on the air supply line.
5. NOTICE: Remove any dirt or other foreign material from the air spring assembly prior to
removing the air spring solenoid valve from
the air spring assembly, or damage to the solenoid valve and air spring may occur.
Remove the air spring solenoid clip.
6. WARNING: Vent all air pressure from the air suspension system prior to disconnecting or
removing any air suspension components. It is
dangerous to remove air suspension components while under pressure. Failure to follow this
instruction may result in serious personal injury.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Level
Control Solenoid Valve > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5575
The air spring solenoid valve has a 2-stage release. Vent the air spring using the following
procedure:
1. Carefully rotate the air spring solenoid counterclockwise until it reaches the first stage and allow
the air in the spring to completely vent.
2. Rotate the solenoid counterclockwise to the second stage and remove the solenoid.
7. NOTE: Inspect the air spring O-ring for damage and install a new O-ring as necessary. Lightly
lubricate the solenoid seal area with silicone
grease.
NOTE: After installing the solenoid, it is necessary to inflate the air suspension system. For
additional information, refer to Ride Height Adjustments See: Service and Repair/Ride Height
Adjustments.
NOTE: When installing the air spring solenoid, make sure that the electrical connector is positioned
away from the air spring.
NOTE: When installing the air lines, make sure the air line is fully inserted into the fitting for correct
installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Ride
Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Service and Repair
Ride Height Sensor: Service and Repair
Suspension Height Sensor
LH Side
RH Side
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Ride
Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5579
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Disconnect the height sensor harness from the sensor bracket.
3. Disconnect the height sensor electrical connector.
4. Disconnect the height sensor arm from the ball stud on the lower control arm.
5. Remove and discard the 2 height sensor bolts.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
6. NOTE: The RH and LH height sensor assemblies cannot be used on opposite sides of the
vehicle.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
7. Calibrate the LH and RH height sensors. For additional information, refer to Ride Height
Adjustments See: Service and Repair/Ride Height
Adjustments.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Suspension Control Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 5583
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 5584
Suspension Control Module: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 5585
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 5586
Suspension Control Module: Service and Repair
Vehicle Dynamics Module (VDM)
Removal and Installation
NOTICE: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these charges,
damage may result.
1. NOTE: The Vehicle Dynamics Module (VDM) is mounted to the lower left side of the dash above
the parking brake control.
Disconnect the 2 VDM electrical connectors.
2. Remove the VDM bracket nuts and the module.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
3. NOTE: The VDM is calibrated with information from the ride height sensors. A new or exchanged
VDM requires that the LH and RH ride height
sensors are calibrated and a Pneumatic Test is carried out. For additional information, refer to
Vehicle Dynamic Suspension See: Testing and Inspection Calibration Initialize System - Clear
C1990 and C1991 DTCs.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Suspension - Rear Wheel Drive (RWD)
Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): Service and Repair Front Suspension - Rear Wheel Drive (RWD)
Shock Absorber and Spring Assembly
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Suspension - Rear Wheel Drive (RWD) > Page 5591
Removal
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be
installed with the same part numbers or equivalent parts, if replacement is necessary. Do not use a
replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified
during reassembly to make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove and discard the shock absorber upper mount nuts.
2. Remove the wheel and tire.
3. Remove and discard the tie-rod end nut.
4. Using the Ball Joint Separator, separate the tie-rod end from the wheel knuckle.
5. Detach the flexible hose retainer from the speed sensor harness.
6. Remove the brake flexible hose bracket bolt and disconnect the bracket from the wheel knuckle.
7. Remove and discard the upper ball joint nut.
8. Remove and discard the shock absorber lower nut and bolt.
9. Using the Ball Joint Separator, disconnect the upper arm ball joint from the wheel knuckle and
remove the shock absorber and spring assembly.
10. NOTE: If the individual spring and/or shock components are not being serviced, continue to the
Installation procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Suspension - Rear Wheel Drive (RWD) > Page 5592
NOTE: For reference during assembly, index-mark the upper mount, spring and shock absorber.
Using a suitable spring compressor, compress the spring until the tension is released from the
shock absorber.
11. NOTE: Use the hex-holding feature to prevent the shock rod from turning while removing the
nut.
While holding the shock rod, remove the nut and the shock absorber.
- Discard the nut.
12. Remove the upper mount, dust boot and insulator.
Installation
NOTICE: Do not tighten the lower shock nut until the installation procedure is complete and the
weight of the vehicle is resting on the wheel and tire assemblies or incorrect clamp load and
bushing damage may occur.
1. Position the shock absorber and spring and install the dust boot, insulator and the upper mount.
2. NOTE: Align the index marks made during disassembly.
Using a suitable spring compressor, compress the spring until the tension is released from the
shock absorber.
3. NOTE: Use the hex-holding feature to prevent the shock rod from turning while installing the nut.
Using the hex-holding feature to hold the shock rod, install the shock absorber and the shock rod
nut.
- Tighten the new nut to 56 Nm (41 lb-ft).
4. Install the shock absorber and spring assembly and connect the upper arm ball joint to the wheel
knuckle.
- Tighten the new nut to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Suspension - Rear Wheel Drive (RWD) > Page 5593
5. NOTE: Do not tighten the nut at this time.
Loosely install the new shock absorber lower nut and bolt.
6. Connect the brake flexible hose bracket to the wheel knuckle and install the bolt.
- Tighten the bolt to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
7. Attach the flexible hose retainer to the speed sensor harness.
8. Install the tie-rod end nut.
- Tighten to 150 Nm (111 lb-ft).
9. Install the wheel and tire.
10. Install the new shock absorber upper mount nuts.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
11. With the weight of the vehicle on the wheel and tire, tighten the shock absorber lower nut to
550 Nm (406 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Suspension - Rear Wheel Drive (RWD) > Page 5594
Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): Service and Repair Rear Suspension
Shock Absorber and Spring Assembly
Removal and Installation
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be
installed with the same part numbers or equivalent part, if replacement is necessary. Do not use a
replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified
during reassembly to make sure correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the lower arm. For additional information, refer to Lower Arm See: Control Arm/Service
and Repair/Rear Suspension/Lower Arm.
2. Remove and discard the shock absorber upper mount nuts.
- To install, tighten the new nuts to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3. Remove the shock absorber and spring assembly.
4. NOTE: If the individual spring and/or shock components are not being serviced, continue with
Step 7.
NOTE: For reference during assembly, index-mark the upper mount, spring and shock absorber.
Using a suitable spring compressor, compress the spring until the tension is released from the
shock absorber.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Suspension - Rear Wheel Drive (RWD) > Page 5595
5. While holding the shock rod, remove the nut and washer.
- Remove the shock absorber.
- Discard the nut.
- To install, tighten the new nut to 56 Nm (41 lb-ft).
6. Remove the upper mount, dust boot and insulator.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Suspension
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Service and Repair Rear Suspension
Shock Absorber and Spring Assembly
Removal and Installation
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be
installed with the same part numbers or equivalent part, if replacement is necessary. Do not use a
replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified
during reassembly to make sure correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the lower arm. For additional information, refer to Lower Arm See: Control Arm/Service
and Repair/Rear Suspension/Lower Arm.
2. Remove and discard the shock absorber upper mount nuts.
- To install, tighten the new nuts to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3. Remove the shock absorber and spring assembly.
4. NOTE: If the individual spring and/or shock components are not being serviced, continue with
Step 7.
NOTE: For reference during assembly, index-mark the upper mount, spring and shock absorber.
Using a suitable spring compressor, compress the spring until the tension is released from the
shock absorber.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Suspension > Page 5600
5. While holding the shock rod, remove the nut and washer.
- Remove the shock absorber.
- Discard the nut.
- To install, tighten the new nut to 56 Nm (41 lb-ft).
6. Remove the upper mount, dust boot and insulator.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Suspension > Page 5601
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Service and Repair Front Suspension - Rear Wheel Drive
(RWD)
Shock Absorber and Spring Assembly
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Suspension > Page 5602
Removal
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be
installed with the same part numbers or equivalent parts, if replacement is necessary. Do not use a
replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified
during reassembly to make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove and discard the shock absorber upper mount nuts.
2. Remove the wheel and tire.
3. Remove and discard the tie-rod end nut.
4. Using the Ball Joint Separator, separate the tie-rod end from the wheel knuckle.
5. Detach the flexible hose retainer from the speed sensor harness.
6. Remove the brake flexible hose bracket bolt and disconnect the bracket from the wheel knuckle.
7. Remove and discard the upper ball joint nut.
8. Remove and discard the shock absorber lower nut and bolt.
9. Using the Ball Joint Separator, disconnect the upper arm ball joint from the wheel knuckle and
remove the shock absorber and spring assembly.
10. NOTE: If the individual spring and/or shock components are not being serviced, continue to the
Installation procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Suspension > Page 5603
NOTE: For reference during assembly, index-mark the upper mount, spring and shock absorber.
Using a suitable spring compressor, compress the spring until the tension is released from the
shock absorber.
11. NOTE: Use the hex-holding feature to prevent the shock rod from turning while removing the
nut.
While holding the shock rod, remove the nut and the shock absorber.
- Discard the nut.
12. Remove the upper mount, dust boot and insulator.
Installation
NOTICE: Do not tighten the lower shock nut until the installation procedure is complete and the
weight of the vehicle is resting on the wheel and tire assemblies or incorrect clamp load and
bushing damage may occur.
1. Position the shock absorber and spring and install the dust boot, insulator and the upper mount.
2. NOTE: Align the index marks made during disassembly.
Using a suitable spring compressor, compress the spring until the tension is released from the
shock absorber.
3. NOTE: Use the hex-holding feature to prevent the shock rod from turning while installing the nut.
Using the hex-holding feature to hold the shock rod, install the shock absorber and the shock rod
nut.
- Tighten the new nut to 56 Nm (41 lb-ft).
4. Install the shock absorber and spring assembly and connect the upper arm ball joint to the wheel
knuckle.
- Tighten the new nut to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Suspension > Page 5604
5. NOTE: Do not tighten the nut at this time.
Loosely install the new shock absorber lower nut and bolt.
6. Connect the brake flexible hose bracket to the wheel knuckle and install the bolt.
- Tighten the bolt to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
7. Attach the flexible hose retainer to the speed sensor harness.
8. Install the tie-rod end nut.
- Tighten to 150 Nm (111 lb-ft).
9. Install the wheel and tire.
10. Install the new shock absorber upper mount nuts.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
11. With the weight of the vehicle on the wheel and tire, tighten the shock absorber lower nut to
550 Nm (406 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Suspension > Page 5605
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Service and Repair Vehicle Dynamic Suspension
Air Shock Absorber - Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Suspension > Page 5606
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not apply heat or flame to the shock absorber or strut tube. The shock absorber
and strut tube are gas pressurized and could explode if heated. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Vent all air pressure from the air suspension system prior to disconnecting or removing
any air suspension components. It is dangerous to remove air suspension components while under
pressure. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
NOTICE: Vehicles built prior to 12/03/2007 use a longer air spring and shock absorber than
vehicles built after 12/03/2007. To prevent component damage, it is important to use the correct air
spring and or shock absorber when replacing these parts.
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the
same part number must be used if installation is necessary. Do not use a new part of lesser quality
or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to make sure of
correct retention of these parts.
1. Using the scan tool, vent the appropriate air spring.
2. Remove the lower arm.
3. Disconnect the air spring solenoid valve electrical connector.
4. Disconnect the air line at the air valve.
- Compress the orange quick connect lock ring, then pull downward on the air supply line.
5. Remove and discard the 3 shock upper nuts.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
6. Remove the air shock absorber.
7. NOTE: If the individual spring and/or shock components are not being serviced, continue with
Step 14.
NOTE: Use the hex-holding feature to prevent the shock rod from turning while removing the nut.
Remove and discard the shock rod nut.
- To install, tighten to 45 Nm (33 lb-ft).
8. Remove the shock rod upper washer and O-ring seal.
- Discard the O-ring seal washer.
9. NOTICE: If the retainer tabs are broken, a new air spring must be installed, or failure of the air
spring may occur.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Suspension > Page 5607
NOTE: Index-mark the air spring and shock absorber for reference during the installation
procedure.
Depress the retainer tabs and remove the air spring.
10. Remove the shock rod lower O-ring seal, washer and jounce bumper.
- Discard the seal and washer.
11. Remove and discard the 2 air spring lower O-ring seals.
12. Remove the 2 upper mount screws and the upper mount.
- Discard the screws.
- To install, tighten the new screws to 4 Nm (35 lb-in).
13. Remove and discard the 2 air spring upper O-ring seals.
14. NOTICE: Use a suitable press to install the upper mount retainer pins. Do not use a hammer or
damage may occur.
NOTICE: When installing the upper and lower shock rod O-ring seals and washers, it is important
to install the washers with the flat face side positioned against the O-ring seals. Damage to the
O-ring seals will occur if the rounded face side of the washers is positioned against the O-ring
seals.
NOTE: Make sure that all seals are clean and free of debris.
NOTE: Apply a thin coat of grease to the new O-ring seals.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Trailing Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Trailing Arm - Upper
Trailing Arm: Service and Repair Trailing Arm - Upper
Trailing Arm - Upper
Removal
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be
installed with the same part numbers or equivalent part, if replacement is necessary. Do not use a
replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified
during reassembly to make sure correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the wheel and tire.
2. Remove and discard the upper trailing arm-to-wheel knuckle bolt.
3. Remove and discard the upper trailing arm-to-frame bolt and flagnut.
4. NOTE: After removal of the upper trailing arm, inspect the knuckle bushing for excessive wear or
damage and install new as necessary. For
additional information, refer to Wheel Knuckle Bushing See: Rear Knuckle/Service and
Repair/Wheel Knuckle Bushing.
Remove the upper trailing arm.
Installation
1. NOTE: Do not tighten the bolt at this time.
Install the upper trailing arm and loosely install the new upper trailing arm-to-frame bolt and flagnut.
2. NOTE: Do not tighten the bolt at this time.
Loosely install the new upper trailing arm-to-wheel knuckle bolt.
3. Install the wheel and tire.
4. Lower the vehicle so that the weight of the vehicle is resting on the wheel and tires.
5. Tighten the upper trailing arm-to-frame bolt and flagnut to 275 Nm (203 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Trailing Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Trailing Arm - Upper > Page 5612
6. Tighten the upper trailing arm-to-wheel knuckle bolt to 250 Nm (184 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Trailing Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Trailing Arm - Upper > Page 5613
Trailing Arm: Service and Repair Trailing Arm - Lower
Trailing Arm - Lower
Removal
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be
installed with the same part numbers or equivalent part, if replacement is necessary. Do not use a
replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified
during reassembly to make sure correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the wheel and tire.
2. Remove and discard the 2 lower trailing arm-to-wheel knuckle bolts.
3. Remove and discard the lower trailing arm-to-frame bolt and flagnut.
4. Remove the lower trailing arm.
Installation
1. NOTE: Do not tighten the bolt at this time.
Install the lower trailing arm and loosely install the new lower trailing arm-to-frame bolt and flagnut.
2. NOTE: Do not tighten the bolt at this time.
Loosely install the 2 new lower trailing arm-to-wheel knuckle bolts.
3. Install the wheel and tire.
4. Lower the vehicle so that the weight of the vehicle is resting on the wheel and tires.
5. Tighten the 2 lower trailing arm-to-wheel knuckle bolts to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
6. Tighten the lower trailing arm-to-frame bolt to 275 Nm (203 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Suspension
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front Suspension
Wheel Bearing and Wheel Hub
Removal and Installation
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be
installed with the same part numbers or equivalent parts, if replacement is necessary. Do not use a
replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified
during reassembly to make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector.
2. Remove the wheel and tire.
3. Remove the wheel speed sensor harness bracket bolt and detach the harness from the
retainers.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 5618
4. NOTICE: Do not allow the caliper and anchor plate assembly to hang from the brake hose or
damage to the hose may result.
Remove the 2 bolts and position the caliper and anchor plate aside.
- Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
- To install, tighten to 200 Nm (148 lb-ft).
5. Remove the brake disc.
6. Remove the 4 bolts and the wheel bearing and wheel hub.
- Discard the bolts.
- To install, tighten to 175 Nm (129 lb-ft).
7. If installing a new wheel bearing and wheel hub, remove the wheel speed sensor bolt and the
wheel speed sensor.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
8. NOTICE: If the original wheel bearing and wheel hub is being installed, a new O-ring seal must
be installed or damage to the wheel
bearing may occur.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 5619
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear Suspension
Wheel Bearing and Wheel Hub
Removal
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts and
systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be installed with the
same part numbers or equivalent part, if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement
part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during
reassembly to make sure of correct retention of these parts.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 5620
1. Remove the wheel and tire.
2. NOTE: Have an assistant press the brake pedal to keep the axle from rotating.
Remove and discard the halfshaft nut.
3. Using a suitable hub puller, separate the outboard CV joint from the wheel hub.
4. NOTICE: Do not allow the caliper and anchor plate assembly to hang from the brake hose or
damage to the hose may result.
Remove the bolts and position the caliper and anchor plate assembly aside.
- Support the caliper and anchor plate assembly using mechanic's wire.
5. Remove the brake disc.
6. Detach the wheel speed sensor harness from the retainers and disconnect the wheel speed
sensor electrical connector. Push the wheel speed sensor
harness grommet through the brake disc shield.
7. Remove the 4 bolts, the wheel bearing and wheel hub, and the wheel speed sensor as an
assembly.
- Route the sensor wiring through the access hole in the brake disc shield.
- Discard the bolts.
8. If necessary, remove the wheel speed sensor bolt and the wheel speed sensor from the wheel
bearing and wheel hub.
Installation
1. If necessary, install the wheel speed sensor and bolt.
- Tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
2. Position the wheel bearing and wheel hub, and the wheel speed sensor. Install the 4 new wheel
bearing and wheel hub bolts.
- Route the sensor wiring through the access hole in the brake disc shield.
- Tighten to 175 Nm (129 lb-ft).
3. Attach the wheel speed sensor harness to the retainers and connect the wheel speed sensor
electrical connector. Push the wheel speed sensor
harness grommet through the brake disc shield.
4. Install the brake disc.
5. Position the caliper and anchor plate assembly and install the bolts.
- Tighten to 190 Nm (140 lb-ft).
6. NOTE: Have an assistant press the brake pedal to keep the axle from rotating.
Install the new halfshaft nut.
- Tighten to 300 Nm (221 lb-ft).
7. Install the wheel and tire.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
Rear Suspension
Wheel Bearing and Wheel Hub
Install the new halfshaft nut, tighten to
.................................................................................................................................................... 300
Nm (221 lb-ft)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub > Wheel Hub Lock Solenoid > Component
Information > Locations
Wheel Hub Lock Solenoid: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub > Wheel Hub Lock Solenoid > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5628
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub > Wheel Hub Lock Solenoid > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5629
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub (Locking) > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Wheel Hub (Locking): Service and Repair
Integrated Wheel End (IWE)
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the front wheel and tire.
3. Remove the dust cap.
4. Remove and discard the axle nut.
5. Disconnect the vacuum tubes from the Integrated Wheel End (IWE).
6. Remove the 3 IWE-to-wheel knuckle retaining bolts.
7. Remove the tie-rod nut and separate the tie rod from the wheel knuckle.
- Discard the tie-rod nut.
8. Remove the wheel speed sensor harness bracket bolt and position the harness aside.
9. Remove the front brake flexible hose bracket bolt and position the brake hose aside.
10. Remove the upper ball joint nut and separate the upper ball joint from the wheel knuckle.
- Discard the upper ball joint nut.
11. NOTE: Allow the wheel knuckle to swing outward while keeping the halfshaft pushed inward.
Once clearance is available, remove the halfshaft outboard end from the wheel knuckle hub
bearing.
12. Remove the IWE from the halfshaft outboard end.
Installation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub (Locking) > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 5633
1. Compress the IWE and install a vacuum cap on the vacuum port.
2. NOTICE: Do not dislodge the Integrated Wheel End (IWE) seal spring when installing the IWE
on halfshaft outboard end or component
damage may occur.
Install the IWE onto the halfshaft outboard end.
3. NOTE: Allow the wheel knuckle to swing outward while keeping the halfshaft pushed inward.
Once clearance is available, install the halfshaft outboard end into the wheel knuckle hub bearing.
4. Connect the upper ball joint and install a new nut.
- Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
5. Connect the tie rod and install a new nut.
- Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
6. Position the front brake flexible hose bracket and install the bolt.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
7. Position the wheel speed sensor harness bracket and install the bolt.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
8. Install the 3 IWE-to-wheel knuckle retaining bolts.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
9. Remove the IWE vacuum cap and connect the vacuum tubes.
10. NOTICE: Verify the spline engagement by checking for spline lash before installing the axle nut
or component damage may occur.
Install the new axle nut.
- Tighten to 27 Nm (20 lb-ft).
11. Install the dust cap.
12. Install the front wheel and tire.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Vehicle Lifting: Description and Operation
Jacking and Lifting
Jacking Points - Front
WARNING: Shut off the electrical power to the air suspension system prior to hoisting or jacking an
air suspension equipped vehicle. Failure to do so may result in unexpected inflation or deflation of
the air springs, which may result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations. Failure to follow
this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Turn off (disable) the power running boards (if equipped) before jacking, lifting or
placing any object under the vehicle.
Never place your hand between the power running board and the vehicle. Extended power running
boards will retract when doors are closed.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: When jacking or lifting the vehicle, block all wheels remaining on the ground. Set the
parking brake if the rear wheels will remain on the ground. These actions help prevent unintended
vehicle movement. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Never get underneath a vehicle that is supported only by a jack. The jack could
unintentionally lower. Always support vehicle with floor stands. Failure to follow these instructions
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Only raise the vehicle when positioned on a hard, level surface. Attempting to raise the
vehicle on an uneven or soft surface may result in vehicle slipping or falling from the jack or
jackstand. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Identify the correct jacking points by locating the triangle stamped into the uni-body
sheet metal or vehicle frame. Raising a vehicle in any other location may result in vehicle shifting or
falling. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
NOTICE: The jack provided with the vehicle is intended to be used in an emergency for changing a
deflated tire. To avoid damage to the vehicle, never use the jack to hoist the vehicle for any other
purpose.
NOTICE: To prevent possible damage to the underbody, do not drive the vehicle onto the drive-on
lift without first checking for possible interference.
NOTICE: Damage to the suspension, exhaust or steering linkage components may occur if care is
not exercised when positioning the hoist adapters prior to lifting the vehicle.
The front jacking point is indicated by an arrow cutout in the frame, located behind the front tire and
wheel.
Jacking Points - Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 5638
NOTICE: Do not use the differential housing as a lift point. Leaks or damage to the rear axle cover
and adjoining differential housing surface may occur if a floor jack or any lifting device is allowed to
contact the cover at any point where the cover joins the housing.
The rear jacking point is indicated by an arrow cutout in the frame, located in front of the rear tire
and wheel.
Lifting Points - Front and Rear
Locate the front hoist adapters and rear hoist adapters as indicated.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Training
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Training
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training
NOTE: If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, the sensors will go into a "sleep
mode" to conserve battery power. It will be necessary to wake them up so they will transmit the
latest tire pressure information to the Smart Junction Box (SJB). For additional information, refer to
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Activation See: Tire Monitoring System/Testing
and Inspection/Programming and Relearning.
NOTE: The tire pressure sensor training procedure must be done on a single vehicle, in an area
without radio frequency noise and at least 1 m (3 ft) away from other vehicles equipped with a Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS). Radio frequency noise is generated by electrical motors and
appliance operation, cellular telephones, remote transmitters, power inverters and portable
entertainment equipment.
NOTE: If a sensor does not respond to the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool, attempt to
activate the same sensor with the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. If the sensor still does not
respond, move the vehicle to rotate the wheels at least one-fourth of a turn and attempt to activate
the same sensor again.
NOTE: The SJB has a 2-minute time limit between sensor responses. If the SJB does not
recognize any 1 of the 4 tire pressure sensors during this time limit, the horn will sound twice and
the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE NOT TRAINED REPEAT and the entire
procedure must be repeated.
NOTE: For vehicles with different front and rear tire pressures (such as the E-Series and certain
F-Series), the tire pressure sensors must be trained following a tire rotation. Failure to train the
sensors will cause the TPMS indicator to illuminate. For vehicles with the same tire pressure for
front and rear tires, tire rotation will not affect the system.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position, then press and release the brake pedal.
2. Cycle the ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN
position.
3. Press and release the brake pedal.
4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
5. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN
position.
- The horn will sound once and the TPMS indicator will flash if the training mode has been entered
successfully. If equipped, the message center will display TRAIN LF TIRE.
6. NOTE: It may take up to 6 seconds to activate a tire pressure sensor. During this time, the Tire
Pressure Monitor Activation Tool must remain in
place 180 degrees from the valve stem.
Place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the LF tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees) from
the valve stem. Press and release the test button on the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. The
horn will sound briefly to indicate that the tire pressure sensor has been recognized by the SJB.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Training > Page 5644
7. Within 2 minutes of the horn sounding, place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the RF
tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees) from the
valve stem and press and release the test button to train the RF tire pressure sensor.
8. NOTE: Do not wait more than 2 minutes between training each sensor or the SJB will time out
and the entire procedure must be repeated.
Repeat Step 7 for the RR and LR tires.
The procedure is completed after the last tire has been trained. When the training procedure is
complete, the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE TRAINING COMPLETE.
For vehicles not equipped with a message center, successful completion of the training procedure
will be verified by turning the ignition switch to the OFF position without the horn sounding. If the
horn sounds twice when the switch is turned to the OFF position, the training procedure was not
successful.
9. Using the scan tool, locate the updated TPMS sensor identifiers trained to the SJB and
document them on the applicable warranty claim.
10. NOTE: This step is required to clear DTC C2780, cause the SJB to exit the manufacturing
mode and to make sure there are no other concerns
with a newly programmed SJB.
If the sensors are being trained due to the installation of a new SJB, clear any DTCs and carry out
the SJB On-Demand Self Test.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Training > Page 5645
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Activation
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Activation
NOTE: The tire pressure sensors will go into a "sleep mode" after 30 minutes of inactivity to
conserve battery power. The sensors do not transmit information while in sleep mode. It will be
necessary to wake them up so they will transmit the latest tire pressure information.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
2. Position the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool against the LF tire sidewall, 180 degrees from
the tire valve stem.
3. NOTE: The Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool will provide feedback in the form of a flashing
green light and a beep sound for each
successful response from a tire pressure sensor.
Press the test button on the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool to activate the sensor, activate
the sensor at least 2 times.
4. Repeat Steps 2 and 3 for the remaining tires.
5. If the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) indicator remains illuminated after adjusting and
activating each sensor, refer to the Symptom
Chart in Diagnosis and Testing. See: Tire Monitoring System/Testing and Inspection/Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Disassembly
WARNING: The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) sensor battery may release hazardous
chemicals if exposed to extreme mechanical damage. If these chemicals contact the skin or eyes,
flush immediately with water for a minimum of 15 minutes and get prompt medical attention. If any
part of the battery is swallowed, contact a physician immediately. When disposing of TPMS
sensors, follow the correct procedures for hazardous material disposal. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in serious personal injury.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application. When
installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color of the
sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor can be removed and installed without removing the strap or the cradle.
1. NOTICE: The sensor, cradle and strap may be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Dismount the tire only as instructed.
Remove the tire from the wheel. For additional information, refer to Wheel and Tire See: Service
and Repair/Overhaul.
2. NOTICE: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to the
sensor locking clip may occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver or similar tool, remove the sensor locking clip.
3. NOTICE: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to the
sensor may occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver or similar tool, detach the sensor from the cradle.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor >
Page 5648
4. Remove the sensor.
Assembly
1. NOTICE: Damage to the sensor may occur if excessive force is applied during sensor
installation.
NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the cradle. The sensor will make a "click" noise
when correctly seated.
Position the sensor into the cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end of the
cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. NOTE: The locking clip can only be fully seated when installed in the correct orientation. If the
sensor locking clip cannot be fully inserted, then
the sensor may not be fully seated on the cradle or the locking clip may be inserted backward.
Insert a new locking clip into the sensor.
3. NOTICE: The sensor, cradle and strap may be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel. For additional information, refer to Wheel and Tire See: Service and
Repair/Overhaul.
4. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s). For additional information, refer to Tire Pressure Monitoring
System (TPMS) Sensor Training See: Tire Monitoring System/Testing and Inspection/Monitors,
Trips, Drive Cycles and Readiness Codes.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor >
Page 5649
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and
Cradle
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and Cradle
Disassembly
WARNING: The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) sensor battery may release hazardous
chemicals if exposed to extreme mechanical damage. If these chemicals contact the skin or eyes,
flush immediately with water for a minimum of 15 minutes and get prompt medical attention. If any
part of the battery is swallowed, contact a physician immediately. When disposing of TPMS
sensors, follow the correct procedures for hazardous material disposal. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in serious personal injury.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application. When
installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color of the
sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor is available separately, the cradle and strap are available as a strap kit. There
are several different strap kits available based on wheel diameter, but all strap kits share the same
base part number.
1. Remove the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) sensor. For additional information, refer to
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Sensor See: Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor.
2. WARNING: Always wear eye protection when servicing a vehicle. Failure to follow this
instruction may result in serious personal injury.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor >
Page 5650
WARNING: Wear protective gloves when handling components or parts that have pointed or sharp
edges. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
Remove a factory-installed strap in the following sequence:
1. Locate the strap buckle and secure the strap to the wheel using duct tape or a similar item on
both sides of the buckle, approximately 25 mm
(0.98 in) from the buckle.
2. Using a large screwdriver and a twisting motion, unbuckle the strap.
3. Discard the strap.
3. To remove a dealer-installed strap, turn the worm gear screw until the strap is fully released from
the worm gear.
- Discard the strap.
4. NOTE: To aid assembly, mark the location of the cradle prior to disassembly.
Using a screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the cradle by inserting the screwdriver under the cradle
and prying up.
Assembly
1. NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the new cradle. The sensor will make a "click"
noise when fully seated.
Position the sensor into the new cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end
of the cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. NOTICE: Metal scrapers may damage the wheel. Use only plastic or non-metallic scrapers to
remove the cradle adhesive strip residue.
NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be installed in the drop well of the wheel, 180 degrees from the
valve stem.
Using wheel and tire cleaner, clean the area where the sensor and cradle are to be installed.
3. NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be positioned with the hinge side of the sensor on the RH
side when viewed from the curb side (beauty side)
of the wheel.
NOTE: The sensor has raised markings indicating how to position the sensor.
Remove the adhesive tape liner from the cradle and position the sensor and cradle into the wheel
drop well 180 degrees from the valve stem.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor >
Page 5651
4. Install the tapered end of the strap through the opening of the cradle on the hinge side of the
sensor. This will position the worm gear on the
locking clip side of the sensor.
5. NOTICE: Steel wheels have a "high spot" along their circumference. Make sure the strap and
sensor are mounted at the lowest spot
possible to avoid damaging the sensor during wheel and tire disassembly and assembly.
NOTE: Keep the strap parallel with the wheel flange while tightening the worm gear.
Position the worm gear 13-26 mm (0.5-1.0 in) away from the sensor and tighten the worm gear.
- Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
6. NOTICE: The sensor, cradle and strap may be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel. For additional information, refer to Wheel and Tire See: Service and
Repair/Overhaul.
7. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s). For additional information, refer to Tire Pressure Monitoring
System (TPMS) Sensor Training See: Tire Monitoring System/Testing and Inspection/Monitors,
Trips, Drive Cycles and Readiness Codes.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Training
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training
NOTE: If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, the sensors will go into a "sleep
mode" to conserve battery power. It will be necessary to wake them up so they will transmit the
latest tire pressure information to the Smart Junction Box (SJB). For additional information, refer to
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Activation See: Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning.
NOTE: The tire pressure sensor training procedure must be done on a single vehicle, in an area
without radio frequency noise and at least 1 m (3 ft) away from other vehicles equipped with a Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS). Radio frequency noise is generated by electrical motors and
appliance operation, cellular telephones, remote transmitters, power inverters and portable
entertainment equipment.
NOTE: If a sensor does not respond to the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool, attempt to
activate the same sensor with the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. If the sensor still does not
respond, move the vehicle to rotate the wheels at least one-fourth of a turn and attempt to activate
the same sensor again.
NOTE: The SJB has a 2-minute time limit between sensor responses. If the SJB does not
recognize any 1 of the 4 tire pressure sensors during this time limit, the horn will sound twice and
the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE NOT TRAINED REPEAT and the entire
procedure must be repeated.
NOTE: For vehicles with different front and rear tire pressures (such as the E-Series and certain
F-Series), the tire pressure sensors must be trained following a tire rotation. Failure to train the
sensors will cause the TPMS indicator to illuminate. For vehicles with the same tire pressure for
front and rear tires, tire rotation will not affect the system.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position, then press and release the brake pedal.
2. Cycle the ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN
position.
3. Press and release the brake pedal.
4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
5. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN
position.
- The horn will sound once and the TPMS indicator will flash if the training mode has been entered
successfully. If equipped, the message center will display TRAIN LF TIRE.
6. NOTE: It may take up to 6 seconds to activate a tire pressure sensor. During this time, the Tire
Pressure Monitor Activation Tool must remain in
place 180 degrees from the valve stem.
Place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the LF tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees) from
the valve stem. Press and release the test button on the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. The
horn will sound briefly to indicate that the tire pressure sensor has been recognized by the SJB.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training > Page
5657
7. Within 2 minutes of the horn sounding, place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the RF
tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees) from the
valve stem and press and release the test button to train the RF tire pressure sensor.
8. NOTE: Do not wait more than 2 minutes between training each sensor or the SJB will time out
and the entire procedure must be repeated.
Repeat Step 7 for the RR and LR tires.
The procedure is completed after the last tire has been trained. When the training procedure is
complete, the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE TRAINING COMPLETE.
For vehicles not equipped with a message center, successful completion of the training procedure
will be verified by turning the ignition switch to the OFF position without the horn sounding. If the
horn sounds twice when the switch is turned to the OFF position, the training procedure was not
successful.
9. Using the scan tool, locate the updated TPMS sensor identifiers trained to the SJB and
document them on the applicable warranty claim.
10. NOTE: This step is required to clear DTC C2780, cause the SJB to exit the manufacturing
mode and to make sure there are no other concerns
with a newly programmed SJB.
If the sensors are being trained due to the installation of a new SJB, clear any DTCs and carry out
the SJB On-Demand Self Test.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training > Page
5658
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Activation
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Activation
NOTE: The tire pressure sensors will go into a "sleep mode" after 30 minutes of inactivity to
conserve battery power. The sensors do not transmit information while in sleep mode. It will be
necessary to wake them up so they will transmit the latest tire pressure information.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
2. Position the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool against the LF tire sidewall, 180 degrees from
the tire valve stem.
3. NOTE: The Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool will provide feedback in the form of a flashing
green light and a beep sound for each
successful response from a tire pressure sensor.
Press the test button on the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool to activate the sensor, activate
the sensor at least 2 times.
4. Repeat Steps 2 and 3 for the remaining tires.
5. If the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) indicator remains illuminated after adjusting and
activating each sensor, refer to the Symptom
Chart in Diagnosis and Testing. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic
Procedures
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Disassembly
WARNING: The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) sensor battery may release hazardous
chemicals if exposed to extreme mechanical damage. If these chemicals contact the skin or eyes,
flush immediately with water for a minimum of 15 minutes and get prompt medical attention. If any
part of the battery is swallowed, contact a physician immediately. When disposing of TPMS
sensors, follow the correct procedures for hazardous material disposal. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in serious personal injury.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application. When
installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color of the
sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor can be removed and installed without removing the strap or the cradle.
1. NOTICE: The sensor, cradle and strap may be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Dismount the tire only as instructed.
Remove the tire from the wheel. For additional information, refer to Wheel and Tire See: Service
and Repair/Overhaul.
2. NOTICE: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to the
sensor locking clip may occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver or similar tool, remove the sensor locking clip.
3. NOTICE: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to the
sensor may occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver or similar tool, detach the sensor from the cradle.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 5661
4. Remove the sensor.
Assembly
1. NOTICE: Damage to the sensor may occur if excessive force is applied during sensor
installation.
NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the cradle. The sensor will make a "click" noise
when correctly seated.
Position the sensor into the cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end of the
cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. NOTE: The locking clip can only be fully seated when installed in the correct orientation. If the
sensor locking clip cannot be fully inserted, then
the sensor may not be fully seated on the cradle or the locking clip may be inserted backward.
Insert a new locking clip into the sensor.
3. NOTICE: The sensor, cradle and strap may be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel. For additional information, refer to Wheel and Tire See: Service and
Repair/Overhaul.
4. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s). For additional information, refer to Tire Pressure Monitoring
System (TPMS) Sensor Training See: Testing and Inspection/Monitors, Trips, Drive Cycles and
Readiness Codes.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 5662
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and
Cradle
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and Cradle
Disassembly
WARNING: The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) sensor battery may release hazardous
chemicals if exposed to extreme mechanical damage. If these chemicals contact the skin or eyes,
flush immediately with water for a minimum of 15 minutes and get prompt medical attention. If any
part of the battery is swallowed, contact a physician immediately. When disposing of TPMS
sensors, follow the correct procedures for hazardous material disposal. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in serious personal injury.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application. When
installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color of the
sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor is available separately, the cradle and strap are available as a strap kit. There
are several different strap kits available based on wheel diameter, but all strap kits share the same
base part number.
1. Remove the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) sensor. For additional information, refer to
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Sensor See: Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor.
2. WARNING: Always wear eye protection when servicing a vehicle. Failure to follow this
instruction may result in serious personal injury.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 5663
WARNING: Wear protective gloves when handling components or parts that have pointed or sharp
edges. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
Remove a factory-installed strap in the following sequence:
1. Locate the strap buckle and secure the strap to the wheel using duct tape or a similar item on
both sides of the buckle, approximately 25 mm
(0.98 in) from the buckle.
2. Using a large screwdriver and a twisting motion, unbuckle the strap.
3. Discard the strap.
3. To remove a dealer-installed strap, turn the worm gear screw until the strap is fully released from
the worm gear.
- Discard the strap.
4. NOTE: To aid assembly, mark the location of the cradle prior to disassembly.
Using a screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the cradle by inserting the screwdriver under the cradle
and prying up.
Assembly
1. NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the new cradle. The sensor will make a "click"
noise when fully seated.
Position the sensor into the new cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end
of the cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. NOTICE: Metal scrapers may damage the wheel. Use only plastic or non-metallic scrapers to
remove the cradle adhesive strip residue.
NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be installed in the drop well of the wheel, 180 degrees from the
valve stem.
Using wheel and tire cleaner, clean the area where the sensor and cradle are to be installed.
3. NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be positioned with the hinge side of the sensor on the RH
side when viewed from the curb side (beauty side)
of the wheel.
NOTE: The sensor has raised markings indicating how to position the sensor.
Remove the adhesive tape liner from the cradle and position the sensor and cradle into the wheel
drop well 180 degrees from the valve stem.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 5664
4. Install the tapered end of the strap through the opening of the cradle on the hinge side of the
sensor. This will position the worm gear on the
locking clip side of the sensor.
5. NOTICE: Steel wheels have a "high spot" along their circumference. Make sure the strap and
sensor are mounted at the lowest spot
possible to avoid damaging the sensor during wheel and tire disassembly and assembly.
NOTE: Keep the strap parallel with the wheel flange while tightening the worm gear.
Position the worm gear 13-26 mm (0.5-1.0 in) away from the sensor and tighten the worm gear.
- Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
6. NOTICE: The sensor, cradle and strap may be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel. For additional information, refer to Wheel and Tire See: Service and
Repair/Overhaul.
7. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s). For additional information, refer to Tire Pressure Monitoring
System (TPMS) Sensor Training See: Testing and Inspection/Monitors, Trips, Drive Cycles and
Readiness Codes.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Suspension
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front Suspension
Wheel Bearing and Wheel Hub
Removal and Installation
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be
installed with the same part numbers or equivalent parts, if replacement is necessary. Do not use a
replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified
during reassembly to make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector.
2. Remove the wheel and tire.
3. Remove the wheel speed sensor harness bracket bolt and detach the harness from the
retainers.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 5669
4. NOTICE: Do not allow the caliper and anchor plate assembly to hang from the brake hose or
damage to the hose may result.
Remove the 2 bolts and position the caliper and anchor plate aside.
- Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
- To install, tighten to 200 Nm (148 lb-ft).
5. Remove the brake disc.
6. Remove the 4 bolts and the wheel bearing and wheel hub.
- Discard the bolts.
- To install, tighten to 175 Nm (129 lb-ft).
7. If installing a new wheel bearing and wheel hub, remove the wheel speed sensor bolt and the
wheel speed sensor.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
8. NOTICE: If the original wheel bearing and wheel hub is being installed, a new O-ring seal must
be installed or damage to the wheel
bearing may occur.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 5670
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear Suspension
Wheel Bearing and Wheel Hub
Removal
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts and
systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be installed with the
same part numbers or equivalent part, if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement
part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during
reassembly to make sure of correct retention of these parts.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 5671
1. Remove the wheel and tire.
2. NOTE: Have an assistant press the brake pedal to keep the axle from rotating.
Remove and discard the halfshaft nut.
3. Using a suitable hub puller, separate the outboard CV joint from the wheel hub.
4. NOTICE: Do not allow the caliper and anchor plate assembly to hang from the brake hose or
damage to the hose may result.
Remove the bolts and position the caliper and anchor plate assembly aside.
- Support the caliper and anchor plate assembly using mechanic's wire.
5. Remove the brake disc.
6. Detach the wheel speed sensor harness from the retainers and disconnect the wheel speed
sensor electrical connector. Push the wheel speed sensor
harness grommet through the brake disc shield.
7. Remove the 4 bolts, the wheel bearing and wheel hub, and the wheel speed sensor as an
assembly.
- Route the sensor wiring through the access hole in the brake disc shield.
- Discard the bolts.
8. If necessary, remove the wheel speed sensor bolt and the wheel speed sensor from the wheel
bearing and wheel hub.
Installation
1. If necessary, install the wheel speed sensor and bolt.
- Tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
2. Position the wheel bearing and wheel hub, and the wheel speed sensor. Install the 4 new wheel
bearing and wheel hub bolts.
- Route the sensor wiring through the access hole in the brake disc shield.
- Tighten to 175 Nm (129 lb-ft).
3. Attach the wheel speed sensor harness to the retainers and connect the wheel speed sensor
electrical connector. Push the wheel speed sensor
harness grommet through the brake disc shield.
4. Install the brake disc.
5. Position the caliper and anchor plate assembly and install the bolts.
- Tighten to 190 Nm (140 lb-ft).
6. NOTE: Have an assistant press the brake pedal to keep the axle from rotating.
Install the new halfshaft nut.
- Tighten to 300 Nm (221 lb-ft).
7. Install the wheel and tire.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information
> Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
Rear Suspension
Wheel Bearing and Wheel Hub
Install the new halfshaft nut, tighten to
.................................................................................................................................................... 300
Nm (221 lb-ft)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Wheel Hub Lock Solenoid >
Component Information > Locations
Wheel Hub Lock Solenoid: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Wheel Hub Lock Solenoid >
Component Information > Locations > Page 5679
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Wheel Hub Lock Solenoid >
Component Information > Locations > Page 5680
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub (Locking) > Component Information
> Service and Repair
Wheel Hub (Locking): Service and Repair
Integrated Wheel End (IWE)
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the front wheel and tire.
3. Remove the dust cap.
4. Remove and discard the axle nut.
5. Disconnect the vacuum tubes from the Integrated Wheel End (IWE).
6. Remove the 3 IWE-to-wheel knuckle retaining bolts.
7. Remove the tie-rod nut and separate the tie rod from the wheel knuckle.
- Discard the tie-rod nut.
8. Remove the wheel speed sensor harness bracket bolt and position the harness aside.
9. Remove the front brake flexible hose bracket bolt and position the brake hose aside.
10. Remove the upper ball joint nut and separate the upper ball joint from the wheel knuckle.
- Discard the upper ball joint nut.
11. NOTE: Allow the wheel knuckle to swing outward while keeping the halfshaft pushed inward.
Once clearance is available, remove the halfshaft outboard end from the wheel knuckle hub
bearing.
12. Remove the IWE from the halfshaft outboard end.
Installation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub (Locking) > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Page 5684
1. Compress the IWE and install a vacuum cap on the vacuum port.
2. NOTICE: Do not dislodge the Integrated Wheel End (IWE) seal spring when installing the IWE
on halfshaft outboard end or component
damage may occur.
Install the IWE onto the halfshaft outboard end.
3. NOTE: Allow the wheel knuckle to swing outward while keeping the halfshaft pushed inward.
Once clearance is available, install the halfshaft outboard end into the wheel knuckle hub bearing.
4. Connect the upper ball joint and install a new nut.
- Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
5. Connect the tie rod and install a new nut.
- Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
6. Position the front brake flexible hose bracket and install the bolt.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
7. Position the wheel speed sensor harness bracket and install the bolt.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
8. Install the 3 IWE-to-wheel knuckle retaining bolts.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
9. Remove the IWE vacuum cap and connect the vacuum tubes.
10. NOTICE: Verify the spline engagement by checking for spline lash before installing the axle nut
or component damage may occur.
Install the new axle nut.
- Tighten to 27 Nm (20 lb-ft).
11. Install the dust cap.
12. Install the front wheel and tire.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Specifications
Wheel Fastener: Specifications
Tighten the wheel nuts in a star/cross pattern. Tighten to....................................................................
...............................................................................................................................135 Nm (100 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Suspension - Rear Wheel Drive (RWD)
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair Front Suspension - Rear Wheel Drive (RWD)
Wheel Studs
Removal
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be
installed with the same part numbers or equivalent parts, if replacement is necessary. Do not use a
replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified
during reassembly to make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the wheel and tire.
2. NOTICE: Do not allow the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly to hang from the brake hose
or damage to the hose may result.
Remove the 2 bolts and position the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly aside.
- Support the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly using mechanic's wire.
3. Remove the brake disc.
4. Using the C-Frame and Screw Assembly, remove the wheel stud.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Suspension - Rear Wheel Drive (RWD) > Page 5690
Installation
1. NOTE: Make sure to use washers that have an ID that is larger than the OD of the wheel stud
serrations. Use enough washers (approximately 4) to
allow the wheel stud to fully seat against the hub flange.
Position the new wheel stud in the wheel hub, aligning the serrations in the wheel hub flange made
by the original wheel stud.
- Place 4 washers over the outside end of the wheel stud and thread a standard wheel nut onto the
wheel stud with the flat side against the washers.
- Tighten the wheel nut until the wheel stud head seats against the back side of the wheel hub
flange.
2. Remove the wheel nut and washers.
3. Install the brake disc.
4. Position the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly and install the bolts.
- Tighten the bolts to 200 Nm (148 lb-ft).
5. Install the wheel and tire.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Suspension - Rear Wheel Drive (RWD) > Page 5691
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair Rear Suspension
Wheel Studs
Removal
NOTICE: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure may result in major service expense. New parts must be
installed with the same part numbers or equivalent part, if replacement is necessary. Do not use a
replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified
during reassembly to make sure correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the wheel bearing and wheel hub. For additional information, refer to Wheel Bearing
and Wheel Hub See: Wheel Bearing/Service and
Repair/Rear Suspension.
2. NOTICE: Never use a hammer to remove a wheel stud. Damage to the wheel hub may result.
Place the wheel hub in a soft-jawed vise and, using the C-Frame and Screw, remove the wheel
stud.
Installation
1. Position the new wheel stud in the wheel bearing and hub assembly, aligning the serrations in
the wheel hub flange made by the original wheel
stud.
2. NOTICE: Do not use power tools to install the wheel stud. The serrations on the flange can be
stripped.
NOTE: Do not use the wheel nut that came with the vehicle.
NOTE: Make sure to use washers that have an ID that is larger than the OD of the wheel stud
serrations. Use enough washers (approximately 4) to allow the wheel stud to fully seat against the
hub flange.
Install 4 washers and a wheel nut on the wheel stud and tighten the wheel nut until the stud seats
against the flange.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Suspension - Rear Wheel Drive (RWD) > Page 5692
3. Remove the wheel nut and washers.
- Discard the wheel nut.
4. Install the wheel bearing and wheel hub. For additional information, refer to Wheel Bearing and
Wheel Hub See: Wheel Bearing/Service and
Repair/Rear Suspension.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Door Actuator / Motor: > 10-5-5 > Mar > 10 > A/C Blend Door Actuator Clicking Noises
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Customer Interest A/C - Blend Door Actuator Clicking Noises
TSB 10-5-5
03/29/10
TEMPERATURE BLEND DOOR ACTUATOR NOISE
FORD: 2009-2010 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a noise coming from the
dash area after vehicle is started or when the customer requests a Heating Ventilation Air
Conditioning (HVAC) temperature change.
ACTION Follow the service procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Test both driver and passenger side temperature blend door actuators on dual zone HVAC
systems.
1. Start the vehicle and set the heater control to full heat. Repeat for full cool setting.
a. If a clicking noise is not heard at either end of the travel, do not continue with this procedure.
b. If a clicking noise is heard at either end of the travel, proceed to Step 2.
2. Replace the temperature blend door actuator with revise parts. Refer to the Workshop Manual,
Section 412-01.
NOTE
THE IGNITION KEY MUST BE OFF WHEN REPLACING THE ACTUATOR. ENERGIZING THE
ACTUATOR BEFORE INSTALLATION ON THE HVAC CASE WILL CAUSE THE PART TO
BECOME MISS POSITIONED AND CORRECT ORIENTATION WILL BE LOST. INCORRECT
ACTUATOR OPERATION MAY RESULT.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100505A 2009-2010 Expedition: 0.5 Hr.
Replace The Right Blend Door Actuator, Includes Time To Diagnose (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
100505A 2009-2010 Navigator: 0.7 Hr.
Replace The Right Blend Door Actuator, Includes Time To Diagnose (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Door Actuator / Motor: > 10-5-5 > Mar > 10 > A/C Blend Door Actuator Clicking Noises > Page 5703
100505B 2009-2010 Expedition, 4.3 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace The Left Blend Door Actuator, Includes Time To Remove And Install The
Instrument Panel (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
100505C 2009-2010 Expedition, 4.4 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Both Left And Right Blend Door Actuators, Includes Time To Remove And
Install The Instrument Panel (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19E616 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Door Actuator / Motor: > 10-5-5 > Mar > 10
> A/C - Blend Door Actuator Clicking Noises
Air Door Actuator / Motor: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Blend Door Actuator Clicking Noises
TSB 10-5-5
03/29/10
TEMPERATURE BLEND DOOR ACTUATOR NOISE
FORD: 2009-2010 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a noise coming from the
dash area after vehicle is started or when the customer requests a Heating Ventilation Air
Conditioning (HVAC) temperature change.
ACTION Follow the service procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Test both driver and passenger side temperature blend door actuators on dual zone HVAC
systems.
1. Start the vehicle and set the heater control to full heat. Repeat for full cool setting.
a. If a clicking noise is not heard at either end of the travel, do not continue with this procedure.
b. If a clicking noise is heard at either end of the travel, proceed to Step 2.
2. Replace the temperature blend door actuator with revise parts. Refer to the Workshop Manual,
Section 412-01.
NOTE
THE IGNITION KEY MUST BE OFF WHEN REPLACING THE ACTUATOR. ENERGIZING THE
ACTUATOR BEFORE INSTALLATION ON THE HVAC CASE WILL CAUSE THE PART TO
BECOME MISS POSITIONED AND CORRECT ORIENTATION WILL BE LOST. INCORRECT
ACTUATOR OPERATION MAY RESULT.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100505A 2009-2010 Expedition: 0.5 Hr.
Replace The Right Blend Door Actuator, Includes Time To Diagnose (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
100505A 2009-2010 Navigator: 0.7 Hr.
Replace The Right Blend Door Actuator, Includes Time To Diagnose (Do Not Use With Any Other
Labor Operations)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Door Actuator / Motor: > 10-5-5 > Mar > 10
> A/C - Blend Door Actuator Clicking Noises > Page 5709
100505B 2009-2010 Expedition, 4.3 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace The Left Blend Door Actuator, Includes Time To Remove And Install The
Instrument Panel (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
100505C 2009-2010 Expedition, 4.4 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Both Left And Right Blend Door Actuators, Includes Time To Remove And
Install The Instrument Panel (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19E616 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Locations Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator > Page 5712
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator > Page 5713
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Locations Air Inlet Mode Door Actuator
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator > Page 5714
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator > Page 5715
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator > Page 5716
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator > Page 5717
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator > Page 5718
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator > Page 5719
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator > Page 5720
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator > Page 5721
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator > Page 5722
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator > Page 5723
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator > Page 5724
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator > Page 5725
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator > Page 5726
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator > Page 5727
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator > Page 5730
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator > Page 5731
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator > Page 5732
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Diagrams Auxiliary Temperature Blend Door Actuator
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator > Page 5733
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator > Page 5734
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator > Page 5735
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator > Page 5736
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator > Page 5737
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator > Page 5738
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator > Page 5739
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator > Page 5740
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator > Page 5741
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Defrost/Panel/Floor Mode Door Actuator > Page 5742
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door
Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The defrost/panel/floor mode door actuator can be accessed from underneath the LH side
of the instrument panel.
1. Disconnect the defrost/panel/floor door mode door actuator electrical connector.
2. Remove the 2 defrost/panel/floor door mode door actuator screws.
3. Remove the defrost/panel/floor door mode door actuator.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 5745
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair Mode Door Actuator - Air Inlet Door
Mode Door Actuator - Air Inlet Door
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH lower instrument panel insulator (if equipped).
2. Remove the junction box cover at the RH lower A-pillar.
3. Remove the 3 air inlet mode door actuator screws.
4. Disconnect the air inlet mode door actuator electrical connector.
5. Remove the air inlet mode door actuator.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 5746
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair Temperature Blend Door Actuator - RH
Temperature Blend Door Actuator - RH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the Audio Control Module (ACM).
2. Disconnect the RH temperature blend door actuator electrical connector.
3. Remove the 2 RH temperature blend door actuator screws.
4. Remove the RH temperature blend door actuator.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 5747
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair Temperature Blend Door Actuator - LH
Temperature Blend Door Actuator - LH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the heater core and evaporator core housing. For additional information, refer to Heater
Core And Evaporator Core Housing See:
Housing Assembly HVAC/Service and Repair/Heater Core And Evaporator Core Housing.
2. Remove the 4 floor duct screws.
3. Remove the floor duct.
4. Disconnect the LH temperature blend door actuator electrical connector.
5. Remove the 2 LH temperature blend door actuator screws.
6. Remove the LH temperature blend door actuator.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 5748
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair
Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door
Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The defrost/panel/floor mode door actuator can be accessed from underneath the LH side
of the instrument panel.
1. Disconnect the defrost/panel/floor door mode door actuator electrical connector.
2. Remove the 2 defrost/panel/floor door mode door actuator screws.
3. Remove the defrost/panel/floor door mode door actuator.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Mode Door Actuator - Air Inlet Door
Mode Door Actuator - Air Inlet Door
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 5749
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH lower instrument panel insulator (if equipped).
2. Remove the junction box cover at the RH lower A-pillar.
3. Remove the 3 air inlet mode door actuator screws.
4. Disconnect the air inlet mode door actuator electrical connector.
5. Remove the air inlet mode door actuator.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Temperature Blend Door Actuator - RH
Temperature Blend Door Actuator - RH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the Audio Control Module (ACM).
2. Disconnect the RH temperature blend door actuator electrical connector.
3. Remove the 2 RH temperature blend door actuator screws.
4. Remove the RH temperature blend door actuator.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 5750
Temperature Blend Door Actuator - LH
Temperature Blend Door Actuator - LH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the heater core and evaporator core housing. For additional information, refer to Heater
Core And Evaporator Core Housing See:
Housing Assembly HVAC/Service and Repair/Heater Core And Evaporator Core Housing.
2. Remove the 4 floor duct screws.
3. Remove the floor duct.
4. Disconnect the LH temperature blend door actuator electrical connector.
5. Remove the 2 LH temperature blend door actuator screws.
6. Remove the LH temperature blend door actuator.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Auxiliary Mode Door Actuator
Auxiliary Mode Door Actuator - Expedition, Navigator
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 5751
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH quarter trim panel cup holder.
2. Remove the RH quarter trim panel utility tray.
3. Remove the 3 auxiliary mode door actuator screws.
4. Disconnect the auxiliary mode door actuator electrical connector.
5. Remove the auxiliary mode door actuator.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Auxiliary Mode Door Actuator - Expedition EL, Navigator L
Auxiliary Mode Door Actuator - Expedition EL, Navigator L
Removal and Installation
1. Fold the third row seats fully forward.
2. Remove the RH D-pillar trim panel.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 5752
3. Remove the liftgate sill plate.
4. Remove the rear floor cargo space trim panel.
5. Position the rear floor cargo space floor trim aside and remove the RH rear quarter trim panel
bolt.
6. Remove the RH quarter trim panel utility tray.
7. Detach the 3 rear and 5 upper RH quarter trim panel clips and position the quarter trim panel
aside.
8. Disconnect the auxiliary mode door actuator electrical connector.
9. Remove the 2 auxiliary mode door actuator screws.
10. Remove the auxiliary mode door actuator.
11. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Auxiliary Temperature Blend Door Actuator
Auxiliary Temperature Blend Door Actuator - Expedition, Navigator
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 5753
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH quarter trim panel.
2. Disconnect the auxiliary temperature blend door actuator electrical connector.
3. Remove the 4 auxiliary temperature blend door actuator screws.
4. Remove the auxiliary temperature blend door actuator.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Auxiliary Temperature Blend Door Actuator - Expedition EL, Navigator L
Auxiliary Temperature Blend Door Actuator - Expedition EL, Navigator L
Removal and Installation
1. Fold the third row seats fully forward.
2. Remove the RH D-pillar trim panel.
3. Remove the liftgate sill plate.
4. Remove the rear floor cargo space trim panel.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 5754
5. Position the rear floor cargo space floor trim aside and remove the RH rear quarter trim panel
bolt.
6. Remove the RH quarter trim panel utility tray.
7. Detach the 3 rear and 5 upper RH quarter trim panel clips and position the quarter trim panel
aside.
8. Disconnect the auxiliary temperature blend door actuator electrical connector.
9. Remove the 2 auxiliary temperature blend door actuator screws.
10. Remove the auxiliary temperature blend door actuator.
11. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair > Floor
Duct
Air Duct: Service and Repair Floor Duct
Floor Duct
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the heater core and evaporator core housing. For additional information, refer to Heater
Core And Evaporator Core Housing See:
Housing Assembly HVAC/Service and Repair/Heater Core And Evaporator Core Housing.
2. Remove the 4 floor duct screws.
3. Remove the floor duct.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair > Floor
Duct > Page 5759
Air Duct: Service and Repair Footwell Duct - Rear
Footwell Duct - Rear
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the front seats.
2. Remove the front floor console.
3. Remove the RH and LH lower cowl trim panels and front door sill plates.
Navigator only
4. Remove the upper and lower instrument panel bracket bolts and position the instrument panel
bracket aside.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
All vehicles
5. Fold back the carpet to completely uncover the rear footwell duct.
6. Remove the 2 rear footwell duct pin-type retainers.
7. Remove the rear footwell duct.
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Register - Climate Control
Air Register: Service and Repair Register - Climate Control
Register - Expedition
Removal and Installation
LH register
1. Remove the steering column opening cover.
2. Remove the 4 steering column opening reinforcement bolts and the steering column
reinforcement.
3. Remove the LH outer instrument panel trim panel.
RH register
4. Lower the glove compartment.
LH or RH register
5. Working through the instrument panel opening, depress the 2 clips on the sides of the register
barrel and tilt the bottom of the register outward to
keep the clips from re-engaging.
6. NOTE: RH register shown, LH register similar.
Using 2 suitable tools, release the clips through the demister nozzle opening and remove the
register.
Center registers
7. Remove the center instrument panel finish panel.
8. Working through the opening below the Audio Control Module (ACM), release the 3 register
retaining clips and remove the register.
All registers
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Register - Climate Control > Page 5764
Air Register: Service and Repair Register - Auxiliary Climate Control
Register
Removal and Installation
1. Fabricate a removal tool from a 3.175 mm (0.12 in) diameter rod.
2. Rotate the register with the removal tool to align the retaining ears with the clearance openings
and remove the register.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component
Information > Locations
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5768
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5769
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component Information
> Locations
Auxiliary Blower Motor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component Information
> Locations > Page 5774
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Auxiliary Blower Motor > Component Information
> Locations > Page 5775
Auxiliary Blower Motor: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Blower Motor Relay
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Blower Motor Relay > Page 5780
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Blower Motor Relay > Page 5781
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Blower Motor Relay > Page 5782
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Blower Motor Relay
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Blower Motor Relay
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Blower Motor Relay > Page 5785
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Blower Motor Relay > Page 5786
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Auxiliary Blower Motor Relay 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Blower Motor Relay > Page 5787
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Blower Motor Relay > Page 5788
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Auxiliary Blower Motor Relay 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Blower Motor Relay > Page 5789
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Blower Motor Relay > Page 5790
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Auxiliary Blower Motor Relay 3
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Blower Motor Relay > Page 5791
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Locations >
Blower Motor Resistor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Locations >
Blower Motor Resistor > Page 5796
Blower Motor Resistor: Locations Auxiliary Blower Motor Resistor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Locations >
Blower Motor Resistor > Page 5797
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Blower Motor Resistor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Blower Motor Resistor > Page 5800
Blower Motor Resistor: Diagrams Auxiliary Blower Motor Resistor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Blower Motor Resistor > Page 5801
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Resistor - Blower Motor
Blower Motor Resistor: Testing and Inspection Resistor - Blower Motor
Climate Control System
Component Tests
Resistor - Blower Motor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Resistor - Blower Motor > Page 5804
Blower Motor Resistor: Testing and Inspection Resistor - Auxiliary Blower Motor
Climate Control System
Component Tests
Resistor - Auxiliary Blower Motor (Expedition/Navigator)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Resistor - Blower Motor > Page 5805
Blower Motor Resistor: Testing and Inspection Resistor - Auxiliary Blower Motor (Expedition
EL/Navigator L)
Climate Control System
Component Tests
Resistor - Auxiliary Blower Motor (Expedition EL/Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Blower Motor Resistor
Blower Motor Resistor: Service and Repair Blower Motor Resistor
Blower Motor Resistor
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the blower motor resistor electrical connector.
2. Remove the 2 blower motor resistor screws.
3. Remove the blower motor resistor.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Blower Motor Resistor > Page 5808
Blower Motor Resistor: Service and Repair Auxiliary Blower Motor Resistor
Auxiliary Blower Motor Resistor
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Expedition or Navigator shown, Expedition EL or Navigator L similar.
All vehicles
1. Remove the RH quarter trim panel access panel.
Expedition or Navigator only
2. Remove the blower motor resistor.
- Disconnect the blower motor resistor electrical connector.
- Remove the 2 blower motor resistor screws and the blower motor resistor.
Expedition EL or Navigator L only
3. Remove the blower motor resistor.
- Disconnect the blower motor resistor electrical connector.
- Remove the blower motor resistor screw.
- Detach the 2 blower motor resistor clips and remove the blower motor resistor.
All vehicles
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 5812
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 5813
Blower Motor Switch: Service and Repair
Blower Motor Speed Control
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH lower instrument panel insulator (if equipped).
2. Disconnect the blower motor speed control electrical connector.
3. Remove the 2 blower motor speed control screws.
4. Remove the blower motor speed control.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Air Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair
Cabin Air Filter: Service and Repair
NOTE: The air distribution system of this vehicle cannot be equipped with a cabin air filter.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component Information >
Locations
Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5820
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5821
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Ambient Air Temperature Sensor
Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair Ambient Air Temperature Sensor
Ambient Air Temperature Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the upper radiator sight shield.
2. Detach and disconnect the ambient temperature sensor electrical connector.
3. Remove the ambient air temperature sensor.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Ambient Air Temperature Sensor > Page 5824
Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor
In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor - Expedition
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument cluster finish panel.
2. Remove the in-vehicle temperature sensor.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Specifications
Compressor Clutch: Specifications
Air gap clearance..................................................................................................................................
...................................0.35-0.65 mm (0.014-0.026 in)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5829
Compressor Clutch: Adjustments
Air Conditioning (A/C) Clutch Air Gap Adjustment
1. Check the A/C clutch air gap at 3 equally spaced places between the clutch plate and the A/C
clutch pulley.
2. Remove the clutch plate. Add or remove spacers between the clutch plate hub and the
compressor shaft until the clearance is within specification.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5833
Compressor Clutch Coil: Service and Repair
Clutch and Clutch Field Coil
Removal
1. Remove the A/C compressor. For additional information, refer to Air Conditioning (A/C)
Compressor See: Service and Repair.
2. Remove the A/C clutch disc and hub bolt.
1. Using the Compressor Clutch Holding Tool, hold the A/C clutch disc and hub.
2. Remove the A/C clutch disc and hub bolt.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5834
3. Remove the A/C clutch disc and hub.
4. Remove the A/C compressor pulley snap ring.
5. NOTICE: Do not use air tools. Damage to the Air Conditioning (A/C) clutch pulley or A/C
compressor may result.
Using the Compressor Pulley Remover, remove the A/C compressor pulley.
1. Install the Compressor Pulley Remover.
2. Remove the A/C compressor pulley.
6. Remove the A/C clutch field coil snap ring.
7. Remove the A/C clutch field coil electrical connector screw.
8. Remove the A/C clutch field coil.
Installation
NOTE: A new A/C compressor may come equipped with a clutch and pulley. If not, the A/C clutch
components should be reused unless obvious signs of damage are found. If excessive grooving is
found on the friction surface, a new A/C clutch disc and hub and a new A/C compressor pulley
must be installed together. Otherwise, each component can be installed individually where needed.
1. Visually inspect the A/C clutch disc and hub, A/C compressor pulley and A/C clutch field coil for
damage.
- Inspect for physical damage, including cracked or melted components or discoloration due to
excessive heat.
- Inspect for excessive wear, including grooving in the A/C clutch disc and hub or A/C compressor
pulley that is more than fingernail depth.
- Inspect for roughness in the A/C compressor pulley bearing.
2. Clean the A/C clutch field coil and pulley mounting surfaces.
3. Install the A/C clutch field coil.
4. Install the A/C clutch field coil electrical connector screw.
5. Install the A/C clutch field coil snap ring.
6. NOTE: The A/C compressor pulley is a tight fit on the A/C compressor. It must be correctly
aligned during installation.
Install the A/C compressor pulley.
7. Install the A/C compressor pulley snap ring with the bevel side out.
8. Place one nominal thickness A/C clutch disc and hub spacer inside the clutch hub spline
opening.
9. Install the A/C clutch disc and hub.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5835
10. Using the Compressor Clutch Holding Tool, install the A/C compressor clutch disc and hub bolt.
1. Hold the A/C clutch disc and hub with the Compressor Clutch Holding Tool.
2. Tighten the bolt to 14 Nm (124 lb-in).
11. Measure and adjust the clutch air gap by removing or adding A/C clutch disc and hub spacers.
12. Install the A/C compressor. For additional information, refer to Air Conditioning (A/C)
Compressor See: Service and Repair.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 5839
Compressor Clutch Relay: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Air Conditioning (A/C) Clutch Relay (A/CCR)
Note: The PCM parameter identifiers (PIDs) wide open throttle air conditioning cutoff (WAC) and
wide open throttle air conditioning cutoff fault (WAC_F) are used to monitor the A/CCR output.
The A/CCR is wired normally open. There is no direct electrical connection between the A/C switch
or electronic automatic temperature control (EATC) module and the A/C clutch. The PCM receives
a signal indicating that A/C is requested. For some applications, this message is sent through the
communications network. When A/C is requested, the PCM checks other A/C related inputs that
are available, such as A/C pressure switch and A/C cycling switch. If these inputs indicate A/C
operation and the engine conditions are OK (coolant temperature, engine RPM, throttle position),
the PCM grounds the A/CCR output, closing the relay contacts and sending voltage to the A/CCR.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Condenser HVAC: Description and Operation
Air Conditioning
A/C Condenser/Power Steering Combo Cooler
The A/C condenser/power steering combo cooler is an aluminum fin-and-tube design heat
exchanger located in front of the vehicle radiator. It cools compressed refrigerant gas by allowing
air to pass over fins and tubes to extract heat and by condensing gas to liquid refrigerant as it is
cooled.
The receiver/drier is incorporated onto the LH side of the condenser core. The receiver/drier
cartridge is a separate component and can be removed and installed separately from the
condenser core.
The top portion of the condenser/power steering combo cooler is partitioned from the refrigerant
system and is used for power steering fluid cooling.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 5843
Condenser HVAC: Service and Repair
Condenser Core
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Recover the refrigerant.
3. Disconnect the battery cables.
4. Remove the upper radiator sight shield.
5. Remove the RH and LH headlamp assemblies.
6. Remove the air cleaner outlet tube.
7. Remove the 4 junction box bolts and position the junction box aside.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 5844
8. Detach the power steering cooler line clip.
9. Remove the condenser inlet fitting bolt and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring and gasket seals.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
10. Remove the condenser outlet fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring and gasket seals.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
11. NOTE: RH bolts shown, LH similar.
Remove the 2 cooling module and 2 cooling fan shroud bolts.
12. Release the clamps and disconnect the 2 power steering cooler lines from the condenser core.
13. Remove the 3 pin-type retainers and detach the LH air deflector from the condenser bracket.
14. Remove the 2 RH outer air deflector pin-type retainers and position the air deflector aside.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 5845
15. Remove the 2 pin-type retainers and detach the RH air deflector from the condenser bracket.
16. Remove the 9 lower radiator splash shield pin-type retainers and position the shield aside.
17. Release the clamps and disconnect the 2 transmission cooler lines from the transmission
cooler.
18. Detach the transmission cooler line pin-type retainer from the condenser core bracket.
19. NOTE: The cooling module must be positioned rearward to raise and detach the 4 condenser
mounts from the cooling module.
NOTE: The condenser must be removed from below the vehicle.
Detach and remove the condenser core and transmission cooler as an assembly in the following
sequence.
1. Position the cooling module rearward enough to allow the condenser to be lifted upward.
2. Depress the retaining tabs on the 2 lower condenser mounting brackets and detach the 4
condenser mounting brackets from the cooling
module.
3. Position the top of the condenser forward to detach the top lip of the condenser bracket from the
cooling module and remove the condenser
core and bracket.
20. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new gasket seals and O-ring seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
21. Fill the power steering fluid level.
22. Fill the transmission fluid level.
23. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Auxiliary Climate Control Assembly
Control Assembly: Service and Repair Auxiliary Climate Control Assembly
Auxiliary Climate Control Assembly
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the floor console upper finish panel.
2. Remove the 2 floor console rear finish panel screws.
3. Disengage the 6 clips and remove the floor console rear finish panel.
- Disconnect the 3 floor console harness electrical connectors.
4. Remove the 4 auxiliary climate control assembly screws.
5. Remove the auxiliary climate control assembly.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Auxiliary Climate Control Assembly > Page 5851
Control Assembly: Service and Repair Heating Ventilation Air Conditioning (HVAC) Module
Heating Ventilation Air Conditioning (HVAC) Module
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Navigator shown, Expedition similar.
1. Remove the center instrument panel finish panel.
2. Remove the 4 HVAC module screws.
3. Remove the HVAC module.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Locations >
HVAC Module, EMTC
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Locations >
HVAC Module, EMTC > Page 5856
Control Module HVAC: Locations HVAC Module, DATC
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Locations >
HVAC Module, EMTC > Page 5857
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
HVAC Module, DATC
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams HVAC Module, DATC
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
HVAC Module, DATC > Page 5860
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
HVAC Module, DATC > Page 5861
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams HVAC Module, EMTC
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
HVAC Module, DATC > Page 5862
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
HVAC Module, DATC > Page 5863
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Evaporator Core: Description and Operation
Air Conditioning
Evaporator Core
NOTE: If an evaporator core leak is suspected, the evaporator core must be vacuum leak tested
before it is removed from the vehicle.
The evaporator core is an aluminum plate/fin type and is located in the heater core and evaporator
core housing. A mixture of liquid refrigerant and oil enters the bottom of the evaporator core
through the evaporator core inlet tube, continues over to the plate/fin sections and then moves out
of the evaporator core through the evaporator core outlet tube as a vapor. Airflow from the blower
motor is cooled and dehumidified as it flows through the evaporator core fins.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 5867
Evaporator Core: Testing and Inspection
Climate Control System
Component Tests
Evaporator/Condenser Core - On-Vehicle Leak Test
1. Discharge and recover the refrigerant. Refer to Air Conditioning (A/C) System Recovery,
Evacuation and Charging See: Service and Repair/Air
Conditioning (A/C) System Recovery, Evacuation and Charging.
2. Disconnect the suspect evaporator core or condenser core from the A/C system.
3. Clean the manifold fittings.
4. Connect the appropriate test fittings to the condenser or evaporator core tube connections.
5. NOTE: The automatic shut-off valves on some gauge set hoses do not open when connected to
the test fittings. If available, use hoses without
shut-off valves. If hoses with shut-off valves are used, make sure the valve opens when attached to
the test fittings or install an adapter that will activate the valve. The test is not valid if the shut-off
valve does not open.
Connect the red and blue hoses from the R-134a Manifold Gauge Set to the test fittings on the
evaporator core or condenser core. Connect the yellow hose to a known good vacuum pump.
6. Open both gauge set valves and start the vacuum pump. Allow the vacuum pump to operate for
a minimum of 45 minutes after the gauge set
low-pressure gauge indicates 101 kPa (30 in-Hg). The 45-minute evacuation is necessary to
remove any refrigerant from oil left in the evaporator core or condenser core. If the refrigerant is not
completely removed from the oil, outgassing will degrade the vacuum and appear as a refrigerant
leak.
7. If the low-pressure gauge reading will not drop to 101 kPa (30 in-Hg) when the valves on the
gauge and manifold set are open and the vacuum
pump is operating, close the gauge set valves and observe the low-pressure gauge. If the pressure
rises rapidly to zero, a large leak is indicated. Recheck the test fitting connections and gauge set
connections before installing a new evaporator core or condenser core.
8. After evacuating for 45 minutes, close the gauge set valves and stop the vacuum pump.
Observe the low-pressure gauge; it should remain at the
101 kPa (30 in-Hg) mark. If the low-pressure gauge reading rises 34 or more kPa (10 or more in-Hg) of vacuum from the 101
kPa (30 in-Hg) position in 10 minutes, a leak is indicated.
- If a very small leak is suspected, wait 30 minutes and observe the vacuum gauge.
- If a small amount of vacuum is lost, operate the vacuum pump with gauge valves open for an
additional 30 minutes to remove any remaining refrigerant from the oil in the evaporator core or
condenser core. Then recheck for loss of vacuum.
- If a very small leak is suspected, allow the system to sit overnight with vacuum applied and check
for vacuum loss.
9. If the evaporator core or condenser core does leak, as verified by the above procedure, install a
new evaporator core or condenser core.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Evaporator Core
Evaporator Core: Service and Repair Evaporator Core
Evaporator Core
Removal and Installation
NOTE: If an evaporator core leak is suspected, the evaporator core must be vacuum leak tested
before it is removed from the vehicle.
NOTE: Installation of a new receiver/drier cartridge is not required when repairing the A/C system
except when there is physical evidence of contamination from a failed A/C compressor or damage
to the receiver/drier cartridge.
NOTE: A new evaporator core seal is supplied as a kit with the evaporator core service part.
Failure to install this seal, or failure to install it correctly, will result in air bypassing the evaporator
core and loss of cooling efficiency.
1. Remove the plenum chamber. For additional information, refer to Plenum Chamber See:
Housing Assembly HVAC/Service and Repair/Plenum
Chamber.
2. Remove 2 heater core quick disconnect fitting clips and the dash panel seal.
3. Detach the wire harness from the upper half of the heater core and evaporator core housing.
4. Remove the 6 air inlet duct screws and the air inlet duct.
5. Remove the 15 heater core and evaporator core housing screws.
6. Separate the 2 halves of the heater core and evaporator core housing.
7. Remove the evaporator core.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Evaporator Core > Page 5870
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Evaporator Core > Page 5871
Evaporator Core: Service and Repair Auxiliary Evaporator Core
Auxiliary Evaporator Core
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The auxiliary evaporator core is not available as a separate component for Expedition EL or
Navigator L vehicles and is serviced only as an assembly with the auxiliary heater core and
evaporator core housing. The auxiliary evaporator core is serviced as an individual component for
Expedition and Navigator vehicles.
NOTE: If an evaporator core leak is suspected, the evaporator core must be vacuum leak tested
before it is removed from the vehicle.
All vehicles
1. Remove the auxiliary heater core and evaporator core housing. For additional information, refer
to Auxiliary Heater Core and Evaporator Core
Housing - Expedition, Navigator See: Housing Assembly HVAC/Service and Repair/Auxiliary
Heater Core and Evaporator Core Housing or Auxiliary Heater Core - Expedition EL, Navigator L
See: Heater Core/Service and Repair/Auxiliary Heater Core - Expedition EL, Navigator L.
Expedition EL or Navigator L
2. Transfer the components from the old heater core and evaporator core housing to the new
heater core and evaporator core housing as needed.
3. Install the auxiliary heater core and evaporator core housing. For additional information, refer to
Auxiliary Heater Core - Expedition EL,
Navigator L See: Heater Core/Service and Repair/Auxiliary Heater Core - Expedition EL, Navigator
L.
Expedition or Navigator only
4. Remove the Thermostatic Expansion Valve (TXV) fitting bolt and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
5. Remove the 12 evaporator/heater core access cover screws.
6. Remove the evaporator/heater core access cover.
- Disconnect the evaporator drain tube.
7. Remove the evaporator core.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Evaporator Core > Page 5872
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new O-ring seals.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5876
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5877
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Air Conditioning
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning
Air Conditioning
Evaporator Temperature Sensor
The evaporator temperature sensor communicates the evaporator fin temperature to the HVAC
module.
The PCM maintains evaporator core temperature and prevents icing of the evaporator core, by
disengaging the A/C compressor clutch when the evaporator temperature sensor reading falls
below acceptable levels, and by engaging the A/C compressor clutch when the discharge air
temperature rises above acceptable levels.
The evaporator temperature sensor electrical connector is located outside of the heater core and
evaporator core housing behind the glove compartment, with the sensor pigtail leading into the
housing to the sensor probe which is inserted between the evaporator core fins.
The evaporator temperature sensor is not available as a separate component. To install a new
evaporator temperature sensor, a new heater core and evaporator core housing must be installed.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Air Conditioning > Page 5880
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Engine Control Components
Engine Control Components
Air Conditioning Evaporator Temperature (ACET) Sensor
The ACET sensor measures the evaporator air discharge temperature. The ACET sensor is a
thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of a
thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance increases as the
temperature decreases. The PCM sources a low current 5 volts on the ACET circuit. With SIG RTN
also connected to the ACET sensor, the varying resistance changes the voltage drop across the
sensor terminals. As A/C evaporator air temperature changes, the varying resistance of the ACET
sensor changes the voltage the PCM detects.
The ACET sensor is used to more accurately control A/C clutch cycling and improve defrost/demist
performance.
Note: These values can vary 15% due to sensor and VREF variations. Voltage values were
calculated for VREF equals 5.0 volts.
A/C Evaporator Temperature (ACET) Sensor Voltage And Resistance Chart
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 5881
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
Air Conditioning (A/C) Evaporator Discharge Air Temperature Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Detach the glove compartment dampener and lower the glove compartment.
2. Disconnect the evaporator discharge air temperature sensor electrical connector.
3. Carefully pry the evaporator discharge air temperature sensor probe out of the heater core and
evaporator core housing.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Block/Orifice Tube > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Thermostatic Expansion Valve (TXV)
Expansion Block/Orifice Tube: Description and Operation Thermostatic Expansion Valve (TXV)
Air Conditioning
Thermostatic Expansion Valve (TXV)
The TXV is located between the evaporator core lines and the TXV manifold and tube assembly at
the RH rear of the engine compartment. The TXV provides a restriction to the flow of refrigerant
from the high-pressure side of the refrigerant system, and separates the low-pressure and
high-pressure sides of the refrigerant system. Refrigerant entering and exiting the evaporator core
passes through the TXV through 2 separate flow paths. An internal temperature sensing bulb
senses the temperature of the refrigerant flowing out of the evaporator core and adjusts an internal
pin-type valve to meter the refrigerant flow into the evaporator core. The internal pin-type valve
decreases the amount of refrigerant entering the evaporator core at lower temperatures and
increases the amount of refrigerant entering the evaporator core at higher temperatures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Block/Orifice Tube > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Thermostatic Expansion Valve (TXV) > Page 5886
Expansion Block/Orifice Tube: Description and Operation A/C Pressure Transducer
Air Conditioning
A/C Pressure Transducer
The A/C pressure transducer communicates the compressor discharge pressure to the PCM. The
PCM will interrupt A/C compressor operation in the event that the A/C pressure transducer
indicates excessively high system discharge pressures. It is also used to sense low charge
conditions. If the pressure is below a predetermined value for a given ambient temperature, the
PCM will not allow the clutch to engage.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Block/Orifice Tube > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Thermostatic Expansion Valve - Climate Control
Expansion Block/Orifice Tube: Service and Repair Thermostatic Expansion Valve - Climate Control
Thermostatic Expansion Valve
Removal and Installation
1. Recover the refrigerant.
2. Remove the Thermostatic Expansion Valve (TXV) manifold and tube bracket bolt.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
3. Detach the wire harness pin-type retainer and position the harness aside.
4. Remove the auxiliary evaporator inlet line fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Block/Orifice Tube > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Thermostatic Expansion Valve - Climate Control > Page 5889
- Discard the O-ring seal and gasket seal.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
5. Remove the TXV fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the gasket seals.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
6. Remove the 2 TXV bolts.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
7. Remove the TXV.
- Discard the gasket seals.
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install a new O-ring seal and new gasket seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
9. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Block/Orifice Tube > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Thermostatic Expansion Valve - Climate Control > Page 5890
Expansion Block/Orifice Tube: Service and Repair Thermostatic Expansion Valve - Auxiliary
Climate Control
Thermostatic Expansion Valve - Expedition, Navigator
Removal and Installation
1. Recover the refrigerant.
2. Remove the RH quarter trim panel.
3. Remove the Thermostatic Expansion Valve (TXV) fitting bolt and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
4. Remove the 2 TXV bolts.
5. Remove the TXV.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new O-ring seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
7. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Block/Orifice Tube > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Thermostatic Expansion Valve - Climate Control > Page 5891
Expansion Block/Orifice Tube: Service and Repair Thermostatic Expansion Valve - Expedition EL,
Navigator L
Thermostatic Expansion Valve - Expedition EL, Navigator L
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Recover the refrigerant.
3. Remove the auxiliary evaporator outlet and inlet line rear fitting nut.
- Discard the gasket seals.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
4. Remove the 2 Thermostatic Expansion Valve (TXV) bolts and the TXV.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new O-ring seals and gasket seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
6. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Heater Core
Heater Core: Testing and Inspection Heater Core
Climate Control System
Component Tests
Heater Core
1. NOTE: If a heater core leak is suspected, the heater core must be tested by following the
Plugged Heater Core component test before the heater
core pressure test. Carry out a system inspection by checking the heater system thoroughly as
follows:
Inspect for evidence of coolant leakage at the heater hose to heater core attachments. A coolant
leak in the heater hose could follow the heater core tube to the heater core and appear as a leak in
the heater core.
2. NOTE: Spring-type clamps are installed as original equipment. Installation and overtightening of
non-specified clamps can cause leakage at the
heater hose connection and damage the heater core.
Check the integrity of the heater hose clamps.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Heater Core > Page 5896
Heater Core: Testing and Inspection Heater Core - Plugged
Climate Control System
Component Tests
Heater Core - Plugged
1. Check to see that the engine coolant is at the correct level.
2. Start the engine and turn on the heater.
3. When the engine coolant reaches operating temperature, using a suitable temperature
measuring device, check the heater core inlet and outlet
hoses to see if they are hot.
4. If the outlet only is not hot:
- the heater core may have an air pocket.
- the heater core may be plugged.
5. If the inlet only is not hot:
- the thermostat may not be working correctly.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Heater Core > Page 5897
Heater Core: Testing and Inspection Heater Core - Pressure Test
Climate Control System
Component Tests
Heater Core - Pressure Test
WARNING: Before disconnecting any heater water hoses, shut OFF the engine and wait until
engine is fully cool. Failure to comply with this warning may result in serious injury or burns from
hot liquid escaping from the engine cooling system.
Use the Pressure Test Kit to carry out the pressure test.
1. NOTE: Due to space limitations, a bench test may be necessary for pressure testing.
Drain the coolant from the cooling system.
2. Disconnect the heater hoses from the heater core.
3. Install a short piece of heater hose, approximately 101 mm (4 in) long on each heater core tube.
4. Fill the heater core and heater hoses with water and install the plug BT-7422-B and the adapter
BT-7422-A from the Pressure Test Kit. Secure the
heater hoses, plug and adapter with hose clamps.
5. Attach the pump and gauge assembly from the Pressure Test Kit to the adapter.
6. Close the bleed valve at the base of the gauge. Pump 138 kPa (20 psi) of air pressure into the
heater core.
7. Observe the pressure gauge for a minimum of 3 minutes.
8. If the pressure drops, check the heater hose connections to the core tubes for leaks. If the
heater hoses do not leak, remove the heater core from the
vehicle and carry out the bench test. See: Heater Core - Bench Test
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Heater Core > Page 5898
Heater Core: Testing and Inspection Heater Core - Bench Test
Climate Control System
Component Tests
Heater Core - Bench Test
1. Remove the heater core from the vehicle.
2. Drain all of the coolant from the heater core.
3. Connect the 101 mm (4 in) test heater hoses with plug and adapter to the core tubes. Then
connect the Pressure Test Kit to the adapter.
4. Apply 138 kPa (20 psi) of air pressure to the heater core. Submerge the heater core in water.
5. If a leak is observed, install a new heater core.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Core
Heater Core: Service and Repair Heater Core
Heater Core
Removal and Installation
NOTE: If a heater core leak is suspected, the heater core must be leak tested before it is removed
from the vehicle.
1. Remove the heater core and evaporator core housing. For additional information, refer to Heater
Core And Evaporator Core Housing See:
Housing Assembly HVAC/Service and Repair/Heater Core And Evaporator Core Housing.
2. Remove the 8 plenum chamber screws.
3. Release the plenum chamber clip and position the plenum chamber aside.
4. Remove 2 heater core fitting clips and the dash panel seal.
5. Remove the heater core tube bracket screw and the heater core tube bracket.
6. Remove the heater core bracket screw and the heater core bracket.
7. Remove the heater core.
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Core > Page 5901
Heater Core: Service and Repair Auxiliary Heater Core
Auxiliary Heater Core - Expedition, Navigator
Removal and Installation
NOTE: If a heater core leak is suspected, the heater core must be pressure leak tested before it is
removed from the vehicle.
1. Remove the auxiliary heater core and evaporator core housing. For additional information, refer
to Auxiliary Heater Core and Evaporator Core
Housing - Expedition, Navigator See: Housing Assembly HVAC/Service and Repair/Auxiliary
Heater Core and Evaporator Core Housing.
2. Release the clip and open the floorpan bracket.
3. Remove the heater core tube bracket screw and the heater core tube bracket.
4. Remove the 12 evaporator/heater core access cover screws.
5. Remove the evaporator/heater core access cover.
6. Remove the heater core.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Core > Page 5902
Heater Core: Service and Repair Auxiliary Heater Core - Expedition EL, Navigator L
Auxiliary Heater Core - Expedition EL, Navigator L
Removal and Installation
NOTE: If a heater core leak is suspected, the heater core must be pressure leak tested before it is
removed from the vehicle.
NOTE: It is not necessary to install the new heater core tubes contained in the heater core service
kit unless there is evidence of damage to the heater core tubes. New O-ring seals must be installed
any time the heater core tubes are detached from the heater core.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Drain the engine coolant.
3. Remove the RH quarter trim panel.
4. Position a suitable drain pan and disconnect the 2 auxiliary heater outlet and inlet line quick
disconnect fittings at the floorpan connections to
allow any residual coolant to drain from the auxiliary heater core.
5. Remove the heater core door screw.
6. Remove the 2 auxiliary heater core tube fitting clips.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Core > Page 5903
7. Disconnect the 2 auxiliary heater core tubes.
1. Position the auxiliary heater core partially out of the housing.
2. Disconnect the auxiliary heater core inlet tube.
3. Disconnect the auxiliary heater core outlet tube.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
8. Remove the auxiliary heater core.
9. NOTE: Use only the O-ring seals contained in the auxiliary heater core service kit.
NOTE: Verify that the heater core tube fittings are completely seated in the heater core before
installing the heater core tube fitting clips.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
10. Fill the engine cooling system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC > Component Information >
Description and Operation
High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC: Description and Operation
Air Conditioning
A/C Pressure Relief Valve
NOTE: If the A/C compressor is operating within limits and the A/C pressure relief valve is venting,
or if the A/C pressure relief valve is leaking around the threads, replace the A/C pressure relief
valve and O-ring. If the A/C pressure relief valve still vents after it is replaced, diagnose the
refrigerant system for a restriction.
An A/C pressure relief valve is incorporated in the A/C compressor to prevent damage to the A/C
compressor and other system components by relieving unusually high system discharge pressure
buildups.
The A/C pressure relief valve is a separate component and can be replaced separately from the
A/C compressor. It is necessary to recover the refrigerant before removing the A/C pressure relief
valve.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 5907
High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC: Service and Repair
Air Conditioning (A/C) Pressure Relief Valve
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Recover the refrigerant.
3. Remove the A/C compressor pressure relief valve and O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
4. NOTE: A new O-ring seal will already be installed on the new A/C pressure relief valve service
part.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
5. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line
Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line
Removal
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 5912
NOTE: The auxiliary evaporator inlet and outlet lines are not supplied together as an assembly for
Expedition or Navigator vehicles. The auxiliary evaporator inlet line and outlet line are each
installed from the factory as one-piece assemblies. The replacement parts are supplied as
separate kits containing multiple-piece lines for ease of installation.
NOTE: The auxiliary evaporator inlet and outlet lines for Expedition EL or Navigator L vehicles are
installed from the factory as a single one-piece assembly including both lines. The replacement
part is supplied as a multiple-piece kit for ease of installation.
NOTE: For Expedition or Navigator vehicles, the following procedure can be used to remove and
install one or both the auxiliary evaporator inlet and auxiliary evaporator outlet lines. If only one
auxiliary evaporator line is to be removed and installed, cut or disconnect only the desired line at
the specified points within the procedure. For Expedition EL or Navigator L vehicles, both lines
must be removed.
All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Recover the refrigerant.
3. NOTE: If only one auxiliary evaporator line is to be removed, disconnect only the desired line.
Remove the auxiliary evaporator outlet and inlet line front fitting nut(s) and disconnect the fitting(s).
- Discard the O-ring seals and gasket seals.
4. Remove the spare tire.
5. Remove the RH front wheel and tire.
6. Remove the RH fender splash shield.
7. Working through the RH fender well opening, remove the front auxiliary line bracket nut and the
front auxiliary line bracket.
8. Working through the RH fender well opening, remove the RH catalytic converter heat shield front
bolt.
Expedition or Navigator only
9. NOTE: Both A/C fittings must be disconnected even if only one line is to be removed.
Disconnect the auxiliary evaporator outlet and inlet line rear fittings.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
Expedition EL or Navigator L only
10. Remove the RH rear wheel and tire assembly.
11. Remove the auxiliary evaporator outlet and inlet line rear fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the gasket seals.
All vehicles
12. Remove the muffler.
13. Remove the 3 spare tire carrier splash shield bolts and the spare tire carrier splash shield.
14. Remove the 3 muffler heat shield bolts and the heat shield.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 5913
15. Remove the 2 exhaust hanger bolts and the exhaust hanger.
16. Remove the RH Catalyst Monitor Sensor (CMS).
17. Remove the 3 remaining RH catalytic converter heat shield bolts and the heat shield.
18. Remove the 3 remaining auxiliary line bracket nuts and the auxiliary line brackets.
19. NOTE: If installing only one auxiliary evaporator line, cut only the desired line.
Assemble and lay out the replacement line(s) in the same position as the existing line(s) and, using
a suitable tool, cut the auxiliary evaporator line(s) in the same position as the fittings on the new
line(s).
Expedition EL or Navigator L only
20. Remove the center section(s) of the auxiliary evaporator line(s) through the RH rear wheel well
opening between the body and the frame.
Expedition or Navigator only
21. Remove the center section(s) of the auxiliary evaporator line(s) by manipulating the line(s)
toward the front of the vehicle between the RH
catalytic converter and frame.
All vehicles
22. Remove the remaining auxiliary evaporator inlet and outlet line pieces.
Installation
Expedition or Navigator only
1. Install the rear portion of the auxiliary evaporator line(s) and connect the auxiliary evaporator
outlet and inlet line rear fittings.
- Install new O-ring seals.
Expedition EL or Navigator L only
2. Install the rear portion of the auxiliary evaporator outlet and inlet line.
3. Connect the auxiliary evaporator outlet and inlet line rear fitting and install the nut.
- Install new gasket seals.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 5914
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
All vehicles
4. Install the front portion of the auxiliary evaporator outlet and inlet line(s).
5. Connect the evaporator outlet and inlet line front fitting(s) and install the nut(s).
- Install new O-ring seals and gasket seals.
- Tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
Expedition EL or Navigator L only
6. NOTE: Loosely connect, but do not tighten, the fittings.
Install the center section(s) of the auxiliary evaporator line(s) by manipulating the line(s) toward the
front of the vehicle through RH rear wheel well opening between the body and the frame.
Expedition or Navigator only
7. NOTE: Loosely connect, but do not tighten, the fittings.
Install the center section(s) of the auxiliary evaporator line(s) by manipulating the line(s) toward the
rear of the vehicle through the opening between the RH catalytic converter and frame.
All vehicles
8. Starting from the rear of the vehicle, install the first 3 auxiliary line brackets and nuts.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
9. NOTE: Expedition/Navigator shown, Expedition EL or Navigator L similar.
Tighten the middle auxiliary evaporator line fittings.
10. Inspect the auxiliary evaporator lines for correct installation. Loosen, reposition and tighten as
needed.
11. Install the RH catalytic converter heat shield and the 3 rear catalytic converter heat shield bolts.
12. Install the exhaust hanger and the 2 exhaust hanger bolts.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 5915
13. Install the muffler heat shield and the 3 muffler heat shield bolts.
14. Install the RH CMS.
15. Install the muffler.
16. Working through the RH fender well opening, Install the RH catalytic converter heat shield front
bolt.
17. Install the front auxiliary line bracket and the front auxiliary line bracket nut.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
18. Install the spare tire carrier splash shield and the 3 spare tire carrier splash shield bolts.
19. Install the RH front fender splash shield.
20. Install the RH front wheel.
Expedition EL or Navigator L only
21. Install the RH rear wheel and tire assembly.
All vehicles
22. Install the spare tire.
23. Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
24. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 5916
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Compressor To Condenser Discharge Line
Compressor to Condenser Discharge Line
Removal and Installation
1. Recover the refrigerant.
2. Remove the compressor discharge fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal and gasket seal.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
3. Remove the condenser inlet jumper line fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal and gasket seal.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
4. Remove the compressor-to-condenser discharge line.
5. If removing the condenser inlet jumper line, remove the RH headlamp assembly.
6. If removing the condenser inlet jumper line, disconnect the A/C pressure transducer electrical
connector.
7. If removing the condenser inlet jumper line, remove the condenser inlet fitting bolt and
disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring and gasket seals.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 5917
8. Remove the condenser inlet jumper line.
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new gasket seals and O-ring seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 5918
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Thermostatic Expansion Valve Manifold and Tube Assembly
Thermostatic Expansion Valve Manifold and Tube Assembly
Removal and Installation
1. Recover the refrigerant.
2. Remove the RH headlamp assembly.
3. Remove the condenser outlet fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal and gasket seal.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
4. Disconnect the 3 PCM electrical connectors.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 5919
5. Disconnect the 2 wire harness electrical connectors at the RH inner fender splash shield.
6. Remove the Thermostatic Expansion Valve (TXV) manifold and tube assembly bracket bolt.
7. Remove the TXV manifold and tube suction fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal and gasket seal.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
8. Remove the auxiliary evaporator inlet line fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal and gasket seal.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
9. Remove the auxiliary evaporator outlet line fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal and gasket seal.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
10. Remove the TXV fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the gasket seals.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
11. Remove the TXV manifold and tube assembly.
12. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new gasket seals and O-ring seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
13. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 5920
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Auxiliary Heater Outlet and Inlet Line
Auxiliary Heater Outlet and Inlet Line
Removal
NOTE: The auxiliary heater inlet and outlet lines are not supplied together as an assembly. The
auxiliary heater inlet line and outlet line are each installed from the factory as one-piece
assemblies. The replacement parts are supplied as separate kits containing multiple-piece lines for
ease of installation.
NOTE: The following procedure can be used to remove and install one or both the auxiliary heater
inlet and auxiliary heater outlet lines. If only one auxiliary heater line is to be removed and installed,
cut or disconnect only the desired line at the specified points within the procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 5921
All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Drain the engine coolant.
3. Remove the spare tire.
4. Remove the RH front wheel and tire.
5. Remove the RH fender splash shield.
6. NOTE: If only one auxiliary heater line is to be removed, disconnect only the desired line.
Disconnect the auxiliary heater outlet and/or inlet line front quick disconnect fitting(s).
7. Working through the RH fender well opening, remove the front auxiliary line bracket nut and the
front auxiliary line bracket.
8. Working through the RH fender well opening, remove the RH catalytic converter heat shield front
bolt.
Expedition EL or Navigator L only
9. Remove the RH rear wheel and tire assembly.
All vehicles
10. NOTE: If only one auxiliary heater line is to be removed, disconnect only the desired line.
Disconnect the auxiliary heater outlet and inlet line rear quick disconnect fitting(s) from the heater
core at the floor pan connection.
11. Remove the muffler.
12. Remove the 3 spare tire carrier splash shield bolts and the spare tire carrier splash shield.
13. Remove the 3 muffler heat shield bolts and the muffler heat shield.
14. Remove the 2 exhaust hanger bolts and the exhaust hanger.
15. Remove the RH Catalyst Monitor Sensor (CMS).
16. Remove the 3 remaining RH catalytic converter heat shield bolts and the heat shield.
17. Remove the 3 remaining auxiliary line bracket nuts and the line brackets.
18. NOTE: If installing only one auxiliary heater line, cut only the desired line.
Assemble and lay out the replacement line(s) in the same position as the existing line(s) and, using
a suitable tool, cut the auxiliary heater line(s) in the same position as the fittings on the new line(s).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 5922
Expedition EL or Navigator L only
19. Remove the center section(s) of the auxiliary heater line(s) through the RH rear wheel well
opening between the body and the frame.
Expedition or Navigator only
20. Remove the center section(s) of the auxiliary heater line(s) by manipulating the line(s) toward
the front of the vehicle between the RH catalytic
converter and frame.
All vehicles
21. Remove the remaining auxiliary heater inlet and outlet line pieces.
Installation
All vehicles
1. Install the rear portion of the auxiliary heater outlet and inlet line(s) and connect the quick
disconnect fittings.
2. Install the front auxiliary heater line(s) and connect the quick disconnect fittings.
Expedition EL or Navigator L only
3. NOTE: Loosely connect, but do not tighten, the fittings.
Install the center section(s) of the auxiliary heater line(s) by manipulating the line(s) toward the
front of the vehicle through RH rear wheel well opening between the body and the frame.
Expedition or Navigator only
4. NOTE: Loosely connect, but do not tighten, the fittings.
Install the center section(s) of the auxiliary heater line(s) by manipulating the line(s) toward the rear
of the vehicle through the opening between the RH catalytic converter and frame.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 5923
All vehicles
5. Starting from the rear of the vehicle, install the first 3 auxiliary line brackets and nuts.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
6. Tighten the middle auxiliary heater line fittings.
7. Inspect the auxiliary heater lines for correct installation. Loosen, reposition and tighten as
needed.
8. Install the RH catalytic converter heat shield and the 3 catalytic converter heat shield rear bolts.
9. Install the RH CMS.
10. Install the exhaust hanger and the 2 exhaust hanger bolts.
11. Install the muffler heat shield and the 3 muffler heat shield bolts.
12. Install the muffler.
13. Install the spare tire carrier splash shield and the 3 spare tire carrier splash shield bolts.
14. Working through the RH fender well opening, Install the RH catalytic converter heat shield front
bolt.
15. Install the front auxiliary line bracket and the front auxiliary line bracket and nut.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
16. Install the RH front fender splash shield.
17. Install the RH front wheel and tire.
Expedition EL or Navigator L only
18. Install the RH rear wheel and tire.
All vehicles
19. Install the spare tire.
20. Fill the engine cooling system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Heater Core And Evaporator Core Housing
Housing Assembly HVAC: Service and Repair Heater Core And Evaporator Core Housing
Heater Core And Evaporator Core Housing
Removal and Installation
NOTE: If an evaporator core leak is suspected, the evaporator must be vacuum leak tested before
it is removed from the vehicle.
1. Recover the refrigerant.
2. Drain the engine coolant.
3. Remove the instrument panel.
4. Disconnect the 2 heater hose quick disconnect fittings at the heater core.
5. Remove the Thermostatic Expansion Valve (TXV) fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the gasket seals.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Heater Core And Evaporator Core Housing > Page 5928
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
6. Remove the 3 heater core and evaporator core housing nuts.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
7. Detach the 4 satellite radio antenna cable pin-type retainers from the heater core and evaporator
core housing (if equipped).
8. Detach the 3 body harness electrical connectors from the bracket below the air inlet duct.
9. Remove the air inlet duct bracket nut.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
10. Remove the plenum chamber nut.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
11. Remove the 4 tunnel instrument panel bracket bolts and the tunnel instrument panel bracket.
12. Detach the rear footwell duct from the heater core and evaporator core housing.
13. Remove the heater core and evaporator core housing.
14. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new gasket seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
15. Fill the engine coolant level.
16. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Heater Core And Evaporator Core Housing > Page 5929
Housing Assembly HVAC: Service and Repair Plenum Chamber
Plenum Chamber
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the heater core and evaporator core housing. For additional information, refer to Heater
Core And Evaporator Core Housing See: Heater
Core And Evaporator Core Housing.
2. Disconnect the mode door actuator electrical connector and position the wire harness aside.
3. Remove the 8 plenum chamber screws.
4. Release the plenum chamber clip and remove the plenum chamber.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Heater Core And Evaporator Core Housing > Page 5930
Housing Assembly HVAC: Service and Repair Auxiliary Heater Core and Evaporator Core Housing
Auxiliary Heater Core and Evaporator Core Housing - Expedition, Navigator
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Recover the refrigerant.
3. Drain the engine coolant.
4. Remove the RH quarter trim panel.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Heater Core And Evaporator Core Housing > Page 5931
5. NOTE: Allow any residual coolant to drain from the auxiliary heater core after disconnecting the
auxiliary heater hose fittings.
Position a suitable drain pan and disconnect the 2 auxiliary heater hose fittings from the heater
core at the floorpan connection.
6. Disconnect the 2 auxiliary evaporator line fittings at the floorpan connection.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
7. Remove the 2 floorpan bracket bolts.
8. Remove the auxiliary headliner duct pin-type retainer and disconnect the duct.
9. Disconnect the auxiliary mode door actuator electrical connector.
10. Disconnect the auxiliary temperature blend door actuator electrical connector.
11. Disconnect the auxiliary blower motor resistor electrical connector.
12. Disconnect the auxiliary blower motor electrical connector and detach the wire harness from
the housing.
13. Remove the 2 auxiliary heater core and evaporator core housing bolts.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
14. Remove the auxiliary heater core and evaporator core housing.
15. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new O-ring seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
16. Fill the engine cooling system.
17. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Heater Core And Evaporator Core Housing > Page 5932
Housing Assembly HVAC: Service and Repair Auxiliary Heater Core and Evaporator Core Housing
- Expedition EL, Navigator L
Auxiliary Heater Core and Evaporator Core Housing - Expedition EL, Navigator L
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Recover the refrigerant.
3. Drain the engine coolant.
4. Remove the RH rear quarter trim panel.
5. NOTE: Allow any residual coolant to drain from the auxiliary heater core after disconnecting the
auxiliary heater core fittings.
Position a suitable drain pan and disconnect the 2 auxiliary heater core quick disconnect fittings
from the heater core at the floorpan connection.
6. Remove the auxiliary evaporator outlet and inlet line rear fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Heater Core And Evaporator Core Housing > Page 5933
- Discard the gasket seals.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
7. Disconnect the auxiliary climate control harness electrical connector.
8. Remove the auxiliary airflow duct bolt.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
9. Remove the 2 heater core and evaporator core housing bolts.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
10. Remove the auxiliary heater core and evaporator core housing.
11. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new gasket seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
12. Fill the engine coolant level.
13. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Receiver Dryer: Description and Operation
Air Conditioning
Receiver/Drier
NOTE: Installation of a new receiver/drier cartridge is not required when repairing the A/C system,
except when there is physical evidence of contamination from a failed A/C compressor or damage
to the receiver/drier cartridge. Damage to the receiver/drier cartridge includes physical damage or
moisture contamination. Moisture contamination results only from a complete loss of refrigerant,
and equalization of the refrigerant system pressure with atmospheric pressure for a period longer
than one hour. If even a slight amount of positive refrigerant pressure is present in the refrigerant
system before repairs are carried out, the receiver/drier cartridge does not need to be replaced.
The receiver/drier is integral to the A/C condenser/power steering combo cooler. It stores
high-pressure liquid after it leaves the condenser core. An A/C desiccant cartridge mounted inside
the receiver/drier removes any retained moisture from the refrigerant. The receiver/drier desiccant
cartridge is a separate component and can be removed and installed separately from the A/C
condenser/power steering combo cooler.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 5937
Receiver Dryer: Service and Repair
Receiver Drier Cartridge
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Installation of a new receiver/drier desiccant cartridge is not required when repairing the
A/C system, except when there is physical evidence of contamination from a failed A/C compressor
or damage to the receiver/drier desiccant cartridge. Damage to the receiver/drier desiccant
cartridge includes physical damage to the receiver/drier desiccant cartridge or moisture
contamination. Moisture contamination results only from a complete loss of refrigerant and
equalization of the refrigerant system pressure with atmospheric pressure for a period longer than
one hour. If even a slight amount of positive refrigerant pressure is present in the system before
repairs are carried out, the receiver/drier desiccant cartridge should not be replaced.
1. Remove the condenser core. For additional information, refer to Condenser Core See:
Condenser HVAC/Service and Repair.
2. Unscrew and remove the plastic receiver/drier cap.
3. Remove the receiver/drier plug.
1. Push the receiver/drier plug upwards and remove the snap ring.
2. Install an M5 bolt in the center of the receiver drier plug and remove the plug.
4. Using a suitable tool, grasp the receiver/drier cartridge grab handle and remove the
receiver/drier cartridge.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 5938
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Lubricate the receiver/drier plug O-ring seals using residual refrigerant oil from inside the
receiver/drier.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Refrigerant: Capacity Specifications
Item..............................................................................................................................R-134a
Refrigerant YN-19 (US); CYN-16-P or CYN-16-R (Canada) Specification...........................................
......................................................................................................................................................WS
H-M17B19-A Fill Capacity....................................................................................................................
...................................................................0.94 kg (33 oz) (2.07 lb)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 5943
Refrigerant: Fluid Type Specifications
Item..............................................................................................................................R-134a
Refrigerant YN-19 (US); CYN-16-P or CYN-16-R (Canada) Specification...........................................
......................................................................................................................................................WS
H-M17B19-A Fill Capacity....................................................................................................................
...................................................................0.94 kg (33 oz) (2.07 lb)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Page
5944
Refrigerant: Testing and Inspection
Refrigerant Identification Testing
Refrigerant Identification
1. NOTE: A Refrigerant Blend Identifier with Printer must be used to identify gas samples taken
directly from the refrigeration system or storage
containers prior to recovering or charging the refrigerant system.
Follow the instructions included with the Refrigerant Blend Identifier with Printer to obtain the
sample for testing.
2. The Refrigerant Blend Identifier with Printer will display one of the following:
- If the purity level of R-134a is 98% or greater by weight, the green PASS LED will light. The
weight concentrations of R-134a, R-12, R-22, hydrocarbons and air will be displayed on the digital
display.
- If refrigerant R-134a does not meet the 98% purity level, the red FAIL LED will light and an alarm
will sound alerting the user of potential hazards. The weight concentrations of R-134a, R-12, R-22
and hydrocarbons will be displayed on the digital display.
- If hydrocarbon concentrations are 2% or greater by weight, the red FAIL LED will light,
"Hydrocarbon High" will be displayed on the digital display, and an alarm will sound alerting the
user of potential hazards. The weight concentrations of R-134a, R-12, R-22 and hydrocarbons will
also be displayed on the digital display.
3. The percentage of air contained in the sample will be displayed if the R-134a content is 98% or
greater. The Refrigerant Blend Identifier with
Printer eliminates the effect of air when determining the refrigerant sample content because air is
not considered a contaminant, although air can affect A/C system performance. When the
Refrigerant Blend Identifier with Printer has determined that a refrigerant source is pure (R-134a is
98% or greater by weight) and air concentration levels are 2% or greater by weight, the scan tool
will prompt the user if an air purge is desired.
4. If contaminated refrigerant is detected, repeat the refrigerant identification test to verify that the
refrigerant is indeed contaminated.
Contaminated Refrigerant Handling
NOTICE: If contaminated refrigerant is detected, DO NOT recover the refrigerant into R-134a
recovery/recycling equipment. Recovery of contaminated refrigerant will contaminate the recovered
refrigerant supply and may damage the recovery/recycling equipment.
NOTE: A new suction accumulator or receiver/drier must be installed as directed by the A/C system
flushing procedure.
1. Recover the contaminated refrigerant using suitable recovery-only equipment designed for
capturing and storing contaminated refrigerant only.
- If this equipment is not available, contact an A/C service facility in the area with the correct
equipment to carry out this service.
2. Determine and correct the cause of the customers initial concern.
3. Flush the A/C system.
4. Dispose of the contaminated refrigerant in accordance with all federal, state and local
regulations.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air
Conditioning (A/C) System Recovery, Evacuation and Charging
Refrigerant: Service and Repair Air Conditioning (A/C) System Recovery, Evacuation and Charging
Air Conditioning (A/C) System Recovery, Evacuation and Charging
Refrigerant System Recovery
NOTICE: An Air Conditioning (A/C) refrigerant analyzer must be used before the recovery of any
vehicle's A/C refrigerant. Failure to do so puts the shop's bulk refrigerant at risk of contamination. If
the vehicle's A/C refrigerant is contaminated, refer the customer to the service
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air
Conditioning (A/C) System Recovery, Evacuation and Charging > Page 5947
facility that carried out the last A/C service. If the customer wishes to pay the additional cost, use
the A/C recovery equipment that is designated for recovering contaminated A/C refrigerant. All
contaminated A/C refrigerant must be disposed of as hazardous waste. For all equipment, follow
the equipment manufacturer procedures and instructions.
NOTE: Ford Motor Company recommends the use of R-134a refrigerant management equipment
that meets the requirements of the SAE J2788 standard.
NOTE: Ford Motor Company recommends use of a R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine to
carry out recovery. If a R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine is not available, refrigerant
system recovery may be accomplished using a separate recovery station.
NOTE: Leaks in refrigerant system service equipment, hoses or gauges can cause a leak in
vacuum that may be misinterpreted as a problem with the vehicle's refrigerant system. It is
necessary to leak-test all refrigerant system service equipment, hoses and gauges on a weekly
basis to verify that no leaks are present.
1. Prior to recovering, the purity of the refrigerant must be verified. For additional information, refer
to Refrigerant Identification Testing See:
Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/Refrigerant Identification
Testing.
2. Connect a R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine to the low- and high-pressure service
gauge port valves following the operating instructions
provided by the equipment manufacturer.
3. Recover the refrigerant from the system following the operating instructions provided by the
equipment manufacturer. Note the amount of oil
removed during the refrigerant recovery (if any). Add that same amount back into the system once
repairs are complete.
4. Once the R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine has recovered the refrigerant, switch OFF
the power supply.
5. Allow the system to set for about 2 minutes, and observe the system vacuum reading. If the
vacuum is not lost, disconnect the recovery equipment.
6. If the system does lose vacuum, repeat Steps 3 through 5 until the vacuum level remains stable
for 2 minutes.
7. Carry out the required repairs.
Refrigerant System Evacuation Using a R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine
NOTE: Ford Motor Company recommends use of a R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine to
carry out recovery, evacuation and charging of the refrigerant system. If a R-134a Refrigerant
Management Machine is not available, evacuation may be accomplished using a separate Vacuum
Pump and R-134a Manifold Gauge Set.
NOTE: Leaks in refrigerant system service equipment, hoses or gauges can cause a leak in
vacuum that may be misinterpreted as a problem with the vehicle's refrigerant system. It is
necessary to leak-test all refrigerant system service equipment, hoses and gauges on a weekly
basis to verify that no leaks are present.
1. Connect a R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine to the low- and high-pressure service
gauge port valves following the operating instructions
provided by the equipment manufacturer.
2. Evacuate the system until the low-pressure gauge reads at least 99.4 kPa (29.5 in-Hg) of
vacuum and as close to 101.1 kPa (30 in-Hg) as possible.
Continue to operate the Vacuum Pump for a minimum of 45 minutes.
3. Turn OFF the Vacuum Pump. Observe the low-pressure gauge for 5 minutes to make sure that
the system vacuum is held. If vacuum is not held for
5 minutes, leak test the system, repair the leak and evacuate the system again.
Refrigerant System Evacuation Using a R-134a Manifold Gauge Set and Vacuum Pump
NOTE: Ford Motor Company recommends use of a R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine to
carry out evacuation of the refrigerant system. If a R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine is not
available, refrigerant system evacuation may be accomplished using a separate Vacuum Pump
and R-134a Manifold Gauge Set.
NOTE: Leaks in refrigerant system service equipment, hoses or gauges can cause a leak in
vacuum that may be misinterpreted as a problem with the vehicle's refrigerant system. It is
necessary to leak-test all refrigerant system service equipment, hoses and gauges on a weekly
basis to verify that no leaks are present.
1. Connect the R-134a Manifold Gauge Set to the low-side and high-side service gauge port
valves.
2. Connect the center (yellow) hose from the R-134a Manifold Gauge Set to the suction port on the
Vacuum Pump.
3. Open all valves on the R-134a Manifold Gauge Set and both service gauge port valves.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air
Conditioning (A/C) System Recovery, Evacuation and Charging > Page 5948
4. Turn on the Vacuum Pump and evacuate the system until the low-pressure gauge reads at least
99.4 kPa (29.5 in-Hg) of vacuum and as close to
101.1 kPa (30 in-Hg) as possible. Continue to operate the Vacuum Pump for a minimum of 45
minutes.
5. Close the high-side and low-side valves on the R-134a Manifold Gauge Set (not the service
gauge port valves) and turn OFF the Vacuum Pump.
6. Observe the low-pressure gauge for 5 minutes to make sure that the system vacuum is held. If
vacuum is not held for 5 minutes, leak test the
system, repair the leak and evacuate the system again.
Refrigerant System Charging Using a R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine
NOTE: Ford Motor Company recommends use of a R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine to
carry out charging of the refrigerant system. If a R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine is not
available, refrigerant system charging may be accomplished using a separate Automatic
Refrigerant Charging Meter and R-134a Manifold Gauge Set.
NOTE: Leaks in refrigerant system service equipment, hoses or gauges can cause a leak that may
be misinterpreted as a problem with the vehicle's refrigerant system. It is necessary to leak-test all
refrigerant system service equipment, hoses and gauges on a weekly basis to verify that no leaks
are present.
1. Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil. For additional
information, refer to Refrigerant Oil Adding See:
Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Adding.
2. Connect a R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine to the low-side and high-side service
gauge port valves following the operating instructions
provided by the equipment manufacturer.
3. Set the refrigerant charge amount, and charge the refrigerant system following the instructions
provided by the equipment manufacturer.
Refrigerant System Charging Using a R-134a Manifold Gauge Set and Automatic Refrigerant
Charging Meter
NOTE: Ford Motor Company recommends use of a R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine to
carry out charging of the refrigerant system. If a R-134a Refrigerant Management Machine is not
available, refrigerant system charging may be accomplished using a separate Automatic
Refrigerant Charging Meter and R-134a Manifold Gauge Set.
NOTE: Leaks in refrigerant system service equipment, hoses or gauges can cause a leak that may
be misinterpreted as a problem with the vehicle's refrigerant system. It is necessary to leak-test all
refrigerant system service equipment, hoses and gauges on a weekly basis to verify that no leaks
are present.
1. Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil. For additional
information, refer to Refrigerant Oil Adding See:
Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Adding.
2. Assemble the R-134a Manifold Gauge Set, Automatic Refrigerant Charging Meter and R-134a
supply tank following the Automatic Refrigerant
Charging Meter operating instructions.
3. Charge the refrigerant system following the Automatic Refrigerant Charging Meter operating
instructions.
4. If the refrigerant flow stops before the refrigerant charge is complete, start the engine, select
MAX A/C operation and allow the refrigerant charge
to complete.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air
Conditioning (A/C) System Recovery, Evacuation and Charging > Page 5949
Refrigerant: Service and Repair Refrigerant System Filtering Following Air Conditioning (A/C)
Compressor Installation
Refrigerant System Filtering Following Air Conditioning (A/C) Compressor Installation
NOTICE: On vehicles being serviced for an internal compressor or desiccant failure, a new
Thermostatic Expansion Valve (TXV), auxiliary system TXV (if equipped) and any hoses containing
mufflers must be installed prior to filtering the Air Conditioning (A/C) system. Internal plumbing of
these devices makes it impossible to correctly remove any foreign material/debris. These
components are typically discarded after A/C system contamination. Hoses without mufflers can
normally be reused unless they are clogged with foreign material. The F8VZ-19E773-AB filter is
intended for use on one vehicle only.
1. Remove the condenser core.
2. Remove the plastic receiver/drier cap.
3. Remove the receiver/drier plug.
1. Push the receiver/drier plug upwards and remove the snap ring.
2. Install an M5 bolt in the center of the receiver/drier plug and remove the plug.
4. Using a suitable tool, grasp the receiver/drier cartridge grab handle and remove the
receiver/drier cartridge.
5. NOTE: Do not install a new receiver/drier cartridge at this time.
With the receiver/drier cartridge removed, reinstall the receiver/drier plug and snap ring into the
condenser core.
6. NOTE: Do not evacuate or charge the refrigerant system at this time.
NOTE: The RH headlamp assembly must remain removed for access to the condenser outlet
fitting.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair > Air
Conditioning (A/C) System Recovery, Evacuation and Charging > Page 5950
Install the condenser core back into the vehicle and completely reassemble the vehicle except for
the condenser outlet fitting and RH headlamp assembly.
7. NOTICE: The flexible extension adapters included in the A/C Flush Adapter Kit (219-00074) are
designed for low-pressure flushing and
are not designed for use with a charged refrigerant system. Do not make the condenser fitting
connections using the flexible extension adapters or damage to the adapters and loss of refrigerant
will occur.
NOTE: Use flexible refrigerant hose of 17,238 kPa (2,500 psi) burst rating.
Using the correct adapters and service hoses, install the pancake filter between the condenser
outlet and the condenser outlet fitting.
8. Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil. For additional
information, refer to Refrigerant Oil Adding See:
Service and Repair/Refrigerant Oil Adding.
9. Evacuate and charge the refrigerant system. For additional information, refer to Air Conditioning
(A/C) System Recovery, Evacuation and
Charging See: Service and Repair/Air Conditioning (A/C) System Recovery, Evacuation and
Charging.
10. Provide adequate airflow to the front of the vehicle (with a fan, if necessary). Start the engine
and allow it to idle briefly. Select A/C operation and
set the blower speed to HI. Verify that the A/C is operating correctly.
11. If the vehicle is equipped with auxiliary A/C, set the auxiliary system to full COOL at HI blower
speed. Verify that the auxiliary A/C is operating
correctly.
12. Gradually bring the engine up to 1,200 rpm by running it at lower rpms for short periods (first at
800 rpm, then at 1,000 rpm). Set the engine at
1,200 rpm and run it for one hour with the A/C system operating.
13. Stop the engine.
14. Recover the refrigerant. For additional information, refer to Air Conditioning (A/C) System
Recovery, Evacuation and Charging See: Service and
Repair/Air Conditioning (A/C) System Recovery, Evacuation and Charging.
15. Remove the pancake filter, hoses and adapter from the vehicle.
16. Remove the condenser core.
17. Remove and discard the receiver/drier plug snap ring and the receiver/drier plug.
18. Install a new receiver/drier cartridge.
19. NOTE: The vehicle should be fully assembled at the completion of this step.
Install the condenser core.
20. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system. For additional information refer to Air
Conditioning (A/C) System Recovery, Evacuation and
Charging See: Service and Repair/Air Conditioning (A/C) System Recovery, Evacuation and
Charging.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications
Refrigerant Oil: Capacity Specifications
Item.........................................................................................................................................PAG
Refrigerant Compressor Oil (R-134a Systems) YN-12-D Specification...............................................
..................................................................................................................................................WSHM1C231-B Fill Capacity........................................................................................................................
......................................207 ml (7 fl oz) See: Service and Repair
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications > Page 5955
Refrigerant Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Item.........................................................................................................................................PAG
Refrigerant Compressor Oil (R-134a Systems) YN-12-D Specification...............................................
..................................................................................................................................................WSHM1C231-B Fill Capacity........................................................................................................................
......................................207 ml (7 fl oz) See: Service and Repair
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Page
5956
Refrigerant Oil: Service and Repair
Refrigerant Oil Adding
Refrigerant Oil Adding
NOTICE: During normal Air Conditioning (A/C) operation, oil is circulated through the system with
the refrigerant, and a small amount is retained in each component. If certain components of the
system are removed, some of the refrigerant oil will go with the component. To maintain the original
total oil charge, it is necessary to compensate for the oil lost by adding oil to the system with the
new part.
1. Refer to the chart below for refrigerant oil adding amounts and methods of installation.
a If an excessive amount of refrigerant oil is lost due to a hose rupture/separation or other damage,
the total system refrigerant oil capacity must be
added.
b The amount specified may be used for one or multiple O-ring leak repairs. Do not multiply the
refrigerant oil amount by the number of O-ring leaks
being repaired.
Refrigerant Oil Adding for New A/C Compressor Without Clutch Installation
NOTE: Service A/C compressors are shipped without refrigerant oil.
1. Rotate the old A/C compressor shaft 8 to 10 full rotations (clockwise) while collecting the
refrigerant oil in a clean measuring cup.
- Add the same amount plus the amount collected during refrigerant recovery.
Refrigerant Oil Adding for New A/C Compressor With Clutch Installation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Page
5957
1. Rotate the old A/C compressor shaft 6 to 8 revolutions while collecting oil in a clean measuring
device.
- If the amount of oil drained from the old A/C compressor is less than 89 ml (3 oz), remove 118 ml
(4 oz) from the new A/C compressor.
- If the amount of oil drained from the old A/C compressor is 89 ml (3 oz), remove 89 ml (3 oz) from
the new A/C compressor.
- If the amount of oil drained from the old A/C compressor is 118 ml (4 oz), remove 59 ml (2 oz)
from the new A/C compressor.
- If the amount of oil drained from the old A/C compressor is 148 ml (5 oz), remove 29 ml (1 oz)
from the new A/C compressor.
- If the amount of oil drained from the old A/C compressor is greater than 148 ml (5 oz), remove 0
ml (0 oz) from the new A/C compressor.
Oil Injection Using a Dye/Lubricant Injector
NOTE: The dye/lubricant injector is included as part of the 219-00069 R-134a Loop/Add On
Injector Kit-Set.
NOTE: If fluorescent leak detection dye is also to be added during A/C charging, the dye may be
added to the dye/lubricant injector along with the refrigerant oil.
1. Evacuate the refrigerant system. For additional information, refer to Air Conditioning (A/C)
System Recovery, Evacuation and Charging See:
Service and Repair/Air Conditioning (A/C) System Recovery, Evacuation and Charging.
2. Assemble the dye/lubricant injector using the correct adapters to match the amount of refrigerant
compressor oil to be injected.
3. Verify that all the valves on the dye/lubricant injector are closed.
4. Fill the dye/lubricant injector with the correct amount of new refrigerant compressor oil.
5. Install the dye/lubricant injector between the low-side service gauge port valve and the
refrigerant service station or manifold gauge set.
6. Open all valves and charge the refrigerant system. For additional information, refer to Air
Conditioning (A/C) System Recovery, Evacuation and
Charging See: Service and Repair/Air Conditioning (A/C) System Recovery, Evacuation and
Charging.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Air Conditioning (A/C) Cycling Switch
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning (A/C) Cycling
Switch
Engine Control Components
Air Conditioning (A/C) Cycling Switch
The A/C cycling switch may be wired to either the ACCS or ACPSW PCM input. When the A/C
cycling switch opens, the PCM turns off the A/C clutch. For information on the specific function of
the A/C cycling switch, refer to the Climate Control System Air Conditioning System Overview.
Also, refer to the applicable Wiring Diagrams for vehicle specific wiring.
If the ACCS signal is not received by the PCM, the PCM circuit will not allow the A/C to operate.
For additional information, refer to wide open throttle air conditioning cutoff (WAC).
Some applications do not have a dedicated (separate) input to the PCM indicating that A/C is
requested. This information is received by the PCM through the communication link.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Air Conditioning (A/C) Cycling Switch > Page 5963
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning (A/C) High
Pressure Switch
Engine Control Components
Air Conditioning (A/C) High Pressure Switch
The A/C high pressure switch is used for additional A/C system pressure control. The A/C high
pressure switch is either dual function for multiple speed, relay controlled for electric fan
applications, or single function for all others.
For refrigerant containment control, the normally closed high pressure contacts open at a
predetermined A/C pressure. This results in the A/C turning off, preventing the A/C pressure from
rising to a level that would open the A/C high pressure relief valve.
For fan control, the normally open medium pressure contacts close at a predetermined A/C
pressure. This grounds the ACPSW circuit input to the PCM. The PCM then turns on the high
speed fan to help reduce the pressure.
For additional information, refer to the Climate Control System, Air Conditioning System Overview
or the Wiring Diagrams.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Air Conditioning (A/C) Cycling Switch > Page 5964
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning Pressure (ACP)
Transducer Sensor
Engine Control Components
Air Conditioning Pressure (ACP) Transducer Sensor
The ACP transducer sensor is located in the high pressure (discharge) side of the A/C system. The
ACP transducer sensor provides a voltage signal to the PCM that is proportional to the A/C
pressure. The PCM uses this information for A/C clutch control, fan control and idle speed control.
A/C Pressure Transducer Sensor Output Voltage Vs Pressure Chart
Typical ACP Transducer Sensor
Typical ACP Transducer Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Blower Motor Relay
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Blower Motor Relay > Page 5970
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Blower Motor Relay > Page 5971
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Blower Motor Relay > Page 5972
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Blower Motor Relay
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Blower Motor Relay
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Blower Motor Relay > Page 5975
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Blower Motor Relay > Page 5976
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Auxiliary Blower Motor Relay 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Blower Motor Relay > Page 5977
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Blower Motor Relay > Page 5978
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Auxiliary Blower Motor Relay 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Blower Motor Relay > Page 5979
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Blower Motor Relay > Page 5980
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Auxiliary Blower Motor Relay 3
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Blower Motor Relay > Page 5981
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 5985
Compressor Clutch Relay: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Air Conditioning (A/C) Clutch Relay (A/CCR)
Note: The PCM parameter identifiers (PIDs) wide open throttle air conditioning cutoff (WAC) and
wide open throttle air conditioning cutoff fault (WAC_F) are used to monitor the A/CCR output.
The A/CCR is wired normally open. There is no direct electrical connection between the A/C switch
or electronic automatic temperature control (EATC) module and the A/C clutch. The PCM receives
a signal indicating that A/C is requested. For some applications, this message is sent through the
communications network. When A/C is requested, the PCM checks other A/C related inputs that
are available, such as A/C pressure switch and A/C cycling switch. If these inputs indicate A/C
operation and the engine conditions are OK (coolant temperature, engine RPM, throttle position),
the PCM grounds the A/CCR output, closing the relay contacts and sending voltage to the A/CCR.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > HVAC Module, EMTC
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > HVAC Module, EMTC > Page 5990
Control Module HVAC: Locations HVAC Module, DATC
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > HVAC Module, EMTC > Page 5991
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > HVAC Module, DATC
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams HVAC Module, DATC
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > HVAC Module, DATC > Page 5994
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > HVAC Module, DATC > Page 5995
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams HVAC Module, EMTC
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > HVAC Module, DATC > Page 5996
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > HVAC Module, DATC > Page 5997
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6002
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6003
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6007
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6008
Blower Motor Switch: Service and Repair
Blower Motor Speed Control
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH lower instrument panel insulator (if equipped).
2. Disconnect the blower motor speed control electrical connector.
3. Remove the 2 blower motor speed control screws.
4. Remove the blower motor speed control.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6012
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6013
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Ambient Air Temperature Sensor
Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair Ambient Air Temperature Sensor
Ambient Air Temperature Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the upper radiator sight shield.
2. Detach and disconnect the ambient temperature sensor electrical connector.
3. Remove the ambient air temperature sensor.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Ambient Air Temperature Sensor > Page 6016
Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor
In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor - Expedition
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument cluster finish panel.
2. Remove the in-vehicle temperature sensor.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Locations
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6020
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6021
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Air Conditioning
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning
Air Conditioning
Evaporator Temperature Sensor
The evaporator temperature sensor communicates the evaporator fin temperature to the HVAC
module.
The PCM maintains evaporator core temperature and prevents icing of the evaporator core, by
disengaging the A/C compressor clutch when the evaporator temperature sensor reading falls
below acceptable levels, and by engaging the A/C compressor clutch when the discharge air
temperature rises above acceptable levels.
The evaporator temperature sensor electrical connector is located outside of the heater core and
evaporator core housing behind the glove compartment, with the sensor pigtail leading into the
housing to the sensor probe which is inserted between the evaporator core fins.
The evaporator temperature sensor is not available as a separate component. To install a new
evaporator temperature sensor, a new heater core and evaporator core housing must be installed.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Air Conditioning > Page 6024
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Engine Control Components
Engine Control Components
Air Conditioning Evaporator Temperature (ACET) Sensor
The ACET sensor measures the evaporator air discharge temperature. The ACET sensor is a
thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of a
thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance increases as the
temperature decreases. The PCM sources a low current 5 volts on the ACET circuit. With SIG RTN
also connected to the ACET sensor, the varying resistance changes the voltage drop across the
sensor terminals. As A/C evaporator air temperature changes, the varying resistance of the ACET
sensor changes the voltage the PCM detects.
The ACET sensor is used to more accurately control A/C clutch cycling and improve defrost/demist
performance.
Note: These values can vary 15% due to sensor and VREF variations. Voltage values were
calculated for VREF equals 5.0 volts.
A/C Evaporator Temperature (ACET) Sensor Voltage And Resistance Chart
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 6025
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
Air Conditioning (A/C) Evaporator Discharge Air Temperature Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Detach the glove compartment dampener and lower the glove compartment.
2. Disconnect the evaporator discharge air temperature sensor electrical connector.
3. Carefully pry the evaporator discharge air temperature sensor probe out of the heater core and
evaporator core housing.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > Air Conditioning (A/C) Cycling Switch
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning (A/C) Cycling
Switch
Engine Control Components
Air Conditioning (A/C) Cycling Switch
The A/C cycling switch may be wired to either the ACCS or ACPSW PCM input. When the A/C
cycling switch opens, the PCM turns off the A/C clutch. For information on the specific function of
the A/C cycling switch, refer to the Climate Control System Air Conditioning System Overview.
Also, refer to the applicable Wiring Diagrams for vehicle specific wiring.
If the ACCS signal is not received by the PCM, the PCM circuit will not allow the A/C to operate.
For additional information, refer to wide open throttle air conditioning cutoff (WAC).
Some applications do not have a dedicated (separate) input to the PCM indicating that A/C is
requested. This information is received by the PCM through the communication link.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > Air Conditioning (A/C) Cycling Switch > Page 6031
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning (A/C) High
Pressure Switch
Engine Control Components
Air Conditioning (A/C) High Pressure Switch
The A/C high pressure switch is used for additional A/C system pressure control. The A/C high
pressure switch is either dual function for multiple speed, relay controlled for electric fan
applications, or single function for all others.
For refrigerant containment control, the normally closed high pressure contacts open at a
predetermined A/C pressure. This results in the A/C turning off, preventing the A/C pressure from
rising to a level that would open the A/C high pressure relief valve.
For fan control, the normally open medium pressure contacts close at a predetermined A/C
pressure. This grounds the ACPSW circuit input to the PCM. The PCM then turns on the high
speed fan to help reduce the pressure.
For additional information, refer to the Climate Control System, Air Conditioning System Overview
or the Wiring Diagrams.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > Air Conditioning (A/C) Cycling Switch > Page 6032
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning Pressure (ACP)
Transducer Sensor
Engine Control Components
Air Conditioning Pressure (ACP) Transducer Sensor
The ACP transducer sensor is located in the high pressure (discharge) side of the A/C system. The
ACP transducer sensor provides a voltage signal to the PCM that is proportional to the A/C
pressure. The PCM uses this information for A/C clutch control, fan control and idle speed control.
A/C Pressure Transducer Sensor Output Voltage Vs Pressure Chart
Typical ACP Transducer Sensor
Typical ACP Transducer Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations
Solar Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6036
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6037
Solar Sensor: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Service Port HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Service Port HVAC: Description and Operation
Air Conditioning
Service Gauge Port Valves
The high-pressure service gauge port valve is located on the high-pressure side of the TXV
manifold and tube at the RH rear of the engine compartment.
The low-pressure service gauge port valve is located on the low-pressure side of the TXV manifold
and tube at the RH rear of the engine compartment.
The fitting is an integral part of the refrigeration line or component.
- Special couplings are required for both the high-side and low-side service gauge ports.
- A very small amount of leakage will always be detectable around the Schrader-type valve, with
the service gauge port valve cap removed, and is considered normal. A new Schrader-type valve
core can be installed if the seal leaks excessively.
- The service gauge port valve caps are used as primary seals in the refrigerant system to prevent
leakage through the Schrader-type valves from reaching the atmosphere. Always install and tighten
the A/C service gauge port valve caps to the correct torque after they are removed.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
Solar Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component Information > Locations >
Page 6044
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component Information > Locations >
Page 6045
Solar Sensor: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision > System Information >
Service and Repair > Inspection and Repair After A Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deployment
Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision: Service and Repair Inspection and Repair After
A Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deployment
Inspection and Repair After a Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deployment
WARNING: Remove restraint system diagnostic tools from the vehicle prior to road testing. If tools
are not removed, the supplemental restraint system (SRS) device may not deploy in a crash.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury or death in a crash and
possibly violate vehicle safety standards.
NOTE: After diagnosing or repairing a Supplemental Restraint System (SRS), the restraint system
diagnostic tools (if required) must be removed before operating the vehicle over the road.
NOTE: Deployable devices (such as air bag modules, pretensioners) may deploy alone or in
various combinations depending on the impact event.
NOTE: Always refer to the appropriate diagnostic/repair information procedures prior to carrying
out vehicle repairs affecting the SRS and safety belt system.
NOTE: The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the
customer.
All vehicles
1. NOTE: Refer to the correct removal and installation procedure for all SRS components being
installed.
When any deployable device or combination of devices are deployed and/or the Restraints Control
Module (RCM) has the DTC B1231 (Event Threshold Exceeded) in memory, the repair of the
vehicle SRS is to include the removal of all deployed devices and the installation of new deployable
devices, the removal and installation of new impact sensors, and the removal and installation of a
new RCM. DTCs must be cleared from all required modules after repairs are carried out.
Vehicles with Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) system
2. NOTE: After installation of new Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) system components,
carry out the Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS)
System Reset procedure as instructed in the diagnostic/repair information. Refer to the appropriate
diagnostic/repair information for OCS system removal and installation procedure.
When a vehicle has been involved in a collision and the Occupant Classification System Module
(OCSM) has DTC B1231/B1193:00 stored in memory, the repair of the OCS system is to include
the following procedures for the specified system: For rail-type OCS system, inspect the passenger side floorpan for damage and repair as
necessary. Install new OCS system rails. Do not install a new OCSM unless DTC B1231 cannot be
cleared.
- For weight sensor bolt-type OCS system, inspect the passenger side floorpan for damage and
repair as necessary. Install a new seat track with OCS system weight sensor bolts. DTC must be
cleared from the OCSM before carrying out Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Reset.
Do not install a new OCSM unless DTC B1231/B1193:00 cannot be cleared.
- NOTE: Most bladder-type OCSM do not store a DTC B1231 in memory after deployment. The
DTC B1231 is stored only by the RCM.
For bladder-type OCS system, inspect for damage and repair as necessary. If installation of an
OCS system component is required, an OCS system service kit must be installed.
All vehicles
3. When any damage to the impact sensor mounting points or mounting hardware has occurred,
repair or install new mounting points and mounting
hardware as needed.
4. When the driver air bag module has deployed, a new clockspring must be installed.
5. New driver and/or front passenger safety belt systems (including retractors, buckles and height
adjusters) must be installed if the vehicle is
involved in a collision that results in deployment of the driver and/or front passenger safety belt
pretensioners. For additional information, refer to Seat Belt Systems.
6. Inspect the entire vehicle for damage, including the following components:
- Steering column (deployable column if equipped)
- Instrument panel knee bolsters and mounting points
- Instrument panel braces and brackets
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision > System Information >
Service and Repair > Inspection and Repair After A Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deployment > Page 6051
- Instrument panel and mounting points
- Seats and seat mounting points
- Safety belts, safety belt buckles and safety belt retractors. For additional information, refer to Seat
Belt Systems
- SRS wiring, wiring harnesses and connectors
7. After carrying out the review and inspection of the entire vehicle for damage, repair or install new
components as needed.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision > System Information >
Service and Repair > Inspection and Repair After A Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deployment > Page 6052
Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision: Service and Repair Safety Belt Procedure After
A Collision
Safety Belt Procedure After a Collision
WARNING: After any crash, all of the following safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware must
be inspected by an authorized dealer to verify correct function:
- Retractors
- Buckles
- Belt tension sensor (BTS) (if equipped)
- Front safety belt buckle support assemblies (slide bar) (if equipped)
- Safety belt shoulder belt height adjusters (if equipped)
- Child safety seat tether bracket assemblies
- Automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature for child safety seats (passenger seating positions only)
If any safety belt assembly is damaged, does not operate correctly or does not pass all of the
Functional Tests in the Diagnosis and Testing portion, a new safety belt assembly must be
installed. If any safety belt assembly attaching areas are damaged or distorted, the sheet metal
must be restored to its original structural integrity and new safety belt assembly and attaching
hardware must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware
may increase the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
After any crash that results in deployment of the driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt
pretensioners, new driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt systems (including retractors,
buckles and height adjusters) must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt systems increases
the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
1. Before installing a new safety belt assembly, the safety belt attaching areas must be inspected
for damage and distortion. If the attaching points are
damaged and distorted, the sheet metal must be worked back to its original shape and structural
integrity.
2. Install the new safety belt(s). For additional information, refer to the appropriate procedure. Carry
out all applicable Functional Tests for the
component(s). For additional information, refer to the appropriate Functional Test procedure in
Safety Belt System See: Seat Belt Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering
Depowering Procedure
WARNING: Always wear eye protection when servicing a vehicle. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on air bag, Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain
modules. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of these
modules, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the
restraints control module (RCM) while the RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON. Failure
to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of the Safety Canopy(R) and
cause serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: To reduce the risk of accidental deployment, do not use any memory saver devices.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF.
2. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
3. At the Smart Junction Box (SJB), located in the RH lower kick panel, remove the cover and the
RCM fuse 32 (10A) from the SJB. For additional
information, refer to the Wiring Diagrams.
4. Turn the ignition switch ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30
seconds. The air bag warning indicator will remain
lit continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
6. WARNING: Always deplete the backup power supply before repairing or installing any new front
or side air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) component and before servicing, removing, installing, adjusting or striking
components near the front or side impact sensors or the restraints control module (RCM). Nearby
components include doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood
latches.
Refer to the Description and Operation portion of Air Bag Systems for location of the RCM and
impact sensor(s).
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
1 minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury or death in the event of an
accidental deployment.
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
Repowering Procedure
1. Make sure that all SRS components are connected.
2. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 6058
3. Install RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the SJB and close the cover.
4. WARNING: Make sure no one is in the vehicle and there is nothing blocking or placed in front of
any air bag module when the battery is
connected. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury in the event of
an accidental deployment.
Connect the battery ground cable.
5. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the back to ON and visually monitor
the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag warning indicator will
illuminate continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an SRS fault is present,
the air bag warning indicator will:
- fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The flashing might not occur until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition has been turned from
the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to complete the testing of the
SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault exists, a chime will sound in a
pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning indicator and any SRS fault
discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous DTCs from the RCM using a scan tool.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 6059
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Deactivation and Reactivation
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deactivation and Reactivation
Deactivation
WARNING: Always carry or place a live air bag module with the air bag and deployment door/trim
cover/tear seam pointed away from the body. Do not set a live air bag module down with the
deployment door/trim cover/tear seam face down. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on air bag, Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain
modules. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of these
modules, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: To reduce the risk of accidental deployment, do not use any memory saver devices.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF.
2. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
3. At the Smart Junction Box (SJB), located in the RH lower kick panel, remove the cover and the
RCM fuse 32 (10A) from the SJB. For additional
information, refer to the Wiring Diagrams.
4. Turn the ignition switch ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30
seconds. The air bag warning indicator will remain
lit continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: Always deplete the backup power supply before repairing or installing any new front
or side air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) component and before servicing, removing, installing, adjusting or striking
components near the front or side impact sensors or the restraints control module (RCM). Nearby
components include doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood
latches.
Refer to the Description and Operation portion of Air Bag Systems for location of the RCM and
impact sensor(s).
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
1 minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury or death in the event of an
accidental deployment.
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
7. Make sure the road wheels are in the straight-ahead position.
8. Center the tilt steering column to allow for steering column upper and lower shroud removal.
9. NOTICE: Turn the steering wheel such that the top is at 90 degrees (at the 9 o'clock position) to
the left from the straight-ahead position
to access the driver air bag module wire clips and to prevent damage to the steering column
multi-function switch. Failure to follow this instruction may result in component damage.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 6060
Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is 90 degrees to the left (at the 9 o'clock position)
as shown.
10. Remove the lower steering column opening cover.
- Remove the 3 screws.
- Pull out to release the top retainers.
- Remove the lower steering column opening cover. If equipped, disconnect the adjustable pedals switch connector.
11. If equipped, remove the screw and steering column manual tilt lever.
12. Remove the 3 steering column lower shroud screws.
13. Release the clips and remove the steering column upper shroud.
14. Remove the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, disconnect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
15. NOTICE: Make sure each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are disengaged from each of
the 3 steering wheel hooks before
removing the driver air bag module from the steering wheel. Failure to follow this instruction may
result in component damage and/or system failure.
NOTE: Steering wheel is removed for clarity. The rear of the steering wheel is shown.
NOTE: Use a mirror to view the rear of the steering wheel to locate where the 3 driver air bag
module wire clips attach to the steering wheel hooks.
Using a screwdriver or a suitable tool, release each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips from
the steering wheel hooks. Access the 3 driver air bag module wire clips through the back of the steering wheel cover and
push the wire clips toward the center of the steering wheel to release.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 6061
16. NOTE: Once the driver air bag module is removed, note the position of the 2 driver air bag
module locator pins on the steering wheel for
installation.
Disconnect the driver air bag module and horn switch electrical connectors and remove the driver
air bag module.
17. Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is back in the straight-ahead position (the 12
o'clock position).
18. Open and lower the glove compartment door to allow access to the passenger air bag electrical
connector.
- If equipped, disconnect the glove compartment door dampener.
19. Disconnect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
20. NOTE: There are 2 similar connectors under the passenger seat. The passenger seat side air
bag module electrical connector is located toward the
seat outboard position.
Remove the passenger front seat cushion panel shield and disconnect the passenger seat side air
bag module electrical.
21. Release the RH second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 6062
22. Remove the bolt and the RH second row safety belt retractor D-ring.
23. Remove the cover and the RH C-pillar trim panel nut.
24. Release the rear door weatherstrip and remove the RH C-pillar trim panel.
25. Disconnect the RH safety canopy module electrical connector.
26. Release the LH second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
27. Remove the bolt and the LH second row safety belt retractor D-ring.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 6063
28. Remove the cover and the LH C-pillar trim panel nut.
29. Release the rear door weatherstrip and remove the driver C-pillar trim panel.
30. Disconnect the LH safety canopy module electrical connector.
31. NOTE: There are 2 similar connectors under the driver seat. The driver seat side air bag
module electrical connector is located toward the seat
outboard position.
Remove the driver front seat cushion panel shield and disconnect the driver seat side air bag
module electrical connector.
32. Install the RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the Smart Junction Box (SJB).
33. Connect the battery ground cable.
Reactivation
1. Remove the RCM fuse 32 (10A) from the SJB.
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
3. Connect the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector and install the driver front seat
cushion panel shield.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 6064
4. Connect the LH safety canopy module electrical connector.
5. Install the LH C-pillar trim panel and attach the rear door weatherstrip.
6. Install the LH C-pillar trim panel nut and cover.
7. Install the LH second row safety belt retractor D-ring and bolt.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
8. Attach the LH second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
9. Connect the RH safety canopy module electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 6065
10. Install the RH C-pillar trim panel and attach the rear door weatherstrip.
11. Install the passenger C-pillar trim panel nut and cover.
12. Install the RH second row safety belt retractor D-ring and bolt.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
13. Attach the RH second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding. Extract and retract the safety belt between the full extension and stowed positions.
- If excessive effort or binding is present, install a new safety belt buckle retractor and tongue
assembly as necessary. For additional information, refer to Seat Belt Systems.
14. Connect the passenger seat side air bag module electrical connector and install the passenger
front seat cushion panel shield.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 6066
15. Connect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
16. Close the glove compartment door.
- If equipped, connect the glove compartment door dampener.
17. NOTICE: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag module. Match
the electrical connector key to the keyway in the driver air bag module. Do not force the electrical
connectors into the driver air bag module. Damage to the connector or component may occur.
Connect the horn switch and 2 driver air bag module electrical connectors.
18. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, lining up the locator pins.
19. NOTE: Make sure that all 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged and seated
correctly to the steering wheel.
NOTE: Audible clicks will be heard when the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged.
Firmly press the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, seating the 3 driver air bag module
wire clips to the steering wheel hooks.
- Check the driver air bag module trim cover to the steering wheel for an even gap clearance and
correct movement.
20. Install the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, connect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
21. Install the steering column upper shroud.
22. Install the 3 steering column lower shroud screws.
23. If equipped, install the steering column manual tilt lever and screw.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
24. If equipped, connect the adjustable pedals switch connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 6067
25. Install the lower steering column opening cover and 3 screws.
26. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON.
27. Install the RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the SJB and install the cover.
28. WARNING: Make sure no one is in the vehicle and there is nothing blocking or placed in front
of any air bag module when the battery is
connected. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury in the event of
an accidental deployment.
Connect the battery ground cable.
29. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition switch from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the ignition switch back to ON
and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag
warning indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag
SRS fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will either:
- fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The air bag warning indicator may not illuminate until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition
switch has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator will need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Clear all continuous memory DTCs from the RCM using a scan tool.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Locations > Driver
Air Bag Module
Air Bag: Locations Driver Air Bag Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Locations > Driver
Air Bag Module > Page 6072
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Locations > Driver
Air Bag Module > Page 6073
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Locations > Driver
Air Bag Module > Page 6074
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Locations > Driver
Air Bag Module > Page 6075
Air Bag: Locations Passenger Air Bag Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Locations > Driver
Air Bag Module > Page 6076
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver
Air Bag Module
Air Bag: Diagrams Driver Air Bag Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver
Air Bag Module > Page 6079
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver
Air Bag Module > Page 6080
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver
Air Bag Module > Page 6081
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver
Air Bag Module > Page 6082
Air Bag: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver
Air Bag Module > Page 6083
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver
Air Bag Module > Page 6084
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver
Air Bag Module > Page 6085
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Air Bag Trim Cover - Passenger
Air Bag: Service and Repair Air Bag Trim Cover - Passenger
Air Bag Trim Cover - Passenger
Expedition
Navigator
Removal
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Air Bag Trim Cover - Passenger > Page 6088
WARNING: Always carry or place a live air bag module with the air bag and deployment door/trim
cover/tear seam pointed away from the body. Do not set a live air bag module down with the
deployment door/trim cover/tear seam face down. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
WARNING: Do not use any sharp tools to separate the passenger air bag module trim cover from
the passenger air bag module canister. Sharp tools may damage the passenger air bag module.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in the passenger air bag module deploying incorrectly
and increases the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
WARNING: Do not unpack or unroll the passenger air bag module soft pack. If the soft pack
becomes unpacked or unrolled, install a new passenger air bag module assembly. Failure to follow
these instructions may result in the passenger air bag module deploying incorrectly and increases
the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
WARNING: Do not manipulate or compromise the passenger air bag module hooks during the
removal or installation procedure. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the passenger air
bag module deploying incorrectly and increases the risk of serious personal injury or death in a
crash.
1. Remove the passenger air bag module. Refer to Passenger Air Bag Module See: Passenger Air
Bag Module.
2. Place a mark on top of the passenger air bag module canister for correct installation.
3. Carefully lift the passenger air bag module cover from the bottom of the air bag module canister,
separating the windows from the canister hooks.
4. NOTE: Place an X mark on the old air bag cover to avoid reinstalling.
Remove the passenger air bag cover from the canister, separating the top windows from the
canister hooks.
Installation
1. Place the passenger air bag cover on a clean work surface once it is removed from the shipping
package.
2. WARNING: Carefully inspect the passenger air bag trim cover, canister and soft pack before
assembly. If any foreign objects are found,
remove them before attaching the passenger air bag trim cover to the canister. If the canister or
soft pack is damaged, install a new passenger air bag module assembly. Failure to follow this
instruction may result in the passenger air bag module deploying incorrectly, which increases the
risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
Match the number of cover windows to the number of canister hooks before attaching the
passenger air bag cover to the canister.
3. Match the top of the passenger air bag cover with the canister mark from the removal procedure.
4. Position the canister onto the passenger air bag cover and engage the bottom hooks into the air
bag cover windows.
5. Push the top of the passenger air bag cover to engage the top canister hooks.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Air Bag Trim Cover - Passenger > Page 6089
6. Inspect the passenger air bag cover windows-to-canister hooks to verify that every window has a
hook installed and the sides are not tucked or
folded against the air bag canister.
7. Install the passenger air bag module. Refer to Passenger Air Bag Module See: Passenger Air
Bag Module.
8. NOTE: The video utilizes an F-Super Duty passenger air bag module assembly. It also applies to
vehicles with similar passenger air bag module
designs.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Air Bag Trim Cover - Passenger > Page 6090
Air Bag: Service and Repair Driver Air Bag Module
Driver Air Bag Module
NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Always carry or place a live air bag module with the air bag and deployment door/trim
cover/tear seam pointed away from the body. Do not set a live air bag module down with the
deployment door/trim cover/tear seam face down. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on air bag, Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain
modules. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of these
modules, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Make sure the road wheels are in the straight-ahead position.
2. Center the tilt steering column to allow for steering column upper and lower shroud removal.
3. NOTICE: Turn the steering wheel such that the top is at 90 degrees (at the 9 o'clock position) to
the left from the straight-ahead position
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Air Bag Trim Cover - Passenger > Page 6091
to access the driver air bag module wire clips and to prevent damage to the steering column
multifunction switch. Failure to follow this instruction may result in component damage.
Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is 90 degrees to the left (at the 9 o'clock position).
4. Depower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering in the General Procedures portion.
5. Remove the lower steering column opening cover.
- Remove the 3 screws.
- Pull out and release the top retainers.
- Remove the lower steering column opening cover. If equipped, disconnect the adjustable pedals switch connector.
6. If equipped, remove the screw and steering column manual tilt lever.
7. Remove the 3 steering column lower shroud screws.
8. Release the clips and remove the steering column upper shroud.
9. Remove the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, disconnect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
10. NOTICE: Make sure each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are disengaged from each of
the 3 steering wheel hooks before
removing the driver air bag module from the steering wheel. Failure to follow this instruction may
result in component damage and/or system failure.
NOTE: Use a mirror to view the rear of the steering wheel to locate where the 3 driver air bag
module wire clips attach to the steering wheel hooks.
Using a screwdriver or a suitable tool, release each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips from
the steering wheel hooks.
- Access the 3 driver air bag module wire clips through the back of the steering wheel cover and
push the wire clips toward the center of the steering wheel to release.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Air Bag Trim Cover - Passenger > Page 6092
11. Disconnect the 2 driver air bag module electrical connectors, horn switch connector and
remove the driver air bag module.
12. Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is back in the straight ahead 12 o'clock position.
Installation
1. Connect the horn switch connector and 2 driver air bag module connectors.
2. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel lining up the locator pins.
3. NOTE: For correct installation, make sure all 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged
and seated correctly to the steering wheel.
Firmly press the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, seating the 3 driver air bag module
wire clips to the steering wheel hooks.
- Check the driver air bag module trim cover to the steering wheel for an even gap clearance and
correct movement.
4. Install the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, connect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
5. Install the steering column upper shroud.
6. Install the 3 steering column lower shroud screws.
7. If equipped, install the steering column manual tilt lever and screw.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Air Bag Trim Cover - Passenger > Page 6093
8. If equipped, connect the adjustable pedals switch connector.
9. Install the lower steering column opening cover and 3 screws.
10. Repower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering in the General Procedures portion.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Air Bag Trim Cover - Passenger > Page 6094
Air Bag: Service and Repair Passenger Air Bag Module
Passenger Air Bag Module
Expedition
Navigator
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Air Bag Trim Cover - Passenger > Page 6095
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Always carry or place a live air bag module with the air bag and deployment door/trim
cover/tear seam pointed away from the body. Do not set a live air bag module down with the
deployment door/trim cover/tear seam face down. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on air bag, Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain
modules. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of these
modules, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death.
NOTICE: Do not install a new passenger air bag module assembly due to a damaged or discolored
passenger air bag cover. The passenger air bag cover can be serviced separately from the
passenger air bag module assembly. For additional information, refer to Air Bag Trim Cover Passenger See: Air Bag Trim Cover - Passenger.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All vehicles
1. Depower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering in the General Procedures portion.
2. Lower the glove compartment door.
3. Disconnect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
Expedition vehicles
4. Remove the 4 passenger air bag trim cover screws.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Air Bag Trim Cover - Passenger > Page 6096
All vehicles
5. Remove the 4 passenger air bag module bolts.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
6. Push out on the bottom of the passenger air bag cover to release the bottom trim cover clips
from the instrument panel and remove the passenger
air bag module.
7. NOTE: For correct installation, make sure all trim cover clips are fully seated into the instrument
panel.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
8. Repower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering in the General Procedures portion.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Air Bag Trim Cover - Passenger > Page 6097
Air Bag: Service and Repair Safety Canopy Module
Safety Canopy Module
NOTE: Expedition shown, other models similar.
Removal
WARNING: Anytime the Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain module has deployed, a new
headliner and new A-, B-, C- and D-pillar upper trim panels and attaching hardware must be
installed. Remove any other damaged components and hardware and install new components and
hardware as needed. Failure to follow these instructions may result in the Safety Canopy(R) or side
air curtain module deploying incorrectly and increases the risk of serious personal injury or death in
a crash.
WARNING: Always carry or place a live air bag module with the air bag and deployment door/trim
cover/tear seam pointed away from the body. Do not set a live air bag module down with the
deployment door/trim cover/tear seam face down. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
WARNING: Do not obstruct or place objects in the deployment path of the Safety Canopy(R) or
side air curtain module. Failure to follow this
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Air Bag Trim Cover - Passenger > Page 6098
instruction may result in the Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain module deploying incorrectly and
increases the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on air bag, Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain
modules. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of these
modules, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All vehicles
1. Depower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering in the General Procedures portion.
2. Remove the headliner.
Vehicles with a moonroof
3. Disconnect the moon roof rear drain hose and release the drain hose retainer from the coat hook
bracket.
All vehicles
4. Disconnect the safety canopy module electrical connector.
5. NOTE: Note the locator tab on the front tether anchor bracket to the A-pillar sheet metal for
installation.
Remove the front tether bolt and bracket from the A-pillar.
6. Remove the 2 front tether cord pin-type retainers from the A-pillar sheet metal.
7. Remove the 2 safety canopy module front bolts and the one B-pillar bracket bolt.
Expedition/Navigator vehicles
8. Detach the safety canopy module rear tether cord routing clip pin-type retainer from the sheet
metal.
9. NOTE: Note the locator tab on the rear tether cord anchor bracket to the D-pillar sheet metal for
installation.
Remove the bolt and the safety canopy module rear tether cord anchor bracket from the D-pillar.
Expedition EL/Navigator L vehicles
10. Detach the 3 safety canopy module rear tether cord routing clip pin-type retainers from the
sheet metal.
11. NOTE: Note the locator tab on the rear tether cord anchor bracket to the D-pillar sheet metal for
installation.
Remove the bolt and the safety canopy module rear tether anchor bracket from the D-pillar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Air Bag Trim Cover - Passenger > Page 6099
All vehicles
12. Remove the C-pillar safety canopy module bolt.
13. Remove the 2 safety canopy module rear bolts and the roof bracket bolt.
14. Gently lift the safety canopy module up and inward at the B-pillar to release the bracket hook
from the sheet metal.
15. Move the safety canopy module forward to release the rear bracket hook from the sheet metal
and remove the safety canopy module.
Installation
All vehicles
WARNING: Never put any type of fastener or tie strap around any part of a Safety Canopy(R)
module, side air curtain module or interior trim panel. This will prevent the Safety Canopy(R) or
side air curtain module from deploying correctly. Failure to follow this instruction may increase the
risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
WARNING: When installing a new headliner on a vehicle equipped with Safety Canopy(R) or side
air curtain modules, make sure the headliner has the word AIRBAG on the headliner where it
meets each B-pillar trim panel. Otherwise, you have the wrong headliner. Failure to follow this
instruction may result in the Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain module not deploying or deploying
incorrectly, increasing the risk of personal injury or death in a crash.
WARNING: Before installing a Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain module, inspect the roofline for
any damage. If necessary, the sheet metal must be reworked to its original condition and structural
integrity. Install new fasteners if damaged and remove foreign material. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in the Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain deploying incorrectly, which
increases the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
WARNING: Inspect a Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain module before installation. If the module
is damaged, the cover has separated or the Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain material has been
exposed, install a new module. Do not attempt to repair the module. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in the Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain deploying incorrectly, which
increases the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
1. Position the safety canopy module by moving it rearward, installing the rear bracket hook in the
sheet metal.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Air Bag Trim Cover - Passenger > Page 6100
2. Install the safety canopy module B-pillar bracket hook in the sheet metal.
3. Install the safety canopy module B-pillar bracket bolt.
- Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
4. Install the safety canopy module roof bracket bolt.
- Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
5. Install the 2 safety canopy module rear bolts.
- Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
6. Install the C-pillar safety canopy module bolt.
- Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
Expedition EL/Navigator L vehicles
7. Install the safety canopy module rear tether anchor bracket and bolt to the D-pillar.
- Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
8. Attach the 3 safety canopy module rear tether routing clip pin-type retainers to the sheet metal.
Expedition/Navigator vehicles
9. Install the safety canopy module rear tether anchor bracket and bolt to the D-pillar.
- Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
10. Attach the safety canopy module rear tether routing clip pin-type retainer to the sheet metal.
All vehicles
11. Install the 2 safety canopy module front bolts.
- Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Air Bag Trim Cover - Passenger > Page 6101
12. Install the 2 front tether pin-type retainers in the A-pillar sheet metal.
13. Install the front tether bracket and bolt in the A-pillar.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
14. Connect the safety canopy module electrical connector.
Vehicles with a moonroof
15. Connect the moonroof rear drain hose and attach the drain hose retainer to the coat hook
bracket.
All vehicles
16. Install the headliner.
17. Repower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering in the General Procedures portion.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Air Bag Trim Cover - Passenger > Page 6102
Air Bag: Service and Repair Side Air Bag Module
Side Air Bag Module
NOTE: Driver seat shown, passenger similar.
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Always carry or place a live air bag module with the air bag and deployment door/trim
cover/tear seam pointed away from the body. Do not set a live air bag module down with the
deployment door/trim cover/tear seam face down. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on air bag, Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain
modules. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of these
modules, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: If the seat side air bag cover has been damaged or separated from its mounting, or if
the air bag material has been exposed, install a new seat side air bag module. Never try to repair
the seat side air bag module. Failure to follow these instructions may result in the seat side air bag
deploying incorrectly, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
WARNING: Front seat backrest trim covers installed on seats equipped with seat side air bags
cannot be repaired. A new trim cover must be installed. Cleaning is permissible. Failure to follow
these instructions may result in the seat side air bag module deploying incorrectly and increase the
risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
NOTE: If a side air bag deployment took place, a new seat back pad, trim cover, side air bag
module and nuts must be installed. The seat back frame should be replaced if necessary.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Move the seat to the full forward and highest position.
2. Depower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering in the General Procedures portion.
3. Release the seat backrest cover lower rear J-clip and unzip the 2 side zippers.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Air Bag Trim Cover - Passenger > Page 6103
4. NOTE: Note the position of the side air bag module locator pin to the seat backrest frame for
installation.
Remove the 2 side air bag module nuts.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
5. Position the backrest foam aside and remove the side air bag module from the backrest frame.
Then slide the side air bag module out of the seat
backrest cover deployment chute. For correct installation, position the locator pin and mounting studs through the holes in the
deployment chute and backrest frame.
6. WARNING: Check the seat side air bag deployment chute for damage. The deployment chute
must not be repaired. If there is any
damage to the deployment chute, a new seat back trim cover and deployment chute must be
installed as a unit. Failure to follow these instructions may result in the seat side air bag module
deploying incorrectly and increase the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
WARNING: Before installing the seat side air bag module/deployment chute assembly: Inspect the side air bag module and mounting surfaces for any damage or foreign material.
- Remove any foreign material from the mounting surfaces of the deployment chute, the seat
backrest frame mounting bracket and the air bag module cavity in the seat backrest foam pad.
- Install new parts if damaged.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in the seat side air bag deploying incorrectly, which
increases the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
WARNING: If the seat side air bag cover has been damaged or separated from its mounting, or if
the air bag material has been exposed, install a new seat side air bag module. Never try to repair
the seat side air bag module. Failure to follow these instructions may result in the seat side air bag
deploying incorrectly, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
7. Repower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering in the General Procedures portion.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations
Air Bag Control Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 6107
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 6108
Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams
C310A
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 6109
C310B Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 6110
C310B Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 6111
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair
Restraints Control Module (RCM)
NOTE: Seats removed for clarity.
Removal
WARNING: If a vehicle has been in a crash, inspect the restraints control module (RCM) and the
impact sensor (if equipped) mounting areas for deformation. If damaged, restore the mounting
areas to the original production configuration. A new RCM and sensors must be installed whether
or not the air bags have deployed. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury or death in a crash.
WARNING: Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the
restraints control module (RCM) while the RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON. Failure
to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of the Safety Canopy(R) and
cause serious personal injury or death.
NOTICE: When installing a new Restraints Control Module (RCM), it is necessary to carry out
Programmable Module Installation (PMI). When installing a new RCM, always make sure the
correct RCM is being installed. If an incorrect RCM is installed, erroneous Diagnostic Trouble
Codes (DTCs) will result. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Information Bus/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All vehicles
NOTE: Carrying out Programmable Module Installation (PMI) will not enable the 911 assist option
that is disabled. The RCM and Accessory Protocol
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 6112
Interface Module (APIM) must be configured correctly to fully support 911 assist functionality.
1. When installing a new RCM, carry out the appropriate steps necessary for the PMI procedure.
2. Depower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering. See: Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering
Vehicles with center console
3. Remove the center console.
Vehicles with bucket seats without center console
4. Position the carpet aside and remove the 3 RCM pushnut retainers and the RCM cover.
All vehicles
5. Disconnect the small RCM electrical connector.
1. Push down to release the retaining tab.
2. While releasing the retaining tab, pull out and disconnect the small RCM electrical connector.
6. Disconnect the large RCM electrical connector.
1. Pinch the thumb tab and pivot the connector position assurance lever away from the RCM,
disengaging the lever.
2. Pull out and disconnect the large RCM electrical connector.
7. Remove the 3 bolts and RCM.
Installation
All vehicles
1. WARNING: Always tighten the fasteners of the restraints control module (RCM) and impact
sensor (if equipped) to the specified torque.
Failure to do so may result in incorrect restraint system operation, which increases the risk of
personal injury or death in a crash.
Install the RCM and 3 bolts. Tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
2. Make sure the connector position assurance lever is in the full release position before attempting
to connect the connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 6113
3. NOTICE: Putting the large Restraints Control Module (RCM) electrical connector into the RCM
on an angle can cause bad electrical
connections and damage components.
Position the large electrical connector into the RCM. NOTICE: Do not push on the connector so that the lever pivots and seats itself. Light pressure is
needed to get the connector into position on the Restraints Control Module (RCM) before using the
lever to fully seat the connector.
With the large RCM electrical connector uniformly aligned to the RCM, lightly push in until a subtle
audible click is heard and slight resistance is felt.
4. Connect the RCM electrical connector.
- Pivot the connector position assurance lever toward the RCM, drawing the connector in to the
RCM. Make sure the thumb tab is engaged to the retainer on the RCM and locked in place.
5. Connect the small RCM electrical connector.
Vehicles with bucket seats without center console
6. Install the 3 pushnut retainers and RCM cover.
Vehicles with center console
7. Install the center console.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 6114
All vehicles
8. Repower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering.
9. If a new RCM was installed, carry out the appropriate steps in the Programmable Module
Installation (PMI) procedure. See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Information Bus/Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning
10. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition switch from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the ignition switch back to ON
and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag
warning indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn OFF. If an air
bag SRS fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will:
- fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The air bag warning indicator might not light until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch
has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator and any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous memory DTCs from the RCM.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Diagrams
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6118
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6119
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Service and Repair
Clockspring
Removal
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Center the tilt steering column to allow for steering column upper and lower shroud removal.
2. Depower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering in the General Procedures portion.
3. Remove the driver air bag module. For additional information, refer to Driver Air Bag Module
See: Air Bag/Service and Repair/Driver Air Bag
Module.
4. NOTICE: To prevent damage to the clockspring, make sure the road wheels are in the
straight-ahead position.
Remove the steering wheel.
5. Disconnect the clockspring electrical connector.
6. Remove the 2 screws and clockspring.
Installation
1. NOTICE: If installing a new clockspring, do not remove the clockspring anti-rotation key until the
steering wheel is installed. If the
anti-rotation key has been removed before installing the steering wheel, the clockspring must be
centered. Failure to follow this instruction may result in component damage and/or system failure.
Install the clockspring and 2 screws.
2. Connect the clockspring electrical connector.
3. WARNING: If the clockspring is not correctly centralized, it may fail prematurely. If in doubt,
repeat the centralizing procedure. Failure
to follow these instructions may increase the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
NOTICE: To prevent component damage and/or system failure, when reusing a clockspring it must
be centered.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6120
NOTICE: Do not over-rotate the clockspring inner rotor. The internal ribbon wire is connected to the
clockspring rotor. The internal ribbon wire acts as a stop and can be broken from its internal
connection. Failure to follow this instruction may result in component damage and/or system
failure.
If a new clockspring was installed and the anti-rotation key has not been removed, proceed to Step
5.
If a new clockspring was installed and the anti-rotation key has been removed before the steering
wheel is installed or the same clockspring is being installed, rotate the clockspring inner rotor
counterclockwise and carefully feel for the ribbon wire to run out of length with slight resistance.
Stop rotating the clockspring inner rotor at this point.
4. Starting with the clockspring rotor wiring and connector in the 12 o'clock position, rotate the
clockspring rotor clockwise through two and
one-quarter to two and one-half revolutions until the clockspring rotor wiring and connector are in
the 12 o'clock position. The clock spring is now centered.
Verify that the clockspring is correctly centralized by observing that the clockspring rotor, wiring and
connector are in the 12 o'clock position.
5. NOTICE: To prevent damage to the clockspring, make sure the road wheels are in the
straight-ahead position.
NOTE: The clockspring inner rotor, wiring and connector must be in the 12 o'clock position to install
the steering wheel.
Install the steering wheel.
6. If a new clockspring was installed, remove the anti-rotation key.
7. Install the driver air bag module. For additional information, refer to Driver Air Bag Module See:
Air Bag/Service and Repair/Driver Air Bag
Module.
8. Repower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering in the General Procedures portion.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Front Impact Severity Sensor
Impact Sensor: Locations Front Impact Severity Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6125
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6126
Impact Sensor: Locations Driver Side Impact Sensor, C-Pillar
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6127
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6128
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6129
Impact Sensor: Locations Passenger Side Impact Sensor, C-Pillar
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6130
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6131
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6132
Impact Sensor: Locations Driver Front Door, Side Impact Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6133
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6134
Impact Sensor: Locations Passenger Front Door, Side Impact Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6135
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Front Impact Severity Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6138
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6139
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6140
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6141
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Front Impact Severity Sensor
Front Impact Severity Sensor
Removal and Installation
WARNING: If a vehicle has been in a crash, inspect the restraints control module (RCM) and the
impact sensor (if equipped) mounting areas for deformation. If damaged, restore the mounting
areas to the original production configuration. A new RCM and sensors must be installed whether
or not the air bags have deployed. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury or death in a crash.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
NOTE: The front impact severity sensor is located on the bottom of the lower radiator support.
1. Depower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering in the General Procedures portion.
2. Disconnect the front impact severity sensor electrical connector.
3. WARNING: Always tighten the fasteners of the restraints control module (RCM) and impact
sensor (if equipped) to the specified torque.
Failure to do so may result in incorrect restraint system operation, which increases the risk of
personal injury or death in a crash.
NOTE: Make sure the radiator support and front impact severity sensor mating surfaces are clean
and free of foreign material.
Remove the bolt and front impact severity sensor. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
5. Repower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering in the General Procedures portion.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6144
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Side Impact Sensor - C-Pillar
Side Impact Sensor - C-Pillar
NOTE: Expedition/Navigator shown, Expedition EL/Navigator L similar.
NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
WARNING: If a vehicle has been in a crash, inspect the restraints control module (RCM) and the
impact sensor (if equipped) mounting areas for deformation. If damaged, restore the mounting
areas to the original production configuration. A new RCM and sensors must be installed whether
or not the air bags have deployed. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury or death in a crash.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the
customer.
1. Depower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering in the General Procedures portion.
2. Remove the rear door scuff plate.
3. Detach the rear door weatherstrip.
4. Remove the bolt and second row safety belt retractor anchor.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
5. Position aside the quarter trim panel.
- Pull out on the quarter trim panel at the C-pillar and release the retaining clips to gain access to
the C-pillar side impact sensor.
6. Disconnect the side impact sensor electrical connector.
7. WARNING: Always tighten the fasteners of the restraints control module (RCM) and impact
sensor (if equipped) to the specified torque.
Failure to do so may result in incorrect restraint system operation, which increases the risk of
personal injury or death in a crash.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6145
NOTE: Make sure the C-pillar and side impact sensor mating surfaces are clean and free of foreign
material.
Remove the bolt and side impact sensor. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
8. NOTE: Before installation, make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted and the safety belts
and buckles are accessible to the occupants.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
9. Repower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering in the General Procedures portion.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6146
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Side Impact Sensor - Front Door
Side Impact Sensor - Front Door
NOTE: RH door shown, LH similar.
Removal and Installation
WARNING: If a vehicle has been in a crash, inspect the restraints control module (RCM) and the
impact sensor (if equipped) mounting areas for deformation. If damaged, restore the mounting
areas to the original production configuration. A new RCM and sensors must be installed whether
or not the air bags have deployed. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury or death in a crash.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Depower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering in the General Procedures portion.
2. Remove the front door trim panel.
3. Separate the weathershield from the door enough to access the side impact sensor.
4. Disconnect the side impact sensor electrical connector.
5. Remove the 2 bolts and side impact sensor.
6. NOTICE: To prevent stripping the insert nuts, tighten the side impact sensor bolts only enough to
retain the side impact sensor correctly.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6147
- Inspect the insert nut for damage. If the insert nut is damaged, install a new insert.
7. Repower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering in the General Procedures portion.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Position Sensor > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Seat Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Seat Position Sensor
NOTE: Power seat shown, manual similar.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Move the driver seat to the full forward and highest position.
2. Change to Ignition Off. Wait 1 minute.
3. Remove the seat position sensor and bracket bolt.
4. Unhook the seat position sensor and bracket from the seat track cross brace.
5. Disconnect the electrical connector and remove the seat position sensor and bracket.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
7. Repower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering in the General Procedures portion.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations
Air Bag Control Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6155
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6156
Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams
C310A
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6157
C310B Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6158
C310B Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6159
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair
Restraints Control Module (RCM)
NOTE: Seats removed for clarity.
Removal
WARNING: If a vehicle has been in a crash, inspect the restraints control module (RCM) and the
impact sensor (if equipped) mounting areas for deformation. If damaged, restore the mounting
areas to the original production configuration. A new RCM and sensors must be installed whether
or not the air bags have deployed. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury or death in a crash.
WARNING: Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the
restraints control module (RCM) while the RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON. Failure
to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of the Safety Canopy(R) and
cause serious personal injury or death.
NOTICE: When installing a new Restraints Control Module (RCM), it is necessary to carry out
Programmable Module Installation (PMI). When installing a new RCM, always make sure the
correct RCM is being installed. If an incorrect RCM is installed, erroneous Diagnostic Trouble
Codes (DTCs) will result. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Information Bus/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All vehicles
NOTE: Carrying out Programmable Module Installation (PMI) will not enable the 911 assist option
that is disabled. The RCM and Accessory Protocol
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6160
Interface Module (APIM) must be configured correctly to fully support 911 assist functionality.
1. When installing a new RCM, carry out the appropriate steps necessary for the PMI procedure.
2. Depower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering. See: Air Bag
Systems/Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) Depowering and Repowering
Vehicles with center console
3. Remove the center console.
Vehicles with bucket seats without center console
4. Position the carpet aside and remove the 3 RCM pushnut retainers and the RCM cover.
All vehicles
5. Disconnect the small RCM electrical connector.
1. Push down to release the retaining tab.
2. While releasing the retaining tab, pull out and disconnect the small RCM electrical connector.
6. Disconnect the large RCM electrical connector.
1. Pinch the thumb tab and pivot the connector position assurance lever away from the RCM,
disengaging the lever.
2. Pull out and disconnect the large RCM electrical connector.
7. Remove the 3 bolts and RCM.
Installation
All vehicles
1. WARNING: Always tighten the fasteners of the restraints control module (RCM) and impact
sensor (if equipped) to the specified torque.
Failure to do so may result in incorrect restraint system operation, which increases the risk of
personal injury or death in a crash.
Install the RCM and 3 bolts. Tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
2. Make sure the connector position assurance lever is in the full release position before attempting
to connect the connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6161
3. NOTICE: Putting the large Restraints Control Module (RCM) electrical connector into the RCM
on an angle can cause bad electrical
connections and damage components.
Position the large electrical connector into the RCM. NOTICE: Do not push on the connector so that the lever pivots and seats itself. Light pressure is
needed to get the connector into position on the Restraints Control Module (RCM) before using the
lever to fully seat the connector.
With the large RCM electrical connector uniformly aligned to the RCM, lightly push in until a subtle
audible click is heard and slight resistance is felt.
4. Connect the RCM electrical connector.
- Pivot the connector position assurance lever toward the RCM, drawing the connector in to the
RCM. Make sure the thumb tab is engaged to the retainer on the RCM and locked in place.
5. Connect the small RCM electrical connector.
Vehicles with bucket seats without center console
6. Install the 3 pushnut retainers and RCM cover.
Vehicles with center console
7. Install the center console.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6162
All vehicles
8. Repower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Air Bag
Systems/Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) Depowering and Repowering.
9. If a new RCM was installed, carry out the appropriate steps in the Programmable Module
Installation (PMI) procedure. See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Information Bus/Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning
10. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition switch from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the ignition switch back to ON
and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag
warning indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn OFF. If an air
bag SRS fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will:
- fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The air bag warning indicator might not light until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch
has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator and any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous memory DTCs from the RCM.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering
Depowering Procedure
WARNING: Always wear eye protection when servicing a vehicle. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on air bag, Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain
modules. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of these
modules, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the
restraints control module (RCM) while the RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON. Failure
to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of the Safety Canopy(R) and
cause serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: To reduce the risk of accidental deployment, do not use any memory saver devices.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF.
2. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
3. At the Smart Junction Box (SJB), located in the RH lower kick panel, remove the cover and the
RCM fuse 32 (10A) from the SJB. For additional
information, refer to the Wiring Diagrams.
4. Turn the ignition switch ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30
seconds. The air bag warning indicator will remain
lit continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
6. WARNING: Always deplete the backup power supply before repairing or installing any new front
or side air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) component and before servicing, removing, installing, adjusting or striking
components near the front or side impact sensors or the restraints control module (RCM). Nearby
components include doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood
latches.
Refer to the Description and Operation portion of Air Bag Systems for location of the RCM and
impact sensor(s).
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
1 minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury or death in the event of an
accidental deployment.
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
Repowering Procedure
1. Make sure that all SRS components are connected.
2. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 6168
3. Install RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the SJB and close the cover.
4. WARNING: Make sure no one is in the vehicle and there is nothing blocking or placed in front of
any air bag module when the battery is
connected. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury in the event of
an accidental deployment.
Connect the battery ground cable.
5. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the back to ON and visually monitor
the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag warning indicator will
illuminate continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an SRS fault is present,
the air bag warning indicator will:
- fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The flashing might not occur until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition has been turned from
the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to complete the testing of the
SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault exists, a chime will sound in a
pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning indicator and any SRS fault
discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous DTCs from the RCM using a scan tool.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 6169
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Deactivation and Reactivation
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deactivation and Reactivation
Deactivation
WARNING: Always carry or place a live air bag module with the air bag and deployment door/trim
cover/tear seam pointed away from the body. Do not set a live air bag module down with the
deployment door/trim cover/tear seam face down. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on air bag, Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain
modules. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of these
modules, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: To reduce the risk of accidental deployment, do not use any memory saver devices.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF.
2. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
3. At the Smart Junction Box (SJB), located in the RH lower kick panel, remove the cover and the
RCM fuse 32 (10A) from the SJB. For additional
information, refer to the Wiring Diagrams.
4. Turn the ignition switch ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30
seconds. The air bag warning indicator will remain
lit continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: Always deplete the backup power supply before repairing or installing any new front
or side air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) component and before servicing, removing, installing, adjusting or striking
components near the front or side impact sensors or the restraints control module (RCM). Nearby
components include doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood
latches.
Refer to the Description and Operation portion of Air Bag Systems for location of the RCM and
impact sensor(s).
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
1 minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury or death in the event of an
accidental deployment.
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
7. Make sure the road wheels are in the straight-ahead position.
8. Center the tilt steering column to allow for steering column upper and lower shroud removal.
9. NOTICE: Turn the steering wheel such that the top is at 90 degrees (at the 9 o'clock position) to
the left from the straight-ahead position
to access the driver air bag module wire clips and to prevent damage to the steering column
multi-function switch. Failure to follow this instruction may result in component damage.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 6170
Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is 90 degrees to the left (at the 9 o'clock position)
as shown.
10. Remove the lower steering column opening cover.
- Remove the 3 screws.
- Pull out to release the top retainers.
- Remove the lower steering column opening cover. If equipped, disconnect the adjustable pedals switch connector.
11. If equipped, remove the screw and steering column manual tilt lever.
12. Remove the 3 steering column lower shroud screws.
13. Release the clips and remove the steering column upper shroud.
14. Remove the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, disconnect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
15. NOTICE: Make sure each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are disengaged from each of
the 3 steering wheel hooks before
removing the driver air bag module from the steering wheel. Failure to follow this instruction may
result in component damage and/or system failure.
NOTE: Steering wheel is removed for clarity. The rear of the steering wheel is shown.
NOTE: Use a mirror to view the rear of the steering wheel to locate where the 3 driver air bag
module wire clips attach to the steering wheel hooks.
Using a screwdriver or a suitable tool, release each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips from
the steering wheel hooks. Access the 3 driver air bag module wire clips through the back of the steering wheel cover and
push the wire clips toward the center of the steering wheel to release.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 6171
16. NOTE: Once the driver air bag module is removed, note the position of the 2 driver air bag
module locator pins on the steering wheel for
installation.
Disconnect the driver air bag module and horn switch electrical connectors and remove the driver
air bag module.
17. Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is back in the straight-ahead position (the 12
o'clock position).
18. Open and lower the glove compartment door to allow access to the passenger air bag electrical
connector.
- If equipped, disconnect the glove compartment door dampener.
19. Disconnect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
20. NOTE: There are 2 similar connectors under the passenger seat. The passenger seat side air
bag module electrical connector is located toward the
seat outboard position.
Remove the passenger front seat cushion panel shield and disconnect the passenger seat side air
bag module electrical.
21. Release the RH second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 6172
22. Remove the bolt and the RH second row safety belt retractor D-ring.
23. Remove the cover and the RH C-pillar trim panel nut.
24. Release the rear door weatherstrip and remove the RH C-pillar trim panel.
25. Disconnect the RH safety canopy module electrical connector.
26. Release the LH second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
27. Remove the bolt and the LH second row safety belt retractor D-ring.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 6173
28. Remove the cover and the LH C-pillar trim panel nut.
29. Release the rear door weatherstrip and remove the driver C-pillar trim panel.
30. Disconnect the LH safety canopy module electrical connector.
31. NOTE: There are 2 similar connectors under the driver seat. The driver seat side air bag
module electrical connector is located toward the seat
outboard position.
Remove the driver front seat cushion panel shield and disconnect the driver seat side air bag
module electrical connector.
32. Install the RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the Smart Junction Box (SJB).
33. Connect the battery ground cable.
Reactivation
1. Remove the RCM fuse 32 (10A) from the SJB.
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
3. Connect the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector and install the driver front seat
cushion panel shield.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 6174
4. Connect the LH safety canopy module electrical connector.
5. Install the LH C-pillar trim panel and attach the rear door weatherstrip.
6. Install the LH C-pillar trim panel nut and cover.
7. Install the LH second row safety belt retractor D-ring and bolt.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
8. Attach the LH second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
9. Connect the RH safety canopy module electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 6175
10. Install the RH C-pillar trim panel and attach the rear door weatherstrip.
11. Install the passenger C-pillar trim panel nut and cover.
12. Install the RH second row safety belt retractor D-ring and bolt.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
13. Attach the RH second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding. Extract and retract the safety belt between the full extension and stowed positions.
- If excessive effort or binding is present, install a new safety belt buckle retractor and tongue
assembly as necessary. For additional information, refer to Seat Belt Systems.
14. Connect the passenger seat side air bag module electrical connector and install the passenger
front seat cushion panel shield.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 6176
15. Connect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
16. Close the glove compartment door.
- If equipped, connect the glove compartment door dampener.
17. NOTICE: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag module. Match
the electrical connector key to the keyway in the driver air bag module. Do not force the electrical
connectors into the driver air bag module. Damage to the connector or component may occur.
Connect the horn switch and 2 driver air bag module electrical connectors.
18. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, lining up the locator pins.
19. NOTE: Make sure that all 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged and seated
correctly to the steering wheel.
NOTE: Audible clicks will be heard when the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged.
Firmly press the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, seating the 3 driver air bag module
wire clips to the steering wheel hooks.
- Check the driver air bag module trim cover to the steering wheel for an even gap clearance and
correct movement.
20. Install the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, connect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
21. Install the steering column upper shroud.
22. Install the 3 steering column lower shroud screws.
23. If equipped, install the steering column manual tilt lever and screw.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
24. If equipped, connect the adjustable pedals switch connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 6177
25. Install the lower steering column opening cover and 3 screws.
26. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON.
27. Install the RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the SJB and install the cover.
28. WARNING: Make sure no one is in the vehicle and there is nothing blocking or placed in front
of any air bag module when the battery is
connected. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury in the event of
an accidental deployment.
Connect the battery ground cable.
29. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition switch from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the ignition switch back to ON
and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag
warning indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag
SRS fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will either:
- fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The air bag warning indicator may not illuminate until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition
switch has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator will need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Clear all continuous memory DTCs from the RCM using a scan tool.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Child Seat Tether Attachment: Service and Repair
Child Safety Seat Tether Anchor
Removal and Installation
WARNING: After any crash, all of the following safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware must
be inspected by an authorized dealer to verify correct function:
- Retractors
- Buckles
- Belt tension sensor (BTS) (if equipped)
- Front safety belt buckle support assemblies (slide bar) (if equipped)
- Safety belt shoulder belt height adjusters (if equipped)
- Child safety seat tether bracket assemblies
- Automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature for child safety seats (passenger seating positions only)
If any safety belt assembly is damaged, does not operate correctly or does not pass all of the
Functional Tests in the Diagnosis and Testing portion, a new safety belt assembly must be
installed. If any safety belt assembly attaching areas are damaged or distorted, the sheet metal
must be restored to its original structural integrity and new safety belt assembly and attaching
hardware must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware
may increase the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
After any crash that results in deployment of the driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt
pretensioners, new driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt systems (including retractors,
buckles and height adjusters) must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt systems increases
the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
1. Position the third row seat backrest downward.
2. Release the seat backrest cover J-clips.
3. With the seat backrest cover and cushion positioned aside, remove the bolt and the child safety
seat tether anchor.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
4. WARNING: Always tighten the child safety seat tether anchor/bolt to specification. Failure to
follow this instruction may result in the
child's safety seat being incorrectly secured, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or
death to the child in a sudden stop or crash.
NOTE: Inspect the seat for damage. If the seat is found to be damaged, install new seat
components.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
5. Check the active restraint system for correct operation. For additional information, refer to the
appropriate Functional Test in Safety Belt System
See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Seat Belt Buckle: Description and Operation
Safety Belt System
WARNING: After any crash, all of the following safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware must
be inspected by an authorized dealer to verify correct function:
- Retractors
- Buckles
- Belt tension sensor (BTS) (if equipped)
- Front safety belt buckle support assemblies (slide bar) (if equipped)
- Safety belt shoulder belt height adjusters (if equipped)
- Child safety seat tether bracket assemblies
- Automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature for child safety seats (passenger seating positions only)
If any safety belt assembly is damaged, does not operate correctly or does not pass all of the
Functional Tests in the Diagnosis and Testing portion, a new safety belt assembly must be
installed. If any safety belt assembly attaching areas are damaged or distorted, the sheet metal
must be restored to its original structural integrity and new safety belt assembly and attaching
hardware must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware
may increase the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
After any crash that results in deployment of the driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt
pretensioners, new driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt systems (including retractors,
buckles and height adjusters) must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt systems increases
the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
The safety belt retractor is designed to let the webbing move freely in and out at all times, except
during vehicle hard braking, hard cornering or an impact of 24 km/h (15 mph) or more, when it is
automatically locked by a mechanically actuated inertia sensor.
When replacing safety belt buckles and/or retractor assemblies, use only the replacement parts
specified in the Ford Customer Service Division Master Parts and Accessories Catalog.
Safety Belt Buckles
Safety Belt Buckle and Pretensioner
The safety belt buckle and pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device that removes excess webbing from
the front seat safety belt system. When the front air bag system is deployed, the pretensioner in the
buckle deploys, causing the buckle to move downward, pulling excess webbing from the lap and
shoulder safety belts.
If the vehicle is involved in a collision that results in deployment of the front air bags and safety belt
pretensioners, the driver and passenger seat belt system (including safety belt buckle and
pretensioners, safety belt retractors and shoulder height adjusters) must be replaced.
For safety belt buckle pretensioner diagnosis and disposal information, refer to Air Bag Systems.
Rear Safety Belt Buckles
The second row seat safety belt buckles and third row RH safety belt buckle are attached to the
seat frames. The third row LH and center safety belt buckle assembly is attached to the floor pan
underneath the 60 percent seat. All rear safety belt buckles are serviceable separately.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 6185
Seat Belt Buckle: Testing and Inspection
Safety Belt System
Component Test
WARNING: After any crash, all of the following safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware must
be inspected by an authorized dealer to verify correct function:
- Retractors
- Buckles
- Belt tension sensor (BTS) (if equipped)
- Front safety belt buckle support assemblies (slide bar) (if equipped)
- Safety belt shoulder belt height adjusters (if equipped)
- Child safety seat tether bracket assemblies
- Automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature for child safety seats (passenger seating positions only)
If any safety belt assembly is damaged, does not operate correctly or does not pass all of the
Functional Tests in the Diagnosis and Testing portion, a new safety belt assembly must be
installed. If any safety belt assembly attaching areas are damaged or distorted, the sheet metal
must be restored to its original structural integrity and new safety belt assembly and attaching
hardware must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware
may increase the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
After any crash that results in deployment of the driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt
pretensioners, new driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt systems (including retractors,
buckles and height adjusters) must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt systems increases
the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
Carry out the appropriate Functional Test(s) as determined in Inspection and Verification.
Functional Test - Safety Belt Buckle and Tongue
The safety belt buckle and tongue assembly must operate freely during the latching and unlatching
function. Fasten the safety belt by inserting the tongue (male portion) into the buckle (female
portion).
1. Verify the following during the latching sequence:
- Tongue insertion is not hindered by excessive effort.
- A click is heard when the safety belt buckle latches the tongue.
2. Verify the system integrity by forcefully pulling on the safety belt webbing.
3. Unlatch the safety belt by fully depressing the safety belt buckle release button and allowing the
safety belt to release and retract.
4. Verify the following during the unlatching process:
- Push-button depression does not require excessive effort.
- The tongue can be removed easily from the buckle.
5. Repeat the above steps 3 times.
6. If the functional test reveals a concern(s), install a new safety belt buckle or safety belt retractor
as required.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 20 Percent Seat
Seat Belt Buckle: Service and Repair Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 20 Percent Seat
Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 20 Percent Seat
Removal and Installation
WARNING: After any crash, all of the following safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware must
be inspected by an authorized dealer to verify correct function:
- Retractors
- Buckles
- Belt tension sensor (BTS) (if equipped)
- Front safety belt buckle support assemblies (slide bar) (if equipped)
- Safety belt shoulder belt height adjusters (if equipped)
- Child safety seat tether bracket assemblies
- Automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature for child safety seats (passenger seating positions only)
If any safety belt assembly is damaged, does not operate correctly or does not pass all of the
Functional Tests in the Diagnosis and Testing portion, a new safety belt assembly must be
installed. If any safety belt assembly attaching areas are damaged or distorted, the sheet metal
must be restored to its original structural integrity and new safety belt assembly and attaching
hardware must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware
may increase the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
After any crash that results in deployment of the driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt
pretensioners, new driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt systems (including retractors,
buckles and height adjusters) must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt systems increases
the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
1. Position the seat upright.
2. Remove the nut and safety belt buckle from underneath the seat.
- To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
3. NOTE: When installing the safety belt buckle, make sure to engage the anti-rotation tab to the
seat frame.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
4. Check the active restraint system for correct operation. For additional information, refer to the
appropriate Functional Test in Safety Belt System
See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 20 Percent Seat > Page 6188
Seat Belt Buckle: Service and Repair Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 40 Percent Seat
Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 40 Percent Seat
NOTE: RH shown, LH similar.
Removal and Installation
WARNING: After any crash, all of the following safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware must
be inspected by an authorized dealer to verify correct function:
- Retractors
- Buckles
- Belt tension sensor (BTS) (if equipped)
- Front safety belt buckle support assemblies (slide bar) (if equipped)
- Safety belt shoulder belt height adjusters (if equipped)
- Child safety seat tether bracket assemblies
- Automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature for child safety seats (passenger seating positions only)
If any safety belt assembly is damaged, does not operate correctly or does not pass all of the
Functional Tests in the Diagnosis and Testing portion, a new safety belt assembly must be
installed. If any safety belt assembly attaching areas are damaged or distorted, the sheet metal
must be restored to its original structural integrity and new safety belt assembly and attaching
hardware must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware
may increase the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
After any crash that results in deployment of the driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt
pretensioners, new driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt systems (including retractors,
buckles and height adjusters) must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt systems increases
the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
1. Pivot the 40 percent seat upward.
2. Remove the rearward screw (not shown) and seat side shield.
- Release the pin-type retainer (not shown).
3. Remove the bolt and safety belt buckle.
- To install, tighten to 50 Nm (37 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
5. Check the active restraint system for correct operation. For additional information, refer to the
appropriate Functional Test in Safety Belt System
See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 20 Percent Seat > Page 6189
Seat Belt Buckle: Service and Repair Safety Belt Buckle - Third Row, 40 Percent Seat
Safety Belt Buckle - Third Row, 40 Percent Seat
Removal and Installation
WARNING: After any crash, all of the following safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware must
be inspected by an authorized dealer to verify correct function:
- Retractors
- Buckles
- Belt tension sensor (BTS) (if equipped)
- Front safety belt buckle support assemblies (slide bar) (if equipped)
- Safety belt shoulder belt height adjusters (if equipped)
- Child safety seat tether bracket assemblies
- Automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature for child safety seats (passenger seating positions only)
If any safety belt assembly is damaged, does not operate correctly or does not pass all of the
Functional Tests in the Diagnosis and Testing portion, a new safety belt assembly must be
installed. If any safety belt assembly attaching areas are damaged or distorted, the sheet metal
must be restored to its original structural integrity and new safety belt assembly and attaching
hardware must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware
may increase the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
After any crash that results in deployment of the driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt
pretensioners, new driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt systems (including retractors,
buckles and height adjusters) must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt systems increases
the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
1. Remove the third row 40 percent seat.
2. Remove the bolt and safety belt buckle.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3. NOTE: Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted and the safety belts and buckles are
accessible to the occupants.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
4. Check the active restraint system for correct operation. For additional information, refer to the
appropriate Functional Test in Safety Belt System
See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 20 Percent Seat > Page 6190
Seat Belt Buckle: Service and Repair Safety Belt Buckle - Third Row, 60 Percent Seat
Safety Belt Buckle - Third Row, 60 Percent Seat
Removal and Installation
WARNING: After any crash, all of the following safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware must
be inspected by an authorized dealer to verify correct function:
- Retractors
- Buckles
- Belt tension sensor (BTS) (if equipped)
- Front safety belt buckle support assemblies (slide bar) (if equipped)
- Safety belt shoulder belt height adjusters (if equipped)
- Child safety seat tether bracket assemblies
- Automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature for child safety seats (passenger seating positions only)
If any safety belt assembly is damaged, does not operate correctly or does not pass all of the
Functional Tests in the Diagnosis and Testing portion, a new safety belt assembly must be
installed. If any safety belt assembly attaching areas are damaged or distorted, the sheet metal
must be restored to its original structural integrity and new safety belt assembly and attaching
hardware must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware
may increase the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
After any crash that results in deployment of the driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt
pretensioners, new driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt systems (including retractors,
buckles and height adjusters) must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt systems increases
the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
1. Fold the 60 percent seat down.
2. Position the load floor panels up.
3. Remove the bolt and safety belt buckle assembly.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
4. Fold the 60 percent seat up and remove the safety belt buckle assembly through the seat.
5. NOTE: Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted and the safety belts and buckles are
accessible to the occupants.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
6. Check the active restraint system for correct operation. For additional information, refer to the
appropriate Functional Test in Safety Belt System
See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 20 Percent Seat > Page 6191
Seat Belt Buckle: Service and Repair Safety Belt Buckle And Pretensioner
Safety Belt Buckle and Pretensioner
Driver Safety Belt Buckle and Pretensioner
Passenger Safety Belt Buckle and Pretensioner
Removal and Installation
WARNING: After any crash, all of the following safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware must
be inspected by an authorized dealer to verify correct function:
- Retractors
- Buckles
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 20 Percent Seat > Page 6192
- Belt tension sensor (BTS) (if equipped)
- Front safety belt buckle support assemblies (slide bar) (if equipped)
- Safety belt shoulder belt height adjusters (if equipped)
- Child safety seat tether bracket assemblies
- Automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature for child safety seats (passenger seating positions only)
If any safety belt assembly is damaged, does not operate correctly or does not pass all of the
Functional Tests in the Diagnosis and Testing portion, a new safety belt assembly must be
installed. If any safety belt assembly attaching areas are damaged or distorted, the sheet metal
must be restored to its original structural integrity and new safety belt assembly and attaching
hardware must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware
may increase the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
After any crash that results in deployment of the driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt
pretensioners, new driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt systems (including retractors,
buckles and height adjusters) must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt systems increases
the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
1. Remove the seat.
2. Release the hook-and-loop strip and pull the seat cushion trim cover up enough to expose the
safety belt buckle and pretensioner.
3. Remove the tie strap from the pretensioner.
- Disconnect the electrical connector(s).
- Note wire harness routing for correct installation.
4. Remove the nut and safety belt buckle and pretensioner.
- To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
6. Check the active restraint system for correct operation. For additional information, refer to the
appropriate Functional Test in Safety Belt System
See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch > Component Information >
Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 6196
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Height Adjuster > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Seat Belt Height Adjuster: Service and Repair
Safety Belt Shoulder Height Adjuster
NOTE: RH shown, LH similar.
Removal and Installation
WARNING: After any crash, all of the following safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware must
be inspected by an authorized dealer to verify correct function:
- Retractors
- Buckles
- Belt tension sensor (BTS) (if equipped)
- Front safety belt buckle support assemblies (slide bar) (if equipped)
- Safety belt shoulder belt height adjusters (if equipped)
- Child safety seat tether bracket assemblies
- Automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature for child safety seats (passenger seating positions only)
If any safety belt assembly is damaged, does not operate correctly or does not pass all of the
Functional Tests in the Diagnosis and Testing portion, a new safety belt assembly must be
installed. If any safety belt assembly attaching areas are damaged or distorted, the sheet metal
must be restored to its original structural integrity and new safety belt assembly and attaching
hardware must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware
may increase the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
After any crash that results in deployment of the driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt
pretensioners, new driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt systems (including retractors,
buckles and height adjusters) must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt systems increases
the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
1. NOTE: Inspect the D-ring cover for damage. If the cover is damaged or does not remain closed,
install a new D-ring cover and bolt. Position the
safety belt guide to the lowest position.
Remove the upper B-pillar trim panel.
2. Access the bolt behind the safety belt shoulder height adjuster cover in the following sequence.
- Lower the safety belt shoulder height adjuster to the lowest point.
- Fold the cover over.
3. Remove the safety belt shoulder height adjuster bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
4. Remove the safety belt shoulder height adjuster.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Height Adjuster > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 6200
1. Rotate the safety belt shoulder height adjuster downward to release the lower tab.
2. Remove the safety belt shoulder height adjuster.
5. NOTE: Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted and the safety belts and buckles are
accessible to the occupants.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
6. Check the active restraint system for correct operation. For additional information, refer to the
appropriate Functional Test in Safety Belt System
See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Reminder Buzzer > Component Information
> Service and Repair
Seat Belt Reminder Buzzer: Service and Repair
Belt-Minder(R) Deactivating/Activating
Preparation
1. Set the parking brake.
2. Place the transmission in PARK (P).
3. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
4. Close all the vehicle doors.
5. Unbuckle the driver and passenger safety belts.
Deactivating/Activating
1. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN position (do not start the engine).
2. Wait until the safety belt warning indicator turns off (approximately 1 minute).
3. NOTE: Step 3 must be completed within 50 seconds after the safety belt warning indicator turns
off or the procedure must be repeated.
Buckle then unbuckle the safety belt 9 times, ending with the safety belt unbuckled.
4. NOTE: After Step 3, the safety belt warning indicator lamp illuminates for 3 seconds.
Within 10 seconds of the safety belt warning indicator turning on, buckle then unbuckle the safety
belt.
- This disables the Belt-Minder(R) feature if it is currently enabled. As confirmation, the safety belt
warning indicator flashes 4 times per second for 3 seconds.
- This enables the Belt-Minder(R) feature if it is currently disabled. As confirmation, the safety belt
warning indicator flashes 4 times per second for 3 seconds followed by a second series of 4
flashes per second for 3 seconds.
5. After confirmation, the deactivation/activation procedure is complete.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Seat Belt Reminder Lamp: Service and Repair
Belt-Minder(R) Deactivating/Activating
Preparation
1. Set the parking brake.
2. Place the transmission in PARK (P).
3. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
4. Close all the vehicle doors.
5. Unbuckle the driver and passenger safety belts.
Deactivating/Activating
1. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN position (do not start the engine).
2. Wait until the safety belt warning indicator turns off (approximately 1 minute).
3. NOTE: Step 3 must be completed within 50 seconds after the safety belt warning indicator turns
off or the procedure must be repeated.
Buckle then unbuckle the safety belt 9 times, ending with the safety belt unbuckled.
4. NOTE: After Step 3, the safety belt warning indicator lamp illuminates for 3 seconds.
Within 10 seconds of the safety belt warning indicator turning on, buckle then unbuckle the safety
belt.
- This disables the Belt-Minder(R) feature if it is currently enabled. As confirmation, the safety belt
warning indicator flashes 4 times per second for 3 seconds.
- This enables the Belt-Minder(R) feature if it is currently disabled. As confirmation, the safety belt
warning indicator flashes 4 times per second for 3 seconds followed by a second series of 4
flashes per second for 3 seconds.
5. After confirmation, the deactivation/activation procedure is complete.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Seat Belt Retractor: Description and Operation
Safety Belt System
WARNING: After any crash, all of the following safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware must
be inspected by an authorized dealer to verify correct function:
- Retractors
- Buckles
- Belt tension sensor (BTS) (if equipped)
- Front safety belt buckle support assemblies (slide bar) (if equipped)
- Safety belt shoulder belt height adjusters (if equipped)
- Child safety seat tether bracket assemblies
- Automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature for child safety seats (passenger seating positions only)
If any safety belt assembly is damaged, does not operate correctly or does not pass all of the
Functional Tests in the Diagnosis and Testing portion, a new safety belt assembly must be
installed. If any safety belt assembly attaching areas are damaged or distorted, the sheet metal
must be restored to its original structural integrity and new safety belt assembly and attaching
hardware must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware
may increase the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
After any crash that results in deployment of the driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt
pretensioners, new driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt systems (including retractors,
buckles and height adjusters) must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt systems increases
the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
The safety belt retractor is designed to let the webbing move freely in and out at all times, except
during vehicle hard braking, hard cornering or an impact of 24 km/h (15 mph) or more, when it is
automatically locked by a mechanically actuated inertia sensor.
When replacing safety belt buckles and/or retractor assemblies, use only the replacement parts
specified in the Ford Customer Service Division Master Parts and Accessories Catalog.
Safety Belt Retractors
The safety belt retractors are a dual locking mode type and consist of the following features:
- Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR)
- Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) (all except driver seat)
Safety Belt Retractor and Features
Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR)
The ELR is a vehicle sensitive feature designed to activate and lock the safety belt webbing when
braking hard, cornering hard or in an impact of approximately 24 km/h (15 mph). The ELR feature
helps to reduce the forward movement of the occupants. For testing, refer to the appropriate
Functional Test procedure in Safety Belt System See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests
and General Diagnostics.
Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR)
The ALR mode is used when locking a child seat in an outboard seating position. The ALR mode is
automatically activated when the safety belt webbing is fully extracted from the retractor and then
allowed to retract. As the safety belt webbing is retracted back onto the spool, an audible clicking
sound is made indicating the safety belt retractor is in ALR mode and the safety belt webbing will
not pull back out of the safety belt retractor. To disengage the ALR mode, allow the safety belt
webbing to fully retract back onto the spool. The ALR mode is disengaged when the webbing is
free to extract and retract back into the retractor. When installing a dual locking mode retractor, the
retractor should be checked to make sure it is not in the ALR mode after installation in the stowed
position. Refer to the appropriate Functional Test procedure in Safety Belt System See: Testing
and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Functional Test - Safety Belt Retractor
Seat Belt Retractor: Testing and Inspection Functional Test - Safety Belt Retractor
Safety Belt System
Component Test
WARNING: After any crash, all of the following safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware must
be inspected by an authorized dealer to verify correct function:
- Retractors
- Buckles
- Belt tension sensor (BTS) (if equipped)
- Front safety belt buckle support assemblies (slide bar) (if equipped)
- Safety belt shoulder belt height adjusters (if equipped)
- Child safety seat tether bracket assemblies
- Automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature for child safety seats (passenger seating positions only)
If any safety belt assembly is damaged, does not operate correctly or does not pass all of the
Functional Tests in the Diagnosis and Testing portion, a new safety belt assembly must be
installed. If any safety belt assembly attaching areas are damaged or distorted, the sheet metal
must be restored to its original structural integrity and new safety belt assembly and attaching
hardware must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware
may increase the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
After any crash that results in deployment of the driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt
pretensioners, new driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt systems (including retractors,
buckles and height adjusters) must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt systems increases
the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
Carry out the appropriate Functional Test(s) as determined in Inspection and Verification.
Functional Test - Safety Belt Retractor
The safety belt retractor must be freely operational for extraction and retraction of the safety belt
webbing between full extension and in-vehicle stowed positions.
1. Extract and retract the safety belt between the full extension and stowed positions.
2. Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
3. Install a new safety belt retractor if any concern is found or the complaint has been verified.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Functional Test - Safety Belt Retractor > Page 6212
Seat Belt Retractor: Testing and Inspection Functional Test - Safety Belt Retractor, Automatic
Locking Retractor (ALR) Mode
Safety Belt System
Component Test
WARNING: After any crash, all of the following safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware must
be inspected by an authorized dealer to verify correct function:
- Retractors
- Buckles
- Belt tension sensor (BTS) (if equipped)
- Front safety belt buckle support assemblies (slide bar) (if equipped)
- Safety belt shoulder belt height adjusters (if equipped)
- Child safety seat tether bracket assemblies
- Automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature for child safety seats (passenger seating positions only)
If any safety belt assembly is damaged, does not operate correctly or does not pass all of the
Functional Tests in the Diagnosis and Testing portion, a new safety belt assembly must be
installed. If any safety belt assembly attaching areas are damaged or distorted, the sheet metal
must be restored to its original structural integrity and new safety belt assembly and attaching
hardware must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware
may increase the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
After any crash that results in deployment of the driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt
pretensioners, new driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt systems (including retractors,
buckles and height adjusters) must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt systems increases
the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
Carry out the appropriate Functional Test(s) as determined in Inspection and Verification.
Functional Test - Safety Belt Retractor, Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) Mode
1. Position the seat backrest fully upright (if adjustable).
2. Position the safety belt shoulder height adjuster (if equipped) in the full down or up position.
3. Fasten the safety belt.
4. Pull out the safety belt webbing until the ALR feature is activated.
5. Allow the safety belt webbing to retract until it stops.
6. Pull on the safety belt webbing to check that the safety belt retractor has remained in the ALR
mode. If the safety belt retractor is not locked,
install a new safety belt retractor.
7. Unfasten the safety belt and allow the safety belt webbing to retract to its stowed position.
8. Pull out and retract the safety belt webbing to verify the safety belt retractor has converted
automatically out of ALR mode. If the safety belt
retractor remains locked in the ALR mode, install a new safety belt retractor.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Functional Test - Safety Belt Retractor > Page 6213
Seat Belt Retractor: Testing and Inspection Functional Test - Safety Belt Retractor, Road Test
Inspection
Safety Belt System
Component Test
WARNING: After any crash, all of the following safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware must
be inspected by an authorized dealer to verify correct function:
- Retractors
- Buckles
- Belt tension sensor (BTS) (if equipped)
- Front safety belt buckle support assemblies (slide bar) (if equipped)
- Safety belt shoulder belt height adjusters (if equipped)
- Child safety seat tether bracket assemblies
- Automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature for child safety seats (passenger seating positions only)
If any safety belt assembly is damaged, does not operate correctly or does not pass all of the
Functional Tests in the Diagnosis and Testing portion, a new safety belt assembly must be
installed. If any safety belt assembly attaching areas are damaged or distorted, the sheet metal
must be restored to its original structural integrity and new safety belt assembly and attaching
hardware must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware
may increase the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
After any crash that results in deployment of the driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt
pretensioners, new driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt systems (including retractors,
buckles and height adjusters) must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt systems increases
the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
Carry out the appropriate Functional Test(s) as determined in Inspection and Verification.
Functional Test - Safety Belt Retractor, Road Test Inspection
WARNING: The driver and passenger must be prepared to brace themselves in the event the
safety belt retractor does not lock. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal
injury.
NOTE: Make sure there is no excessive slack in the safety belt webbing across the torso during
testing.
NOTE: Do not jerk on the safety belt webbing when carrying out this test.
1. Test the safety belts in the following sequence:
1. Fasten the safety belts and proceed to a safe area.
2. Attain a speed of 24 km/h (15 mph).
3. WARNING: Apply maximum brake force only on dry concrete or equivalent hard surface,
NEVER on wet pavement or gravel.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
Grasp the shoulder harness, lean forward and apply the brakes, making a maximum braking
application without a skid.
4. The safety belts should lock up with minimum webbing extension.
5. If there is a lockup of all safety belt retractors being tested, the safety belt retractors are
functioning correctly. If any safety belt retractor fails
to lock up, install a new safety belt retractor(s).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Front
Seat Belt Retractor: Service and Repair Safety Belt Retractor - Front
Safety Belt Retractor - Front
NOTE: RH shown, LH similar.
Removal and Installation
WARNING: After any crash, all of the following safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware must
be inspected by an authorized dealer to verify correct function:
- Retractors
- Buckles
- Belt tension sensor (BTS) (if equipped)
- Front safety belt buckle support assemblies (slide bar) (if equipped)
- Safety belt shoulder belt height adjusters (if equipped)
- Child safety seat tether bracket assemblies
- Automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature for child safety seats (passenger seating positions only)
If any safety belt assembly is damaged, does not operate correctly or does not pass all of the
Functional Tests in the Diagnosis and Testing portion, a new safety belt assembly must be
installed. If any safety belt assembly attaching areas are damaged or distorted, the sheet metal
must be restored to its original structural integrity and new safety belt assembly and attaching
hardware must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware
may increase the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
After any crash that results in deployment of the driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt
pretensioners, new driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt systems (including retractors,
buckles and height adjusters) must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt systems increases
the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
1. NOTE: Inspect the D-ring cover for damage. If the cover is damaged or does not remain closed,
install a new D-ring cover.
Remove the upper and lower B-pillar trim panels.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Front > Page 6216
2. Release the 2 pin-type retainers and safety belt guide.
3. Remove the bolt and safety belt retractor.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
4. NOTE: Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted and the safety belts and buckles are
accessible to the occupants.
NOTE: Remove the shipping clip after safety belt retractor installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
5. Check the active restraint system for correct operation. For additional information, refer to the
appropriate Functional Test in Safety Belt System
See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Front > Page 6217
Seat Belt Retractor: Service and Repair Safety Belt Retractor - Second Row and Third Row,
Outboard
Safety Belt Retractor - Second Row and Third Row, Outboard
Expedition/Navigator
NOTE: RH shown, LH similar.
Expedition EL/Navigator L
NOTE: RH shown, LH similar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Front > Page 6218
Removal and Installation
WARNING: After any crash, all of the following safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware must
be inspected by an authorized dealer to verify correct function:
- Retractors
- Buckles
- Belt tension sensor (BTS) (if equipped)
- Front safety belt buckle support assemblies (slide bar) (if equipped)
- Safety belt shoulder belt height adjusters (if equipped)
- Child safety seat tether bracket assemblies
- Automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature for child safety seats (passenger seating positions only)
If any safety belt assembly is damaged, does not operate correctly or does not pass all of the
Functional Tests in the Diagnosis and Testing portion, a new safety belt assembly must be
installed. If any safety belt assembly attaching areas are damaged or distorted, the sheet metal
must be restored to its original structural integrity and new safety belt assembly and attaching
hardware must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware
may increase the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
After any crash that results in deployment of the driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt
pretensioners, new driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt systems (including retractors,
buckles and height adjusters) must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt systems increases
the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
All retractors
1. Remove the rear quarter trim panel.
Second row retractors
2. NOTE: Inspect the D-ring cover for damage. If the cover is damaged or does not remain closed,
install a new D-ring cover and bolt.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Front > Page 6219
Open the D-ring cover and remove the D-ring bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3. Remove the safety belt anchor bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
Third row retractors
4. NOTE: Inspect the D-ring cover for damage. If the cover is damaged or does not remain closed,
install a new D-ring cover and bolt. Expedition
and Navigator third row D-ring cover is serviced as part of the safety belt retractor assembly.
If equipped, open the D-ring cover and remove the D-ring bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
5. If equipped, remove the sling bolt cover and safety belt sling bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
6. For RH third row safety belt retractor, remove the 2 screws and position aside the auxiliary relay
box, if equipped.
All retractors
7. Remove the bolt and safety belt retractor.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
8. NOTE: Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted and the safety belts and buckles are
accessible to the occupants.
NOTE: Before installing the third row safety belt anchor, make sure the floor-slotted plastic insert is
still present. If it is not, another insert must be installed.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
9. Check the active restraint system for correct operation. For additional information, refer to the
appropriate Functional Test in Safety Belt System
See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Front > Page 6220
Seat Belt Retractor: Service and Repair Safety Belt Retractor - Second Row, Center
Safety Belt Retractor - Second Row, Center
Removal and Installation
WARNING: After any crash, all of the following safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware must
be inspected by an authorized dealer to verify correct function:
- Retractors
- Buckles
- Belt tension sensor (BTS) (if equipped)
- Front safety belt buckle support assemblies (slide bar) (if equipped)
- Safety belt shoulder belt height adjusters (if equipped)
- Child safety seat tether bracket assemblies
- Automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature for child safety seats (passenger seating positions only)
If any safety belt assembly is damaged, does not operate correctly or does not pass all of the
Functional Tests in the Diagnosis and Testing portion, a new safety belt assembly must be
installed. If any safety belt assembly attaching areas are damaged or distorted, the sheet metal
must be restored to its original structural integrity and new safety belt assembly and attaching
hardware must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware
may increase the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
After any crash that results in deployment of the driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt
pretensioners, new driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt systems (including retractors,
buckles and height adjusters) must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt systems increases
the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
NOTE: The retractor may be equipped with an additional web stop button (small, thin, round button,
not to be confused with the larger web stop button) located on the safety belt webbing. This button
is only used for vehicle assembly and serves no other functional purpose. The button can possibly
be
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Front > Page 6221
retracted under the trim bezel, making it difficult to pull the safety belt webbing out of the retractor.
To service, remove this web stop button. Do not install a new safety belt retractor to eliminate this
condition. Any resulting appearance concerns with the webbing can be worked out by hand. For
additional information, refer to Safety Belt System See: Description and Operation.
1. Remove the second row 20 percent seat backrest trim cover.
2. Remove the seat backrest foam pad.
3. Remove the safety belt retractor cover foam.
4. Remove the 2 screws from the seat belt retractor cover and remove the cover.
5. Remove the safety belt retractor bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
6. Pinch and release the safety belt retractor guide from the seat backrest frame and remove the
safety belt retractor.
7. NOTE: Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted and the safety belts and buckles are
accessible to the occupants.
NOTE: Remove the shipping clip after safety belt retractor installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
8. Check the active restraint system for correct operation. For additional information, refer to the
appropriate Functional Test in Safety Belt System
See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Front > Page 6222
Seat Belt Retractor: Service and Repair Safety Belt Retractor - Third Row, Center
Safety Belt Retractor - Third Row, Center
Removal and Installation
WARNING: After any crash, all of the following safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware must
be inspected by an authorized dealer to verify correct function:
- Retractors
- Buckles
- Belt tension sensor (BTS) (if equipped)
- Front safety belt buckle support assemblies (slide bar) (if equipped)
- Safety belt shoulder belt height adjusters (if equipped)
- Child safety seat tether bracket assemblies
- Automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature for child safety seats (passenger seating positions only)
If any safety belt assembly is damaged, does not operate correctly or does not pass all of the
Functional Tests in the Diagnosis and Testing portion, a new safety belt assembly must be
installed. If any safety belt assembly attaching areas are damaged or distorted, the sheet metal
must be restored to its original structural integrity and new safety belt assembly and attaching
hardware must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware
may increase the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
After any crash that results in deployment of the driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt
pretensioners, new driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt systems (including retractors,
buckles and height adjusters) must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt systems increases
the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
NOTE: The retractor may be equipped with an additional web stop button (small, thin, round button,
not to be confused with the larger web stop button) located on the safety belt webbing. This button
is only used for vehicle assembly and serves no other functional purpose. The button can possibly
be
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Front > Page 6223
retracted under the trim bezel, making it difficult to pull the safety belt webbing out of the retractor.
To service, remove this web stop button. Do not install a new safety belt retractor to eliminate this
condition. Any resulting appearance concerns with the webbing can be worked out by hand.
1. Remove the third row 60 percent seat backrest trim cover.
2. Remove the seat backrest foam pad.
3. Remove the 4 screws from the safety belt retractor cover (2 shown).
4. Remove the safety belt retractor bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
5. Pinch to release the safety belt retractor guide and remove the safety belt retractor.
6. NOTE: Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted and the safety belts and buckles are
accessible to the occupants.
NOTE: Remove the shipping clip after safety belt retractor installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
7. Check the active restraint system for correct operation. For additional information, refer to the
appropriate Functional Test in Safety Belt System
See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Diagrams > Safety Belt Buckle Pretensioner, Driver
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Diagrams > Safety Belt Buckle Pretensioner, Driver > Page 6228
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 6229
Seat Belt Tensioner: Description and Operation
Safety Belt System
WARNING: After any crash, all of the following safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware must
be inspected by an authorized dealer to verify correct function:
- Retractors
- Buckles
- Belt tension sensor (BTS) (if equipped)
- Front safety belt buckle support assemblies (slide bar) (if equipped)
- Safety belt shoulder belt height adjusters (if equipped)
- Child safety seat tether bracket assemblies
- Automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature for child safety seats (passenger seating positions only)
If any safety belt assembly is damaged, does not operate correctly or does not pass all of the
Functional Tests in the Diagnosis and Testing portion, a new safety belt assembly must be
installed. If any safety belt assembly attaching areas are damaged or distorted, the sheet metal
must be restored to its original structural integrity and new safety belt assembly and attaching
hardware must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware
may increase the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
After any crash that results in deployment of the driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt
pretensioners, new driver and/or front outboard passenger safety belt systems (including retractors,
buckles and height adjusters) must be installed. Failure to install new safety belt systems increases
the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
The safety belt retractor is designed to let the webbing move freely in and out at all times, except
during vehicle hard braking, hard cornering or an impact of 24 km/h (15 mph) or more, when it is
automatically locked by a mechanically actuated inertia sensor.
When replacing safety belt buckles and/or retractor assemblies, use only the replacement parts
specified in the Ford Customer Service Division Master Parts and Accessories Catalog.
Safety Belt Retractors
The safety belt retractors are a dual locking mode type and consist of the following features:
- Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR)
- Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) (all except driver seat)
Safety Belt Retractor and Features
Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR)
The ELR is a vehicle sensitive feature designed to activate and lock the safety belt webbing when
braking hard, cornering hard or in an impact of approximately 24 km/h (15 mph). The ELR feature
helps to reduce the forward movement of the occupants. For testing, refer to the appropriate
Functional Test procedure in Safety Belt System See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests
and General Diagnostics.
Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR)
The ALR mode is used when locking a child seat in an outboard seating position. The ALR mode is
automatically activated when the safety belt webbing is fully extracted from the retractor and then
allowed to retract. As the safety belt webbing is retracted back onto the spool, an audible clicking
sound is made indicating the safety belt retractor is in ALR mode and the safety belt webbing will
not pull back out of the safety belt retractor. To disengage the ALR mode, allow the safety belt
webbing to fully retract back onto the spool. The ALR mode is disengaged when the webbing is
free to extract and retract back into the retractor. When installing a dual locking mode retractor, the
retractor should be checked to make sure it is not in the ALR mode after installation in the stowed
position. Refer to the appropriate Functional Test procedure in Safety Belt System See: Testing
and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch > Component Information >
Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 6233
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor
Impact Sensor: Locations Front Impact Severity Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6239
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6240
Impact Sensor: Locations Driver Side Impact Sensor, C-Pillar
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6241
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6242
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6243
Impact Sensor: Locations Passenger Side Impact Sensor, C-Pillar
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6244
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6245
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6246
Impact Sensor: Locations Driver Front Door, Side Impact Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6247
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6248
Impact Sensor: Locations Passenger Front Door, Side Impact Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6249
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Front Impact Severity Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6252
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6253
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6254
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6255
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Front Impact Severity Sensor
Front Impact Severity Sensor
Removal and Installation
WARNING: If a vehicle has been in a crash, inspect the restraints control module (RCM) and the
impact sensor (if equipped) mounting areas for deformation. If damaged, restore the mounting
areas to the original production configuration. A new RCM and sensors must be installed whether
or not the air bags have deployed. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury or death in a crash.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
NOTE: The front impact severity sensor is located on the bottom of the lower radiator support.
1. Depower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Air Bag
Systems/Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) Depowering and Repowering in the General Procedures portion.
2. Disconnect the front impact severity sensor electrical connector.
3. WARNING: Always tighten the fasteners of the restraints control module (RCM) and impact
sensor (if equipped) to the specified torque.
Failure to do so may result in incorrect restraint system operation, which increases the risk of
personal injury or death in a crash.
NOTE: Make sure the radiator support and front impact severity sensor mating surfaces are clean
and free of foreign material.
Remove the bolt and front impact severity sensor. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
5. Repower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Air Bag
Systems/Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) Depowering and Repowering in the General Procedures portion.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6258
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Side Impact Sensor - C-Pillar
Side Impact Sensor - C-Pillar
NOTE: Expedition/Navigator shown, Expedition EL/Navigator L similar.
NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
WARNING: If a vehicle has been in a crash, inspect the restraints control module (RCM) and the
impact sensor (if equipped) mounting areas for deformation. If damaged, restore the mounting
areas to the original production configuration. A new RCM and sensors must be installed whether
or not the air bags have deployed. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury or death in a crash.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the
customer.
1. Depower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Air Bag
Systems/Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) Depowering and Repowering in the General Procedures portion.
2. Remove the rear door scuff plate.
3. Detach the rear door weatherstrip.
4. Remove the bolt and second row safety belt retractor anchor.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
5. Position aside the quarter trim panel.
- Pull out on the quarter trim panel at the C-pillar and release the retaining clips to gain access to
the C-pillar side impact sensor.
6. Disconnect the side impact sensor electrical connector.
7. WARNING: Always tighten the fasteners of the restraints control module (RCM) and impact
sensor (if equipped) to the specified torque.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6259
Failure to do so may result in incorrect restraint system operation, which increases the risk of
personal injury or death in a crash.
NOTE: Make sure the C-pillar and side impact sensor mating surfaces are clean and free of foreign
material.
Remove the bolt and side impact sensor. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
8. NOTE: Before installation, make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted and the safety belts
and buckles are accessible to the occupants.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
9. Repower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Air Bag
Systems/Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) Depowering and Repowering in the General Procedures portion.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6260
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Side Impact Sensor - Front Door
Side Impact Sensor - Front Door
NOTE: RH door shown, LH similar.
Removal and Installation
WARNING: If a vehicle has been in a crash, inspect the restraints control module (RCM) and the
impact sensor (if equipped) mounting areas for deformation. If damaged, restore the mounting
areas to the original production configuration. A new RCM and sensors must be installed whether
or not the air bags have deployed. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury or death in a crash.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Depower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Air Bag
Systems/Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) Depowering and Repowering in the General Procedures portion.
2. Remove the front door trim panel.
3. Separate the weathershield from the door enough to access the side impact sensor.
4. Disconnect the side impact sensor electrical connector.
5. Remove the 2 bolts and side impact sensor.
6. NOTICE: To prevent stripping the insert nuts, tighten the side impact sensor bolts only enough to
retain the side impact sensor correctly.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 6261
- Inspect the insert nut for damage. If the insert nut is damaged, install a new insert.
7. Repower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Air Bag
Systems/Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) Depowering and Repowering in the General Procedures portion.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6265
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Seat Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Seat Position Sensor
NOTE: Power seat shown, manual similar.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Move the driver seat to the full forward and highest position.
2. Change to Ignition Off. Wait 1 minute.
3. Remove the seat position sensor and bracket bolt.
4. Unhook the seat position sensor and bracket from the seat track cross brace.
5. Disconnect the electrical connector and remove the seat position sensor and bracket.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
7. Repower the SRS. For additional information, refer to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering See: Air Bag
Systems/Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming/Service and Repair/Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) Depowering and Repowering in the General Procedures portion.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6272
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6278
Accessory Delay Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6279
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna Control Module > Component
Information > Locations
Antenna Control Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna Control Module > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6284
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna Control Module > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6285
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna Control Module > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6286
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Antenna Cable >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Antenna Cable - AM/FM
Antenna Cable: Service and Repair Antenna Cable - AM/FM
Antenna Cable - AM/FM
Removal and Installation
Front AM/FM antenna cable
1. Remove the Audio Control Module (ACM). For additional information, refer to Audio Control
Module (ACM) See: Cellular
Phone/Communications Control Module/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Audio
Control Module (ACM).
Rear AM/FM antenna cable
2. Remove the RH scuff plate.
3. Remove the RH A-pillar lower trim panel.
Both AM/FM antenna cables
4. Disconnect the AM/FM antenna cable connection.
5. NOTE: The rear AM/FM antenna cable is an integral part of the wiring harness and cannot be
replaced separately from the harness. Cut the ends
off the old antenna cable and tape the remainder to the wiring harness to prevent noise.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Antenna Cable >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Antenna Cable - AM/FM > Page 6292
Remove the AM/FM antenna cable.
6. NOTE: When installing a new rear AM/FM antenna cable, tape or wire-tie the new cable to the
wiring harness to prevent noise.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Antenna Cable >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Antenna Cable - AM/FM > Page 6293
Antenna Cable: Service and Repair Antenna Cable - Satellite Radio
Antenna Cable - Satellite Radio
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH A-pillar trim panel.
2. Remove the RH sun visor.
3. Lower the front of the headliner enough to gain access to the satellite radio antenna electrical
connector.
4. Disconnect the satellite radio antenna electrical connector.
5. Remove the satellite radio antenna.
- Disconnect the satellite radio antenna cable-to-Satellite Digital Audio Receiver System (SDARS)
module electrical connector.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm System Transmitter
> Component Information > Service and Repair
Alarm System Transmitter: Service and Repair
Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) Transceiver
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the steering wheel.
2. Remove the 2 screws and the lower steering column shroud.
3. Disconnect the Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) transceiver electrical connector.
4. Remove the screw and the PATS transceiver.
5. NOTE: Replacement of the PATS transceiver does not require the PATS keys to be
programmed into the Instrument Cluster (IC) again.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm System
Transponder > Component Information > Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Hood Sensor/Switch (For
Alarm) > Component Information > Locations
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Hood Sensor/Switch (For
Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 6304
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Hood Sensor/Switch (For
Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 6305
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Key-Pad > Component Information > Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Key-Pad > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6310
Keyless Entry Key-Pad: Testing and Inspection
Keyless Entry Keypad Code Programming
Programming a Personal Code and Keypad Association to Memory Seats and Mirrors (If Equipped)
NOTE: If the wrong code has been entered 7 times (35 consecutive button presses), the keypad
will go into an anti-scan mode. This mode disables the keypad for one minute and the keypad
illumination will flash. The anti-scan feature will turn off after one minute of keypad inactivity, after
pressing the UNLOCK button on the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter, or after the ignition
key has been turned to the ON position.
NOTE: The factory set code cannot be associated with a memory setting.
1. Enter the permanent factory keyless entry keypad code.
2. Within 5 seconds, press the 1/2 button on the keypad.
3. Enter the new 5-digit keyless entry keypad code. Each number must be entered within 5
seconds of each other.
4. To associate the entry code with a memory setting, enter a sixth digit to indicate which driver
should be set in a memory recalled by the personal
entry code: Pressing the 1/2 button recalls driver 1 settings
- Pressing the 3/4 button recalls driver 2 settings
- Pressing other keypad buttons or not pressing a keypad button as a sixth digit does not set a
driver and will not recall a memory setting
5. The doors will lock then unlock to confirm the new code is programmed.
Erasing the Personal Codes
NOTE: If the wrong code has been entered 7 times (35 consecutive button presses), the keypad
will go into an anti-scan mode. This mode disables the keypad for one minute and the keypad
illumination will flash. The anti-scan feature will turn off after one minute of keypad inactivity, after
pressing the UNLOCK button on the RKE transmitter, or after the ignition key has been turned to
the ON position.
1. Enter the permanent factory keyless entry keypad code.
2. Within 5 seconds, press the 1/2 button on the keypad and release.
3. Within 5 seconds, press and hold the 1/2 button on the keypad for 2 seconds.
4. All personal codes are now erased and only the permanent factory keyless entry keypad code
will work.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Key-Pad > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6311
Keyless Entry Key-Pad: Service and Repair
Keyless Entry Keypad
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the exterior mirror.
2. Remove the front door outer glass weatherstrip.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. Release the tabs and remove the keyless entry keypad.
- Disconnect the keypad harness retaining clips from the weatherstrip.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) Transmitter
Programming
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Testing and Inspection Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) Transmitter
Programming
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) Transmitter Programming
NOTE: This procedure is for programming conventional keyfobs only. The Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) transmitter of the Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) is programmed automatically during
the Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) programming. For additional information, refer to Key
Programming Using Two Programmed Keys or Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key
Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment in Antitheft and Alarm Systems to program the IKT.
See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key Programming Using Two
Programmed Keys See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Integrated Keyhead
Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment
NOTE: All RKE transmitters must be programmed at the same time.
NOTE: Do not apply the brake pedal during this sequencing, as doing so ends the sequence and
the transmitters will not be programmed.
1. Electronically unlock the door locks using the door lock control switch.
2. Cycle the ignition switch from the OFF to the RUN position 8 times in rapid succession (within 10
seconds), with the eighth turn ending in RUN.
If the module successfully enters program mode, it locks and then unlocks all the doors.
3. NOTE: If no action is taken within 20 seconds after a transmitter has been programmed, the
programming sequence ends (the doors lock and
unlock to confirm that programming is complete).
Within 20 seconds, press any button on the RKE transmitter to be programmed. The doors lock
and then unlock to confirm that each RKE transmitter is programmed. Repeat this step for each
RKE transmitter.
4. Exiting the programming mode is accomplished if one of the following occurs:
- The key transitions to the OFF position.
- 20 seconds have passed since entering programming mode or since the last RKE transmitter was
programmed.
- The maximum number (4) of RKE transmitters have been programmed.
5. Check the operation of the RKE transmitter. If the door locks do not respond for the programmed
RKE transmitter(s), wait several seconds and
press the button again. If the door locks still fail to respond, refer to Locks, Latches and Entry
Systems See: Body and Frame/Locks/Power Locks/Testing and Inspection. (Make sure that no
more than the maximum number of RKE transmitters are attempted to be programmed.)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) Transmitter
Programming > Page 6316
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Testing and Inspection Autolock and Auto-Unlock Programming
Autolock and Auto-Unlock Programming
Programming the Autolock Feature Using the Door Lock Control Switch
NOTE: This feature can also be enabled or disabled using the message center switch functions, if
equipped.
NOTE: The autolock feature can be enabled or disabled independently of the auto-unlock feature.
NOTE: The following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure will need to be
repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF to the RUN position.
2. Press the unlock button on the door lock control 3 times.
3. Turn the ignition switch from the RUN to the OFF position.
4. Press the unlock button on the door lock control switch 3 times.
5. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN position. The horn chirps one time to indicate that
programming mode is entered.
6. NOTE: The unlock and lock buttons must be pressed within 5 seconds of each other.
Within 30 seconds of entering the programming mode, press the unlock button and then the lock
button on the door lock control switch within 5 seconds to enable/disable the autolock feature. The
horn chirps once if the autolocks are disabled or a chirp followed by a honk if the autolocks are
enabled.
7. Programming ends when the ignition switch state changes or times out after 2 minutes.
Programming the Auto-Unlock Feature Using the Door Lock Control Switch
NOTE: This feature can also be enabled or disabled using the message center switch functions, if
equipped.
NOTE: The auto-unlock feature can be enabled or disabled independently of the autolock feature.
NOTE: The following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure will need to be
repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF to the RUN position.
2. Press the unlock button on the door unlock control 3 times.
3. Turn the ignition switch from the RUN to the OFF position.
4. Press the unlock button on the door lock control switch 3 times.
5. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN position. The horn chirps one time to indicate that
programming mode is entered.
6. NOTE: The lock and unlock buttons must be pressed within 5 seconds of each other.
Within 30 seconds of entering the programming mode, press the lock button on the door lock
control switch then the unlock button to enable/disable the auto-unlock feature. The horn chirps
once if the autolocks are disabled or a chirp followed by a honk if the autolocks are enabled.
7. Programming ends when the ignition switch state changes or times out after 2 minutes.
Programming the Autolock Feature Using the Keyless Entry Keypad
NOTE: The autolock feature can be enabled or disabled independently of the auto-unlock feature.
NOTE: The following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure needs to be
repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) Transmitter
Programming > Page 6317
1. Enter the factory set 5 digit entry code.
2. Press and hold the 3/4 button.
3. While holding the 3/4 button, press and release the 7/8 button.
4. Release the 3/4 button. The horn chirps once if the autolocks are disabled, or chirps once
followed by a honk if the autolocks are enabled.
Programming the Auto-Unlock Feature Using the Keyless Entry Keypad
NOTE: The auto-unlock feature can be enabled or disabled independently of the autolock feature.
NOTE: The following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure will need to be
repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. Enter the factory set 5 digit entry code.
2. Press and hold the 3/4 button.
3. While holding the 3/4 button, press and release the 7/8 button twice.
4. Release the 3/4 button. The horn chirps once if auto-unlock is disabled, or chirps once followed
by a honk if auto-unlock is enabled.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) Transmitter
Programming > Page 6318
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Testing and Inspection Remote Memory Activation
Remote Memory Activation
1. Position the driver seat, adjustable pedals, steering column and exterior mirror to the desired
positions.
2. Press and hold either memory button (1 or 2) for 5 seconds. A tone will be heard after 1-1/2
seconds when the memory store is done. Continue to
hold until a second tone is heard after 5 seconds.
3. Within 3 seconds, press the LOCK button on the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter.
4. If a second memory setting is desired, repeat the procedure with the second RKE transmitter.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) Transmitter
Programming > Page 6319
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Testing and Inspection Remote Memory Deactivation
Remote Memory Deactivation
1. Press and hold either memory button (1 or 2) for 5 seconds. A tone will be heard after 1-1/2
seconds when the memory store is done. Continue to
hold until a second tone is heard after 5 seconds.
2. Within 3 seconds, press the UNLOCK button on the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter.
3. If a second memory setting is desired to be deactivated, repeat the procedure with the second
RKE transmitter.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) Transmitter
Programming > Page 6320
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Testing and Inspection
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) Transmitter Programming
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) Transmitter Programming
NOTE: This procedure is for programming conventional keyfobs only. The Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) transmitter of the Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) is programmed automatically during
the Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) programming. For additional information, refer to Key
Programming Using Two Programmed Keys or Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key
Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment in Antitheft and Alarm Systems to program the IKT.
See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key Programming Using Two
Programmed Keys See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Integrated Keyhead
Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment
NOTE: All RKE transmitters must be programmed at the same time.
NOTE: Do not apply the brake pedal during this sequencing, as doing so ends the sequence and
the transmitters will not be programmed.
1. Electronically unlock the door locks using the door lock control switch.
2. Cycle the ignition switch from the OFF to the RUN position 8 times in rapid succession (within 10
seconds), with the eighth turn ending in RUN.
If the module successfully enters program mode, it locks and then unlocks all the doors.
3. NOTE: If no action is taken within 20 seconds after a transmitter has been programmed, the
programming sequence ends (the doors lock and
unlock to confirm that programming is complete).
Within 20 seconds, press any button on the RKE transmitter to be programmed. The doors lock
and then unlock to confirm that each RKE transmitter is programmed. Repeat this step for each
RKE transmitter.
4. Exiting the programming mode is accomplished if one of the following occurs:
- The key transitions to the OFF position.
- 20 seconds have passed since entering programming mode or since the last RKE transmitter was
programmed.
- The maximum number (4) of RKE transmitters have been programmed.
5. Check the operation of the RKE transmitter. If the door locks do not respond for the programmed
RKE transmitter(s), wait several seconds and
press the button again. If the door locks still fail to respond, refer to Locks, Latches and Entry
Systems See: Body and Frame/Locks/Power Locks/Testing and Inspection. (Make sure that no
more than the maximum number of RKE transmitters are attempted to be programmed.)
Autolock and Auto-Unlock Programming
Autolock and Auto-Unlock Programming
Programming the Autolock Feature Using the Door Lock Control Switch
NOTE: This feature can also be enabled or disabled using the message center switch functions, if
equipped.
NOTE: The autolock feature can be enabled or disabled independently of the auto-unlock feature.
NOTE: The following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure will need to be
repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF to the RUN position.
2. Press the unlock button on the door lock control 3 times.
3. Turn the ignition switch from the RUN to the OFF position.
4. Press the unlock button on the door lock control switch 3 times.
5. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN position. The horn chirps one time to indicate that
programming mode is entered.
6. NOTE: The unlock and lock buttons must be pressed within 5 seconds of each other.
Within 30 seconds of entering the programming mode, press the unlock button and then the lock
button on the door lock control switch within 5
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) Transmitter
Programming > Page 6321
seconds to enable/disable the autolock feature. The horn chirps once if the autolocks are disabled
or a chirp followed by a honk if the autolocks are enabled.
7. Programming ends when the ignition switch state changes or times out after 2 minutes.
Programming the Auto-Unlock Feature Using the Door Lock Control Switch
NOTE: This feature can also be enabled or disabled using the message center switch functions, if
equipped.
NOTE: The auto-unlock feature can be enabled or disabled independently of the autolock feature.
NOTE: The following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure will need to be
repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF to the RUN position.
2. Press the unlock button on the door unlock control 3 times.
3. Turn the ignition switch from the RUN to the OFF position.
4. Press the unlock button on the door lock control switch 3 times.
5. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN position. The horn chirps one time to indicate that
programming mode is entered.
6. NOTE: The lock and unlock buttons must be pressed within 5 seconds of each other.
Within 30 seconds of entering the programming mode, press the lock button on the door lock
control switch then the unlock button to enable/disable the auto-unlock feature. The horn chirps
once if the autolocks are disabled or a chirp followed by a honk if the autolocks are enabled.
7. Programming ends when the ignition switch state changes or times out after 2 minutes.
Programming the Autolock Feature Using the Keyless Entry Keypad
NOTE: The autolock feature can be enabled or disabled independently of the auto-unlock feature.
NOTE: The following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure needs to be
repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. Enter the factory set 5 digit entry code.
2. Press and hold the 3/4 button.
3. While holding the 3/4 button, press and release the 7/8 button.
4. Release the 3/4 button. The horn chirps once if the autolocks are disabled, or chirps once
followed by a honk if the autolocks are enabled.
Programming the Auto-Unlock Feature Using the Keyless Entry Keypad
NOTE: The auto-unlock feature can be enabled or disabled independently of the autolock feature.
NOTE: The following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure will need to be
repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. Enter the factory set 5 digit entry code.
2. Press and hold the 3/4 button.
3. While holding the 3/4 button, press and release the 7/8 button twice.
4. Release the 3/4 button. The horn chirps once if auto-unlock is disabled, or chirps once followed
by a honk if auto-unlock is enabled.
Remote Memory Activation
Remote Memory Activation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) Transmitter
Programming > Page 6322
1. Position the driver seat, adjustable pedals, steering column and exterior mirror to the desired
positions.
2. Press and hold either memory button (1 or 2) for 5 seconds. A tone will be heard after 1-1/2
seconds when the memory store is done. Continue to
hold until a second tone is heard after 5 seconds.
3. Within 3 seconds, press the LOCK button on the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter.
4. If a second memory setting is desired, repeat the procedure with the second RKE transmitter.
Remote Memory Deactivation
Remote Memory Deactivation
1. Press and hold either memory button (1 or 2) for 5 seconds. A tone will be heard after 1-1/2
seconds when the memory store is done. Continue to
hold until a second tone is heard after 5 seconds.
2. Within 3 seconds, press the UNLOCK button on the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter.
3. If a second memory setting is desired to be deactivated, repeat the procedure with the second
RKE transmitter.
Perimeter Lighting Feature Programming
Perimeter Lighting Feature Programming
Programming the Perimeter Lighting Feature Using the Door Lock Control Switch
NOTE: The following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure will need to be
repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF to the ON position.
2. Press the unlock button on the door lock control switch 3 times.
3. Turn the ignition switch from the ON to the OFF position.
4. Press the unlock button on the door lock control switch 3 times.
5. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position. The horn chirps one time to indicate that
programming mode is entered.
6. NOTE: The unlock button must be pressed twice within 5 seconds.
Within 30 seconds of entering the programming mode, press the unlock button on the door lock
control switch twice to enable/disable the perimeter lighting feature. The horn chirps once if the
perimeter lighting is disabled or a chirp followed by a honk if the perimeter lighting is enabled.
7. Programming ends when the ignition switch state changes or times out after 2 minutes.
Stepped Unlock Programming
Stepped Unlock Programming
1. With the ignition switch in the OFF position, press the LOCK and UNLOCK buttons on the
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter
simultaneously for 4 seconds. The turn signals flash twice to indicate the mode change.
2. Repeat Step 1 to enable/disable the stepped unlocking feature.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone Microphone: >
10-25-12 > Dec > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Audio Quality
Technical Service Bulletin # 10-25-12 Date: 101223
SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Audio Quality
TSB 10-25-12
12/23/10
SYNC - CALL SOUND QUALITY/BACKGROUND NOISE ISSUES AND/OR VOICE
RECOGNITION DIFFICULTIES WHILE DRIVING
FORD: 2008-2009 Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus 2008-2011 Focus 2008-2010 Edge, Explorer Sport
Trac, Explorer 2009-2010 F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex 2009-2011 Escape, Expedition
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009-2011 MKS 2008-2010 MKX 2009-2011 Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable 2008-2010 Mountaineer 2009-2011 Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 10-8-4 to update the vehicle model years, Service Procedure and the
Part List. The new SYNC service Microphone kit now includes a voltage filter incorporated into the
jumper harness.
ISSUE Some customers of 2008-2011 SYNC equipped vehicles may express concern with their
call sound quality while using the SYNC microphone, complaints of excessive background noise
during a phone call and/or issues with voice recognition accuracy while driving.
ACTION Follow the service procedure to correct the condition.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT102512 Claim Diagnosis And Labor Actual
Performed As Actual Time. Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
17700 42
Disclaimer
Service Procedure
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone Microphone: >
10-25-12 > Dec > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Audio Quality > Page 6332
The following procedure involves updating the Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
software level and installing an external alternate SYNC microphone attached to the headliner.
NOTE
THIS PROCEDURE DOES NOT APPLY TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH HEADLINER
MICROPHONE OR DEALER-INSTALLED SYNC SYSTEMS.
Go to Step 2 if the vehicle is already equipped with SYNC 3.0 Traffic and Directions or has already
been upgraded to latest available consumer interface processor (CIP) level 9L3T-14D544-AE
without E911/VHR, 9L2T-14D544-BE with E911/VHR or later versions. To determine the current
APIM software level, Refer to the Professional Technician Society (PTS) website, enter the VIN in
OASIS, click the GO button and select the SYNC button.
1. Reprogram the APIM to CIP software level 9L3T-1 4D544-AE without E9 11 /VHR,
9L2T-14D544-BE with E911/VHR or later version. For
additional information Refer to other SYNC TSB's and WSM, Section 418-01. Service Pack files
may also be obtained at www.syncmyride.com.
When diagnosing a concern related to voice recognition (VR) difficulties, instruct the customer to
test VR functionality while the vehicle is parked. If customer concerns are still present, this
procedure will not yield an improvement and the service procedure should not be performed.
Instead, refer to the SYNC supplement guide and www.syncmyride.com for additional VR tips to
assist customer.
The VR experience can be improved with user training and making improvements to the phone
book entries (longer entries make the system more robust). Ensure the customer does not try to
speak too loud or slow and remove any objects hanging on the rear view mirror as this will reduce
system effectiveness.
When diagnosing a concern related to call sound quality, expect marginal improvements for calls
described as speaking in a tunnel, chamber, etc. Expect substantial improvements for complaints
where the call audio seems to drop out intermittently.
NOTE
THIS REPAIR WILL CHANGE THE APPEARANCE OF THE VEHICLE INTERIOR. REFER TO
THE PHOTOGRAPHS FOR THE APPLICABLE VEHICLE LOCATED IN THIS PROCEDURE. DO
NOT PERFORM THIS REPAIR WITHOUT CUSTOMER APPROVAL PRIOR TO PROCEEDING
WITH MICROPHONE INSTALLATION.
2. Install SYNC microphone service kit. Installing the kit includes mounting an external microphone
directly to the headliner and splicing in a jumper
harness to the vehicle's existing wiring harness. The existing SYNC microphone will no longer be
functional. The jumper harness is equipped with a voltage filter. The filter will need to be wrapped
in soft foam 164-R4901 or flock tape 164-R4903 from the Rotunda squeak and rattle kit 164-R4900
to prevent interior squeak/rattle noise.
a. Refer to the appropriate vehicle line and microphone illustration(s) below for microphone
installation and wire splicing locations. Refer to
Wiring Diagram (WD), Section 5-1 for recommended splicing methods.
b. Ensure the SYNC microphone wires are secure and do not interfere with vehicle operation or
functionality.
c. The microphone is directional. Make sure the microphone is always positioned so wire length is
minimized from view. When installing the
microphone adjacent to trim, place the microphone as close to trim as possible to help minimize
visible wire.
Edge / MKX
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 1)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone Microphone: >
10-25-12 > Dec > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Audio Quality > Page 6333
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 501-12 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable up through existing hole in the headliner and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connectors 210 and 211 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124 for
links to location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13, RMM13 and DMM13 (shield) from C211. Cut the three circuits on the
female side of the connector (14334 harness).
These are the microphone positive, negative and shield circuits. Then splice the yellow jumper
harness wire to VMM13 and any two of the three black jumper harness wires to RMM13 and
DMM13 (shield). Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off
and secure the cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
7. Identify circuits CBP41 and GD133 from C210. This is power and ground for both the new
microphone and the existing mirror. Splice in the blue
jumper harness wire to CBP41 and the remaining black jumper harness wire to GD133. Ensure
that the original circuits remain intact and connected as this is power for other items within the rear
view mirror and in the roof.
8. Do not plug in the microphone at this time, proceed to Final Test / Service Steps.
Escape / Mariner
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration (Figures 2 and 3). Firmly
press the microphone into place. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead
console trim (if equipped) or positioned directly above A-pillar on headliner if not equipped with an
overhead console. Proceed to Step 5 if not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner to
run microphone cable.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone Microphone: >
10-25-12 > Dec > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Audio Quality > Page 6334
5. Gain access to connector 214 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13, RMM13 and DMM13 (shield) from C214. Cut the three circuits on the
female side of the connector (14334 harness).
These are the microphone positive, negative and shield circuits. Then splice the yellow jumper
harness wire to VMM13 and any two of the three black jumper harness wires to RMM13 and
DMM13 (shield). Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off
and secure the cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
7. Identify circuits CBP41 and GD182 from C214. This is power and ground for both the new
microphone and the existing mirror. Splice in the blue
jumper harness wire to CBP41 and the remaining black jumper harness wire to GD1 82. Ensure
that the original circuits remain intact and connected as this is power for other items within the rear
view mirror and in the roof.
8. Do not plug in the microphone at this time, proceed to Final Test / Service Steps.
Navigator / Expedition
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figures 4 and 5)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim (if equipped) or
positioned directly above A-pillar on headliner if not equipped with an overhead console.
^ Proceed to Step 5 if not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 501-12 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 298 located behind the dash panel on passenger side. Refer to online
WD, Section 124 for links to location and connector
views.
6. Identify circuits VMN07, RMNO7 and DMN07 (shield) from C298. Cut the three circuits on the
female side of the connector (17C712 harness).
These are the microphone positive, negative and shield circuits. Then splice the yellow jumper
harness wire to VMNO7 and any two (of the three) black jumper harness wires to RMNO7 and
DMNO7 (shield). Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off
and secure the cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
7. Identify circuits CBP41 and GD133 from C298. This is power and ground for both the new
microphone and the existing mirror. Splice in the blue
jumper harness wire to CBP41 and the remaining black jumper harness wire to GD133. Ensure
that the original circuits remain intact and connected as this is power for other items within the rear
view mirror and in the roof.
8. Do not plug in the microphone at this time, proceed to Final Test / Service Steps.
Explorer / Explorer Sport Trac / Mountaineer
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 6)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone Microphone: >
10-25-12 > Dec > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Audio Quality > Page 6335
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 501-12 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner to
run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 248 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMNO7, RMNO7 and DMNO7 (shield) from C248 (Sport Trac uses C260). Cut
the three circuits on the female side of the
connector (14334 harness). These are the microphone positive, negative and shield circuits. Then
splice the yellow jumper harness wire to VMNO7 and any two (of the three) black jumper harness
wires to RMNO7 and DMNO7 (shield). Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the
connector. Tape off and secure the cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer
used.
7. Identify circuits CBPO5 and GD143 from C248. This is power and ground for both the new
microphone and the existing mirror. Splice in the blue
jumper harness wire to CBPO5 and the remaining black jumper harness wire to GD143. Ensure
that the original circuits remain intact and connected as this is power for other items within the rear
view mirror and in the roof.
8. Do not plug in the microphone at this time, proceed to Final Test / Service Steps.
F-150
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 7)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim or front lamp.
2. Lower the overhead console or front lamp. Refer to WSM, Section 501-12 for additional
information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner and temporarily tuck excess wire
into headliner to the rear of the console or lamp.
4. Install overhead console or front lamp; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console or
front lamp trim directly behind microphone as
shown.
5. Gain access to connectors 314 and 315 in roof panel near left hand side. Refer to online WD,
Section 124 for links to location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13, RMM13 and DMM13 (shield) from C314. Cut the three circuits on the
female side of the connector (14358 harness).
These are the microphone positive, negative and shield circuits. Then splice the yellow jumper
harness wire to VMM13 and any two (of the three) black jumper harness wires to RMM13 and
DMM13 (shield). Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off
and secure the cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
7. Identify circuits CBP41 from C315 and GD133 from C314. This is power and ground for both the
new microphone and the existing mirror. Splice in
the blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 and the remaining black jumper harness wire to GD133.
Ensure that the original circuits remain intact and connected as this is power for other items within
the rear view mirror and in the roof.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone Microphone: >
10-25-12 > Dec > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Audio Quality > Page 6336
8. Do not plug in the microphone at this time, proceed to Final Test / Service Steps.
F-Super Duty
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 8)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
c. This repair is not recommended for vehicles not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 501-12 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 264 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13, RMM13 and DMM13 (shield) from C264. Cut the three circuits on the
female side of the connector (17K745 harness).
These are the microphone positive, negative and shield circuits. Then splice the yellow jumper
harness wire to VMM13 and any two (of the three) black jumper harness wires to RMM13 and
DMM13 (shield). Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off
and secure the cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used
7. Identify circuits CBP41 and GD133 from C264. This is power and ground for both the new
microphone and the existing mirror. Splice in the blue
jumper harness wire to CBP41 and the remaining black jumper harness wire to GD133. Ensure
that the original circuits remain intact and connected as this is power for other items within the rear
view mirror and in the roof.
8. Do not plug in the microphone at this time, proceed to Final Test / Service Steps.
Flex
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone Microphone: >
10-25-12 > Dec > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Audio Quality > Page 6337
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 9)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 501-12 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 925 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13, RMM13 and DMM13 (shield) from C925. Cut the three circuits on the
female side of the connector (14334 harness).
These are the microphone positive, negative and shield circuits. Then splice the yellow jumper
harness wire to VMM13 and any two (of the three) black jumper harness wires to RMM13 and
DMM13 (shield). Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off
and secure the cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
7. Identify circuits CBP41 and GD133 from C925. This is power and ground for both the new
microphone and the existing mirror. Splice in the blue
jumper harness wire to CBP41 and the remaining black jumper harness wire to GD133. Ensure
that the original circuits remain intact and connected as this is power for other items within the rear
view mirror and in the roof.
8. Do not plug in the microphone at this time, proceed to Final Test / Service Steps.
Focus
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 10) Firmly press
the microphone into place. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to the interior lamp trim.
2. Lower the interior lamp assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone Microphone: >
10-25-12 > Dec > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Audio Quality > Page 6338
3. Route microphone cable up through existing hole in the headliner and over to the passenger
side A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop
headliner to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install interior lamp assembly; ensure microphone cable enters the interior lamp trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 934 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD for location and connector
views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13, RMM13 and DMM13 (shield) from C934. Cut the three circuits on the
female side of the connector (14334 harness).
These are the microphone positive, negative and shield circuits. Then splice the yellow jumper
harness wire to VMM13 and any two (of the three) black jumper harness wires to RMM13 and
DMM13 (shield). Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off
and secure the cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
7. Identify circuits CPL6O and GD161 from C934. This is power and ground for both the new
microphone and the existing mirror. Splice in the blue
jumper harness wire to CPL6O and the remaining black jumper harness wire to GD161. Ensure
that the original circuits remain intact and connected as this is power for other items within the rear
view mirror and in the roof.
8. Do not plug in the microphone at this time, proceed to Final Test / Service Steps.
Fusion / Milan / MKZ
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 11)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 501-12 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 913 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13, RMM13 and DMM13 (shield) from C913. Cut the three circuits on the
female side of the connector (14334 harness).
These are the microphone positive, negative and shield circuits. Then splice the yellow jumper
harness wire to VMM13 and any two (of the three) black jumper harness wires to RMM13 and
DMM13 (shield). Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off
and secure the cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
7. Identify circuits CBPO2 and GD139 from C913. This is power and ground for both the new
microphone and the existing mirror. Splice in the blue
jumper harness wire to CBPO2 and the remaining black jumper harness wire to GD139. Ensure
that the original circuits remain intact and connected as this is power for other items within the rear
view mirror and in the roof.
8. Do not plug in the microphone at this time proceed to Final Test / Service Steps.
Taurus / Sable / Taurus X
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone Microphone: >
10-25-12 > Dec > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Audio Quality > Page 6339
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 12)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 501-12 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner to
run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 925 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMN02, RMN02 and DMN07 (shield) from C925. Cut the three circuits on the
female side of the connector (17K745 harness).
These are the microphone positive, negative and shield circuits. Then splice the yellow jumper
harness wire to VMN02 and any two (of the three) black jumper harness wires to RMN02 and
DMNO7 (shield). Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off
and secure the cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
7. Identify circuits CBP41 and GD133 from C925. This is power and ground for both the new
microphone and the existing mirror. Splice in the blue
jumper harness wire to CBP41 and the remaining black jumper harness wire to GD133. Ensure
that the original circuits remain intact and connected as this is power for other items within the rear
view mirror and in the roof.
8. Do not plug in the microphone at this time, proceed to Final Test I Service Steps.
MKS
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 13)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone Microphone: >
10-25-12 > Dec > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Audio Quality > Page 6340
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 501-12 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner and out the front of the headliner
above the rear view mirror.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 911 at the rear view mirror. Refer to the online WD, Section 124 for
links to location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMN02, RMNO2 and DMN07 (shield) from C911. Pull back the black harness
sleeve and cut the three circuits near C911 or if
equipped with a headlamp control module-2 (HCM-2), remove the HCM-2 access cover and cut
circuits under trim cover. Refer to WSM Section 417-01 for additional information. These are the
microphone positive, negative and shield circuits. Then splice the yellow jumper harness wire to
VMNO2 and remaining black jumper harness wires to RMNO2 and DMNO7 (shield). Only splice
into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the cut wire ends
heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
7. Identify circuits CBP41 and GD133 from C911. This is power and ground for both the new
microphone and the existing mirror. Splice in the blue
jumper harness wire to CBP41 and the remaining black jumper harness wire to GD133. Ensure
that the original circuits remain intact and connected as this is power for other items within the rear
view mirror and in the roof.
8. Do not plug in the microphone at this time, proceed to Final Test I Service Steps.
Final Test / Service Steps
1. After splicing/soldering is complete, apply power to the vehicle and confirm the voltage at the
jumper inline connector before connecting the
microphone.
^ Jumper blue wire equal 12V positive.
^ Jumper black wire equal ground reference.
^ Jumper yellow wire equal microphone return signal circuit less than IV.
2. Turn off ignition and attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector. Make
sure that the connector tabs have locked together after
connecting. Reversing this connector would cause a failure of the microphone.
3. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone Microphone: >
09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality
Cellular Phone Microphone: All Technical Service Bulletins SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone
Sound Quality
TSB 09-13-5
07/13/09
SYNC - CALL SOUND QUALITY/BACKGROUND NOISE ISSUES AND/OR VOICE
RECOGNITION DIFFICULTIES WHILE DRIVING
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape Hybrid, Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner Hybrid, Mariner
ISSUE Some customers of 2008-2009 SYNC equipped vehicles may express concern with their
call sound quality while using the SYNC microphone, complaints of excessive background noise
during a phone call, and/or issues with voice recognition accuracy while driving.
ACTION Follow the service procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The following service procedure involves updating the Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
software level and installing an external alternate SYNC microphone attached to the headliner.
NOTE
THIS PROCEDURE DOES NOT APPLY TO DEALER-INSTALLED SYNC SYSTEMS.
Do not perform Step 1 if vehicle is already equipped with SYNC 2.0 (911 and Vehicle Health
Report) or has been upgraded to consumer interface processor (CIP) level 9L3T-14D544-AE. To
determine the current APIM software level, Refer to the Professional Technician Society (PTS)
website, enter the VIN in OASIS, click the GO button, and select the SYNC button.
1. Reprogram the APIM to CIP software level 9L3T-14D544-AE. For additional information Refer to
other SYNC TSB's and WSM, Section 418-01.
Service Pack files may also be obtained at www.syncmyride.com.
When diagnosing a concern related to voice recognition (VR) difficulties, instruct the customer to
test VR functionality while the vehicle is parked. If customer concerns are still present, this
procedure will not yield an improvement, and the service procedure should not be performed.
Instead, Refer to the SYNC supplement guide and www.syncmyride.com for additional VR tips to
assist customer.
The VR experience can be improved with user training and making improvements to the phone
book entries (longer entries make the system more robust). Ensure the customer does not try to
speak too loud or slow and remove any objects hanging on the rear view mirror as this will reduce
system effectiveness.
When diagnosing a concern related to call sound quality, expect marginal improvements for calls
described as speaking in a tunnel, chamber, etc. Expect substantial improvements for complaints
where the call audio seems to drop out intermittently.
NOTE
THIS REPAIR WILL CHANGE THE APPEARANCE OF THE VEHICLE INTERIOR. REFER TO
THE PHOTOGRAPHS FOR THE APPLICABLE VEHICLE LOCATED IN THIS PROCEDURE. DO
NOT PERFORM THIS REPAIR WITHOUT CUSTOMER APPROVAL PRIOR TO PROCEEDING
WITH MICROPHONE INSTALLATION.
2. Install SYNC microphone service kit. Installing the kit includes mounting an external microphone
directly to the headliner and splicing in a jumper
harness to the vehicle's existing wiring harness. The existing SYNC microphone will no longer be
functional.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone Microphone: >
09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6345
a. Refer to the appropriate vehicle line and microphone illustration(s) below for microphone
installation and wire splicing locations. Refer to
Wiring Diagram (WD), Section 5-1 for recommended splicing methods.
b. Ensure the SYNC microphone wires are secure and do not interfere with vehicle operation or
functionality.
c. The microphone is directional. Make sure the microphone is always positioned so wire length is
minimized from view. When installing the
microphone adjacent to trim, place microphone as close to trim as possible to help minimize visible
wire.
2008-2009 Edge / MKX
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 1)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable up through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connectors 210 and 211 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for
links to location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C211. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C210.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2009 Escape / Mariner
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone Microphone: >
09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6346
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration (Figures 2 and 3). Firmly
press the microphone into place. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead
console trim (if equipped), or positioned directly above A-pillar on headliner if not equipped with an
overhead console. Proceed to Step 5 if not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner to
run microphone cable.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 214 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C214. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD182 (BK-GY) from C214.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD1 82 (BK-GY).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
9. Connect the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Navigator / 2009 Expedition
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone Microphone: >
09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6347
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figures 4 and 5)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim (if equipped), or
positioned directly above A-pillar on headliner if not
equipped with an overhead console.
^ Proceed to Step 5 if not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 298 located behind the dash panel on passenger side. Refer to online
WD, Section 124-1 for links to location and connector
views.
6. Identify circuits VMN07 (GY), RMN07 (VT), and DMN07 (shield - BK) from C298. Cut the three
circuits on the male side of the connector
(17C712 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP31 (BU-OG) and GD133 (BK) from C298 (2008 Navigator only). Identify
circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C298
(2009 Expedition/Navigator only).
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP31 (BU-OG) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK)
for 2008 Navigator only. Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness
wire to GD133 (BK) for 2009 Expedition/Navigator only.
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone Microphone: >
09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6348
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN07 (GY) and remaining black jumper harness wires to RMN07
(VT) and DMN07 (shield - BK).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Connect the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the headliner.
2008-2009 Explorer / Explorer Sport Trac / Mountaineer
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 6)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner run
microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 248 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify and cut circuits VMNO7 (GY), RMNO7 (VT), and DMNO7 (shield) from C248. Cut the
three circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP05 (YE) and GD143 (BK-VT) from C248.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP05 (YE) and any black jumper harness wire to GD143 (BK-VT).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN07 (GY) and remaining black jumper harness wires to RMN07
(VT) and DMN07 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2009 F-150
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone Microphone: >
09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6349
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 7)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim or front lamp.
2. Lower the overhead console or front lamp. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional
information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and temporarily tuck excess wire
into headliner to the rear of the console or lamp.
4. Install overhead console or front lamp; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console or
front lamp trim directly behind microphone as
shown.
5. Gain access to connectors 314 and 315 in roof panel near left hand side. Refer to online WD,
Section 124-1 for links to location and connector
views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C314. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14358 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) from C315 and GD133 (BK) from C314.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the headliner.
2009 F-Super Duty
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone Microphone: >
09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6350
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 8)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
c. This repair is not recommended for vehicles not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 264 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield - BK) from C264. Cut the
three circuits on the female side of the connector
(17K745 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C264.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield - BK).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Connect the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2009 Flex
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone Microphone: >
09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6351
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 9)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 925 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C925. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector (14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C925.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Focus
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone Microphone: >
09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6352
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration (Figure 10). Firmly press
the microphone into place. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to the dome lamp trim.
2. Lower the dome lamp assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable up through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger
side A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop
headliner to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install dome lamp assembly; ensure microphone cable enters the dome lamp trim directly behind
microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 934 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD for location and connector
views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C934. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CPL60 (BN-YE) and GD161 (BK-YE) from C934.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CPL60 (BN-YE) and any black jumper harness wire to GD161
(BK-YE).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Fusion / Milan / MKZ
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone Microphone: >
09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6353
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 11)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 913 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C913. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP02 (GN) and GD139 (BK-YE) from C913.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP02 (GN) and any black jumper harness wire to GD139 (BK-YE).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Taurus / Sable / Taurus X
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 12)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner to
run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone Microphone: >
09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6354
5. Gain access to connector 925 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMN02 (WH-BN), RMN02 (VT-BN), and DMN07 (shield) from C925. Cut the
three circuits on the female side of the connector
(17K745 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C925.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN02 (WH-BN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMN02 (VT-BN) and DMN07 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2009 MKS
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 13)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and out the front of the headliner
above the rear view mirror.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 911 at the rear view mirror. Refer to the online WD, Section 124-1 for
links to location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMNO2 (WH-BN), RMN02 (VT-BN), and DMN07 (shield) from C911. Pull back
the black harness sleeve and cut the three
circuits near C91 1 or if equipped with a headlamp control module-2 (HCM-2), remove the HCM-2
access cover and cut circuits under trim cover. Refer to WSM, Section 417-01 for additional
information.
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C911.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Cellular Phone Microphone: >
09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6355
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN02 (WH-BN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMN02 (VT-BN) and DMN07 (shield).
^ Only splice into the wires heading away from the connector. The wires heading into the connector
(mirror) are no longer used.
^ Ensure the wiring is neatly routed from the splice locations into the headliner, following the
existing wire harness routing from mirror to headliner.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 08-21-2
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT091305 Claim Diagnosis And Labor Actual
Performed As Actual Time. Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
17700 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cellular Phone Microphone: > 10-25-12 > Dec
> 10 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Audio Quality
Technical Service Bulletin # 10-25-12 Date: 101223
SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Audio Quality
TSB 10-25-12
12/23/10
SYNC - CALL SOUND QUALITY/BACKGROUND NOISE ISSUES AND/OR VOICE
RECOGNITION DIFFICULTIES WHILE DRIVING
FORD: 2008-2009 Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus 2008-2011 Focus 2008-2010 Edge, Explorer Sport
Trac, Explorer 2009-2010 F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex 2009-2011 Escape, Expedition
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009-2011 MKS 2008-2010 MKX 2009-2011 Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable 2008-2010 Mountaineer 2009-2011 Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 10-8-4 to update the vehicle model years, Service Procedure and the
Part List. The new SYNC service Microphone kit now includes a voltage filter incorporated into the
jumper harness.
ISSUE Some customers of 2008-2011 SYNC equipped vehicles may express concern with their
call sound quality while using the SYNC microphone, complaints of excessive background noise
during a phone call and/or issues with voice recognition accuracy while driving.
ACTION Follow the service procedure to correct the condition.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT102512 Claim Diagnosis And Labor Actual
Performed As Actual Time. Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
17700 42
Disclaimer
Service Procedure
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cellular Phone Microphone: > 10-25-12 > Dec
> 10 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Audio Quality > Page 6361
The following procedure involves updating the Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
software level and installing an external alternate SYNC microphone attached to the headliner.
NOTE
THIS PROCEDURE DOES NOT APPLY TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH HEADLINER
MICROPHONE OR DEALER-INSTALLED SYNC SYSTEMS.
Go to Step 2 if the vehicle is already equipped with SYNC 3.0 Traffic and Directions or has already
been upgraded to latest available consumer interface processor (CIP) level 9L3T-14D544-AE
without E911/VHR, 9L2T-14D544-BE with E911/VHR or later versions. To determine the current
APIM software level, Refer to the Professional Technician Society (PTS) website, enter the VIN in
OASIS, click the GO button and select the SYNC button.
1. Reprogram the APIM to CIP software level 9L3T-1 4D544-AE without E9 11 /VHR,
9L2T-14D544-BE with E911/VHR or later version. For
additional information Refer to other SYNC TSB's and WSM, Section 418-01. Service Pack files
may also be obtained at www.syncmyride.com.
When diagnosing a concern related to voice recognition (VR) difficulties, instruct the customer to
test VR functionality while the vehicle is parked. If customer concerns are still present, this
procedure will not yield an improvement and the service procedure should not be performed.
Instead, refer to the SYNC supplement guide and www.syncmyride.com for additional VR tips to
assist customer.
The VR experience can be improved with user training and making improvements to the phone
book entries (longer entries make the system more robust). Ensure the customer does not try to
speak too loud or slow and remove any objects hanging on the rear view mirror as this will reduce
system effectiveness.
When diagnosing a concern related to call sound quality, expect marginal improvements for calls
described as speaking in a tunnel, chamber, etc. Expect substantial improvements for complaints
where the call audio seems to drop out intermittently.
NOTE
THIS REPAIR WILL CHANGE THE APPEARANCE OF THE VEHICLE INTERIOR. REFER TO
THE PHOTOGRAPHS FOR THE APPLICABLE VEHICLE LOCATED IN THIS PROCEDURE. DO
NOT PERFORM THIS REPAIR WITHOUT CUSTOMER APPROVAL PRIOR TO PROCEEDING
WITH MICROPHONE INSTALLATION.
2. Install SYNC microphone service kit. Installing the kit includes mounting an external microphone
directly to the headliner and splicing in a jumper
harness to the vehicle's existing wiring harness. The existing SYNC microphone will no longer be
functional. The jumper harness is equipped with a voltage filter. The filter will need to be wrapped
in soft foam 164-R4901 or flock tape 164-R4903 from the Rotunda squeak and rattle kit 164-R4900
to prevent interior squeak/rattle noise.
a. Refer to the appropriate vehicle line and microphone illustration(s) below for microphone
installation and wire splicing locations. Refer to
Wiring Diagram (WD), Section 5-1 for recommended splicing methods.
b. Ensure the SYNC microphone wires are secure and do not interfere with vehicle operation or
functionality.
c. The microphone is directional. Make sure the microphone is always positioned so wire length is
minimized from view. When installing the
microphone adjacent to trim, place the microphone as close to trim as possible to help minimize
visible wire.
Edge / MKX
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 1)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cellular Phone Microphone: > 10-25-12 > Dec
> 10 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Audio Quality > Page 6362
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 501-12 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable up through existing hole in the headliner and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connectors 210 and 211 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124 for
links to location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13, RMM13 and DMM13 (shield) from C211. Cut the three circuits on the
female side of the connector (14334 harness).
These are the microphone positive, negative and shield circuits. Then splice the yellow jumper
harness wire to VMM13 and any two of the three black jumper harness wires to RMM13 and
DMM13 (shield). Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off
and secure the cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
7. Identify circuits CBP41 and GD133 from C210. This is power and ground for both the new
microphone and the existing mirror. Splice in the blue
jumper harness wire to CBP41 and the remaining black jumper harness wire to GD133. Ensure
that the original circuits remain intact and connected as this is power for other items within the rear
view mirror and in the roof.
8. Do not plug in the microphone at this time, proceed to Final Test / Service Steps.
Escape / Mariner
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration (Figures 2 and 3). Firmly
press the microphone into place. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead
console trim (if equipped) or positioned directly above A-pillar on headliner if not equipped with an
overhead console. Proceed to Step 5 if not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner to
run microphone cable.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cellular Phone Microphone: > 10-25-12 > Dec
> 10 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Audio Quality > Page 6363
5. Gain access to connector 214 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13, RMM13 and DMM13 (shield) from C214. Cut the three circuits on the
female side of the connector (14334 harness).
These are the microphone positive, negative and shield circuits. Then splice the yellow jumper
harness wire to VMM13 and any two of the three black jumper harness wires to RMM13 and
DMM13 (shield). Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off
and secure the cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
7. Identify circuits CBP41 and GD182 from C214. This is power and ground for both the new
microphone and the existing mirror. Splice in the blue
jumper harness wire to CBP41 and the remaining black jumper harness wire to GD1 82. Ensure
that the original circuits remain intact and connected as this is power for other items within the rear
view mirror and in the roof.
8. Do not plug in the microphone at this time, proceed to Final Test / Service Steps.
Navigator / Expedition
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figures 4 and 5)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim (if equipped) or
positioned directly above A-pillar on headliner if not equipped with an overhead console.
^ Proceed to Step 5 if not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 501-12 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 298 located behind the dash panel on passenger side. Refer to online
WD, Section 124 for links to location and connector
views.
6. Identify circuits VMN07, RMNO7 and DMN07 (shield) from C298. Cut the three circuits on the
female side of the connector (17C712 harness).
These are the microphone positive, negative and shield circuits. Then splice the yellow jumper
harness wire to VMNO7 and any two (of the three) black jumper harness wires to RMNO7 and
DMNO7 (shield). Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off
and secure the cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
7. Identify circuits CBP41 and GD133 from C298. This is power and ground for both the new
microphone and the existing mirror. Splice in the blue
jumper harness wire to CBP41 and the remaining black jumper harness wire to GD133. Ensure
that the original circuits remain intact and connected as this is power for other items within the rear
view mirror and in the roof.
8. Do not plug in the microphone at this time, proceed to Final Test / Service Steps.
Explorer / Explorer Sport Trac / Mountaineer
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 6)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cellular Phone Microphone: > 10-25-12 > Dec
> 10 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Audio Quality > Page 6364
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 501-12 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner to
run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 248 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMNO7, RMNO7 and DMNO7 (shield) from C248 (Sport Trac uses C260). Cut
the three circuits on the female side of the
connector (14334 harness). These are the microphone positive, negative and shield circuits. Then
splice the yellow jumper harness wire to VMNO7 and any two (of the three) black jumper harness
wires to RMNO7 and DMNO7 (shield). Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the
connector. Tape off and secure the cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer
used.
7. Identify circuits CBPO5 and GD143 from C248. This is power and ground for both the new
microphone and the existing mirror. Splice in the blue
jumper harness wire to CBPO5 and the remaining black jumper harness wire to GD143. Ensure
that the original circuits remain intact and connected as this is power for other items within the rear
view mirror and in the roof.
8. Do not plug in the microphone at this time, proceed to Final Test / Service Steps.
F-150
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 7)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim or front lamp.
2. Lower the overhead console or front lamp. Refer to WSM, Section 501-12 for additional
information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner and temporarily tuck excess wire
into headliner to the rear of the console or lamp.
4. Install overhead console or front lamp; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console or
front lamp trim directly behind microphone as
shown.
5. Gain access to connectors 314 and 315 in roof panel near left hand side. Refer to online WD,
Section 124 for links to location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13, RMM13 and DMM13 (shield) from C314. Cut the three circuits on the
female side of the connector (14358 harness).
These are the microphone positive, negative and shield circuits. Then splice the yellow jumper
harness wire to VMM13 and any two (of the three) black jumper harness wires to RMM13 and
DMM13 (shield). Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off
and secure the cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
7. Identify circuits CBP41 from C315 and GD133 from C314. This is power and ground for both the
new microphone and the existing mirror. Splice in
the blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 and the remaining black jumper harness wire to GD133.
Ensure that the original circuits remain intact and connected as this is power for other items within
the rear view mirror and in the roof.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cellular Phone Microphone: > 10-25-12 > Dec
> 10 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Audio Quality > Page 6365
8. Do not plug in the microphone at this time, proceed to Final Test / Service Steps.
F-Super Duty
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 8)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
c. This repair is not recommended for vehicles not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 501-12 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 264 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13, RMM13 and DMM13 (shield) from C264. Cut the three circuits on the
female side of the connector (17K745 harness).
These are the microphone positive, negative and shield circuits. Then splice the yellow jumper
harness wire to VMM13 and any two (of the three) black jumper harness wires to RMM13 and
DMM13 (shield). Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off
and secure the cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used
7. Identify circuits CBP41 and GD133 from C264. This is power and ground for both the new
microphone and the existing mirror. Splice in the blue
jumper harness wire to CBP41 and the remaining black jumper harness wire to GD133. Ensure
that the original circuits remain intact and connected as this is power for other items within the rear
view mirror and in the roof.
8. Do not plug in the microphone at this time, proceed to Final Test / Service Steps.
Flex
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cellular Phone Microphone: > 10-25-12 > Dec
> 10 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Audio Quality > Page 6366
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 9)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 501-12 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 925 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13, RMM13 and DMM13 (shield) from C925. Cut the three circuits on the
female side of the connector (14334 harness).
These are the microphone positive, negative and shield circuits. Then splice the yellow jumper
harness wire to VMM13 and any two (of the three) black jumper harness wires to RMM13 and
DMM13 (shield). Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off
and secure the cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
7. Identify circuits CBP41 and GD133 from C925. This is power and ground for both the new
microphone and the existing mirror. Splice in the blue
jumper harness wire to CBP41 and the remaining black jumper harness wire to GD133. Ensure
that the original circuits remain intact and connected as this is power for other items within the rear
view mirror and in the roof.
8. Do not plug in the microphone at this time, proceed to Final Test / Service Steps.
Focus
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 10) Firmly press
the microphone into place. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to the interior lamp trim.
2. Lower the interior lamp assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cellular Phone Microphone: > 10-25-12 > Dec
> 10 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Audio Quality > Page 6367
3. Route microphone cable up through existing hole in the headliner and over to the passenger
side A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop
headliner to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install interior lamp assembly; ensure microphone cable enters the interior lamp trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 934 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD for location and connector
views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13, RMM13 and DMM13 (shield) from C934. Cut the three circuits on the
female side of the connector (14334 harness).
These are the microphone positive, negative and shield circuits. Then splice the yellow jumper
harness wire to VMM13 and any two (of the three) black jumper harness wires to RMM13 and
DMM13 (shield). Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off
and secure the cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
7. Identify circuits CPL6O and GD161 from C934. This is power and ground for both the new
microphone and the existing mirror. Splice in the blue
jumper harness wire to CPL6O and the remaining black jumper harness wire to GD161. Ensure
that the original circuits remain intact and connected as this is power for other items within the rear
view mirror and in the roof.
8. Do not plug in the microphone at this time, proceed to Final Test / Service Steps.
Fusion / Milan / MKZ
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 11)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 501-12 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 913 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13, RMM13 and DMM13 (shield) from C913. Cut the three circuits on the
female side of the connector (14334 harness).
These are the microphone positive, negative and shield circuits. Then splice the yellow jumper
harness wire to VMM13 and any two (of the three) black jumper harness wires to RMM13 and
DMM13 (shield). Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off
and secure the cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
7. Identify circuits CBPO2 and GD139 from C913. This is power and ground for both the new
microphone and the existing mirror. Splice in the blue
jumper harness wire to CBPO2 and the remaining black jumper harness wire to GD139. Ensure
that the original circuits remain intact and connected as this is power for other items within the rear
view mirror and in the roof.
8. Do not plug in the microphone at this time proceed to Final Test / Service Steps.
Taurus / Sable / Taurus X
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cellular Phone Microphone: > 10-25-12 > Dec
> 10 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Audio Quality > Page 6368
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 12)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 501-12 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner to
run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 925 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMN02, RMN02 and DMN07 (shield) from C925. Cut the three circuits on the
female side of the connector (17K745 harness).
These are the microphone positive, negative and shield circuits. Then splice the yellow jumper
harness wire to VMN02 and any two (of the three) black jumper harness wires to RMN02 and
DMNO7 (shield). Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off
and secure the cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
7. Identify circuits CBP41 and GD133 from C925. This is power and ground for both the new
microphone and the existing mirror. Splice in the blue
jumper harness wire to CBP41 and the remaining black jumper harness wire to GD133. Ensure
that the original circuits remain intact and connected as this is power for other items within the rear
view mirror and in the roof.
8. Do not plug in the microphone at this time, proceed to Final Test I Service Steps.
MKS
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 13)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cellular Phone Microphone: > 10-25-12 > Dec
> 10 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Audio Quality > Page 6369
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 501-12 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner and out the front of the headliner
above the rear view mirror.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 911 at the rear view mirror. Refer to the online WD, Section 124 for
links to location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMN02, RMNO2 and DMN07 (shield) from C911. Pull back the black harness
sleeve and cut the three circuits near C911 or if
equipped with a headlamp control module-2 (HCM-2), remove the HCM-2 access cover and cut
circuits under trim cover. Refer to WSM Section 417-01 for additional information. These are the
microphone positive, negative and shield circuits. Then splice the yellow jumper harness wire to
VMNO2 and remaining black jumper harness wires to RMNO2 and DMNO7 (shield). Only splice
into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the cut wire ends
heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
7. Identify circuits CBP41 and GD133 from C911. This is power and ground for both the new
microphone and the existing mirror. Splice in the blue
jumper harness wire to CBP41 and the remaining black jumper harness wire to GD133. Ensure
that the original circuits remain intact and connected as this is power for other items within the rear
view mirror and in the roof.
8. Do not plug in the microphone at this time, proceed to Final Test I Service Steps.
Final Test / Service Steps
1. After splicing/soldering is complete, apply power to the vehicle and confirm the voltage at the
jumper inline connector before connecting the
microphone.
^ Jumper blue wire equal 12V positive.
^ Jumper black wire equal ground reference.
^ Jumper yellow wire equal microphone return signal circuit less than IV.
2. Turn off ignition and attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector. Make
sure that the connector tabs have locked together after
connecting. Reversing this connector would cause a failure of the microphone.
3. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cellular Phone Microphone: > 09-13-5 > Jul >
09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality
Cellular Phone Microphone: Customer Interest SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality
TSB 09-13-5
07/13/09
SYNC - CALL SOUND QUALITY/BACKGROUND NOISE ISSUES AND/OR VOICE
RECOGNITION DIFFICULTIES WHILE DRIVING
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape Hybrid, Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner Hybrid, Mariner
ISSUE Some customers of 2008-2009 SYNC equipped vehicles may express concern with their
call sound quality while using the SYNC microphone, complaints of excessive background noise
during a phone call, and/or issues with voice recognition accuracy while driving.
ACTION Follow the service procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The following service procedure involves updating the Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
software level and installing an external alternate SYNC microphone attached to the headliner.
NOTE
THIS PROCEDURE DOES NOT APPLY TO DEALER-INSTALLED SYNC SYSTEMS.
Do not perform Step 1 if vehicle is already equipped with SYNC 2.0 (911 and Vehicle Health
Report) or has been upgraded to consumer interface processor (CIP) level 9L3T-14D544-AE. To
determine the current APIM software level, Refer to the Professional Technician Society (PTS)
website, enter the VIN in OASIS, click the GO button, and select the SYNC button.
1. Reprogram the APIM to CIP software level 9L3T-14D544-AE. For additional information Refer to
other SYNC TSB's and WSM, Section 418-01.
Service Pack files may also be obtained at www.syncmyride.com.
When diagnosing a concern related to voice recognition (VR) difficulties, instruct the customer to
test VR functionality while the vehicle is parked. If customer concerns are still present, this
procedure will not yield an improvement, and the service procedure should not be performed.
Instead, Refer to the SYNC supplement guide and www.syncmyride.com for additional VR tips to
assist customer.
The VR experience can be improved with user training and making improvements to the phone
book entries (longer entries make the system more robust). Ensure the customer does not try to
speak too loud or slow and remove any objects hanging on the rear view mirror as this will reduce
system effectiveness.
When diagnosing a concern related to call sound quality, expect marginal improvements for calls
described as speaking in a tunnel, chamber, etc. Expect substantial improvements for complaints
where the call audio seems to drop out intermittently.
NOTE
THIS REPAIR WILL CHANGE THE APPEARANCE OF THE VEHICLE INTERIOR. REFER TO
THE PHOTOGRAPHS FOR THE APPLICABLE VEHICLE LOCATED IN THIS PROCEDURE. DO
NOT PERFORM THIS REPAIR WITHOUT CUSTOMER APPROVAL PRIOR TO PROCEEDING
WITH MICROPHONE INSTALLATION.
2. Install SYNC microphone service kit. Installing the kit includes mounting an external microphone
directly to the headliner and splicing in a jumper
harness to the vehicle's existing wiring harness. The existing SYNC microphone will no longer be
functional.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cellular Phone Microphone: > 09-13-5 > Jul >
09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6374
a. Refer to the appropriate vehicle line and microphone illustration(s) below for microphone
installation and wire splicing locations. Refer to
Wiring Diagram (WD), Section 5-1 for recommended splicing methods.
b. Ensure the SYNC microphone wires are secure and do not interfere with vehicle operation or
functionality.
c. The microphone is directional. Make sure the microphone is always positioned so wire length is
minimized from view. When installing the
microphone adjacent to trim, place microphone as close to trim as possible to help minimize visible
wire.
2008-2009 Edge / MKX
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 1)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable up through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connectors 210 and 211 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for
links to location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C211. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C210.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2009 Escape / Mariner
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cellular Phone Microphone: > 09-13-5 > Jul >
09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6375
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration (Figures 2 and 3). Firmly
press the microphone into place. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead
console trim (if equipped), or positioned directly above A-pillar on headliner if not equipped with an
overhead console. Proceed to Step 5 if not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner to
run microphone cable.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 214 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C214. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD182 (BK-GY) from C214.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD1 82 (BK-GY).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
9. Connect the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Navigator / 2009 Expedition
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cellular Phone Microphone: > 09-13-5 > Jul >
09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6376
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figures 4 and 5)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim (if equipped), or
positioned directly above A-pillar on headliner if not
equipped with an overhead console.
^ Proceed to Step 5 if not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 298 located behind the dash panel on passenger side. Refer to online
WD, Section 124-1 for links to location and connector
views.
6. Identify circuits VMN07 (GY), RMN07 (VT), and DMN07 (shield - BK) from C298. Cut the three
circuits on the male side of the connector
(17C712 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP31 (BU-OG) and GD133 (BK) from C298 (2008 Navigator only). Identify
circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C298
(2009 Expedition/Navigator only).
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP31 (BU-OG) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK)
for 2008 Navigator only. Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness
wire to GD133 (BK) for 2009 Expedition/Navigator only.
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cellular Phone Microphone: > 09-13-5 > Jul >
09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6377
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN07 (GY) and remaining black jumper harness wires to RMN07
(VT) and DMN07 (shield - BK).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Connect the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the headliner.
2008-2009 Explorer / Explorer Sport Trac / Mountaineer
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 6)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner run
microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 248 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify and cut circuits VMNO7 (GY), RMNO7 (VT), and DMNO7 (shield) from C248. Cut the
three circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP05 (YE) and GD143 (BK-VT) from C248.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP05 (YE) and any black jumper harness wire to GD143 (BK-VT).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN07 (GY) and remaining black jumper harness wires to RMN07
(VT) and DMN07 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2009 F-150
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cellular Phone Microphone: > 09-13-5 > Jul >
09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6378
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 7)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim or front lamp.
2. Lower the overhead console or front lamp. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional
information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and temporarily tuck excess wire
into headliner to the rear of the console or lamp.
4. Install overhead console or front lamp; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console or
front lamp trim directly behind microphone as
shown.
5. Gain access to connectors 314 and 315 in roof panel near left hand side. Refer to online WD,
Section 124-1 for links to location and connector
views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C314. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14358 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) from C315 and GD133 (BK) from C314.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the headliner.
2009 F-Super Duty
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cellular Phone Microphone: > 09-13-5 > Jul >
09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6379
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 8)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
c. This repair is not recommended for vehicles not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 264 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield - BK) from C264. Cut the
three circuits on the female side of the connector
(17K745 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C264.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield - BK).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Connect the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2009 Flex
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cellular Phone Microphone: > 09-13-5 > Jul >
09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6380
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 9)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 925 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C925. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector (14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C925.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Focus
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cellular Phone Microphone: > 09-13-5 > Jul >
09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6381
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration (Figure 10). Firmly press
the microphone into place. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to the dome lamp trim.
2. Lower the dome lamp assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable up through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger
side A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop
headliner to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install dome lamp assembly; ensure microphone cable enters the dome lamp trim directly behind
microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 934 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD for location and connector
views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C934. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CPL60 (BN-YE) and GD161 (BK-YE) from C934.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CPL60 (BN-YE) and any black jumper harness wire to GD161
(BK-YE).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Fusion / Milan / MKZ
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cellular Phone Microphone: > 09-13-5 > Jul >
09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6382
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 11)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 913 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C913. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP02 (GN) and GD139 (BK-YE) from C913.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP02 (GN) and any black jumper harness wire to GD139 (BK-YE).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Taurus / Sable / Taurus X
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 12)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner to
run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cellular Phone Microphone: > 09-13-5 > Jul >
09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6383
5. Gain access to connector 925 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMN02 (WH-BN), RMN02 (VT-BN), and DMN07 (shield) from C925. Cut the
three circuits on the female side of the connector
(17K745 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C925.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN02 (WH-BN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMN02 (VT-BN) and DMN07 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2009 MKS
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 13)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and out the front of the headliner
above the rear view mirror.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 911 at the rear view mirror. Refer to the online WD, Section 124-1 for
links to location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMNO2 (WH-BN), RMN02 (VT-BN), and DMN07 (shield) from C911. Pull back
the black harness sleeve and cut the three
circuits near C91 1 or if equipped with a headlamp control module-2 (HCM-2), remove the HCM-2
access cover and cut circuits under trim cover. Refer to WSM, Section 417-01 for additional
information.
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C911.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Cellular Phone Microphone >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Cellular Phone Microphone: > 09-13-5 > Jul >
09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6384
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN02 (WH-BN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMN02 (VT-BN) and DMN07 (shield).
^ Only splice into the wires heading away from the connector. The wires heading into the connector
(mirror) are no longer used.
^ Ensure the wiring is neatly routed from the splice locations into the headliner, following the
existing wire harness routing from mirror to headliner.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 08-21-2
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT091305 Claim Diagnosis And Labor Actual
Performed As Actual Time. Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
17700 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Communications Control Module: > 10-2-8 >
Feb > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Defaults To 'Privacy Mode'
Communications Control Module: Customer Interest SYNC(R) System - Defaults To 'Privacy Mode'
TSB 10-2-8
02/15/10
SYNC SYSTEM DEFAULTS TO OR STAYS IN PRIVACY MODE, MULTIPLE VEHICLE LINES
FORD: 2008-2009 Taurus X 2008-2010 Focus, Fusion, Mustang, Taurus, Edge, Escape,
Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer, F-150, F-250, F-350, F-450 2009-2010 Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2010 MKZ 2009-2010 MKS 2008 Mark LT 2008-2010 MKX, Navigator 2010 MKT
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable 2008-2010 Milan, Mariner, Mountaineer
ISSUE Some customers of 2008-2010 SYNC-equipped vehicles may express concern with their
SYNC paired device defaulting, switching or staying on privacy mode. The customer may not be
able to accept the call through the SYNC system or must answer the call manually on their
personal device.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Set the Privacy mode to Off on the device and recheck Sync operation.
2. If necessary, test the device on another vehicle with the same version SYNC. If the concern is
still present, the device is the concern. Continue with
normal WSM Diagnostics.
NOTE
PRIVACY MODE MEANS THAT THE PHONE IS CONTROLLING THE AUDIO. SYNC ONLY
MAKES REQUESTS TO THE PHONE TO TRANSFER THIS RESPONSIBILITY OR AUDIO TO
SYNC. IF THE PHONE DOES NOT ACCEPT THIS REQUEST OR THERE IS A PROBLEM IN
THE COMMUNICATION TO MAKE THIS HAPPEN, YOU ARE BY DEFAULT IN PRIVACY MODE.
WARRANTY STATUS: Information Only
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Communications Control Module: > 09-26-8 >
Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns
Communications Control Module: Customer Interest SYNC(R) System - Software Update For
Various Concerns
TSB 09-26-8
01/04/10
SYNC SOFTWARE UPDATE - VARIOUS ISSUES
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 9-22-14 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2008 and 2009 SYNC® equipped vehicles may exhibit one or more of the following
symptoms:
^ Universal Serial Bus (USB) port inoperative.
^ USB audio muting when using various non-Apple USB devices.
^ Phone book access difficulty on certain 2-digit phone book entries when using voice commands.
^ Excessive background noise and/or poor voice sound quality.
^ Phone book auto download inoperative on supported devices.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative intermittently.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Reprogram the accessory protocol inter[ace module (APIM) to the following consumer inter[ace
processor (CIP) software levels.
^ 9L3T-14D544-AE (vehicles not equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health Report)
^ 9L2T-14D544-BE (vehicles already equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health
Report)
Service Pack files may be obtained at www.syncmyride.com.
Reprogram the APIM
Contains software fix updates for the following:
^ Phone book auto download inoperative.
^ USB audio muting.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative.
^ Voice recognition on 2-digit entries.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Communications Control Module: > 09-26-8 >
Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns > Page 6397
^ USB port inoperative with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B1342.
^ Poor call sound quality.
This software update also contains enhancements that will improve the reliability of both Bluetooth
and USB connections to SYNC(R) from various consumer devices, and microphone enhancements
to reduce background noise, and will default Vehicle Health Report (if equipped) to off. The
Bluetooth enhancements improve the stability of hands-free calls, call waiting, caller ID, multiple
call handling and other mobile phone features. The USB enhancements improve support for media
players and the playing of file formats and podcasts.
NOTE
REFERENCE OTHER TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETINS (TSB) FOR ADDITIONAL SYNC
SOFTWARE PROGRAMMING TIPS.
1. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
2. Connect the VCM to the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) tool or laptop running IDS software.
3. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
4. Launch IDS tool.
5. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
6. Close the IDS tool.
7. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN & DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO button.
8. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
9. Press read APIM button.
10. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
11. Program both processors in the APIM (Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and CIP).
NOTE
DO NOT USE A MALE-TO-MALE USB DATA TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
a. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software and
to the vehicle USB port.
b. Follow the on-screen instructions to program both processors on the Sync module (VIP and
CIP).
12. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
13. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 08-21-02
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092608A 2008-2009 Edge, Explorer, 0.4 Hr.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Communications Control Module: > 09-26-8 >
Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns > Page 6398
Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac, Focus, Fusion, Milan, MKX, MKZ, Sable, Navigator, Taurus,
Taurus X, 2009 Expedition, Escape, Escape Hybrid, Mariner, Mariner Hybrid, F-150, F-Super Duty,
Flex, MKS: Reprogram The APIM (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Communications Control Module: > 09-14-3 >
Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set
Communications Control Module: Customer Interest SYNC(R) System - Functions
Inoperative/DTC's Set
TSB 09-14-3
07/27/09
SYNC FUNCTIONS INOPERATIVE, DTC U3000-41, U0485, OR U0100, AND/OR BATTERY
DRAW WITH ACCESSORY PROTOCOL INTERFACE MODULE CONNECTED
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Taurus X, Taurus 2008-2010 Fusion 2010 Mustang 2008-2009 Edge,
Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009 Escape Hybrid, Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 Zephyr 2008-2010 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable 2008-2010 Milan 2008-2009 Mountaineer 2009 Mariner Hybrid,
Mariner
ISSUE Some 2008-2010 vehicles equipped with SYNC version 2 software level, SYNC 911 Assist
and Vehicle Health Report, may exhibit all or most of the following symptoms:
^ Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC) U3000-41, U0485, or U0100 in Accessory Protocol Interface
Module (APIM)
^ SYNC display menus/options blank
^ USB port inoperative
^ No SYNC Blue Tooth device connectivity
^ Voice/Phone/OK steering wheel controls inoperative
^ Lack of APIM communication
^ Parasitic battery draw with APIM connected
These symptoms may be triggered by a low battery state of charge, or a recent battery
disconnect/reconnect.
ACTION Follow the service procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
This software upgrade only applies to the following Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and Customer Interface Processor (CIP) software levels:
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AC / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BC
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AD / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BD
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AE / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BD
To determine the current APIM software level, reference the Professional Technician Society (PTS)
website, enter the VIN in OASIS, click the GO
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Communications Control Module: > 09-14-3 >
Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set > Page 6403
button and select the SYNC button.
1. Determine if communication can be established with the APIM using IDS.
a. If communication cannot be verified, proceed to Step 2.
b. If communication is present, proceed to Step 3.
2. Reference Workshop Manual, Section 418-00, Module Communication Network to determine if
communication can be established. If not, perform
an APIM power reset by disconnecting and reconnecting the vehicle battery.
a. If communication is now present, proceed to Step 3.
b. If communication still cannot be established, replace the APIM.
3. Reprogram the APIM to VIP software level 9L2T-14D205-AF by following the Service Procedure.
NOTE
SOFTWARE IS AVAILABLE ONLY THROUGH THE PTS WEBSITE, AND NOT AVAILABLE
THROUGH THE SYNCMYRIDE.COM WEBSITE.
NOTE
CONFIGURATION AND PROGRAMMING REQUIRES THE USE OF A SPECIAL PTS
APPLICATION. INSTALLER MUST HAVE ACCESS TO PTS AND HAVE A VALID PTS USER ID
AND PASSWORD.
a. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
b. Connect the VCM to the IDS tool or laptop running IDS software.
c. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
d. Launch IDS tool.
e. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
f. Close the IDS tool.
g. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN And DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO
button.
h. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
i. Press read APIM button.
j. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMU5B2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT USE A TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
k. Program the processor in the APIM.
l. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMU5B2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software, and to the vehicle USB port.
m. Follow the on-screen instructions to program the VIP module.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Communications Control Module: > 09-14-3 >
Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set > Page 6404
n. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
o. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT091403 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Communications Control Module:
> 10-2-8 > Feb > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Defaults To 'Privacy Mode'
Communications Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins SYNC(R) System - Defaults To
'Privacy Mode'
TSB 10-2-8
02/15/10
SYNC SYSTEM DEFAULTS TO OR STAYS IN PRIVACY MODE, MULTIPLE VEHICLE LINES
FORD: 2008-2009 Taurus X 2008-2010 Focus, Fusion, Mustang, Taurus, Edge, Escape,
Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer, F-150, F-250, F-350, F-450 2009-2010 Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2010 MKZ 2009-2010 MKS 2008 Mark LT 2008-2010 MKX, Navigator 2010 MKT
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable 2008-2010 Milan, Mariner, Mountaineer
ISSUE Some customers of 2008-2010 SYNC-equipped vehicles may express concern with their
SYNC paired device defaulting, switching or staying on privacy mode. The customer may not be
able to accept the call through the SYNC system or must answer the call manually on their
personal device.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Set the Privacy mode to Off on the device and recheck Sync operation.
2. If necessary, test the device on another vehicle with the same version SYNC. If the concern is
still present, the device is the concern. Continue with
normal WSM Diagnostics.
NOTE
PRIVACY MODE MEANS THAT THE PHONE IS CONTROLLING THE AUDIO. SYNC ONLY
MAKES REQUESTS TO THE PHONE TO TRANSFER THIS RESPONSIBILITY OR AUDIO TO
SYNC. IF THE PHONE DOES NOT ACCEPT THIS REQUEST OR THERE IS A PROBLEM IN
THE COMMUNICATION TO MAKE THIS HAPPEN, YOU ARE BY DEFAULT IN PRIVACY MODE.
WARRANTY STATUS: Information Only
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Communications Control Module:
> 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns
Communications Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins SYNC(R) System - Software
Update For Various Concerns
TSB 09-26-8
01/04/10
SYNC SOFTWARE UPDATE - VARIOUS ISSUES
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 9-22-14 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2008 and 2009 SYNC® equipped vehicles may exhibit one or more of the following
symptoms:
^ Universal Serial Bus (USB) port inoperative.
^ USB audio muting when using various non-Apple USB devices.
^ Phone book access difficulty on certain 2-digit phone book entries when using voice commands.
^ Excessive background noise and/or poor voice sound quality.
^ Phone book auto download inoperative on supported devices.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative intermittently.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Reprogram the accessory protocol inter[ace module (APIM) to the following consumer inter[ace
processor (CIP) software levels.
^ 9L3T-14D544-AE (vehicles not equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health Report)
^ 9L2T-14D544-BE (vehicles already equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health
Report)
Service Pack files may be obtained at www.syncmyride.com.
Reprogram the APIM
Contains software fix updates for the following:
^ Phone book auto download inoperative.
^ USB audio muting.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative.
^ Voice recognition on 2-digit entries.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Communications Control Module:
> 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns > Page 6414
^ USB port inoperative with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B1342.
^ Poor call sound quality.
This software update also contains enhancements that will improve the reliability of both Bluetooth
and USB connections to SYNC(R) from various consumer devices, and microphone enhancements
to reduce background noise, and will default Vehicle Health Report (if equipped) to off. The
Bluetooth enhancements improve the stability of hands-free calls, call waiting, caller ID, multiple
call handling and other mobile phone features. The USB enhancements improve support for media
players and the playing of file formats and podcasts.
NOTE
REFERENCE OTHER TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETINS (TSB) FOR ADDITIONAL SYNC
SOFTWARE PROGRAMMING TIPS.
1. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
2. Connect the VCM to the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) tool or laptop running IDS software.
3. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
4. Launch IDS tool.
5. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
6. Close the IDS tool.
7. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN & DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO button.
8. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
9. Press read APIM button.
10. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
11. Program both processors in the APIM (Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and CIP).
NOTE
DO NOT USE A MALE-TO-MALE USB DATA TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
a. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software and
to the vehicle USB port.
b. Follow the on-screen instructions to program both processors on the Sync module (VIP and
CIP).
12. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
13. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 08-21-02
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092608A 2008-2009 Edge, Explorer, 0.4 Hr.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Communications Control Module:
> 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns > Page 6415
Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac, Focus, Fusion, Milan, MKX, MKZ, Sable, Navigator, Taurus,
Taurus X, 2009 Expedition, Escape, Escape Hybrid, Mariner, Mariner Hybrid, F-150, F-Super Duty,
Flex, MKS: Reprogram The APIM (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Communications Control Module:
> 09-14-3 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set
Communications Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins SYNC(R) System - Functions
Inoperative/DTC's Set
TSB 09-14-3
07/27/09
SYNC FUNCTIONS INOPERATIVE, DTC U3000-41, U0485, OR U0100, AND/OR BATTERY
DRAW WITH ACCESSORY PROTOCOL INTERFACE MODULE CONNECTED
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Taurus X, Taurus 2008-2010 Fusion 2010 Mustang 2008-2009 Edge,
Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009 Escape Hybrid, Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 Zephyr 2008-2010 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable 2008-2010 Milan 2008-2009 Mountaineer 2009 Mariner Hybrid,
Mariner
ISSUE Some 2008-2010 vehicles equipped with SYNC version 2 software level, SYNC 911 Assist
and Vehicle Health Report, may exhibit all or most of the following symptoms:
^ Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC) U3000-41, U0485, or U0100 in Accessory Protocol Interface
Module (APIM)
^ SYNC display menus/options blank
^ USB port inoperative
^ No SYNC Blue Tooth device connectivity
^ Voice/Phone/OK steering wheel controls inoperative
^ Lack of APIM communication
^ Parasitic battery draw with APIM connected
These symptoms may be triggered by a low battery state of charge, or a recent battery
disconnect/reconnect.
ACTION Follow the service procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
This software upgrade only applies to the following Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and Customer Interface Processor (CIP) software levels:
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AC / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BC
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AD / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BD
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AE / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BD
To determine the current APIM software level, reference the Professional Technician Society (PTS)
website, enter the VIN in OASIS, click the GO
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Communications Control Module:
> 09-14-3 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set > Page 6420
button and select the SYNC button.
1. Determine if communication can be established with the APIM using IDS.
a. If communication cannot be verified, proceed to Step 2.
b. If communication is present, proceed to Step 3.
2. Reference Workshop Manual, Section 418-00, Module Communication Network to determine if
communication can be established. If not, perform
an APIM power reset by disconnecting and reconnecting the vehicle battery.
a. If communication is now present, proceed to Step 3.
b. If communication still cannot be established, replace the APIM.
3. Reprogram the APIM to VIP software level 9L2T-14D205-AF by following the Service Procedure.
NOTE
SOFTWARE IS AVAILABLE ONLY THROUGH THE PTS WEBSITE, AND NOT AVAILABLE
THROUGH THE SYNCMYRIDE.COM WEBSITE.
NOTE
CONFIGURATION AND PROGRAMMING REQUIRES THE USE OF A SPECIAL PTS
APPLICATION. INSTALLER MUST HAVE ACCESS TO PTS AND HAVE A VALID PTS USER ID
AND PASSWORD.
a. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
b. Connect the VCM to the IDS tool or laptop running IDS software.
c. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
d. Launch IDS tool.
e. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
f. Close the IDS tool.
g. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN And DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO
button.
h. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
i. Press read APIM button.
j. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMU5B2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT USE A TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
k. Program the processor in the APIM.
l. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMU5B2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software, and to the vehicle USB port.
m. Follow the on-screen instructions to program the VIP module.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Communications Control Module:
> 09-14-3 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set > Page 6421
n. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
o. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT091403 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Communications Control Module: Locations Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) > Page 6424
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) > Page 6425
Communications Control Module: Locations Audio Control Module (ACM)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) > Page 6426
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) > Page 6427
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Communications Control Module: Diagrams Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) > Page 6430
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) > Page 6431
Communications Control Module: Diagrams Audio Control Module (ACM)
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) > Page 6432
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) > Page 6433
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) > Page 6434
Communications Control Module: Diagrams Audio Digital Signal Processing (DSP) Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) > Page 6435
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) > Page 6436
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Communications Control Module: Procedures
Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) Software Level Check
Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) Software Level Check
NOTE: This procedure applies to checking the Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
software level. To program the APIM, refer to Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Programming in Information Bus. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Information Bus/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Accessory Protocol
Interface Module (APIM) Programming
1. Turn the Audio Control Module (ACM) on.
2. Connect the scan tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC).
3. Connect one end of the Universal Serial Bus (USB) male-A to male-A cable to the scan tool.
4. Connect the other end of the USB male-A to male-A cable to the vehicle USB port.
5. From the technician service publication website, run On-Line Automotive Service Information
System (OASIS) using Quick Start or by manually
entering the Vehicle Identification Number (VIN).
6. From the OASIS tab, select the "Sync/APIM" bullet.
7. Select the "Read APIM" button to verify the current APIM software level.
- The display shows both the Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and Consumer Interface Processor
(CIP) software levels.
8. The scan tool displays the following information:
- Last Recorded State - Hardware VIN: vehicle identification number associated with the current APIM
- Installed date: date the APIM was installed
- Radio: currently identified ACM in the vehicle
- HW Part No.: APIM hardware part number
- Un-installed date: date (if any) the APIM was uninstalled
- S/N: APIM serial number
- Last Recorded State - Software Date/Time: date and time of last recorded software installation
- VIP: VIP software that was installed at that time
- CIP: CIP software that was installed at that time
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6439
- Description: a description of the content of the software revision
- History - Software Date/Time: date and time of any recorded software installation
- VIP: VIP software that was installed at that time
- CIP: CIP software that was installed at that time
- Description: a description of the content of the software revision
- Available Software for Programming Select: allows the software package to be selected
- Lineage: the original software release, if the software available is a revision
- VIP: VIP software level that is available with the selection
- CIP: CIP software level that is available with the selection
- Description: a description of the content of the software revision
9. Click a CIP software level to view the device compatibility list associated with the CIP software
level, if desired.
10. To exit the APIM software level check, disconnect the scan tool from the DLC and the USB
port, or exit the OASIS screen.
Audio Control Module (ACM) Self-Diagnostic Mode
Audio Control Module (ACM) Self-Diagnostic Mode
Audio Systems Without Navigation
1. Turn the Audio Control Module (ACM) on.
2. Operate the audio system in radio tuner (AM/FM) mode.
3. Press and hold preset buttons 3 and 6 for 3 seconds until the speaker walk test begins.
- The display indicates each speaker as it is tested.
4. NOTE: If the speaker walk test is the only test required, this procedure can be stopped after Step
3 by turning the ACM off.
Before the speaker walk test is complete, carry out any of the following actions:
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6440
5. To exit the self-diagnostic mode, turn the ACM off.
Satellite Digital Audio Receiver System (SDARS) Module Electronic Serial Number (ESN) Retrieval
- Vehicles Without Navigation
1. Operate the audio system in satellite radio mode.
2. Press and hold the AUX button and preset button 1, simultaneously.
- The Satellite Digital Audio Receiver System (SDARS) module Electronic Serial Number (ESN)
displays on the screen.
3. Record the SDARS module ESN.
4. Turn the audio system off.
Audio Systems With Navigation
1. Turn the Audio Control Module (ACM) on.
2. Operate the audio system in radio tuner (AM/FM) mode.
3. Press and hold preset buttons 3 and 6 for 3 seconds until the speaker walk test begins.
- The display indicates each speaker as it is tested.
4. NOTE: If the speaker walk test is the only test required, this procedure can be stopped after this
step, or by allowing the speaker walk test to
complete on its own.
Before the speaker walk test is complete, press the "End Test" selection.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6441
5. The following tests are available through the "BEZEL DIAGNOSTICS" menu:
6. To exit the self-diagnostic mode, press the "Exit Diagnostics" selection from the "BEZEL
DIAGNOSTICS" menu.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6442
Communications Control Module: Removal and Replacement
Audio Digital Signal Processing (DSP) Module
Audio Digital Signal Processing (DSP) Module
Audio Digital Signal Processing (DSP) Module Lower Attachment
Audio DSP Module Upper Attachment
Audio DSP Module Removal Routing
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6443
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: Module configuration is required when a new audio Digital Signal Processing (DSP)
module is being installed.
Upload the audio DSP module configuration information to the scan tool.
2. Remove the Audio Control Module (ACM). For additional information, refer to Audio Control
Module (ACM) See: Audio Control Module
(ACM).
3. Remove the necessary attachments and move the center console 5 cm (2.0 in) towards the rear
of the vehicle.
4. Disconnect the audio DSP module electrical connectors.
5. Remove the 2 lower audio DSP module nuts.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
6. NOTICE: The audio Digital Signal Processing (DSP) module is heavy. Be sure to support the
amplifier during removal, or damage to the
vehicle may occur.
Remove the 2 upper audio DSP module nuts.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
7. Remove the audio DSP module.
- Route the audio DSP module down and towards the passenger side of the vehicle.
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Download the configuration information to the audio DSP module.
Audio Control Module (ACM)
Audio Control Module (ACM)
NOTE: Expedition without navigation shown, all others similar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6444
Removal and Installation
NOTE: It is not necessary to remove the Audio Control Module (ACM) to retrieve the part number.
For additional information, refer to Audio Control Module (ACM) Self-Diagnostic Mode See:
Procedures/Audio Control Module (ACM) Self-Diagnostic Mode.
1. NOTE: Module configuration is required when a new ACM is being installed.
Upload the ACM configuration information to the scan tool.
2. Remove the instrument panel center finish panel.
3. Remove the 4 screws and the ACM.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors and the antenna cable connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Download the configuration information to the ACM.
Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6445
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: It is necessary to record the current Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
software and hardware level when a new APIM is being
installed to make sure that the new component is the same version as the component being
replaced.
Retrieve and record the current APIM software and hardware level. For additional information, refer
to Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) Software Level Check See: Procedures/Accessory
Protocol Interface Module (APIM) Software Level Check.
2. Remove the front floor console.
3. Remove the 4 APIM screws and position the APIM aside.
4. Disconnect the Universal Serial Bus (USB) cable and the electrical connectors, and remove the
APIM.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- If a new APIM is being installed, program the APIM to the correct software level.
Universal Serial Bus (USB) Cable And Port
Universal Serial Bus (USB) Cable and Port
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the floor console.
2. Remove the rear cupholder trim panel by pulling straight upward to disengage the clips.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Communications Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6446
ERROR: undefined
OFFENDING COMMAND: ‘~
STACK:
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Parking Assist Control Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6451
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6452
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6453
Parking Assist Control Module: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6454
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6455
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6456
Parking Assist Control Module: Service and Repair
Parking Aid Module (PAM) - Expedition
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the Parking Aid Module (PAM) sub-harness from the body harness.
2. Remove the rear bumper cover.
3. Remove the 4 insulator-to-bumper cover nuts and the insulator from the bumper cover.
4. Disconnect the sub-harness from the PAM.
5. Remove the 2 PAM bracket bolts.
6. Remove the PAM bracket assembly.
7. Release the module tabs from the bracket and remove the module from the bracket.
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left > Page 6461
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left > Page 6462
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left > Page 6463
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left > Page 6464
Parking Assist Distance Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left > Page 6465
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left > Page 6466
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left > Page 6467
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left > Page 6468
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left > Page 6469
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left > Page 6470
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left > Page 6471
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor Front Outer Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor Front Outer Left > Page 6474
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor Front Outer Left > Page 6475
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor Front Outer Left > Page 6476
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor Front Outer Left > Page 6477
Parking Assist Distance Sensor: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor Front Outer Left > Page 6478
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor Front Outer Left > Page 6479
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor Front Outer Left > Page 6480
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Aid Sensor - Front
Parking Assist Distance Sensor: Service and Repair Parking Aid Sensor - Front
Parking Aid Sensor - Front
Sedan
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front bumper cover.
2. Disconnect the parking aid sensor electrical connectors.
3. NOTE: Press the retaining tabs to release the sensor(s).
Remove the parking aid sensor(s).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- NOTICE: Paint the new sensor(s) with base coat and one coat of clear. Excessive paint film
buildup may result in incorrect sensor operation.
Using the scan tool, verify that the parking aid sensor PIDs read no object present, and that the
parking aid sensor attenuation PIDs read between 0.8-1.6 ms. If the parking aid sensor attenuation
PIDs do not read between 0.8-1.6 ms, the paint is too thick on the sensor(s) and it will be
necessary to repaint the sensor(s) as required.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Aid Sensor - Front > Page 6483
Parking Assist Distance Sensor: Service and Repair Parking Aid Sensor - Rear
Parking Aid Sensor - Rear
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear bumper cover.
2. Disconnect the parking aid sensor electrical connectors.
3. NOTE: Press the retaining tabs to release the sensor(s).
Remove the parking aid sensor(s).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Using the scan tool, verify that the parking aid sensor PIDs read no object present, and that the
parking aid sensor attenuation PIDs read between 0.8-1.6 ms.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Warning Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Speaker Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Warning Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Speaker Front > Page 6488
Parking Assist Warning Indicator: Diagrams Parking Aid Speaker
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Warning Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6489
Parking Assist Warning Indicator: Service and Repair
Parking Aid Speaker - Expedition
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the LH quarter trim panel.
2. Remove the bolt and the speaker and bracket assembly.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems > Rear
Vision Camera > Component Information > Diagrams
Rear Vision Camera: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems > Rear
Vision Camera > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6493
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems > Rear
Vision Camera > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6494
Rear Vision Camera: Service and Repair
Video Camera
Expedition
Navigator
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel.
- Position the water shield aside.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems > Rear
Vision Camera > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6495
Expedition
2. Remove the 4 nuts and the license lamp housing.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. Squeeze release tabs and remove the video camera and bracket from the license lamp housing.
Navigator
4. Remove the liftgate parking lamps.
5. Remove the 6 nuts and the license plate housing.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
6. Remove the 2 screws and the video camera bracket.
All vehicles
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Locations
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6499
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6500
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Reset Procedure
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Reset Procedure
Oil Life Reset - Message Center Cluster
Message Center Configuration
Oil Life Reset - Message Center Cluster
NOTE: The oil life calculation is set at a maximum of approximately 12,000 km (7,500 miles) or 180
days.
NOTE: The XX's in the message center displays below represent a numeric value. For example,
the message center may display OIL LIFE = 80%.
1. Press and release the SETUP button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX%
HOLD RESET = NEW.
2. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the message center displays
OIL LIFE SET TO 100%.
3. Press and release the SETUP button to exit the procedure.
Oil Life Reset - Base Instrument Cluster (IC)
Message Center Configuration
Oil Life Reset - Base Instrument Cluster (IC)
NOTE: All message center functions are carried out using the single stem reset button in the
Instrument Cluster (IC).
NOTE: The oil life calculation is set at a maximum of approximately 12,000 km (7,500 miles) or 180
days.
NOTE: The XX's in the message center displays below represent a numeric value. For example,
the message center may display OIL LIFE = 80%.
1. Press and release the reset button to scroll through the information displays until the message
center displays HOLD RESET FOR SETUP MENU.
2. Press and hold the reset button for approximately 2 seconds until the message center displays
HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK.
3. Press and release the reset button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX% HOLD
RESET = NEW.
4. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the message center displays
OIL LIFE SET TO 100%.
5. Press and release the reset button to exit the procedure.
Oil Life Start Value - Message Center Cluster
Message Center Configuration
Oil Life Start Value - Message Center Cluster
NOTE: The oil life start value is used to increase or decrease the starting point of the oil life. The
value can be changed back to the maximum of approximately 12,000 km (7,500 miles) if the value
was previously changed or lowered by 10% increments down to 10%.
NOTE: The XX's in the message center displays below represent a numeric value. For example,
the message center may display OIL LIFE = 80%.
1. Press and release the SETUP button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX%
HOLD RESET = NEW.
2. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the message center displays
OIL LIFE SET TO 100%.
3. NOTE: The oil life start value can be lowered from 100% to 10% in 10% increments then the
value starts again at 100%.
Press the RESET button once for each 10% reduction below the default 100% until the message
center displays OIL LIFE SET TO XX%.
4. Press and release the SETUP button to exit the procedure.
Oil Life Start Value - Base Instrument Cluster (IC)
Message Center Configuration
Oil Life Start Value - Base Instrument Cluster (IC)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Reset Procedure > Page 6503
NOTE: All message center functions are carried out using the single stem reset button in the
Instrument Cluster (IC).
NOTE: The oil life start value is used to increase or decrease the starting point of the oil life. The
value can be changed back to the maximum of approximately 12,000 km (7,500 miles) if the value
was previously changed or lowered by 10% increments down to 10%.
1. Press and release the reset button to scroll through the information displays until the message
center displays HOLD RESET FOR SETUP MENU.
2. Press and hold the reset button for approximately 2 seconds until the message center displays
HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK.
3. Press and release the reset button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX% HOLD
RESET = NEW.
4. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the message center displays
OIL LIFE SET TO 100%.
5. Press the RESET button to lower 10% from the default 100% until the message center displays
OIL LIFE SET TO XX%.
6. NOTE: The oil life start value can be lowered from 100% to 10% in 10% increments then the
value starts again at 100%.
Repeat steps 2-5 for each desired 10% reduction.
7. Press and release the reset button to exit the procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Reset Procedure > Page 6504
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Removal and Replacement
Message Center Switch
Expedition
Navigator
Removal and Installation
Expedition
1. Pull the instrument panel center finish panel straight out to release the retaining clips.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Reset Procedure > Page 6505
Navigator
2. NOTE: The transmission selector lever bezel is held in place by 4 tabs that are located in the
shifter assembly.
Remove the transmission selector lever bezel.
3. Open the floor console compartment door and pull the floor console finish panel straight up to
release the retainer clips.
4. Remove the 2 screws and pull the instrument panel center finish panel straight out to release the
retainer clips.
- Position the instrument panel center finish panel aside.
All vehicles
5. Disconnect the electrical connectors.
6. Press the 4 retaining tabs and remove the message center switch from the center instrument
panel finish panel.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-14-3 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set
Emergency Contact Module: Customer Interest SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's
Set
TSB 09-14-3
07/27/09
SYNC FUNCTIONS INOPERATIVE, DTC U3000-41, U0485, OR U0100, AND/OR BATTERY
DRAW WITH ACCESSORY PROTOCOL INTERFACE MODULE CONNECTED
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Taurus X, Taurus 2008-2010 Fusion 2010 Mustang 2008-2009 Edge,
Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009 Escape Hybrid, Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 Zephyr 2008-2010 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable 2008-2010 Milan 2008-2009 Mountaineer 2009 Mariner Hybrid,
Mariner
ISSUE Some 2008-2010 vehicles equipped with SYNC version 2 software level, SYNC 911 Assist
and Vehicle Health Report, may exhibit all or most of the following symptoms:
^ Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC) U3000-41, U0485, or U0100 in Accessory Protocol Interface
Module (APIM)
^ SYNC display menus/options blank
^ USB port inoperative
^ No SYNC Blue Tooth device connectivity
^ Voice/Phone/OK steering wheel controls inoperative
^ Lack of APIM communication
^ Parasitic battery draw with APIM connected
These symptoms may be triggered by a low battery state of charge, or a recent battery
disconnect/reconnect.
ACTION Follow the service procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
This software upgrade only applies to the following Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and Customer Interface Processor (CIP) software levels:
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AC / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BC
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AD / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BD
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AE / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BD
To determine the current APIM software level, reference the Professional Technician Society (PTS)
website, enter the VIN in OASIS, click the GO
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-14-3 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set
> Page 6514
button and select the SYNC button.
1. Determine if communication can be established with the APIM using IDS.
a. If communication cannot be verified, proceed to Step 2.
b. If communication is present, proceed to Step 3.
2. Reference Workshop Manual, Section 418-00, Module Communication Network to determine if
communication can be established. If not, perform
an APIM power reset by disconnecting and reconnecting the vehicle battery.
a. If communication is now present, proceed to Step 3.
b. If communication still cannot be established, replace the APIM.
3. Reprogram the APIM to VIP software level 9L2T-14D205-AF by following the Service Procedure.
NOTE
SOFTWARE IS AVAILABLE ONLY THROUGH THE PTS WEBSITE, AND NOT AVAILABLE
THROUGH THE SYNCMYRIDE.COM WEBSITE.
NOTE
CONFIGURATION AND PROGRAMMING REQUIRES THE USE OF A SPECIAL PTS
APPLICATION. INSTALLER MUST HAVE ACCESS TO PTS AND HAVE A VALID PTS USER ID
AND PASSWORD.
a. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
b. Connect the VCM to the IDS tool or laptop running IDS software.
c. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
d. Launch IDS tool.
e. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
f. Close the IDS tool.
g. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN And DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO
button.
h. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
i. Press read APIM button.
j. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMU5B2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT USE A TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
k. Program the processor in the APIM.
l. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMU5B2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software, and to the vehicle USB port.
m. Follow the on-screen instructions to program the VIP module.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-14-3 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set
> Page 6515
n. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
o. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT091403 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality
Emergency Contact Module: Customer Interest SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality
TSB 09-13-5
07/13/09
SYNC - CALL SOUND QUALITY/BACKGROUND NOISE ISSUES AND/OR VOICE
RECOGNITION DIFFICULTIES WHILE DRIVING
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape Hybrid, Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner Hybrid, Mariner
ISSUE Some customers of 2008-2009 SYNC equipped vehicles may express concern with their
call sound quality while using the SYNC microphone, complaints of excessive background noise
during a phone call, and/or issues with voice recognition accuracy while driving.
ACTION Follow the service procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The following service procedure involves updating the Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
software level and installing an external alternate SYNC microphone attached to the headliner.
NOTE
THIS PROCEDURE DOES NOT APPLY TO DEALER-INSTALLED SYNC SYSTEMS.
Do not perform Step 1 if vehicle is already equipped with SYNC 2.0 (911 and Vehicle Health
Report) or has been upgraded to consumer interface processor (CIP) level 9L3T-14D544-AE. To
determine the current APIM software level, Refer to the Professional Technician Society (PTS)
website, enter the VIN in OASIS, click the GO button, and select the SYNC button.
1. Reprogram the APIM to CIP software level 9L3T-14D544-AE. For additional information Refer to
other SYNC TSB's and WSM, Section 418-01.
Service Pack files may also be obtained at www.syncmyride.com.
When diagnosing a concern related to voice recognition (VR) difficulties, instruct the customer to
test VR functionality while the vehicle is parked. If customer concerns are still present, this
procedure will not yield an improvement, and the service procedure should not be performed.
Instead, Refer to the SYNC supplement guide and www.syncmyride.com for additional VR tips to
assist customer.
The VR experience can be improved with user training and making improvements to the phone
book entries (longer entries make the system more robust). Ensure the customer does not try to
speak too loud or slow and remove any objects hanging on the rear view mirror as this will reduce
system effectiveness.
When diagnosing a concern related to call sound quality, expect marginal improvements for calls
described as speaking in a tunnel, chamber, etc. Expect substantial improvements for complaints
where the call audio seems to drop out intermittently.
NOTE
THIS REPAIR WILL CHANGE THE APPEARANCE OF THE VEHICLE INTERIOR. REFER TO
THE PHOTOGRAPHS FOR THE APPLICABLE VEHICLE LOCATED IN THIS PROCEDURE. DO
NOT PERFORM THIS REPAIR WITHOUT CUSTOMER APPROVAL PRIOR TO PROCEEDING
WITH MICROPHONE INSTALLATION.
2. Install SYNC microphone service kit. Installing the kit includes mounting an external microphone
directly to the headliner and splicing in a jumper
harness to the vehicle's existing wiring harness. The existing SYNC microphone will no longer be
functional.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality
> Page 6520
a. Refer to the appropriate vehicle line and microphone illustration(s) below for microphone
installation and wire splicing locations. Refer to
Wiring Diagram (WD), Section 5-1 for recommended splicing methods.
b. Ensure the SYNC microphone wires are secure and do not interfere with vehicle operation or
functionality.
c. The microphone is directional. Make sure the microphone is always positioned so wire length is
minimized from view. When installing the
microphone adjacent to trim, place microphone as close to trim as possible to help minimize visible
wire.
2008-2009 Edge / MKX
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 1)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable up through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connectors 210 and 211 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for
links to location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C211. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C210.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2009 Escape / Mariner
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality
> Page 6521
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration (Figures 2 and 3). Firmly
press the microphone into place. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead
console trim (if equipped), or positioned directly above A-pillar on headliner if not equipped with an
overhead console. Proceed to Step 5 if not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner to
run microphone cable.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 214 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C214. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD182 (BK-GY) from C214.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD1 82 (BK-GY).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
9. Connect the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Navigator / 2009 Expedition
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality
> Page 6522
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figures 4 and 5)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim (if equipped), or
positioned directly above A-pillar on headliner if not
equipped with an overhead console.
^ Proceed to Step 5 if not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 298 located behind the dash panel on passenger side. Refer to online
WD, Section 124-1 for links to location and connector
views.
6. Identify circuits VMN07 (GY), RMN07 (VT), and DMN07 (shield - BK) from C298. Cut the three
circuits on the male side of the connector
(17C712 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP31 (BU-OG) and GD133 (BK) from C298 (2008 Navigator only). Identify
circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C298
(2009 Expedition/Navigator only).
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP31 (BU-OG) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK)
for 2008 Navigator only. Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness
wire to GD133 (BK) for 2009 Expedition/Navigator only.
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality
> Page 6523
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN07 (GY) and remaining black jumper harness wires to RMN07
(VT) and DMN07 (shield - BK).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Connect the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the headliner.
2008-2009 Explorer / Explorer Sport Trac / Mountaineer
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 6)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner run
microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 248 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify and cut circuits VMNO7 (GY), RMNO7 (VT), and DMNO7 (shield) from C248. Cut the
three circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP05 (YE) and GD143 (BK-VT) from C248.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP05 (YE) and any black jumper harness wire to GD143 (BK-VT).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN07 (GY) and remaining black jumper harness wires to RMN07
(VT) and DMN07 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2009 F-150
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality
> Page 6524
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 7)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim or front lamp.
2. Lower the overhead console or front lamp. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional
information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and temporarily tuck excess wire
into headliner to the rear of the console or lamp.
4. Install overhead console or front lamp; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console or
front lamp trim directly behind microphone as
shown.
5. Gain access to connectors 314 and 315 in roof panel near left hand side. Refer to online WD,
Section 124-1 for links to location and connector
views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C314. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14358 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) from C315 and GD133 (BK) from C314.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the headliner.
2009 F-Super Duty
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality
> Page 6525
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 8)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
c. This repair is not recommended for vehicles not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 264 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield - BK) from C264. Cut the
three circuits on the female side of the connector
(17K745 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C264.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield - BK).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Connect the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2009 Flex
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality
> Page 6526
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 9)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 925 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C925. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector (14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C925.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Focus
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality
> Page 6527
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration (Figure 10). Firmly press
the microphone into place. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to the dome lamp trim.
2. Lower the dome lamp assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable up through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger
side A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop
headliner to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install dome lamp assembly; ensure microphone cable enters the dome lamp trim directly behind
microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 934 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD for location and connector
views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C934. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CPL60 (BN-YE) and GD161 (BK-YE) from C934.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CPL60 (BN-YE) and any black jumper harness wire to GD161
(BK-YE).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Fusion / Milan / MKZ
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality
> Page 6528
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 11)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 913 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C913. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP02 (GN) and GD139 (BK-YE) from C913.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP02 (GN) and any black jumper harness wire to GD139 (BK-YE).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Taurus / Sable / Taurus X
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 12)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner to
run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality
> Page 6529
5. Gain access to connector 925 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMN02 (WH-BN), RMN02 (VT-BN), and DMN07 (shield) from C925. Cut the
three circuits on the female side of the connector
(17K745 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C925.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN02 (WH-BN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMN02 (VT-BN) and DMN07 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2009 MKS
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 13)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and out the front of the headliner
above the rear view mirror.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 911 at the rear view mirror. Refer to the online WD, Section 124-1 for
links to location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMNO2 (WH-BN), RMN02 (VT-BN), and DMN07 (shield) from C911. Pull back
the black harness sleeve and cut the three
circuits near C91 1 or if equipped with a headlamp control module-2 (HCM-2), remove the HCM-2
access cover and cut circuits under trim cover. Refer to WSM, Section 417-01 for additional
information.
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C911.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality
> Page 6530
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN02 (WH-BN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMN02 (VT-BN) and DMN07 (shield).
^ Only splice into the wires heading away from the connector. The wires heading into the connector
(mirror) are no longer used.
^ Ensure the wiring is neatly routed from the splice locations into the headliner, following the
existing wire harness routing from mirror to headliner.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 08-21-2
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT091305 Claim Diagnosis And Labor Actual
Performed As Actual Time. Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
17700 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-14-3 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins SYNC(R) System - Functions
Inoperative/DTC's Set
TSB 09-14-3
07/27/09
SYNC FUNCTIONS INOPERATIVE, DTC U3000-41, U0485, OR U0100, AND/OR BATTERY
DRAW WITH ACCESSORY PROTOCOL INTERFACE MODULE CONNECTED
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Taurus X, Taurus 2008-2010 Fusion 2010 Mustang 2008-2009 Edge,
Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009 Escape Hybrid, Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 Zephyr 2008-2010 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable 2008-2010 Milan 2008-2009 Mountaineer 2009 Mariner Hybrid,
Mariner
ISSUE Some 2008-2010 vehicles equipped with SYNC version 2 software level, SYNC 911 Assist
and Vehicle Health Report, may exhibit all or most of the following symptoms:
^ Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC) U3000-41, U0485, or U0100 in Accessory Protocol Interface
Module (APIM)
^ SYNC display menus/options blank
^ USB port inoperative
^ No SYNC Blue Tooth device connectivity
^ Voice/Phone/OK steering wheel controls inoperative
^ Lack of APIM communication
^ Parasitic battery draw with APIM connected
These symptoms may be triggered by a low battery state of charge, or a recent battery
disconnect/reconnect.
ACTION Follow the service procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
This software upgrade only applies to the following Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and Customer Interface Processor (CIP) software levels:
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AC / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BC
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AD / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BD
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AE / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BD
To determine the current APIM software level, reference the Professional Technician Society (PTS)
website, enter the VIN in OASIS, click the GO
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-14-3 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set > Page 6536
button and select the SYNC button.
1. Determine if communication can be established with the APIM using IDS.
a. If communication cannot be verified, proceed to Step 2.
b. If communication is present, proceed to Step 3.
2. Reference Workshop Manual, Section 418-00, Module Communication Network to determine if
communication can be established. If not, perform
an APIM power reset by disconnecting and reconnecting the vehicle battery.
a. If communication is now present, proceed to Step 3.
b. If communication still cannot be established, replace the APIM.
3. Reprogram the APIM to VIP software level 9L2T-14D205-AF by following the Service Procedure.
NOTE
SOFTWARE IS AVAILABLE ONLY THROUGH THE PTS WEBSITE, AND NOT AVAILABLE
THROUGH THE SYNCMYRIDE.COM WEBSITE.
NOTE
CONFIGURATION AND PROGRAMMING REQUIRES THE USE OF A SPECIAL PTS
APPLICATION. INSTALLER MUST HAVE ACCESS TO PTS AND HAVE A VALID PTS USER ID
AND PASSWORD.
a. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
b. Connect the VCM to the IDS tool or laptop running IDS software.
c. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
d. Launch IDS tool.
e. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
f. Close the IDS tool.
g. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN And DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO
button.
h. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
i. Press read APIM button.
j. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMU5B2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT USE A TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
k. Program the processor in the APIM.
l. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMU5B2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software, and to the vehicle USB port.
m. Follow the on-screen instructions to program the VIP module.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-14-3 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set > Page 6537
n. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
o. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT091403 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone
Sound Quality
TSB 09-13-5
07/13/09
SYNC - CALL SOUND QUALITY/BACKGROUND NOISE ISSUES AND/OR VOICE
RECOGNITION DIFFICULTIES WHILE DRIVING
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape Hybrid, Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner Hybrid, Mariner
ISSUE Some customers of 2008-2009 SYNC equipped vehicles may express concern with their
call sound quality while using the SYNC microphone, complaints of excessive background noise
during a phone call, and/or issues with voice recognition accuracy while driving.
ACTION Follow the service procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The following service procedure involves updating the Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
software level and installing an external alternate SYNC microphone attached to the headliner.
NOTE
THIS PROCEDURE DOES NOT APPLY TO DEALER-INSTALLED SYNC SYSTEMS.
Do not perform Step 1 if vehicle is already equipped with SYNC 2.0 (911 and Vehicle Health
Report) or has been upgraded to consumer interface processor (CIP) level 9L3T-14D544-AE. To
determine the current APIM software level, Refer to the Professional Technician Society (PTS)
website, enter the VIN in OASIS, click the GO button, and select the SYNC button.
1. Reprogram the APIM to CIP software level 9L3T-14D544-AE. For additional information Refer to
other SYNC TSB's and WSM, Section 418-01.
Service Pack files may also be obtained at www.syncmyride.com.
When diagnosing a concern related to voice recognition (VR) difficulties, instruct the customer to
test VR functionality while the vehicle is parked. If customer concerns are still present, this
procedure will not yield an improvement, and the service procedure should not be performed.
Instead, Refer to the SYNC supplement guide and www.syncmyride.com for additional VR tips to
assist customer.
The VR experience can be improved with user training and making improvements to the phone
book entries (longer entries make the system more robust). Ensure the customer does not try to
speak too loud or slow and remove any objects hanging on the rear view mirror as this will reduce
system effectiveness.
When diagnosing a concern related to call sound quality, expect marginal improvements for calls
described as speaking in a tunnel, chamber, etc. Expect substantial improvements for complaints
where the call audio seems to drop out intermittently.
NOTE
THIS REPAIR WILL CHANGE THE APPEARANCE OF THE VEHICLE INTERIOR. REFER TO
THE PHOTOGRAPHS FOR THE APPLICABLE VEHICLE LOCATED IN THIS PROCEDURE. DO
NOT PERFORM THIS REPAIR WITHOUT CUSTOMER APPROVAL PRIOR TO PROCEEDING
WITH MICROPHONE INSTALLATION.
2. Install SYNC microphone service kit. Installing the kit includes mounting an external microphone
directly to the headliner and splicing in a jumper
harness to the vehicle's existing wiring harness. The existing SYNC microphone will no longer be
functional.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6542
a. Refer to the appropriate vehicle line and microphone illustration(s) below for microphone
installation and wire splicing locations. Refer to
Wiring Diagram (WD), Section 5-1 for recommended splicing methods.
b. Ensure the SYNC microphone wires are secure and do not interfere with vehicle operation or
functionality.
c. The microphone is directional. Make sure the microphone is always positioned so wire length is
minimized from view. When installing the
microphone adjacent to trim, place microphone as close to trim as possible to help minimize visible
wire.
2008-2009 Edge / MKX
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 1)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable up through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connectors 210 and 211 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for
links to location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C211. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C210.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2009 Escape / Mariner
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6543
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration (Figures 2 and 3). Firmly
press the microphone into place. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead
console trim (if equipped), or positioned directly above A-pillar on headliner if not equipped with an
overhead console. Proceed to Step 5 if not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner to
run microphone cable.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 214 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C214. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD182 (BK-GY) from C214.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD1 82 (BK-GY).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
9. Connect the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Navigator / 2009 Expedition
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6544
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figures 4 and 5)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim (if equipped), or
positioned directly above A-pillar on headliner if not
equipped with an overhead console.
^ Proceed to Step 5 if not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 298 located behind the dash panel on passenger side. Refer to online
WD, Section 124-1 for links to location and connector
views.
6. Identify circuits VMN07 (GY), RMN07 (VT), and DMN07 (shield - BK) from C298. Cut the three
circuits on the male side of the connector
(17C712 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP31 (BU-OG) and GD133 (BK) from C298 (2008 Navigator only). Identify
circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C298
(2009 Expedition/Navigator only).
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP31 (BU-OG) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK)
for 2008 Navigator only. Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness
wire to GD133 (BK) for 2009 Expedition/Navigator only.
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6545
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN07 (GY) and remaining black jumper harness wires to RMN07
(VT) and DMN07 (shield - BK).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Connect the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the headliner.
2008-2009 Explorer / Explorer Sport Trac / Mountaineer
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 6)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner run
microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 248 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify and cut circuits VMNO7 (GY), RMNO7 (VT), and DMNO7 (shield) from C248. Cut the
three circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP05 (YE) and GD143 (BK-VT) from C248.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP05 (YE) and any black jumper harness wire to GD143 (BK-VT).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN07 (GY) and remaining black jumper harness wires to RMN07
(VT) and DMN07 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2009 F-150
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6546
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 7)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim or front lamp.
2. Lower the overhead console or front lamp. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional
information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and temporarily tuck excess wire
into headliner to the rear of the console or lamp.
4. Install overhead console or front lamp; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console or
front lamp trim directly behind microphone as
shown.
5. Gain access to connectors 314 and 315 in roof panel near left hand side. Refer to online WD,
Section 124-1 for links to location and connector
views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C314. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14358 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) from C315 and GD133 (BK) from C314.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the headliner.
2009 F-Super Duty
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6547
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 8)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
c. This repair is not recommended for vehicles not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 264 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield - BK) from C264. Cut the
three circuits on the female side of the connector
(17K745 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C264.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield - BK).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Connect the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2009 Flex
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6548
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 9)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 925 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C925. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector (14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C925.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Focus
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6549
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration (Figure 10). Firmly press
the microphone into place. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to the dome lamp trim.
2. Lower the dome lamp assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable up through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger
side A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop
headliner to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install dome lamp assembly; ensure microphone cable enters the dome lamp trim directly behind
microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 934 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD for location and connector
views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C934. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CPL60 (BN-YE) and GD161 (BK-YE) from C934.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CPL60 (BN-YE) and any black jumper harness wire to GD161
(BK-YE).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Fusion / Milan / MKZ
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6550
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 11)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 913 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C913. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP02 (GN) and GD139 (BK-YE) from C913.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP02 (GN) and any black jumper harness wire to GD139 (BK-YE).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Taurus / Sable / Taurus X
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 12)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner to
run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6551
5. Gain access to connector 925 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMN02 (WH-BN), RMN02 (VT-BN), and DMN07 (shield) from C925. Cut the
three circuits on the female side of the connector
(17K745 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C925.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN02 (WH-BN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMN02 (VT-BN) and DMN07 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2009 MKS
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 13)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and out the front of the headliner
above the rear view mirror.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 911 at the rear view mirror. Refer to the online WD, Section 124-1 for
links to location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMNO2 (WH-BN), RMN02 (VT-BN), and DMN07 (shield) from C911. Pull back
the black harness sleeve and cut the three
circuits near C91 1 or if equipped with a headlamp control module-2 (HCM-2), remove the HCM-2
access cover and cut circuits under trim cover. Refer to WSM, Section 417-01 for additional
information.
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C911.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6552
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN02 (WH-BN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMN02 (VT-BN) and DMN07 (shield).
^ Only splice into the wires heading away from the connector. The wires heading into the connector
(mirror) are no longer used.
^ Ensure the wiring is neatly routed from the splice locations into the headliner, following the
existing wire harness routing from mirror to headliner.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 08-21-2
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT091305 Claim Diagnosis And Labor Actual
Performed As Actual Time. Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
17700 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-11-8 > Jun > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - 911 Assist VHR Software Upgrade
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins SYNC(R) System - 911 Assist VHR
Software Upgrade
TSB 09-11-8
06/15/09
SYNC WITH 911 ASSIST AND VEHICLE HEALTH REPORT (VHR) DEALER UPGRADE
SOFTWARE
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape Hybrid, Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner Hybrid, Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 9-5-4 to update the Service Procedure and add a production fix date.
ISSUE Some customers with 2008 or 2009 vehicles equipped with SYNC may request the 911
assist and vehicle health report (VHR) service upgrade installation. This software upgrade is not a
warrantable repair. Software is available only through professional technician society (PTS)
website, and not available through the syncmyride.com website.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to upgrade the SYNC software.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
This software upgrade applies only to the following vehicle model years and build dates:
^ 2008-2009 Focus built before 1/20/2009
^ 2008-2009 Explorer, Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer built before 1/12/2009
^ 2008-2009 Edge, MKX, and 2009 Flex, Escape, Mariner built before 12/4/2008
^ 2008-2009 Taurus, Taurus X, Sable, and 2009 F-Super Duty, MKS, F-150 built before 12/1/2008
^ 2008-2009 Fusion, Milan, MKZ
Vehicles built on or after these dates are already equipped with the 911 Assist/Vehicle Health
Report features and do not require updating.
To determine if the vehicles are within these build ranges or have already been upgraded to SYNC
911 Assist/VHR, access the Professional Technician Society (PTS) website, run OASIS by
pressing the Read VIN and DTC's button, and click on the SYNC tab. If the description box
indicates 911 and Vehicle Health Report, vehicle has been upgraded.
The 911 assist with VHR upgrade automatically reprograms the accessory protocol interface
module (APIM), instrument cluster (IC), and restraints control module (RCM).
The VHR applies only to United States (US) vehicles, 911 assist is for US and Canadian vehicles
operated within the US and Canada.
Performing this upgrade may result in some untested devices losing certain functionality, such as
bluetooth connection and phonebook download. Before continuing with this upgrade, make sure
the customer's device is listed on the compatibility matrix. It is strongly recommended to pair the
device to another vehicle currently equipped with 911 Assist/Vehicle Health Report to ensure
proper functionality before continuing.
Configuration and programming requires the use of IDS and a special PTS application. Installer
must have access to PTS and have a valid PTS user ID and password. Ensure the IDS is at the
latest software version.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-11-8 > Jun > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - 911 Assist VHR Software Upgrade > Page 6557
For additional programming tips, dealer network setting requirements, and possible error states
related to 911 Assist and VHR upgrades, reference the latest information on the Professional
Technician Society (PTS) website.
1. When updating 2008-2009 Explorer, Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac, Expedition, or Navigator
vehicles, it is necessary to manually record and
reenter the Oil Life % Value as displayed on the message center. Record the current oil life before
updating 911 Assist/VHR, and reenter using the message center once programming is complete.
2. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
3. Connect the VCM to the IDS tool or laptop running IDS software.
4. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
5. Launch IDS tool but do not start a new session.
6. If required, update the VCM with the latest IDS release 59.9 and higher.
7. Close the IDS tool.
8. From the P15 website, run OASIS by pressing the read VIN and DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the go button.
9. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, select the Upgrade/Mods tab.
10. Once correct vehicle is chosen, select SYNC upgrade with 911 Assist/VHR.
11. Follow the on-screen instructions to program the APIM, IC, and RCM.
NOTE
TO COMPLETE THE UPGRADE PROCESS PERFORM THE FOLLOWING STEPS TO CONFIRM
THE VEHICLE HAS BEEN CORRECTLY CONFIGURED TO HAVE THESE FEATURES. FAILING
TO COMPLETE THE STEPS BELOW MAY RESULT IN 911 ASSIST/VHR NOT DISPLAYING ON
THE SYNC MENU.
12. Set ignition to off.
13. Open and close driver side door.
14. Set ignition to on.
15. Follow applicable instructions (see below) to ensure 911 Assist/VHR appear on Sync menu.
16. Close all Internet Explorer browser windows.
17. Clear all DTC's on all modules.
18. Reenter the Oil Life % Value for 2008-2009 Explorer, Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac,
Expedition, or Navigator vehicles.
Navigation Radio Instructions
911 Assist/VHR feature confirmation.
1. Press phone button on the Navigation LCD to enter phone menu.
2. Press cancel when pop-up menu appears on Navigation LCD display.
3. Press settings soft key on Navigation LCD display.
4. Press advanced soft key on Navigation LCD display.
5. Verify 911 Assist/VHR is in menu in Navigation LCD display.
Non Navigation Radio Instructions
911 Assist/VHR feature confirmation.
1. Press phone button on steering wheel.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-11-8 > Jun > 09 >
SYNC(R) System - 911 Assist VHR Software Upgrade > Page 6558
2. Press left arrow on steering wheel until return is displayed on radio screen, then press ok.
3. Press left arrow on steering wheel until return is displayed on radio screen, then press ok.
4. Press left arrow until 911 Assist/VHR is displayed.
Once 911 Assist/VHR installation is complete, the customer will need to reload their phone book if
that application is desired.
NOTE
IF SERVICE IS REQUIRED ON 2008 OR 2009 EARLY BUILT VEHICLES UPGRADED TO 911
ASSIST/VHR, REFERENCE THE APPLICABLE 2009 WORKSHOP MANUAL AND FOLLOW THE
V2 DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURES.
WARRANTY STATUS: Information Only - Not Warrantable
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-11-8 > Jun > 09 > SYNC(R)
System - 911 Assist VHR Software Upgrade
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins SYNC(R) System - 911 Assist VHR
Software Upgrade
TSB 09-11-8
06/15/09
SYNC WITH 911 ASSIST AND VEHICLE HEALTH REPORT (VHR) DEALER UPGRADE
SOFTWARE
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape Hybrid, Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner Hybrid, Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 9-5-4 to update the Service Procedure and add a production fix date.
ISSUE Some customers with 2008 or 2009 vehicles equipped with SYNC may request the 911
assist and vehicle health report (VHR) service upgrade installation. This software upgrade is not a
warrantable repair. Software is available only through professional technician society (PTS)
website, and not available through the syncmyride.com website.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to upgrade the SYNC software.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
This software upgrade applies only to the following vehicle model years and build dates:
^ 2008-2009 Focus built before 1/20/2009
^ 2008-2009 Explorer, Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer built before 1/12/2009
^ 2008-2009 Edge, MKX, and 2009 Flex, Escape, Mariner built before 12/4/2008
^ 2008-2009 Taurus, Taurus X, Sable, and 2009 F-Super Duty, MKS, F-150 built before 12/1/2008
^ 2008-2009 Fusion, Milan, MKZ
Vehicles built on or after these dates are already equipped with the 911 Assist/Vehicle Health
Report features and do not require updating.
To determine if the vehicles are within these build ranges or have already been upgraded to SYNC
911 Assist/VHR, access the Professional Technician Society (PTS) website, run OASIS by
pressing the Read VIN and DTC's button, and click on the SYNC tab. If the description box
indicates 911 and Vehicle Health Report, vehicle has been upgraded.
The 911 assist with VHR upgrade automatically reprograms the accessory protocol interface
module (APIM), instrument cluster (IC), and restraints control module (RCM).
The VHR applies only to United States (US) vehicles, 911 assist is for US and Canadian vehicles
operated within the US and Canada.
Performing this upgrade may result in some untested devices losing certain functionality, such as
bluetooth connection and phonebook download. Before continuing with this upgrade, make sure
the customer's device is listed on the compatibility matrix. It is strongly recommended to pair the
device to another vehicle currently equipped with 911 Assist/Vehicle Health Report to ensure
proper functionality before continuing.
Configuration and programming requires the use of IDS and a special PTS application. Installer
must have access to PTS and have a valid PTS user ID and password. Ensure the IDS is at the
latest software version.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-11-8 > Jun > 09 > SYNC(R)
System - 911 Assist VHR Software Upgrade > Page 6564
For additional programming tips, dealer network setting requirements, and possible error states
related to 911 Assist and VHR upgrades, reference the latest information on the Professional
Technician Society (PTS) website.
1. When updating 2008-2009 Explorer, Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac, Expedition, or Navigator
vehicles, it is necessary to manually record and
reenter the Oil Life % Value as displayed on the message center. Record the current oil life before
updating 911 Assist/VHR, and reenter using the message center once programming is complete.
2. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
3. Connect the VCM to the IDS tool or laptop running IDS software.
4. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
5. Launch IDS tool but do not start a new session.
6. If required, update the VCM with the latest IDS release 59.9 and higher.
7. Close the IDS tool.
8. From the P15 website, run OASIS by pressing the read VIN and DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the go button.
9. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, select the Upgrade/Mods tab.
10. Once correct vehicle is chosen, select SYNC upgrade with 911 Assist/VHR.
11. Follow the on-screen instructions to program the APIM, IC, and RCM.
NOTE
TO COMPLETE THE UPGRADE PROCESS PERFORM THE FOLLOWING STEPS TO CONFIRM
THE VEHICLE HAS BEEN CORRECTLY CONFIGURED TO HAVE THESE FEATURES. FAILING
TO COMPLETE THE STEPS BELOW MAY RESULT IN 911 ASSIST/VHR NOT DISPLAYING ON
THE SYNC MENU.
12. Set ignition to off.
13. Open and close driver side door.
14. Set ignition to on.
15. Follow applicable instructions (see below) to ensure 911 Assist/VHR appear on Sync menu.
16. Close all Internet Explorer browser windows.
17. Clear all DTC's on all modules.
18. Reenter the Oil Life % Value for 2008-2009 Explorer, Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac,
Expedition, or Navigator vehicles.
Navigation Radio Instructions
911 Assist/VHR feature confirmation.
1. Press phone button on the Navigation LCD to enter phone menu.
2. Press cancel when pop-up menu appears on Navigation LCD display.
3. Press settings soft key on Navigation LCD display.
4. Press advanced soft key on Navigation LCD display.
5. Verify 911 Assist/VHR is in menu in Navigation LCD display.
Non Navigation Radio Instructions
911 Assist/VHR feature confirmation.
1. Press phone button on steering wheel.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-11-8 > Jun > 09 > SYNC(R)
System - 911 Assist VHR Software Upgrade > Page 6565
2. Press left arrow on steering wheel until return is displayed on radio screen, then press ok.
3. Press left arrow on steering wheel until return is displayed on radio screen, then press ok.
4. Press left arrow until 911 Assist/VHR is displayed.
Once 911 Assist/VHR installation is complete, the customer will need to reload their phone book if
that application is desired.
NOTE
IF SERVICE IS REQUIRED ON 2008 OR 2009 EARLY BUILT VEHICLES UPGRADED TO 911
ASSIST/VHR, REFERENCE THE APPLICABLE 2009 WORKSHOP MANUAL AND FOLLOW THE
V2 DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURES.
WARRANTY STATUS: Information Only - Not Warrantable
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Auxiliary Input / Output Jack,
Entertainment System > Component Information > Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Auxiliary Input / Output Jack,
Entertainment System > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6570
Auxiliary Input / Output Jack: Service and Repair
Audio Input Jack
NOTE: Vehicle with the SYNC system shown, others similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Open the floor console stowage bin door.
2. Using a suitable flat-bladed tool, remove the audio input jack bezel by prying straight upward.
- Disconnect the audio input jack electrical connector and the Universal Serial Bus (USB) cable, if
equipped.
3. Release the tabs and remove the audio input jack.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Entertainment System Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Entertainment System Control
Module: > 10-9-7 > May > 10 > Audio System - Unexpected CD Shuffle With Key Off
Entertainment System Control Module: Customer Interest Audio System - Unexpected CD Shuffle
With Key Off
TSB 10-9-7
05/24/10
UNEXPECTED COMPACT DISC SHUFFLE OR CYCLING DURING NORMAL RADIO
OPERATION OR WITH THE KEY OFF - NON-NAVIGATION RADIOS ONLY
FORD: 2008-2010 Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer
MERCURY: 2008-2010 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some 2008-2010 Expedition, Explorer, Explorer Sport Trac and Mountaineer vehicles
equipped with a non-navigation CD-6 Audio Control Module (ACM) may experience an unexpected
Compact Disc (CD) shuffle or cycling during start up, during normal ACM operation, or shutting off
the vehicle.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
This service procedure affects non-navigation radios only. If you attempt to run module
reprogramming on the 2008-2010 ACM and the service tool does not recognize the part numbers
of the ACM currently installed, this procedure does not apply.
Reprogram the ACM to the latest calibration using IDS release 66.05A and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010. Version A DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained
at the website.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100907A 2008-2010 Expedition, 0.3 Hr.
Explorer, Mountaineer, And Explorer Sport Trac: Reprogram The Audio Control Module (Do Not
Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Entertainment System Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Entertainment System
Control Module: > 10-9-7 > May > 10 > Audio System - Unexpected CD Shuffle With Key Off
Entertainment System Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Audio System - Unexpected
CD Shuffle With Key Off
TSB 10-9-7
05/24/10
UNEXPECTED COMPACT DISC SHUFFLE OR CYCLING DURING NORMAL RADIO
OPERATION OR WITH THE KEY OFF - NON-NAVIGATION RADIOS ONLY
FORD: 2008-2010 Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer
MERCURY: 2008-2010 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some 2008-2010 Expedition, Explorer, Explorer Sport Trac and Mountaineer vehicles
equipped with a non-navigation CD-6 Audio Control Module (ACM) may experience an unexpected
Compact Disc (CD) shuffle or cycling during start up, during normal ACM operation, or shutting off
the vehicle.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
This service procedure affects non-navigation radios only. If you attempt to run module
reprogramming on the 2008-2010 ACM and the service tool does not recognize the part numbers
of the ACM currently installed, this procedure does not apply.
Reprogram the ACM to the latest calibration using IDS release 66.05A and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010. Version A DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained
at the website.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100907A 2008-2010 Expedition, 0.3 Hr.
Explorer, Mountaineer, And Explorer Sport Trac: Reprogram The Audio Control Module (Do Not
Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Entertainment System Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Rear Entertainment Module (RETM)
Entertainment System Control Module: Locations Rear Entertainment Module (RETM)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Entertainment System Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Rear Entertainment Module (RETM) > Page 6586
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Entertainment System Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Rear Entertainment Module (RETM) > Page 6587
Entertainment System Control Module: Locations Audio Rear Control Unit (RCU) Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Entertainment System Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Rear Entertainment Module (RETM) > Page 6588
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Entertainment System Control
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Rear Entertainment Module (RETM)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Entertainment System Control
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Rear Entertainment Module (RETM) > Page 6591
Entertainment System Control Module: Diagrams Audio Rear Control Unit (RCU) Module
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Entertainment System Control
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Rear Entertainment Module (RETM) > Page 6592
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Entertainment System Control
Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair
Entertainment System Control Panel: Service and Repair
Rear Entertainment Module (RETM)
Removal
1. NOTE: Module configuration is required when a new Rear Entertainment Module (RETM) is
being installed.
Upload the RETM configuration to the scan tool.
2. NOTE: Open the video display.
Remove the 4 screws.
3. Remove the RETM.
- Pull down on the sides of the RETM to disengage the clips from the bracket.
- Using a suitable tool, such as a flat-bladed screwdriver, push the rear most U-hook forward and
release the U-hooks.
- Hang the RETM on the J-hooks and disconnect the electrical connector.
- Remove the RETM from the J-hooks.
Installation
1. Hang the RETM on the J-hooks.
2. Connect the electrical connector.
3. Remove the RETM from the J-hooks.
4. NOTE: Tilt the RETM, as necessary, to align it correctly.
Align the left side guide pin with the left side locating hole.
5. Lift up the right side of the RETM and engage the U-hooks.
6. Install the 4 screws.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Entertainment System Control
Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 6596
7. Push on the left and right sides of the RETM to engage the clips.
8. Download the configuration information to the RETM configuration.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: Description and Operation
Universal Transmitter
The universal transmitter is an integral part of the LH sun visor and provides a convenient way to
substitute up to 3 hand-held transmitters with a single built-in device. The universal transmitter can
learn the radio frequency codes of most current transmitters. The universal transmitter:
- operates garage doors, gates and home/office lighting and security systems.
- learns and transmits the radio frequency of up to 3 hand-held transmitters from any of the
systems mentioned above.
- is powered by the vehicle battery and charging system.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Universal Transmitter
Inspection and Verification
1. Verify the customer concern.
2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of mechanical damage.
Visual Inspection Chart
3. If an obvious cause for an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible)
before proceeding to the next step.
4. If the fault is not visually evident, verify the symptom and GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 6602
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Universal Transmitter
Symptom Chart
Symptom Chart
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 6603
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: Pinpoint Tests
Universal Transmitter
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test A: The Universal Transmitter is Inoperative
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 89, Interior Lamps for schematic and connector information. See:
Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The universal transmitter receives voltage with the key in the ON position on circuit CLN09
(YE/GN) and ground on circuit GD138 (BK/WH).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Universal transmitter
- Receiver unit
PINPOINT TEST A: THE UNIVERSAL TRANSMITTER IS INOPERATIVE
------------------------------------------------- A1 CHECK THE LEFT VANITY MIRROR OPERATION
- Check the illumination of the left vanity mirror lamps.
- Do the left vanity mirror lamps illuminate?
Yes
GO to A2.
No
REFER to Courtesy Lamp. See: Lighting and Horns/Courtesy Lamp/Testing and Inspection
------------------------------------------------- A2 PROGRAM A HAND-HELD TRANSMITTER INTO THE
UNIVERSAL TRANSMITTER
- NOTE: If the garage door is equipped with rolling codes, refer to Training a Garage Door Opener
Equipped With "Rolling Codes".
- Program the universal transmitter. Refer to Universal Transmitter Programming See:
Programming and Relearning.
- Does the universal transmitter program successfully?
Yes
The universal transmitter is OK. VERIFY the receiver unit operates correctly.
No
INSTALL a new LH sun visor assembly. TEST the system for normal operation.
-------------------------------------------------
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 6604
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: Programming and Relearning
Universal Transmitter Programming
NOTE: A new battery in the hand-held transmitter may allow quicker and easier training due to a
more accurate transmission of the radio frequency signal.
1. Verify the hand-held transmitter is operative.
2. Turn the key to the ON position.
3. Prepare for programming the universal transmitter by erasing all 3 channels by holding down the
2 outside buttons until the red light begins to
flash (20-30 seconds). Release both buttons.
4. Select 1 of the 3 universal transmitter buttons to be used for programming.
5. Hold the end of the hand-held transmitter 25-76 mm (1-3 in) away from the front surface of the
universal transmitter so that the universal
transmitter red light can still be seen.
6. NOTE: During programming, the hand-held transmitter may automatically stop transmitting after
2 seconds, which may not be long enough to
program the universal transmitter. If programming with this type of hand-held transmitter, continue
to hold the button on the universal transmitter while pressing and releasing the hand-held
transmitter button every 2 seconds.
At the same time, press the hand-held transmitter button and the desired button on the universal
transmitter until the red light on the universal transmitter flashes first slowly, and then rapidly.
Release both buttons when the rapid flashing begins.
7. Firmly press and hold for 5 seconds, then release the just-trained universal transmitter button up
to 2 separate times to activate the door. If after 2
separate times, the door still does not activate, press and hold the just-trained universal transmitter
button and observe the indicator light. If the indicator light stays on constantly, programming is complete and the device should activate
when the universal transmitter button is pressed and released.
- If the indicator light blinks rapidly for 2 seconds and then turns to a constant light, follow the
Training a Garage Door Opener Equipped With "Rolling Codes" procedure to complete the
programming of a rolling code equipped device.
Training a Garage Door Opener Equipped With "Rolling Codes"
1. At the garage door opener receiver (motor-head unit) in the garage, locate the "learn" or "smart"
button. This can usually be found where the
hanging antenna wire is attached to the motor-head unit.
2. Firmly press and release the "learn" or "smart" button. (The name and color of the button may
vary by manufacturer.) There are 30 seconds to
initiate step 3.
3. Return to the vehicle and firmly press, hold for 2 seconds and release the programmed universal
transmitter button. Repeat the press/hold/release
sequence a second time, and depending on the brand of the garage door opener (or other rolling
code equipped device), repeat this sequence a third time to complete the programming process.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Global Positioning System > Global Positioning System
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Global Positioning System Module:
> 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns
Global Positioning System Module: Customer Interest SYNC(R) System - Software Update For
Various Concerns
TSB 09-26-8
01/04/10
SYNC SOFTWARE UPDATE - VARIOUS ISSUES
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 9-22-14 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2008 and 2009 SYNC® equipped vehicles may exhibit one or more of the following
symptoms:
^ Universal Serial Bus (USB) port inoperative.
^ USB audio muting when using various non-Apple USB devices.
^ Phone book access difficulty on certain 2-digit phone book entries when using voice commands.
^ Excessive background noise and/or poor voice sound quality.
^ Phone book auto download inoperative on supported devices.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative intermittently.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Reprogram the accessory protocol inter[ace module (APIM) to the following consumer inter[ace
processor (CIP) software levels.
^ 9L3T-14D544-AE (vehicles not equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health Report)
^ 9L2T-14D544-BE (vehicles already equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health
Report)
Service Pack files may be obtained at www.syncmyride.com.
Reprogram the APIM
Contains software fix updates for the following:
^ Phone book auto download inoperative.
^ USB audio muting.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative.
^ Voice recognition on 2-digit entries.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Global Positioning System > Global Positioning System
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Global Positioning System Module:
> 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns > Page 6614
^ USB port inoperative with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B1342.
^ Poor call sound quality.
This software update also contains enhancements that will improve the reliability of both Bluetooth
and USB connections to SYNC(R) from various consumer devices, and microphone enhancements
to reduce background noise, and will default Vehicle Health Report (if equipped) to off. The
Bluetooth enhancements improve the stability of hands-free calls, call waiting, caller ID, multiple
call handling and other mobile phone features. The USB enhancements improve support for media
players and the playing of file formats and podcasts.
NOTE
REFERENCE OTHER TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETINS (TSB) FOR ADDITIONAL SYNC
SOFTWARE PROGRAMMING TIPS.
1. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
2. Connect the VCM to the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) tool or laptop running IDS software.
3. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
4. Launch IDS tool.
5. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
6. Close the IDS tool.
7. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN & DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO button.
8. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
9. Press read APIM button.
10. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
11. Program both processors in the APIM (Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and CIP).
NOTE
DO NOT USE A MALE-TO-MALE USB DATA TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
a. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software and
to the vehicle USB port.
b. Follow the on-screen instructions to program both processors on the Sync module (VIP and
CIP).
12. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
13. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 08-21-02
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092608A 2008-2009 Edge, Explorer, 0.4 Hr.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Global Positioning System > Global Positioning System
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Global Positioning System Module:
> 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns > Page 6615
Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac, Focus, Fusion, Milan, MKX, MKZ, Sable, Navigator, Taurus,
Taurus X, 2009 Expedition, Escape, Escape Hybrid, Mariner, Mariner Hybrid, F-150, F-Super Duty,
Flex, MKS: Reprogram The APIM (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Global Positioning System > Global Positioning System
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Global Positioning
System Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns
Global Positioning System Module: All Technical Service Bulletins SYNC(R) System - Software
Update For Various Concerns
TSB 09-26-8
01/04/10
SYNC SOFTWARE UPDATE - VARIOUS ISSUES
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 9-22-14 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2008 and 2009 SYNC® equipped vehicles may exhibit one or more of the following
symptoms:
^ Universal Serial Bus (USB) port inoperative.
^ USB audio muting when using various non-Apple USB devices.
^ Phone book access difficulty on certain 2-digit phone book entries when using voice commands.
^ Excessive background noise and/or poor voice sound quality.
^ Phone book auto download inoperative on supported devices.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative intermittently.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Reprogram the accessory protocol inter[ace module (APIM) to the following consumer inter[ace
processor (CIP) software levels.
^ 9L3T-14D544-AE (vehicles not equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health Report)
^ 9L2T-14D544-BE (vehicles already equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health
Report)
Service Pack files may be obtained at www.syncmyride.com.
Reprogram the APIM
Contains software fix updates for the following:
^ Phone book auto download inoperative.
^ USB audio muting.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative.
^ Voice recognition on 2-digit entries.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Global Positioning System > Global Positioning System
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Global Positioning
System Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns > Page 6621
^ USB port inoperative with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B1342.
^ Poor call sound quality.
This software update also contains enhancements that will improve the reliability of both Bluetooth
and USB connections to SYNC(R) from various consumer devices, and microphone enhancements
to reduce background noise, and will default Vehicle Health Report (if equipped) to off. The
Bluetooth enhancements improve the stability of hands-free calls, call waiting, caller ID, multiple
call handling and other mobile phone features. The USB enhancements improve support for media
players and the playing of file formats and podcasts.
NOTE
REFERENCE OTHER TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETINS (TSB) FOR ADDITIONAL SYNC
SOFTWARE PROGRAMMING TIPS.
1. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
2. Connect the VCM to the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) tool or laptop running IDS software.
3. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
4. Launch IDS tool.
5. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
6. Close the IDS tool.
7. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN & DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO button.
8. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
9. Press read APIM button.
10. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
11. Program both processors in the APIM (Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and CIP).
NOTE
DO NOT USE A MALE-TO-MALE USB DATA TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
a. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software and
to the vehicle USB port.
b. Follow the on-screen instructions to program both processors on the Sync module (VIP and
CIP).
12. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
13. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 08-21-02
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092608A 2008-2009 Edge, Explorer, 0.4 Hr.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Global Positioning System > Global Positioning System
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Global Positioning
System Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns > Page 6622
Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac, Focus, Fusion, Milan, MKX, MKZ, Sable, Navigator, Taurus,
Taurus X, 2009 Expedition, Escape, Escape Hybrid, Mariner, Mariner Hybrid, F-150, F-Super Duty,
Flex, MKS: Reprogram The APIM (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning
Module > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6627
Memory Positioning Module: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6628
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6629
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6630
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6631
Memory Positioning Module: Service and Repair
Driver Seat Module (DSM)
Removal and Installation
NOTICE: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these charges,
damage may result.
NOTE: Prior to the removal of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to a scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new Driver Seat Module
(DSM) after installation.
1. Upload the module configuration information from the DSM into the scan tool.
2. NOTE: The module is accessed with the seat fully in the UP position.
Position the DSM forward to remove it from the bracket.
3. Disconnect the battery.
4. Disconnect the electrical connectors and remove the DSM.
5. NOTE: Once the module is installed, it is necessary to download the module configuration
information from the scan tool into the new module.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Memory Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Memory Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6635
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Navigation Module > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Navigation Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R)
System - Software Update For Various Concerns
Navigation Module: Customer Interest SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns
TSB 09-26-8
01/04/10
SYNC SOFTWARE UPDATE - VARIOUS ISSUES
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 9-22-14 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2008 and 2009 SYNC® equipped vehicles may exhibit one or more of the following
symptoms:
^ Universal Serial Bus (USB) port inoperative.
^ USB audio muting when using various non-Apple USB devices.
^ Phone book access difficulty on certain 2-digit phone book entries when using voice commands.
^ Excessive background noise and/or poor voice sound quality.
^ Phone book auto download inoperative on supported devices.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative intermittently.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Reprogram the accessory protocol inter[ace module (APIM) to the following consumer inter[ace
processor (CIP) software levels.
^ 9L3T-14D544-AE (vehicles not equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health Report)
^ 9L2T-14D544-BE (vehicles already equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health
Report)
Service Pack files may be obtained at www.syncmyride.com.
Reprogram the APIM
Contains software fix updates for the following:
^ Phone book auto download inoperative.
^ USB audio muting.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative.
^ Voice recognition on 2-digit entries.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Navigation Module > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Navigation Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R)
System - Software Update For Various Concerns > Page 6645
^ USB port inoperative with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B1342.
^ Poor call sound quality.
This software update also contains enhancements that will improve the reliability of both Bluetooth
and USB connections to SYNC(R) from various consumer devices, and microphone enhancements
to reduce background noise, and will default Vehicle Health Report (if equipped) to off. The
Bluetooth enhancements improve the stability of hands-free calls, call waiting, caller ID, multiple
call handling and other mobile phone features. The USB enhancements improve support for media
players and the playing of file formats and podcasts.
NOTE
REFERENCE OTHER TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETINS (TSB) FOR ADDITIONAL SYNC
SOFTWARE PROGRAMMING TIPS.
1. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
2. Connect the VCM to the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) tool or laptop running IDS software.
3. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
4. Launch IDS tool.
5. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
6. Close the IDS tool.
7. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN & DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO button.
8. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
9. Press read APIM button.
10. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
11. Program both processors in the APIM (Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and CIP).
NOTE
DO NOT USE A MALE-TO-MALE USB DATA TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
a. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software and
to the vehicle USB port.
b. Follow the on-screen instructions to program both processors on the Sync module (VIP and
CIP).
12. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
13. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 08-21-02
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092608A 2008-2009 Edge, Explorer, 0.4 Hr.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Navigation Module > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Navigation Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R)
System - Software Update For Various Concerns > Page 6646
Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac, Focus, Fusion, Milan, MKX, MKZ, Sable, Navigator, Taurus,
Taurus X, 2009 Expedition, Escape, Escape Hybrid, Mariner, Mariner Hybrid, F-150, F-Super Duty,
Flex, MKS: Reprogram The APIM (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Navigation Module > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 >
SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns
Navigation Module: All Technical Service Bulletins SYNC(R) System - Software Update For
Various Concerns
TSB 09-26-8
01/04/10
SYNC SOFTWARE UPDATE - VARIOUS ISSUES
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 9-22-14 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2008 and 2009 SYNC® equipped vehicles may exhibit one or more of the following
symptoms:
^ Universal Serial Bus (USB) port inoperative.
^ USB audio muting when using various non-Apple USB devices.
^ Phone book access difficulty on certain 2-digit phone book entries when using voice commands.
^ Excessive background noise and/or poor voice sound quality.
^ Phone book auto download inoperative on supported devices.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative intermittently.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Reprogram the accessory protocol inter[ace module (APIM) to the following consumer inter[ace
processor (CIP) software levels.
^ 9L3T-14D544-AE (vehicles not equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health Report)
^ 9L2T-14D544-BE (vehicles already equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health
Report)
Service Pack files may be obtained at www.syncmyride.com.
Reprogram the APIM
Contains software fix updates for the following:
^ Phone book auto download inoperative.
^ USB audio muting.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative.
^ Voice recognition on 2-digit entries.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Navigation Module > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 >
SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns > Page 6652
^ USB port inoperative with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B1342.
^ Poor call sound quality.
This software update also contains enhancements that will improve the reliability of both Bluetooth
and USB connections to SYNC(R) from various consumer devices, and microphone enhancements
to reduce background noise, and will default Vehicle Health Report (if equipped) to off. The
Bluetooth enhancements improve the stability of hands-free calls, call waiting, caller ID, multiple
call handling and other mobile phone features. The USB enhancements improve support for media
players and the playing of file formats and podcasts.
NOTE
REFERENCE OTHER TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETINS (TSB) FOR ADDITIONAL SYNC
SOFTWARE PROGRAMMING TIPS.
1. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
2. Connect the VCM to the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) tool or laptop running IDS software.
3. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
4. Launch IDS tool.
5. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
6. Close the IDS tool.
7. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN & DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO button.
8. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
9. Press read APIM button.
10. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
11. Program both processors in the APIM (Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and CIP).
NOTE
DO NOT USE A MALE-TO-MALE USB DATA TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
a. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software and
to the vehicle USB port.
b. Follow the on-screen instructions to program both processors on the Sync module (VIP and
CIP).
12. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
13. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 08-21-02
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092608A 2008-2009 Edge, Explorer, 0.4 Hr.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Navigation Module > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Navigation Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 >
SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns > Page 6653
Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac, Focus, Fusion, Milan, MKX, MKZ, Sable, Navigator, Taurus,
Taurus X, 2009 Expedition, Escape, Escape Hybrid, Mariner, Mariner Hybrid, F-150, F-Super Duty,
Flex, MKS: Reprogram The APIM (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Motor >
Component Information > Locations
Pedal Positioning Motor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Motor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6658
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Motor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6659
Pedal Positioning Motor: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Motor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6660
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Pedal Positioning Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6664
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6665
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Adjustable Pedal Switch - Without Memory
Pedal Positioning Switch: Testing and Inspection Adjustable Pedal Switch - Without Memory
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Adjustable Pedal Switch - Without Memory > Page 6668
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Adjustable Pedal Switch - Without Memory > Page 6669
Pedal Positioning Switch: Testing and Inspection Adjustable Pedal Switch - With Memory
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Adjustable Pedal Switch - Without Memory > Page 6670
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Amplifier, Sound
System > Component Information > Diagrams > Subwoofer Amplifier
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Amplifier, Sound
System > Component Information > Diagrams > Subwoofer Amplifier > Page 6676
Amplifier: Diagrams Audio Amplifier
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Amplifier, Sound
System > Component Information > Diagrams > Subwoofer Amplifier > Page 6677
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Amplifier, Sound
System > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6678
Amplifier: Service and Repair
Audio Amplifier
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the Audio Control Module (ACM). For additional information, refer to Audio Control
Module (ACM) See: Cellular
Phone/Communications Control Module/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Audio
Control Module (ACM).
2. Disconnect the audio amplifier electrical connectors.
3. Remove the 3 bolts and the audio amplifier.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc Player
(CD) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Compact Disc Player
(CD): > 10-9-7 > May > 10 > Audio System - Unexpected CD Shuffle With Key Off
Compact Disc Player (CD): All Technical Service Bulletins Audio System - Unexpected CD Shuffle
With Key Off
TSB 10-9-7
05/24/10
UNEXPECTED COMPACT DISC SHUFFLE OR CYCLING DURING NORMAL RADIO
OPERATION OR WITH THE KEY OFF - NON-NAVIGATION RADIOS ONLY
FORD: 2008-2010 Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer
MERCURY: 2008-2010 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some 2008-2010 Expedition, Explorer, Explorer Sport Trac and Mountaineer vehicles
equipped with a non-navigation CD-6 Audio Control Module (ACM) may experience an unexpected
Compact Disc (CD) shuffle or cycling during start up, during normal ACM operation, or shutting off
the vehicle.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
This service procedure affects non-navigation radios only. If you attempt to run module
reprogramming on the 2008-2010 ACM and the service tool does not recognize the part numbers
of the ACM currently installed, this procedure does not apply.
Reprogram the ACM to the latest calibration using IDS release 66.05A and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010. Version A DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained
at the website.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100907A 2008-2010 Expedition, 0.3 Hr.
Explorer, Mountaineer, And Explorer Sport Trac: Reprogram The Audio Control Module (Do Not
Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc Player
(CD) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Compact Disc Player (CD): > 10-9-7 >
May > 10 > Audio System - Unexpected CD Shuffle With Key Off
Compact Disc Player (CD): Customer Interest Audio System - Unexpected CD Shuffle With Key Off
TSB 10-9-7
05/24/10
UNEXPECTED COMPACT DISC SHUFFLE OR CYCLING DURING NORMAL RADIO
OPERATION OR WITH THE KEY OFF - NON-NAVIGATION RADIOS ONLY
FORD: 2008-2010 Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer
MERCURY: 2008-2010 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some 2008-2010 Expedition, Explorer, Explorer Sport Trac and Mountaineer vehicles
equipped with a non-navigation CD-6 Audio Control Module (ACM) may experience an unexpected
Compact Disc (CD) shuffle or cycling during start up, during normal ACM operation, or shutting off
the vehicle.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
This service procedure affects non-navigation radios only. If you attempt to run module
reprogramming on the 2008-2010 ACM and the service tool does not recognize the part numbers
of the ACM currently installed, this procedure does not apply.
Reprogram the ACM to the latest calibration using IDS release 66.05A and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010. Version A DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained
at the website.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100907A 2008-2010 Expedition, 0.3 Hr.
Explorer, Mountaineer, And Explorer Sport Trac: Reprogram The Audio Control Module (Do Not
Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Locations
Radio/Stereo: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6695
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6696
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Audio Rear Control Unit (RCU) Module
Radio/Stereo: Service and Repair Audio Rear Control Unit (RCU) Module
Audio Rear Control Unit (RCU) Module
NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. NOTE: Module configuration is required when a new audio Rear Control Unit (RCU) module is
being installed.
Upload the audio RCU module configuration information to the scan tool.
Navigator
2. Remove the floor console cupholders.
3. Remove the 2 screws securing the rear trim panel to the floor console.
Expedition
4. Remove the 2 screws under the armrest cover.
All vehicles
5. Remove the bolt and the center console rear trim panel.
- Disengage the pin-type retainers.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Audio Rear Control Unit (RCU) Module > Page 6699
- Disconnect the audio RCU module electrical connector.
6. Remove the RCU module.
- Remove the 4 screws.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Download the configuration information to the audio RCU module.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Audio Rear Control Unit (RCU) Module > Page 6700
Radio/Stereo: Service and Repair Satellite Digital Audio Receiver System (SDARS) Module
Satellite Digital Audio Receiver System (SDARS) Module
Removal and Installation
NOTE: This procedure applies to vehicles without navigation only. For vehicles with navigation, the
Satellite Digital Audio Receiver System (SDARS) module is integral to the Audio Control Module
(ACM).
1. NOTE: Module configuration is required when a new SDARS module is being installed.
Upload the SDARS module configuration information to the scan tool.
2. Remove the center console.
3. Remove the 4 screws and the SDARS module.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
- To install, tighten the screws to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Download the configuration information to the SDARS module.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Remote Control,
Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Service and Repair
Remote Control: Service and Repair
Steering Wheel Controls - Expedition
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: It is not necessary to remove the driver air bag module during this procedure.
NOTE: When removing the steering wheel controls, disengage the RH side of the controls first.
Using an appropriate tool, pry the steering wheel controls out of the steering wheel.
2. NOTE: Do not allow the electrical connector to fall back into the steering wheel.
Remove the steering wheel controls.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Speaker: > 09-20-10 > Oct > 09 > Audio
System - Inoperative/Speaker Popping Noise
Speaker: Customer Interest Audio System - Inoperative/Speaker Popping Noise
TSB 09-20-10
10/19/09
SPEAKER POP AND/OR RADIO INOPERATIVE/BLANK/LOCKED UP
FORD: 2008-2009 Fusion, Mustang 2008 F-150 2008-2009 Edge, Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac,
Explorer, F-Super Duty
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 9-16-3 to update the vehicle lines.
ISSUE Some 2008-2009 F-Super Duty, Expedition, Explorer, Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer,
Fusion, Milan, Mustang,, Edge and 2008 F-150 vehicles equipped with Single CD and CDX6 Audio
Control Modules (ACM), may exhibit either a speaker pop noise and/or a condition where the ACM
is completely inoperative or will not power on.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The speaker pop typically happens after an extended drive period when vehicle is warm and
opening/closing a door; however, it may happen anytime the (ACM) is turned off. Using the vehicle
heater through the instrument panel (IP) panel vents (on high setting) may also cause the condition
to repeat more often. The ACM may be completely inoperative, blank. or locked up. It may be
caused by a software lockup event within the ACM.
Reprogram the ACM to the latest calibration using IDS 63.02 and higher. This new calibration is not
included in the VCM 2009.9 DVD Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
An ACM replacement will be necessary for 2008 F-150 for the above symptoms, it can not be
reprogrammed with IDS. Reference Workshop Manual, Section 415-00 for removal and installation
instructions. Please specify speaker pop noise/lock up on the 1878 form when ordering a
replacement ACM for F-150.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092010A 2008-2009 F-Super Duty, 0.3 Hr.
Expedition, Explorer, Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac, Edge, Fusion, Milan, Mustang: Reprogram
The ACM (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
092010B 2008 F-150: Retrieve The 0.2 Hr.
ACM Unit Part Number - Acquire And Order An Exchange Unit Can Be Claimed with Operation C
(Do Not Use With Any Labor Operation Outside Of This Article)
092010C 2008 F-150: Replace The 0.4 Hr.
ACM, Can Be Claimed
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Speaker: > 09-20-10 > Oct > 09 > Audio
System - Inoperative/Speaker Popping Noise > Page 6712
with Operation B (Do Not Use With Any Labor Operation Outside Of This Article)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Speaker: > 09-20-10 > Oct > 09 >
Audio System - Inoperative/Speaker Popping Noise
Speaker: All Technical Service Bulletins Audio System - Inoperative/Speaker Popping Noise
TSB 09-20-10
10/19/09
SPEAKER POP AND/OR RADIO INOPERATIVE/BLANK/LOCKED UP
FORD: 2008-2009 Fusion, Mustang 2008 F-150 2008-2009 Edge, Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac,
Explorer, F-Super Duty
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 9-16-3 to update the vehicle lines.
ISSUE Some 2008-2009 F-Super Duty, Expedition, Explorer, Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer,
Fusion, Milan, Mustang,, Edge and 2008 F-150 vehicles equipped with Single CD and CDX6 Audio
Control Modules (ACM), may exhibit either a speaker pop noise and/or a condition where the ACM
is completely inoperative or will not power on.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The speaker pop typically happens after an extended drive period when vehicle is warm and
opening/closing a door; however, it may happen anytime the (ACM) is turned off. Using the vehicle
heater through the instrument panel (IP) panel vents (on high setting) may also cause the condition
to repeat more often. The ACM may be completely inoperative, blank. or locked up. It may be
caused by a software lockup event within the ACM.
Reprogram the ACM to the latest calibration using IDS 63.02 and higher. This new calibration is not
included in the VCM 2009.9 DVD Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
An ACM replacement will be necessary for 2008 F-150 for the above symptoms, it can not be
reprogrammed with IDS. Reference Workshop Manual, Section 415-00 for removal and installation
instructions. Please specify speaker pop noise/lock up on the 1878 form when ordering a
replacement ACM for F-150.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092010A 2008-2009 F-Super Duty, 0.3 Hr.
Expedition, Explorer, Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac, Edge, Fusion, Milan, Mustang: Reprogram
The ACM (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
092010B 2008 F-150: Retrieve The 0.2 Hr.
ACM Unit Part Number - Acquire And Order An Exchange Unit Can Be Claimed with Operation C
(Do Not Use With Any Labor Operation Outside Of This Article)
092010C 2008 F-150: Replace The 0.4 Hr.
ACM, Can Be Claimed
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Speaker: > 09-20-10 > Oct > 09 >
Audio System - Inoperative/Speaker Popping Noise > Page 6718
with Operation B (Do Not Use With Any Labor Operation Outside Of This Article)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Instrument Panel Speaker
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 6721
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 6722
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 6723
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 6724
Speaker: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 6725
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 6726
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 6727
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 6728
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 6729
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 6730
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 6731
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 6732
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 6733
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 6734
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Speaker - Door
Speaker: Service and Repair Speaker - Door
Speaker - Door
NOTE: Front door shown, rear door similar.
Removal and Installation
All speakers
1. Remove the door trim panels.
Front door tweeter speaker
2. Remove the 2 screws and the door tweeter speaker.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
Front or rear door speaker
3. Remove the 4 screws and the speaker.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
All speakers
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Speaker - Door > Page 6737
Speaker: Service and Repair Speaker - Subwoofer
Speaker - Subwoofer
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the LH quarter trim panel.
2. Remove the 2 nuts, the bolt, and the subwoofer speaker.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Speaker - Door > Page 6738
Speaker: Service and Repair Speaker - Instrument Panel
Speaker - Instrument Panel
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument panel center finish panel.
2. Remove the 4 screws and the instrument panel speaker cover.
3. Remove the 4 screws and the instrument panel speaker.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 6744
Accessory Delay Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 6745
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Antenna Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Antenna Control Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Antenna Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6749
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Antenna Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6750
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Antenna Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6751
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest
for Communications Control Module: > 10-2-8 > Feb > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Defaults To 'Privacy Mode'
Communications Control Module: Customer Interest SYNC(R) System - Defaults To 'Privacy Mode'
TSB 10-2-8
02/15/10
SYNC SYSTEM DEFAULTS TO OR STAYS IN PRIVACY MODE, MULTIPLE VEHICLE LINES
FORD: 2008-2009 Taurus X 2008-2010 Focus, Fusion, Mustang, Taurus, Edge, Escape,
Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer, F-150, F-250, F-350, F-450 2009-2010 Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2010 MKZ 2009-2010 MKS 2008 Mark LT 2008-2010 MKX, Navigator 2010 MKT
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable 2008-2010 Milan, Mariner, Mountaineer
ISSUE Some customers of 2008-2010 SYNC-equipped vehicles may express concern with their
SYNC paired device defaulting, switching or staying on privacy mode. The customer may not be
able to accept the call through the SYNC system or must answer the call manually on their
personal device.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Set the Privacy mode to Off on the device and recheck Sync operation.
2. If necessary, test the device on another vehicle with the same version SYNC. If the concern is
still present, the device is the concern. Continue with
normal WSM Diagnostics.
NOTE
PRIVACY MODE MEANS THAT THE PHONE IS CONTROLLING THE AUDIO. SYNC ONLY
MAKES REQUESTS TO THE PHONE TO TRANSFER THIS RESPONSIBILITY OR AUDIO TO
SYNC. IF THE PHONE DOES NOT ACCEPT THIS REQUEST OR THERE IS A PROBLEM IN
THE COMMUNICATION TO MAKE THIS HAPPEN, YOU ARE BY DEFAULT IN PRIVACY MODE.
WARRANTY STATUS: Information Only
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest
for Communications Control Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns
Communications Control Module: Customer Interest SYNC(R) System - Software Update For
Various Concerns
TSB 09-26-8
01/04/10
SYNC SOFTWARE UPDATE - VARIOUS ISSUES
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 9-22-14 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2008 and 2009 SYNC® equipped vehicles may exhibit one or more of the following
symptoms:
^ Universal Serial Bus (USB) port inoperative.
^ USB audio muting when using various non-Apple USB devices.
^ Phone book access difficulty on certain 2-digit phone book entries when using voice commands.
^ Excessive background noise and/or poor voice sound quality.
^ Phone book auto download inoperative on supported devices.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative intermittently.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Reprogram the accessory protocol inter[ace module (APIM) to the following consumer inter[ace
processor (CIP) software levels.
^ 9L3T-14D544-AE (vehicles not equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health Report)
^ 9L2T-14D544-BE (vehicles already equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health
Report)
Service Pack files may be obtained at www.syncmyride.com.
Reprogram the APIM
Contains software fix updates for the following:
^ Phone book auto download inoperative.
^ USB audio muting.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative.
^ Voice recognition on 2-digit entries.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest
for Communications Control Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns >
Page 6764
^ USB port inoperative with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B1342.
^ Poor call sound quality.
This software update also contains enhancements that will improve the reliability of both Bluetooth
and USB connections to SYNC(R) from various consumer devices, and microphone enhancements
to reduce background noise, and will default Vehicle Health Report (if equipped) to off. The
Bluetooth enhancements improve the stability of hands-free calls, call waiting, caller ID, multiple
call handling and other mobile phone features. The USB enhancements improve support for media
players and the playing of file formats and podcasts.
NOTE
REFERENCE OTHER TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETINS (TSB) FOR ADDITIONAL SYNC
SOFTWARE PROGRAMMING TIPS.
1. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
2. Connect the VCM to the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) tool or laptop running IDS software.
3. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
4. Launch IDS tool.
5. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
6. Close the IDS tool.
7. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN & DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO button.
8. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
9. Press read APIM button.
10. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
11. Program both processors in the APIM (Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and CIP).
NOTE
DO NOT USE A MALE-TO-MALE USB DATA TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
a. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software and
to the vehicle USB port.
b. Follow the on-screen instructions to program both processors on the Sync module (VIP and
CIP).
12. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
13. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 08-21-02
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092608A 2008-2009 Edge, Explorer, 0.4 Hr.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest
for Communications Control Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns >
Page 6765
Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac, Focus, Fusion, Milan, MKX, MKZ, Sable, Navigator, Taurus,
Taurus X, 2009 Expedition, Escape, Escape Hybrid, Mariner, Mariner Hybrid, F-150, F-Super Duty,
Flex, MKS: Reprogram The APIM (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest
for Communications Control Module: > 09-14-3 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set
Communications Control Module: Customer Interest SYNC(R) System - Functions
Inoperative/DTC's Set
TSB 09-14-3
07/27/09
SYNC FUNCTIONS INOPERATIVE, DTC U3000-41, U0485, OR U0100, AND/OR BATTERY
DRAW WITH ACCESSORY PROTOCOL INTERFACE MODULE CONNECTED
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Taurus X, Taurus 2008-2010 Fusion 2010 Mustang 2008-2009 Edge,
Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009 Escape Hybrid, Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 Zephyr 2008-2010 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable 2008-2010 Milan 2008-2009 Mountaineer 2009 Mariner Hybrid,
Mariner
ISSUE Some 2008-2010 vehicles equipped with SYNC version 2 software level, SYNC 911 Assist
and Vehicle Health Report, may exhibit all or most of the following symptoms:
^ Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC) U3000-41, U0485, or U0100 in Accessory Protocol Interface
Module (APIM)
^ SYNC display menus/options blank
^ USB port inoperative
^ No SYNC Blue Tooth device connectivity
^ Voice/Phone/OK steering wheel controls inoperative
^ Lack of APIM communication
^ Parasitic battery draw with APIM connected
These symptoms may be triggered by a low battery state of charge, or a recent battery
disconnect/reconnect.
ACTION Follow the service procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
This software upgrade only applies to the following Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and Customer Interface Processor (CIP) software levels:
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AC / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BC
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AD / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BD
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AE / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BD
To determine the current APIM software level, reference the Professional Technician Society (PTS)
website, enter the VIN in OASIS, click the GO
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest
for Communications Control Module: > 09-14-3 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set > Page
6770
button and select the SYNC button.
1. Determine if communication can be established with the APIM using IDS.
a. If communication cannot be verified, proceed to Step 2.
b. If communication is present, proceed to Step 3.
2. Reference Workshop Manual, Section 418-00, Module Communication Network to determine if
communication can be established. If not, perform
an APIM power reset by disconnecting and reconnecting the vehicle battery.
a. If communication is now present, proceed to Step 3.
b. If communication still cannot be established, replace the APIM.
3. Reprogram the APIM to VIP software level 9L2T-14D205-AF by following the Service Procedure.
NOTE
SOFTWARE IS AVAILABLE ONLY THROUGH THE PTS WEBSITE, AND NOT AVAILABLE
THROUGH THE SYNCMYRIDE.COM WEBSITE.
NOTE
CONFIGURATION AND PROGRAMMING REQUIRES THE USE OF A SPECIAL PTS
APPLICATION. INSTALLER MUST HAVE ACCESS TO PTS AND HAVE A VALID PTS USER ID
AND PASSWORD.
a. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
b. Connect the VCM to the IDS tool or laptop running IDS software.
c. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
d. Launch IDS tool.
e. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
f. Close the IDS tool.
g. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN And DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO
button.
h. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
i. Press read APIM button.
j. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMU5B2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT USE A TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
k. Program the processor in the APIM.
l. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMU5B2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software, and to the vehicle USB port.
m. Follow the on-screen instructions to program the VIP module.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest
for Communications Control Module: > 09-14-3 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set > Page
6771
n. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
o. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT091403 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Communications Control Module: > 10-2-8 > Feb > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Defaults To 'Privacy Mode'
Communications Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins SYNC(R) System - Defaults To
'Privacy Mode'
TSB 10-2-8
02/15/10
SYNC SYSTEM DEFAULTS TO OR STAYS IN PRIVACY MODE, MULTIPLE VEHICLE LINES
FORD: 2008-2009 Taurus X 2008-2010 Focus, Fusion, Mustang, Taurus, Edge, Escape,
Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer, F-150, F-250, F-350, F-450 2009-2010 Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2010 MKZ 2009-2010 MKS 2008 Mark LT 2008-2010 MKX, Navigator 2010 MKT
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable 2008-2010 Milan, Mariner, Mountaineer
ISSUE Some customers of 2008-2010 SYNC-equipped vehicles may express concern with their
SYNC paired device defaulting, switching or staying on privacy mode. The customer may not be
able to accept the call through the SYNC system or must answer the call manually on their
personal device.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Set the Privacy mode to Off on the device and recheck Sync operation.
2. If necessary, test the device on another vehicle with the same version SYNC. If the concern is
still present, the device is the concern. Continue with
normal WSM Diagnostics.
NOTE
PRIVACY MODE MEANS THAT THE PHONE IS CONTROLLING THE AUDIO. SYNC ONLY
MAKES REQUESTS TO THE PHONE TO TRANSFER THIS RESPONSIBILITY OR AUDIO TO
SYNC. IF THE PHONE DOES NOT ACCEPT THIS REQUEST OR THERE IS A PROBLEM IN
THE COMMUNICATION TO MAKE THIS HAPPEN, YOU ARE BY DEFAULT IN PRIVACY MODE.
WARRANTY STATUS: Information Only
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Communications Control Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For
Various Concerns
Communications Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins SYNC(R) System - Software
Update For Various Concerns
TSB 09-26-8
01/04/10
SYNC SOFTWARE UPDATE - VARIOUS ISSUES
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 9-22-14 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2008 and 2009 SYNC® equipped vehicles may exhibit one or more of the following
symptoms:
^ Universal Serial Bus (USB) port inoperative.
^ USB audio muting when using various non-Apple USB devices.
^ Phone book access difficulty on certain 2-digit phone book entries when using voice commands.
^ Excessive background noise and/or poor voice sound quality.
^ Phone book auto download inoperative on supported devices.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative intermittently.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Reprogram the accessory protocol inter[ace module (APIM) to the following consumer inter[ace
processor (CIP) software levels.
^ 9L3T-14D544-AE (vehicles not equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health Report)
^ 9L2T-14D544-BE (vehicles already equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health
Report)
Service Pack files may be obtained at www.syncmyride.com.
Reprogram the APIM
Contains software fix updates for the following:
^ Phone book auto download inoperative.
^ USB audio muting.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative.
^ Voice recognition on 2-digit entries.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Communications Control Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For
Various Concerns > Page 6781
^ USB port inoperative with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B1342.
^ Poor call sound quality.
This software update also contains enhancements that will improve the reliability of both Bluetooth
and USB connections to SYNC(R) from various consumer devices, and microphone enhancements
to reduce background noise, and will default Vehicle Health Report (if equipped) to off. The
Bluetooth enhancements improve the stability of hands-free calls, call waiting, caller ID, multiple
call handling and other mobile phone features. The USB enhancements improve support for media
players and the playing of file formats and podcasts.
NOTE
REFERENCE OTHER TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETINS (TSB) FOR ADDITIONAL SYNC
SOFTWARE PROGRAMMING TIPS.
1. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
2. Connect the VCM to the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) tool or laptop running IDS software.
3. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
4. Launch IDS tool.
5. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
6. Close the IDS tool.
7. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN & DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO button.
8. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
9. Press read APIM button.
10. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
11. Program both processors in the APIM (Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and CIP).
NOTE
DO NOT USE A MALE-TO-MALE USB DATA TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
a. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software and
to the vehicle USB port.
b. Follow the on-screen instructions to program both processors on the Sync module (VIP and
CIP).
12. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
13. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 08-21-02
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092608A 2008-2009 Edge, Explorer, 0.4 Hr.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Communications Control Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For
Various Concerns > Page 6782
Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac, Focus, Fusion, Milan, MKX, MKZ, Sable, Navigator, Taurus,
Taurus X, 2009 Expedition, Escape, Escape Hybrid, Mariner, Mariner Hybrid, F-150, F-Super Duty,
Flex, MKS: Reprogram The APIM (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Communications Control Module: > 09-14-3 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions
Inoperative/DTC's Set
Communications Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins SYNC(R) System - Functions
Inoperative/DTC's Set
TSB 09-14-3
07/27/09
SYNC FUNCTIONS INOPERATIVE, DTC U3000-41, U0485, OR U0100, AND/OR BATTERY
DRAW WITH ACCESSORY PROTOCOL INTERFACE MODULE CONNECTED
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Taurus X, Taurus 2008-2010 Fusion 2010 Mustang 2008-2009 Edge,
Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009 Escape Hybrid, Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 Zephyr 2008-2010 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable 2008-2010 Milan 2008-2009 Mountaineer 2009 Mariner Hybrid,
Mariner
ISSUE Some 2008-2010 vehicles equipped with SYNC version 2 software level, SYNC 911 Assist
and Vehicle Health Report, may exhibit all or most of the following symptoms:
^ Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC) U3000-41, U0485, or U0100 in Accessory Protocol Interface
Module (APIM)
^ SYNC display menus/options blank
^ USB port inoperative
^ No SYNC Blue Tooth device connectivity
^ Voice/Phone/OK steering wheel controls inoperative
^ Lack of APIM communication
^ Parasitic battery draw with APIM connected
These symptoms may be triggered by a low battery state of charge, or a recent battery
disconnect/reconnect.
ACTION Follow the service procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
This software upgrade only applies to the following Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and Customer Interface Processor (CIP) software levels:
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AC / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BC
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AD / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BD
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AE / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BD
To determine the current APIM software level, reference the Professional Technician Society (PTS)
website, enter the VIN in OASIS, click the GO
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Communications Control Module: > 09-14-3 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions
Inoperative/DTC's Set > Page 6787
button and select the SYNC button.
1. Determine if communication can be established with the APIM using IDS.
a. If communication cannot be verified, proceed to Step 2.
b. If communication is present, proceed to Step 3.
2. Reference Workshop Manual, Section 418-00, Module Communication Network to determine if
communication can be established. If not, perform
an APIM power reset by disconnecting and reconnecting the vehicle battery.
a. If communication is now present, proceed to Step 3.
b. If communication still cannot be established, replace the APIM.
3. Reprogram the APIM to VIP software level 9L2T-14D205-AF by following the Service Procedure.
NOTE
SOFTWARE IS AVAILABLE ONLY THROUGH THE PTS WEBSITE, AND NOT AVAILABLE
THROUGH THE SYNCMYRIDE.COM WEBSITE.
NOTE
CONFIGURATION AND PROGRAMMING REQUIRES THE USE OF A SPECIAL PTS
APPLICATION. INSTALLER MUST HAVE ACCESS TO PTS AND HAVE A VALID PTS USER ID
AND PASSWORD.
a. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
b. Connect the VCM to the IDS tool or laptop running IDS software.
c. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
d. Launch IDS tool.
e. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
f. Close the IDS tool.
g. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN And DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO
button.
h. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
i. Press read APIM button.
j. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMU5B2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT USE A TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
k. Program the processor in the APIM.
l. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMU5B2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software, and to the vehicle USB port.
m. Follow the on-screen instructions to program the VIP module.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Communications Control Module: > 09-14-3 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions
Inoperative/DTC's Set > Page 6788
n. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
o. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT091403 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Accessory Protocol Interface Module
(APIM)
Communications Control Module: Locations Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Accessory Protocol Interface Module
(APIM) > Page 6791
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Accessory Protocol Interface Module
(APIM) > Page 6792
Communications Control Module: Locations Audio Control Module (ACM)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Accessory Protocol Interface Module
(APIM) > Page 6793
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Accessory Protocol Interface Module
(APIM) > Page 6794
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Accessory Protocol Interface Module
(APIM)
Communications Control Module: Diagrams Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Accessory Protocol Interface Module
(APIM) > Page 6797
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Accessory Protocol Interface Module
(APIM) > Page 6798
Communications Control Module: Diagrams Audio Control Module (ACM)
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Accessory Protocol Interface Module
(APIM) > Page 6799
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Accessory Protocol Interface Module
(APIM) > Page 6800
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Accessory Protocol Interface Module
(APIM) > Page 6801
Communications Control Module: Diagrams Audio Digital Signal Processing (DSP) Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Accessory Protocol Interface Module
(APIM) > Page 6802
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Accessory Protocol Interface Module
(APIM) > Page 6803
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Communications Control Module: Procedures
Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) Software Level Check
Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) Software Level Check
NOTE: This procedure applies to checking the Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
software level. To program the APIM, refer to Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Programming in Information Bus. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control
Systems/Information Bus/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Accessory Protocol
Interface Module (APIM) Programming
1. Turn the Audio Control Module (ACM) on.
2. Connect the scan tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC).
3. Connect one end of the Universal Serial Bus (USB) male-A to male-A cable to the scan tool.
4. Connect the other end of the USB male-A to male-A cable to the vehicle USB port.
5. From the technician service publication website, run On-Line Automotive Service Information
System (OASIS) using Quick Start or by manually
entering the Vehicle Identification Number (VIN).
6. From the OASIS tab, select the "Sync/APIM" bullet.
7. Select the "Read APIM" button to verify the current APIM software level.
- The display shows both the Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and Consumer Interface Processor
(CIP) software levels.
8. The scan tool displays the following information:
- Last Recorded State - Hardware VIN: vehicle identification number associated with the current APIM
- Installed date: date the APIM was installed
- Radio: currently identified ACM in the vehicle
- HW Part No.: APIM hardware part number
- Un-installed date: date (if any) the APIM was uninstalled
- S/N: APIM serial number
- Last Recorded State - Software Date/Time: date and time of last recorded software installation
- VIP: VIP software that was installed at that time
- CIP: CIP software that was installed at that time
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6806
- Description: a description of the content of the software revision
- History - Software Date/Time: date and time of any recorded software installation
- VIP: VIP software that was installed at that time
- CIP: CIP software that was installed at that time
- Description: a description of the content of the software revision
- Available Software for Programming Select: allows the software package to be selected
- Lineage: the original software release, if the software available is a revision
- VIP: VIP software level that is available with the selection
- CIP: CIP software level that is available with the selection
- Description: a description of the content of the software revision
9. Click a CIP software level to view the device compatibility list associated with the CIP software
level, if desired.
10. To exit the APIM software level check, disconnect the scan tool from the DLC and the USB
port, or exit the OASIS screen.
Audio Control Module (ACM) Self-Diagnostic Mode
Audio Control Module (ACM) Self-Diagnostic Mode
Audio Systems Without Navigation
1. Turn the Audio Control Module (ACM) on.
2. Operate the audio system in radio tuner (AM/FM) mode.
3. Press and hold preset buttons 3 and 6 for 3 seconds until the speaker walk test begins.
- The display indicates each speaker as it is tested.
4. NOTE: If the speaker walk test is the only test required, this procedure can be stopped after Step
3 by turning the ACM off.
Before the speaker walk test is complete, carry out any of the following actions:
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6807
5. To exit the self-diagnostic mode, turn the ACM off.
Satellite Digital Audio Receiver System (SDARS) Module Electronic Serial Number (ESN) Retrieval
- Vehicles Without Navigation
1. Operate the audio system in satellite radio mode.
2. Press and hold the AUX button and preset button 1, simultaneously.
- The Satellite Digital Audio Receiver System (SDARS) module Electronic Serial Number (ESN)
displays on the screen.
3. Record the SDARS module ESN.
4. Turn the audio system off.
Audio Systems With Navigation
1. Turn the Audio Control Module (ACM) on.
2. Operate the audio system in radio tuner (AM/FM) mode.
3. Press and hold preset buttons 3 and 6 for 3 seconds until the speaker walk test begins.
- The display indicates each speaker as it is tested.
4. NOTE: If the speaker walk test is the only test required, this procedure can be stopped after this
step, or by allowing the speaker walk test to
complete on its own.
Before the speaker walk test is complete, press the "End Test" selection.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6808
5. The following tests are available through the "BEZEL DIAGNOSTICS" menu:
6. To exit the self-diagnostic mode, press the "Exit Diagnostics" selection from the "BEZEL
DIAGNOSTICS" menu.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6809
Communications Control Module: Removal and Replacement
Audio Digital Signal Processing (DSP) Module
Audio Digital Signal Processing (DSP) Module
Audio Digital Signal Processing (DSP) Module Lower Attachment
Audio DSP Module Upper Attachment
Audio DSP Module Removal Routing
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6810
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: Module configuration is required when a new audio Digital Signal Processing (DSP)
module is being installed.
Upload the audio DSP module configuration information to the scan tool.
2. Remove the Audio Control Module (ACM). For additional information, refer to Audio Control
Module (ACM) See: Audio Control Module
(ACM).
3. Remove the necessary attachments and move the center console 5 cm (2.0 in) towards the rear
of the vehicle.
4. Disconnect the audio DSP module electrical connectors.
5. Remove the 2 lower audio DSP module nuts.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
6. NOTICE: The audio Digital Signal Processing (DSP) module is heavy. Be sure to support the
amplifier during removal, or damage to the
vehicle may occur.
Remove the 2 upper audio DSP module nuts.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
7. Remove the audio DSP module.
- Route the audio DSP module down and towards the passenger side of the vehicle.
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Download the configuration information to the audio DSP module.
Audio Control Module (ACM)
Audio Control Module (ACM)
NOTE: Expedition without navigation shown, all others similar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6811
Removal and Installation
NOTE: It is not necessary to remove the Audio Control Module (ACM) to retrieve the part number.
For additional information, refer to Audio Control Module (ACM) Self-Diagnostic Mode See:
Procedures/Audio Control Module (ACM) Self-Diagnostic Mode.
1. NOTE: Module configuration is required when a new ACM is being installed.
Upload the ACM configuration information to the scan tool.
2. Remove the instrument panel center finish panel.
3. Remove the 4 screws and the ACM.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors and the antenna cable connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Download the configuration information to the ACM.
Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6812
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: It is necessary to record the current Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
software and hardware level when a new APIM is being
installed to make sure that the new component is the same version as the component being
replaced.
Retrieve and record the current APIM software and hardware level. For additional information, refer
to Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM) Software Level Check See: Procedures/Accessory
Protocol Interface Module (APIM) Software Level Check.
2. Remove the front floor console.
3. Remove the 4 APIM screws and position the APIM aside.
4. Disconnect the Universal Serial Bus (USB) cable and the electrical connectors, and remove the
APIM.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- If a new APIM is being installed, program the APIM to the correct software level.
Universal Serial Bus (USB) Cable And Port
Universal Serial Bus (USB) Cable and Port
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the floor console.
2. Remove the rear cupholder trim panel by pulling straight upward to disengage the clips.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Communications Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6813
ERROR: undefined
OFFENDING COMMAND: ‘~
STACK:
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: >
09-14-3 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set
Emergency Contact Module: Customer Interest SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's
Set
TSB 09-14-3
07/27/09
SYNC FUNCTIONS INOPERATIVE, DTC U3000-41, U0485, OR U0100, AND/OR BATTERY
DRAW WITH ACCESSORY PROTOCOL INTERFACE MODULE CONNECTED
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Taurus X, Taurus 2008-2010 Fusion 2010 Mustang 2008-2009 Edge,
Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009 Escape Hybrid, Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 Zephyr 2008-2010 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable 2008-2010 Milan 2008-2009 Mountaineer 2009 Mariner Hybrid,
Mariner
ISSUE Some 2008-2010 vehicles equipped with SYNC version 2 software level, SYNC 911 Assist
and Vehicle Health Report, may exhibit all or most of the following symptoms:
^ Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC) U3000-41, U0485, or U0100 in Accessory Protocol Interface
Module (APIM)
^ SYNC display menus/options blank
^ USB port inoperative
^ No SYNC Blue Tooth device connectivity
^ Voice/Phone/OK steering wheel controls inoperative
^ Lack of APIM communication
^ Parasitic battery draw with APIM connected
These symptoms may be triggered by a low battery state of charge, or a recent battery
disconnect/reconnect.
ACTION Follow the service procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
This software upgrade only applies to the following Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and Customer Interface Processor (CIP) software levels:
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AC / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BC
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AD / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BD
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AE / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BD
To determine the current APIM software level, reference the Professional Technician Society (PTS)
website, enter the VIN in OASIS, click the GO
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: >
09-14-3 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set > Page 6822
button and select the SYNC button.
1. Determine if communication can be established with the APIM using IDS.
a. If communication cannot be verified, proceed to Step 2.
b. If communication is present, proceed to Step 3.
2. Reference Workshop Manual, Section 418-00, Module Communication Network to determine if
communication can be established. If not, perform
an APIM power reset by disconnecting and reconnecting the vehicle battery.
a. If communication is now present, proceed to Step 3.
b. If communication still cannot be established, replace the APIM.
3. Reprogram the APIM to VIP software level 9L2T-14D205-AF by following the Service Procedure.
NOTE
SOFTWARE IS AVAILABLE ONLY THROUGH THE PTS WEBSITE, AND NOT AVAILABLE
THROUGH THE SYNCMYRIDE.COM WEBSITE.
NOTE
CONFIGURATION AND PROGRAMMING REQUIRES THE USE OF A SPECIAL PTS
APPLICATION. INSTALLER MUST HAVE ACCESS TO PTS AND HAVE A VALID PTS USER ID
AND PASSWORD.
a. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
b. Connect the VCM to the IDS tool or laptop running IDS software.
c. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
d. Launch IDS tool.
e. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
f. Close the IDS tool.
g. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN And DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO
button.
h. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
i. Press read APIM button.
j. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMU5B2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT USE A TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
k. Program the processor in the APIM.
l. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMU5B2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software, and to the vehicle USB port.
m. Follow the on-screen instructions to program the VIP module.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: >
09-14-3 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set > Page 6823
n. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
o. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT091403 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: >
09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality
Emergency Contact Module: Customer Interest SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality
TSB 09-13-5
07/13/09
SYNC - CALL SOUND QUALITY/BACKGROUND NOISE ISSUES AND/OR VOICE
RECOGNITION DIFFICULTIES WHILE DRIVING
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape Hybrid, Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner Hybrid, Mariner
ISSUE Some customers of 2008-2009 SYNC equipped vehicles may express concern with their
call sound quality while using the SYNC microphone, complaints of excessive background noise
during a phone call, and/or issues with voice recognition accuracy while driving.
ACTION Follow the service procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The following service procedure involves updating the Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
software level and installing an external alternate SYNC microphone attached to the headliner.
NOTE
THIS PROCEDURE DOES NOT APPLY TO DEALER-INSTALLED SYNC SYSTEMS.
Do not perform Step 1 if vehicle is already equipped with SYNC 2.0 (911 and Vehicle Health
Report) or has been upgraded to consumer interface processor (CIP) level 9L3T-14D544-AE. To
determine the current APIM software level, Refer to the Professional Technician Society (PTS)
website, enter the VIN in OASIS, click the GO button, and select the SYNC button.
1. Reprogram the APIM to CIP software level 9L3T-14D544-AE. For additional information Refer to
other SYNC TSB's and WSM, Section 418-01.
Service Pack files may also be obtained at www.syncmyride.com.
When diagnosing a concern related to voice recognition (VR) difficulties, instruct the customer to
test VR functionality while the vehicle is parked. If customer concerns are still present, this
procedure will not yield an improvement, and the service procedure should not be performed.
Instead, Refer to the SYNC supplement guide and www.syncmyride.com for additional VR tips to
assist customer.
The VR experience can be improved with user training and making improvements to the phone
book entries (longer entries make the system more robust). Ensure the customer does not try to
speak too loud or slow and remove any objects hanging on the rear view mirror as this will reduce
system effectiveness.
When diagnosing a concern related to call sound quality, expect marginal improvements for calls
described as speaking in a tunnel, chamber, etc. Expect substantial improvements for complaints
where the call audio seems to drop out intermittently.
NOTE
THIS REPAIR WILL CHANGE THE APPEARANCE OF THE VEHICLE INTERIOR. REFER TO
THE PHOTOGRAPHS FOR THE APPLICABLE VEHICLE LOCATED IN THIS PROCEDURE. DO
NOT PERFORM THIS REPAIR WITHOUT CUSTOMER APPROVAL PRIOR TO PROCEEDING
WITH MICROPHONE INSTALLATION.
2. Install SYNC microphone service kit. Installing the kit includes mounting an external microphone
directly to the headliner and splicing in a jumper
harness to the vehicle's existing wiring harness. The existing SYNC microphone will no longer be
functional.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: >
09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6828
a. Refer to the appropriate vehicle line and microphone illustration(s) below for microphone
installation and wire splicing locations. Refer to
Wiring Diagram (WD), Section 5-1 for recommended splicing methods.
b. Ensure the SYNC microphone wires are secure and do not interfere with vehicle operation or
functionality.
c. The microphone is directional. Make sure the microphone is always positioned so wire length is
minimized from view. When installing the
microphone adjacent to trim, place microphone as close to trim as possible to help minimize visible
wire.
2008-2009 Edge / MKX
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 1)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable up through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connectors 210 and 211 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for
links to location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C211. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C210.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2009 Escape / Mariner
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: >
09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6829
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration (Figures 2 and 3). Firmly
press the microphone into place. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead
console trim (if equipped), or positioned directly above A-pillar on headliner if not equipped with an
overhead console. Proceed to Step 5 if not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner to
run microphone cable.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 214 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C214. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD182 (BK-GY) from C214.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD1 82 (BK-GY).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
9. Connect the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Navigator / 2009 Expedition
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: >
09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6830
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figures 4 and 5)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim (if equipped), or
positioned directly above A-pillar on headliner if not
equipped with an overhead console.
^ Proceed to Step 5 if not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 298 located behind the dash panel on passenger side. Refer to online
WD, Section 124-1 for links to location and connector
views.
6. Identify circuits VMN07 (GY), RMN07 (VT), and DMN07 (shield - BK) from C298. Cut the three
circuits on the male side of the connector
(17C712 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP31 (BU-OG) and GD133 (BK) from C298 (2008 Navigator only). Identify
circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C298
(2009 Expedition/Navigator only).
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP31 (BU-OG) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK)
for 2008 Navigator only. Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness
wire to GD133 (BK) for 2009 Expedition/Navigator only.
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: >
09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6831
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN07 (GY) and remaining black jumper harness wires to RMN07
(VT) and DMN07 (shield - BK).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Connect the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the headliner.
2008-2009 Explorer / Explorer Sport Trac / Mountaineer
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 6)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner run
microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 248 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify and cut circuits VMNO7 (GY), RMNO7 (VT), and DMNO7 (shield) from C248. Cut the
three circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP05 (YE) and GD143 (BK-VT) from C248.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP05 (YE) and any black jumper harness wire to GD143 (BK-VT).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN07 (GY) and remaining black jumper harness wires to RMN07
(VT) and DMN07 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2009 F-150
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: >
09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6832
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 7)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim or front lamp.
2. Lower the overhead console or front lamp. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional
information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and temporarily tuck excess wire
into headliner to the rear of the console or lamp.
4. Install overhead console or front lamp; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console or
front lamp trim directly behind microphone as
shown.
5. Gain access to connectors 314 and 315 in roof panel near left hand side. Refer to online WD,
Section 124-1 for links to location and connector
views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C314. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14358 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) from C315 and GD133 (BK) from C314.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the headliner.
2009 F-Super Duty
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: >
09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6833
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 8)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
c. This repair is not recommended for vehicles not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 264 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield - BK) from C264. Cut the
three circuits on the female side of the connector
(17K745 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C264.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield - BK).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Connect the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2009 Flex
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: >
09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6834
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 9)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 925 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C925. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector (14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C925.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Focus
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: >
09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6835
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration (Figure 10). Firmly press
the microphone into place. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to the dome lamp trim.
2. Lower the dome lamp assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable up through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger
side A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop
headliner to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install dome lamp assembly; ensure microphone cable enters the dome lamp trim directly behind
microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 934 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD for location and connector
views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C934. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CPL60 (BN-YE) and GD161 (BK-YE) from C934.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CPL60 (BN-YE) and any black jumper harness wire to GD161
(BK-YE).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Fusion / Milan / MKZ
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: >
09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6836
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 11)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 913 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C913. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP02 (GN) and GD139 (BK-YE) from C913.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP02 (GN) and any black jumper harness wire to GD139 (BK-YE).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Taurus / Sable / Taurus X
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 12)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner to
run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: >
09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6837
5. Gain access to connector 925 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMN02 (WH-BN), RMN02 (VT-BN), and DMN07 (shield) from C925. Cut the
three circuits on the female side of the connector
(17K745 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C925.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN02 (WH-BN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMN02 (VT-BN) and DMN07 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2009 MKS
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 13)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and out the front of the headliner
above the rear view mirror.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 911 at the rear view mirror. Refer to the online WD, Section 124-1 for
links to location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMNO2 (WH-BN), RMN02 (VT-BN), and DMN07 (shield) from C911. Pull back
the black harness sleeve and cut the three
circuits near C91 1 or if equipped with a headlamp control module-2 (HCM-2), remove the HCM-2
access cover and cut circuits under trim cover. Refer to WSM, Section 417-01 for additional
information.
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C911.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: >
09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page 6838
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN02 (WH-BN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMN02 (VT-BN) and DMN07 (shield).
^ Only splice into the wires heading away from the connector. The wires heading into the connector
(mirror) are no longer used.
^ Ensure the wiring is neatly routed from the splice locations into the headliner, following the
existing wire harness routing from mirror to headliner.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 08-21-2
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT091305 Claim Diagnosis And Labor Actual
Performed As Actual Time. Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
17700 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-14-3 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins SYNC(R) System - Functions
Inoperative/DTC's Set
TSB 09-14-3
07/27/09
SYNC FUNCTIONS INOPERATIVE, DTC U3000-41, U0485, OR U0100, AND/OR BATTERY
DRAW WITH ACCESSORY PROTOCOL INTERFACE MODULE CONNECTED
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Taurus X, Taurus 2008-2010 Fusion 2010 Mustang 2008-2009 Edge,
Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009 Escape Hybrid, Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 Zephyr 2008-2010 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Sable 2008-2010 Milan 2008-2009 Mountaineer 2009 Mariner Hybrid,
Mariner
ISSUE Some 2008-2010 vehicles equipped with SYNC version 2 software level, SYNC 911 Assist
and Vehicle Health Report, may exhibit all or most of the following symptoms:
^ Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC) U3000-41, U0485, or U0100 in Accessory Protocol Interface
Module (APIM)
^ SYNC display menus/options blank
^ USB port inoperative
^ No SYNC Blue Tooth device connectivity
^ Voice/Phone/OK steering wheel controls inoperative
^ Lack of APIM communication
^ Parasitic battery draw with APIM connected
These symptoms may be triggered by a low battery state of charge, or a recent battery
disconnect/reconnect.
ACTION Follow the service procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
This software upgrade only applies to the following Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and Customer Interface Processor (CIP) software levels:
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AC / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BC
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AD / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BD
^ VIP: 9L2T-14D205-AE / CIP: 9L2T-14D544-BD
To determine the current APIM software level, reference the Professional Technician Society (PTS)
website, enter the VIN in OASIS, click the GO
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-14-3 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set >
Page 6844
button and select the SYNC button.
1. Determine if communication can be established with the APIM using IDS.
a. If communication cannot be verified, proceed to Step 2.
b. If communication is present, proceed to Step 3.
2. Reference Workshop Manual, Section 418-00, Module Communication Network to determine if
communication can be established. If not, perform
an APIM power reset by disconnecting and reconnecting the vehicle battery.
a. If communication is now present, proceed to Step 3.
b. If communication still cannot be established, replace the APIM.
3. Reprogram the APIM to VIP software level 9L2T-14D205-AF by following the Service Procedure.
NOTE
SOFTWARE IS AVAILABLE ONLY THROUGH THE PTS WEBSITE, AND NOT AVAILABLE
THROUGH THE SYNCMYRIDE.COM WEBSITE.
NOTE
CONFIGURATION AND PROGRAMMING REQUIRES THE USE OF A SPECIAL PTS
APPLICATION. INSTALLER MUST HAVE ACCESS TO PTS AND HAVE A VALID PTS USER ID
AND PASSWORD.
a. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
b. Connect the VCM to the IDS tool or laptop running IDS software.
c. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
d. Launch IDS tool.
e. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
f. Close the IDS tool.
g. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN And DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO
button.
h. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
i. Press read APIM button.
j. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMU5B2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT USE A TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
k. Program the processor in the APIM.
l. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMU5B2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software, and to the vehicle USB port.
m. Follow the on-screen instructions to program the VIP module.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-14-3 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Functions Inoperative/DTC's Set >
Page 6845
n. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
o. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT091403 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone
Sound Quality
TSB 09-13-5
07/13/09
SYNC - CALL SOUND QUALITY/BACKGROUND NOISE ISSUES AND/OR VOICE
RECOGNITION DIFFICULTIES WHILE DRIVING
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape Hybrid, Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner Hybrid, Mariner
ISSUE Some customers of 2008-2009 SYNC equipped vehicles may express concern with their
call sound quality while using the SYNC microphone, complaints of excessive background noise
during a phone call, and/or issues with voice recognition accuracy while driving.
ACTION Follow the service procedure to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The following service procedure involves updating the Accessory Protocol Interface Module (APIM)
software level and installing an external alternate SYNC microphone attached to the headliner.
NOTE
THIS PROCEDURE DOES NOT APPLY TO DEALER-INSTALLED SYNC SYSTEMS.
Do not perform Step 1 if vehicle is already equipped with SYNC 2.0 (911 and Vehicle Health
Report) or has been upgraded to consumer interface processor (CIP) level 9L3T-14D544-AE. To
determine the current APIM software level, Refer to the Professional Technician Society (PTS)
website, enter the VIN in OASIS, click the GO button, and select the SYNC button.
1. Reprogram the APIM to CIP software level 9L3T-14D544-AE. For additional information Refer to
other SYNC TSB's and WSM, Section 418-01.
Service Pack files may also be obtained at www.syncmyride.com.
When diagnosing a concern related to voice recognition (VR) difficulties, instruct the customer to
test VR functionality while the vehicle is parked. If customer concerns are still present, this
procedure will not yield an improvement, and the service procedure should not be performed.
Instead, Refer to the SYNC supplement guide and www.syncmyride.com for additional VR tips to
assist customer.
The VR experience can be improved with user training and making improvements to the phone
book entries (longer entries make the system more robust). Ensure the customer does not try to
speak too loud or slow and remove any objects hanging on the rear view mirror as this will reduce
system effectiveness.
When diagnosing a concern related to call sound quality, expect marginal improvements for calls
described as speaking in a tunnel, chamber, etc. Expect substantial improvements for complaints
where the call audio seems to drop out intermittently.
NOTE
THIS REPAIR WILL CHANGE THE APPEARANCE OF THE VEHICLE INTERIOR. REFER TO
THE PHOTOGRAPHS FOR THE APPLICABLE VEHICLE LOCATED IN THIS PROCEDURE. DO
NOT PERFORM THIS REPAIR WITHOUT CUSTOMER APPROVAL PRIOR TO PROCEEDING
WITH MICROPHONE INSTALLATION.
2. Install SYNC microphone service kit. Installing the kit includes mounting an external microphone
directly to the headliner and splicing in a jumper
harness to the vehicle's existing wiring harness. The existing SYNC microphone will no longer be
functional.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page
6850
a. Refer to the appropriate vehicle line and microphone illustration(s) below for microphone
installation and wire splicing locations. Refer to
Wiring Diagram (WD), Section 5-1 for recommended splicing methods.
b. Ensure the SYNC microphone wires are secure and do not interfere with vehicle operation or
functionality.
c. The microphone is directional. Make sure the microphone is always positioned so wire length is
minimized from view. When installing the
microphone adjacent to trim, place microphone as close to trim as possible to help minimize visible
wire.
2008-2009 Edge / MKX
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 1)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable up through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connectors 210 and 211 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for
links to location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C211. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C210.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2009 Escape / Mariner
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page
6851
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration (Figures 2 and 3). Firmly
press the microphone into place. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead
console trim (if equipped), or positioned directly above A-pillar on headliner if not equipped with an
overhead console. Proceed to Step 5 if not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner to
run microphone cable.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 214 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C214. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD182 (BK-GY) from C214.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD1 82 (BK-GY).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
9. Connect the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Navigator / 2009 Expedition
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page
6852
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figures 4 and 5)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim (if equipped), or
positioned directly above A-pillar on headliner if not
equipped with an overhead console.
^ Proceed to Step 5 if not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 298 located behind the dash panel on passenger side. Refer to online
WD, Section 124-1 for links to location and connector
views.
6. Identify circuits VMN07 (GY), RMN07 (VT), and DMN07 (shield - BK) from C298. Cut the three
circuits on the male side of the connector
(17C712 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP31 (BU-OG) and GD133 (BK) from C298 (2008 Navigator only). Identify
circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C298
(2009 Expedition/Navigator only).
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP31 (BU-OG) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK)
for 2008 Navigator only. Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness
wire to GD133 (BK) for 2009 Expedition/Navigator only.
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page
6853
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN07 (GY) and remaining black jumper harness wires to RMN07
(VT) and DMN07 (shield - BK).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Connect the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the headliner.
2008-2009 Explorer / Explorer Sport Trac / Mountaineer
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 6)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner run
microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 248 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify and cut circuits VMNO7 (GY), RMNO7 (VT), and DMNO7 (shield) from C248. Cut the
three circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP05 (YE) and GD143 (BK-VT) from C248.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP05 (YE) and any black jumper harness wire to GD143 (BK-VT).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN07 (GY) and remaining black jumper harness wires to RMN07
(VT) and DMN07 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
cut wire ends heading up the A-pillar as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2009 F-150
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page
6854
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the
microphone. (Figure 7)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim or front lamp.
2. Lower the overhead console or front lamp. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional
information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and temporarily tuck excess wire
into headliner to the rear of the console or lamp.
4. Install overhead console or front lamp; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console or
front lamp trim directly behind microphone as
shown.
5. Gain access to connectors 314 and 315 in roof panel near left hand side. Refer to online WD,
Section 124-1 for links to location and connector
views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C314. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14358 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) from C315 and GD133 (BK) from C314.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the headliner.
2009 F-Super Duty
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page
6855
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 8)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
c. This repair is not recommended for vehicles not equipped with an overhead console.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 264 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield - BK) from C264. Cut the
three circuits on the female side of the connector
(17K745 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C264.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield - BK).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Connect the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2009 Flex
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page
6856
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 9)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 925 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C925. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector (14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C925.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Focus
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page
6857
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration (Figure 10). Firmly press
the microphone into place. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to the dome lamp trim.
2. Lower the dome lamp assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable up through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger
side A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop
headliner to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install dome lamp assembly; ensure microphone cable enters the dome lamp trim directly behind
microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 934 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD for location and connector
views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C934. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CPL60 (BN-YE) and GD161 (BK-YE) from C934.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CPL60 (BN-YE) and any black jumper harness wire to GD161
(BK-YE).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable over the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Fusion / Milan / MKZ
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page
6858
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 11)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the passenger side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner
to run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 913 in the right A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMM13 (YE-GN), RMM13 (BU), and DMM13 (shield) from C913. Cut the three
circuits on the female side of the connector
(14334 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP02 (GN) and GD139 (BK-YE) from C913.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP02 (GN) and any black jumper harness wire to GD139 (BK-YE).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMM13 (YE-GN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMM13 (BU) and DMM13 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2008-2009 Taurus / Sable / Taurus X
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 12)
^ Firmly press the microphone into place.
^ Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and over to the driver side
A-pillar. It may be necessary to slightly drop headliner to
run microphone cable. Refer to WSM, Section 501-05 for additional information.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page
6859
5. Gain access to connector 925 in the left A-pillar. Refer to online WD, Section 124-1 for links to
location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMN02 (WH-BN), RMN02 (VT-BN), and DMN07 (shield) from C925. Cut the
three circuits on the female side of the connector
(17K745 harness).
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C925.
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN02 (WH-BN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMN02 (VT-BN) and DMN07 (shield).
^ Only splice into the cut wires heading in the direction of the connector. Tape off and secure the
other cut wire ends as they are no longer used.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
2009 MKS
1. Remove the protective backing from the adhesive on the microphone and attach the microphone
as shown in the illustration. (Figure 13)
a. Firmly press the microphone into place.
b. Ensure the microphone is parallel and adjacent to overhead console trim.
2. Lower the overhead console. Refer to WSM, Section 417-02 for additional information.
3. Route microphone cable through existing hole in the headliner, and out the front of the headliner
above the rear view mirror.
4. Install overhead console; ensure microphone cable enters the overhead console trim directly
behind microphone as shown.
5. Gain access to connector 911 at the rear view mirror. Refer to the online WD, Section 124-1 for
links to location and connector views.
6. Identify circuits VMNO2 (WH-BN), RMN02 (VT-BN), and DMN07 (shield) from C911. Pull back
the black harness sleeve and cut the three
circuits near C91 1 or if equipped with a headlamp control module-2 (HCM-2), remove the HCM-2
access cover and cut circuits under trim cover. Refer to WSM, Section 417-01 for additional
information.
7. Identify circuits CBP41 (BU) and GD133 (BK) from C911.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-13-5 > Jul > 09 > SYNC(R) System - Poor Cell Phone Sound Quality > Page
6860
8. Splice the five jumper harness wires into the following circuits:
^ Blue jumper harness wire to CBP41 (BU) and any black jumper harness wire to GD133 (BK).
^ Ensure original circuits remain connected in splice.
^ Yellow jumper harness wire to VMN02 (WH-BN) and remaining black jumper harness wires to
RMN02 (VT-BN) and DMN07 (shield).
^ Only splice into the wires heading away from the connector. The wires heading into the connector
(mirror) are no longer used.
^ Ensure the wiring is neatly routed from the splice locations into the headliner, following the
existing wire harness routing from mirror to headliner.
9. Attach the microphone connector to the jumper harness connector.
10. Bundle and tuck the remainder of the microphone cable above the front of the headliner.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 08-21-2
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT091305 Claim Diagnosis And Labor Actual
Performed As Actual Time. Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
17700 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-11-8 > Jun > 09 > SYNC(R) System - 911 Assist VHR Software Upgrade
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins SYNC(R) System - 911 Assist VHR
Software Upgrade
TSB 09-11-8
06/15/09
SYNC WITH 911 ASSIST AND VEHICLE HEALTH REPORT (VHR) DEALER UPGRADE
SOFTWARE
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape Hybrid, Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner Hybrid, Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 9-5-4 to update the Service Procedure and add a production fix date.
ISSUE Some customers with 2008 or 2009 vehicles equipped with SYNC may request the 911
assist and vehicle health report (VHR) service upgrade installation. This software upgrade is not a
warrantable repair. Software is available only through professional technician society (PTS)
website, and not available through the syncmyride.com website.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to upgrade the SYNC software.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
This software upgrade applies only to the following vehicle model years and build dates:
^ 2008-2009 Focus built before 1/20/2009
^ 2008-2009 Explorer, Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer built before 1/12/2009
^ 2008-2009 Edge, MKX, and 2009 Flex, Escape, Mariner built before 12/4/2008
^ 2008-2009 Taurus, Taurus X, Sable, and 2009 F-Super Duty, MKS, F-150 built before 12/1/2008
^ 2008-2009 Fusion, Milan, MKZ
Vehicles built on or after these dates are already equipped with the 911 Assist/Vehicle Health
Report features and do not require updating.
To determine if the vehicles are within these build ranges or have already been upgraded to SYNC
911 Assist/VHR, access the Professional Technician Society (PTS) website, run OASIS by
pressing the Read VIN and DTC's button, and click on the SYNC tab. If the description box
indicates 911 and Vehicle Health Report, vehicle has been upgraded.
The 911 assist with VHR upgrade automatically reprograms the accessory protocol interface
module (APIM), instrument cluster (IC), and restraints control module (RCM).
The VHR applies only to United States (US) vehicles, 911 assist is for US and Canadian vehicles
operated within the US and Canada.
Performing this upgrade may result in some untested devices losing certain functionality, such as
bluetooth connection and phonebook download. Before continuing with this upgrade, make sure
the customer's device is listed on the compatibility matrix. It is strongly recommended to pair the
device to another vehicle currently equipped with 911 Assist/Vehicle Health Report to ensure
proper functionality before continuing.
Configuration and programming requires the use of IDS and a special PTS application. Installer
must have access to PTS and have a valid PTS user ID and password. Ensure the IDS is at the
latest software version.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-11-8 > Jun > 09 > SYNC(R) System - 911 Assist VHR Software Upgrade >
Page 6865
For additional programming tips, dealer network setting requirements, and possible error states
related to 911 Assist and VHR upgrades, reference the latest information on the Professional
Technician Society (PTS) website.
1. When updating 2008-2009 Explorer, Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac, Expedition, or Navigator
vehicles, it is necessary to manually record and
reenter the Oil Life % Value as displayed on the message center. Record the current oil life before
updating 911 Assist/VHR, and reenter using the message center once programming is complete.
2. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
3. Connect the VCM to the IDS tool or laptop running IDS software.
4. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
5. Launch IDS tool but do not start a new session.
6. If required, update the VCM with the latest IDS release 59.9 and higher.
7. Close the IDS tool.
8. From the P15 website, run OASIS by pressing the read VIN and DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the go button.
9. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, select the Upgrade/Mods tab.
10. Once correct vehicle is chosen, select SYNC upgrade with 911 Assist/VHR.
11. Follow the on-screen instructions to program the APIM, IC, and RCM.
NOTE
TO COMPLETE THE UPGRADE PROCESS PERFORM THE FOLLOWING STEPS TO CONFIRM
THE VEHICLE HAS BEEN CORRECTLY CONFIGURED TO HAVE THESE FEATURES. FAILING
TO COMPLETE THE STEPS BELOW MAY RESULT IN 911 ASSIST/VHR NOT DISPLAYING ON
THE SYNC MENU.
12. Set ignition to off.
13. Open and close driver side door.
14. Set ignition to on.
15. Follow applicable instructions (see below) to ensure 911 Assist/VHR appear on Sync menu.
16. Close all Internet Explorer browser windows.
17. Clear all DTC's on all modules.
18. Reenter the Oil Life % Value for 2008-2009 Explorer, Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac,
Expedition, or Navigator vehicles.
Navigation Radio Instructions
911 Assist/VHR feature confirmation.
1. Press phone button on the Navigation LCD to enter phone menu.
2. Press cancel when pop-up menu appears on Navigation LCD display.
3. Press settings soft key on Navigation LCD display.
4. Press advanced soft key on Navigation LCD display.
5. Verify 911 Assist/VHR is in menu in Navigation LCD display.
Non Navigation Radio Instructions
911 Assist/VHR feature confirmation.
1. Press phone button on steering wheel.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-11-8 > Jun > 09 > SYNC(R) System - 911 Assist VHR Software Upgrade >
Page 6866
2. Press left arrow on steering wheel until return is displayed on radio screen, then press ok.
3. Press left arrow on steering wheel until return is displayed on radio screen, then press ok.
4. Press left arrow until 911 Assist/VHR is displayed.
Once 911 Assist/VHR installation is complete, the customer will need to reload their phone book if
that application is desired.
NOTE
IF SERVICE IS REQUIRED ON 2008 OR 2009 EARLY BUILT VEHICLES UPGRADED TO 911
ASSIST/VHR, REFERENCE THE APPLICABLE 2009 WORKSHOP MANUAL AND FOLLOW THE
V2 DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURES.
WARRANTY STATUS: Information Only - Not Warrantable
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-11-8 > Jun > 09 > SYNC(R) System - 911 Assist VHR Software Upgrade
Emergency Contact Module: All Technical Service Bulletins SYNC(R) System - 911 Assist VHR
Software Upgrade
TSB 09-11-8
06/15/09
SYNC WITH 911 ASSIST AND VEHICLE HEALTH REPORT (VHR) DEALER UPGRADE
SOFTWARE
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape Hybrid, Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner Hybrid, Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 9-5-4 to update the Service Procedure and add a production fix date.
ISSUE Some customers with 2008 or 2009 vehicles equipped with SYNC may request the 911
assist and vehicle health report (VHR) service upgrade installation. This software upgrade is not a
warrantable repair. Software is available only through professional technician society (PTS)
website, and not available through the syncmyride.com website.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to upgrade the SYNC software.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
This software upgrade applies only to the following vehicle model years and build dates:
^ 2008-2009 Focus built before 1/20/2009
^ 2008-2009 Explorer, Explorer Sport Trac, Mountaineer built before 1/12/2009
^ 2008-2009 Edge, MKX, and 2009 Flex, Escape, Mariner built before 12/4/2008
^ 2008-2009 Taurus, Taurus X, Sable, and 2009 F-Super Duty, MKS, F-150 built before 12/1/2008
^ 2008-2009 Fusion, Milan, MKZ
Vehicles built on or after these dates are already equipped with the 911 Assist/Vehicle Health
Report features and do not require updating.
To determine if the vehicles are within these build ranges or have already been upgraded to SYNC
911 Assist/VHR, access the Professional Technician Society (PTS) website, run OASIS by
pressing the Read VIN and DTC's button, and click on the SYNC tab. If the description box
indicates 911 and Vehicle Health Report, vehicle has been upgraded.
The 911 assist with VHR upgrade automatically reprograms the accessory protocol interface
module (APIM), instrument cluster (IC), and restraints control module (RCM).
The VHR applies only to United States (US) vehicles, 911 assist is for US and Canadian vehicles
operated within the US and Canada.
Performing this upgrade may result in some untested devices losing certain functionality, such as
bluetooth connection and phonebook download. Before continuing with this upgrade, make sure
the customer's device is listed on the compatibility matrix. It is strongly recommended to pair the
device to another vehicle currently equipped with 911 Assist/Vehicle Health Report to ensure
proper functionality before continuing.
Configuration and programming requires the use of IDS and a special PTS application. Installer
must have access to PTS and have a valid PTS user ID and password. Ensure the IDS is at the
latest software version.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-11-8 > Jun > 09 > SYNC(R) System - 911 Assist VHR Software Upgrade >
Page 6872
For additional programming tips, dealer network setting requirements, and possible error states
related to 911 Assist and VHR upgrades, reference the latest information on the Professional
Technician Society (PTS) website.
1. When updating 2008-2009 Explorer, Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac, Expedition, or Navigator
vehicles, it is necessary to manually record and
reenter the Oil Life % Value as displayed on the message center. Record the current oil life before
updating 911 Assist/VHR, and reenter using the message center once programming is complete.
2. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
3. Connect the VCM to the IDS tool or laptop running IDS software.
4. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
5. Launch IDS tool but do not start a new session.
6. If required, update the VCM with the latest IDS release 59.9 and higher.
7. Close the IDS tool.
8. From the P15 website, run OASIS by pressing the read VIN and DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the go button.
9. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, select the Upgrade/Mods tab.
10. Once correct vehicle is chosen, select SYNC upgrade with 911 Assist/VHR.
11. Follow the on-screen instructions to program the APIM, IC, and RCM.
NOTE
TO COMPLETE THE UPGRADE PROCESS PERFORM THE FOLLOWING STEPS TO CONFIRM
THE VEHICLE HAS BEEN CORRECTLY CONFIGURED TO HAVE THESE FEATURES. FAILING
TO COMPLETE THE STEPS BELOW MAY RESULT IN 911 ASSIST/VHR NOT DISPLAYING ON
THE SYNC MENU.
12. Set ignition to off.
13. Open and close driver side door.
14. Set ignition to on.
15. Follow applicable instructions (see below) to ensure 911 Assist/VHR appear on Sync menu.
16. Close all Internet Explorer browser windows.
17. Clear all DTC's on all modules.
18. Reenter the Oil Life % Value for 2008-2009 Explorer, Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac,
Expedition, or Navigator vehicles.
Navigation Radio Instructions
911 Assist/VHR feature confirmation.
1. Press phone button on the Navigation LCD to enter phone menu.
2. Press cancel when pop-up menu appears on Navigation LCD display.
3. Press settings soft key on Navigation LCD display.
4. Press advanced soft key on Navigation LCD display.
5. Verify 911 Assist/VHR is in menu in Navigation LCD display.
Non Navigation Radio Instructions
911 Assist/VHR feature confirmation.
1. Press phone button on steering wheel.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Emergency Contact Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service
Bulletins for Emergency Contact Module: > 09-11-8 > Jun > 09 > SYNC(R) System - 911 Assist VHR Software Upgrade >
Page 6873
2. Press left arrow on steering wheel until return is displayed on radio screen, then press ok.
3. Press left arrow on steering wheel until return is displayed on radio screen, then press ok.
4. Press left arrow until 911 Assist/VHR is displayed.
Once 911 Assist/VHR installation is complete, the customer will need to reload their phone book if
that application is desired.
NOTE
IF SERVICE IS REQUIRED ON 2008 OR 2009 EARLY BUILT VEHICLES UPGRADED TO 911
ASSIST/VHR, REFERENCE THE APPLICABLE 2009 WORKSHOP MANUAL AND FOLLOW THE
V2 DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURES.
WARRANTY STATUS: Information Only - Not Warrantable
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest for Entertainment System Control Module: > 10-9-7 > May > 10 > Audio System - Unexpected CD Shuffle With Key
Off
Entertainment System Control Module: Customer Interest Audio System - Unexpected CD Shuffle
With Key Off
TSB 10-9-7
05/24/10
UNEXPECTED COMPACT DISC SHUFFLE OR CYCLING DURING NORMAL RADIO
OPERATION OR WITH THE KEY OFF - NON-NAVIGATION RADIOS ONLY
FORD: 2008-2010 Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer
MERCURY: 2008-2010 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some 2008-2010 Expedition, Explorer, Explorer Sport Trac and Mountaineer vehicles
equipped with a non-navigation CD-6 Audio Control Module (ACM) may experience an unexpected
Compact Disc (CD) shuffle or cycling during start up, during normal ACM operation, or shutting off
the vehicle.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
This service procedure affects non-navigation radios only. If you attempt to run module
reprogramming on the 2008-2010 ACM and the service tool does not recognize the part numbers
of the ACM currently installed, this procedure does not apply.
Reprogram the ACM to the latest calibration using IDS release 66.05A and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010. Version A DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained
at the website.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100907A 2008-2010 Expedition, 0.3 Hr.
Explorer, Mountaineer, And Explorer Sport Trac: Reprogram The Audio Control Module (Do Not
Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Entertainment System Control Module: > 10-9-7 > May > 10 > Audio System - Unexpected CD Shuffle
With Key Off
Entertainment System Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Audio System - Unexpected
CD Shuffle With Key Off
TSB 10-9-7
05/24/10
UNEXPECTED COMPACT DISC SHUFFLE OR CYCLING DURING NORMAL RADIO
OPERATION OR WITH THE KEY OFF - NON-NAVIGATION RADIOS ONLY
FORD: 2008-2010 Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer
MERCURY: 2008-2010 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some 2008-2010 Expedition, Explorer, Explorer Sport Trac and Mountaineer vehicles
equipped with a non-navigation CD-6 Audio Control Module (ACM) may experience an unexpected
Compact Disc (CD) shuffle or cycling during start up, during normal ACM operation, or shutting off
the vehicle.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
This service procedure affects non-navigation radios only. If you attempt to run module
reprogramming on the 2008-2010 ACM and the service tool does not recognize the part numbers
of the ACM currently installed, this procedure does not apply.
Reprogram the ACM to the latest calibration using IDS release 66.05A and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010. Version A DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained
at the website.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100907A 2008-2010 Expedition, 0.3 Hr.
Explorer, Mountaineer, And Explorer Sport Trac: Reprogram The Audio Control Module (Do Not
Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Rear Entertainment Module
(RETM)
Entertainment System Control Module: Locations Rear Entertainment Module (RETM)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Rear Entertainment Module
(RETM) > Page 6889
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Rear Entertainment Module
(RETM) > Page 6890
Entertainment System Control Module: Locations Audio Rear Control Unit (RCU) Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Rear Entertainment Module
(RETM) > Page 6891
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Rear Entertainment Module
(RETM)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Rear Entertainment Module
(RETM) > Page 6894
Entertainment System Control Module: Diagrams Audio Rear Control Unit (RCU) Module
Part 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Entertainment System Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Rear Entertainment Module
(RETM) > Page 6895
Part 2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Global Positioning System Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest for Global Positioning System Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various
Concerns
Global Positioning System Module: Customer Interest SYNC(R) System - Software Update For
Various Concerns
TSB 09-26-8
01/04/10
SYNC SOFTWARE UPDATE - VARIOUS ISSUES
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 9-22-14 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2008 and 2009 SYNC® equipped vehicles may exhibit one or more of the following
symptoms:
^ Universal Serial Bus (USB) port inoperative.
^ USB audio muting when using various non-Apple USB devices.
^ Phone book access difficulty on certain 2-digit phone book entries when using voice commands.
^ Excessive background noise and/or poor voice sound quality.
^ Phone book auto download inoperative on supported devices.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative intermittently.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Reprogram the accessory protocol inter[ace module (APIM) to the following consumer inter[ace
processor (CIP) software levels.
^ 9L3T-14D544-AE (vehicles not equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health Report)
^ 9L2T-14D544-BE (vehicles already equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health
Report)
Service Pack files may be obtained at www.syncmyride.com.
Reprogram the APIM
Contains software fix updates for the following:
^ Phone book auto download inoperative.
^ USB audio muting.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative.
^ Voice recognition on 2-digit entries.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Global Positioning System Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest for Global Positioning System Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various
Concerns > Page 6904
^ USB port inoperative with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B1342.
^ Poor call sound quality.
This software update also contains enhancements that will improve the reliability of both Bluetooth
and USB connections to SYNC(R) from various consumer devices, and microphone enhancements
to reduce background noise, and will default Vehicle Health Report (if equipped) to off. The
Bluetooth enhancements improve the stability of hands-free calls, call waiting, caller ID, multiple
call handling and other mobile phone features. The USB enhancements improve support for media
players and the playing of file formats and podcasts.
NOTE
REFERENCE OTHER TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETINS (TSB) FOR ADDITIONAL SYNC
SOFTWARE PROGRAMMING TIPS.
1. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
2. Connect the VCM to the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) tool or laptop running IDS software.
3. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
4. Launch IDS tool.
5. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
6. Close the IDS tool.
7. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN & DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO button.
8. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
9. Press read APIM button.
10. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
11. Program both processors in the APIM (Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and CIP).
NOTE
DO NOT USE A MALE-TO-MALE USB DATA TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
a. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software and
to the vehicle USB port.
b. Follow the on-screen instructions to program both processors on the Sync module (VIP and
CIP).
12. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
13. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 08-21-02
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092608A 2008-2009 Edge, Explorer, 0.4 Hr.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Global Positioning System Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest for Global Positioning System Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various
Concerns > Page 6905
Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac, Focus, Fusion, Milan, MKX, MKZ, Sable, Navigator, Taurus,
Taurus X, 2009 Expedition, Escape, Escape Hybrid, Mariner, Mariner Hybrid, F-150, F-Super Duty,
Flex, MKS: Reprogram The APIM (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Global Positioning System Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Global Positioning System Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For
Various Concerns
Global Positioning System Module: All Technical Service Bulletins SYNC(R) System - Software
Update For Various Concerns
TSB 09-26-8
01/04/10
SYNC SOFTWARE UPDATE - VARIOUS ISSUES
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 9-22-14 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2008 and 2009 SYNC® equipped vehicles may exhibit one or more of the following
symptoms:
^ Universal Serial Bus (USB) port inoperative.
^ USB audio muting when using various non-Apple USB devices.
^ Phone book access difficulty on certain 2-digit phone book entries when using voice commands.
^ Excessive background noise and/or poor voice sound quality.
^ Phone book auto download inoperative on supported devices.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative intermittently.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Reprogram the accessory protocol inter[ace module (APIM) to the following consumer inter[ace
processor (CIP) software levels.
^ 9L3T-14D544-AE (vehicles not equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health Report)
^ 9L2T-14D544-BE (vehicles already equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health
Report)
Service Pack files may be obtained at www.syncmyride.com.
Reprogram the APIM
Contains software fix updates for the following:
^ Phone book auto download inoperative.
^ USB audio muting.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative.
^ Voice recognition on 2-digit entries.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Global Positioning System Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Global Positioning System Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For
Various Concerns > Page 6911
^ USB port inoperative with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B1342.
^ Poor call sound quality.
This software update also contains enhancements that will improve the reliability of both Bluetooth
and USB connections to SYNC(R) from various consumer devices, and microphone enhancements
to reduce background noise, and will default Vehicle Health Report (if equipped) to off. The
Bluetooth enhancements improve the stability of hands-free calls, call waiting, caller ID, multiple
call handling and other mobile phone features. The USB enhancements improve support for media
players and the playing of file formats and podcasts.
NOTE
REFERENCE OTHER TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETINS (TSB) FOR ADDITIONAL SYNC
SOFTWARE PROGRAMMING TIPS.
1. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
2. Connect the VCM to the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) tool or laptop running IDS software.
3. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
4. Launch IDS tool.
5. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
6. Close the IDS tool.
7. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN & DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO button.
8. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
9. Press read APIM button.
10. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
11. Program both processors in the APIM (Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and CIP).
NOTE
DO NOT USE A MALE-TO-MALE USB DATA TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
a. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software and
to the vehicle USB port.
b. Follow the on-screen instructions to program both processors on the Sync module (VIP and
CIP).
12. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
13. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 08-21-02
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092608A 2008-2009 Edge, Explorer, 0.4 Hr.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Global Positioning System Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Global Positioning System Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For
Various Concerns > Page 6912
Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac, Focus, Fusion, Milan, MKX, MKZ, Sable, Navigator, Taurus,
Taurus X, 2009 Expedition, Escape, Escape Hybrid, Mariner, Mariner Hybrid, F-150, F-Super Duty,
Flex, MKS: Reprogram The APIM (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Navigation Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Navigation
Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns
Navigation Module: Customer Interest SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns
TSB 09-26-8
01/04/10
SYNC SOFTWARE UPDATE - VARIOUS ISSUES
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 9-22-14 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2008 and 2009 SYNC® equipped vehicles may exhibit one or more of the following
symptoms:
^ Universal Serial Bus (USB) port inoperative.
^ USB audio muting when using various non-Apple USB devices.
^ Phone book access difficulty on certain 2-digit phone book entries when using voice commands.
^ Excessive background noise and/or poor voice sound quality.
^ Phone book auto download inoperative on supported devices.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative intermittently.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Reprogram the accessory protocol inter[ace module (APIM) to the following consumer inter[ace
processor (CIP) software levels.
^ 9L3T-14D544-AE (vehicles not equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health Report)
^ 9L2T-14D544-BE (vehicles already equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health
Report)
Service Pack files may be obtained at www.syncmyride.com.
Reprogram the APIM
Contains software fix updates for the following:
^ Phone book auto download inoperative.
^ USB audio muting.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative.
^ Voice recognition on 2-digit entries.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Navigation Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Navigation
Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns > Page 6921
^ USB port inoperative with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B1342.
^ Poor call sound quality.
This software update also contains enhancements that will improve the reliability of both Bluetooth
and USB connections to SYNC(R) from various consumer devices, and microphone enhancements
to reduce background noise, and will default Vehicle Health Report (if equipped) to off. The
Bluetooth enhancements improve the stability of hands-free calls, call waiting, caller ID, multiple
call handling and other mobile phone features. The USB enhancements improve support for media
players and the playing of file formats and podcasts.
NOTE
REFERENCE OTHER TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETINS (TSB) FOR ADDITIONAL SYNC
SOFTWARE PROGRAMMING TIPS.
1. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
2. Connect the VCM to the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) tool or laptop running IDS software.
3. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
4. Launch IDS tool.
5. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
6. Close the IDS tool.
7. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN & DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO button.
8. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
9. Press read APIM button.
10. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
11. Program both processors in the APIM (Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and CIP).
NOTE
DO NOT USE A MALE-TO-MALE USB DATA TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
a. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software and
to the vehicle USB port.
b. Follow the on-screen instructions to program both processors on the Sync module (VIP and
CIP).
12. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
13. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 08-21-02
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092608A 2008-2009 Edge, Explorer, 0.4 Hr.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Navigation Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Navigation
Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns > Page 6922
Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac, Focus, Fusion, Milan, MKX, MKZ, Sable, Navigator, Taurus,
Taurus X, 2009 Expedition, Escape, Escape Hybrid, Mariner, Mariner Hybrid, F-150, F-Super Duty,
Flex, MKS: Reprogram The APIM (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Navigation Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Navigation Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns
Navigation Module: All Technical Service Bulletins SYNC(R) System - Software Update For
Various Concerns
TSB 09-26-8
01/04/10
SYNC SOFTWARE UPDATE - VARIOUS ISSUES
FORD: 2008-2009 Focus, Fusion, Taurus X, Taurus, Edge, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer 2009
Escape, Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty, Flex
LINCOLN: 2008-2009 MKZ 2009 MKS 2008-2009 MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2008-2009 Milan, Sable, Mountaineer 2009 Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 9-22-14 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2008 and 2009 SYNC® equipped vehicles may exhibit one or more of the following
symptoms:
^ Universal Serial Bus (USB) port inoperative.
^ USB audio muting when using various non-Apple USB devices.
^ Phone book access difficulty on certain 2-digit phone book entries when using voice commands.
^ Excessive background noise and/or poor voice sound quality.
^ Phone book auto download inoperative on supported devices.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative intermittently.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Reprogram the accessory protocol inter[ace module (APIM) to the following consumer inter[ace
processor (CIP) software levels.
^ 9L3T-14D544-AE (vehicles not equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health Report)
^ 9L2T-14D544-BE (vehicles already equipped with SYNC V2, 911 Assist and Vehicle Health
Report)
Service Pack files may be obtained at www.syncmyride.com.
Reprogram the APIM
Contains software fix updates for the following:
^ Phone book auto download inoperative.
^ USB audio muting.
^ SYNC steering wheel control (SWC) switches being inoperative.
^ Voice recognition on 2-digit entries.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Navigation Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Navigation Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns > Page 6928
^ USB port inoperative with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B1342.
^ Poor call sound quality.
This software update also contains enhancements that will improve the reliability of both Bluetooth
and USB connections to SYNC(R) from various consumer devices, and microphone enhancements
to reduce background noise, and will default Vehicle Health Report (if equipped) to off. The
Bluetooth enhancements improve the stability of hands-free calls, call waiting, caller ID, multiple
call handling and other mobile phone features. The USB enhancements improve support for media
players and the playing of file formats and podcasts.
NOTE
REFERENCE OTHER TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETINS (TSB) FOR ADDITIONAL SYNC
SOFTWARE PROGRAMMING TIPS.
1. Connect the vehicle communication module (VCM) to the data link connector (DLC).
2. Connect the VCM to the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) tool or laptop running IDS software.
3. Turn the ignition key to the on position.
4. Launch IDS tool.
5. If required, update the VCM with the latest software.
6. Close the IDS tool.
7. From the PTS website, run OASIS by pressing the Read VIN & DTC's button. After vehicle
communication is established, press the GO button.
8. From the Vehicle Service Session screen, Select the SYNC button.
9. Press read APIM button.
10. Select software and press program APIM to update the SYNC module.
NOTE
YOU MUST USE A MALE-A TO MALE-A USB CABLE LIKE ROTUNDA PART NUMBER
CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10 TO COMPLETE THIS STEP.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCONNECT THE VCM OR USB CABLES DURING APIM PROGRAMMING.
NOTE
THE SYSTEM MAY PROMPT YOU TO INSTALL SOFTWARE FOR THE USB PORT. FOLLOW
THE ON SCREEN INSTRUCTIONS TO INSTALL THE USB PORT DRIVER ALREADY
INCLUDED IN WINDOWS XP.
11. Program both processors in the APIM (Vehicle Interface Processor (VIP) and CIP).
NOTE
DO NOT USE A MALE-TO-MALE USB DATA TRANSFER TYPE CABLE.
a. Connect the Male-A to Male-A USB cable, Rotunda part number CCMUSB2-AM-AM-10, to the
IDS tool or laptop running IDS software and
to the vehicle USB port.
b. Follow the on-screen instructions to program both processors on the Sync module (VIP and
CIP).
12. At the end of the configuration and programming procedure, the programming has been
completed successfully screen will be displayed.
13. Exit PTS, disconnect the VCM and disconnect the USB cable.
OTHER APPLICABLE ARTICLES: 08-21-02
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
092608A 2008-2009 Edge, Explorer, 0.4 Hr.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Navigation Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Navigation Module: > 09-26-8 > Jan > 10 > SYNC(R) System - Software Update For Various Concerns > Page 6929
Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac, Focus, Fusion, Milan, MKX, MKZ, Sable, Navigator, Taurus,
Taurus X, 2009 Expedition, Escape, Escape Hybrid, Mariner, Mariner Hybrid, F-150, F-Super Duty,
Flex, MKS: Reprogram The APIM (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14D212 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Parking Assist Control Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6933
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6934
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6935
Parking Assist Control Module: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6936
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6937
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6938
Parking Assist Control Module: Service and Repair
Parking Aid Module (PAM) - Expedition
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the Parking Aid Module (PAM) sub-harness from the body harness.
2. Remove the rear bumper cover.
3. Remove the 4 insulator-to-bumper cover nuts and the insulator from the bumper cover.
4. Disconnect the sub-harness from the PAM.
5. Remove the 2 PAM bracket bolts.
6. Remove the PAM bracket assembly.
7. Release the module tabs from the bracket and remove the module from the bracket.
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 6943
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 6944
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left
> Page 6949
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left
> Page 6950
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left
> Page 6951
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left
> Page 6952
Parking Assist Distance Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left
> Page 6953
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left
> Page 6954
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left
> Page 6955
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left
> Page 6956
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left
> Page 6957
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left
> Page 6958
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Parking Aid Sensor, Front Outer Left
> Page 6959
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor Front Outer Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor Front Outer Left >
Page 6962
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor Front Outer Left >
Page 6963
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor Front Outer Left >
Page 6964
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor Front Outer Left >
Page 6965
Parking Assist Distance Sensor: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor Front Outer Left >
Page 6966
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor Front Outer Left >
Page 6967
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Sensor Front Outer Left >
Page 6968
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Aid Sensor - Front
Parking Assist Distance Sensor: Service and Repair Parking Aid Sensor - Front
Parking Aid Sensor - Front
Sedan
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front bumper cover.
2. Disconnect the parking aid sensor electrical connectors.
3. NOTE: Press the retaining tabs to release the sensor(s).
Remove the parking aid sensor(s).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- NOTICE: Paint the new sensor(s) with base coat and one coat of clear. Excessive paint film
buildup may result in incorrect sensor operation.
Using the scan tool, verify that the parking aid sensor PIDs read no object present, and that the
parking aid sensor attenuation PIDs read between 0.8-1.6 ms. If the parking aid sensor attenuation
PIDs do not read between 0.8-1.6 ms, the paint is too thick on the sensor(s) and it will be
necessary to repaint the sensor(s) as required.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Distance Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Parking Aid Sensor - Front >
Page 6971
Parking Assist Distance Sensor: Service and Repair Parking Aid Sensor - Rear
Parking Aid Sensor - Rear
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear bumper cover.
2. Disconnect the parking aid sensor electrical connectors.
3. NOTE: Press the retaining tabs to release the sensor(s).
Remove the parking aid sensor(s).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Using the scan tool, verify that the parking aid sensor PIDs read no object present, and that the
parking aid sensor attenuation PIDs read between 0.8-1.6 ms.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Pedal Positioning Switch > Component Information > Locations
Pedal Positioning Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Pedal Positioning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6975
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Pedal Positioning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6976
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Pedal Positioning Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Adjustable Pedal Switch Without Memory
Pedal Positioning Switch: Testing and Inspection Adjustable Pedal Switch - Without Memory
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Pedal Positioning Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Adjustable Pedal Switch Without Memory > Page 6979
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Pedal Positioning Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Adjustable Pedal Switch Without Memory > Page 6980
Pedal Positioning Switch: Testing and Inspection Adjustable Pedal Switch - With Memory
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Pedal Positioning Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Adjustable Pedal Switch Without Memory > Page 6981
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Brake Control Module >
Component Information > Locations
Trailer Brake Control Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Brake Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6986
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Brake Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6987
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Trailer Connector: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagram in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be
seen completely in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference
is given to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in parentheses next to or under a component.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System, and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6992
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in set 4
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the
indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to
illustrate proper orientation.
Power Distribution
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6993
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
Component and Connector Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6994
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component Location
Charts.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Locations information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the
various items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written
description of the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6995
Symbols (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6996
Symbols (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6997
Symbols (Part 3)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6998
Symbols (Part 4)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6999
Symbols (Part 5)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7000
Trailer Connector: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminal by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7001
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal.
Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7002
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7003
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7004
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seat wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7005
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7006
7. If visible, be sure to place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the
barrel. 9. Holding the wire in place, barrel squeeze tool handles appropriate ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7007
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7008
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7009
Trailer Connector: Connector Views
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7010
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7011
Trailer Connector: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
95-1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7012
95-2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7013
95-3
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (i.e. 13-2, 24-6, 10-2, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Location Views. See: Locations/Component Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Hitch > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Trailer Hitch: Service and Repair
Trailer Hitch
Trailer Hitch
Removal and Installation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Hitch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 7017
WARNING: Do not permanently remove the trailer hitch. The trailer hitch is an integral part of the
vehicle frame. Always reinstall the hitch before delivery of the vehicle to the customer. Failure to
follow this instruction may compromise vehicle crash integrity and increase the risk of personal
injury in a rear end collision.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the trailer hitch rear bumper
cover trim panel, if equipped. 3. Remove the 4 trailer lighting plug cover bolts.
4. Remove the trailer lighting plug.
- Position the plug away from the trailer hitch.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
- Remove the trailer lighting plug.
5. Remove the electrical connector from the trailer hitch and unclip the harness from the retainers
on the frame.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Hitch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 7018
6. Remove the 4 trailer hitch side mounting bolts (2 each side).
- To install, tighten to 175 Nm (129 lb-ft).
7. Remove the 4 trailer hitch lower mounting bolts (2 each side) and remove the trailer hitch.
- To install, tighten to 275 Nm (203 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Hitch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 7019
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Trailer Lamps: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagram in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be
seen completely in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference
is given to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in parentheses next to or under a component.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System, and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7024
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in set 4
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the
indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to
illustrate proper orientation.
Power Distribution
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7025
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
Component and Connector Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7026
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component Location
Charts.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Locations information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the
various items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written
description of the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7027
Symbols (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7028
Symbols (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7029
Symbols (Part 3)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7030
Symbols (Part 4)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7031
Symbols (Part 5)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7032
Trailer Lamps: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminal by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7033
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal.
Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7034
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7035
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7036
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seat wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7037
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7038
7. If visible, be sure to place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the
barrel. 9. Holding the wire in place, barrel squeeze tool handles appropriate ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7039
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7040
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7041
Trailer Lamps: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
95-1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7042
95-2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7043
95-3
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (i.e. 13-2, 24-6, 10-2, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Location Views. See: Locations/Component Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Trailer Lamps: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Special Tools Used With Diagnostics
Trailer Lamps
Principles Of Operation
Trailer Lamps
Principles of Operation
NOTE: The Smart Junction Box (SJB) is also known as the Generic Electronic Module (GEM).
The trailer lamps and battery charge are supplied power by relays that are energized to correspond
with the exterior lighting functions of the vehicle. If equipped, the vehicle also supplies circuitry to
support the installation of an aftermarket Trailer Brake Control (TBC) module (installed by the
customer). The vehicle circuitry only supplies voltage, ground, stoplamp switch input and a
controlling circuit to the trailer tow connector. The trailer electric brakes themselves are controlled
by the aftermarket TBC module and not the vehicle itself.
Inspection And Verification
Trailer Lamps
Inspection and Verification
1. Verify the customer concern.
2. Verify the exterior lighting system of the vehicle is operating correctly. If not, refer to the
appropriate pinpoint test.
3. Visually inspect for obvious signs of electrical damage.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7046
Visual Inspection Chart
4. If the concern is not visually evident, verify the symptom. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7047
Trailer Lamps: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Trailer Lamps
Symptom Chart
Symptom Chart
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7048
Trailer Lamps: Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test Y: All The Trailer Lamps Are Inoperative
Trailer Lamps
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test Y: All The Trailer Lamps Are Inoperative
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 95, Trailer/Camper Adapter for schematic and connector information.
See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The trailer tow connectors receive ground through circuit RAT08 (WH) for all of the trailer lamps.
The trailer tow parking and stop/turn relays share the same ground through circuit GD123 (BK/GY).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Trailer
PINPOINT TEST Y: ALL THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Before beginning diagnostics, visually inspect the trailer tow connector for signs of
corrosion or damage. Repair or install a new trailer tow connector as required.
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- Y1 CHECK THE RELAY GROUND CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Trailer Tow Parking Lamp Relay.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow parking lamp relay pin 3, circuit SBB28 (BU/RD), BJB
face side and the trailer tow parking lamp relay pin 2, circuit GD123 (BK/GY), BJB face side.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to Y2.
No
REPAIR circuit GD123 (BK/GY) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation
------------------------------------------------- Y2 CHECK THE TRAILER TOW CONNECTOR GROUND
CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN THROUGH THE CONNECTOR
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7049
- For the 4-pin connector, measure the resistance between the trailer tow C4098-4, circuit RAT08
(WH), harness side and ground.
- For the 7-pin connector, measure the resistance between the trailer tow connector pin 2, circuit
RAT08 (WH), component side and ground.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
The vehicle is operating correctly. SEND the trailer to an authorized camper/trailer repair facility.
No
For the 4-pin connector, REPAIR circuit RAT08 (WH) for an open. TEST the system for normal
operation.
For the 7-pin connector.GO to Y3.
------------------------------------------------- Y3 CHECK THE TRAILER TOW GROUND CIRCUIT FOR
AN OPEN
- Disconnect: Trailer Tow C4099.
- Measure the resistance between the trailer tow C4099-2, circuit RAT08 (WH), harness side and
ground.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
INSTALL a new trailer tow connector. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
REPAIR the circuit. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test Z: The Individual Trailer Lamp Is Inoperative - Trailer Turn/Stoplamp
Trailer Lamps
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test Z: The Individual Trailer Lamp Is Inoperative - Trailer Turn/Stoplamp
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 95, Trailer/Camper Adapter for schematic and connector information.
See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7050
The Battery Junction Box (BJB) fuse 45 (25A) supplies voltage to both trailer tow turn relays
through circuit SBB45 (GY/RD). The trailer tow turn/stop relay coils are provided ground through
circuit GD123 (BK/GY).
The trailer tow LH turn relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS18 (GY/BN) when the vehicle
LH rear stoplamp is illuminated. When the trailer tow LH turn relay is energized, the voltage is
routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT06 (YE).
The trailer tow RH turn relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS19 (VT/OG) when the vehicle
RH rear stoplamp is illuminated. When the trailer tow RH turn relay is energized, the voltage is
routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT09 (GN).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Trailer tow turn relay
- Trailer
PINPOINT TEST Z: THE INDIVIDUAL TRAILER LAMP IS INOPERATIVE - TRAILER
TURN/STOPLAMP
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Before beginning diagnostics, visually inspect the trailer tow connector for signs of
corrosion or damage. Repair or install a new trailer tow connector as required.
------------------------------------------------- Z1 VERIFY THE TRAILER LAMP OPERATION
- Ignition OFF.
- Determine if both trailer stop/turn lamps are inoperative.
- Are both trailer stop/turn lamps inoperative?
Yes
VERIFY the BJB fuse 45 (25A) is OK. If OK, REPAIR circuit SBB45 (GY/RD) for an open. TEST
the system for normal operation. If not OK, REFER to the Wiring Diagrams to identify the possible
causes of the circuit short.
No
For an inoperative LH trailer lamp, GO to Z2.
For an inoperative RH trailer lamp, GO to Z8.
------------------------------------------------- Z2 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE THROUGH THE TRAILER TOW
CONNECTOR (LH TRAILER STOP/TURN LAMP)
- For the 4-pin connector, while applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the trailer
tow C4098-2, circuit CAT06 (YE), harness side and ground.
- For the 7-pin connector, while applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the trailer
tow connector pin 1, circuit CAT06 (YE), component side and ground.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7051
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
The vehicle is operating correctly. SEND the trailer to an authorized camper/trailer repair facility.
No
For the 4-pin connector, GO to Z4.
For the 7-pin connector, GO to Z3.
------------------------------------------------- Z3 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE TRAILER TOW
CONNECTOR (LH STOP/TURN 7-PIN)
- Disconnect: Trailer Tow C4099.
- While applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the trailer tow C4099-1, circuit
CAT06 (YE), harness side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
INSTALL a new trailer tow connector. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
GO to Z4.
------------------------------------------------- Z4 CHECK THE TRAILER TOW LH STOP/TURN RELAY
- Disconnect: Trailer Tow LH Stop/Turn Relay.
- Substitute a known good relay.
- For the 4-pin connector, while applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the trailer
tow C4098-2, circuit CAT06 (YE), harness side and ground.
- For the 7-pin connector, while applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the trailer
tow C4099-1, circuit CAT06 (YE), harness side and ground.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7052
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
REMOVE the known good relay. INSTALL a new trailer tow turn relay. TEST the system for normal
operation.
No
REMOVE the known good relay. GO to Z5.
------------------------------------------------- Z5 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE LH STOP/TURN LAMP
RELAY COIL
- While applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the trailer tow LH turn relay pin 1,
circuit CLS18 (GY/BN), BJB face side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to Z6.
No
REPAIR circuit CLS18 (GY/BN) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- Z6 CHECK THE VOLTAGE SUPPLY CIRCUIT TO THE LH
STOP/TURN LAMP RELAY
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow LH turn relay pin 3, circuit SBB45 (GY/RD), BJB face
side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to Z7.
No
REPAIR circuit SBB45 (GY/RD) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- Z7 CHECK THE VOLTAGE SUPPLY CIRCUIT TO THE LH
STOP/TURN LAMP RELAY USING THE RELAY GROUND PIN
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow LH turn relay pin 3, circuit SBB45 (GY/RD), BJB face
side and the trailer tow LH turn relay pin 2, circuit GD123 (BK/GY), BJB face side.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7053
Yes
REPAIR circuit CAT06 (YE) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
REPAIR circuit GD123 (BK/GY) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- Z8 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE THROUGH THE TRAILER TOW
CONNECTOR (RH TRAILER STOP/TURN LAMP)
- For the 4-pin connector, while applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the trailer
tow C4098-1, circuit CAT09 (GN), harness side and ground.
- For the 7-pin connector, while applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the trailer
tow connector pin 4, circuit CAT09 (GN), component side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
The vehicle is operating correctly. SEND the trailer to an authorized camper/trailer repair facility.
No
For the 4-pin connector, GO to Z10.
For the 7-pin connector, GO to Z9.
------------------------------------------------- Z9 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE TRAILER TOW
CONNECTOR (RH STOP/TURN 7-PIN)
- Disconnect: Trailer Tow C4099.
- While applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the trailer tow C4099-4, circuit
CAT09 (GN), harness side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
INSTALL a new trailer tow connector. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
GO to Z10.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7054
------------------------------------------------- Z10 CHECK THE TRAILER TOW RH STOP/TURN RELAY
- Disconnect: Trailer Tow RH Stop/Turn Relay.
- Substitute a known good relay.
- For the 4-pin connector, while applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the trailer
tow C4098-1, circuit CAT09 (GN), harness side and ground.
- For the 7-pin connector, while applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the trailer
tow C4099-4, circuit CAT09 (GN), harness side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
REMOVE the known good relay. INSTALL a new trailer tow turn relay. TEST the system for normal
operation.
No
REMOVE the known good relay. GO to Z11.
------------------------------------------------- Z11 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE RH STOP/TURN
LAMP RELAY COIL
- While applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the trailer tow RH turn relay pin 1,
circuit CLS19 (VT/OG), BJB face side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to Z12.
No
REPAIR circuit CLS19 (VT/OG) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- Z12 CHECK THE VOLTAGE SUPPLY CIRCUIT TO THE RH
STOP/TURN LAMP RELAY
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow RH turn relay pin 3, circuit SBB45 (GY/RD), BJB face
side and ground.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7055
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to Z13.
No
REPAIR circuit SBB45 (GY/RD) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- Z13 CHECK THE VOLTAGE SUPPLY CIRCUIT TO THE RH
STOP/TURN LAMP RELAY USING THE RELAY GROUND PIN
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow RH turn relay pin 3, circuit SBB45 (GY/RD), BJB face
side and the trailer tow RH turn relay pin 2, circuit GD123 (BK/GY), BJB face side.
- Is the voltage less than 5 ohms?
Yes
REPAIR circuit CAT09 (GN) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
REPAIR ground GD123 (BK/GY) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test AA: The Trailer Lamps Are Inoperative - Trailer Parking Lamps
Trailer Lamps
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test AA: The Trailer Lamps Are Inoperative - Trailer Parking Lamps
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 95, Trailer/Camper Adapter for schematic and connector information.
See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The trailer tow parking lamp relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) when the
vehicle parking lamps are illuminated. The trailer tow parking lamp relay coil is provided ground
through circuit GD123 (BK/GY). Voltage is supplied from Battery Junction Box (BJB) fuse 28 (25A)
to the trailer tow parking lamp relay switch side through circuit SBB28 (GN/RD). When the trailer
tow parking lamp relay is energized, voltage is routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit
CAT11 (BN).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Trailer tow parking lamp relay
- Trailer
PINPOINT TEST AA: THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE - TRAILER PARKING LAMPS
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7056
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Before beginning diagnostics, visually inspect the trailer tow connector for signs of
corrosion or damage. Repair or install a new trailer tow connector as required.
------------------------------------------------- AA1 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE THROUGH THE TRAILER
TOW CONNECTOR
- Ignition OFF.
- Place the headlamp switch in the PARKING LAMPS ON position.
- For the 4-pin connector, measure the voltage between the trailer tow C4098-3, circuit CAT11
(BN), harness side and ground.
- For the 7-pin connector, measure the voltage between the trailer tow connector pin 6, circuit
CAT11 (BN), component side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
The vehicle is operating correctly. SEND the trailer to an authorized camper/trailer repair facility.
No
For the 4-pin connector, GO to AA3.
For the 7-pin connector, GO to AA2.
------------------------------------------------- AA2 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE TRAILER TOW
CONNECTOR (7-PIN)
- Disconnect: Trailer Tow C4099.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow C4099-6, circuit CAT11 (BN), harness side and
ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
INSTALL a new trailer tow connector. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
GO to AA3.
-------------------------------------------------
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7057
AA3 CHECK THE TRAILER TOW PARKING LAMP RELAY
- Place the headlamp switch in the OFF position.
- Disconnect: Trailer Tow Parking Lamp Relay.
- Substitute a known good relay.
- Place the headlamp switch in the PARKING LAMPS ON position.
- For the 4-pin connector, measure the voltage between the trailer tow C4098-3, circuit CAT11
(BN), harness side and ground.
- For the 7-pin connector, measure the voltage between the trailer tow C4099-6, circuit CAT11
(BN), harness side and ground.
- Is the trailer tow parking lamp relay OK?
Yes
REMOVE the known good relay. GO to AA4.
No
REMOVE the known good relay. INSTALL a new trailer tow parking lamp relay. TEST the system
for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- AA4 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE TRAILER TOW
PARKING LAMP RELAY COIL
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow parking lamp relay pin 1, circuit CLS30 (VT/WH),
BJB face side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to AA5.
No
REPAIR circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- AA5 CHECK THE VOLTAGE SUPPLY CIRCUIT TO THE
TRAILER TOW PARKING LAMP RELAY
- Place the headlamp switch in the OFF position.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow parking lamp relay pin 3, circuit SBB28 (GN/RD),
BJB face side and ground.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7058
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to AA6.
No
VERIFY the BJB fuse 28 (25A) is OK. If OK, REPAIR circuit SBB28 (GN/RD) for an open. TEST
the system for normal operation. If not OK, REFER to the Wiring Diagrams to identify the possible
causes of the circuit short.
------------------------------------------------- AA6 CHECK THE VOLTAGE SUPPLY CIRCUIT TO THE
TRAILER TOW PARKING LAMP RELAY USING THE RELAY GROUND PIN
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow parking lamp relay pin 3, circuit SBB28 (GN/RD),
BJB face side and the trailer tow parking lamp relay pin 2, circuit GD123 (BK/GY), BJB face side.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
REPAIR circuit CAT11 (BN) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
REPAIR circuit GD123 (BK/GY) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test AB: The Trailer Lamps Are Inoperative - Trailer Reversing Lamps
Trailer Lamps
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test AB: The Trailer Lamps Are Inoperative - Trailer Reversing Lamps
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 95, Trailer/Camper Adapter for schematic and connector information.
See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The Battery Junction Box (BJB) fuse 58 (15A) receives voltage from circuit CLS10 (GY/BN) when
the vehicle reversing lamps are illuminated. The voltage is then routed to the trailer tow connector
through circuit CAT16 (GY/BN).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7059
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Trailer
PINPOINT TEST AB: THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE - TRAILER REVERSING
LAMPS
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Before beginning diagnostics, visually inspect the trailer tow connector for signs of
corrosion or damage. Repair or install a new trailer tow connector as required.
------------------------------------------------- AB1 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE THROUGH THE TRAILER
TOW CONNECTOR
- Ignition OFF.
- Apply the parking brake.
- Ignition ON.
- Select REVERSE.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow connector pin 7, circuit CAT16 (GY/BN), component
side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
The vehicle is operating correctly. SEND the trailer to an authorized camper/trailer repair facility.
No
VERIFY the BJB fuse 58 (15A) is OK. If OK, GO to AB2. If not OK, REFER to the Wiring Diagrams
to identify the possible causes of the circuit short.
------------------------------------------------- AB2 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE TRAILER TOW
CONNECTOR
- Disconnect: Trailer Tow C4099.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow C4099-7, circuit CAT16 (GY/BN), harness side and
ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
INSTALL a new trailer tow connector. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
GO to AB3.
------------------------------------------------- AB3 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE BJB FUSE 58 (15A)
- Measure the voltage between the BJB fuse 58 (15A), circuit CLS10 (GY/BN), input side and
ground.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7060
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
REPAIR circuit CAT16 (GY/BN) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
REPAIR circuit CLS10 (GY/BN) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test AC: The Trailer Lamps Are On Continuously
Trailer Lamps
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test AC: The Trailer Lamps Are On Continuously
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 95, Trailer/Camper Adapter for schematic and connector information.
See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation - Trailer Tow Turn/Stoplamp
The trailer tow LH turn relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS18 (GY/BN) when the vehicle
LH rear stoplamp is illuminated. When the trailer tow LH turn relay is energized, the voltage is
routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT06 (YE).
The trailer tow RH turn relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS19 (VT/OG) when the vehicle
RH rear stoplamp is illuminated. When the trailer tow RH turn relay is energized, the voltage is
routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT09 (GN).
Trailer Tow Parking
The trailer tow parking lamp relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) when the
vehicle parking lamps are illuminated. When the trailer tow parking lamp relay is energized, the
voltage is routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT11 (BN).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Trailer tow relay
- Trailer
PINPOINT TEST AC: THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE ON CONTINUOUSLY
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Before beginning diagnostics, visually inspect the trailer tow connector for signs of
corrosion or damage. Repair or install a new trailer tow connector as required.
------------------------------------------------- AC1 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE AT THE TRAILER TOW
CONNECTOR
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow 4-pin connector, harness side and ground as follows:
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7061
- Is any voltage present?
Yes
GO to AC2.
No
The vehicle is operating correctly. SEND the trailer to an authorized camper/trailer repair facility.
------------------------------------------------- AC2 CHECK THE TRAILER TOW RELAY
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Suspect Trailer Tow Relay.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow 4-pin connector, harness side and ground as follows:
- Is any voltage present?
Yes
REPAIR circuit CAT06 (YE) (LH turn), circuit CAT09 (OG) (RH turn), or circuit CAT11 (BN) (parking
lamps) for a short to voltage. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
INSTALL a new turn trailer tow relay. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test AD: The Trailer Battery Charging Is Inoperative/Does Not Operate Correctly
Trailer Lamps
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test AD: The Trailer Battery Charging Is Inoperative/Does Not Operate Correctly
Normal Operation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7062
The trailer battery charge relay coil receives voltage from the Smart Junction Box (SJB) fuse 42
(10A) through circuit CAT23 (GY/YE) when the ignition switch is in the RUN position. Ground for
the trailer battery charge relay coil is supplied through circuit GD123 (BK/GY). The Battery Junction
Box (BJB) fuse 21 (30A) supplies voltage to the trailer battery charge relay switch side through
circuit SBB21 (GY/RD). When the trailer battery charge relay is energized, the voltage is routed to
the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT14 (OG).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Trailer battery charge relay
- Trailer
- SJB
PINPOINT TEST AD: THE TRAILER BATTERY CHARGING IS INOPERATIVE/DOES NOT
OPERATE CORRECTLY
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Before beginning diagnostics, visually inspect the trailer tow connector for signs of
corrosion or damage. Repair or install a new trailer tow connector as required.
------------------------------------------------- AD1 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE THROUGH THE TRAILER
TOW CONNECTOR (BATTERY CHARGE INOPERATIVE)
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow connector pin 5, circuit CAT14 (OG), component side
and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to AD8.
No
GO to AD2.
------------------------------------------------- AD2 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE AT THE TRAILER TOW
CONNECTOR (BATTERY CHARGE INOPERATIVE)
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Trailer Tow C4099.
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow C4099-5, circuit CAT14 (OG) and ground.
Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
INSTALL a new trailer tow connector. TEST the system for normal operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7063
No
GO to AD3.
------------------------------------------------- AD3 CHECK THE TRAILER BATTERY CHARGE RELAY
(INOPERATIVE)
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Trailer Battery Charge Relay.
- Substitute a known good relay.
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow C4099-5, circuit CAT14 (OG) and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
REMOVE the known good relay. INSTALL a new trailer battery charge relay. TEST the system for
normal operation.
No
REMOVE the known good relay. GO to AD4.
------------------------------------------------- AD4 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE TRAILER TOW
BATTERY CHARGE RELAY
- Ignition OFF.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer battery charge relay pin 3, circuit SBB21 (GY/RD), BJB
face side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to AD5.
No
VERIFY the BJB fuse 21 (30A) is OK. If OK, REPAIR circuit SBB21 (GY/RD) for an open. TEST
the system for normal operation. If not OK, REFER to the Wiring Diagrams to identify the possible
causes of the circuit short.
------------------------------------------------- AD5 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE TRAILER TOW
BATTERY CHARGE RELAY USING THE RELAY GROUND PIN
- Measure the voltage between the trailer battery charge relay pin 3, circuit SBB21 (GY/RD), BJB
face side and the trailer battery charge relay pin 2, circuit GD123 (BK/GY), BJB face side.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7064
Yes
GO to AD6.
No
REPAIR circuit GD123 (BK/GY) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- AD6 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE TRAILER BATTERY
CHARGE RELAY COIL (INOPERATIVE CONDITION)
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer battery charge relay pin 1, circuit CAT23 (GN/YE), BJB
face side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
REPAIR circuit CAT14 (OG) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
VERIFY the SJB fuse 44 (10A) is OK. If OK, GO to AD7. If not OK, REFER to the Wiring Diagrams
to identify the possible causes of the circuit short.
------------------------------------------------- AD7 CHECK THE TRAILER BATTERY CHARGE RELAY
COIL VOLTAGE SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: SJB C2280b.
- Measure the resistance between the trailer battery charge relay pin 1, circuit CAT23 (GN/YE),
BJB face side and the SJB C2280b-6, circuit CAT23 (GN/YE), harness side.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to AD12.
No
REPAIR circuit CAT23 (GN/YE) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- AD8 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE AT THE TRAILER TOW
CONNECTOR (BATTERY CHARGE ALWAYS ON)
- Ignition OFF.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow connector pin 5, circuit CAT14 (OG), component side
and ground.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7065
- Is any voltage present?
Yes
GO to AD9.
No
The vehicle is operating correctly. SEND the trailer to an authorized camper/trailer repair facility.
------------------------------------------------- AD9 CHECK THE TRAILER BATTERY CHARGE VOLTAGE
SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE
- Disconnect: Trailer Battery Charge Relay.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow connector pin 5, circuit CAT14 (OG), component side
and ground.
- Is any voltage present?
Yes
REPAIR circuit CAT14 (OG) for a short to voltage. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
GO to AD10.
------------------------------------------------- AD10 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE TRAILER BATTERY
CHARGE RELAY COIL (BATTERY CHARGE ALWAYS ON)
- Measure the voltage between the trailer battery charge relay pin 1, circuit CAT23 (GN/YE), BJB
face side and ground.
- Is any voltage present?
Yes
GO to AD11.
No
INSTALL a new trailer battery charge relay. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- AD11 CHECK THE TRAILER BATTERY CHARGE RELAY
COIL SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7066
- Disconnect: SJB C2280b.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer battery charge relay pin 1, circuit CAT23 (GN/YE), BJB
face side and ground.
- Is any voltage present?
Yes
REPAIR circuit CAT23 (GN/YE) for a short to voltage. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
GO to AD12.
------------------------------------------------- AD12 CHECK FOR CORRECT SJB OPERATION
- Disconnect all the SJB connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the SJB connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new SJB. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test AE: The Trailer Electric Brakes Are Inoperative/Do Not Operate Correctly
Trailer Lamps
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test AE: The Trailer Electric Brakes Are Inoperative/Do Not Operate Correctly
Normal Operation
The Trailer Brake Control (TBC) module is provided voltage at all times by the Battery Junction Box
(BJB) fuse 18 (30A) through circuit SBB18 (YE/RD). Ground for the TBC module is provided
through circuit GD138 (BK/WH). The TBC module receives voltage from the stoplamp switch
through circuit CLS17 (YE/GY) when the brake pedal is applied. When requested, the TBC module
sends voltage to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT19 (BU).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- TBC module
- Trailer
PINPOINT TEST AE: THE TRAILER ELECTRIC BRAKES ARE INOPERATIVE/DO NOT
OPERATE CORRECTLY
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7067
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Before beginning diagnostics, visually inspect the trailer tow connector for signs of
corrosion or damage. Repair or install a new trailer tow connector as required.
------------------------------------------------- AE1 CHECK THE TRAILER ELECTRIC BRAKE
CONTROLLER FOR A SHORTED OUTPUT
- Ignition ON.
- With the brake pedal released, measure the voltage between the trailer tow connector pin 3,
circuit CAT19 (BU), component side and ground.
- Is any voltage present?
Yes
GO to AE2.
No
GO to AE3.
------------------------------------------------- AE2 CHECK THE TBC MODULE OUTPUT CIRCUIT FOR A
SHORT TO VOLTAGE
- Disconnect: TBC Module C2142.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow connector pin 3, circuit CAT19 (BU), component side
and ground.
- Is any voltage present?
Yes
REPAIR circuit CAT19 (BU) for a short to voltage. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
INSTALL a new TBC module. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- AE3 CHECK THE TBC MODULE OUTPUT
- Ignition OFF.
- Set the gain on the TBC module to the maximum setting.
- While applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the trailer tow connector pin 3,
circuit CAT19 (BU), component side and ground.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7068
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
The vehicle is operating correctly. SEND the trailer to an authorized camper/trailer repair facility.
No
GO to AE4.
------------------------------------------------- AE4 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE TRAILER TOW
CONNECTOR
- Disconnect: Trailer Tow C4099.
- NOTE: Make sure the gain is still set to the maximum setting.
- While applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the trailer tow C4099-3, circuit
CAT19 (BU), harness side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
INSTALL a new trailer tow connector. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
GO to AE5.
------------------------------------------------- AE5 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE TBC MODULE
- Disconnect: TBC Module C2142.
- Measure the voltage between the TBC module C2142-1, circuit SBB18 (YE/RD), harness side
and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to AE6.
No
VERIFY the BJB fuse 18 (30A) is OK. If OK, REPAIR circuit SBB18 (YE/RD) for an open. TEST the
system for normal operation. If not OK, REFER to the Wiring Diagrams to identify the possible
causes of the circuit short.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7069
------------------------------------------------- AE6 CHECK THE STOPLAMP SWITCH INPUT TO THE
TBC MODULE
- While applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the TBC module C2142-2, circuit
CLS17 (YE/GY), harness side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to AE7.
No
REPAIR circuit CLS17 (YE/GY) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- AE7 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE TBC MODULE USING
THE CONNECTOR GROUND PIN
- While applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the TBC module C2142-2, circuit
CLS17 (YE/GY), harness side and the TBC module C2142-6, circuit GD138 (BK/WH), harness
side.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to AE8.
No
REPAIR circuit GD138 (BK/WH) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- AE8 CHECK THE TBC MODULE OUTPUT CIRCUIT FOR A
SHORT TO GROUND
- Measure the resistance between the TBC module C2142-3, circuit CAT19 (BU), harness side and
ground.
- Is the resistance greater than 10,000 ohms?
Yes
GO to AE9.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7070
No
REPAIR circuit CAT19 (BU) fro a short to ground. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- AE9 CHECK THE TRAILER ELECTRIC BRAKE
CONTROLLER OUTPUT CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN
- Connect a fused jumper wire between the TBC module C2142-1, circuit SBB18 (YE/RD), harness
side and the TBC module C2142-3, circuit CAT19 (BU), harness side.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow C4099-3, circuit CAT19 (BU), harness side and
ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
REMOVE the jumper wire. INSTALL a new TBC module. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
REMOVE the jumper wire. REPAIR circuit CAT19 (BU) for an open. TEST the system for normal
operation.
-------------------------------------------------
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Right Turn
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Right Turn > Page 7075
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Right Turn > Page 7076
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Right Turn > Page 7077
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp > Page 7080
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp > Page 7081
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp > Page 7082
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions
Trailer Connector: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagram in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be
seen completely in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference
is given to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in parentheses next to or under a component.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System, and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7090
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in set 4
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the
indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to
illustrate proper orientation.
Power Distribution
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7091
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
Component and Connector Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7092
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component Location
Charts.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Locations information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the
various items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written
description of the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7093
Symbols (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7094
Symbols (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7095
Symbols (Part 3)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7096
Symbols (Part 4)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7097
Symbols (Part 5)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7098
Trailer Connector: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminal by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7099
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal.
Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7100
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7101
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7102
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seat wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7103
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7104
7. If visible, be sure to place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the
barrel. 9. Holding the wire in place, barrel squeeze tool handles appropriate ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7105
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7106
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7107
Trailer Connector: Connector Views
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7108
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7109
Trailer Connector: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
95-1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7110
95-2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7111
95-3
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (i.e. 13-2, 24-6, 10-2, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Location Views. See: Locations/Component Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > Specifications
Body Control Systems: Specifications
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > Specifications > Page 7116
Body Control Systems: Description and Operation
Module Controlled Functions
NOTE: The Smart Junction Box (SJB) is also known as the Generic Electronic Module (GEM).
The 2 multifunction electronic modules on this vehicle are the:
- Driver Seat Module (DSM)
- SJB
Driver Seat Module (DSM)
The DSM is located under the driver seat. It controls the memory functions of the driver seat
position, the adjustable pedals, and the exterior rear view mirrors. The memory driver seat feature
allows the driver to program 2 personalized seat/adjustable pedal/exterior mirrors position that can
be recalled using the memory set switches or the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter(s) (part
of the Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) key). Refer to Locks for information on the DSM
memory settings activation and deactivation.
Smart Junction Box (SJB)
NOTE: The time out for the battery saver relay and the accessory delay relay (both are controlled
by the SJB) is 1 minute if the vehicle has less than 80 km (50 miles). Once the vehicle passes the
approximate mileage threshold of 80 km (50 miles), the time out for both relays is 10 minutes, as
described by the Owner's Literature. For the accessory delay relay, refer to Windows.
The SJB controls the following functions:
- Autolamps
- Battery saver
- Exterior lighting
- Interior lighting
- Power windows global open/close
- Power locks
- Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)
- Third row power-fold seat
- Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
- Warning chimes and warning lamps
Post Crash Alert
The post crash alert function is controlled by the SJB. If the Restraints Control Module (RCM)
determines an impact of severity enough to deploy air bags has occurred (the air bags may or may
not be deployed by the RCM), the RCM will send a message to the Instrument Cluster (IC) over the
High Speed Controller Area Network (HS-CAN) that an air bag deployable impact has occurred.
The IC sends the message to the SJB over the Medium Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN).
The SJB activates the post crash alert function by repeatedly cycling the horn on 3 times, then off
for 4 seconds, until the battery dies or the function is turned off. The hazard lights will also flash
with the horn sounding, but will keep flashing during the horn off cycle.
The post crash alert function can be turned off by:
- pressing the hazard switch (which may need to be pressed more than once).
- pressing the RKE transmitter UNLOCK button.
- pressing the RKE transmitter PANIC button.
The post crash alert feature acts similar to the perimeter alarm, but the horn cycle is different. The
perimeter alarm function cycles the horn on and off, in regular intervals until 2 minutes and 45
seconds have elapsed, the battery dies or the function is turned off. Turning the ignition to the ON
position will not deactivate the post crash alert, but will deactivate an activated perimeter alarm.
The post crash alert function cannot be configured off.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Body Control Systems: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Inspection And Verification
Driver Seat Module (DSM)
Inspection and Verification
1. Verify the customer concern.
2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of electrical damage.
Visual Inspection Chart
3. If an obvious cause for an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible)
before proceeding to the next step.
4. NOTE: Make sure to use the latest scan tool software release.
If the cause is not visually evident, connect the scan tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC).
5. NOTE: The Vehicle Communication Module (VCM) LED prove-out confirms power and ground
from the DLC are provided to the VCM.
If the scan tool does not communicate with the VCM:
- Check the VCM connection to the vehicle.
- Check the scan tool connection to the VCM.
- Refer to Information Bus, No Power To The Scan Tool, to diagnose no power to the scan tool.
6. If the scan tool does not communicate with the vehicle:
- Verify the ignition key is in the ON position.
- Verify the scan tool operation with a known good vehicle.
- Refer to Information Bus to diagnose no response from the PCM.
7. Carry out the network test.
- If the scan tool responds with no communication for one or more modules, refer to Information
Bus.
- If the network test passes, retrieve and record the continuous memory DTCs.
8. Clear the continuous DTCs and carry out the self-test diagnostics for the DSM.
9. If the DTCs retrieved are related to the concern, go to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Chart
See: Diagnostic Trouble Code
Descriptions/Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Chart.
10. If no DTCs related to the concern are retrieved, GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures/Driver Seat Module (DSM)
Principles Of Operation
Driver Seat Module (DSM)
Principles of Operation
NOTE: The Smart Junction Box (SJB) is also known as the Generic Electronic Module (GEM).
The Driver Seat Module (DSM) is on the Medium Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN)
communication network.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7119
The DSM controls the memory power exterior mirrors. This feature allows the driver to program
personalized mirror positions. Once the driver has stored a mirror position, the driver can recall the
setting by pressing the corresponding memory switch or by using a programmed Remote Keyless
Entry (RKE) transmitter. Refer to Mirrors.
The memory driver seat feature allows the driver to program a personalized seat position that can
be recalled using the memory switches or the RKE transmitter. Refer to Seats.
The memory adjustable pedals and memory power tilt column are also controlled by the DSM.
These systems permit the adjustment of the brake, the accelerator pedals and the tilt column by
pressing the desired memory set switch or by using a programmed RKE transmitter.
The power fold mirrors are also controlled by the DSM. This system permits the mirrors to be
folded in or out using the power mirror switch.
Special Tools Used With Diagnostics
Driver Seat Module (DSM)
Inspection And Verification
Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Inspection and Verification
1. Verify the customer concern.
2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of electrical damage.
Visual Inspection Chart
3. If an obvious cause for an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible)
before proceeding to the next step.
4. NOTE: Make sure to use the latest scan tool software release.
If the cause is not visually evident, connect the scan tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7120
5. NOTE: The Vehicle Communication Module (VCM) LED prove-out confirms power and ground
from the DLC are provided to the VCM.
If the scan tool does not communicate with the VCM:
- Check the VCM connection to the vehicle.
- Check the scan tool connection to the VCM.
- Refer to Information Bus, No Power To The Scan Tool, to diagnose no power to the scan tool.
6. If the scan tool does not communicate with the vehicle:
- Verify the ignition key is in the ON position.
- Verify the scan tool operation with a known good vehicle.
- Refer to Information Bus to diagnose no response from the PCM.
7. Carry out the network test.
- If the scan tool responds with no communication for one or more modules, refer to Information
Bus.
- If the network test passes, retrieve and record the continuous memory DTCs.
8. Clear the continuous DTCs and carry out the self-test diagnostics for the SJB.
9. If the DTCs retrieved are related to the concern, go to DTC Charts. See: Diagnostic Trouble
Code Descriptions/Smart Junction Box (SJB)
10. If no DTCs related to the concern are retrieved, GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures/Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Principles Of Operation
Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Principles of Operation
NOTE: The Smart Junction Box (SJB) is also known as the Generic Electronic Module (GEM).
NOTE: The time out for the battery saver relay and the accessory delay relay (both are controlled
by the SJB) is 1 minute if the vehicle has less than 80 km (50 miles). Once the vehicle passes the
approximate mileage threshold of 80 km (50 miles), the time out for both relays is 10 minutes, as
described by the Owner's Literature. For the accessory delay relay, refer to Windows.
The SJB communicates via the Medium Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN).
The SJB controls the power door lock system. The SJB monitors the door lock/unlock switch inputs
from the interior door lock switches. When the SJB receives an unlock/lock command from any
door lock control switch, the module activates the door lock actuators. Refer to Locks.
The SJB also controls the following remote lock/unlock features:
- Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter lock/unlock
- Panic alarm (button is part of the RKE transmitter)
- Keyless entry keypad
The SJB controls the autolamp subsystem. The autolamp subsystem provides light-sensitive
automatic on/off control of the headlamps and parking lamps.
The SJB controls the battery saver, delayed accessory function, the horn, and exterior and interior
lighting.
The SJB controls the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS).
Field-Effect Transistor (FET) Protection
The SJB utilizes a Field-Effect Transistor (FET) protective circuit strategy for many of its outputs
(for example, the headlamp output circuit). Output loads (current level) are monitored for excessive
current (typically short circuits) and are shut down (turns off the voltage or ground provided by the
module) when a fault event is detected. A continuous DTC is stored at that time of the fault event
and a cumulative counter is started.
The module resets the FET protection and after a customer demand of the function (switching the
component on, battery saver being energized), attempts
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7121
to provide the requested output (voltage or ground). Each time the module detects an excessive
load on the protected circuit, the counter advances.
When the excessive circuit load occurs enough, the module shuts down the output until a repair
procedure is carried out. Each FET protected circuit has 3 predefined levels of short circuit
tolerance established in the module based on each circuits' total protective capability. For example,
if the total predefined tolerance level is 600 fault events, the tolerance levels are reached at 200,
400 and 600 fault events.
When each tolerance level is reached the continuous DTC that was stored on the first failure,
cannot be cleared by a command to clear the continuous DTCs. The module does not allow this
code to be cleared or the circuit restored to normal operation until a successful self-test proves that
the fault has been repaired. After the self-test has successfully completed (no on-demand DTCs
present), the continuous DTC clears and the circuit function returns.
When the first or second level is reached, the continuous DTC (associated with the short circuit)
sets along with DTC B106E. These DTCs can be cleared using the Clear DTC operation on the
scan tool as long as the fault itself has been corrected.
If any of the circuits are shorted past the third level, then DTCs B106F and B1342 set along with
the associated continuous DTC. These DTCs cannot be cleared and the module must be replaced.
The SJB FET protected output circuits for the headlamp system are for the LH low beam output
and the RH low beam output circuits.
Special Tools Used With Diagnostics
Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7122
Body Control Systems: Diagnostic Trouble Code Descriptions
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Chart
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Chart
NOTE: Most powertrain (P-code) DTCs are diagnosed in Computers and Control Systems
Information. If the P-code retrieved is not listed below, refer to Computers and Control Systems
Information to continue diagnostics.
NOTE: The Smart Junction Box (SJB) is also known as the Generic Electronic Module (GEM).
NOTE: Some of these modules utilize a 5-character DTC followed by a 2-character failure-type
code. The failure-type code provides information about specific fault conditions such as opens, or
shorts to ground. Continuous memory DTCs have an additional 2-character DTC status code suffix
to assist in determining DTC history.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7123
B103B-B1119
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7124
B111B-B1172
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7125
B11BA:1C-B1253
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7126
B1255-B1328
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7127
B1331-B1600
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7128
B1601-B1727
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7129
B19A1-B1991
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7130
B1A01:01-B19A8
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7131
B1A05:12-B1A89:01
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7132
B1A89:13-B2051
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7133
B208A-B2282
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7134
B236A-B2404
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7135
B2405-B2607
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7136
B272A-B2741
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7137
B287A-B2918
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7138
B2A2A-B2999
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7139
B2A3A-B2A44 / C1001:01-C1155
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7140
C1165-C1705
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7141
C1706-C1790
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7142
C1795-C2208
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7143
C2209-C2784 / P062F-P0667
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7144
P0701-P0783
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7145
P0784-P1812
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7146
PXXXX-P2764 / U0001-U0073
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7147
U0073-U0140
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7148
U0140-U0155:00
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7149
U0159-U0196:00
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7150
U0197-U0301
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7151
U201A:51-U2023
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7152
U2023-U2101:00
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7153
U261A-U3003:17
Driver Seat Module (DSM)
Driver Seat Module (DSM)
DTC Charts
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7154
B106E-B1342 / U0140-U0155
Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Smart Junction Box (SJB)
DTC Charts
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7155
B2A2B-B2949 / P062F / U0155-U2050
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7156
Body Control Systems: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Driver Seat Module (DSM)
Driver Seat Module (DSM)
Symptom Chart
Symptom Chart
Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Symptom Chart
Symptom Chart
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7157
Body Control Systems: Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test F: DTCs B106E, B106F
Driver Seat Module (DSM)
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test F: DTCs B106E, B106F
Normal Operation
The Driver Seat Module (DSM) controls the output of several vehicle systems by means of solid
state drivers. When an overload occurs on any of these drivers, a DTC will be set. The module also
tracks the number of repetitive faults on each of these circuits. The module compares this number
of overloads to 3 progressive thresholds established for each circuit. If the 3 thresholds have not
been exceeded, then the DTC of the affected circuit can be cleared by eliminating the fault, then
clearing the DTCs and running the self-test. At the point that each of the first 2 thresholds are
exceeded, B106E will be set along with the DTC relating to the affected circuit. Once the final
threshold has been exceeded, the affected output is permanently disabled, and B106F will be set
along with B1342, at which time the DSM must be replaced.
- DTC B106E (Solid State Driver Disabled Due To Short Circuit) - sets when the DSM has disabled
a circuit due to a repetitive fault causing a circuit overload. A corresponding DTC for the circuit in
question will also set.
- DTC B106F (Module Disabled Due to External Fault) - sets when one or more output functions
are permanently disabled due to a repetitive circuit overload fault. DTC B106F will be set with DTC
B1342. When DTC B106F is present, a new DSM must be installed after the fault condition has
been corrected.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Output circuit short to ground or voltage
- DSM
PINPOINT TEST F: DTCs B106E, B106F
NOTICE: If DTC B106F is present, the fault condition must be corrected prior to installing a new
DSM. Failure to correct the fault condition first may cause damage to the new DSM, resulting in a
repeat repair.
------------------------------------------------- F1 REVIEW THE DTCs
- Review the DTCs from the DSM self-test.
- Are DTCs B106F and B1342 present?
Yes
CORRECT the cause of any other DTCs present. When the other DTCs are corrected, INSTALL a
new DSM. REFER to Driver Seat Module (DSM) See: Mirrors/Memory Positioning
Systems/Memory Positioning Module/Service and Repair. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
GO to F2.
------------------------------------------------- F2 REPAIR OTHER DTCs
- Repair the cause of any DTCs present, other than DTC B106E. Refer to the Diagnostic Trouble
Code (DTC) Chart See: Diagnostic Trouble Code Descriptions/Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC)
Chart.
- Clear the DTCs.
- Carry out the DSM self-test.
- Is DTC B106E still present?
Yes
The fault causing the output state to be disabled is still present. REPAIR the cause of the concern.
CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the self-test.
No
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7158
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern was caused by a fault in one of the
output circuits.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test G: DTC B1317
Driver Seat Module (DSM)
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test G: DTC B1317
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 117, Remote Keyless Entry and Alarm for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The Driver Seat Module (DSM) monitors the voltage from the battery to determine if it goes above
or below specific thresholds and sets DTC B1317 in continuous memory if the DSM detects high
battery voltage above 15 volts on circuit SBB45 (GY/RD).
- DTC B1317 (Battery Voltage High) - a continuous memory DTC that sets when the DSM detects
battery voltage above 15 volts on circuit SBB45 (GY/RD).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Charging system concern
- DSM
PINPOINT TEST G: DTC B1317
NOTE: DTC B1317 may be stored in the module memory due to previous battery charging or
vehicle jump starting events.
------------------------------------------------- G1 CHECK FOR DTC B1317, B1676 OR P0563 SET IN
OTHER MODULES
- Ignition ON.
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: (All Modules) Self-Test.
- Retrieve the continuous memory DTCs from all modules.
- Is DTC B1317, B1676 or P0563 (PCM) set in more than one module?
Yes
REFER to Charging System to diagnose an overcharging condition.
No
GO to G2.
------------------------------------------------- G2 CHECK THE BATTERY VOLTAGE
- Turn off all interior/exterior lights and accessories.
- Start and run the engine at approximately 2,000 rpm for 3 minutes while monitoring the battery
voltage.
- Does the battery voltage rise to 15 volts or higher?
Yes
REFER to Charging System to diagnose an overcharging condition.
No
GO to G3.
------------------------------------------------- G3 RECHECK FOR DTC B1317
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7159
- Turn the engine off.
- Ignition ON.
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: DSM Self-Test.
- Clear the continuous memory DTCs.
- Carry out the DSM self-test.
- Is DTC B1317 present?
Yes
INSTALL a new DSM. REFER to Driver Seat Module (DSM) See: Mirrors/Memory Positioning
Systems/Memory Positioning Module/Service and Repair. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
The system is operating normally at this time. The DTC may have been set previously during
battery charging or while jump starting the vehicle.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test H: DTC B1318
Driver Seat Module (DSM)
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test H: DTC B1318
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 117, Remote Keyless Entry and Alarm for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The Driver Seat Module (DSM) monitors the voltage from the battery to determine if it goes above
or below specific thresholds and sets DTC B1318 in continuous memory if the DSM detects low
battery voltage below 10 volts on circuit SBB45 (GY/RD).
- DTC B1318 (Battery Voltage Low) - a continuous memory DTC that sets when the DSM detects
battery voltage below 10 volts on circuit SBB45 (GY/RD).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- High circuit resistance
- DSM
PINPOINT TEST H: DTC B1318
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- H1 RECHECK THE DSM DTCs
- Ignition ON.
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: DSM Self-Test.
- Clear the DTCs. Repeat the DSM self-test.
- Is DTC B1318 still present?
Yes
GO to H2.
No
The system is operating normally at this time. The DTC may have been set previously during
battery charging or while jump starting the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7160
------------------------------------------------- H2 CHECK FOR CHARGING SYSTEM DTCs IN THE PCM
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: PCM Self-Test.
- Retrieve the continuous memory DTCs from the PCM.
- Is DTC P0620, P0625, P0626 or P065B set in the PCM?
Yes
REFER to Charging System.
No
GO to H3.
------------------------------------------------- H3 CHECK THE BATTERY CONDITION AND STATE OF
CHARGE
- Ignition OFF.
- Check the battery condition and verify the battery is fully charged. Refer to Battery, Battery
Condition Test. See: Starting and Charging/Battery/Testing and Inspection/Pinpoint Tests
- Is the battery OK and fully charged?
Yes
GO to H4.
No
REFER to Charging System.
------------------------------------------------- H4 CHECK THE DSM VOLTAGE SUPPLY
- Measure and record the voltage at the battery.
- Disconnect: DSM C341A.
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the DSM C341A-1, circuit SBB45 (GY/RD), harness side and
ground.
- Is the voltage within 0.2 volt of the recorded battery voltage?
Yes
GO to H5.
No
REPAIR the circuit for high resistance. CLEAR the DTC. REPEAT the self-test.
------------------------------------------------- H5 CHECK THE DSM GROUND CIRCUIT
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
- Measure the resistance between the DSM C341A-2, circuit GD143 (BK/VT), harness side and
ground.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7161
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to H6.
No
REPAIR the circuit for high resistance. CONNECT the negative battery cable. TEST the system for
normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- H6 CHECK FOR CORRECT DSM OPERATION
- Disconnect the DSM connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect the DSM connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new DSM. REFER to Driver Seat Module (DSM) See: Mirrors/Memory Positioning
Systems/Memory Positioning Module/Service and Repair. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test I: DTC U0140
Driver Seat Module (DSM)
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test I: DTC U0140
Normal Operation
- DTC U0140 (Lost Communication With Body Control Module (GEM)) - set by the DSM whenever
it receives invalid data from the Smart Junction Box (SJB).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Module communication
- DSM
- SJB
PINPOINT TEST I: DTC U0140
------------------------------------------------- I1 VERIFY CUSTOMER CONCERN
- Ignition ON.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7162
- Verify that there is an observable symptom present.
- Is an observable symptom present?
Yes
GO to I2.
No
The system is operating normally at this time. The DTC may have been set due to high network
traffic or an intermittent fault condition.
------------------------------------------------- I2 CHECK THE COMMUNICATION NETWORK
- Ignition ON.
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Network Test.
- Carry out the network test.
- Does the SJB pass the network test?
Yes
GO to I3.
No
REFER to Information Bus.
------------------------------------------------- I3 RETRIEVE THE RECORDED DTCs FROM THE
SELF-TEST
- Check for recorded DSM DTCs from the self-test.
- Is DTC B1317 or B1318 recorded?
Yes
For DTC B1317, Go To Pinpoint Test g. See: Driver Seat Module (DSM)/Pinpoint Test G: DTC
B1317
For DTC B1318, Go To Pinpoint Test h. See: Driver Seat Module (DSM)/Pinpoint Test H: DTC
B1318
No
GO to I4.
------------------------------------------------- I4 RECHECK THE DSM DTCs
NOTE: If new modules were installed prior to the DTC being set, the module configuration may be
incorrectly set during Programmable Module Installation (PMI) or the PMI may not have been
carried out.
- Clear the DTCs. Repeat the DSM self-test.
- Is DTC U0140 still present?
Yes
GO to I5.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The DTC may have been set due to high network
traffic or an intermittent fault condition.
------------------------------------------------- I5 CHECK FOR DTC U0140 SET IN OTHER MODULES
- Clear all DTCs.
- Ignition OFF.
- Ignition ON.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7163
- Wait 10 seconds.
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Self-Test.
- Retrieve the continuous memory DTCs from all modules.
- Is DTC U0140 set in the ACM, DSM, audio DSP module or PAM?
Yes
INSTALL a new SJB. REFER to Smart Junction Box (SJB) See: Power and Ground
Distribution/Power Distribution Module/Service and Repair.
No
INSTALL a new DSM. REFER to Driver Seat Module (DSM) See: Mirrors/Memory Positioning
Systems/Memory Positioning Module/Service and Repair.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test J: DTC U0155
Driver Seat Module (DSM)
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test J: DTC U0155
Normal Operation
- DTC U0155 (Lost Communication With Instrument Panel Cluster (IC) Control Module) - set by the
DSM whenever it receives invalid data from the Instrument Cluster (IC).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Module communication
- DSM
- IC
PINPOINT TEST J: DTC U0155
------------------------------------------------- J1 VERIFY CUSTOMER CONCERN
- Ignition ON.
- Verify that there is an observable symptom present.
- Is an observable symptom present?
Yes
GO to J2.
No
The system is operating normally at this time. The DTC may have been set due to high network
traffic or an intermittent fault condition.
------------------------------------------------- J2 CHECK THE COMMUNICATION NETWORK
- Ignition ON.
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Network Test.
- Carry out the network test.
Does the IC pass the network test?
Yes
GO to J3.
No
REFER to Information Bus.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7164
------------------------------------------------- J3 RETRIEVE THE RECORDED DTCs FROM THE
SELF-TEST
- Check for recorded DSM DTCs from the self-test.
Is DTC B1317 or B1318 recorded?
Yes
For DTC B1317, Go To Pinpoint Test g. See: Driver Seat Module (DSM)/Pinpoint Test G: DTC
B1317
For DTC B1318, Go To Pinpoint Test h. See: Driver Seat Module (DSM)/Pinpoint Test H: DTC
B1318
No
GO to J4.
------------------------------------------------- J4 RECHECK THE DSM DTCs
NOTE: If new modules were installed prior to the DTC being set, the module configuration may be
incorrectly set during Programmable Module Installation (PMI) or the PMI may not have been
carried out.
- Clear the DTCs. Repeat the DSM self-test.
- Is DTC U0155 still present?
Yes
GO to J5.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The DTC may have been set due to high network
traffic or an intermittent fault condition.
------------------------------------------------- J5 CHECK FOR DTC U0155 SET IN OTHER MODULES
- Clear all DTCs.
- Ignition OFF.
- Ignition ON.
- Wait 10 seconds.
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Self-Test.
- Retrieve the continuous memory DTCs from all modules.
Is DTC U0155 set in the ACM, DSM, audio DSP module or PAM?
Yes
INSTALL a new IC.
No
INSTALL a new DSM. REFER to Driver Seat Module (DSM) See: Mirrors/Memory Positioning
Systems/Memory Positioning Module/Service and Repair.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test A: DTCs B106E, B106F
Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test A: DTCs B106E, B106F
Normal Operation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7165
The Smart Junction Box (SJB) controls the output of several vehicle systems by means of solid
state drivers. When an overload occurs on any of these drivers, a DTC will be set. The module also
tracks the number of repetitive faults on each of these circuits. The module compares this number
of overloads to 3 progressive thresholds established for each circuit. If the 3 thresholds have not
been exceeded, then the DTC of the affected circuit can be cleared by eliminating the fault, then
clearing the DTCs and running the self-test. At the point that each of the first 2 thresholds are
exceeded, DTC B106E will be set along with the DTC relating to the affected circuit. Once the final
threshold has been exceeded, the affected output is permanently disabled, and DTC B106F will be
set along with DTC B1342, at which time the SJB must be replaced.
- DTC B106E (Solid State Driver Disabled Due to Short Circuit) - sets when the SJB has disabled a
circuit due to a repetitive fault causing a circuit overload. A corresponding DTC for the circuit in
question will also set.
- DTC B106F (Module Disabled Due to External Fault) - sets when one or more output functions
are permanently disabled due to a repetitive circuit overload fault. DTC B106F will be set with DTC
B106E. When DTC B106F is present, a new SJB must be installed after the fault condition has
been corrected.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Output circuit short to ground or voltage
- SJB
PINPOINT TEST A: DTCs B106E, B106F
NOTICE: If DTC B106F is present and a new SJB is to be installed, the fault condition must be
corrected first. Failure to correct the fault condition first may cause damage to the new SJB,
resulting in a repeat repair.
------------------------------------------------- A1 REVIEW THE DTCs
- Review the DTCs from the SJB self-test.
Are only DTCs B106E and B106F present?
Yes
INSTALL a new SJB. REFER to Smart Junction Box (SJB) See: Power and Ground
Distribution/Power Distribution Module/Service and Repair. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
CORRECT any DTCs present other than DTCs B106E and B106F. REFER to the DTC Charts.
After the repair, GO to A2. See: Diagnostic Trouble Code Descriptions/Smart Junction Box (SJB)
------------------------------------------------- A2 CARRY OUT THE SJB SELF-TEST
- Carry out the SJB self-test.
- Is DTC B106F present?
Yes
INSTALL a new SJB. REFER to Smart Junction Box (SJB) See: Power and Ground
Distribution/Power Distribution Module/Service and Repair. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern was caused by a fault in one of the
output circuits.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test B: DTCs B2048, B2050, B2949, B2A2B, B2A2C, B2A38
Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test B: DTCs B2048, B2050, B2949, B2A2B, B2A2C, B2A38
Normal Operation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7166
If the Smart Junction Box (SJB) is not configured correctly, these DTCs may appear in error. The
SJB will need to be configured correctly, which may require entering As-Built data, in order to
correct this issue and clear the DTCs. If not, then the following pinpoint test will need to be carried
out to determine if the SJB is at fault.
- DTC B2048 (Left Rear Turn Lamp Circuit Short to Ground) - sets when the LR turn lamp circuit
(on SJB C2280D-21) is shorted to ground.
- DTC B2050 (Right Rear Turn Lamp Circuit Short to Ground) - sets when the RR turn lamp circuit
(on SJB C2280D-19) is shorted to ground.
- DTC B2949 (Global Opening/Closing Circuit Short to Battery) - sets when the global
opening/closing circuit (on SJB C2280D-10) is shorted to battery.
- DTC B2A2B (Left Corner Lamp Output Circuit Short to Ground) - sets when the left corner lamp
output circuit (on SJB C2280B-17) is shorted to ground.
- DTC B2A2C (Right Corner Lamp Output Circuit Short to Ground) - sets when the right corner
lamp output circuit (on SJB C2280B-19) is shorted to ground.
- DTC B2A38 (Floor Lamp Output Circuit Short to Ground) - sets when the floor lamp output circuit
(on SJB C2280G-2) is shorted to ground.
NOTE: The pins mentioned above are not populated.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- SJB
PINPOINT TEST B: DTCs B2048, B2050, B2949, B2A2B, B2A2C, B2A38
------------------------------------------------- B1 CHECK FOR CORRECT SJB OPERATION
- Disconnect all the SJB connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the SJB connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Clear the DTCs.
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Repeat the Self-Test.
- Is DTC B2048, B2050, B2949, B2A2B, B2A2C, or B2A38 retrieved (or any combination of the
previously mentioned DTCs)?
Yes
INSTALL a new SJB. REFER to Smart Junction Box (SJB) See: Power and Ground
Distribution/Power Distribution Module/Service and Repair. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the
self-test. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the self-test. TEST the system for normal
operation.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test C: DTC B1317
Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test C: DTC B1317
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 117, Remote Keyless Entry and Alarm for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The Smart Junction Box (SJB) monitors the voltage from the battery to determine if it goes above
or below specific thresholds and sets DTC B1317 in continuous memory if the SJB detects high
battery voltage above 15 volts on circuit SDC04 (RD).
- DTC B1317 (Battery Voltage High) - a continuous memory DTC that sets when the SJB detects
battery voltage above 15 volts on circuit SDC04 (RD).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7167
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Charging system concern
- SJB
PINPOINT TEST C: DTC B1317
NOTE: DTC B1317 may be stored in the module memory due to previous battery charging or
vehicle jump starting events.
------------------------------------------------- C1 CHECK FOR DTCs B1317, B1676 OR P0563 SET IN
OTHER MODULES
- Ignition ON.
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: (All Modules) Self-Test.
- Retrieve the continuous memory DTCs from all modules.
- Is DTC B1317, B1676 or P0563 (PCM) set in more than one module?
Yes
REFER to Charging System to diagnose an overcharging condition.
No
GO to C2.
------------------------------------------------- C2 CHECK THE BATTERY VOLTAGE
- Turn off all interior/exterior lights and accessories.
- Start and run the engine at approximately 2,000 rpm for 3 minutes while monitoring the battery
voltage.
- Does the battery voltage rise to 15 volts or higher?
Yes
REFER to Charging System to diagnose an overcharging condition.
No
GO to C3.
------------------------------------------------- C3 RECHECK FOR DTC B1317
- Turn the engine off.
- Ignition ON.
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: SJB Self-Test.
- Clear the continuous memory DTCs.
- Carry out the SJB self-test.
- Is DTC B1317 present?
Yes
INSTALL a new SJB. REFER to Smart Junction Box (SJB) See: Power and Ground
Distribution/Power Distribution Module/Service and Repair. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
The system is operating normally at this time. The DTC may have been set previously during
battery charging or while jump starting the vehicle.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test D: DTC B1318
Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7168
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test D: DTC B1318
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 117, Remote Keyless Entry and Alarm for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The Smart Junction Box (SJB) monitors the voltage from the battery to determine if it goes above
or below specific thresholds and sets DTC B1318 in continuous memory if the SJB detects low
battery voltage below 10 volts on circuit SDC04 (RD).
- DTC B1318 (Battery Voltage Low) - a continuous memory DTC that sets when the SJB detects
battery voltage below 10 volts on circuit SDC04 (RD).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- High circuit resistance
- SJB
PINPOINT TEST D: DTC B1318
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- D1 RECHECK THE SJB DTCs
- Ignition ON.
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: SJB Self-Test.
- Clear the DTCs. Repeat the SJB self-test.
- Is DTC B1318 still present?
Yes
GO to D2.
No
The system is operating normally at this time. The DTC may have been set previously during
battery charging or while jump starting the vehicle.
------------------------------------------------- D2 CHECK FOR CHARGING SYSTEM DTCs IN THE PCM
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: PCM Self-Test.
- Retrieve the continuous memory DTCs from the PCM.
- Is DTC P0620, P0625, P0626 or P065B set in the PCM?
Yes
REFER to Charging System.
No
GO to D3.
------------------------------------------------- D3 CHECK THE BATTERY CONDITION AND STATE OF
CHARGE
- Ignition OFF.
- Check the battery condition and verify the battery is fully charged. Refer to Battery, Battery
Condition Test. See: Starting and Charging/Battery/Testing and Inspection/Pinpoint Tests
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7169
- Is the battery OK and fully charged?
Yes
GO to D4.
No
REFER to Charging System.
------------------------------------------------- D4 CHECK THE SJB VOLTAGE SUPPLY
- Measure and record the voltage at the battery.
- Disconnect: SJB C2280C.
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the SJB C2280C-1, circuit SDC04 (RD), harness side and ground.
- Is the voltage within 0.2 volt of the recorded battery voltage?
Yes
GO to D5.
No
REPAIR the circuit for high resistance. CLEAR the DTC. REPEAT the self-test.
------------------------------------------------- D5 CHECK THE SJB GROUND CIRCUIT
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
- Disconnect: SJB C2280E.
- Measure the resistance between the SJB C2280E-7, 8, 12, 24, circuit GD138 (BK/WH), harness
side and ground.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
CONNECT the negative battery cable. GO to D6.
No
REPAIR the circuit for high resistance. CONNECT the negative battery cable. TEST the system for
normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- D6 CHECK FOR CORRECT SJB OPERATION
- Disconnect the SJB connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7170
- Connect the SJB connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new SJB. REFER to Smart Junction Box (SJB) See: Power and Ground
Distribution/Power Distribution Module/Service and Repair. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test E: DTC U0155
Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test E: DTC U0155
Normal Operation
- DTC U0155 (Lost Communication With Instrument Panel Cluster (IC) Control Module) - set by the
SJB whenever it receives invalid data from the Instrument Cluster (IC).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Module communication
- SJB
- IC
PINPOINT TEST E: DTC U0155
------------------------------------------------- E1 VERIFY CUSTOMER CONCERN
- Ignition ON.
- Verify that there is an observable symptom present.
- Is an observable symptom present?
Yes
GO to E2.
No
The system is operating normally at this time. The DTC may have been set due to high network
traffic or an intermittent fault condition.
------------------------------------------------- E2 CHECK THE COMMUNICATION NETWORK
- Ignition ON.
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Network Test.
- Carry out the network test.
- Does the IC pass the network test?
Yes
GO to E3.
No
REFER to Information Bus.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > System Information > System Diagnosis > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7171
------------------------------------------------- E3 RETRIEVE THE RECORDED DTCs FROM THE
SELF-TEST
- Check for recorded SJB DTCs from the self-test.
Is DTC B1317 or B1318 recorded?
Yes
For DTC B1317, Go To Pinpoint Test c. See: Smart Junction Box (SJB)/Pinpoint Test C: DTC
B1317
For DTC B1318, Go To Pinpoint Test d. See: Smart Junction Box (SJB)/Pinpoint Test D: DTC
B1318
No
GO to E4.
------------------------------------------------- E4 RECHECK THE SJB DTCs
NOTE: If new modules were installed prior to the DTC being set, the module configuration may be
incorrectly set during Programmable Module Installation (PMI) or the PMI may not have been
carried out.
- Clear the DTCs. Repeat the SJB self-test.
- Is DTC U0155 still present?
Yes
GO to E5.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The DTC may have been set due to high network
traffic or an intermittent fault condition.
------------------------------------------------- E5 CHECK FOR DTC U0155 SET IN OTHER MODULES
- Clear all DTCs.
- Ignition OFF.
- Ignition ON.
- Wait 10 seconds.
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: Self-Test.
- Retrieve the continuous memory DTCs from all modules.
Is DTC U0155 set in the ACM, DSM, audio DSP module or PAM?
Yes
INSTALL a new IC.
No
INSTALL a new SJB. REFER to Smart Junction Box (SJB) See: Power and Ground
Distribution/Power Distribution Module/Service and Repair.
-------------------------------------------------
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > Auxiliary Step / Running Board Module >
Component Information > Locations
Auxiliary Step / Running Board Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > Auxiliary Step / Running Board Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7176
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > Auxiliary Step / Running Board Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7177
Auxiliary Step / Running Board Module: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > Auxiliary Step / Running Board Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7178
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > Auxiliary Step / Running Board Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7179
Auxiliary Step / Running Board Module: Service and Repair
Power Running Board (PRB) Module
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the LH B-pillar trim panel.
2. Disconnect the Power Running Board (PRB) module electrical connectors.
3. Remove the 2 bolts and the PRB module assembly.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > Auxiliary Step / Running Board Motor >
Component Information > Locations > Running Board Motor, Left
Auxiliary Step / Running Board Motor: Locations Running Board Motor, Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > Auxiliary Step / Running Board Motor >
Component Information > Locations > Running Board Motor, Left > Page 7184
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > Auxiliary Step / Running Board Motor >
Component Information > Locations > Running Board Motor, Left > Page 7185
Auxiliary Step / Running Board Motor: Locations Running Board Motor, Right
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > Auxiliary Step / Running Board Motor >
Component Information > Locations > Running Board Motor, Left > Page 7186
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > Auxiliary Step / Running Board Motor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Running Board Motor, Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > Auxiliary Step / Running Board Motor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Running Board Motor, Left > Page 7189
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Front Bumper Cover / Fascia: Procedures
Tab Repair - Bumper
1. NOTE: Inspect the bumper cover to determine if part can be repaired to an acceptable level of
quality of appearance, fit and durability. Will labor
and material cost of the repair meet or exceed the cost of a new replacement bumper cover? If the
bumper cover is determined to be repairable, proceed to the following steps.
NOTE: The following steps are to be used as a guideline. Depending on what brand of adhesives
or patch materials are used, procedures may vary slightly.
Remove the affected bumper.
NOTE: Illustration is not vehicle specific.
2. Clean the broken tab(s) with a plastics wax and grease remover.
3. Hand sand the repair area with 80-grit sandpaper and remove any foreign material with
compressed air.
4. Apply a plastics adhesion promoter per label directions to the repair area.
5. Measure and cut a patch of fiberglass cloth or equivalent large enough to form the front of the
tab, then slope back in a wedge shape approximately
51 mm (2 in) from original tab.
6. Prepare the repair adhesive cloth patch per manufacturer's instructions and apply to the affected
area.
- Immediately position the plastic repair material patch to form the tab shape.
7. Allow appropriate cure time and shape the repair tab using a small angle sander. Use extreme
care to not sand through the exterior surface.
8. Carry out any required paint repair operations to the bumper cover using Ford-approved paint
systems.
9. Reassemble and install the bumper cover.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 7196
Front Bumper Cover / Fascia: Removal and Replacement
Bumper Cover - Front
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the 3 lower air deflector pin-type retainers.
- Position the air deflector aside.
2. Remove the 2 front bumper cover lower pin-type retainers.
3. Remove the 4 LH and RH front fender splash shield screws.
4. Remove the 4 LH and RH front bumper cover-to-fender bolts.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
5. If equipped, disconnect the fog lamp electrical connector.
6. If equipped, disconnect the park aid sensor electrical connector.
7. Remove the upper air deflector.
- Remove the 10 pin-type retainers.
NOTE: Right side shown, left side similar.
8. Remove the 2 upper pin-type retainers for the lower air deflector.
9. Remove the 4 grille-to-radiator support bolts.
10. Remove the front bumper cover.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 7197
11. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia > System Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures
Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia: Procedures
Tab Repair - Bumper
1. NOTE: Inspect the bumper cover to determine if part can be repaired to an acceptable level of
quality of appearance, fit and durability. Will labor
and material cost of the repair meet or exceed the cost of a new replacement bumper cover? If the
bumper cover is determined to be repairable, proceed to the following steps.
NOTE: The following steps are to be used as a guideline. Depending on what brand of adhesives
or patch materials are used, procedures may vary slightly.
Remove the affected bumper.
NOTE: Illustration is not vehicle specific.
2. Clean the broken tab(s) with a plastics wax and grease remover.
3. Hand sand the repair area with 80-grit sandpaper and remove any foreign material with
compressed air.
4. Apply a plastics adhesion promoter per label directions to the repair area.
5. Measure and cut a patch of fiberglass cloth or equivalent large enough to form the front of the
tab, then slope back in a wedge shape approximately
51 mm (2 in) from original tab.
6. Prepare the repair adhesive cloth patch per manufacturer's instructions and apply to the affected
area.
- Immediately position the plastic repair material patch to form the tab shape.
7. Allow appropriate cure time and shape the repair tab using a small angle sander. Use extreme
care to not sand through the exterior surface.
8. Carry out any required paint repair operations to the bumper cover using Ford-approved paint
systems.
9. Reassemble and install the bumper cover.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia > System Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 7203
Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia: Removal and Replacement
Bumper Cover - Rear
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the 4 LH and RH rear fender splash shield screws.
NOTE: Left side shown, right side similar.
2. Remove the 4 LH and RH inner bumper cover nuts.
3. If equipped, disconnect the reverse parking aid electrical connector.
4. Remove the 2 rear bumper cover lower pin-type retainers.
5. Remove the rear bumper cover.
- Remove the 2 rear bumper cover pin-type retainers and the 3 rear bumper cover bolts.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Service and Repair
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair
Cowl Panel Grille
Removal and Installation
Both sides
1. Remove the windshield wipers.
LH side
2. Remove the pin-type retainer and lift the LH cowl trim panel to release the 3 underside pushpin
retainers that are attached to the cowl trim panel.
- Disconnect the windshield washer tube.
RH side
3. Remove the pin-type retainer and lift the RH cowl trim panel to release the 2 underside pushpin
retainers that are attached to the cowl trim panel.
- Disconnect the windshield washer tube.
Both sides
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
5. If necessary, adjust the windshield wiper arms.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Exterior Handle: Service and Repair
Exterior Front Door Handle
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The front door window glass must be completely raised.
1. Remove the front door trim panel.
- Position the water shield aside.
2. Open the clip and disconnect the exterior door handle actuating rod.
3. If equipped, disconnect the door lock cylinder actuating rod from the lock cylinder.
4. NOTE: Push the exterior door handle out from the bottom surface of the handle.
Remove the 2 nuts and the exterior front door handle.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
5. NOTE: Make sure the exterior door handle and the door handle actuating rod are in a relaxed
position and that the exterior door handle rod is all
the way up before closing the clip.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair > Page 7215
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Interior Handle: Service and Repair
Interior Door Handle
NOTE: Door trim panel removed for clarity.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the screw and the interior door handle trim bezel.
2. Release the door handle retaining clip and position the interior door handle aside.
3. Release the interior door handle actuating cable from the interior door handle.
4. NOTE: Make sure the interior door handle spring is realigned before installation of the door
handle. Check for normal operation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Hinge > System
Information > Adjustments
Front Door Hinge: Adjustments
Door Alignment - Front
All alignments
1. NOTE: Driver side shown, passenger side similar.
Remove the door latch striker plate.
Front door in and out, up and down alignment
2. Loosen, but do not remove, the front door hinge-to-front door fasteners enough to allow door
alignment.
Front door fore, aft and tilt alignment
3. Remove the front fender.
4. Loosen, but do not remove, the upper front door hinge-to-body fasteners enough to allow door
alignment.
5. Loosen, but do not remove, the lower front door hinge-to-body fasteners enough to allow door
alignment.
All alignments
6. Adjust the door.
7. Tighten the door fasteners.
- Tighten the front door hinge-to-front door fasteners to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
- Tighten the front door hinge-to-body fasteners to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Hinge > System
Information > Adjustments > Page 7222
8. Install and adjust the door striker as necessary.
- Tighten the door latch striker plate bolts to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Latch > System
Information > Adjustments
Front Door Latch: Adjustments
Door Handle to Latch Rod Adjustment
NOTE: An incorrectly adjusted exterior door handle can cause a loose handle, rattle noise, door
hard to open from the outside door handle, or the outside door handle to not sit flush in the closed
position.
NOTE: Prior to carrying out the adjustment procedure, the door latch, exterior door handle, and
linkages must be installed on the door.
1. Raise the door glass to the full-up position.
2. Remove the door trim panel.
3. Position the watershield aside.
4. Open the clip and disconnect the exterior door handle actuating rod.
5. Position the actuating rod and latch actuating lever in a neutral position.
6. NOTE: Do not push up or pull down on the actuating rod or latch actuating lever.
Reinstall the exterior door handle actuating rod back into the clip.
7. Close the clip and test the system to make sure that the exterior door handle is operating
correctly.
8. Reseal the watershield.
9. Install the door trim panel.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Front Door Latch: Procedures
Latch Lubrication
1. Open the door.
2. Using a screwdriver, fully close the latch (two clicks).
3. Spray the multi-purpose grease into the opening on the door latch for approximately 5 seconds.
4. Open the latch using either the interior or exterior door handle.
5. Open and close the door several times to circulate the lubricant inside the latch.
6. Wipe off any excess grease.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 7228
Front Door Latch: Removal and Replacement
Front Door Latch
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The door glass must be completely raised.
1. Remove the front door trim panel.
- Position the watershield aside.
2. For the LH door, disconnect the door lock cylinder actuating lock rod from the lock cylinder.
3. Open the clip and disconnect the exterior door handle actuating rod.
4. Disconnect the manual actuating lock rod from the door latch.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 7229
5. Remove and discard the 3 bolts and position the front door latch aside.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
6. Disconnect the electrical connectors.
- Separate the door harness from the door latch.
7. Release the interior door handle actuating cable and remove the front door latch.
1. Position the cable cover aside.
2. Release the conduit and the interior door handle actuating cable.
8. NOTE: Make sure the exterior door handle and the door handle actuating rod are in a neutral
position and that the exterior door handle rod is all
the way up before closing the clip.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Limiter > System
Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Limiter: Service and Repair
Door Check Arm
Left and right sides
1. Remove the lower cowl trim panel.
- Remove the door scuff plate.
Left side
2. Remove the parking brake control assembly and position aside.
Left and right sides
3. Remove the lower cowl panel weather shield.
4. Remove the 2 door check arm-to-door bolts.
5. NOTE: Left side shown, right side similar.
Remove the 2 door check arm nuts.
6. Remove the door check arm from the opening in the lower cowl panel.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Panel: Service and Repair
Door Trim Panel - Front
NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator, Expedition EL and Navigator L similar.
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Left front door shown, right front door similar.
1. Remove the door handle screw cover.
- Use the service notch.
2. Remove the door handle screw.
3. Remove the door handle trim bezel.
4. Remove the front door trim panel finish cover.
5. Remove the 2 door trim panel armrest screws.
6. Remove the door trim panel screw.
7. Remove the 2 lower door trim panel screws.
8. Disengage the sail panel clip.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 7236
9. NOTICE: To avoid damage to the door trim panel, lift the door trim panel by pulling directly
upward on the armrest to disengage the
panel clips.
Remove the front door trim panel.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
10. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass >
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Glass, Frames and Mechanisms Exploded View, Front Door
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Glass, Frames and Mechanisms Exploded View, Front Door
Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Front Door
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass >
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Glass, Frames and Mechanisms Exploded View, Front Door > Page 7242
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Door Glass Top Run - Front
Door Glass Top Run - Front
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The power window regulator motor must be re-initialized whenever the LF/RF (Navigator) or
LF (Expedition) motor is removed from the vehicle. For additional information, refer to Window
Motor Initialization See: Windows and Glass/Windows/Service and Repair.
1. Remove the front door window glass. For additional information, refer to Window Glass - Front
Door See: Service and Repair/Window Glass Front Door.
2. Remove the inside glass weatherstrip.
3. Remove the front door glass channel bolt and front door glass top run.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- The power window regulator motor must be re-initialized whenever the LF/RF (Navigator) or LF
(Expedition) motor is removed from the vehicle. For additional information, refer to Window Motor
Initialization See: Windows and Glass/Windows/Service and Repair.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Front Door
Front Door Window Motor: Service and Repair Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View,
Front Door
Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Front Door
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Front Door > Page 7247
Front Door Window Motor: Service and Repair Window Regulator Motor - Front Door
Window Regulator Motor - Front Door
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The power window regulator motor must be re-initialized whenever the LF/RF (Navigator) or
LF (Expedition) motor is removed from the vehicle. For additional information, refer to Window
Motor Initialization See: Windows and Glass/Windows/Service and Repair.
1. Remove the front door trim panel.
2. Position the front door weathershield aside.
3. NOTE: Use a flat-blade screwdriver between the window regulator motor and window regulator
assembly to hold the window regulator assembly
drum in place.
Remove the bolts and the front door window regulator motor.
1. Disconnect the electrical connector.
2. Remove the bolts.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Cycle the window glass to make sure the gears engage.
- The power window regulator motor must be re-initialized whenever the LF/RF (Navigator) or LF
(Expedition) window regulator is removed from the vehicle. For additional information, refer to
Window Motor Initialization See: Windows and Glass/Windows/Service and Repair.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair > Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Front Door
Front Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded
View, Front Door
Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Front Door
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair > Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Front Door >
Page 7252
Front Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair Window Regulator - Front Door
Window Regulator - Front Door
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The power window regulator motor must be re-initialized whenever the LF/RF (Navigator) or
LF (Expedition) motor is removed from the vehicle. For additional information, refer to Window
Motor Initialization See: Windows and Glass/Windows/Service and Repair.
1. Remove the front door trim panel.
2. NOTE: There are 2 tabs on the opposite side not shown in the illustration.
Unlock the 4 tabs and remove the window control switch from the door trim panel.
3. Remove the screws and the front door speaker.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. Remove the front door weathershield.
5. Re-connect the electrical connectors to the window control switch.
6. Lower the window glass to access the 2 window glass clamp bolts.
7. Loosen the window glass clamp bolts.
- To install, raise the window glass until it stalls in the UP position. Tighten the window glass clamp
bolts to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
8. NOTE: Secure the front window glass in the full UP position.
Secure the front window glass with tape to the front door frame.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair > Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Front Door >
Page 7253
9. Position the interior door handle aside.
1. Remove the cable conduit fitting from the carrier assembly.
2. Lift upward on the interior door handle retaining bracket and pivot the interior door handle out of
the bracket.
3. Remove the cable from the door handle.
10. Release the crash sensor harness pin-type retainers.
11. Position the front door window regulator harness aside.
1. Disconnect the electrical connectors.
2. Release the pin-type retainers.
12. Remove the front window regulator.
1. Loosen the 2 hanger bolts.
2. Remove the front window regulator bolts and front top run channel bolt.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair > Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Front Door >
Page 7254
13. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- The power window regulator motor must be re-initialized whenever the LF/RF (Navigator) or LF
(Expedition) window regulator is removed from the vehicle. For additional information, refer to
Window Motor Initialization See: Windows and Glass/Windows/Service and Repair.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Exterior Handle: Service and Repair
Exterior Rear Door Handle
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The door glass must be completely raised.
1. Remove the rear door trim panel.
- Position the water shield aside.
2. Remove and discard the 3 bolts and position the rear door latch aside.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
3. Open the clip and disconnect the exterior door handle actuating rod.
4. Remove the 2 nuts and the exterior rear door handle.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
5. NOTE: Make sure the exterior door handle and the door handle actuating rod are in a relaxed
position and that the exterior door handle rod is all
the way up before closing the clip.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Hinge > System
Information > Adjustments
Rear Door Hinge: Adjustments
Door Alignment - Rear
All alignments
1. NOTE: Driver side shown, passenger side similar.
Remove the door latch striker plate.
Rear door in and out, up and down alignment
2. Loosen, but do not remove, the rear door hinge-to-rear door fasteners enough to allow door
alignment.
Front door fore, aft and tilt alignment
3. Remove the B-pillar trim panel.
4. Loosen, but do not remove, the rear door hinge-to-body nuts inside at the inside B-pillar enough
to allow door alignment.
All alignments
5. Adjust the door.
6. Tighten the door fasteners.
- Tighten the rear door hinge-to-rear door fasteners to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
- Tighten the rear door hinge-to-body fasteners to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
7. Install and adjust the door striker as necessary.
- Tighten the door latch striker plate bolts to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Latch > System
Information > Adjustments
Rear Door Latch: Adjustments
Door Handle to Latch Rod Adjustment
NOTE: An incorrectly adjusted exterior door handle can cause a loose handle, rattle noise, door
hard to open from the outside door handle, or the outside door handle to not sit flush in the closed
position.
NOTE: Prior to carrying out the adjustment procedure, the door latch, exterior door handle, and
linkages must be installed on the door.
1. Raise the door glass to the full-up position.
2. Remove the door trim panel.
3. Position the watershield aside.
4. Open the clip and disconnect the exterior door handle actuating rod.
5. Position the actuating rod and latch actuating lever in a neutral position.
6. NOTE: Do not push up or pull down on the actuating rod or latch actuating lever.
Reinstall the exterior door handle actuating rod back into the clip.
7. Close the clip and test the system to make sure that the exterior door handle is operating
correctly.
8. Reseal the watershield.
9. Install the door trim panel.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Rear Door Latch: Procedures
Latch Lubrication
1. Open the door.
2. Using a screwdriver, fully close the latch (two clicks).
3. Spray the multi-purpose grease into the opening on the door latch for approximately 5 seconds.
4. Open the latch using either the interior or exterior door handle.
5. Open and close the door several times to circulate the lubricant inside the latch.
6. Wipe off any excess grease.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 7268
Rear Door Latch: Removal and Replacement
Rear Door Latch
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The rear door window glass must be completely raised.
1. Remove rear door trim panel.
- Position the watershield aside.
2. Remove and discard the 3 bolts and position the rear door latch aside.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
3. Open the clip and disconnect the exterior door handle actuating rod.
4. Disconnect the electrical connectors.
5. Release the interior door handle actuating cable and remove the rear door latch.
1. Position the cable cover aside.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 7269
2. Release the conduit and the interior door handle actuating cable.
6. NOTE: Make sure the exterior door handle and the door handle actuating rod are in a neutral
position and that the exterior door handle rod is all
the way up before closing the clip.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Panel: Service and Repair
Door Trim Panel - Rear
NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator, Expedition EL and Navigator L similar.
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Left rear door shown, right rear door similar.
1. Remove the door handle screw cover.
- Use the service notch.
2. Remove the door handle screw.
3. Remove the door handle trim bezel.
4. Remove the rear door trim panel finish cover.
5. Remove the 2 door trim panel armrest screws.
6. Remove the door trim panel screw.
7. Remove the 2 lower door trim panel screws.
8. NOTICE: To avoid damage to the door trim panel, lift the door trim panel by pulling directly
upward on the armrest to disengage the
panel clips.
Remove the rear door trim panel.
- If equipped, disconnect the electrical connectors.
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Glass >
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Door Glass Top Run - Rear
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Door Glass Top Run - Rear
Door Glass Top Run - Rear
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear door window glass. For additional information, refer to Window Glass - Rear
Door See: Service and Repair/Window Glass Rear Door.
2. Remove the rear door glass channel bolt.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
3. Remove the rear door glass top run.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Glass >
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Door Glass Top Run - Rear >
Page 7278
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Glass, Frames and Mechanisms Exploded View, Rear Door
Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Rear Door
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Rear Door
Rear Door Window Motor: Service and Repair Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View,
Rear Door
Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Rear Door
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Rear Door > Page 7283
Rear Door Window Motor: Service and Repair Window Regulator Motor - Rear Door
Window Regulator Motor - Rear Door
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear door trim panel.
2. Position the rear door weathershield aside.
3. NOTE: Use a flat-blade screwdriver between the window regulator motor and the window
regulator assembly to hold the window regulator
assembly drum in place.
Remove the rear door window regulator motor.
1. Disconnect the electrical connector.
2. Remove the bolts.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Cycle the door glass to make sure of gear engagement.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Regulator
> System Information > Service and Repair > Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Rear Door
Rear Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded
View, Rear Door
Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Rear Door
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Regulator
> System Information > Service and Repair > Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Rear Door > Page 7288
Rear Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair Window Regulator - Rear Door
Window Regulator - Rear Door
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear door trim panel.
2. NOTE: There are 2 tabs on the opposite side not shown in the illustration.
NOTE: LF shown, LR and RR are similar.
Unlock the 4 tabs and remove the window control switch from the door trim panel.
3. Remove the rear door speaker.
1. Remove the screws.
2. Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. Remove the speaker.
4. Remove the rear door weathershield.
5. Connect the window control switch.
6. Lower the window glass to access the window glass clamp bolts.
7. Disconnect the window control switch.
8. Loosen the window glass clamp bolts and remove the rear door window glass.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
9. NOTE: Secure the rear window glass in the full UP position.
Secure the rear window glass with tape to the rear door frame.
10. Disconnect the rear door window regulator electrical connectors.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Regulator
> System Information > Service and Repair > Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Rear Door > Page 7289
11. Position the interior door handle aside.
- Lift upward on the interior door handle retaining bracket and pivot the interior door handle out of
the bracket.
12. Remove the rear door window regulator assembly.
- Remove the bolts. -
To install, tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
13. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Fuel Door > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Fuel Door: Service and Repair
Fuel Filler Door Cup Bezel
Removal
NOTICE: The fuel filler door cup bezel is a one-time use only part. Removal of this part will result in
damage to the component.
NOTICE: Do not attempt to pry on the bottom of the fuel filler door cup bezel. Failure to follow this
direction may result in damage to the vehicle.
1. Using a non-marring body tool, pry outward on the upper RH side of the fuel filler door cup bezel
until the clip breaks.
2. Using a non-marring body tool, pry the upper LH side of the fuel filler door cup bezel until the clip
breaks.
3. Pull upward and outward to remove the fuel filler door cup bezel.
Installation
1. NOTICE: Make sure to align the fuel filler door cup bezel to the alignment slots and the filler
neck. Failure to follow this direction may
result in damage to the component and/or vehicle.
Align the fuel filler door cup bezel to the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Fuel Door > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 7293
2. Push inward and downward until the clips snap into place.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Hood Latch: Service and Repair
Hood Latch
NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the 10 pin-type retainers and the upper radiator sight shield.
2. Remove the 2 bolts and the hood latch.
- To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
3. Release the hood latch cable from the hood latch.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Verify the hood latch engages the striker in the latched position (secondary).
- Verify the hood latch engages the striker in the fully latched position (primary).
- Adjust the hood latch as necessary.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch Release > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Hood Latch Release: Service and Repair
Hood Latch Release Handle
NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the hood latch. For additional information, refer to Hood Latch See: Hood Latch/Service
and Repair.
- Note the routing of the hood release cable.
2. Remove the 3 screws and the steering column cover.
3. Remove the 2 screws and the hood latch release handle.
4. Release the cable guides and pull the cable through the cowl panel.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Switch / Sensor > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Switch / Sensor > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 7305
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Switch / Sensor > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 7306
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Liftgate Window Glass >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Liftgate Window Glass: Service and Repair
Window Glass - Liftgate
Removal and Installation
Window glass assembly
1. Remove the rear window wiper motor.
2. Disconnect the rear window defrost electrical connectors.
3. NOTICE: Do not extend the socket clips more than 2.0 mm (0.08 in) or failure of the socket can
occur.
NOTE: The liftgate glass must be supported when removing and installing the liftgate assist
cylinders.
Disconnect the 2 liftgate glass assist cylinders.
1. Insert a screwdriver blade under the socket clip and lift.
2. Gently pull the socket off the ball stud.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Liftgate Window Glass >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 7311
Window glass assembly or hinge assembly
4. Remove the liftgate glass hinge-to-body fasteners and remove the glass.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
Window hinge assembly
5. Remove the liftgate glass to hinge fasteners and remove the glass.
- Apply threadlock to the liftgate glass-to-hinge fasteners during installation.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
Window glass assembly or window hinge assembly
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Check the liftgate glass for high effort when closing. If high effort is present, adjust the striker
one-half turn outboard. If high effort is still present, adjust the striker an additional one-half turn
outboard. Do not exceed one full turn.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Locations
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7315
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7316
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7317
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7318
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Latch Remote Control
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Service and Repair Liftgate Latch Remote Control
Liftgate Latch Remote Control
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The liftgate latch remote control is available with power liftgate only.
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel.
2. Position the watershield aside.
3. NOTICE: Be careful not to kink the liftgate latch actuating cable while disconnecting it from the
latch.
Disconnect the liftgate latch.
1. Release the liftgate latch actuator rod.
2. Disconnect the liftgate latch actuating cable.
4. Remove 3 bolts and position the liftgate latch remote control aside.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-in).
5. Disconnect the electrical connectors and remove the liftgate latch remote control.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Latch Remote Control > Page 7321
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Service and Repair Liftgate/Trunk Module (LTM)
Liftgate/Trunk Module (LTM)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear quarter trim panel.
2. Remove the Liftgate/Trunk Module (LTM).
1. Disconnect the electrical connectors.
2. Remove the bolt.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Initialize the power liftgate. For additional information, refer to Power Liftgate Initialization See:
Service and Repair/Procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Actuator > Component Information > Locations
Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock Actuator: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 7325
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 7326
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 7327
Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock Actuator: Service and Repair
Liftgate Latch Actuator
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel.
2. Position the watershield aside.
3. Release the liftgate latch actuator rod from the liftgate latch.
4. Disconnect the liftgate latch actuator electrical connector.
5. Remove the rivet and the liftgate latch actuator.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Use the Heavy Duty Riveter to install the new rivet.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Handle Release Switch
Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock Switch: Locations Handle Release Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Handle Release Switch > Page 7332
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Handle Release Switch > Page 7333
Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock Switch: Locations Liftgate Glass Release Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Handle Release Switch > Page 7334
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Handle Release Switch
Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock Switch: Diagrams Handle Release Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Handle Release Switch > Page 7337
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Handle Release Switch > Page 7338
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7339
Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock Switch: Service and Repair
Liftgate Release Switch
Expedition
Navigator
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel.
- Position the water shield aside.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7340
Expedition
2. Remove the 2 nuts and the liftgate release handle.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
3. Remove the liftgate release switch.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
Navigator
4. Remove the liftgate parking lamps.
5. Remove the 6 nuts and the license plate housing.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
6. Remove the 2 nuts and the liftgate release switch housing.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
7. Remove the liftgate release switch.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
All vehicles
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Hazard
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Pinch Strip, Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Hazard
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Pinch Strip, Left > Page 7345
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Interior Trim
Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair
Trunk / Liftgate Interior Trim Panel: Service and Repair
Liftgate Trim Panel
NOTE: Non-power liftgate shown, power liftgate similar.
All vehicles
1. Open the liftgate glass and remove the 2 scrivets.
Vehicles with power liftgate
2. Remove the power liftgate rod-to-liftgate cover and nut.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
3. Remove the power liftgate rod from the liftgate.
All vehicles
4. Remove the upper liftgate trim panel.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Interior Trim
Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 7349
- Pull the lower corners toward the center on both sides and pull down along the top.
5. Remove the liftgate assist handle.
1. Remove the 2 liftgate assist handle screws.
2. Remove the liftgate assist handle.
6. NOTICE: To avoid damage to the liftgate trim panel, remove any retaining clips from the body
and attach them to the liftgate trim panel
before installing.
NOTE: The back of the liftgate trim panel shown, with the location of the liftgate trim panel retainers
indicated.
Remove the lower liftgate trim panel.
- Pull the lower liftgate trim panel at the center to release the center retaining clips.
- Release the remaining retaining clips 2 to 3 at a time, starting from the right side and working to
the left side.
- When all of the retaining clips are released, slide the liftgate trim panel forward and down, away
from the liftgate.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Latch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Latch > Page 7354
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Trunk / Liftgate Latch: Procedures
Liftgate Latch Manual Release
1. Remove the liftgate latch access cover from the center of the liftgate trim panel.
2. Vehicles with manual liftgate, press the liftgate latch manual release lever to the left to release
the liftgate latch.
3. Vehicles with power liftgate, press the liftgate latch manual release lever down to release the
liftgate latch.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 7357
Trunk / Liftgate Latch: Removal and Replacement
Liftgate Latch
Liftgate Latch
Manual Liftgate
Power Liftgate
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 7358
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel.
- Position the watershield aside.
2. Remove and discard the 3 bolts (4 bolts if equipped with a power liftgate) and the liftgate latch.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Liftgate Latch - Window
Liftgate Latch - Window
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel.
2. Remove the 2 screws and the liftgate window latch.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Motor >
Component Information > Locations
Trunk / Liftgate Motor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Motor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7362
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Motor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7363
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Motor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7364
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Motor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7365
Trunk / Liftgate Motor: Service and Repair
Power Liftgate Motor
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the power liftgate rod assembly. For additional information, refer to Power Liftgate Rod
See: Trunk / Liftgate Shock / Support/Service
and Repair.
2. Disconnect the power liftgate motor electrical connectors.
3. Remove the power liftgate retaining fasteners and the power liftgate motor assembly.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Initialize the power liftgate. For additional information, refer to Power Liftgate Initialization See:
Service and Repair/Procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Trunk / Liftgate Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Pinch Strip Switch
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Left side shown, right side similar.
1. Remove the brake light.
- Remove the screws.
2. Disconnect the pinch strip electrical connector.
3. Remove the pinch strip.
1. Remove the pin-type retainers.
2. Remove the grommet and route the harness out of the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 7369
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Shock / Support >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Trunk / Liftgate Shock / Support: Service and Repair
Power Liftgate Rod
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the LH quarter trim panel.
2. Unclip the power liftgate rod from the motor assembly.
- Squeeze the clip as shown to release and position upward on the rod assembly.
3. Remove the cover and the power liftgate rod-to-liftgate retaining nut.
- To install, apply threadlock to the threads of fastener and tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Shock / Support >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 7373
4. Remove the power liftgate rod-to-bracket bolt and the power liftgate rod assembly.
- To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Initialize the power liftgate. For additional information, refer to Power Liftgate Initialization See:
Service and Repair/Procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Rear Control Switch
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Locations Liftgate Rear Control Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Rear Control Switch > Page 7378
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Rear Control Switch > Page 7379
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Rear Control Switch > Page 7380
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Locations Power Liftgate/Traction Control/Hazard Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Rear Control Switch > Page 7381
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Rear Control Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Rear Control Switch > Page 7384
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information >
Service and Repair
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair
Cowl Panel Grille
Removal and Installation
Both sides
1. Remove the windshield wipers.
LH side
2. Remove the pin-type retainer and lift the LH cowl trim panel to release the 3 underside pushpin
retainers that are attached to the cowl trim panel.
- Disconnect the windshield washer tube.
RH side
3. Remove the pin-type retainer and lift the RH cowl trim panel to release the 2 underside pushpin
retainers that are attached to the cowl trim panel.
- Disconnect the windshield washer tube.
Both sides
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
5. If necessary, adjust the windshield wiper arms.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Fender > Front Fender > Front Fender Liner > System Information > Service
and Repair > Fender Splash Shield
Front Fender Liner: Service and Repair Fender Splash Shield
Fender Splash Shield
Vehicles with power running boards
1. Lower the running board.
2. WARNING: Turn off (disable) the power running boards (if equipped) before jacking, lifting or
placing any object under the vehicle.
Never place your hand between the power running board and the vehicle. Extended power running
boards will retract when doors are closed.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
All vehicles
3. Remove the lower pin-type retainer from the fender.
4. Remove the 8 fender splash shield screws.
5. Remove the 2 inner pin-type retainers from the fender splash shield.
6. Remove the fender splash shield.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Fender > Front Fender > Front Fender Liner > System Information > Service
and Repair > Fender Splash Shield > Page 7395
Front Fender Liner: Service and Repair Front End Body Panels - Exploded View
Front End Body Panels - Exploded View
NOTE: Navigator shown, Expedition similar.
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Body / Frame Mount Bushing: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION AND OPERATION
Frame and Body Mounting
The frame is made up of 2 steel boxed side rails and crossmembers, which are welded to the 2
side rails. The transmission crossmember is bolted to the side rails. The side welded rails and
crossmembers are not replaced separately.
The service kits available for the frame are the following: RH front horn replacement kit
- LH front horn replacement kit
- Front bumper bracket replacement kit
- 1B crossmember replacement kit
- Transmission crossmember replacement kit
- Exhaust hanger bracket kit
Refer to the instructions included in the kits for installation instructions.
Frame Mounted Heat Shields
All frame-mounted heat shields, except the spare tire heat shield and the upper control arm heat
shield, are tightened to 20 Nm (177 lb-in). The spare tire heat shield is tightened to 25 Nm (18
lb-ft). The upper control arm heat shield is tightened to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
Frame Components
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 7400
Frame Components
Spare Tire Winch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 7401
Spare Tire Winch
Skid Plates
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 7402
Skid Plates
NOTICE: When removing upper body mounts, enough adjacent body mount support bolts or nuts
must be removed to prevent damage occurring to the vehicle.
NOTE: Do not reuse body support mounting fasteners. New fasteners must be installed for each fastener
that has been removed or loosened.
- No lubricants of any kind are to be used during body mount installation.
Body Support - Front End Sheet Metal (FESM)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 7403
Body Support Front End Sheet Metal (FESM)
Body Support - No. 1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 7404
Body Support - No. 1
Body Support - No. 2 and No. 3
NOTE: No. 2 body mount shown, No. 3 body mount similar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 7405
Body Support - No. 2 and No. 3
Body Support - No. 4
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 7406
Body Support - No. 4
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Component Information > Service and Repair
Cross-Member: Service and Repair
Transmission Support Crossmember
Removal and Installation
Transmission Support Crossmember - Exploded View
NOTE: Transmission not shown for clarity.
Transmission Support Crossmember - Exploded View
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. If equipped, remove the skid plate
fasteners and skid plate. 3. Remove the LH and RH exhaust heat shield-to-crossmember
fasteners.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Page 7410
4. Remove the 2 transmission mount nuts.
- To install, tighten to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
5. Support the transmission.
6. NOTE:
- Mark the transmission crossmember next to the edge of the frame bracket to make sure the
crossmember is installed in the same position it was removed from.
- The crossmember nuts are installed on the crossmember bolts facing the front of the vehicle.
Remove the 4 transmission crossmember bolts (2 each side) and the transmission crossmember. To install, tighten to 90 Nm (66 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Page 7411
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Hitch > Component Information > Service and Repair
Trailer Hitch: Service and Repair
Trailer Hitch
Trailer Hitch
Removal and Installation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Hitch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page
7415
WARNING: Do not permanently remove the trailer hitch. The trailer hitch is an integral part of the
vehicle frame. Always reinstall the hitch before delivery of the vehicle to the customer. Failure to
follow this instruction may compromise vehicle crash integrity and increase the risk of personal
injury in a rear end collision.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the trailer hitch rear bumper
cover trim panel, if equipped. 3. Remove the 4 trailer lighting plug cover bolts.
4. Remove the trailer lighting plug.
- Position the plug away from the trailer hitch.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
- Remove the trailer lighting plug.
5. Remove the electrical connector from the trailer hitch and unclip the harness from the retainers
on the frame.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Hitch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page
7416
6. Remove the 4 trailer hitch side mounting bolts (2 each side).
- To install, tighten to 175 Nm (129 lb-ft).
7. Remove the 4 trailer hitch lower mounting bolts (2 each side) and remove the trailer hitch.
- To install, tighten to 275 Nm (203 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Hitch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page
7417
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Grille > Component Information > Service and Repair > Radiator Grille
Grille: Service and Repair Radiator Grille
Radiator Grille
Expedition
Navigator
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Grille > Component Information > Service and Repair > Radiator Grille >
Page 7425
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the front bumper cover.
Expedition only
2. Remove the 4 bumper assembly-to-grille bracket retainer nuts and the bumper assembly-to-grille
bracket.
All vehicles
3. NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Remove the clips and remove the front grille.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Grille > Component Information > Service and Repair > Radiator Grille >
Page 7426
Grille: Service and Repair Radiator Grille Support
Radiator Grille Support
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front bumper cover.
2. Remove the headlamp bolts.
3. Disconnect the battery.
4. Remove the 4 electrical junction box bolts.
- To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Grille > Component Information > Service and Repair > Radiator Grille >
Page 7427
5. Disconnect the ambient air temperature sensor retaining clip and position the sensor and
harness aside.
6. Disconnect the horn assembly electrical connector and remove the horn assemble bracket bolt.
- To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
7. Disconnect the hood latch cable retainers, remove the hood latch assembly bolts and position
the latch assembly and cable aside.
- To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
8. Remove the LH and RH coolant module bolts.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
9. Remove the 6 radiator grille support bolts (3 each side).
- To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Grille > Component Information > Service and Repair > Radiator Grille >
Page 7428
10. Remove the radiator grille support.
11. NOTICE: Inspect and transfer all of the radiator grille support isolators. Replace as necessary.
NOTE: Transfer all necessary components.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Console - Overhead
Console: Service and Repair Console - Overhead
Console - Overhead
NOTE: Overhead console with roof opening panel shown, all others similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Using a suitable trim removal tool, remove the overhead console by prying down on the
overhead console to release the 2 retaining clips.
2. Disconnect the electrical connector(s).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Make sure to align the overhead console retaining clips to the adjacent retaining clip holes.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Console - Overhead > Page 7435
Console: Service and Repair Console - Front, Floor
Console - Front, Floor, Expedition
Removal
All vehicles
1. Apply the parking brake.
2. Position the selector lever in the NEUTRAL position.
3. Position the front seats forward.
4. Remove the 2 front floor console rear bolts.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Console - Overhead > Page 7436
5. Position the front seats rearward.
6. Remove the 2 front floor console front bolts.
- Remove the 2 front floor console bolt covers.
- Remove the 2 front floor console bolts.
7. Remove the selector lever trim ring.
Funkmaster Flex edition only
8. NOTICE: The serial numbered name plate is securely fastened to the console with double-sided
adhesive tape. Excessive lifting or prying
will bend or damage the serial numbered name plate.
Using an appropriate pry tool, slightly lift the lower RH corner of the serial numbered name plate
upward to gain access to the double-sided adhesive tape, located on the bottom of the name plate.
9. NOTICE: The serial numbered name plate is securely fastened to the console with double-sided
adhesive tape. Excessive lifting or prying
will bend or damage the serial numbered name plate.
Starting at the RH corner of the serial numbered name plate, position a piano wire, or an equivalent
tool, between the name plate and the floor console finish panel and cut the double-sided adhesive
tape on the bottom of name plate.
10. Remove the serial numbered name plate.
All vehicles except Funkmaster Flex edition
11. Remove the front floor console utility tray mat.
All vehicles
12. Remove the front floor console utility tray screw.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Console - Overhead > Page 7437
13. Remove the floor console upper finish panel.
14. Position the selector lever indicator bezel aside.
- Release the 4 retainers and position aside.
15. Disconnect the selector lever cable from the selector lever and the floor console.
16. Remove the front floor console front screws.
17. Disconnect the front floor console electrical connectors.
1. Loosen the bulkhead electrical connector bolts.
2. Disconnect the bulkhead electrical connectors.
3. Disconnect the electrical connector.
18. Remove the front floor console.
Installation
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Console - Overhead > Page 7438
1. Install the front floor console.
2. Connect the front floor console electrical connectors.
- Tighten the bulkhead electrical connector bolt to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
3. Install the front floor console front screws.
- Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
4. Install the selector lever cable.
5. Install the selector lever indicator bezel.
6. Install the floor console upper finish panel.
- Make sure to align the trim panel retaining clips to the retaining clip holes in the floor console.
7. Install the front floor console utility tray screw.
All vehicles except Funkmaster Flex edition
8. Install the front floor console utility tray mat.
Funkmaster Flex edition only
9. Using alcohol, remove the double-sided adhesive tape from the serial numbered name plate and
floor console finish panel surfaces.
10. Locally obtain 3M PT1100 double-sided adhesive tape and apply 6 new tape strips to the
bottom of the serial numbered name plate, as indicated.
11. Position the serial numbered name plate onto the floor console finish panel and apply
downward pressure, to securely fasten the name plate to the
floor console finish panel.
All vehicles
12. Install the selector lever trim ring.
13. Install the 2 front floor console front bolts.
- Tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
14. Install the 2 front floor console front bolt covers.
15. Position the front seats forward.
16. Install the 2 front floor console rear bolts.
- Tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Console - Overhead > Page 7439
17. Position the front seats rearward.
18. Position the selector lever in the PARK position.
19. Release the parking brake
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Console - Overhead > Page 7440
Console: Service and Repair Console - Rear, Floor
Console - Rear, Floor
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the 2 rear floor console front bolts.
- Open the rear floor console storage bin.
- Remove the rear floor console cup holder.
- Remove the rear floor console front bolts. To install, tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
2. Remove the 2 rear floor console rear bolts.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Console - Overhead > Page 7441
- Open the rear floor console storage compartment door.
- Remove the rear floor console rear bolts.
- Remove the rear floor console.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Make sure to align the trim panel retaining clips to the retaining clip holes in the floor console.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering
Depowering Procedure
WARNING: Always wear eye protection when servicing a vehicle. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on air bag, Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain
modules. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of these
modules, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the
restraints control module (RCM) while the RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON. Failure
to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of the Safety Canopy(R) and
cause serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: To reduce the risk of accidental deployment, do not use any memory saver devices.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF.
2. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
3. At the Smart Junction Box (SJB), located in the RH lower kick panel, remove the cover and the
RCM fuse 32 (10A) from the SJB. For additional
information, refer to the Wiring Diagrams.
4. Turn the ignition switch ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30
seconds. The air bag warning indicator will remain
lit continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
6. WARNING: Always deplete the backup power supply before repairing or installing any new front
or side air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) component and before servicing, removing, installing, adjusting or striking
components near the front or side impact sensors or the restraints control module (RCM). Nearby
components include doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood
latches.
Refer to the Description and Operation portion of Air Bag Systems for location of the RCM and
impact sensor(s).
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
1 minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury or death in the event of an
accidental deployment.
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
Repowering Procedure
1. Make sure that all SRS components are connected.
2. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 7447
3. Install RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the SJB and close the cover.
4. WARNING: Make sure no one is in the vehicle and there is nothing blocking or placed in front of
any air bag module when the battery is
connected. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury in the event of
an accidental deployment.
Connect the battery ground cable.
5. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the back to ON and visually monitor
the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag warning indicator will
illuminate continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an SRS fault is present,
the air bag warning indicator will:
- fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The flashing might not occur until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition has been turned from
the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to complete the testing of the
SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault exists, a chime will sound in a
pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning indicator and any SRS fault
discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous DTCs from the RCM using a scan tool.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 7448
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Deactivation and Reactivation
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deactivation and Reactivation
Deactivation
WARNING: Always carry or place a live air bag module with the air bag and deployment door/trim
cover/tear seam pointed away from the body. Do not set a live air bag module down with the
deployment door/trim cover/tear seam face down. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on air bag, Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain
modules. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of these
modules, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: To reduce the risk of accidental deployment, do not use any memory saver devices.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF.
2. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
3. At the Smart Junction Box (SJB), located in the RH lower kick panel, remove the cover and the
RCM fuse 32 (10A) from the SJB. For additional
information, refer to the Wiring Diagrams.
4. Turn the ignition switch ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30
seconds. The air bag warning indicator will remain
lit continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: Always deplete the backup power supply before repairing or installing any new front
or side air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) component and before servicing, removing, installing, adjusting or striking
components near the front or side impact sensors or the restraints control module (RCM). Nearby
components include doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood
latches.
Refer to the Description and Operation portion of Air Bag Systems for location of the RCM and
impact sensor(s).
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
1 minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury or death in the event of an
accidental deployment.
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
7. Make sure the road wheels are in the straight-ahead position.
8. Center the tilt steering column to allow for steering column upper and lower shroud removal.
9. NOTICE: Turn the steering wheel such that the top is at 90 degrees (at the 9 o'clock position) to
the left from the straight-ahead position
to access the driver air bag module wire clips and to prevent damage to the steering column
multi-function switch. Failure to follow this instruction may result in component damage.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 7449
Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is 90 degrees to the left (at the 9 o'clock position)
as shown.
10. Remove the lower steering column opening cover.
- Remove the 3 screws.
- Pull out to release the top retainers.
- Remove the lower steering column opening cover. If equipped, disconnect the adjustable pedals switch connector.
11. If equipped, remove the screw and steering column manual tilt lever.
12. Remove the 3 steering column lower shroud screws.
13. Release the clips and remove the steering column upper shroud.
14. Remove the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, disconnect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
15. NOTICE: Make sure each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are disengaged from each of
the 3 steering wheel hooks before
removing the driver air bag module from the steering wheel. Failure to follow this instruction may
result in component damage and/or system failure.
NOTE: Steering wheel is removed for clarity. The rear of the steering wheel is shown.
NOTE: Use a mirror to view the rear of the steering wheel to locate where the 3 driver air bag
module wire clips attach to the steering wheel hooks.
Using a screwdriver or a suitable tool, release each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips from
the steering wheel hooks. Access the 3 driver air bag module wire clips through the back of the steering wheel cover and
push the wire clips toward the center of the steering wheel to release.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 7450
16. NOTE: Once the driver air bag module is removed, note the position of the 2 driver air bag
module locator pins on the steering wheel for
installation.
Disconnect the driver air bag module and horn switch electrical connectors and remove the driver
air bag module.
17. Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is back in the straight-ahead position (the 12
o'clock position).
18. Open and lower the glove compartment door to allow access to the passenger air bag electrical
connector.
- If equipped, disconnect the glove compartment door dampener.
19. Disconnect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
20. NOTE: There are 2 similar connectors under the passenger seat. The passenger seat side air
bag module electrical connector is located toward the
seat outboard position.
Remove the passenger front seat cushion panel shield and disconnect the passenger seat side air
bag module electrical.
21. Release the RH second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 7451
22. Remove the bolt and the RH second row safety belt retractor D-ring.
23. Remove the cover and the RH C-pillar trim panel nut.
24. Release the rear door weatherstrip and remove the RH C-pillar trim panel.
25. Disconnect the RH safety canopy module electrical connector.
26. Release the LH second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
27. Remove the bolt and the LH second row safety belt retractor D-ring.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 7452
28. Remove the cover and the LH C-pillar trim panel nut.
29. Release the rear door weatherstrip and remove the driver C-pillar trim panel.
30. Disconnect the LH safety canopy module electrical connector.
31. NOTE: There are 2 similar connectors under the driver seat. The driver seat side air bag
module electrical connector is located toward the seat
outboard position.
Remove the driver front seat cushion panel shield and disconnect the driver seat side air bag
module electrical connector.
32. Install the RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the Smart Junction Box (SJB).
33. Connect the battery ground cable.
Reactivation
1. Remove the RCM fuse 32 (10A) from the SJB.
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
3. Connect the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector and install the driver front seat
cushion panel shield.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 7453
4. Connect the LH safety canopy module electrical connector.
5. Install the LH C-pillar trim panel and attach the rear door weatherstrip.
6. Install the LH C-pillar trim panel nut and cover.
7. Install the LH second row safety belt retractor D-ring and bolt.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
8. Attach the LH second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
9. Connect the RH safety canopy module electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 7454
10. Install the RH C-pillar trim panel and attach the rear door weatherstrip.
11. Install the passenger C-pillar trim panel nut and cover.
12. Install the RH second row safety belt retractor D-ring and bolt.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
13. Attach the RH second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding. Extract and retract the safety belt between the full extension and stowed positions.
- If excessive effort or binding is present, install a new safety belt buckle retractor and tongue
assembly as necessary. For additional information, refer to Seat Belt Systems.
14. Connect the passenger seat side air bag module electrical connector and install the passenger
front seat cushion panel shield.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 7455
15. Connect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
16. Close the glove compartment door.
- If equipped, connect the glove compartment door dampener.
17. NOTICE: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag module. Match
the electrical connector key to the keyway in the driver air bag module. Do not force the electrical
connectors into the driver air bag module. Damage to the connector or component may occur.
Connect the horn switch and 2 driver air bag module electrical connectors.
18. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, lining up the locator pins.
19. NOTE: Make sure that all 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged and seated
correctly to the steering wheel.
NOTE: Audible clicks will be heard when the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged.
Firmly press the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, seating the 3 driver air bag module
wire clips to the steering wheel hooks.
- Check the driver air bag module trim cover to the steering wheel for an even gap clearance and
correct movement.
20. Install the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, connect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
21. Install the steering column upper shroud.
22. Install the 3 steering column lower shroud screws.
23. If equipped, install the steering column manual tilt lever and screw.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
24. If equipped, connect the adjustable pedals switch connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 7456
25. Install the lower steering column opening cover and 3 screws.
26. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON.
27. Install the RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the SJB and install the cover.
28. WARNING: Make sure no one is in the vehicle and there is nothing blocking or placed in front
of any air bag module when the battery is
connected. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury in the event of
an accidental deployment.
Connect the battery ground cable.
29. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition switch from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the ignition switch back to ON
and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag
warning indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag
SRS fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will either:
- fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The air bag warning indicator may not illuminate until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition
switch has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator will need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Clear all continuous memory DTCs from the RCM using a scan tool.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Glove Compartment > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Glove Compartment: Service and Repair
Glove Compartment
NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Open the glove compartment.
2. NOTICE: Forcing the glove compartment past the stops will damage the dampener.
If equipped, disconnect the dampener.
3. Release the stops.
4. Remove the 3 glove compartment screws and the glove compartment.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Glove Compartment > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 7460
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Headliner: Service and Repair
Headliner
All vehicles
1. Position aside the front and rear door weatherstrips.
2. If equipped, remove the roof opening panel trim ring.
3. Remove the LH and RH A-pillar trim panels. For additional information, refer to A-Pillar Trim
Panel See: Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/A-Pillar Trim Panel.
4. Remove the 2 wiring harness pin-type retainers from the A-pillar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 7464
5. Open and fully lower the glove compartment.
- Release the glove compartment tabs.
6. If equipped, disconnect the satellite radio antenna.
7. Remove the pin-type retainer and disconnect the electronic compass/auto-dimming rear view
mirror electrical connector.
8. If equipped, separate the satellite antenna cable from the wiring harness.
9. If equipped, remove the electronic compass sensor.
10. If equipped, disconnect the auto-dimming mirror electrical connector.
11. Remove the LH and RH sun visors.
- Remove the 6 sun visor screws.
- If equipped, disconnect the electrical connectors.
12. Remove the LH and RH sun visor clips.
- Remove the 2 sun visor clip screws.
13. If equipped, remove the overhead console.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 7465
- Pull the overhead console downward to release the overhead console retaining clips.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
14. If equipped, remove the DVD player.
15. Remove the LH and RH B-pillar trim panels. For additional information, refer to B-Pillar Trim
Panel See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/B-Pillar
Trim Panel.
16. Remove the LH and RH C-pillar trim panels. For additional information, refer to C-Pillar Trim
Panel See: Trim Panel/Service and Repair/C-Pillar
Trim Panel.
17. Remove the LH and RH D-pillar trim panels. For additional information, refer to D-Pillar Trim
Panel See: Trim Panel/Service and
Repair/D-Pillar Trim Panel.
Vehicles with safety canopies
18. Remove the 4 garment hangers.
- Open the access panel.
- Remove the garment hanger screws.
Vehicles without safety canopies
19. NOTICE: To prevent damage to the garment hanger retainer, use a 3/16-inch flat-blade
screwdriver for this step.
NOTE: The garment hanger is shown without the roof sheet metal to show the metal retainer clip.
The metal retainer clip will remain engaged in the sheet metal after the garment hanger is
removed.
Remove the 2 garment hangers.
1. Open the access cover.
2. Insert the flat-blade screwdriver fully into the garment slot.
3. Rotate the screwdriver 90 degrees so that the screwdriver spreads the metal retainer clip.
Remove the plastic garment hanger.
Expedition EL/Navigator L
20. Open the third row safety belt anchor bolt cover.
21. Remove the third row seat safety belt anchor bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
22. Remove the third row safety belt.
All vehicles
23. Remove the 2 center pin-type retainers.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 7466
24. Remove the 2 rear pin-type retainers.
Vehicles with rear climate control
25. Tilt the headliner to release the vent duct.
All vehicles
26. Disconnect the rear electrical connector.
27. NOTICE: To avoid bending or crimping the headliner, the help of an assistant is required for
this step.
Remove the headliner.
28. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Transfer parts as necessary.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Interior Trim - Exploded View
Trim Panel: Service and Repair Interior Trim - Exploded View
Interior Trim - Exploded View
NOTE: Expedition/Navigator shown, Expedition EL/Navigator L similar.
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Interior Trim - Exploded View > Page 7471
Trim Panel: Service and Repair A-Pillar Trim Panel
A-Pillar Trim Panel
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the 2 A-pillar assist handle bolt covers.
2. Remove the 2 A-pillar assist handle bolts.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
3. NOTE: Carefully rotate the A-pillar trim panel during this step.
Remove the A-pillar trim panel.
- Pull the A-pillar trim panel outward to release the A-pillar retaining clips.
4. NOTICE: To avoid damage to the A-pillar trim panel, remove any retaining clips from the body
and attach them to the A-pillar trim
panel before installing.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Interior Trim - Exploded View > Page 7472
Trim Panel: Service and Repair B-Pillar Trim Panel
B-Pillar Trim Panel
Removal and Installation
Upper and lower
1. Move the front seat to the full forward position.
2. NOTE: Position the shoulder safety belt guide to the lowest position.
NOTE: Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt guide
cover is damaged or the cover does not remain closed, install a new shoulder safety belt guide
cover.
Remove the shoulder safety belt guide cover.
- Detach the top of the shoulder safety belt guide cover.
- Rotate the shoulder safety belt guide cover 90 degrees and remove from the safety belt guide
bolt.
3. Remove the shoulder safety belt guide.
- Remove the shoulder safety belt guide bolt. To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
- Remove the shoulder safety belt guide.
4. NOTICE: To avoid damage to the upper B-pillar trim panel, remove any retaining clips from the
body and attach them to the upper
B-pillar trim panel before installing.
Remove the upper B-pillar trim panel.
1. Remove the bolt cover and bolt.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
2. Remove the upper B-pillar trim panel by pulling outward to release the clips.
Lower
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Interior Trim - Exploded View > Page 7473
5. Remove the front and rear door scuff plates.
6. NOTICE: To avoid damage to the lower B-pillar trim panel, remove any retaining clips from the
body and attach them to the lower
B-pillar trim panel before installing.
Pull outward to release the lower B-pillar trim panel clips and reposition the lower B-pillar trim
panel.
7. Remove the front safety belt anchor bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
8. Feed the safety belt through the lower B-pillar trim panel and remove.
Upper and lower
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- When installing the upper B-pillar trim panel, insert the safety belt guide slide into the upper
B-pillar trim panel.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Interior Trim - Exploded View > Page 7474
Trim Panel: Service and Repair C-Pillar Trim Panel
C-Pillar Trim Panel
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. NOTE: Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt guide
cover is damaged or the cover does not remain
closed, install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
Remove the shoulder safety belt guide.
1. Position the shoulder safety belt cover upward.
2. Remove the safety belt guide bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3. Remove the shoulder safety belt guide.
2. Detach the safety belt holder pin-type retainer.
3. Remove the C-pillar trim panel fastener cover.
Expedition EL/Navigator L only
4. Remove the C-pillar trim panel nut.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
All vehicles except Expedition EL/Navigator L
5. Remove the C-pillar trim panel bolt.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
All vehicles
6. NOTICE: To avoid damage to the C-pillar trim panel, remove any retaining clips from the body
and attach them to the C-pillar trim
panel before installing.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Interior Trim - Exploded View > Page 7475
Remove the C-pillar trim panel.
- Pull the C-pillar trim panel outward to release the C-pillar trim panel retaining clips.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Interior Trim - Exploded View > Page 7476
Trim Panel: Service and Repair D-Pillar Trim Panel
D-Pillar Trim Panel
Removal and Installation
All vehicles except Expedition EL/Navigator L
NOTE: Right side with power vent windows shown, all others similar.
1. NOTE: Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt guide
cover is damaged or cover does not remain
closed, install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
Remove the shoulder safety belt guide.
1. Position the shoulder safety belt guide cover upward.
2. Remove the shoulder safety belt guide bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3. Remove the shoulder safety belt guide.
All vehicles
2. Remove the rear upper headliner trim panel.
- Pull the rear upper headliner trim panel downward to release the retaining clips.
3. NOTICE: To avoid damage to the D-pillar trim panel, remove any retaining clips from the body
and attach them to the D-pillar trim
panel before installing.
Remove the D-pillar trim panel.
1. Disengage the upper clip by pulling downward.
2. Unseat the D-pillar trim panel and rotate forward to remove.
- If equipped, disconnect the speaker electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Interior Trim - Exploded View > Page 7477
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Utility Storage Compartment > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Utility Storage Compartment: Service and Repair
Instrument Panel - Exploded View
Expedition
Navigator
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Utility Storage Compartment > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 7481
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Door Locks > Door Lock Cylinder > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Door Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
Door Lock Cylinder
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Individual lock cylinders are repaired by discarding the inoperative lock cylinder and
building a new lock cylinder using the appropriate lock repair package. The lock repair package
includes a detailed instruction sheet to build the new lock cylinder to the current code of the
vehicle.
1. Remove the exterior front door handle. For additional information, refer to Exterior Front Door
Handle See: Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front
Door/Front Door Handle/Front Door Exterior Handle/Service and Repair.
2. Remove the retainer and the front door lock cylinder.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Key > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Integrated
Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment
Key: Testing and Inspection Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using
Diagnostic Equipment
Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment
NOTE: This procedure is used when a customer needs keys programmed into the system and
does not have 2 programmed ignition keys available. This procedure is also useful when a
programmed ignition key(s) is lost or the ignition lock cylinder is replaced, and it is desired to erase
key code(s) from the Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) memory.
NOTE: This procedure erases all programmed ignition keys from the vehicle memory and the
vehicle does not start until 2 keys are programmed to the vehicle. This procedure also erases the
Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) identification codes (TICs) from the Smart Junction Box
(SJB), preventing the erased IKT from operating the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) functions on the
vehicle.
NOTE: Two PATS encoded (contains a transponder) IKT keys (or standard PATS keys) with the
correct mechanical cut must be available to carry out this procedure. One or both of them may be
the customer's original keys. One or both of them may be an IKT or a standard PATS key.
NOTE: If additional keys are to be programmed, refer to Key Programming Using Two
Programmed Keys See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing
and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys. If
the remaining keys are with the customer and are not available with the vehicle, instruct the
customer to refer to the Owner's Literature for instructions on programming the remaining keys. In
this case, the IC PID SPAREKEY must be enabled.
NOTE: This procedure is not necessary if only the PATS transceiver was replaced. Replacement of
the transceiver does not erase the PATS key codes in the IC.
1. Turn the key from the OFF position to the ON position.
2. From the scan tool, enter TOOLBOX. Select BODY-SECURITY-PATS Functions and follow the
on-screen instructions to ENTER SECURITY
ACCESS. For additional information, refer to Anti-Theft Security Access See: Accessories and
Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and
General Diagnostics.
3. From the scan tool menu select: IGNITION KEY CODE ERASE. Follow all Integrated Diagnostic
System (IDS) screen instructions until the key
erase procedure completes. The scan tool will also instruct to program 2 keys to complete the
process.
4. Turn the key to the OFF position and disconnect the scan tool (the key does not need to be
removed at this time).
5. NOTE: The RKE data transfer takes place between the key and the IC first. After both keys are
programmed into the IC, the RKE data transfers
from the IC to the SJB. Until the final data transfer takes place into the SJB, the RKE functions do
not operate.
NOTE: IKT keys require a 6-second programming time frame for the RKE data transfer to take
place, while standard PATS keys only require a minimum of 3 seconds.
Turn the first PATS key to the ON position for a minimum of 6 seconds (this additional 3 second
time frame allows for the RKE data transfer to take place).
6. Turn the first PATS key to the OFF position and remove the key from the ignition lock cylinder.
7. Insert the second PATS key into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the key to the ON position for
a minimum of 6 seconds (this additional 3
second time frame allows for the RKE data transfer to take place).
8. The vehicle should now start with both ignition keys and the RKE transmitter portion of an IKT
should function.
9. If it is desired to program additional key(s) (only up to 8 keys total can be programmed into the
IC), refer to Key Programming Using Two
Programmed Keys See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing
and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys for
each additional key that needs to be programmed.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Key > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Integrated
Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment > Page 7491
Key: Testing and Inspection Key Programming Switch State Control
Key Programming Switch State Control
NOTE: The spare key programming switch is a programmable switch which provides the capability
to enable/disable the normal customer spare key programming procedure detailed in the Owner's
Literature. It must read ENABLE if more than 2 keys need to be programmed into the Instrument
Cluster (IC). For additional information, refer to Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys
See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys. This
programmable switch is provided as a convenience for rental company fleets or other fleet
purchasers who may not want the spare key programming procedure available to the vehicle
driver.
NOTE: The spare key programming switch state can be viewed with the IC PID SPAREKEY.
NOTE: If the Instrument Cluster (IC) SPAREKEY PID reads ENABLE, up to 8 keys total can be
programmed into the IC. For additional information, refer to Key Programming Using Two
Programmed Keys See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing
and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys. If
the SPAREKEY PID reads DISABLED, the key programming using two programmed keys
procedure cannot function. The switch is set to ENABLE when the vehicle is built. The switch does
not affect the Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment procedure or the Spare Key
Programming - Unlimited Key Mode procedure or the Spare Key Programming - Using Diagnostic
Equipment procedure.
1. Insert a programmed Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) key into the ignition lock cylinder and
turn the key from the OFF position to the ON
position.
2. From the scan tool, follow the on-screen instructions to ENTER SECURITY ACCESS. For
additional information, refer to Anti-Theft Security
Access See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics .
3. From the scan tool menu select: "Customer Spare Key Programming Enable" (or "Customer
Spare Key Programming Disable").
- "Customer Spare Key Programming Enable" - spare key programming procedure is accessible.
- "Customer Spare Key Programming Disable" - spare key programming procedure is not
accessible.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Key > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Integrated
Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment > Page 7492
Key: Testing and Inspection Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys
Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys
NOTE: This procedure works only if 2 or more programmed ignition keys are available. If 2
programmed keys are not available, refer to Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key
Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and
Alarm Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Integrated Keyhead
Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment.
NOTE: The Instrument Cluster (IC) PID SPAREKEY must be enabled for this procedure to operate.
If this PID is not enabled, refer to Key Programming Switch State Control See: Accessories and
Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and
Relearning/Key Programming Switch State Control, then select SPAREKEY programming switch:
ENABLED. The PID SPAREKEY is set to ENABLE when the vehicle is built.
NOTE: If the programming procedure is successful, the new key(s) starts the vehicle and the
anti-theft indicator proves-out for approximately 3 seconds. If the programming procedure is not
successful and the new key(s) does not start the engine, leave the key in the ON position for at
least 3 seconds, then turn the key off. Repeat the key programming procedure from Step 1. If the
failure repeats, refer to Anti-Theft See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm
Systems/Testing and Inspection in the Diagnosis and Testing portion to review the DTCs and carry
out the appropriate pinpoint tests.
NOTE: A maximum of 8 Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) keys can be programmed into the
Instrument Cluster (IC) during this programming procedure, but only if the PID SPAREKEY is
ENABLED.
NOTE: If the vehicle is in unlimited key mode, this spare key programming procedure still functions.
Any 2 keys that can start the vehicle can be used to program an additional unlimited key.
NOTE: If additional keys are to be programmed, and the remaining keys are with the customer, or
are not available, instruct the customer to refer to the Owner's Literature for instructions on
programming the remaining keys. In this case, the PID SPAREKEY must be enabled.
NOTE: If the steps are not carried out as outlined, the programming procedure ends.
NOTE: Ignition keys must have a correct mechanical key cut for the vehicle and must be
PATS-encoded keys (contain a transponder).
NOTE: This procedure is not necessary if only the PATS transceiver was replaced. Replacement of
the transceiver does not erase the PATS key codes in the IC.
NOTE: When in the unlimited key mode (after the first 2 keys have been programmed to the
vehicle), the N_KEYCODE PID will always read 2, no matter how many keys are programmed to
the vehicle.
1. Insert the first programmed key into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the key from the OFF
position to the ON position (maintain the key in the
ON position for a minimum of 3 seconds and less than 10 seconds).
2. Turn the key to the OFF position and remove the key from the ignition lock cylinder.
3. Within 5 seconds of turning the key to the OFF position, insert the second programmed key into
the ignition lock cylinder and turn the key from
the OFF position to the ON position (maintain the key in the ON position for a minimum of 3
seconds and less than 10 seconds).
4. Turn the key to the OFF position and remove the key from the ignition lock cylinder.
5. Within 10 seconds of turning the key to the OFF position, insert the unprogrammed key (the new
key) into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the
key from the OFF position to the ON position, maintaining the key in the ON position for a minimum
of 6 seconds (the additional 3 second time frame allows for the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) data
transfer to take place, if programming an Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) key).
6. Start the vehicle with the new key(s).
7. If it is desired to program additional key(s) (only up to 8 keys total can be programmed into the
IC), repeat Steps 1-5 for each additional key that
needs to be programmed.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Key > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Integrated
Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment > Page 7493
Key: Testing and Inspection Spare Key Programming - Unlimited Key Mode
Spare Key Programming - Unlimited Key Mode
Enabling Unlimited Key Mode
NOTE: Unlimited key mode is intended for use by those customers who need more than 8 keys for
their vehicle.
NOTE: Before programming, the new key(s) must have the correct mechanical cut for the ignition
lock cylinder(s).
NOTE: The unlimited key mode is set up by creating a special, unique unlimited transponder
security key code and programming this key code into all of the vehicle keys so they contain the
same key code.
NOTE: When in the unlimited key mode (after the first 2 keys have been programmed to the
vehicle), the N_KEYCODE PID will always read 2, no matter how many keys are programmed to
the vehicle.
1. The customer must choose an 8-digit number (except for 00000000 or 00000001) to be
programmed to all of their vehicles keys (or, to all of the
keys they want programmed to one vehicle). All customer vehicles keys (or all keys for one vehicle)
need to use the same number. Valid digits are 0-9 and the letters A-F.
2. NOTE: If the PID UNL_KEY_ID is not available, unlimited key mode is turned on, and must be
turned off before viewing the stored code. At
this time, unlimited keys may be programmed to the vehicle(s). To view/change the stored code,
follow the procedure for disabling the unlimited key mode below.
Monitor the PID UNL_KEY_ID and compare its value against the code chosen in Step 1. It should
not be the same key code.
3. From the scan tool, follow the on-screen instructions to ENTER SECURITY ACCESS. For
additional information, refer to Anti-Theft Security
Access See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics .
4. Once in security access, select: "program unlimited key code" and follow the on-screen
instructions. Enter the 8-digit code chosen by the customer
in Step 1 of this procedure and follow the on-screen instructions.
5. Select: "unlimited key mode ON" and follow the on-screen instructions.
6. Select: "Ignition Key Code Erase" and follow the on-screen instructions.
7. Disconnect the scan tool and turn the ignition key to the OFF position.
8. Insert the first Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) key into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the
key to the ON position for 3 seconds (6 seconds
if it is an Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) key).
9. Turn the first PATS key to the OFF position and remove the key from the ignition lock cylinder.
10. Insert the second PATS key into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the key to the ON position
for 3 seconds (6 seconds if it is an IKT key).
11. The vehicle should now start with both PATS keys.
12. If it is desired to program additional key(s), refer to Key Programming Using Two Programmed
Keys See: Accessories and Optional
Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key
Programming Using Two Programmed Keys for each additional key that needs to be programmed.
Disabling Unlimited Key Mode
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Key > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Integrated
Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment > Page 7494
NOTE: By disabling the unlimited key mode, the previous access code no longer operates the
vehicle.
1. From the scan tool, follow the on-screen instructions to ENTER SECURITY ACCESS. For
additional information, refer to Anti-Theft Security
Access See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics .
2. Select: "unlimited key mode OFF" and follow the on-screen instructions.
3. Select: "Ignition Key Code Erase" and follow the on-screen instructions.
4. Disconnect the scan tool and turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
5. Insert the first PATS key into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the key to the ON position for 3
seconds (6 seconds if it is an IKT key).
6. Turn the first PATS key to the OFF position and remove the key from the ignition lock cylinder.
7. Insert the second PATS key into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the key to the ON position for
3 seconds (6 seconds if it is an IKT key).
8. NOTE: With the unlimited key mode turned off, a maximum of 8 keys can be programmed into
the Instrument Cluster (IC) using the Key
Programming Using Two Programmed Keys See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft
and Alarm Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key Programming Using
Two Programmed Keys procedure. The IC PID SPAREKEY must be enabled.
If it is desired to program additional key(s), refer to Key Programming Using Two Programmed
Keys See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys for each
additional key (up to 8 keys, total) that needs to be programmed. The IC PID SPAREKEY must be
enabled.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Key > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Integrated
Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment > Page 7495
Key: Testing and Inspection
Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment
Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment
NOTE: This procedure is used when a customer needs keys programmed into the system and
does not have 2 programmed ignition keys available. This procedure is also useful when a
programmed ignition key(s) is lost or the ignition lock cylinder is replaced, and it is desired to erase
key code(s) from the Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) memory.
NOTE: This procedure erases all programmed ignition keys from the vehicle memory and the
vehicle does not start until 2 keys are programmed to the vehicle. This procedure also erases the
Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) identification codes (TICs) from the Smart Junction Box
(SJB), preventing the erased IKT from operating the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) functions on the
vehicle.
NOTE: Two PATS encoded (contains a transponder) IKT keys (or standard PATS keys) with the
correct mechanical cut must be available to carry out this procedure. One or both of them may be
the customer's original keys. One or both of them may be an IKT or a standard PATS key.
NOTE: If additional keys are to be programmed, refer to Key Programming Using Two
Programmed Keys See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing
and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys. If
the remaining keys are with the customer and are not available with the vehicle, instruct the
customer to refer to the Owner's Literature for instructions on programming the remaining keys. In
this case, the IC PID SPAREKEY must be enabled.
NOTE: This procedure is not necessary if only the PATS transceiver was replaced. Replacement of
the transceiver does not erase the PATS key codes in the IC.
1. Turn the key from the OFF position to the ON position.
2. From the scan tool, enter TOOLBOX. Select BODY-SECURITY-PATS Functions and follow the
on-screen instructions to ENTER SECURITY
ACCESS. For additional information, refer to Anti-Theft Security Access See: Accessories and
Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and
General Diagnostics.
3. From the scan tool menu select: IGNITION KEY CODE ERASE. Follow all Integrated Diagnostic
System (IDS) screen instructions until the key
erase procedure completes. The scan tool will also instruct to program 2 keys to complete the
process.
4. Turn the key to the OFF position and disconnect the scan tool (the key does not need to be
removed at this time).
5. NOTE: The RKE data transfer takes place between the key and the IC first. After both keys are
programmed into the IC, the RKE data transfers
from the IC to the SJB. Until the final data transfer takes place into the SJB, the RKE functions do
not operate.
NOTE: IKT keys require a 6-second programming time frame for the RKE data transfer to take
place, while standard PATS keys only require a minimum of 3 seconds.
Turn the first PATS key to the ON position for a minimum of 6 seconds (this additional 3 second
time frame allows for the RKE data transfer to take place).
6. Turn the first PATS key to the OFF position and remove the key from the ignition lock cylinder.
7. Insert the second PATS key into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the key to the ON position for
a minimum of 6 seconds (this additional 3
second time frame allows for the RKE data transfer to take place).
8. The vehicle should now start with both ignition keys and the RKE transmitter portion of an IKT
should function.
9. If it is desired to program additional key(s) (only up to 8 keys total can be programmed into the
IC), refer to Key Programming Using Two
Programmed Keys See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing
and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys for
each additional key that needs to be programmed.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Key > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Integrated
Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment > Page 7496
Key Programming Switch State Control
Key Programming Switch State Control
NOTE: The spare key programming switch is a programmable switch which provides the capability
to enable/disable the normal customer spare key programming procedure detailed in the Owner's
Literature. It must read ENABLE if more than 2 keys need to be programmed into the Instrument
Cluster (IC). For additional information, refer to Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys
See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys. This
programmable switch is provided as a convenience for rental company fleets or other fleet
purchasers who may not want the spare key programming procedure available to the vehicle
driver.
NOTE: The spare key programming switch state can be viewed with the IC PID SPAREKEY.
NOTE: If the Instrument Cluster (IC) SPAREKEY PID reads ENABLE, up to 8 keys total can be
programmed into the IC. For additional information, refer to Key Programming Using Two
Programmed Keys See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing
and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys. If
the SPAREKEY PID reads DISABLED, the key programming using two programmed keys
procedure cannot function. The switch is set to ENABLE when the vehicle is built. The switch does
not affect the Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment procedure or the Spare Key
Programming - Unlimited Key Mode procedure or the Spare Key Programming - Using Diagnostic
Equipment procedure.
1. Insert a programmed Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) key into the ignition lock cylinder and
turn the key from the OFF position to the ON
position.
2. From the scan tool, follow the on-screen instructions to ENTER SECURITY ACCESS. For
additional information, refer to Anti-Theft Security
Access See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics .
3. From the scan tool menu select: "Customer Spare Key Programming Enable" (or "Customer
Spare Key Programming Disable").
- "Customer Spare Key Programming Enable" - spare key programming procedure is accessible.
- "Customer Spare Key Programming Disable" - spare key programming procedure is not
accessible.
Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys
Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys
NOTE: This procedure works only if 2 or more programmed ignition keys are available. If 2
programmed keys are not available, refer to Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key
Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and
Alarm Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Integrated Keyhead
Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment.
NOTE: The Instrument Cluster (IC) PID SPAREKEY must be enabled for this procedure to operate.
If this PID is not enabled, refer to Key Programming Switch State Control See: Accessories and
Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and
Relearning/Key Programming Switch State Control, then select SPAREKEY programming switch:
ENABLED. The PID SPAREKEY is set to ENABLE when the vehicle is built.
NOTE: If the programming procedure is successful, the new key(s) starts the vehicle and the
anti-theft indicator proves-out for approximately 3 seconds. If the programming procedure is not
successful and the new key(s) does not start the engine, leave the key in the ON position for at
least 3 seconds, then turn the key off. Repeat the key programming procedure from Step 1. If the
failure repeats, refer to Anti-Theft See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm
Systems/Testing and Inspection in the Diagnosis and Testing portion to review the DTCs and carry
out the appropriate pinpoint tests.
NOTE: A maximum of 8 Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) keys can be programmed into the
Instrument Cluster (IC) during this programming procedure, but only if the PID SPAREKEY is
ENABLED.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Key > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Integrated
Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment > Page 7497
NOTE: If the vehicle is in unlimited key mode, this spare key programming procedure still functions.
Any 2 keys that can start the vehicle can be used to program an additional unlimited key.
NOTE: If additional keys are to be programmed, and the remaining keys are with the customer, or
are not available, instruct the customer to refer to the Owner's Literature for instructions on
programming the remaining keys. In this case, the PID SPAREKEY must be enabled.
NOTE: If the steps are not carried out as outlined, the programming procedure ends.
NOTE: Ignition keys must have a correct mechanical key cut for the vehicle and must be
PATS-encoded keys (contain a transponder).
NOTE: This procedure is not necessary if only the PATS transceiver was replaced. Replacement of
the transceiver does not erase the PATS key codes in the IC.
NOTE: When in the unlimited key mode (after the first 2 keys have been programmed to the
vehicle), the N_KEYCODE PID will always read 2, no matter how many keys are programmed to
the vehicle.
1. Insert the first programmed key into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the key from the OFF
position to the ON position (maintain the key in the
ON position for a minimum of 3 seconds and less than 10 seconds).
2. Turn the key to the OFF position and remove the key from the ignition lock cylinder.
3. Within 5 seconds of turning the key to the OFF position, insert the second programmed key into
the ignition lock cylinder and turn the key from
the OFF position to the ON position (maintain the key in the ON position for a minimum of 3
seconds and less than 10 seconds).
4. Turn the key to the OFF position and remove the key from the ignition lock cylinder.
5. Within 10 seconds of turning the key to the OFF position, insert the unprogrammed key (the new
key) into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the
key from the OFF position to the ON position, maintaining the key in the ON position for a minimum
of 6 seconds (the additional 3 second time frame allows for the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) data
transfer to take place, if programming an Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) key).
6. Start the vehicle with the new key(s).
7. If it is desired to program additional key(s) (only up to 8 keys total can be programmed into the
IC), repeat Steps 1-5 for each additional key that
needs to be programmed.
Spare Key Programming - Unlimited Key Mode
Spare Key Programming - Unlimited Key Mode
Enabling Unlimited Key Mode
NOTE: Unlimited key mode is intended for use by those customers who need more than 8 keys for
their vehicle.
NOTE: Before programming, the new key(s) must have the correct mechanical cut for the ignition
lock cylinder(s).
NOTE: The unlimited key mode is set up by creating a special, unique unlimited transponder
security key code and programming this key code into all of the vehicle keys so they contain the
same key code.
NOTE: When in the unlimited key mode (after the first 2 keys have been programmed to the
vehicle), the N_KEYCODE PID will always read 2, no matter how many keys are programmed to
the vehicle.
1. The customer must choose an 8-digit number (except for 00000000 or 00000001) to be
programmed to all of their vehicles keys (or, to all of the
keys they want programmed to one vehicle). All customer vehicles keys (or all keys for one vehicle)
need to use the same number. Valid digits are 0-9 and the letters A-F.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Key > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Integrated
Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment > Page 7498
2. NOTE: If the PID UNL_KEY_ID is not available, unlimited key mode is turned on, and must be
turned off before viewing the stored code. At
this time, unlimited keys may be programmed to the vehicle(s). To view/change the stored code,
follow the procedure for disabling the unlimited key mode below.
Monitor the PID UNL_KEY_ID and compare its value against the code chosen in Step 1. It should
not be the same key code.
3. From the scan tool, follow the on-screen instructions to ENTER SECURITY ACCESS. For
additional information, refer to Anti-Theft Security
Access See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics .
4. Once in security access, select: "program unlimited key code" and follow the on-screen
instructions. Enter the 8-digit code chosen by the customer
in Step 1 of this procedure and follow the on-screen instructions.
5. Select: "unlimited key mode ON" and follow the on-screen instructions.
6. Select: "Ignition Key Code Erase" and follow the on-screen instructions.
7. Disconnect the scan tool and turn the ignition key to the OFF position.
8. Insert the first Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) key into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the
key to the ON position for 3 seconds (6 seconds
if it is an Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) key).
9. Turn the first PATS key to the OFF position and remove the key from the ignition lock cylinder.
10. Insert the second PATS key into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the key to the ON position
for 3 seconds (6 seconds if it is an IKT key).
11. The vehicle should now start with both PATS keys.
12. If it is desired to program additional key(s), refer to Key Programming Using Two Programmed
Keys See: Accessories and Optional
Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key
Programming Using Two Programmed Keys for each additional key that needs to be programmed.
Disabling Unlimited Key Mode
NOTE: By disabling the unlimited key mode, the previous access code no longer operates the
vehicle.
1. From the scan tool, follow the on-screen instructions to ENTER SECURITY ACCESS. For
additional information, refer to Anti-Theft Security
Access See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics .
2. Select: "unlimited key mode OFF" and follow the on-screen instructions.
3. Select: "Ignition Key Code Erase" and follow the on-screen instructions.
4. Disconnect the scan tool and turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
5. Insert the first PATS key into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the key to the ON position for 3
seconds (6 seconds if it is an IKT key).
6. Turn the first PATS key to the OFF position and remove the key from the ignition lock cylinder.
7. Insert the second PATS key into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the key to the ON position for
3 seconds (6 seconds if it is an IKT key).
8. NOTE: With the unlimited key mode turned off, a maximum of 8 keys can be programmed into
the Instrument Cluster (IC) using the Key
Programming Using Two Programmed Keys See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft
and Alarm Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key Programming Using
Two Programmed Keys procedure. The IC PID SPAREKEY must be enabled.
If it is desired to program additional key(s), refer to Key Programming Using Two Programmed
Keys See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys for each
additional key (up to 8 keys, total) that needs to be programmed. The IC PID SPAREKEY must be
enabled.
Spare Key Programming - Using Diagnostic Equipment
Spare Key Programming - Using Diagnostic Equipment
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Key > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Integrated
Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment > Page 7499
NOTE: This procedure is used when a customer needs to have an additional key programmed into
the vehicle without erasing stored key codes, but does not have 2 programmed keys available. This
procedure is also useful when attempting to determine if an ignition key is damaged, as a new key
can be installed without erasing keys or without having 2 programmed keys available.
NOTE: Before programming, the new key must have the correct mechanical cut for the ignition lock
cylinder.
NOTE: If 8 keys are already programmed, this procedure does not allow any more Passive
Anti-Theft System (PATS) keys to be programmed. The number of keys that are programmed into
the PATS can be determined by viewing the Instrument Cluster (IC) PID N_KEYCODE.
NOTE: When in the unlimited key mode (after the first 2 keys have been programmed to the
vehicle), the N_KEYCODE PID will always read 2, no matter how many keys are programmed to
the vehicle.
1. Turn the unprogrammed PATS key from the OFF position to the ON position.
2. From the scan tool, follow the on-screen instructions to ENTER SECURITY ACCESS. For
additional information, refer to Anti-Theft Security
Access See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics .
3. NOTE: Make sure the selection made is "PROGRAM". If the "ERASE" selection is made, all of
the keys are erased from the system.
From the scan tool menu select: "Program additional ignition key".
4. Turn the key to the OFF position and disconnect the scan tool.
5. Start the vehicle with the new PATS key. The vehicle starts with the new PATS key and also with
the original PATS keys.
Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) Parameter Reset
Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) Parameter Reset
NOTE: When using the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS), the Instrument Cluster (IC) and the
PCM parameters are reset at the same time.
1. Turn the key from the OFF position to the ON position.
2. From the scan tool, follow the on-screen instructions to ENTER SECURITY ACCESS. For
additional information, refer to Anti-Theft Security
Access See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics .
3. From the scan tool, select: Parameter Reset and follow the on-screen instructions.
4. NOTE: If the IC was replaced, follow Steps 4-9. If the IC and the PCM were replaced, follow
Steps 4-9. If only the PCM was replaced, go to Step
9.
From the scan tool, select: Ignition Key Code Erase and follow the on-screen instructions.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Key > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Integrated
Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment > Page 7500
5. Turn the key to the OFF position and disconnect the scan tool.
6. Turn the key to the ON position for a minimum of 3 seconds.
7. Turn the key to the OFF position and remove the key.
8. Insert the second key into the ignition lock cylinder and turn the key to the ON position for a
minimum of 3 seconds.
9. Both keys will now start the vehicle.
10. If more keys are required to be programmed, refer to Key Programming Using Two
Programmed Keys See: Accessories and Optional
Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key
Programming Using Two Programmed Keys.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Key-Pad > Component Information >
Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Key-Pad > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 7505
Keyless Entry Key-Pad: Testing and Inspection
Keyless Entry Keypad Code Programming
Programming a Personal Code and Keypad Association to Memory Seats and Mirrors (If Equipped)
NOTE: If the wrong code has been entered 7 times (35 consecutive button presses), the keypad
will go into an anti-scan mode. This mode disables the keypad for one minute and the keypad
illumination will flash. The anti-scan feature will turn off after one minute of keypad inactivity, after
pressing the UNLOCK button on the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter, or after the ignition
key has been turned to the ON position.
NOTE: The factory set code cannot be associated with a memory setting.
1. Enter the permanent factory keyless entry keypad code.
2. Within 5 seconds, press the 1/2 button on the keypad.
3. Enter the new 5-digit keyless entry keypad code. Each number must be entered within 5
seconds of each other.
4. To associate the entry code with a memory setting, enter a sixth digit to indicate which driver
should be set in a memory recalled by the personal
entry code: Pressing the 1/2 button recalls driver 1 settings
- Pressing the 3/4 button recalls driver 2 settings
- Pressing other keypad buttons or not pressing a keypad button as a sixth digit does not set a
driver and will not recall a memory setting
5. The doors will lock then unlock to confirm the new code is programmed.
Erasing the Personal Codes
NOTE: If the wrong code has been entered 7 times (35 consecutive button presses), the keypad
will go into an anti-scan mode. This mode disables the keypad for one minute and the keypad
illumination will flash. The anti-scan feature will turn off after one minute of keypad inactivity, after
pressing the UNLOCK button on the RKE transmitter, or after the ignition key has been turned to
the ON position.
1. Enter the permanent factory keyless entry keypad code.
2. Within 5 seconds, press the 1/2 button on the keypad and release.
3. Within 5 seconds, press and hold the 1/2 button on the keypad for 2 seconds.
4. All personal codes are now erased and only the permanent factory keyless entry keypad code
will work.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Key-Pad > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 7506
Keyless Entry Key-Pad: Service and Repair
Keyless Entry Keypad
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the exterior mirror.
2. Remove the front door outer glass weatherstrip.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. Release the tabs and remove the keyless entry keypad.
- Disconnect the keypad harness retaining clips from the weatherstrip.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection > Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) Transmitter Programming
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Testing and Inspection Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) Transmitter
Programming
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) Transmitter Programming
NOTE: This procedure is for programming conventional keyfobs only. The Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) transmitter of the Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) is programmed automatically during
the Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) programming. For additional information, refer to Key
Programming Using Two Programmed Keys or Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key
Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment in Antitheft and Alarm Systems to program the IKT.
See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys See:
Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming
Using Diagnostic Equipment
NOTE: All RKE transmitters must be programmed at the same time.
NOTE: Do not apply the brake pedal during this sequencing, as doing so ends the sequence and
the transmitters will not be programmed.
1. Electronically unlock the door locks using the door lock control switch.
2. Cycle the ignition switch from the OFF to the RUN position 8 times in rapid succession (within 10
seconds), with the eighth turn ending in RUN.
If the module successfully enters program mode, it locks and then unlocks all the doors.
3. NOTE: If no action is taken within 20 seconds after a transmitter has been programmed, the
programming sequence ends (the doors lock and
unlock to confirm that programming is complete).
Within 20 seconds, press any button on the RKE transmitter to be programmed. The doors lock
and then unlock to confirm that each RKE transmitter is programmed. Repeat this step for each
RKE transmitter.
4. Exiting the programming mode is accomplished if one of the following occurs:
- The key transitions to the OFF position.
- 20 seconds have passed since entering programming mode or since the last RKE transmitter was
programmed.
- The maximum number (4) of RKE transmitters have been programmed.
5. Check the operation of the RKE transmitter. If the door locks do not respond for the programmed
RKE transmitter(s), wait several seconds and
press the button again. If the door locks still fail to respond, refer to Locks, Latches and Entry
Systems See: Power Locks/Testing and Inspection. (Make sure that no more than the maximum
number of RKE transmitters are attempted to be programmed.)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection > Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) Transmitter Programming > Page 7511
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Testing and Inspection Autolock and Auto-Unlock Programming
Autolock and Auto-Unlock Programming
Programming the Autolock Feature Using the Door Lock Control Switch
NOTE: This feature can also be enabled or disabled using the message center switch functions, if
equipped.
NOTE: The autolock feature can be enabled or disabled independently of the auto-unlock feature.
NOTE: The following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure will need to be
repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF to the RUN position.
2. Press the unlock button on the door lock control 3 times.
3. Turn the ignition switch from the RUN to the OFF position.
4. Press the unlock button on the door lock control switch 3 times.
5. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN position. The horn chirps one time to indicate that
programming mode is entered.
6. NOTE: The unlock and lock buttons must be pressed within 5 seconds of each other.
Within 30 seconds of entering the programming mode, press the unlock button and then the lock
button on the door lock control switch within 5 seconds to enable/disable the autolock feature. The
horn chirps once if the autolocks are disabled or a chirp followed by a honk if the autolocks are
enabled.
7. Programming ends when the ignition switch state changes or times out after 2 minutes.
Programming the Auto-Unlock Feature Using the Door Lock Control Switch
NOTE: This feature can also be enabled or disabled using the message center switch functions, if
equipped.
NOTE: The auto-unlock feature can be enabled or disabled independently of the autolock feature.
NOTE: The following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure will need to be
repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF to the RUN position.
2. Press the unlock button on the door unlock control 3 times.
3. Turn the ignition switch from the RUN to the OFF position.
4. Press the unlock button on the door lock control switch 3 times.
5. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN position. The horn chirps one time to indicate that
programming mode is entered.
6. NOTE: The lock and unlock buttons must be pressed within 5 seconds of each other.
Within 30 seconds of entering the programming mode, press the lock button on the door lock
control switch then the unlock button to enable/disable the auto-unlock feature. The horn chirps
once if the autolocks are disabled or a chirp followed by a honk if the autolocks are enabled.
7. Programming ends when the ignition switch state changes or times out after 2 minutes.
Programming the Autolock Feature Using the Keyless Entry Keypad
NOTE: The autolock feature can be enabled or disabled independently of the auto-unlock feature.
NOTE: The following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure needs to be
repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection > Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) Transmitter Programming > Page 7512
1. Enter the factory set 5 digit entry code.
2. Press and hold the 3/4 button.
3. While holding the 3/4 button, press and release the 7/8 button.
4. Release the 3/4 button. The horn chirps once if the autolocks are disabled, or chirps once
followed by a honk if the autolocks are enabled.
Programming the Auto-Unlock Feature Using the Keyless Entry Keypad
NOTE: The auto-unlock feature can be enabled or disabled independently of the autolock feature.
NOTE: The following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure will need to be
repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. Enter the factory set 5 digit entry code.
2. Press and hold the 3/4 button.
3. While holding the 3/4 button, press and release the 7/8 button twice.
4. Release the 3/4 button. The horn chirps once if auto-unlock is disabled, or chirps once followed
by a honk if auto-unlock is enabled.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection > Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) Transmitter Programming > Page 7513
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Testing and Inspection Remote Memory Activation
Remote Memory Activation
1. Position the driver seat, adjustable pedals, steering column and exterior mirror to the desired
positions.
2. Press and hold either memory button (1 or 2) for 5 seconds. A tone will be heard after 1-1/2
seconds when the memory store is done. Continue to
hold until a second tone is heard after 5 seconds.
3. Within 3 seconds, press the LOCK button on the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter.
4. If a second memory setting is desired, repeat the procedure with the second RKE transmitter.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection > Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) Transmitter Programming > Page 7514
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Testing and Inspection Remote Memory Deactivation
Remote Memory Deactivation
1. Press and hold either memory button (1 or 2) for 5 seconds. A tone will be heard after 1-1/2
seconds when the memory store is done. Continue to
hold until a second tone is heard after 5 seconds.
2. Within 3 seconds, press the UNLOCK button on the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter.
3. If a second memory setting is desired to be deactivated, repeat the procedure with the second
RKE transmitter.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection > Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) Transmitter Programming > Page 7515
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Testing and Inspection
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) Transmitter Programming
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) Transmitter Programming
NOTE: This procedure is for programming conventional keyfobs only. The Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) transmitter of the Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) is programmed automatically during
the Passive Anti-Theft System (PATS) programming. For additional information, refer to Key
Programming Using Two Programmed Keys or Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key
Programming Using Diagnostic Equipment in Antitheft and Alarm Systems to program the IKT.
See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Key Programming Using Two Programmed Keys See:
Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and Alarm Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning/Integrated Keyhead Transmitter (IKT) Key Programming
Using Diagnostic Equipment
NOTE: All RKE transmitters must be programmed at the same time.
NOTE: Do not apply the brake pedal during this sequencing, as doing so ends the sequence and
the transmitters will not be programmed.
1. Electronically unlock the door locks using the door lock control switch.
2. Cycle the ignition switch from the OFF to the RUN position 8 times in rapid succession (within 10
seconds), with the eighth turn ending in RUN.
If the module successfully enters program mode, it locks and then unlocks all the doors.
3. NOTE: If no action is taken within 20 seconds after a transmitter has been programmed, the
programming sequence ends (the doors lock and
unlock to confirm that programming is complete).
Within 20 seconds, press any button on the RKE transmitter to be programmed. The doors lock
and then unlock to confirm that each RKE transmitter is programmed. Repeat this step for each
RKE transmitter.
4. Exiting the programming mode is accomplished if one of the following occurs:
- The key transitions to the OFF position.
- 20 seconds have passed since entering programming mode or since the last RKE transmitter was
programmed.
- The maximum number (4) of RKE transmitters have been programmed.
5. Check the operation of the RKE transmitter. If the door locks do not respond for the programmed
RKE transmitter(s), wait several seconds and
press the button again. If the door locks still fail to respond, refer to Locks, Latches and Entry
Systems See: Power Locks/Testing and Inspection. (Make sure that no more than the maximum
number of RKE transmitters are attempted to be programmed.)
Autolock and Auto-Unlock Programming
Autolock and Auto-Unlock Programming
Programming the Autolock Feature Using the Door Lock Control Switch
NOTE: This feature can also be enabled or disabled using the message center switch functions, if
equipped.
NOTE: The autolock feature can be enabled or disabled independently of the auto-unlock feature.
NOTE: The following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure will need to be
repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF to the RUN position.
2. Press the unlock button on the door lock control 3 times.
3. Turn the ignition switch from the RUN to the OFF position.
4. Press the unlock button on the door lock control switch 3 times.
5. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN position. The horn chirps one time to indicate that
programming mode is entered.
6. NOTE: The unlock and lock buttons must be pressed within 5 seconds of each other.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection > Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) Transmitter Programming > Page 7516
Within 30 seconds of entering the programming mode, press the unlock button and then the lock
button on the door lock control switch within 5 seconds to enable/disable the autolock feature. The
horn chirps once if the autolocks are disabled or a chirp followed by a honk if the autolocks are
enabled.
7. Programming ends when the ignition switch state changes or times out after 2 minutes.
Programming the Auto-Unlock Feature Using the Door Lock Control Switch
NOTE: This feature can also be enabled or disabled using the message center switch functions, if
equipped.
NOTE: The auto-unlock feature can be enabled or disabled independently of the autolock feature.
NOTE: The following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure will need to be
repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF to the RUN position.
2. Press the unlock button on the door unlock control 3 times.
3. Turn the ignition switch from the RUN to the OFF position.
4. Press the unlock button on the door lock control switch 3 times.
5. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN position. The horn chirps one time to indicate that
programming mode is entered.
6. NOTE: The lock and unlock buttons must be pressed within 5 seconds of each other.
Within 30 seconds of entering the programming mode, press the lock button on the door lock
control switch then the unlock button to enable/disable the auto-unlock feature. The horn chirps
once if the autolocks are disabled or a chirp followed by a honk if the autolocks are enabled.
7. Programming ends when the ignition switch state changes or times out after 2 minutes.
Programming the Autolock Feature Using the Keyless Entry Keypad
NOTE: The autolock feature can be enabled or disabled independently of the auto-unlock feature.
NOTE: The following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure needs to be
repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. Enter the factory set 5 digit entry code.
2. Press and hold the 3/4 button.
3. While holding the 3/4 button, press and release the 7/8 button.
4. Release the 3/4 button. The horn chirps once if the autolocks are disabled, or chirps once
followed by a honk if the autolocks are enabled.
Programming the Auto-Unlock Feature Using the Keyless Entry Keypad
NOTE: The auto-unlock feature can be enabled or disabled independently of the autolock feature.
NOTE: The following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure will need to be
repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. Enter the factory set 5 digit entry code.
2. Press and hold the 3/4 button.
3. While holding the 3/4 button, press and release the 7/8 button twice.
4. Release the 3/4 button. The horn chirps once if auto-unlock is disabled, or chirps once followed
by a honk if auto-unlock is enabled.
Remote Memory Activation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection > Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) Transmitter Programming > Page 7517
Remote Memory Activation
1. Position the driver seat, adjustable pedals, steering column and exterior mirror to the desired
positions.
2. Press and hold either memory button (1 or 2) for 5 seconds. A tone will be heard after 1-1/2
seconds when the memory store is done. Continue to
hold until a second tone is heard after 5 seconds.
3. Within 3 seconds, press the LOCK button on the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter.
4. If a second memory setting is desired, repeat the procedure with the second RKE transmitter.
Remote Memory Deactivation
Remote Memory Deactivation
1. Press and hold either memory button (1 or 2) for 5 seconds. A tone will be heard after 1-1/2
seconds when the memory store is done. Continue to
hold until a second tone is heard after 5 seconds.
2. Within 3 seconds, press the UNLOCK button on the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter.
3. If a second memory setting is desired to be deactivated, repeat the procedure with the second
RKE transmitter.
Perimeter Lighting Feature Programming
Perimeter Lighting Feature Programming
Programming the Perimeter Lighting Feature Using the Door Lock Control Switch
NOTE: The following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure will need to be
repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF to the ON position.
2. Press the unlock button on the door lock control switch 3 times.
3. Turn the ignition switch from the ON to the OFF position.
4. Press the unlock button on the door lock control switch 3 times.
5. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position. The horn chirps one time to indicate that
programming mode is entered.
6. NOTE: The unlock button must be pressed twice within 5 seconds.
Within 30 seconds of entering the programming mode, press the unlock button on the door lock
control switch twice to enable/disable the perimeter lighting feature. The horn chirps once if the
perimeter lighting is disabled or a chirp followed by a honk if the perimeter lighting is enabled.
7. Programming ends when the ignition switch state changes or times out after 2 minutes.
Stepped Unlock Programming
Stepped Unlock Programming
1. With the ignition switch in the OFF position, press the LOCK and UNLOCK buttons on the
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter
simultaneously for 4 seconds. The turn signals flash twice to indicate the mode change.
2. Repeat Step 1 to enable/disable the stepped unlocking feature.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Door Lock Actuator, Right Front
Power Door Lock Actuator: Locations Door Lock Actuator, Right Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Door Lock Actuator, Right Front > Page 7523
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Door Lock Actuator, Right Front > Page 7524
Power Door Lock Actuator: Locations Door Lock Actuator, Left Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Door Lock Actuator, Right Front > Page 7525
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Door Lock Actuator, Right Front > Page 7526
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Door Lock Actuator, Right Front > Page 7527
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Diagrams > Door Lock Actuator, Left Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Diagrams > Door Lock Actuator, Left Front > Page 7530
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Diagrams > Door Lock Actuator, Left Front > Page 7531
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Diagrams > Door Lock Actuator, Left Front > Page 7532
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Diagrams > Page 7533
Power Door Lock Actuator: Service and Repair
Door Lock Actuator
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door latch. For additional information, refer to Front Door Latch See: Doors, Hood
and Trunk/Doors/Front Door/Front Door
Latch/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement or Rear Door Latch See: Doors, Hood and
Trunk/Doors/Rear Door/Rear Door Latch/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement.
2. Release the locking tab and remove the door lock actuator.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side
Power Door Lock Switch: Locations Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side > Page 7538
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side > Page 7539
Power Door Lock Switch: Locations Door Lock Switch, Driver Side
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side > Page 7540
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Door Lock Switch, Driver Side
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Door Lock Switch, Driver Side > Page 7543
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 7544
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 7545
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7551
Memory Positioning Module: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7552
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7553
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7554
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7555
Memory Positioning Module: Service and Repair
Driver Seat Module (DSM)
Removal and Installation
NOTICE: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these charges,
damage may result.
NOTE: Prior to the removal of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to a scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new Driver Seat Module
(DSM) after installation.
1. Upload the module configuration information from the DSM into the scan tool.
2. NOTE: The module is accessed with the seat fully in the UP position.
Position the DSM forward to remove it from the bracket.
3. Disconnect the battery.
4. Disconnect the electrical connectors and remove the DSM.
5. NOTE: Once the module is installed, it is necessary to download the module configuration
information from the scan tool into the new module.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Memory Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Memory Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7559
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Mirror Motor: Service and Repair
Exterior Mirror Motor
Removal and Installation
NOTE: If equipped with power folding mirrors, they must be synchronized any time the mirrors
have been folded or unfolded without using the mirror control switch. For additional information,
refer to Exterior Mirror Motor Synchronization - Power Folding See: Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning.
1. Remove the mirror glass. For additional information, refer to Exterior Mirror Glass See: Service
and Repair/Exterior Mirror Glass.
2. Remove the 3 exterior mirror motor screws and exterior mirror motor.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- If equipped with power folding mirrors, they must be synchronized. For additional information,
refer to Exterior Mirror Motor Synchronization - Power Folding See: Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Locations
Power Mirror Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
7566
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
7567
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
7568
Power Mirror Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
7569
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
7570
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
7571
Power Mirror Switch: Service and Repair
Exterior Mirror Control Switch
NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the driver front door trim panel.
2. Remove the exterior mirror control switch.
1. Depress the locking tabs.
2. Remove the exterior mirror control switch.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7576
Memory Positioning Module: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7577
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7578
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7579
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7580
Memory Positioning Module: Service and Repair
Driver Seat Module (DSM)
Removal and Installation
NOTICE: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these charges,
damage may result.
NOTE: Prior to the removal of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to a scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new Driver Seat Module
(DSM) after installation.
1. Upload the module configuration information from the DSM into the scan tool.
2. NOTE: The module is accessed with the seat fully in the UP position.
Position the DSM forward to remove it from the bracket.
3. Disconnect the battery.
4. Disconnect the electrical connectors and remove the DSM.
5. NOTE: Once the module is installed, it is necessary to download the module configuration
information from the scan tool into the new module.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7584
Power Seat Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7585
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Locations
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7589
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7590
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7591
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7592
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Latch Remote Control
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Service and Repair Liftgate Latch Remote Control
Liftgate Latch Remote Control
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The liftgate latch remote control is available with power liftgate only.
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel.
2. Position the watershield aside.
3. NOTICE: Be careful not to kink the liftgate latch actuating cable while disconnecting it from the
latch.
Disconnect the liftgate latch.
1. Release the liftgate latch actuator rod.
2. Disconnect the liftgate latch actuating cable.
4. Remove 3 bolts and position the liftgate latch remote control aside.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-in).
5. Disconnect the electrical connectors and remove the liftgate latch remote control.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Latch Remote Control > Page 7595
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Service and Repair Liftgate/Trunk Module (LTM)
Liftgate/Trunk Module (LTM)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear quarter trim panel.
2. Remove the Liftgate/Trunk Module (LTM).
1. Disconnect the electrical connectors.
2. Remove the bolt.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Initialize the power liftgate. For additional information, refer to Power Liftgate Initialization See:
Doors, Hood and Trunk/Trunk / Liftgate/Service and Repair/Procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board
Module > Component Information > Locations
Auxiliary Step / Running Board Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7599
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7600
Auxiliary Step / Running Board Module: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7601
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7602
Auxiliary Step / Running Board Module: Service and Repair
Power Running Board (PRB) Module
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the LH B-pillar trim panel.
2. Disconnect the Power Running Board (PRB) module electrical connectors.
3. Remove the 2 bolts and the PRB module assembly.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Rear Heated Seat Module
Seat Heater Control Module: Locations Rear Heated Seat Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Rear Heated Seat Module > Page 7607
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Rear Heated Seat Module > Page 7608
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Rear Heated Seat Module
Seat Heater Control Module: Diagrams Rear Heated Seat Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Rear Heated Seat Module > Page 7611
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Rear Heated Seat Module > Page 7612
Seat Heater Control Module: Diagrams Dual Climate Controlled Seat Module (DCSM)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Rear Heated Seat Module > Page 7613
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Rear Heated Seat Module > Page 7614
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat Heater Control Module: Service and Repair Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent
NOTE: Driver power seat backrest shown, passenger and manual similar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 7617
ERROR: undefined
OFFENDING COMMAND: f‘~
STACK:
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 7618
Seat Heater Control Module: Service and Repair Dual Climate Controlled Seat Module (DCSM)
Dual Climate Controlled Seat Module (DCSM)
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on safety belt buckle/retractor pretensioners or
adaptive load limiting retractors. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental
deployment of the safety belt pretensioners or adaptive load limiting retractors, which increases the
risk of serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on air bag, Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain
modules. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of these
modules, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
NOTE: For component identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Front See:
Seats/Service and Repair/Front Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Front.
1. When installing a new Dual Climate Controlled Seat Module (DCSM), carry out the appropriate
steps in the Programmable Module Installation
(PMI) procedure. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Information
Bus/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning
2. NOTICE: Do not pull from the inboard side of the front seat cushion panel shield to avoid
damaging it.
Position the front passenger seat fully upward and remove the front seat cushion panel shield.
- Release the upper retaining clips working from the outboard side and then release the lower
retaining clips.
3. Release the 2 tabs and slide out the DCSM.
4. Remove the DCSM.
- Cut and remove the wiring harness tie strap.
- Release the 2 locking wedges.
- Disconnect the 3 electrical connectors.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
6. If a new DCSM has been installed, carry out the appropriate steps in the Programmable Module
Installation (PMI) procedure. See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Information Bus/Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 7619
Seat Heater Control Module: Service and Repair Heated Seat Module - Second Row
Heated Seat Module - Second Row
NOTE: Bottom of floor console shown.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front floor console.
2. Disconnect the 2 heated seat module electrical connectors at the bottom of the front floor
console.
3. Remove the screw and un-hook the heated seat module.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
5. Carry out the auto-configuration sequence to program the heated seat module for use with a
dual momentary switch.
- Start the vehicle and push the low button on either heated seat switch.
- Operate the heated seats, monitor the indicators and verify the system is operating correctly in
high and low.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Module >
Component Information > Locations
Sunroof / Moonroof Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7623
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7624
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View
Sunroof / Moonroof Motor: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View
Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View > Page 7634
Sunroof / Moonroof Motor: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel Motor
Roof Opening Panel Motor
Removal
NOTE: The roof opening panel must be initialized when repairs are carried out on any part of the
roof opening panel, including: whenever the roof opening panel has been removed from the roof
opening panel assembly, a new roof opening panel motor/module has been installed or when a
new roof opening panel assembly has been installed. For additional information, refer to Roof
Opening Panel Motor Initialization See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning.
1. Remove the headliner.
2. Disconnect the roof opening panel motor electrical connector.
3. Remove the roof opening panel motor.
- Remove the 3 screws.
Installation
1. Connect the roof opening panel motor electrical connector.
2. NOTE: When installing the roof opening panel motor/module, align the 3 attach holes before
engaging the drive gear into the roof opening panel
drive cable. Do not rotate the motor assembly after the drive gear is engaged with the roof opening
panel drive cable. Otherwise, the cable can bind.
Install the roof opening panel motor.
- Align the attach holes, then install the 3 screws and tighten to 4 Nm (35 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View > Page 7635
3. Connect the overhead console electrical connectors.
4. Initialize the roof opening panel motor/module. For additional information, refer to Roof Opening
Panel Motor Initialization See: Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning.
5. Disconnect the overhead console electrical connectors.
6. Install the headliner.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 7639
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View
Sunroof / Moonroof Track: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View
Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View > Page 7644
Sunroof / Moonroof Track: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel Rear Trough Guide
Roof Opening Panel Rear Trough Guide
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The roof opening panel must be initialized when repairs are carried out on any part of the
roof opening panel, including: whenever the roof opening panel has been removed from the roof
opening panel assembly, a new roof opening panel motor/module has been installed or when a
new roof opening panel assembly has been installed. For additional information, refer to Roof
Opening Panel Motor Initialization See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning.
1. Remove the roof opening panel glass. For additional information, refer to Roof Opening Panel
Glass See: Sunroof / Moonroof Panel/Service and
Repair/Roof Opening Panel Glass.
2. Remove the 2 plastic trough guide retaining screws and the trough from the trough guide
assembly.
- To install, tighten to 1 Nm (9 lb-in).
3. Disconnect the trough guide rods from the lifter arm assemblies.
4. Slide the trough guide back to the slot (approximately 15 mm [0.6 in]) cut in track.
- Carefully twist trough guide through the slot in the track to remove.
5. Inspect the trough guide assembly for damage. If damage is found, inspect the track for broken
pieces and remove them.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Align the roof opening panel. For additional information, refer to Roof Opening Panel Alignment
See: Adjustments.
- Initialize the roof opening panel motor. For additional information, refer to Roof Opening Panel
Motor Initialization See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Windguard > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View
Sunroof / Moonroof Windguard: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View
Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Windguard > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View > Page 7649
Sunroof / Moonroof Windguard: Service and Repair Air Deflector
Air Deflector
Removal and Installation
1. Open the roof opening panel.
2. NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
Remove the 2 plastic air deflector screws.
- To install, tighten to 1 Nm (9 lb-in).
3. Raise the front of the air deflector.
4. Slide the air deflector toward the rear, then lift up to release it from the pivot shafts.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Frame > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View
Sunroof / Moonroof Frame: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View
Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Frame > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View > Page 7654
Sunroof / Moonroof Frame: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel Frame
Roof Opening Panel Frame
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The roof opening panel must be initialized when repairs are carried out on any part of the
roof opening panel, including: whenever the roof opening panel has been removed from the roof
opening panel assembly, a new roof opening panel motor/module has been installed or when a
new roof opening panel assembly has been installed. For additional information, refer to Roof
Opening Panel Motor Initialization See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning.
1. Remove the headliner.
2. Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. Remove the roof opening panel frame.
1. Disconnect the 4 roof opening panel drain hoses.
2. Remove the 11 bolts.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
3. Remove the roof opening panel frame.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure. If a new roof opening panel frame is being installed,
transfer the existing roof opening panel motor, air
deflector, rear trough, roof opening panel glass and roof opening panel shield onto the new frame
assembly. Initialize the roof opening panel motor. For additional information, refer to Roof Opening
Panel Motor Initialization See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Module > Component Information > Locations
Sunroof / Moonroof Module: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7658
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7659
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View
Sunroof / Moonroof Panel: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View
Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View > Page 7664
Sunroof / Moonroof Panel: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel Glass
Roof Opening Panel Glass
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The roof opening panel motor must be initialized when repairs are carried out on any part of
the roof opening panel, including: whenever the roof opening panel motor has been removed from
the roof opening panel assembly, a new roof opening panel motor has been installed or when a
new roof opening panel frame has been installed. For additional information, refer to Roof Opening
Panel Motor Initialization See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning.
1. NOTE: The roof opening panel glass must be in the CLOSED position.
Remove the 4 roof opening panel glass screws.
2. Remove the roof opening panel glass.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Align the roof opening panel. For additional information, refer to Roof Opening Panel Alignment
See: Adjustments.
- Initialize the roof opening panel motor. For additional information, refer to Roof Opening Panel
Motor Initialization See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View > Page 7665
Sunroof / Moonroof Panel: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel Shield
Roof Opening Panel Shield
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The roof opening panel must be initialized when repairs are carried out on any part of the
roof opening panel, including: whenever the roof opening panel has been removed from the roof
opening panel assembly, a new roof opening panel motor/module has been installed or when a
new roof opening panel assembly has been installed. For additional information, refer to Roof
Opening Panel Motor Initialization See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning.
1. Remove the roof opening panel glass. For additional information, refer to Roof Opening Panel
Glass See: Roof Opening Panel Glass.
2. Remove the water trough.
1. Remove the 2 screws.
- To install, tighten to 1 Nm (9 lb-in).
2. Remove the water trough.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel - Exploded View > Page 7666
ERROR: stackunderflow
OFFENDING COMMAND: ~
STACK:
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof
Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: Customer Interest Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High
Pressure Car Wash
TSB 08-24-8
12/08/08
WATER LEAKS - ROOF OPENING PANEL DURING HIGH PRESSURE CAR WASH
FORD: 2005-2008 F-150, F-250, F-350, F-450, F-550 2005-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2009 Navigator 2006-2008 Mark LT
This article supersedes TSB 08-1-4 to update the Part List and Service procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2009 Expedition, Navigator, 2005-2008 F-150, F-Super Duty and 2006-2008
Mark LT vehicles with factory installed roof opening panel may experience a water leak at the rear
of roof opening panel during a high pressure car wash.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
2005-2008 F-150 / F-Super Duty 250-550 / 2006-2008 Mark LT
1. Remove roof opening panel glass only. Refer to Work Shop Manual (WSM), Section 501-17.
2. To avoid paint damage to the roof, apply protective covering on roof finish.
3. From above vehicle, remove the two (2) trough guide retaining screws and the rear trough from
the trough guide assembly.
4. With rear trough removed; wipe clean the top inside of the trough with an alcohol based cleaner
or equivalent.
5. Remove the adhesive tape covering from trough seal.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof
Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash > Page 7675
6. Attach seal to front of trough starting at one end of the trough. Make sure the vertical leg of seal
lines up against front flange of trough. (Figures 1-3)
7. Secure seal across entire trough. Apply pressure along entire seal to ensure bonding to trough.
8. Install the rear trough onto the trough guide assembly. Install the two (2) trough guide retaining
screws and torque to 9 lb-in. (1 N.m)
9. Remove protective covering.
10. Install roof opening panel following WSM, Section 501-17.
2005-2009 Expedition / Navigator
1. Remove roof opening panel glass only. Refer to WSM, Section 501-17.
2. To avoid paint damage to the roof, apply protective covering on roof finish.
3. From above vehicle, remove the two (2) trough guide retaining screws and the rear trough from
the trough guide assembly.
4. Install new trough and seal assembly.
5. Install the rear trough and seal assembly onto the trough guide assembly. Install the two (2)
trough guide retaining screws and torque to 9 lb-in. (1 N.m)
6. Remove protective covering.
7. Install roof opening panel following WSM, Section 501-17.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof
Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash > Page 7676
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082408A 2005-2009 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator: Follow The Service Procedure To Repair The Water leak (Do Not Use With 5028A)
082408A 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.6 Hr.
F-150, 2005-2008 Mark LT: Follow The Service Procedure To Repair The Water leak (Do Not Use
With 5028A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
78502C50 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof
/ Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Sunroof Water Leaks
During High Pressure Car Wash
TSB 08-24-8
12/08/08
WATER LEAKS - ROOF OPENING PANEL DURING HIGH PRESSURE CAR WASH
FORD: 2005-2008 F-150, F-250, F-350, F-450, F-550 2005-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2009 Navigator 2006-2008 Mark LT
This article supersedes TSB 08-1-4 to update the Part List and Service procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2009 Expedition, Navigator, 2005-2008 F-150, F-Super Duty and 2006-2008
Mark LT vehicles with factory installed roof opening panel may experience a water leak at the rear
of roof opening panel during a high pressure car wash.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
2005-2008 F-150 / F-Super Duty 250-550 / 2006-2008 Mark LT
1. Remove roof opening panel glass only. Refer to Work Shop Manual (WSM), Section 501-17.
2. To avoid paint damage to the roof, apply protective covering on roof finish.
3. From above vehicle, remove the two (2) trough guide retaining screws and the rear trough from
the trough guide assembly.
4. With rear trough removed; wipe clean the top inside of the trough with an alcohol based cleaner
or equivalent.
5. Remove the adhesive tape covering from trough seal.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof
/ Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash > Page
7682
6. Attach seal to front of trough starting at one end of the trough. Make sure the vertical leg of seal
lines up against front flange of trough. (Figures 1-3)
7. Secure seal across entire trough. Apply pressure along entire seal to ensure bonding to trough.
8. Install the rear trough onto the trough guide assembly. Install the two (2) trough guide retaining
screws and torque to 9 lb-in. (1 N.m)
9. Remove protective covering.
10. Install roof opening panel following WSM, Section 501-17.
2005-2009 Expedition / Navigator
1. Remove roof opening panel glass only. Refer to WSM, Section 501-17.
2. To avoid paint damage to the roof, apply protective covering on roof finish.
3. From above vehicle, remove the two (2) trough guide retaining screws and the rear trough from
the trough guide assembly.
4. Install new trough and seal assembly.
5. Install the rear trough and seal assembly onto the trough guide assembly. Install the two (2)
trough guide retaining screws and torque to 9 lb-in. (1 N.m)
6. Remove protective covering.
7. Install roof opening panel following WSM, Section 501-17.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof
/ Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash > Page
7683
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082408A 2005-2009 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator: Follow The Service Procedure To Repair The Water leak (Do Not Use With 5028A)
082408A 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.6 Hr.
F-150, 2005-2008 Mark LT: Follow The Service Procedure To Repair The Water leak (Do Not Use
With 5028A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
78502C50 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7684
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
Roof Opening Panel Weatherstrip
Removal
NOTE: The roof opening panel must be initialized when repairs are carried out on any part of the
roof opening panel, including: whenever the roof opening panel has been removed from the roof
opening panel assembly, a new roof opening panel motor/module has been installed or when a
new roof opening panel assembly has been installed. For additional information, refer to Roof
Opening Panel Motor Initialization See: Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning.
1. Remove the roof opening panel glass. For additional information, refer to Roof Opening Panel
Glass See: Sunroof / Moonroof Panel/Service and
Repair/Roof Opening Panel Glass.
2. Place roof opening panel, topside up, on a worktable. Take care to support the glass assembly
from below to prevent damaging the mounting tabs.
3. Remove the old roof opening panel weatherstrip by pulling up on the weatherstrip.
Installation
1. Place a new weatherstrip into position on the glass assembly, with the splice (seam) on the
passenger side.
2. Starting with the corners, push the weatherstrip into position. Continue pushing the weatherstrip
into position around the glass assembly until
complete. Use a plastic or rubber hammer if necessary.
3. Install the roof opening panel. For additional information, refer to Roof Opening Panel Glass
See: Sunroof / Moonroof Panel/Service and
Repair/Roof Opening Panel Glass.
4. Align the roof panel. For additional information, refer to Roof Opening Panel Alignment See:
Adjustments.
5. Initialize the roof opening panel motor. For additional information, refer to Roof Opening Panel
Motor Initialization See: Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7690
Memory Positioning Module: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7691
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7692
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7693
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7694
Memory Positioning Module: Service and Repair
Driver Seat Module (DSM)
Removal and Installation
NOTICE: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these charges,
damage may result.
NOTE: Prior to the removal of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to a scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new Driver Seat Module
(DSM) after installation.
1. Upload the module configuration information from the DSM into the scan tool.
2. NOTE: The module is accessed with the seat fully in the UP position.
Position the DSM forward to remove it from the bracket.
3. Disconnect the battery.
4. Disconnect the electrical connectors and remove the DSM.
5. NOTE: Once the module is installed, it is necessary to download the module configuration
information from the scan tool into the new module.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Memory Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Memory Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7698
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 7703
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 7704
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 7705
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 7706
Power Seat Motor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 7707
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 7708
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 7709
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 7710
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 7711
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 7712
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 7713
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 7714
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 7715
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 7716
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 7717
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 7718
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor > Page 7719
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor
Power Seat Motor: Diagrams Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 7722
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 7723
Power Seat Motor: Diagrams Passenger Seat Front Height Motor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 7724
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 7725
Power Seat Motor: Diagrams Passenger Seat Rear Height Motor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 7726
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 7727
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 7728
Power Seat Motor: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 7729
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 7730
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 7731
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 7732
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 7733
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 7734
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 7735
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 7736
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat - Exploded View, Front
Power Seat Motor: Service and Repair Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent
NOTE: Driver power seat backrest shown, passenger and manual similar.
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent
NOTE: Driver memory seat shown, driver and passenger power seat similar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 7739
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 7740
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 7741
Power Seat Motor: Service and Repair Power-Fold Seat Motor
Power-Fold Seat Motor
Removal and Installation
NOTE: For parts identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Third Row See:
Service and Repair/Third Row Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Third Row.
1. Remove the load floor panel.
2. Remove the 2 bolts and mid-floor panel support.
- Release the 3 pin-type retainers.
3. Disconnect the power seat motor electrical connector and detach the wiring harness.
4. Remove the bracket-to-pivot bolt and bushing from the power-fold seat motor.
- Note bushing shoulder position for correct installation.
- To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
5. Remove the bracket-to-latch bolt and power-fold seat motor.
- Slide the power-fold seat motor and bracket away from the latch and torque shaft. For installation, slightly rotate the torque shaft until seated into the power-fold seat motor.
- To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front Height Position Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front Height Position Sensor > Page 7746
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front Height Position Sensor > Page 7747
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front Height Position Sensor > Page 7748
Power Seat Motor Position Sensor: Locations Height Sensor, Left Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front Height Position Sensor > Page 7749
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front Height Position Sensor > Page 7750
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front Height Position Sensor > Page 7751
Power Seat Motor Position Sensor: Locations Height Sensor, Right Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front Height Position Sensor > Page 7752
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor > Page 7755
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor > Page 7756
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor > Page 7757
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor > Page 7758
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page
7762
Power Seat Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page
7763
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Locations > Third
Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left
Power Seat Switch: Locations Third Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Locations > Third
Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left > Page 7768
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Locations > Third
Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left > Page 7769
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Locations > Third
Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left > Page 7770
Power Seat Switch: Locations Third Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Right
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Locations > Third
Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left > Page 7771
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Locations > Third
Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left > Page 7772
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Locations > Third
Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left > Page 7773
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Locations > Third
Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left > Page 7774
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Seat
Control Switch, Left
Power Seat Switch: Diagrams Seat Control Switch, Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Seat
Control Switch, Left > Page 7777
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Seat
Control Switch, Left > Page 7778
Power Seat Switch: Diagrams Seat Control Switch, Right
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Seat
Control Switch, Left > Page 7779
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Seat
Control Switch, Left > Page 7780
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Seat
Control Switch, Left > Page 7781
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 7784
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 7785
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Right
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 7786
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 7787
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Seat Control Switch, 6-Way - Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 7788
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 7789
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Seat Control Switch, 6-Way - Right
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 7790
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 7791
ERROR: undefined
OFFENDING COMMAND: f‘~
STACK:
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 7792
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 7793
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 7794
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 7795
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 7796
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 7797
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 7798
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 7799
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 7800
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 7801
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 7802
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 7803
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat - Exploded View, Front
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent
NOTE: Driver power seat backrest shown, passenger and manual similar.
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent
NOTE: Driver memory seat shown, driver and passenger power seat similar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 7806
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 7807
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 7808
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Memory Set Switch
Memory Set Switch
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on safety belt buckle/retractor pretensioners or
adaptive load limiting retractors. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental
deployment of the safety belt pretensioners or adaptive load limiting retractors, which increases the
risk of serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on air bag, Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain
modules. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of these
modules, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: For component identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Front See:
Service and Repair/Front Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Front.
All seats
1. NOTICE: Do not pull from the inboard side of the front seat cushion panel shield to avoid
damaging it.
Remove the front seat cushion panel shield.
- Release the upper retaining clips working from the outboard side and then release the lower
retaining clips.
Driver seat side shield with insert
2. Release the retainers and remove the insert from the side shield.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
Driver seat side shield with cover
3. Remove the front side shield screw.
4. Remove the side shield cover.
All seats
5. Release the clips and remove the memory SET switch.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 7809
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement
Seat Back: Removal and Replacement
Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent
NOTE: Driver power seat backrest shown, passenger and manual similar.
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent
NOTE: Driver memory seat shown, driver and passenger power seat similar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 7814
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 7815
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Seat Backrest - Front
Seat Backrest - Front
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Always carry or place a live air bag module with the air bag and deployment door/trim
cover/tear seam pointed away from the body. Do not set a live air bag module down with the
deployment door/trim cover/tear seam face down. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
WARNING: If the seat side air bag cover has been damaged or separated from its mounting, or if
the air bag material has been exposed, install a new seat side air bag module. Never try to repair
the seat side air bag module. Failure to follow these instructions may result in the seat side air bag
deploying incorrectly, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
NOTE: If a side air bag deployment took place, a new seat back pad, trim cover and side air bag
module and nuts must be installed. The seat back frame should be installed new if necessary.
NOTE: For component identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Front See:
Service and Repair/Front Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Front.
NOTE: Note all backrest wire harness routing for correct installation.
All seats
1. Remove the seat. For additional information, refer to Seat - Front See: Service and Repair/Front
Seats/Seat - Front.
2. If equipped, remove the manual lumbar knob.
- Adjust the manual lumbar to the fully relaxed position.
- Pull and remove the manual lumbar knob.
Seat with side shield insert
3. Release the retainers and remove the insert from the side shield.
- For power seat, disconnect the electrical connector(s).
4. Remove the front side shield screw.
5. Remove the 4 side shield screws.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 7816
Seat with side shield cover
6. Remove the front side shield screw.
7. Remove the side shield cover.
- Pry and release the 2 tabs at the rear of the side shield cover.
- If equipped, disconnect the electrical connector(s).
- Slide the cover forward and remove.
8. Remove the 5 side shield screws.
All seats
9. Release the backrest lower J-strip and unzip the 2 side zippers.
10. If equipped, remove the manual lumbar actuator.
- Make sure the lumbar is fully relaxed.
- Remove the 2 screws and lumbar actuator.
- Detach and route out the lumbar cable from the cushion.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 7817
- Note cable routing for correct installation.
11. Remove the 2 side air bag module nuts.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
12. Position the backrest foam aside and remove the side air bag module from the backrest frame.
Then slide the side air bag module out of the seat
backrest cover deployment chute. For installation, position the locator pin and mounting studs through the holes in the deployment
chute and backrest frame.
13. Disconnect the electrical connector and remove the side air bag module.
14. Detach the 3 pin-type retainers and side air bag wiring harness.
15. For power and climate controlled seat, disconnect the backrest wiring harness electrical
connector and route the wire harness from the cushion.
16. Release the cushion cover fastener from the rear inboard side.
17. Remove the 4 backrest frame-to-seat track bolts and backrest.
- To install, tighten to 45 Nm (33 lb-ft).
18. WARNING: Check the seat side air bag deployment chute for damage. The deployment chute
must not be repaired. If there is any
damage to the deployment chute, a new seat back trim cover and deployment chute must be
installed as a unit. Failure to follow these instructions may result in the seat side air bag module
deploying incorrectly and increase the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
WARNING: Before installing the seat side air bag module/deployment chute assembly: Inspect the side air bag module and mounting surfaces for any damage or foreign material.
- Remove any foreign material from the mounting surfaces of the deployment chute, the seat
backrest frame mounting bracket and the air bag module cavity in the seat backrest foam pad.
- Install new parts if damaged.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 7818
Failure to follow these instructions may result in the seat side air bag deploying incorrectly, which
increases the risk of serious personal injury or death in a crash.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Seat - Exploded View, Second Row
Seat - Exploded View, Second Row
Seat Backrest - 20 Percent
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 7819
Seat Cushion - 20 Percent
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 7820
Seat Backrest - 40 Percent
NOTE: LH seat shown, RH similar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 7821
Seat Cushion - 40 Percent Seat
NOTE: LH seat shown, RH seat similar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 7822
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Seat Backrest - Second Row, 20 Percent
Seat Backrest - Second Row, 20 Percent
Removal and Installation
NOTE: For parts identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Second Row See:
Service and Repair/Second Row Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Second Row.
1. Remove the seat. For additional information, refer to Seat - Second Row, 20 Percent See:
Service and Repair/Second Row Seats/Seat - Second
Row, 20 Percent.
2. Remove the screw and pivot bolt cover.
- Route the attaching strap through the pivot bolt cover.
3. Release the 2 lower backrest cover J-clips.
4. Remove the pin-type retainer and detach the LH side attaching strap.
5. Remove the 2 screws and RH side shield.
- Raise the backrest upright to access and remove the center screw.
- Release the 2 pin-type retainers.
6. Remove the pin-type retainer and detach the RH attaching strap.
- Note attaching strap routing for correct installation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 7823
7. Remove the safety belt anchor bolt.
- To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
8. Remove the 2 pin-type retainers and lower panel.
9. Release the 3 lower backrest cover J-clips and route the RH flap through the child safety seat
anchorage.
10. Release the 2 J-clips and remove the attaching straps.
11. Detach the latch release cable from the seat base.
- Release the cable clamp.
- Detach the cable end.
12. NOTICE: Use care when separating the cushion cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or the
hook-and-loop strip may be torn from the
cushion foam pad.
Partially invert the backrest cover to access the backrest fasteners.
13. Position aside the foam pad and remove the 2 swivel bolts.
- To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
14. Remove the pivot bolt.
- To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
15. Remove the 2 backrest-to-cushion bolts.
- To install, tighten to 48 Nm (35 lb-ft).
16. Remove the seat backrest.
- Route out the latch release cable.
- Note the cable routing for correct installation.
17. NOTE: Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted and the safety belts and buckles are
accessible to the occupants.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Seat - Exploded View, Third Row
Seat - Exploded View, Third Row
Seat Backrest - 40 percent
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 7824
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 7825
Seat Cushion - 40 Percent
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 7826
Seat Backrest - 60 Percent
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 7827
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 7828
Seat Cushion - 60 Percent
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 7829
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Seat Backrest - Third Row, 40 Percent
Seat Backrest - Third Row, 40 Percent
Removal and Installation
NOTE: For parts identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Third Row See:
Service and Repair/Third Row Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Third Row.
All seats
1. Remove the seat. For additional information, refer to Seat - Third Row See: Service and
Repair/Third Row Seats/Seat - Third Row.
2. Remove the 2 screws and inboard and outboard slide bracket covers.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 7830
3. Release the backrest cover lower and inboard J-clips.
Manual fold seat
4. Remove the manual seat cable.
1. Release the cable clamp.
2. Detach the cable end.
All seats
5. Remove the outboard slide bracket-to-backrest frame and outboard slide bracket-to-outboard
latch nuts.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
6. Remove the inboard slide bracket-to-backrest frame and inboard slide bracket-to-inboard latch
nuts.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
7. Separate the backrest from the seat and remove.
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Seat Backrest - Third Row, 60 Percent
Seat Backrest - Third Row, 60 Percent
Removal and Installation
NOTE: For parts identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Third Row See:
Service and Repair/Third Row Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Third Row.
All seats
1. Remove the seat. For additional information, refer to Seat - Third Row See: Service and
Repair/Third Row Seats/Seat - Third Row.
2. Remove the 2 screws and inboard and outboard slide bracket covers.
3. Release the backrest cover lower and inboard J-clips.
Manual fold seats
4. Remove the manual seat cable.
1. Release the cable clamp.
2. Detach the cable end.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 7831
All seats
5. Remove the outboard slide bracket-to-backrest frame and outboard slide bracket-to-outboard
latch nuts.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
6. Remove the inboard slide bracket-to-backrest frame and inboard slide bracket-to-inboard latch
nuts.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
7. Separate the backrest from the seat and remove.
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 7832
Seat Back: Overhaul
Front Seats
Seat Backrest - Front
Disassembly and Assembly
NOTE: For component identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Front See:
Service and Repair/Front Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Front.
1. Remove the seat backrest cover. For additional information, refer to Seat Backrest Cover - Front
See: Seat Cover/Service and Repair/Front
Seats/Seat Backrest Cover - Front.
2. Release the lower flap from the backrest frame hooks and remove the backrest foam pad.
3. Remove the 4 bolts and lumbar assembly.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
- If equipped, disconnect the electrical connector from the lumbar assembly.
- If equipped, route out the manual lumbar cable.
4. For climate controlled seat, remove the backrest Thermo-Electric Device (TED).
- Disconnect the TED electrical connector.
- Remove the scrivet.
- Detach the 2 retainer clips from the backrest frame support wires.
5. If equipped, disconnect the recliner motor electrical connector.
6. For power and climate controlled seat, detach the wire harness retainers and remove the
backrest wiring harness.
- Note the wire harness routing for correct installation.
7. To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure.
Second Row Seats
Seat Backrest - Second Row, 20 Percent
Disassembly and Assembly
NOTE: For parts identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Second Row See:
Service and Repair/Second Row Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Second Row.
1. Remove the seat backrest. For additional information, refer to Seat Backrest - Second Row, 20
Percent See: Removal and Replacement/Second
Row Seats/Seat Backrest - Second Row, 20 Percent.
2. Remove the safety belt guide cover.
- Insert an appropriate tool into the holes and release the 3 locking tabs.
- Detach the safety belt guide cover.
- Route the safety belt webbing through the slot.
3. Remove the latch release handle bezel.
- Release the upper tab and separate the bezel from the latch release handle.
4. NOTICE: Use care when separating the backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or the
hook-and-loop strip may be torn from
the backrest foam pad.
Separate the hook-and-loop strips and invert the backrest trim cover to the row of hog rings.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 7833
5. Remove all hog rings.
6. Continue inverting and remove the backrest cover.
- Route the safety belt webbing through the backrest cover opening.
7. Remove the 2 pin-type retainers and foam pad.
8. Remove the safety belt retractor foam cover.
9. Remove the 2 screws and safety belt retractor cover.
10. Remove the safety belt retractor bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
11. Release the 2 tabs and detach the safety belt retractor guide.
12. Remove the safety belt retractor.
- Route out the safety belt webbing, guide, tongue and anchor through the backrest frame.
- Note safety belt routing for correct installation.
13. Release the pin-type retainer and detach the release cable from the backrest frame.
14. Remove the 2 screws, latch release handle and route out the cable.
- Note cable routing for correct installation.
15. Remove the 2 pin-type retainers and 2 attaching straps.
16. Remove the 8 backrest support panel screws.
17. NOTE: Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted and the safety belts and buckles are
accessible to the occupants.
To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure.
Seat Backrest - Third Row, 40 Percent
Seat Backrest - Third Row, 40 Percent
Disassembly and Assembly
NOTE: For parts identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Third Row See:
Service and Repair/Third Row Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Third Row.
1. Remove the seat backrest cover. For additional information, refer to Seat Backrest Cover - Third
Row See: Seat Cover/Service and Repair/Third
Row Seats/Seat Backrest Cover - Third Row.
2. Remove the bolt and the safety belt buckle.
- For installation, align the anti-rotation tab.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3. Remove the nut, screw and support bracket.
4. Remove the 2 inboard latch-to-backrest frame bolts and the inboard latch.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 7834
5. Remove the outboard latch-to-cushion frame bolt and the outboard latch.
- To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
6. Remove the 6 screws and the backrest support panel.
7. To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure.
Seat Backrest - Third Row, 60 Percent
Seat Backrest - Third Row, 60 Percent
Disassembly and Assembly
NOTE: For parts identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Third Row See:
Service and Repair/Third Row Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Third Row.
1. Remove the seat backrest cover. For additional information, refer to Seat Backrest Cover - Third
Row See: Seat Cover/Service and Repair/Third
Row Seats/Seat Backrest Cover - Third Row.
2. Remove the safety belt anchor bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3. Remove the backrest foam pad.
4. Remove the nut, screw and support bracket.
5. Remove the outboard latch-to-cushion frame bolt and outboard latch.
- To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
6. Remove the 2 inboard latch-to-backrest frame bolts and inboard latch.
- To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
7. Remove the 4 screws and safety belt retractor cover.
8. Remove the safety belt retractor bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
9. Pinch to release the safety belt guide and remove the safety belt retractor.
- Route through the backrest frame.
10. Remove the 15 screws and backrest support panel.
11. Remove the bolt and child safety seat tether anchor.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
12. To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Seats
Seat Cover: Service and Repair Front Seats
Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent
NOTE: Driver power seat backrest shown, passenger and manual similar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Seats > Page 7839
ERROR: undefined
OFFENDING COMMAND: ‘~
STACK:
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Seats > Page 7840
Seat Cover: Service and Repair Second Row Seats
Seat - Exploded View, Second Row
Seat - Exploded View, Second Row
Seat Backrest - 20 Percent
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Seats > Page 7841
Seat Cushion - 20 Percent
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Seats > Page 7842
Seat Backrest - 40 Percent
NOTE: LH seat shown, RH similar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Seats > Page 7843
Seat Cushion - 40 Percent Seat
NOTE: LH seat shown, RH seat similar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Seats > Page 7844
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Seat Backrest Cover - Second Row, 20 Percent
Seat Backrest Cover - Second Row, 20 Percent
Removal and Installation
NOTE: For parts identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Second Row See:
Service and Repair/Second Row Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Second Row.
1. Remove the screw and pivot bolt cover.
- Route the attaching strap through the pivot bolt cover.
2. Release the 2 lower backrest cover J-clips.
3. Remove the pin-type retainer and detach the LH side attaching strap.
4. Remove the 2 screws and RH side shield.
- Raise the backrest upright to access and remove the center screw.
- Release the 2 pin-type retainers.
5. Remove the pin-type retainer and detach the RH attaching strap.
- Note attaching strap routing for correct installation.
6. Remove the safety belt anchor bolt.
- To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Seats > Page 7845
7. Remove the 2 pin-type retainers and lower panel.
8. Release the 3 lower J-clips and route the RH flap through the child safety seat anchorage.
9. Detach the 2 J-clips and remove the attaching straps.
10. Remove the safety belt guide cover.
- Insert an appropriate tool into the holes and release the 3 locking tabs.
- Detach the safety belt guide cover.
- Route the safety belt webbing through the slot.
11. Remove the latch release handle bezel.
- Release the upper tab and separate the bezel from the latch release handle.
12. NOTICE: Use care when separating the backrest cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or the
hook-and-loop strip may be torn from the
backrest foam pad.
Partially invert the backrest cover to the row of hog rings.
13. Remove all hog rings and backrest cover.
- Route the safety belt webbing through the backrest cover opening.
14. NOTE: Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted and the safety belts and buckles are
accessible to the occupants.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Seat Backrest Cover - Second Row, 40 Percent
Seat Backrest Cover - Second Row, 40 Percent
Removal and Installation
1. NOTICE: Use care when releasing the spring clips. They can fall inside the backrest frame.
Remove the head restraint.
- Pull the backrest cover material away from the head restraint guide to access the spring clips.
- Release the 2 spring clips by pushing on the side shown. Note the spring clip position for correct installation.
- Raise and remove the head restraint.
2. Position the backrest downward.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Seats > Page 7846
3. Remove the kneeling release (cargo mode) handle.
- Raise the handle to access the cable.
- Detach the cable jacket from the kneeling release handle.
- Release the retainers and position aside the kneeling release handle.
4. Release the lower backrest cover J-clip.
5. Position aside the backrest cover rear flap and remove the 4 pin-type retainers.
6. If equipped, disconnect the backrest heater mat electrical connector.
- Release the cushion cover rear J-clip.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
- Detach the electrical connector and heater mat wiring.
7. Raise the backrest and route the J-clip between the backrest and cushion.
8. NOTICE: Use care when separating the seat backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or
the hook-and-loop strip may be torn
from the seat backrest foam pad.
Invert the backrest cover to the row of hog rings.
- Separate the hook-and-loop strips.
- If equipped, route the heater mat wiring through the backrest cover.
9. Remove the row of hog rings.
10. Continue inverting the backrest cover to the head restraint guides.
11. NOTICE: Use care when separating the head restraints and spring clips to avoid tearing or
damaging the backrest cover.
Pinch the head restraint guide ends to release and remove the 2 head restraint guides.
12. Remove the backrest cover.
13. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Seat Cushion Cover - Second Row, 20 Percent
Seat Cushion Cover - Second Row, 20 Percent
Removal and Installation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Seats > Page 7847
NOTE: For parts identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Second Row See:
Service and Repair/Second Row Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Second Row.
1. Release the 2 backrest cover lower J-clips.
2. Remove the screw and pivot bolt cover.
- Route out the attaching strap.
3. Remove the 2 pin-type retainers and lower panel.
4. Lower the backrest, release the cushion cover rear J-clip and route between the cushion and
backrest.
5. Release the hook-and-loop strip and remaining cushion cover J-clips.
6. Remove the cushion foam pad and cushion cover together.
7. NOTICE: Use care when separating the seat cushion cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or the
hook-and-loop strip may be torn from
the seat cushion foam.
Release the hook-and-loop strips and invert the cushion cover to the row of hog rings.
8. Remove all hog rings and cushion cover.
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Seat Cushion Cover - Second Row, 40 Percent
Seat Cushion Cover - Second Row, 40 Percent
Removal and Installation
1. With the seat in the E-Z entry position, release the rear J-clip and partially invert the cushion
cover.
2. Release the trim cover J-clips from both sides of the cushion.
3. Release the outer and inner rear J-clips from the cushion.
4. If equipped, disconnect and detach the cushion heater mat electrical connector and heater mat
wiring.
5. Latch the seat to the floor and raise the backrest.
6. Release the front J-clip from the cushion.
7. Release the 2 cushion trim cover retainers from the 2 child safety seat lower anchors and tethers
for children anchors.
- Pull the cushion trim cover rearward and release the 2 clips.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Seats > Page 7848
8. NOTICE: Use care when separating the seat cushion trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or
the hook-and-loop strip may be torn
from the seat cushion foam.
Separate the hook-and-loop strips and invert the cushion trim cover to the row of hog rings.
9. Remove the row of hog rings.
10. Remove the cushion trim cover.
- Route the trim cover from between the cushion and backrest.
11. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Seats > Page 7849
Seat Cover: Service and Repair Third Row Seats
Seat - Exploded View, Third Row
Seat - Exploded View, Third Row
Seat Backrest - 40 percent
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Seats > Page 7850
Seat Cushion - 40 Percent
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Seats > Page 7851
Seat Backrest - 60 Percent
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Seats > Page 7852
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Seats > Page 7853
Seat Cushion - 60 Percent
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Seats > Page 7854
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Seat Backrest Cover - Third Row
Seat Backrest Cover - Third Row
Removal and Installation
NOTE: For parts identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Third Row See:
Service and Repair/Third Row Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Third Row.
NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
All seats
1. Remove the seat. Refer to Seat - Third Row See: Service and Repair/Third Row Seats/Seat Third Row.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Seats > Page 7855
2. Remove the seat backrest. Refer to Seat Backrest - Third Row, 40 Percent See: Seat
Back/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Third
Row Seats/Seat Backrest - Third Row, 40 Percent or Seat Backrest - Third Row, 60 Percent See:
Seat Back/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Third Row Seats/Seat Backrest - Third
Row, 60 Percent.
3. NOTICE: Use care when releasing the spring clips. They can fall inside the backrest frame.
Remove the head restraint.
- Pull the trim cover material away from the head restraint guide to access the spring clips.
- Release the 2 spring clips by pushing on the side shown. Note the spring clip position for correct installation.
- Raise and remove the head restraint.
4. Release all backrest cover J-clips.
5. Remove all staples.
LH seat
6. Release the hook-and-loop strip.
7. Remove the safety belt anchor bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
8. Remove the safety belt guide cover.
Manual fold seat
9. Remove the 2 screws and manual latch handle and cable assembly.
- Note cable routing for correct installation.
All seats
10. Reach up into backrest and squeeze the head restraint guide ends together to release and pull
the 2 head restraint guides out.
- The head restraint guides are not interchangeable. Note location for correct installation.
11. NOTICE: Use care when separating the backrest cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or the
hook-and-loop strip may be torn from the
backrest foam pad.
Separate the hook-and-loop strips and invert the backrest cover to the row of hog rings.
12. Remove all hog rings.
13. Remove the backrest cover.
- For LH seat backrest, route the safety belt webbing through the backrest cover.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Seats > Page 7856
14. NOTE: Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted and the safety belts and buckles are
accessible to the occupants.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Seat Cushion Cover - Third Row
Seat Cushion Cover - Third Row
Removal and Installation
NOTE: For parts identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Third Row See:
Service and Repair/Third Row Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Third Row.
NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
1. Remove the seat. For additional information, refer to Seat - Third Row See: Service and
Repair/Third Row Seats/Seat - Third Row.
2. Raise the cushion, separate the cushion cover hook-and-loop strips and release the J-clips.
3. Remove the cushion cover and foam pad from the cushion frame.
4. NOTICE: Use care when separating the cushion cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or the
hook-and-loop strip may be torn from the
cushion foam pad.
Separate the hook-and-loop strips and invert the cushion cover to the row of hog rings.
5. Remove all hog rings and cushion cover.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seats
Seat Cushion: Service and Repair Front Seats
Seat Cushion - Front
Disassembly and Assembly
NOTE: If a new Driver Seat Module (DSM) has been installed, all seat and power tilt column (if
equipped) soft stops must be reset. If a new seat track, recline motor or power tilt column has been
installed, only reset the soft stops for that component being installed new. To set the soft stops,
refer to principles of operation. See: Testing and Inspection/Initial Inspection and Diagnostic
Overview/Principles Of Operation
NOTE: For component identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Front See:
Service and Repair/Front Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Front.
All seats
1. Remove the seat backrest. For additional information, refer to Seat Backrest - Front See: Seat
Back/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Front Seats/Seat Backrest - Front.
2. Remove the seat cushion cover. For additional information, refer to Seat Cushion Cover - Front
See: Seat Cover/Service and Repair/Front
Seats/Seat Cushion Cover - Front.
3. Remove the cushion foam pad.
4. Remove the safety belt buckle and pretensioner.
- Remove the tie strap.
- Disconnect the 2 electrical connectors.
- Remove the nut and safety belt buckle and pretensioner. To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
5. For driver seat, disconnect the seat track position sensor electrical connector and detach the
wiring harness pin-type retainer.
Climate controlled seat
6. Remove the cushion TED.
- Detach the wiring harness and remove the TED.
- Note wire harness routing for correct installation.
7. Release the 2 tabs and slide out the Dual Climate Controlled Seat Module (DCSM).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seats > Page 7861
8. NOTE: When installing a new DCSM, it is necessary to carry out Programmable Module
Installation (PMI). See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Information Bus/Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning
For passenger seat, remove the DCSM. Cut and remove the wire harness tie strap.
- Release the 2 locking wedges.
- Disconnect the 3 electrical connectors.
Power seat
9. If equipped, remove the DSM.
- Disconnect the 4 electrical connectors.
- Release the 2 tabs and slide out the DSM.
10. Disconnect the 3 seat track motor electrical connectors.
- For driver seat with memory, disconnect the 3 additional motor sensor electrical connectors.
11. Remove the wire harness.
- Remove the 3 wire harness bracket screws.
- Remove the tie strap and release the rear wire harness bracket clip from the seat track.
- Separate the electrical connectors and wire harness from the seat track.
- Remove the wire harness and bracket.
- For correct installation, note wire harness routing.
All seats
12. For manual seat, remove the inboard and outboard seat track rails.
- Remove the 6 seat track rail-to-seat track nuts from the inboard and outboard seat track rails. To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
- Remove the inboard and outboard seat track rails.
- Release and separate the seat track adjust handle from the seat track rails. Disconnect the spring.
- Slightly bend the tab and detach the seat adjust handle from the inboard seat track rail.
- Note the spring position for correct installation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seats > Page 7862
13. To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seats > Page 7863
Seat Cushion: Service and Repair Second Row Seats
Seat Cushion - Second Row, 20 Percent
Disassembly and Assembly
NOTE: For parts identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Second Row See:
Service and Repair/Second Row Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Second Row.
1. Remove the seat backrest. For additional information, refer to Seat Backrest - Second Row, 20
Percent See: Seat Back/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement/Second Row Seats/Seat Backrest - Second Row, 20 Percent.
2. Remove the 2 screws and LH side shield.
3. Remove the nut and safety belt buckle.
- To install, align the anti-rotation tab. To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
4. Release the cushion cover front J-clip.
5. Remove the 2 riser-to-cushion frame bolts and cushion frame.
- To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
6. Release the hook-and-loop strip and remaining cushion cover J-clips.
7. Remove the cushion frame from the foam pad and cushion cover.
8. NOTICE: Use care when separating the seat cushion cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or the
hook-and-loop strip may be torn from
the seat cushion foam.
Release the hook-and-loop strips and invert the cushion cover to the row of hog rings.
9. Remove all hog rings and cushion cover.
10. To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seats > Page 7864
Seat Cushion: Service and Repair Third Row Seats
Seat Cushion - Third Row, 40 Percent
Seat Cushion - Third Row, 40 Percent
Disassembly and Assembly
NOTE: For parts identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Third Row See:
Service and Repair/Third Row Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Third Row.
1. Remove the seat backrest. For additional information, refer to Seat Backrest - Third Row, 40
Percent See: Seat Back/Service and Repair/Removal
and Replacement/Third Row Seats/Seat Backrest - Third Row, 40 Percent.
2. Remove the inboard and outboard slide bracket-to-cushion frame nuts and slide bracket from
both sides of the seat cushion.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
3. Remove the 2 seat riser-to-cushion frame bolts and riser.
- To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
4. Release the cushion cover J-clips and remove the cushion frame.
5. NOTICE: Use care when separating the cushion cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or the
hook-and-loop strip may be torn from the
cushion foam pad.
Separate the hook-and-loop strips and invert the cushion cover to the row of hog rings.
6. Remove all hog rings and cushion cover.
7. To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure.
Seat Cushion - Third Row, 60 Percent
Seat Cushion - Third Row, 60 Percent
Disassembly and Assembly
NOTE: For parts identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Third Row See:
Service and Repair/Third Row Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Third Row.
1. Remove the seat backrest. For additional information, refer to Seat Backrest - Third Row, 60
Percent See: Seat Back/Service and Repair/Removal
and Replacement/Third Row Seats/Seat Backrest - Third Row, 60 Percent.
2. Remove the inboard and outboard slide bracket-to-cushion frame nuts and slide bracket from
both sides of the seat cushion.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
3. Remove the 2 seat riser-to-cushion frame bolts and riser.
- To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
4. Release the cushion cover J-clips and remove the cushion frame.
5. NOTICE: Use care when separating the cushion cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or the
hook-and-loop strip may be torn from the
cushion foam pad.
Separate the hook-and-loop strips and invert the cushion cover to the row of hog rings.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front Seats > Page 7865
6. Remove all hog rings and cushion cover.
7. To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Seat Heater: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagram in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be
seen completely in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference
is given to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in parentheses next to or under a component.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System, and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7870
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in set 4
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the
indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to
illustrate proper orientation.
Power Distribution
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7871
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
Component and Connector Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7872
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component Location
Charts.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Locations information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the
various items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written
description of the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7873
Symbols (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7874
Symbols (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7875
Symbols (Part 3)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7876
Symbols (Part 4)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7877
Symbols (Part 5)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7878
Seat Heater: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminal by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7879
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal.
Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7880
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7881
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7882
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seat wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7883
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7884
7. If visible, be sure to place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the
barrel. 9. Holding the wire in place, barrel squeeze tool handles appropriate ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7885
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7886
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7887
Seat Heater: Connector Views
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7888
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7889
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7890
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7891
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7892
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7893
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7894
Seat Heater: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
119-1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7895
119-2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7896
119-3
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7897
119-4
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7898
119-5
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7899
119-6
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (i.e. 13-2, 24-6, 10-2, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Location Views. See: Locations/Component Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat Exploded View, Front
Seat Heater: Service and Repair Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent
NOTE: Driver power seat backrest shown, passenger and manual similar.
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent
NOTE: Driver memory seat shown, driver and passenger power seat similar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat Exploded View, Front > Page 7902
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat Exploded View, Front > Page 7903
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat Exploded View, Front > Page 7904
Seat Heater: Service and Repair Seat Backrest
Seat Backrest Thermo-Electric Device
Seat Backrest Thermo-Electric Device
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on air bag, Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain
modules. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of these
modules, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: For component identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Front See:
Service and Repair/Front Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Front.
1. With the backrest fully forward, release the seat backrest cover lower rear J-clip and unzip the 2
side zippers.
2. Remove the climate controlled seat Thermo-Electric Device (TED).
- Disconnect the TED electrical connector.
- Remove the scrivet.
- Detach the 2 retainer clips from the backrest frame support wires.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Seat Backrest Heater Mat
Seat Backrest Heater Mat
Removal
NOTICE: Do not reinstall any heater mat after removal. The adhesive will not adhere correctly to
the foam pad causing it to bunch up or shift out of place. A new heater mat must be installed.
Failure to follow this instruction can result in seat component damage and system failure.
1. Remove the seat backrest cover. For additional information, refer to Seat Backrest Cover Second Row, 40 Percent See: Seat Cover/Service and
Repair/Second Row Seats/Seat Backrest Cover/Seat Backrest Cover - Second Row, 40 Percent.
2. Route the heater mat wiring harness from the seat.
- Note harness routing for correct installation.
3. NOTICE: Do not use a razor knife or other sharp tool to separate the heater mat from the foam
pad. Damage to the foam pad may result.
Install a new foam pad if torn or burned.
Carefully peel the backrest heater mat from the foam pad and discard.
- Only a thin layer of foam should peel off with the adhesive.
4. If burned or torn, remove and discard the backrest foam pad.
Installation
1. If needed, install a new backrest foam pad.
2. NOTICE: Remove all paper strips from the adhesive before applying the heater mat to the foam
pad. Otherwise, damage to the seat can
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat Exploded View, Front > Page 7905
occur.
Install the heater mat to the foam pad.
- Align the heater mat square to the seat backrest with the narrow area of the heater mat tucked
into the valley of the foam pad and the wiring toward the lower edge.
- Firmly apply the heater mat to the foam pad making sure it is straight and free of any wrinkles that
may show through the backrest cover.
3. Route the heater mat wire harness as noted in removal.
4. Install the seat backrest cover. For additional information, refer to Seat Backrest Cover - Second
Row, 40 Percent See: Seat Cover/Service and
Repair/Second Row Seats/Seat Backrest Cover/Seat Backrest Cover - Second Row, 40 Percent.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat Exploded View, Front > Page 7906
Seat Heater: Service and Repair Seat Cushion
Seat Cushion Thermo-Electric Device
Seat Cushion Thermo-Electric Device
Removal and Installation
NOTE: For component identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Front See:
Service and Repair/Front Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Front.
1. Remove the seat. For additional information, refer to Seat - Front See: Service and Repair/Front
Seats/Seat - Front.
2. NOTE: Use care when removing the Thermo-Electric Device (TED). The U-nuts can slip into the
cushion frame.
Remove the seat cushion TED.
- Disconnect the electrical connector and detach the wire harness.
- Remove the 2 screws and TED.
- For correct installation, note wire harness routing.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Seat Cushion Heater Mat
Seat Cushion Heater Mat
Removal
NOTICE: Do not reinstall any heater mat after removal. The adhesive will not adhere correctly to
the foam pad causing it to bunch up or shift out of place. A new heater mat must be installed.
Failure to follow this instruction can result in seat component damage and system failure.
1. Remove the seat cushion trim cover. For additional information, refer to Seat Cushion Cover Second Row, 40 Percent See: Seat Cover/Service
and Repair/Second Row Seats/Seat Cushion Cover/Seat Cushion Cover - Second Row, 40
Percent.
2. Route the heater mat wiring harness from the seat.
- Note harness routing for correct installation.
3. NOTICE: Do not use a razor knife or other sharp tool to separate the heater mat from the foam
pad. Damage to the foam pad may result.
Install a new foam pad if torn or burned.
Carefully peel the cushion heater mat from the foam pad and discard.
- Only a thin layer of foam should peel off with the adhesive.
4. If burned or torn, remove and discard the cushion foam pad.
Installation
1. If needed, install a new cushion foam pad.
2. NOTICE: Remove all paper strips from the adhesive before applying the heater mat to the foam
pad. Otherwise, damage to the seat can
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat Exploded View, Front > Page 7907
occur.
Install the heater mat to the foam pad.
- Align the heater mat square to the seat cushion with the narrow area of the heater mat tucked into
the valley of the foam pad and the wiring toward the rear edge of the seat cushion frame.
- Firmly apply the heater mat to the foam pad making sure it is straight and free of any wrinkles that
may show through the cushion cover.
3. Route the heater mat wire harness as noted in removal.
4. Install the seat cushion cover. For additional information, refer to Seat Cushion Cover - Second
Row, 40 Percent See: Seat Cover/Service and
Repair/Second Row Seats/Seat Cushion Cover/Seat Cushion Cover - Second Row, 40 Percent.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Rear Heated Seat Module
Seat Heater Control Module: Locations Rear Heated Seat Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Rear Heated Seat Module > Page 7912
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Rear Heated Seat Module > Page 7913
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams >
Rear Heated Seat Module
Seat Heater Control Module: Diagrams Rear Heated Seat Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams >
Rear Heated Seat Module > Page 7916
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams >
Rear Heated Seat Module > Page 7917
Seat Heater Control Module: Diagrams Dual Climate Controlled Seat Module (DCSM)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams >
Rear Heated Seat Module > Page 7918
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams >
Rear Heated Seat Module > Page 7919
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat Heater Control Module: Service and Repair Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent
NOTE: Driver power seat backrest shown, passenger and manual similar.
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent
NOTE: Driver memory seat shown, driver and passenger power seat similar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 7922
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 7923
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 7924
Seat Heater Control Module: Service and Repair Dual Climate Controlled Seat Module (DCSM)
Dual Climate Controlled Seat Module (DCSM)
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on safety belt buckle/retractor pretensioners or
adaptive load limiting retractors. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental
deployment of the safety belt pretensioners or adaptive load limiting retractors, which increases the
risk of serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on air bag, Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain
modules. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of these
modules, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
NOTE: For component identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Front See:
Service and Repair/Front Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Front.
1. When installing a new Dual Climate Controlled Seat Module (DCSM), carry out the appropriate
steps in the Programmable Module Installation
(PMI) procedure. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Information
Bus/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning
2. NOTICE: Do not pull from the inboard side of the front seat cushion panel shield to avoid
damaging it.
Position the front passenger seat fully upward and remove the front seat cushion panel shield.
- Release the upper retaining clips working from the outboard side and then release the lower
retaining clips.
3. Release the 2 tabs and slide out the DCSM.
4. Remove the DCSM.
- Cut and remove the wiring harness tie strap.
- Release the 2 locking wedges.
- Disconnect the 3 electrical connectors.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
6. If a new DCSM has been installed, carry out the appropriate steps in the Programmable Module
Installation (PMI) procedure. See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Information Bus/Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 7925
Seat Heater Control Module: Service and Repair Heated Seat Module - Second Row
Heated Seat Module - Second Row
NOTE: Bottom of floor console shown.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front floor console.
2. Disconnect the 2 heated seat module electrical connectors at the bottom of the front floor
console.
3. Remove the screw and un-hook the heated seat module.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
5. Carry out the auto-configuration sequence to program the heated seat module for use with a
dual momentary switch.
- Start the vehicle and push the low button on either heated seat switch.
- Operate the heated seats, monitor the indicators and verify the system is operating correctly in
high and low.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Locations > Heated
Seat Switch, Left Rear
Seat Heater Switch: Locations Heated Seat Switch, Left Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Locations > Heated
Seat Switch, Left Rear > Page 7930
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Locations > Heated
Seat Switch, Left Rear > Page 7931
Seat Heater Switch: Locations Heated Seat Switch, Right Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Locations > Heated
Seat Switch, Left Rear > Page 7932
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated
Seat Switch, Left Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated
Seat Switch, Left Rear > Page 7935
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent
NOTE: Driver power seat backrest shown, passenger and manual similar.
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent
NOTE: Driver memory seat shown, driver and passenger power seat similar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 7938
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 7939
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 7940
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Seat Control Switch - Front
Seat Control Switch - Front
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on safety belt buckle/retractor pretensioners or
adaptive load limiting retractors. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental
deployment of the safety belt pretensioners or adaptive load limiting retractors, which increases the
risk of serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on air bag, Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain
modules. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of these
modules, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: For component identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Front See:
Service and Repair/Front Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Front.
NOTE: Driver seat shown, passenger similar.
All seats
1. NOTICE: Do not pull from the inboard side of the front seat cushion panel shield to avoid
damaging it.
Remove the front seat cushion panel shield.
- Release the upper retaining clips working from the outboard side and then release the lower
retaining clips.
Side shield with insert
2. Release the retainers and remove the insert from the side shield.
- Disconnect the electrical connector(s).
Side shield with cover
3. Remove the front side shield screw.
4. Remove the side shield cover.
- Disconnect the electrical connector(s).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 7941
All seats
5. Pull and remove the seat control switch button(s).
- If equipped, remove the power recliner switch button.
6. Release the clips and remove the seat control switch.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 7942
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Heated Seat Switch - Second Row
Heated Seat Switch - Second Row
Removal and Installation
1. Release the 4 retainer clips and remove the rear cup holder.
- Remove any remaining retainers from the floor console and reinstall to the cup holder before
installation.
2. Remove the front floor console rear panel.
- Remove the 2 screws.
- Release the 6 retainer clips and separate the rear panel.
- Disconnect all the electrical connectors and remove the rear panel.
- Remove any remaining retainers from the floor console and reinstall to the rear cover before
installation.
3. Release and remove the heated seat switch(es).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 7943
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Seat Control Switch - Third Row
Seat Control Switch - Third Row
Removal and Installation
1. Release and remove the tray from the RH rear quarter trim panel.
2. NOTE: The LH and RH switch wiring harness electrical connectors are not interchangeable.
Remove the affected seat control switch.
- Release the 2 retaining tabs and detach the seat control switch from the RH rear quarter trim
panel.
- Pull the seat control switch through the opening and disconnect the electrical connector.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Latch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Second
Row Seats
Seat Latch: Service and Repair Second Row Seats
Seat - Exploded View, Second Row
Seat Backrest - 20 Percent
Seat Cushion - 20 Percent
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Latch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Second
Row Seats > Page 7948
Seat Backrest - 40 Percent
NOTE: LH seat shown, RH similar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Latch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Second
Row Seats > Page 7949
Seat Cushion - 40 Percent Seat
NOTE: LH seat shown, RH seat similar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Latch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Second
Row Seats > Page 7950
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Latch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Second
Row Seats > Page 7951
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Latch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Second
Row Seats > Page 7952
Seat Latch: Service and Repair Third Row Seats
Seat - Exploded View, Third Row
Seat Backrest - 40 percent
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Latch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Second
Row Seats > Page 7953
Seat Cushion - 40 Percent
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Latch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Second
Row Seats > Page 7954
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Latch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Second
Row Seats > Page 7955
ERROR: stackunderflow
OFFENDING COMMAND: ~
STACK:
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Track - Manual
Seat Track: Service and Repair Seat Track - Manual
Seat Track - Manual
Removal and Installation
NOTE: For component identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Front See:
Service and Repair/Front Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Front.
1. Remove the seat. For additional information, refer to Seat - Front See: Service and Repair/Front
Seats/Seat - Front or.
2. Remove the inboard and outboard seat track rails.
- Remove the 6 seat track rail-to-seat track nuts from the inboard and outboard seat track rails. To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
- Remove the inboard and outboard seat track rails.
- Release and separate the seat track adjust handle from the seat track rails. Disconnect the spring.
- Slightly bend the tab and detach the seat adjust handle from the inboard seat track rail.
- Note the spring position for correct installation.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Track - Manual > Page 7960
Seat Track: Service and Repair Seat Track - Power
Seat Track - Power
Removal and Installation
NOTE: If a new Driver Seat Module (DSM) has been installed, all seat and power tilt column (if
equipped) soft stops must be reset. If a new seat track, recline motor or power tilt column has been
installed, only reset the soft stops for that component being installed new. To reset the soft stops,
refer to principles of operation. See: Testing and Inspection/Initial Inspection and Diagnostic
Overview/Principles Of Operation
NOTE: For component identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Front See:
Service and Repair/Front Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Front.
All seats
1. Remove the affected seat. For additional information, refer to Seat - Front See: Service and
Repair/Front Seats/Seat - Front.
2. Remove the seat backrest. For additional information, refer to Seat Backrest - Front See: Seat
Back/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement/Front Seats/Seat Backrest - Front.
3. Remove the safety belt buckle and pretensioner.
- Remove the tie strap.
- Disconnect the 2 electrical connectors.
- Remove the nut and safety belt buckle and pretensioner. To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
4. Release the cushion cover front and rear J-clips and rear hook-and-loop strip.
Climate controlled seats
5. NOTE: Use care when removing the Thermo-Electric Device (TED). The U-nuts can slip into the
cushion frame.
Remove the cushion TED.
- Disconnect the electrical connector and detach the wire harness.
- Remove the 2 screws and TED.
- For correct installation, note wire harness routing.
6. Release the 2 tabs and slide out the Dual Climate Controlled Seat Module (DCSM).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Track - Manual > Page 7961
7. NOTE: When installing a new DCSM, it is necessary to carry out Programmable Module
Installation (PMI). See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Information Bus/Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning
If passenger seat, remove the DCSM. Cut and remove the wiring harness tie strap.
- Release the 2 locking wedges.
- Disconnect the 3 electrical connectors.
Driver memory seat
8. Remove the DSM.
- Disconnect the 4 electrical connectors.
- Release the 2 tabs and slide out the DSM.
All seats
9. Remove the cushion frame, foam pad and cushion cover assembly from the seat track.
- Remove the 4 cushion frame-to-seat track bolts. To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
- Release the 2 cushion frame rear clips and straps from the seat track and remove the cushion
frame.
10. Disconnect the 3 seat track motor electrical connectors.
- For driver seat with memory, disconnect the additional 3 motor sensor electrical connectors.
11. Remove the wire harness.
- Remove the 3 wire harness bracket screws.
- Remove the tie strap and release the rear wire harness bracket clip from the seat track.
- Separate the electrical connectors and wire harness from the seat track.
- Remove the wire harness and bracket.
- For correct installation, note wire harness routing.
12. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Track - Manual > Page 7962
Seat Track: Service and Repair Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent
NOTE: Driver power seat backrest shown, passenger and manual similar.
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent
NOTE: Driver memory seat shown, driver and passenger power seat similar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Track - Manual > Page 7963
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Track - Manual > Page 7964
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Vacuum/Pressure Pump, Seats > Component Information >
Locations > Lumbar Motor, Driver Seat
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Vacuum/Pressure Pump, Seats > Component Information >
Locations > Lumbar Motor, Driver Seat > Page 7969
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Vacuum/Pressure Pump, Seats > Component Information >
Diagrams > Lumbar Motor, Driver Seat
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Vacuum/Pressure Pump, Seats > Component Information >
Diagrams > Lumbar Motor, Driver Seat > Page 7972
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 7978
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 7979
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Pedal Positioning Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7983
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7984
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Adjustable Pedal Switch - Without Memory
Pedal Positioning Switch: Testing and Inspection Adjustable Pedal Switch - Without Memory
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Adjustable Pedal Switch - Without Memory > Page 7987
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Adjustable Pedal Switch - Without Memory > Page 7988
Pedal Positioning Switch: Testing and Inspection Adjustable Pedal Switch - With Memory
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Adjustable Pedal Switch - Without Memory > Page 7989
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side
Power Door Lock Switch: Locations Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side > Page 7994
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side > Page 7995
Power Door Lock Switch: Locations Door Lock Switch, Driver Side
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side > Page 7996
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Door Lock Switch, Driver Side
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Door Lock Switch, Driver Side > Page 7999
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8000
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8001
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Power Mirror Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8005
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8006
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8007
Power Mirror Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8008
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8009
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8010
Power Mirror Switch: Service and Repair
Exterior Mirror Control Switch
NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the driver front door trim panel.
2. Remove the exterior mirror control switch.
1. Depress the locking tabs.
2. Remove the exterior mirror control switch.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front Height Position Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front Height Position Sensor > Page 8015
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front Height Position Sensor > Page 8016
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front Height Position Sensor > Page 8017
Power Seat Motor Position Sensor: Locations Height Sensor, Left Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front Height Position Sensor > Page 8018
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front Height Position Sensor > Page 8019
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front Height Position Sensor > Page 8020
Power Seat Motor Position Sensor: Locations Height Sensor, Right Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front Height Position Sensor > Page 8021
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor > Page 8024
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor > Page 8025
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor > Page 8026
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor > Page 8027
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Third Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left
Power Seat Switch: Locations Third Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Third Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left > Page 8032
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Third Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left > Page 8033
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Third Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left > Page 8034
Power Seat Switch: Locations Third Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Right
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Third Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left > Page 8035
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Third Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left > Page 8036
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Third Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left > Page 8037
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Third Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left > Page 8038
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Seat Control Switch, Left
Power Seat Switch: Diagrams Seat Control Switch, Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Seat Control Switch, Left > Page 8041
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Seat Control Switch, Left > Page 8042
Power Seat Switch: Diagrams Seat Control Switch, Right
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Seat Control Switch, Left > Page 8043
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Seat Control Switch, Left > Page 8044
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Seat Control Switch, Left > Page 8045
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 8048
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 8049
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Right
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 8050
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 8051
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Seat Control Switch, 6-Way - Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 8052
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 8053
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Seat Control Switch, 6-Way - Right
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 8054
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 8055
ERROR: undefined
OFFENDING COMMAND: f‘~
STACK:
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 8056
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 8057
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 8058
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 8059
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 8060
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 8061
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 8062
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 8063
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 8064
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 8065
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 8066
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Seat Control Switch, 10-Way - Left > Page 8067
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent
NOTE: Driver power seat backrest shown, passenger and manual similar.
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent
NOTE: Driver memory seat shown, driver and passenger power seat similar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 8070
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 8071
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 8072
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Memory Set Switch
Memory Set Switch
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on safety belt buckle/retractor pretensioners or
adaptive load limiting retractors. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental
deployment of the safety belt pretensioners or adaptive load limiting retractors, which increases the
risk of serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on air bag, Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain
modules. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of these
modules, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: For component identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Front See:
Seats/Service and Repair/Front Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Front.
All seats
1. NOTICE: Do not pull from the inboard side of the front seat cushion panel shield to avoid
damaging it.
Remove the front seat cushion panel shield.
- Release the upper retaining clips working from the outboard side and then release the lower
retaining clips.
Driver seat side shield with insert
2. Release the retainers and remove the insert from the side shield.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
Driver seat side shield with cover
3. Remove the front side shield screw.
4. Remove the side shield cover.
All seats
5. Release the clips and remove the memory SET switch.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 8073
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Hazard
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Pinch Strip, Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Hazard
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Pinch Strip, Left > Page 8078
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Handle Release Switch
Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock Switch: Locations Handle Release Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Handle Release Switch > Page 8083
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Handle Release Switch > Page 8084
Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock Switch: Locations Liftgate Glass Release Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Handle Release Switch > Page 8085
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Handle Release Switch
Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock Switch: Diagrams Handle Release Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Handle Release Switch > Page 8088
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Handle Release Switch > Page 8089
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8090
Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock Switch: Service and Repair
Liftgate Release Switch
Expedition
Navigator
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel.
- Position the water shield aside.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8091
Expedition
2. Remove the 2 nuts and the liftgate release handle.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
3. Remove the liftgate release switch.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
Navigator
4. Remove the liftgate parking lamps.
5. Remove the 6 nuts and the license plate housing.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
6. Remove the 2 nuts and the liftgate release switch housing.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
7. Remove the liftgate release switch.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
All vehicles
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Heated Seat Switch, Left Rear
Seat Heater Switch: Locations Heated Seat Switch, Left Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Heated Seat Switch, Left Rear > Page 8096
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Heated Seat Switch, Left Rear > Page 8097
Seat Heater Switch: Locations Heated Seat Switch, Right Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Heated Seat Switch, Left Rear > Page 8098
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Heated Seat Switch, Left Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Heated Seat Switch, Left Rear > Page 8101
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat - Exploded View, Front
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent
NOTE: Driver power seat backrest shown, passenger and manual similar.
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent
NOTE: Driver memory seat shown, driver and passenger power seat similar.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 8104
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 8105
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 8106
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Seat Control Switch - Front
Seat Control Switch - Front
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on safety belt buckle/retractor pretensioners or
adaptive load limiting retractors. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental
deployment of the safety belt pretensioners or adaptive load limiting retractors, which increases the
risk of serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on air bag, Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain
modules. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of these
modules, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: For component identification and locations, refer to Seat - Exploded View, Front See:
Seats/Service and Repair/Front Seats/Seat - Exploded View, Front.
NOTE: Driver seat shown, passenger similar.
All seats
1. NOTICE: Do not pull from the inboard side of the front seat cushion panel shield to avoid
damaging it.
Remove the front seat cushion panel shield.
- Release the upper retaining clips working from the outboard side and then release the lower
retaining clips.
Side shield with insert
2. Release the retainers and remove the insert from the side shield.
- Disconnect the electrical connector(s).
Side shield with cover
3. Remove the front side shield screw.
4. Remove the side shield cover.
- Disconnect the electrical connector(s).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 8107
All seats
5. Pull and remove the seat control switch button(s).
- If equipped, remove the power recliner switch button.
6. Release the clips and remove the seat control switch.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 8108
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Heated Seat Switch - Second Row
Heated Seat Switch - Second Row
Removal and Installation
1. Release the 4 retainer clips and remove the rear cup holder.
- Remove any remaining retainers from the floor console and reinstall to the cup holder before
installation.
2. Remove the front floor console rear panel.
- Remove the 2 screws.
- Release the 6 retainer clips and separate the rear panel.
- Disconnect all the electrical connectors and remove the rear panel.
- Remove any remaining retainers from the floor console and reinstall to the rear cover before
installation.
3. Release and remove the heated seat switch(es).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Seat - Exploded View, Front > Page 8109
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Seat Control Switch - Third Row
Seat Control Switch - Third Row
Removal and Installation
1. Release and remove the tray from the RH rear quarter trim panel.
2. NOTE: The LH and RH switch wiring harness electrical connectors are not interchangeable.
Remove the affected seat control switch.
- Release the 2 retaining tabs and detach the seat control switch from the RH rear quarter trim
panel.
- Pull the seat control switch through the opening and disconnect the electrical connector.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Memory Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Memory Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8113
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 8117
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Rear Control Switch
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Locations Liftgate Rear Control Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Rear Control Switch > Page 8122
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Rear Control Switch > Page 8123
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Rear Control Switch > Page 8124
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Locations Power Liftgate/Traction Control/Hazard Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Rear Control Switch > Page 8125
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Rear Control Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Rear Control Switch > Page 8128
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Trunk / Liftgate Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Pinch Strip Switch
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Left side shown, right side similar.
1. Remove the brake light.
- Remove the screws.
2. Disconnect the pinch strip electrical connector.
3. Remove the pinch strip.
1. Remove the pin-type retainers.
2. Remove the grommet and route the harness out of the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8132
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sound Proofing / Insulation > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Insulation
Sound Proofing / Insulation: Description and Operation Insulation
Insulation
Insulation is used as a sound-deadener to reduce exterior road and powertrain noises from the
interior of the vehicle. Mastic insulators are also used as insulation. For information on the location
of the mastic insulators, refer to Sound Deadeners and Insulators. Insulation is installed: See:
Sound Deadeners and Insulators
- under the roof.
- above and below the instrument panel.
- at the cowl sides.
- over the transmission tunnel.
- over the floorpan areas.
- inside the quarter panels.
It has heat-bondable mastic deadeners for improved NVH characteristics (Navigator).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sound Proofing / Insulation > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Insulation > Page 8137
Sound Proofing / Insulation: Description and Operation Sound Deadeners and Insulators
Sound Deadeners and Insulators
NOTICE: Mastic is made of a combustible material and should be removed prior to carrying out
welding procedures to the area. Heat zones from welding near the mastic can cause the mastic
material to burn.
NOTICE: Corrosion protection must be restored to the area AFTER the mastic material is applied.
Corrosion protection products may be wax based and loss of adhesion may occur.
NOTE: The following illustrations serve as a reference to indicate mastic patch (butyl pad)
locations. Additional insulators and sound deadeners are used beyond those indicated in the
illustration.
NOTE: To restore the vehicle to design intent, missing or damaged sound deadeners and
insulators should be replaced with the correct service replacement component.
1. NOTE: In applications where mastic material is applied as a pumpable material at the factory,
replacement of missing or damaged mastic is
acceptable in the form of cut-to-fit butyl pad(s) or pumpable mastic material(s) when carrying out
repairs.
Whenever replacement of an existing mastic insulator is carried out, the surface must be
thoroughly cleaned to make sure correct adhesion will occur. The surface should be 10°C (50°F) or
greater before applying the mastic. The use of a heat gun to warm the metal surface will aid in
adhesion.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Service and
Repair
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair
Cowl Panel Grille
Removal and Installation
Both sides
1. Remove the windshield wipers.
LH side
2. Remove the pin-type retainer and lift the LH cowl trim panel to release the 3 underside pushpin
retainers that are attached to the cowl trim panel.
- Disconnect the windshield washer tube.
RH side
3. Remove the pin-type retainer and lift the RH cowl trim panel to release the 2 underside pushpin
retainers that are attached to the cowl trim panel.
- Disconnect the windshield washer tube.
Both sides
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
5. If necessary, adjust the windshield wiper arms.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Front Door
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Glass, Frames and Mechanisms Exploded View, Front Door
Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Front Door
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Front Door > Page 8148
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Door Glass Top Run - Front
Door Glass Top Run - Front
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The power window regulator motor must be re-initialized whenever the LF/RF (Navigator) or
LF (Expedition) motor is removed from the vehicle. For additional information, refer to Window
Motor Initialization See: Windows and Glass/Windows/Service and Repair.
1. Remove the front door window glass. For additional information, refer to Window Glass - Front
Door See: Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front
Door/Front Door Window Glass/Service and Repair/Window Glass - Front Door.
2. Remove the inside glass weatherstrip.
3. Remove the front door glass channel bolt and front door glass top run.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- The power window regulator motor must be re-initialized whenever the LF/RF (Navigator) or LF
(Expedition) motor is removed from the vehicle. For additional information, refer to Window Motor
Initialization See: Windows and Glass/Windows/Service and Repair.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Door Glass Top Run - Rear
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Door Glass Top Run - Rear
Door Glass Top Run - Rear
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear door window glass. For additional information, refer to Window Glass - Rear
Door See: Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Rear
Door/Rear Door Window Glass/Service and Repair/Window Glass - Rear Door.
2. Remove the rear door glass channel bolt.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
3. Remove the rear door glass top run.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Door Glass Top Run - Rear > Page 8153
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Glass, Frames and Mechanisms Exploded View, Rear Door
Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Rear Door
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: Customer Interest Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High
Pressure Car Wash
TSB 08-24-8
12/08/08
WATER LEAKS - ROOF OPENING PANEL DURING HIGH PRESSURE CAR WASH
FORD: 2005-2008 F-150, F-250, F-350, F-450, F-550 2005-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2009 Navigator 2006-2008 Mark LT
This article supersedes TSB 08-1-4 to update the Part List and Service procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2009 Expedition, Navigator, 2005-2008 F-150, F-Super Duty and 2006-2008
Mark LT vehicles with factory installed roof opening panel may experience a water leak at the rear
of roof opening panel during a high pressure car wash.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
2005-2008 F-150 / F-Super Duty 250-550 / 2006-2008 Mark LT
1. Remove roof opening panel glass only. Refer to Work Shop Manual (WSM), Section 501-17.
2. To avoid paint damage to the roof, apply protective covering on roof finish.
3. From above vehicle, remove the two (2) trough guide retaining screws and the rear trough from
the trough guide assembly.
4. With rear trough removed; wipe clean the top inside of the trough with an alcohol based cleaner
or equivalent.
5. Remove the adhesive tape covering from trough seal.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash > Page 8162
6. Attach seal to front of trough starting at one end of the trough. Make sure the vertical leg of seal
lines up against front flange of trough. (Figures 1-3)
7. Secure seal across entire trough. Apply pressure along entire seal to ensure bonding to trough.
8. Install the rear trough onto the trough guide assembly. Install the two (2) trough guide retaining
screws and torque to 9 lb-in. (1 N.m)
9. Remove protective covering.
10. Install roof opening panel following WSM, Section 501-17.
2005-2009 Expedition / Navigator
1. Remove roof opening panel glass only. Refer to WSM, Section 501-17.
2. To avoid paint damage to the roof, apply protective covering on roof finish.
3. From above vehicle, remove the two (2) trough guide retaining screws and the rear trough from
the trough guide assembly.
4. Install new trough and seal assembly.
5. Install the rear trough and seal assembly onto the trough guide assembly. Install the two (2)
trough guide retaining screws and torque to 9 lb-in. (1 N.m)
6. Remove protective covering.
7. Install roof opening panel following WSM, Section 501-17.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash > Page 8163
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082408A 2005-2009 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator: Follow The Service Procedure To Repair The Water leak (Do Not Use With 5028A)
082408A 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.6 Hr.
F-150, 2005-2008 Mark LT: Follow The Service Procedure To Repair The Water leak (Do Not Use
With 5028A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
78502C50 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 >
Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Sunroof Water Leaks
During High Pressure Car Wash
TSB 08-24-8
12/08/08
WATER LEAKS - ROOF OPENING PANEL DURING HIGH PRESSURE CAR WASH
FORD: 2005-2008 F-150, F-250, F-350, F-450, F-550 2005-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2009 Navigator 2006-2008 Mark LT
This article supersedes TSB 08-1-4 to update the Part List and Service procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2009 Expedition, Navigator, 2005-2008 F-150, F-Super Duty and 2006-2008
Mark LT vehicles with factory installed roof opening panel may experience a water leak at the rear
of roof opening panel during a high pressure car wash.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
2005-2008 F-150 / F-Super Duty 250-550 / 2006-2008 Mark LT
1. Remove roof opening panel glass only. Refer to Work Shop Manual (WSM), Section 501-17.
2. To avoid paint damage to the roof, apply protective covering on roof finish.
3. From above vehicle, remove the two (2) trough guide retaining screws and the rear trough from
the trough guide assembly.
4. With rear trough removed; wipe clean the top inside of the trough with an alcohol based cleaner
or equivalent.
5. Remove the adhesive tape covering from trough seal.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 >
Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash > Page 8169
6. Attach seal to front of trough starting at one end of the trough. Make sure the vertical leg of seal
lines up against front flange of trough. (Figures 1-3)
7. Secure seal across entire trough. Apply pressure along entire seal to ensure bonding to trough.
8. Install the rear trough onto the trough guide assembly. Install the two (2) trough guide retaining
screws and torque to 9 lb-in. (1 N.m)
9. Remove protective covering.
10. Install roof opening panel following WSM, Section 501-17.
2005-2009 Expedition / Navigator
1. Remove roof opening panel glass only. Refer to WSM, Section 501-17.
2. To avoid paint damage to the roof, apply protective covering on roof finish.
3. From above vehicle, remove the two (2) trough guide retaining screws and the rear trough from
the trough guide assembly.
4. Install new trough and seal assembly.
5. Install the rear trough and seal assembly onto the trough guide assembly. Install the two (2)
trough guide retaining screws and torque to 9 lb-in. (1 N.m)
6. Remove protective covering.
7. Install roof opening panel following WSM, Section 501-17.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 >
Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash > Page 8170
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082408A 2005-2009 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator: Follow The Service Procedure To Repair The Water leak (Do Not Use With 5028A)
082408A 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.6 Hr.
F-150, 2005-2008 Mark LT: Follow The Service Procedure To Repair The Water leak (Do Not Use
With 5028A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
78502C50 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8171
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
Roof Opening Panel Weatherstrip
Removal
NOTE: The roof opening panel must be initialized when repairs are carried out on any part of the
roof opening panel, including: whenever the roof opening panel has been removed from the roof
opening panel assembly, a new roof opening panel motor/module has been installed or when a
new roof opening panel assembly has been installed. For additional information, refer to Roof
Opening Panel Motor Initialization See: Roof and Associated Components/Sunroof /
Moonroof/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning.
1. Remove the roof opening panel glass. For additional information, refer to Roof Opening Panel
Glass See: Roof and Associated
Components/Sunroof / Moonroof/Sunroof / Moonroof Panel/Service and Repair/Roof Opening
Panel Glass.
2. Place roof opening panel, topside up, on a worktable. Take care to support the glass assembly
from below to prevent damaging the mounting tabs.
3. Remove the old roof opening panel weatherstrip by pulling up on the weatherstrip.
Installation
1. Place a new weatherstrip into position on the glass assembly, with the splice (seam) on the
passenger side.
2. Starting with the corners, push the weatherstrip into position. Continue pushing the weatherstrip
into position around the glass assembly until
complete. Use a plastic or rubber hammer if necessary.
3. Install the roof opening panel. For additional information, refer to Roof Opening Panel Glass
See: Roof and Associated Components/Sunroof /
Moonroof/Sunroof / Moonroof Panel/Service and Repair/Roof Opening Panel Glass.
4. Align the roof panel. For additional information, refer to Roof Opening Panel Alignment See:
Roof and Associated Components/Sunroof /
Moonroof/Adjustments.
5. Initialize the roof opening panel motor. For additional information, refer to Roof Opening Panel
Motor Initialization See: Roof and Associated
Components/Sunroof / Moonroof/Testing and Inspection/Programming and Relearning.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) > Component Information > Locations
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) > Component Information > Locations > Page
8176
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) > Component Information > Locations > Page
8177
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
Engine Control Components
Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to as the stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal
to the PCM indicating the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Typical BPP Switch
Typical BPP Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch > Page 8180
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Brake Pedal Switch (BPS)/Brake
Deactivator Switch
Engine Control Components
Brake Pedal Switch (BPS)/Brake Deactivator Switch
The BPS, also called the brake deactivator switch, is for vehicle speed control deactivation. A
normally closed switch supplies battery positive voltage (B+) to the PCM when the brake pedal is
not applied. When the brake pedal is applied, the normally closed switch opens and power is
removed from the PCM.
On some applications the normally closed BPS, along with the normally open BPP switch, are used
for a brake rationality test within the PCM. The PCM misfire monitor profile learn function may be
disabled if a brake switch concern occurs. If one or both brake pedal inputs to the PCM is not
changing states when they were expected to, a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) is set by the PCM
strategy.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise Control > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
The CPP switch is an input to the PCM indicating the clutch pedal position. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the CPP circuit. When the CPP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The CPP input to the PCM is used to detect a reduction in engine
load. The PCM uses the load information for mass air flow and fuel calculations.
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair
Speed Control Switch
Expedition
Navigator
Removal and Installation
Expedition
NOTE: It is not necessary to remove the driver air bag module during this procedure.
NOTE: Be careful not to allow the speed control switch electrical connector to fall back into the
steering wheel.
1. Remove the speed control switch by pulling the switch toward the rear of the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page
8187
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
Navigator
2. Remove the driver air bag module. For additional information, refer to Air Bag Systems.
3. Remove the 2 screws and the steering wheel controls bezel.
4. Remove the speed control switch by pulling the switch toward the rear of the vehicle.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
All vehicles
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) >
Component Information > Locations
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8192
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8193
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
Engine Control Components
Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to as the stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal
to the PCM indicating the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Typical BPP Switch
Typical BPP Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch > Page 8196
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Brake Pedal Switch (BPS)/Brake
Deactivator Switch
Engine Control Components
Brake Pedal Switch (BPS)/Brake Deactivator Switch
The BPS, also called the brake deactivator switch, is for vehicle speed control deactivation. A
normally closed switch supplies battery positive voltage (B+) to the PCM when the brake pedal is
not applied. When the brake pedal is applied, the normally closed switch opens and power is
removed from the PCM.
On some applications the normally closed BPS, along with the normally open BPP switch, are used
for a brake rationality test within the PCM. The PCM misfire monitor profile learn function may be
disabled if a brake switch concern occurs. If one or both brake pedal inputs to the PCM is not
changing states when they were expected to, a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) is set by the PCM
strategy.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise Control >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
The CPP switch is an input to the PCM indicating the clutch pedal position. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the CPP circuit. When the CPP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The CPP input to the PCM is used to detect a reduction in engine
load. The PCM uses the load information for mass air flow and fuel calculations.
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair
Speed Control Switch
Expedition
Navigator
Removal and Installation
Expedition
NOTE: It is not necessary to remove the driver air bag module during this procedure.
NOTE: Be careful not to allow the speed control switch electrical connector to fall back into the
steering wheel.
1. Remove the speed control switch by pulling the switch toward the rear of the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 8203
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
Navigator
2. Remove the driver air bag module. For additional information, refer to Air Bag Systems.
3. Remove the 2 screws and the steering wheel controls bezel.
4. Remove the speed control switch by pulling the switch toward the rear of the vehicle.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
All vehicles
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Cigarette Lighter: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagram in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be
seen completely in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference
is given to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in parentheses next to or under a component.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System, and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8212
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in set 4
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the
indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to
illustrate proper orientation.
Power Distribution
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8213
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
Component and Connector Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8214
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component Location
Charts.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Locations information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the
various items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written
description of the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8215
Symbols (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8216
Symbols (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8217
Symbols (Part 3)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8218
Symbols (Part 4)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8219
Symbols (Part 5)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8220
Cigarette Lighter: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminal by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8221
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal.
Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8222
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8223
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8224
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seat wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8225
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8226
7. If visible, be sure to place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the
barrel. 9. Holding the wire in place, barrel squeeze tool handles appropriate ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8227
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8228
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8229
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8230
Cigarette Lighter: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
44-1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8231
44-2
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (i.e. 13-2, 24-6, 10-2, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Location Views. See: Locations/Component Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Clock > Component Information > Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Clock > Component Information > Diagrams
> Page 8235
Clock: Description and Operation
Clock
The stand-alone electric analog clock, available in the Navigator only, is centrally located on the
instrument panel and displays time in a 12-hour format. The clock is backlit when the headlamps
and parking lamps are on. The Expedition clock is integrated into the radio.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Clock > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Clock: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Special Tools Used With Diagnostics
Clock
Inspection And Verification
Clock
Inspection and Verification
NOTE: The Smart Junction Box (SJB) is also known as the Generic Electronic Module (GEM).
1. Verify the customer concern.
2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of mechanical or electrical damage.
Visual Inspection Chart
3. If an obvious cause for an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible)
before proceeding to the next step.
4. If the fault is not visually evident, verify the symptom. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Clock > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8238
Clock: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Clock
Symptom Chart
Symptom Chart
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Clock > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8239
Clock: Pinpoint Tests
Clock
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Tests A: The Clock Is Inoperative
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 44, Horn/Cigar Lighter for schematic and connector information. See:
Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The clock receives battery voltage from the Smart Junction Box (SJB) through circuit SBP14
(BN/RD). Ground for the clock is supplied through circuit GD138 (BK/WH).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Clock
- SJB
PINPOINT TEST A: THE CLOCK IS INOPERATIVE
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- A1 CHECK CIRCUIT SBP14 (BN/RD) FOR VOLTAGE
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Clock C2016.
- Measure the voltage between the clock C2016-6, circuit SBP14 (BN/RD), harness side and
ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to A2.
No
VERIFY the SJB fuse 14 (10A) is OK. If OK, GO to A3. TEST the system for normal operation. If
not OK, REFER to the Wiring Diagrams to identify the possible causes of the circuit short.
------------------------------------------------- A2 CHECK CIRCUIT GD138 (BK/WH) FOR AN OPEN
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
- Measure the resistance between the clock C2016-5, circuit GD138 (BK/WH), harness side and
ground.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Clock > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8240
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
INSTALL a new clock. REFER to Clock See: Service and Repair. TEST the system for normal
operation.
No
REPAIR the circuit. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- A3 CHECK CIRCUIT SBP14 (BN/RD) FOR AN OPEN
- Disconnect: SJB C2280b.
- Measure the resistance between the SJB C2280b-4, circuit SBP14 (BN/RD), harness side and
the clock C2016-6, circuit SBP14 (BN/RD), harness side.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to A4.
No
REPAIR the circuit. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- A4 CHECK FOR CORRECT SJB OPERATION
- Disconnect all the SJB connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the SJB connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new SJB. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector.
-------------------------------------------------
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Clock > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 8241
Clock: Service and Repair
Clock
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the upper instrument panel center finish panel.
2. Release the 3 retaining clips and remove the clock from the upper instrument panel center finish
panel.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Compass Zone Adjustment - With Message Center
Compass: Service and Repair Compass Zone Adjustment - With Message Center
Compass Zone Adjustment - With Message Center
1. Determine which magnetic zone you are in for your geographic location.
2. Start the engine.
3. Press the message center SETUP button until RESET FOR ZONE SETTING is displayed.
4. Press and release the RESET button until ZONE XX RESET = CHANGE is displayed.
5. NOTE: The zone selection increases with each subsequent button press with a range of zones
from 1 to 15 scrolling back to the beginning.
Press and release the RESET button until the desired zone appears in the message center display.
6. To exit the zone setting mode and lock in the changes, press and release either the RESET or
SETUP button or simply wait 4 seconds and the
message center locks in the zone.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Compass Zone Adjustment - With Message Center > Page 8246
Compass: Service and Repair Compass Zone Adjustment - Without Message Center
Compass Zone Adjustment - Without Message Center
1. Determine which magnetic zone you are in for your geographic location.
2. Press and release the SELECT/RESET button to scroll through the information displays until the
message center displays HOLD RESET FOR
SETUP MENU.
3. Press and hold the SELECT/RESET button for approximately 2 seconds until the message
center displays HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM
CHECK.
4. Press and release the SELECT/RESET button to scroll through the system check displays until
the message center displays COMPASS ZONE XX
is displayed.
5. Press and hold the SELECT/RESET button for approximately 2 seconds to enter the compass
zone adjustment mode.
6. NOTE: The zone selection increases with each subsequent button press with a range of zones
from 1 to 15 scrolling back to the beginning.
Press and release the SELECT/RESET button until the desired zone number appears.
7. Release the SELECT/RESET button and allow the setup timer to expire to exit the procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Compass Zone Adjustment - With Message Center > Page 8247
Compass: Service and Repair Compass Calibration - With Message Center
Compass Calibration - With Message Center
1. NOTE: For optimum calibration, drive to an open, level location away from large metallic objects
or structures. Switch off all non-essential
electrical accessories (heated rear window, heater, A/C, map lamps, wiper, etc.) and make sure all
the doors are closed.
Start the vehicle.
2. Press the message center SETUP button until RESET FOR CALIBRATION is displayed.
3. NOTE: The message center displays CIRCLE SLOWLY TO CALIBRATE in the calibration
function.
Press the RESET control button to start the compass calibration function.
4. NOTE: This step may require up to 5 circles to complete the calibration.
NOTE: If the RESET button is pressed during the calibration or 3 minutes has elapsed since the
beginning of the calibration without driving the vehicle, the message center reverts back to normal
operation and the INFO displays CAL until a successful calibration is carried out.
Slowly drive the vehicle in a circle less than 5 km/h (3 mph) until the CIRCLE SLOWLY TO
CALIBRATE display changes to CALIBRATION COMPLETED.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Compass Zone Adjustment - With Message Center > Page 8248
Compass: Service and Repair Compass Calibration - Without Message Center
Compass Calibration - Without Message Center
1. NOTE: For optimum calibration, drive to an open, level location away from large metallic objects
or structures. Switch off all non-essential
electrical accessories (heated rear window, heater, A/C, map lamps, wiper, etc.) and make sure all
the doors are closed.
Start the vehicle.
2. Press and release the SELECT/RESET button to scroll through the information displays until the
message center displays HOLD RESET FOR
SETUP MENU.
3. Press and hold the SELECT/RESET button for approximately 2 seconds until the message
center displays HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM
CHECK.
4. Press and release the SELECT/RESET button to scroll through the system check displays until
the message center displays RESET FOR
CALIBRATION is displayed.
5. Press and hold the SELECT/RESET button for approximately 2 seconds to enter the compass
zone adjustment mode.
6. Press and hold the SELECT/RESET button until the message center displays CIRCLE SLOWLY
TO CALIBRATE is displayed.
7. NOTE: This step may require up to 5 circles to complete the calibration.
NOTE: If the RESET button is pressed during the calibration or 3 minutes has elapsed since the
beginning of the calibration without driving the vehicle, the message center reverts back to normal
operation and the INFO displays CAL until a successful calibration is carried out.
Slowly drive the vehicle in a circle less than 5 km/h (3 mph) until the CIRCLE SLOWLY TO
CALIBRATE display changes to CALIBRATION COMPLETED.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering
Depowering Procedure
WARNING: Always wear eye protection when servicing a vehicle. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on air bag, Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain
modules. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of these
modules, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the
restraints control module (RCM) while the RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON. Failure
to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of the Safety Canopy(R) and
cause serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: To reduce the risk of accidental deployment, do not use any memory saver devices.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF.
2. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
3. At the Smart Junction Box (SJB), located in the RH lower kick panel, remove the cover and the
RCM fuse 32 (10A) from the SJB. For additional
information, refer to the Wiring Diagrams.
4. Turn the ignition switch ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30
seconds. The air bag warning indicator will remain
lit continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
6. WARNING: Always deplete the backup power supply before repairing or installing any new front
or side air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) component and before servicing, removing, installing, adjusting or striking
components near the front or side impact sensors or the restraints control module (RCM). Nearby
components include doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood
latches.
Refer to the Description and Operation portion of Air Bag Systems for location of the RCM and
impact sensor(s).
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
1 minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury or death in the event of an
accidental deployment.
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
Repowering Procedure
1. Make sure that all SRS components are connected.
2. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 8254
3. Install RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the SJB and close the cover.
4. WARNING: Make sure no one is in the vehicle and there is nothing blocking or placed in front of
any air bag module when the battery is
connected. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury in the event of
an accidental deployment.
Connect the battery ground cable.
5. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the back to ON and visually monitor
the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag warning indicator will
illuminate continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an SRS fault is present,
the air bag warning indicator will:
- fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The flashing might not occur until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition has been turned from
the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to complete the testing of the
SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault exists, a chime will sound in a
pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning indicator and any SRS fault
discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous DTCs from the RCM using a scan tool.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 8255
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Deactivation and Reactivation
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deactivation and Reactivation
Deactivation
WARNING: Always carry or place a live air bag module with the air bag and deployment door/trim
cover/tear seam pointed away from the body. Do not set a live air bag module down with the
deployment door/trim cover/tear seam face down. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on air bag, Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain
modules. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of these
modules, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: To reduce the risk of accidental deployment, do not use any memory saver devices.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF.
2. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
3. At the Smart Junction Box (SJB), located in the RH lower kick panel, remove the cover and the
RCM fuse 32 (10A) from the SJB. For additional
information, refer to the Wiring Diagrams.
4. Turn the ignition switch ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30
seconds. The air bag warning indicator will remain
lit continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: Always deplete the backup power supply before repairing or installing any new front
or side air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) component and before servicing, removing, installing, adjusting or striking
components near the front or side impact sensors or the restraints control module (RCM). Nearby
components include doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood
latches.
Refer to the Description and Operation portion of Air Bag Systems for location of the RCM and
impact sensor(s).
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
1 minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury or death in the event of an
accidental deployment.
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
7. Make sure the road wheels are in the straight-ahead position.
8. Center the tilt steering column to allow for steering column upper and lower shroud removal.
9. NOTICE: Turn the steering wheel such that the top is at 90 degrees (at the 9 o'clock position) to
the left from the straight-ahead position
to access the driver air bag module wire clips and to prevent damage to the steering column
multi-function switch. Failure to follow this instruction may result in component damage.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 8256
Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is 90 degrees to the left (at the 9 o'clock position)
as shown.
10. Remove the lower steering column opening cover.
- Remove the 3 screws.
- Pull out to release the top retainers.
- Remove the lower steering column opening cover. If equipped, disconnect the adjustable pedals switch connector.
11. If equipped, remove the screw and steering column manual tilt lever.
12. Remove the 3 steering column lower shroud screws.
13. Release the clips and remove the steering column upper shroud.
14. Remove the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, disconnect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
15. NOTICE: Make sure each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are disengaged from each of
the 3 steering wheel hooks before
removing the driver air bag module from the steering wheel. Failure to follow this instruction may
result in component damage and/or system failure.
NOTE: Steering wheel is removed for clarity. The rear of the steering wheel is shown.
NOTE: Use a mirror to view the rear of the steering wheel to locate where the 3 driver air bag
module wire clips attach to the steering wheel hooks.
Using a screwdriver or a suitable tool, release each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips from
the steering wheel hooks. Access the 3 driver air bag module wire clips through the back of the steering wheel cover and
push the wire clips toward the center of the steering wheel to release.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 8257
16. NOTE: Once the driver air bag module is removed, note the position of the 2 driver air bag
module locator pins on the steering wheel for
installation.
Disconnect the driver air bag module and horn switch electrical connectors and remove the driver
air bag module.
17. Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is back in the straight-ahead position (the 12
o'clock position).
18. Open and lower the glove compartment door to allow access to the passenger air bag electrical
connector.
- If equipped, disconnect the glove compartment door dampener.
19. Disconnect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
20. NOTE: There are 2 similar connectors under the passenger seat. The passenger seat side air
bag module electrical connector is located toward the
seat outboard position.
Remove the passenger front seat cushion panel shield and disconnect the passenger seat side air
bag module electrical.
21. Release the RH second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 8258
22. Remove the bolt and the RH second row safety belt retractor D-ring.
23. Remove the cover and the RH C-pillar trim panel nut.
24. Release the rear door weatherstrip and remove the RH C-pillar trim panel.
25. Disconnect the RH safety canopy module electrical connector.
26. Release the LH second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
27. Remove the bolt and the LH second row safety belt retractor D-ring.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 8259
28. Remove the cover and the LH C-pillar trim panel nut.
29. Release the rear door weatherstrip and remove the driver C-pillar trim panel.
30. Disconnect the LH safety canopy module electrical connector.
31. NOTE: There are 2 similar connectors under the driver seat. The driver seat side air bag
module electrical connector is located toward the seat
outboard position.
Remove the driver front seat cushion panel shield and disconnect the driver seat side air bag
module electrical connector.
32. Install the RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the Smart Junction Box (SJB).
33. Connect the battery ground cable.
Reactivation
1. Remove the RCM fuse 32 (10A) from the SJB.
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
3. Connect the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector and install the driver front seat
cushion panel shield.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 8260
4. Connect the LH safety canopy module electrical connector.
5. Install the LH C-pillar trim panel and attach the rear door weatherstrip.
6. Install the LH C-pillar trim panel nut and cover.
7. Install the LH second row safety belt retractor D-ring and bolt.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
8. Attach the LH second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
9. Connect the RH safety canopy module electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 8261
10. Install the RH C-pillar trim panel and attach the rear door weatherstrip.
11. Install the passenger C-pillar trim panel nut and cover.
12. Install the RH second row safety belt retractor D-ring and bolt.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
13. Attach the RH second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding. Extract and retract the safety belt between the full extension and stowed positions.
- If excessive effort or binding is present, install a new safety belt buckle retractor and tongue
assembly as necessary. For additional information, refer to Seat Belt Systems.
14. Connect the passenger seat side air bag module electrical connector and install the passenger
front seat cushion panel shield.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 8262
15. Connect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
16. Close the glove compartment door.
- If equipped, connect the glove compartment door dampener.
17. NOTICE: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag module. Match
the electrical connector key to the keyway in the driver air bag module. Do not force the electrical
connectors into the driver air bag module. Damage to the connector or component may occur.
Connect the horn switch and 2 driver air bag module electrical connectors.
18. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, lining up the locator pins.
19. NOTE: Make sure that all 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged and seated
correctly to the steering wheel.
NOTE: Audible clicks will be heard when the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged.
Firmly press the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, seating the 3 driver air bag module
wire clips to the steering wheel hooks.
- Check the driver air bag module trim cover to the steering wheel for an even gap clearance and
correct movement.
20. Install the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, connect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
21. Install the steering column upper shroud.
22. Install the 3 steering column lower shroud screws.
23. If equipped, install the steering column manual tilt lever and screw.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
24. If equipped, connect the adjustable pedals switch connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 8263
25. Install the lower steering column opening cover and 3 screws.
26. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON.
27. Install the RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the SJB and install the cover.
28. WARNING: Make sure no one is in the vehicle and there is nothing blocking or placed in front
of any air bag module when the battery is
connected. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury in the event of
an accidental deployment.
Connect the battery ground cable.
29. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition switch from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the ignition switch back to ON
and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag
warning indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag
SRS fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will either:
- fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The air bag warning indicator may not illuminate until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition
switch has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator will need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Clear all continuous memory DTCs from the RCM using a scan tool.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair
Instrument Panel Dimmer Switch
NOTE: Navigator shown, Expedition similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the Instrument Cluster (IC) finish panel.
2. Press the tabs and remove the instrument panel dimmer switch.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 8271
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 8272
Door Switch: Locations Door Ajar Switch, Left Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 8273
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 8274
Door Switch: Locations Door Ajar Switch, Right Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 8275
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 8278
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 8279
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 8280
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 8281
Door Switch: Service and Repair
Door Ajar Switch
NOTE: LH front door latch shown, others similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door latch. For additional information, refer to Front Door Latch See: Body and
Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front
Door/Front Door Latch/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement or Rear Door Latch See:
Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Rear Door/Rear Door Latch/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement.
2. Release the locking tab and remove the door ajar switch.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Locations
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8285
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8286
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Reset Procedure
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Reset Procedure
Oil Life Reset - Message Center Cluster
Message Center Configuration
Oil Life Reset - Message Center Cluster
NOTE: The oil life calculation is set at a maximum of approximately 12,000 km (7,500 miles) or 180
days.
NOTE: The XX's in the message center displays below represent a numeric value. For example,
the message center may display OIL LIFE = 80%.
1. Press and release the SETUP button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX%
HOLD RESET = NEW.
2. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the message center displays
OIL LIFE SET TO 100%.
3. Press and release the SETUP button to exit the procedure.
Oil Life Reset - Base Instrument Cluster (IC)
Message Center Configuration
Oil Life Reset - Base Instrument Cluster (IC)
NOTE: All message center functions are carried out using the single stem reset button in the
Instrument Cluster (IC).
NOTE: The oil life calculation is set at a maximum of approximately 12,000 km (7,500 miles) or 180
days.
NOTE: The XX's in the message center displays below represent a numeric value. For example,
the message center may display OIL LIFE = 80%.
1. Press and release the reset button to scroll through the information displays until the message
center displays HOLD RESET FOR SETUP MENU.
2. Press and hold the reset button for approximately 2 seconds until the message center displays
HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK.
3. Press and release the reset button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX% HOLD
RESET = NEW.
4. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the message center displays
OIL LIFE SET TO 100%.
5. Press and release the reset button to exit the procedure.
Oil Life Start Value - Message Center Cluster
Message Center Configuration
Oil Life Start Value - Message Center Cluster
NOTE: The oil life start value is used to increase or decrease the starting point of the oil life. The
value can be changed back to the maximum of approximately 12,000 km (7,500 miles) if the value
was previously changed or lowered by 10% increments down to 10%.
NOTE: The XX's in the message center displays below represent a numeric value. For example,
the message center may display OIL LIFE = 80%.
1. Press and release the SETUP button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX%
HOLD RESET = NEW.
2. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the message center displays
OIL LIFE SET TO 100%.
3. NOTE: The oil life start value can be lowered from 100% to 10% in 10% increments then the
value starts again at 100%.
Press the RESET button once for each 10% reduction below the default 100% until the message
center displays OIL LIFE SET TO XX%.
4. Press and release the SETUP button to exit the procedure.
Oil Life Start Value - Base Instrument Cluster (IC)
Message Center Configuration
Oil Life Start Value - Base Instrument Cluster (IC)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Reset Procedure > Page 8289
NOTE: All message center functions are carried out using the single stem reset button in the
Instrument Cluster (IC).
NOTE: The oil life start value is used to increase or decrease the starting point of the oil life. The
value can be changed back to the maximum of approximately 12,000 km (7,500 miles) if the value
was previously changed or lowered by 10% increments down to 10%.
1. Press and release the reset button to scroll through the information displays until the message
center displays HOLD RESET FOR SETUP MENU.
2. Press and hold the reset button for approximately 2 seconds until the message center displays
HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK.
3. Press and release the reset button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX% HOLD
RESET = NEW.
4. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the message center displays
OIL LIFE SET TO 100%.
5. Press the RESET button to lower 10% from the default 100% until the message center displays
OIL LIFE SET TO XX%.
6. NOTE: The oil life start value can be lowered from 100% to 10% in 10% increments then the
value starts again at 100%.
Repeat steps 2-5 for each desired 10% reduction.
7. Press and release the reset button to exit the procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Reset Procedure > Page 8290
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Removal and Replacement
Message Center Switch
Expedition
Navigator
Removal and Installation
Expedition
1. Pull the instrument panel center finish panel straight out to release the retaining clips.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Reset Procedure > Page 8291
Navigator
2. NOTE: The transmission selector lever bezel is held in place by 4 tabs that are located in the
shifter assembly.
Remove the transmission selector lever bezel.
3. Open the floor console compartment door and pull the floor console finish panel straight up to
release the retainer clips.
4. Remove the 2 screws and pull the instrument panel center finish panel straight out to release the
retainer clips.
- Position the instrument panel center finish panel aside.
All vehicles
5. Disconnect the electrical connectors.
6. Press the 4 retaining tabs and remove the message center switch from the center instrument
panel finish panel.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Filler Cap Warning Indicator >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Filler Cap Warning Indicator: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Check Fuel Cap Indicator
The check fuel cap indicator is a communications network message sent by the PCM. The PCM
sends the message to illuminate the lamp when the strategy determines there is a concern in the
EVAP system due to the fuel filler cap or capless fuel tank filler pipe not being sealed correctly.
This is detected by the inability to pull vacuum in the fuel tank after a fueling event.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-11-7 > Jun > 09 > Fuel System - Lower Than Expected
Fuel Fill Capacity
Fuel Gauge Sender: Customer Interest Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity
TSB 09-11-7
06/15/09
LONG WHEEL BASE (LWB), LOWER THAN EXPECTED FUEL FILL CAPACITY - BUILT
BEFORE 4/10/2009
FORD: 2007-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Expedition and Navigator long wheel base (LWB) vehicles built before
4/10/2009, may encounter the amount of fuel needed to fill the fuel tank may be lower than
expected. This may be encountered when the distance to empty (DIE) states 50 miles or lower to
empty, or the fuel gauge reads lower than 1/8 tank of fuel prior to refueling.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Ask the customer the following questions.
1. Does the customer refill the fuel tank with the engine off?
a. No - Retest the vehicle with engine off before proceeding, if concern does not occur, this
procedure does not apply.
b. Yes - Go to Step 2.
NOTE
SOME CREDIT CARDS HAVE PRESET LIMITS ON THE DOLLAR AMOUNT AVAILABLE FUEL
TRANSACTION. THE PUMP WILL SHUT OFF AT THIS LIMIT. THIS LIMIT MAY BE IN THE
RANGE OF $50 TO $75.
2. Does the customer refill the fuel tank until 1 to 3 gas pump automatic shutoffs?
a. Yes - Go to Step 3.
b. No - Retest the vehicle using the gasoline pump automatic shutoff function before proceeding, if
concern does not occur, this procedure does not
apply.
3. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) using the Workshop Manual, Section 310-01 with
certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near the
gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091107A 2007-2009 Expedition, 1.8 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace The Fuel Delivery Module (Do
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-11-7 > Jun > 09 > Fuel System - Lower Than Expected
Fuel Fill Capacity > Page 8303
Not Use With 9002A, 9002A6)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-11-7 > Jun > 09 > Fuel System - Lower
Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity
Fuel Gauge Sender: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill
Capacity
TSB 09-11-7
06/15/09
LONG WHEEL BASE (LWB), LOWER THAN EXPECTED FUEL FILL CAPACITY - BUILT
BEFORE 4/10/2009
FORD: 2007-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Expedition and Navigator long wheel base (LWB) vehicles built before
4/10/2009, may encounter the amount of fuel needed to fill the fuel tank may be lower than
expected. This may be encountered when the distance to empty (DIE) states 50 miles or lower to
empty, or the fuel gauge reads lower than 1/8 tank of fuel prior to refueling.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Ask the customer the following questions.
1. Does the customer refill the fuel tank with the engine off?
a. No - Retest the vehicle with engine off before proceeding, if concern does not occur, this
procedure does not apply.
b. Yes - Go to Step 2.
NOTE
SOME CREDIT CARDS HAVE PRESET LIMITS ON THE DOLLAR AMOUNT AVAILABLE FUEL
TRANSACTION. THE PUMP WILL SHUT OFF AT THIS LIMIT. THIS LIMIT MAY BE IN THE
RANGE OF $50 TO $75.
2. Does the customer refill the fuel tank until 1 to 3 gas pump automatic shutoffs?
a. Yes - Go to Step 3.
b. No - Retest the vehicle using the gasoline pump automatic shutoff function before proceeding, if
concern does not occur, this procedure does not
apply.
3. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) using the Workshop Manual, Section 310-01 with
certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near the
gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091107A 2007-2009 Expedition, 1.8 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace The Fuel Delivery Module (Do
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-11-7 > Jun > 09 > Fuel System - Lower
Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity > Page 8309
Not Use With 9002A, 9002A6)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body
- Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Sunroof Water Leaks
During High Pressure Car Wash
TSB 08-24-8
12/08/08
WATER LEAKS - ROOF OPENING PANEL DURING HIGH PRESSURE CAR WASH
FORD: 2005-2008 F-150, F-250, F-350, F-450, F-550 2005-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2009 Navigator 2006-2008 Mark LT
This article supersedes TSB 08-1-4 to update the Part List and Service procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2009 Expedition, Navigator, 2005-2008 F-150, F-Super Duty and 2006-2008
Mark LT vehicles with factory installed roof opening panel may experience a water leak at the rear
of roof opening panel during a high pressure car wash.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
2005-2008 F-150 / F-Super Duty 250-550 / 2006-2008 Mark LT
1. Remove roof opening panel glass only. Refer to Work Shop Manual (WSM), Section 501-17.
2. To avoid paint damage to the roof, apply protective covering on roof finish.
3. From above vehicle, remove the two (2) trough guide retaining screws and the rear trough from
the trough guide assembly.
4. With rear trough removed; wipe clean the top inside of the trough with an alcohol based cleaner
or equivalent.
5. Remove the adhesive tape covering from trough seal.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body
- Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash > Page 8315
6. Attach seal to front of trough starting at one end of the trough. Make sure the vertical leg of seal
lines up against front flange of trough. (Figures 1-3)
7. Secure seal across entire trough. Apply pressure along entire seal to ensure bonding to trough.
8. Install the rear trough onto the trough guide assembly. Install the two (2) trough guide retaining
screws and torque to 9 lb-in. (1 N.m)
9. Remove protective covering.
10. Install roof opening panel following WSM, Section 501-17.
2005-2009 Expedition / Navigator
1. Remove roof opening panel glass only. Refer to WSM, Section 501-17.
2. To avoid paint damage to the roof, apply protective covering on roof finish.
3. From above vehicle, remove the two (2) trough guide retaining screws and the rear trough from
the trough guide assembly.
4. Install new trough and seal assembly.
5. Install the rear trough and seal assembly onto the trough guide assembly. Install the two (2)
trough guide retaining screws and torque to 9 lb-in. (1 N.m)
6. Remove protective covering.
7. Install roof opening panel following WSM, Section 501-17.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body
- Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash > Page 8316
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082408A 2005-2009 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator: Follow The Service Procedure To Repair The Water leak (Do Not Use With 5028A)
082408A 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.6 Hr.
F-150, 2005-2008 Mark LT: Follow The Service Procedure To Repair The Water leak (Do Not Use
With 5028A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
78502C50 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body
- Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash > Page 8322
6. Attach seal to front of trough starting at one end of the trough. Make sure the vertical leg of seal
lines up against front flange of trough. (Figures 1-3)
7. Secure seal across entire trough. Apply pressure along entire seal to ensure bonding to trough.
8. Install the rear trough onto the trough guide assembly. Install the two (2) trough guide retaining
screws and torque to 9 lb-in. (1 N.m)
9. Remove protective covering.
10. Install roof opening panel following WSM, Section 501-17.
2005-2009 Expedition / Navigator
1. Remove roof opening panel glass only. Refer to WSM, Section 501-17.
2. To avoid paint damage to the roof, apply protective covering on roof finish.
3. From above vehicle, remove the two (2) trough guide retaining screws and the rear trough from
the trough guide assembly.
4. Install new trough and seal assembly.
5. Install the rear trough and seal assembly onto the trough guide assembly. Install the two (2)
trough guide retaining screws and torque to 9 lb-in. (1 N.m)
6. Remove protective covering.
7. Install roof opening panel following WSM, Section 501-17.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body
- Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash > Page 8323
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082408A 2005-2009 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator: Follow The Service Procedure To Repair The Water leak (Do Not Use With 5028A)
082408A 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.6 Hr.
F-150, 2005-2008 Mark LT: Follow The Service Procedure To Repair The Water leak (Do Not Use
With 5028A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
78502C50 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module
Fuel Gauge Sender: Locations Fuel Pump Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 8326
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 8327
Fuel Gauge Sender: Locations Fuel Pump (FP) Control Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 8328
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 8329
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Engine Control Components
Fuel Pump (FP) Module
The FP module is a device that contains the fuel pump and sender assembly. The fuel pump is
located inside the FP module reservoir and supplies fuel through the FP module manifold to the
engine and FP module jet pump. The jet pump continuously refills the reservoir with fuel, and a
check valve located in the manifold outlet maintains system pressure when the fuel pump is not
energized. A flapper valve located in the bottom of the reservoir allows fuel to enter the reservoir
and prime the fuel pump during the initial fill.
Typical Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Typical Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Typical Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Typical Mechanical Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Typical Mechanical Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump (FP) Module > Page 8332
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Fuel Pump (FP) Module and Reservoir
Engine Control Components
Fuel Pump (FP) Module and Reservoir
The FP module is mounted inside the fuel tank in a reservoir. The pump has a discharge check
valve that maintains the system pressure after the ignition has been turned off to minimize starting
concerns. The reservoir prevents fuel flow interruptions during extreme vehicle maneuvers with low
tank fill levels.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View
Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View
106L (28 Gal) Fuel Tank
127L (33.5 Gal) Fuel Tank
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 8335
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 8336
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module
Fuel Pump Module
106L (28 Gal) Fuel Tank
127L (33.5 Gal) Fuel Tank
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 8337
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
All fuel tanks
1. Remove the fuel tank. For additional information, refer to Fuel Tank See: Powertrain
Management/Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel
Tank/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Fuel Tank.
127L (33.5 gal) fuel tank
2. Remove the 4 nuts and the Fuel Pump (FP) module cover.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
3. Disconnect the return fuel tube-to-FP module quick connect coupling.
All fuel tanks
4. Disconnect the Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-FP module quick
connect coupling and the supply fuel tube-to-FP
module quick connect coupling.
5. Using the Fuel Tank Sender Unit Wrench, remove the FP lock ring.
106L (28 gal) fuel tank
6. NOTICE: Carefully remove the Fuel Pump (FP) assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level
sensor.
NOTE: If the FP does not clear the FP mounting flange on the fuel tank, the use of a screwdriver
may be necessary.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page 8338
Remove the FP and FP O-ring seal. If necessary, insert a screwdriver into the empty FP rod hole and slightly pull the screwdriver
inboard until the base of the FP clears the FP mounting flange.
- Discard the FP O-ring seal.
127L (33.5 gal) fuel tank
7. NOTICE: Carefully remove the Fuel Pump (FP) assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level
sensor.
NOTE: Note the location of the FP alignment tabs.
Remove the FP module assembly. Remove and discard the O-ring seal.
All fuel tanks
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering
Depowering Procedure
WARNING: Always wear eye protection when servicing a vehicle. Failure to follow this instruction
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on air bag, Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain
modules. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of these
modules, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the
restraints control module (RCM) while the RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON. Failure
to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of the Safety Canopy(R) and
cause serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: To reduce the risk of accidental deployment, do not use any memory saver devices.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF.
2. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
3. At the Smart Junction Box (SJB), located in the RH lower kick panel, remove the cover and the
RCM fuse 32 (10A) from the SJB. For additional
information, refer to the Wiring Diagrams.
4. Turn the ignition switch ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30
seconds. The air bag warning indicator will remain
lit continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
6. WARNING: Always deplete the backup power supply before repairing or installing any new front
or side air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) component and before servicing, removing, installing, adjusting or striking
components near the front or side impact sensors or the restraints control module (RCM). Nearby
components include doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood
latches.
Refer to the Description and Operation portion of Air Bag Systems for location of the RCM and
impact sensor(s).
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
1 minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury or death in the event of an
accidental deployment.
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
Repowering Procedure
1. Make sure that all SRS components are connected.
2. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 8344
3. Install RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the SJB and close the cover.
4. WARNING: Make sure no one is in the vehicle and there is nothing blocking or placed in front of
any air bag module when the battery is
connected. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury in the event of
an accidental deployment.
Connect the battery ground cable.
5. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the back to ON and visually monitor
the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag warning indicator will
illuminate continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an SRS fault is present,
the air bag warning indicator will:
- fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The flashing might not occur until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition has been turned from
the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to complete the testing of the
SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault exists, a chime will sound in a
pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning indicator and any SRS fault
discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous DTCs from the RCM using a scan tool.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 8345
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Deactivation and Reactivation
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deactivation and Reactivation
Deactivation
WARNING: Always carry or place a live air bag module with the air bag and deployment door/trim
cover/tear seam pointed away from the body. Do not set a live air bag module down with the
deployment door/trim cover/tear seam face down. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
WARNING: Never probe the electrical connectors on air bag, Safety Canopy(R) or side air curtain
modules. Failure to follow this instruction may result in the accidental deployment of these
modules, which increases the risk of serious personal injury or death.
WARNING: To reduce the risk of accidental deployment, do not use any memory saver devices.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury or death.
NOTE: The air bag warning indicator illuminates when the correct Restraints Control Module
(RCM) fuse is removed and the ignition is ON.
NOTE: The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) must be fully operational and free of faults
before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF.
2. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
3. At the Smart Junction Box (SJB), located in the RH lower kick panel, remove the cover and the
RCM fuse 32 (10A) from the SJB. For additional
information, refer to the Wiring Diagrams.
4. Turn the ignition switch ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30
seconds. The air bag warning indicator will remain
lit continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed. If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: Always deplete the backup power supply before repairing or installing any new front
or side air bag supplemental restraint
system (SRS) component and before servicing, removing, installing, adjusting or striking
components near the front or side impact sensors or the restraints control module (RCM). Nearby
components include doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood
latches.
Refer to the Description and Operation portion of Air Bag Systems for location of the RCM and
impact sensor(s).
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
1 minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).
Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury or death in the event of an
accidental deployment.
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
7. Make sure the road wheels are in the straight-ahead position.
8. Center the tilt steering column to allow for steering column upper and lower shroud removal.
9. NOTICE: Turn the steering wheel such that the top is at 90 degrees (at the 9 o'clock position) to
the left from the straight-ahead position
to access the driver air bag module wire clips and to prevent damage to the steering column
multi-function switch. Failure to follow this instruction may result in component damage.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 8346
Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is 90 degrees to the left (at the 9 o'clock position)
as shown.
10. Remove the lower steering column opening cover.
- Remove the 3 screws.
- Pull out to release the top retainers.
- Remove the lower steering column opening cover. If equipped, disconnect the adjustable pedals switch connector.
11. If equipped, remove the screw and steering column manual tilt lever.
12. Remove the 3 steering column lower shroud screws.
13. Release the clips and remove the steering column upper shroud.
14. Remove the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, disconnect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
15. NOTICE: Make sure each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are disengaged from each of
the 3 steering wheel hooks before
removing the driver air bag module from the steering wheel. Failure to follow this instruction may
result in component damage and/or system failure.
NOTE: Steering wheel is removed for clarity. The rear of the steering wheel is shown.
NOTE: Use a mirror to view the rear of the steering wheel to locate where the 3 driver air bag
module wire clips attach to the steering wheel hooks.
Using a screwdriver or a suitable tool, release each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips from
the steering wheel hooks. Access the 3 driver air bag module wire clips through the back of the steering wheel cover and
push the wire clips toward the center of the steering wheel to release.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 8347
16. NOTE: Once the driver air bag module is removed, note the position of the 2 driver air bag
module locator pins on the steering wheel for
installation.
Disconnect the driver air bag module and horn switch electrical connectors and remove the driver
air bag module.
17. Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is back in the straight-ahead position (the 12
o'clock position).
18. Open and lower the glove compartment door to allow access to the passenger air bag electrical
connector.
- If equipped, disconnect the glove compartment door dampener.
19. Disconnect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
20. NOTE: There are 2 similar connectors under the passenger seat. The passenger seat side air
bag module electrical connector is located toward the
seat outboard position.
Remove the passenger front seat cushion panel shield and disconnect the passenger seat side air
bag module electrical.
21. Release the RH second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 8348
22. Remove the bolt and the RH second row safety belt retractor D-ring.
23. Remove the cover and the RH C-pillar trim panel nut.
24. Release the rear door weatherstrip and remove the RH C-pillar trim panel.
25. Disconnect the RH safety canopy module electrical connector.
26. Release the LH second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
27. Remove the bolt and the LH second row safety belt retractor D-ring.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 8349
28. Remove the cover and the LH C-pillar trim panel nut.
29. Release the rear door weatherstrip and remove the driver C-pillar trim panel.
30. Disconnect the LH safety canopy module electrical connector.
31. NOTE: There are 2 similar connectors under the driver seat. The driver seat side air bag
module electrical connector is located toward the seat
outboard position.
Remove the driver front seat cushion panel shield and disconnect the driver seat side air bag
module electrical connector.
32. Install the RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the Smart Junction Box (SJB).
33. Connect the battery ground cable.
Reactivation
1. Remove the RCM fuse 32 (10A) from the SJB.
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
3. Connect the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector and install the driver front seat
cushion panel shield.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 8350
4. Connect the LH safety canopy module electrical connector.
5. Install the LH C-pillar trim panel and attach the rear door weatherstrip.
6. Install the LH C-pillar trim panel nut and cover.
7. Install the LH second row safety belt retractor D-ring and bolt.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
8. Attach the LH second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
9. Connect the RH safety canopy module electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 8351
10. Install the RH C-pillar trim panel and attach the rear door weatherstrip.
11. Install the passenger C-pillar trim panel nut and cover.
12. Install the RH second row safety belt retractor D-ring and bolt.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
13. Attach the RH second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding. Extract and retract the safety belt between the full extension and stowed positions.
- If excessive effort or binding is present, install a new safety belt buckle retractor and tongue
assembly as necessary. For additional information, refer to Seat Belt Systems.
14. Connect the passenger seat side air bag module electrical connector and install the passenger
front seat cushion panel shield.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 8352
15. Connect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
16. Close the glove compartment door.
- If equipped, connect the glove compartment door dampener.
17. NOTICE: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag module. Match
the electrical connector key to the keyway in the driver air bag module. Do not force the electrical
connectors into the driver air bag module. Damage to the connector or component may occur.
Connect the horn switch and 2 driver air bag module electrical connectors.
18. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, lining up the locator pins.
19. NOTE: Make sure that all 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged and seated
correctly to the steering wheel.
NOTE: Audible clicks will be heard when the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged.
Firmly press the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, seating the 3 driver air bag module
wire clips to the steering wheel hooks.
- Check the driver air bag module trim cover to the steering wheel for an even gap clearance and
correct movement.
20. Install the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, connect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
21. Install the steering column upper shroud.
22. Install the 3 steering column lower shroud screws.
23. If equipped, install the steering column manual tilt lever and screw.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
24. If equipped, connect the adjustable pedals switch connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 8353
25. Install the lower steering column opening cover and 3 screws.
26. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON.
27. Install the RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the SJB and install the cover.
28. WARNING: Make sure no one is in the vehicle and there is nothing blocking or placed in front
of any air bag module when the battery is
connected. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury in the event of
an accidental deployment.
Connect the battery ground cable.
29. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition switch from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the ignition switch back to ON
and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag
warning indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag
SRS fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will either:
- fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The air bag warning indicator may not illuminate until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition
switch has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator will need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Clear all continuous memory DTCs from the RCM using a scan tool.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator: Procedures
Message Center Configuration
Oil Life Reset Message Center Cluster
NOTE: The oil life calculation is set at a maximum of approximately 12,000 km (7,500 miles) or 180
days.
NOTE: The XX's in the message center displays below represent a numeric value. For example,
the message center may display OIL LIFE = 80%.
1. Press and release the SETUP button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX%
HOLD RESET = NEW. 2. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the
message center displays OIL LIFE SET TO 100%. 3. Press and release the SETUP button to exit
the procedure. Oil Life Reset Base Instrument Cluster (IC)
NOTE: All message center functions are carried out using the single stem reset button in the
Instrument Cluster (IC).
NOTE: The oil life calculation is set at a maximum of approximately 12,000 km (7,500 miles) or 180
days.
NOTE: The XX's in the message center displays below represent a numeric value. For example,
the message center may display OIL LIFE = 80%.
1. Press and release the reset button to scroll through the information displays until the message
center displays HOLD RESET FOR SETUP MENU. 2. Press and hold the reset button for
approximately 2 seconds until the message center displays HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK.
3. Press and release the reset button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX% HOLD
RESET = NEW. 4. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the
message center displays OIL LIFE SET TO 100%. 5. Press and release the reset button to exit the
procedure. Oil Life Start Value Message Center Cluster
NOTE: The oil life start value is used to increase or decrease the starting point of the oil life. The
value can be changed back to the maximum of approximately 12,000 km (7,500 miles) if the value
was previously changed or lowered by 10% increments down to 10%.
NOTE: The XX's in the message center displays below represent a numeric value. For example,
the message center may display OIL LIFE = 80%.
1. Press and release the SETUP button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX%
HOLD RESET = NEW. 2. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the
message center displays OIL LIFE SET TO 100%. 3. NOTE: The oil life start value can be lowered
from 100% to 10% in 10% increments then the value starts again at 100%. Press the RESET
button once for each 10% reduction below the default 100% until the message center displays OIL
LIFE SET TO XX%. 4. Press and release the SETUP button to exit the procedure. Oil Life Start
Value Base Instrument Cluster (IC)
NOTE: All message center functions are carried out using the single stem reset button in the
Instrument Cluster (IC).
NOTE: The oil life start value is used to increase or decrease the starting point of the oil life. The
value can be changed back to the maximum of approximately 12,000 km (7,500 miles) if the value
was previously changed or lowered by 10% increments down to 10%.
1. Press and release the reset button to scroll through the information displays until the message
center displays HOLD RESET FOR SETUP MENU. 2. Press and hold the reset button for
approximately 2 seconds until the message center displays HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK.
3. Press and release the reset button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX% HOLD
RESET = NEW. 4. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the
message center displays OIL LIFE SET TO 100%. 5. Press the RESET button to lower 10% from
the default 100% until the message center displays OIL LIFE SET TO XX%. 6. NOTE: The oil life
start value can be lowered from 100% to 10% in 10% increments then the value starts again at
100%. Repeat steps 2-5 for each desired 10% reduction. 7. Press and release the reset button to
exit the procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8358
Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator: Reset Procedure
Oil Life Reset - Message Center Cluster
Message Center Configuration
Oil Life Reset - Message Center Cluster
NOTE: The oil life calculation is set at a maximum of approximately 12,000 km (7,500 miles) or 180
days.
NOTE: The XX's in the message center displays below represent a numeric value. For example,
the message center may display OIL LIFE = 80%.
1. Press and release the SETUP button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX%
HOLD RESET = NEW.
2. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the message center displays
OIL LIFE SET TO 100%.
3. Press and release the SETUP button to exit the procedure.
Oil Life Reset - Base Instrument Cluster (IC)
Message Center Configuration
Oil Life Reset - Base Instrument Cluster (IC)
NOTE: All message center functions are carried out using the single stem reset button in the
Instrument Cluster (IC).
NOTE: The oil life calculation is set at a maximum of approximately 12,000 km (7,500 miles) or 180
days.
NOTE: The XX's in the message center displays below represent a numeric value. For example,
the message center may display OIL LIFE = 80%.
1. Press and release the reset button to scroll through the information displays until the message
center displays HOLD RESET FOR SETUP MENU.
2. Press and hold the reset button for approximately 2 seconds until the message center displays
HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK.
3. Press and release the reset button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX% HOLD
RESET = NEW.
4. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the message center displays
OIL LIFE SET TO 100%.
5. Press and release the reset button to exit the procedure.
Oil Life Start Value - Message Center Cluster
Message Center Configuration
Oil Life Start Value - Message Center Cluster
NOTE: The oil life start value is used to increase or decrease the starting point of the oil life. The
value can be changed back to the maximum of approximately 12,000 km (7,500 miles) if the value
was previously changed or lowered by 10% increments down to 10%.
NOTE: The XX's in the message center displays below represent a numeric value. For example,
the message center may display OIL LIFE = 80%.
1. Press and release the SETUP button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX%
HOLD RESET = NEW.
2. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the message center displays
OIL LIFE SET TO 100%.
3. NOTE: The oil life start value can be lowered from 100% to 10% in 10% increments then the
value starts again at 100%.
Press the RESET button once for each 10% reduction below the default 100% until the message
center displays OIL LIFE SET TO XX%.
4. Press and release the SETUP button to exit the procedure.
Oil Life Start Value - Base Instrument Cluster (IC)
Message Center Configuration
Oil Life Start Value - Base Instrument Cluster (IC)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8359
NOTE: All message center functions are carried out using the single stem reset button in the
Instrument Cluster (IC).
NOTE: The oil life start value is used to increase or decrease the starting point of the oil life. The
value can be changed back to the maximum of approximately 12,000 km (7,500 miles) if the value
was previously changed or lowered by 10% increments down to 10%.
1. Press and release the reset button to scroll through the information displays until the message
center displays HOLD RESET FOR SETUP MENU.
2. Press and hold the reset button for approximately 2 seconds until the message center displays
HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK.
3. Press and release the reset button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX% HOLD
RESET = NEW.
4. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the message center displays
OIL LIFE SET TO 100%.
5. Press the RESET button to lower 10% from the default 100% until the message center displays
OIL LIFE SET TO XX%.
6. NOTE: The oil life start value can be lowered from 100% to 10% in 10% increments then the
value starts again at 100%.
Repeat steps 2-5 for each desired 10% reduction.
7. Press and release the reset button to exit the procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL)
The MIL notifies the driver that the powertrain control module (PCM) has detected an on board
diagnostic (OBD) emission-related component or system concern. When this occurs, an OBD
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) sets.
- The MIL is located in the instrument cluster and is labeled CHECK ENGINE, SERVICE ENGINE
SOON or the international standards organization (ISO) standard engine symbol.
- The MIL is illuminated during the instrument cluster prove out for approximately four seconds.
- The MIL remains illuminated after instrument cluster prove out if:
- an emission-related concern and DTC exists.
- the PCM does not send a control message to the instrument cluster (applications with the MIL
controlled through the communication link).
- the PCM is operating in the hardware limited operation strategy (HLOS).
- The MIL remains off during the instrument cluster prove out if an indicator or instrument cluster
concern is present.
- To turn off the MIL after a repair, a reset command from the scan tool must be sent, or three
consecutive drive cycles must be completed without a concern.
- For all MIL concerns, go to Symptom Charts See: Powertrain Management/Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/No Diagnostic
Trouble Codes (DTCs) Present Symptom Chart Index.
- If the MIL flashes at a steady rate, a severe misfire condition may exist.
- If the MIL flashes erratically, the PCM can reset while cranking if the battery voltage is low.
- The MIL flashes after a period of time with the ignition in the RUN position (engine not running) if
DTC P1000 is set.
CHECK ENGINE, SERVICE ENGINE SOON, or ISO Standard Engine Symbol
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Change Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Oil Change Reminder Lamp: Service and Repair
Oil Life
An oil change is required whenever indicated by the message center. USE ONLY
RECOMMENDED ENGINE OILS.
To reset the oil monitoring system to 100% after each oil change ( approximately 7,500 miles (
12,000 km ) or 12 months ) perform the following:
1. Press and release the SETUP control to display "OIL LIFE = XXX% HOLD RESET = NEW".
2. Press and hold the RESET stem for 2 seconds and release. Oil life is set to XX% and "OIL LIFE
SET TO XX%" is displayed.
Note: Oil Life Start Value of 100% equals 7,500 miles (12,070 km) or 6 months. For example,
setting Oil Life Start Value to 60% sets the Oil Life Start Value to 3,000 miles (4,828 km) and 120
days.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 8369
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 8370
Oil Pressure Sender: Service and Repair
Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) Switch
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Disconnect the Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) switch electrical connector.
3. Remove the EOP switch.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Outside Temperature Display > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Outside Temperature Display: Description and Operation
Climate Control System
External Temperature Display
The external temperature is displayed when the EXT button is pressed. While the actual external
temperature can vary continuously, the value that is displayed will update at a specific rate
depending on whether or not the engine is "hot" and whether or not the vehicle is moving.
When the external temperature is rising, the display will updated slowly. Updates (when the actual
external temperature is higher than currently displayed value) will be limited to 0.55°C (1°F) every
20 seconds while the vehicle is moving at 40 kph (25 mph) for more than 90 seconds OR 0.55°C
(1°F) every 20 minutes if the vehicle is not moving at this speed. This is to prevent the heat from
the engine compartment from affecting the accuracy of the display.
When the external temperature is dropping, the display will update quickly. Updates (when the
actual external temperature is lower than currently displayed value) will only be limited to 0.55°C
(1°F) every 2 seconds (regardless of vehicle speed), consequently the display will essentially follow
the drop experienced by the external temperature thermistor.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Assist Warning Indicator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Speaker Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Assist Warning Indicator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Parking Aid Speaker Front > Page 8378
Parking Assist Warning Indicator: Diagrams Parking Aid Speaker
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Assist Warning Indicator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8379
Parking Assist Warning Indicator: Service and Repair
Parking Aid Speaker - Expedition
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the LH quarter trim panel.
2. Remove the bolt and the speaker and bracket assembly.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8383
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8384
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Seat Belt Reminder Buzzer > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Seat Belt Reminder Buzzer: Service and Repair
Belt-Minder(R) Deactivating/Activating
Preparation
1. Set the parking brake.
2. Place the transmission in PARK (P).
3. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
4. Close all the vehicle doors.
5. Unbuckle the driver and passenger safety belts.
Deactivating/Activating
1. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN position (do not start the engine).
2. Wait until the safety belt warning indicator turns off (approximately 1 minute).
3. NOTE: Step 3 must be completed within 50 seconds after the safety belt warning indicator turns
off or the procedure must be repeated.
Buckle then unbuckle the safety belt 9 times, ending with the safety belt unbuckled.
4. NOTE: After Step 3, the safety belt warning indicator lamp illuminates for 3 seconds.
Within 10 seconds of the safety belt warning indicator turning on, buckle then unbuckle the safety
belt.
- This disables the Belt-Minder(R) feature if it is currently enabled. As confirmation, the safety belt
warning indicator flashes 4 times per second for 3 seconds.
- This enables the Belt-Minder(R) feature if it is currently disabled. As confirmation, the safety belt
warning indicator flashes 4 times per second for 3 seconds followed by a second series of 4
flashes per second for 3 seconds.
5. After confirmation, the deactivation/activation procedure is complete.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Seat Belt Reminder Lamp: Service and Repair
Belt-Minder(R) Deactivating/Activating
Preparation
1. Set the parking brake.
2. Place the transmission in PARK (P).
3. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
4. Close all the vehicle doors.
5. Unbuckle the driver and passenger safety belts.
Deactivating/Activating
1. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN position (do not start the engine).
2. Wait until the safety belt warning indicator turns off (approximately 1 minute).
3. NOTE: Step 3 must be completed within 50 seconds after the safety belt warning indicator turns
off or the procedure must be repeated.
Buckle then unbuckle the safety belt 9 times, ending with the safety belt unbuckled.
4. NOTE: After Step 3, the safety belt warning indicator lamp illuminates for 3 seconds.
Within 10 seconds of the safety belt warning indicator turning on, buckle then unbuckle the safety
belt.
- This disables the Belt-Minder(R) feature if it is currently enabled. As confirmation, the safety belt
warning indicator flashes 4 times per second for 3 seconds.
- This enables the Belt-Minder(R) feature if it is currently disabled. As confirmation, the safety belt
warning indicator flashes 4 times per second for 3 seconds followed by a second series of 4
flashes per second for 3 seconds.
5. After confirmation, the deactivation/activation procedure is complete.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair
Instrument Panel Dimmer Switch
NOTE: Navigator shown, Expedition similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the Instrument Cluster (IC) finish panel.
2. Press the tabs and remove the instrument panel dimmer switch.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 8399
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 8400
Door Switch: Locations Door Ajar Switch, Left Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 8401
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 8402
Door Switch: Locations Door Ajar Switch, Right Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 8403
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 8406
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 8407
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 8408
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8409
Door Switch: Service and Repair
Door Ajar Switch
NOTE: LH front door latch shown, others similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door latch. For additional information, refer to Front Door Latch See: Body and
Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front
Door/Front Door Latch/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement or Rear Door Latch See:
Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Rear Door/Rear Door Latch/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement.
2. Release the locking tab and remove the door ajar switch.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge Sender: >
09-11-7 > Jun > 09 > Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity
Fuel Gauge Sender: Customer Interest Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity
TSB 09-11-7
06/15/09
LONG WHEEL BASE (LWB), LOWER THAN EXPECTED FUEL FILL CAPACITY - BUILT
BEFORE 4/10/2009
FORD: 2007-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Expedition and Navigator long wheel base (LWB) vehicles built before
4/10/2009, may encounter the amount of fuel needed to fill the fuel tank may be lower than
expected. This may be encountered when the distance to empty (DIE) states 50 miles or lower to
empty, or the fuel gauge reads lower than 1/8 tank of fuel prior to refueling.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Ask the customer the following questions.
1. Does the customer refill the fuel tank with the engine off?
a. No - Retest the vehicle with engine off before proceeding, if concern does not occur, this
procedure does not apply.
b. Yes - Go to Step 2.
NOTE
SOME CREDIT CARDS HAVE PRESET LIMITS ON THE DOLLAR AMOUNT AVAILABLE FUEL
TRANSACTION. THE PUMP WILL SHUT OFF AT THIS LIMIT. THIS LIMIT MAY BE IN THE
RANGE OF $50 TO $75.
2. Does the customer refill the fuel tank until 1 to 3 gas pump automatic shutoffs?
a. Yes - Go to Step 3.
b. No - Retest the vehicle using the gasoline pump automatic shutoff function before proceeding, if
concern does not occur, this procedure does not
apply.
3. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) using the Workshop Manual, Section 310-01 with
certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near the
gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091107A 2007-2009 Expedition, 1.8 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace The Fuel Delivery Module (Do
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge Sender: >
09-11-7 > Jun > 09 > Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity > Page 8418
Not Use With 9002A, 9002A6)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge
Sender: > 09-11-7 > Jun > 09 > Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity
Fuel Gauge Sender: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill
Capacity
TSB 09-11-7
06/15/09
LONG WHEEL BASE (LWB), LOWER THAN EXPECTED FUEL FILL CAPACITY - BUILT
BEFORE 4/10/2009
FORD: 2007-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Expedition and Navigator long wheel base (LWB) vehicles built before
4/10/2009, may encounter the amount of fuel needed to fill the fuel tank may be lower than
expected. This may be encountered when the distance to empty (DIE) states 50 miles or lower to
empty, or the fuel gauge reads lower than 1/8 tank of fuel prior to refueling.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Ask the customer the following questions.
1. Does the customer refill the fuel tank with the engine off?
a. No - Retest the vehicle with engine off before proceeding, if concern does not occur, this
procedure does not apply.
b. Yes - Go to Step 2.
NOTE
SOME CREDIT CARDS HAVE PRESET LIMITS ON THE DOLLAR AMOUNT AVAILABLE FUEL
TRANSACTION. THE PUMP WILL SHUT OFF AT THIS LIMIT. THIS LIMIT MAY BE IN THE
RANGE OF $50 TO $75.
2. Does the customer refill the fuel tank until 1 to 3 gas pump automatic shutoffs?
a. Yes - Go to Step 3.
b. No - Retest the vehicle using the gasoline pump automatic shutoff function before proceeding, if
concern does not occur, this procedure does not
apply.
3. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) using the Workshop Manual, Section 310-01 with
certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near the
gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091107A 2007-2009 Expedition, 1.8 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace The Fuel Delivery Module (Do
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge
Sender: > 09-11-7 > Jun > 09 > Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity > Page 8424
Not Use With 9002A, 9002A6)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module
Fuel Gauge Sender: Locations Fuel Pump Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 8427
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 8428
Fuel Gauge Sender: Locations Fuel Pump (FP) Control Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Module > Page 8429
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Locations > Page 8430
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Engine Control Components
Fuel Pump (FP) Module
The FP module is a device that contains the fuel pump and sender assembly. The fuel pump is
located inside the FP module reservoir and supplies fuel through the FP module manifold to the
engine and FP module jet pump. The jet pump continuously refills the reservoir with fuel, and a
check valve located in the manifold outlet maintains system pressure when the fuel pump is not
energized. A flapper valve located in the bottom of the reservoir allows fuel to enter the reservoir
and prime the fuel pump during the initial fill.
Typical Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Typical Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Typical Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Typical Mechanical Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Typical Mechanical Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pump (FP) Module > Page 8433
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation Fuel Pump (FP) Module and Reservoir
Engine Control Components
Fuel Pump (FP) Module and Reservoir
The FP module is mounted inside the fuel tank in a reservoir. The pump has a discharge check
valve that maintains the system pressure after the ignition has been turned off to minimize starting
concerns. The reservoir prevents fuel flow interruptions during extreme vehicle maneuvers with low
tank fill levels.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View
Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View
106L (28 Gal) Fuel Tank
127L (33.5 Gal) Fuel Tank
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page
8436
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page
8437
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Fuel Pump Module
Fuel Pump Module
106L (28 Gal) Fuel Tank
127L (33.5 Gal) Fuel Tank
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page
8438
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working
on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio
equipment of any type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable
mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in
serious personal injury.
All fuel tanks
1. Remove the fuel tank. For additional information, refer to Fuel Tank See: Powertrain
Management/Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Fuel
Tank/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement/Fuel Tank.
127L (33.5 gal) fuel tank
2. Remove the 4 nuts and the Fuel Pump (FP) module cover.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
3. Disconnect the return fuel tube-to-FP module quick connect coupling.
All fuel tanks
4. Disconnect the Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-FP module quick
connect coupling and the supply fuel tube-to-FP
module quick connect coupling.
5. Using the Fuel Tank Sender Unit Wrench, remove the FP lock ring.
106L (28 gal) fuel tank
6. NOTICE: Carefully remove the Fuel Pump (FP) assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level
sensor.
NOTE: If the FP does not clear the FP mounting flange on the fuel tank, the use of a screwdriver
may be necessary.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Tank and Filler Pipe - Exploded View > Page
8439
Remove the FP and FP O-ring seal. If necessary, insert a screwdriver into the empty FP rod hole and slightly pull the screwdriver
inboard until the base of the FP clears the FP mounting flange.
- Discard the FP O-ring seal.
127L (33.5 gal) fuel tank
7. NOTICE: Carefully remove the Fuel Pump (FP) assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level
sensor.
NOTE: Note the location of the FP alignment tabs.
Remove the FP module assembly. Remove and discard the O-ring seal.
All fuel tanks
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Parking Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Parking Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 8443
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Parking Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 8444
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Shift Indicator: Service and Repair
Selector Lever Indicator Bulb
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the selector lever assembly.
2. Release the 4 tabs on the selector lever bezel and lift the selector lever bezel up to the selector
lever knob.
3. Remove the bulb retainers from the bezel and replace the bulb(s) as necessary.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Training
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training
NOTE: If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, the sensors will go into a "sleep
mode" to conserve battery power. It will be necessary to wake them up so they will transmit the
latest tire pressure information to the Smart Junction Box (SJB). For additional information, refer to
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Activation See: Testing and
Inspection/Programming and Relearning.
NOTE: The tire pressure sensor training procedure must be done on a single vehicle, in an area
without radio frequency noise and at least 1 m (3 ft) away from other vehicles equipped with a Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS). Radio frequency noise is generated by electrical motors and
appliance operation, cellular telephones, remote transmitters, power inverters and portable
entertainment equipment.
NOTE: If a sensor does not respond to the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool, attempt to
activate the same sensor with the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. If the sensor still does not
respond, move the vehicle to rotate the wheels at least one-fourth of a turn and attempt to activate
the same sensor again.
NOTE: The SJB has a 2-minute time limit between sensor responses. If the SJB does not
recognize any 1 of the 4 tire pressure sensors during this time limit, the horn will sound twice and
the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE NOT TRAINED REPEAT and the entire
procedure must be repeated.
NOTE: For vehicles with different front and rear tire pressures (such as the E-Series and certain
F-Series), the tire pressure sensors must be trained following a tire rotation. Failure to train the
sensors will cause the TPMS indicator to illuminate. For vehicles with the same tire pressure for
front and rear tires, tire rotation will not affect the system.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position, then press and release the brake pedal.
2. Cycle the ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN
position.
3. Press and release the brake pedal.
4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
5. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN
position.
- The horn will sound once and the TPMS indicator will flash if the training mode has been entered
successfully. If equipped, the message center will display TRAIN LF TIRE.
6. NOTE: It may take up to 6 seconds to activate a tire pressure sensor. During this time, the Tire
Pressure Monitor Activation Tool must remain in
place 180 degrees from the valve stem.
Place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the LF tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees) from
the valve stem. Press and release the test button on the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. The
horn will sound briefly to indicate that the tire pressure sensor has been recognized by the SJB.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training >
Page 8453
7. Within 2 minutes of the horn sounding, place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the RF
tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees) from the
valve stem and press and release the test button to train the RF tire pressure sensor.
8. NOTE: Do not wait more than 2 minutes between training each sensor or the SJB will time out
and the entire procedure must be repeated.
Repeat Step 7 for the RR and LR tires.
The procedure is completed after the last tire has been trained. When the training procedure is
complete, the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE TRAINING COMPLETE.
For vehicles not equipped with a message center, successful completion of the training procedure
will be verified by turning the ignition switch to the OFF position without the horn sounding. If the
horn sounds twice when the switch is turned to the OFF position, the training procedure was not
successful.
9. Using the scan tool, locate the updated TPMS sensor identifiers trained to the SJB and
document them on the applicable warranty claim.
10. NOTE: This step is required to clear DTC C2780, cause the SJB to exit the manufacturing
mode and to make sure there are no other concerns
with a newly programmed SJB.
If the sensors are being trained due to the installation of a new SJB, clear any DTCs and carry out
the SJB On-Demand Self Test.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training >
Page 8454
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Activation
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Activation
NOTE: The tire pressure sensors will go into a "sleep mode" after 30 minutes of inactivity to
conserve battery power. The sensors do not transmit information while in sleep mode. It will be
necessary to wake them up so they will transmit the latest tire pressure information.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
2. Position the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool against the LF tire sidewall, 180 degrees from
the tire valve stem.
3. NOTE: The Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool will provide feedback in the form of a flashing
green light and a beep sound for each
successful response from a tire pressure sensor.
Press the test button on the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool to activate the sensor, activate
the sensor at least 2 times.
4. Repeat Steps 2 and 3 for the remaining tires.
5. If the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) indicator remains illuminated after adjusting and
activating each sensor, refer to the Symptom
Chart in Diagnosis and Testing. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic
Procedures
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Disassembly
WARNING: The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) sensor battery may release hazardous
chemicals if exposed to extreme mechanical damage. If these chemicals contact the skin or eyes,
flush immediately with water for a minimum of 15 minutes and get prompt medical attention. If any
part of the battery is swallowed, contact a physician immediately. When disposing of TPMS
sensors, follow the correct procedures for hazardous material disposal. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in serious personal injury.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application. When
installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color of the
sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor can be removed and installed without removing the strap or the cradle.
1. NOTICE: The sensor, cradle and strap may be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Dismount the tire only as instructed.
Remove the tire from the wheel. For additional information, refer to Wheel and Tire See:
Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Overhaul.
2. NOTICE: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to the
sensor locking clip may occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver or similar tool, remove the sensor locking clip.
3. NOTICE: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to the
sensor may occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver or similar tool, detach the sensor from the cradle.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 8457
4. Remove the sensor.
Assembly
1. NOTICE: Damage to the sensor may occur if excessive force is applied during sensor
installation.
NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the cradle. The sensor will make a "click" noise
when correctly seated.
Position the sensor into the cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end of the
cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. NOTE: The locking clip can only be fully seated when installed in the correct orientation. If the
sensor locking clip cannot be fully inserted, then
the sensor may not be fully seated on the cradle or the locking clip may be inserted backward.
Insert a new locking clip into the sensor.
3. NOTICE: The sensor, cradle and strap may be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel. For additional information, refer to Wheel and Tire See:
Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Overhaul.
4. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s). For additional information, refer to Tire Pressure Monitoring
System (TPMS) Sensor Training See: Testing and Inspection/Monitors, Trips, Drive Cycles and
Readiness Codes.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 8458
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and
Cradle
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and Cradle
Disassembly
WARNING: The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) sensor battery may release hazardous
chemicals if exposed to extreme mechanical damage. If these chemicals contact the skin or eyes,
flush immediately with water for a minimum of 15 minutes and get prompt medical attention. If any
part of the battery is swallowed, contact a physician immediately. When disposing of TPMS
sensors, follow the correct procedures for hazardous material disposal. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in serious personal injury.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application. When
installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color of the
sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor is available separately, the cradle and strap are available as a strap kit. There
are several different strap kits available based on wheel diameter, but all strap kits share the same
base part number.
1. Remove the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) sensor. For additional information, refer to
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Sensor See: Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor.
2. WARNING: Always wear eye protection when servicing a vehicle. Failure to follow this
instruction may result in serious personal injury.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 8459
WARNING: Wear protective gloves when handling components or parts that have pointed or sharp
edges. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
Remove a factory-installed strap in the following sequence:
1. Locate the strap buckle and secure the strap to the wheel using duct tape or a similar item on
both sides of the buckle, approximately 25 mm
(0.98 in) from the buckle.
2. Using a large screwdriver and a twisting motion, unbuckle the strap.
3. Discard the strap.
3. To remove a dealer-installed strap, turn the worm gear screw until the strap is fully released from
the worm gear.
- Discard the strap.
4. NOTE: To aid assembly, mark the location of the cradle prior to disassembly.
Using a screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the cradle by inserting the screwdriver under the cradle
and prying up.
Assembly
1. NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the new cradle. The sensor will make a "click"
noise when fully seated.
Position the sensor into the new cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end
of the cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. NOTICE: Metal scrapers may damage the wheel. Use only plastic or non-metallic scrapers to
remove the cradle adhesive strip residue.
NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be installed in the drop well of the wheel, 180 degrees from the
valve stem.
Using wheel and tire cleaner, clean the area where the sensor and cradle are to be installed.
3. NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be positioned with the hinge side of the sensor on the RH
side when viewed from the curb side (beauty side)
of the wheel.
NOTE: The sensor has raised markings indicating how to position the sensor.
Remove the adhesive tape liner from the cradle and position the sensor and cradle into the wheel
drop well 180 degrees from the valve stem.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 8460
4. Install the tapered end of the strap through the opening of the cradle on the hinge side of the
sensor. This will position the worm gear on the
locking clip side of the sensor.
5. NOTICE: Steel wheels have a "high spot" along their circumference. Make sure the strap and
sensor are mounted at the lowest spot
possible to avoid damaging the sensor during wheel and tire disassembly and assembly.
NOTE: Keep the strap parallel with the wheel flange while tightening the worm gear.
Position the worm gear 13-26 mm (0.5-1.0 in) away from the sensor and tighten the worm gear.
- Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
6. NOTICE: The sensor, cradle and strap may be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel. For additional information, refer to Wheel and Tire See:
Maintenance/Wheels and Tires/Service and Repair/Overhaul.
7. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s). For additional information, refer to Tire Pressure Monitoring
System (TPMS) Sensor Training See: Testing and Inspection/Monitors, Trips, Drive Cycles and
Readiness Codes.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Transmission Control Indicator Lamp (TCIL)
The TCIL is an output signal from the PCM that controls the lamp on/off function depending on the
engagement or disengagement of overdrive.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
Ambient Light Sensor: Service and Repair
Light Sensor
NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Using a suitable tool (such as a pocket screwdriver), remove the light sensor from the instrument
panel.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
2. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Brake Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagram in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be
seen completely in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference
is given to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in parentheses next to or under a component.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System, and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8476
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in set 4
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the
indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to
illustrate proper orientation.
Power Distribution
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8477
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
Component and Connector Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8478
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component Location
Charts.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Locations information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the
various items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written
description of the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8479
Symbols (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8480
Symbols (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8481
Symbols (Part 3)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8482
Symbols (Part 4)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8483
Symbols (Part 5)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8484
Brake Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminal by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8485
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal.
Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8486
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8487
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8488
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seat wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8489
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8490
7. If visible, be sure to place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the
barrel. 9. Holding the wire in place, barrel squeeze tool handles appropriate ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8491
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8492
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8493
Brake Lamp: Connector Views
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8494
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8495
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8496
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8497
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8498
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8499
Brake Lamp: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
90-1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8500
90-2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8501
90-3
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8502
90-4
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (i.e. 13-2, 24-6, 10-2, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Location Views. See: Locations/Component Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Brake Lamp: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Special Tools Used With Diagnostics
Stoplamps
Principles Of Operation
Stoplamps
Principles of Operation
NOTE: The Smart Junction Box (SJB) is also known as the Generic Electronic Module (GEM).
The SJB monitors the input from the stoplamp switch. When the brake pedal is applied, voltage is
routed to the SJB and the high mounted stoplamp. The SJB then supplies voltage to the
stoplamps.
Field-Effect Transistor (FET) Protection
The SJB utilizes a Field-Effect Transistor (FET) protective circuit strategy for many of its outputs
(for example, the headlamp output circuit). Output loads (current level) are monitored for excessive
current (typically short circuits) and are shut down (turns off the voltage or ground provided by the
module) when a fault event is detected. A continuous DTC is stored at the fault event and a
cumulative counter is started.
When the demand for the output is no longer present, the module resets the FET circuit protection.
The next time a request activates a circuit that has been shut down by a previous short (FET
protection) and the circuit remains shorted, the FET protection shuts off the circuit again and the
cumulative counter advances.
When the excessive circuit load occurs often enough, the module shuts down the output until a
repair procedure is carried out. Each FET protected circuit has 3 predefined levels of short circuit
tolerance based on the harmful effect of each circuit fault on the FET and the ability of the FET to
withstand it. A total level of fault events is established based upon the durability of the FET. If the
total tolerance level is determined to be 600 fault events, the 3 predefined levels would be 200, 400
and 600 fault events.
When each tolerance level is reached, the continuous DTC that was stored on the first failure
cannot be cleared by a command to clear the continuous DTCs. The module does not allow this
code to be cleared or the circuit restored to normal operation until a successful self-test proves that
the fault has been repaired. After the self-test has successfully completed (no on-demand DTCs
present), the continuous DTC automatically clears and the circuit function returns.
When the first or second level is reached, the continuous DTC (associated with the short circuit)
sets along with DTC B106E. These DTCs can be cleared using the module self-test, then the Clear
DTC operation on the scan tool as long as the fault itself has been corrected.
If the number of short circuit fault events reach the third level, then DTCs B106F and B1342 set
along with the associated continuous DTC. This DTC
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8505
cannot be cleared and the module must be replaced.
The SJB FET protected output circuits for the stoplamp system are the LH rear stop/turn lamp
output and the RH rear stop/turn lamp output circuits.
Inspection And Verification
Stoplamps
Inspection and Verification
1. Verify the customer concern.
2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of mechanical or electrical damage.
Visual Inspection Chart
3. If an obvious cause for an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible)
before proceeding to the next step.
NOTE: Make sure the headlamp switch is in the OFF position.
NOTE: Make sure the multifunction switch is in the LOW BEAM position.
4. NOTE: Make sure to use the latest scan tool software release.
If the cause is not visually evident, connect the scan tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC).
5. NOTE: The Vehicle Communication Module (VCM) LED prove-out confirms power and ground
from the DLC are provided to the VCM.
If the scan tool does not communicate with the VCM:
- Check the VCM connection to the vehicle.
- Check the scan tool connection to the VCM.
- Refer to Information Bus, No Power To The Scan Tool, to diagnose no power to the scan tool.
6. If the scan tool does not communicate with the vehicle:
- Verify the ignition key is in the ON position.
- Verify the scan tool operation with a known good vehicle.
- Refer to Information Bus to diagnose no response from the PCM.
7. Carry out the network test.
- If the scan tool responds with no communication for one or more modules, refer to Information
Bus.
- If the network test passes, retrieve and record the continuous memory DTCs.
8. Clear the continuous DTCs and carry out the self-test diagnostics for the SJB.
9. If the DTCs retrieved are related to the concern, refer to the Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC)
Chart See: Testing and Inspection. For all other
DTCs, refer to the Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Chart in Body Control Systems. See: Body and
Frame/Body Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Descriptions/Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Chart
10. If no DTCs related to the concern are retrieved, GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8506
Brake Lamp: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Stoplamps
Symptom Chart
Symptom Chart
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8507
Brake Lamp: Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test I: All The Stoplamps Are Inoperative
Stoplamps
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test I: All The Stoplamps Are Inoperative
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 90, Turn Signal/Stop/Hazard Lamps for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The stoplamp switch is supplied voltage through circuit SBB43 (BU/RD) from the Battery Junction
Box (BJB). When the brake pedal is applied, the stoplamp switch routes voltage to the Smart
Junction Box (SJB) and the high mounted stoplamp through circuit CLS17 (YE/GY).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Stoplamp switch
PINPOINT TEST I: ALL THE STOPLAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
------------------------------------------------- I1 CHECK CIRCUIT SBB43 (BU/RD) FOR AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Stoplamp Switch C278.
- Measure the voltage between the stoplamp switch C278-1, circuit SBB43 (BU/RD), harness side
and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to I2.
No
VERIFY the BJB fuse 43 (15A) is OK. If OK, REPAIR circuit SBB43 (BU/RD) for an open. TEST
the system for normal operation. If not OK, REFER to the Wiring Diagrams to identify the possible
causes of the circuit short.
------------------------------------------------- I2 BYPASS THE STOPLAMP SWITCH
- Connect a fused jumper wire between the stoplamp switch C278-1, circuit SBB43 (BU/RD),
harness side and the stoplamp switch C278-4, circuit CLS17 (YE/GY), harness side.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8508
- Are the stoplamps illuminated?
Yes
REMOVE the jumper wire. INSTALL a new stoplamp switch. REFER to Stoplamp Switch See:
Brake Light Switch/Service and Repair. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
REMOVE the jumper wire. REPAIR circuit CLS17 (YE/GY) for an open. TEST the system for
normal operation.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test J: One Or More Stoplamps Are Inoperative
Stoplamps
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test J: One Or More Stoplamps Are Inoperative
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 90, Turn Signal/Stop/Hazard Lamps for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
When the brake pedal is applied, the stoplamp switch routes voltage to the Smart Junction Box
(SJB) and the high mounted stoplamp through circuit CLS17 (YE/GY). When the SJB detects the
brake pedal is applied, the SJB provides voltage to the LH rear stoplamp and trailer tow LH
stop/turn relay through circuit CLS18 (GY/BN) and the RH rear stoplamp and trailer tow RH
stop/turn relay through circuit CLS19 (VT/OG). Ground for the LH rear stoplamp is provided
through circuit GD149 (BK/GY) and the RH rear stoplamp through circuit GD150 (BK/WH). Ground
for the high mounted stoplamp is provided through circuit GD150 (BK/WH).
B2044-B2047
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Trailer tow stop/turn relay
- Bulb holder
- High mounted stoplamp
- SJB
PINPOINT TEST J: ONE OR MORE STOPLAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
-------------------------------------------------
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8509
J1 DETERMINE THE INOPERATIVE STOPLAMP
- Ignition OFF.
- Apply the brake pedal and observe the stoplamps.
- Are all the stoplamps inoperative?
Yes
Go To Pinpoint Test I See: Pinpoint Test I: All The Stoplamps Are Inoperative
No
For the high mounted stoplamp, GO to J2.
If both sides (LH and RH rear stoplamps) are inoperative, VERIFY the SJB fuse 6 (20A) is OK. If
OK, GO to J4. If not OK, REFER to the Wiring Diagrams to identify the possible causes of the
circuit short.
If only one side (the LH or RH rear stoplamp) is inoperative, GO to J5.
------------------------------------------------- J2 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE HIGH MOUNTED
STOPLAMP
- Disconnect: High Mounted Stoplamp C475.
- While applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the high mounted stoplamp
C475-1, circuit CLS17 (YE/GY), harness side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to J3.
No
REPAIR circuit CLS17 (YE/GY) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- J3 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE HIGH MOUNTED
STOPLAMP USING THE CONNECTOR GROUND
- While applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the high mounted stoplamp
C475-1, circuit CLS17 (YE/GY), harness side and the high mounted stoplamp C475-2, circuit
GD150 (BK/WH), harness side.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
INSTALL a new high mounted stoplamp. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8510
REPAIR circuit GD150 (BK/WH) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- J4 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE SJB
- Disconnect: SJB C2280b.
- While applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the SJB C2280b-40, circuit CLS17
(YE/GY), harness side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to J13.
No
REPAIR circuit CLS17 (YE/GY) for an open. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the self-test.
------------------------------------------------- J5 USE THE RECORDED DTCs FROM THE SJB
SELF-TEST
- Check the recorded results from the SJB on-demand self-test.
- Is DTC B2044 or B2046 present?
Yes
GO to J6.
No
GO to J10.
------------------------------------------------- J6 CHECK THE TRAILER TOW TURN RELAY
- Disconnect: LH Trailer Tow Turn Relay (DTC B2044).
- Disconnect: RH Trailer Tow Turn Relay (DTC B2046).
- Ignition ON.
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: SJB Self-Test.
- Repeat the SJB on-demand self-test.
- Is on-demand DTC B2044 or B2046 retrieved again?
Yes
GO to J7.
No
INSTALL a new trailer tow stop/turn relay. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- J7 CHECK THE BULB HOLDER FOR A SHORT TO
GROUND
- Disconnect: LH Rear Lamp C4035 (DTC B2044, Expedition).
- Disconnect: LH Rear Lamp C4112 (DTC B2044, Navigator).
- Disconnect: RH Rear Lamp C4032 (DTC B2046, Expedition).
- Disconnect: RH Rear Lamp C4114 (DTC B2046, Navigator).
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: SJB Self-Test.
- Repeat the SJB on-demand self-test.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8511
- Is on-demand DTC B2044 or B2046 retrieved again?
Yes
For Navigator, GO to J8.
For Expedition, GO to J9.
No
INSTALL a new bulb holder. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- J8 CHECK THE BULB HOLDER FOR A SHORT TO
GROUND (NAVIGATOR SECOND LAMP)
- Disconnect: LH Rear Lamp C4113 (DTC B2044).
- Disconnect: RH Rear Lamp C4115 (DTC B2046).
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: SJB Self-Test.
- Repeat the SJB on-demand self-test.
- Is on-demand DTC B2044 or B2046 retrieved again?
Yes
GO to J9.
No
INSTALL a new bulb holder. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- J9 CHECK THE SJB STOPLAMP OUTPUT CIRCUIT FOR A
SHORT TO GROUND
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: SJB C2280d.
- Measure the resistance between the SJB C2280d-25, circuit CLS18 (GY/BN), harness side and
ground; or between the SJB C2280d-26, circuit CLS19 (VT/OG), harness side and ground.
- Is the resistance greater than 10,000 ohms?
Yes
GO to J13.
No
REPAIR circuit CLS18 (GY/BN) (LH rear stoplamp) or circuit CLS19 (VT/OG) (RH rear stoplamp)
for a short to ground. RUN the on-demand self-test (required to clear certain DTCs). CORRECT
any unresolved DTCs. CLEAR all DTCs. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- J10 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE INOPERATIVE
STOPLAMP
- Disconnect: Inoperative Rear Lamp.
- While applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the inoperative rear lamp, harness
side and ground as follows:
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8512
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to J12.
No
For Expedition, GO to J11.
For Navigator if both lamps on one side are inoperative, GO to J11.
For Navigator if one lamp is inoperative, REPAIR circuit CLS18 (GY/BN) (LH rear stoplamp) or
circuit CLS19 (VT/OG) (RH rear stoplamp) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- J11 CHECK THE SJB STOPLAMP OUTPUT CIRCUIT FOR
AN OPEN
- Disconnect: SJB C2280d.
- Measure the resistance between the inoperative rear lamp, harness side and the SJB, harness
side; and between the inoperative rear lamp, harness side and ground as follows:
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8513
Yes
GO to J13.
No
REPAIR circuit CLS18 (GY/BN) (LH rear stoplamp) or circuit CLS19 (VT/OG) (RH rear stoplamp)
for an open. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the self-test.
------------------------------------------------- J12 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE INOPERATIVE
STOPLAMP USING THE CONNECTOR GROUND
- While applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the inoperative rear lamp, harness
side and ground as follows:
- Is the voltages greater than 10 volts?
Yes
INSTALL a new bulb holder. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the self-test.
No
REPAIR circuit GD149 (BK/GY) (LH rear stoplamp) or circuit GD150 (BK/WH) (RH rear stoplamp)
for an open. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the self-test.
------------------------------------------------- J13 CHECK FOR CORRECT SJB OPERATION
- Disconnect all the SJB connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the SJB connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new SJB. TEST the system for normal operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8514
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the self-test.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test K: The Stoplamps Are On Continuously
Stoplamps
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test K: The Stoplamps Are On Continuously
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 90, Turn Signal/Stop/Hazard Lamps for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
When the brake pedal is applied, the stoplamp switch routes voltage to the Smart Junction Box
(SJB) and the high mounted stoplamp, the PCM, the ABS module and the Trailer Brake Control
(TBC) module through circuit CLS17 (YE/GY). When the SJB detects the brake pedal applied, the
SJB provides voltage to the LH rear stoplamp(s) and trailer tow turn relay through circuit CLS18
(GY/BN) and to the RH rear stoplamp(s) and trailer tow turn relay through circuit CLS19 (VT/OG).
- DTC B1485 (Brake Pedal Input Short to Battery) - an on-demand DTC that sets when the SJB
detects a short to voltage from the stoplamp switch input circuit.
- DTC B2045 (Left Rear Stop Lamp Circuit Open) - an on-demand DTC that sets when the SJB
detects a short to voltage on the LH rear stop/turn lamp voltage supply circuit.
- DTC B2047 (Right Rear Stop Lamp Circuit Open) - an on-demand DTC that sets when the SJB
detects a short to voltage on the RH rear stop/turn lamp voltage supply circuit.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Stoplamp switch
- TBC module
- ABS module
- PCM
- SJB
PINPOINT TEST K: THE STOPLAMPS ARE ON CONTINUOUSLY
------------------------------------------------- K1 DETERMINE IF ALL THE STOPLAMPS ARE
ILLUMINATED
- Ignition OFF.
- Observe the stoplamps with the brake pedal released.
- Are all of the stoplamps illuminated?
Yes
GO to K3.
No
GO to K2.
------------------------------------------------- K2 CHECK THE SJB STOPLAMP OUTPUT CIRCUIT FOR A
SHORT TO VOLTAGE
- Disconnect: SJB C2280d.
- Do the stoplamps continue to illuminate?
Yes
If the LH rear lamp continues to illuminate, REPAIR circuit CLS18 (GY/BN) for a short to voltage.
CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the self-test.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8515
If the RH rear lamp continues to illuminate, REPAIR circuit CLS19 (VT/OG) for a short to voltage.
CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the self-test.
No
GO to K10.
------------------------------------------------- K3 CHECK THE STOPLAMP SWITCH
- Disconnect: Stoplamp Switch C278.
- Do the stoplamps continue to illuminate?
Yes
If the vehicle is equipped with a TBC module, GO to K4.
If the vehicle is not equipped with a TBC module, GO to K5.
No
INSTALL a new stoplamp switch. REFER to Stoplamp Switch See: Brake Light Switch/Service and
Repair. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the self-test.
------------------------------------------------- K4 CHECK THE TBC MODULE
- Disconnect: TBC Module C2142.
- Do the stoplamps continue to illuminate?
Yes
GO to K5.
No
INSTALL a new TBC module. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the self-test.
------------------------------------------------- K5 CHECK THE PCM
- Disconnect: PCM C175b.
- Do the stoplamps continue to illuminate?
Yes
GO to K6.
No
GO to K8.
------------------------------------------------- K6 CHECK THE ABS MODULE
- Disconnect: ABS Module C135.
Do the stoplamps continue to illuminate?
Yes
GO to K7.
No
GO to K9.
-------------------------------------------------
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8516
K7 CHECK THE STOPLAMP SWITCH OUTPUT CIRCUIT FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE
- Disconnect: SJB C2280d.
- Does the high mounted stoplamp continue to illuminate?
Yes
REPAIR circuit CLS17 (YE/GY) for a short to voltage. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the self-test.
No
GO to K10.
------------------------------------------------- K8 CHECK FOR CORRECT PCM OPERATION
- Disconnect all the PCM connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the PCM connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new PCM. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the self-test.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the self-test.
------------------------------------------------- K9 CHECK FOR CORRECT ABS MODULE OPERATION
- Disconnect the ABS module connector.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect the ABS module connector and make sure it seats correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new ABS module. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the self-test.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the self-test.
------------------------------------------------- K10 CHECK FOR CORRECT SJB OPERATION
- Disconnect all the SJB connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the SJB connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8517
Yes
INSTALL a new SJB. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the self-test.
-------------------------------------------------
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Aug > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Adjustment
Technical Service Bulletin # 09C09 Date: 090817
Attachment I - Administrative Information
OASIS ACTIVATED?
Yes, OASIS will be activated on June 17, 2009.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Aug > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Adjustment > Page 8526
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED?
Yes, FSA VIN list will be available through by June 17, 2009. Owner names and addresses will be
available by July 13, 2009.
NOTE:
Your FSA VIN list may contain owner names and addresses obtained from motor vehicle
registration records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than in
connection with this recall is a violation of law in several states, provinces, and countries.
Accordingly, you must limit the use of this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this recall
action.
STOCK VEHICLES
Correct all affected units in your new vehicle inventory before delivery.
SOLD VEHICLES
^ Owners of affected vehicles will be directed to dealers for repairs.
^ Immediately contact any of your affected owners whose vehicles are not on your VIN lists but are
identified in OASIS. Give the customer a copy of the Owner Notification Letter (when available) and
schedule a service date.
^ Correct other affected vehicles identified in OASIS which are brought to your dealership.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition, call the
Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted. Ford Motor Company
reserves the right to deny coverage for related damage in cases where the vehicle owner has not
had this recall performed on a timely basis.
ADDITIONAL LABOR TIME
^ If a condition exists that requires additional labor to complete the repair, call the Special Service
Support Center to request approval prior to performing any additional labor. Requests for approval
after completion of the repair will not be granted.
^ If you encounter aftermarket equipment or modifications to the vehicle which might prevent the
repair of the covered condition, call the Special Service Support Center.
OWNER REFUNDS
Refunds are not authorized for this program.
RENTAL VEHICLES
The use of rental vehicles is not authorized for this program.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
^ Related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line on which
the FSA is claimed. Related damage requires prior approval from the Special Service Support
Center.
^ "MT" labor should be submitted on a separate repair line with the related damage flag checked.
"MT" labor requires prior approval from the Special Service Support Center.
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Aug > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Adjustment > Page 8527
LABOR ALLOWANCES
PARTS REQUIREMENTS / ORDERING INFORMATION
Parts are not required to complete this repair.
Attachment III - Technical Information
OVERVIEW
This program involves adjustment of the brake stoplamp switch by removing and reinstalling it.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
It is very important to not press, pull or touch the brake pedal assembly during the installation of the
brake stoplamp switch. Failure to follow these instructions may damage the brake stoplamp switch.
1. Disconnect the brake stoplamp switch electrical connector.
2. NOTE: The stoplamp switch will be difficult to remove if the switch plunger is not depressed. A
slight rearward force should be adequate to depress
the plunger.
With a light force (approximately 1-4 Pounds [4-16 Newtons]), pull rearward on the brake pedal,
rotate the brake stoplamp switch 45 degrees clockwise and remove the brake stoplamp switch.
3. Without movement to the brake pedal assembly, install the brake stoplamp switch and rotate 45
degrees counterclockwise.
4. Connect the brake stoplamp switch electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Aug > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Adjustment > Page 8528
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Aug > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Adjustment > Page 8529
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > NHTSA09V232000 > Jun > 09 > Recall 09V232000: Brake Light Switch Adjustment
Brake Light Switch: Recalls Recall 09V232000: Brake Light Switch Adjustment
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Ford/Expedition 2009 Lincoln/Navigator 2009
MANUFACTURER: Ford Motor Company
MFR'S REPORT DATE: June 23, 2009
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 09V232000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Service Brakes, Hydraulic: Switches: Brake Light
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 1357
SUMMARY: Ford is recalling 1,357 M/Y 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles for failing to
comply with the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No. 108, "Lamps, Reflective Devices, and
Associated Equipment." The brake stop lamp switch may be improperly adjusted. This may result
in a delay in brake stoplamp illumination when the brake pedal is depressed. In situations of very
mild brake application, the brake stoplamps may not illuminate.
CONSEQUENCE: Delay or loss of brake stoplamp function may increase the risk of a crash.
REMEDY: Dealers will adjust the brake stoplamp switch free of charge. The recall is expected to
begin on or before July 6, 2009. Owners may contact Ford Motor Company Customer Relationship
Center at 1-866-436-7332 or www.ownerconnection.com.
NOTES: Ford recall No. 09C09. Owners may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Non-Compliance
Technical Service Bulletin # 09C09 Date: 090617
Attachment I - Administrative Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Non-Compliance > Page 8538
OASIS ACTIVATED?
Yes, OASIS will be activated on June 17,2009.
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED?
Yes, FSA VIN list will be available through the website by June 17, 2009. Owner names and
addresses will be available by July 13, 2009.
NOTE:
Your FSA VIN list may contain owner names and addresses obtained from motor vehicle
registration records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than in
connection with this recall is a violation of law in several states, provinces, and countries.
Accordingly, you must limit the use of this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this recall
action.
STOCK VEHICLES
Correct all affected units in your new vehicle inventory before delivery.
SOLD VEHICLES
^ Owners of affected vehicles will be directed to dealers for repairs.
^ Immediately contact any of your affected owners whose vehicles are not on your VIN lists but are
identified in OASIS. Give the customer a copy of the Owner Notification Letter (when available) and
schedule a service date.
^ Correct other affected vehicles identified in OASIS which are brought to your dealership.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition, call the
Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted. Ford Motor Company
reserves the right to deny coverage for related damage in cases where the vehicle owner has not
had this recall performed on a timely basis.
ADDITIONAL LABOR TIME
^ If a condition exists that requires additional labor to complete the repair, call the Special Service
Support Center to request approval prior to performing any additional labor. Requests for approval
after completion of the repair will not be granted.
^ If you encounter aftermarket equipment or modifications to the vehicle which might prevent the
repair of the covered condition, call the Special Service Support Center.
OWNER REFUNDS
Refunds are not authorized for this program.
RENTAL VEHICLES
The use of rental vehicles is not authorized for this program.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
^ Related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line on which
the FSA is claimed. Related damage requires prior approval from the Special Service Support
Center.
^ "MT" labor should be submitted on a separate repair line with the related damage flag checked.
"MT" labor requires prior approval from the Special Service Support Center.
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Non-Compliance > Page 8539
LABOR ALLOWANCES
PARTS REQUIREMENTS / ORDERING INFORMATION
Parts are not required to complete this repair.
Attachment III - Technical Information
OVERVIEW
This program involves adjustment of the brake stoplamp switch by removing and reinstalling it.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
It is very important to not press, pull or touch the brake pedal assembly during the installation of the
brake stoplamp switch. Failure to follow these instructions may damage the brake stoplamp switch.
1. Disconnect the brake stoplamp switch electrical connector.
2. NOTE: The stoplamp switch will be difficult to remove if the switch plunger is not depressed. A
slight rearward force should be adequate to depress
the plunger.
With a light force (approximately 1-4 Pounds [4-16 Newtons]), pull rearward on the brake pedal,
rotate the brake stoplamp switch 45 degrees clockwise and remove the brake stoplamp switch.
3. Without movement to the brake pedal assembly, install the brake stoplamp switch and rotate 45
degrees counterclockwise.
4. Connect the brake stoplamp switch electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Non-Compliance > Page 8540
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Non-Compliance > Page 8541
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Aug > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Adjustment
Technical Service Bulletin # 09C09 Date: 090817
Attachment I - Administrative Information
OASIS ACTIVATED?
Yes, OASIS will be activated on June 17, 2009.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Aug > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Adjustment >
Page 8547
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED?
Yes, FSA VIN list will be available through by June 17, 2009. Owner names and addresses will be
available by July 13, 2009.
NOTE:
Your FSA VIN list may contain owner names and addresses obtained from motor vehicle
registration records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than in
connection with this recall is a violation of law in several states, provinces, and countries.
Accordingly, you must limit the use of this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this recall
action.
STOCK VEHICLES
Correct all affected units in your new vehicle inventory before delivery.
SOLD VEHICLES
^ Owners of affected vehicles will be directed to dealers for repairs.
^ Immediately contact any of your affected owners whose vehicles are not on your VIN lists but are
identified in OASIS. Give the customer a copy of the Owner Notification Letter (when available) and
schedule a service date.
^ Correct other affected vehicles identified in OASIS which are brought to your dealership.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition, call the
Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted. Ford Motor Company
reserves the right to deny coverage for related damage in cases where the vehicle owner has not
had this recall performed on a timely basis.
ADDITIONAL LABOR TIME
^ If a condition exists that requires additional labor to complete the repair, call the Special Service
Support Center to request approval prior to performing any additional labor. Requests for approval
after completion of the repair will not be granted.
^ If you encounter aftermarket equipment or modifications to the vehicle which might prevent the
repair of the covered condition, call the Special Service Support Center.
OWNER REFUNDS
Refunds are not authorized for this program.
RENTAL VEHICLES
The use of rental vehicles is not authorized for this program.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
^ Related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line on which
the FSA is claimed. Related damage requires prior approval from the Special Service Support
Center.
^ "MT" labor should be submitted on a separate repair line with the related damage flag checked.
"MT" labor requires prior approval from the Special Service Support Center.
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Aug > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Adjustment >
Page 8548
LABOR ALLOWANCES
PARTS REQUIREMENTS / ORDERING INFORMATION
Parts are not required to complete this repair.
Attachment III - Technical Information
OVERVIEW
This program involves adjustment of the brake stoplamp switch by removing and reinstalling it.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
It is very important to not press, pull or touch the brake pedal assembly during the installation of the
brake stoplamp switch. Failure to follow these instructions may damage the brake stoplamp switch.
1. Disconnect the brake stoplamp switch electrical connector.
2. NOTE: The stoplamp switch will be difficult to remove if the switch plunger is not depressed. A
slight rearward force should be adequate to depress
the plunger.
With a light force (approximately 1-4 Pounds [4-16 Newtons]), pull rearward on the brake pedal,
rotate the brake stoplamp switch 45 degrees clockwise and remove the brake stoplamp switch.
3. Without movement to the brake pedal assembly, install the brake stoplamp switch and rotate 45
degrees counterclockwise.
4. Connect the brake stoplamp switch electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Aug > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Adjustment >
Page 8549
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Aug > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Adjustment >
Page 8550
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > NHTSA09V232000 > Jun > 09 > Recall 09V232000: Brake Light
Switch Adjustment
Brake Light Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 09V232000: Brake Light Switch
Adjustment
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Ford/Expedition 2009 Lincoln/Navigator 2009
MANUFACTURER: Ford Motor Company
MFR'S REPORT DATE: June 23, 2009
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 09V232000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Service Brakes, Hydraulic: Switches: Brake Light
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 1357
SUMMARY: Ford is recalling 1,357 M/Y 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles for failing to
comply with the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No. 108, "Lamps, Reflective Devices, and
Associated Equipment." The brake stop lamp switch may be improperly adjusted. This may result
in a delay in brake stoplamp illumination when the brake pedal is depressed. In situations of very
mild brake application, the brake stoplamps may not illuminate.
CONSEQUENCE: Delay or loss of brake stoplamp function may increase the risk of a crash.
REMEDY: Dealers will adjust the brake stoplamp switch free of charge. The recall is expected to
begin on or before July 6, 2009. Owners may contact Ford Motor Company Customer Relationship
Center at 1-866-436-7332 or www.ownerconnection.com.
NOTES: Ford recall No. 09C09. Owners may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Non-Compliance
Technical Service Bulletin # 09C09 Date: 090617
Attachment I - Administrative Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Non-Compliance
> Page 8559
OASIS ACTIVATED?
Yes, OASIS will be activated on June 17,2009.
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED?
Yes, FSA VIN list will be available through the website by June 17, 2009. Owner names and
addresses will be available by July 13, 2009.
NOTE:
Your FSA VIN list may contain owner names and addresses obtained from motor vehicle
registration records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than in
connection with this recall is a violation of law in several states, provinces, and countries.
Accordingly, you must limit the use of this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this recall
action.
STOCK VEHICLES
Correct all affected units in your new vehicle inventory before delivery.
SOLD VEHICLES
^ Owners of affected vehicles will be directed to dealers for repairs.
^ Immediately contact any of your affected owners whose vehicles are not on your VIN lists but are
identified in OASIS. Give the customer a copy of the Owner Notification Letter (when available) and
schedule a service date.
^ Correct other affected vehicles identified in OASIS which are brought to your dealership.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition, call the
Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted. Ford Motor Company
reserves the right to deny coverage for related damage in cases where the vehicle owner has not
had this recall performed on a timely basis.
ADDITIONAL LABOR TIME
^ If a condition exists that requires additional labor to complete the repair, call the Special Service
Support Center to request approval prior to performing any additional labor. Requests for approval
after completion of the repair will not be granted.
^ If you encounter aftermarket equipment or modifications to the vehicle which might prevent the
repair of the covered condition, call the Special Service Support Center.
OWNER REFUNDS
Refunds are not authorized for this program.
RENTAL VEHICLES
The use of rental vehicles is not authorized for this program.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
^ Related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line on which
the FSA is claimed. Related damage requires prior approval from the Special Service Support
Center.
^ "MT" labor should be submitted on a separate repair line with the related damage flag checked.
"MT" labor requires prior approval from the Special Service Support Center.
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Non-Compliance
> Page 8560
LABOR ALLOWANCES
PARTS REQUIREMENTS / ORDERING INFORMATION
Parts are not required to complete this repair.
Attachment III - Technical Information
OVERVIEW
This program involves adjustment of the brake stoplamp switch by removing and reinstalling it.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
It is very important to not press, pull or touch the brake pedal assembly during the installation of the
brake stoplamp switch. Failure to follow these instructions may damage the brake stoplamp switch.
1. Disconnect the brake stoplamp switch electrical connector.
2. NOTE: The stoplamp switch will be difficult to remove if the switch plunger is not depressed. A
slight rearward force should be adequate to depress
the plunger.
With a light force (approximately 1-4 Pounds [4-16 Newtons]), pull rearward on the brake pedal,
rotate the brake stoplamp switch 45 degrees clockwise and remove the brake stoplamp switch.
3. Without movement to the brake pedal assembly, install the brake stoplamp switch and rotate 45
degrees counterclockwise.
4. Connect the brake stoplamp switch electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Non-Compliance
> Page 8561
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Non-Compliance
> Page 8562
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Page 8563
Brake Light Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Page 8564
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Page 8565
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Page 8566
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to as the stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal
to the PCM indicating the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Typical BPP Switch
Typical BPP Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Page 8567
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
Stoplamp Switch
Removal
1. Disconnect the stoplamp switch electrical connector.
2. NOTE: The stoplamp switch will be difficult to remove if the switch plunger is not depressed. A
slight rearward force should be adequate to
depress the plunger.
With a light force (approximately 1-4 N [1-3 lb]), pull rearward on the brake pedal, rotate the
stoplamp switch 45 degrees clockwise and remove the stoplamp switch.
Installation
NOTICE: It is very important to not press, pull or touch the brake pedal assembly during the
installation of the stoplamp switch. Failure to follow these instructions may damage the stoplamp
switch.
1. Without movement to the brake pedal assembly, install the stoplamp switch and rotate 45
degrees counterclockwise.
2. Connect the stoplamp switch electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Cargo Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Cargo Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8571
Cargo Lamp: Service and Repair
Cargo Lamp
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the cargo lamp lens.
2. Release the 2 retaining clips (through the access holes) and remove the cargo lamp.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Ash Tray Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Glove Box Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Daytime Running Lamp: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Principles Of Operation
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL)
Principles of Operation
NOTE: The Smart Junction Box (SJB) is also known as the Generic Electronic Module (GEM).
NOTE: When installing a new SJB, it must be configured for this feature, if originally equipped.
Refer to Information Bus.
The SJB controls the Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) by using various inputs to determine whether
or not the DRL should be illuminated. These inputs include:
- Ignition switch position
- Headlamp switch position
- Headlamps on or off
- Transmission gear selection
When the DRL is active, the SJB provides a pulse-width modulated voltage to the low beam
headlamps. This illuminates the headlamps at a reduced intensity.
The SJB can be configured to turn the DRL on for this vehicle. Refer to Information Bus for
additional information on this programmable parameter.
Special Tools Used With Diagnostics
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL)
Inspection And Verification
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL)
Inspection and Verification
1. Verify the customer concern.
2. If an obvious cause for an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible)
before proceeding to the next step.
NOTE: Make sure the headlamp switch is in the OFF position.
NOTE: Make sure the multifunction switch is not in the HIGH BEAM position.
3. NOTE: Make sure to use the latest scan tool software release.
If the cause is not visually evident, connect the scan tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC).
4. NOTE: The Vehicle Communication Module (VCM) LED prove-out confirms power and ground
from the DLC are provided to the VCM.
If the scan tool does not communicate with the VCM:
- Check the VCM connection to the vehicle.
- Check the scan tool connection to the VCM.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8586
- Refer to Information Bus, No Power To The Scan Tool, to diagnose no power to the scan tool.
5. If the scan tool does not communicate with the vehicle:
- Verify the ignition key is in the ON position.
- Verify the scan tool operation with a known good vehicle.
- Refer to Information Bus to diagnose no response from the PCM.
6. Carry out the network test.
- If the scan tool responds with no communication for one or more modules, refer to Information
Bus.
- If the network test passes, retrieve and record the continuous memory DTCs.
7. If the DTCs retrieved are related to the concern, refer to the Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC)
Chart See: Testing and Inspection. For all other
DTCs, refer to the Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Chart in Body Control Systems. See: Body and
Frame/Body Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Descriptions/Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Chart
8. If no DTCs related to the concern are retrieved, GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8587
Daytime Running Lamp: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL)
Symptom Chart
Symptom Chart
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8588
Daytime Running Lamp: Pinpoint Tests
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL)
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test AF: The Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Are Inoperative
Normal Operation
When the ignition switch is in the RUN position, the headlamps are not on (from the autolamp
system or manual control from the headlamp switch), and the transmission not in PARK (P), the
Smart Junction Box (SJB) illuminates the headlamps at a reduced intensity.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Exterior lighting system input/output
- SJB configuration
- Ignition switch input
- Transmission gear input
- SJB
PINPOINT TEST AF: THE DRL ARE INOPERATIVE
------------------------------------------------- AF1 VERIFY THE DRL OPERATION
- Ignition ON.
- Make sure the headlamp switch is in the OFF position.
- Place the gear selector lever in any gear other than PARK (P).
- Do the DRL illuminate?
Yes
The system is operating correctly. INFORM the customer of the conditions required for the DRL to
operate correctly.
No
GO to AF2.
------------------------------------------------- AF2 CHECK THE OPERATION OF THE HEADLAMPS
- Place the headlamp switch in the HEADLAMPS ON position and observe the headlamps.
Do the headlamps operate correctly?
Yes
GO to AF3.
No
REFER to Headlamps See: Headlamp/Testing and Inspection.
------------------------------------------------- AF3 CHECK THE IGNITION SWITCH INPUT
- Place the headlamp switch in the OFF position.
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: SJB DataLogger.
- Monitor the SJB ignition switch PID (IGN_O_ECU, IGN_A_ECU, IGN_R_ECU, and IGN_S_ECU)
while cycling the ignition switch through all its positions.
- Do the PIDs agree with the ignition switch positions?
Yes
GO to AF4.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8589
No
REFER to Steering Column to diagnose the input from the ignition switch. See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Column/Testing and Inspection
------------------------------------------------- AF4 CHECK THE TRANSMISSION GEAR INPUT
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: TCM DataLogger.
- Monitor the TCM transmission gear status PID (TR) while placing the gear selector lever through
all its positions.
- Does the PID agree with the gear selection?
Yes
GO to AF5.
No
REFER to Transmission Control Systems to diagnose the transmission range input. See:
Powertrain Management/Transmission Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
------------------------------------------------- AF5 CHECK THE SJB FOR DRL CONFIGURATION
- Enter the following diagnostic mode on the scan tool: SJB Configuration.
- Check the SJB configuration and make sure the DRL feature is enabled.
- Is the SJB DRL configuration enabled?
Yes
INSTALL a new SJB. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
ENABLE the DRL configuration. TEST the system for normal operation.
-------------------------------------------------
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Page 8590
Daytime Running Lamp: Adjustments
Autolamps Time Delay Adjustment
NOTE: The time delay can be programmed through the instrument cluster message center using
the message center buttons (if equipped) or using the following steps.
NOTE: Steps 2 through 5 must be carried out within a 10-second period.
1. Start with the ignition switch off and the headlamp switch in the AUTOLAMPS ON position.
2. Place the headlamp switch in the OFF position.
3. Place the ignition switch in the RUN position.
4. Place the ignition switch in the OFF position.
5. Place the headlamp switch in the AUTOLAMPS ON position. The exterior lamps turn on at this
point.
6. Wait the desired amount of time and place the headlamp switch in the OFF position (maximum
of 3 minutes). The exterior lamps turn off and the
autolamp time delay is now set.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair
Instrument Panel Dimmer Switch
NOTE: Navigator shown, Expedition similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the Instrument Cluster (IC) finish panel.
2. Press the tabs and remove the instrument panel dimmer switch.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dome Lamp > Component Information > Service and Repair > Interior
Lamp
Dome Lamp: Service and Repair Interior Lamp
Interior Lamp
Front Interior Lamp (Except Expedition XLS)
NOTE: Overhead console with roof opening panel shown. Other consoles are similar.
Front Interior Lamp (Expedition XLS)
Removal and Installation
Front interior lamp (except Expedition XLS)
1. NOTE: Do not pull down on the front of the overhead console.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dome Lamp > Component Information > Service and Repair > Interior
Lamp > Page 8598
Pull down on the rear of the overhead console to remove the overhead console from the retaining
clips.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
2. Release the 4 retaining clips, and remove the lamp assembly from the overhead console.
3. Release the 6 retaining clips, and remove the lens from the lamp assembly.
NOTE: The bulbs can be pushed out from the backside of the lamp assembly.
Replace the bulb(s) as necessary.
Front interior lamp (Expedition XLS)
4. Remove the interior lamp lens.
5. Release the 2 retaining clips (through the access holes) and remove the interior lamp.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
All interior lamps
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dome Lamp > Component Information > Service and Repair > Interior
Lamp > Page 8599
Dome Lamp: Service and Repair Interior/Map Reading Lamp
Interior/Map Reading Lamp
Removal and Installation
1. Release the tab on the front side of the lens.
2. Tilt the front of the lens down.
3. Remove the lamp.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch,
Driver Side Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch,
Driver Side Rear > Page 8604
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch,
Driver Side Rear > Page 8605
Door Switch: Locations Door Ajar Switch, Left Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch,
Driver Side Rear > Page 8606
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch,
Driver Side Rear > Page 8607
Door Switch: Locations Door Ajar Switch, Right Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch,
Driver Side Rear > Page 8608
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left
Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left
Front > Page 8611
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left
Front > Page 8612
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left
Front > Page 8613
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8614
Door Switch: Service and Repair
Door Ajar Switch
NOTE: LH front door latch shown, others similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door latch. For additional information, refer to Front Door Latch See: Body and
Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front
Door/Front Door Latch/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement or Rear Door Latch See:
Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Rear Door/Rear Door Latch/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement.
2. Release the locking tab and remove the door ajar switch.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Exterior Lighting Module > Component Information > Service and Repair
Exterior Lighting Module: Service and Repair
Ballast
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Make sure that the headlamp switch and the ignition switch are in the OFF position.
1. Remove the headlamp assembly. For additional information, refer to Headlamp Assembly See:
Headlamp/Service and Repair.
2. Remove the 4 bolts and the ballast.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Bulb > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Fog/Driving Lamp Bulb: Service and Repair
Fog Lamp Bulb
NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Removal and Installation
WARNING: The bulb contains gas under pressure. The bulb may shatter if the glass envelope is
scratched or if the bulb is dropped. Handle the bulb only by its base. Avoid touching the glass
envelope. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
NOTE: The fog lamp bulb should not be removed from the fog lamp until just before a new bulb is
installed. Removing the bulb for an extended period of time may affect headlamp bulb
performance. Contaminants may enter the headlamp where they can settle on the lens and
reflector. Never turn on the fog lamp with the bulb removed from the fog lamp.
NOTE: Make sure the headlamp switch and the ignition switch are in the OFF position.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Disconnect the electrical connector and remove the fog lamp bulb.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Hazard Warning Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 8626
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 8627
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 8628
Hazard Warning Switch: Service and Repair
Hazard Flasher Lamp Switch
NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument panel center finish panel.
2. Release the tabs and remove the hazard flasher lamp switch.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Headlamp Bulb: Service and Repair
Headlamp Bulb
Expedition Headlamp
Navigator High Intensity Discharge (HID) Headlamp Bulb
Removal and Installation
WARNING: The bulb contains gas under pressure. The bulb may shatter if the glass envelope is
scratched or if the bulb is dropped. Handle the bulb only by its base. Avoid touching the glass
envelope. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
NOTE: The headlamp bulb should not be removed from the headlamp until just before a new bulb
is installed. Removing the bulb for an extended period of time may affect headlamp bulb
performance. Contaminants may enter the headlamp where they can settle on the lens and
reflector. Never turn on the headlamp with the bulb removed from the headlamp.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 8633
NOTE: Make sure that the headlamp switch and the ignition switch are in the OFF position.
All vehicles
1. Remove the headlamp assembly. For additional information, refer to Headlamp Assembly See:
Service and Repair.
Expedition
2. Rotate the headlamp bulb approximately 1/8 turn counterclockwise and remove the bulb from
the headlamp assembly.
Navigator
3. Remove the High Intensity Discharge (HID) bulb access cover.
4. Remove the 2 screws and the HID bulb.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
All vehicles
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Locations
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 8637
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Multifunction Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Multifunction Switch > Page 8640
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Illumination Dimmer Switch
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Testing and Inspection Illumination Dimmer Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Illumination Dimmer Switch > Page 8643
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Illumination Dimmer Switch > Page 8644
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Illumination Dimmer Switch > Page 8645
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 8646
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
NOTE: Power tilt column shown, manual tilt similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the steering column shroud.
2. Disconnect the 2 multifunction switch electrical connectors.
3. Remove the 2 screws and the multifunction switch.
- To install, tighten to 1 Nm (9 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Relay > Component Information > Locations > High
Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Relay > Component Information > Locations > High
Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 8651
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left
Headlamp Relay: Testing and Inspection High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 8654
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 8655
Headlamp Relay: Testing and Inspection High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Right
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 8656
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations
Headlamp Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 8660
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 8661
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 8662
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 8663
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 8664
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair
Headlamp Switch
Expedition
Navigator
Removal and Installation
Expedition
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 8665
1. Remove the screw and the LH lower instrument panel finish panel.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
Navigator
2. Remove the 3 screws and the steering column finish panel.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
All vehicles
3. NOTE: The headlamp switch is removed by releasing the tabs and pushing from behind.
Remove the headlamp switch.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Locations
Horn Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 8673
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 8674
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
License Plate Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagram in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be
seen completely in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference
is given to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in parentheses next to or under a component.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System, and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8679
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in set 4
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the
indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to
illustrate proper orientation.
Power Distribution
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8680
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
Component and Connector Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8681
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component Location
Charts.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Locations information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the
various items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written
description of the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8682
Symbols (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8683
Symbols (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8684
Symbols (Part 3)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8685
Symbols (Part 4)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8686
Symbols (Part 5)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8687
License Plate Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminal by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8688
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal.
Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8689
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8690
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8691
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seat wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8692
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8693
7. If visible, be sure to place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the
barrel. 9. Holding the wire in place, barrel squeeze tool handles appropriate ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8694
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8695
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8696
License Plate Lamp: Connector Views
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8697
License Plate Lamp: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
92-1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8698
92-2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8699
92-3
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (i.e. 13-2, 24-6, 10-2, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Location Views. See: Locations/Component Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Marker Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagram in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be
seen completely in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference
is given to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in parentheses next to or under a component.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System, and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8704
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in set 4
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the
indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to
illustrate proper orientation.
Power Distribution
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8705
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
Component and Connector Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8706
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component Location
Charts.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Locations information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the
various items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written
description of the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8707
Symbols (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8708
Symbols (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8709
Symbols (Part 3)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8710
Symbols (Part 4)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8711
Symbols (Part 5)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8712
Marker Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminal by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8713
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal.
Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8714
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8715
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8716
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seat wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8717
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8718
7. If visible, be sure to place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the
barrel. 9. Holding the wire in place, barrel squeeze tool handles appropriate ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8719
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8720
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8721
Marker Lamp: Connector Views
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8722
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8723
Marker Lamp: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
92-1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8724
92-2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8725
92-3
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (i.e. 13-2, 24-6, 10-2, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Location Views. See: Locations/Component Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Parking Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagram in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be
seen completely in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference
is given to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in parentheses next to or under a component.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System, and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8730
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in set 4
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the
indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to
illustrate proper orientation.
Power Distribution
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8731
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
Component and Connector Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8732
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component Location
Charts.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Locations information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the
various items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written
description of the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8733
Symbols (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8734
Symbols (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8735
Symbols (Part 3)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8736
Symbols (Part 4)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8737
Symbols (Part 5)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8738
Parking Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminal by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8739
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal.
Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8740
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8741
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8742
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seat wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8743
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8744
7. If visible, be sure to place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the
barrel. 9. Holding the wire in place, barrel squeeze tool handles appropriate ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8745
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8746
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8747
Parking Lamp: Connector Views
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8748
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8749
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8750
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8751
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8752
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8753
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8754
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8755
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8756
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8757
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8758
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8759
Parking Lamp: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
92-1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8760
92-2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8761
92-3
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (i.e. 13-2, 24-6, 10-2, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Location Views. See: Locations/Component Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Parking Lamp: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Principles Of Operation
Parking, Rear and License Plate Lamps
Principles of Operation
NOTE: The Smart Junction Box (SJB) is also known as the Generic Electronic Module (GEM).
The SJB monitors the headlamp switch position by sending voltage reference signals on multiple
circuits to the headlamp switch. At any given time, one of the signal circuits is routed to ground. If
the SJB does not detect any of the inputs to the headlamp switch as active (routed to ground) for 5
seconds, the SJB turns on the exterior lights and keeps them on for 10 minutes after the ignition
switch is turned off (or 10 minutes from the time the SJB does not detect any headlamp switch
input if the ignition switch was already off). If the SJB detects multiple circuits short to ground, the
SJB implements a planned strategy depending on the multiple inputs received. Based on the
multiple inputs received, the autolamps, the headlamps and/or the parking lamps are turned on.
If either of these situations occur, the SJB should not be ruled immediately as being at fault. This is
normal behavior of the SJB when it has detected a fault with the inputs from the headlamp switch.
When the SJB receives an input from the headlamp switch indicating a request for the parking
lamps, the SJB energizes the parking lamp relay, which supplies voltage to the exterior lamps.
Special Tools Used With Diagnostics
Parking, Rear and License Plate Lamps
Inspection And Verification
Parking, Rear and License Plate Lamps
Inspection and Verification
1. Verify the customer concern.
2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of mechanical or electrical damage.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8764
Visual Inspection Chart
3. If an obvious cause for an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible)
before proceeding to the next step.
NOTE: Make sure the headlamp switch is in the OFF position.
NOTE: Make sure the multifunction switch is in the LOW BEAM position.
4. NOTE: Make sure to use the latest scan tool software release.
If the cause is not visually evident, connect the scan tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC).
5. NOTE: The Vehicle Communication Module (VCM) LED prove-out confirms power and ground
from the DLC are provided to the VCM.
If the scan tool does not communicate with the VCM:
- Check the VCM connection to the vehicle.
- Check the scan tool connection to the VCM.
- Refer to Information Bus, No Power To The Scan Tool, to diagnose no power to the scan tool.
6. If the scan tool does not communicate with the vehicle:
- Verify the ignition key is in the ON position.
- Verify the scan tool operation with a known good vehicle.
- Refer to Information Bus to diagnose no response from the PCM.
7. Carry out the network test.
- If the scan tool responds with no communication for one or more modules, refer to Information
Bus.
- If the network test passes, retrieve and record the continuous memory DTCs.
8. Clear the continuous DTCs and carry out the self-test diagnostics for the SJB.
9. If the DTCs retrieved are related to the concern, refer to the Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC)
Chart See: Testing and Inspection. For all other
DTCs, refer to the Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Chart in Body Control Systems. See: Body and
Frame/Body Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Descriptions/Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) Chart
10. If no DTCs related to the concern are retrieved, GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8765
Parking Lamp: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Parking, Rear and License Plate Lamps
Symptom Chart
Symptom Chart
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8766
Parking Lamp: Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test P: One Or More Parking, Rear Or License Plate Lamps Is Inoperative
Parking, Rear and License Plate Lamps
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test P: One Or More Parking, Rear or License Plate Lamps Is Inoperative
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 92, Parking, Rear and License Lamps for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
When the headlamp switch is placed in the PARKING LAMPS ON position, the Smart Junction Box
(SJB) provides a ground for the parking lamp relay coil (integrated into the SJB). When the parking
lamp relay is energized, voltage is routed through circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) to the rear and front
parking lamps. Ground is provided to the rear parking, liftgate and license plate lamps through
circuits GD149 (BK/GY) and GD150 (BK/WH). Ground is provided to the front parking and side
marker lamps through circuits GD120 (BK/GN) and GD123 (BK/GY).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Bulb holder
- SJB
PINPOINT TEST P: ONE OR MORE PARKING, REAR OR LICENSE PLATE LAMPS IS
INOPERATIVE
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
------------------------------------------------- P1 DETERMINE IF ALL THE PARKING LAMPS ARE
INOPERATIVE
- Ignition OFF.
- Place the headlamp switch in the PARKING LAMPS ON position.
- Are all the parking lamps inoperative?
Yes
PLACE the headlamp switch in the OFF position. VERIFY the SJB fuse 22 (15A) is OK. If OK, GO
to P6. If not OK, REFER to the Wiring Diagrams to identify the possible causes of the circuit short.
No
If all the front parking lamps are inoperative, GO to P2.
If all the rear parking and license plate lamps are inoperative, GO to P3.
For all other inoperative lamps, GO to P4.
------------------------------------------------- P2 CHECK THE SJB FRONT PARKING LAMPS OUTPUT
CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN
- Disconnect: SJB C2280e.
- Connect a fused jumper wire between the SJB C2280e-1, circuit CBB56 (BU/GN), harness side
and the SJB C2280e-6, circuit CLS30 (VT/WH), harness side.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8767
- Ignition ON.
- Do the front parking lamps illuminate?
Yes
REMOVE the jumper wire. GO to P6.
No
REMOVE the jumper wire. REPAIR circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) for an open. TEST the system for
normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- P3 CHECK THE SJB REAR PARKING LAMPS OUTPUT
CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN
- Disconnect: SJB C2280d.
- Connect a fused jumper wire between the positive battery terminal and the SJB C2280d-20,
circuit CLS30 (VT/WH), harness side.
- Do the rear parking lamps illuminate?
Yes
REMOVE the jumper wire. GO to P6.
No
REMOVE the jumper wire. REPAIR circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) for an open. TEST the system for
normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- P4 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE INOPERATIVE
PARKING LAMP(S)
- Place the headlamp switch in the OFF position.
- Disconnect: Inoperative Lamp.
- Place the headlamp switch in the PARKING LAMPS ON position.
- Measure the voltage between the inoperative lamp, harness side and ground as follows:
Expedition
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8768
Navigator
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
For the license plate lamp(s), REPAIR circuit 57 (BK) or circuit GD150 (BK/WH) for an open. TEST
the system for normal operation.
For all other lamps, GO to P5.
No
REPAIR circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- P5 CHECK THE PARKING LAMP GROUND CIRCUIT FOR
AN OPEN
- Measure the voltage between the inoperative lamp, harness side and ground as follows:
Expedition
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8769
Navigator
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
INSTALL a new bulb holder. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
REPAIR the ground circuit in question for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- P6 CHECK FOR CORRECT SJB OPERATION
- Disconnect all the SJB connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the SJB connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new SJB. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test Q: The Parking, Rear Or License Plate Lamps Are On Continuously
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8770
Parking, Rear and License Plate Lamps
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test Q: The Parking, Rear Or License Plate Lamps Are On Continuously
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 92, Parking, Rear and License Lamps for schematic and connector
information. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The Smart Junction Box (SJB) monitors the parking lamp request input from the headlamp switch
through circuit CLS05 (BU/GY). The SJB provides a ground for the parking lamp relay coil
(integrated into the SJB) when a request for the parking lamps is received. When the parking lamp
relay is energized, voltage is routed through circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) to the rear and front parking
lamps.
- DTC B1578 (Lamp Park Input Circuit Short to Ground) - an on-demand DTC that may set when
the SJB detects a short to ground in the parking lamps on input circuit.
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Headlamp switch
- SJB
PINPOINT TEST Q: THE PARKING, REAR OR LICENSE PLATE LAMPS ARE ON
CONTINUOUSLY
------------------------------------------------- Q1 USE THE RECORDED DTCs FROM THE SJB
SELF-TEST
- Check the recorded results from the SJB self-test.
- Was DTC B1578 recorded?
Yes
GO to Q2.
No
GO to Q4.
------------------------------------------------- Q2 CHECK THE HEADLAMP SWITCH
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Headlamp Switch C205.
- Carry out the headlamp switch component test.
- Is the headlamp switch OK?
Yes
GO to Q3.
No
INSTALL a new headlamp switch. REFER to Headlamp Switch See: Headlamp/Headlamp
Switch/Service and Repair. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the self-test.
------------------------------------------------- Q3 CHECK CIRCUIT CLS05 (BU/GY) FOR A SHORT TO
GROUND
- Disconnect: SJB C2280b.
- Measure the resistance between the headlamp switch C205-5, circuit CLS05 (BU/GY), harness
side and ground.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8771
- Is the resistance greater than 10,000 ohms?
Yes
GO to Q7.
No
REPAIR the circuit. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the self-test.
------------------------------------------------- Q4 CHECK THE SJB REAR PARKING LAMPS OUTPUT
CIRCUIT FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: SJB C2280d.
- Ignition ON.
- Do the rear parking lamps continue to illuminate?
Yes
If not equipped with remote start, REPAIR circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) for a short to voltage. TEST the
system for normal operation.
If equipped with remote start, GO to Q5.
No
GO to Q6.
------------------------------------------------- Q5 ISOLATE THE REMOTE START SYSTEM
- Disconnect: Remote Start C2390.
- Do the rear lamps continue to illuminate?
Yes
REPAIR circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) for a short to voltage. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
INSTALL a new remote start. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- Q6 CHECK THE SJB FRONT PARKING LAMPS OUTPUT
CIRCUIT FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: SJB C2280e.
- Ignition ON.
- Do the front parking lamps continue to illuminate?
Yes
REPAIR circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) for a short to voltage. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
GO to Q6.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8772
------------------------------------------------- Q7 CHECK FOR CORRECT SJB OPERATION
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect all the SJB connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the SJB connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new SJB. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector. CLEAR the DTCs. REPEAT the self-test.
-------------------------------------------------
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page
8773
Parking Lamp: Service and Repair
Parking Lamp - Liftgate
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel.
- Remove the water shield.
2. Remove the 4 nuts and the liftgate parking lamp.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Exterior Lighting Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Exterior Lighting Module: Service and Repair
Ballast
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Make sure that the headlamp switch and the ignition switch are in the OFF position.
1. Remove the headlamp assembly. For additional information, refer to Headlamp Assembly See:
Headlamp/Service and Repair.
2. Remove the 4 bolts and the ballast.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay > Component
Information > Locations > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay > Component
Information > Locations > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 8785
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left
Headlamp Relay: Testing and Inspection High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 8788
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 8789
Headlamp Relay: Testing and Inspection High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Right
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 8790
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Right Turn
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Right Turn > Page 8798
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Right Turn > Page 8799
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Right Turn > Page 8800
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp > Page 8803
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp > Page 8804
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp > Page 8805
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Ambient Light Sensor: Service and Repair
Light Sensor
NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Using a suitable tool (such as a pocket screwdriver), remove the light sensor from the instrument
panel.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
2. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Aug > 09 > Recall Brake Light Switch Adjustment
Technical Service Bulletin # 09C09 Date: 090817
Attachment I - Administrative Information
OASIS ACTIVATED?
Yes, OASIS will be activated on June 17, 2009.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Aug > 09 > Recall Brake Light Switch Adjustment > Page 8818
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED?
Yes, FSA VIN list will be available through by June 17, 2009. Owner names and addresses will be
available by July 13, 2009.
NOTE:
Your FSA VIN list may contain owner names and addresses obtained from motor vehicle
registration records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than in
connection with this recall is a violation of law in several states, provinces, and countries.
Accordingly, you must limit the use of this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this recall
action.
STOCK VEHICLES
Correct all affected units in your new vehicle inventory before delivery.
SOLD VEHICLES
^ Owners of affected vehicles will be directed to dealers for repairs.
^ Immediately contact any of your affected owners whose vehicles are not on your VIN lists but are
identified in OASIS. Give the customer a copy of the Owner Notification Letter (when available) and
schedule a service date.
^ Correct other affected vehicles identified in OASIS which are brought to your dealership.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition, call the
Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted. Ford Motor Company
reserves the right to deny coverage for related damage in cases where the vehicle owner has not
had this recall performed on a timely basis.
ADDITIONAL LABOR TIME
^ If a condition exists that requires additional labor to complete the repair, call the Special Service
Support Center to request approval prior to performing any additional labor. Requests for approval
after completion of the repair will not be granted.
^ If you encounter aftermarket equipment or modifications to the vehicle which might prevent the
repair of the covered condition, call the Special Service Support Center.
OWNER REFUNDS
Refunds are not authorized for this program.
RENTAL VEHICLES
The use of rental vehicles is not authorized for this program.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
^ Related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line on which
the FSA is claimed. Related damage requires prior approval from the Special Service Support
Center.
^ "MT" labor should be submitted on a separate repair line with the related damage flag checked.
"MT" labor requires prior approval from the Special Service Support Center.
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Aug > 09 > Recall Brake Light Switch Adjustment > Page 8819
LABOR ALLOWANCES
PARTS REQUIREMENTS / ORDERING INFORMATION
Parts are not required to complete this repair.
Attachment III - Technical Information
OVERVIEW
This program involves adjustment of the brake stoplamp switch by removing and reinstalling it.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
It is very important to not press, pull or touch the brake pedal assembly during the installation of the
brake stoplamp switch. Failure to follow these instructions may damage the brake stoplamp switch.
1. Disconnect the brake stoplamp switch electrical connector.
2. NOTE: The stoplamp switch will be difficult to remove if the switch plunger is not depressed. A
slight rearward force should be adequate to depress
the plunger.
With a light force (approximately 1-4 Pounds [4-16 Newtons]), pull rearward on the brake pedal,
rotate the brake stoplamp switch 45 degrees clockwise and remove the brake stoplamp switch.
3. Without movement to the brake pedal assembly, install the brake stoplamp switch and rotate 45
degrees counterclockwise.
4. Connect the brake stoplamp switch electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Aug > 09 > Recall Brake Light Switch Adjustment > Page 8820
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Aug > 09 > Recall Brake Light Switch Adjustment > Page 8821
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > NHTSA09V232000 > Jun > 09 >
Recall 09V232000: Brake Light Switch Adjustment
Brake Light Switch: Recalls Recall 09V232000: Brake Light Switch Adjustment
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Ford/Expedition 2009 Lincoln/Navigator 2009
MANUFACTURER: Ford Motor Company
MFR'S REPORT DATE: June 23, 2009
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 09V232000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Service Brakes, Hydraulic: Switches: Brake Light
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 1357
SUMMARY: Ford is recalling 1,357 M/Y 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles for failing to
comply with the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No. 108, "Lamps, Reflective Devices, and
Associated Equipment." The brake stop lamp switch may be improperly adjusted. This may result
in a delay in brake stoplamp illumination when the brake pedal is depressed. In situations of very
mild brake application, the brake stoplamps may not illuminate.
CONSEQUENCE: Delay or loss of brake stoplamp function may increase the risk of a crash.
REMEDY: Dealers will adjust the brake stoplamp switch free of charge. The recall is expected to
begin on or before July 6, 2009. Owners may contact Ford Motor Company Customer Relationship
Center at 1-866-436-7332 or www.ownerconnection.com.
NOTES: Ford recall No. 09C09. Owners may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake
Light Switch Non-Compliance
Technical Service Bulletin # 09C09 Date: 090617
Attachment I - Administrative Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake
Light Switch Non-Compliance > Page 8830
OASIS ACTIVATED?
Yes, OASIS will be activated on June 17,2009.
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED?
Yes, FSA VIN list will be available through the website by June 17, 2009. Owner names and
addresses will be available by July 13, 2009.
NOTE:
Your FSA VIN list may contain owner names and addresses obtained from motor vehicle
registration records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than in
connection with this recall is a violation of law in several states, provinces, and countries.
Accordingly, you must limit the use of this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this recall
action.
STOCK VEHICLES
Correct all affected units in your new vehicle inventory before delivery.
SOLD VEHICLES
^ Owners of affected vehicles will be directed to dealers for repairs.
^ Immediately contact any of your affected owners whose vehicles are not on your VIN lists but are
identified in OASIS. Give the customer a copy of the Owner Notification Letter (when available) and
schedule a service date.
^ Correct other affected vehicles identified in OASIS which are brought to your dealership.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition, call the
Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted. Ford Motor Company
reserves the right to deny coverage for related damage in cases where the vehicle owner has not
had this recall performed on a timely basis.
ADDITIONAL LABOR TIME
^ If a condition exists that requires additional labor to complete the repair, call the Special Service
Support Center to request approval prior to performing any additional labor. Requests for approval
after completion of the repair will not be granted.
^ If you encounter aftermarket equipment or modifications to the vehicle which might prevent the
repair of the covered condition, call the Special Service Support Center.
OWNER REFUNDS
Refunds are not authorized for this program.
RENTAL VEHICLES
The use of rental vehicles is not authorized for this program.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
^ Related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line on which
the FSA is claimed. Related damage requires prior approval from the Special Service Support
Center.
^ "MT" labor should be submitted on a separate repair line with the related damage flag checked.
"MT" labor requires prior approval from the Special Service Support Center.
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake
Light Switch Non-Compliance > Page 8831
LABOR ALLOWANCES
PARTS REQUIREMENTS / ORDERING INFORMATION
Parts are not required to complete this repair.
Attachment III - Technical Information
OVERVIEW
This program involves adjustment of the brake stoplamp switch by removing and reinstalling it.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
It is very important to not press, pull or touch the brake pedal assembly during the installation of the
brake stoplamp switch. Failure to follow these instructions may damage the brake stoplamp switch.
1. Disconnect the brake stoplamp switch electrical connector.
2. NOTE: The stoplamp switch will be difficult to remove if the switch plunger is not depressed. A
slight rearward force should be adequate to depress
the plunger.
With a light force (approximately 1-4 Pounds [4-16 Newtons]), pull rearward on the brake pedal,
rotate the brake stoplamp switch 45 degrees clockwise and remove the brake stoplamp switch.
3. Without movement to the brake pedal assembly, install the brake stoplamp switch and rotate 45
degrees counterclockwise.
4. Connect the brake stoplamp switch electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake
Light Switch Non-Compliance > Page 8832
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 > Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake
Light Switch Non-Compliance > Page 8833
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 >
Aug > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Adjustment
Technical Service Bulletin # 09C09 Date: 090817
Attachment I - Administrative Information
OASIS ACTIVATED?
Yes, OASIS will be activated on June 17, 2009.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 >
Aug > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Adjustment > Page 8839
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED?
Yes, FSA VIN list will be available through by June 17, 2009. Owner names and addresses will be
available by July 13, 2009.
NOTE:
Your FSA VIN list may contain owner names and addresses obtained from motor vehicle
registration records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than in
connection with this recall is a violation of law in several states, provinces, and countries.
Accordingly, you must limit the use of this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this recall
action.
STOCK VEHICLES
Correct all affected units in your new vehicle inventory before delivery.
SOLD VEHICLES
^ Owners of affected vehicles will be directed to dealers for repairs.
^ Immediately contact any of your affected owners whose vehicles are not on your VIN lists but are
identified in OASIS. Give the customer a copy of the Owner Notification Letter (when available) and
schedule a service date.
^ Correct other affected vehicles identified in OASIS which are brought to your dealership.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition, call the
Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted. Ford Motor Company
reserves the right to deny coverage for related damage in cases where the vehicle owner has not
had this recall performed on a timely basis.
ADDITIONAL LABOR TIME
^ If a condition exists that requires additional labor to complete the repair, call the Special Service
Support Center to request approval prior to performing any additional labor. Requests for approval
after completion of the repair will not be granted.
^ If you encounter aftermarket equipment or modifications to the vehicle which might prevent the
repair of the covered condition, call the Special Service Support Center.
OWNER REFUNDS
Refunds are not authorized for this program.
RENTAL VEHICLES
The use of rental vehicles is not authorized for this program.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
^ Related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line on which
the FSA is claimed. Related damage requires prior approval from the Special Service Support
Center.
^ "MT" labor should be submitted on a separate repair line with the related damage flag checked.
"MT" labor requires prior approval from the Special Service Support Center.
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 >
Aug > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Adjustment > Page 8840
LABOR ALLOWANCES
PARTS REQUIREMENTS / ORDERING INFORMATION
Parts are not required to complete this repair.
Attachment III - Technical Information
OVERVIEW
This program involves adjustment of the brake stoplamp switch by removing and reinstalling it.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
It is very important to not press, pull or touch the brake pedal assembly during the installation of the
brake stoplamp switch. Failure to follow these instructions may damage the brake stoplamp switch.
1. Disconnect the brake stoplamp switch electrical connector.
2. NOTE: The stoplamp switch will be difficult to remove if the switch plunger is not depressed. A
slight rearward force should be adequate to depress
the plunger.
With a light force (approximately 1-4 Pounds [4-16 Newtons]), pull rearward on the brake pedal,
rotate the brake stoplamp switch 45 degrees clockwise and remove the brake stoplamp switch.
3. Without movement to the brake pedal assembly, install the brake stoplamp switch and rotate 45
degrees counterclockwise.
4. Connect the brake stoplamp switch electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 >
Aug > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Adjustment > Page 8841
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 >
Aug > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Adjustment > Page 8842
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: >
NHTSA09V232000 > Jun > 09 > Recall 09V232000: Brake Light Switch Adjustment
Brake Light Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 09V232000: Brake Light Switch
Adjustment
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Ford/Expedition 2009 Lincoln/Navigator 2009
MANUFACTURER: Ford Motor Company
MFR'S REPORT DATE: June 23, 2009
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 09V232000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Service Brakes, Hydraulic: Switches: Brake Light
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 1357
SUMMARY: Ford is recalling 1,357 M/Y 2009 Expedition and Navigator vehicles for failing to
comply with the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No. 108, "Lamps, Reflective Devices, and
Associated Equipment." The brake stop lamp switch may be improperly adjusted. This may result
in a delay in brake stoplamp illumination when the brake pedal is depressed. In situations of very
mild brake application, the brake stoplamps may not illuminate.
CONSEQUENCE: Delay or loss of brake stoplamp function may increase the risk of a crash.
REMEDY: Dealers will adjust the brake stoplamp switch free of charge. The recall is expected to
begin on or before July 6, 2009. Owners may contact Ford Motor Company Customer Relationship
Center at 1-866-436-7332 or www.ownerconnection.com.
NOTES: Ford recall No. 09C09. Owners may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 >
Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Non-Compliance
Technical Service Bulletin # 09C09 Date: 090617
Attachment I - Administrative Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 >
Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Non-Compliance > Page 8851
OASIS ACTIVATED?
Yes, OASIS will be activated on June 17,2009.
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED?
Yes, FSA VIN list will be available through the website by June 17, 2009. Owner names and
addresses will be available by July 13, 2009.
NOTE:
Your FSA VIN list may contain owner names and addresses obtained from motor vehicle
registration records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than in
connection with this recall is a violation of law in several states, provinces, and countries.
Accordingly, you must limit the use of this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this recall
action.
STOCK VEHICLES
Correct all affected units in your new vehicle inventory before delivery.
SOLD VEHICLES
^ Owners of affected vehicles will be directed to dealers for repairs.
^ Immediately contact any of your affected owners whose vehicles are not on your VIN lists but are
identified in OASIS. Give the customer a copy of the Owner Notification Letter (when available) and
schedule a service date.
^ Correct other affected vehicles identified in OASIS which are brought to your dealership.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition, call the
Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted. Ford Motor Company
reserves the right to deny coverage for related damage in cases where the vehicle owner has not
had this recall performed on a timely basis.
ADDITIONAL LABOR TIME
^ If a condition exists that requires additional labor to complete the repair, call the Special Service
Support Center to request approval prior to performing any additional labor. Requests for approval
after completion of the repair will not be granted.
^ If you encounter aftermarket equipment or modifications to the vehicle which might prevent the
repair of the covered condition, call the Special Service Support Center.
OWNER REFUNDS
Refunds are not authorized for this program.
RENTAL VEHICLES
The use of rental vehicles is not authorized for this program.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
^ Related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line on which
the FSA is claimed. Related damage requires prior approval from the Special Service Support
Center.
^ "MT" labor should be submitted on a separate repair line with the related damage flag checked.
"MT" labor requires prior approval from the Special Service Support Center.
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 >
Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Non-Compliance > Page 8852
LABOR ALLOWANCES
PARTS REQUIREMENTS / ORDERING INFORMATION
Parts are not required to complete this repair.
Attachment III - Technical Information
OVERVIEW
This program involves adjustment of the brake stoplamp switch by removing and reinstalling it.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
It is very important to not press, pull or touch the brake pedal assembly during the installation of the
brake stoplamp switch. Failure to follow these instructions may damage the brake stoplamp switch.
1. Disconnect the brake stoplamp switch electrical connector.
2. NOTE: The stoplamp switch will be difficult to remove if the switch plunger is not depressed. A
slight rearward force should be adequate to depress
the plunger.
With a light force (approximately 1-4 Pounds [4-16 Newtons]), pull rearward on the brake pedal,
rotate the brake stoplamp switch 45 degrees clockwise and remove the brake stoplamp switch.
3. Without movement to the brake pedal assembly, install the brake stoplamp switch and rotate 45
degrees counterclockwise.
4. Connect the brake stoplamp switch electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 >
Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Non-Compliance > Page 8853
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Light Switch: > 09C09 >
Jun > 09 > Recall - Brake Light Switch Non-Compliance > Page 8854
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8855
Brake Light Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8856
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8857
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8858
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation
Engine Control Components
Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to as the stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal
to the PCM indicating the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Typical BPP Switch
Typical BPP Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8859
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
Stoplamp Switch
Removal
1. Disconnect the stoplamp switch electrical connector.
2. NOTE: The stoplamp switch will be difficult to remove if the switch plunger is not depressed. A
slight rearward force should be adequate to
depress the plunger.
With a light force (approximately 1-4 N [1-3 lb]), pull rearward on the brake pedal, rotate the
stoplamp switch 45 degrees clockwise and remove the stoplamp switch.
Installation
NOTICE: It is very important to not press, pull or touch the brake pedal assembly during the
installation of the stoplamp switch. Failure to follow these instructions may damage the stoplamp
switch.
1. Without movement to the brake pedal assembly, install the stoplamp switch and rotate 45
degrees counterclockwise.
2. Connect the stoplamp switch electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 8864
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 8865
Door Switch: Locations Door Ajar Switch, Left Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 8866
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 8867
Door Switch: Locations Door Ajar Switch, Right Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 8868
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 8871
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 8872
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 8873
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 8874
Door Switch: Service and Repair
Door Ajar Switch
NOTE: LH front door latch shown, others similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door latch. For additional information, refer to Front Door Latch See: Body and
Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Front
Door/Front Door Latch/Service and Repair/Removal and Replacement or Rear Door Latch See:
Body and Frame/Doors, Hood and Trunk/Doors/Rear Door/Rear Door Latch/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement.
2. Release the locking tab and remove the door ajar switch.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Hazard Warning Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8878
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8879
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8880
Hazard Warning Switch: Service and Repair
Hazard Flasher Lamp Switch
NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument panel center finish panel.
2. Release the tabs and remove the hazard flasher lamp switch.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8884
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Multifunction Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Multifunction Switch > Page 8887
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Illumination Dimmer Switch
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Testing and Inspection Illumination Dimmer Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Illumination Dimmer Switch > Page 8890
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Illumination Dimmer Switch > Page 8891
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Illumination Dimmer Switch > Page 8892
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 8893
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
NOTE: Power tilt column shown, manual tilt similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the steering column shroud.
2. Disconnect the 2 multifunction switch electrical connectors.
3. Remove the 2 screws and the multifunction switch.
- To install, tighten to 1 Nm (9 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Headlamp Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8897
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8898
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8899
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8900
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8901
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair
Headlamp Switch
Expedition
Navigator
Removal and Installation
Expedition
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8902
1. Remove the screw and the LH lower instrument panel finish panel.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
Navigator
2. Remove the 3 screws and the steering column finish panel.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
All vehicles
3. NOTE: The headlamp switch is removed by releasing the tabs and pushing from behind.
Remove the headlamp switch.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Horn Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 8906
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 8907
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Turn Signal Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8911
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8912
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8913
Turn Signal Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8914
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8915
Turn Signal Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
NOTE: Power tilt column shown, manual tilt similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the steering column shroud.
2. Disconnect the 2 multifunction switch electrical connectors.
3. Remove the 2 screws and the multifunction switch.
- To install, tighten to 1 Nm (9 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Tail Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagram in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be
seen completely in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference
is given to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in parentheses next to or under a component.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System, and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8920
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in set 4
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the
indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to
illustrate proper orientation.
Power Distribution
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8921
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
Component and Connector Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8922
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component Location
Charts.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Locations information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the
various items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written
description of the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8923
Symbols (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8924
Symbols (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8925
Symbols (Part 3)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8926
Symbols (Part 4)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8927
Symbols (Part 5)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8928
Tail Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminal by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8929
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal.
Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8930
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8931
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8932
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seat wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8933
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8934
7. If visible, be sure to place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the
barrel. 9. Holding the wire in place, barrel squeeze tool handles appropriate ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8935
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8936
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8937
Tail Lamp: Connector Views
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8938
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8939
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8940
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8941
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8942
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8943
Tail Lamp: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
92-1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8944
92-2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8945
92-3
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (i.e. 13-2, 24-6, 10-2, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Location Views. See: Locations/Component Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Trailer Lamps: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in the Power and Ground Distribution
Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagram in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be
seen completely in the Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference
is given to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in parentheses next to or under a component.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System, and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8950
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in set 4
"Symbols".
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse/Locations and Relay/Locations contains a view of the fuse/relay box, in which all fuses and
relays are identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the
indication of the fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to
illustrate proper orientation.
Power Distribution
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8951
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagram that shows the complete details for
each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
Component and Connector Information
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8952
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in Component Location
Charts.
Component Location Views show the components and their connecting wires as they can be found
on the vehicle.
Locations information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the
various items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written
description of the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery set. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8953
Symbols (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8954
Symbols (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8955
Symbols (Part 3)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8956
Symbols (Part 4)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8957
Symbols (Part 5)
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8958
Trailer Lamps: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminal by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8959
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal.
Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8960
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
4 = Harness tape
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8961
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8962
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seat wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8963
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8964
7. If visible, be sure to place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the
barrel. 9. Holding the wire in place, barrel squeeze tool handles appropriate ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8965
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8966
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8967
Trailer Lamps: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
95-1
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8968
95-2
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 8969
95-3
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (i.e. 13-2, 24-6, 10-2, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Location Views. See: Locations/Component Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Trailer Lamps: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Special Tools Used With Diagnostics
Trailer Lamps
Principles Of Operation
Trailer Lamps
Principles of Operation
NOTE: The Smart Junction Box (SJB) is also known as the Generic Electronic Module (GEM).
The trailer lamps and battery charge are supplied power by relays that are energized to correspond
with the exterior lighting functions of the vehicle. If equipped, the vehicle also supplies circuitry to
support the installation of an aftermarket Trailer Brake Control (TBC) module (installed by the
customer). The vehicle circuitry only supplies voltage, ground, stoplamp switch input and a
controlling circuit to the trailer tow connector. The trailer electric brakes themselves are controlled
by the aftermarket TBC module and not the vehicle itself.
Inspection And Verification
Trailer Lamps
Inspection and Verification
1. Verify the customer concern.
2. Verify the exterior lighting system of the vehicle is operating correctly. If not, refer to the
appropriate pinpoint test.
3. Visually inspect for obvious signs of electrical damage.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8972
Visual Inspection Chart
4. If the concern is not visually evident, verify the symptom. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8973
Trailer Lamps: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Trailer Lamps
Symptom Chart
Symptom Chart
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8974
Trailer Lamps: Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test Y: All The Trailer Lamps Are Inoperative
Trailer Lamps
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test Y: All The Trailer Lamps Are Inoperative
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 95, Trailer/Camper Adapter for schematic and connector information.
See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The trailer tow connectors receive ground through circuit RAT08 (WH) for all of the trailer lamps.
The trailer tow parking and stop/turn relays share the same ground through circuit GD123 (BK/GY).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Trailer
PINPOINT TEST Y: ALL THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Before beginning diagnostics, visually inspect the trailer tow connector for signs of
corrosion or damage. Repair or install a new trailer tow connector as required.
NOTE: Failure to disconnect the battery when instructed will result in false resistance readings.
Refer to Battery.
------------------------------------------------- Y1 CHECK THE RELAY GROUND CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Trailer Tow Parking Lamp Relay.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow parking lamp relay pin 3, circuit SBB28 (BU/RD), BJB
face side and the trailer tow parking lamp relay pin 2, circuit GD123 (BK/GY), BJB face side.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to Y2.
No
REPAIR circuit GD123 (BK/GY) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation
------------------------------------------------- Y2 CHECK THE TRAILER TOW CONNECTOR GROUND
CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN THROUGH THE CONNECTOR
- Disconnect: Negative Battery Cable.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8975
- For the 4-pin connector, measure the resistance between the trailer tow C4098-4, circuit RAT08
(WH), harness side and ground.
- For the 7-pin connector, measure the resistance between the trailer tow connector pin 2, circuit
RAT08 (WH), component side and ground.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
The vehicle is operating correctly. SEND the trailer to an authorized camper/trailer repair facility.
No
For the 4-pin connector, REPAIR circuit RAT08 (WH) for an open. TEST the system for normal
operation.
For the 7-pin connector.GO to Y3.
------------------------------------------------- Y3 CHECK THE TRAILER TOW GROUND CIRCUIT FOR
AN OPEN
- Disconnect: Trailer Tow C4099.
- Measure the resistance between the trailer tow C4099-2, circuit RAT08 (WH), harness side and
ground.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
INSTALL a new trailer tow connector. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
REPAIR the circuit. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test Z: The Individual Trailer Lamp Is Inoperative - Trailer Turn/Stoplamp
Trailer Lamps
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test Z: The Individual Trailer Lamp Is Inoperative - Trailer Turn/Stoplamp
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 95, Trailer/Camper Adapter for schematic and connector information.
See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8976
The Battery Junction Box (BJB) fuse 45 (25A) supplies voltage to both trailer tow turn relays
through circuit SBB45 (GY/RD). The trailer tow turn/stop relay coils are provided ground through
circuit GD123 (BK/GY).
The trailer tow LH turn relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS18 (GY/BN) when the vehicle
LH rear stoplamp is illuminated. When the trailer tow LH turn relay is energized, the voltage is
routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT06 (YE).
The trailer tow RH turn relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS19 (VT/OG) when the vehicle
RH rear stoplamp is illuminated. When the trailer tow RH turn relay is energized, the voltage is
routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT09 (GN).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Trailer tow turn relay
- Trailer
PINPOINT TEST Z: THE INDIVIDUAL TRAILER LAMP IS INOPERATIVE - TRAILER
TURN/STOPLAMP
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Before beginning diagnostics, visually inspect the trailer tow connector for signs of
corrosion or damage. Repair or install a new trailer tow connector as required.
------------------------------------------------- Z1 VERIFY THE TRAILER LAMP OPERATION
- Ignition OFF.
- Determine if both trailer stop/turn lamps are inoperative.
- Are both trailer stop/turn lamps inoperative?
Yes
VERIFY the BJB fuse 45 (25A) is OK. If OK, REPAIR circuit SBB45 (GY/RD) for an open. TEST
the system for normal operation. If not OK, REFER to the Wiring Diagrams to identify the possible
causes of the circuit short.
No
For an inoperative LH trailer lamp, GO to Z2.
For an inoperative RH trailer lamp, GO to Z8.
------------------------------------------------- Z2 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE THROUGH THE TRAILER TOW
CONNECTOR (LH TRAILER STOP/TURN LAMP)
- For the 4-pin connector, while applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the trailer
tow C4098-2, circuit CAT06 (YE), harness side and ground.
- For the 7-pin connector, while applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the trailer
tow connector pin 1, circuit CAT06 (YE), component side and ground.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8977
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
The vehicle is operating correctly. SEND the trailer to an authorized camper/trailer repair facility.
No
For the 4-pin connector, GO to Z4.
For the 7-pin connector, GO to Z3.
------------------------------------------------- Z3 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE TRAILER TOW
CONNECTOR (LH STOP/TURN 7-PIN)
- Disconnect: Trailer Tow C4099.
- While applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the trailer tow C4099-1, circuit
CAT06 (YE), harness side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
INSTALL a new trailer tow connector. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
GO to Z4.
------------------------------------------------- Z4 CHECK THE TRAILER TOW LH STOP/TURN RELAY
- Disconnect: Trailer Tow LH Stop/Turn Relay.
- Substitute a known good relay.
- For the 4-pin connector, while applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the trailer
tow C4098-2, circuit CAT06 (YE), harness side and ground.
- For the 7-pin connector, while applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the trailer
tow C4099-1, circuit CAT06 (YE), harness side and ground.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8978
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
REMOVE the known good relay. INSTALL a new trailer tow turn relay. TEST the system for normal
operation.
No
REMOVE the known good relay. GO to Z5.
------------------------------------------------- Z5 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE LH STOP/TURN LAMP
RELAY COIL
- While applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the trailer tow LH turn relay pin 1,
circuit CLS18 (GY/BN), BJB face side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to Z6.
No
REPAIR circuit CLS18 (GY/BN) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- Z6 CHECK THE VOLTAGE SUPPLY CIRCUIT TO THE LH
STOP/TURN LAMP RELAY
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow LH turn relay pin 3, circuit SBB45 (GY/RD), BJB face
side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to Z7.
No
REPAIR circuit SBB45 (GY/RD) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- Z7 CHECK THE VOLTAGE SUPPLY CIRCUIT TO THE LH
STOP/TURN LAMP RELAY USING THE RELAY GROUND PIN
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow LH turn relay pin 3, circuit SBB45 (GY/RD), BJB face
side and the trailer tow LH turn relay pin 2, circuit GD123 (BK/GY), BJB face side.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8979
Yes
REPAIR circuit CAT06 (YE) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
REPAIR circuit GD123 (BK/GY) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- Z8 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE THROUGH THE TRAILER TOW
CONNECTOR (RH TRAILER STOP/TURN LAMP)
- For the 4-pin connector, while applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the trailer
tow C4098-1, circuit CAT09 (GN), harness side and ground.
- For the 7-pin connector, while applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the trailer
tow connector pin 4, circuit CAT09 (GN), component side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
The vehicle is operating correctly. SEND the trailer to an authorized camper/trailer repair facility.
No
For the 4-pin connector, GO to Z10.
For the 7-pin connector, GO to Z9.
------------------------------------------------- Z9 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE TRAILER TOW
CONNECTOR (RH STOP/TURN 7-PIN)
- Disconnect: Trailer Tow C4099.
- While applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the trailer tow C4099-4, circuit
CAT09 (GN), harness side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
INSTALL a new trailer tow connector. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
GO to Z10.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8980
------------------------------------------------- Z10 CHECK THE TRAILER TOW RH STOP/TURN RELAY
- Disconnect: Trailer Tow RH Stop/Turn Relay.
- Substitute a known good relay.
- For the 4-pin connector, while applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the trailer
tow C4098-1, circuit CAT09 (GN), harness side and ground.
- For the 7-pin connector, while applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the trailer
tow C4099-4, circuit CAT09 (GN), harness side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
REMOVE the known good relay. INSTALL a new trailer tow turn relay. TEST the system for normal
operation.
No
REMOVE the known good relay. GO to Z11.
------------------------------------------------- Z11 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE RH STOP/TURN
LAMP RELAY COIL
- While applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the trailer tow RH turn relay pin 1,
circuit CLS19 (VT/OG), BJB face side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to Z12.
No
REPAIR circuit CLS19 (VT/OG) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- Z12 CHECK THE VOLTAGE SUPPLY CIRCUIT TO THE RH
STOP/TURN LAMP RELAY
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow RH turn relay pin 3, circuit SBB45 (GY/RD), BJB face
side and ground.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8981
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to Z13.
No
REPAIR circuit SBB45 (GY/RD) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- Z13 CHECK THE VOLTAGE SUPPLY CIRCUIT TO THE RH
STOP/TURN LAMP RELAY USING THE RELAY GROUND PIN
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow RH turn relay pin 3, circuit SBB45 (GY/RD), BJB face
side and the trailer tow RH turn relay pin 2, circuit GD123 (BK/GY), BJB face side.
- Is the voltage less than 5 ohms?
Yes
REPAIR circuit CAT09 (GN) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
REPAIR ground GD123 (BK/GY) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test AA: The Trailer Lamps Are Inoperative - Trailer Parking Lamps
Trailer Lamps
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test AA: The Trailer Lamps Are Inoperative - Trailer Parking Lamps
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 95, Trailer/Camper Adapter for schematic and connector information.
See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The trailer tow parking lamp relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) when the
vehicle parking lamps are illuminated. The trailer tow parking lamp relay coil is provided ground
through circuit GD123 (BK/GY). Voltage is supplied from Battery Junction Box (BJB) fuse 28 (25A)
to the trailer tow parking lamp relay switch side through circuit SBB28 (GN/RD). When the trailer
tow parking lamp relay is energized, voltage is routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit
CAT11 (BN).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Trailer tow parking lamp relay
- Trailer
PINPOINT TEST AA: THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE - TRAILER PARKING LAMPS
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8982
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Before beginning diagnostics, visually inspect the trailer tow connector for signs of
corrosion or damage. Repair or install a new trailer tow connector as required.
------------------------------------------------- AA1 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE THROUGH THE TRAILER
TOW CONNECTOR
- Ignition OFF.
- Place the headlamp switch in the PARKING LAMPS ON position.
- For the 4-pin connector, measure the voltage between the trailer tow C4098-3, circuit CAT11
(BN), harness side and ground.
- For the 7-pin connector, measure the voltage between the trailer tow connector pin 6, circuit
CAT11 (BN), component side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
The vehicle is operating correctly. SEND the trailer to an authorized camper/trailer repair facility.
No
For the 4-pin connector, GO to AA3.
For the 7-pin connector, GO to AA2.
------------------------------------------------- AA2 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE TRAILER TOW
CONNECTOR (7-PIN)
- Disconnect: Trailer Tow C4099.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow C4099-6, circuit CAT11 (BN), harness side and
ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
INSTALL a new trailer tow connector. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
GO to AA3.
-------------------------------------------------
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8983
AA3 CHECK THE TRAILER TOW PARKING LAMP RELAY
- Place the headlamp switch in the OFF position.
- Disconnect: Trailer Tow Parking Lamp Relay.
- Substitute a known good relay.
- Place the headlamp switch in the PARKING LAMPS ON position.
- For the 4-pin connector, measure the voltage between the trailer tow C4098-3, circuit CAT11
(BN), harness side and ground.
- For the 7-pin connector, measure the voltage between the trailer tow C4099-6, circuit CAT11
(BN), harness side and ground.
- Is the trailer tow parking lamp relay OK?
Yes
REMOVE the known good relay. GO to AA4.
No
REMOVE the known good relay. INSTALL a new trailer tow parking lamp relay. TEST the system
for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- AA4 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE TRAILER TOW
PARKING LAMP RELAY COIL
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow parking lamp relay pin 1, circuit CLS30 (VT/WH),
BJB face side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to AA5.
No
REPAIR circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- AA5 CHECK THE VOLTAGE SUPPLY CIRCUIT TO THE
TRAILER TOW PARKING LAMP RELAY
- Place the headlamp switch in the OFF position.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow parking lamp relay pin 3, circuit SBB28 (GN/RD),
BJB face side and ground.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8984
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to AA6.
No
VERIFY the BJB fuse 28 (25A) is OK. If OK, REPAIR circuit SBB28 (GN/RD) for an open. TEST
the system for normal operation. If not OK, REFER to the Wiring Diagrams to identify the possible
causes of the circuit short.
------------------------------------------------- AA6 CHECK THE VOLTAGE SUPPLY CIRCUIT TO THE
TRAILER TOW PARKING LAMP RELAY USING THE RELAY GROUND PIN
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow parking lamp relay pin 3, circuit SBB28 (GN/RD),
BJB face side and the trailer tow parking lamp relay pin 2, circuit GD123 (BK/GY), BJB face side.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
REPAIR circuit CAT11 (BN) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
REPAIR circuit GD123 (BK/GY) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test AB: The Trailer Lamps Are Inoperative - Trailer Reversing Lamps
Trailer Lamps
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test AB: The Trailer Lamps Are Inoperative - Trailer Reversing Lamps
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 95, Trailer/Camper Adapter for schematic and connector information.
See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation
The Battery Junction Box (BJB) fuse 58 (15A) receives voltage from circuit CLS10 (GY/BN) when
the vehicle reversing lamps are illuminated. The voltage is then routed to the trailer tow connector
through circuit CAT16 (GY/BN).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8985
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Trailer
PINPOINT TEST AB: THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE - TRAILER REVERSING
LAMPS
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Before beginning diagnostics, visually inspect the trailer tow connector for signs of
corrosion or damage. Repair or install a new trailer tow connector as required.
------------------------------------------------- AB1 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE THROUGH THE TRAILER
TOW CONNECTOR
- Ignition OFF.
- Apply the parking brake.
- Ignition ON.
- Select REVERSE.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow connector pin 7, circuit CAT16 (GY/BN), component
side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
The vehicle is operating correctly. SEND the trailer to an authorized camper/trailer repair facility.
No
VERIFY the BJB fuse 58 (15A) is OK. If OK, GO to AB2. If not OK, REFER to the Wiring Diagrams
to identify the possible causes of the circuit short.
------------------------------------------------- AB2 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE TRAILER TOW
CONNECTOR
- Disconnect: Trailer Tow C4099.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow C4099-7, circuit CAT16 (GY/BN), harness side and
ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
INSTALL a new trailer tow connector. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
GO to AB3.
------------------------------------------------- AB3 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE BJB FUSE 58 (15A)
- Measure the voltage between the BJB fuse 58 (15A), circuit CLS10 (GY/BN), input side and
ground.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8986
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
REPAIR circuit CAT16 (GY/BN) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
REPAIR circuit CLS10 (GY/BN) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test AC: The Trailer Lamps Are On Continuously
Trailer Lamps
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test AC: The Trailer Lamps Are On Continuously
Refer to Wiring Diagram Set 95, Trailer/Camper Adapter for schematic and connector information.
See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Normal Operation - Trailer Tow Turn/Stoplamp
The trailer tow LH turn relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS18 (GY/BN) when the vehicle
LH rear stoplamp is illuminated. When the trailer tow LH turn relay is energized, the voltage is
routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT06 (YE).
The trailer tow RH turn relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS19 (VT/OG) when the vehicle
RH rear stoplamp is illuminated. When the trailer tow RH turn relay is energized, the voltage is
routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT09 (GN).
Trailer Tow Parking
The trailer tow parking lamp relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) when the
vehicle parking lamps are illuminated. When the trailer tow parking lamp relay is energized, the
voltage is routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT11 (BN).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Trailer tow relay
- Trailer
PINPOINT TEST AC: THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE ON CONTINUOUSLY
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Before beginning diagnostics, visually inspect the trailer tow connector for signs of
corrosion or damage. Repair or install a new trailer tow connector as required.
------------------------------------------------- AC1 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE AT THE TRAILER TOW
CONNECTOR
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow 4-pin connector, harness side and ground as follows:
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8987
- Is any voltage present?
Yes
GO to AC2.
No
The vehicle is operating correctly. SEND the trailer to an authorized camper/trailer repair facility.
------------------------------------------------- AC2 CHECK THE TRAILER TOW RELAY
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Suspect Trailer Tow Relay.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow 4-pin connector, harness side and ground as follows:
- Is any voltage present?
Yes
REPAIR circuit CAT06 (YE) (LH turn), circuit CAT09 (OG) (RH turn), or circuit CAT11 (BN) (parking
lamps) for a short to voltage. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
INSTALL a new turn trailer tow relay. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test AD: The Trailer Battery Charging Is Inoperative/Does Not Operate Correctly
Trailer Lamps
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test AD: The Trailer Battery Charging Is Inoperative/Does Not Operate Correctly
Normal Operation
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8988
The trailer battery charge relay coil receives voltage from the Smart Junction Box (SJB) fuse 42
(10A) through circuit CAT23 (GY/YE) when the ignition switch is in the RUN position. Ground for
the trailer battery charge relay coil is supplied through circuit GD123 (BK/GY). The Battery Junction
Box (BJB) fuse 21 (30A) supplies voltage to the trailer battery charge relay switch side through
circuit SBB21 (GY/RD). When the trailer battery charge relay is energized, the voltage is routed to
the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT14 (OG).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- Trailer battery charge relay
- Trailer
- SJB
PINPOINT TEST AD: THE TRAILER BATTERY CHARGING IS INOPERATIVE/DOES NOT
OPERATE CORRECTLY
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Before beginning diagnostics, visually inspect the trailer tow connector for signs of
corrosion or damage. Repair or install a new trailer tow connector as required.
------------------------------------------------- AD1 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE THROUGH THE TRAILER
TOW CONNECTOR (BATTERY CHARGE INOPERATIVE)
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow connector pin 5, circuit CAT14 (OG), component side
and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to AD8.
No
GO to AD2.
------------------------------------------------- AD2 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE AT THE TRAILER TOW
CONNECTOR (BATTERY CHARGE INOPERATIVE)
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Trailer Tow C4099.
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow C4099-5, circuit CAT14 (OG) and ground.
Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
INSTALL a new trailer tow connector. TEST the system for normal operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8989
No
GO to AD3.
------------------------------------------------- AD3 CHECK THE TRAILER BATTERY CHARGE RELAY
(INOPERATIVE)
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: Trailer Battery Charge Relay.
- Substitute a known good relay.
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow C4099-5, circuit CAT14 (OG) and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
REMOVE the known good relay. INSTALL a new trailer battery charge relay. TEST the system for
normal operation.
No
REMOVE the known good relay. GO to AD4.
------------------------------------------------- AD4 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE TRAILER TOW
BATTERY CHARGE RELAY
- Ignition OFF.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer battery charge relay pin 3, circuit SBB21 (GY/RD), BJB
face side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to AD5.
No
VERIFY the BJB fuse 21 (30A) is OK. If OK, REPAIR circuit SBB21 (GY/RD) for an open. TEST
the system for normal operation. If not OK, REFER to the Wiring Diagrams to identify the possible
causes of the circuit short.
------------------------------------------------- AD5 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE TRAILER TOW
BATTERY CHARGE RELAY USING THE RELAY GROUND PIN
- Measure the voltage between the trailer battery charge relay pin 3, circuit SBB21 (GY/RD), BJB
face side and the trailer battery charge relay pin 2, circuit GD123 (BK/GY), BJB face side.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8990
Yes
GO to AD6.
No
REPAIR circuit GD123 (BK/GY) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- AD6 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE TRAILER BATTERY
CHARGE RELAY COIL (INOPERATIVE CONDITION)
- Ignition ON.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer battery charge relay pin 1, circuit CAT23 (GN/YE), BJB
face side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
REPAIR circuit CAT14 (OG) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
VERIFY the SJB fuse 44 (10A) is OK. If OK, GO to AD7. If not OK, REFER to the Wiring Diagrams
to identify the possible causes of the circuit short.
------------------------------------------------- AD7 CHECK THE TRAILER BATTERY CHARGE RELAY
COIL VOLTAGE SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN
- Ignition OFF.
- Disconnect: SJB C2280b.
- Measure the resistance between the trailer battery charge relay pin 1, circuit CAT23 (GN/YE),
BJB face side and the SJB C2280b-6, circuit CAT23 (GN/YE), harness side.
- Is the resistance less than 5 ohms?
Yes
GO to AD12.
No
REPAIR circuit CAT23 (GN/YE) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- AD8 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE AT THE TRAILER TOW
CONNECTOR (BATTERY CHARGE ALWAYS ON)
- Ignition OFF.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow connector pin 5, circuit CAT14 (OG), component side
and ground.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8991
- Is any voltage present?
Yes
GO to AD9.
No
The vehicle is operating correctly. SEND the trailer to an authorized camper/trailer repair facility.
------------------------------------------------- AD9 CHECK THE TRAILER BATTERY CHARGE VOLTAGE
SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE
- Disconnect: Trailer Battery Charge Relay.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow connector pin 5, circuit CAT14 (OG), component side
and ground.
- Is any voltage present?
Yes
REPAIR circuit CAT14 (OG) for a short to voltage. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
GO to AD10.
------------------------------------------------- AD10 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE TRAILER BATTERY
CHARGE RELAY COIL (BATTERY CHARGE ALWAYS ON)
- Measure the voltage between the trailer battery charge relay pin 1, circuit CAT23 (GN/YE), BJB
face side and ground.
- Is any voltage present?
Yes
GO to AD11.
No
INSTALL a new trailer battery charge relay. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- AD11 CHECK THE TRAILER BATTERY CHARGE RELAY
COIL SUPPLY CIRCUIT FOR A SHORT TO VOLTAGE
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8992
- Disconnect: SJB C2280b.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer battery charge relay pin 1, circuit CAT23 (GN/YE), BJB
face side and ground.
- Is any voltage present?
Yes
REPAIR circuit CAT23 (GN/YE) for a short to voltage. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
GO to AD12.
------------------------------------------------- AD12 CHECK FOR CORRECT SJB OPERATION
- Disconnect all the SJB connectors.
- Check for: corrosion
- damaged pins
- pushed-out pins
- Connect all the SJB connectors and make sure they seat correctly.
- Operate the system and verify the concern is still present.
- Is the concern still present?
Yes
INSTALL a new SJB. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
The system is operating correctly at this time. The concern may have been caused by a loose or
corroded connector.
------------------------------------------------Pinpoint Test AE: The Trailer Electric Brakes Are Inoperative/Do Not Operate Correctly
Trailer Lamps
Pinpoint Tests
Pinpoint Test AE: The Trailer Electric Brakes Are Inoperative/Do Not Operate Correctly
Normal Operation
The Trailer Brake Control (TBC) module is provided voltage at all times by the Battery Junction Box
(BJB) fuse 18 (30A) through circuit SBB18 (YE/RD). Ground for the TBC module is provided
through circuit GD138 (BK/WH). The TBC module receives voltage from the stoplamp switch
through circuit CLS17 (YE/GY) when the brake pedal is applied. When requested, the TBC module
sends voltage to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT19 (BU).
This pinpoint test is intended to diagnose the following:
- Fuse
- Wiring, terminals or connectors
- TBC module
- Trailer
PINPOINT TEST AE: THE TRAILER ELECTRIC BRAKES ARE INOPERATIVE/DO NOT
OPERATE CORRECTLY
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8993
NOTICE: Use the correct probe adapter(s) when making measurements. Failure to use the correct
probe adapter(s) may damage the connector.
NOTE: Before beginning diagnostics, visually inspect the trailer tow connector for signs of
corrosion or damage. Repair or install a new trailer tow connector as required.
------------------------------------------------- AE1 CHECK THE TRAILER ELECTRIC BRAKE
CONTROLLER FOR A SHORTED OUTPUT
- Ignition ON.
- With the brake pedal released, measure the voltage between the trailer tow connector pin 3,
circuit CAT19 (BU), component side and ground.
- Is any voltage present?
Yes
GO to AE2.
No
GO to AE3.
------------------------------------------------- AE2 CHECK THE TBC MODULE OUTPUT CIRCUIT FOR A
SHORT TO VOLTAGE
- Disconnect: TBC Module C2142.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow connector pin 3, circuit CAT19 (BU), component side
and ground.
- Is any voltage present?
Yes
REPAIR circuit CAT19 (BU) for a short to voltage. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
INSTALL a new TBC module. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- AE3 CHECK THE TBC MODULE OUTPUT
- Ignition OFF.
- Set the gain on the TBC module to the maximum setting.
- While applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the trailer tow connector pin 3,
circuit CAT19 (BU), component side and ground.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8994
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
The vehicle is operating correctly. SEND the trailer to an authorized camper/trailer repair facility.
No
GO to AE4.
------------------------------------------------- AE4 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE TRAILER TOW
CONNECTOR
- Disconnect: Trailer Tow C4099.
- NOTE: Make sure the gain is still set to the maximum setting.
- While applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the trailer tow C4099-3, circuit
CAT19 (BU), harness side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
INSTALL a new trailer tow connector. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
GO to AE5.
------------------------------------------------- AE5 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE TBC MODULE
- Disconnect: TBC Module C2142.
- Measure the voltage between the TBC module C2142-1, circuit SBB18 (YE/RD), harness side
and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to AE6.
No
VERIFY the BJB fuse 18 (30A) is OK. If OK, REPAIR circuit SBB18 (YE/RD) for an open. TEST the
system for normal operation. If not OK, REFER to the Wiring Diagrams to identify the possible
causes of the circuit short.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8995
------------------------------------------------- AE6 CHECK THE STOPLAMP SWITCH INPUT TO THE
TBC MODULE
- While applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the TBC module C2142-2, circuit
CLS17 (YE/GY), harness side and ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to AE7.
No
REPAIR circuit CLS17 (YE/GY) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- AE7 CHECK FOR VOLTAGE TO THE TBC MODULE USING
THE CONNECTOR GROUND PIN
- While applying the brake pedal, measure the voltage between the TBC module C2142-2, circuit
CLS17 (YE/GY), harness side and the TBC module C2142-6, circuit GD138 (BK/WH), harness
side.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
GO to AE8.
No
REPAIR circuit GD138 (BK/WH) for an open. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- AE8 CHECK THE TBC MODULE OUTPUT CIRCUIT FOR A
SHORT TO GROUND
- Measure the resistance between the TBC module C2142-3, circuit CAT19 (BU), harness side and
ground.
- Is the resistance greater than 10,000 ohms?
Yes
GO to AE9.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8996
No
REPAIR circuit CAT19 (BU) fro a short to ground. TEST the system for normal operation.
------------------------------------------------- AE9 CHECK THE TRAILER ELECTRIC BRAKE
CONTROLLER OUTPUT CIRCUIT FOR AN OPEN
- Connect a fused jumper wire between the TBC module C2142-1, circuit SBB18 (YE/RD), harness
side and the TBC module C2142-3, circuit CAT19 (BU), harness side.
- Measure the voltage between the trailer tow C4099-3, circuit CAT19 (BU), harness side and
ground.
- Is the voltage greater than 10 volts?
Yes
REMOVE the jumper wire. INSTALL a new TBC module. TEST the system for normal operation.
No
REMOVE the jumper wire. REPAIR circuit CAT19 (BU) for an open. TEST the system for normal
operation.
-------------------------------------------------
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow
Relay, Right Turn
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow
Relay, Right Turn > Page 9001
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow
Relay, Right Turn > Page 9002
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow
Relay, Right Turn > Page 9003
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp > Page 9006
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp > Page 9007
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp > Page 9008
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Park/Turn Lamp, Left Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Park/Turn Lamp, Left Front > Page 9014
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Park/Turn Lamp, Left Front > Page 9015
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Park/Turn Lamp, Left Front > Page 9016
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Park/Turn Lamp, Left Front > Page 9017
Turn Signal Lamp: Diagrams
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Park/Turn Lamp, Left Front > Page 9018
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Park/Turn Lamp, Left Front > Page 9019
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Park/Turn Lamp, Left Front > Page 9020
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Park/Turn Lamp, Left Front > Page 9021
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Park/Turn Lamp, Left Front > Page 9022
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Park/Turn Lamp, Left Front > Page 9023
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Park/Turn Lamp, Left Front > Page 9024
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Park/Turn Lamp, Left Front > Page 9025
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Park/Turn Lamp, Left Front > Page 9026
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Locations
Turn Signal Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 9030
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 9031
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 9032
Turn Signal Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 9033
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 9034
Turn Signal Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
NOTE: Power tilt column shown, manual tilt similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the steering column shroud.
2. Disconnect the 2 multifunction switch electrical connectors.
3. Remove the 2 screws and the multifunction switch.
- To install, tighten to 1 Nm (9 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Vanity Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Vanity Mirror Lamp,
Left
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Vanity Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Vanity Mirror Lamp,
Left > Page 9039
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Element Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Element Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9045
Heated Glass Element Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Element Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9046
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element Relay
> Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element Relay
> Component Information > Locations > Page 9051
Heated Glass Element Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element Relay
> Component Information > Locations > Page 9052
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Quarter Window Open Relay
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Quarter Window Open Relay > Page 9057
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay
Power Window Relay: Testing and Inspection Quarter Window Close Relay
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay > Page 9060
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay > Page 9061
Power Window Relay: Testing and Inspection Quarter Window Open Relay
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay > Page 9062
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Locations Master Window Adjust Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9068
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9069
Power Window Switch: Locations Power Window Switch, RH Side Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9070
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9071
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9072
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Master Window Adjust Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9075
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9076
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9077
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9078
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9079
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Power Window Switch, RH Side Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9080
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Master Window Adjust Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9083
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9084
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Window Switch, RH Side Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9085
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9086
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Window Adjust Switches - Left Rear and Right Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9087
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 9088
Power Window Switch: Service and Repair
Window Control Switch
Removal and Installation
NOTE: LF shown, all others similar.
1. Remove the door trim panel.
2. NOTE: There are 2 tabs on the opposite side not shown in the illustration.
Unlock the 4 tabs and remove the window control switch from the door trim panel.
3. To install, reverse removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Front Door
Front Door Window Motor: Service and Repair Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View,
Front Door
Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Front Door
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Front Door > Page 9095
Front Door Window Motor: Service and Repair Window Regulator Motor - Front Door
Window Regulator Motor - Front Door
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The power window regulator motor must be re-initialized whenever the LF/RF (Navigator) or
LF (Expedition) motor is removed from the vehicle. For additional information, refer to Window
Motor Initialization See: Service and Repair.
1. Remove the front door trim panel.
2. Position the front door weathershield aside.
3. NOTE: Use a flat-blade screwdriver between the window regulator motor and window regulator
assembly to hold the window regulator assembly
drum in place.
Remove the bolts and the front door window regulator motor.
1. Disconnect the electrical connector.
2. Remove the bolts.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Cycle the window glass to make sure the gears engage.
- The power window regulator motor must be re-initialized whenever the LF/RF (Navigator) or LF
(Expedition) window regulator is removed from the vehicle. For additional information, refer to
Window Motor Initialization See: Service and Repair.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Quarter Window Motor > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Quarter Window Motor: Service and Repair
Window Regulator Motor - Rear Quarter
Removal
1. Remove the D-pillar trim panel.
2. Disconnect the rear quarter window regulator motor.
- Remove the retaining clip.
3. Remove the bolts and rear quarter window regulator motor.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Rear Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Rear Door
Rear Door Window Motor: Service and Repair Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View,
Rear Door
Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Rear Door
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Rear Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Rear Door > Page 9103
Rear Door Window Motor: Service and Repair Window Regulator Motor - Rear Door
Window Regulator Motor - Rear Door
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear door trim panel.
2. Position the rear door weathershield aside.
3. NOTE: Use a flat-blade screwdriver between the window regulator motor and the window
regulator assembly to hold the window regulator
assembly drum in place.
Remove the rear door window regulator motor.
1. Disconnect the electrical connector.
2. Remove the bolts.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Cycle the door glass to make sure of gear engagement.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Quarter Window Open Relay
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Quarter Window Open Relay > Page 9108
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay
Power Window Relay: Testing and Inspection Quarter Window Close Relay
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay > Page 9111
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay > Page 9112
Power Window Relay: Testing and Inspection Quarter Window Open Relay
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay > Page 9113
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Master Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Locations Master Window Adjust Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9118
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9119
Power Window Switch: Locations Power Window Switch, RH Side Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9120
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9121
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9122
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Master Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Master Window Adjust Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9125
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9126
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9127
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9128
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9129
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Power Window Switch, RH Side Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9130
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Master Window Adjust Switch
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9133
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9134
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Window Switch, RH Side Front
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9135
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9136
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Window Adjust Switches - Left Rear and Right Rear
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 9137
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 9138
Power Window Switch: Service and Repair
Window Control Switch
Removal and Installation
NOTE: LF shown, all others similar.
1. Remove the door trim panel.
2. NOTE: There are 2 tabs on the opposite side not shown in the illustration.
Unlock the 4 tabs and remove the window control switch from the door trim panel.
3. To install, reverse removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > Front Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded
View, Front Door
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Glass, Frames and Mechanisms Exploded View, Front Door
Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Front Door
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > Front Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded
View, Front Door > Page 9145
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Door Glass Top Run - Front
Door Glass Top Run - Front
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The power window regulator motor must be re-initialized whenever the LF/RF (Navigator) or
LF (Expedition) motor is removed from the vehicle. For additional information, refer to Window
Motor Initialization See: Service and Repair.
1. Remove the front door window glass. For additional information, refer to Window Glass - Front
Door See: Service and Repair/Window Glass Front Door.
2. Remove the inside glass weatherstrip.
3. Remove the front door glass channel bolt and front door glass top run.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- The power window regulator motor must be re-initialized whenever the LF/RF (Navigator) or LF
(Expedition) motor is removed from the vehicle. For additional information, refer to Window Motor
Initialization See: Service and Repair.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Liftgate Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Liftgate Window Glass: Service and Repair
Window Glass - Liftgate
Removal and Installation
Window glass assembly
1. Remove the rear window wiper motor.
2. Disconnect the rear window defrost electrical connectors.
3. NOTICE: Do not extend the socket clips more than 2.0 mm (0.08 in) or failure of the socket can
occur.
NOTE: The liftgate glass must be supported when removing and installing the liftgate assist
cylinders.
Disconnect the 2 liftgate glass assist cylinders.
1. Insert a screwdriver blade under the socket clip and lift.
2. Gently pull the socket off the ball stud.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Liftgate Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 9149
Window glass assembly or hinge assembly
4. Remove the liftgate glass hinge-to-body fasteners and remove the glass.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
Window hinge assembly
5. Remove the liftgate glass to hinge fasteners and remove the glass.
- Apply threadlock to the liftgate glass-to-hinge fasteners during installation.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
Window glass assembly or window hinge assembly
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Check the liftgate glass for high effort when closing. If high effort is present, adjust the striker
one-half turn outboard. If high effort is still present, adjust the striker an additional one-half turn
outboard. Do not exceed one full turn.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Quarter Window Glass: Service and Repair
Window Glass - Rear Quarter
Removal
All vehicles
1. Remove the rear quarter trim panel.
2. Remove the front and rear coat hooks and lower the headliner over the rear quarter window
glass.
Vehicles with power vent window
3. Remove the bolts and rear quarter window regulator motor.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 9153
4. Disconnect the rear quarter window regulator.
All vehicles
5. Disconnect the audio antenna.
6. If equipped, remove the air duct.
- Remove the pin-type retainer.
7. NOTE: Have an assistant hold the rear quarter window glass.
Remove the rear quarter window glass.
1. Remove the nuts.
2. Remove the rear quarter window glass.
8. Remove the excess foam core butyl from the window opening.
Installation
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 9154
1. Apply 8 mm (0.32 in) foam core butyl to the rear quarter window glass frame.
- Start at the bottom middle and work around the frame.
2. Install the rear quarter window glass.
1. Position the rear quarter window glass.
2. Install the rear quarter window glass nuts.
- Tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
3. If equipped, install the air duct.
- Install the pin-type retainer.
4. Connect the audio antenna.
Vehicles with power vent windows
5. Install the rear quarter window regulator.
6. Install the bolts and rear quarter window regulator motor.
- Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
- Connect the electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 9155
All vehicles
7. Position the headliner and install the coat hooks.
8. Install the rear quarter trim panel.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Rear Door Window Glass > Rear Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Door Glass Top Run - Rear
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Door Glass Top Run - Rear
Door Glass Top Run - Rear
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear door window glass. For additional information, refer to Window Glass - Rear
Door See: Service and Repair/Window Glass Rear Door.
2. Remove the rear door glass channel bolt.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
3. Remove the rear door glass top run.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Rear Door Window Glass > Rear Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Door Glass Top Run - Rear > Page 9161
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Glass, Frames and Mechanisms Exploded View, Rear Door
Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Rear Door
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Front Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair > Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Front Door
Front Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded
View, Front Door
Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Front Door
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Front Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair > Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Front Door > Page 9167
Front Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair Window Regulator - Front Door
Window Regulator - Front Door
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The power window regulator motor must be re-initialized whenever the LF/RF (Navigator) or
LF (Expedition) motor is removed from the vehicle. For additional information, refer to Window
Motor Initialization See: Service and Repair.
1. Remove the front door trim panel.
2. NOTE: There are 2 tabs on the opposite side not shown in the illustration.
Unlock the 4 tabs and remove the window control switch from the door trim panel.
3. Remove the screws and the front door speaker.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. Remove the front door weathershield.
5. Re-connect the electrical connectors to the window control switch.
6. Lower the window glass to access the 2 window glass clamp bolts.
7. Loosen the window glass clamp bolts.
- To install, raise the window glass until it stalls in the UP position. Tighten the window glass clamp
bolts to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
8. NOTE: Secure the front window glass in the full UP position.
Secure the front window glass with tape to the front door frame.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Front Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair > Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Front Door > Page 9168
9. Position the interior door handle aside.
1. Remove the cable conduit fitting from the carrier assembly.
2. Lift upward on the interior door handle retaining bracket and pivot the interior door handle out of
the bracket.
3. Remove the cable from the door handle.
10. Release the crash sensor harness pin-type retainers.
11. Position the front door window regulator harness aside.
1. Disconnect the electrical connectors.
2. Release the pin-type retainers.
12. Remove the front window regulator.
1. Loosen the 2 hanger bolts.
2. Remove the front window regulator bolts and front top run channel bolt.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Front Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair > Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Front Door > Page 9169
13. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- The power window regulator motor must be re-initialized whenever the LF/RF (Navigator) or LF
(Expedition) window regulator is removed from the vehicle. For additional information, refer to
Window Motor Initialization See: Service and Repair.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Rear Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair > Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Rear Door
Rear Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded
View, Rear Door
Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Rear Door
1. For additional information, refer to the procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Rear Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair > Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Rear Door > Page 9174
Rear Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair Window Regulator - Rear Door
Window Regulator - Rear Door
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear door trim panel.
2. NOTE: There are 2 tabs on the opposite side not shown in the illustration.
NOTE: LF shown, LR and RR are similar.
Unlock the 4 tabs and remove the window control switch from the door trim panel.
3. Remove the rear door speaker.
1. Remove the screws.
2. Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. Remove the speaker.
4. Remove the rear door weathershield.
5. Connect the window control switch.
6. Lower the window glass to access the window glass clamp bolts.
7. Disconnect the window control switch.
8. Loosen the window glass clamp bolts and remove the rear door window glass.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
9. NOTE: Secure the rear window glass in the full UP position.
Secure the rear window glass with tape to the rear door frame.
10. Disconnect the rear door window regulator electrical connectors.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Rear Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair > Glass, Frames and Mechanisms - Exploded View, Rear Door > Page 9175
11. Position the interior door handle aside.
- Lift upward on the interior door handle retaining bracket and pivot the interior door handle out of
the bracket.
12. Remove the rear door window regulator assembly.
- Remove the bolts. -
To install, tighten to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
13. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Windshield
Glass
Windshield: Service and Repair Windshield Glass
Windshield Glass
Removal
NOTE: If the windshield glass is being removed to repair a dust/water leak, remove and reinstall
the existing windshield glass.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Windshield
Glass > Page 9180
1. Remove the cowl panel grille.
2. Remove the A-pillar trim panels.
3. If equipped, remove the overhead console.
4. If equipped, remove the rain sensor.
5. Remove the interior rear view mirror.
6. Remove the sun visors.
7. Lower the front portion of the headliner.
8. Remove the windshield side mouldings.
- Pull out starting at the top corner.
9. Remove the upper windshield weatherstrip.
- Pull out starting at the corner.
10. Mark the outside of the windshield glass with a wax pencil to avoid damaging the glass stops
when cutting the urethane adhesive.
11. Before cutting the urethane adhesive, remove dirt and other foreign material from the
windshield pinch weld area.
- Use a clean shop towel or oil-free compressed air.
12. NOTE: Refer to manufacturer's instructions before using the Deluxe Windshield Removal Tool.
Lubricate the urethane adhesive with water to aid the Deluxe Windshield Removal Tool when
cutting the urethane adhesive.
13. WARNING: Always wear eye protection when servicing a vehicle. Failure to follow this
instruction may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING: Wear protective gloves when handling components or parts that have pointed or sharp
edges. Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury.
NOTICE: To avoid rust formation, use extreme care not to scratch the paint or primer, or otherwise
damage the pinch weld during glass removal.
NOTE: Insert the blade into the Deluxe Windshield Removal Tool so that the flat side is against the
glass. This will leave the entire urethane adhesive bead on the pinch weld and allow a dry fit of the
replacement windshield glass.
NOTE: Support the windshield glass as necessary to prevent the glass from dropping while cutting
the urethane adhesive.
Insert the Deluxe Windshield Removal Tool at the upper center of the windshield glass and work
toward the bottom corners.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Windshield
Glass > Page 9181
14. Using The Pumper, distance the windshield from the body.
15. Insert the Deluxe Windshield Removal Tool into the bottom of the urethane adhesive and cut
from corner to corner.
16. NOTE: Removing the windshield glass requires more than one technician.
Carefully remove the windshield glass from the vehicle and place on a stable work surface.
Installation
1. Dry-fit the windshield glass on the existing urethane adhesive bead on the pinch weld.
- Position the windshield glass on the pinch weld.
- Center the windshield glass in the opening.
- Adjust the windshield glass stop blocks (if equipped) as needed for best fit.
- Make alignment marks with tape or non-staining grease pencil (preferably at the windshield glass
stop blocks) on the windshield glass and the body.
2. After the dry-fit alignment, remove the windshield glass and place on a stable work surface with
the interior side of the glass facing upward.
3. WARNING: Repair any corrosion found on the pinch weld. The pinch weld is a structural
component of the vehicle. Corrosion left
unrepaired may reduce the structural integrity of the vehicle. Failure to follow this instruction may
result in serious injury to vehicle occupant(s).
NOTE: Avoid scratching the pinch weld. Repair all minor scratches or exposed metal on the pinch
weld following manufacturer's instructions. Use the same brand pinch weld primer, glass primer
and urethane adhesive.
Using an appropriate tool, trim the urethane adhesive leaving a 1-2 mm (0.04-0.8 in) base or
original equipment urethane adhesive on the pinch weld.
4. Using a clean shop towel, brush or oil-free compressed air, clean the pinch weld area around the
existing urethane adhesive. Remove any foreign
material or water that may have entered during windshield removal.
5. If reinstalling the same windshield glass, remove any remaining urethane adhesive from the
glass leaving a thin layer to bond with the new
urethane adhesive bead.
6. Clean the inside of the new windshield glass with glass cleaner.
- Make sure to thoroughly clean the surface of the blackened border area where the urethane
adhesive will be applied.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Windshield
Glass > Page 9182
7. NOTE: Be sure to use the same brand and cure-rate products for the urethane adhesive and
glass primer. Do not mix different brands of urethane
adhesive and glass primer. Refer to the Material Chart in this procedure.
If installing a new windshield glass, apply glass primer according to manufacturer's instructions.
Allow at least 6 minutes to dry.
8. Install the upper windshield weatherstrip.
9. Cut the urethane adhesive applicator tip to specification.
10. NOTE: The windshield glass must be positioned within 10 minutes of applying the urethane
adhesive.
Apply a uniform bead of urethane adhesive on top of the existing trimmed urethane adhesive bead
on the pinch weld just outside the foam butyl dam.
- Make sure there are no gaps in the urethane adhesive bead.
11. WARNING: Do not drive vehicle until the urethane adhesive seal has cured. Follow urethane
adhesive manufacturer's curing directions.
Inadequate or incorrect curing of the urethane adhesive seal will adversely affect glass retention.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious injury to vehicle occupant(s).
NOTICE: Before positioning the windshield glass, open vehicle windows to prevent the air pressure
of closing doors from affecting the urethane adhesive bond.
Using the alignment marks made previously, position the windshield glass on the pinch weld.
12. NOTE: The urethane adhesive must cure for a minimum of one hour before testing for air or
water leaks.
After the urethane adhesive has cured, check the windshield glass seal for air or water leaks
through the urethane adhesive bead and add urethane adhesive as necessary.
13. NOTE: Be sure the moldings seat completely.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Windshield
Glass > Page 9183
Install the windshield side mouldings.
14. Install the headliner.
15. Install the interior rear view mirror.
16. If equipped, install the rain sensor.
17. Install the overhead console.
18. Install the A-pillar trim panels.
19. Install the sun visors.
20. Install the cowl panel grille.
21. Run the blower motor on defrost HIGH to check for glass that may have fallen into the defroster
vents.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Windshield
Glass > Page 9184
Windshield: Service and Repair Glass Reseal - Windshield
Glass Reseal - Windshield
1. Remove the cowl panel grille.
2. Remove the A-pillar trim panels.
3. If equipped, remove the overhead console.
4. If equipped, remove the rain sensor.
5. If equipped, remove the roof opening panel trim.
6. Remove the interior rear view mirror.
7. Remove the sun visors.
8. Partially lower the front portion of the headliner near the windshield upper opening and block
with a suitable material.
9. Clean the edge formed by the existing urethane adhesive and the glass on the inside at the top
and sides, and outside on the bottom of the
windshield with glass cleaner.
10. Cut the urethane adhesive applicator tip to specification.
11. NOTE: Use either a high-ratio electric or battery-operated caulk gun that will apply the urethane
adhesive with less effort and a continuous bead.
Apply a bead of urethane adhesive to the cleaned area.
12. NOTE: Make sure that all gaps in the urethane adhesive are smoothed into one continuous
bead.
Backfill the urethane application and clean the excess.
13. NOTE: The urethane adhesive must cure for a minimum of one hour before testing for air or
water leaks.
After the urethane adhesive has cured, check the windshield seal for air or water leaks through the
urethane adhesive bead and add urethane adhesive as necessary.
14. Reposition the headliner.
15. Install the sun visors.
16. Install the interior rear view mirror.
17. If equipped, install the roof opening panel trim.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Windshield
Glass > Page 9185
18. If equipped, install the rain sensor.
19. If equipped, install the overhead console.
20. Install the A-pillar trim panels.
21. Install the cowl panel grille.
22. Clean the interior and exterior of the windshield glass with glass cleaner.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Rain Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Rain Sensor: > 09-24-13 > Dec > 09 > Wipers/Washers - Rain Sensor Detached From
Windshield
Rain Sensor: Customer Interest Wipers/Washers - Rain Sensor Detached From Windshield
TSB 09-24-13
12/14/09
RAIN SENSOR MOUNTING RING DETACHED FROM WINDSHIELD
FORD: 2010 Taurus
2009-2010 Expedition, F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 MKS 2010 MKZ 2009-2010 Navigator 2010 MKT
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 F-150 Platinum, Expedition, Navigator, MKS and 2010 Taurus, MKT and
MKZ vehicles equipped with Rain Sensing Windshield Wipers may exhibit a detached rain sensor
mounting ring. The rain sensor mounting ring is attached to the inside of the windshield near the
rear view mirror. The windshield wipers will continue to function in manual mode, only the rain
sensor feature is affected.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
A service repair kit has been made available to resolve this issue. Order the Rain Sensor Repair Kit
and follow the instruction sheet contained with this kit to resolve a detached rain sensor mounting
ring.
NOTE
THE KIT REQUIRES CHEMICALS WHICH ARE NOT INCLUDED IN THE KIT. THESE
CHEMICALS HAVE A SHORT SHELF LIFE AND ARE REQUIRED TO BE OBTAINED DIRECTLY
FROM A SOURCE LISTED IN THE INSTRUCTION SHEET.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT092413 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
17D596 33
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Rain Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rain Sensor: > 09-24-13 > Dec > 09 > Wipers/Washers - Rain Sensor
Detached From Windshield
Rain Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Wipers/Washers - Rain Sensor Detached From
Windshield
TSB 09-24-13
12/14/09
RAIN SENSOR MOUNTING RING DETACHED FROM WINDSHIELD
FORD: 2010 Taurus
2009-2010 Expedition, F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 MKS 2010 MKZ 2009-2010 Navigator 2010 MKT
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 F-150 Platinum, Expedition, Navigator, MKS and 2010 Taurus, MKT and
MKZ vehicles equipped with Rain Sensing Windshield Wipers may exhibit a detached rain sensor
mounting ring. The rain sensor mounting ring is attached to the inside of the windshield near the
rear view mirror. The windshield wipers will continue to function in manual mode, only the rain
sensor feature is affected.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
A service repair kit has been made available to resolve this issue. Order the Rain Sensor Repair Kit
and follow the instruction sheet contained with this kit to resolve a detached rain sensor mounting
ring.
NOTE
THE KIT REQUIRES CHEMICALS WHICH ARE NOT INCLUDED IN THE KIT. THESE
CHEMICALS HAVE A SHORT SHELF LIFE AND ARE REQUIRED TO BE OBTAINED DIRECTLY
FROM A SOURCE LISTED IN THE INSTRUCTION SHEET.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT092413 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
17D596 33
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Rain Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 9200
Rain Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Rain Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 9201
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Rain Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 9202
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Rain Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 9203
Rain Sensor: Service and Repair
Rain Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Pull outward on the rain sensor cover to remove.
2. Disconnect the rain sensor electrical connector.
3. NOTE: Prior to releasing the rain sensor retaining clips, it is necessary to apply light inward
pressure at the bend of the retaining clips.
Using a suitable screwdriver, release the 2 rain sensor retaining clips from the windshield mounted
bracket and remove the rain sensor.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay
> Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay
> Component Information > Locations > Page 9208
Wiper Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay
> Component Information > Locations > Page 9209
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Rain
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Rain Sensor: > 09-24-13 > Dec > 09
> Wipers/Washers - Rain Sensor Detached From Windshield
Rain Sensor: Customer Interest Wipers/Washers - Rain Sensor Detached From Windshield
TSB 09-24-13
12/14/09
RAIN SENSOR MOUNTING RING DETACHED FROM WINDSHIELD
FORD: 2010 Taurus
2009-2010 Expedition, F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 MKS 2010 MKZ 2009-2010 Navigator 2010 MKT
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 F-150 Platinum, Expedition, Navigator, MKS and 2010 Taurus, MKT and
MKZ vehicles equipped with Rain Sensing Windshield Wipers may exhibit a detached rain sensor
mounting ring. The rain sensor mounting ring is attached to the inside of the windshield near the
rear view mirror. The windshield wipers will continue to function in manual mode, only the rain
sensor feature is affected.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
A service repair kit has been made available to resolve this issue. Order the Rain Sensor Repair Kit
and follow the instruction sheet contained with this kit to resolve a detached rain sensor mounting
ring.
NOTE
THE KIT REQUIRES CHEMICALS WHICH ARE NOT INCLUDED IN THE KIT. THESE
CHEMICALS HAVE A SHORT SHELF LIFE AND ARE REQUIRED TO BE OBTAINED DIRECTLY
FROM A SOURCE LISTED IN THE INSTRUCTION SHEET.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT092413 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
17D596 33
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Rain
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rain Sensor: >
09-24-13 > Dec > 09 > Wipers/Washers - Rain Sensor Detached From Windshield
Rain Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Wipers/Washers - Rain Sensor Detached From
Windshield
TSB 09-24-13
12/14/09
RAIN SENSOR MOUNTING RING DETACHED FROM WINDSHIELD
FORD: 2010 Taurus
2009-2010 Expedition, F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 MKS 2010 MKZ 2009-2010 Navigator 2010 MKT
ISSUE Some 2009-2010 F-150 Platinum, Expedition, Navigator, MKS and 2010 Taurus, MKT and
MKZ vehicles equipped with Rain Sensing Windshield Wipers may exhibit a detached rain sensor
mounting ring. The rain sensor mounting ring is attached to the inside of the windshield near the
rear view mirror. The windshield wipers will continue to function in manual mode, only the rain
sensor feature is affected.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
A service repair kit has been made available to resolve this issue. Order the Rain Sensor Repair Kit
and follow the instruction sheet contained with this kit to resolve a detached rain sensor mounting
ring.
NOTE
THE KIT REQUIRES CHEMICALS WHICH ARE NOT INCLUDED IN THE KIT. THESE
CHEMICALS HAVE A SHORT SHELF LIFE AND ARE REQUIRED TO BE OBTAINED DIRECTLY
FROM A SOURCE LISTED IN THE INSTRUCTION SHEET.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT092413 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
17D596 33
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Rain
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9224
Rain Sensor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Rain
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9225
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Rain
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9226
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Rain
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9227
Rain Sensor: Service and Repair
Rain Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Pull outward on the rain sensor cover to remove.
2. Disconnect the rain sensor electrical connector.
3. NOTE: Prior to releasing the rain sensor retaining clips, it is necessary to apply light inward
pressure at the bend of the retaining clips.
Using a suitable screwdriver, release the 2 rain sensor retaining clips from the windshield mounted
bracket and remove the rain sensor.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer
Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Locations
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer
Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9231
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer
Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9232
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations
Windshield Washer Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9236
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9237
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9238
Windshield Washer Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9239
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9240
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9241
Windshield Washer Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
NOTE: Power tilt column shown, manual tilt similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the steering column shroud.
2. Disconnect the 2 multifunction switch electrical connectors.
3. Remove the 2 screws and the multifunction switch.
- To install, tighten to 1 Nm (9 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Wiper Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9245
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9246
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9247
Wiper Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9248
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9249
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9250
Wiper Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
NOTE: Power tilt column shown, manual tilt similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the steering column shroud.
2. Disconnect the 2 multifunction switch electrical connectors.
3. Remove the 2 screws and the multifunction switch.
- To install, tighten to 1 Nm (9 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Locations
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Page 9254
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Page 9255
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Motor > Component Information > Locations
Windshield Washer Motor: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 9259
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 9260
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Pump > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Windshield Washer Pump: Service and Repair
Washer Pump
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
NOTICE: When servicing the windshield washer pump, be careful not to damage the windshield
washer pump seal.
NOTICE: Do not operate the windshield washer pump before filling the windshield washer
reservoir. Failure to do so may result in premature pump failure.
1. Remove the RH headlamp assembly.
2. Position aside the shield as necessary to gain access to the washer pump.
3. Disconnect the windshield washer reservoir hoses.
4. Disconnect the windshield washer pump electrical connector.
5. Remove the windshield washer pump.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Reservoir > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Windshield Washer Reservoir: Service and Repair
Washer Reservoir
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. Failure to follow these instructions may result in serious
personal injury.
NOTICE: When servicing the windshield washer pump, be careful not to damage the windshield
washer pump seal.
NOTICE: Do not operate the windshield pump before filling the windshield washer reservoir. Failure
to do so may result in premature pump failure.
NOTE: The washer reservoir is integrated with the battery tray and cannot be serviced separately.
1. Remove the vehicle battery.
2. Drain the cooling system.
3. Disconnect the upper radiator hose at the radiator inlet, and position aside.
4. Remove the 3 battery tray bolts.
- To install, tighten to 17 Nm (150 lb-in).
5. Carefully position the washer reservoir assembly to gain access to the electrical connectors and
washer hoses.
6. Disconnect the windshield washer solvent level electrical connector, washer pump electrical
connectors and washer hoses.
7. NOTE: If necessary, drain the windshield washer reservoir after removal.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Reservoir > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Page 9267
Remove the washer reservoir assembly.
8. Transfer components as necessary.
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Refer to Cooling System for coolant filling and bleeding procedures.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations
Windshield Washer Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Page 9271
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Page 9272
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Page 9273
Windshield Washer Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Page 9274
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Page 9275
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Page 9276
Windshield Washer Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
NOTE: Power tilt column shown, manual tilt similar.
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the steering column shroud.
2. Disconnect the 2 multifunction switch electrical connectors.
3. Remove the 2 screws and the multifunction switch.
- To install, tighten to 1 Nm (9 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Adjustments > Wiper
Blade and Pivot Arm Adjustment - Windshield
Wiper Arm: Adjustments Wiper Blade and Pivot Arm Adjustment - Windshield
Wiper Blade and Pivot Arm Adjustment - Windshield
1. Cycle and park the windshield wipers.
2. Verify the distance between the outer tip of the (1) RH windshield wiper blade and the (3) edge
of the cowl panel grille and between the outer tip
of the (2) LH windshield wiper blade and the (3) edge of the cowl panel grille are within
specifications.
3. If the distance is not within specification, remove the windshield wiper pivot arm and reposition to
specification. For additional information, refer
to Wiper Pivot Arm - Front See: Service and Repair/Wiper Pivot Arm - Front.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Adjustments > Wiper
Blade and Pivot Arm Adjustment - Windshield > Page 9281
Wiper Arm: Adjustments Wiper Blade and Pivot Arm Adjustment - Rear
Wiper Blade and Pivot Arm Adjustment - Rear
1. Cycle and park the rear window wiper pivot arm and blade.
2. Check the rear window wiper park measurement. If not within specification, remove the rear
window wiper pivot arm and reposition to the correct
location. For additional information, refer to Wiper Pivot Arm - Rear See: Service and Repair/Wiper
Pivot Arm - Rear.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Pivot Arm - Front
Wiper Arm: Service and Repair Wiper Pivot Arm - Front
Wiper Pivot Arm - Front
Removal and Installation
NOTICE: To prevent damage to the wiper pivot arm shaft splines, do not rotate the pivot arms into
position manually.
NOTE: The windshield wiper pivot arms must be in the highest position to remove them.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
2. Turn the windshield wiper on.
3. Stop the windshield wiper pivot arms at the highest position by turning the ignition switch OFF.
4. Remove the windshield wiper pivot arm.
- Remove the pivot arm nut cover.
- Remove the nut.
- Using a suitable 2-leg puller, remove the windshield wiper pivot arm.
- To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
5. NOTE: Make sure the wiper motor is in the PARK position before installation of the wiper pivot
arms.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Adjust the windshield wiper pivot arms. For additional information, refer to Wiper Blade and Pivot
Arm Adjustment - Windshield See: Adjustments/Wiper Blade and Pivot Arm Adjustment Windshield.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Pivot Arm - Front > Page 9284
Wiper Arm: Service and Repair Wiper Pivot Arm - Rear
Wiper Pivot Arm - Rear
Removal and Installation
1. NOTICE: Use a shop towel or similar device to protect the vehicle finish when carrying out the
procedure.
Remove the rear window wiper pivot arm.
- Lift the pivot arm nut cover.
- Remove the nut.
- Using a suitable 2-leg gear puller, remove the rear window wiper pivot arm.
- To install, tighten the nut to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
2. NOTE: This step makes sure that the wiper motor is in the PARK position.
Turn the rear window wiper switch ON and allow the motor to operate for at least one cycle. Turn
the rear window wiper switch to OFF.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Adjust the rear wiper pivot arm. For additional information, refer to Wiper Blade and Pivot Arm
Adjustment - Rear See: Adjustments/Wiper Blade and Pivot Arm Adjustment - Rear.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Pivot Arm - Front > Page 9285
Wiper Arm: Service and Repair Wiper Mounting Arm and Pivot Shaft - Windshield
Wiper Mounting Arm and Pivot Shaft - Windshield
Removal and Installation
NOTICE: To prevent damage to the wiper pivot arm shaft splines, do not rotate the pivot arms into
position manually.
NOTE: The windshield wiper pivot arms must be in the highest position on the windshield before
they are removed in order for the wiper mounting arm and pivot shaft assembly to be removed from
the vehicle.
1. Remove the cowl grille panel.
2. Disconnect and position the hood light harness aside.
3. NOTICE: To prevent damage to the windshield glass and hood painted surfaces, make sure to
protect the vehicle components using a
shop towel or similar device when carrying out this step.
With the aid of an assistant, remove the hood struts.
- Using a suitable method, carefully support the hood in close proximity to the windshield glass.
4. Remove the mounting arm and pivot shaft assembly.
1. Disconnect the electrical connector and position the wiring harness aside.
2. Remove the bolts.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
5. NOTE: If installing a new wiper mounting arm and pivot shaft assembly or windshield wiper
motor, it will be necessary to temporarily connect
the wiper motor electrical connector to operate the motor until the wiper motor crank has rotated
approximately 180 degrees from the PARK position (as shipped).
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Pivot Arm - Front > Page 9286
Wiper Arm: Service and Repair Striker and Wiper Pivot Shaft Assembly - Rear
Striker and Wiper Pivot Shaft Assembly - Rear
Removal
1. Remove the rear wiper pivot arm. For additional information, refer to Wiper Pivot Arm - Rear
See: Wiper Pivot Arm - Rear.
2. Remove the dust boot cover.
3. Remove the nut and the rear window glass handle.
4. Remove the nuts and the rear window striker and wiper pivot shaft assembly.
Installation
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel.
2. NOTE: An audible click should be heard as the striker engages the latch.
Push the rear window wiper striker and pivot shaft assembly into the wiper motor. The pivot shaft
pin should be aligned with the hole in the motor disc.
3. Install the rear window wiper motor alignment tool (2L1Z-14A163-AB). If installing a new rear
wiper motor, one is provided with the motor
assembly.
1. Make sure the alignment tool fits over the motor disc and striker assembly.
2. Make sure the alignment tool clips are securely engaged.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Pivot Arm - Front > Page 9287
4. Carefully close the liftgate glass.
5. Open the liftgate. Install the rear window wiper striker and wiper pivot arm mounting assembly
nuts. Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
6. Remove the rear window wiper motor alignment tool.
7. Close the liftgate.
8. Install the rear window wiper pivot shaft nut and handle. Tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
9. Install the dust boot cover.
10. NOTE: This step makes sure that the wiper motor is in the PARK position.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Pivot Arm - Front > Page 9288
Turn the rear window wiper switch ON and allow the motor to operate for at least one cycle. Turn
the rear window wiper switch to OFF.
11. Install the rear wiper pivot arm. For additional information, refer to Wiper Pivot Arm - Rear See:
Wiper Pivot Arm - Rear.
12. Open the liftgate.
13. Install the liftgate trim panel.
14. Test the liftgate and liftgate glass for normal operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Pivot Arm - Front > Page 9289
Wiper Arm: Service and Repair Wiper Mounting Arm and Pivot Shaft - Rear
Wiper Mounting Arm and Pivot Shaft - Rear
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear wiper pivot arm. For additional information, refer to Wiper Pivot Arm - Rear
See: Wiper Pivot Arm - Rear.
2. Remove the dust boot cover.
3. Remove the nut and the rear window glass handle.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
4. Open the liftgate glass.
5. Remove the nuts and the rear window wiper striker and wiper pivot shaft assembly.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
6. To install reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Locations > Windshield
Wiper Motor Assembly
Wiper Motor: Locations Windshield Wiper Motor Assembly
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Locations > Windshield
Wiper Motor Assembly > Page 9294
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Locations > Windshield
Wiper Motor Assembly > Page 9295
Wiper Motor: Locations Rear Wiper Motor Assembly
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Locations > Windshield
Wiper Motor Assembly > Page 9296
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Rear Wiper
Motor Assembly
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Rear Wiper
Motor Assembly > Page 9299
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Motor - Windshield
Wiper Motor: Service and Repair Wiper Motor - Windshield
Wiper Motor - Windshield
Removal
1. Remove the mounting arm and pivot shaft. For additional information, refer to Wiper Mounting
Arm and Pivot Shaft - Windshield See: Wiper
Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper Mounting Arm and Pivot Shaft - Windshield.
2. Remove the windshield wiper motor crank from the motor assembly.
- Remove the windshield wiper motor crank nut.
- Using a suitable 2-leg puller, remove the wiper motor crank from the wiper motor shaft.
3. Remove the 3 windshield wiper motor bolts and the wiper motor.
Installation
1. Install the windshield wiper motor to the wiper mounting arm and pivot shaft assembly.
- Install the 3 windshield wiper motor bolts and tighten to 15 Nm (133 lb-in).
2. NOTICE: A new wiper motor is shipped in the PARK position. It is important the new wiper motor
shaft position is not disturbed until
the wiper motor crank arm is installed in the following steps. Failure to follow these instructions may
result in the wiper arms not parking correctly when installed into the vehicle.
Install the supplied template (part of 17504) to the wiper mounting arm bracket as shown.
3. NOTE: The alignment marks will allow the crank to be installed correctly in the PARK position.
Using the alignment marks on the template, install the wiper motor crank arm to the wiper motor
shaft.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Motor - Windshield > Page 9302
4. NOTE: Make sure the wiper motor crank-to-wiper motor shaft alignment is not lost while
tightening the wiper motor crank nut.
Using an adjustable wrench as shown to prevent movement of the wiper motor crank, install the
windshield wiper motor crank nut and tighten to 29 Nm (21 lb-ft).
- Remove the template and discard.
5. Install the mounting arm and pivot shaft. For additional information, refer to Wiper Mounting Arm
and Pivot Shaft - Windshield See: Wiper
Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper Mounting Arm and Pivot Shaft - Windshield.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Motor - Windshield > Page 9303
Wiper Motor: Service and Repair Wiper Motor - Rear Window
Wiper Motor - Rear Window
Removal
1. Remove the rear wiper pivot arm. For additional information, refer to Wiper Pivot Arm - Rear
See: Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper Pivot
Arm - Rear.
2. Remove the dust boot cover.
3. Remove the nut and the rear window glass handle.
4. Open the liftgate glass.
5. Remove the nuts and the rear window striker and wiper pivot shaft assembly.
6. Remove the liftgate trim panel.
7. Close the liftgate.
8. If installing a new rear wiper motor, remove the liftgate window glass latch.
1. Disconnect the electrical connector.
2. Remove the bolts.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Motor - Windshield > Page 9304
9. Remove the rear window wiper motor.
1. Disconnect the electrical connector.
2. Remove the bolts.
Installation
1. If installing a new rear wiper motor, install the liftgate window glass latch.
1. Tighten bolts to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
2. NOTE: An audible click should be heard as the striker engages the latch.
Push the rear window wiper striker and pivot shaft assembly into the wiper motor. The pivot shaft
pin should be aligned with the hole in the motor disc.
3. Install the rear window wiper motor alignment tool. If installing a new rear wiper motor, one is
provided with the motor assembly.
1. Make sure the alignment tool fits over the motor disc and striker assembly.
2. Make sure the alignment tool clips are securely engaged.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Motor - Windshield > Page 9305
4. Install the rear wiper motor.
1. Tighten the bolts to 11 Nm (97 lb-in).
2. Connect the electrical connectors.
5. Carefully close the liftgate glass.
6. Open the liftgate. Install the rear window wiper striker and wiper pivot arm mounting assembly
nuts.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
7. Close the liftgate.
8. Install the rear window glass handle and nut..
- Tighten to 18 Nm (159 lb-in).
9. Install the dust boot cover.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Motor - Windshield > Page 9306
10. Install the rear wiper pivot arm. For additional information, refer to Wiper Pivot Arm - Rear See:
Wiper Arm/Service and Repair/Wiper Pivot
Arm - Rear.
11. Open the liftgate.
12. Remove the rear window wiper motor aligning tool.
13. Open the liftgate glass.
14. Install the liftgate trim panel.
15. Test the liftgate and liftgate glass for normal operation.
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 9310
Wiper Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 9311
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Locations
Wiper Switch: Locations
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9315
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9316
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9317
Wiper Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9318
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2009))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9319